Full
Full
Full
(OPENSTAX)
The LibreTexts mission is to unite students, faculty and scholars in a cooperative effort to develop an easy-to-use online platform
for the construction, customization, and dissemination of OER content to reduce the burdens of unreasonable textbook costs to our
students and society. The LibreTexts project is a multi-institutional collaborative venture to develop the next generation of open-
access texts to improve postsecondary education at all levels of higher learning by developing an Open Access Resource
environment. The project currently consists of 14 independently operating and interconnected libraries that are constantly being
optimized by students, faculty, and outside experts to supplant conventional paper-based books. These free textbook alternatives are
organized within a central environment that is both vertically (from advance to basic level) and horizontally (across different fields)
integrated.
The LibreTexts libraries are Powered by MindTouch® and are supported by the Department of Education Open Textbook Pilot
Project, the UC Davis Office of the Provost, the UC Davis Library, the California State University Affordable Learning Solutions
Program, and Merlot. This material is based upon work supported by the National Science Foundation under Grant No. 1246120,
1525057, and 1413739. Unless otherwise noted, LibreTexts content is licensed by CC BY-NC-SA 3.0.
Any opinions, findings, and conclusions or recommendations expressed in this material are those of the author(s) and do not
necessarily reflect the views of the National Science Foundation nor the US Department of Education.
Have questions or comments? For information about adoptions or adaptions contact info@LibreTexts.org. More information on our
activities can be found via Facebook (https://facebook.com/Libretexts), Twitter (https://twitter.com/libretexts), or our blog
(http://Blog.Libretexts.org).
5: Thermochemistry
5.0: Prelude to Thermochemistry
5.1: Energy Basics
5.2: Calorimetry
5.3: Enthalpy
5.E: Thermochemistry (Exercises)
1 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/182306
6: Electronic Structure and Periodic Properties
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
6.2: The Bohr Model
6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron Con gurations)
6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties
6.E: Electronic Structure and Periodic Properties (Exercises)
9: Gases
9.1: Gas Pressure
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law
9.3: Stoichiometry of Gaseous Substances, Mixtures, and Reactions
9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases
9.5: The Kinetic-Molecular Theory
9.6: Non-Ideal Gas Behavior
9.E: Gases (Exercises)
2 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/182306
11.3: Solubility
11.4: Colligative Properties
11.5: Colloids
11.E: Solutions and Colloids (Exercises)
12: Kinetics
12.0: Prelude to Kinetics
12.1: Chemical Reaction Rates
12.2: Factors Affecting Reaction Rates
12.3: Rate Laws
12.4: Integrated Rate Laws
12.5: Collision Theory
12.6: Reaction Mechanisms
12.7: Catalysis
12.E: Kinetics (Exercises)
16: Thermodynamics
16.1: Spontaneity
16.2: Entropy
16.3: The Second and Third Laws of Thermodynamics
16.4: Gibbs Energy
16.E: Thermodynamics (Exercises)
3 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/182306
17: Electrochemistry
17.1: Balancing Oxidation-Reduction Reactions
17.2: Galvanic Cells
17.3: Standard Reduction Potentials
17.4: The Nernst Equation
17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells
17.6: Corrosion
17.7: Electrolysis
17.E: Electrochemistry (Exercises)
4 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/182306
Appendices
Composition of Commercial Acids and Bases
Essential Mathematics
Formation Constants for Complex Ions
Fundamental Physical Constants
Ionization Constants of Weak Acids
Ionization Constants of Weak Bases
Solubility Products
Standard Electrode (Half-Cell) Potentials
Standard Thermodynamic Properties for Selected Substances
The Periodic Table
Units and Conversion Factors
Water Properties
Index
Glossary
Detailed Licensing
5 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/182306
Licensing
A detailed breakdown of this resource's licensing can be found in Back Matter/Detailed Licensing.
1 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/417133
CHAPTER OVERVIEW
1: Essential Ideas of Chemistry
This page titled 1: Essential Ideas of Chemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
1.1: Chemistry in Context
Learning Objectives
Outline the historical development of chemistry
Provide examples of the importance of chemistry in everyday life
Describe the scientific method and informs the scientific process
Differentiate among hypotheses, theories, and laws
Provide examples illustrating macroscopic, microscopic, and symbolic domains
Throughout human history, people have tried to convert matter into more useful forms. Our Stone Age ancestors chipped pieces of
flint into useful tools and carved wood into statues and toys. These endeavors involved changing the shape of a substance without
changing the substance itself. But as our knowledge increased, humans began to change the composition of the substances as well
—clay was converted into pottery, hides were cured to make garments, copper ores were transformed into copper tools and
weapons, and grain was made into bread.
Humans began to practice chemistry when they learned to control fire and use it to cook, make pottery, and smelt metals.
Subsequently, they began to separate and use specific components of matter. A variety of drugs such as aloe, myrrh, and opium
were isolated from plants. Dyes, such as indigo and Tyrian purple, were extracted from plant and animal matter. Metals were
combined to form alloys—for example, copper and tin were mixed together to make bronze—and more elaborate smelting
techniques produced iron. Alkalis were extracted from ashes, and soaps were prepared by combining these alkalis with fats.
Alcohol was produced by fermentation and purified by distillation.
Attempts to understand the behavior of matter extend back for more than 2500 years. As early as the sixth century BC, Greek
philosophers discussed a system in which water was the basis of all things. You may have heard of the Greek postulate that matter
consists of four elements: earth, air, fire, and water. Subsequently, an amalgamation of chemical technologies and philosophical
speculations were spread from Egypt, China, and the eastern Mediterranean by alchemists, who endeavored to transform “base
metals” such as lead into “noble metals” like gold, and to create elixirs to cure disease and extend life (Figure 1.1.1).
Figure 1.1.1 : This portrayal shows an alchemist’s workshop circa 1580. Although alchemy made some useful contributions to how
to manipulate matter, it was not scientific by modern standards. (credit: Chemical Heritage Foundation).
A sketch depicts 4 people stirring and handling chemicals. The chemicals are held in a variety of barrels and large cylinders.
Several of the containers are being heated over burning embers. A large stove in the laboratory is filled with burning embers. There
is also a large chest in the corner that is producing steam.
From alchemy came the historical progressions that led to modern chemistry: the isolation of drugs from natural sources,
metallurgy, and the dye industry. Today, chemistry continues to deepen our understanding and improve our ability to harness and
control the behavior of matter. This effort has been so successful that many people do not realize either the central position of
chemistry among the sciences or the importance and universality of chemistry in daily life.
between many subdisciplines within the two fields, such as chemical physics and nuclear chemistry. Mathematics, computer
science, and information theory provide important tools that help us calculate, interpret, describe, and generally make sense of the
chemical world. Biology and chemistry converge in biochemistry, which is crucial to understanding the many complex factors and
processes that keep living organisms (such as us) alive. Chemical engineering, materials science, and nanotechnology combine
chemical principles and empirical findings to produce useful substances, ranging from gasoline to fabrics to electronics.
Agriculture, food science, veterinary science, and brewing and wine making help provide sustenance in the form of food and drink
to the world’s population. Medicine, pharmacology, biotechnology, and botany identify and produce substances that help keep us
healthy. Environmental science, geology, oceanography, and atmospheric science incorporate many chemical ideas to help us better
understand and protect our physical world. Chemical ideas are used to help understand the universe in astronomy and cosmology.
Figure 1.1.2 : Knowledge of chemistry is central to understanding a wide range of scientific disciplines. This diagram shows just
some of the interrelationships between chemistry and other fields.
A flowchart shows a box containing chemistry at its center. Chemistry is connected to geochemistry, nuclear chemistry, chemical
physics, nanoscience and nanotechnology, materials science, chemical engineering, biochemistry and molecular biology,
environmental science, agriculture, and mathematics. Each of these disciplines is further connected to other related fields including
medicine, biology, food science, geology earth sciences, toxicology, physics, and computer science.
What are some changes in matter that are essential to daily life? Digesting and assimilating food, synthesizing polymers that are
used to make clothing, containers, cookware, and credit cards, and refining crude oil into gasoline and other products are just a few
examples. As you proceed through this course, you will discover many different examples of changes in the composition and
structure of matter, how to classify these changes and how they occurred, their causes, the changes in energy that accompany them,
and the principles and laws involved. As you learn about these things, you will be learning chemistry, the study of the composition,
properties, and interactions of matter. The practice of chemistry is not limited to chemistry books or laboratories: It happens
whenever someone is involved in changes in matter or in conditions that may lead to such changes.
In this flowchart, the observation and curiosity box has an arrow pointing to a box labeled form hypothesis; make prediction. A
curved arrow labeled next connects this box to a box labeled perform experiment; make more observations. Another arrow points
back to the box that says form hypothesis; make prediction. This arrow is labeled results not consistent with prediction. Another
arrow, labeled results are consistent with prediction points from the perform experiment box to a box labeled contributes to body of
knowledge. However, an arrow also points from contributes to body of knowledge back to the form hypothesis; make prediction
box. This arrow is labeled further testing does not support hypothesis. There are also two other arrows leading out from contributes
to body of knowledge. One arrow is labeled much additional testing yields constant observations. This leads to the observation
becomes law box. The other arrow is labeled much additional testing supports hypothesis. This arrow leads to the hypothesis
becomes theory box.
Figure 1.1.3 : The scientific method follows a process similar to the one shown in this diagram. All the key components are shown,
in roughly the right order. Scientific progress is seldom neat and clean: It requires open inquiry and the reworking of questions and
ideas in response to findings.
Figure 1.1.4 : (a) Moisture in the air, icebergs, and the ocean represent water in the macroscopic domain. (b) At the molecular level
(microscopic domain), gas molecules are far apart and disorganized, solid water molecules are close together and organized, and
liquid molecules are close together and disorganized. (c) The formula H2O symbolizes water, and (g), (s), and (l) symbolize its
phases. Note that clouds are actually comprised of either very small liquid water droplets or solid water crystals; gaseous water in
our atmosphere is not visible to the naked eye, although it may be sensed as humidity. (credit a: modification of work by
“Gorkaazk”/Wikimedia Commons).
Figure A shows a photo of an iceberg floating in a sea has three arrows. Each arrow points to figure B, which contains three
diagrams showing how the water molecules are organized in the air, ice, and sea. In the air, which contains the gaseous form of
water, H subscript 2 O gas, the water molecules are disconnected and widely spaced. In the ice, which is the solid form of water, H
subscript 2 O solid, the water molecules are bonded together into rings, with each ring containing six water molecules. Three of
these rings are connected to each other. In the sea, which is the liquid form of water, H subscript 2 O liquid, the water molecules are
very densely packed. The molecules are not bonded together.
Glossary
chemistry
study of the composition, properties, and interactions of matter
hypothesis
tentative explanation of observations that acts as a guide for gathering and checking information
law
statement that summarizes a vast number of experimental observations, and describes or predicts some aspect of the natural
world
microscopic domain
realm of things that are much too small to be sensed directly
scientific method
path of discovery that leads from question and observation to law or hypothesis to theory, combined with experimental
verification of the hypothesis and any necessary modification of the theory
symbolic domain
specialized language used to represent components of the macroscopic and microscopic domains, such as chemical symbols,
chemical formulas, chemical equations, graphs, drawings, and calculations
theory
well-substantiated, comprehensive, testable explanation of a particular aspect of nature
This page titled 1.1: Chemistry in Context is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Matter is defined as anything that occupies space and has mass, and it is all around us. Solids and liquids are more obviously
matter: We can see that they take up space, and their weight tells us that they have mass. Gases are also matter; if gases did not take
up space, a balloon would stay collapsed rather than inflate when filled with gas.
Solids, liquids, and gases are the three states of matter commonly found on earth (Figure 1.2.1). A solid is rigid and possesses a
definite shape. A liquid flows and takes the shape of a container, except that it forms a flat or slightly curved upper surface when
acted upon by gravity. (In zero gravity, liquids assume a spherical shape.) Both liquid and solid samples have volumes that are very
nearly independent of pressure. A gas takes both the shape and volume of its container.
Figure 1.2.1 : The three most common states or phases of matter are solid, liquid, and gas.
A beaker labeled solid contains a cube of red matter and says has fixed shape and volume. A beaker labeled liquid contains a
brownish-red colored liquid. This beaker says takes shape of container, forms horizontal surfaces, has fixed volume. The beaker
labeled gas is filled with a light brown gas. This beaker says expands to fill container.
A fourth state of matter, plasma, occurs naturally in the interiors of stars. A plasma is a gaseous state of matter that contains
appreciable numbers of electrically charged particles (Figure 1.2.2). The presence of these charged particles imparts unique
properties to plasmas that justify their classification as a state of matter distinct from gases. In addition to stars, plasmas are found
in some other high-temperature environments (both natural and man-made), such as lightning strikes, certain television screens,
and specialized analytical instruments used to detect trace amounts of metals.
What is Plasma?
Video 1.2.1 : In a tiny cell in a plasma television, the plasma emits ultraviolet light, which in turn causes the display at that
location to appear a specific color. The composite of these tiny dots of color makes up the image that you see. Watch this video to
learn more about plasma and the places you encounter it.
Some samples of matter appear to have properties of solids, liquids, and/or gases at the same time. This can occur when the sample
is composed of many small pieces. For example, we can pour sand as if it were a liquid because it is composed of many small
grains of solid sand. Matter can also have properties of more than one state when it is a mixture, such as with clouds. Clouds appear
to behave somewhat like gases, but they are actually mixtures of air (gas) and tiny particles of water (liquid or solid).
The mass of an object is a measure of the amount of matter in it. One way to measure an object’s mass is to measure the force it
takes to accelerate the object. It takes much more force to accelerate a car than a bicycle because the car has much more mass. A
more common way to determine the mass of an object is to use a balance to compare its mass with a standard mass.
Although weight is related to mass, it is not the same thing. Weight refers to the force that gravity exerts on an object. This force is
directly proportional to the mass of the object. The weight of an object changes as the force of gravity changes, but its mass does
not. An astronaut’s mass does not change just because she goes to the moon. But her weight on the moon is only one-sixth her
earth-bound weight because the moon’s gravity is only one-sixth that of the earth’s. She may feel “weightless” during her trip when
she experiences negligible external forces (gravitational or any other), although she is, of course, never “massless.”
The law of conservation of matter summarizes many scientific observations about matter: It states that there is no detectable
change in the total quantity of matter present when matter converts from one type to another (a chemical change) or changes
among solid, liquid, or gaseous states (a physical change). Brewing beer and the operation of batteries provide examples of the
conservation of matter (Figure 1.2.4). During the brewing of beer, the ingredients (water, yeast, grains, malt, hops, and sugar) are
converted into beer (water, alcohol, carbonation, and flavoring substances) with no actual loss of substance. This is most clearly
seen during the bottling process, when glucose turns into ethanol and carbon dioxide, and the total mass of the substances does not
change. This can also be seen in a lead-acid car battery: The original substances (lead, lead oxide, and sulfuric acid), which are
Figure 1.2.3 : (a) The mass of beer precursor materials is the same as the mass of beer produced: Sugar has become alcohol and
carbonation. (b) The mass of the lead, lead oxide plates, and sulfuric acid that goes into the production of electricity is exactly
equal to the mass of lead sulfate and water that is formed.
Diagram A shows a beer bottle containing pre-beer and sugar. An arrow points from this bottle to a second bottle. This second
bottle contains the same volume of liquid, however, the sugar has been converted into ethanol and carbonation as beer was made.
Diagram B shows a car battery that contains sheets of P B and P B O subscript 2 along with H subscript 2 S O subscript 4. After the
battery is used, it contains an equal mass of P B S O subscript 4 and H subscript 2 O.
Although this conservation law holds true for all conversions of matter, convincing examples are few and far between because,
outside of the controlled conditions in a laboratory, we seldom collect all of the material that is produced during a particular
conversion. For example, when you eat, digest, and assimilate food, all of the matter in the original food is preserved. But because
some of the matter is incorporated into your body, and much is excreted as various types of waste, it is challenging to verify by
measurement.
Figure 1.2.4 : (a) This photograph shows a gold nugget. (b) A scanning-tunneling microscope (STM) can generate views of the
surfaces of solids, such as this image of a gold crystal. Each sphere represents one gold atom. (credit a: modification of work by
United States Geological Survey; credit b: modification of work by “Erwinrossen”/Wikimedia Commons)
Figure A shows a gold nugget as it would appear to the naked eye. The gold nugget is very irregular, with many sharp edges. It
appears gold in color. The microscope image of a gold crystal shows many similarly sized gold stripes that are separated by dark
areas. Looking closely, one can see that the gold stripes are made of many, tiny, circular atoms.
The first suggestion that matter is composed of atoms is attributed to the Greek philosophers Leucippus and Democritus, who
developed their ideas in the 5th century BCE. However, it was not until the early nineteenth century that John Dalton (1766–1844),
a British schoolteacher with a keen interest in science, supported this hypothesis with quantitative measurements. Since that time,
repeated experiments have confirmed many aspects of this hypothesis, and it has become one of the central theories of chemistry.
Figure 1.2.5 : These images provide an increasingly closer view: (a) a cotton boll, (b) a single cotton fiber viewed under an optical
microscope (magnified 40 times), (c) an image of a cotton fiber obtained with an electron microscope (much higher magnification
than with the optical microscope); and (d and e) atomic-level models of the fiber (spheres of different colors represent atoms of
different elements). (credit c: modification of work by “Featheredtar”/Wikimedia Commons)
Figure A shows a puffy white cotton boll growing on a brown twig. Figure B shows a magnified cotton strand. The strand appears
transparent but contains dark areas within its interior. Figure C shows the surface of several crisscrossing and overlapping cotton
fibers. Its surface is rough along the edges but smooth near the center of each strand. Figure D shows three strands of molecules
connected into three vertical chains. Each strand contains about five molecules. Figure E shows that the cotton molecule contains
about a dozen atoms. The black carbon atoms form rings that are connected by red oxygen atoms. Many of the carbon atoms are
also bonded to hydrogen atoms, shown as white balls, or other oxygen atoms.
An atom is so light that its mass is also difficult to imagine. A billion lead atoms (1,000,000,000 atoms) weigh about 3 × 10 −13
grams, a mass that is far too light to be weighed on even the world’s most sensitive balances. It would require over
300,000,000,000,000 lead atoms (300 trillion, or 3 × 1014) to be weighed, and they would weigh only 0.0000001 gram.
It is rare to find collections of individual atoms. Only a few elements, such as the gases helium, neon, and argon, consist of a
collection of individual atoms that move about independently of one another. Other elements, such as the gases hydrogen, nitrogen,
oxygen, and chlorine, are composed of units that consist of pairs of atoms (Figure 1.2.6). One form of the element phosphorus
consists of units composed of four phosphorus atoms. The element sulfur exists in various forms, one of which consists of units
composed of eight sulfur atoms. These units are called molecules. A molecule consists of two or more atoms joined by strong
forces called chemical bonds. The atoms in a molecule move around as a unit, much like the cans of soda in a six-pack or a bunch
of keys joined together on a single key ring. A molecule may consist of two or more identical atoms, as in the molecules found in
the elements hydrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, or it may consist of two or more different atoms, as in the molecules found in water.
Each water molecule is a unit that contains two hydrogen atoms and one oxygen atom. Each glucose molecule is a unit that
contains 6 carbon atoms, 12 hydrogen atoms, and 6 oxygen atoms. Like atoms, molecules are incredibly small and light. If an
ordinary glass of water were enlarged to the size of the earth, the water molecules inside it would be about the size of golf balls.
Figure 1.2.7 : (a)The compound mercury(II) oxide, (b)when heated, (c) decomposes into silvery droplets of liquid mercury and
invisible oxygen gas. (credit: modification of work by Paul Flowers)
This figure shows a series of three photos labeled a, b, and c. Photo a shows the bottom of a test tube that is filled with an orange-
red substance. A slight amount of a silver substance is also visible. Photo b shows the substance in the test tube being heated over a
flame. Photo c shows a test tube that is not longer being heated. The orange-red substance is almost completely gone, and small,
silver droplets of a substance are left.
The properties of combined elements are different from those in the free, or uncombined, state. For example, white crystalline
sugar (sucrose) is a compound resulting from the chemical combination of the element carbon, which is a black solid in one of its
uncombined forms, and the two elements hydrogen and oxygen, which are colorless gases when uncombined. Free sodium, an
element that is a soft, shiny, metallic solid, and free chlorine, an element that is a yellow-green gas, combine to form sodium
chloride (table salt), a compound that is a white, crystalline solid.
Figure 1.2.7 : (a) Oil and vinegar salad dressing is a heterogeneous mixture because its composition is not uniform throughout. (b)
A commercial sports drink is a homogeneous mixture because its composition is uniform throughout. (credit a “left”: modification
of work by John Mayer; credit a “right”: modification of work by Umberto Salvagnin; credit b “left: modification of work by Jeff
Bedford)
Diagram A shows a glass containing a red liquid with a layer of yellow oil floating on the surface of the red liquid. A zoom in box
is magnifying a portion of the red liquid that contains some of the yellow oil. The zoomed in image shows that oil is forming round
droplets within the red liquid. Diagram B shows a photo of Gatorade G 2. A zoom in box is magnifying a portion of the Gatorade,
which is uniformly red.
Although there are just over 100 elements, tens of millions of chemical compounds result from different combinations of these
elements. Each compound has a specific composition and possesses definite chemical and physical properties by which we can
distinguish it from all other compounds. And, of course, there are innumerable ways to combine elements and compounds to form
different mixtures. A summary of how to distinguish between the various major classifications of matter is shown in (Figure 1.2.8).
Figure 1.2.8 : Depending on its properties, a given substance can be classified as a homogeneous mixture, a heterogeneous mixture,
a compound, or an element.
This flow chart begins with matter at the top and the question: does the matter have constant properties and composition? If no,
then it is a mixture. This leads to the next question: is it uniform throughout? If no, it is heterogeneous. If yes, it is homogenous. If
the matter does have constant properties and composition, it is a pure substance. This leads to the next question: can it be simplified
chemically? If no, it is an element. If yes, then it is a compound.
Eleven elements make up about 99% of the earth’s crust and atmosphere (Table 1.2.1). Oxygen constitutes nearly one-half and
silicon about one-quarter of the total quantity of these elements. A majority of elements on earth are found in chemical
combinations with other elements; about one-quarter of the elements are also found in the free state.
Table 1.2.1 : Elemental Composition of Earth
Element Symbol Percent Mass Element Symbol Percent Mass
Figure 1.2.9 : The decomposition of water is shown at the macroscopic, microscopic, and symbolic levels. The battery provides an
electric current (microscopic) that decomposes water. At the macroscopic level, the liquid separates into the gases hydrogen (on the
left) and oxygen (on the right). Symbolically, this change is presented by showing how liquid H2O separates into H2 and O2 gases.
A rectangular battery is immersed in a beaker filled with liquid. Each of the battery terminals are covered by an overturned test
tube. The test tubes each contain a bubbling liquid. Zoom in areas indicate that the liquid in the beaker is water, 2 H subscript 2 O
liquid. The bubbles in the test tube over the negative terminal are hydrogen gas, 2 H subscript 2 gas. The bubbles in the test tube
over the positive terminal are oxygen gas, O subscript 2 gas.
The breakdown of water involves a rearrangement of the atoms in water molecules into different molecules, each composed of two
hydrogen atoms and two oxygen atoms, respectively. Two water molecules form one oxygen molecule and two hydrogen
molecules. The representation for what occurs, 2 H O(l) → 2 H (g) + O (g) , will be explored in more depth in later chapters.
2 2 2
The two gases produced have distinctly different properties. Oxygen is not flammable but is required for combustion of a fuel, and
hydrogen is highly flammable and a potent energy source. How might this knowledge be applied in our world? One application
involves research into more fuel-efficient transportation. Fuel-cell vehicles (FCV) run on hydrogen instead of gasoline (Figure
1.2.10). They are more efficient than vehicles with internal combustion engines, are nonpolluting, and reduce greenhouse gas
emissions, making us less dependent on fossil fuels. FCVs are not yet economically viable, however, and current hydrogen
production depends on natural gas. If we can develop a process to economically decompose water, or produce hydrogen in another
environmentally sound way, FCVs may be the way of the future.
Figure 1.2.11 : Almost one-third of naturally occurring elements are used to make a modern cell phone. (credit: modification of
work by John Taylor)
A cell phone is labeled to show what its components are made of. The case components are made of polymers such as A B S and or
metals such as aluminum, iron, and magnesium. The processor components are made of silicon, common metals such as copper, tin
and gold, and uncommon elements such as yttrium and gadolinium. The screen components are made of silicon oxide, also known
as glass. The glass is strengthened by the addition of aluminum, sodium, and potassium. The battery components contain lithium
combined with other metals such as cobalt, iron, and copper.
Glossary
atom
smallest particle of an element that can enter into a chemical combination
compound
pure substance that can be decomposed into two or more elements
element
substance that is composed of a single type of atom; a substance that cannot be decomposed by a chemical change
gas
state in which matter has neither definite volume nor shape
heterogeneous mixture
combination of substances with a composition that varies from point to point
homogeneous mixture
(also, solution) combination of substances with a composition that is uniform throughout
liquid
state of matter that has a definite volume but indefinite shape
mass
fundamental property indicating amount of matter
matter
anything that occupies space and has mass
mixture
matter that can be separated into its components by physical means
molecule
bonded collection of two or more atoms of the same or different elements
plasma
gaseous state of matter containing a large number of electrically charged atoms and/or molecules
pure substance
homogeneous substance that has a constant composition
weight
force that gravity exerts on an object
This page titled 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The characteristics that enable us to distinguish one substance from another are called properties. A physical property is a
characteristic of matter that is not associated with a change in its chemical composition. Familiar examples of physical properties
include density, color, hardness, melting and boiling points, and electrical conductivity. We can observe some physical properties,
such as density and color, without changing the physical state of the matter observed. Other physical properties, such as the melting
temperature of iron or the freezing temperature of water, can only be observed as matter undergoes a physical change. A physical
change is a change in the state or properties of matter without any accompanying change in its chemical composition (the identities
of the substances contained in the matter). We observe a physical change when wax melts, when sugar dissolves in coffee, and
when steam condenses into liquid water (Figure 1.3.1). Other examples of physical changes include magnetizing and
demagnetizing metals (as is done with common antitheft security tags) and grinding solids into powders (which can sometimes
yield noticeable changes in color). In each of these examples, there is a change in the physical state, form, or properties of the
substance, but no change in its chemical composition.
Figure 1.3.1 : (a) Wax undergoes a physical change when solid wax is heated and forms liquid wax. (b) Steam condensing inside a
cooking pot is a physical change, as water vapor is changed into liquid water. (credit a: modification of work by
“95jb14”/Wikimedia Commons; credit b: modification of work by “mjneuby”/Flickr).
The change of one type of matter into another type (or the inability to change) is a chemical property. Examples of chemical
properties include flammability, toxicity, acidity, reactivity (many types), and heat of combustion. Iron, for example, combines with
oxygen in the presence of water to form rust; chromium does not oxidize (Figure 1.3.2). Nitroglycerin is very dangerous because it
explodes easily; neon poses almost no hazard because it is very unreactive.
Figure 1.3.2 : (a) One of the chemical properties of iron is that it rusts; (b) one of the chemical properties of chromium is that it
does not. (credit a: modification of work by Tony Hisgett; credit b: modification of work by “Atoma”/Wikimedia Commons)
Comparison of two metal equipments. The first image shows a rusted brown appearance and the following image shows a shiny
metallic appearance.
Figure 1.3.3 : (a) Copper and nitric acid undergo a chemical change to form copper nitrate and brown, gaseous nitrogen dioxide. (b)
During the combustion of a match, cellulose in the match and oxygen from the air undergo a chemical change to form carbon
dioxide and water vapor. (c) Cooking red meat causes a number of chemical changes, including the oxidation of iron in myoglobin
that results in the familiar red-to-brown color change. (d) A banana turning brown is a chemical change as new, darker (and less
tasty) substances form. (credit b: modification of work by Jeff Turner; credit c: modification of work by Gloria Cabada-Leman;
credit d: modification of work by Roberto Verzo)
Four pictures. A. a flask with copper wires placed in a blue solution and also the presence of a gas. B. A lighted match. C. meat
cubes being cooked on a pan. D. Bananas forming black spots on its peel.
Properties of matter fall into one of two categories. If the property depends on the amount of matter present, it is an extensive
property. The mass and volume of a substance are examples of extensive properties; for instance, a gallon of milk has a larger mass
and volume than a cup of milk. The value of an extensive property is directly proportional to the amount of matter in question. If
the property of a sample of matter does not depend on the amount of matter present, it is an intensive property. Temperature is an
example of an intensive property. If the gallon and cup of milk are each at 20 °C (room temperature), when they are combined, the
temperature remains at 20 °C. As another example, consider the distinct but related properties of heat and temperature. A drop of
hot cooking oil spattered on your arm causes brief, minor discomfort, whereas a pot of hot oil yields severe burns. Both the drop
and the pot of oil are at the same temperature (an intensive property), but the pot clearly contains much more heat (extensive
property).
Summary
All substances have distinct physical and chemical properties, and may undergo physical or chemical changes. Physical properties,
such as hardness and boiling point, and physical changes, such as melting or freezing, do not involve a change in the composition
of matter. Chemical properties, such flammability and acidity, and chemical changes, such as rusting, involve production of matter
that differs from that present beforehand.
Measurable properties fall into one of two categories. Extensive properties depend on the amount of matter present, for example,
the mass of gold. Intensive properties do not depend on the amount of matter present, for example, the density of gold. Heat is an
example of an extensive property, and temperature is an example of an intensive property.
Glossary
chemical change
change producing a different kind of matter from the original kind of matter
chemical property
behavior that is related to the change of one kind of matter into another kind of matter
extensive property
property of a substance that depends on the amount of the substance
intensive property
property of a substance that is independent of the amount of the substance
physical change
change in the state or properties of matter that does not involve a change in its chemical composition
physical property
This page titled 1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Measurements provide the macroscopic information that is the basis of most of the hypotheses, theories, and laws that describe the
behavior of matter and energy in both the macroscopic and microscopic domains of chemistry. Every measurement provides three
kinds of information: the size or magnitude of the measurement (a number); a standard of comparison for the measurement (a unit);
and an indication of the uncertainty of the measurement. While the number and unit are explicitly represented when a quantity is
written, the uncertainty is an aspect of the measurement result that is more implicitly represented and will be discussed later.
The number in the measurement can be represented in different ways, including decimal form and scientific notation. For example,
the maximum takeoff weight of a Boeing 777-200ER airliner is 298,000 kilograms, which can also be written as 2.98 × 105 kg.
The mass of the average mosquito is about 0.0000025 kilograms, which can be written as 2.5 × 10−6 kg.
Units, such as liters, pounds, and centimeters, are standards of comparison for measurements. When we buy a 2-liter bottle of a soft
drink, we expect that the volume of the drink was measured, so it is two times larger than the volume that everyone agrees to be 1
liter. The meat used to prepare a 0.25-pound hamburger is measured so it weighs one-fourth as much as 1 pound. Without units, a
number can be meaningless, confusing, or possibly life threatening. Suppose a doctor prescribes phenobarbital to control a patient’s
seizures and states a dosage of “100” without specifying units. Not only will this be confusing to the medical professional giving
the dose, but the consequences can be dire: 100 mg given three times per day can be effective as an anticonvulsant, but a single
dose of 100 g is more than 10 times the lethal amount.
We usually report the results of scientific measurements in SI units, an updated version of the metric system, using the units listed
in Table 1.4.1. Other units can be derived from these base units. The standards for these units are fixed by international agreement,
and they are called the International System of Units or SI Units (from the French, Le Système International d’Unités). SI units
have been used by the United States National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) since 1964.
Table 1.4.1 : Base Units of the SI System
Property Measured Name of Unit Symbol of Unit
length meter m
mass kilogram kg
time second s
temperature kelvin K
Sometimes we use units that are fractions or multiples of a base unit. Ice cream is sold in quarts (a familiar, non-SI base unit), pints
(0.5 quart), or gallons (4 quarts). We also use fractions or multiples of units in the SI system, but these fractions or multiples are
always powers of 10. Fractional or multiple SI units are named using a prefix and the name of the base unit. For example, a length
of 1000 meters is also called a kilometer because the prefix kilo means “one thousand,” which in scientific notation is 103 (1
kilometer = 1000 m = 103 m). The prefixes used and the powers to which 10 are raised are listed in Table 1.4.2.
NG, equals 4 times ten to the negative 9, or 0.000000004 g. The prefix micro has the greek letter mu as its symbol and a factor of
10 to the negative sixth power. Therefore, 1 microliter, or mu L, is equal to one times ten to the negative 6 or 0.000001 L. The
prefix milli has a lowercase M as its symbol and a factor of 10 to the negative third power. Therefore, 2 millimoles, or M mol, are
equal to two times ten to the negative 3 or 0.002 mol. The prefix centi has a lowercase C as its symbol and a factor of 10 to the
1.4.1.1: Length
The standard unit of length in both the SI and original metric systems is the meter (m). A meter was originally specified as
1/10,000,000 of the distance from the North Pole to the equator. It is now defined as the distance light in a vacuum travels in
1/299,792,458 of a second. A meter is about 3 inches longer than a yard (Figure 1.4.1); one meter is about 39.37 inches or 1.094
yards. Longer distances are often reported in kilometers (1 km = 1000 m = 103 m), whereas shorter distances can be reported in
centimeters (1 cm = 0.01 m = 10−2 m) or millimeters (1 mm = 0.001 m = 10−3 m).
1.4.1.2: Mass
The standard unit of mass in the SI system is the kilogram (kg). A kilogram was originally defined as the mass of a liter of water (a
cube of water with an edge length of exactly 0.1 meter). It is now defined by a certain cylinder of platinum-iridium alloy, which is
kept in France (Figure 1.4.2). Any object with the same mass as this cylinder is said to have a mass of 1 kilogram. One kilogram is
about 2.2 pounds. The gram (g) is exactly equal to 1/1000 of the mass of the kilogram (10−3 kg).
Figure 1.4.2 : This replica prototype kilogram is housed at the National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) in Maryland.
(credit: National Institutes of Standards and Technology).
1.4.1.3: Temperature
Temperature is an intensive property. The SI unit of temperature is the kelvin (K). The IUPAC convention is to use kelvin (all
lowercase) for the word, K (uppercase) for the unit symbol, and neither the word “degree” nor the degree symbol (°). The degree
Celsius (°C) is also allowed in the SI system, with both the word “degree” and the degree symbol used for Celsius measurements.
Celsius degrees are the same magnitude as those of kelvin, but the two scales place their zeros in different places. Water freezes at
273.15 K (0 °C) and boils at 373.15 K (100 °C) by definition, and normal human body temperature is approximately 310 K (37
°C). The conversion between these two units and the Fahrenheit scale will be discussed later in this chapter.
1.4.1.4: Time
The SI base unit of time is the second (s). Small and large time intervals can be expressed with the appropriate prefixes; for
example, 3 microseconds = 0.000003 s = 3 × 10−6 and 5 megaseconds = 5,000,000 s = 5 × 106 s. Alternatively, hours, days, and
years can be used.
Figure 1.4.3 : (a) The relative volumes are shown for cubes of 1 m3, 1 dm3 (1 L), and 1 cm3 (1 mL) (not to scale). (b) The diameter
of a dime is compared relative to the edge length of a 1-cm3 (1-mL) cube.
A more commonly used unit of volume is derived from the decimeter (0.1 m, or 10 cm). A cube with edge lengths of exactly one
decimeter contains a volume of one cubic decimeter (dm3). A liter (L) is the more common name for the cubic decimeter. One liter
is about 1.06 quarts. A cubic centimeter (cm3) is the volume of a cube with an edge length of exactly one centimeter. The
abbreviation cc (for cubic centimeter) is often used by health professionals. A cubic centimeter is also called a milliliter (mL) and is
1/1000 of a liter.
1.4.2.2: Density
We use the mass and volume of a substance to determine its density. Thus, the units of density are defined by the base units of mass
and length.
The density of a substance is the ratio of the mass of a sample of the substance to its volume. The SI unit for density is the kilogram
per cubic meter (kg/m3). For many situations, however, this as an inconvenient unit, and we often use grams per cubic centimeter
(g/cm3) for the densities of solids and liquids, and grams per liter (g/L) for gases. Although there are exceptions, most liquids and
solids have densities that range from about 0.7 g/cm3 (the density of gasoline) to 19 g/cm3 (the density of gold). The density of air
is about 1.2 g/L. Table 1.4.3 shows the densities of some common substances.
Table 1.4.3 : Densities of Common Substances
Solids Liquids Gases (at 25 °C and 1 atm)
ice (at 0 °C) 0.92 g/cm3 water 1.0 g/cm3 dry air 1.20 g/L
oak (wood) 0.60–0.90 g/cm3 ethanol 0.79 g/cm3 oxygen 1.31 g/L
copper 9.0 g/cm3 glycerin 1.26 g/cm3 carbon dioxide 1.80 g/L
lead 11.3 g/cm3 olive oil 0.92 g/cm3 helium 0.16 g/L
While there are many ways to determine the density of an object, perhaps the most straightforward method involves separately
finding the mass and volume of the object, and then dividing the mass of the sample by its volume. In the following example, the
mass is found directly by weighing, but the volume is found indirectly through length measurements.
mass
density =
volume
Calculation of Density Gold—in bricks, bars, and coins—has been a form of currency for centuries. In order to swindle people
into paying for a brick of gold without actually investing in a brick of gold, people have considered filling the centers of
hollow gold bricks with lead to fool buyers into thinking that the entire brick is gold. It does not work: Lead is a dense
substance, but its density is not as great as that of gold, 19.3 g/cm3. What is the density of lead if a cube of lead has an edge
length of 2.00 cm and a mass of 90.7 g?
Solution
The density of a substance can be calculated by dividing its mass by its volume. The volume of a cube is calculated by cubing
the edge length.
3
volume of lead cube = 2.00 cm × 2.00 cm × 2.00 cm = 8.00 cm
(We will discuss the reason for rounding to the first decimal place in the next section.)
Exercise 1.4.1
a. To three decimal places, what is the volume of a cube (cm3) with an edge length of 0.843 cm?
b. If the cube in part (a) is copper and has a mass of 5.34 g, what is the density of copper to two decimal places?
Answer a
0.599 cm3;
Answer b
8.91 g/cm3
This PhET simulation illustrates another way to determine density, using displacement of water. Determine the density of the
red and yellow blocks.
Solution
When you open the density simulation and select Same Mass, you can choose from several 5.00-kg colored blocks that you can
drop into a tank containing 100.00 L water. The yellow block floats (it is less dense than water), and the water level rises to
105.00 L. While floating, the yellow block displaces 5.00 L water, an amount equal to the weight of the block. The red block
sinks (it is more dense than water, which has density = 1.00 kg/L), and the water level rises to 101.25 L.
The red block therefore displaces 1.25 L water, an amount equal to the volume of the block. The density of the red block is:
mass 5.00 kg
density = = = 4.00 kg/L
volume 1.25 L
Note that since the yellow block is not completely submerged, you cannot determine its density from this information. But if
you hold the yellow block on the bottom of the tank, the water level rises to 110.00 L, which means that it now displaces 10.00
L water, and its density can be found:
mass 5.00 kg
density = = = 0.500 kg/L
volume 10.00 L
Remove all of the blocks from the water and add the green block to the tank of water, placing it approximately in the middle of
the tank. Determine the density of the green block.
Answer
2.00 kg/L
Summary
Measurements provide quantitative information that is critical in studying and practicing chemistry. Each measurement has an
amount, a unit for comparison, and an uncertainty. Measurements can be represented in either decimal or scientific notation.
Scientists primarily use the SI (International System) or metric systems. We use base SI units such as meters, seconds, and
kilograms, as well as derived units, such as liters (for volume) and g/cm3 (for density). In many cases, we find it convenient to use
unit prefixes that yield fractional and multiple units, such as microseconds (10−6 seconds) and megahertz (106 hertz), respectively.
Glossary
Celsius (°C)
unit of temperature; water freezes at 0 °C and boils at 100 °C on this scale
density
ratio of mass to volume for a substance or object
kelvin (K)
SI unit of temperature; 273.15 K = 0 ºC
kilogram (kg)
standard SI unit of mass; 1 kg = approximately 2.2 pounds
length
measure of one dimension of an object
liter (L)
(also, cubic decimeter) unit of volume; 1 L = 1,000 cm3
meter (m)
standard metric and SI unit of length; 1 m = approximately 1.094 yards
milliliter (mL)
1/1,000 of a liter; equal to 1 cm3
second (s)
SI unit of time
unit
standard of comparison for measurements
volume
amount of space occupied by an object
This page titled 1.4: Measurements is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Counting is the only type of measurement that is free from uncertainty, provided the number of objects being counted does not
change while the counting process is underway. The result of such a counting measurement is an example of an exact number. If
we count eggs in a carton, we know exactly how many eggs the carton contains. The numbers of defined quantities are also exact.
By definition, 1 foot is exactly 12 inches, 1 inch is exactly 2.54 centimeters, and 1 gram is exactly 0.001 kilogram. Quantities
derived from measurements other than counting, however, are uncertain to varying extents due to practical limitations of the
measurement process used.
Figure 1.5.1 : To measure the volume of liquid in this graduated cylinder, you must mentally subdivide the distance between the 21
and 22 mL marks into tenths of a milliliter, and then make a reading (estimate) at the bottom of the meniscus.
A 25 millilter graduated cylinder filled with liquid. The markings on the cylinders is zoomed in to show the bottom of the meniscus
between 21 and 22 milliliters.
Refer to the illustration in Figure 1.5.1. The bottom of the meniscus in this case clearly lies between the 21 and 22 markings,
meaning the liquid volume is certainly greater than 21 mL but less than 22 mL. The meniscus appears to be a bit closer to the 22-
mL mark than to the 21-mL mark, and so a reasonable estimate of the liquid’s volume would be 21.6 mL. In the number 21.6, then,
the digits 2 and 1 are certain, but the 6 is an estimate. Some people might estimate the meniscus position to be equally distant from
each of the markings and estimate the tenth-place digit as 5, while others may think it to be even closer to the 22-mL mark and
estimate this digit to be 7. Note that it would be pointless to attempt to estimate a digit for the hundredths place, given that the
tenths-place digit is uncertain. In general, numerical scales such as the one on this graduated cylinder will permit measurements to
one-tenth of the smallest scale division. The scale in this case has 1-mL divisions, and so volumes may be measured to the nearest
0.1 mL.
The left diagram uses the example of 3090. The zero in the hundreds place is labeled “captive” and the zero in the ones place is
labeled trailing. The right diagram uses the example 0.008020. The three zeros in the ones, tenths, and hundredths places are
labeled “leading.” The zero in the ten-thousandths place is labeled “captive” and the zero in the millionths place is labeled
“trailing.”
Starting with the first nonzero digit on the left, count this digit and all remaining digits to the right. This is the number of
significant figures in the measurement unless the last digit is a trailing zero lying to the left of the decimal point.
The left diagram uses the example of 1267 meters. The number 1 is the first nonzero figure on the left. 1267 has 4 significant
figures in total. The right diagram uses the example of 55.0 grams. The number 5 in the tens place is the first nonzero figure on the
left. 55.0 has 3 significant figures. Note that the 0 is to the right of the decimal point and therefore is a significant figure.
Captive zeros result from measurement and are therefore always significant. Leading zeros, however, are never significant—they
merely tell us where the decimal point is located.
The left diagram uses the example of 70.607 milliliters. The number 7 is the first nonzero figure on the left. 70.607 has 5
significant figures in total, as all figures are measured including the 2 zeros. The right diagram uses the example of 0.00832407 M
L. The number 8 is the first nonzero figure on the left. 0.00832407 has 6 significant figures.
The leading zeros in this example are not significant. We could use exponential notation (as described in Appendix B) and express
the number as 8.32407 × 10−3; then the number 8.32407 contains all of the significant figures, and 10−3 locates the decimal point.
The number of significant figures is uncertain in a number that ends with a zero to the left of the decimal point location. The zeros
in the measurement 1,300 grams could be significant or they could simply indicate where the decimal point is located. The
ambiguity can be resolved with the use of exponential notation: 1.3 × 103 (two significant figures), 1.30 × 103 (three significant
figures, if the tens place was measured), or 1.300 × 103 (four significant figures, if the ones place was also measured). In cases
where only the decimal-formatted number is available, it is prudent to assume that all trailing zeros are not significant.
Solution
a. 31.57 rounds “up” to 32 (the dropped digit is 5, and the retained digit is even)
b. 8.1649 rounds “down” to 8.16 (the dropped digit, 4, is less than 5)
c. 0.051065 rounds “down” to 0.05106 (the dropped digit is 5, and the retained digit is even)
d. 0.90275 rounds “up” to 0.9028 (the dropped digit is 5, and the retained digit is even)
Answer a
0.42
Answer b
0.00387
Answer c
421.2
Answer d
28,684
When we add or subtract numbers, we should round the result to the same number of decimal places as the number with the
least number of decimal places (i.e., the least precise value in terms of addition and subtraction).
a. Add 1.0023 g and 4.383 g.
b. Subtract 421.23 g from 486 g.
Solution
(a)
1.0023 g
+ 4.383 g
––––––––
5.3853 g
− 421.23 g
––––––––
64.77 g
Answer a
2.64 mL
Answer b
0.658 m
Rule: When we multiply or divide numbers, we should round the result to the same number of digits as the number with the
least number of significant figures (the least precise value in terms of multiplication and division).
a. Multiply 0.6238 cm by 6.6 cm.
b. Divide 421.23 g by 486 mL.
Solution
(a)
2 2
0.6238 cm × 6.6 cm = 4.11708 cm → result is 4.1 cm (round to two significant figures)
four significant figures × two significant figures → two significant figures answer
(b)
421.23 g
= 0.86728... g/mL → result is 0.867 g/mL (round to three significant figures)
486 mL
Exercise 1.5.3
a. Multiply 2.334 cm and 0.320 cm.
b. Divide 55.8752 m by 56.53 s.
Answer a
0.747 cm2
Answer b
0.9884 m/s
In the midst of all these technicalities, it is important to keep in mind the reason why we use significant figures and rounding rules
—to correctly represent the certainty of the values we report and to ensure that a calculated result is not represented as being more
certain than the least certain value used in the calculation.
One common bathtub is 13.44 dm long, 5.920 dm wide, and 2.54 dm deep. Assume that the tub is rectangular and calculate its
approximate volume in liters.
3
= 202 dm , or 202 L (answer rounded to three significant figures)
What is the density of a liquid with a mass of 31.1415 g and a volume of 30.13 cm3?
Answer
1.034 g/mL
Example 1.5.4
A piece of rebar is weighed and then submerged in a graduated cylinder partially filled with water, with results as shown.
A graduated cylinder filled with liquid is shown. One shows the level before the rebar is added and the other shows the level
with the rebar submerged in the liquid. Rebar mass is 69.658 grams, final volume is 22.4 milliliters, and initial volume is 13.5
milliliters.
a. Use these values to determine the density of this piece of rebar.
b. Rebar is mostly iron. Does your result in (a) support this statement? How?
Solution
The volume of the piece of rebar is equal to the volume of the water displaced:
3
volume = 22.4 mL − 13.5 mL = 8.9 mL = 8.9 cm
(rounded to the nearest 0.1 mL, per the rule for addition and subtraction)
The density is the mass-to-volume ratio:
mass 69.658 g
3
density = = = 7.8 g/cm
3
volume 8.9 cm
(rounded to two significant figures, per the rule for multiplication and division)
The density of iron is 7.9 g/cm3, very close to that of rebar, which lends some support to the fact that rebar is mostly iron.
A graduated cylinder filled with liquid is shown. One shows the level before the material is added and the other shows the level
with the material submerged in the liquid. Mass is 51.842 grams, final volume is 19.8 milliliters, and initial volume is 17.1
milliliters.
a. Use these values to determine the density of this material.
b. Do you have any reasonable guesses as to the identity of this material? Explain your reasoning.
Answer a
19 g/cm3
Answer b
It is likely gold; it has the right appearance for gold and very close to the density given for gold.
Figure 1.5.2 : (a) These arrows are close to both the bull’s eye and one another, so they are both accurate and precise. (b) These
arrows are close to one another but not on target, so they are precise but not accurate. (c) These arrows are neither on target nor
close to one another, so they are neither accurate nor precise.
Suppose a quality control chemist at a pharmaceutical company is tasked with checking the accuracy and precision of three
different machines that are meant to dispense 10 ounces (296 mL) of cough syrup into storage bottles. She proceeds to use each
Table 1.5.2 : Volume (mL) of Cough Medicine Delivered by 10-oz (296 mL) Dispensers
Dispenser #1 Dispenser #2 Dispenser #3
Considering these results, she will report that dispenser #1 is precise (values all close to one another, within a few tenths of a
milliliter) but not accurate (none of the values are close to the target value of 296 mL, each being more than 10 mL too low).
Results for dispenser #2 represent improved accuracy (each volume is less than 3 mL away from 296 mL) but worse precision
(volumes vary by more than 4 mL). Finally, she can report that dispenser #3 is working well, dispensing cough syrup both
accurately (all volumes within 0.1 mL of the target volume) and precisely (volumes differing from each other by no more than 0.2
mL).
Summary
Quantities can be exact or measured. Measured quantities have an associated uncertainty that is represented by the number of
significant figures in the measurement. The uncertainty of a calculated value depends on the uncertainties in the values used in the
calculation and is reflected in how the value is rounded. Measured values can be accurate (close to the true value) and/or precise
(showing little variation when measured repeatedly).
Glossary
uncertainty
estimate of amount by which measurement differs from true value
significant figures
(also, significant digits) all of the measured digits in a determination, including the uncertain last digit
rounding
procedure used to ensure that calculated results properly reflect the uncertainty in the measurements used in the calculation
precision
how closely a measurement matches the same measurement when repeated
exact number
number derived by counting or by definition
accuracy
how closely a measurement aligns with a correct value
This page titled 1.5: Measurement Uncertainty, Accuracy, and Precision is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
It is often the case that a quantity of interest may not be easy (or even possible) to measure directly but instead must be calculated from other directly measured properties and appropriate
mathematical relationships. For example, consider measuring the average speed of an athlete running sprints. This is typically accomplished by measuring the time required for the athlete to run from
the starting line to the finish line, and the distance between these two lines, and then computing speed from the equation that relates these three properties:
distance
speed =
time
Note that this simple arithmetic involves dividing the numbers of each measured quantity to yield the number of the computed quantity (100/10 = 10) and likewise dividing the units of each measured
quantity to yield the unit of the computed quantity (m/s = m/s). Now, consider using this same relation to predict the time required for a person running at this speed to travel a distance of 25 m. The
same relation between the three properties is used, but in this case, the two quantities provided are a speed (10 m/s) and a distance (25 m). To yield the sought property, time, the equation must be
rearranged appropriately:
distance
time =
speed
Again, arithmetic on the numbers (25/10 = 2.5) was accompanied by the same arithmetic on the units (m/m/s = s) to yield the number and unit of the result, 2.5 s. Note that, just as for numbers, when
a unit is divided by an identical unit (in this case, m/m), the result is “1”—or, as commonly phrased, the units “cancel.”
These calculations are examples of a versatile mathematical approach known as dimensional analysis (or the factor-label method). Dimensional analysis is based on this premise: the units of quantities
must be subjected to the same mathematical operations as their associated numbers. This method can be applied to computations ranging from simple unit conversions to more complex, multi-step
calculations involving several different quantities.
Several other commonly used conversion factors are given in Table 1.6.1.
Table 1.6.1 : Common Conversion Factors
Length Volume Mass
When we multiply a quantity (such as distance given in inches) by an appropriate unit conversion factor, we convert the quantity to an equivalent value with different units (such as distance in
centimeters). For example, a basketball player’s vertical jump of 34 inches can be converted to centimeters by:
2.54 cm
34 in. × = 86 cm
1 in.
Since this simple arithmetic involves quantities, the premise of dimensional analysis requires that we multiply both numbers and units. The numbers of these two quantities are multiplied to yield the
number of the product quantity, 86, whereas the units are multiplied to yield
in. ×cm
.
in.
Just as for numbers, a ratio of identical units is also numerically equal to one,
in.
=1
in.
and the unit product thus simplifies to cm. (When identical units divide to yield a factor of 1, they are said to “cancel.”) Using dimensional analysis, we can determine that a unit conversion factor has
been set up correctly by checking to confirm that the original unit will cancel, and the result will contain the sought (converted) unit.
Solution
If we have the conversion factor, we can determine the mass in kilograms using an equation similar the one used for converting length from inches to centimeters.
The correct unit conversion factor is the ratio that cancels the units of grams and leaves ounces.
1 oz
x oz = 125 g ×
28.349 g
125
=( ) oz
28.349
Exercise 1.6.1
Convert a volume of 9.345 qt to liters.
Answer
8.844 L
Beyond simple unit conversions, the factor-label method can be used to solve more complex problems involving computations. Regardless of the details, the basic approach is the same—all the
factors involved in the calculation must be appropriately oriented to insure that their labels (units) will appropriately cancel and/or combine to yield the desired unit in the result. This is why it is
referred to as the factor-label method. As your study of chemistry continues, you will encounter many opportunities to apply this approach.
What is the density of common antifreeze in units of g/mL? A 4.00-qt sample of the antifreeze weighs 9.26 lb.
Solution
mass
Since density = , we need to divide the mass in grams by the volume in milliliters. In general: the number of units of B = the number of units of A × unit conversion factor. The
volume
necessary conversion factors are given in Table 1.7.1: 1 lb = 453.59 g; 1 L = 1.0567 qt; 1 L = 1,000 mL. We can convert mass from pounds to grams in one step:
453.59 g
3
9.26 lb × = 4.20 × 10 g
1 lb
Then,
3
4.20 × 10 g
density = = 1.11 g/mL
3
3.78 × 10 mL
Alternatively, the calculation could be set up in a way that uses three unit conversion factors sequentially as follows:
9.26 lb 1.0567 qt 1 L
453.59 g
× × × = 1.11 g/mL
4.00 qt 1 L 1000 mL
1 lb
Exercise 1.6.2
What is the volume in liters of 1.000 oz, given that 1 L = 1.0567 qt and 1 qt = 32 oz (exactly)?
Answer
−2
2.956 × 10 L
While being driven from Philadelphia to Atlanta, a distance of about 1250 km, a 2014 Lamborghini Aventador Roadster uses 213 L gasoline.
a. What (average) fuel economy, in miles per gallon, did the Roadster get during this trip?
b. If gasoline costs $3.80 per gallon, what was the fuel cost for this trip?
Solution
(a) We first convert distance from kilometers to miles:
0.62137 mi
1250 km × = 777 mi
1 km
1.0567 qt
1 gal
213 L × × = 56.3 gal
1 L 4 qt
Then,
Alternatively, the calculation could be set up in a way that uses all the conversion factors sequentially, as follows:
1250 km 0.62137 mi 1 L 4 qt
× × × = 13.8 mpg
213 L 1 km 1.0567 qt 1 gal
Exercise 1.6.3
A Toyota Prius Hybrid uses 59.7 L gasoline to drive from San Francisco to Seattle, a distance of 1300 km (two significant digits).
a. What (average) fuel economy, in miles per gallon, did the Prius get during this trip?
b. If gasoline costs $3.90 per gallon, what was the fuel cost for this trip?
Answer a
51 mpg
Answer b
$62
where
y = length in feet,
x = length in inches, and
the proportionality constant, m, is the conversion factor.
The Celsius and Fahrenheit temperature scales, however, do not share a common zero point, and so the relationship between these two scales is a linear one rather than a proportional one (
y = mx + b ). Consequently, converting a temperature from one of these scales into the other requires more than simple multiplication by a conversion factor, m, it also must take into account
∘ ∘
212 F − 32 F
=
∘ ∘
100 C −0 C
∘
180 F
=
∘
100 C
∘
9 F
=
∘
5 C
The y-intercept of the equation, b, is then calculated using either of the equivalent temperature pairs, (100 °C, 212 °F) or (0 °C, 32 °F), as:
b = y − mx
∘
∘
9 F ∘
= 32 F− ×0 C
∘
5 C
∘
= 32 F
An abbreviated form of this equation that omits the measurement units is:
9
T∘ F = × T∘ C + 32
5
Rearrangement of this equation yields the form useful for converting from Fahrenheit to Celsius:
5
T∘ C = (T∘ F + 32)
9
As mentioned earlier in this chapter, the SI unit of temperature is the kelvin (K). Unlike the Celsius and Fahrenheit scales, the kelvin scale is an absolute temperature scale in which 0 (zero) K
corresponds to the lowest temperature that can theoretically be achieved. The early 19th-century discovery of the relationship between a gas's volume and temperature suggested that the volume of a
TK = T∘ C + 273.15
T∘ C = TK − 273.15
The 273.15 in these equations has been determined experimentally, so it is not exact. Figure 1.6.1 shows the relationship among the three temperature scales. Recall that we do not use the degree sign
with temperatures on the kelvin scale.
Figure 1.6.1 : The Fahrenheit, Celsius, and kelvin temperature scales are compared.
Although the kelvin (absolute) temperature scale is the official SI temperature scale, Celsius is commonly used in many scientific contexts and is the scale of choice for nonscience contexts in almost
all areas of the world. Very few countries (the U.S. and its territories, the Bahamas, Belize, Cayman Islands, and Palau) still use Fahrenheit for weather, medicine, and cooking.
Normal body temperature has been commonly accepted as 37.0 °C (although it varies depending on time of day and method of measurement, as well as among individuals). What is this
temperature on the kelvin scale and on the Fahrenheit scale?
Solution
∘
K= C + 273.15 = 37.0 + 273.2 = 310.2 K
9 9
∘ ∘ ∘
F = C + 32.0 = ( × 37.0) + 32.0 = 66.6 + 32.0 = 98.6 F
5 5
Exercise 1.6.4
Convert 80.92 °C to K and °F.
Answer
354.07 K, 177.7 °F
Baking a ready-made pizza calls for an oven temperature of 450 °F. If you are in Europe, and your oven thermometer uses the Celsius scale, what is the setting? What is the kelvin temperature?
Solution
5 5 5
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
C = ( F − 32) = (450 − 32) = × 418 = 232 C → set oven to 230 C (two significant figures)
9 9 9
∘ 2
K= C + 273.15 = 230 + 273 = 503 K → 5.0 × 10 K (two signif icant f igures)
Exercise 1.6.5
Convert 50 °F to °C and K.
Answer
10 °C, 280 K
Summary
Measurements are made using a variety of units. It is often useful or necessary to convert a measured quantity from one unit into another. These conversions are accomplished using unit conversion
factors, which are derived by simple applications of a mathematical approach called the factor-label method or dimensional analysis. This strategy is also employed to calculate sought quantities using
measured quantities and appropriate mathematical relations.
T∘ C = K − 273.15
Glossary
dimensional analysis
(also, factor-label method) versatile mathematical approach that can be applied to computations ranging from simple unit conversions to more complex, multi-step calculations involving several
different quantities
Fahrenheit
unit of temperature; water freezes at 32 °F and boils at 212 °F on this scale
This page titled 1.6: Mathematical Treatment of Measurement Results is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and
standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1.E.1.2: S1.1.1
Place a glass of water outside. It will freeze if the temperature is below 0 °C.
1.E.1.3: Q1.1.2
Identify each of the following statements as being most similar to a hypothesis, a law, or a theory. Explain your reasoning.
a. Falling barometric pressure precedes the onset of bad weather.
b. All life on earth has evolved from a common, primitive organism through the process of natural selection.
c. My truck’s gas mileage has dropped significantly, probably because it’s due for a tune-up.
1.E.1.4: Q1.1.3
Identify each of the following statements as being most similar to a hypothesis, a law, or a theory. Explain your reasoning.
a. The pressure of a sample of gas is directly proportional to the temperature of the gas.
b. Matter consists of tiny particles that can combine in specific ratios to form substances with specific properties.
c. At a higher temperature, solids (such as salt or sugar) will dissolve better in water.
1.E.1.5: S1.1.3
(a) law (states a consistently observed phenomenon, can be used for prediction); (b) theory (a widely accepted explanation of the
behavior of matter); (c) hypothesis (a tentative explanation, can be investigated by experimentation)
Identify each of the underlined items as a part of either the macroscopic domain, the microscopic domain, or the symbolic domain
of chemistry. For any in the symbolic domain, indicate whether they are symbols for a macroscopic or a microscopic feature.
a. (a) The mass of a lead pipe is 14 lb.
b. (b) The mass of a certain chlorine atom is 35 amu.
c. (c) A bottle with a label that reads Al contains aluminum metal.
d. (d) Al is the symbol for an aluminum atom.
Identify each of the underlined items as a part of either the macroscopic domain, the microscopic domain, or the symbolic domain
of chemistry. For those in the symbolic domain, indicate whether they are symbols for a macroscopic or a microscopic feature.
a. (a) A certain molecule contains one H atom and one Cl atom.
b. (b) Copper wire has a density of about 8 g/cm3.
c. (c) The bottle contains 15 grams of Ni powder.
d. (d) A sulfur molecule is composed of eight sulfur atoms.
(a) symbolic, microscopic; (b) macroscopic; (c) symbolic, macroscopic; (d) microscopic
According to one theory, the pressure of a gas increases as its volume decreases because the molecules in the gas have to move a
shorter distance to hit the walls of the container. Does this theory follow a macroscopic or microscopic description of chemical
behavior? Explain your answer.
The amount of heat required to melt 2 lbs of ice is twice the amount of heat required to melt 1 lb of ice. Is this observation a
macroscopic or microscopic description of chemical behavior? Explain your answer.
Macroscopic. The heat required is determined from macroscopic properties.
a. If 200.0 g of glucose is fully converted, what will be the total mass of ethanol and carbon dioxide produced?
b. If the fermentation is carried out in an open container, would you expect the mass of the container and contents after
fermentation to be less than, greater than, or the same as the mass of the container and contents before fermentation?
Explain.
c. If 97.7 g of carbon dioxide is produced, what mass of ethanol is produced?
1.E.2.2: Solutions
2 Liquids can change their shape (flow); solids can’t. Gases can undergo large volume changes as pressure changes; liquids do not.
Gases flow and change volume; solids do not.
4.The mixture can have a variety of compositions; a pure substance has a definite composition. Both have the same composition
from point to point.
6 Molecules of elements contain only one type of atom; molecules of compounds contain two or more types of atoms. They are
similar in that both are comprised of two or more atoms chemically bonded together.
8. Answers will vary. Sample answer: Gatorade contains water, sugar, dextrose, citric acid, salt, sodium chloride, monopotassium
phosphate, and sucrose acetate isobutyrate.
11. (a) element; (b) element; (c) compound; (d) mixture, (e) compound; (f) compound; (g) compound; (h) mixture
12. In each case, a molecule consists of two or more combined atoms. They differ in that the types of atoms change from one
substance to the next.
14. Gasoline (a mixture of compounds), oxygen, and to a lesser extent, nitrogen are consumed. Carbon dioxide and water are the
principal products. Carbon monoxide and nitrogen oxides are produced in lesser amounts.
16. (a) Increased as it would have combined with oxygen in the air thus increasing the amount of matter and therefore the mass. (b)
0.9 g
18. (a) 200.0 g; (b) The mass of the container and contents would decrease as carbon dioxide is a gaseous product and would leave
the container. (c) 102.3 g
Considering that mass and volume are both extensive properties, explain why their ratio, density, is intensive.
Being extensive properties, both mass and volume are directly proportional to the amount of substance under study. Dividing one
extensive property by another will in effect “cancel” this dependence on amount, yielding a ratio that is independent of amount (an
intensive property).
This page titled 2: Atoms, Molecules, and Ions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
2.0: Prelude to Atoms
Your overall health and susceptibility to disease depends upon the complex interaction between your genetic makeup and
environmental exposure, with the outcome difficult to predict. Early detection of biomarkers, substances that indicate an organism’s
disease or physiological state, could allow diagnosis and treatment before a condition becomes serious or irreversible. Recent
studies have shown that your exhaled breath can contain molecules that may be biomarkers for recent exposure to environmental
contaminants or for pathological conditions ranging from asthma to lung cancer.
Figure 2.0.1 : Analysis of molecules in an exhaled breath can provide valuable information, leading to early diagnosis of diseases or
detection of environmental exposure to harmful substances. (credit: modification of work by Paul Flowers)
A person is shown blowing into a tube connected to a plastic bag. There is a computer screen displaying data that reads “Mass
Spectral Breath Analysis.” An arrow from the plastic bag points to an illustration of different molecular compounds contained in
the person’s exhalation
Scientists are working to develop biomarker “fingerprints” that could be used to diagnose a specific disease based on the amounts
and identities of certain molecules in a patient’s exhaled breath. An essential concept underlying this goal is that of a molecule’s
identity, which is determined by the numbers and types of atoms it contains, and how they are bonded together. This chapter will
describe some of the fundamental chemical principles related to the composition of matter, including those central to the concept of
molecular identity.
This page titled 2.0: Prelude to Atoms is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The language used in chemistry is seen and heard in many disciplines, ranging from medicine to engineering to forensics to art.
The language of chemistry includes its own vocabulary as well as its own form of shorthand. Chemical symbols are used to
represent atoms and elements. Chemical formulas depict molecules as well as the composition of compounds. Chemical equations
provide information about the quality and quantity of the changes associated with chemical reactions.
This chapter will lay the foundation for our study of the language of chemistry. The concepts of this foundation include the atomic
theory, the composition and mass of an atom, the variability of the composition of isotopes, ion formation, chemical bonds in ionic
and covalent compounds, the types of chemical reactions, and the naming of compounds. We will also introduce one of the most
powerful tools for organizing chemical knowledge: the periodic table.
Figure 2.1.1 : A pre-1982 copper penny (left) contains approximately 3 × 1022 copper atoms (several dozen are represented as
brown spheres at the right), each of which has the same chemical properties. (credit: modification of work by “slgckgc”/Flickr)
The left image shows a photograph of a stack of pennies. The right image calls out an area of one of the pennies, which is made up
of many sphere-shaped copper atoms. The atoms are densely organized.
3. Atoms of one element differ in properties from atoms of all other elements.
4. A compound consists of atoms of two or more elements combined in a small, whole-number ratio. In a given compound, the
numbers of atoms of each of its elements are always present in the same ratio (Figure 2.1.2).
Figure 2.1.3 : When the elements copper (a shiny, red-brown solid, shown here as brown spheres) and oxygen (a clear and colorless
gas, shown here as red spheres) react, their atoms rearrange to form a compound containing copper and oxygen (a powdery, black
solid). (credit copper: modification of work by Copper [images-of-elements.com]).
The left stoppered bottle contains copper and oxygen. There is a callout which shows that copper is made up of many sphere-
shaped atoms. The atoms are densely organized. The open space of the bottle contains oxygen gas, which is made up of bonded
pairs of oxygen atoms that are evenly spaced. The right stoppered bottle shows the compound copper two oxide. A callout from the
powder shows a molecule of copper two oxide, which contains copper atoms that are clustered together with an equal number of
oxygen atoms.
Dalton’s atomic theory provides a microscopic explanation of the many macroscopic properties of matter that you’ve learned about.
For example, if an element such as copper consists of only one kind of atom, then it cannot be broken down into simpler
substances, that is, into substances composed of fewer types of atoms. And if atoms are neither created nor destroyed during a
chemical change, then the total mass of matter present when matter changes from one type to another will remain constant (the law
of conservation of matter).
In the following drawing, the green spheres represent atoms of a certain element. The purple spheres represent atoms of
another element. If the spheres touch, they are part of a single unit of a compound. Does the following chemical change
represented by these symbols violate any of the ideas of Dalton’s atomic theory? If so, which one?
Solution
The starting materials consist of two green spheres and two purple spheres. The products consist of only one green sphere and
one purple sphere. This violates Dalton’s postulate that atoms are neither created nor destroyed during a chemical change, but
are merely redistributed. (In this case, atoms appear to have been destroyed.)
Exercise 2.1.1
In the following drawing, the green spheres represent atoms of a certain element. The purple spheres represent atoms of
another element. If the spheres touch, they are part of a single unit of a compound. Does the following chemical change
represented by these symbols violate any of the ideas of Dalton’s atomic theory? If so, which one
This equation shows that the starting materials of the reaction are two sets of bonded, green spheres which are each being
combined with two smaller, bonded purple spheres. The products of the change are two molecules that each contain one purple
sphere bonded between two green spheres.
Answer
The starting materials consist of four green spheres and two purple spheres. The products consist of four green spheres and
two purple spheres. This does not violate any of Dalton’s postulates: Atoms are neither created nor destroyed, but are
redistributed in small, whole-number ratios.
Dalton knew of the experiments of French chemist Joseph Proust, who demonstrated that all samples of a pure compound contain
the same elements in the same proportion by mass. This statement is known as the law of definite proportions or the law of constant
composition. The suggestion that the numbers of atoms of the elements in a given compound always exist in the same ratio is
consistent with these observations. For example, when different samples of isooctane (a component of gasoline and one of the
standards used in the octane rating system) are analyzed, they are found to have a carbon-to-hydrogen mass ratio of 5.33:1, as
shown in Table 2.1.1.
Table 2.1.1 : Constant Composition of Isooctane
Sample Carbon Hydrogen Mass Ratio
14.82 g carbon 5.33 g carbon
A 14.82 g 2.78 g =
2.78 g hydrogen 1.00 g hydrogen
It is worth noting that although all samples of a particular compound have the same mass ratio, the converse is not true in general.
That is, samples that have the same mass ratio are not necessarily the same substance. For example, there are many compounds
other than isooctane that also have a carbon-to-hydrogen mass ratio of 5.33:1.00.
Dalton also used data from Proust, as well as results from his own experiments, to formulate another interesting law. The law of
multiple proportions states that when two elements react to form more than one compound, a fixed mass of one element will react
1 g Cu 2
=
0.558 g Cl 1
1 g Cu
This 2-to-1 ratio means that the brown compound has twice the amount of chlorine per amount of copper as the green compound.
This can be explained by atomic theory if the copper-to-chlorine ratio in the brown compound is 1 copper atom to 2 chlorine atoms,
and the ratio in the green compound is 1 copper atom to 1 chlorine atom. The ratio of chlorine atoms (and thus the ratio of their
masses) is therefore 2 to 1 (Figure 2.1.4).
Figure 2.1.4 : Compared to the copper chlorine compound in (a), where copper is represented by brown spheres and chlorine by
green spheres, the copper chlorine compound in (b) has twice as many chlorine atoms per copper atom. (credit a: modification of
work by “Benjah-bmm27”/Wikimedia Commons; credit b: modification of work by “Walkerma”/Wikimedia Commons)
Figure A shows a pile of green powder. A callout shows that the green powder is made up of a lattice of copper atoms interspersed
with chlorine atoms. The atoms are color coded brown for copper and green for chlorine. The number of copper atoms is equal to
the number of chlorine atoms in the molecule. Figure B shows a pile of brown powder. A callout shows that the brown powder is
also made up of copper and chlorine atoms similar to the molecule shown in figure A.
A sample of compound A (a clear, colorless gas) is analyzed and found to contain 4.27 g carbon and 5.69 g oxygen. A sample
of compound B (also a clear, colorless gas) is analyzed and found to contain 5.19 g carbon and 13.84 g oxygen. Are these data
an example of the law of definite proportions, the law of multiple proportions, or neither? What do these data tell you about
substances A and B?
Solution
In compound A, the mass ratio of carbon to oxygen is:
1.33 g O
1 g C
1 g C
1 g C 1
=
2.67 g O 2
1 g C
This supports the law of multiple proportions. This means that A and B are different compounds, with A having one-half as
much carbon per amount of oxygen (or twice as much oxygen per amount of carbon) as B. A possible pair of compounds that
would fit this relationship would be A = CO2 and B = CO.
Exercise 2.1.1
A sample of compound X (a clear, colorless, combustible liquid with a noticeable odor) is analyzed and found to contain 14.13
g carbon and 2.96 g hydrogen. A sample of compound Y (a clear, colorless, combustible liquid with a noticeable odor that is
slightly different from X’s odor) is analyzed and found to contain 19.91 g carbon and 3.34 g hydrogen. Are these data an
example of the law of definite proportions, the law of multiple proportions, or neither? What do these data tell you about
substances X and Y?
Answer
14.13 g C
In compound X, the mass ratio of carbon to hydrogen is .
2.96 g H
19.91 g C
In compound Y, the mass ratio of carbon to oxygen is .
3.34 g H
3.34 g H
This small, whole-number ratio supports the law of multiple proportions. This means that X and Y are different
compounds.
Summary
The ancient Greeks proposed that matter consists of extremely small particles called atoms. Dalton postulated that each element has
a characteristic type of atom that differs in properties from atoms of all other elements, and that atoms of different elements can
combine in fixed, small, whole-number ratios to form compounds. Samples of a particular compound all have the same elemental
proportions by mass. When two elements form different compounds, a given mass of one element will combine with masses of the
other element in a small, whole-number ratio. During any chemical change, atoms are neither created nor destroyed.
Glossary
Dalton’s atomic theory
set of postulates that established the fundamental properties of atoms
Paul Flowers (University of North Carolina - Pembroke), Klaus Theopold (University of Delaware) and Richard Langley
(Stephen F. Austin State University) with contributing authors. Textbook content produced by OpenStax College is licensed
under a Creative Commons Attribution License 4.0 license. Download for free at http://cnx.org/contents/85abf193-
2bd...a7ac8df6@9.110).
This page titled 2.1: Early Ideas in Atomic Theory is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In the two centuries since Dalton developed his ideas, scientists have made significant progress in furthering our understanding of
atomic theory. Much of this came from the results of several seminal experiments that revealed the details of the internal structure
of atoms. Here, we will discuss some of those key developments, with an emphasis on application of the scientific method, as well
as understanding how the experimental evidence was analyzed. While the historical persons and dates behind these experiments
can be quite interesting, it is most important to understand the concepts resulting from their work.
Figure 2.2.1 : (a) J. J. Thomson produced a visible beam in a cathode ray tube. (b) This is an early cathode ray tube, invented in
1897 by Ferdinand Braun. (c) In the cathode ray, the beam (shown in yellow) comes from the cathode and is accelerated past the
anode toward a fluorescent scale at the end of the tube. Simultaneous deflections by applied electric and magnetic fields permitted
Thomson to calculate the mass-to-charge ratio of the particles composing the cathode ray. (credit a: modification of work by Nobel
Foundation; credit b: modification of work by Eugen Nesper; credit c: modification of work by “Kurzon”/Wikimedia Commons).
Based on his observations, here is what Thomson proposed and why: The particles are attracted by positive (+) charges and
repelled by negative (−) charges, so they must be negatively charged (like charges repel and unlike charges attract); they are less
massive than atoms and indistinguishable, regardless of the source material, so they must be fundamental, subatomic constituents
of all atoms. Although controversial at the time, Thomson’s idea was gradually accepted, and his cathode ray particle is what we
Figure 2.2.2 : Millikan’s experiment measured the charge of individual oil drops. The tabulated data are examples of a few possible
values.
Looking at the charge data that Millikan gathered, you may have recognized that the charge of an oil droplet is always a multiple of
a specific charge, 1.6 × 10−19 C. Millikan concluded that this value must therefore be a fundamental charge—the charge of a single
electron—with his measured charges due to an excess of one electron (1 times 1.6 × 10−19 C), two electrons (2 times 1.6 × 10−19
C), three electrons (3 times 1.6 × 10−19 C), and so on, on a given oil droplet. Since the charge of an electron was now known due
to Millikan’s research, and the charge-to-mass ratio was already known due to Thomson’s research (1.759 × 1011 C/kg), it only
required a simple calculation to determine the mass of the electron as well.
−19
1 kg −31
Mass of electron = 1.602 × 10 C × = 9.107 × 10 kg (2.3.1)
11
1.759 × 10 C
Scientists had now established that the atom was not indivisible as Dalton had believed, and due to the work of Thomson, Millikan,
and others, the charge and mass of the negative, subatomic particles—the electrons—were known. However, the positively charged
part of an atom was not yet well understood. In 1904, Thomson proposed the “plum pudding” model of atoms, which described a
positively charged mass with an equal amount of negative charge in the form of electrons embedded in it, since all atoms are
electrically neutral. A competing model had been proposed in 1903 by Hantaro Nagaoka, who postulated a Saturn-like atom,
consisting of a positively charged sphere surrounded by a halo of electrons (Figure 2.2.3).
Figure 2.2.3 : (a) Thomson suggested that atoms resembled plum pudding, an English dessert consisting of moist cake with
embedded raisins (“plums”). (b) Nagaoka proposed that atoms resembled the planet Saturn, with a ring of electrons surrounding a
positive “planet.” (credit a: modification of work by “Man vyi”/Wikimedia Commons; credit b: modification of work by
“NASA”/Wikimedia Commons).
Figure 2.2.4 : Geiger and Rutherford fired α particles at a piece of gold foil and detected where those particles went, as shown in
this schematic diagram of their experiment. Most of the particles passed straight through the foil, but a few were deflected slightly
and a very small number were significantly deflected.
Here is what Rutherford deduced: Because most of the fast-moving α particles passed through the gold atoms undeflected, they
must have traveled through essentially empty space inside the atom. Alpha particles are positively charged, so deflections arose
when they encountered another positive charge (like charges repel each other). Since like charges repel one another, the few
positively charged α particles that changed paths abruptly must have hit, or closely approached, another body that also had a highly
concentrated, positive charge. Since the deflections occurred a small fraction of the time, this charge only occupied a small amount
of the space in the gold foil. Analyzing a series of such experiments in detail, Rutherford drew two conclusions:
1. The volume occupied by an atom must consist of a large amount of empty space.
2. A small, relatively heavy, positively charged body, the nucleus, must be at the center of each atom.
This analysis led Rutherford to propose a model in which an atom consists of a very small, positively charged nucleus, in which
most of the mass of the atom is concentrated, surrounded by the negatively charged electrons, so that the atom is electrically neutral
(Figure 2.2.5).
Summary
Although no one has actually seen the inside of an atom, experiments have demonstrated much about atomic structure. Thomson’s
cathode ray tube showed that atoms contain small, negatively charged particles called electrons. Millikan discovered that there is a
fundamental electric charge—the charge of an electron. Rutherford’s gold foil experiment showed that atoms have a small, dense,
positively charged nucleus; the positively charged particles within the nucleus are called protons. Chadwick discovered that the
nucleus also contains neutral particles called neutrons. Soddy demonstrated that atoms of the same element can differ in mass;
these are called isotopes.
Glossary
alpha particle (α particle)
positively charged particle consisting of two protons and two neutrons
electron
negatively charged, subatomic particle of relatively low mass located outside the nucleus
isotopes
atoms that contain the same number of protons but different numbers of neutrons
neutron
uncharged, subatomic particle located in the nucleus
proton
positively charged, subatomic particle located in the nucleus
nucleus
massive, positively charged center of an atom made up of protons and neutrons
This page titled 2.2: Evolution of Atomic Theory is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The development of modern atomic theory revealed much about the inner structure of atoms. It was learned that an atom contains a
very small nucleus composed of positively charged protons and uncharged neutrons, surrounded by a much larger volume of space
containing negatively charged electrons. The nucleus contains the majority of an atom’s mass because protons and neutrons are
much heavier than electrons, whereas electrons occupy almost all of an atom’s volume. The diameter of an atom is on the order of
10−10 m, whereas the diameter of the nucleus is roughly 10−15 m—about 100,000 times smaller. For a perspective about their
relative sizes, consider this: If the nucleus were the size of a blueberry, the atom would be about the size of a football stadium
(Figure 2.3.1).
Figure 2.3.1 : If an atom could be expanded to the size of a football stadium, the nucleus would be the size of a single blueberry.
(credit middle: modification of work by “babyknight”/Wikimedia Commons; credit right: modification of work by Paxson
Woelber).
The diagram on the left shows a picture of an atom with a nucleus. The central figure shows a photograph of an American football
stadium. The figure on the right shows a photograph of a handful of blueberries.
Atoms—and the protons, neutrons, and electrons that compose them—are extremely small. For example, a carbon atom weighs
less than 2 × 10−23 g, and an electron has a charge of less than 2 × 10−19 C (coulomb). When describing the properties of tiny
objects such as atoms, we use appropriately small units of measure, such as the atomic mass unit (amu) and the fundamental unit of
charge (e). The amu was originally defined based on hydrogen, the lightest element, then later in terms of oxygen. Since 1961, it
has been defined with regard to the most abundant isotope of carbon, atoms of which are assigned masses of exactly 12 amu. (This
isotope is known as “carbon-12” as will be discussed later in this module.) Thus, one amu is exactly 1/12 of the mass of one
carbon-12 atom: 1 amu = 1.6605 × 10−24 g. (The Dalton (Da) and the unified atomic mass unit (u) are alternative units that are
equivalent to the amu.) The fundamental unit of charge (also called the elementary charge) equals the magnitude of the charge of an
electron (e) with e = 1.602 × 10−19 C.
A proton has a mass of 1.0073 amu and a charge of 1+. A neutron is a slightly heavier particle with a mass 1.0087 amu and a
charge of zero; as its name suggests, it is neutral. The electron has a charge of 1− and is a much lighter particle with a mass of
about 0.00055 amu (it would take about 1800 electrons to equal the mass of one proton. The properties of these fundamental
particles are summarized in Table 2.3.1. (An observant student might notice that the sum of an atom’s subatomic particles does not
equal the atom’s actual mass: The total mass of six protons, six neutrons, and six electrons is 12.0993 amu, slightly larger than the
12.00 amu of an actual carbon-12 atom. This “missing” mass is known as the mass defect, and you will learn about it in the chapter
on nuclear chemistry.)
Table 2.3.1 : Properties of Subatomic Particles
Name Location Charge (C) Unit Charge Mass (amu) Mass (g)
The number of protons in the nucleus of an atom is its atomic number (Z ). This is the defining trait of an element: Its value
determines the identity of the atom. For example, any atom that contains six protons is the element carbon and has the atomic
number 6, regardless of how many neutrons or electrons it may have. A neutral atom must contain the same number of positive and
negative charges, so the number of protons equals the number of electrons. Therefore, the atomic number also indicates the number
of electrons in an atom. The total number of protons and neutrons in an atom is called its mass number (A). The number of
neutrons is therefore the difference between the mass number and the atomic number: A – Z = number of neutrons.
atomic number (Z) = number of protons
Atoms are electrically neutral if they contain the same number of positively charged protons and negatively charged electrons.
When the numbers of these subatomic particles are not equal, the atom is electrically charged and is called an ion. The charge of an
atom is defined as follows:
Atomic charge = number of protons − number of electrons
As will be discussed in more detail later in this chapter, atoms (and molecules) typically acquire charge by gaining or losing
electrons. An atom that gains one or more electrons will exhibit a negative charge and is called an anion. Positively charged atoms
called cations are formed when an atom loses one or more electrons. For example, a neutral sodium atom (Z = 11) has 11 electrons.
If this atom loses one electron, it will become a cation with a 1+ charge (11 − 10 = 1+). A neutral oxygen atom (Z = 8) has eight
electrons, and if it gains two electrons it will become an anion with a 2− charge (8 − 10 = 2−).
Iodine is an essential trace element in our diet; it is needed to produce thyroid hormone. Insufficient iodine in the diet can lead
to the development of a goiter, an enlargement of the thyroid gland (Figure 2.3.2).
Figure 2.3.2 : (a) Insufficient iodine in the diet can cause an enlargement of the thyroid gland called a goiter. (b) The addition
of small amounts of iodine to salt, which prevents the formation of goiters, has helped eliminate this concern in the US where
salt consumption is high. (credit a: modification of work by “Almazi”/Wikimedia Commons; credit b: modification of work by
Mike Mozart)
Figure A shows a photo of a person who has a very swollen thyroid in his or her neck. Figure B shows a photo of a canister of
Morton iodized salt.
The addition of small amounts of iodine to table salt (iodized salt) has essentially eliminated this health concern in the United
States, but as much as 40% of the world’s population is still at risk of iodine deficiency. The iodine atoms are added as anions,
and each has a 1− charge and a mass number of 127. Determine the numbers of protons, neutrons, and electrons in one of these
iodine anions.
Exercise 2.3.1
An ion of platinum has a mass number of 195 and contains 74 electrons. How many protons and neutrons does it contain, and
what is its charge?
Answer
78 protons; 117 neutrons; charge is 4+
Figure 2.3.3 : The symbol Hg represents the element mercury regardless of the amount; it could represent one atom of mercury or a
large amount of mercury. from Wikipedia (user: Materialscientist).
The symbols for several common elements and their atoms are listed in Table 2.3.2. Some symbols are derived from the common
name of the element; others are abbreviations of the name in another language. Symbols have one or two letters, for example, H for
hydrogen and Cl for chlorine. To avoid confusion with other notations, only the first letter of a symbol is capitalized. For example,
Co is the symbol for the element cobalt, but CO is the notation for the compound carbon monoxide, which contains atoms of the
elements carbon (C) and oxygen (O). All known elements and their symbols are in the periodic table.
Table 2.3.2 : Some Common Elements and Their Symbols
Element Symbol Element Symbol
calcium Ca magnesium Mg
chlorine Cl nitrogen N
chromium Cr oxygen O
helium He sulfur S
iodine I zinc Zn
Traditionally, the discoverer (or discoverers) of a new element names the element. However, until the name is recognized by the
International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry (IUPAC), the recommended name of the new element is based on the Latin
word(s) for its atomic number. For example, element 106 was called unnilhexium (Unh), element 107 was called unnilseptium
(Uns), and element 108 was called unniloctium (Uno) for several years. These elements are now named after scientists or locations;
for example, element 106 is now known as seaborgium (Sg) in honor of Glenn Seaborg, a Nobel Prize winner who was active in
the discovery of several heavy elements.
2.3.2: Isotopes
The symbol for a specific isotope of any element is written by placing the mass number as a superscript to the left of the element
symbol (Figure 2.3.4). The atomic number is sometimes written as a subscript preceding the symbol, but since this number defines
the element’s identity, as does its symbol, it is often omitted. For example, magnesium exists as a mixture of three isotopes, each
with an atomic number of 12 and with mass numbers of 24, 25, and 26, respectively. These isotopes can be identified as 24Mg,
25
Mg, and 26Mg. These isotope symbols are read as “element, mass number” and can be symbolized consistent with this reading.
For instance, 24Mg is read as “magnesium 24,” and can be written as “magnesium-24” or “Mg-24.” 25Mg is read as “magnesium
25,” and can be written as “magnesium-25” or “Mg-25.” All magnesium atoms have 12 protons in their nucleus. They differ only
because a 24Mg atom has 12 neutrons in its nucleus, a 25Mg atom has 13 neutrons, and a 26Mg has 14 neutrons.
Figure 2.3.4 : The symbol for an atom indicates the element via its usual two-letter symbol, the mass number as a left superscript,
the atomic number as a left subscript (sometimes omitted), and the charge as a right superscript.
This diagram shows the symbol for helium, “H e.” The number to the upper left of the symbol is the mass number, which is 4. The
number to the upper right of the symbol is the charge which is positive 2. The number to the lower left of the symbol is the atomic
number, which is 2. This number is often omitted. Also shown is “M g” which stands for magnesium It has a mass number of 24, a
charge of positive 2, and an atomic number of 12.
Information about the naturally occurring isotopes of elements with atomic numbers 1 through 10 is given in Table 2.3.2. Note that
in addition to standard names and symbols, the isotopes of hydrogen are often referred to using common names and accompanying
symbols. Hydrogen-2, symbolized 2H, is also called deuterium and sometimes symbolized D. Hydrogen-3, symbolized 3H, is also
called tritium and sometimes symbolized T.
Table 2.3.2 : Nuclear Compositions of Atoms of the Very Light Elements
Number of Number of % Natural
Element Symbol Atomic Number Mass (amu)
Protons Neutrons Abundance
1
H
1
1 1 0 1.0078 99.989
(protium)
2
H
hydrogen 1
1 1 1 2.0141 0.0115
(deuterium)
3
H
1
1 1 2 3.01605 — (trace)
(tritium)
3
2
He 2 2 1 3.01603 0.00013
helium
4
2
He 2 2 2 4.0026 100
beryllium 9
4
Be 4 4 5 9.0122 100
10
5
B 5 5 5 10.0129 19.9
boron
11
5
B 5 5 6 11.0093 80.1
12
6
C 6 6 6 12.0000 98.89
carbon 13
6
C 6 6 7 13.0034 1.11
14
6
C 6 6 8 14.0032 — (trace)
14
7
N 7 7 7 14.0031 99.63
nitrogen
15
7
N 7 7 8 15.0001 0.37
16
8
O 8 8 8 15.9949 99.757
oxygen 17
8
O 8 8 9 16.9991 0.038
18
8
O 8 8 10 17.9992 0.205
fluorine 19
9
F 9 9 10 18.9984 100
20
10
Ne 10 10 10 19.9924 90.48
neon 21
10
Ne 10 10 11 20.9938 0.27
22
10
Ne 10 10 12 21.9914 9.25
For example, the element boron is composed of two isotopes: About 19.9% of all boron atoms are 10B with a mass of 10.0129 amu,
and the remaining 80.1% are 11B with a mass of 11.0093 amu. The average atomic mass for boron is calculated to be:
= 10.81 amu
It is important to understand that no single boron atom weighs exactly 10.8 amu; 10.8 amu is the average mass of all boron atoms,
and individual boron atoms weigh either approximately 10 amu or 11 amu.
A meteorite found in central Indiana contains traces of the noble gas neon picked up from the solar wind during the meteorite’s
trip through the solar system. Analysis of a sample of the gas showed that it consisted of 91.84% 20Ne (mass 19.9924 amu),
0.47% 21Ne (mass 20.9940 amu), and 7.69% 22Ne (mass 21.9914 amu). What is the average mass of the neon in the solar
wind?
= 20.15 amu
The average mass of a neon atom in the solar wind is 20.15 amu. (The average mass of a terrestrial neon atom is 20.1796 amu.
This result demonstrates that we may find slight differences in the natural abundance of isotopes, depending on their origin.)
Exercise 2.3.2
A sample of magnesium is found to contain 78.70% of 24Mg atoms (mass 23.98 amu), 10.13% of 25
Mg atoms (mass 24.99
amu), and 11.17% of 26Mg atoms (mass 25.98 amu). Calculate the average mass of a Mg atom.
Answer
24.31 amu
We can also do variations of this type of calculation, as shown in the next example.
Naturally occurring chlorine consists of 35Cl (mass 34.96885 amu) and 37Cl (mass 36.96590 amu), with an average mass of
35.453 amu. What is the percent composition of Cl in terms of these two isotopes?
Solution
The average mass of chlorine is the fraction that is 35Cl times the mass of 35Cl plus the fraction that is 37Cl times the mass of
37Cl.
35 35 37 37
average mass = (f raction of Cl × mass of Cl) + (f raction of Cl × mass of Cl)
If we let x represent the fraction that is 35Cl, then the fraction that is 37Cl is represented by 1.00 − x.
(The fraction that is 35Cl + the fraction that is 37Cl must add up to 1, so the fraction of 37Cl must equal 1.00 − the fraction of
35Cl.)
1.99705x = 1.513
1.513
x = = 0.7576
1.99705
35
So solving yields: x = 0.7576, which means that 1.00 − 0.7576 = 0.2424. Therefore, chlorine consists of 75.76% Cl and
24.24% 37Cl.
Exercise 2.3.3
Naturally occurring copper consists of 63Cu (mass 62.9296 amu) and 65Cu (mass 64.9278 amu), with an average mass of
63.546 amu. What is the percent composition of Cu in terms of these two isotopes?
Answer
69.15% Cu-63 and 30.85% Cu-65
The occurrence and natural abundances of isotopes can be experimentally determined using an instrument called a mass
spectrometer. Mass spectrometry (MS) is widely used in chemistry, forensics, medicine, environmental science, and many other
fields to analyze and help identify the substances in a sample of material. In a typical mass spectrometer (Figure 2.3.5), the sample
is vaporized and exposed to a high-energy electron beam that causes the sample’s atoms (or molecules) to become electrically
charged, typically by losing one or more electrons. These cations then pass through a (variable) electric or magnetic field that
deflects each cation’s path to an extent that depends on both its mass and charge (similar to how the path of a large steel ball
bearing rolling past a magnet is deflected to a lesser extent that that of a small steel BB). The ions are detected, and a plot of the
relative number of ions generated versus their mass-to-charge ratios (a mass spectrum) is made. The height of each vertical feature
or peak in a mass spectrum is proportional to the fraction of cations with the specified mass-to-charge ratio. Since its initial use
during the development of modern atomic theory, MS has evolved to become a powerful tool for chemical analysis in a wide range
of applications.
Mass Spectrometry MS
Video 2.3.1 : Watch this video from the Royal Society for Chemistry for a brief description of the rudiments of mass spectrometry.
Summary
An atom consists of a small, positively charged nucleus surrounded by electrons. The nucleus contains protons and neutrons; its
diameter is about 100,000 times smaller than that of the atom. The mass of one atom is usually expressed in atomic mass units
(amu), which is referred to as the atomic mass. An amu is defined as exactly 1/12 of the mass of a carbon-12 atom and is equal to
1.6605 × 10−24 g.
Glossary
anion
negatively charged atom or molecule (contains more electrons than protons)
atomic mass
average mass of atoms of an element, expressed in amu
cation
positively charged atom or molecule (contains fewer electrons than protons)
chemical symbol
one-, two-, or three-letter abbreviation used to represent an element or its atoms
Dalton (Da)
alternative unit equivalent to the atomic mass unit
ion
electrically charged atom or molecule (contains unequal numbers of protons and electrons)
Paul Flowers (University of North Carolina - Pembroke), Klaus Theopold (University of Delaware) and Richard Langley
(Stephen F. Austin State University) with contributing authors. Textbook content produced by OpenStax College is licensed
under a Creative Commons Attribution License 4.0 license. Download for free at http://cnx.org/contents/85abf193-
2bd...a7ac8df6@9.110).
A molecular formula is a representation of a molecule that uses chemical symbols to indicate the types of atoms followed by
subscripts to show the number of atoms of each type in the molecule. (A subscript is used only when more than one atom of a given
type is present.) Molecular formulas are also used as abbreviations for the names of compounds.
The structural formula for a compound gives the same information as its molecular formula (the types and numbers of atoms in the
molecule) but also shows how the atoms are connected in the molecule. The structural formula for methane contains symbols for
one C atom and four H atoms, indicating the number of atoms in the molecule (Figure 2.4.1). The lines represent bonds that hold
the atoms together. (A chemical bond is an attraction between atoms or ions that holds them together in a molecule or a crystal.) We
will discuss chemical bonds and see how to predict the arrangement of atoms in a molecule later. For now, simply know that the
lines are an indication of how the atoms are connected in a molecule. A ball-and-stick model shows the geometric arrangement of
the atoms with atomic sizes not to scale, and a space-filling model shows the relative sizes of the atoms.
Figure 2.4.1 : A methane molecule can be represented as (a) a molecular formula, (b) a structural formula, (c) a ball-and-stick
model, and (d) a space-filling model. Carbon and hydrogen atoms are represented by black and white spheres, respectively.
Figure A shows C H subscript 4. Figure B shows a carbon atom that is bonded to four hydrogen atoms at right angles: one above,
one to the left, one to the right, and one below. Figure C shows a 3-D, ball-and-stick model of the carbon atom bonded to four
hydrogen atoms. Figure D shows a space-filling model of a carbon atom with hydrogen atoms partially embedded into the surface
of the carbon atom.
Although many elements consist of discrete, individual atoms, some exist as molecules made up of two or more atoms of the
element chemically bonded together. For example, most samples of the elements hydrogen, oxygen, and nitrogen are composed of
molecules that contain two atoms each (called diatomic molecules) and thus have the molecular formulas H2, O2, and N2,
respectively. Other elements commonly found as diatomic molecules are fluorine (F2), chlorine (Cl2), bromine (Br2), and iodine
(I2). The most common form of the element sulfur is composed of molecules that consist of eight atoms of sulfur; its molecular
formula is S8 (Figure 2.4.2).
Figure 2.4.2 : A molecule of sulfur is composed of eight sulfur atoms and is therefore written as S8. It can be represented as (a) a
structural formula, (b) a ball-and-stick model, and (c) a space-filling model. Sulfur atoms are represented by yellow spheres.
Figure A shows eight sulfur atoms, symbolized with the letter S, that are bonded to each other to form an octagon. Figure B shows
a 3-D, ball-and-stick model of the arrangement of the sulfur atoms. The shape is clearly not octagonal as it is represented in the
structural formula. Figure C is a space-filling model that shows each sulfur atom is partially embedded into the sulfur atom it bonds
with.
It is important to note that a subscript following a symbol and a number in front of a symbol do not represent the same thing; for
example, H2 and 2H represent distinctly different species. H2 is a molecular formula; it represents a diatomic molecule of
hydrogen, consisting of two atoms of the element that are chemically bonded together. The expression 2H, on the other hand,
Figure 2.4.3 : The symbols H, 2H, H2, and 2H2 represent very different entities.
This figure shows four diagrams. The diagram for H shows a single, white sphere and is labeled one H atom. The diagram for 2 H
shows two white spheres that are not bonded together. It is labeled 2 H atoms. The diagram for H subscript 2 shows two white
spheres bonded together. It is labeled one H subscript 2 molecule. The diagram for 2 H subscript 2 shows two sets of bonded, white
spheres. It is labeled 2 H subscript 2 molecules.
Compounds are formed when two or more elements chemically combine, resulting in the formation of bonds. For example,
hydrogen and oxygen can react to form water, and sodium and chlorine can react to form table salt. We sometimes describe the
composition of these compounds with an empirical formula, which indicates the types of atoms present and the simplest whole-
number ratio of the number of atoms (or ions) in the compound. For example, titanium dioxide (used as pigment in white paint and
in the thick, white, blocking type of sunscreen) has an empirical formula of TiO2. This identifies the elements titanium (Ti) and
oxygen (O) as the constituents of titanium dioxide, and indicates the presence of twice as many atoms of the element oxygen as
atoms of the element titanium (Figure 2.4.4).
Figure 2.4.4 : (a) The white compound titanium dioxide provides effective protection from the sun. (b) A crystal of titanium
dioxide, TiO2, contains titanium and oxygen in a ratio of 1 to 2. The titanium atoms are gray and the oxygen atoms are red. (credit
a: modification of work by “osseous”/Flickr).
Figure A shows a photo of a person applying suntan lotion to his or her lower leg. Figure B shows a 3-D ball-and-stick model of
the molecule titanium dioxide, which involves a complicated interlocking of many titanium and oxygen atoms. The titanium atoms
in the molecule are shown as silver spheres and the oxygen atoms are shown as red spheres. There are twice as many oxygen atoms
as titanium atoms in the molecule.
As discussed previously, we can describe a compound with a molecular formula, in which the subscripts indicate the actual
numbers of atoms of each element in a molecule of the compound. In many cases, the molecular formula of a substance is derived
from experimental determination of both its empirical formula and its molecular mass (the sum of atomic masses for all atoms
composing the molecule). For example, it can be determined experimentally that benzene contains two elements, carbon (C) and
hydrogen (H), and that for every carbon atom in benzene, there is one hydrogen atom. Thus, the empirical formula is CH. An
experimental determination of the molecular mass reveals that a molecule of benzene contains six carbon atoms and six hydrogen
atoms, so the molecular formula for benzene is C6H6 (Figure 2.4.5).
Figure 2.4.6 : (a) Vinegar contains acetic acid, C2H4O2, which has an empirical formula of CH2O. It can be represented as (b) a
structural formula and (c) as a ball-and-stick model. (credit a: modification of work by “HomeSpot HQ”/Flickr)
Figure A shows a jug of distilled, white vinegar. Figure B shows a structural formula for acetic acid which contains two carbon
atoms connected by a single bond. The left carbon atom forms single bonds with three hydrogen atoms. The right carbon atom
forms a double bond with an oxygen atom. The right carbon atom also forms a single bond with an oxygen atom. This oxygen
forms a single bond with a hydrogen atom. Figure C shows a 3-D ball-and-stick model of acetic acid.
Molecules of glucose (blood sugar) contain 6 carbon atoms, 12 hydrogen atoms, and 6 oxygen atoms. What are the molecular
and empirical formulas of glucose?
Solution
The molecular formula is C6H12O6 because one molecule actually contains 6 C, 12 H, and 6 O atoms. The simplest whole-
number ratio of C to H to O atoms in glucose is 1:2:1, so the empirical formula is CH2O.
Exercise 2.4.1
A molecule of metaldehyde (a pesticide used for snails and slugs) contains 8 carbon atoms, 16 hydrogen atoms, and 4 oxygen
atoms. What are the molecular and empirical formulas of metaldehyde?
Answer
Molecular formula, C8H16O4; empirical formula, C2H4O
Figure 2.4.7 : Molecules of (a) acetic acid and methyl formate (b) are structural isomers; they have the same formula (C2H4O2) but
different structures (and therefore different chemical properties).
Figure A shows a structural diagram of acetic acid, C subscript 2 H subscript 4 O subscript 2. Acetic acid contains two carbon
atoms connected by a single bond. The left carbon atom forms single bonds with three hydrogen atoms. The carbon on the right
forms a double bond with an oxygen atom. The right carbon atom also forms a single bond to an oxygen atom which forms a single
bond with a hydrogen atom. Figure B shows a structural diagram of methyl formate, C subscript 2 H subscript 4 O subscript 2. This
molecule contains a carbon atom which forms single bonds with three hydrogen atoms, and a single bond with an oxygen atom.
The oxygen atom forms a single bond with another carbon atom which forms a double bond with another oxygen atom and a single
bond with a hydrogen atom.
Many types of isomers exist (Figure 2.4.8). Acetic acid and methyl formate are structural isomers, compounds in which the
molecules differ in how the atoms are connected to each other. There are also various types of spatial isomers, in which the relative
orientations of the atoms in space can be different. For example, the compound carvone (found in caraway seeds, spearmint, and
mandarin orange peels) consists of two isomers that are mirror images of each other. S-(+)-carvone smells like caraway, and R-(−)-
carvone smells like spearmint.
Summary
A molecular formula uses chemical symbols and subscripts to indicate the exact numbers of different atoms in a molecule or
compound. An empirical formula gives the simplest, whole-number ratio of atoms in a compound. A structural formula indicates
the bonding arrangement of the atoms in the molecule. Ball-and-stick and space-filling models show the geometric arrangement of
atoms in a molecule. Isomers are compounds with the same molecular formula but different arrangements of atoms.
Glossary
empirical formula
formula showing the composition of a compound given as the simplest whole-number ratio of atoms
isomers
compounds with the same chemical formula but different structures
molecular formula
formula indicating the composition of a molecule of a compound and giving the actual number of atoms of each element in a
molecule of the compound.
spatial isomers
compounds in which the relative orientations of the atoms in space differ
structural isomer
one of two substances that have the same molecular formula but different physical and chemical properties because their atoms
are bonded differently
structural formula
shows the atoms in a molecule and how they are connected
As early chemists worked to purify ores and discovered more elements, they realized that various elements could be grouped
together by their similar chemical behaviors. One such grouping includes lithium (Li), sodium (Na), and potassium (K): These
elements all are shiny, conduct heat and electricity well, and have similar chemical properties. A second grouping includes calcium
(Ca), strontium (Sr), and barium (Ba), which also are shiny, good conductors of heat and electricity, and have chemical properties
in common. However, the specific properties of these two groupings are notably different from each other. For example: Li, Na,
and K are much more reactive than are Ca, Sr, and Ba; Li, Na, and K form compounds with oxygen in a ratio of two of their atoms
to one oxygen atom, whereas Ca, Sr, and Ba form compounds with one of their atoms to one oxygen atom. Fluorine (F), chlorine
(Cl), bromine (Br), and iodine (I) also exhibit similar properties to each other, but these properties are drastically different from
those of any of the elements above.
Dimitri Mendeleev in Russia (1869) and Lothar Meyer in Germany (1870) independently recognized that there was a periodic
relationship among the properties of the elements known at that time. Both published tables with the elements arranged according
to increasing atomic mass. But Mendeleev went one step further than Meyer: He used his table to predict the existence of elements
that would have the properties similar to aluminum and silicon, but were yet unknown. The discoveries of gallium (1875) and
germanium (1886) provided great support for Mendeleev’s work. Although Mendeleev and Meyer had a long dispute over priority,
Mendeleev’s contributions to the development of the periodic table are now more widely recognized (Figure 2.5.1).
Atoms of each of the following elements are essential for life. Give the group name for the following elements:
a. chlorine
b. calcium
c. sodium
d. sulfur
Solution
The family names are as follows:
a. halogen
b. alkaline earth metal
c. alkali metal
d. chalcogen
Exercise 2.5.1
Answer a
In studying the periodic table, you might have noticed something about the atomic masses of some of the elements. Element 43
(technetium), element 61 (promethium), and most of the elements with atomic number 84 (polonium) and higher have their atomic
mass given in square brackets. This is done for elements that consist entirely of unstable, radioactive isotopes (you will learn more
about radioactivity in the nuclear chemistry chapter). An average atomic weight cannot be determined for these elements because
their radioisotopes may vary significantly in relative abundance, depending on the source, or may not even exist in nature. The
number in square brackets is the atomic mass number (and approximate atomic mass) of the most stable isotope of that element.
Summary
The discovery of the periodic recurrence of similar properties among the elements led to the formulation of the periodic table, in
which the elements are arranged in order of increasing atomic number in rows known as periods and columns known as groups.
Elements in the same group of the periodic table have similar chemical properties. Elements can be classified as metals, metalloids,
and nonmetals, or as a main-group elements, transition metals, and inner transition metals. Groups are numbered 1–18 from left to
right. The elements in group 1 are known as the alkali metals; those in group 2 are the alkaline earth metals; those in 15 are the
pnictogens; those in 16 are the chalcogens; those in 17 are the halogens; and those in 18 are the noble gases.
Glossary
actinide
inner transition metal in the bottom of the bottom two rows of the periodic table
alkali metal
element in group 1
chalcogen
element in group 16
group
vertical column of the periodic table
halogen
element in group 17
inert gas
(also, noble gas) element in group 18
main-group element
(also, representative element) element in columns 1, 2, and 12–18
metal
element that is shiny, malleable, good conductor of heat and electricity
metalloid
element that conducts heat and electricity moderately well, and possesses some properties of metals and some properties of
nonmetals
noble gas
(also, inert gas) element in group 18
nonmetal
element that appears dull, poor conductor of heat and electricity
period
(also, series) horizontal row of the periodic table
periodic law
properties of the elements are periodic function of their atomic numbers.
periodic table
table of the elements that places elements with similar chemical properties close together
pnictogen
element in group 15
representative element
(also, main-group element) element in columns 1, 2, and 12–18
transition metal
element in columns 3–11
series
(also, period) horizontal row of the period table
This page titled 2.5: The Periodic Table is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In ordinary chemical reactions, the nucleus of each atom (and thus the identity of the element) remains unchanged. Electrons,
however, can be added to atoms by transfer from other atoms, lost by transfer to other atoms, or shared with other atoms. The
transfer and sharing of electrons among atoms govern the chemistry of the elements. During the formation of some compounds,
atoms gain or lose electrons, and form electrically charged particles called ions (Figure 2.6.1).
Figure 2.6.1 : (a) A sodium atom (Na) has equal numbers of protons and electrons (11) and is uncharged. (b) A sodium cation (Na+)
has lost an electron, so it has one more proton (11) than electrons (10), giving it an overall positive charge, signified by a
superscripted plus sign.
Figure A shows a sodium atom which has a nucleus containing 11 protons, 12 neutrons, and 11 electrons. Figure B shows a sodium
ion. Its nucleus contains 11 protons, 12 neutrons, and 11 electrons.
You can use the periodic table to predict whether an atom will form an anion or a cation, and you can often predict the charge of the
resulting ion. Atoms of many main-group metals lose enough electrons to leave them with the same number of electrons as an atom
of the preceding noble gas. To illustrate, an atom of an alkali metal (group 1) loses one electron and forms a cation with a 1+
charge; an alkaline earth metal (group 2) loses two electrons and forms a cation with a 2+ charge, and so on. For example, a neutral
calcium atom, with 20 protons and 20 electrons, readily loses two electrons. This results in a cation with 20 protons, 18 electrons,
and a 2+ charge. It has the same number of electrons as atoms of the preceding noble gas, argon, and is symbolized Ca2+. The name
of a metal ion is the same as the name of the metal atom from which it forms, so Ca2+ is called a calcium ion.
When atoms of nonmetal elements form ions, they generally gain enough electrons to give them the same number of electrons as an
atom of the next noble gas in the periodic table. Atoms of group 17 gain one electron and form anions with a 1− charge; atoms of
group 16 gain two electrons and form ions with a 2− charge, and so on. For example, the neutral bromine atom, with 35 protons
and 35 electrons, can gain one electron to provide it with 36 electrons. This results in an anion with 35 protons, 36 electrons, and a
1− charge. It has the same number of electrons as atoms of the next noble gas, krypton, and is symbolized Br−. (A discussion of the
theory supporting the favored status of noble gas electron numbers reflected in these predictive rules for ion formation is provided
in a later chapter of this text.)
Note the usefulness of the periodic table in predicting likely ion formation and charge (Figure 2.6.2). Moving from the far left to
the right on the periodic table, main-group elements tend to form cations with a charge equal to the group number. That is, group 1
elements form 1+ ions; group 2 elements form 2+ ions, and so on. Moving from the far right to the left on the periodic table,
elements often form anions with a negative charge equal to the number of groups moved left from the noble gases. For example,
group 17 elements (one group left of the noble gases) form 1− ions; group 16 elements (two groups left) form 2− ions, and so on.
This trend can be used as a guide in many cases, but its predictive value decreases when moving toward the center of the periodic
table. In fact, transition metals and some other metals often exhibit variable charges that are not predictable by their location in the
table. For example, copper can form ions with a 1+ or 2+ charge, and iron can form ions with a 2+ or 3+ charge.
An ion found in some compounds used as antiperspirants contains 13 protons and 10 electrons. What is its symbol?
Solution
Because the number of protons remains unchanged when an atom forms an ion, the atomic number of the element must be 13.
Knowing this lets us use the periodic table to identify the element as Al (aluminum). The Al atom has lost three electrons and
thus has three more positive charges (13) than it has electrons (10). This is the aluminum cation, Al3+.
Exercise 2.6.1
Give the symbol and name for the ion with 34 protons and 36 electrons.
Answer
Se2−, the selenide ion
Magnesium and nitrogen react to form an ionic compound. Predict which forms an anion, which forms a cation, and the
charges of each ion. Write the symbol for each ion and name them.
Solution
Magnesium’s position in the periodic table (group 2) tells us that it is a metal. Metals form positive ions (cations). A
magnesium atom must lose two electrons to have the same number electrons as an atom of the previous noble gas, neon. Thus,
a magnesium atom will form a cation with two fewer electrons than protons and a charge of 2+. The symbol for the ion is
Mg2+, and it is called a magnesium ion.
Exercise 2.6.2
Aluminum and carbon react to form an ionic compound. Predict which forms an anion, which forms a cation, and the charges
of each ion. Write the symbol for each ion and name them.
Answer
Al will form a cation with a charge of 3+: Al3+, an aluminum ion. Carbon will form an anion with a charge of 4−: C4−, a
carbide ion.
The ions that we have discussed so far are called monatomic ions, that is, they are ions formed from only one atom. We also find
many polyatomic ions. These ions, which act as discrete units, are electrically charged molecules (a group of bonded atoms with an
overall charge). Some of the more important polyatomic ions are listed in Table 2.6.1. Oxyanions are polyatomic ions that contain
one or more oxygen atoms. At this point in your study of chemistry, you should memorize the names, formulas, and charges of the
most common polyatomic ions. Because you will use them repeatedly, they will soon become familiar.
Table 2.6.1 : Common Polyatomic Ions
Name Formula Related Acid Formula
ammonium NH
+
hydronium H O
3
+
oxide O
2 −
peroxide O
2 −
2
hydroxide OH
−
acetate CH COO
3
−
acetic acid CH COOH
3
cyanide CN
−
hydrocyanic acid HCN
azide N
−
3
hydrazoic acid HN
3
carbonate CO
2 −
3
carbonic acid H CO
2 3
bicarbonate HCO
−
3
nitrate NO
−
3
nitric acid HNO
3
nitrite NO
−
2
nitrous acid HNO
2
sulfate SO
2 −
4
sulfuric acid H SO
2 4
sulfite SO
2 −
3
sulfurous acid H SO
2 3
phosphate PO
3 −
4
phosphoric acid H PO
3 4
dihydrogen phosphate H PO
2
−
4
perchlorate ClO
−
4
perchloric acid HClO
4
chlorate ClO
−
3
chloric acid HClO
3
chlorite ClO
−
2
chlorous acid HClO
2
hypochlorite ClO
−
hypochlorous acid HClO
chromate CrO
2 −
4
chromic acid H CrO
2 4
dichromate Cr O
2
2 −
7
dichromic acid H Cr O
2 2 7
permanganate MnO
−
4
permanganic acid HMnO
4
Note that there is a system for naming some polyatomic ions; -ate and -ite are suffixes designating polyatomic ions containing
more or fewer oxygen atoms. Per- (short for “hyper”) and hypo- (meaning “under”) are prefixes meaning more oxygen atoms than
-ate and fewer oxygen atoms than -ite, respectively. For example, perchlorate is ClO , chlorate is ClO , chlorite is ClO and
−
4
−
3
−
2
hypochlorite is ClO−. Unfortunately, the number of oxygen atoms corresponding to a given suffix or prefix is not consistent; for
example, nitrate is NO while sulfate is SO . This will be covered in more detail in the next module on nomenclature.
−
3
2 −
4
The nature of the attractive forces that hold atoms or ions together within a compound is the basis for classifying chemical bonding.
When electrons are transferred and ions form, ionic bonds result. Ionic bonds are electrostatic forces of attraction, that is, the
attractive forces experienced between objects of opposite electrical charge (in this case, cations and anions). When electrons are
“shared” and molecules form, covalent bonds result. Covalent bonds are the attractive forces between the positively charged nuclei
of the bonded atoms and one or more pairs of electrons that are located between the atoms. Compounds are classified as ionic or
molecular (covalent) on the basis of the bonds present in them.
The gemstone sapphire (Figure 2.6.4) is mostly a compound of aluminum and oxygen that contains aluminum cations, Al3+,
and oxygen anions, O2−. What is the formula of this compound?
Figure 2.6.4 : Although pure aluminum oxide is colorless, trace amounts of iron and titanium give blue sapphire its
characteristic color. (credit: modification of work by Stanislav Doronenko)
Solution Because the ionic compound must be electrically neutral, it must have the same number of positive and negative
charges. Two aluminum ions, each with a charge of 3+, would give us six positive charges, and three oxide ions, each with a
charge of 2−, would give us six negative charges. The formula would be Al2O3.
Exercise 2.6.3
Predict the formula of the ionic compound formed between the sodium cation, Na+, and the sulfide anion, S2−.
Answer
Na2S
Many ionic compounds contain polyatomic ions (Table 2.6.1) as the cation, the anion, or both. As with simple ionic compounds,
these compounds must also be electrically neutral, so their formulas can be predicted by treating the polyatomic ions as discrete
units. We use parentheses in a formula to indicate a group of atoms that behave as a unit. For example, the formula for calcium
phosphate, one of the minerals in our bones, is Ca3(PO4)2. This formula indicates that there are three calcium ions (Ca2+) for every
two phosphate (PO ) groups. The PO
3 −
4
groups are discrete units, each consisting of one phosphorus atom and four oxygen
3 −
4
Baking powder contains calcium dihydrogen phosphate, an ionic compound composed of the ions Ca2+ and H 2
−
PO4 . What is
the formula of this compound?
Solution
The positive and negative charges must balance, and this ionic compound must be electrically neutral. Thus, we must have two
negative charges to balance the 2+ charge of the calcium ion. This requires a ratio of one Ca2+ ion to two H PO ions. We
2
−
4
designate this by enclosing the formula for the dihydrogen phosphate ion in parentheses and adding a subscript 2. The formula
is Ca(H2PO4)2.
Exercise 2.6.4
Predict the formula of the ionic compound formed between the lithium ion and the peroxide ion, O 2−
2
(Hint: Use the periodic
table to predict the sign and the charge on the lithium ion.)
Answer
Li2O2
Because an ionic compound is not made up of single, discrete molecules, it may not be properly symbolized using a molecular
formula. Instead, ionic compounds must be symbolized by a formula indicating the relative numbers of its constituent ions. For
compounds containing only monatomic ions (such as NaCl) and for many compounds containing polyatomic ions (such as CaSO4),
these formulas are just the empirical formulas introduced earlier in this chapter. However, the formulas for some ionic compounds
containing polyatomic ions are not empirical formulas. For example, the ionic compound sodium oxalate is comprised of Na+ and
C O
2
2−
4
ions combined in a 2:1 ratio, and its formula is written as Na2C2O4. The subscripts in this formula are not the smallest-
possible whole numbers, as each can be divided by 2 to yield the empirical formula, NaCO2. This is not the accepted formula for
sodium oxalate, however, as it does not accurately represent the compound’s polyatomic anion, C O .2
2−
Solution
a. Potassium (group 1) is a metal, and iodine (group 17) is a nonmetal; KI is predicted to be ionic.
b. Hydrogen (group 1) is a nonmetal, and oxygen (group 16) is a nonmetal; H2O2 is predicted to be molecular.
c. Carbon (group 14) is a nonmetal, hydrogen (group 1) is a nonmetal, and chlorine (group 17) is a nonmetal; CHCl3 is
predicted to be molecular.
d. Lithium (group 1) is a metal, and carbonate is a polyatomic ion; Li2CO3 is predicted to be ionic.
Exercise 2.6.5
Using the periodic table, predict whether the following compounds are ionic or covalent:
a. SO2
b. CaF2
c. N2H4
d. Al2(SO4)3
Answer a
molecular
Answer b
ionic
Answer c
molecular
Answer d
ionic
Summary
Metals (particularly those in groups 1 and 2) tend to lose the number of electrons that would leave them with the same number of
electrons as in the preceding noble gas in the periodic table. By this means, a positively charged ion is formed. Similarly, nonmetals
(especially those in groups 16 and 17, and, to a lesser extent, those in Group 15) can gain the number of electrons needed to
provide atoms with the same number of electrons as in the next noble gas in the periodic table. Thus, nonmetals tend to form
negative ions. Positively charged ions are called cations, and negatively charged ions are called anions. Ions can be either
monatomic (containing only one atom) or polyatomic (containing more than one atom).
Compounds that contain ions are called ionic compounds. Ionic compounds generally form from metals and nonmetals.
Compounds that do not contain ions, but instead consist of atoms bonded tightly together in molecules (uncharged groups of atoms
that behave as a single unit), are called covalent compounds. Covalent compounds usually form from two or more nonmetals.
Glossary
covalent bond
attractive force between the nuclei of a molecule’s atoms and pairs of electrons between the atoms
covalent compound
(also, molecular compound) composed of molecules formed by atoms of two or more different elements
ionic bond
electrostatic forces of attraction between the oppositely charged ions of an ionic compound
molecular compound
(also, covalent compound) composed of molecules formed by atoms of two or more different elements
monatomic ion
ion composed of a single atom
polyatomic ion
ion composed of more than one atom
oxyanion
polyatomic anion composed of a central atom bonded to oxygen atoms
This page titled 2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Nomenclature, a collection of rules for naming things, is important in science and in many other situations. This module describes
an approach that is used to name simple ionic and molecular compounds, such as NaCl, CaCO3, and N2O4. The simplest of these
are binary compounds, those containing only two elements, but we will also consider how to name ionic compounds containing
polyatomic ions, and one specific, very important class of compounds known as acids (subsequent chapters in this text will focus
on these compounds in great detail). We will limit our attention here to inorganic compounds, compounds that are composed
principally of elements other than carbon, and will follow the nomenclature guidelines proposed by IUPAC. The rules for organic
compounds, in which carbon is the principle element, will be treated in a later chapter on organic chemistry.
Every day you encounter and use a large number of ionic compounds. Some of these compounds, where they are found, and
what they are used for are listed in Table 2.7.3. Look at the label or ingredients list on the various products that you use during
the next few days, and see if you run into any of those in this table, or find other ionic compounds that you could now name or
write as a formula.
Table 2.7.3 : Everyday Ionic Compounds
Ionic Compound Name Use
Out-of-date nomenclature used the suffixes –ic and –ous to designate metals with higher and lower charges, respectively: Iron(III)
chloride, FeCl3, was previously called ferric chloride, and iron(II) chloride, FeCl2, was known as ferrous chloride. Though this
naming convention has been largely abandoned by the scientific community, it remains in use by some segments of industry. For
example, you may see the words stannous fluoride on a tube of toothpaste. This represents the formula SnF2, which is more
Name the following ionic compounds, which contain a metal that can have more than one ionic charge:
a. Fe2S3
b. CuSe
c. GaN
d. CrCl3
e. Ti2(SO4)3
Solution
The anions in these compounds have a fixed negative charge (S2−, Se2− , N3−, Cl−, and SO ), and the compounds must be
2−
neutral. Because the total number of positive charges in each compound must equal the total number of negative charges, the
positive ions must be Fe3+, Cu2+, Ga3+, Cr3+, and Ti3+. These charges are used in the names of the metal ions:
a. iron(III) sulfide
b. copper(II) selenide
c. gallium(III) nitride
d. chromium(III) chloride
e. titanium(III) sulfate
Exercise 2.7.1
Answer a
CrP
Answer b
HgS
Answer c
Mn3(PO4)2
Answer d
Cu2O
Answer e
CrF6
In the early 1990s, legal file clerk Erin Brockovich (Figure 2.7.2) discovered a high rate of serious illnesses in the small town
of Hinckley, California. Her investigation eventually linked the illnesses to groundwater contaminated by Cr(VI) used by
Pacific Gas & Electric (PG&E) to fight corrosion in a nearby natural gas pipeline. As dramatized in the film Erin Brokovich
(for which Julia Roberts won an Oscar), Erin and lawyer Edward Masry sued PG&E for contaminating the water near Hinckley
Figure 2.7.2: (a) Erin Brockovich found that Cr(VI), used by PG&E, had contaminated the Hinckley, California, water supply.
(b) The Cr(VI) ion is often present in water as the polyatomic ions chromate, CrO (left), and dichromate, Cr O (right).
2−
4 2
2−
Chromium compounds are widely used in industry, such as for chrome plating, in dye-making, as preservatives, and to prevent
corrosion in cooling tower water, as occurred near Hinckley. In the environment, chromium exists primarily in either the
Cr(III) or Cr(VI) forms. Cr(III), an ingredient of many vitamin and nutritional supplements, forms compounds that are not very
soluble in water, and it has low toxicity. Cr(VI), on the other hand, is much more toxic and forms compounds that are
reasonably soluble in water. Exposure to small amounts of Cr(VI) can lead to damage of the respiratory, gastrointestinal, and
immune systems, as well as the kidneys, liver, blood, and skin.
Despite cleanup efforts, Cr(VI) groundwater contamination remains a problem in Hinckley and other locations across the
globe. A 2010 study by the Environmental Working Group found that of 35 US cities tested, 31 had higher levels of Cr(VI) in
their tap water than the public health goal of 0.02 parts per billion set by the California Environmental Protection Agency.
2 di- 7 hepta-
3 tri- 8 octa-
4 tetra- 9 nona-
5 penta- 10 deca-
There are a few common names that you will encounter as you continue your study of chemistry. For example, although NO is
often called nitric oxide, its proper name is nitrogen monoxide. Similarly, N2O is known as nitrous oxide even though our rules
would specify the name dinitrogen monoxide. (And H2O is usually called water, not dihydrogen monoxide.) You should commit to
memory the common names of compounds as you encounter them.
Solution
Because these compounds consist solely of nonmetals, we use prefixes to designate the number of atoms of each element:
a. sulfur hexafluoride
b. dinitrogen trioxide
c. dichlorine heptoxide
d. tetraphosphorus hexoxide
Exercise 2.7.2
Answer a
PCl5
Answer b
N2O
Answer c
IF7
Answer d
CCl4
2.7.8: Oxyacids
Many compounds containing three or more elements (such as organic compounds or coordination compounds) are subject to
specialized nomenclature rules that you will learn later. However, we will briefly discuss the important compounds known as
oxyacids, compounds that contain hydrogen, oxygen, and at least one other element, and are bonded in such a way as to impart
acidic properties to the compound (you will learn the details of this in a later chapter). Typical oxyacids consist of hydrogen
combined with a polyatomic, oxygen-containing ion. To name oxyacids:
1. Omit “hydrogen”
2. Start with the root name of the anion
3. Replace –ate with –ic, or –ite with –ous
4. Add “acid”
For example, consider H2CO3 (which you might be tempted to call “hydrogen carbonate”). To name this correctly, “hydrogen” is
omitted; the –ate of carbonate is replace with –ic; and acid is added—so its name is carbonic acid. Other examples are given in
Table 2.7.8. There are some exceptions to the general naming method (e.g., H2SO4 is called sulfuric acid, not sulfic acid, and
H2SO3 is sulfurous, not sulfous, acid).
Table 2.7.8 : Names of Common Oxyacids
Formula Anion Name Acid Name
Summary
Chemists use nomenclature rules to clearly name compounds. Ionic and molecular compounds are named using somewhat-different
methods. Binary ionic compounds typically consist of a metal and a nonmetal. The name of the metal is written first, followed by
the name of the nonmetal with its ending changed to –ide. For example, K2O is called potassium oxide. If the metal can form ions
with different charges, a Roman numeral in parentheses follows the name of the metal to specify its charge. Thus, FeCl2 is iron(II)
chloride and FeCl3 is iron(III) chloride. Some compounds contain polyatomic ions; the names of common polyatomic ions should
be memorized. Molecular compounds can form compounds with different ratios of their elements, so prefixes are used to specify
the numbers of atoms of each element in a molecule of the compound. Examples include SF6, sulfur hexafluoride, and N2O4,
dinitrogen tetroxide. Acids are an important class of compounds containing hydrogen and having special nomenclature rules.
Binary acids are named using the prefix hydro-, changing the –ide suffix to –ic, and adding “acid;” HCl is hydrochloric acid.
Oxyacids are named by changing the ending of the anion (-ate to –ic, and -ite to -ous) and adding “acid;” H2CO3 is carbonic acid.
Glossary
binary acid
compound that contains hydrogen and one other element, bonded in a way that imparts acidic properties to the compound
(ability to release H+ ions when dissolved in water)
binary compound
compound containing two different elements.
oxyacid
compound that contains hydrogen, oxygen, and one other element, bonded in a way that imparts acidic properties to the
compound (ability to release H+ ions when dissolved in water)
nomenclature
system of rules for naming objects of interest
This page titled 2.7: Chemical Nomenclature is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The starting materials consist of one green sphere and two purple spheres. The products consist of two green spheres and two
purple spheres. This violates Dalton’s postulate that that atoms are not created during a chemical change, but are merely
redistributed.
Which postulate of Dalton’s theory is consistent with the following observation concerning the weights of reactants and products?
When 100 grams of solid calcium carbonate is heated, 44 grams of carbon dioxide and 56 grams of calcium oxide are produced.
Identify the postulate of Dalton’s theory that is violated by the following observations: 59.95% of one sample of titanium dioxide is
titanium; 60.10% of a different sample of titanium dioxide is titanium.
This statement violates Dalton’s fourth postulate: In a given compound, the numbers of atoms of each type (and thus also the
percentage) always have the same ratio.
Samples of compound X, Y, and Z are analyzed, with results shown here.
Do these data provide example(s) of the law of definite proportions, the law of multiple proportions, neither, or both? What do
these data tell you about compounds X, Y, and Z?
2.E.3: Exercises
1. The existence of isotopes violates one of the original ideas of Dalton’s atomic theory. Which one?
2. How are electrons and protons similar? How are they different?
3. How are protons and neutrons similar? How are they different?
4. Predict and test the behavior of α particles fired at a “plum pudding” model atom.
a. Predict the paths taken by α particles that are fired at atoms with a Thomson’s plum pudding model structure. Explain why
you expect the α particles to take these paths.
b. If α particles of higher energy than those in (a) are fired at plum pudding atoms, predict how their paths will differ from the
lower-energy α particle paths. Explain your reasoning.
c. Now test your predictions from (a) and (b). Open the Rutherford Scattering simulation and select the “Plum Pudding Atom”
tab. Set “Alpha Particles Energy” to “min,” and select “show traces.” Click on the gun to start firing α particles. Does this
match your prediction from (a)? If not, explain why the actual path would be that shown in the simulation. Hit the pause
button, or “Reset All.” Set “Alpha Particles Energy” to “max,” and start firing α particles. Does this match your prediction
from (b)? If not, explain the effect of increased energy on the actual paths as shown in the simulation.
5. Predict and test the behavior of α particles fired at a Rutherford atom model.
2.E.3.1: Solutions
1 Dalton originally thought that all atoms of a particular element had identical properties, including mass. Thus, the concept of
isotopes, in which an element has different masses, was a violation of the original idea. To account for the existence of isotopes, the
second postulate of his atomic theory was modified to state that atoms of the same element must have identical chemical properties.
2 Both are subatomic particles that reside in an atom’s nucleus. Both have approximately the same mass. Protons are positively
charged, whereas neutrons are uncharged.
3 Both are subatomic particles that reside in an atom’s nucleus. Both have approximately the same mass. Protons are positively
charged, whereas neutrons are uncharged.
4. (a) The plum pudding model indicates that the positive charge is spread uniformly throughout the atom, so we expect the α
particles to (perhaps) be slowed somewhat by the positive-positive repulsion, but to follow straight-line paths (i.e., not to be
deflected) as they pass through the atoms. (b) Higher-energy α particles will be traveling faster (and perhaps slowed less) and will
also follow straight-line paths through the atoms. (c) The α particles followed straight-line paths through the plum pudding atom.
There was no apparent slowing of the α particles as they passed through the atoms.
5. (a) The Rutherford atom has a small, positively charged nucleus, so most α particles will pass through empty space far from the
nucleus and be undeflected. Those α particles that pass near the nucleus will be deflected from their paths due to positive-positive
repulsion. The more directly toward the nucleus the α particles are headed, the larger the deflection angle will be. (b) Higher-energy
α particles that pass near the nucleus will still undergo deflection, but the faster they travel, the less the expected angle of
deflection. (c) If the nucleus is smaller, the positive charge is smaller and the expected deflections are smaller—both in terms of
how closely the α particles pass by the nucleus undeflected and the angle of deflection. If the nucleus is larger, the positive charge
is larger and the expected deflections are larger—more α particles will be deflected, and the deflection angles will be larger. (d) The
paths followed by the α particles match the predictions from (a), (b), and (c).
Determine the number of protons, neutrons, and electrons in the following isotopes that are used in medical diagnoses:
(a) atomic number 9, mass number 18, charge of 1−
(b) atomic number 43, mass number 99, charge of 7+
(c) atomic number 53, atomic mass number 131, charge of 1−
(d) atomic number 81, atomic mass number 201, charge of 1+
(e) Name the elements in parts (a), (b), (c), and (d).
The following are properties of isotopes of two elements that are essential in our diet. Determine the number of protons, neutrons
and electrons in each and name them.
(a) atomic number 26, mass number 58, charge of 2+
(b) atomic number 53, mass number 127, charge of 1−
(a) Iron, 26 protons, 24 electrons, and 32 neutrons; (b) iodine, 53 protons, 54 electrons, and 74 neutrons
Give the number of protons, electrons, and neutrons in neutral atoms of each of the following isotopes:
(a) 10
5
B
(b) 199
80
Hg
(c) 63
29
Cu
(d) 13
6
C
(e) 77
34
Se
Give the number of protons, electrons, and neutrons in neutral atoms of each of the following isotopes:
(b) 125
52
Te
(c) 109
47
Ag
(d) 15
7
N
(e) 31
15
P
(a) 3 protons, 3 electrons, 4 neutrons; (b) 52 protons, 52 electrons, 73 neutrons; (c) 47 protons, 47 electrons, 62 neutrons; (d) 7
protons, 7 electrons, 8 neutrons; (e) 15 protons, 15 electrons, 16 neutrons
Click on the site and select the “Mix Isotopes” tab, hide the “Percent Composition” and “Average Atomic Mass” boxes, and then
select the element boron.
(a) Write the symbols of the isotopes of boron that are shown as naturally occurring in significant amounts.
(b) Predict the relative amounts (percentages) of these boron isotopes found in nature. Explain the reasoning behind your choice.
(c) Add isotopes to the black box to make a mixture that matches your prediction in (b). You may drag isotopes from their bins or
click on “More” and then move the sliders to the appropriate amounts.
(d) Reveal the “Percent Composition” and “Average Atomic Mass” boxes. How well does your mixture match with your
prediction? If necessary, adjust the isotope amounts to match your prediction.
(e) Select “Nature’s” mix of isotopes and compare it to your prediction. How well does your prediction compare with the naturally
occurring mixture? Explain. If necessary, adjust your amounts to make them match “Nature’s” amounts as closely as possible.
Repeat Exercise using an element that has three naturally occurring isotopes.
Let us use neon as an example. Since there are three isotopes, there is no way to be sure to accurately predict the abundances to
make the total of 20.18 amu average atomic mass. Let us guess that the abundances are 9% Ne-22, 91% Ne-20, and only a trace of
Ne-21. The average mass would be 20.18 amu. Checking the nature’s mix of isotopes shows that the abundances are 90.48% Ne-
20, 9.25% Ne-22, and 0.27% Ne-21, so our guessed amounts have to be slightly adjusted.
An element has the following natural abundances and isotopic masses: 90.92% abundance with 19.99 amu, 0.26% abundance with
20.99 amu, and 8.82% abundance with 21.99 amu. Calculate the average atomic mass of this element.
Average atomic masses listed by IUPAC are based on a study of experimental results. Bromine has two isotopes 79Br and 81Br,
whose masses (78.9183 and 80.9163 amu) and abundances (50.69% and 49.31%) were determined in earlier experiments.
Calculate the average atomic mass of bromine based on these experiments.
79.904 amu
Variations in average atomic mass may be observed for elements obtained from different sources. Lithium provides an example of
this. The isotopic composition of lithium from naturally occurring minerals is 7.5% 6Li and 92.5% 7Li, which have masses of
6.01512 amu and 7.01600 amu, respectively. A commercial source of lithium, recycled from a military source, was 3.75% 6Li (and
the rest 7Li). Calculate the average atomic mass values for each of these two sources.
The average atomic masses of some elements may vary, depending upon the sources of their ores. Naturally occurring boron
consists of two isotopes with accurately known masses (10B, 10.0129 amu and 11B, 11.0931 amu). The actual atomic mass of boron
can vary from 10.807 to 10.819, depending on whether the mineral source is from Turkey or the United States. Calculate the
percent abundances leading to the two values of the average atomic masses of boron from these two countries.
Turkey source: 0.2649 (of 10.0129 amu isotope); US source: 0.2537 (of 10.0129 amu isotope)
The 18O:16O abundance ratio in some meteorites is greater than that used to calculate the average atomic mass of oxygen on earth.
Is the average mass of an oxygen atom in these meteorites greater than, less than, or equal to that of a terrestrial oxygen atom?
(b)
(c)
(d)
(a) molecular CO2, empirical CO2; (b) molecular C2H2, empirical CH; (c) molecular C2H4, empirical CH2; (d) molecular H2SO4,
empirical H2SO4
Write the molecular and empirical formulas of the following compounds:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(b)
(c) These molecules have the same chemical composition (types and number of atoms) but different chemical structures. They are
structural isomers.
Use the Build a Molecule simulation to repeat Exercise, but build a molecule with three carbons, seven hydrogens, and one
chlorine.
a. Draw the structural formula of this molecule and state its name.
b. Can you arrange these atoms to make a different molecule? If so, draw its structural formula and state its name.
c. How are the molecules drawn in (a) and (b) the same? How do they differ? What are they called (the type of relationship
between these molecules, not their names)?
Write a symbol for each of the following neutral isotopes. Include the atomic number and mass number for each.
1. (a) the chalcogen with a mass number of 125
2. (b) the halogen whose longest-lived isotope is radioactive
3. (c) the noble gas, used in lighting, with 10 electrons and 10 neutrons
4. (d) the lightest alkali metal with three neutrons
4
2−
3 2
PO
−
4
; (e) covalent; (f) ionic, Na+, O2−
4
2−
5. (e) Mg2+, PO 3−
4
(a) CaS; (b) (NH4)2CO3; (c) AlBr3; (d) Na2HPO4; (e) Mg3 (PO4)2
For each of the following pairs of ions, write the symbol for the formula of the compound they will form:
1. (a) K+, O2−
2. (b) NH , PO
+
4
3−
4
5. (e) Ba2+, PO 3−
This page titled 2.E: Atoms, Molecules, and Ions (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 3: Composition of Substances and Solutions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
3.1: Formula Mass and the Mole Concept
Learning Objectives
Calculate formula masses for covalent and ionic compounds
Define the amount unit mole and the related quantity Avogadro’s number
Explain the relation between mass, moles, and numbers of atoms or molecules, and perform calculations deriving these
quantities from one another
We can argue that modern chemical science began when scientists started exploring the quantitative as well as the qualitative
aspects of chemistry. For example, Dalton’s atomic theory was an attempt to explain the results of measurements that allowed him
to calculate the relative masses of elements combined in various compounds. Understanding the relationship between the masses of
atoms and the chemical formulas of compounds allows us to quantitatively describe the composition of substances.
Figure 3.1.1 : The average mass of a chloroform molecule, CHCl3, is 119.37 amu, which is the sum of the average atomic masses of
each of its constituent atoms. The model shows the molecular structure of chloroform.
A table and diagram are shown. The table is made up of six columns and five rows. The header row reads: “Element,” “Quantity,”
a blank space, “Average atomic mass (a m u),” a blank space, and “Subtotal (a m u).” The first column contains the symbols “C,”
“H,” “C l” and a blank, merged cell that runs the width of the first five columns. The second column contains the numbers “1,” “1,”
and “3” as well as the merged cell. The third column contains the multiplication symbol in each cell except for the last, merged
cell. The fourth column contains the numbers “12.01,” “1.008,” and “35.45” as well as the merged cell. The fifth column contains
the symbol “=” in each cell except for the last, merged cell. The sixth column contains the values “12.01,” “1.008,” “106.35,” and
“119.37.” There is a thick black line below the number 106.35. The merged cell under the first five columns reads “Molecular
mass.” To the left of the table is a diagram of a molecule. Three green spheres are attached to a slightly smaller black sphere, which
is also attached to a smaller white sphere. The green spheres lie beneath and to the sides of the black sphere while the white sphere
is located straight up from the black sphere.
Likewise, the molecular mass of an aspirin molecule, C9H8O4, is the sum of the atomic masses of nine carbon atoms, eight
hydrogen atoms, and four oxygen atoms, which amounts to 180.15 amu (Figure 3.1.2).
Ibuprofen, C13H18O2, is a covalent compound and the active ingredient in several popular nonprescription pain medications,
such as Advil and Motrin. What is the molecular mass (amu) for this compound?
Solution
Molecules of this compound are comprised of 13 carbon atoms, 18 hydrogen atoms, and 2 oxygen atoms. Following the
approach described above, the average molecular mass for this compound is therefore:
Exercise 3.1.1
Acetaminophen, C8H9NO2, is a covalent compound and the active ingredient in several popular nonprescription pain
medications, such as Tylenol. What is the molecular mass (amu) for this compound?
Answer
151.16 amu
Figure 3.1.3 : Table salt, NaCl, contains an array of sodium and chloride ions combined in a 1:1 ratio. Its formula mass is 58.44
amu.
A table and diagram are shown. The table is made up of six columns and four rows. The header row reads: “Element,” “Quantity,”
a blank space, “Average atomic mass (a m u),” a blank space and “Subtotal (a m u).” The first column contains the symbols “N a”,
“C l,” and a merged cell. The merged cell runs the length of the first five columns. The second column contains the numbers “1”
and “1” as well as the merged cell. The third column contains the multiplication symbol in each cell except for the last, merged
cell. The fourth column contains the numbers “22.99” and “35.45” as well as the merged cell. The fifth column contains the symbol
“=” in each cell except for the last, merged cell. The sixth column contains the values “22.99,” “35.45,” and “58.44.” There is a
thick black line below the number “35.45.” The merged cell under the first five columns reads “Formula mass.” To the left of the
table is a diagram of a chemical structure. The diagram shows green and purple spheres placed in an alternating pattern, making up
the corners of eight stacked cubes to form one larger cube. The green spheres are slightly smaller than the purple spheres.
Note that the average masses of neutral sodium and chlorine atoms were used in this computation, rather than the masses for
sodium cations and chlorine anions. This approach is perfectly acceptable when computing the formula mass of an ionic
compound. Even though a sodium cation has a slightly smaller mass than a sodium atom (since it is missing an electron), this
difference will be offset by the fact that a chloride anion is slightly more massive than a chloride atom (due to the extra electron).
Moreover, the mass of an electron is negligibly small with respect to the mass of a typical atom. Even when calculating the mass of
an isolated ion, the missing or additional electrons can generally be ignored, since their contribution to the overall mass is
negligible, reflected only in the nonsignificant digits that will be lost when the computed mass is properly rounded. The few
exceptions to this guideline are very light ions derived from elements with precisely known atomic masses.
Aluminum sulfate, Al2(SO4)3, is an ionic compound that is used in the manufacture of paper and in various water purification
processes. What is the formula mass (amu) of this compound?
Solution
The formula for this compound indicates it contains Al3+ and SO42− ions combined in a 2:3 ratio. For purposes of computing a
formula mass, it is helpful to rewrite the formula in the simpler format, Al2S3O12. Following the approach outlined above, the
formula mass for this compound is calculated as follows:
Exercise 3.1.2
Calcium phosphate, Ca (PO ) , is an ionic compound and a common anti-caking agent added to food products. What is the
3 4 2
Answer
310.18 amu
hydrogen and oxygen atoms. However, because a hydrogen peroxide molecule contains two oxygen atoms, as opposed to the water
molecule, which has only one, the two substances exhibit very different properties. Today, we possess sophisticated instruments
that allow the direct measurement of these defining microscopic traits; however, the same traits were originally derived from the
measurement of macroscopic properties (the masses and volumes of bulk quantities of matter) using relatively simple tools
(balances and volumetric glassware). This experimental approach required the introduction of a new unit for amount of substances,
the mole, which remains indispensable in modern chemical science.
The mole is an amount unit similar to familiar units like pair, dozen, gross, etc. It provides a specific measure of the number of
atoms or molecules in a bulk sample of matter. A mole is defined as the amount of substance containing the same number of
discrete entities (such as atoms, molecules, and ions) as the number of atoms in a sample of pure 12C weighing exactly 12 g. One
Latin connotation for the word “mole” is “large mass” or “bulk,” which is consistent with its use as the name for this unit. The
mole provides a link between an easily measured macroscopic property, bulk mass, and an extremely important fundamental
property, number of atoms, molecules, and so forth.
The number of entities composing a mole has been experimentally determined to be 6.02214179 × 10 , a fundamental constant
23
named Avogadro’s number (N ) or the Avogadro constant in honor of Italian scientist Amedeo Avogadro. This constant is
A
properly reported with an explicit unit of “per mole,” a conveniently rounded version being 6.022 × 10 /mol. 23
Consistent with its definition as an amount unit, 1 mole of any element contains the same number of atoms as 1 mole of any other
element. The masses of 1 mole of different elements, however, are different, since the masses of the individual atoms are drastically
different. The molar mass of an element (or compound) is the mass in grams of 1 mole of that substance, a property expressed in
units of grams per mole (g/mol) (Figure 3.1.4).
Figure 3.1.4 : Each sample contains 6.022 × 10 atoms —1.00 mol of atoms. From left to right (top row): 65.4 g zinc, 12.0 g
23
carbon, 24.3 g magnesium, and 63.5 g copper. From left to right (bottom row): 32.1 g sulfur, 28.1 g silicon, 207 g lead, and 118.7 g
tin. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott).
This figure contains eight different substances displayed on white circles. The amount of each substance is visibly different.
Because the definitions of both the mole and the atomic mass unit are based on the same reference substance, 12C, the molar mass
of any substance is numerically equivalent to its atomic or formula weight in amu. Per the amu definition, a single 12C atom weighs
12 amu (its atomic mass is 12 amu). According to the definition of the mole, 12 g of 12C contains 1 mole of 12C atoms (its molar
mass is 12 g/mol). This relationship holds for all elements, since their atomic masses are measured relative to that of the amu-
reference substance, 12C. Extending this principle, the molar mass of a compound in grams is likewise numerically equivalent to its
formula mass in amu (Figure 3.1.5).
from the upper left: 130.2 g of C8H17OH (1-octanol, formula mass 130.2 amu), 454.4 g of HgI2 (mercury(II) iodide, formula mass
454.4 amu), 32.0 g of CH3OH (methanol, formula mass 32.0 amu) and 256.5 g of S8 (sulfur, formula mass 256.5 amu). (credit:
Sahar Atwa).
Table 3.1.1 : Mass of one mole of elements
Element Average Atomic Mass (amu) Molar Mass (g/mol) Atoms/Mole
While atomic mass and molar mass are numerically equivalent, keep in mind that they are vastly different in terms of scale, as
represented by the vast difference in the magnitudes of their respective units (amu versus g). To appreciate the enormity of the
mole, consider a small drop of water after a rainfall. Although this represents just a tiny fraction of 1 mole of water (~18 g), it
contains more water molecules than can be clearly imagined. If the molecules were distributed equally among the roughly seven
billion people on earth, each person would receive more than 100 billion molecules.
Video 3.1.1 : The mole is used in chemistry to represent 6.022 × 10 of something, but it can be difficult to conceptualize such a
23
large number. Watch this video and then complete the “Think” questions that follow. Explore more about the mole by reviewing the
information under “Dig Deeper.”
The relationships between formula mass, the mole, and Avogadro’s number can be applied to compute various quantities that
describe the composition of substances and compounds. For example, if we know the mass and chemical composition of a
substance, we can determine the number of moles and calculate number of atoms or molecules in the sample. Likewise, if we know
the number of moles of a substance, we can derive the number of atoms or molecules and calculate the substance’s mass.
According to nutritional guidelines from the US Department of Agriculture, the estimated average requirement for dietary
potassium is 4.7 g. What is the estimated average requirement of potassium in moles?
Solution
The mass of K is provided, and the corresponding amount of K in moles is requested. Referring to the periodic table, the
atomic mass of K is 39.10 amu, and so its molar mass is 39.10 g/mol. The given mass of K (4.7 g) is a bit more than one-tenth
the molar mass (39.10 g), so a reasonable “ballpark” estimate of the number of moles would be slightly greater than 0.1 mol.
The factor-label method supports this mathematical approach since the unit “g” cancels and the answer has units of “mol:”
mol K
4.7 g K( ) = 0.12 mol K
39.10 g
The calculated magnitude (0.12 mol K) is consistent with our ballpark expectation, since it is a bit greater than 0.1 mol.
Beryllium is a light metal used to fabricate transparent X-ray windows for medical imaging instruments. How many moles of
Be are in a thin-foil window weighing 3.24 g?
Answer
0.360 mol
Solution
The molar amount of Ar is provided and must be used to derive the corresponding mass in grams. Since the amount of Ar is
less than 1 mole, the mass will be less than the mass of 1 mole of Ar, approximately 40 g. The molar amount in question is
approximately one-one thousandth (~10−3) of a mole, and so the corresponding mass should be roughly one-one thousandth of
the molar mass (~0.04 g):
In this case, logic dictates (and the factor-label method supports) multiplying the provided amount (mol) by the molar mass
(g/mol):
39.95 g
−4
9.2 × 10 mol Ar ( ) = 0.037 g Ar
mol Ar
Exercise 3.1.4
Answer
504.4 g
Figure 3.1.6 : Copper wire is composed of many, many atoms of Cu. (credit: Emilian Robert Vicol)
Solution
The number of Cu atoms in the wire may be conveniently derived from its mass by a two-step computation: first calculating
the molar amount of Cu, and then using Avogadro’s number (NA) to convert this molar amount to number of Cu atoms:
Considering that the provided sample mass (5.00 g) is a little less than one-tenth the mass of 1 mole of Cu (~64 g), a
reasonable estimate for the number of atoms in the sample would be on the order of one-tenth NA, or approximately 1022 Cu
atoms. Carrying out the two-step computation yields:
23
mol Cu 6.022 × 10 atoms
22
5.00 g Cu ( )( ) = 4.74 × 10 atoms of copper
63.55 g mol
The factor-label method yields the desired cancellation of units, and the computed result is on the order of 1022 as expected.
Exercise 3.1.6
A prospector panning for gold in a river collects 15.00 g of pure gold. How many Au atoms are in this quantity of gold?
Answer
4.586 × 10
22
Au atoms
Our bodies synthesize protein from amino acids. One of these amino acids is glycine, which has the molecular formula
C2H5O2N. How many moles of glycine molecules are contained in 28.35 g of glycine?
Solution
We can derive the number of moles of a compound from its mass following the same procedure we used for an element in
Example 3.1.6:
A table is shown that is made up of six columns and six rows. The header row reads: “Element,” “Quantity (mol element / mol
compound,” a blank space, “Molar mass (g / mol element),” a blank space, and “Subtotal (a m u).” The first column contains
the symbols “C,” “H,” “O,” “N,” and a merged cell. The merged cell runs the width of the first five columns. The second
column contains the numbers “2,” “5,” “2,” and “1” as well as the merged cell. The third column contains the multiplication
symbol in each cell except for the last, merged cell. The fourth column contains the numbers “12.01,” “1.008,” “16.00,” and
“14.007” as well as the merged cell. The fifth column contains the symbol “=” in each cell except for the last, merged cell. The
sixth column contains the values “24.02,” “5.040,” “32.00,” “14.007,” and “75.07.” There is a thick black line under the
number 14.007. The merged cell under the first five columns reads “Molar mass (g / mol compound). There is a ball-and-stick
drawing to the right of this table. It shows a black sphere that forms a double bond with a slightly smaller red sphere, a single
bond with another red sphere, and a single bond with another black sphere. The red sphere that forms a single bond with the
black sphere also forms a single bond with a smaller, white sphere. The second black sphere forms a single bond with a
smaller, white sphere and a smaller blue sphere. The blue sphere forms a single bond with two smaller, white spheres each.
The provided mass of glycine (~28 g) is a bit more than one-third the molar mass (~75 g/mol), so we would expect the
computed result to be a bit greater than one-third of a mole (~0.33 mol). Dividing the compound’s mass by its molar mass
yields:
mol glycine
28.35 g glycine ( ) = 0.378 mol glycine
75.07 g
Exercise 3.1.7
How many moles of sucrose, C 12 H22 O11 , are in a 25-g sample of sucrose?
Answer
0.073 mol
Vitamin C is a covalent compound with the molecular formula C6H8O6. The recommended daily dietary allowance of vitamin
C for children aged 4–8 years is 1.42 × 10−4 mol. What is the mass of this allowance in grams?
Solution
As for elements, the mass of a compound can be derived from its molar amount as shown:
The molar mass for this compound is computed to be 176.124 g/mol. The given number of moles is a very small fraction of a
mole (~10−4 or one-ten thousandth); therefore, we would expect the corresponding mass to be about one-ten thousandth of the
molar mass (~0.02 g). Performing the calculation, we get:
Exercise 3.1.8
Answer
14.2 g
Example 3.1.9: Deriving the Number of Molecules from the Compound Mass
A packet of an artificial sweetener contains 40.0 mg of saccharin (C7H5NO3S), which has the structural formula:
Given that saccharin has a molar mass of 183.18 g/mol, how many saccharin molecules are in a 40.0-mg (0.0400-g) sample of
saccharin? How many carbon atoms are in the same sample?
Solution
The number of molecules in a given mass of compound is computed by first deriving the number of moles, as demonstrated in
Example 3.1.8, and then multiplying by Avogadro’s number:
Using the provided mass and molar mass for saccharin yields:
23
mol C H NO S 6.022 × 10 C H NO S molecules
7 5 3 7 5 3
0.0400 g C H NO S ( )( )
7 5 3
183.18 g C H NO S 1 mol C H NO S
7 5 3
7 5 3
20
= 1.31 × 10 C H NO S molecules
7 5 3
The compound’s formula shows that each molecule contains seven carbon atoms, and so the number of C atoms in the
provided sample is:
20
7 C atoms 21
1.31 × 10 C H NO S molecules ( ) = 9.20 × 10 C atoms
7 5 3
1 C H NO S molecule
7 5 3
Exercise 3.1.9
How many C 4 H10 molecules are contained in 9.213 g of this compound? How many hydrogen atoms?
Answer
Summary
The formula mass of a substance is the sum of the average atomic masses of each atom represented in the chemical formula and is
expressed in atomic mass units. The formula mass of a covalent compound is also called the molecular mass. A convenient amount
unit for expressing very large numbers of atoms or molecules is the mole. Experimental measurements have determined the number
of entities composing 1 mole of substance to be 6.022 × 1023, a quantity called Avogadro’s number. The mass in grams of 1 mole of
substance is its molar mass. Due to the use of the same reference substance in defining the atomic mass unit and the mole, the
formula mass (amu) and molar mass (g/mol) for any substance are numerically equivalent (for example, one H2O molecule weighs
approximately18 amu and 1 mole of H2O molecules weighs approximately 18 g).
Footnotes
1. 1 Omiatek, Donna M., Amanda J. Bressler, Ann-Sofie Cans, Anne M. Andrews, Michael L. Heien, and Andrew G. Ewing. “The
Real Catecholamine Content of Secretory Vesicles in the CNS Revealed by Electrochemical Cytometry.” Scientific Report 3
(2013): 1447, accessed January 14, 2015, doi:10.1038/srep01447.
Glossary
Avogadro’s number (NA)
experimentally determined value of the number of entities comprising 1 mole of substance, equal to 6.022 × 1023 mol−1
formula mass
sum of the average masses for all atoms represented in a chemical formula; for covalent compounds, this is also the molecular
mass
mole
amount of substance containing the same number of atoms, molecules, ions, or other entities as the number of atoms in exactly
12 grams of 12C
molar mass
mass in grams of 1 mole of a substance
This page titled 3.1: Formula Mass and the Mole Concept is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In the previous section, we discussed the relationship between the bulk mass of a substance and the number of atoms or molecules
it contains (moles). Given the chemical formula of the substance, we were able to determine the amount of the substance (moles)
from its mass, and vice versa. But what if the chemical formula of a substance is unknown? In this section, we will explore how to
apply these very same principles in order to derive the chemical formulas of unknown substances from experimental mass
measurements.
mass C
%C = × 100%
mass compound
If analysis of a 10.0-g sample of this gas showed it to contain 2.5 g H and 7.5 g C, the percent composition would be calculated to
be 25% H and 75% C:
2.5 g H
%H = × 100% = 25%
10.0 g compound
7.5 g C
%C = × 100% = 75%
10.0 g compound
Solution
To calculate percent composition, we divide the experimentally derived mass of each element by the overall mass of the
compound, and then convert to a percentage:
7.34 g C
%C = × 100% = 61.0%
12.04 g compound
1.85 g H
%H = × 100% = 15.4%
12.04 g compound
2.85 g N
%N = × 100% = 23.7%
12.04 g compound
The analysis results indicate that the compound is 61.0% C, 15.4% H, and 23.7% N by mass.
A 24.81-g sample of a gaseous compound containing only carbon, oxygen, and chlorine is determined to contain 3.01 g C, 4.00
g O, and 17.81 g Cl. What is this compound’s percent composition?
Answer
12.1% C, 16.1% O, 71.8% Cl
3.024 amu N
%H = × 100% = 17.76%
17.03 amu NH3
This same approach may be taken considering a pair of molecules, a dozen molecules, or a mole of molecules, etc. The latter
amount is most convenient and would simply involve the use of molar masses instead of atomic and formula masses, as
demonstrated Example 3.2.2. As long as we know the chemical formula of the substance in question, we can easily derive percent
composition from the formula mass or molar mass.
Aspirin is a compound with the molecular formula C9H8O4. What is its percent composition?
Solution
To calculate the percent composition, we need to know the masses of C, H, and O in a known mass of C9H8O4. It is convenient
to consider 1 mol of C9H8O4 and use its molar mass (180.159 g/mole, determined from the chemical formula) to calculate the
percentages of each of its elements:
%C = 60.00 % C
%H = 4.476 % H
%O = 35.52%
Note that these percentages sum to equal 100.00% when appropriately rounded.
To three significant digits, what is the mass percentage of iron in the compound F e 2 O3 ?
Answer
69.9% Fe
1 mol H
0.287 g H × = 0.284 mol H
1.008 g H
Thus, we can accurately represent this compound with the formula C0.142H0.284. Of course, per accepted convention, formulas
contain whole-number subscripts, which can be achieved by dividing each subscript by the smaller subscript:
C 0.142 H 0.284 or CH
2
0.142 0.142
(Recall that subscripts of “1” are not written, but rather assumed if no other number is present.)
The empirical formula for this compound is thus CH2. This may or not be the compound’s molecular formula as well; however, we
would need additional information to make that determination (as discussed later in this section).
Consider as another example a sample of compound determined to contain 5.31 g Cl and 8.40 g O. Following the same approach
yields a tentative empirical formula of:
In this case, dividing by the smallest subscript still leaves us with a decimal subscript in the empirical formula. To convert this into
a whole number, we must multiply each of the subscripts by two, retaining the same atom ratio and yielding Cl2O7 as the final
empirical formula.
Procedure
In summary, empirical formulas are derived from experimentally measured element masses by:
1. Deriving the number of moles of each element from its mass
2. Dividing each element’s molar amount by the smallest molar amount to yield subscripts for a tentative empirical formula
3. Multiplying all coefficients by an integer, if necessary, to ensure that the smallest whole-number ratio of subscripts is
obtained
Figure 3.2.1 outlines this procedure in flow chart fashion for a substance containing elements A and X.
A sample of the black mineral hematite (Figure 3.2.2), an oxide of iron found in many iron ores, contains 34.97 g of iron and
15.03 g of oxygen. What is the empirical formula of hematite?
Figure 3.2.2 : Hematite is an iron oxide that is used in jewelry. (credit: Mauro Cateb)
Solution
For this problem, we are given the mass in grams of each element. Begin by finding the moles of each:
mol Fe
34.97 g Fe ( ) = 0.6261 mol Fe
55.85 g
mol O
15.03 g O ( ) = 0.9394 mol O
16.00 g
Next, derive the iron-to-oxygen molar ratio by dividing by the lesser number of moles:
0.6261
= 1.000 mol Fe
0.6261
0.9394
= 1.500 mol O
0.6261
The ratio is 1.000 mol of iron to 1.500 mol of oxygen (Fe1O1.5). Finally, multiply the ratio by two to get the smallest possible
whole number subscripts while still maintaining the correct iron-to-oxygen ratio:
2(F e1 O1.5 ) = F e2 O3
What is the empirical formula of a compound if a sample contains 0.130 g of nitrogen and 0.370 g of oxygen?
Answer
N2 O5
Video 3.2.1 : Additional worked examples illustrating the derivation of empirical formulas are presented in the brief video clip.
The bacterial fermentation of grain to produce ethanol forms a gas with a percent composition of 27.29% C and 72.71% O
(Figure 3.2.3). What is the empirical formula for this gas?
Figure 3.2.3 : An oxide of carbon is removed from these fermentation tanks through the large copper pipes at the top. (credit:
“Dual Freq”/Wikimedia Commons)
A picture is shown of four copper-colored industrial containers with a large pipe connecting to the top of each one.
Solution
Since the scale for percentages is 100, it is most convenient to calculate the mass of elements present in a sample weighing 100
g. The calculation is “most convenient” because, per the definition for percent composition, the mass of a given element in
grams is numerically equivalent to the element’s mass percentage. This numerical equivalence results from the definition of the
72.71 g O
72.71 % O =
100 g compound
The molar amounts of carbon and hydrogen in a 100-g sample are calculated by dividing each element’s mass by its molar mass:
mol C
27.29 g C ( ) = 2.272 mol C
12.01 g
mol O
72.71 g O ( ) = 4.544 mol O
16.00 g
Coefficients for the tentative empirical formula are derived by dividing each molar amount by the lesser of the two:
2.272 mol C
=1
2.272
4.544 mol O
=2
2.272
Since the resulting ratio is one carbon to two oxygen atoms, the empirical formula is CO2.
Exercise 3.2.4
What is the empirical formula of a compound containing 40.0% C, 6.71% H, and 53.28% O?
Answer
C H2 O
The molecular formula is then obtained by multiplying each subscript in the empirical formula by n, as shown by the generic
empirical formula AxBy:
Molecules of this compound are then represented by molecular formulas whose subscripts are six times greater than those in the
empirical formula:
(CH O) =C H O
2 6 6 12 6
Note that this same approach may be used when the molar mass (g/mol) instead of the molecular mass (amu) is used. In this case,
we are merely considering one mole of empirical formula units and molecules, as opposed to single units and molecules.
Nicotine, an alkaloid in the nightshade family of plants that is mainly responsible for the addictive nature of cigarettes,
contains 74.02% C, 8.710% H, and 17.27% N. If 40.57 g of nicotine contains 0.2500 mol nicotine, what is the molecular
formula?
Solution
Determining the molecular formula from the provided data will require comparison of the compound’s empirical formula mass
to its molar mass. As the first step, use the percent composition to derive the compound’s empirical formula. Assuming a
convenient, a 100-g sample of nicotine yields the following molar amounts of its elements:
1 mol C
(74.02 g C) ( ) = 6.163 mol C (3.2.1)
12.01 g C
1 mol H
(8.710 g H) ( ) = 8.624 mol H (3.2.2)
1.01 g H
1 mol N
(17.27 g N) ( ) = 1.233 mol N (3.2.3)
14.01 g N
Next, we calculate the molar ratios of these elements relative to the least abundant element, N .
6.163 mol C / 1.233 mol N = 5
8.264 mol H / 1.233 mol N = 7
1.233 mol N / 1.233 mol N = 1
1.233/1.233 = 1.000 mol N
6.163/1.233 = 4.998 mol C
8.624/1.233 = 6.994 mol H
The C-to-N and H-to-N molar ratios are adequately close to whole numbers, and so the empirical formula is C5H7N. The
empirical formula mass for this compound is therefore 81.13 amu/formula unit, or 81.13 g/mol formula unit.
We calculate the molar mass for nicotine from the given mass and molar amount of compound:
40.57 g nicotine 162.3 g
=
0.2500 mol nicotine mol
Comparing the molar mass and empirical formula mass indicates that each nicotine molecule contains two formula units:
162.3 g/mol
= 2 f ormula units/molecule
g
81.13
f ormula unit
(C H N) =C H N
5 7 2 10 14 2
Exercise 3.2.5
What is the molecular formula of a compound with a percent composition of 49.47% C, 5.201% H, 28.84% N, and 16.48% O,
and a molecular mass of 194.2 amu?
Answer
C8H10N4O2
Summary
The chemical identity of a substance is defined by the types and relative numbers of atoms composing its fundamental entities
(molecules in the case of covalent compounds, ions in the case of ionic compounds). A compound’s percent composition provides
the mass percentage of each element in the compound, and it is often experimentally determined and used to derive the compound’s
empirical formula. The empirical formula mass of a covalent compound may be compared to the compound’s molecular or molar
mass to derive a molecular formula.
Glossary
percent composition
percentage by mass of the various elements in a compound
This page titled 3.2: Determining Empirical and Molecular Formulas is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
In preceding sections, we focused on the composition of substances: samples of matter that contain only one type of element or
compound. However, mixtures—samples of matter containing two or more substances physically combined—are more commonly
encountered in nature than are pure substances. Similar to a pure substance, the relative composition of a mixture plays an
important role in determining its properties. The relative amount of oxygen in a planet’s atmosphere determines its ability to sustain
aerobic life. The relative amounts of iron, carbon, nickel, and other elements in steel (a mixture known as an “alloy”) determine its
physical strength and resistance to corrosion. The relative amount of the active ingredient in a medicine determines its effectiveness
in achieving the desired pharmacological effect. The relative amount of sugar in a beverage determines its sweetness (Figure
3.3.1). In this section, we will describe one of the most common ways in which the relative compositions of mixtures may be
quantified.
Figure 3.3.1 : Sugar is one of many components in the complex mixture known as coffee. The amount of sugar in a given amount
of coffee is an important determinant of the beverage’s sweetness. (credit: Jane Whitney)
3.3.1: Solutions
We have previously defined solutions as homogeneous mixtures, meaning that the composition of the mixture (and therefore its
properties) is uniform throughout its entire volume. Solutions occur frequently in nature and have also been implemented in many
forms of manmade technology. We will explore a more thorough treatment of solution properties in the chapter on solutions and
colloids, but here we will introduce some of the basic properties of solutions.
The relative amount of a given solution component is known as its concentration. Often, though not always, a solution contains one
component with a concentration that is significantly greater than that of all other components. This component is called the solvent
and may be viewed as the medium in which the other components are dispersed, or dissolved. Solutions in which water is the
solvent are, of course, very common on our planet. A solution in which water is the solvent is called an aqueous solution.
A solute is a component of a solution that is typically present at a much lower concentration than the solvent. Solute concentrations
are often described with qualitative terms such as dilute (of relatively low concentration) and concentrated (of relatively high
concentration).
Concentrations may be quantitatively assessed using a wide variety of measurement units, each convenient for particular
applications. Molarity (M) is a useful concentration unit for many applications in chemistry. Molarity is defined as the number of
moles of solute in exactly 1 liter (1 L) of the solution:
mol solute
M = (3.3.1)
L solution
A 355-mL soft drink sample contains 0.133 mol of sucrose (table sugar). What is the molar concentration of sucrose in the
beverage?
Solution
Since the molar amount of solute and the volume of solution are both given, the molarity can be calculated using the definition
of molarity. Per this definition, the solution volume must be converted from mL to L:
mol solute
M =
L solution
0.133 mol
=
1 L
355 mL ×
1000 mL
= 0.375 M
Exercise 3.3.1
A teaspoon of table sugar contains about 0.01 mol sucrose. What is the molarity of sucrose if a teaspoon of sugar has been
dissolved in a cup of tea with a volume of 200 mL?
Answer
0.05 M
How much sugar (mol) is contained in a modest sip (~10 mL) of the soft drink from Example 3.3.1?
Solution
In this case, we can rearrange the definition of molarity to isolate the quantity sought, moles of sugar. We then substitute the
value for molarity that we derived in Example 3.4.2, 0.375 M:
mol solute
M = (3.3.2)
L solution
mol sugar 1 L
mol solute = 0.375 × (10 mL × ) = 0.004 mol sugar
L 1000 mL
Exercise 3.3.2
What volume (mL) of the sweetened tea described in Example 3.3.1 contains the same amount of sugar (mol) as 10 mL of the
soft drink in this example?
Answer
80 mL
Distilled white vinegar (Figure 3.3.2) is a solution of acetic acid, C H C O H, in water. A 0.500-L vinegar solution contains
3 2
25.2 g of acetic acid. What is the concentration of the acetic acid solution in units of molarity?
Solution
As in previous examples, the definition of molarity is the primary equation used to calculate the quantity sought. In this case,
the mass of solute is provided instead of its molar amount, so we must use the solute’s molar mass to obtain the amount of
solute in moles:
1 mol CH CO H
3 2
25.2 g CH CO H ×
3 2
mol solute 60.052 g CH CO H
3 2
M = = = 0.839 M (3.3.3)
L solution 0.500 L solution
Exercise 3.3.3
Calculate the molarity of 6.52 g of C oC l (128.9 g/mol) dissolved in an aqueous solution with a total volume of 75.0 mL.
2
Answer
0.674 M
Solution
The volume and molarity of the solution are specified, so the amount (mol) of solute is easily computed as demonstrated in
Example 3.3.3:
mol NaCl
mol solute = 5.30 × 0.250 L = 1.325 mol NaCl (3.3.7)
L
Exercise 3.3.4
How many grams of C aC l (110.98 g/mol) are contained in 250.0 mL of a 0.200-M solution of calcium chloride?
2
Answer
5.55 g C aC l 2
When performing calculations stepwise, as in Example 3.3.3, it is important to refrain from rounding any intermediate calculation
results, which can lead to rounding errors in the final result. In Example 3.3.4, the molar amount of NaCl computed in the first
step, 1.325 mol, would be properly rounded to 1.32 mol if it were to be reported; however, although the last digit (5) is not
significant, it must be retained as a guard digit in the intermediate calculation. If we had not retained this guard digit, the final
calculation for the mass of NaCl would have been 77.1 g, a difference of 0.3 g.
In addition to retaining a guard digit for intermediate calculations, we can also avoid rounding errors by performing computations
in a single step (Example 3.3.5). This eliminates intermediate steps so that only the final result is rounded.
In Example 3.3.3 , we found the typical concentration of vinegar to be 0.839 M. What volume of vinegar contains 75.6 g of
acetic acid?
Solution
First, use the molar mass to calculate moles of acetic acid from the given mass:
mol solute
g solute × = mol solute (3.3.9)
g solute
Then, use the molarity of the solution to calculate the volume of solution containing this molar amount of solute:
L solution
mol solute × = L solution (3.3.10)
mol solute
mol CH CO H L solution
3 2
75.6 g CH CO H ( )( ) = 1.50 L solution (3.3.12)
3 2
60.05 g 0.839 mol CH CO H
3 2
Exercise 3.3.5:
Answer
Figure 3.3.2 : Both solutions contain the same mass of copper nitrate. The solution on the right is more dilute because the copper
nitrate is dissolved in more solvent. (credit: Mark Ott).
This figure shows two graduated cylinders side-by-side. The first has about half as much blue liquid as the second. The blue liquid
is darker in the first cylinder than in the second.
Dilution is also a common means of preparing solutions of a desired concentration. By adding solvent to a measured portion of a
more concentrated stock solution, we can achieve a particular concentration. For example, commercial pesticides are typically sold
as solutions in which the active ingredients are far more concentrated than is appropriate for their application. Before they can be
used on crops, the pesticides must be diluted. This is also a very common practice for the preparation of a number of common
laboratory reagents (Figure 3.3.3).
Figure 3.3.3 : A solution of KM nO is prepared by mixing water with 4.74 g of KMnO4 in a flask. (credit: modification of work
4
by Mark Ott)
This figure shows two photos. In the first, there is an empty glass container, 4.75 g of K M n O subscript 4 powder on a white
circle, and a bottle of distilled water. In the second photo the powder and about half the water have been added to the glass
container. The liquid in the glass container is almost black in color.
A simple mathematical relationship can be used to relate the volumes and concentrations of a solution before and after the dilution
process. According to the definition of molarity, the molar amount of solute in a solution is equal to the product of the solution’s
molarity and its volume in liters:
n = ML
Expressions like these may be written for a solution before and after it is diluted:
n2 = M2 L2
where the subscripts “1” and “2” refer to the solution before and after the dilution, respectively. Since the dilution process does not
change the amount of solute in the solution,n1 = n2. Thus, these two equations may be set equal to one another:
M1 L1 = M2 L2
This relation is commonly referred to as the dilution equation. Although we derived this equation using molarity as the unit of
concentration and liters as the unit of volume, other units of concentration and volume may be used, so long as the units properly
cancel per the factor-label method. Reflecting this versatility, the dilution equation is often written in the more general form:
C1 V1 = C2 V2
If 0.850 L of a 5.00-M solution of copper nitrate, Cu(NO3)2, is diluted to a volume of 1.80 L by the addition of water, what is
the molarity of the diluted solution?
Solution
We are given the volume and concentration of a stock solution, V1 and C1, and the volume of the resultant diluted solution, V2.
We need to find the concentration of the diluted solution, C2. We thus rearrange the dilution equation in order to isolate C2:
C1 V1 = C2 V2
C1 V1
C2 =
V2
Since the stock solution is being diluted by more than two-fold (volume is increased from 0.85 L to 1.80 L), we would expect
the diluted solution’s concentration to be less than one-half 5 M. We will compare this ballpark estimate to the calculated result
to check for any gross errors in computation (for example, such as an improper substitution of the given quantities).
Substituting the given values for the terms on the right side of this equation yields:
mol
0.850 L × 5.00
L
C2 = = 2.36 M
1.80 L
This result compares well to our ballpark estimate (it’s a bit less than one-half the stock concentration, 5 M).
Exercise 3.3.6
What is the concentration of the solution that results from diluting 25.0 mL of a 2.04-M solution of CH3OH to 500.0 mL?
Answer
0.102 M C H 3 OH
What volume of 0.12 M HBr can be prepared from 11 mL (0.011 L) of 0.45 M HBr?
Solution
C1 V1 = C2 V2
C1 V1
V2 =
C2
Since the diluted concentration (0.12 M) is slightly more than one-fourth the original concentration (0.45 M), we would expect
the volume of the diluted solution to be roughly four times the original volume, or around 44 mL. Substituting the given values
and solving for the unknown volume yields:
(0.45 M )(0.011 L)
V2 =
(0.12 M )
V2 = 0.041 L
The volume of the 0.12-M solution is 0.041 L (41 mL). The result is reasonable and compares well with our rough estimate.
Exercise 3.3.7
A laboratory experiment calls for 0.125 M H N O . What volume of 0.125 M H N O can be prepared from 0.250 L of 1.88 M
3 3
HN O ?3
Answer
3.76 L
Solution
We are given the concentration of a stock solution, C1, and the volume and concentration of the resultant diluted solution, V2
and C2. We need to find the volume of the stock solution, V1. We thus rearrange the dilution equation in order to isolate V1:
C1 V1 = C2 V2
C2 V2
V1 =
C1
Since the concentration of the diluted solution 0.100 M is roughly one-sixteenth that of the stock solution (1.59 M), we would
expect the volume of the stock solution to be about one-sixteenth that of the diluted solution, or around 0.3 liters. Substituting
the given values and solving for the unknown volume yields:
(0.100 M )(5.00 L)
V1 =
1.59 M
V1 = 0.314 L
Thus, we would need 0.314 L of the 1.59-M solution to prepare the desired solution. This result is consistent with our rough
estimate.
Answer
0.261
Summary
Solutions are homogeneous mixtures. Many solutions contain one component, called the solvent, in which other components,
called solutes, are dissolved. An aqueous solution is one for which the solvent is water. The concentration of a solution is a measure
of the relative amount of solute in a given amount of solution. Concentrations may be measured using various units, with one very
useful unit being molarity, defined as the number of moles of solute per liter of solution. The solute concentration of a solution may
be decreased by adding solvent, a process referred to as dilution. The dilution equation is a simple relation between concentrations
and volumes of a solution before and after dilution.
Glossary
aqueous solution
solution for which water is the solvent
concentrated
qualitative term for a solution containing solute at a relatively high concentration
concentration
quantitative measure of the relative amounts of solute and solvent present in a solution
dilute
qualitative term for a solution containing solute at a relatively low concentration
dilution
process of adding solvent to a solution in order to lower the concentration of solutes
dissolved
describes the process by which solute components are dispersed in a solvent
molarity (M)
unit of concentration, defined as the number of moles of solute dissolved in 1 liter of solution
solute
solution component present in a concentration less than that of the solvent
solvent
solution component present in a concentration that is higher relative to other components
This page titled 3.3: Molarity is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that
was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In the previous section, we introduced molarity, a very useful measurement unit for evaluating the concentration of solutions.
However, molarity is only one measure of concentration. In this section, we will introduce some other units of concentration that
are commonly used in various applications, either for convenience or by convention.
We are generally most interested in the mass percentages of solutes, but it is also possible to compute the mass percentage of
solvent.
Mass percentage is also referred to by similar names such as percent mass, percent weight, weight/weight percent, and other
variations on this theme. The most common symbol for mass percentage is simply the percent sign, %, although more detailed
symbols are often used including %mass, %weight, and (w/w)%. Use of these more detailed symbols can prevent confusion of
mass percentages with other types of percentages, such as volume percentages (to be discussed later in this section).
Mass percentages are popular concentration units for consumer products. The label of a typical liquid bleach bottle (Figure 3.4.1)
cites the concentration of its active ingredient, sodium hypochlorite (NaOCl), as being 7.4%. A 100.0-g sample of bleach would
therefore contain 7.4 g of NaOCl.
Figure 3.4.1 : Liquid bleach is an aqueous solution of sodium hypochlorite (NaOCl). This brand has a concentration of 7.4%
NaOCl by mass.
The sides of two cylindrical containers are shown. Each container’s label is partially visible. The left container’s label reads
“Bleach.” The right label contains more information about the product including the phrase, “Contains: Sodium hypochlorite 7.4
%.”
Solution
The spinal fluid sample contains roughly 4 mg of glucose in 5000 mg of fluid, so the mass fraction of glucose should be a bit
less than one part in 1000, or about 0.1%. Substituting the given masses into the equation defining mass percentage yields:
The computed mass percentage agrees with our rough estimate (it’s a bit less than 0.1%).
Note that while any mass unit may be used to compute a mass percentage (mg, g, kg, oz, and so on), the same unit must be
used for both the solute and the solution so that the mass units cancel, yielding a dimensionless ratio. In this case, we converted
the units of solute in the numerator from mg to g to match the units in the denominator. We could just as easily have converted
the denominator from g to mg instead. As long as identical mass units are used for both solute and solution, the computed mass
percentage will be correct.
Exercise 3.4.1
A bottle of a tile cleanser contains 135 g of HCl and 775 g of water. What is the percent by mass of HCl in this cleanser?
Answer
14.8%
“Concentrated” hydrochloric acid is an aqueous solution of 37.2% HCl that is commonly used as a laboratory reagent. The
density of this solution is 1.19 g/mL. What mass of HCl is contained in 0.500 L of this solution?
Solution
The HCl concentration is near 40%, so a 100-g portion of this solution would contain about 40 g of HCl. Since the solution
density isn’t greatly different from that of water (1 g/mL), a reasonable estimate of the HCl mass in 500 g (0.5 L) of the
solution is about five times greater than that in a 100 g portion, or 5 × 40 = 200 g . To derive the mass of solute in a solution
from its mass percentage, we need to know the corresponding mass of the solution. Using the solution density given, we can
convert the solution’s volume to mass, and then use the given mass percentage to calculate the solute mass. This mathematical
approach is outlined in this flowchart:
A diagram of three boxes connected by a right-facing arrow in between each is shown. The box on the left contains the phrase,
“Volume of solution ( m L ),” the middle box reads, “Mass of solution ( g ),” while the one on the right contains the phrase,
“Mass of H C l ( g ).” There is a phrase under the left arrow that says, “Multiply by density ( g / m L )” and under the right
arrow it states, “Multiply by mass percent as ratio ( g H C l / g solution ).”
For proper unit cancellation, the 0.500-L volume is converted into 500 mL, and the mass percentage is expressed as a ratio,
37.2 g HCl/g solution:
1.19 g solution 37.2 g HCl
500 mL solution ( )( ) = 221 g HCl
mL solution 100 g solution
This mass of HCl is consistent with our rough estimate of approximately 200 g.
Exercise 3.4.2
What volume of concentrated HCl solution contains 125 g of HCl?
Answer
Rubbing alcohol (isopropanol) is usually sold as a 70%vol aqueous solution. If the density of isopropyl alcohol is 0.785 g/mL,
how many grams of isopropyl alcohol are present in a 355 mL bottle of rubbing alcohol?
Solution
Per the definition of volume percentage, the isopropanol volume is 70% of the total solution volume. Multiplying the
isopropanol volume by its density yields the requested mass:
70 mL isopropyl alcohol 0.785 g isopropyl alcohol
355 mL solution( )( ) = 195 g isopropyl alcohol
100 mL solution 1 mL isopropyl alcohol
Exercise 3.4.3
Wine is approximately 12% ethanol (CH CH OH ) by volume. Ethanol has a molar mass of 46.06 g/mol and a density 0.789
3 2
g/mL. How many moles of ethanol are present in a 750-mL bottle of wine?
Answer
1.5 mol ethanol
mass solute
9
ppb = × 10 ppb (3.4.4)
mass solution
Both ppm and ppb are convenient units for reporting the concentrations of pollutants and other trace contaminants in water.
Concentrations of these contaminants are typically very low in treated and natural waters, and their levels cannot exceed relatively
low concentration thresholds without causing adverse effects on health and wildlife. For example, the EPA has identified the
maximum safe level of fluoride ion in tap water to be 4 ppm. Inline water filters are designed to reduce the concentration of
fluoride and several other trace-level contaminants in tap water (Figure 3.4.3).
Figure 3.4.3 : (a) In some areas, trace-level concentrations of contaminants can render unfiltered tap water unsafe for drinking and
cooking. (b) Inline water filters reduce the concentration of solutes in tap water. (credit a: modification of work by Jenn Durfey;
credit b: modification of work by “vastateparkstaff”/Wikimedia commons).
Two pictures are shown labeled a and b. Picture a depicts a clear, colorless solution in a plastic bag being held in a person’s hand.
Picture b shows a person’s hand holding a detection meter with a digital readout screen while another hand holds someone’s finger
up to the end of the meter. The meter is pressed to the drop of blood that is at the end of the person’s finger.
According to the EPA, when the concentration of lead in tap water reaches 15 ppb, certain remedial actions must be taken.
What is this concentration in ppm? At this concentration, what mass of lead (μg) would be contained in a typical glass of water
(300 mL)?
Solution
The definitions of the ppm and ppb units may be used to convert the given concentration from ppb to ppm. Comparing these
two unit definitions shows that ppm is 1000 times greater than ppb (1 ppm = 103 ppb). Thus:
1 ppm
15 ppb × = 0.015 ppm
3
10 ppb
The definition of the ppb unit may be used to calculate the requested mass if the mass of the solution is provided. However,
only the volume of solution (300 mL) is given, so we must use the density to derive the corresponding mass. We can assume
the density of tap water to be roughly the same as that of pure water (~1.00 g/mL), since the concentrations of any dissolved
substances should not be very large. Rearranging the equation defining the ppb unit and substituting the given quantities yields:
mass solute
9
ppb = × 10 ppb
mass solution
1.00 g
15 ppb × 300 mL ×
mL −6
mass solute = = 4.5 × 10 g
9
10 ppb
Exercise 3.4.4
A 50.0-g sample of industrial wastewater was determined to contain 0.48 mg of mercury. Express the mercury concentration of
the wastewater in ppm and ppb units.
Answer
9.6 ppm, 9600 ppb
Summary
In addition to molarity, a number of other solution concentration units are used in various applications. Percentage concentrations
based on the solution components’ masses, volumes, or both are useful for expressing relatively high concentrations, whereas lower
concentrations are conveniently expressed using ppm or ppb units. These units are popular in environmental, medical, and other
fields where mole-based units such as molarity are not as commonly used.
Glossary
mass percentage
ratio of solute-to-solution mass expressed as a percentage
mass-volume percent
volume percentage
ratio of solute-to-solution volume expressed as a percentage
This page titled 3.4: Other Units for Solution Concentrations is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
(b)
(c)
(d)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(b)
(c)
Write a sentence that describes how to determine the number of moles of a compound in a known mass of the compound if we
know its molecular formula.
119.0 g KBr
311.2 moles KBr × = 37, 030 g
1 mole KBr
37,030g; 37.03 kg
Calculate the number of moles and the mass of the solute in each of the following solutions:
1. (a) 2.00 L of 18.5 M H2SO4, concentrated sulfuric acid
2. (b) 100.0 mL of 3.8 × 10−5 M NaCN, the minimum lethal concentration of sodium cyanide in blood serum
3. (c) 5.50 L of 13.3 M H2CO, the formaldehyde used to “fix” tissue samples
4. (d) 325 mL of 1.8 × 10−6 M FeSO4, the minimum concentration of iron sulfate detectable by taste in drinking water
(a) 37.0 mol H2SO4;
3.63 × 103 g H2SO4;
35.23 mL = 0.03523 L
−3
9.232 × 10 moles HCl
= 0.2621 M HCl
0.03523 L
0.2621 M ;
Calculate the molarity of each of the following solutions:
(a) 0.195 g of cholesterol, C27H46O, in 0.100 L of serum, the average concentration of cholesterol in human serum
(b) 4.25 g of NH3 in 0.500 L of solution, the concentration of NH3 in household ammonia
(c) 1.49 kg of isopropyl alcohol, C3H7OH, in 2.50 L of solution, the concentration of isopropyl alcohol in rubbing alcohol
(d) 0.029 g of I2 in 0.100 L of solution, the solubility of I2 in water at 20 °C
(a) 5.04 × 10−3 M;
milligrams of CaCO per liter of water. What is the molar concentration of Ca2+ ions in a water sample with a hardness count
3
of 175 mg CaCO3/L?
6. The level of mercury in a stream was suspected to be above the minimum considered safe (1 part per billion by weight). An
analysis indicated that the concentration was 0.68 parts per billion. Assume a density of 1.0 g/mL and calculate the molarity of
mercury in the stream.
7. In Canada and the United Kingdom, devices that measure blood glucose levels provide a reading in millimoles per liter. If a
measurement of 5.3 mM is observed, what is the concentration of glucose (C6H12O6) in mg/dL?
8. A throat spray is 1.40% by mass phenol, C H OH , in water. If the solution has a density of 0.9956 g/mL, calculate the
6 5
3.E.4.2: Solutions
1
(a) The dilution equation can be used, appropriately modified to accommodate mass-based concentration units:
This equation can be rearranged to isolate mass and the given quantities substituted into this equation.
1
(b) 58.8 g
3. 114 g 5. 1.75 × 10 −3
M 7 95 mg/dL9 2.38 × 10 −4
mol 11 0.29mol
This page titled 3.E: Composition of Substances and Solutions (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
This page titled 4: Stoichiometry of Chemical Reactions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
4.0: Prelude to Stoichiometry
Solid-fuel rockets are a central feature in the world’s space exploration programs, including the new Space Launch System being
developed by the National Aeronautics and Space Administration (NASA) to replace the retired Space Shuttle fleet (Figure 4.0.1).
The engines of these rockets rely on carefully prepared solid mixtures of chemicals combined in precisely measured amounts.
Igniting the mixture initiates a vigorous chemical reaction that rapidly generates large amounts of gaseous products. These gases
are ejected from the rocket engine through its nozzle, providing the thrust needed to propel heavy payloads into space. Both the
nature of this chemical reaction and the relationships between the amounts of the substances being consumed and produced by the
reaction are critically important considerations that determine the success of the technology. This chapter will describe how to
symbolize chemical reactions using chemical equations, how to classify some common chemical reactions by identifying patterns
of reactivity, and how to determine the quantitative relations between the amounts of substances involved in chemical reactions—
that is, the reaction stoichiometry.
Figure 4.0.1 : Many modern rocket fuels are solid mixtures of substances combined in carefully measured amounts and ignited to
yield a thrust-generating chemical reaction. (credit: modification of work by NASA)
An image is shown of a rocket that appears to have just passed through a layer of clouds as it travels skyward. A bright white light
is seen in the upper right corner of the image. To the lower left appears the layer of clouds and the bottom of the rocket with fire
projecting from the fuel cones at its base.
This page titled 4.0: Prelude to Stoichiometry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The preceding chapter introduced the use of element symbols to represent individual atoms. When atoms gain or lose electrons to
yield ions, or combine with other atoms to form molecules, their symbols are modified or combined to generate chemical formulas
that appropriately represent these species. Extending this symbolism to represent both the identities and the relative quantities of
substances undergoing a chemical (or physical) change involves writing and balancing a chemical equation. Consider as an
example the reaction between one methane molecule (CH4) and two diatomic oxygen molecules (O2) to produce one carbon
dioxide molecule (CO2) and two water molecules (H2O). The chemical equation representing this process is provided in the upper
half of Figure 4.1.1, with space-filling molecular models shown in the lower half of the figure.
Figure 4.1.1 : The reaction between methane and oxygen to yield carbon dioxide and water (shown at bottom) may be represented
by a chemical equation using formulas (top).
This figure shows a balanced chemical equation followed below by a representation of the equation using space-filling models. The
equation reads C H subscript 4 plus 2 O subscript 2 arrow C O subscript 2 plus 2 H subscript 2 O. Under the C H subscript 4, the
molecule is shown with a central black sphere, representing a C atom, to which 4 smaller white spheres, representing H atoms, are
distributed evenly around. All four H atoms are bonded to the central black C atom. This is followed by a plus sign. Under the 2 O
subscript 2, two molecules are shown. The molecules are each composed of two red spheres bonded together. The red spheres
represent O atoms. To the right of an arrow and under the C O subscript 2, appears a single molecule with a black central sphere
with two red spheres bonded to the left and right. Following a plus sign and under the 2 H subscript 2 O, are two molecules, each
with a central red sphere and two smaller white spheres attached to the lower right and lower left sides of the central red sphere.
Note that in space filling models of molecules, spheres appear slightly compressed in regions where there is a bond between two
atoms.
This example illustrates the fundamental aspects of any chemical equation:
1. The substances undergoing reaction are called reactants, and their formulas are placed on the left side of the equation.
2. The substances generated by the reaction are called products, and their formulas are placed on the right sight of the equation.
3. Plus signs (+) separate individual reactant and product formulas, and an arrow (⟶) separates the reactant and product (left and
right) sides of the equation.
4. The relative numbers of reactant and product species are represented by coefficients (numbers placed immediately to the left of
each formula). A coefficient of 1 is typically omitted.
It is common practice to use the smallest possible whole-number coefficients in a chemical equation, as is done in this example.
Realize, however, that these coefficients represent the relative numbers of reactants and products, and, therefore, they may be
correctly interpreted as ratios. Methane and oxygen react to yield carbon dioxide and water in a 1:2:1:2 ratio. This ratio is satisfied
if the numbers of these molecules are, respectively, 1-2-1-2, or 2-4-2-4, or 3-6-3-6, and so on (Figure 4.1.2). Likewise, these
coefficients may be interpreted with regard to any amount (number) unit, and so this equation may be correctly read in many ways,
including:
One methane molecule and two oxygen molecules react to yield one carbon dioxide molecule and two water molecules.
One dozen methane molecules and two dozen oxygen molecules react to yield one dozen carbon dioxide molecules and two
dozen water molecules.
Figure 4.1.2 : Regardless of the absolute number of molecules involved, the ratios between numbers of molecules of each species
that react (the reactants) and molecules of each species that form (the products) are the same and are given in the chemical
equation.
⎛ 2 O atoms ⎞ ⎛ 1 O atom ⎞
1 CO molecule × + 2 H O molecule × = 4 O atoms
2 2
⎝ CO molecule ⎠ ⎝ H O molecule ⎠
2 2
The equation for the reaction between methane and oxygen to yield carbon dioxide and water is confirmed to be balanced per this
approach, as shown here:
CH +2 O → CO +2 H O
4 2 2 2
O 2×2=4 (1 × 2) + (2 × 1) = 4 4 = 4, yes
A balanced chemical equation often may be derived from a qualitative description of some chemical reaction by a fairly simple
approach known as balancing by inspection. Consider as an example the decomposition of water to yield molecular hydrogen and
oxygen. This process is represented qualitatively by an unbalanced chemical equation:
H O→ H +O (unbalanced)
2 2 2
Comparing the number of H and O atoms on either side of this equation confirms its imbalance:
Comparisons between H and O atoms
Element Reactants Products Balanced?
O 1×1=1 1×2=2 1 ≠ 2, no
The numbers of H atoms on the reactant and product sides of the equation are equal, but the numbers of O atoms are not. To
achieve balance, the coefficients of the equation may be changed as needed. Keep in mind, of course, that the formula subscripts
define, in part, the identity of the substance, and so these cannot be changed without altering the qualitative meaning of the
equation. For example, changing the reactant formula from H2O to H2O2 would yield balance in the number of atoms, but doing so
also changes the reactant’s identity (it’s now hydrogen peroxide and not water). The O atom balance may be achieved by changing
the coefficient for H2O to 2.
2H O→ H +O (unbalanced)
2 2 2
H 2×2=4 1×2=2 4 ≠ 2, no
The H atom balance was upset by this change, but it is easily reestablished by changing the coefficient for the H2 product to 2.
2H O→ 2H +O (balanced)
2 2 2
H atom balance upset but easily reestablished by changing the coefficient for the H2 product to 2.
Element Reactants Products Balanced?
These coefficients yield equal numbers of both H and O atoms on the reactant and product sides, and the balanced equation is,
therefore:
2H O→ 2H +O
2 2 2
Write a balanced equation for the reaction of molecular nitrogen (N2) and oxygen (O2) to form dinitrogen pentoxide.
Solution
First, write the unbalanced equation.
N +O → N O (unbalanced)
2 2 2 5
Next, count the number of each type of atom present in the unbalanced equation.
Unbalanced Equation
Element Reactants Products Balanced?
O 1×2=2 1×5=5 2 ≠ 5, no
Though nitrogen is balanced, changes in coefficients are needed to balance the number of oxygen atoms. To balance the
number of oxygen atoms, a reasonable first attempt would be to change the coefficients for the O2 and N2O5 to integers that
will yield 10 O atoms (the least common multiple for the O atom subscripts in these two formulas).
N +5O → 2N O (unbalanced)
2 2 2 5
N 1×2=2 2×2=4 2 ≠ 4, no
O 5 × 2 = 10 2 × 5 = 10 10 = 10, yes
The N atom balance has been upset by this change; it is restored by changing the coefficient for the reactant N2 to 2.
2N +5 O → 2N O
2 2 2 5
N atom balance upset but restored by changing the coefficient for the reactant N2 to 2.
Element Reactants Products Balanced?
O 5 × 2 = 10 2 × 5 = 10 10 = 10, yes
The numbers of N and O atoms on either side of the equation are now equal, and so the equation is balanced.
Exercise 4.1.1
Write a balanced equation for the decomposition of ammonium nitrate to form molecular nitrogen, molecular oxygen, and
water. (Hint: Balance oxygen last, since it is present in more than one molecule on the right side of the equation.)
Answer
2 NH NO → 2N +O +4 H O
4 3 2 2 2
It is sometimes convenient to use fractions instead of integers as intermediate coefficients in the process of balancing a chemical
equation. When balance is achieved, all the equation’s coefficients may then be multiplied by a whole number to convert the
fractional coefficients to integers without upsetting the atom balance. For example, consider the reaction of ethane (C2H6) with
oxygen to yield H2O and CO2, represented by the unbalanced equation:
C H +O → H O + CO (unbalanced)
2 6 2 2 2
Following the usual inspection approach, one might first balance C and H atoms by changing the coefficients for the two product
species, as shown:
C H +O → 3 H O + 2 CO (unbalanced)
2 6 2 2 2
This results in seven O atoms on the product side of the equation, an odd number—no integer coefficient can be used with the O2
reactant to yield an odd number, so a fractional coefficient, , is used instead to yield a provisional balanced equation:
7
7
C H + O → 3 H O + 2 CO
2 6 2 2 2 2
A conventional balanced equation with integer-only coefficients is derived by multiplying each coefficient by 2:
2C H +7 O → 6 H O + 4 CO
2 6 2 2 2
Finally with regard to balanced equations, recall that convention dictates use of the smallest whole-number coefficients. Although
the equation for the reaction between molecular nitrogen and molecular hydrogen to produce ammonia is, indeed, balanced,
the coefficients are not the smallest possible integers representing the relative numbers of reactant and product molecules. Dividing
each coefficient by the greatest common factor, 3, gives the preferred equation:
N +3 H → 2 NH
2 2 3
Phet Simulation
Use this interactive tutorial for additional practice balancing equations.
This equation represents the reaction that takes place when sodium metal is placed in water. The solid sodium reacts with liquid
water to produce molecular hydrogen gas and the ionic compound sodium hydroxide (a solid in pure form, but readily dissolved in
water).
Special conditions necessary for a reaction are sometimes designated by writing a word or symbol above or below the equation’s
arrow. For example, a reaction carried out by heating may be indicated by the uppercase Greek letter delta (Δ) over the arrow.
Δ
CaCO (s) −
−→ CaO(s) + CO (g)
3 2
Other examples of these special conditions will be encountered in more depth in later chapters.
This balanced equation, derived in the usual fashion, is called a molecular equation because it doesn’t explicitly represent the ionic
species that are present in solution. When ionic compounds dissolve in water, they may dissociate into their constituent ions, which
are subsequently dispersed homogenously throughout the resulting solution (a thorough discussion of this important process is
provided in the chapter on solutions). Ionic compounds dissolved in water are, therefore, more realistically represented as
dissociated ions, in this case:
2+ −
CaCl (aq) → Ca (aq) + 2 Cl (aq)
2
+ −
2 AgNO (aq) → 2 Ag (aq) + 2 NO3 (aq)
3
2+ −
Ca (NO ) (aq) → Ca (aq) + 2 NO (aq)
3 2 3
Unlike these three ionic compounds, AgCl does not dissolve in water to a significant extent, as signified by its physical state
notation, (s).
Explicitly representing all dissolved ions results in a complete ionic equation. In this particular case, the formulas for the dissolved
ionic compounds are replaced by formulas for their dissociated ions:
2+ − + − 2+ −
Ca (aq) + 2 Cl (aq) + 2 Ag (aq) + 2 NO (aq) → Ca (aq) + 2 NO (aq) + 2 Ag Cl(s)
3 3
NO (aq) . These spectator ions—ions whose presence is required to maintain charge neutrality—are neither chemically nor
−
3
physically changed by the process, and so they may be eliminated from the equation to yield a more succinct representation called a
net ionic equation:
2+ − + − 2+ −
Ca (aq) + 2 Cl (aq) + 2 Ag (aq) + 2 NO (aq) → Ca (aq) + 2 NO (aq) + 2 AgCl(s)
3 3
− +
2 Cl (aq) + 2 Ag (aq) → 2 AgCl(s)
Following the convention of using the smallest possible integers as coefficients, this equation is then written:
− +
Cl (aq) + Ag (aq) → AgCl(s)
This net ionic equation indicates that solid silver chloride may be produced from dissolved chloride and silver(I) ions, regardless of
the source of these ions. These molecular and complete ionic equations provide additional information, namely, the ionic
compounds used as sources of Cl and Ag .
− +
When carbon dioxide is dissolved in an aqueous solution of sodium hydroxide, the mixture reacts to yield aqueous sodium
carbonate and liquid water. Write balanced molecular, complete ionic, and net ionic equations for this process.
Solution
Begin by identifying formulas for the reactants and products and arranging them properly in chemical equation form:
CO (aq) + NaOH(aq) → Na CO (aq) + H O(l) (unbalanced)
2 2 3 2
Balance is achieved easily in this case by changing the coefficient for NaOH to 2, resulting in the molecular equation for this
reaction:
+
CO (aq) NaOH(aq) → Na CO (aq) + H O(l)
2 2 2 3 2
The two dissolved ionic compounds, NaOH and Na2CO3, can be represented as dissociated ions to yield the complete ionic
equation:
+ − + 2 −
CO (aq) + 2 Na (aq) + 2 OH (aq) → 2 Na (aq) + CO3 (aq) + H O(l)
2 2
+
Finally, identify the spectator ion(s), in this case Na (aq), and remove it from each side of the equation to generate the net ionic
equation:
+ − + 2−
CO (aq) + 2 Na (aq) + 2 OH (aq) → 2 Na (aq) + CO (aq) + H O(l)
2 3 2
− 2−
CO (aq) + 2 OH (aq) → CO (aq) + H O(l)
2 3 2
Exercise 4.1.2
Diatomic chlorine and sodium hydroxide (lye) are commodity chemicals produced in large quantities, along with diatomic
hydrogen, via the electrolysis of brine, according to the following unbalanced equation:
electricity
Write balanced molecular, complete ionic, and net ionic equations for this process.
Answer
Balanced molecular equation:
Glossary
balanced equation
chemical equation with equal numbers of atoms for each element in the reactant and product
chemical equation
symbolic representation of a chemical reaction
coefficient
number placed in front of symbols or formulas in a chemical equation to indicate their relative amount
molecular equation
chemical equation in which all reactants and products are represented as neutral substances
product
substance formed by a chemical or physical change; shown on the right side of the arrow in a chemical equation
reactant
substance undergoing a chemical or physical change; shown on the left side of the arrow in a chemical equation
spectator ion
ion that does not undergo a chemical or physical change during a reaction, but its presence is required to maintain charge
neutrality
This page titled 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated
by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon
request.
Humans interact with one another in various and complex ways, and we classify these interactions according to common patterns
of behavior. When two humans exchange information, we say they are communicating. When they exchange blows with their fists
or feet, we say they are fighting. Faced with a wide range of varied interactions between chemical substances, scientists have
likewise found it convenient (or even necessary) to classify chemical interactions by identifying common patterns of reactivity.
This module will provide an introduction to three of the most prevalent types of chemical reactions: precipitation, acid-base, and
oxidation-reduction.
group 1 metal cations (Li+, Na+, K+, Rb+, and Cs+) and ammonium
ion (NH )
+
4
the halide ions (Cl−, Br−, and I−) halides of Ag+, Hg , and Pb2+
2+
2
A vivid example of precipitation is observed when solutions of potassium iodide and lead nitrate are mixed, resulting in the
formation of solid lead iodide:
4.2.1 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
This observation is consistent with the solubility guidelines: The only insoluble compound among all those involved is lead iodide,
one of the exceptions to the general solubility of iodide salts.
The net ionic equation representing this reaction is:
2+ −
Pb (aq) + 2 I (aq) → PbI (s)
2
Lead iodide is a bright yellow solid that was formerly used as an artist’s pigment known as iodine yellow (Figure 4.2.1 ). The
properties of pure PbI2 crystals make them useful for fabrication of X-ray and gamma ray detectors.
Figure 4.2.1 : A precipitate of PbI2 forms when solutions containing Pb2+ and I− are mixed. (credit: Der Kreole/Wikimedia
Commons)
A photograph is shown of a yellow green opaque substance swirled through a clear, colorless liquid in a test tube.
The solubility guidelines in Table 4.2.1 may be used to predict whether a precipitation reaction will occur when solutions of
soluble ionic compounds are mixed together. One merely needs to identify all the ions present in the solution and then consider if
possible cation/anion pairing could result in an insoluble compound. For example, mixing solutions of silver nitrate and sodium
fluoride will yield a solution containing Ag+, NO , Na+, and F− ions. Aside from the two ionic compounds originally present in
−
3
the solutions, AgNO3 and NaF, two additional ionic compounds may be derived from this collection of ions: NaNO3 and AgF. The
solubility guidelines indicate all nitrate salts are soluble but that AgF is one of the exceptions to the general solubility of fluoride
salts. A precipitation reaction, therefore, is predicted to occur, as described by the following equations:
+ −
Ag (aq) + F (aq) → AgF(s) (net ionic)
Solution
(a) The two possible products for this combination are KNO3 and BaSO4. The solubility guidelines indicate BaSO4 is
insoluble, and so a precipitation reaction is expected. The net ionic equation for this reaction, derived in the manner detailed in
the previous module, is
2+ 2−
Ba (aq) + SO (aq) → BaSO (s)
4 4
4.2.2 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
(b) The two possible products for this combination are LiC2H3O2 and AgCl. The solubility guidelines indicate AgCl is
insoluble, and so a precipitation reaction is expected. The net ionic equation for this reaction, derived in the manner detailed in
the previous module, is
+ −
Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) → AgCl(s)
(c) The two possible products for this combination are PbCO3 and NH4NO3. The solubility guidelines indicate PbCO3 is
insoluble, and so a precipitation reaction is expected. The net ionic equation for this reaction, derived in the manner detailed in
the previous module, is
2+ 2−
Pb (aq) + CO3 (aq) → PbCO (s)
3
Exercise 4.2.1
Which solution could be used to precipitate the barium ion, Ba2+, in a water sample: sodium chloride, sodium hydroxide, or
sodium sulfate? What is the formula for the expected precipitate?
Answer
sodium sulfate, BaSO4
The process represented by this equation confirms that hydrogen chloride is an acid. When dissolved in water, H3O+ ions are
produced by a chemical reaction in which H+ ions are transferred from HCl molecules to H2O molecules (Figure 4.2.2).
4.2.3 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
Figure 4.2.2 : When hydrogen chloride gas dissolves in water, (a) it reacts as an acid, transferring protons to water molecules to
yield (b) hydronium ions (and solvated chloride ions)
This figure shows two flasks, labeled a and b. The flasks are both sealed with stoppers and are nearly three-quarters full of a liquid.
Flask a is labeled H C l followed by g in parentheses. In the liquid there are approximately twenty space-filling molecular models
composed of one red sphere and two smaller attached white spheres. The label H subscript 2 O followed by a q in parentheses is
connected with a line to one of these models. In the space above the liquid in the flask, four space filling molecular models
composed of one larger green sphere to which a smaller white sphere is bonded are shown. To one of these models, the label H C l
followed by g in parentheses is attached with a line segment. An arrow is drawn from the space above the liquid pointing down into
the liquid below. Flask b is labeled H subscript 3 O superscript positive sign followed by a q in parentheses. This is followed by a
plus sign and C l superscript negative sign which is also followed by a q in parentheses. In this flask, no molecules are shown in the
open space above the liquid. A label, C l superscript negative sign followed by a q in parentheses, is connected with a line segment
to a green sphere. This sphere is surrounded by four molecules composed each of one red sphere and two white smaller spheres. A
few of these same molecules appear separate from the green spheres in the liquid. A line segment connects one of them to the label
H subscript 2 O which is followed by l in parentheses. There are a few molecules formed from one central larger red sphere to
which three smaller white spheres are bonded. A line segment is drawn from one of these to the label H subscript 3 O superscript
positive sign, followed by a q in parentheses.
The nature of HCl is such that its reaction with water as just described is essentially 100% efficient: Virtually every HCl molecule
that dissolves in water will undergo this reaction. Acids that completely react in this fashion are called strong acids, and HCl is one
among just a handful of common acid compounds that are classified as strong (Table 4.2.1). A far greater number of compounds
behave as weak acids and only partially react with water, leaving a large majority of dissolved molecules in their original form and
generating a relatively small amount of hydronium ions. Weak acids are commonly encountered in nature, being the substances
partly responsible for the tangy taste of citrus fruits, the stinging sensation of insect bites, and the unpleasant smells associated with
body odor. A familiar example of a weak acid is acetic acid, the main ingredient in food vinegars:
− +
CH CO H(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ CH CO (aq) + H O (aq)
3 2 2 3 2 3
When dissolved in water under typical conditions, only about 1% of acetic acid molecules are present in the ionized form,
CH CO
3
(Figure 4.2.3). (The use of a double-arrow in the equation above denotes the partial reaction aspect of this process, a
−
4.2.4 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
Figure 4.2.3 : (a) Fruits such as oranges, lemons, and grapefruit contain the weak acid citric acid. (b) Vinegars contain the weak
acid acetic acid. (credit a: modification of work by Scott Bauer; credit b: modification of work by Brücke-Osteuropa/Wikimedia
Commons)
This figure contains two images, each with an associated structural formula provided in the lower left corner of the image. The first
image is a photograph of a variety of thinly sliced, circular cross sections of citrus fruits ranging in color for green to yellow, to
orange and reddish-orange. The slices are closely packed on a white background. The structural formula with this picture shows a
central chain of five C atoms. The leftmost C atom has an O atom double bonded above and to the left and a singly bonded O atom
below and to the left. This single bonded O atom has an H atom indicated in red on its left side which is highlighted in pink. The
second C atom moving to the right has H atoms bonded above and below. The third C atom has a single bonded O atom above
which has an H atom on its right. This third C atom has a C atom bonded below it which has an O atom double bonded below and
to the left and a singly bonded O atom below and to the right. An H atom appears in red and is highlighted in pink to the right of
the singly bonded O atom. The fourth C atom has H atoms bonded above and below. The fifth C atom is at the right end of the
structure. It has an O atom double bonded above and to the right and a singly bonded O atom below and to the right. This single
bonded O atom has a red H atom on its right side which is highlighted in pink. The second image is a photograph of bottles of
vinegar. The bottles are labeled, “Balsamic Vinegar,” and appear to be clear and colorless. The liquid in this bottle appears to be
brown. The structural formula that appears with this image shows a chain of two C atoms. The leftmost C atom has H atoms
bonded above, below, and to the left. The C atom on the right has a doubly bonded O atom above and to the right and a singly
bonded O atom below and to the right. This O atom has an H atom bonded to its right which is highlighted in pink.
Table 4.2.2 : Common Strong Acids
Compound Formula Name in Aqueous Solution
HI hydroiodic acid
A base is a substance that will dissolve in water to yield hydroxide ions, OH−. The most common bases are ionic compounds
composed of alkali or alkaline earth metal cations (groups 1 and 2) combined with the hydroxide ion—for example, NaOH and
Ca(OH)2. When these compounds dissolve in water, hydroxide ions are released directly into the solution. For example, KOH and
Ba(OH)2 dissolve in water and dissociate completely to produce cations (K+ and Ba2+, respectively) and hydroxide ions, OH−.
These bases, along with other hydroxides that completely dissociate in water, are considered strong bases.
Consider as an example the dissolution of lye (sodium hydroxide) in water:
+ −
NaOH(s) → Na (aq) + OH (aq)
This equation confirms that sodium hydroxide is a base. When dissolved in water, NaOH dissociates to yield Na+ and OH− ions.
This is also true for any other ionic compound containing hydroxide ions. Since the dissociation process is essentially complete
when ionic compounds dissolve in water under typical conditions, NaOH and other ionic hydroxides are all classified as strong
bases.
4.2.5 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
Unlike ionic hydroxides, some compounds produce hydroxide ions when dissolved by chemically reacting with water molecules. In
all cases, these compounds react only partially and so are classified as weak bases. These types of compounds are also abundant in
nature and important commodities in various technologies. For example, global production of the weak base ammonia is typically
well over 100 metric tons annually, being widely used as an agricultural fertilizer, a raw material for chemical synthesis of other
compounds, and an active ingredient in household cleaners (Figure 4.2.4). When dissolved in water, ammonia reacts partially to
yield hydroxide ions, as shown here:
+ −
NH (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ NH (aq) + OH (aq)
3 2 4
This is, by definition, an acid-base reaction, in this case involving the transfer of H+ ions from water molecules to ammonia
molecules. Under typical conditions, only about 1% of the dissolved ammonia is present as NH ions. +
Figure 4.2.4 : Ammonia is a weak base used in a variety of applications. (a) Pure ammonia is commonly applied as an agricultural
fertilizer. (b) Dilute solutions of ammonia are effective household cleansers. (credit a: modification of work by National Resources
Conservation Service; credit b: modification of work by pat00139)
This photograph shows a large agricultural tractor in a field pulling a field sprayer and a large, white cylindrical tank which is
labeled “Caution Ammonia.”
The chemical reactions described in which acids and bases dissolved in water produce hydronium and hydroxide ions, respectively,
are, by definition, acid-base reactions. In these reactions, water serves as both a solvent and a reactant. A neutralization reaction is
a specific type of acid-base reaction in which the reactants are an acid and a base, the products are often a salt and water, and
neither reactant is the water itself:
To illustrate a neutralization reaction, consider what happens when a typical antacid such as milk of magnesia (an aqueous
suspension of solid Mg(OH)2) is ingested to ease symptoms associated with excess stomach acid (HCl):
Note that in addition to water, this reaction produces a salt, magnesium chloride.
Solution
(a) The two reactants are provided, HOCl and H2O. Since the substance is reported to be an acid, its reaction with water will
involve the transfer of H+ from HOCl to H2O to generate hydronium ions, H3O+ and hypochlorite ions, OCl−.
− +
HOCl(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ OCl (aq) + H O (aq)
2 3
A double-arrow is appropriate in this equation because it indicates the HOCl is a weak acid that has not reacted completely.
(b) The two reactants are provided, Ba(OH)2 and HNO3. Since this is a neutralization reaction, the two products will be water
and a salt composed of the cation of the ionic hydroxide (Ba2+) and the anion generated when the acid transfers its hydrogen
ion (NO ).
−
3
4.2.6 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
Ba (OH) (aq) + 2 HNO (aq) → Ba (NO ) (aq) + 2 H O(l)
2 3 3 2 2
Exercise 4.2.21
Write the net ionic equation representing the neutralization of any strong acid with an ionic hydroxide. (Hint: Consider the ions
produced when a strong acid is dissolved in water.)
Answer
+ −
H O (aq) + OH (aq) → 2 H O(l)
3 2
Explore the microscopic view of strong and weak acids and bases.
It is helpful to view the process with regard to each individual reactant, that is, to represent the fate of each reactant in the form of
an equation called a half-reaction:
+ −
2 Na(s) → 2 Na (s) + 2 e
− −
Cl (g) + 2 e → 2 Cl (s)
2
These equations show that Na atoms lose electrons while Cl atoms (in the Cl2 molecule) gain electrons, the “s” subscripts for the
resulting ions signifying they are present in the form of a solid ionic compound. For redox reactions of this sort, the loss and gain
of electrons define the complementary processes that occur:
oxidation = loss of electrons (4.2.1)
In this reaction, then, sodium is oxidized and chlorine undergoes reduction. Viewed from a more active perspective, sodium
functions as a reducing agent (reductant), since it provides electrons to (or reduces) chlorine. Likewise, chlorine functions as an
oxidizing agent (oxidant), as it effectively removes electrons from (oxidizes) sodium.
reducing agent = species that is oxidized (4.2.3)
Some redox processes, however, do not involve the transfer of electrons. Consider, for example, a reaction similar to the one
yielding NaCl:
The product of this reaction is a covalent compound, so transfer of electrons in the explicit sense is not involved. To clarify the
similarity of this reaction to the previous one and permit an unambiguous definition of redox reactions, a property called oxidation
number has been defined. The oxidation number (or oxidation state) of an element in a compound is the charge its atoms would
possess if the compound was ionic. The following guidelines are used to assign oxidation numbers to each element in a molecule or
ion.
1. The oxidation number of an atom in an elemental substance is zero.
2. The oxidation number of a monatomic ion is equal to the ion’s charge.
3. Oxidation numbers for common nonmetals are usually assigned as follows:
4.2.7 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
Hydrogen: +1 when combined with nonmetals, −1 when combined with metals
1
Oxygen: −2 in most compounds, sometimes −1 (so-called peroxides, O 2−
2
), very rarely − (so-called superoxides, O ),−
2
2
positive values when combined with F (values vary)
Halogens: −1 for F always, −1 for other halogens except when combined with oxygen or other halogens (positive oxidation
numbers in these cases, varying values)
4. The sum of oxidation numbers for all atoms in a molecule or polyatomic ion equals the charge on the molecule or ion.
Note: The proper convention for reporting charge is to write the number first, followed by the sign (e.g., 2+), while oxidation
number is written with the reversed sequence, sign followed by number (e.g., +2). This convention aims to emphasize the
distinction between these two related properties.
Follow the guidelines in this section of the text to assign oxidation numbers to all the elements in the following species:
a. H2S
b. SO 2−
3
c. Na2SO4
Solution
(a) According to guideline 1, the oxidation number for H is +1.
Using this oxidation number and the compound’s formula, guideline 4 may then be used to calculate the oxidation number for
sulfur:
charge on H S = 0 = (2 × +1) + (1 × x)
2
x = 0 − (2 × +1) = −2
x = −2 − (3 × −2) = +4
(c) For ionic compounds, it’s convenient to assign oxidation numbers for the cation and anion separately.
According to guideline 2, the oxidation number for sodium is +1.
Assuming the usual oxidation number for oxygen (−2 per guideline 3), the oxidation number for sulfur is calculated as directed
by guideline 4:
2−
charge on SO = −2 = (4 × −2) + (1 × x)
4
x = −2 − (4 × −2) = +6
Exercise 4.2.3
Assign oxidation states to the elements whose atoms are underlined in each of the following compounds or ions:
a. KNO3
b. AlH3
c. –
NH
–
+
4
d. H –
2 PO
– 4
−
Answer a
N, +5
Answer b
4.2.8 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
Al, +3
Answer c
N, −3
Answer d
P, +5
Using the oxidation number concept, an all-inclusive definition of redox reaction has been established. Oxidation-reduction (redox)
reactions are those in which one or more elements involved undergo a change in oxidation number. While the vast majority of
redox reactions involve changes in oxidation number for two or more elements, a few interesting exceptions to this rule do exist as
shown below\). Definitions for the complementary processes of this reaction class are correspondingly revised as shown here:
oxidation = increase in oxidation number (4.2.5)
Returning to the reactions used to introduce this topic, they may now both be identified as redox processes. In the reaction between
sodium and chlorine to yield sodium chloride, sodium is oxidized (its oxidation number increases from 0 in Na to +1 in NaCl) and
chlorine is reduced (its oxidation number decreases from 0 in Cl2 to −1 in NaCl). In the reaction between molecular hydrogen and
chlorine, hydrogen is oxidized (its oxidation number increases from 0 in H2 to +1 in HCl) and chlorine is reduced (its oxidation
number decreases from 0 in Cl2 to −1 in HCl).
Several subclasses of redox reactions are recognized, including combustion reactions in which the reductant (also called a fuel) and
oxidant (often, but not necessarily, molecular oxygen) react vigorously and produce significant amounts of heat, and often light, in
the form of a flame. Solid rocket-fuel reactions such as the one depicted below are combustion processes. A typical propellant
reaction in which solid aluminum is oxidized by ammonium perchlorate is represented by this equation:
Watch a brief video showing the test firing of a small-scale, prototype, hybrid rocket engine planned for use in the new Space
Launch System being developed by NASA. The first engines firing at 3 s (green flame) use a liquid fuel/oxidant mixture, and
the second, more powerful engines firing at 4 s (yellow flame) use a solid mixture.
Single-displacement (replacement) reactions are redox reactions in which an ion in solution is displaced (or replaced) via the
oxidation of a metallic element. One common example of this type of reaction is the acid oxidation of certain metals:
Metallic elements may also be oxidized by solutions of other metal salts; for example:
4.2.9 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
This reaction may be observed by placing copper wire in a solution containing a dissolved silver salt. Silver ions in solution are
reduced to elemental silver at the surface of the copper wire, and the resulting Cu2+ ions dissolve in the solution to yield a
characteristic blue color (Figure 4.2.4).
Figure 4.2.4 : (a) A copper wire is shown next to a solution containing silver(I) ions. (b) Displacement of dissolved silver ions by
copper ions results in (c) accumulation of gray-colored silver metal on the wire and development of a blue color in the solution, due
to dissolved copper ions. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott)
This figure contains three photographs. In a, a coiled copper wire is shown beside a test tube filled with a clear, colorless liquid. In
b, the wire has been inserted into the test tube with the clear, colorless liquid. In c, the test tube contains a light blue liquid and the
coiled wire appears to have a fuzzy silver gray coating.
Identify which equations represent redox reactions, providing a name for the reaction if appropriate. For those reactions
identified as redox, name the oxidant and reductant.
a. ZnCO (s) → ZnO(s) + CO (g)
3 2
Solution
Redox reactions are identified per definition if one or more elements undergo a change in oxidation number.
a. This is not a redox reaction, since oxidation numbers remain unchanged for all elements.
b. This is a redox reaction. Gallium is oxidized, its oxidation number increasing from 0 in Ga(l) to +3 in GaBr3(s). The
reducing agent is Ga(l). Bromine is reduced, its oxidation number decreasing from 0 in Br2(l) to −1 in GaBr3(s). The
oxidizing agent is Br2(l).
c. This is a redox reaction. It is a particularly interesting process, as it involves the same element, oxygen, undergoing both
oxidation and reduction (a so-called disproportionation reaction). Oxygen is oxidized, its oxidation number increasing from
−1 in H2O2(aq) to 0 in O2(g). Oxygen is also reduced, its oxidation number decreasing from −1 in H2O2(aq) to −2 in
H2O(l). For disproportionation reactions, the same substance functions as an oxidant and a reductant.
d. This is not a redox reaction, since oxidation numbers remain unchanged for all elements.
e. This is a redox reaction (combustion). Carbon is oxidized, its oxidation number increasing from −2 in C2H4(g) to +4 in
CO2(g). The reducing agent (fuel) is C2H4(g). Oxygen is reduced, its oxidation number decreasing from 0 in O2(g) to −2 in
H2O(l). The oxidizing agent is O2(g).
Exercise 4.2.4
Is this a redox reaction? If so, provide a more specific name for the reaction if appropriate, and identify the oxidant and
reductant.
Answer
4.2.10 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
Yes, a single-replacement reaction. Sn(s) is the reductant, HCl(g) is the oxidant.
Write a balanced equation for the reaction between dichromate ion and iron(II) to yield iron(III) and chromium(III) in acidic
solution.
2− 2+ 3+ 3+
Cr O + Fe → Cr + Fe
2 7
Solution
Write the two half-reactions.
Each half-reaction will contain one reactant and one product with one element in common.
2+ 3+
Fe → Fe
2− 3+
Cr O7 → Cr
2
Balance all elements except oxygen and hydrogen. The iron half-reaction is already balanced, but the chromium half-reaction
shows two Cr atoms on the left and one Cr atom on the right. Changing the coefficient on the right side of the equation to 2
achieves balance with regard to Cr atoms.
2+ 3+
Fe → Fe
2− 3+
Cr O7 → 2 Cr
2
Balance oxygen atoms by adding H2O molecules. The iron half-reaction does not contain O atoms. The chromium half-reaction
shows seven O atoms on the left and none on the right, so seven water molecules are added to the right side.
2+ 3+
Fe → Fe
2− 3+
Cr O → 2 Cr +7 H O
2 7 2
+
Balance hydrogen atoms by adding H ions. The iron half-reaction does not contain H atoms. The chromium half-reaction shows 14
H atoms on the right and none on the left, so 14 hydrogen ions are added to the left side.
4.2.11 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
2+ 3+
Fe → Fe
2− + 3+
Cr O + 14 H → 2 Cr +7 H O
2 7 2
Balance charge by adding electrons. The iron half-reaction shows a total charge of 2+ on the left side (1 Fe2+ ion) and 3+ on the
right side (1 Fe3+ ion). Adding one electron to the right side bring that side’s total charge to (3+) + (1−) = 2+, and charge balance is
achieved.
The chromium half-reaction shows a total charge of (1 × 2−) + (14 × 1+) = 12+ on the left side (1 Cr O ion and 14 H+ ions). 2
2−
The total charge on the right side is (2 × 3+) = 6 + (2 Cr3+ ions). Adding six electrons to the left side will bring that side’s total
charge to (12+ + 6−) = 6+, and charge balance is achieved.
2+ 3+ −
Fe → Fe +e
2− + − 3+
Cr O + 14 H +6 e → 2 Cr +7 H O
2 7 2
Multiply the two half-reactions so the number of electrons in one reaction equals the number of electrons in the other reaction. To
be consistent with mass conservation, and the idea that redox reactions involve the transfer (not creation or destruction) of
electrons, the iron half-reaction’s coefficient must be multiplied by 6.
2+ 3+ −
6 Fe → 6 Fe +6 e
2− − + 3+
Cr O +6 e + 14 H → 2 Cr +7 H O
2 7 2
Add the balanced half-reactions and cancel species that appear on both sides of the equation.
2+ 2− − + 3+ − 3+
6 Fe + Cr O +6 e + 14 H → 6 Fe +6 e + 2 Cr +7 H O
2 7 2
Only the six electrons are redundant species. Removing them from each side of the equation yields the simplified, balanced
equation here:
2+ 2− + 3+ 3+
6 Fe + Cr O + 14 H → 6 Fe + 2 Cr +7 H O
2 7 2
A final check of atom and charge balance confirms the equation is balanced.
Final check of atom and charge balance confirms the equation is balanced.
Reactants Products
Fe 6 6
Cr 2 2
O 7 7
H 14 14
Exercise 4.2.5
In acidic solution, hydrogen peroxide reacts with Fe2+ to produce Fe3+ and H2O. Write a balanced equation for this reaction.
Answer
+ 2+ 3+
H O (aq) + 2 H (aq) + 2 Fe → 2 H O(l) + 2 Fe
2 2 2
Summary
Chemical reactions are classified according to similar patterns of behavior. A large number of important reactions are included in
three categories: precipitation, acid-base, and oxidation-reduction (redox). Precipitation reactions involve the formation of one or
more insoluble products. Acid-base reactions involve the transfer of hydrogen ions between reactants. Redox reactions involve a
4.2.12 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
change in oxidation number for one or more reactant elements. Writing balanced equations for some redox reactions that occur in
aqueous solutions is simplified by using a systematic approach called the half-reaction method.
4.2.3.1: Footnotes
1. 1 The requirement of “charge balance” is just a specific type of “mass balance” in which the species in question are electrons.
An equation must represent equal numbers of electrons on the reactant and product sides, and so both atoms and charges must
be balanced.
2. 2 The requirement of “charge balance” is just a specific type of “mass balance” in which the species in question are electrons.
An equation must represent equal numbers of electrons on the reactant and product sides, and so both atoms and charges must
be balanced.
4.2.3.2: Glossary
acid
substance that produces H3O+ when dissolved in water
acid-base reaction
reaction involving the transfer of a hydrogen ion between reactant species
base
substance that produces OH− when dissolved in water
combustion reaction
vigorous redox reaction producing significant amounts of energy in the form of heat and, sometimes, light
half-reaction
an equation that shows whether each reactant loses or gains electrons in a reaction.
insoluble
of relatively low solubility; dissolving only to a slight extent
neutralization reaction
reaction between an acid and a base to produce salt and water
oxidation
process in which an element’s oxidation number is increased by loss of electrons
oxidation-reduction reaction
(also, redox reaction) reaction involving a change in oxidation number for one or more reactant elements
oxidation number
(also, oxidation state) the charge each atom of an element would have in a compound if the compound were ionic
oxidizing agent
(also, oxidant) substance that brings about the oxidation of another substance, and in the process becomes reduced
precipitate
insoluble product that forms from reaction of soluble reactants
precipitation reaction
reaction that produces one or more insoluble products; when reactants are ionic compounds, sometimes called double-
displacement or metathesis
reduction
process in which an element’s oxidation number is decreased by gain of electrons
4.2.13 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
reducing agent
(also, reductant) substance that brings about the reduction of another substance, and in the process becomes oxidized
salt
ionic compound that can be formed by the reaction of an acid with a base that contains a cation and an anion other than
hydroxide or oxide
single-displacement reaction
(also, replacement) redox reaction involving the oxidation of an elemental substance by an ionic species
soluble
of relatively high solubility; dissolving to a relatively large extent
solubility
the extent to which a substance may be dissolved in water, or any solvent
strong acid
acid that reacts completely when dissolved in water to yield hydronium ions
strong base
base that reacts completely when dissolved in water to yield hydroxide ions
weak acid
acid that reacts only to a slight extent when dissolved in water to yield hydronium ions
weak base
base that reacts only to a slight extent when dissolved in water to yield hydroxide ions
4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by LibreTexts.
4.2.14 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/38155
4.3: Reaction Stoichiometry
Learning Objectives
Explain the concept of stoichiometry as it pertains to chemical reactions
Use balanced chemical equations to derive stoichiometric factors relating amounts of reactants and products
Perform stoichiometric calculations involving mass, moles, and solution molarity
A balanced chemical equation provides a great deal of information in a very succinct format. Chemical formulas provide the
identities of the reactants and products involved in the chemical change, allowing classification of the reaction. Coefficients
provide the relative numbers of these chemical species, allowing a quantitative assessment of the relationships between the
amounts of substances consumed and produced by the reaction. These quantitative relationships are known as the reaction’s
stoichiometry, a term derived from the Greek words stoicheion (meaning “element”) and metron (meaning “measure”). In this
module, the use of balanced chemical equations for various stoichiometric applications is explored.
The general approach to using stoichiometric relationships is similar in concept to the way people go about many common
activities. Cooking, for example, offers an appropriate comparison. Suppose a recipe for making eight pancakes calls for 1 cup
3
pancake mix, cup milk, and one egg. The “equation” representing the preparation of pancakes per this recipe is
4
3
1 cup mix + cup milk + 1 egg → 8 pancakes (4.3.1)
4
If two dozen pancakes are needed for a big family breakfast, the ingredient amounts must be increased proportionally according to
the amounts given in the recipe. For example, the number of eggs required to make 24 pancakes is
1 egg
24 pancakes × = 3 eggs (4.3.2)
8 pancakes
Balanced chemical equations are used in much the same fashion to determine the amount of one reactant required to react with a
given amount of another reactant, or to yield a given amount of product, and so forth. The coefficients in the balanced equation are
used to derive stoichiometric factors that permit computation of the desired quantity. To illustrate this idea, consider the production
of ammonia by reaction of hydrogen and nitrogen:
N (g) + 3 H (g) → 2 NH (g) (4.3.3)
2 2 3
This equation shows that ammonia molecules are produced from hydrogen molecules in a 2:3 ratio, and stoichiometric factors may
be derived using any amount (number) unit:
2 NH molecules 2 doz NH molecules 2 mol NH molecules
3 3 3
or or (4.3.4)
3H molecules 3 doz H molecules 3 mol H molecules
2 2 2
These stoichiometric factors can be used to compute the number of ammonia molecules produced from a given number of
hydrogen molecules, or the number of hydrogen molecules required to produce a given number of ammonia molecules. Similar
factors may be derived for any pair of substances in any chemical equation.
2 Al + 3 I → 2 AlI (4.3.5)
2 3
Solution
3 mol I
Referring to the balanced chemical equation, the stoichiometric factor relating the two substances of interest is 2
. The
2 mol Al
molar amount of iodine is derived by multiplying the provided molar amount of aluminum by this factor:
3 mol I2
mol I2 = 0.429 mol Al ×
2 mol Al
= 0.644 mol I2
Exercise 4.3.1
How many moles of Ca(OH)2 are required to react with 1.36 mol of H3PO4 to produce Ca3(PO4)2 according to the equation
3 Ca (OH) + 2 H PO → Ca (PO ) + 6 H O ?
2 3 4 3 4 2 2
Answer
2.04 mol
How many carbon dioxide molecules are produced when 0.75 mol of propane is combusted according to this equation?
C H +5 O → 3 CO +4 H O (4.3.6)
3 8 2 2 2
Solution
The approach here is the same as for Example 4.3.1, though the absolute number of molecules is requested, not the number of
moles of molecules. This will simply require use of the moles-to-numbers conversion factor, Avogadro’s number.
The balanced equation shows that carbon dioxide is produced from propane in a 3:1 ratio:
\[\ce{\dfrac{3\: mol\: CO2}{1\: mol\: C3H8}} \label{4.4.7} \]
Using this stoichiometric factor, the provided molar amount of propane, and Avogadro’s number,
Exercise 4.3.1
How many NH3 molecules are produced by the reaction of 4.0 mol of Ca(OH)2 according to the following equation:
(NH ) SO + Ca (OH) → 2 NH + CaSO +2 H O (4.3.8)
4 2 4 2 3 4 2
Answer
4.8 × 1024 NH3 molecules
These examples illustrate the ease with which the amounts of substances involved in a chemical reaction of known stoichiometry
may be related. Directly measuring numbers of atoms and molecules is, however, not an easy task, and the practical application of
stoichiometry requires that we use the more readily measured property of mass.
What mass of sodium hydroxide, NaOH, would be required to produce 16 g of the antacid milk of magnesia [magnesium
hydroxide, Mg(OH)2] by the following reaction?
MgCl (aq) + 2 NaOH(aq) → Mg (OH) (s) + 2 NaCl(aq)
2 2
Solution
The approach used previously in Examples 4.3.1 and 4.3.2 is likewise used here; that is, we must derive an appropriate
stoichiometric factor from the balanced chemical equation and use it to relate the amounts of the two substances of interest. In this
case, however, masses (not molar amounts) are provided and requested, so additional steps of the sort learned in the previous
chapter are required. The calculations required are outlined in this flowchart:
Exercise 4.3.3
What mass of gallium oxide, Ga2O3, can be prepared from 29.0 g of gallium metal? The equation for the reaction is
4 Ga + 3 O → 2 Ga O .
2 2 3
Answer
39.0 g
2C H + 25 O → 16 CO + 18 H O
8 18 2 2 2
Solution
The approach required here is the same as for the Example 4.3.3, differing only in that the provided and requested masses are
both for reactant species.
1 mol C H 25 mol O
8 18 2 32.00 g O
2 3
702 g C H × × × = 2.46 × 10 g O
8 18 2
114.23 g C H 2 mol C H mol O
8 18 8 18 2
Exercise 4.3.4
What mass of CO is required to react with 25.13 g of Fe2O3 according to the equation Fe 2
O
3
+ 3 CO → 2 Fe + 3 CO
2
?
Answer
13.22 g
These examples illustrate just a few instances of reaction stoichiometry calculations. Numerous variations on the beginning and
ending computational steps are possible depending upon what particular quantities are provided and sought (volumes, solution
concentrations, and so forth). Regardless of the details, all these calculations share a common essential component: the use of
stoichiometric factors derived from balanced chemical equations. Figure 4.3.2 provides a general outline of the various
computational steps associated with many reaction stoichiometry calculations.
Airbags
Airbags (Figure 4.3.3) are a safety feature provided in most automobiles since the 1990s. The effective operation of an airbag
requires that it be rapidly inflated with an appropriate amount (volume) of gas when the vehicle is involved in a collision. This
requirement is satisfied in many automotive airbag systems through use of explosive chemical reactions, one common choice
being the decomposition of sodium azide, NaN3. When sensors in the vehicle detect a collision, an electrical current is passed
through a carefully measured amount of NaN3 to initiate its decomposition:
This reaction is very rapid, generating gaseous nitrogen that can deploy and fully inflate a typical airbag in a fraction of a second
(~0.03–0.1 s). Among many engineering considerations, the amount of sodium azide used must be appropriate for generating
enough nitrogen gas to fully inflate the air bag and ensure its proper function. For example, a small mass (~100 g) of NaN3 will
generate approximately 50 L of N2.
Summary
A balanced chemical equation may be used to describe a reaction’s stoichiometry (the relationships between amounts of reactants
and products). Coefficients from the equation are used to derive stoichiometric factors that subsequently may be used for
computations relating reactant and product masses, molar amounts, and other quantitative properties.
4.3.0.1: Glossary
stoichiometric factor
ratio of coefficients in a balanced chemical equation, used in computations relating amounts of reactants and products
stoichiometry
relationships between the amounts of reactants and products of a chemical reaction
This page titled 4.3: Reaction Stoichiometry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The relative amounts of reactants and products represented in a balanced chemical equation are often referred to as stoichiometric
amounts. All the exercises of the preceding module involved stoichiometric amounts of reactants. For example, when calculating
the amount of product generated from a given amount of reactant, it was assumed that any other reactants required were available
in stoichiometric amounts (or greater). In this module, more realistic situations are considered, in which reactants are not present in
stoichiometric amounts.
Stoichiometric amounts of sandwich ingredients for this recipe are bread and cheese slices in a 2:1 ratio. Provided with 28 slices of
bread and 11 slices of cheese, one may prepare 11 sandwiches per the provided recipe, using all the provided cheese and having six
slices of bread left over. In this scenario, the number of sandwiches prepared has been limited by the number of cheese slices, and
the bread slices have been provided in excess.
Figure 4.4.1 : Sandwich making can illustrate the concepts of limiting and excess reactants.
This figure has three rows showing the ingredients needed to make a sandwich. The first row reads, “1 sandwich = 2 slices of bread
+ 1 slice of cheese.” Two slices of bread and one slice of cheese are shown. The second row reads, “Provided with: 28 slices of
bread + 11 slices of cheese.” There are 28 slices of bread and 11 slices of cheese shown. The third row reads, “We can make: 11
sandwiches + 6 slices of bread left over.” 11 sandwiches are shown with six extra slices of bread.
Consider this concept now with regard to a chemical process, the reaction of hydrogen with chlorine to yield hydrogen chloride:
The balanced equation shows the hydrogen and chlorine react in a 1:1 stoichiometric ratio. If these reactants are provided in any
other amounts, one of the reactants will nearly always be entirely consumed, thus limiting the amount of product that may be
generated. This substance is the limiting reactant, and the other substance is the excess reactant. Identifying the limiting and excess
reactants for a given situation requires computing the molar amounts of each reactant provided and comparing them to the
stoichiometric amounts represented in the balanced chemical equation.
For example, imagine combining 6 moles of H2 and 4 moles of Cl2. Identifying the limiting reactant involves comparing the
amount of product expected for the complete reaction of each reactant. Each reactant amount is used to separately calculate the
The chlorine will be completely consumed once 8 moles of HCl have been produced. Since enough hydrogen was provided to yield
12 moles of HCl, there will be non-reacted hydrogen remaining once this reaction is complete. Chlorine, therefore, is the limiting
reactant and hydrogen is the excess reactant (Figure 4.4.2). To determine the amount of excess reactant that remains, the amount
of hydrogen consumed in the reaction can be subtracted from the starting quantity of hydrogen.
The amount of hydrogen consumed is
1 mol H2
mol H2 produced = 8 mol HCl × = 4 mol H2
2 mol HCl
Figure 4.4.2 : When H2 and Cl2 are combined in nonstoichiometric amounts, one of these reactants will limit the amount of HCl
that can be produced. This illustration shows a reaction in which hydrogen is present in excess and chlorine is the limiting reactant.
The figure shows a space-filling molecular models reacting. There is a reaction arrow pointing to the right in the middle. To the left
of the reaction arrow there are three molecules each consisting of two green spheres bonded together. There are also five molecules
each consisting of two smaller, white spheres bonded together. Above these molecules is the label, “Before reaction,” and below
these molecules is the label, “6 H subscript 2 and 4 C l subscript 2.” To the right of the reaction arrow, there are eight molecules
each consisting of one green sphere bonded to a smaller white sphere. There are also two molecules each consisting of two white
spheres bonded together. Above these molecules is the label, “After reaction,” and below these molecules is the label, “8 H C l and
2 H subscript 2.”
Solution
1 mol N2
mol N2 = 1.50 g N2 × = 0.0535 mol N2
28.02 g N2
Comparing these ratios shows that Si is provided in a less-than-stoichiometric amount, and so is the limiting reactant.
Alternatively, compute the amount of product expected for complete reaction of each of the provided reactants. The 0.0712
moles of silicon would yield
1 mol Si3 N4
mol Si3 N4 produced = 0.0712 mol Si × = 0.0237 mol Si3 N4
3 mol Si
Since silicon yields the lesser amount of product, it is the limiting reactant.
Exercise 4.4.1
Which is the limiting reactant when 5.00 g of H2 and 10.0 g of O2 react and form water?
Answer
O2
Actual and theoretical yields may be expressed as masses or molar amounts (or any other appropriate property; e.g., volume, if the
product is a gas). As long as both yields are expressed using the same units, these units will cancel when percent yield is calculated.
Solution
The provided information identifies copper sulfate as the limiting reactant, and so the theoretical yield is found by the approach
illustrated in the previous module, as shown here:
Using this theoretical yield and the provided value for actual yield, the percent yield is calculated to be
actual yield
percent yield = ( ) × 100
theoretical yield
0.392 g Cu
percent yield = ( ) × 100
0.5072 g Cu
= 77.3%
Exercise 4.4.2
What is the percent yield of a reaction that produces 12.5 g of the gas Freon CF2Cl2 from 32.9 g of CCl4 and excess HF?
CCl + 2 HF → CF Cl + 2 HCl
4 2 2
Answer
48.3%
Though the definition of atom economy at first glance appears very similar to that for percent yield, be aware that this property
represents a difference in the theoretical efficiencies of different chemical processes. The percent yield of a given chemical
process, on the other hand, evaluates the efficiency of a process by comparing the yield of product actually obtained to the
maximum yield predicted by stoichiometry.
The synthesis of the common nonprescription pain medication, ibuprofen, nicely illustrates the success of a green chemistry
approach (Figure 4.4.3). First marketed in the early 1960s, ibuprofen was produced using a six-step synthesis that required 514
g of reactants to generate each mole (206 g) of ibuprofen, an atom economy of 40%. In the 1990s, an alternative process was
Figure 4.4.3 : (a) Ibuprofen is a popular nonprescription pain medication commonly sold as 200 mg tablets. (b) The BHC
process for synthesizing ibuprofen requires only three steps and exhibits an impressive atom economy. (credit a: modification
of work by Derrick Coetzee)
Summary
When reactions are carried out using less-than-stoichiometric quantities of reactants, the amount of product generated will be
determined by the limiting reactant. The amount of product generated by a chemical reaction is its actual yield. This yield is often
less than the amount of product predicted by the stoichiometry of the balanced chemical equation representing the reaction (its
theoretical yield). The extent to which a reaction generates the theoretical amount of product is expressed as its percent yield.
Glossary
actual yield
amount of product formed in a reaction
excess reactant
reactant present in an amount greater than required by the reaction stoichiometry
limiting reactant
reactant present in an amount lower than required by the reaction stoichiometry, thus limiting the amount of product generated
percent yield
measure of the efficiency of a reaction, expressed as a percentage of the theoretical yield
theoretical yield
amount of product that may be produced from a given amount of reactant(s) according to the reaction stoichiometry
This page titled 4.4: Reaction Yields is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In the 18th century, the strength (actually the concentration) of vinegar samples was determined by noting the amount of potassium
carbonate, K2CO3, which had to be added, a little at a time, before bubbling ceased. The greater the weight of potassium carbonate
added to reach the point where the bubbling ended, the more concentrated the vinegar.
We now know that the effervescence that occurred during this process was due to reaction with acetic acid, CH3CO2H, the
compound primarily responsible for the odor and taste of vinegar. Acetic acid reacts with potassium carbonate according to the
following equation:
4.5.1: Titration
The described approach to measuring vinegar strength was an early version of the analytical technique known as titration analysis.
A typical titration analysis involves the use of a buret (Figure 4.5.1) to make incremental additions of a solution containing a
known concentration of some substance (the titrant) to a sample solution containing the substance whose concentration is to be
measured (the analyte). The titrant and analyte undergo a chemical reaction of known stoichiometry, and so measuring the volume
of titrant solution required for complete reaction with the analyte (the equivalence point of the titration) allows calculation of the
analyte concentration. The equivalence point of a titration may be detected visually if a distinct change in the appearance of the
sample solution accompanies the completion of the reaction. The halt of bubble formation in the classic vinegar analysis is one
such example, though, more commonly, special dyes called indicators are added to the sample solutions to impart a change in color
at or very near the equivalence point of the titration. Equivalence points may also be detected by measuring some solution property
that changes in a predictable way during the course of the titration. Regardless of the approach taken to detect a titration’s
equivalence point, the volume of titrant actually measured is called the end point. Properly designed titration methods typically
ensure that the difference between the equivalence and end points is negligible. Though any type of chemical reaction may serve as
the basis for a titration analysis, the three described in this chapter (precipitation, acid-base, and redox) are most common.
Additional details regarding titration analysis are provided in the chapter on acid-base equilibria.
The end point in a titration of a 50.00-mL sample of aqueous HCl was reached by addition of 35.23 mL of 0.250 M NaOH
titrant. The titration reaction is:
HCl(aq) + NaOH(aq) → NaCl(aq) + H O(l)
2
Solution
As for all reaction stoichiometry calculations, the key issue is the relation between the molar amounts of the chemical species
of interest as depicted in the balanced chemical equation. The approach outlined in previous modules of this chapter is
followed, with additional considerations required, since the amounts of reactants provided and requested are expressed as
solution concentrations.
For this exercise, the calculation will follow the following outlined steps:
Using the provided volume of HCl solution and the definition of molarity, the HCl concentration is:
mol HCl
M =
L solution
−3
8.81 × 10 mol HCl
M =
1 L
50.00 mL ×
1000 mL
M = 0.176 M
Note: For these types of titration calculations, it is convenient to recognize that solution molarity is also equal to the number of
millimoles of solute per milliliter of solution:
3
10 mmol
Using this version of the molarity unit will shorten the calculation by eliminating two conversion factors:
0.250 mmol NaOH 1 mmol HCl
35.23 mL NaOH × ×
mL NaOH 1 mmol NaOH
= 0.176 M HCl
50.00 mL solution
Exercise 4.5.1
A 20.00-mL sample of aqueous oxalic acid, H2C2O4, was titrated with a 0.09113-M solution of potassium permanganate,
KMnO4.
− + 2+
2 MnO (aq) + 5 H C O (aq) + 6 H (aq) → 10 CO (g) + 2 Mn (aq) + 8 H O(l)
4 2 2 4 2 2
A volume of 23.24 mL was required to reach the end point. What is the oxalic acid molarity?
Answer
0.2648 M
A 0.4550-g solid mixture containing MgSO4 is dissolved in water and treated with an excess of Ba(NO3)2, resulting in the
precipitation of 0.6168 g of BaSO4.
Solution
The plan for this calculation is similar to others used in stoichiometric calculations, the central step being the connection
between the moles of BaSO4 and MgSO4 through their stoichiometric factor. Once the mass of MgSO4 is computed, it may be
used along with the mass of the sample mixture to calculate the requested percentage concentration.
The mass of MgSO4 that would yield the provided precipitate mass is
0.3181 g
× 100% = 69.91%
0.4550 g
Exercise 4.5.2
What is the percent of chloride ion in a sample if 1.1324 g of the sample produces 1.0881 g of AgCl when treated with excess
Ag+?
+ −
Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) → AgCl(s)
Answer
23.76%
Polyethylene is a hydrocarbon polymer used to produce food-storage bags and many other flexible plastic items. A combustion
analysis of a 0.00126-g sample of polyethylene yields 0.00394 g of CO2 and 0.00161 g of H2O. What is the empirical formula
of polyethylene?
Solution
The primary assumption in this exercise is that all the carbon in the sample combusted is converted to carbon dioxide, and all
the hydrogen in the sample is converted to water:
y
Cx Hy (s) + excess O (g) → x CO (g) + H O(g)
2 2 2
2
Note that a balanced equation is not necessary for the task at hand. To derive the empirical formula of the compound, only the
subscripts x and y are needed.
First, calculate the molar amounts of carbon and hydrogen in the sample, using the provided masses of the carbon dioxide and
water, respectively. With these molar amounts, the empirical formula for the compound may be written as described in the
previous chapter of this text. An outline of this approach is given in the following flow chart:
1 mol H2 O 2 mol H
−4
mol H = 0.00161 g H2 O × × = 1.79 × 10 mol H
18.02 g/mol 1 mol H2 O
The empirical formula for the compound is then derived by identifying the smallest whole-number multiples for these molar
amounts. The H-to-C molar ratio is
−4
mol H 1.79 × 10 mol H 2 mol H
= =
−5
mol C 8.95 × 10 mol C 1 mol C
Exercise 4.5.3
A 0.00215-g sample of polystyrene, a polymer composed of carbon and hydrogen, produced 0.00726 g of CO2 and 0.00148 g
of H2O in a combustion analysis. What is the empirical formula for polystyrene?
Answer
CH
Glossary
analyte
chemical species of interest
buret
device used for the precise delivery of variable liquid volumes, such as in a titration analysis
combustion analysis
gravimetric technique used to determine the elemental composition of a compound via the collection and weighing of its
gaseous combustion products
end point
measured volume of titrant solution that yields the change in sample solution appearance or other property expected for
stoichiometric equivalence (see equivalence point)
equivalence point
volume of titrant solution required to react completely with the analyte in a titration analysis; provides a stoichiometric amount
of titrant for the sample’s analyte according to the titration reaction
gravimetric analysis
quantitative chemical analysis method involving the separation of an analyte from a sample by a physical or chemical process
and subsequent mass measurements of the analyte, reaction product, and/or sample
indicator
substance added to the sample in a titration analysis to permit visual detection of the end point
quantitative analysis
the determination of the amount or concentration of a substance in a sample
titrant
solution containing a known concentration of substance that will react with the analyte in a titration analysis
titration analysis
quantitative chemical analysis method that involves measuring the volume of a reactant solution required to completely react
with the analyte in a sample
This page titled 4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
4.E.1.2: S4.1.1
An equation is balanced when the same number of each element is represented on the reactant and product sides. Equations must be
balanced to accurately reflect the law of conservation of matter.
4.E.1.3: Q4.1.2
Consider molecular, complete ionic, and net ionic equations.
a. What is the difference between these types of equations?
b. In what circumstance would the complete and net ionic equations for a reaction be identical?
4.E.1.4: Q4.1.3
Balance the following equations:
a. PCl (s) + H O(l) → POCl (l) + HCl(aq)
5 2 3
4.E.1.5: S4.1.3
a. PCl (s) + H O(l) → POCl (l) + 2 HCl(aq) ;
5 2 3
4.E.2: Q4.1.4
Balance the following equations:
a. Ag(s) + H S(g) + O (g) → Ag S(s) + H O(l)
2 2 2 2
4.E.2.1: S4.1.4
a. 4 Ag(s) + 2 H S(g) + O (g) → 2 Ag S(s) + 2 H
2 2 2 2
O(l)
4.E.2.2: Q4.1.5
Write a balanced molecular equation describing each of the following chemical reactions.
a. Solid calcium carbonate is heated and decomposes to solid calcium oxide and carbon dioxide gas.
b. Gaseous butane, C4H10, reacts with diatomic oxygen gas to yield gaseous carbon dioxide and water vapor.
c. Aqueous solutions of magnesium chloride and sodium hydroxide react to produce solid magnesium hydroxide and aqueous sodium
chloride.
d. Water vapor reacts with sodium metal to produce solid sodium hydroxide and hydrogen gas.
4.E.2.3: S4.1.5
a. CaCO (s) → CaO(s) + CO (g) ;
3 2
4.E.2.4: Q4.1.6
Write a balanced equation describing each of the following chemical reactions.
a. Solid potassium chlorate, KClO3, decomposes to form solid potassium chloride and diatomic oxygen gas.
b. Solid aluminum metal reacts with solid diatomic iodine to form solid Al2I6.
c. When solid sodium chloride is added to aqueous sulfuric acid, hydrogen chloride gas and aqueous sodium sulfate are produced.
d. Aqueous solutions of phosphoric acid and potassium hydroxide react to produce aqueous potassium dihydrogen phosphate and
liquid water.
4.E.2.5: Q4.1.7
Colorful fireworks often involve the decomposition of barium nitrate and potassium chlorate and the reaction of the metals
magnesium, aluminum, and iron with oxygen.
a. Write the formulas of barium nitrate and potassium chlorate.
b. The decomposition of solid potassium chlorate leads to the formation of solid potassium chloride and diatomic oxygen gas. Write
an equation for the reaction.
c. The decomposition of solid barium nitrate leads to the formation of solid barium oxide, diatomic nitrogen gas, and diatomic
oxygen gas. Write an equation for the reaction.
d. Write separate equations for the reactions of the solid metals magnesium, aluminum, and iron with diatomic oxygen gas to yield
the corresponding metal oxides. (Assume the iron oxide contains Fe3+ ions.)
4.E.2.6: Q4.1.7
a. Ba(NO3)2, KClO3;
b. 2 KClO (s) → 2 KCl(s) + 3 O (g) ;
3 2
4.E.2.7: Q4.1.8
Fill in the blank with a single chemical formula for a covalent compound that will balance the equation:
4.E.2.9: S4.1.9
a. 4 HF(aq) + SiO (s) → SiF (g) + 2 H O(l) ;
2 4 2
4.E.2.10: Q4.1.10
A novel process for obtaining magnesium from sea water involves several reactions. Write a balanced chemical equation for each step
of the process.
a. The first step is the decomposition of solid calcium carbonate from seashells to form solid calcium oxide and gaseous carbon
dioxide.
b. The second step is the formation of solid calcium hydroxide as the only product from the reaction of the solid calcium oxide with
liquid water.
c. Solid calcium hydroxide is then added to the seawater, reacting with dissolved magnesium chloride to yield solid magnesium
hydroxide and aqueous calcium chloride.
d. The solid magnesium hydroxide is added to a hydrochloric acid solution, producing dissolved magnesium chloride and liquid
water.
e. Finally, the magnesium chloride is melted and electrolyzed to yield liquid magnesium metal and diatomic chlorine gas.
4.E.2.11: Q4.1.11
From the balanced molecular equations, write the complete ionic and net ionic equations for the following:
a. K C O (aq) + Ba(OH) (aq) → 2 KOH(aq) + BaC O (s)
2 2 4 2 2 2
4.E.2.12: S4.1.11
a. 2K
+
(aq) + C O
2
2−
4
(aq) + Ba
2+
(aq) + 2 OH
−
(aq) → 2 K
+
(aq) + 2 OH
−
(aq) + BaC O (s)
2 4
(complete) (4.E.1)
2+ 2−
Ba (aq) + C O (aq) → BaC O (s) (net) (4.E.2)
2 4 2 4
b. Pb
2+
(aq) + 2 NO3 (aq) + 2 H
− +
(aq) + SO
2−
4
(aq) → PbSO (s) + 2 H
4
+
(aq) + 2 NO3 (aq)
−
(complete) (4.E.3)
2+ 2−
Pb (aq) + SO (aq) → PbSO (s) (net) (4.E.4)
4 4
c. CaCO (s) + 2 H
3
+
(aq) + SO
2−
4
(aq) → CaSO (s) + CO (g) + H O(l)
4 2 2
(complete) (4.E.5)
+ 2−
CaCO (s) + 2 H (aq) + SO 4 (aq) → CaSO (s) + CO (g) + H O(l) (net) (4.E.6)
3 4 2 2
3
(aq) → AgCl(s) + Na
+
(aq) + NO
−
3
(aq)
4.E.3.2: S4.2.1
a.) i. H 2 O(solid) → H2 O(liquid)
b.) iii.
c.) iii. 2 CH 3
OH(g) + 3 O (g) → 2 CO (g) + 4 H O(g)
2 2 2
d.) v.
4.E.3.3: Q4.2.2
Indicate what type, or types, of reaction each of the following represents:
a. Ca(s) + Br (l) → CaBr (s) 2 2
4.E.3.4: S4.2.2
oxidation-reduction (addition); acid-base (neutralization); oxidation-reduction (combustion)
<
4.E.3.5: Q4.2.3
Indicate what type, or types, of reaction each of the following represents:
a. H O(g) + C(s) → CO(g) + H (g)
2 2
4.E.3.6: Q4.2.4
Silver can be separated from gold because silver dissolves in nitric acid while gold does not. Is the dissolution of silver in nitric acid
an acid-base reaction or an oxidation-reduction reaction? Explain your answer.
4.E.3.7: S4.2.4
It is an oxidation-reduction reaction because the oxidation state of the silver changes during the reaction.
4.E.3.8: Q4.2.5
Determine the oxidation states of the elements in the following compounds:
a. NaI
b. GdCl3
c. LiNO3
d. H2Se
e. Mg2Si
f. RbO2, rubidium superoxide
g. HF
4.E.3.9: Q4.2.6
Determine the oxidation states of the elements in the compounds listed. None of the oxygen-containing compounds are peroxides or
superoxides.
a. H3PO4
b. Al(OH)3
c. SeO2
d. KNO2
4.E.3.10: S4.2.6
H +1, P +5, O −2; Al +3, H +1, O −2; Se +4, O −2; K +1, N +3, O −2; In +3, S −2; P +3, O −2
4.E.3.11: Q4.2.7
Determine the oxidation states of the elements in the compounds listed. None of the oxygen-containing compounds are peroxides or
superoxides.
a. H2SO4
b. Ca(OH)2
c. BrOH
d. ClNO2
e. TiCl4
f. NaH
4.E.3.12: S4.2.7
a. H1+, O2-, S6+
b. H1+, O2-, Ca+2
c. H1+, O2-, Br1+
d. O2-, Cl1-, N5+
e. Cl1-, Ti4+
f. H1+, Na1-
4.E.3.13: Q4.2.8
Classify the following as acid-base reactions or oxidation-reduction reactions:
a. Na S(aq) + 2 HCl(aq) → 2 NaCl(aq) + H S(g)
2 2
4.E.3.14: S4.2.9
acid-base; oxidation-reduction: Na is oxidized, H+ is reduced; oxidation-reduction: Mg is oxidized, Cl2 is reduced; acid-base;
oxidation-reduction: P3− is oxidized, O2 is reduced; acid-base
4.E.3.15: Q4.2.10
Identify the atoms that are oxidized and reduced, the change in oxidation state for each, and the oxidizing and reducing agents in each
of the following equations:
a. Mg(s) + NiCl (aq) → MgCl (aq) + Ni(s)
2 2
4.E.3.16: Q4.2.11
Complete and balance the following acid-base equations:
a. HCl gas reacts with solid Ca(OH)2(s).
b. A solution of Sr(OH)2 is added to a solution of HNO3.
4.E.3.18: Q4.2.12
Complete and balance the following acid-base equations:
a. A solution of HClO4 is added to a solution of LiOH.
b. Aqueous H2SO4 reacts with NaOH.
c. Ba(OH)2 reacts with HF gas.
4.E.3.19: Q4.2.13
Complete and balance the following oxidation-reduction reactions, which give the highest possible oxidation state for the oxidized
atoms.
a. Al(s) + F (g) →
2
c. P (s) + O (g) →
4 2
4.E.3.20: S4.2.13
a. 2 Al(s) + 3 F (g) → 2 AlF (s) ;
2 3
4.E.3.21: Q4.2.14
Complete and balance the following oxidation-reduction reactions, which give the highest possible oxidation state for the oxidized
atoms.
a. K(s) + H O(l) →
2
b. Ba(s) + HBr(aq) →
c. Sn(s) + I (s) →
2
4.E.3.22: Q4.2.15
Complete and balance the equations for the following acid-base neutralization reactions. If water is used as a solvent, write the
reactants and products as aqueous ions. In some cases, there may be more than one correct answer, depending on the amounts of
reactants used.
a. Mg(OH) (s) + HClO (aq) →
2 4
b. SO (g) + H O(l) → (assume an excess of water and that the product dissolves)
3 2
c. SrO(s) + H SO (l) → 2 4
4.E.3.23: S4.2.15
a. Mg(OH) (s) + 2 HClO (aq) → Mg (aq) + 2 ClO (aq) + 2 H O(l) ;
2 4
2+ −
4 2
4.E.3.24: Q4.2.16
When heated to 700–800 °C, diamonds, which are pure carbon, are oxidized by atmospheric oxygen. (They burn!) Write the balanced
equation for this reaction.
4.E.3.25: Q4.2.17
The military has experimented with lasers that produce very intense light when fluorine combines explosively with hydrogen. What is
the balanced equation for this reaction?
4.E.3.27: Q4.2.18
Write the molecular, total ionic, and net ionic equations for the following reactions:
a. Ca(OH) (aq) + HC H O (aq) →
2 2 3 2
4.E.3.28: Q4.2.19
Great Lakes Chemical Company produces bromine, Br2, from bromide salts such as NaBr, in Arkansas brine by treating the brine with
chlorine gas. Write a balanced equation for the reaction of NaBr with Cl2.
4.E.3.29: S4.2.19
2 NaBr(aq) + Cl (g) → 2 NaCl(aq) + Br (l)
2 2
4.E.3.30: Q4.2.20
In a common experiment in the general chemistry laboratory, magnesium metal is heated in air to produce MgO. MgO is a white solid,
but in these experiments it often looks gray, due to small amounts of Mg3N2, a compound formed as some of the magnesium reacts
with nitrogen. Write a balanced equation for each reaction.
4.E.3.31: Q4.2.21
Lithium hydroxide may be used to absorb carbon dioxide in enclosed environments, such as manned spacecraft and submarines. Write
an equation for the reaction that involves 2 mol of LiOH per 1 mol of CO2. (Hint: Water is one of the products.)
4.E.3.32: S4.2.21
2 LiOH(aq) + CO (g) → Li CO (aq) + H O(l)
2 2 3 2
4.E.3.33: Q4.2.22
Calcium propionate is sometimes added to bread to retard spoilage. This compound can be prepared by the reaction of calcium
carbonate, CaCO3, with propionic acid, C2H5CO2H, which has properties similar to those of acetic acid. Write the balanced equation
for the formation of calcium propionate.
4.E.3.34: Q4.2.23
Complete and balance the equations of the following reactions, each of which could be used to remove hydrogen sulfide from natural
gas:
a. Ca(OH) (s) + H 2 2
S(g) →
b. Na CO (aq) + H
2 3 2
S(g) →
4.E.3.35: S4.2.23
a. Ca(OH) (s) + H 2 2
S(g) → CaS(s) + 2 H O(l)
2
;
b. Na CO (aq) + H
2 3 2
S(g) → Na S(aq) + CO (g) + H O(l)
2 2 2
4.E.3.36: Q4.2.24
Copper(II) sulfide is oxidized by molecular oxygen to produce gaseous sulfur trioxide and solid copper(II) oxide. The gaseous product
then reacts with liquid water to produce liquid hydrogen sulfate as the only product. Write the two equations which represent these
reactions.
4.E.3.37: Q4.2.25
Write balanced chemical equations for the reactions used to prepare each of the following compounds from the given starting
material(s). In some cases, additional reactants may be required.
a. solid ammonium nitrate from gaseous molecular nitrogen via a two-step process (first reduce the nitrogen to ammonia, then
neutralize the ammonia with an appropriate acid)
b. gaseous hydrogen bromide from liquid molecular bromine via a one-step redox reaction
4.E.3.38: S4.2.25
a. step 1: N (g) + 3 H (g) → 2 NH (g) , step 2: NH (g) + HNO (aq) → NH
2 2 3 3 3 4
NO (aq) → NH NO (s)(after drying)
3 4 3
;
b. H (g) + Br (l) → 2 HBr(g) ;
2 2
4.E.3.39: Q4.2.26
Calcium cyclamate Ca(C6H11NHSO3)2 is an artificial sweetener used in many countries around the world but is banned in the United
States. It can be purified industrially by converting it to the barium salt through reaction of the acid C6H11NHSO3H with barium
carbonate, treatment with sulfuric acid (barium sulfate is very insoluble), and then neutralization with calcium hydroxide. Write the
balanced equations for these reactions.
4.E.3.40: Q4.2.27
Complete and balance each of the following half-reactions (steps 2–5 in half-reaction method):
a. Sn (aq) → Sn (aq)
4+ 2+
+
b. [Ag(NH ) ] (aq) → Ag(s) + NH (aq)
3 2 3
e. IO (aq) → I (s)
−
3 2
4
2+
4.E.3.41: S4.2.27
a. Sn (aq) + 2 e → Sn (aq) ,
4+ − 2+
3
2−
4
+ −
4.E.3.42: Q4.2.28
Complete and balance each of the following half-reactions (steps 2–5 in half-reaction method):
a. Cr (aq) → Cr (aq)
2+ 3+
4.E.3.43: Q4.2.29
Balance each of the following equations according to the half-reaction method:
a. Sn (aq) + Cu (aq) → Sn (aq) + Cu (aq)
2+ 2+ 4+ +
2
− −
2 2
− −
3
O
+
(aq) ;
d. Fe (aq) + Ce (aq) → Fe (aq) + Ce (aq) ;
2+ 4+ 3+ 3+
4.E.3.45: Q4.2.30
Balance each of the following equations according to the half-reaction method:
a. Zn(s) + NO (aq) → Zn (aq) + N (g) (in acid)
−
3
2+
3
2+
3
3
2+
4.E.3.46: Q4.2.31
Balance each of the following equations according to the half-reaction method:
a. MnO (aq) + NO (aq) → MnO (s) + NO (aq) (in base)
−
4
−
2 2
−
4.E.3.47: S4.2.31
a. 2 MnO (aq) + 3 NO (aq) + H O(l) → 2 MnO (s) + 3 NO (aq) + 2 OH (aq) ;
−
4
−
2 2 2
−
3
−
b. 3 MnO (aq) + 2 H O(l) → 2 MnO (aq) + 4 OH (aq) + MnO (s) (in base) ;
2−
4 2
−
4
−
2
f.
4.E.4.2: Q4.3.2
Determine the number of moles and the mass requested for each reaction in Exercise.
4.E.4.3: S4.3.2
0.435 mol Na, 0.217 mol Cl2, 15.4 g Cl2; 0.005780 mol HgO, 2.890 × 10−3 mol O2, 9.248 × 10−2 g O2; 8.00 mol NaNO3, 6.8 × 102 g
NaNO3; 1665 mol CO2, 73.3 kg CO2; 18.86 mol CuO, 2.330 kg CuCO3; 0.4580 mol C2H4Br2, 86.05 g C2H4Br2
f.
4.E.4.5: Q4.3.4
Determine the number of moles and the mass requested for each reaction in Exercise.
4.E.4.6: S4.3.4
0.0686 mol Mg, 1.67 g Mg; 2.701 × 10−3 mol O2, 0.08644 g O2; 6.43 mol MgCO3, 542 g MgCO3 713 mol H2O, 12.8 kg H2O; 16.31
mol BaO2, 2762 g BaO2; 0.207 mol C2H4, 5.81 g C2H4
4.E.4.7: Q4.3.5
H2 is produced by the reaction of 118.5 mL of a 0.8775-M solution of H3PO4 according to the following equation:
2 Cr + 2 H PO → 3 H + 2 CrPO .
3 4 2 4
a. Outline the steps necessary to determine the number of moles and mass of H2.
b. Perform the calculations outlined.
4.E.4.8: S4.3.5
a.)
1. Convert mL to L
2. Multiply L by the molarity to determine moles of H3PO4
3. Convert moles of H3PO4 to moles of H2
4. Multiply moles of H2 by the molar mass of H2 to get the answer in grams
b.)
1 L
1. 118.5 mL × = 0.1185 L
1000 mL
0.8775 moles H PO
2. 0.1185 L × 3 4
= 0.1040 moles H PO
3 4
1 L
3 moles H
2
3. 0.1040 moles H 3
PO
4
× = 0.1560 moles H
2
2 moles H PO
3 4
2.02g
4. 0.1560 moles H 2
× = 0.3151g H
2
1 mole
4.E.4.9: Q4.3.6
Gallium chloride is formed by the reaction of 2.6 L of a 1.44 M solution of HCl according to the following equation:
2 Ga + 6 HCl → 2 GaCl + 3 H .
3 2
a. Outline the steps necessary to determine the number of moles and mass of gallium chloride.
b. Perform the calculations outlined.
4.E.4.11: Q4.3.7
I2 is produced by the reaction of 0.4235 mol of CuCl2 according to the following equation: 2 CuCl 2
+ 4 KI → 2 CuI + 4 KCl + I
2
.
a. How many molecules of I2 are produced?
b. What mass of I2 is produced?
4.E.4.12: Q4.3.8
Silver is often extracted from ores as K[Ag(CN)2] and then recovered by the reaction
2 K[Ag (CN) ](aq) + Zn(s) → 2 Ag(s) + Zn(CN) (aq) + 2 KCN(aq)
2 2
a. How many molecules of Zn(CN)2 are produced by the reaction of 35.27 g of K[Ag(CN)2]?
b. What mass of Zn(CN)2 is produced?
4.E.4.13: S4.3.8
5.337 × 1022 molecules; 10.41 g Zn(CN)2
4.E.4.14: Q4.3.9
What mass of silver oxide, Ag2O, is required to produce 25.0 g of silver sulfadiazine, AgC10H9N4SO2, from the reaction of silver
oxide and sulfadiazine?
2C H N SO + Ag O → 2 AgC H N SO +H O
10 10 4 2 2 10 9 4 2 2
4.E.4.15: Q4.3.10
Carborundum is silicon carbide, SiC, a very hard material used as an abrasive on sandpaper and in other applications. It is prepared by
the reaction of pure sand, SiO2, with carbon at high temperature. Carbon monoxide, CO, is the other product of this reaction. Write the
balanced equation for the reaction, and calculate how much SiO2 is required to produce 3.00 kg of SiC.
4.E.4.16: S4.3.10
SiO
2
+ 3 C → SiC + 2 CO , 4.50 kg SiO2
4.E.4.17: Q4.3.11
Automotive air bags inflate when a sample of sodium azide, NaN3, is very rapidly decomposed.
2 NaN (s) → 2 Na(s) + 3 N (g)
3 2
What mass of sodium azide is required to produce 2.6 ft3 (73.6 L) of nitrogen gas with a density of 1.25 g/L?
4.E.4.18: S4.3.11
142g NaN3
4.E.4.19: Q4.3.12
Urea, CO(NH2)2, is manufactured on a large scale for use in producing urea-formaldehyde plastics and as a fertilizer. What is the
maximum mass of urea that can be manufactured from the CO2 produced by combustion of 1.00×103 kg of carbon followed by the
reaction?
CO (g) + 2 NH (g) → CO(NH ) (s) + H O(l) (4.E.7)
2 3 2 2 2
4.E.4.20: S4.3.12
5.00 × 103 kg
4.E.4.21: Q4.3.13
In an accident, a solution containing 2.5 kg of nitric acid was spilled. Two kilograms of Na2CO3 was quickly spread on the area and
CO2 was released by the reaction. Was sufficient Na2CO3 used to neutralize all of the acid?
4.E.4.23: S4.3.14
1.28 × 105 g CO2
4.E.4.24: Q4.3.15
What volume of a 0.750 M solution of hydrochloric acid, a solution of HCl, can be prepared from the HCl produced by the reaction of
25.0 g of NaCl with an excess of sulfuric acid?
NaCl(s) + H SO (l) → HCl(g) + NaHSO (s) (4.E.8)
2 4 4
4.E.4.25: Q4.3.16
What volume of a 0.2089 M KI solution contains enough KI to react exactly with the Cu(NO3)2 in 43.88 mL of a 0.3842 M solution of
Cu(NO3)2?
2 Cu(NO ) + 4 KI → 2 CuI + I + 4 KNO (4.E.9)
3 2 2 3
4.E.4.26: S4.3.16
161.40 mL KI solution
4.E.4.27: Q4.3.17
A mordant is a substance that combines with a dye to produce a stable fixed color in a dyed fabric. Calcium acetate is used as a
mordant. It is prepared by the reaction of acetic acid with calcium hydroxide.
What mass of Ca(OH)2 is required to react with the acetic acid in 25.0 mL of a solution having a density of 1.065 g/mL and containing
58.0% acetic acid by mass?
4.E.4.28: Q4.3.18
The toxic pigment called white lead, Pb3(OH)2(CO3)2, has been replaced in white paints by rutile, TiO2. How much rutile (g) can be
prepared from 379 g of an ore that contains 88.3% ilmenite (FeTiO3) by mass?
2 FeTiO + 4 HCl + Cl → 2 FeCl + 2 TiO +2 H O (4.E.11)
3 2 3 2 2
4.E.4.29: S4.3.18
176 g TiO2
4.E.5.2: Q4.4.2
What is the limiting reactant in a reaction that produces sodium chloride from 8 g of sodium and 8 g of diatomic chlorine?
4.E.5.3: S4.4.2
The limiting reactant is Cl2.
4.E.5.5: Q4.4.4
A student isolated 25 g of a compound following a procedure that would theoretically yield 81 g. What was his percent yield?
4.E.5.6: S4.4.4
Percent yield = 31%
4.E.5.7: Q4.4.5
A sample of 0.53 g of carbon dioxide was obtained by heating 1.31 g of calcium carbonate. What is the percent yield for this reaction?
CaCO (s) → CaO(s) + CO (s) (4.E.12)
3 2
4.E.5.8: Q4.4.6
Freon-12, CCl2F2, is prepared from CCl4 by reaction with HF. The other product of this reaction is HCl. Outline the steps needed to
determine the percent yield of a reaction that produces 12.5 g of CCl2F2 from 32.9 g of CCl4. Freon-12 has been banned and is no
longer used as a refrigerant because it catalyzes the decomposition of ozone and has a very long lifetime in the atmosphere. Determine
the percent yield.
4.E.5.9: S4.4.6
g CCl → mol CCl → mol CCl F → g CCl F , percent yield = 48.3%
4 4 2 2 2 2
4.E.5.10: Q4.4.7
Citric acid, C6H8O7, a component of jams, jellies, and fruity soft drinks, is prepared industrially via fermentation of sucrose by the
mold Aspergillus niger. The equation representing this reaction is
C H O +H O+3 O → 2C H O +4 H O (4.E.13)
12 22 11 2 2 6 8 7 2
What mass of citric acid is produced from exactly 1 metric ton (1.000 × 103 kg) of sucrose if the yield is 92.30%?
4.E.5.11: Q4.4.8
Toluene, C6H5CH3, is oxidized by air under carefully controlled conditions to benzoic acid, C6H5CO2H, which is used to prepare the
food preservative sodium benzoate, C6H5CO2Na. What is the percent yield of a reaction that converts 1.000 kg of toluene to 1.21 kg
of benzoic acid?
2 C H CH +3 O → 2 C H CO H + 2 H O (4.E.14)
6 5 3 2 6 5 2 2
4.E.5.12: S4.4.8
percent yield = 91.3%
4.E.5.13: Q4.4.9
In a laboratory experiment, the reaction of 3.0 mol of H2 with 2.0 mol of I2 produced 1.0 mol of HI. Determine the theoretical yield in
grams and the percent yield for this reaction.
4.E.5.14: Q4.4.10
Outline the steps needed to solve the following problem, then do the calculations. Ether, (C2H5)2O, which was originally used as an
anesthetic but has been replaced by safer and more effective medications, is prepared by the reaction of ethanol with sulfuric acid.
2C2H5OH + H2SO4 ⟶ (C2H5)2 + H2SO4·H2O
4.E.5.15: Q4.4.11
What is the percent yield of ether if 1.17 L (d = 0.7134 g/mL) is isolated from the reaction of 1.500 L of C2H5OH (d = 0.7894 g/mL)?
4.E.5.16: S4.4.11
Convert mass of ethanol to moles of ethanol; relate the moles of ethanol to the moles of ether produced using the stoichiometry of the
balanced equation. Convert moles of ether to grams; divide the actual grams of ether (determined through the density) by the
theoretical mass to determine the percent yield; 87.6%
4.E.5.18: Q4.4.13
Outline the steps needed to determine the limiting reactant when 0.50 g of Cr and 0.75 g of H3PO4 react according to the following
chemical equation?
2 Cr + 2 H PO → 2 CrPO +3 H (4.E.16)
3 4 4 2
4.E.5.19: S4.4.13
The conversion needed is mol Cr → mol H PO
2 4
. Then compare the amount of Cr to the amount of acid present. Cr is the limiting
reactant.
4.E.5.20: Q4.4.14
What is the limiting reactant when 1.50 g of lithium and 1.50 g of nitrogen combine to form lithium nitride, a component of advanced
batteries, according to the following unbalanced equation?
Li + N → Li N (4.E.17)
2 3
4.E.5.21: S4.4.14
6 Li + N → 2 Li N (4.E.18)
2 3
1 mole Li 2 mole Li N
3
1.50g Li × × = 0.0720 moles Li N (4.E.19)
3
6.94g Li 6 mole Li
1 mole N 2 mole Li N
2 3
1.50g N × × = 0.107 moles Li N (4.E.20)
2 3
28.02g N 1 mole N
2 2
4.E.5.22: Q4.4.15
Uranium can be isolated from its ores by dissolving it as UO2(NO3)2, then separating it as solid UO2(C2O4)·3H2O. Addition of 0.4031
g of sodium oxalate, Na2C2O4, to a solution containing 1.481 g of uranyl nitrate, UO2(NO2)2, yields 1.073 g of solid
UO2(C2O4)·3H2O.
Determine the limiting reactant and the percent yield of this reaction.
4.E.5.23: S4.4.15
Na2C2O4 is the limiting reactant. percent yield = 86.6%
4.E.5.24: Q4.4.16
How many molecules of C2H4Cl2 can be prepared from 15 C2H4 molecules and 8 Cl2 molecules?
4.E.5.25: Q4.4.17
How many molecules of the sweetener saccharin can be prepared from 30 C atoms, 25 H atoms, 12 O atoms, 8 S atoms, and 14 N
atoms?
4.E.5.27: Q4.4.18
The phosphorus pentoxide used to produce phosphoric acid for cola soft drinks is prepared by burning phosphorus in oxygen.
a. What is the limiting reactant when 0.200 mol of P4 and 0.200 mol of O2 react according to
P +5 O → P O (4.E.22)
4 2 4 10
b. Calculate the percent yield if 10.0 g of P4O10 is isolated from the reaction.
4.E.5.28: Q4.4.19
Would you agree to buy 1 trillion (1,000,000,000,000) gold atoms for $5? Explain why or why not. Find the current price of gold at
http://money.cnn.com/data/commodities/ (1 troy ounce = 31.1 g)
4.E.5.29: S4.4.19
This amount cannot be weighted by ordinary balances and is worthless.
4.E.6.2: Q4.5.2
Titration of a 20.0-mL sample of acid rain required 1.7 mL of 0.0811 M NaOH to reach the end point. If we assume that the acidity of
the rain is due to the presence of sulfuric acid, what was the concentration of sulfuric acid in this sample of rain?
4.E.6.3: S4.5.2
3.4 × 10−3 M H2SO4
4.E.6.4: Q4.5.3
What is the concentration of NaCl in a solution if titration of 15.00 mL of the solution with 0.2503 M AgNO3 requires 20.22 mL of the
AgNO3 solution to reach the end point?
AgNO (aq) + NaCl(aq) → AgCl(s) + NaNO (aq) (4.E.24)
3 3
4.E.6.5: Q4.5.4
In a common medical laboratory determination of the concentration of free chloride ion in blood serum, a serum sample is titrated
with a Hg(NO3)2 solution.
− −
2 Cl (aq) + Hg (NO ) (aq) → 2 NO3 (aq) + HgCl (s) (4.E.25)
3 2 2
What is the Cl− concentration in a 0.25-mL sample of normal serum that requires 1.46 mL of 5.25 × 10−4 M Hg(NO3)2(aq) to reach
the end point?
4.E.6.6: S4.5.4
9.6 × 10−3 M Cl−
4.E.6.8: Q4.5.6
A sample of gallium bromide, GaBr2, weighing 0.165 g was dissolved in water and treated with silver nitrate, AgNO3, resulting in the
precipitation of 0.299 g AgBr. Use these data to compute the %Ga (by mass) GaBr2.
4.E.6.9: S4.5.6
22.4%
4.E.6.10: Q4.5.7
The principal component of mothballs is naphthalene, a compound with a molecular mass of about 130 amu, containing only carbon
and hydrogen. A 3.000-mg sample of naphthalene burns to give 10.3 mg of CO2. Determine its empirical and molecular formulas.
4.E.6.11: Q4.5.8
A 0.025-g sample of a compound composed of boron and hydrogen, with a molecular mass of ~28 amu, burns spontaneously when
exposed to air, producing 0.063 g of B2O3. What are the empirical and molecular formulas of the compound.
4.E.6.12: S4.5.8
The empirical formula is BH3. The molecular formula is B2H6.
4.E.6.13: Q4.5.9
Sodium bicarbonate (baking soda), NaHCO3, can be purified by dissolving it in hot water (60 °C), filtering to remove insoluble
impurities, cooling to 0 °C to precipitate solid NaHCO3, and then filtering to remove the solid, leaving soluble impurities in solution.
Any NaHCO3 that remains in solution is not recovered. The solubility of NaHCO3 in hot water of 60 °C is 164 g L. Its solubility in
cold water of 0 °C is 69 g/L. What is the percent yield of NaHCO3 when it is purified by this method?
4.E.6.14: Q4.5.10
What volume of 0.600 M HCl is required to react completely with 2.50 g of sodium hydrogen carbonate?
NaHCO (aq) + HCl(aq) → NaCl(aq) + CO (g) + H O(l) (4.E.26)
3 2 2
4.E.6.15: S4.5.10
49.6 mL
4.E.6.16: Q4.5.11
What volume of 0.08892 M HNO3 is required to react completely with 0.2352 g of potassium hydrogen phosphate?
4.E.6.17: Q4.5.12
What volume of a 0.3300-M solution of sodium hydroxide would be required to titrate 15.00 mL of 0.1500 M oxalic acid?
C O H (aq) + 2 NaOH(aq) → Na C O (aq) + 2 H O(l) (4.E.28)
2 4 2 2 2 4 2
4.E.6.18: S4.5.12
13.64 mL
4.E.6.19: Q4.5.13
What volume of a 0.00945-M solution of potassium hydroxide would be required to titrate 50.00 mL of a sample of acid rain with a
H2SO4 concentration of 1.23 × 10−4 M.
H SO (aq) + 2 KOH(aq) → K SO (aq) + 2 H O(l) (4.E.29)
2 4 2 4 2
4.E.6.21: Q4.5.14
A sample of solid calcium hydroxide, Ca(OH)2, is allowed to stand in water until a saturated solution is formed. A titration of 75.00
mL of this solution with 5.00 × 10−2 M HCl requires 36.6 mL of the acid to reach the end point.
4.E.6.22: S4.5.14
1.22 M
4.E.6.23: Q4.5.15
What mass of Ca(OH)2 will react with 25.0 g of propionic acid to form the preservative calcium propionate according to the equation?
4.E.6.24: Q4.5.16
How many milliliters of a 0.1500-M solution of KOH will be required to titrate 40.00 mL of a 0.0656-M solution of H3PO4?
H PO (aq) + 2 KOH(aq) → K HPO (aq) + 2 H O(l) (4.E.31)
3 4 2 4 2
4.E.6.25: S4.5.16
34.99 mL KOH
4.E.6.26: Q4.5.17
Potassium acid phthalate, KHC6H4O4, or KHP, is used in many laboratories, including general chemistry laboratories, to standardize
solutions of base. KHP is one of only a few stable solid acids that can be dried by warming and weighed. A 0.3420-g sample of
KHC6H4O4 reacts with 35.73 mL of a NaOH solution in a titration. What is the molar concentration of the NaOH?
4.E.6.27: Q4.5.18
The reaction of WCl6 with Al at ~400 °C gives black crystals of a compound containing only tungsten and chlorine. A sample of this
compound, when reduced with hydrogen, gives 0.2232 g of tungsten metal and hydrogen chloride, which is absorbed in water.
Titration of the hydrochloric acid thus produced requires 46.2 mL of 0.1051 M NaOH to reach the end point. What is the empirical
formula of the black tungsten chloride?
4.E.6.28: S4.5.19
The empirical formula is WCl4.
This page titled 4.E: Stoichiometry of Chemical Reactions (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon
request.
This page titled 5: Thermochemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
5.0: Prelude to Thermochemistry
Chemical reactions, such as those that occur when you light a match, involve changes in energy as well as matter. Societies at all
levels of development could not function without the energy released by chemical reactions. In 2012, about 85% of US energy
consumption came from the combustion of petroleum products, coal, wood, and garbage. We use this energy to produce electricity
(38%); to transport food, raw materials, manufactured goods, and people (27%); for industrial production (21%); and to heat and
power our homes and businesses (10%).1 While these combustion reactions help us meet our essential energy needs, they are also
recognized by the majority of the scientific community as a major contributor to global climate change.
Figure 5.0.1 : Sliding a match head along a rough surface initiates a combustion reaction that produces energy in the form of heat
and light. (credit: modification of work by Laszlo Ilyes).
Useful forms of energy are also available from a variety of chemical reactions other than combustion. For example, the energy
produced by the batteries in a cell phone, car, or flashlight results from chemical reactions. This chapter introduces many of the
basic ideas necessary to explore the relationships between chemical changes and energy, with a focus on thermal energy.
Footnotes
1. US Energy Information Administration, Primary Energy Consumption by Source and Sector, 2012, Total Energy
[www.eia.gov]. Data derived from US Energy Information Administration, Monthly Energy Review (January 2014).
This page titled 5.0: Prelude to Thermochemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Chemical changes and their accompanying changes in energy are important parts of our everyday world (Figure 5.1.1). The
macronutrients in food (proteins, fats, and carbohydrates) undergo metabolic reactions that provide the energy to keep our bodies
functioning. We burn a variety of fuels (gasoline, natural gas, coal) to produce energy for transportation, heating, and the
generation of electricity. Industrial chemical reactions use enormous amounts of energy to produce raw materials (such as iron and
aluminum). Energy is then used to manufacture those raw materials into useful products, such as cars, skyscrapers, and bridges.
Figure 5.1.1 : The energy involved in chemical changes is important to our daily lives: (a) A cheeseburger for lunch provides the
energy you need to get through the rest of the day; (b) the combustion of gasoline provides the energy that moves your car (and
you) between home, work, and school; and (c) coke, a processed form of coal, provides the energy needed to convert iron ore into
iron, which is essential for making many of the products we use daily. (credit a: modification of work by “Pink Sherbet
Photography”/Flickr; credit b: modification of work by Jeffery Turner).
Three pictures are shown and labeled a, b, and c. Picture a is a cheeseburger. Picture b depicts a highway that is full of traffic.
Picture c is a view into an industrial metal furnace. The view into the furnace shows a hot fire burning inside.
Over 90% of the energy we use comes originally from the sun. Every day, the sun provides the earth with almost 10,000 times the
amount of energy necessary to meet all of the world’s energy needs for that day. Our challenge is to find ways to convert and store
incoming solar energy so that it can be used in reactions or chemical processes that are both convenient and nonpolluting. Plants
and many bacteria capture solar energy through photosynthesis. We release the energy stored in plants when we burn wood or plant
products such as ethanol. We also use this energy to fuel our bodies by eating food that comes directly from plants or from animals
that got their energy by eating plants. Burning coal and petroleum also releases stored solar energy: These fuels are fossilized plant
and animal matter.
This chapter will introduce the basic ideas of an important area of science concerned with the amount of heat absorbed or released
during chemical and physical changes—an area called thermochemistry. The concepts introduced in this chapter are widely used in
almost all scientific and technical fields. Food scientists use them to determine the energy content of foods. Biologists study the
energetics of living organisms, such as the metabolic combustion of sugar into carbon dioxide and water. The oil, gas, and
transportation industries, renewable energy providers, and many others endeavor to find better methods to produce energy for our
commercial and personal needs. Engineers strive to improve energy efficiency, find better ways to heat and cool our homes,
refrigerate our food and drinks, and meet the energy and cooling needs of computers and electronics, among other applications.
Understanding thermochemical principles is essential for chemists, physicists, biologists, geologists, every type of engineer, and
just about anyone who studies or does any kind of science.
5.1.1: Energy
Energy can be defined as the capacity to supply heat or do work. One type of work (w) is the process of causing matter to move
against an opposing force. For example, we do work when we inflate a bicycle tire—we move matter (the air in the pump) against
the opposing force of the air surrounding the tire.
Figure 5.1.2 : (a) Water that is higher in elevation, for example, at the top of Victoria Falls, has a higher potential energy than water
at a lower elevation. As the water falls, some of its potential energy is converted into kinetic energy. (b) If the water flows through
generators at the bottom of a dam, such as the Hoover Dam shown here, its kinetic energy is converted into electrical energy.
(credit a: modification of work by Steve Jurvetson; credit b: modification of work by “curimedia”/Wikimedia commons).
Two pictures are shown and labeled a and b. Picture a shows a large waterfall with water falling from a high elevation at the top of
the falls to a lower elevation. The second picture is a view looking down into the Hoover Dam. Water is shown behind the high
wall of the dam on one side and at the base of the dam on the other.
Energy can be converted from one form into another, but all of the energy present before a change occurs always exists in some
form after the change is completed. This observation is expressed in the law of conservation of energy: during a chemical or
physical change, energy can be neither created nor destroyed, although it can be changed in form. (This is also one version of the
first law of thermodynamics, as you will learn later.)
When one substance is converted into another, there is always an associated conversion of one form of energy into another. Heat is
usually released or absorbed, but sometimes the conversion involves light, electrical energy, or some other form of energy. For
example, chemical energy (a type of potential energy) is stored in the molecules that compose gasoline. When gasoline is
combusted within the cylinders of a car’s engine, the rapidly expanding gaseous products of this chemical reaction generate
mechanical energy (a type of kinetic energy) when they move the cylinders’ pistons.
According to the law of conservation of matter (seen in an earlier chapter), there is no detectable change in the total amount of
matter during a chemical change. When chemical reactions occur, the energy changes are relatively modest and the mass changes
are too small to measure, so the laws of conservation of matter and energy hold well. However, in nuclear reactions, the energy
changes are much larger (by factors of a million or so), the mass changes are measurable, and matter-energy conversions are
significant. This will be examined in more detail in a later chapter on nuclear chemistry. To encompass both chemical and nuclear
changes, we combine these laws into one statement: The total quantity of matter and energy in the universe is fixed.
A picture labeled a is shown as well as a pair of drawings labeled b. Picture a shows the lower portion of an alcohol thermometer.
The thermometer has a printed scale to the left of the tube in the center that reads from negative forty degrees at the bottom to forty
degrees at the top. It also has a scale printed to the right of the tube that reads from negative thirty degrees at the bottom to thirty
five degrees at the top. On both scales, the volume of the alcohol in the tube reads between nine and ten degrees. The two images
labeled b both depict a metal strip coiled into a spiral and composed of brass and steel. The left coil, which is loosely coiled, is
labeled along its upper edge with the 30 degrees C and 10 degrees C. The end of the coil is near the 30 degrees C label. The right
hand coil is much more tightly wound and the end is near the 10 degree C label.
Figure 5.1.4 : (a) In an alcohol or mercury thermometer, the liquid (dyed red for visibility) expands when heated and contracts
when cooled, much more so than the glass tube that contains the liquid. (b) In a bimetallic thermometer, two different metals (such
as brass and steel) form a two-layered strip. When heated or cooled, one of the metals (brass) expands or contracts more than the
other metal (steel), causing the strip to coil or uncoil. Both types of thermometers have a calibrated scale that indicates the
temperature. (credit a: modification of work by “dwstucke”/Flickr). (c) The demonstration allows one to view the effects of heating
and cooling a coiled bimetallic strip.A bimetallic coil from a thermometer reacts to the heat from a lighter, by uncoiling and then
coiling back up when the lighter is removed. Animation used with permission from Hustvedt (via Wikipedia).
Heat (q) is the transfer of thermal energy between two bodies at different temperatures. Heat flow (a redundant term, but one
commonly used) increases the thermal energy of one body and decreases the thermal energy of the other. Suppose we initially have
a high temperature (and high thermal energy) substance (H) and a low temperature (and low thermal energy) substance (L). The
atoms and molecules in H have a higher average KE than those in L. If we place substance H in contact with substance L, the
thermal energy will flow spontaneously from substance H to substance L. The temperature of substance H will decrease, as will the
average KE of its molecules; the temperature of substance L will increase, along with the average KE of its molecules. Heat flow
will continue until the two substances are at the same temperature (Figure 5.1.5).
Matter undergoing chemical reactions and physical changes can release or absorb heat. A change that releases heat is called an
exothermic process. For example, the combustion reaction that occurs when using an oxyacetylene torch is an exothermic process
—this process also releases energy in the form of light as evidenced by the torch’s flame (Figure 5.1.6a). A reaction or change that
absorbs heat is an endothermic process. A cold pack used to treat muscle strains provides an example of an endothermic process.
When the substances in the cold pack (water and a salt like ammonium nitrate) are brought together, the resulting process absorbs
heat, leading to the sensation of cold.
Figure 5.1.6 : (a) An oxyacetylene torch produces heat by the combustion of acetylene in oxygen. The energy released by this
exothermic reaction heats and then melts the metal being cut. The sparks are tiny bits of the molten metal flying away. (b) A cold
pack uses an endothermic process to create the sensation of cold. (credit a: modification of work by “Skatebiker”/Wikimedia
commons).
Two pictures are shown and labeled a and b. Picture a shows a metal railroad tie being cut with the flame of an acetylene torch.
Picture b shows a chemical cold pack containing ammonium nitrate.
Heat capacity is determined by both the type and amount of substance that absorbs or releases heat. It is therefore an extensive
property—its value is proportional to the amount of the substance.
For example, consider the heat capacities of two cast iron frying pans. The heat capacity of the large pan is five times greater than
that of the small pan because, although both are made of the same material, the mass of the large pan is five times greater than the
mass of the small pan. More mass means more atoms are present in the larger pan, so it takes more energy to make all of those
atoms vibrate faster. The heat capacity of the small cast iron frying pan is found by observing that it takes 18,150 J of energy to
raise the temperature of the pan by 50.0 °C
18, 140 J
Csmall pan = = 363 J/°C (5.1.2)
50.0 °C
The larger cast iron frying pan, while made of the same substance, requires 90,700 J of energy to raise its temperature by 50.0 °C.
The larger pan has a (proportionally) larger heat capacity because the larger amount of material requires a (proportionally) larger
amount of energy to yield the same temperature change:
90, 700 J
Clarge pan = = 1814 J/°C (5.1.3)
50.0 °C
The specific heat capacity (c) of a substance, commonly called its “specific heat,” is the quantity of heat required to raise the
temperature of 1 gram of a substance by 1 degree Celsius (or 1 kelvin):
q
c = (5.1.4)
mΔT
Specific heat capacity depends only on the kind of substance absorbing or releasing heat. It is an intensive property—the type, but
not the amount, of the substance is all that matters. For example, the small cast iron frying pan has a mass of 808 g. The specific
heat of iron (the material used to make the pan) is therefore:
18, 140 J
ciron = = 0.449 J/g °C (5.1.5)
(808 g)(50.0 °C)
The large frying pan has a mass of 4040 g. Using the data for this pan, we can also calculate the specific heat of iron:
90, 700 J
ciron = = 0.449 J/g °C (5.1.6)
(4, 040 g)(50.0 °C)
Although the large pan is more massive than the small pan, since both are made of the same material, they both yield the same
value for specific heat (for the material of construction, iron). Note that specific heat is measured in units of energy per temperature
per mass and is an intensive property, being derived from a ratio of two extensive properties (heat and mass). The molar heat
capacity, also an intensive property, is the heat capacity per mole of a particular substance and has units of J/mol °C (Figure 5.1.7).
Figure 5.1.7 : Due to its larger mass, a large frying pan has a larger heat capacity than a small frying pan. Because they are made of
the same material, both frying pans have the same specific heat. (credit: Mark Blaser).
The picture shows two black metal frying pans sitting on a flat surface. The left pan is about half the size of the right pan.
air 1.007
If we know the mass of a substance and its specific heat, we can determine the amount of heat, q, entering or leaving the substance
by measuring the temperature change before and after the heat is gained or lost:
q = (specific heat) × (mass of substance) × (temperature change)
q = c × m × ΔT
= c × m × (Tfinal − Tinitial)
In this equation, c is the specific heat of the substance, m is its mass, and ΔT (which is read “delta T”) is the temperature change,
Tfinal − Tinitial. If a substance gains thermal energy, its temperature increases, its final temperature is higher than its initial
temperature, Tfinal − Tinitial has a positive value, and the value of q is positive. If a substance loses thermal energy, its temperature
decreases, the final temperature is lower than the initial temperature, Tfinal − Tinitial has a negative value, and the value of q is
negative.
Solution
To answer this question, consider these factors:
the specific heat of the substance being heated (in this case, water)
= c × m × (Tfinal − Tinitial)
Because the temperature increased, the water absorbed heat and q is positive.
Exercise 5.1.1
Note that the relationship between heat, specific heat, mass, and temperature change can be used to determine any of these
quantities (not just heat) if the other three are known or can be deduced.
A piece of unknown metal weighs 348 g. When the metal piece absorbs 6.64 kJ of heat, its temperature increases from 22.4 °C
to 43.6 °C. Determine the specific heat of this metal (which might provide a clue to its identity).
Solution
Since mass, heat, and temperature change are known for this metal, we can determine its specific heat using the relationship:
q = c × m × ΔT
= c × m × (Tfinal − Tinitial)
Solving:
6, 640 J
c = = 0.900 J/g °C
(348 g) × (21.2°C)
Comparing this value with the values in Table 5.1.1, this value matches the specific heat of aluminum, which suggests that the
unknown metal may be aluminum.
Answer
c = 0.45 J/g °C ; the metal is likely to be iron from checking Table 5.1.1.
Figure 5.1.8 : This solar thermal plant uses parabolic trough mirrors to concentrate sunlight. (credit a: modification of work by
Bureau of Land Management)
This figure has two parts labeled a and b. Part a shows rows and rows of trough mirrors. Part b shows how a solar thermal plant
works. Heat transfer fluid enters a tank via pipes. The tank contains water which is heated. As the heat is exchanged from the pipes
to the water, the water becomes steam. The steam travels to a steam turbine. The steam turbine begins to turn which powers a
generator. Exhaust steam exits the steam turbine and enters a cooling tower.
The 377-megawatt Ivanpah Solar Generating System, located in the Mojave Desert in California, is the largest solar thermal power
plant in the world (Figure 5.1.9). Its 170,000 mirrors focus huge amounts of sunlight on three water-filled towers, producing steam
at over 538 °C that drives electricity-producing turbines. It produces enough energy to power 140,000 homes. Water is used as the
working fluid because of its large heat capacity and heat of vaporization.
Summary
Energy is the capacity to do work (applying a force to move matter). Kinetic energy (KE) is the energy of motion; potential energy
is energy due to relative position, composition, or condition. When energy is converted from one form into another, energy is
neither created nor destroyed (law of conservation of energy or first law of thermodynamics). Matter has thermal energy due to the
KE of its molecules and temperature that corresponds to the average KE of its molecules. Heat is energy that is transferred between
objects at different temperatures; it flows from a high to a low temperature. Chemical and physical processes can absorb heat
(endothermic) or release heat (exothermic). The SI unit of energy, heat, and work is the joule (J). Specific heat and heat capacity
are measures of the energy needed to change the temperature of a substance or object. The amount of heat absorbed or released by
a substance depends directly on the type of substance, its mass, and the temperature change it undergoes.
Glossary
calorie (cal)
unit of heat or other energy; the amount of energy required to raise 1 gram of water by 1 degree Celsius; 1 cal is defined as
4.184 J
endothermic process
chemical reaction or physical change that absorbs heat
energy
capacity to supply heat or do work
exothermic process
chemical reaction or physical change that releases heat
heat (q)
transfer of thermal energy between two bodies
joule (J)
SI unit of energy; 1 joule is the kinetic energy of an object with a mass of 2 kilograms moving with a velocity of 1 meter per
second, 1 J = 1 kg m2/s and 4.184 J = 1 cal
potential energy
energy of a particle or system of particles derived from relative position, composition, or condition
temperature
intensive property of matter that is a quantitative measure of “hotness” and “coldness”
thermal energy
kinetic energy associated with the random motion of atoms and molecules
thermochemistry
study of measuring the amount of heat absorbed or released during a chemical reaction or a physical change
work (w)
energy transfer due to changes in external, macroscopic variables such as pressure and volume; or causing matter to move
against an opposing force
This page titled 5.1: Energy Basics is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
One technique we can use to measure the amount of heat involved in a chemical or physical process is known as calorimetry. Calorimetry is used
to measure amounts of heat transferred to or from a substance. To do so, the heat is exchanged with a calibrated object (calorimeter). The change
in temperature of the measuring part of the calorimeter is converted into the amount of heat (since the previous calibration was used to establish
its heat capacity). The measurement of heat transfer using this approach requires the definition of a system (the substance or substances
undergoing the chemical or physical change) and its surroundings (the other components of the measurement apparatus that serve to either
provide heat to the system or absorb heat from the system). Knowledge of the heat capacity of the surroundings, and careful measurements of the
masses of the system and surroundings and their temperatures before and after the process allows one to calculate the heat transferred as
described in this section.
A calorimeter is a device used to measure the amount of heat involved in a chemical or physical process. For example, when an exothermic
reaction occurs in solution in a calorimeter, the heat produced by the reaction is absorbed by the solution, which increases its temperature. When
an endothermic reaction occurs, the heat required is absorbed from the thermal energy of the solution, which decreases its temperature (Figure
5.2.1). The temperature change, along with the specific heat and mass of the solution, can then be used to calculate the amount of heat involved
in either case.
Figure 5.2.1 : In a calorimetric determination, either (a) an exothermic process occurs and heat, q, is negative, indicating that thermal energy is
transferred from the system to its surroundings, or (b) an endothermic process occurs and heat, q, is positive, indicating that thermal energy is
transferred from the surroundings to the system.
Two diagrams labeled a and b are shown. Each is made up of two rectangular containers with a thermometer inserted into the top right and
extending inside. There is a right facing arrow connecting each box in each diagram. The left container in diagram a depicts a pink and green
swirling solution with the terms “Exothermic process” and “System” written in the center with arrows facing away from the terms pointing to
“q.” The labels “Solution” and “Surroundings” are written at the bottom of the container. The right container in diagram a has the term “Solution”
written at the bottom of the container and a red arrow facing up near the thermometer with the phrase “Temperature increased” next to it. The
pink and green swirls are more blended in this container. The left container in diagram b depicts a purple and blue swirling solution with the
terms “Endothermic process” and “System” written in the center with arrows facing away from the terms and “Solution” and “Surroundings”
written at the bottom. The arrows point away from the letter “q.” The right container in diagram b has the term “Solution” written at the bottom
and a red arrow facing down near the thermometer with the phrase “Temperature decreased” next to it. The blue and purple swirls are more
blended in this container.
By convention, q is given a negative (-) sign when the system releases heat to the surroundings (exothermic); q is given a positive (+) sign
when the system absorbs heat from the surroundings (endothermic).
Scientists use well-insulated calorimeters that all but prevent the transfer of heat between the calorimeter and its environment. This enables the
accurate determination of the heat involved in chemical processes, the energy content of foods, and so on. General chemistry students often use
simple calorimeters constructed from polystyrene cups (Figure 5.2.2). These easy-to-use “coffee cup” calorimeters allow more heat exchange
with their surroundings, and therefore produce less accurate energy values.
Figure 5.2.3 : Commercial solution calorimeters range from (a) simple, inexpensive models for student use to (b) expensive, more accurate
models for industry and research.
Two diagrams are shown and labeled a and b. Diagram a depicts a thermometer which passes through a disk-like insulating cover and into a metal
cylinder which is labeled “metal inner vessel,” which is in turn nested in a metal cylinder labeled “metal outer vessel.” The inner cylinder rests on
an insulating support ring. A stirrer passes through the insulating cover and into the inner cylinder as well. Diagram b shows an inner metal vessel
half full of liquid resting on an insulating support ring and nested in a metal outer vessel. A precision temperature probe and motorized stirring
rod are placed into the solution in the inner vessel and connected by wires to equipment exterior to the set-up.
Before we practice calorimetry problems involving chemical reactions, consider a simple example that illustrates the core idea behind
calorimetry. Suppose we initially have a high-temperature substance, such as a hot piece of metal (M), and a low-temperature substance, such as
cool water (W). If we place the metal in the water, heat will flow from M to W. The temperature of M will decrease, and the temperature of W
will increase, until the two substances have the same temperature—that is, when they reach thermal equilibrium (Figure 5.2.4). If this occurs in a
calorimeter, ideally all of this heat transfer occurs between the two substances, with no heat gained or lost by either the calorimeter or the
calorimeter’s surroundings. Under these ideal circumstances, the net heat change is zero:
This relationship can be rearranged to show that the heat gained by substance M is equal to the heat lost by substance W:
q are opposite in direction of heat flow (gain or loss) but does not indicate the arithmetic sign of either q value (that is determined by
substance W
whether the matter in question gains or loses heat, per definition). In the specific situation described, q is a negative value and
substance M
Figure 5.2.4 : In a simple calorimetry process, (a) heat, q, is transferred from the hot metal, M, to the cool water, W, until (b) both are at the same
temperature.
Two diagrams are shown and labeled a and b. Each diagram is composed of a rectangular container with a thermometer inserted inside from the
top right corner. Both containers are connected by a right-facing arrow. Both containers are full of water, which is depicted by the letter “W,” and
each container has a square in the middle which represents a metal which is labeled with a letter “M.” In diagram a, the metal is drawn in brown
and has three arrows facing away from it. Each arrow has the letter “q” at its end. The metal is labeled “system” and the water is labeled
“surroundings.” The thermometer in this diagram has a relatively low reading. In diagram b, the metal is depicted in purple and the thermometer
has a relatively high reading.
A hot 360-g piece of rebar (a steel rod used for reinforcing concrete) is dropped into 425 mL of water at 24.0 °C. The final temperature of the
water is measured as 42.7 °C. Calculate the initial temperature of the piece of rebar. Assume the specific heat of steel is approximately the
same as that for iron (Table T4), and that all heat transfer occurs between the rebar and the water (there is no heat exchange with the
surroundings).
Solution
The temperature of the water increases from 24.0 °C to 42.7 °C, so the water absorbs heat. That heat came from the piece of rebar, which
initially was at a higher temperature. Assuming that all heat transfer was between the rebar and the water, with no heat “lost” to the
surroundings, then heat given off by rebar = − heat taken in by water, or:
qrebar = −qwater
crebar × mrebar × (Tf ,rebar − Ti,rebar) = −cwater × mwater × (Tf ,water − Ti,water)
The density of water is 1.0 g/mL, so 425 mL of water = 425 g. Noting that the final temperature of both the rebar and water is 42.7 °C,
substituting known values yields:
Solving this gives Ti,rebar= 248 °C, so the initial temperature of the rebar was 248 °C.
Answer
The initial temperature of the copper was 335.6 °C.
Exercise 5.2.1B
A 248-g piece of copper initially at 314 °C is dropped into 390 mL of water initially at 22.6 °C. Assuming that all heat transfer occurs
between the copper and the water, calculate the final temperature.
Answer
The final temperature (reached by both copper and water) is 38.7 °C.
This method can also be used to determine other quantities, such as the specific heat of an unknown metal.
A 59.7 g piece of metal that had been submerged in boiling water was quickly transferred into 60.0 mL of water initially at 22.0 °C. The final
temperature is 28.5 °C. Use these data to determine the specific heat of the metal. Use this result to identify the metal.
Solution
Assuming perfect heat transfer, heat given off by metal = −heat taken in by water, or:
qmetal = −qwater
cmetal × mmetal × (Tf ,metal − Ti,metal) = −cwater × mwater × (Tf ,water − Ti,water)
Noting that since the metal was submerged in boiling water, its initial temperature was 100.0 °C; and that for water, 60.0 mL = 60.0 g; we
have:
Solving this:
−(4.184 J/g °C)(60.0 g)(6.5°C)
cmetal = = 0.38 J/g °C
(59.7 g)(−71.5°C)
Comparing this with values in Table T4, our experimental specific heat is closest to the value for copper (0.39 J/g °C), so we identify the
metal as copper.
Exercise 5.2.2
A 92.9-g piece of a silver/gray metal is heated to 178.0 °C, and then quickly transferred into 75.0 mL of water initially at 24.0 °C. After 5
minutes, both the metal and the water have reached the same temperature: 29.7 °C. Determine the specific heat and the identity of the metal.
(Note: You should find that the specific heat is close to that of two different metals. Explain how you can confidently determine the identity
of the metal).
Answer
cmetal = 0.13 J/g °C
This specific heat is close to that of either gold or lead. It would be difficult to determine which metal this was based solely on the
numerical values. However, the observation that the metal is silver/gray in addition to the value for the specific heat indicates that the
metal is lead.
This means that the amount of heat produced or consumed in the reaction equals the amount of heat absorbed or lost by the solution:
qreaction = −qsolution (5.2.4)
This concept lies at the heart of all calorimetry problems and calculations.
When 50.0 mL of 0.10 M HCl(aq) and 50.0 mL of 1.00 M NaOH(aq), both at 22.0 °C, are added to a coffee cup calorimeter, the temperature
of the mixture reaches a maximum of 28.9 °C. What is the approximate amount of heat produced by this reaction?
Solution
To visualize what is going on, imagine that you could combine the two solutions so quickly that no reaction took place while they mixed;
then after mixing, the reaction took place. At the instant of mixing, you have 100.0 mL of a mixture of HCl and NaOH at 22.0 °C. The HCl
and NaOH then react until the solution temperature reaches 28.9 °C.
The heat given off by the reaction is equal to that taken in by the solution. Therefore:
qreaction = −qsolution
(It is important to remember that this relationship only holds if the calorimeter does not absorb any heat from the reaction, and there is no
heat exchange between the calorimeter and its surroundings.)
Next, we know that the heat absorbed by the solution depends on its specific heat, mass, and temperature change:
qsolution = (c × m × ΔT )solution
To proceed with this calculation, we need to make a few more reasonable assumptions or approximations. Since the solution is aqueous, we
can proceed as if it were water in terms of its specific heat and mass values. The density of water is approximately 1.0 g/mL, so 100.0 mL has
a mass of about 1.0 × 102 g (two significant figures). The specific heat of water is approximately 4.18 J/g °C, so we use that for the specific
heat of the solution. Substituting these values gives:
2 3
qsolution = (4.184 J/g °C)(1.0 × 10 g)(28.9°C − 22.0°C) = 2.89 × 10 J
Finally, since we are trying to find the heat of the reaction, we have:
3
qreaction = −qsolution = −2.89 × 10 J
The negative sign indicates that the reaction is exothermic. It produces 2.89 kJ of heat.
Exercise 5.2.3
When 100 mL of 0.200 M NaCl(aq) and 100 mL of 0.200 M AgNO3(aq), both at 21.9 °C, are mixed in a coffee cup calorimeter, the
temperature increases to 23.5 °C as solid AgCl forms. How much heat is produced by this precipitation reaction? What assumptions did you
make to determine your value?
Answer
J; assume no heat is absorbed by the calorimeter, no heat is exchanged between the calorimeter and its surroundings, and that
3
1.34 × 10
the specific heat and mass of the solution are the same as those for water
When working or playing outdoors on a cold day, you might use a hand warmer to warm your hands (Figure 5.2.5). A common reusable
hand warmer contains a supersaturated solution of NaC2H3O2 (sodium acetate) and a metal disc. Bending the disk creates nucleation sites
warming them (at least for a while). If the hand warmer is reheated, the NaC2H3O2 redissolves and can be reused.
Figure 5.2.5 : Chemical hand warmers produce heat that warms your hand on a cold day. In this one, you can see the metal disc that initiates
the exothermic precipitation reaction. (credit: modification of work by Science Buddies TV/YouTube)
A series of three photos is shown. There are two right-facing arrows connecting one photo to the next. The first photo shows a chemical hand
warmer. It is a bag that contains a clear, colorless liquid. There is a white disk located to the right inside the bag. The second photo shows the
same thing, except the white disc has become a white, cloudy substance. The third photo shows the entire bag filled with this white
substance.
Another common hand warmer produces heat when it is ripped open, exposing iron and water in the hand warmer to oxygen in the air. One
simplified version of this exothermic reaction is
3
2 Fe(s) + O (g) ⟶ Fe O (s). n
2 2 2 3
Salt in the hand warmer catalyzes the reaction, so it produces heat more rapidly; cellulose, vermiculite, and activated carbon help distribute
the heat evenly. Other types of hand warmers use lighter fluid (a platinum catalyst helps lighter fluid oxidize exothermically), charcoal
(charcoal oxidizes in a special case), or electrical units that produce heat by passing an electrical current from a battery through resistive
wires.
When solid ammonium nitrate dissolves in water, the solution becomes cold. This is the basis for an “instant ice pack” (Figure 5.2.5). When
3.21 g of solid NH4NO3 dissolves in 50.0 g of water at 24.9 °C in a calorimeter, the temperature decreases to 20.3 °C.
Calculate the value of q for this reaction and explain the meaning of its arithmetic sign. State any assumptions that you made.
Figure 5.2.5 : An instant cold pack consists of a bag containing solid ammonium nitrate and a second bag of water. When the bag of water is
broken, the pack becomes cold because the dissolution of ammonium nitrate is an endothermic process that removes thermal energy from the
water. The cold pack then removes thermal energy from your body.
Solution
We assume that the calorimeter prevents heat transfer between the solution and its external environment (including the calorimeter itself), in
which case:
qrxn = −qsoln
with “rxn” and “soln” used as shorthand for “reaction” and “solution,” respectively.
Assuming also that the specific heat of the solution is the same as that for water, we have:
3
+ 1.0 × 10 J = +1.0 kJ
The positive sign for q indicates that the dissolution is an endothermic process.
Exercise 5.2.4
When a 3.00-g sample of KCl was added to 3.00 × 102 g of water in a coffee cup calorimeter, the temperature decreased by 1.05 °C. How
much heat is involved in the dissolution of the KCl? What assumptions did you make?
Answer
1.33 kJ; assume that the calorimeter prevents heat transfer between the solution and its external environment (including the calorimeter
itself) and that the specific heat of the solution is the same as that for water.
If the amount of heat absorbed by a calorimeter is too large to neglect or if we require more accurate results, then we must take into account the
heat absorbed both by the solution and by the calorimeter.
Figure 5.2.6 : (a) A bomb calorimeter is used to measure heat produced by reactions involving gaseous reactants or products, such as combustion.
(b) The reactants are contained in the gas-tight “bomb,” which is submerged in water and surrounded by insulating materials. (credit a:
modification of work by “Harbor1”/Wikimedia commons)
A picture and a diagram are shown, labeled a and b, respectively. Picture a depicts a bomb calorimeter. It is a cube-shaped machine with a cavity
in the top, a metal cylinder that is above the cavity, and a read-out panel attached to the top-right side. Diagram b depicts a cut away figure of a
cube with a cylindrical container full of water in the middle of it. Another container, labeled “bomb,” sits inside of a smaller cylinder which holds
a sample cup and is nested in the cylindrical container surrounded by the water. A black line extends into the water and is labeled “Precision
thermometer.” Two wires labeled “Electrodes” extend away from a cover that sits on top of the interior container. A read-out panel is located at
the top right of the cube.
The calorimeters described are designed to operate at constant (atmospheric) pressure and are convenient to measure heat flow accompanying
processes that occur in solution. A different type of calorimeter that operates at constant volume, colloquially known as a bomb calorimeter, is
used to measure the energy produced by reactions that yield large amounts of heat and gaseous products, such as combustion reactions. (The term
“bomb” comes from the observation that these reactions can be vigorous enough to resemble explosions that would damage other calorimeters.)
This type of calorimeter consists of a robust steel container (the “bomb”) that contains the reactants and is itself submerged in water (Figure
5.2.6). The sample is placed in the bomb, which is then filled with oxygen at high pressure. A small electrical spark is used to ignite the sample.
The energy produced by the reaction is trapped in the steel bomb and the surrounding water. The temperature increase is measured and, along
with the known heat capacity of the calorimeter, is used to calculate the energy produced by the reaction. Bomb calorimeters require calibration
to determine the heat capacity of the calorimeter and ensure accurate results. The calibration is accomplished using a reaction with a known q,
such as a measured quantity of benzoic acid ignited by a spark from a nickel fuse wire that is weighed before and after the reaction. The
temperature change produced by the known reaction is used to determine the heat capacity of the calorimeter. The calibration is generally
performed each time before the calorimeter is used to gather research data.
Video 5.2.1 : Video of view how a bomb calorimeter is prepared for action.
When 3.12 g of glucose, C6H12O6, is burned in a bomb calorimeter, the temperature of the calorimeter increases from 23.8 °C to 35.6 °C.
The calorimeter contains 775 g of water, and the bomb itself has a heat capacity of 893 J/°C. How much heat was produced by the
combustion of the glucose sample?
Solution
The combustion produces heat that is primarily absorbed by the water and the bomb. (The amounts of heat absorbed by the reaction products
and the unreacted excess oxygen are relatively small and dealing with them is beyond the scope of this text. We will neglect them in our
calculations.)
The heat produced by the reaction is absorbed by the water and the bomb:
= −[(4.184 J/g °C) × (775 g) × (35.6°C − 23.8°C) + 893 J/°C × (35.6°C − 23.8°C)]
This reaction released 48.7 kJ of heat when 3.12 g of glucose was burned.
Exercise 5.2.5
When 0.963 g of benzene, C6H6, is burned in a bomb calorimeter, the temperature of the calorimeter increases by 8.39 °C. The bomb has a
heat capacity of 784 J/°C and is submerged in 925 mL of water. How much heat was produced by the combustion of the glucose sample?
Answer
39.0 kJ
Since the first one was constructed in 1899, 35 calorimeters have been built to measure the heat produced by a living person.1 These whole-body
calorimeters of various designs are large enough to hold an individual human being. More recently, whole-room calorimeters allow for relatively
normal activities to be performed, and these calorimeters generate data that more closely reflect the real world. These calorimeters are used to
measure the metabolism of individuals under different environmental conditions, different dietary regimes, and with different health conditions,
such as diabetes. In humans, metabolism is typically measured in Calories per day. A nutritional calorie (Calorie) is the energy unit used to
quantify the amount of energy derived from the metabolism of foods; one Calorie is equal to 1000 calories (1 kcal), the amount of energy needed
to heat 1 kg of water by 1 °C.
Figure 5.2.7 : (a) Macaroni and cheese contain energy in the form of the macronutrients in the food. (b) The food’s nutritional information is
shown on the package label. In the US, the energy content is given in Calories (per serving); the rest of the world usually uses kilojoules.
(credit a: modification of work by “Rex Roof”/Flickr)
For the example shown in (b), the total energy per 228-g portion is calculated by:
(5 g protein × 4 Calories/g) + (31 g carb × 4 Calories/g) + (12 g f at × 9 Calories/g) = 252 Calories (5.2.5)
So, you can use food labels to count your Calories. But where do the values come from? And how accurate are they? The caloric content of
foods can be determined by using bomb calorimetry; that is, by burning the food and measuring the energy it contains. A sample of food is
weighed, mixed in a blender, freeze-dried, ground into powder, and formed into a pellet. The pellet is burned inside a bomb calorimeter, and
the measured temperature change is converted into energy per gram of food.
Today, the caloric content on food labels is derived using a method called the Atwater system that uses the average caloric content of the
different chemical constituents of food, protein, carbohydrate, and fats. The average amounts are those given in the equation and are derived
from the various results given by bomb calorimetry of whole foods. The carbohydrate amount is discounted a certain amount for the fiber
content, which is indigestible carbohydrate. To determine the energy content of a food, the quantities of carbohydrate, protein, and fat are
each multiplied by the average Calories per gram for each and the products summed to obtain the total energy.
Summary
Calorimetry is used to measure the amount of thermal energy transferred in a chemical or physical process. This requires careful measurement of
the temperature change that occurs during the process and the masses of the system and surroundings. These measured quantities are then used to
compute the amount of heat produced or consumed in the process using known mathematical relations. Calorimeters are designed to minimize
energy exchange between the system being studied and its surroundings. They range from simple coffee cup calorimeters used by introductory
chemistry students to sophisticated bomb calorimeters used to determine the energy content of food.
Footnotes
1. 1 Francis D. Reardon et al. “The Snellen human calorimeter revisited, re-engineered and upgraded: Design and performance characteristics.”
Medical and Biological Engineering and Computing 8 (2006)721–28, The Snellen human calorimeter revisited, re-engineered and upgraded:
design and performance characteristics [link.springer.com].
Glossary
bomb calorimeter
device designed to measure the energy change for processes occurring under conditions of constant volume; commonly used for reactions
involving solid and gaseous reactants or products
calorimetry
process of measuring the amount of heat involved in a chemical or physical process
surroundings
all matter other than the system being studied
system
portion of matter undergoing a chemical or physical change being studied
This page titled 5.2: Calorimetry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited
to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Thermochemistry is a branch of chemical thermodynamics, the science that deals with the relationships between heat, work, and
other forms of energy in the context of chemical and physical processes. As we concentrate on thermochemistry in this chapter, we
need to consider some widely used concepts of thermodynamics.
Substances act as reservoirs of energy, meaning that energy can be added to them or removed from them. Energy is stored in a
substance when the kinetic energy of its atoms or molecules is raised. The greater kinetic energy may be in the form of increased
translations (travel or straight-line motions), vibrations, or rotations of the atoms or molecules. When thermal energy is lost, the
intensities of these motions decrease and the kinetic energy falls. The total of all possible kinds of energy present in a substance is
called the internal energy (U), sometimes symbolized as E.
As a system undergoes a change, its internal energy can change, and energy can be transferred from the system to the surroundings,
or from the surroundings to the system. Energy is transferred into a system when it absorbs heat (q) from the surroundings or when
the surroundings do work (w) on the system. For example, energy is transferred into room-temperature metal wire if it is immersed
in hot water (the wire absorbs heat from the water), or if you rapidly bend the wire back and forth (the wire becomes warmer
because of the work done on it). Both processes increase the internal energy of the wire, which is reflected in an increase in the
wire’s temperature. Conversely, energy is transferred out of a system when heat is lost from the system, or when the system does
work on the surroundings.
The relationship between internal energy, heat, and work can be represented by the equation:
ΔU = q + w (5.3.1)
as shown in Figure 5.3.1. This is one version of the first law of thermodynamics, and it shows that the internal energy of a system
changes through heat flow into or out of the system (positive q is heat flow in; negative q is heat flow out) or work done on or by
the system. The work, w, is positive if it is done on the system and negative if it is done by the system.
Figure 5.3.1 : The internal energy, U, of a system can be changed by heat flow and work. If heat flows into the system, qin, or work
is done on the system, won, its internal energy increases, ΔU > 0. If heat flows out of the system, qout, or work is done by the
system, wby, its internal energy decreases, ΔU < 0.
A type of work called expansion work (or pressure-volume work) occurs when a system pushes back the surroundings against a
restraining pressure, or when the surroundings compress the system. An example of this occurs during the operation of an internal
combustion engine. The reaction of gasoline and oxygen is exothermic. Some of this energy is given off as heat, and some does
work pushing the piston in the cylinder. The substances involved in the reaction are the system, and the engine and the rest of the
Figure 5.3.2 : Paths X and Y represent two different routes to the summit of Mt. Kilimanjaro. Both have the same change in
elevation (altitude or elevation on a mountain is a state function; it does not depend on path), but they have very different distances
traveled (distance walked is not a state function; it depends on the path). (credit: modification of work by Paul Shaffner)
An aerial photo depicts a view of Mount Kilimanjaro. A straight, green arrow labeled X is drawn from the term “base,” written at
the bottom of the mountain, to the term “Summit,” written at the top of the mountain. Another arrow labeled Y is draw from the
base to the summit alongside the green arrow, but this arrow is pink and has three large S-shaped curves along its length.
Chemists ordinarily use a property known as enthalpy (H ) to describe the thermodynamics of chemical and physical processes.
Enthalpy is defined as the sum of a system’s internal energy (U ) and the mathematical product of its pressure (P ) and volume (V ):
H = U +PV (5.3.2)
Since it is derived from three state functions (U , P , and V ), enthalpy is also a state function. Enthalpy values for specific
substances cannot be measured directly; only enthalpy changes for chemical or physical processes can be determined. For
processes that take place at constant pressure (a common condition for many chemical and physical changes), the enthalpy change (
ΔH ) is:
ΔH = ΔU + P ΔV (5.3.3)
The mathematical product P ΔV represents work (w), namely, expansion or pressure-volume work as noted. By their definitions,
the arithmetic signs of ΔV and w will always be opposite:
P ΔV = −w (5.3.4)
Substituting Equation 5.3.4 and the definition of internal energy (Equation 5.3.1) into Equation 5.3.3 yields:
ΔH = ΔU + P ΔV (5.3.5)
= qp + w − w (5.3.6)
= qp (5.3.7)
And so, if a chemical or physical process is carried out at constant pressure with the only work done caused by expansion or
contraction, then the heat flow (q ) and enthalpy change (ΔH ) for the process are equal.
p
This equation indicates that when 1 mole of hydrogen gas and 12 mole of oxygen gas at some temperature and pressure change
to 1 mole of liquid water at the same temperature and pressure, 286 kJ of heat are released to the surroundings. If the
coefficients of the chemical equation are multiplied by some factor, the enthalpy change must be multiplied by that same factor
(ΔH is an extensive property).
(two-fold increase in amounts)
1 1 1 1
H (g) + O (g) ⟶ H O(l) ΔH = × (−286 kJ) = −143 kJ
2 2 2
2 4 2 2
2. The enthalpy change of a reaction depends on the physical state of the reactants and products of the reaction (whether we have
gases, liquids, solids, or aqueous solutions), so these must be shown. For example, when 1 mole of hydrogen gas and 12 mole
of oxygen gas change to 1 mole of liquid water at the same temperature and pressure, 286 kJ of heat are released. If gaseous
water forms, only 242 kJ of heat are released.
1
H (g) + O (g) ⟶ H O(g) ΔH = −242 kJ (5.3.9)
2 2 2 2
3. A negative value of an enthalpy change, ΔH, indicates an exothermic reaction; a positive value of ΔH indicates an endothermic
reaction. If the direction of a chemical equation is reversed, the arithmetic sign of its ΔH is changed (a process that is
endothermic in one direction is exothermic in the opposite direction).
When 0.0500 mol of HCl(aq) reacts with 0.0500 mol of NaOH(aq) to form 0.0500 mol of NaCl(aq), 2.9 kJ of heat are
produced. What is ΔH, the enthalpy change, per mole of acid reacting, for the acid-base reaction run under the conditions
described ?
Solution
For the reaction of 0.0500 mol acid (HCl), q = −2.9 kJ. This ratio
−2.9 kJ
can be used as a conversion factor to find the heat produced when 1 mole of HCl reacts:
−2.9 kJ
ΔH = 1 mol HCl × = −58 kJ
0.0500 mol HCl
Exercise 5.3.1
When 1.34 g Zn(s) reacts with 60.0 mL of 0.750 M HCl(aq), 3.14 kJ of heat are produced. Determine the enthalpy change per
mole of zinc reacting for the reaction:
Answer
ΔH = −153 kJ
Be sure to take both stoichiometry and limiting reactants into account when determining the ΔH for a chemical reaction.
Solution
1 mol
We have 2.67 g × = 0.00780 mol C12 H22 O11 available, and
342.3 g
1 mol
7.19 g × = 0.0587 mol KCl O3 available.
122.5 g
Since
1 mol C H O
12 22 11
0.0587 mol KCl O3 × = 0.00734 mol C H O
12 22 11
8 mol KClO3
is needed, C12H22O11 is the excess reactant and KClO3 is the limiting reactant.
−43.7 kJ
The reaction uses 8 mol KClO3, and the conversion factor is , so we have
0.0587 mol KClO3
−43.7 kJ
ΔH = 8 mol × = −5960 kJ . The enthalpy change for this reaction is −5960 kJ, and the
0.0587 mol KClO3
Exercise 5.3.2
When 1.42 g of iron reacts with 1.80 g of chlorine, 3.22 g of FeCl 2(s)
and 8.60 kJ of heat is produced. What is the enthalpy
change for the reaction when 1 mole of FeCl (s) is produced? 2
Answer
ΔH = −338 kJ
process occurring under these conditions. (The symbol ΔH is used to indicate an enthalpy change for a reaction occurring under
nonstandard conditions.)
The enthalpy changes for many types of chemical and physical processes are available in the reference literature, including those
for combustion reactions, phase transitions, and formation reactions. As we discuss these quantities, it is important to pay attention
to the extensive nature of enthalpy and enthalpy changes. Since the enthalpy change for a given reaction is proportional to the
amounts of substances involved, it may be reported on that basis (i.e., as the ΔH for specific amounts of reactants). However, we
often find it more useful to divide one extensive property (ΔH) by another (amount of substance), and report a per-amount intensive
value of ΔH, often “normalized” to a per-mole basis. (Note that this is similar to determining the intensive property specific heat
from the extensive property heat capacity, as seen previously.)
oxygen) under standard state conditions; it is sometimes called “heat of combustion.” For example, the enthalpy of combustion of
ethanol, −1366.8 kJ/mol, is the amount of heat produced when one mole of ethanol undergoes complete combustion at 25 °C and 1
atmosphere pressure, yielding products also at 25 °C and 1 atm.
∘
C H OH(l) + 3 O (g) ⟶ 2 CO + 3 H O(l) ΔH = −1366.8 kJ (5.3.10)
2 5 2 2 2 298
Enthalpies of combustion for many substances have been measured; a few of these are listed in Table 5.3.1. Many readily available
substances with large enthalpies of combustion are used as fuels, including hydrogen, carbon (as coal or charcoal), and
hydrocarbons (compounds containing only hydrogen and carbon), such as methane, propane, and the major components of
gasoline.
Table 5.3.1 : Standard Molar Enthalpies of Combustion
Enthalpy of Combustion
Substance Combustion Reaction ∘
kJ
ΔHc ( at 25°C)
mol
hydrogen H (g) +
2
1
2
O (g) ⟶ H O(l)
2 2
−285.8
magnesium Mg(s) +
1
2
O (g) ⟶ MgO(s)
2
−601.6
2
O (g) ⟶ CO (g)
2 2
−283.0
25
isooctane C H
8 18
(l) + O (g) ⟶ 8 CO (g) + 9 H O(l)
2 2 2
−5461
2
As Figure 5.3.3 suggests, the combustion of gasoline is a highly exothermic process. Let us determine the approximate amount
of heat produced by burning 1.00 L of gasoline, assuming the enthalpy of combustion of gasoline is the same as that of
isooctane, a common component of gasoline. The density of isooctane is 0.692 g/mL.
Figure 5.3.3 : The combustion of gasoline is very exothermic. (credit: modification of work by “AlexEagle”/Flickr)
Solution
Starting with a known amount (1.00 L of isooctane), we can perform conversions between units until we arrive at the desired
amount of heat or energy. The enthalpy of combustion of isooctane provides one of the necessary conversions. Table 5.3.1
gives this value as −5460 kJ per 1 mole of isooctane (C8H18).
Using these data,
The combustion of 1.00 L of isooctane produces 33,100 kJ of heat. (This amount of energy is enough to melt 99.2 kg, or about
218 lbs, of ice.)
Note: If you do this calculation one step at a time, you would find:
3
1.00 L C H ⟶ 1.00 × 10 mL C H
8 18 8 18
3
1.00 × 10 mL C H ⟶ 692 g C H
8 18 8 18
4
692 g C H ⟶ −3.31 × 10 kJ
8 18
Exercise 5.3.3
How much heat is produced by the combustion of 125 g of acetylene?
Answer
6.25 × 103 kJ
As reserves of fossil fuels diminish and become more costly to extract, the search is ongoing for replacement fuel sources for
the future. Among the most promising biofuels are those derived from algae (Figure 5.3.4). The species of algae used are
nontoxic, biodegradable, and among the world’s fastest growing organisms. About 50% of algal weight is oil, which can be
readily converted into fuel such as biodiesel. Algae can yield 26,000 gallons of biofuel per hectare—much more energy per
acre than other crops. Some strains of algae can flourish in brackish water that is not usable for growing other crops. Algae can
produce biodiesel, biogasoline, ethanol, butanol, methane, and even jet fuel.
Figure 5.3.5 : Algae convert sunlight and carbon dioxide into oil that is harvested, extracted, purified, and transformed into a
variety of renewable fuels.
from free elements in their most stable states under standard state conditions. These values are especially useful for computing or
predicting enthalpy changes for chemical reactions that are impractical or dangerous to carry out, or for processes for which it is
difficult to make measurements. If we have values for the appropriate standard enthalpies of formation, we can determine the
enthalpy change for any reaction, which we will practice in the next section on Hess’s law.
The standard enthalpy of formation of CO2(g) is −393.5 kJ/mol. This is the enthalpy change for the exothermic reaction:
∘ ∘
C(s) + O (g) ⟶ CO (g) ΔH = ΔH = −393.5 kJ (5.3.11)
2 2 f 298
starting with the reactants at a pressure of 1 atm and 25 °C (with the carbon present as graphite, the most stable form of carbon
under these conditions) and ending with one mole of CO2, also at 1 atm and 25 °C. For nitrogen dioxide, NO , ΔH is 33.2 2(g)
∘
f
A reaction equation with mole of N2 and 1 mole of O2 is correct in this case because the standard enthalpy of formation always
1
∘
3 O (g) ⟶ 2 O (g) ΔH = +286 kJ
2 3 298
Solution ΔH is the enthalpy change for the formation of one mole of a substance in its standard state from the elements in
f
∘
their standard states. Thus, ΔH for O3(g) is the enthalpy change for the reaction:
∘
f
3
O (g) ⟶ O (g)
2 3
2
286 kJ
For the formation of 2 mol of O3(g), ΔH ∘
298
= +286 kJ . This ratio, ( ), can be used as a conversion factor to find
2 mol O3
the heat produced when 1 mole of O3(g) is formed, which is the enthalpy of formation for O3(g):
286 kJ
∘
ΔH for 1 mole of O (g) = 1 mol O3 × = 143 kJ
3
2 mol O3
Therefore, ΔH f
∘
[ O (g)] = +143 kJ/mol
3
.
Exercise 5.3.4
Hydrogen gas, H2, reacts explosively with gaseous chlorine, Cl2, to form hydrogen chloride, HCl(g). What is the enthalpy
change for the reaction of 1 mole of H2(g) with 1 mole of Cl2(g) if both the reactants and products are at standard state
conditions? The standard enthalpy of formation of HCl(g) is −92.3 kJ/mol.
Answer
For the reaction
∘
H (g) + Cl (g) ⟶ 2 HCl(g) ΔH = −184.6 kJ
2 2 298
b. Ca (PO )
3 4 2(s)
Solution
Remembering that ΔH reaction equations are for forming 1 mole of the compound from its constituent elements under
∘
f
2 2 2 5
2 4 2 3 4 2
Exercise 5.3.5
Write the heat of formation reaction equations for:
a. C H OC
2 5 2
H5(l)
b. Na CO2 3(s)
2
O (g) ⟶ C H OC H (l)
2 2 5 2 5
;
Answer b
3
2 Na(s) + C(s, graphite) + O (g) ⟶ Na CO (s)
2 2 3
2
The equation describing the overall reaction is the sum of these two chemical changes:
1
Step 1: C(s) + O (g) ⟶ CO(g)
2
2
1
Step 2: CO(g) + O (g) ⟶ CO (g)
2 2
2
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
1 1
Sum: C(s) + O (g) + CO(g) + O (g) ⟶ CO(g) + CO (g)
2 2 2
2 2
Because the CO produced in Step 1 is consumed in Step 2, the net change is:
C(s) + O2(g) ⟶ CO2(g) (5.3.16)
According to Hess’s law, the enthalpy change of the reaction will equal the sum of the enthalpy changes of the steps. We can apply
the data from the experimental enthalpies of combustion in Table 5.3.1 to find the enthalpy change of the entire reaction from its
two steps:
1
∘
C(s) + O (g) ⟶ CO(g) ΔH = −111 kJ
2 298
2
1
∘
CO(g) + O (g) ⟶ CO (g) ΔH = −283 kJ
2 2 298
2
¯
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯ ¯
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
∘
C(s) + O (g) ⟶ CO (g) ΔH = −394 kJ
2 2 298
The result is shown in Figure 5.3.6. We see that ΔH of the overall reaction is the same whether it occurs in one step or two. This
finding (overall ΔH for the reaction = sum of ΔH values for reaction “steps” in the overall reaction) is true in general for chemical
and physical processes.
When 2 moles of NO2 (twice as much) are formed, the ΔH will be twice as large:
N (g) + 2 O (g) ⟶ 2 NO (g) ΔH = +66.4 kJ (5.3.18)
2 2 2
In general, if we multiply or divide an equation by a number, then the enthalpy change should also be multiplied or divided by
the same number.
2. ΔH for a reaction in one direction is equal in magnitude and opposite in sign to ΔH for the reaction in the reverse direction. For
example, given that:
H (g) + Cl (g) ⟶ 2 HCl(g) ΔH = −184.6 kJ (5.3.19)
2 2
Then, for the “reverse” reaction, the enthalpy change is also “reversed”:
2 HCl(g) ⟶ H (g) + Cl (g) ΔH = +184.6 kJ (5.3.20)
2 2
1
FeCl (s) + Cl (g) ⟶ FeCl (s) ΔH ° = −57.7 kJ
2 2 3
2
Solution
We are trying to find the standard enthalpy of formation of FeCl3(s), which is equal to ΔH° for the reaction:
3
∘
Fe(s) + Cl (g) ⟶ FeCl (s) ΔH =?
2 3 f
2
Looking at the reactions, we see that the reaction for which we want to find ΔH° is the sum of the two reactions with known
ΔH values, so we must sum their ΔHs:
1
FeCl (s) +Cl (g) ⟶ FeCl (s) ΔH ° = −57.7 kJ
2 2 3
2
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
1
Fe(s) + Cl (g) ⟶ FeCl (s) ΔH ° = −399.5 kJ
2 3
2
Exercise 5.3.6
1
NO(g) + O (g) ⟶ NO (g) ΔH = −57.06 kJ
2 2
2
Answer
66.4 kJ
Here is a less straightforward example that illustrates the thought process involved in solving many Hess’s law problems. It shows
how we can find many standard enthalpies of formation (and other values of ΔH) if they are difficult to determine experimentally.
Using Hess’s Law Chlorine monofluoride can react with fluorine to form chlorine trifluoride:
(i) ClF(g) + F 2
(g) ⟶ ClF (g)
3
ΔH ° = ?
Use the reactions here to determine the ΔH° for reaction (i):
(ii) 2 OF 2
(g) ⟶ O (g) + 2 F (g)
2 2
ΔH
∘
(ii)
= −49.4 kJ
(iii) 2 ClF(g) + O 2
(g) ⟶ Cl O(g) + OF (g)
2 2
ΔH
∘
(iii)
= +205.6 kJ
3
(iv) ClF 3
(g) + O (g) ⟶
2
1
2
Cl O(g) +
2
OF (g)
2
ΔH
∘
(iv)
= +266.7 kJ
2
Solution
Our goal is to manipulate and combine reactions (ii), (iii), and (iv) such that they add up to reaction (i). Going from left to right
in (i), we first see that ClF is needed as a reactant. This can be obtained by multiplying reaction (iii) by , which means that
(g)
1
1 1 1 1
ClF(g) + O (g) ⟶ Cl O(g) + OF (g) ΔH ° = (205.6) = +102.8 kJ
2 2 2
2 2 2 2
Next, we see that F is also needed as a reactant. To get this, reverse and halve reaction (ii), which means that the ΔH° changes
2
3
Reactants 1
2
O
2
and 1
2
O
2
cancel out product O2; product 1
2
Cl O
2
cancels reactant 1
2
Cl O
2
; and reactant OF
2
is cancelled by
2
products OF and OF2. This leaves only reactants ClF(g) and F2(g) and product ClF3(g), which are what we want. Since
1
2 2
summing these three modified reactions yields the reaction of interest, summing the three modified ΔH° values will give the
desired ΔH°:
ΔH ° = (+102.8 kJ) + (24.7 kJ) + (−266.7 kJ) = −139.2 kJ
Exercise 5.3.7
Use the reactions here to determine the ΔH° for reaction (i):
(ii) HCl(g) ⟶ HCl(aq) ΔH
∘
(ii)
= −74.8 kJ
(iii) H 2
(g) + Cl (g) ⟶ 2 HCl(g)
2
ΔH
∘
(iii)
= −185 kJ
(iv) AlCl 3
(aq) ⟶ AlCl (s)
3
ΔH
∘
(iv)
= +323 kJ/mol
Answer
−1407 kJ
We also can use Hess’s law to determine the enthalpy change of any reaction if the corresponding enthalpies of formation of the
reactants and products are available. The stepwise reactions we consider are: (i) decompositions of the reactants into their
component elements (for which the enthalpy changes are proportional to the negative of the enthalpies of formation of the
reactants), followed by (ii) re-combinations of the elements to give the products (with the enthalpy changes proportional to the
enthalpies of formation of the products). The standard enthalpy change of the overall reaction is therefore equal to: (ii) the sum of
the standard enthalpies of formation of all the products plus (i) the sum of the negatives of the standard enthalpies of formation of
the reactants. This is usually rearranged slightly to be written as follows, with ∑ representing “the sum of” and n standing for the
stoichiometric coefficients:
∘ ∘ ∘
ΔH = ∑ n × ΔH (products) − ∑ n × ΔH (reactants) (5.3.21)
reaction f f
The following example shows in detail why this equation is valid, and how to use it to calculate the enthalpy change for a reaction
of interest.
⎡ −207.4 kJ +90.2 kJ ⎤
= 2 mol HNO3 × +1 mol NO (g) ×
⎣ mol HNO3 (aq) mol NO (g) ⎦
⎡ +33.2 kJ −285.8 kJ ⎤
− 3 mol NO2 (g) × +1 mol H2 O (l) ×
⎣ mol NO2 (g) mol H2 O (l) ⎦
= −138.4 kJ
3
∘
3 NO (g) ⟶ N (g) + 3 O (g) ΔH = −99.6 kJ
2 2 2 1
2
1
∘ ∘
H O(l) ⟶ H (g) + O (g) ΔH = +285.8 kJ [−1 × ΔH (H O)]
2 2 2 2 f 2
2
∘ ∘
H (g) + N (g) + 3 O (g) ⟶ 2 HNO (aq) ΔH = −414.8 kJ [2 × ΔH (HNO )]
2 2 2 3 3 f 3
1 1
∘
N (g) + O (g) ⟶ NO(g) ΔH = +90.2 kJ [1 × (NO)]
2 2 4
2 2
Summing these reaction equations gives the reaction we are interested in:
= −138.4 kJ
So the standard enthalpy change for this reaction is ΔH° = −138.4 kJ.
Note that this result was obtained by:
1. multiplying the ΔH of each product by its stoichiometric coefficient and summing those values,
∘
f
2. multiplying the ΔH of each reactant by its stoichiometric coefficient and summing those values, and then
∘
f
3. subtracting the result found in step 2 from the result found in step 1.
This is also the procedure in using the general equation, as shown.
Exercise 5.3.8
Calculate the heat of combustion of 1 mole of ethanol, C2H5OH(l), when H2O(l) and CO2(g) are formed. Use the following
enthalpies of formation: C2H5OH(l), −278 kJ/mol; H2O(l), −286 kJ/mol; and CO2(g), −394 kJ/mol.
Answer
−1368 kJ/mol
value of ΔH for a reaction in one direction is equal in magnitude, but opposite in sign, to ΔH for the reaction in the opposite
direction, and ΔH is directly proportional to the quantity of reactants and products. Examples of enthalpy changes include enthalpy
of combustion, enthalpy of fusion, enthalpy of vaporization, and standard enthalpy of formation. The standard enthalpy of
formation, ΔH , is the enthalpy change accompanying the formation of 1 mole of a substance from the elements in their most
∘
f
stable states at 1 bar (standard state). Many of the processes are carried out at 298.15 K. If the enthalpies of formation are available
for the reactants and products of a reaction, the enthalpy change can be calculated using Hess’s law: If a process can be written as
the sum of several stepwise processes, the enthalpy change of the total process equals the sum of the enthalpy changes of the
various steps.
Footnotes
1. 1 For more on algal fuel, see www.theguardian.com/environme...n-fuel-problem.
Glossary
chemical thermodynamics
area of science that deals with the relationships between heat, work, and all forms of energy associated with chemical and
physical processes
enthalpy (H)
sum of a system’s internal energy and the mathematical product of its pressure and volume
Hess’s law
if a process can be represented as the sum of several steps, the enthalpy change of the process equals the sum of the enthalpy
changes of the steps
hydrocarbon
compound composed only of hydrogen and carbon; the major component of fossil fuels
heat released when one mole of a compound undergoes complete combustion under standard conditions
enthalpy change of a chemical reaction in which 1 mole of a pure substance is formed from its elements in their most stable
states under standard state conditions
This page titled 5.3: Enthalpy is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that
was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
S5.1.1
The temperature of 1 gram of burning wood is approximately the same for both a match and a bonfire. This is an intensive property
and depends on the material (wood). However, the overall amount of produced heat depends on the amount of material; this is an
extensive property. The amount of wood in a bonfire is much greater than that in a match; the total amount of produced heat is also
much greater, which is why we can sit around a bonfire to stay warm, but a match would not provide enough heat to keep us from
getting cold.
Q5.1.2
Prepare a table identifying several energy transitions that take place during the typical operation of an automobile.
Q5.1.3
Explain the difference between heat capacity and specific heat of a substance.
S5.1.3
Heat capacity refers to the heat required to raise the temperature of the mass of the substance 1 degree; specific heat refers to the
heat required to raise the temperature of 1 gram of the substance 1 degree. Thus, heat capacity is an extensive property, and specific
heat is an intensive one.
Q5.1.4
Calculate the heat capacity, in joules and in calories per degree, of the following:
a. 28.4 g of water
b. 1.00 oz of lead
Q5.1.5
Calculate the heat capacity, in joules and in calories per degree, of the following:
a. 45.8 g of nitrogen gas
b. 1.00 pound of aluminum metal
S5.1.5
a. 47.6 J/°C; 11.38 cal °C−1;
b. 407 J/°C; 97.3 cal °C−1
Q5.1.6
How much heat, in joules and in calories, must be added to a 75.0–g iron block with a specific heat of 0.449 J/g °C to increase its
temperature from 25 °C to its melting temperature of 1535 °C?
S5.1.6
q = mC Δ°T
0.449 J
q = (75.0g) × ( ) × (1, 510°K) = 50, 800J
g °C
50,800J ; 12,200cal
S5.1.7
1310 J; 313 cal
Q5.1.8
How much would the temperature of 275 g of water increase if 36.5 kJ of heat were added?
S5.1.8
ΔT° = 31.7° C
Q5.1.9
If 14.5 kJ of heat were added to 485 g of liquid water, how much would its temperature increase?
S5.1.9
7.15 °C
Q5.1.10
A piece of unknown substance weighs 44.7 g and requires 2110 J to increase its temperature from 23.2 °C to 89.6 °C.
a. What is the specific heat of the substance?
b. If it is one of the substances found in Table, what is its likely identity?
S5.1.10
a.) Solve for the specific heat C and compare the values with the chart
q = mC Δ°T
2110 J
C =
2970 g °C
0.711 J
C =
g °C
b.) Silicon
Q5.1.11
A piece of unknown solid substance weighs 437.2 g, and requires 8460 J to increase its temperature from 19.3 °C to 68.9 °C.
a. What is the specific heat of the substance?
b. If it is one of the substances found in Table, what is its likely identity?
S5.1.11
a. 0.390 J/g °C;
b. Copper is a likely candidate.
Q5.1.12
An aluminum kettle weighs 1.05 kg.
a. What is the heat capacity of the kettle?
b. How much heat is required to increase the temperature of this kettle from 23.0 °C to 99.0 °C?
c. How much heat is required to heat this kettle from 23.0 °C to 99.0 °C if it contains 1.25 L of water (density of 0.997 g/mL and a
specific heat of 4.184 J/g °C)?
S5.1.13
We assume that the density of water is 1.0 g/cm3(1 g/mL) and that it takes as much energy to keep the water at 85 °F as to heat it
from 72 °F to 85 °F. We also assume that only the water is going to be heated. Energy required = 7.47 kWh
5.2: Calorimetry
Q5.2.1
A 500-mL bottle of water at room temperature and a 2-L bottle of water at the same temperature were placed in a refrigerator. After
30 minutes, the 500-mL bottle of water had cooled to the temperature of the refrigerator. An hour later, the 2-L of water had cooled
to the same temperature. When asked which sample of water lost the most heat, one student replied that both bottles lost the same
amount of heat because they started at the same temperature and finished at the same temperature. A second student thought that
the 2-L bottle of water lost more heat because there was more water. A third student believed that the 500-mL bottle of water lost
more heat because it cooled more quickly. A fourth student thought that it was not possible to tell because we do not know the
initial temperature and the final temperature of the water. Indicate which of these answers is correct and describe the error in each
of the other answers.
Q5.2.2
Would the amount of heat measured for the reaction in Example be greater, lesser, or remain the same if we used a calorimeter that
was a poorer insulator than a coffee cup calorimeter? Explain your answer.
S5.2.2
lesser; more heat would be lost to the coffee cup and the environment and so ΔT for the water would be lesser and the calculated q
would be lesser
Q5.2.3
Would the amount of heat absorbed by the dissolution in Example appear greater, lesser, or remain the same if the experimenter
used a calorimeter that was a poorer insulator than a coffee cup calorimeter? Explain your answer.
Q5.2.4
Would the amount of heat absorbed by the dissolution in Example appear greater, lesser, or remain the same if the heat capacity of
the calorimeter were taken into account? Explain your answer.
S5.2.4
greater, since taking the calorimeter’s heat capacity into account will compensate for the thermal energy transferred to the solution
from the calorimeter; this approach includes the calorimeter itself, along with the solution, as “surroundings”: qrxn = −(qsolution +
qcalorimeter); since both qsolution and qcalorimeter are negative, including the latter term (qrxn) will yield a greater value for the heat of
the dissolution
Q5.2.5
How many milliliters of water at 23 °C with a density of 1.00 g/mL must be mixed with 180 mL (about 6 oz) of coffee at 95 °C so
that the resulting combination will have a temperature of 60 °C? Assume that coffee and water have the same density and the same
specific heat.
Q5.2.6
How much will the temperature of a cup (180 g) of coffee at 95 °C be reduced when a 45 g silver spoon (specific heat 0.24 J/g °C)
at 25 °C is placed in the coffee and the two are allowed to reach the same temperature? Assume that the coffee has the same density
S5.2.6
The temperature of the coffee will drop 1 degree.
Q5.2.7
A 45-g aluminum spoon (specific heat 0.88 J/g °C) at 24 °C is placed in 180 mL (180 g) of coffee at 85 °C and the temperature of
the two become equal.
a. What is the final temperature when the two become equal? Assume that coffee has the same specific heat as water.
b. The first time a student solved this problem she got an answer of 88 °C. Explain why this is clearly an incorrect answer.
Q5.2.8
The temperature of the cooling water as it leaves the hot engine of an automobile is 240 °F. After it passes through the radiator it
has a temperature of 175 °F. Calculate the amount of heat transferred from the engine to the surroundings by one gallon of water
with a specific heat of 4.184 J/g °C.
S5.2.8
2
5.7 × 10 kJ
Q5.2.8
A 70.0-g piece of metal at 80.0 °C is placed in 100 g of water at 22.0 °C contained in a calorimeter like that shown in Figure. The
metal and water come to the same temperature at 24.6 °C. How much heat did the metal give up to the water? What is the specific
heat of the metal?
Q5.2.9
If a reaction produces 1.506 kJ of heat, which is trapped in 30.0 g of water initially at 26.5 °C in a calorimeter like that in Figure,
what is the resulting temperature of the water?
S5.2.9
38.5 °C
Q5.2.10
A 0.500-g sample of KCl is added to 50.0 g of water in a calorimeter (Figure). If the temperature decreases by 1.05 °C, what is the
approximate amount of heat involved in the dissolution of the KCl, assuming the heat capacity of the resulting solution is 4.18 J/g
°C? Is the reaction exothermic or endothermic?
Q5.2.11
Dissolving 3.0 g of CaCl2(s) in 150.0 g of water in a calorimeter (Figure) at 22.4 °C causes the temperature to rise to 25.8 °C. What
is the approximate amount of heat involved in the dissolution, assuming the heat capacity of the resulting solution is 4.18 J/g °C? Is
the reaction exothermic or endothermic?
S5.2.11
2.2 kJ; The heat produced shows that the reaction is exothermic.
Q5.2.12
When 50.0 g of 0.200 M NaCl(aq) at 24.1 °C is added to 100.0 g of 0.100 M AgNO3(aq) at 24.1 °C in a calorimeter, the
temperature increases to 25.2 °C as AgCl(s) forms. Assuming the specific heat of the solution and products is 4.20 J/g °C, calculate
the approximate amount of heat in joules produced.
Q5.2.13
The addition of 3.15 g of Ba(OH)2•8H2O to a solution of 1.52 g of NH4SCN in 100 g of water in a calorimeter caused the
temperature to fall by 3.1 °C. Assuming the specific heat of the solution and products is 4.20 J/g °C, calculate the approximate
amount of heat absorbed by the reaction, which can be represented by the following equation:
S5.2.13
1.4 kJ
Q5.2.14
The reaction of 50 mL of acid and 50 mL of base described in Example increased the temperature of the solution by 6.9 degrees.
How much would the temperature have increased if 100 mL of acid and 100 mL of base had been used in the same calorimeter
starting at the same temperature of 22.0 °C? Explain your answer.
Q5.2.15
If the 3.21 g of NH4NO3 in Example were dissolved in 100.0 g of water under the same conditions, how much would the
temperature change? Explain your answer.
S5.2.15
22.6. Since the mass and the heat capacity of the solution is approximately equal to that of the water, the two-fold increase in the
amount of water leads to a two-fold decrease of the temperature change.
Q5.2.16
When 1.0 g of fructose, C6H12O6(s), a sugar commonly found in fruits, is burned in oxygen in a bomb calorimeter, the temperature
of the calorimeter increases by 1.58 °C. If the heat capacity of the calorimeter and its contents is 9.90 kJ/°C, what is q for this
combustion?
Q5.2.17
When a 0.740-g sample of trinitrotoluene (TNT), C7H5N2O6, is burned in a bomb calorimeter, the temperature increases from 23.4
°C to 26.9 °C. The heat capacity of the calorimeter is 534 J/°C, and it contains 675 mL of water. How much heat was produced by
the combustion of the TNT sample?
S5.2.17
11.7 kJ
Q5.2.18
One method of generating electricity is by burning coal to heat water, which produces steam that drives an electric generator. To
determine the rate at which coal is to be fed into the burner in this type of plant, the heat of combustion per ton of coal must be
determined using a bomb calorimeter. When 1.00 g of coal is burned in a bomb calorimeter, the temperature increases by 1.48 °C.
If the heat capacity of the calorimeter is 21.6 kJ/°C, determine the heat produced by combustion of a ton of coal (2.000 × 103
pounds).
Q5.2.19
The amount of fat recommended for someone with a daily diet of 2000 Calories is 65 g. What percent of the calories in this diet
would be supplied by this amount of fat if the average number of Calories for fat is 9.1 Calories/g?
S5.2.19
30%
Q5.2.20
A teaspoon of the carbohydrate sucrose (common sugar) contains 16 Calories (16 kcal). What is the mass of one teaspoon of
sucrose if the average number of Calories for carbohydrates is 4.1 Calories/g?
Q5.2.21
What is the maximum mass of carbohydrate in a 6-oz serving of diet soda that contains less than 1 Calorie per can if the average
number of Calories for carbohydrates is 4.1 Calories/g?
Q5.2.22
A pint of premium ice cream can contain 1100 Calories. What mass of fat, in grams and pounds, must be produced in the body to
store an extra 1.1 × 103 Calories if the average number of Calories for fat is 9.1 Calories/g?
Q5.2.23
A serving of a breakfast cereal contains 3 g of protein, 18 g of carbohydrates, and 6 g of fat. What is the Calorie content of a
serving of this cereal if the average number of Calories for fat is 9.1 Calories/g, for carbohydrates is 4.1 Calories/g, and for protein
is 4.1 Calories/g?
S5.2.23
1.4 × 102 Calories
Q5.2.24
Which is the least expensive source of energy in kilojoules per dollar: a box of breakfast cereal that weighs 32 ounces and costs
$4.23, or a liter of isooctane (density, 0.6919 g/mL) that costs $0.45? Compare the nutritional value of the cereal with the heat
produced by combustion of the isooctane under standard conditions. A 1.0-ounce serving of the cereal provides 130 Calories.
5.3: Enthalpy
Q5.3.1
Explain how the heat measured in [link] differs from the enthalpy change for the exothermic reaction described by the following
equation:
The enthalpy change of the indicated reaction is for exactly 1 mol HCL and 1 mol NaOH; the heat in the example is produced by
0.0500 mol HCl and 0.0500 mol NaOH. Using the data in the check your learning section of [link], calculate ΔH in kJ/mol of
AgNO3(aq) for the reaction:
Q5.3.2
Calculate the enthalpy of solution (ΔH for the dissolution) per mole of NH4NO3 under the conditions described in [link].
S5.3.2
25 kJ mol−1
Q5.3.3
Calculate ΔH for the reaction described by the equation.
Ba (OH) ⋅ 8 H O(s) + 2 NH SCN(aq) ⟶ Ba (SCN) (aq) + 2 NH (aq) + 10 H O(l)
2 2 4 2 3 2
Q5.3.4
Calculate the enthalpy of solution (ΔH for the dissolution) per mole of CaCl2.
S5.3.4
81 kJ mol−1
Q5.3.5
Although the gas used in an oxyacetylene torch is essentially pure acetylene, the heat produced by combustion of one mole of
acetylene in such a torch is likely not equal to the enthalpy of combustion of acetylene listed in Table. Considering the conditions
for which the tabulated data are reported, suggest an explanation.
S5.3.6
5204.4 kJ
Q5.3.7
How much heat is produced by combustion of 125 g of methanol under standard state conditions?
Q5.3.8
How many moles of isooctane must be burned to produce 100 kJ of heat under standard state conditions?
S5.3.8
1.83 × 10−2 mol
Q5.3.9
What mass of carbon monoxide must be burned to produce 175 kJ of heat under standard state conditions?
Q5.3.10
When 2.50 g of methane burns in oxygen, 125 kJ of heat is produced. What is the enthalpy of combustion per mole of methane
under these conditions?
S5.3.10
802 kJ mol−1
Q5.3.11
How much heat is produced when 100 mL of 0.250 M HCl (density, 1.00 g/mL) and 200 mL of 0.150 M NaOH (density, 1.00
g/mL) are mixed?
∘
HCl(aq) + NaOH(aq) ⟶ NaCl(aq) + H O(l) ΔH = −58 kJ (5.E.4)
2 298
If both solutions are at the same temperature and the heat capacity of the products is 4.19 J/g °C, how much will the temperature
increase? What assumption did you make in your calculation?
Q5.3.12
A sample of 0.562 g of carbon is burned in oxygen in a bomb calorimeter, producing carbon dioxide. Assume both the reactants
and products are under standard state conditions, and that the heat released is directly proportional to the enthalpy of combustion of
graphite. The temperature of the calorimeter increases from 26.74 °C to 27.93 °C. What is the heat capacity of the calorimeter and
its contents?
S5.3.12
15.5 kJ/ºC
Q5.3.13
Before the introduction of chlorofluorocarbons, sulfur dioxide (enthalpy of vaporization, 6.00 kcal/mol) was used in household
refrigerators. What mass of SO2 must be evaporated to remove as much heat as evaporation of 1.00 kg of CCl2F2 (enthalpy of
vaporization is 17.4 kJ/mol)?
The vaporization reactions for SO2 and CCl2F2 are
SO (l) ⟶ SO (g)
2 2
and CCl 2
F(l) ⟶ CCl F (g)
2 2
, respectively.
Q5.3.14
Homes may be heated by pumping hot water through radiators. What mass of water will provide the same amount of heat when
cooled from 95.0 to 35.0 °C, as the heat provided when 100 g of steam is cooled from 110 °C to 100 °C.
Q5.3.15
Which of the enthalpies of combustion in Table the table are also standard enthalpies of formation?
Q5.3.16
Does the standard enthalpy of formation of H2O(g) differ from ΔH° for the reaction 2 H 2
(g) + O (g) ⟶ 2 H O(g)
2 2
?
S5.3.16
No.
Q5.3.17
Joseph Priestly prepared oxygen in 1774 by heating red mercury(II) oxide with sunlight focused through a lens. How much heat is
required to decompose exactly 1 mole of red HgO(s) to Hg(l) and O2(g) under standard conditions?
Q5.3.18
How many kilojoules of heat will be released when exactly 1 mole of manganese, Mn, is burned to form Mn3O4(s) at standard state
conditions?
S5.3.18
459.6 kJ
Q5.3.19
How many kilojoules of heat will be released when exactly 1 mole of iron, Fe, is burned to form Fe2O3(s) at standard state
conditions?
Q5.3.20
The following sequence of reactions occurs in the commercial production of aqueous nitric acid:
4 NH (g) + 5 O (g) ⟶ 4 NO(g) + 6 H O(l) ΔH = −907 kJ
3 2 2
Determine the total energy change for the production of one mole of aqueous nitric acid by this process.
S5.3.20
495 kJ/mol
Q5.3.21
Both graphite and diamond burn.
C(s, diamond) + O (g) ⟶ CO (g)
2 2
Which produces more heat, the combustion of graphite or the combustion of diamond?
Q5.3.22
From the molar heats of formation in Appendix G, determine how much heat is required to evaporate one mole of water:
H O(l) ⟶ H O(g)
2 2
S5.3.22
44.01 kJ/mol
or
Os(s) ⟶ 2 O (g) ⟶ OsO (g)
2 4
Q5.3.24
Calculate ΔH ∘
298
for the process
5
Sb(s) + Cl (g) ⟶ SbCl (g)
2 5
2
∘
SbCl (s) + Cl (g) ⟶ SbCl (g) ΔH = −80 kJ
3 2 5 298
S5.3.24
394 kJ
Q5.3.25
Calculate ΔH ∘
298
for the process Zn(s) + S(s) + 2 O 2
(g) ⟶ ZnSO (s)
4
∘
ZnS(s) + 2 O (g) ⟶ ZnSO (s) ΔH = −776.8 kJ
2 4 298
Q5.3.26
Calculate ΔH for the process
Hg Cl (s) ⟶ 2 Hg(l) + Cl (g)
2 2 2
S5.3.26
265 kJ
Q5.3.27
Calculate ΔH ∘
298
for the process
Co O (s) ⟶ 3 Co(s) + 2 O (g)
3 4 2
∘
3 Co(s) + O (g) ⟶ Co O (s) ΔH = −177.5 kJ
2 3 4 298
Q5.3.28
Calculate the standard molar enthalpy of formation of NO(g) from the following data:
∘
N (g) + 2 O ⟶ 2 NO (g) ΔH = 66.4 kJ
2 2 2 298
S5.3.28
90.3 mol−1 of NO
Q5.3.29
Using the data in Appendix G, calculate the standard enthalpy change for each of the following reactions:
a. N (g) + O (g) ⟶ 2 NO(g)
2 2
Q5.3.30
Using the data in Appendix G, calculate the standard enthalpy change for each of the following reactions:
a. Si(s) + 2 F (g) ⟶ SiF (g)
2 4
S5.3.30
a. −1615.0 kJ mol−1;
b. −484.3 kJ mol−1;
c. 164.2 kJ;
d. −232.1 kJ
Q5.3.31
The following reactions can be used to prepare samples of metals. Determine the enthalpy change under standard state conditions
for each.
a. 2 Ag O(s) ⟶ 4 Ag(s) + O (g)
2 2
Q5.3.32
The decomposition of hydrogen peroxide, H2O2, has been used to provide thrust in the control jets of various space vehicles. Using
the data in Appendix G, determine how much heat is produced by the decomposition of exactly 1 mole of H2O2 under standard
conditions.
2 H O (l) ⟶ 2 H O(g) + O (g)
2 2 2 2
S5.3.32
−54.04 kJ mol−1
Q5.3.33
Calculate the enthalpy of combustion of propane, C3H8(g), for the formation of H2O(g) and CO2(g). The enthalpy of formation of
propane is −104 kJ/mol.
Q5.3.34
Calculate the enthalpy of combustion of butane, C4H10(g) for the formation of H2O(g) and CO2(g). The enthalpy of formation of
butane is −126 kJ/mol.
Q5.3.35
Both propane and butane are used as gaseous fuels. Which compound produces more heat per gram when burned?
Q5.3.36
The white pigment TiO2 is prepared by the reaction of titanium tetrachloride, TiCl4, with water vapor in the gas phase:
TiCl (g) + 2 H O(g) ⟶ TiO (s) + 4 HCl(g)
4 2 2
.
How much heat is evolved in the production of exactly 1 mole of TiO2(s) under standard state conditions?
S5.3.36
67.1 kJ
Q5.3.37
Water gas, a mixture of H2 and CO, is an important industrial fuel produced by the reaction of steam with red hot coke, essentially
pure carbon:
C(s) + H O(g) ⟶ CO(g) + H (g)
2 2
.
a. Assuming that coke has the same enthalpy of formation as graphite, calculate ΔH for this reaction.∘
298
b. Methanol, a liquid fuel that could possibly replace gasoline, can be prepared from water gas and additional hydrogen at high
temperature and pressure in the presence of a suitable catalyst:
2 H (g) + CO(g) ⟶ CH OH(g). (5.E.5)
2 3
Under the conditions of the reaction, methanol forms as a gas. Calculate ΔH for this reaction and for the condensation of
∘
298
Q5.3.38
In the early days of automobiles, illumination at night was provided by burning acetylene, C2H2. Though no longer used as auto
headlamps, acetylene is still used as a source of light by some cave explorers. The acetylene is (was) prepared in the lamp by the
reaction of water with calcium carbide, CaC2:
CaC (s) + H O(l) ⟶ Ca (OH) (s) + C H (g)
2 2 2 2 2
.
Calculate the standard enthalpy of the reaction. The ΔH of CaC2 is −15.14 kcal/mol.
f
∘
S5.3.38
122.8 kJ
Q5.3.39
From the data in Table, determine which of the following fuels produces the greatest amount of heat per gram when burned under
standard conditions: CO(g), CH4(g), or C2H2(g).
Q5.3.40
The enthalpy of combustion of hard coal averages −35 kJ/g, that of gasoline, 1.28 × 105 kJ/gal. How many kilograms of hard coal
provide the same amount of heat as is available from 1.0 gallon of gasoline? Assume that the density of gasoline is 0.692 g/mL (the
same as the density of isooctane).
S5.3.40
3.7 kg
Q5.3.42
Among the substances that react with oxygen and that have been considered as potential rocket fuels are diborane [B2H6, produces
B2O3(s) and H2O(g)], methane [CH4, produces CO2(g) and H2O(g)], and hydrazine [N2H4, produces N2(g) and H2O(g)]. On the
basis of the heat released by 1.00 g of each substance in its reaction with oxygen, which of these compounds offers the best
possibility as a rocket fuel? The ΔH of B2H6(g), CH4(g), and N2H4(l) may be found in Appendix G.
f
∘
S5.3.42
On the assumption that the best rocket fuel is the one that gives off the most heat, B2H6 is the prime candidate.
Q5.3.43
How much heat is produced when 1.25 g of chromium metal reacts with oxygen gas under standard conditions?
Ethylene, C2H2, a byproduct from the fractional distillation of petroleum, is fourth among the 50 chemical compounds produced
commercially in the largest quantities. About 80% of synthetic ethanol is manufactured from ethylene by its reaction with water in
the presence of a suitable catalyst.
C H (g) + H O(g) ⟶ C H OH(l)
2 4 2 2 5
Using the data in the table in Appendix G, calculate ΔH° for the reaction.
S5.3.43
88.2 kJ
Q5.3.44
The oxidation of the sugar glucose, C6H12O6, is described by the following equation:
C H O (s) + 6 O (g) ⟶ 6 CO (g) + 6 H O(l) ΔH = −2816 kJ
6 12 6 2 2 2
The metabolism of glucose gives the same products, although the glucose reacts with oxygen in a series of steps in the body.
a. How much heat in kilojoules can be produced by the metabolism of 1.0 g of glucose?
b. How many Calories can be produced by the metabolism of 1.0 g of glucose?
Q5.3.45
Propane, C3H8, is a hydrocarbon that is commonly used as a fuel.
a. Write a balanced equation for the complete combustion of propane gas.
b. Calculate the volume of air at 25 °C and 1.00 atmosphere that is needed to completely combust 25.0 grams of propane. Assume
that air is 21.0 percent O2 by volume. (Hint: we will see how to do this calculation in a later chapter on gases—for now use the
information that 1.00 L of air at 25 °C and 1.00 atm contains 0.275 g of O2 per liter.)
c. The heat of combustion of propane is −2,219.2 kJ/mol. Calculate the heat of formation, ΔH of propane given that ΔH of
∘
f f
∘
d. Assuming that all of the heat released in burning 25.0 grams of propane is transferred to 4.00 kilograms of water, calculate the
increase in temperature of the water.
S5.3.45
a. C H (g) + 5 O
3 8 2
(g) ⟶ 3 CO (g) + 4 H O(l)
2 2
;
b. 330 L;
Q5.3.46
During a recent winter month in Sheboygan, Wisconsin, it was necessary to obtain 3500 kWh of heat provided by a natural gas
furnace with 89% efficiency to keep a small house warm (the efficiency of a gas furnace is the percent of the heat produced by
combustion that is transferred into the house).
a. Assume that natural gas is pure methane and determine the volume of natural gas in cubic feet that was required to heat the
house. The average temperature of the natural gas was 56 °F; at this temperature and a pressure of 1 atm, natural gas has a
density of 0.681 g/L.
b. How many gallons of LPG (liquefied petroleum gas) would be required to replace the natural gas used? Assume the LPG is
liquid propane [C3H8: density, 0.5318 g/mL; enthalpy of combustion, 2219 kJ/mol for the formation of CO2(g) and H2O(l)] and
the furnace used to burn the LPG has the same efficiency as the gas furnace.
c. What mass of carbon dioxide is produced by combustion of the methane used to heat the house?
d. What mass of water is produced by combustion of the methane used to heat the house?
e. What volume of air is required to provide the oxygen for the combustion of the methane used to heat the house? Air contains
23% oxygen by mass. The average density of air during the month was 1.22 g/L.
f. How many kilowatt–hours (1 kWh = 3.6 × 106 J) of electricity would be required to provide the heat necessary to heat the
house? Note electricity is 100% efficient in producing heat inside a house.
g. Although electricity is 100% efficient in producing heat inside a house, production and distribution of electricity is not 100%
efficient. The efficiency of production and distribution of electricity produced in a coal-fired power plant is about 40%. A
certain type of coal provides 2.26 kWh per pound upon combustion. What mass of this coal in kilograms will be required to
produce the electrical energy necessary to heat the house if the efficiency of generation and distribution is 40%?
This page titled 5.E: Thermochemistry (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 6: Electronic Structure and Periodic Properties is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
Learning Objectives
Explain the basic behavior of waves, including traveling waves and standing waves
Describe the wave nature of light
Use appropriate equations to calculate related light-wave properties such as period, frequency, wavelength, and energy
Distinguish between line and continuous emission spectra
Describe the particle nature of light
The nature of light has been a subject of inquiry since antiquity. In the seventeenth century, Isaac Newton performed experiments
with lenses and prisms and was able to demonstrate that white light consists of the individual colors of the rainbow combined
together. Newton explained his optics findings in terms of a "corpuscular" view of light, in which light was composed of streams of
extremely tiny particles travelling at high speeds according to Newton's laws of motion. Others in the seventeenth century, such as
Christiaan Huygens, had shown that optical phenomena such as reflection and refraction could be equally well explained in terms
of light as waves travelling at high speed through a medium called "luminiferous aether" that was thought to permeate all space.
Early in the nineteenth century, Thomas Young demonstrated that light passing through narrow, closely spaced slits produced
interference patterns that could not be explained in terms of Newtonian particles but could be easily explained in terms of waves.
Later in the nineteenth century, after James Clerk Maxwell developed his theory of electromagnetic radiation and showed that light
was the visible part of a vast spectrum of electromagnetic waves, the particle view of light became thoroughly discredited. By the
end of the nineteenth century, scientists viewed the physical universe as roughly comprising two separate domains: matter
composed of particles moving according to Newton's laws of motion, and electromagnetic radiation consisting of waves governed
by Maxwell's equations. Today, these domains are referred to as classical mechanics and classical electrodynamics (or classical
electromagnetism). Although there were a few physical phenomena that could not be explained within this framework, scientists at
that time were so confident of the overall soundness of this framework that they viewed these aberrations as puzzling paradoxes
that would ultimately be resolved somehow within this framework. As we shall see, these paradoxes led to a contemporary
framework that intimately connects particles and waves at a fundamental level called wave-particle duality, which has superseded
the classical view.
Visible light and other forms of electromagnetic radiation play important roles in chemistry, since they can be used to infer the
energies of electrons within atoms and molecules. Much of modern technology is based on electromagnetic radiation. For example,
radio waves from a mobile phone, X-rays used by dentists, the energy used to cook food in your microwave, the radiant heat from
red-hot objects, and the light from your television screen are forms of electromagnetic radiation that all exhibit wavelike behavior.
6.1.1: Waves
A wave is an oscillation or periodic movement that can transport energy from one point in space to another. Common examples of
waves are all around us. Shaking the end of a rope transfers energy from your hand to the other end of the rope, dropping a pebble
into a pond causes waves to ripple outward along the water's surface, and the expansion of air that accompanies a lightning strike
generates sound waves (thunder) that can travel outward for several miles. In each of these cases, kinetic energy is transferred
through matter (the rope, water, or air) while the matter remains essentially in place. An insightful example of a wave occurs in
sports stadiums when fans in a narrow region of seats rise simultaneously and stand with their arms raised up for a few seconds
before sitting down again while the fans in neighboring sections likewise stand up and sit down in sequence. While this wave can
quickly encircle a large stadium in a few seconds, none of the fans actually travel with the wave-they all stay in or above their
seats.
Waves need not be restricted to travel through matter. As Maxwell showed, electromagnetic waves consist of an electric field
oscillating in step with a perpendicular magnetic field, both of which are perpendicular to the direction of travel. These waves can
travel through a vacuum at a constant speed of 2.998 × 108 m/s, the speed of light (denoted by c).
All waves, including forms of electromagnetic radiation, are characterized by, a wavelength (denoted by λ, the lowercase Greek
letter lambda), a frequency (denoted by ν, the lowercase Greek letter nu), and an amplitude. As can be seen in Figure 6.1.1, the
wavelength is the distance between two consecutive peaks or troughs in a wave (measured in meters in the SI system).
Electromagnetic waves have wavelengths that fall within an enormous range-wavelengths of kilometers (103 m) to picometers
(10−12 m) have been observed. The frequency is the number of wave cycles that pass a specified point in space in a specified
Figure 6.1.1 : One-dimensional sinusoidal waves show the relationship among wavelength, frequency, and speed. The wave with
the shortest wavelength has the highest frequency. Amplitude is one-half the height of the wave from peak to trough. (CC by 4.0;
OpenStax)
This figure includes 5 one-dimensional sinusoidal waves in two columns. The column on the left includes three waves, and the
column on the right includes two waves. In each column, dashed vertical line segments extend down the left and right sides of the
column. A right pointing arrow extends from the left dashed line to the right dashed line in both columns and is labeled, “Distance
traveled in 1 second.” The waves all begin on the left side at a crest. The wave at the upper left shows 3 peaks to the right of the
starting point. A bracket labeled, “lambda subscript 1,” extends upward from the second and third peaks. Beneath this wave is the
label, “nu subscript 1 equals 4 cycles per second equals 3 hertz.” The wave below has six peaks to the right of the starting point
with a bracket similarly connecting the third and fourth peaks which is labeled, “lambda subscript 2.” Beneath this wave is the
label, “nu subscript 2 equals 8 cycles per second equals 6 hertz” The third wave in the column has twelve peaks to the right of the
starting point with a bracket similarly connecting the seventh and eighth peaks which is labeled, “lambda subscript 3.” Beneath this
wave is the label, “nu subscript 3 equals 12 cycles per second equals 12 hertz.” All waves in this column appear to have the same
vertical distance from peak to trough. In the second column, the two waves are similarly shown, but lack the lambda labels. The top
wave in this column has a greater vertical distance between the peaks and troughs and is labeled, “Higher amplitude.” The wave
beneath it has a lesser distance between the peaks and troughs and is labeled, “Lower amplitude.”
The product of a wave's wavelength (λ) and its frequency (ν), λν, is the speed of the wave. Thus, for electromagnetic radiation in a
vacuum:
8 −1
c = 2.998 × 10 ms = λν (6.1.1)
Wavelength and frequency are inversely proportional: As the wavelength increases, the frequency decreases. The inverse
proportionality is illustrated in Figure 6.1.2. This figure also shows the electromagnetic spectrum, the range of all types of
electromagnetic radiation. Each of the various colors of visible light has specific frequencies and wavelengths associated with
them, and you can see that visible light makes up only a small portion of the electromagnetic spectrum. Because the technologies
developed to work in various parts of the electromagnetic spectrum are different, for reasons of convenience and historical legacies,
different units are typically used for different parts of the spectrum. For example, radio waves are usually specified as frequencies
(typically in units of MHz), while the visible region is usually specified in wavelengths (typically in units of nm or angstroms).
A sodium streetlight gives off yellow light that has a wavelength of 589 nm (1 nm = 1 × 10−9 m). What is the frequency of this
light?
Solution
We can rearrange the Equation 6.1.1 to solve for the frequency:
c
ν =
λ
Since c is expressed in meters per second, we must also convert 589 nm to meters.
8 −1 9
2.998 × 10 m s 1 × 10 nm
14 −1
ν =( )( ) = 5.09 × 10 s
589 nm 1 m
Exercise 6.1.1
One of the frequencies used to transmit and receive cellular telephone signals in the United States is 850 MHz. What is the
wavelength in meters of these radio waves?
Answer
0.353 m = 35.3 cm
Other technologies also operate in the radio-wave portion of the electromagnetic spectrum. For example, 4G cellular telephone
signals are approximately 880 MHz, while Global Positioning System (GPS) signals operate at 1.228 and 1.575 GHz, local area
wireless technology (Wi-Fi) networks operate at 2.4 to 5 GHz, and highway toll sensors operate at 5.8 GHz. The frequencies
associated with these applications are convenient because such waves tend not to be absorbed much by common building materials.
Figure 6.1.4 : This schematic depicts how amplitude modulation (AM) and frequency modulation (FM) can be used to transmit a
radio wave.
One particularly characteristic phenomenon of waves results when two or more waves come into contact: They interfere with each
other. Figure 6.1.5 shows the interference patterns that arise when light passes through narrow slits closely spaced about a
wavelength apart. The fringe patterns produced depend on the wavelength, with the fringes being more closely spaced for shorter
wavelength light passing through a given set of slits. When the light passes through the two slits, each slit effectively acts as a new
source, resulting in two closely spaced waves coming into contact at the detector (the camera in this case). The dark regions in
Figure 6.1.5 correspond to regions where the peaks for the wave from one slit happen to coincide with the troughs for the wave
from the other slit (destructive interference), while the brightest regions correspond to the regions where the peaks for the two
waves (or their two troughs) happen to coincide (constructive interference). Likewise, when two stones are tossed close together
into a pond, interference patterns are visible in the interactions between the waves produced by the stones. Such interference
patterns cannot be explained by particles moving according to the laws of classical mechanics.
Dorothy Hodgkin
Because the wavelengths of X-rays (10-10,000 picometers [pm]) are comparable to the size of atoms, X-rays can be used to
determine the structure of molecules. When a beam of X-rays is passed through molecules packed together in a crystal, the X-
rays collide with the electrons and scatter. Constructive and destructive interference of these scattered X-rays creates a specific
diffraction pattern. Calculating backward from this pattern, the positions of each of the atoms in the molecule can be
determined very precisely. One of the pioneers who helped create this technology was Dorothy Crowfoot Hodgkin.
She was born in Cairo, Egypt, in 1910, where her British parents were studying archeology. Even as a young girl, she was
fascinated with minerals and crystals. When she was a student at Oxford University, she began researching how X-ray
crystallography could be used to determine the structure of biomolecules. She invented new techniques that allowed her and
her students to determine the structures of vitamin B12, penicillin, and many other important molecules. Diabetes, a disease that
affects 382 million people worldwide, involves the hormone insulin. Hodgkin began studying the structure of insulin in 1934,
but it required several decades of advances in the field before she finally reported the structure in 1969. Understanding the
structure has led to better understanding of the disease and treatment options.
Not all waves are travelling waves. Standing waves (also known as stationary waves) remain constrained within some region of
space. As we shall see, standing waves play an important role in our understanding of the electronic structure of atoms and
molecules. The simplest example of a standing wave is a one-dimensional wave associated with a vibrating string that is held fixed
at its two end points. Figure 6.1.6 shows the four lowest-energy standing waves (the fundamental wave and the lowest three
harmonics) for a vibrating string at a particular amplitude. Although the string's motion lies mostly within a plane, the wave itself is
considered to be one dimensional, since it lies along the length of the string. The motion of string segments in a direction
perpendicular to the string length generates the waves and so the amplitude of the waves is visible as the maximum displacement of
the curves seen in Figure 6.1.6. The key observation from the figure is that only those waves having an integer number, n, of half-
wavelengths between the end points can form. A system with fixed end points such as this restricts the number and type of the
possible waveforms. This is an example of quantization, in which only discrete values from a more general set of continuous values
of some property are observed. Another important observation is that the harmonic waves (those waves displaying more than one-
half wavelength) all have one or more points between the two end points that are not in motion. These special points are nodes. The
energies of the standing waves with a given amplitude in a vibrating string increase with the number of half-wavelengths n. Since
the number of nodes is n – 1, the energy can also be said to depend on the number of nodes, generally increasing as the number of
nodes increases.
Figure 6.1.6 : A vibrating string shows some one-dimensional standing waves. Since the two end points of the string are held fixed,
only waves having an integer number of half-wavelengths can form. The points on the string between the end points that are not
moving are called the nodes.
Figure 6.1.7 : Two-dimensional standing waves can be visualized on a vibrating surface. The surface has been sprinkled with a
powder that collects near the nodal lines. There are two types of nodes visible: radial nodes (circles) and angular nodes (radii).
For a more animated video, check this link out.
E = nhν, n = 1, 2, 3, . . .
The quantity h is a constant now known as Planck's constant, in his honor. Although Planck was pleased he had resolved the
blackbody radiation paradox, he was disturbed that to do so, he needed to assume the vibrating atoms required quantized energies,
Figure 6.1.9 : Blackbody spectral distribution curves are shown for some representative temperatures.
A graph is shown with a horizontal axis labeled, “Wavelength lambda (micrometers)” and a vertical axis labeled, “Intensity I (a r b.
units).” The horizontal axis begins at 0 and extends to 3.0 with markings provided every 0.1 micrometer. Similarly, the vertical axis
begins at 0 and extends to 10 with markings every 1 unit. Two vertical dashed lines are drawn. The first appears at about 0.39
micrometers and the second at about 0.72 micrometers. To the left of the first of these lines, the label, “Ultraviolet,” appears at the
top of the graph. Between these lines, the label, “Visible,” appears at the top of the graph. To the right of the second of these lines,
the label, “Infrared,” appears at the top of the graph. To the far right of the graph in open space a purple dot is placed which is
labeled, “lambda maximum.” A “Temperature” label is located in a central region of the graph. A blue curve begins on the
horizontal axis at about 0.05 micrometers. This curve increases steeply to a maximum value between the two vertical line segments
of approximately 9.5 at about 0.55 micrometers. This curve decreases rapidly at first, then tapers off to reach a value of about 1.5 at
the far right end of the graph. This blue curve is labeled 6000 K beneath the “Temperature” label. Curves are similarly drawn in
green for 5000 K, orange for 4000 K, and red for 3000 K. As the temperature decreases, the height of the peak is lower and shifted
right on the graph. The maximum value for the green curve is around 4.5 at 7.2 micrometers. This curve tapers at the right end of
the graph to a value around 0.6. The maximum for the orange curve is around 2 at about 0.9 micrometers. This curve tapers at the
right end of the graph to a value around 0.2. The maximum for the red curve is around 0.7 at about 1.2 micrometers. This curve
tapers at the right end of the graph to a value around 0.1. The entire region under the blue curve that is between the two dashed
lines, indicating the visible region, is shaded with vertical bands of color. The colors extending left to right across this region are
violet, indigo, blue, green, yellow, orange, and red. A purple dot is placed at the peak of each of the four colored curves. These
peaks are connected with a dashed curve.
Figure 6.1.10 : Photons with low frequencies do not have enough energy to cause electrons to be ejected via the photoelectric
effect. For any frequency of light above the threshold frequency, the kinetic energy of an ejected electron will increase linearly with
the energy of the incoming photon.
The figure includes three diagrams of waves approaching a flat, horizontal surface that is labeled, “Metal,” from an angle around
45 degrees above and to the left relative to the surface. At the top of the diagram at the center is the label, “E equals h nu.” At the
left, a sinusoidal wave reaches the surface and stops. The portion of the diagram near the flat metal surface is labeled, “No
electrons ejected,” and the wave is labeled, “700 n m.” To the right, a second similar, more compressed wave, which is labeled,
“550 n m,” reaches the flat surface. This time, an arrow extends up and to the right at an angle of approximately 45 degrees. A tiny
yellow circle with a negative sign in it is at the center of the arrow shaft. Above this arrow is the equation, “v subscript max equals
2.96 times 10 superscript 5 m per s.” To the far right, a third similar, even more compressed wave, which is labeled “400 n m”
reaches the flat surface. This time, an arrow extends up and to the right at an angle of approximately 45 degrees. A tiny yellow
circle with a negative sign in it is at the center of the arrow shaft. Above this arrow is the equation “v subscript max equals 6.22
times 10 superscript 5 m per s.”
When we see light from a neon sign, we are observing radiation from excited neon atoms. If this radiation has a wavelength of
640 nm, what is the energy of the photon being emitted?
Solution
We use the part of Planck's equation that includes the wavelength, λ, and convert units of nanometers to meters so that the units
of λ and c are the same.
hc
E =
λ
−34 8 −1
(6.626 × 10 J s )(2.998 × 10 m s )
=
1 m
(640 nm ) ( )
9
10 nm
−19
= 3.10 × 10 J
Exercise 6.1.2
The microwaves in an oven are of a specific frequency that will heat the water molecules contained in food. (This is why most
plastics and glass do not become hot in a microwave oven-they do not contain water molecules.) This frequency is about 3 ×
109 Hz. What is the energy of one photon in these microwaves?
Identify which of the following statements are false and, where necessary, change the italicized word or phrase to make them
true, consistent with Einstein's explanation of the photoelectric effect.
a. Increasing the brightness of incoming light increases the kinetic energy of the ejected electrons.
b. Increasing the wavelength of incoming light increases the kinetic energy of the ejected electrons.
c. Increasing the brightness of incoming light increases the number of ejected electrons.
d. Increasing the frequency of incoming light can increase the number of ejected electrons.
Solution
a. False. Increasing the brightness of incoming light has no effect on the kinetic energy of the ejected electrons. Only energy,
not the number or amplitude, of the photons influences the kinetic energy of the electrons.
b. False. Increasing the frequency of incoming light increases the kinetic energy of the ejected electrons. Frequency is
proportional to energy and inversely proportional to wavelength. Frequencies above the threshold value transfer the excess
energy into the kinetic energy of the electrons.
c. True. Because the number of collisions with photons increases with brighter light, the number of ejected electrons
increases.
d. True with regard to the threshold energy binding the electrons to the metal. Below this threshold, electrons are not emitted
and above it they are. Once over the threshold value, further increasing the frequency does not increase the number of
ejected electrons
Exercise 6.1.3
Calculate the threshold energy in kJ/mol of electrons in aluminum, given that the lowest frequency photon for which the
photoelectric effect is observed is 9.87 × 10 H z .
14
Answer
3.94 kJ/mol
Figure 6.1.12 : Line spectra of select gas. Compare the two types of emission spectra: continuous spectrum of white light (top) and
the line spectra of the light from excited sodium, hydrogen, calcium, and mercury atoms.
An image is shown with 5 rows. Across the top and bottom of the image is a scale that begins at 4000 angstroms at the left and
extends to 740 angstroms at the far right. The top row is a continuous band of the visible spectrum, showing the colors from violet
at the far left through indigo, blue, green, yellow, orange, and red at the far right. The second row, labeled, “N a,” shows the
emission spectrum for the element sodium, which includes two narrow vertical bands in the blue range, two narrow bands in the
yellow-green range, two narrow bands in the yellow range, and one narrow band in the orange range. The third row, labeled, “H,”
shows the emission spectrum for hydrogen. This spectrum shows single bands in the violet, indigo, blue, and orange regions. The
fourth row, labeled, “C a,” shows the emission spectrum for calcium. This spectrum shows bands in the following colors and
frequencies; one violet, five indigo, one blue, two green, two yellow-green, one yellow, two yellow-orange, one orange, and one
red. The fifth row, labeled, “H g,” shows the emission spectrum for mercury. This spectrum shows bands in the following colors
and frequencies; two violet, one indigo, two blue, one green, two yellow, two orange, and one orange-red. It is important to note
that each of the color bands for the emission spectra of the elements matches to a specific wavelength of light. Extending a vertical
line from the bands to the scale above or below the diagram will match the band to a specific measurement on the scale.
The origin of discrete spectra in atoms and molecules was extremely puzzling to scientists in the late nineteenth century, since
according to classical electromagnetic theory, only continuous spectra should be observed. Even more puzzling, in 1885, Johann
Other discrete lines for the hydrogen atom were found in the UV and IR regions. Johannes Rydberg generalized Balmer's work and
developed an empirical formula that predicted all of hydrogen's emission lines, not just those restricted to the visible range, where,
n1 and n2 are integers, n1 < n2, and R is the Rydberg constant (1.097 × 107 m−1).
∞
1 1 1
= R∞ ( − )
2 2
λ n n
1 2
Even in the late nineteenth century, spectroscopy was a very precise science, and so the wavelengths of hydrogen were measured to
very high accuracy, which implied that the Rydberg constant could be determined very precisely as well. That such a simple
formula as the Rydberg formula could account for such precise measurements seemed astounding at the time, but it was the
eventual explanation for emission spectra by Neils Bohr in 1913 that ultimately convinced scientists to abandon classical physics
and spurred the development of modern quantum mechanics.
Summary
Light and other forms of electromagnetic radiation move through a vacuum with a constant speed, c, of 2.998 × 108 m s−1. This
radiation shows wavelike behavior, which can be characterized by a frequency, ν, and a wavelength, λ, such that c = λν. Light is an
example of a travelling wave. Other important wave phenomena include standing waves, periodic oscillations, and vibrations.
Standing waves exhibit quantization, since their wavelengths are limited to discrete integer multiples of some characteristic lengths.
Electromagnetic radiation that passes through two closely spaced narrow slits having dimensions roughly similar to the wavelength
will show an interference pattern that is a result of constructive and destructive interference of the waves. Electromagnetic radiation
also demonstrates properties of particles called photons. The energy of a photon is related to the frequency (or alternatively, the
hc
wavelength) of the radiation as E = hν (or E = ), where h is Planck's constant. That light demonstrates both wavelike and
λ
particle-like behavior is known as wave-particle duality. All forms of electromagnetic radiation share these properties, although
various forms including X-rays, visible light, microwaves, and radio waves interact differently with matter and have very different
practical applications. Electromagnetic radiation can be generated by exciting matter to higher energies, such as by heating it. The
emitted light can be either continuous (incandescent sources like the sun) or discrete (from specific types of excited atoms).
Continuous spectra often have distributions that can be approximated as blackbody radiation at some appropriate temperature. The
line spectrum of hydrogen can be obtained by passing the light from an electrified tube of hydrogen gas through a prism. This line
spectrum was simple enough that an empirical formula called the Rydberg formula could be derived from the spectrum. Three
historically important paradoxes from the late 19th and early 20th centuries that could not be explained within the existing
framework of classical mechanics and classical electromagnetism were the blackbody problem, the photoelectric effect, and the
discrete spectra of atoms. The resolution of these paradoxes ultimately led to quantum theories that superseded the classical
theories.
1 1 1
= R∞ ( − )
2 2
λ n n
1 2
Glossary
amplitude
extent of the displacement caused by a wave (for sinusoidal waves, it is one-half the difference from the peak height to the
trough depth, and the intensity is proportional to the square of the amplitude)
blackbody
continuous spectrum
electromagnetic radiation given off in an unbroken series of wavelengths (e.g., white light from the sun)
electromagnetic radiation
energy transmitted by waves that have an electric-field component and a magnetic-field component
electromagnetic spectrum
range of energies that electromagnetic radiation can comprise, including radio, microwaves, infrared, visible, ultraviolet, X-
rays, and gamma rays; since electromagnetic radiation energy is proportional to the frequency and inversely proportional to the
wavelength, the spectrum can also be specified by ranges of frequencies or wavelengths
frequency (ν )
number of wave cycles (peaks or troughs) that pass a specified point in space per unit time
hertz (Hz)
the unit of frequency, which is the number of cycles per second, s−1
intensity
property of wave-propagated energy related to the amplitude of the wave, such as brightness of light or loudness of sound
interference pattern
pattern typically consisting of alternating bright and dark fringes; it results from constructive and destructive interference of
waves
line spectrum
electromagnetic radiation emitted at discrete wavelengths by a specific atom (or atoms) in an excited state
node
any point of a standing wave with zero amplitude
photon
smallest possible packet of electromagnetic radiation, a particle of light
quantization
occurring only in specific discrete values, not continuous
standing wave
(also, stationary wave) localized wave phenomenon characterized by discrete wavelengths determined by the boundary
conditions used to generate the waves; standing waves are inherently quantized
wave
oscillation that can transport energy from one point to another in space
wavelength (λ)
distance between two consecutive peaks or troughs in a wave
wave-particle duality
term used to describe the fact that elementary particles including matter exhibit properties of both particles (including localized
position, momentum) and waves (including nonlocalization, wavelength, frequency)
This page titled 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Following the work of Ernest Rutherford and his colleagues in the early twentieth century, the picture of atoms consisting of tiny
dense nuclei surrounded by lighter and even tinier electrons continually moving about the nucleus was well established. This
picture was called the planetary model, since it pictured the atom as a miniature “solar system” with the electrons orbiting the
nucleus like planets orbiting the sun. The simplest atom is hydrogen, consisting of a single proton as the nucleus about which a
single electron moves. The electrostatic force attracting the electron to the proton depends only on the distance between the two
particles.
m1 m2
Fgravity = G
2
r
with
G is a gravitational constant
m1 and m are the masses of particle 1 and 2, respectively
2
The electrostatic force has the same form as the gravitational force between two mass particles except that the electrostatic force
depends on the magnitudes of the charges on the particles (+1 for the proton and −1 for the electron) instead of the magnitudes of
the particle masses that govern the gravitational force.
m1 m2
Felectrostatic = k
2
r
with
k is a constant
m1 and m are the masses of particle 1 and 2, respectively
2
Since forces can be derived from potentials, it is convenient to work with potentials instead, since they are forms of energy. The
electrostatic potential is also called the Coulomb potential. Because the electrostatic potential has the same form as the gravitational
potential, according to classical mechanics, the equations of motion should be similar, with the electron moving around the nucleus
in circular or elliptical orbits (hence the label “planetary” model of the atom). Potentials of the form V(r) that depend only on the
radial distance r are known as central potentials. Central potentials have spherical symmetry, and so rather than specifying the
position of the electron in the usual Cartesian coordinates (x, y, z), it is more convenient to use polar spherical coordinates centered
at the nucleus, consisting of a linear coordinate r and two angular coordinates, usually specified by the Greek letters theta (θ) and
phi (Φ). These coordinates are similar to the ones used in GPS devices and most smart phones that track positions on our (nearly)
spherical earth, with the two angular coordinates specified by the latitude and longitude, and the linear coordinate specified by sea-
level elevation. Because of the spherical symmetry of central potentials, the energy and angular momentum of the classical
hydrogen atom are constants, and the orbits are constrained to lie in a plane like the planets orbiting the sun. This classical
mechanics description of the atom is incomplete, however, since an electron moving in an elliptical orbit would be accelerating (by
changing direction) and, according to classical electromagnetism, it should continuously emit electromagnetic radiation. This loss
in orbital energy should result in the electron’s orbit getting continually smaller until it spirals into the nucleus, implying that atoms
are inherently unstable.
In 1913, Niels Bohr attempted to resolve the atomic paradox by ignoring classical electromagnetism’s prediction that the orbiting
electron in hydrogen would continuously emit light. Instead, he incorporated into the classical mechanics description of the atom
Planck’s ideas of quantization and Einstein’s finding that light consists of photons whose energy is proportional to their frequency.
Bohr assumed that the electron orbiting the nucleus would not normally emit any radiation (the stationary state hypothesis), but it
would emit or absorb a photon if it moved to a different orbit. The energy absorbed or emitted would reflect differences in the
orbital energies according to this equation:
In this equation, h is Planck’s constant and Ei and Ef are the initial and final orbital energies, respectively. The absolute value of the
energy difference is used, since frequencies and wavelengths are always positive. Instead of allowing for continuous values for the
angular momentum, energy, and orbit radius, Bohr assumed that only discrete values for these could occur (actually, quantizing any
one of these would imply that the other two are also quantized). Bohr’s expression for the quantized energies is:
k
En = − (6.2.2)
2
n
with n = 1, 2, 3, . . .
In this expression, k is a constant comprising fundamental constants such as the electron mass and charge and Planck’s constant.
Inserting the expression for the orbit energies into the equation for ΔE gives
1 1 hc
ΔE = k ( − ) = (6.2.3)
2 2
n n λ
1 2
or
1 k 1 1
= ( − ) (6.2.4)
2 2
λ hc n n
1 2
The lowest few energy levels are shown in Figure 6.2.1. One of the fundamental laws of physics is that matter is most stable with
the lowest possible energy. Thus, the electron in a hydrogen atom usually moves in the n = 1 orbit, the orbit in which it has the
lowest energy. When the electron is in this lowest energy orbit, the atom is said to be in its ground electronic state (or simply
ground state). If the atom receives energy from an outside source, it is possible for the electron to move to an orbit with a higher n
value and the atom is now in an excited electronic state (or simply an excited state) with a higher energy. When an electron
transitions from an excited state (higher energy orbit) to a less excited state, or ground state, the difference in energy is emitted as a
photon. Similarly, if a photon is absorbed by an atom, the energy of the photon moves an electron from a lower energy orbit up to a
more excited one.
Figure 6.2.1 : Quantum numbers and energy levels in a hydrogen atom. The more negative the calculated value, the lower the
energy.
We can relate the energy of electrons in atoms to what we learned previously about energy. The law of conservation of energy says
that we can neither create nor destroy energy. Thus, if a certain amount of external energy is required to excite an electron from one
energy level to another, that same amount of energy will be liberated when the electron returns to its initial state (Figure 6.2.2). In
effect, an atom can “store” energy by using it to promote an electron to a state with a higher energy and release it when the electron
returns to a lower state. The energy can be released as one quantum of energy, as the electron returns to its ground state (say, from
Figure 6.2.2 : The horizontal lines show the relative energy of orbits in the Bohr model of the hydrogen atom, and the vertical
arrows depict the energy of photons absorbed (left) or emitted (right) as electrons move between these orbits.
The figure includes a diagram representing the relative energy levels of the quantum numbers of the hydrogen atom. An upward
pointing arrow at the left of the diagram is labeled, “E.” A grey shaded vertically oriented rectangle is placed just right of the arrow.
The rectangle height matches the arrow length. Colored, horizontal line segments are placed inside the rectangle and labels are
placed to the right of the box, arranged in a column with the heading, “Energy, n.” At the very base of the rectangle, a purple
horizontal line segment is drawn. A black line extends to the right to the label, “1.” At a level approximately three-quarters of the
distance to the top of the rectangle, a blue horizontal line segment is drawn. A black line extends to the right to the label, “2.” At a
level approximately seven-eighths the distance from the base of the rectangle, a green horizontal line segment is drawn. A black
line extends to the right to the label, “3.” Just a short distance above this segment, an orange horizontal line segment is drawn. A
black line segment extends to the right to the label, “4.” Just above this segment, a red horizontal line segment is drawn. A black
line extends to the right to the label, “5.” Just a short distance above this segment, a brown horizontal line segment is drawn. A
black line extends to the right to the label, “infinity.” Arrows are drawn to depict energies of photons absorbed, as shown by
upward pointing arrows on the left, or released as shown by downward pointing arrows on the right side of the diagram between
the colored line segments. The label, “Electron moves to higher energy as light is absorbed,” is placed beneath the upward pointing
arrows. Similarly, the label, “Electron moves to lower energy as light is emitted,” appears beneath the downward pointing arrows.
Moving left to right across the diagram, arrows extend from one colored line segment to the next in the following order: purple to
blue, purple to green, purple to orange, purple to red, purple to brown, blue to green, blue to orange, and blue to red. The arrows
originating from the same colored segment are grouped together by close placement of the arrows. Similarly, the downward arrows
follow in this sequence; brown to purple, red to purple, orange to purple, green to purple, blue to purple, red to blue, orange to blue,
and green to blue. Arrows are again grouped by close placement according to the color at which the arrows end.
Since Bohr’s model involved only a single electron, it could also be applied to the single electron ions He+, Li2+, Be3+, and so
forth, which differ from hydrogen only in their nuclear charges, and so one-electron atoms and ions are collectively referred to as
hydrogen-like or hydrogenic atoms. The energy expression for hydrogen-like atoms is a generalization of the hydrogen atom
energy, in which Z is the nuclear charge (+1 for hydrogen, +2 for He, +3 for Li, and so on) and k has a value of 2.179 × 10 J . –18
2
kZ
En = − (6.2.5)
2
n
The sizes of the circular orbits for hydrogen-like atoms are given in terms of their radii by the following expression, in which a is o
2
n
r = a0 (6.2.6)
Z
The equation also shows us that as the electron’s energy increases (as n increases), the electron is found at greater distances from
the nucleus. This is implied by the inverse dependence on r in the Coulomb potential, since, as the electron moves away from the
nucleus, the electrostatic attraction between it and the nucleus decreases, and it is held less tightly in the atom. Note that as n gets
larger and the orbits get larger, their energies get closer to zero, and so the limits n ⟶ ∞ and r ⟶ ∞ imply that E = 0
With three extremely puzzling paradoxes now solved (blackbody radiation, the photoelectric effect, and the hydrogen atom), and all
involving Planck’s constant in a fundamental manner, it became clear to most physicists at that time that the classical theories that
worked so well in the macroscopic world were fundamentally flawed and could not be extended down into the microscopic domain
of atoms and molecules. Unfortunately, despite Bohr’s remarkable achievement in deriving a theoretical expression for the Rydberg
constant, he was unable to extend his theory to the next simplest atom, He, which only has two electrons. Bohr’s model was
severely flawed, since it was still based on the classical mechanics notion of precise orbits, a concept that was later found to be
untenable in the microscopic domain, when a proper model of quantum mechanics was developed to supersede classical
mechanics.
Early researchers were very excited when they were able to predict the energy of an electron at a particular distance from the
nucleus in a hydrogen atom. If a spark promotes the electron in a hydrogen atom into an orbit with n = 3 , what is the
calculated energy, in joules, of the electron?
Solution
The energy of the electron is given by Equation 6.2.5:
2
−kZ
E =
2
n
Exercise 6.2.1
The electron in Example 6.2.1 in the n = 3 state is promoted even further to an orbit with n = 6 . What is its new energy?
Answer
TBD
What is the energy (in joules) and the wavelength (in meters) of the line in the spectrum of hydrogen that represents the
movement of an electron from Bohr orbit with n = 4 to the orbit with n = 6? In what part of the electromagnetic spectrum do
we find this radiation?
Solution
In this case, the electron starts out with n = 4 , so n = 4 . It comes to rest in the
1 n =6 orbit, so n2 = 6 . The difference in
energy between the two states is given by this expression:
1 1
−18
ΔE = E1 − E2 = 2.179 × 10 ( − )
2 2
n n
1 2
1 1
−18
ΔE = 2.179 × 10 ( − ) J
2 2
4 6
−20
ΔE = 7.566 × 10 J
This energy difference is positive, indicating a photon enters the system (is absorbed) to excite the electron from the n = 4 orbit
up to the n = 6 orbit. The wavelength of a photon with this energy is found by the expression E = hcλ . Rearrangement gives:
hc
λ =
E
From the figure of electromagnetic radiation, we can see that this wavelength is found in the infrared portion of the
electromagnetic spectrum.
Exercise 6.2.2
What is the energy in joules and the wavelength in meters of the photon produced when an electron falls from the n = 5 to the
n = 3 level in a H e ion (Z = 2 for H e )?
+ +
Answer
6.198 × 10
–19
J and 3.205 × 10−7
m
Bohr’s model of the hydrogen atom provides insight into the behavior of matter at the microscopic level, but it is does not account
for electron–electron interactions in atoms with more than one electron. It does introduce several important features of all models
used to describe the distribution of electrons in an atom. These features include the following:
The energies of electrons (energy levels) in an atom are quantized, described by quantum numbers: integer numbers having only
specific allowed value and used to characterize the arrangement of electrons in an atom.
An electron’s energy increases with increasing distance from the nucleus.
The discrete energies (lines) in the spectra of the elements result from quantized electronic energies.
Of these features, the most important is the postulate of quantized energy levels for an electron in an atom. As a consequence, the
model laid the foundation for the quantum mechanical model of the atom. Bohr won a Nobel Prize in Physics for his contributions
to our understanding of the structure of atoms and how that is related to line spectra emissions.
Summary
Bohr incorporated Planck’s and Einstein’s quantization ideas into a model of the hydrogen atom that resolved the paradox of atom
stability and discrete spectra. The Bohr model of the hydrogen atom explains the connection between the quantization of photons
and the quantized emission from atoms. Bohr described the hydrogen atom in terms of an electron moving in a circular orbit about
a nucleus. He postulated that the electron was restricted to certain orbits characterized by discrete energies. Transitions between
these allowed orbits result in the absorption or emission of photons. When an electron moves from a higher-energy orbit to a more
stable one, energy is emitted in the form of a photon. To move an electron from a stable orbit to a more excited one, a photon of
energy must be absorbed. Using the Bohr model, we can calculate the energy of an electron and the radius of its orbit in any one-
electron system.
Glossary
Bohr’s model of the hydrogen atom
structural model in which an electron moves around the nucleus only in circular orbits, each with a specific allowed radius; the
orbiting electron does not normally emit electromagnetic radiation, but does so when changing from one orbit to another.
excited state
state having an energy greater than the ground-state energy
quantum number
integer number having only specific allowed values and used to characterize the arrangement of electrons in an atom
This page titled 6.2: The Bohr Model is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Bohr’s model explained the experimental data for the hydrogen atom and was widely accepted, but it also raised many questions.
Why did electrons orbit at only fixed distances defined by a single quantum number n = 1, 2, 3, and so on, but never in between?
Why did the model work so well describing hydrogen and one-electron ions, but could not correctly predict the emission spectrum
for helium or any larger atoms? To answer these questions, scientists needed to completely revise the way they thought about
matter.
Figure 6.3.1 : An interference pattern on the water surface is formed by interacting waves. The waves are caused by reflection of
water from the rocks. (credit: modification of work by Sukanto Debnath)
A photograph is shown of ripples in water. The ripples display an interference pattern with each other.
As technological improvements allowed scientists to probe the microscopic world in greater detail, it became increasingly clear by
the 1920s that very small pieces of matter follow a different set of rules from those we observe for large objects. The
unquestionable separation of waves and particles was no longer the case for the microscopic world.
One of the first people to pay attention to the special behavior of the microscopic world was Louis de Broglie. He asked the
question: If electromagnetic radiation can have particle-like character, can electrons and other submicroscopic particles exhibit
wavelike character? In his 1925 doctoral dissertation, de Broglie extended the wave–particle duality of light that Einstein used to
resolve the photoelectric-effect paradox to material particles. He predicted that a particle with mass m and velocity v (that is, with
linear momentum p) should also exhibit the behavior of a wave with a wavelength value λ, given by this expression in which h is
the familiar Planck’s constant
h h
λ = = (6.3.1)
mv p
Figure 6.3.1 : If an electron is viewed as a wave circling around the nucleus, an integer number of wavelengths must fit into the
orbit for this standing wave behavior to be possible.
This figure includes a circle formed from a dashed line. A sinusoidal wave pattern indicated with a solid red line is wrapped around
the circle, centered about the edge of the circle. Line segments extend outward from the circle extending through 2 wave crests
along the circle. A double ended arrow is drawn between these segments and is labeled, “wavelength, lambda.” A dashed double
headed arrow is drawn from the center to the edge of the circle and is labeled, “radius r.”
For a circular orbit of radius r, the circumference is 2πr, and so de Broglie’s condition is:
2πr = nλ (6.3.2)
with n = 1, 2, 3, . . .
Since the de Broglie expression relates the wavelength to the momentum and, hence, velocity, this implies:
nh nh nhr nhr
2πr = nλ = = = = (6.3.3)
p mv mvr L
This expression can be rearranged to give Bohr’s formula for the quantization of the angular momentum:
nh
L = = nℏ (6.3.4)
2π
Classical angular momentum L for a circular motion is equal to the product of the radius of the circle and the momentum of the
moving particle p.
L = rp = rmv (for a circular motion) (6.3.5)
Figure 6.3.3 : The diagram shows angular momentum for a circular motion.
Shortly after de Broglie proposed the wave nature of matter, two scientists at Bell Laboratories, C. J. Davisson and L. H. Germer,
demonstrated experimentally that electrons can exhibit wavelike behavior by showing an interference pattern for electrons
travelling through a regular atomic pattern in a crystal. The regularly spaced atomic layers served as slits, as used in other
interference experiments. Since the spacing between the layers serving as slits needs to be similar in size to the wavelength of the
tested wave for an interference pattern to form, Davisson and Germer used a crystalline nickel target for their “slits,” since the
spacing of the atoms within the lattice was approximately the same as the de Broglie wavelengths of the electrons that they used.
Figure 6.3.4 shows an interference pattern.
The wave–particle duality of matter can be seen by observing what happens if electron collisions are recorded over a long period of
time. Initially, when only a few electrons have been recorded, they show clear particle-like behavior, having arrived in small
localized packets that appear to be random. As more and more electrons arrived and were recorded, a clear interference pattern that
is the hallmark of wavelike behavior emerged. Thus, it appears that while electrons are small localized particles, their motion does
not follow the equations of motion implied by classical mechanics, but instead it is governed by some type of a wave equation that
governs a probability distribution even for a single electron’s motion. Thus the wave–particle duality first observed with photons is
actually a fundamental behavior intrinsic to all quantum particles.
Video 6.3.1 : View the Dr. Quantum – Double Slit Experiment cartoon for an easy-to-understand description of wave–particle
duality and the associated experiments.
If an electron travels at a velocity of 1.000 × 107 m s–1 and has a mass of 9.109 × 10–28 g, what is its wavelength?
Solution
−34 2
6.626 × 10 kg m /s
=
−31 7
(9.109 × 10 kg)(1.000 × 10 m/s)
−11
= 7.274 × 10 m
This is a small value, but it is significantly larger than the size of an electron in the classical (particle) view. This size is the
same order of magnitude as the size of an atom. This means that electron wavelike behavior is going to be noticeable in an
atom.
Exercise 6.3.1
Calculate the wavelength of a softball with a mass of 100 g traveling at a velocity of 35 m s–1, assuming that it can be modeled
as a single particle.
Answer
1.9 × 10–34 m.
We never think of a thrown softball having a wavelength, since this wavelength is so small it is impossible for our senses or any
known instrument to detect (strictly speaking, the wavelength of a real baseball would correspond to the wavelengths of its
constituent atoms and molecules, which, while much larger than this value, would still be microscopically tiny). The de Broglie
wavelength is only appreciable for matter that has a very small mass and/or a very high velocity.
Werner Heisenberg considered the limits of how accurately we can measure properties of an electron or other microscopic particles.
He determined that there is a fundamental limit to how accurately one can measure both a particle’s position and its momentum
simultaneously. The more accurately we measure the momentum of a particle, the less accurately we can determine its position at
that time, and vice versa. This is summed up in what we now call the Heisenberg uncertainty principle: It is fundamentally
impossible to determine simultaneously and exactly both the momentum and the position of a particle. For a particle of mass m
moving with velocity vx in the x direction (or equivalently with momentum px), the product of the uncertainty in the position, Δx,
ℏ h
and the uncertainty in the momentum, Δpx , must be greater than or equal to (recall that ℏ = , the value of Planck’s constant
2 2π
divided by 2π).
ℏ
Δx × Δpx = (Δx)(mΔv) ≥
2
This equation allows us to calculate the limit to how precisely we can know both the simultaneous position of an object and its
momentum. For example, if we improve our measurement of an electron’s position so that the uncertainty in the position (Δx) has a
value of, say, 1 pm (10–12 m, about 1% of the diameter of a hydrogen atom), then our determination of its momentum must have an
uncertainty with a value of at least
−34 2
h (1.055 × 10 kg m /s)
−23
[Δp = mΔv = ] = = 5 × 10 kg m/s.
−12
(2Δx) (2 × 1 × 10 m)
The value of ħ is not large, so the uncertainty in the position or momentum of a macroscopic object like a baseball is too
insignificant to observe. However, the mass of a microscopic object such as an electron is small enough that the uncertainty can be
large and significant.
It should be noted that Heisenberg’s uncertainty principle is not just limited to uncertainties in position and momentum, but it also
links other dynamical variables. For example, when an atom absorbs a photon and makes a transition from one energy state to
ℏ
another, the uncertainty in the energy and the uncertainty in the time required for the transition are similarly related, as ΔE Δt ≥ .
2
As will be discussed later, even the vector components of angular momentum cannot all be specified exactly simultaneously.
location in space. This means that wavefunctions can be used to determine the distribution of the electron’s density with respect to
the nucleus in an atom. In the most general form, the Schrödinger equation can be written as:
^
H ψ = Eψ
^
H is the Hamiltonian operator, a set of mathematical operations representing the total energy of the quantum particle (such as an
electron in an atom), ψ is the wavefunction of this particle that can be used to find the special distribution of the probability of
finding the particle, and E is the actual value of the total energy of the particle.
Schrödinger’s work, as well as that of Heisenberg and many other scientists following in their footsteps, is generally referred to as
quantum mechanics.
Schrödinger's Cat
Video 6.3.2 : You may also have heard of Schrödinger because of his famous thought experiment. This story explains the concepts
of superposition and entanglement as related to a cat in a box with poison (Schrödinger's Cat [www.youtube.com]).
1 1
−18
= −2.18 × 10 ( − ) J
2 2
n n
f i
The values nf and ni are the final and initial energy states of the electron.
The principal quantum number is one of three quantum numbers used to characterize an orbital. An atomic orbital, which is distinct
from an orbit, is a general region in an atom within which an electron is most probable to reside. The quantum mechanical model
specifies the probability of finding an electron in the three-dimensional space around the nucleus and is based on solutions of the
Schrödinger equation. In addition, the principal quantum number defines the energy of an electron in a hydrogen or hydrogen-like
atom or an ion (an atom or an ion with only one electron) and the general region in which discrete energy levels of electrons in a
multi-electron atoms and ions are located.
Another quantum number is l, the angular momentum quantum number. It is an integer that defines the shape of the orbital, and
takes on the values, l = 0, 1, 2, …, n – 1. This means that an orbital with n = 1 can have only one value of l, l = 0, whereas n = 2
permits l = 0 and l = 1, and so on. The principal quantum number defines the general size and energy of the orbital. The l value
specifies the shape of the orbital. Orbitals with the same value of l form a subshell. In addition, the greater the angular momentum
quantum number, the greater is the angular momentum of an electron at this orbital.
Figure 6.3.6 : The graphs show the probability (y axis) of finding an electron for the 1s, 2s, 3s orbitals as a function of distance
from the nucleus.
Consider the examples in Figure 6.3.7. The orbitals depicted are of the s type, thus l = 0 for all of them. It can be seen from the
graphs of the probability densities that there are 1 – 0 – 1 = 0 places where the density is zero (nodes) for 1s (n = 1), 2 – 0 – 1 = 1
node for 2s, and 3 – 0 – 1 = 2 nodes for the 3s orbitals.
The s subshell electron density distribution is spherical and the p subshell has a dumbbell shape. The d and f orbitals are more
complex. These shapes represent the three-dimensional regions within which the electron is likely to be found.
If an electron has an angular momentum (l ≠ 0), then this vector can point in different directions. In addition, the z component of
the angular momentum can have more than one value. This means that if a magnetic field is applied in the z direction, orbitals with
different values of the z component of the angular momentum will have different energies resulting from interacting with the field.
The magnetic quantum number, called ml, specifies the z component of the angular momentum for a particular orbital. For
example, for an s orbital, l = 0, and the only value of ml is zero. For p orbitals, l = 1, and ml can be equal to –1, 0, or +1. Generally
speaking, ml can be equal to –l, –(l – 1), …, –1, 0, +1, …, (l – 1), l. The total number of possible orbitals with the same value of l (a
subshell) is 2l + 1. Thus, there is one s-orbital for ml = 0, there are three p-orbitals for ml = 1, five d-orbitals for ml = 2, seven f-
orbitals for ml = 3, and so forth. The principal quantum number defines the general value of the electronic energy. The angular
momentum quantum number determines the shape of the orbital. And the magnetic quantum number specifies orientation of the
orbital in space, as can be seen in Figure 6.3.7.
Figure 6.3.9 : Electrons with spin values \(±\ce{1/2}\) in an external magnetic field.
2
2
has a lower energy if its magnetic moment is aligned with the external magnetic field (the left electron) and a higher energy for the
1
magnetic moment being opposite to the applied field. This is why an electron with ms = has a slightly lower energy in an
2
1
external field in the positive z direction, and an electron with m s =− has a slightly higher energy in the same field. This is true
2
even for an electron occupying the same orbital in an atom. A spectral line corresponding to a transition for electrons from the
same orbital but with different spin quantum numbers has two possible values of energy; thus, the line in the spectrum will show a
fine structure splitting.
same orbital, they must have opposite spins). Therefore, any atomic orbital can be populated by only zero, one, or two electrons.
The properties and meaning of the quantum numbers of electrons in atoms are briefly summarized in Table 6.3.1.
Table 6.3.1 : Quantum Numbers, Their Properties, and Significance
Name Symbol Allowed values Physical meaning
Indicate the number of subshells, the number of orbitals in each subshell, and the values of l and ml for the orbitals in the n = 4
shell of an atom.
Solution
For n = 4, l can have values of 0, 1, 2, and 3. Thus, s, p, d, and f subshells are found in the n = 4 shell of an atom. For l = 0 (the
s subshell), ml can only be 0. Thus, there is only one 4s orbital. For l = 1 (p-type orbitals), m can have values of –1, 0, +1, so
we find three 4p orbitals. For l = 2 (d-type orbitals), ml can have values of –2, –1, 0, +1, +2, so we have five 4d orbitals. When
l = 3 (f-type orbitals), ml can have values of –3, –2, –1, 0, +1, +2, +3, and we can have seven 4f orbitals. Thus, we find a total
of 16 orbitals in the n = 4 shell of an atom.
Identify the subshell in which electrons with the following quantum numbers are found:
a. n = 3, l = 1;
b. n = 5, l = 3;
c. n = 2, l = 0.
Answer a
3p
Answer b
5f
Answer c
2s
Calculate the maximum number of electrons that can occupy a shell with (a) n = 2, (b) n = 5, and (c) n as a variable. Note you
are only looking at the orbitals with the specified n value, not those at lower energies.
Solution
(a) When n = 2, there are four orbitals (a single 2s orbital, and three orbitals labeled 2p). These four orbitals can contain eight
electrons.
(b) When n = 5, there are five subshells of orbitals that we need to sum:
1 orbital labeled 5s
3 orbitals labeled 5p
5 orbitals labeled 5d
7 orbitals labeled 5f
+9 orbitals labeled 5g
–––––––––––––––––––––
25 orbitals total
Again, each orbital holds two electrons, so 50 electrons can fit in this shell.
(c) The number of orbitals in any shell n will equal n2. There can be up to two electrons in each orbital, so the maximum number of
electrons will be 2 × n2
Exercise 6.3.3
Answer
n=4
4f
4 1
7 7 3
5d
Solution
The table can be completed using the following rules:
The orbital designation is nl, where l = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, … is mapped to the letter sequence s, p, d, f, g, h, …,
The ml degeneracy is the number of orbitals within an l subshell, and so is 2l + 1 (there is one s orbital, three p orbitals, five
d orbitals, seven f orbitals, and so forth).
The number of radial nodes is equal to n – l – 1.
Solution to Example 6.3.4
Orbital n l ml degeneracy Radial nodes (no.)
4f 4 3 7 0
4p 4 1 3 2
7f 7 3 7 3
5d 5 2 5 2
Exercise 6.3.4
Answer
The five degenerate 3d orbitals
Summary
Macroscopic objects act as particles. Microscopic objects (such as electrons) have properties of both a particle and a wave. Their
exact trajectories cannot be determined. The quantum mechanical model of atoms describes the three-dimensional position of the
electron in a probabilistic manner according to a mathematical function called a wavefunction, often denoted as ψ. Atomic
wavefunctions are also called orbitals. The squared magnitude of the wavefunction describes the distribution of the probability of
finding the electron in a particular region in space. Therefore, atomic orbitals describe the areas in an atom where electrons are
most likely to be found.
An atomic orbital is characterized by three quantum numbers. The principal quantum number, n, can be any positive integer. The
general region for value of energy of the orbital and the average distance of an electron from the nucleus are related to n. Orbitals
having the same value of n are said to be in the same shell. The angular momentum quantum number, l, can have any integer value
from 0 to n – 1. This quantum number describes the shape or type of the orbital. Orbitals with the same principal quantum number
and the same l value belong to the same subshell. The magnetic quantum number, ml, with 2l + 1 values ranging from –l to +l,
1
describes the orientation of the orbital in space. In addition, each electron has a spin quantum number, ms, that can be equal to ± .
2
No two electrons in the same atom can have the same set of values for all the four quantum numbers.
Glossary
angular momentum quantum number (l)
quantum number distinguishing the different shapes of orbitals; it is also a measure of the orbital angular momentum
d orbital
region of space with high electron density that is either four lobed or contains a dumbbell and torus shape; describes orbitals
with l = 2. An electron in this orbital is called a d electron
electron density
a measure of the probability of locating an electron in a particular region of space, it is equal to the squared absolute value of
the wave function ψ
f orbital
multilobed region of space with high electron density, describes orbitals with l = 3. An electron in this orbital is called an f
electron
p orbital
dumbbell-shaped region of space with high electron density, describes orbitals with l = 1. An electron in this orbital is called a p
electron
quantum mechanics
field of study that includes quantization of energy, wave-particle duality, and the Heisenberg uncertainty principle to describe
matter
s orbital
spherical region of space with high electron density, describes orbitals with l = 0. An electron in this orbital is called an s
electron
shell
set of orbitals with the same principal quantum number, n
subshell
set of orbitals in an atom with the same values of n and l
wavefunction (ψ)
This page titled 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Having introduced the basics of atomic structure and quantum mechanics, we can use our understanding of quantum numbers to
determine how atomic orbitals relate to one another. This allows us to determine which orbitals are occupied by electrons in each
atom. The specific arrangement of electrons in orbitals of an atom determines many of the chemical properties of that atom.
Figure 6.4.1 : Generalized energy-level diagram for atomic orbitals in an atom with two or more electrons (not to scale).
Electrons in successive atoms on the periodic table tend to fill low-energy orbitals first. Thus, many students find it confusing that,
for example, the 5p orbitals fill immediately after the 4d, and immediately before the 6s. The filling order is based on observed
experimental results, and has been confirmed by theoretical calculations. As the principal quantum number, n, increases, the size of
the orbital increases and the electrons spend more time farther from the nucleus. Thus, the attraction to the nucleus is weaker and
the energy associated with the orbital is higher (less stabilized). But this is not the only effect we have to take into account. Within
each shell, as the value of l increases, the electrons are less penetrating (meaning there is less electron density found close to the
nucleus), in the order s > p > d > f. Electrons that are closer to the nucleus slightly repel electrons that are farther out, offsetting the
more dominant electron–nucleus attractions slightly (recall that all electrons have −1 charges, but nuclei have +Z charges). This
phenomenon is called shielding and will be discussed in more detail in the next section. Electrons in orbitals that experience more
shielding are less stabilized and thus higher in energy. For small orbitals (1s through 3p), the increase in energy due to n is more
significant than the increase due to l; however, for larger orbitals the two trends are comparable and cannot be simply predicted. We
will discuss methods for remembering the observed order.
The arrangement of electrons in the orbitals of an atom is called the electron configuration of the atom. We describe an electron
configuration with a symbol that contains three pieces of information ( Figure 6.4.2):
1. The number of the principal quantum shell, n,
Figure 6.4.2 : The diagram of an electron configuration specifies the subshell (n and l value, with letter symbol) and superscript
number of electrons.
Figure 6.4.3 : The arrow leads through each subshell in the appropriate filling order for electron configurations. This chart is
straightforward to construct. Simply make a column for all the s orbitals with each n shell on a separate row. Repeat for p, d, and f.
Be sure to only include orbitals allowed by the quantum numbers (no 1p or 2d, and so forth). Finally, draw diagonal lines from top
to bottom as shown.
Since the arrangement of the periodic table is based on the electron configurations, Figure 6.4.4 provides an alternative method for
determining the electron configuration. The filling order simply begins at hydrogen and includes each subshell as you proceed in
increasing Z order. For example, after filling the 3p block up to Ar, we see the orbital will be 4s (K, Ca), followed by the 3d
orbitals.
We will now construct the ground-state electron configuration and orbital diagram for a selection of atoms in the first and second
periods of the periodic table. Orbital diagrams are pictorial representations of the electron configuration, showing the individual
orbitals and the pairing arrangement of electrons. We start with a single hydrogen atom (atomic number 1), which consists of one
proton and one electron. Referring to either Figure 6.4.3 or 6.4.4, we would expect to find the electron in the 1s orbital. By
1
convention, the m s =+ value is usually filled first. The electron configuration and the orbital diagram are:
2
Following hydrogen is the noble gas helium, which has an atomic number of 2. The helium atom contains two protons and two
1
electrons. The first electron has the same four quantum numbers as the hydrogen atom electron (n = 1, l = 0, ml = 0, ms = + ).
2
The second electron also goes into the 1s orbital and fills that orbital. The second electron has the same n, l, and ml quantum
1
numbers, but must have the opposite spin quantum number, ms = − . This is in accord with the Pauli exclusion principle: No
2
two electrons in the same atom can have the same set of four quantum numbers. For orbital diagrams, this means two arrows go in
each box (representing two electrons in each orbital) and the arrows must point in opposite directions (representing paired spins).
The electron configuration and orbital diagram of helium are:
An atom of the alkaline earth metal beryllium, with an atomic number of 4, contains four protons in the nucleus and four electrons
surrounding the nucleus. The fourth electron fills the remaining space in the 2s orbital.
An atom of boron (atomic number 5) contains five electrons. The n = 1 shell is filled with two electrons and three electrons will
occupy the n = 2 shell. Because any s subshell can contain only two electrons, the fifth electron must occupy the next energy level,
which will be a 2p orbital. There are three degenerate 2p orbitals (ml = −1, 0, +1) and the electron can occupy any one of these p
orbitals. When drawing orbital diagrams, we include empty boxes to depict any empty orbitals in the same subshell that we are
filling.
Carbon (atomic number 6) has six electrons. Four of them fill the 1s and 2s orbitals. The remaining two electrons occupy the 2p
subshell. We now have a choice of filling one of the 2p orbitals and pairing the electrons or of leaving the electrons unpaired in two
different, but degenerate, p orbitals. The orbitals are filled as described by Hund’s rule: the lowest-energy configuration for an atom
with electrons within a set of degenerate orbitals is that having the maximum number of unpaired electrons. Thus, the two electrons
in the carbon 2p orbitals have identical n, l, and ms quantum numbers and differ in their ml quantum number (in accord with the
Pauli exclusion principle). The electron configuration and orbital diagram for carbon are:
Nitrogen (atomic number 7) fills the 1s and 2s subshells and has one electron in each of the three 2p orbitals, in accordance with
Hund’s rule. These three electrons have unpaired spins. Oxygen (atomic number 8) has a pair of electrons in any one of the 2p
orbitals (the electrons have opposite spins) and a single electron in each of the other two. Fluorine (atomic number 9) has only one
2p orbital containing an unpaired electron. All of the electrons in the noble gas neon (atomic number 10) are paired, and all of the
orbitals in the n = 1 and the n = 2 shells are filled. The electron configurations and orbital diagrams of these four elements are:
Figure 6.4.5 : A core-abbreviated electron configuration (right) replaces the core electrons with the noble gas symbol whose
configuration matches the core electron configuration of the other element.
Similarly, the abbreviated configuration of lithium can be represented as [He]2s1, where [He] represents the configuration of the
helium atom, which is identical to that of the filled inner shell of lithium. Writing the configurations in this way emphasizes the
similarity of the configurations of lithium and sodium. Both atoms, which are in the alkali metal family, have only one electron in a
valence s subshell outside a filled set of inner shells.
1
Li : [He] 2s
1
Na : [Ne] 3s
The alkaline earth metal magnesium (atomic number 12), with its 12 electrons in a [Ne]3s2 configuration, is analogous to its family
member beryllium, [He]2s2. Both atoms have a filled s subshell outside their filled inner shells. Aluminum (atomic number 13),
with 13 electrons and the electron configuration [Ne]3s23p1, is analogous to its family member boron, [He]2s22p1.
Figure 6.4.6 : This version of the periodic table shows the outer-shell electron configuration of each element. Note that down each
group, the configuration is often similar.
When we come to the next element in the periodic table, the alkali metal potassium (atomic number 19), we might expect that we
would begin to add electrons to the 3d subshell. However, all available chemical and physical evidence indicates that potassium is
like lithium and sodium, and that the next electron is not added to the 3d level but is, instead, added to the 4s level (Figure 6.4.3 or
6.4.4). As discussed previously, the 3d orbital with no radial nodes is higher in energy because it is less penetrating and more
shielded from the nucleus than the 4s, which has three radial nodes. Thus, potassium has an electron configuration of [Ar]4s1.
Hence, potassium corresponds to Li and Na in its valence shell configuration. The next electron is added to complete the 4s
subshell and calcium has an electron configuration of [Ar]4s2. This gives calcium an outer-shell electron configuration
corresponding to that of beryllium and magnesium.
Beginning with the transition metal scandium (atomic number 21), additional electrons are added successively to the 3d subshell.
This subshell is filled to its capacity with 10 electrons (remember that for l = 2 [d orbitals], there are 2l + 1 = 5 values of ml,
meaning that there are five d orbitals that have a combined capacity of 10 electrons). The 4p subshell fills next. Note that for three
series of elements, scandium (Sc) through copper (Cu), yttrium (Y) through silver (Ag), and lutetium (Lu) through gold (Au), a
total of 10 d electrons are successively added to the (n – 1) shell next to the n shell to bring that (n – 1) shell from 8 to 18 electrons.
For two series, lanthanum (La) through lutetium (Lu) and actinium (Ac) through lawrencium (Lr), 14 f electrons (l = 3, 2l + 1 = 7
ml values; thus, seven orbitals with a combined capacity of 14 electrons) are successively added to the (n – 2) shell to bring that
shell from 18 electrons to a total of 32 electrons.
The last electron added is a 3p electron. Therefore, n = 3 and, for a p-type orbital, l = 1. The ml value could be –1, 0, or +1. The
1
three p orbitals are degenerate, so any of these ml values is correct. For unpaired electrons, convention assigns the value of +
2
1
for the spin quantum number; thus, m s =+ .
2
Exercise 6.4.1
Answer a
Mn
Answer b
Xe
The periodic table can be a powerful tool in predicting the electron configuration of an element. However, we do find exceptions to
the order of filling of orbitals that are shown in Figure 6.4.3 or 6.4.4. For instance, the electron configurations of the transition
metals chromium (Cr; atomic number 24) and copper (Cu; atomic number 29), among others, are not those we would expect. In
general, such exceptions involve subshells with very similar energy, and small effects can lead to changes in the order of filling.
In the case of Cr and Cu, we find that half-filled and completely filled subshells apparently represent conditions of preferred
stability. This stability is such that an electron shifts from the 4s into the 3d orbital to gain the extra stability of a half-filled 3d
subshell (in Cr) or a filled 3d subshell (in Cu). Other exceptions also occur. For example, niobium (Nb, atomic number 41) is
predicted to have the electron configuration [Kr]5s24d3. Experimentally, we observe that its ground-state electron configuration is
actually [Kr]5s14d4. We can rationalize this observation by saying that the electron–electron repulsions experienced by pairing the
electrons in the 5s orbital are larger than the gap in energy between the 5s and 4d orbitals. There is no simple method to predict the
exceptions for atoms where the magnitude of the repulsions between electrons is greater than the small differences in energy
between subshells.
Exercise 6.4.2
a. Which ion with a +2 charge has the electron configuration 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p64d5?
b. Which ion with a +3 charge has this configuration?
Answer a
Tc2+
Answer b
Ru3+
Summary
The relative energy of the subshells determine the order in which atomic orbitals are filled (1s, 2s, 2p, 3s, 3p, 4s, 3d, 4p, and so on).
Electron configurations and orbital diagrams can be determined by applying the Pauli exclusion principle (no two electrons can
have the same set of four quantum numbers) and Hund’s rule (whenever possible, electrons retain unpaired spins in degenerate
orbitals).
Electrons in the outermost orbitals, called valence electrons, are responsible for most of the chemical behavior of elements. In the
periodic table, elements with analogous valence electron configurations usually occur within the same group. There are some
exceptions to the predicted filling order, particularly when half-filled or completely filled orbitals can be formed. The periodic table
can be divided into three categories based on the orbital in which the last electron to be added is placed: main group elements (s
and p orbitals), transition elements (d orbitals), and inner transition elements (f orbitals).
Glossary
Aufbau principle
procedure in which the electron configuration of the elements is determined by “building” them in order of atomic numbers,
adding one proton to the nucleus and one electron to the proper subshell at a time
core electron
electron in an atom that occupies the orbitals of the inner shells
electron configuration
electronic structure of an atom in its ground state given as a listing of the orbitals occupied by the electrons
Hund’s rule
orbital diagram
pictorial representation of the electron configuration showing each orbital as a box and each electron as an arrow
valence electrons
electrons in the outermost or valence shell (highest value of n) of a ground-state atom; determine how an element reacts
valence shell
outermost shell of electrons in a ground-state atom; for main group elements, the orbitals with the highest n level (s and p
subshells) are in the valence shell, while for transition metals, the highest energy s and d subshells make up the valence shell
and for inner transition elements, the highest s, d, and f subshells are included
This page titled 6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron Configurations) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
The elements in groups (vertical columns) of the periodic table exhibit similar chemical behavior. This similarity occurs because
the members of a group have the same number and distribution of electrons in their valence shells. However, there are also other
patterns in chemical properties on the periodic table. For example, as we move down a group, the metallic character of the atoms
increases. Oxygen, at the top of Group 16 (6A), is a colorless gas; in the middle of the group, selenium is a semiconducting solid;
and, toward the bottom, polonium is a silver-grey solid that conducts electricity.
As we go across a period from left to right, we add a proton to the nucleus and an electron to the valence shell with each successive
element. As we go down the elements in a group, the number of electrons in the valence shell remains constant, but the principal
quantum number increases by one each time. An understanding of the electronic structure of the elements allows us to examine
some of the properties that govern their chemical behavior. These properties vary periodically as the electronic structure of the
elements changes. They are (1) size (radius) of atoms and ions, (2) ionization energies, and (3) electron affinities.
F 64 +9
Cl 99 +17
Br 114 +35
I 133 +53
At 148 +85
specific electron by the nucleus, taking into account any electron–electron repulsions. For hydrogen, there is only one electron and
so the nuclear charge (Z) and the effective nuclear charge (Zeff) are equal. For all other atoms, the inner electrons partially shield the
outer electrons from the pull of the nucleus, and thus:
Zeff = Z − shielding
Shielding is determined by the probability of another electron being between the electron of interest and the nucleus, as well as by
the electron–electron repulsions the electron of interest encounters. Core electrons are adept at shielding, while electrons in the
same valence shell do not block the nuclear attraction experienced by each other as efficiently. Thus, each time we move from one
element to the next across a period, Z increases by one, but the shielding increases only slightly. Thus, Zeff increases as we move
from left to right across a period. The stronger pull (higher effective nuclear charge) experienced by electrons on the right side of
the periodic table draws them closer to the nucleus, making the covalent radii smaller.
Figure 6.5.2 : Within each period, the trend in atomic radius decreases as Z increases; for example, from K to Kr. Within each group
(e.g., the alkali metals shown in purple), the trend is that atomic radius increases as Z increases.
This graph is labeled Atomic Number on the horizontal axis and Radius (p m) on the vertical axis. A black jagged line connects the
radii values for elements with atomic numbers 1 through 60 on the graph. Peaks are evident at the locations of the alkali metals: L i,
N a, K, R b, and C s. Similarly, minima exist at the locations of noble or inert gases: H e, N e, A r, K r, X e, and R n. The locations
of period 4 and period 5 transition elements are provided with green dots.
Thus, as we would expect, the outermost or valence electrons are easiest to remove because they have the highest energies, are
shielded more, and are farthest from the nucleus. As a general rule, when the representative elements form cations, they do so by
the loss of the ns or np electrons that were added last in the Aufbau process. The transition elements, on the other hand, lose the ns
electrons before they begin to lose the (n – 1)d electrons, even though the ns electrons are added first, according to the Aufbau
principle.
Predict the order of increasing covalent radius for Ge, Fl, Br, Kr.
Solution
Exercise 6.5.1
Answer
Ne or He
Figure 6.5.3 : The radius for a cation is smaller than the parent atom (Al), due to the lost electrons; the radius for an anion is larger
than the parent (S), due to the gained electrons.
The figure includes spheres in green to represent the relative sizes of A l and S atoms. Beneath each of these spheres is a red
sphere. The red sphere represents the ionic states of aluminum and sulfur respectively. While radius for the aluminum cation is
smaller than aluminum, the sulfur anion has a greater radius than sulfur.
Cations with larger charges are smaller than cations with smaller charges (e.g., V2+ has an ionic radius of 79 pm, while that of V3+
is 64 pm). Proceeding down the groups of the periodic table, we find that cations of successive elements with the same charge
generally have larger radii, corresponding to an increase in the principal quantum number, n.
An anion (negative ion) is formed by the addition of one or more electrons to the valence shell of an atom. This results in a greater
repulsion among the electrons and a decrease in Z per electron. Both effects (the increased number of electrons and the
ef f
decreased Zeff) cause the radius of an anion to be larger than that of the parent atom ( Figure 6.5.3). For example, a sulfur atom
([Ne]3s23p4) has a covalent radius of 104 pm, whereas the ionic radius of the sulfide anion ([Ne]3s23p6) is 170 pm. For consecutive
elements proceeding down any group, anions have larger principal quantum numbers and, thus, larger radii.
Atoms and ions that have the same electron configuration are said to be isoelectronic. Examples of isoelectronic species are N3–,
O2–, F–, Ne, Na+, Mg2+, and Al3+ (1s22s22p6). Another isoelectronic series is P3–, S2–, Cl–, Ar, K+, Ca2+, and Sc3+ ([Ne]3s23p6). For
atoms or ions that are isoelectronic, the number of protons determines the size. The greater the nuclear charge, the smaller the
radius in a series of isoelectronic ions and atoms.
The energy required to remove the second most loosely bound electron is called the second ionization energy (IE2).
+ 2+ −
X (g) ⟶ X (g) + e IE
2
The energy required to remove the third electron is the third ionization energy, and so on. Energy is always required to remove
electrons from atoms or ions, so ionization processes are endothermic and IE values are always positive. For larger atoms, the most
loosely bound electron is located farther from the nucleus and so is easier to remove. Thus, as size (atomic radius) increases, the
Figure 6.5.4 : The first ionization energy of the elements in the first five periods are plotted against their atomic number.
This figure includes Atomic Number on the horizontal axis and, Ionization Energy (k J divided by mol) on the vertical axis. A red
jagged line connects the ionization energies for elements with atomic numbers 1 through 86 on the graph. Peaks are evident at the
locations of the noble or inert gases: H e, N e, A r, K r, X e, and R n. Similarly, minima exist at the locations of the alkali metals: L
i, N a, K, R b, and C s.
Figure 6.5.4 graphs the relationship between the first ionization energy and the atomic number of several elements. Within a
period, the values of first ionization energy for the elements (IE1) generally increases with increasing Z. Down a group, the IE1
value generally decreases with increasing Z. There are some systematic deviations from this trend, however. Note that the
ionization energy of boron (atomic number 5) is less than that of beryllium (atomic number 4) even though the nuclear charge of
boron is greater by one proton. This can be explained because the energy of the subshells increases as l increases, due to
penetration and shielding (as discussed previously in this chapter). Within any one shell, the s electrons are lower in energy than the
p electrons. This means that an s electron is harder to remove from an atom than a p electron in the same shell. The electron
removed during the ionization of beryllium ([He]2s2) is an s electron, whereas the electron removed during the ionization of boron
([He]2s22p1) is a p electron; this results in a lower first ionization energy for boron, even though its nuclear charge is greater by one
proton. Thus, we see a small deviation from the predicted trend occurring each time a new subshell begins.
Figure 6.5.5 : This version of the periodic table shows the first ionization energy of (IE: 1), in kJ/mol, of selected elements.
The trends for first ionization energies across periods and down groups are shown in this version of the periodic table.
Another deviation occurs as orbitals become more than one-half filled. The first ionization energy for oxygen is slightly less than
that for nitrogen, despite the trend in increasing IE1 values across a period. Looking at the orbital diagram of oxygen, we can see
The electronic configuration for oxygen is 1s superscript 2, 2s superscript, 2p superscript 4. An orbital diagram shows 2 squares
each filled with a pair of opposite pointing arrows to represent the 1s ans 2s orbitals. Each of the three connected square which
represents the 2p orbitals are filled with one arrow respectively with the addition of 1 red arrow in the first of the three squares.
Removing an electron from a cation is more difficult than removing an electron from a neutral atom because of the greater
electrostatic attraction to the cation. Likewise, removing an electron from a cation with a higher positive charge is more difficult
than removing an electron from an ion with a lower charge. Thus, successive ionization energies for one element always increase.
As seen in Table 6.5.2, there is a large increase in the ionization energies (color change) for each element. This jump corresponds
to removal of the core electrons, which are harder to remove than the valence electrons. For example, Sc and Ga both have three
valence electrons, so the rapid increase in ionization energy occurs after the third ionization.
Table 6.5.2: Successive Ionization Energies for Selected Elements (kJ/mol)
Element IE1 IE2 IE3 IE4 IE5 IE6 IE7
Solution
Removing the 6p1 electron from Tl is easier than removing the 3p1 electron from Al because the higher n orbital is farther from
the nucleus, so IE1(Tl) < IE1(Al). Ionizing the third electron from
2+ 3+ −
Al (Al ⟶ Al +e )
requires more energy because the cation Al2+ exerts a stronger pull on the electron than the neutral Al atom, so IE1(Al) <
IE3(Al). The second ionization energy for sodium removes a core electron, which is a much higher energy process than
removing valence electrons. Putting this all together, we obtain:
IE1(Tl) < IE1(Al) < IE3(Al) < IE2(Na).
Exercise 6.5.2
Which has the lowest value for IE1: O, Po, Pb, or Ba?
Answer
Ba
This process can be either endothermic or exothermic, depending on the element. The EA of some of the elements is given in
Figure 6.5.6. You can see that many of these elements have negative values of EA, which means that energy is released when the
gaseous atom accepts an electron. However, for some elements, energy is required for the atom to become negatively charged and
the value of their EA is positive. Just as with ionization energy, subsequent EA values are associated with forming ions with more
charge. The second EA is the energy associated with adding an electron to an anion to form a –2 ion, and so on.
Figure 6.5.6 : This version of the periodic table displays the electron affinity values (in kJ/mol) for selected elements.:
The trend for electron affinity values across periods and down groups is shown in this version of the periodic table. Values are not
shown for groups 3 to 12 as well as period 7.
As we might predict, it becomes easier to add an electron across a series of atoms as the effective nuclear charge of the atoms
increases. We find, as we go from left to right across a period, EAs tend to become more negative. The exceptions found among the
elements of group 2 (2A), group 15 (5A), and group 18 (8A) can be understood based on the electronic structure of these groups.
The noble gases, group 18 (8A), have a completely filled shell and the incoming electron must be added to a higher n level, which
is more difficult to do. Group 2 (2A) has a filled ns subshell, and so the next electron added goes into the higher energy np, so,
again, the observed EA value is not as the trend would predict. Finally, group 15 (5A) has a half-filled np subshell and the next
electron must be paired with an existing np electron. In all of these cases, the initial relative stability of the electron configuration
disrupts the trend in EA.
We also might expect the atom at the top of each group to have the largest EA; their first ionization potentials suggest that these
atoms have the largest effective nuclear charges. However, as we move down a group, we see that the second element in the group
most often has the greatest EA. The reduction of the EA of the first member can be attributed to the small size of the n = 2 shell and
the resulting large electron–electron repulsions. For example, chlorine, with an EA value of –348 kJ/mol, has the highest value of
any element in the periodic table. The EA of fluorine is –322 kJ/mol. When we add an electron to a fluorine atom to form a fluoride
anion (F–), we add an electron to the n = 2 shell. The electron is attracted to the nucleus, but there is also significant repulsion from
the other electrons already present in this small valence shell. The chlorine atom has the same electron configuration in the valence
shell, but because the entering electron is going into the n = 3 shell, it occupies a considerably larger region of space and the
electron–electron repulsions are reduced. The entering electron does not experience as much repulsion and the chlorine atom
accepts an additional electron more readily.
The properties discussed in this section (size of atoms and ions, effective nuclear charge, ionization energies, and electron
affinities) are central to understanding chemical reactivity. For example, because fluorine has an energetically favorable EA and a
large energy barrier to ionization (IE), it is much easier to form fluorine anions than cations. Metallic properties including
Summary
Electron configurations allow us to understand many periodic trends. Covalent radius increases as we move down a group because
the n level (orbital size) increases. Covalent radius mostly decreases as we move left to right across a period because the effective
nuclear charge experienced by the electrons increases, and the electrons are pulled in tighter to the nucleus. Anionic radii are larger
than the parent atom, while cationic radii are smaller, because the number of valence electrons has changed while the nuclear
charge has remained constant. Ionization energy (the energy associated with forming a cation) decreases down a group and mostly
increases across a period because it is easier to remove an electron from a larger, higher energy orbital. Electron affinity (the energy
associated with forming an anion) is more favorable (exothermic) when electrons are placed into lower energy orbitals, closer to
the nucleus. Therefore, electron affinity becomes increasingly negative as we move left to right across the periodic table and
decreases as we move down a group. For both IE and electron affinity data, there are exceptions to the trends when dealing with
completely filled or half-filled subshells.
Glossary
covalent radius
one-half the distance between the nuclei of two identical atoms when they are joined by a covalent bond
electron affinity
energy required to add an electron to a gaseous atom to form an anion
ionization energy
energy required to remove an electron from a gaseous atom or ion. The associated number (e.g., second ionization energy)
corresponds to the charge of the ion produced (X2+)
isoelectronic
group of ions or atoms that have identical electron configurations
This page titled 6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
S6.1.1
The spectrum consists of colored lines, at least one of which (probably the brightest) is red.
Q6.1.2
An FM radio station found at 103.1 on the FM dial broadcasts at a frequency of 1.031 × 108 s−1 (103.1 MHz). What is the
wavelength of these radio waves in meters?
S6.1.2
c
λ =
ν
m
8
2.998 × 10
s
λ = = 2.908 m
1
8
1.031 × 10
s
Q6.1.3
FM-95, an FM radio station, broadcasts at a frequency of 9.51 × 107 s−1 (95.1 MHz). What is the wavelength of these radio waves
in meters?
S6.1.3
c
λ =
ν
m
8
2.998 × 10
s
λ = = 3.15 m
1
7
9.51 × 10
s
Q6.1.4
A bright violet line occurs at 435.8 nm in the emission spectrum of mercury vapor. What amount of energy, in joules, must be
released by an electron in a mercury atom to produce a photon of this light?
S6.1.4
hc
E =
λ
8
m −34
(2.998 × 10 ) (6.6262 × 10 Js)
s
E =
−7
4.358 × 10 m
−19
= 4.56 × 10 J
Q6.1.5
Light with a wavelength of 614.5 nm looks orange. What is the energy, in joules, per photon of this orange light? What is the
energy in eV (1 eV = 1.602 × 10−19 J)?
S6.1.5
1.) First convert 614.5 nm into meters
6.145nm = 6.145 × 10 −7
m
s
λ = wavelength of photon → 6.145 × 10 −7
m
−34 8
m
(6.6262 × 10 Js) (2.998 × 10 )
s −19
= = 3.233 × 10 J (6.E.1)
−7
6.145 × 10 m
−19
1eV
= (3.233 × 10 J) × (6.E.2)
−19
1.602 × 10 J
= 2.018eV (6.E.3)
Q6.1.6
Heated lithium atoms emit photons of light with an energy of 2.961 × 10−19 J. Calculate the frequency and wavelength of one of
these photons. What is the total energy in 1 mole of these photons? What is the color of the emitted light?
S6.1.6
E
1.) E = hν and ν =
h
−19
2.961 × 10 J
Frequency: ν = −34
= 4.469 × 10
14
Hz
6.6262 × 10 Js
c
2.) λ =
ν
m
c = Speed of light → 2.998 × 10 8
m
8
2.998 × 10
s
Wavelength: λ = = 6.709 × 10
−7
m = Red Light
1
14
4.469 × 10
s
Total energy:
−19 23
2.961 × 10 J 6.022 × 10 photons
5
E = × = 1.783 × 10 J
1 photon 1 mole
Q6.1.7
A photon of light produced by a surgical laser has an energy of 3.027 × 10−19 J. Calculate the frequency and wavelength of the
photon. What is the total energy in 1 mole of photons? What is the color of the emitted light?
S6.1.7
ν = 4.568 × 1014 s; λ = 656.3 nm; Energy mol−1 = 1.823 × 105 J mol−1; red
Q6.1.8
When rubidium ions are heated to a high temperature, two lines are observed in its line spectrum at wavelengths (a) 7.9 × 10−7 m
and (b) 4.2 × 10−7 m. What are the frequencies of the two lines? What color do we see when we heat a rubidium compound?
S6.1.9
(a) λ = 8.69 × 10−7 m; E = 2.29 × 10−19 J; (b) λ = 4.59 × 10−7 m; E = 4.33 × 10−19 J; The color of (a) is red; (b) is blue.
Q6.1.10
Photons of infrared radiation are responsible for much of the warmth we feel when holding our hands before a fire. These photons
will also warm other objects. How many infrared photons with a wavelength of 1.5 × 10−6 m must be absorbed by the water to
warm a cup of water (175 g) from 25.0 °C to 40 °
S6.1.10
1.) First we must use the equation: q=mCΔT° to calculate the amount of Energy in Joules (J) to warm 175g of H2O a total of 15°
Celsius
m = mass in grams(g) → 175g
4.184J
C = Specific heat of H2O(l) →
g°C
q= 11,000 J
2.) Now we need to calculate the amount of energy in Joules (J) that one Photon with a wavelength of 1.5x10-6 m contains. We will
use the equations:
c hc
E = hν and ν = which can be manipulated algebraically into: E =
λ λ
s
λ = wavelength of photon → 1.5 × 10 −6
m
m
−34 8
(6.6262 × 10 Js) (2.998 × 10 )
s −19
= = 1.3 × 10 J (6.E.5)
−6
1.5 × 10 m
This is the energy in one photon, so now we have to see how many times 1.3x10-19 J fits into the 11,000 J from our first calculation:
11, 000 J
22
= = 8.3 × 10 photons (6.E.6)
J
−19
1.3 × 10
photon
22
= 8.3 × 10 photons (6.E.7)
Q6.1.11
One of the radiographic devices used in a dentist's office emits an X-ray of wavelength 2.090 × 10−11 m. What is the energy, in
joules, and frequency of this X-ray?
S6.1.11
E = 9.502 × 10−15 J; ν = 1.434 × 1019 s−1
Q6.1.12
The eyes of certain reptiles pass a single visual signal to the brain when the visual receptors are struck by photons of a wavelength
of 850 nm. If a total energy of 3.15 × 10−14 J is required to trip the signal, what is the minimum number of photons that must strike
S6.1.12
1.) First we need to convert nanometers to meters
850nm = 8.5 x 10-7 m
2. Then calculate Energy in Joules a photon of this wavelength (λ) produces:
m
−34 8
(6.6262 × 10 Js) (2.998 × 10 )
hc s −19
J
(E = ) = = 2.3 × 10 (6.E.8)
−7
λ 8.5 × 10 m photon
3.) Then we need to find out how many of these photons it will take to trip the visual signal to the brain:
−14
3.15 × 10 J
= (6.E.9)
J
−19
2.3 × 10
photon
5
= 1.3 × 10 photons (6.E.10)
Q6.1.13
RGB color television and computer displays use cathode ray tubes that produce colors by mixing red, green, and blue light. If we
look at the screen with a magnifying glass, we can see individual dots turn on and off as the colors change. Using a spectrum of
visible light, determine the approximate wavelength of each of these colors. What is the frequency and energy of a photon of each
of these colors?
S6.1.13
Red: 660 nm; 4.54 × 1014 Hz; 3.01 × 10−19 J.
Green: 520 nm; 5.77 × 1014 Hz; 3.82 × 10−19 J.
Blue: 440 nm; 6.81 × 1014 Hz; 4.51 × 10−19 J.
Somewhat different numbers are also possible.
Q6.1.14
Answer the following questions about a Blu-ray laser:
a. The laser on a Blu-ray player has a wavelength of 405 nm. In what region of the electromagnetic spectrum is this radiation?
What is its frequency?
b. A Blu-ray laser has a power of 5 milliwatts (1 watt = 1 J s−1). How many photons of light are produced by the laser in 1 hour?
c. The ideal resolution of a player using a laser (such as a Blu-ray player), which determines how close together data can be stored
on a compact disk, is determined using the following formula: Resolution = 0.60(λ/NA), where λ is the wavelength of the laser
and NA is the numerical aperture. Numerical aperture is a measure of the size of the spot of light on the disk; the larger the NA,
the smaller the spot. In a typical Blu-ray system, NA = 0.95. If the 405-nm laser is used in a Blu-ray player, what is the closest
that information can be stored on a Blu-ray disk?
d. The data density of a Blu-ray disk using a 405-nm laser is 1.5 × 107 bits mm−2. Disks have an outside diameter of 120 mm and
a hole of 15-mm diameter. How many data bits can be contained on the disk? If a Blu-ray disk can hold 9,400,000 pages of text,
how many data bits are needed for a typed page? (Hint: Determine the area of the disk that is available to hold data. The area
inside a circle is given by A = πr2, where the radius r is one-half of the diameter.)
Q6.1.15
What is the threshold frequency for sodium metal if a photon with frequency 6.66 × 1014 s−1 ejects a photon with 7.74 × 10−20 J
kinetic energy? Will the photoelectric effect be observed if sodium is exposed to orange light?
S6.1.15
5.49 × 1014 s−1; no
Q6.2.2
What does it mean to say that the energy of the electrons in an atom is quantized?
S6.2.2
Quantized energy means that the electrons can possess only certain discrete energy values; values between those quantized
values are not permitted.
Q6.2.3
Using the Bohr model, determine the energy, in joules, necessary to ionize a ground-state hydrogen atom. Show your
calculations.
Q6.2.4
The electron volt (eV) is a convenient unit of energy for expressing atomic-scale energies. It is the amount of energy that an
electron gains when subjected to a potential of 1 volt; 1 eV = 1.602 × 10 J . Using the Bohr model, determine the energy,
−19
in electron volts, of the photon produced when an electron in a hydrogen atom moves from the orbit with n = 5 to the orbit
with n = 2 . Show your calculations.
S6.2.4
1 1
−18
E = E2 − E5 = 2.179 × 10 ( − ) J (6.E.11)
2 2
n n
2 5
1 1
−18 −19
= 2.179 × 10 ( − ) = 4.576 × 10 J (6.E.12)
2 2
2 5
−19
4.576 × 10 J
= = 2.856 eV (6.E.13)
−19 −1
1.602 × 10 J eV
Q6.2.5
Using the Bohr model, determine the lowest possible energy for the electron in the H e ion. +
Q6.2.6
Using the Bohr model, determine the energy of an electron with n = 6 in a hydrogen atom.
S6.2.6
−8.716 × 10−18 J
Q6.2.7
Using the Bohr model, determine the energy of an electron with n = 8 in a hydrogen atom.
Q6.2.8
How far from the nucleus in angstroms (1 angstrom = 1 × 10
–10
m ) is the electron in a hydrogen atom if it has an energy of
J?
−20
−8.72 × 10
S6.2.8
−20
−3.405 × 10 J
Q6.2.10
Using the Bohr model, determine the energy in joules of the photon produced when an electron in a He ion moves from the
+
Q6.2.11
Using the Bohr model, determine the energy in joules of the photon produced when an electron in a Li2+ ion moves from the
orbit with n = 2 to the orbit with n = 1.
S6.2.11
1.471 × 10−17 J
Q6.2.12
Consider a large number of hydrogen atoms with electrons randomly distributed in the n = 1, 2, 3, and 4 orbits
a. How many different wavelengths of light are emitted by these atoms as the electrons fall into lower-energy orbitals?
b. Calculate the lowest and highest energies of light produced by the transitions described in part (a).
c. Calculate the frequencies and wavelengths of the light produced by the transitions described in part (b).
Q6.2.13
How are the Bohr model and the Rutherford model of the atom similar? How are they different?
Q6.2.14
The spectra of hydrogen and of calcium are shown in[link]. What causes the lines in these spectra? Why are the colors of the
lines different? Suggest a reason for the observation that the spectrum of calcium is more complicated than the spectrum of
hydrogen
S6.2.14
Both involve a relatively heavy nucleus with electrons moving around it, although strictly speaking, the Bohr model works only for
one-electron atoms or ions. According to classical mechanics, the Rutherford model predicts a miniature “solar system” with
electrons moving about the nucleus in circular or elliptical orbits that are confined to planes. If the requirements of classical
electromagnetic theory that electrons in such orbits would emit electromagnetic radiation are ignored, such atoms would be stable,
having constant energy and angular momentum, but would not emit any visible light (contrary to observation). If classical
electromagnetic theory is applied, then the Rutherford atom would emit electromagnetic radiation of continually increasing
frequency (contrary to the observed discrete spectra), thereby losing energy until the atom collapsed in an absurdly short time
(contrary to the observed long-term stability of atoms). The Bohr model retains the classical mechanics view of circular orbits
confined to planes having constant energy and angular momentum, but restricts these to quantized values dependent on a single
quantum number, n. The orbiting electron in Bohr’s model is assumed not to emit any electromagnetic radiation while moving
about the nucleus in its stationary orbits, but the atom can emit or absorb electromagnetic radiation when the electron changes from
one orbit to another. Because of the quantized orbits, such “quantum jumps” will produce discrete spectra, in agreement with
observations.
S6.3.1
Both models have a central positively charged nucleus with electrons moving about the nucleus in accordance with the Coulomb
electrostatic potential. The Bohr model assumes that the electrons move in circular orbits that have quantized energies, angular
momentum, and radii that are specified by a single quantum number, n = 1, 2, 3, …, but this quantization is an ad hoc assumption
made by Bohr to incorporate quantization into an essentially classical mechanics description of the atom. Bohr also assumed that
Q6.3.2
What are the allowed values for each of the four quantum numbers: n, l, ml, and ms?
Q6.3.3
Describe the properties of an electron associated with each of the following four quantum numbers: n, l, ml, and ms.
S6.3.3
n determines the general range for the value of energy and the probable distances that the electron can be from the nucleus. l
determines the shape of the orbital. ml determines the orientation of the orbitals of the same l value with respect to one another. ms
determines the spin of an electron.
Q6.3.4
Answer the following questions:
a. Without using quantum numbers, describe the differences between the shells, subshells, and orbitals of an atom.
b. How do the quantum numbers of the shells, subshells, and orbitals of an atom differ?
Q6.3.5
Identify the subshell in which electrons with the following quantum numbers are found:
a. n = 2, l = 1
b. n = 4, l = 2
c. n = 6, l = 0
S6.3.5
(a) 2p; (b) 4d; (c) 6s
Q6.3.6
Which of the subshells described in Question 5 contain degenerate orbitals? How many degenerate orbitals are in each?
Q6.3.7
Identify the subshell in which electrons with the following quantum numbers are found:
a. n = 3, l = 2
b. n = 1, l = 0
c. n = 4, l = 3
S6.3.7
(a) 3d; (b) 1s; (c) 4f
Q6.3.9
Sketch the boundary surface of a d 2
x −y
2 and a py orbital. Be sure to show and label the axes.
Q6.3.10
Sketch the px and dxz orbitals. Be sure to show and label the coordinates.
Q6.3.11
Consider the orbitals shown here in outline.
a. What is the maximum number of electrons contained in an orbital of type (x)? Of type (y)? Of type (z)?
b. How many orbitals of type (x) are found in a shell with n = 2? How many of type (y)? How many of type (z)?
c. Write a set of quantum numbers for an electron in an orbital of type (x) in a shell with n = 4. Of an orbital of type (y) in a shell
with n = 2. Of an orbital of type (z) in a shell with n = 3.
d. What is the smallest possible n value for an orbital of type (x)? Of type (y)? Of type (z)?
e. What are the possible l and ml values for an orbital of type (x)? Of type (y)? Of type (z)?
S6.3.11
1 1 1
(a) x. 2, y. 2, z. 2; (b) x. 1, y. 3, z. 0; (c) x. 4 0 0 , y. 2 1 0 , z. 3 2 0 ; (d) x. 1, y. 2, z. 3; (e) x. l = 0, ml = 0, y. l = 1, ml = –1, 0,
2 2 2
or +1, z. l = 2, ml = –2, –1, 0, +1, +2
Q6.3.12
State the Heisenberg uncertainty principle. Describe briefly what the principle implies.
Q6.3.13
How many electrons could be held in the second shell of an atom if the spin quantum number ms could have three values instead of
just two? (Hint: Consider the Pauli exclusion principle.)
S6.3.13
12
Q6.3.14
Which of the following equations describe particle-like behavior? Which describe wavelike behavior? Do any involve both types of
behavior? Describe the reasons for your choices.
Q6.3.15
Write a set of quantum numbers for each of the electrons with an n of 4 in a Se atom.
S6.3.15
n l ml s
1
4 0 0 +
2
1
4 0 0 −
2
1
4 1 −1 +
2
1
4 1 0 +
2
1
4 1 +1 +
2
1
4 1 −1 −
2
Q6.4.2
Read the labels of several commercial products and identify monatomic ions of at least six main group elements contained in the
products. Write the complete electron configurations of these cations and anions.
S6.4.2
For example, Na+: 1s22s22p6; Ca2+: 1s22s22p6; Sn2+: 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p64d105s2; F–: 1s22s22p6; O2–: 1s22s22p6; Cl–:
1s22s22p63s23p6.
Q6.4.3
Using complete subshell notation (not abbreviations, 1s22s22p6, and so forth), predict the electron configuration of each of the
following atoms:
a. C
b. P
c. V
d. Sb
e. Sm
S6.4.3
a.) 1s22s22p2
b.) 1s22s22p63s23p3
c.) 1s22s22p63s23p63d34s2
Q6.4.4
Using complete subshell notation (1s22s22p6, and so forth), predict the electron configuration of each of the following atoms:
a. N
b. Si
c. Fe
d. Te
e. Tb
S6.4.4
a. 1s22s22p3;
b. 1s22s22p63s23p2;
c. 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d6;
d. 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d104p65s24d105p4;
e. 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d104p65s24d105p66s24f9
Q6.4.5
Is 1s22s22p6 the symbol for a macroscopic property or a microscopic property of an element? Explain your answer.
Q6.4.6
What additional information do we need to answer the question “Which ion has the electron configuration 1s22s22p63s23p6”?
S6.4.6
The charge on the ion.
Q6.4.7
Draw the orbital diagram for the valence shell of each of the following atoms:
a. C
b. P
c. V
d. Sb
e. Ru
Q6.4.8
Use an orbital diagram to describe the electron configuration of the valence shell of each of the following atoms:
a. N
b. Si
c. Fe
d. Te
e. Mo
S6.4.8
(a)
(b)
(d)
(e)
Q6.4.9
Using complete subshell notation (1s22s22p6, and so forth), predict the electron configurations of the following ions.
a. N3–
b. Ca2+
c. S–
d. Cs2+
e. Cr2+
f. Gd3+
Q6.4.10
Which atom has the electron configuration: 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d104p65s24d2?
S6.4.10
Zr
Q6.4.11
Which atom has the electron configuration: 1s22s22p63s23p63d74s2?
S6.4.11
Co ; Cobalt
Q6.4.12
Which ion with a +1 charge has the electron configuration 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p6? Which ion with a –2 charge has this
configuration?
S6.4.12
Rb+, Se2−
S6.4.13
B ; Boron
Q6.4.14
Which of the following has two unpaired electrons?
a. Mg
b. Si
c. S
d. Both Mg and S
e. Both Si and S.
S6.4.14
Although both (b) and (c) are correct, (e) encompasses both and is the best answer.
Q6.4.15
Which atom would be expected to have a half-filled 6p subshell?
S6.4.15
Bi ; Bismuth
Q6.4.16
Which atom would be expected to have a half-filled 4s subshell?
S6.4.16
K
Q6.4.17
In one area of Australia, the cattle did not thrive despite the presence of suitable forage. An investigation showed the cause to be
the absence of sufficient cobalt in the soil. Cobalt forms cations in two oxidation states, Co2+ and Co3+. Write the electron structure
of the two cations.
Q6.4.18
Thallium was used as a poison in the Agatha Christie mystery story “The Pale Horse.” Thallium has two possible cationic forms,
+1 and +3. The +1 compounds are the more stable. Write the electron structure of the +1 cation of thallium.
S6.4.18
1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p64d105s25p66s24f145d10
Q6.4.19
Write the electron configurations for the following atoms or ions:
a. B3+
b. O–
c. Cl3+
d. Ca2+
e. Ti
Q6.4.20
Cobalt–60 and iodine–131 are radioactive isotopes commonly used in nuclear medicine. How many protons, neutrons, and
electrons are in atoms of these isotopes? Write the complete electron configuration for each isotope.
Q6.4.21
Write a set of quantum numbers for each of the electrons with an n of 3 in a Sc atom.
S6.5.1
Cl
Q6.5.2
Based on their positions in the periodic table, predict which has the largest atomic radius: Li, Rb, N, F, I.
Q6.5.3
Based on their positions in the periodic table, predict which has the largest first ionization energy: Mg, Ba, B, O, Te.
S6.5.3
O
Q6.5.4
Based on their positions in the periodic table, predict which has the smallest first ionization energy: Li, Cs, N, F, I.
Q6.5.5
Based on their positions in the periodic table, rank the following atoms in order of increasing first ionization energy: F, Li, N, Rb
S6.5.5
Rb < Li < N < F
Q6.5.6
Based on their positions in the periodic table, rank the following atoms or compounds in order of increasing first ionization energy:
Mg, O, S, Si
Q6.5.7
Atoms of which group in the periodic table have a valence shell electron configuration of ns2np3?
S6.5.7
15 (5A)
Q6.5.8
Atoms of which group in the periodic table have a valence shell electron configuration of ns2?
Q6.5.9
Based on their positions in the periodic table, list the following atoms in order of increasing radius: Mg, Ca, Rb, Cs.
S6.5.9
Mg < Ca < Rb < Cs
Q6.5.11
Based on their positions in the periodic table, list the following ions in order of increasing radius: K+, Ca2+, Al3+, Si4+.
S6.5.11
Si4+ < Al3+ < Ca2+ < K+
Q6.5.12
List the following ions in order of increasing radius: Li+, Mg2+, Br–, Te2–.
Q6.5.13
Which atom and/or ion is (are) isoelectronic with Br+: Se2+, Se, As–, Kr, Ga3+, Cl–?
S6.5.13
Se, As−
Q6.5.14
Which of the following atoms and ions is (are) isoelectronic with S2+: Si4+, Cl3+, Ar, As3+, Si, Al3+?
Q6.5.15
Compare both the numbers of protons and electrons present in each to rank the following ions in order of increasing radius: As3–,
Br–, K+, Mg2+.
S6.5.15
Mg2+ < K+ < Br– < As3–
Q6.5.16
Of the five elements Al, Cl, I, Na, Rb, which has the most exothermic reaction? (E represents an atom.) What name is given to the
energy for the reaction? Hint: note the process depicted does not correspond to electron affinity
+ −
E (g) + e ⟶ E(g)
Q6.5.17
Of the five elements Sn, Si, Sb, O, Te, which has the most endothermic reaction? (E represents an atom.) What name is given to the
energy for the reaction?
+ −
E(g) ⟶ E (g) + e (6.E.14)
S6.5.17
O, IE1
Q6.5.18
The ionic radii of the ions S2–, Cl–, and K+ are 184, 181, 138 pm respectively. Explain why these ions have different sizes even
though they contain the same number of electrons.
Q6.5.19
Which main group atom would be expected to have the lowest second ionization energy?
S6.5.19
Ra
This page titled 6.E: Electronic Structure and Periodic Properties (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
Thumbnail: Covalently bonded hydrogen and carbon in a w:molecule of methane. (CC BY-SA 2.5; DynaBlast via Wikipedia)
This page titled 7: Chemical Bonding and Molecular Geometry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
7.0: Prelude to Chemical Bonding and Molecular Geometry
It has long been known that pure carbon occurs in different forms (allotropes) including graphite and diamonds. But it was not until
1985 that a new form of carbon was recognized: buckminsterfullerene, commonly known as a “buckyball.” This molecule was
named after the architect and inventor R. Buckminster Fuller (1895–1983), whose signature architectural design was the geodesic
dome, characterized by a lattice shell structure supporting a spherical surface. Experimental evidence revealed the formula, C60,
and then scientists determined how 60 carbon atoms could form one symmetric, stable molecule. They were guided by bonding
theory—the topic of this chapter—which explains how individual atoms connect to form more complex structures.
Figure 7.0.1 : Nicknamed “buckyballs,” buckminsterfullerene molecules (C60) contain only carbon atoms. Here they are shown in a
ball-and-stick model (left). These molecules have single and double carbon-carbon bonds arranged to form a geometric framework
of hexagons and pentagons, similar to the pattern on a soccer ball (center). This unconventional molecular structure is named after
architect R. Buckminster Fuller, whose innovative designs combined simple geometric shapes to create large, strong structures such
as this weather radar dome near Tucson, Arizona (right). (credit middle: modification of work by “Petey21”/Wikimedia Commons;
credit right: modification of work by Bill Morrow).
Three figures are shown. The left figure is a many-sides spherical ball composed of hexagonal rings which have carbon atoms at
each corner. The center picture shows a soccer ball. The right picture shown as water tower with sides shaped like hexagonal rings.
This page titled 7.0: Prelude to Chemical Bonding and Molecular Geometry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
As you have learned, ions are atoms or molecules bearing an electrical charge. A cation (a positive ion) forms when a neutral atom
loses one or more electrons from its valence shell, and an anion (a negative ion) forms when a neutral atom gains one or more
electrons in its valence shell.
Compounds composed of ions are called ionic compounds (or salts), and their constituent ions are held together by ionic bonds:
electrostatic forces of attraction between oppositely charged cations and anions. The properties of ionic compounds shed some light
on the nature of ionic bonds. Ionic solids exhibit a crystalline structure and tend to be rigid and brittle; they also tend to have high
melting and boiling points, which suggests that ionic bonds are very strong. Ionic solids are also poor conductors of electricity for
the same reason—the strength of ionic bonds prevents ions from moving freely in the solid state. Most ionic solids, however,
dissolve readily in water. Once dissolved or melted, ionic compounds are excellent conductors of electricity and heat because the
ions can move about freely.
Neutral atoms and their associated ions have very different physical and chemical properties. Sodium atoms form sodium metal, a
soft, silvery-white metal that burns vigorously in air and reacts explosively with water. Chlorine atoms form chlorine gas, Cl2, a
yellow-green gas that is extremely corrosive to most metals and very poisonous to animals and plants. The vigorous reaction
between the elements sodium and chlorine forms the white, crystalline compound sodium chloride, common table salt, which
contains sodium cations and chloride anions (Figure Figure 7.1.1). The compound composed of these ions exhibits properties
entirely different from the properties of the elements sodium and chlorine. Chlorine is poisonous, but sodium chloride is essential
to life; sodium atoms react vigorously with water, but sodium chloride simply dissolves in water.
Figure 7.1.1 : (a) Sodium is a soft metal that must be stored in mineral oil to prevent reaction with air or water. (b) Chlorine is a
pale yellow-green gas. (c) When combined, they form white crystals of sodium chloride (table salt). (credit a: modification of work
by “Jurii”/Wikimedia Commons)
Figure 7.1.2 : The atoms in sodium chloride (common table salt) are arranged to (a) maximize opposite charges interacting. The
smaller spheres represent sodium ions, the larger ones represent chloride ions. In the expanded view (b), the geometry can be seen
more clearly. Note that each ion is “bonded” to all of the surrounding ions—six in this case.
Two diagrams are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Diagram a shows a cube made up of twenty-seven alternating purple and green
spheres. The purple spheres are smaller than the green spheres. Diagram b shows the same spheres, but this time, they are spread
out and connected in three dimensions by white rods. The purple spheres are labeled “N superscript postive sign” while the green
are labeled “C l superscript negative sign.”
The strong electrostatic attraction between Na+ and Cl– ions holds them tightly together in solid NaCl. It requires 769 kJ of energy
to dissociate one mole of solid NaCl into separate gaseous Na+ and Cl– ions:
+ −
NaCl(s) ⟶ Na (g) + Cl (g) ΔH = 769 kJ
There are at least 14 elements categorized as “essential trace elements” for the human body. They are called “essential”
because they are required for healthy bodily functions, “trace” because they are required only in small amounts, and
“elements” in spite of the fact that they are really ions. Two of these essential trace elements, chromium and zinc, are required
as Cr3+ and Zn2+. Write the electron configurations of these cations.
Solution
First, write the electron configuration for the neutral atoms:
Zn: [Ar]3d104s2
Cr: [Ar]3d54s1
Next, remove electrons from the highest energy orbital. For the transition metals, electrons are removed from the s orbital first
and then from the d orbital. For the p-block elements, electrons are removed from the p orbitals and then from the s orbital.
Zinc is a member of group 12, so it should have a charge of 2+, and thus loses only the two electrons in its s orbital. Chromium
is a transition element and should lose its s electrons and then its d electrons when forming a cation. Thus, we find the
following electron configurations of the ions:
Zn2+: [Ar]3d10
Cr3+: [Ar]3d3
Exercise 7.1.1
Potassium and magnesium are required in our diet. Write the electron configurations of the ions expected from these elements.
Answer
K+: [Ar], Mg2+: [Ne]
Selenium and iodine are two essential trace elements that form anions. Write the electron configurations of the anions.
Solution
Se2–: [Ar]3d104s24p6
I–: [Kr]4d105s25p6
Exercise 7.1.2
Write the electron configurations of a phosphorus atom and its negative ion. Give the charge on the anion.
Answer
Summary
Atoms gain or lose electrons to form ions with particularly stable electron configurations. The charges of cations formed by the
representative metals may be determined readily because, with few exceptions, the electronic structures of these ions have either a
noble gas configuration or a completely filled electron shell. The charges of anions formed by the nonmetals may also be readily
determined because these ions form when nonmetal atoms gain enough electrons to fill their valence shells.
Glossary
inert pair effect
tendency of heavy atoms to form ions in which their valence s electrons are not lost
ionic bond
strong electrostatic force of attraction between cations and anions in an ionic compound
This page titled 7.1: Ionic Bonding is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In ionic compounds, electrons are transferred between atoms of different elements to form ions. But this is not the only way that
compounds can be formed. Atoms can also make chemical bonds by sharing electrons between each other. Such bonds are called
covalent bonds. Covalent bonds are formed between two atoms when both have similar tendencies to attract electrons to
themselves (i.e., when both atoms have identical or fairly similar ionization energies and electron affinities). For example, two
hydrogen atoms bond covalently to form an H2 molecule; each hydrogen atom in the H2 molecule has two electrons stabilizing it,
giving each atom the same number of valence electrons as the noble gas He.
Compounds that contain covalent bonds exhibit different physical properties than ionic compounds. Because the attraction between
molecules, which are electrically neutral, is weaker than that between electrically charged ions, covalent compounds generally have
much lower melting and boiling points than ionic compounds. In fact, many covalent compounds are liquids or gases at room
temperature, and, in their solid states, they are typically much softer than ionic solids. Furthermore, whereas ionic compounds are
good conductors of electricity when dissolved in water, most covalent compounds, being electrically neutral, are poor conductors
of electricity in any state.
Conversely, the same amount of energy is released when one mole of H2 molecules forms from two moles of H atoms:
Cl + Cl ⟶ Cl
2
The total number of electrons around each individual atom consists of six nonbonding electrons and two shared (i.e., bonding)
electrons for eight total electrons, matching the number of valence electrons in the noble gas argon. Since the bonding atoms are
identical, Cl2 also features a pure covalent bond.
When the atoms linked by a covalent bond are different, the bonding electrons are shared, but no longer equally. Instead, the
bonding electrons are more attracted to one atom than the other, giving rise to a shift of electron density toward that atom. This
unequal distribution of electrons is known as a polar covalent bond, characterized by a partial positive charge on one atom and a
partial negative charge on the other. The atom that attracts the electrons more strongly acquires the partial negative charge and vice
versa. For example, the electrons in the H–Cl bond of a hydrogen chloride molecule spend more time near the chlorine atom than
near the hydrogen atom. Thus, in an HCl molecule, the chlorine atom carries a partial negative charge and the hydrogen atom has a
partial positive charge. Figure 7.2.2 shows the distribution of electrons in the H–Cl bond. Note that the shaded area around Cl is
much larger than it is around H. Compare this to Figure 7.2.1, which shows the even distribution of electrons in the H2 nonpolar
bond.
7.2.3: Electronegativity
Whether a bond is nonpolar or polar covalent is determined by a property of the bonding atoms called electronegativity.
Electronegativity is a measure of the tendency of an atom to attract electrons (or electron density) towards itself. It determines how
the shared electrons are distributed between the two atoms in a bond. The more strongly an atom attracts the electrons in its bonds,
the larger its electronegativity. Electrons in a polar covalent bond are shifted toward the more electronegative atom; thus, the more
electronegative atom is the one with the partial negative charge. The greater the difference in electronegativity, the more polarized
the electron distribution and the larger the partial charges of the atoms.
Figure 7.2.3 shows the electronegativity values of the elements as proposed by one of the most famous chemists of the twentieth
century: Linus Pauling. In general, electronegativity increases from left to right across a period in the periodic table and decreases
down a group. Thus, the nonmetals, which lie in the upper right, tend to have the highest electronegativities, with fluorine the most
electronegative element of all (EN = 4.0). Metals tend to be less electronegative elements, and the group 1 metals have the lowest
electronegativities. Note that noble gases are excluded from this figure because these atoms usually do not share electrons with
others atoms since they have a full valence shell. (While noble gas compounds such as XeO2 do exist, they can only be formed
under extreme conditions, and thus they do not fit neatly into the general model of electronegativity.)
Figure 7.2.3 : The electronegativity values derived by Pauling follow predictable periodic trends with the higher electronegativities
toward the upper right of the periodic table.
Linus Pauling
Linus Pauling is the only person to have received two unshared (individual) Nobel Prizes: one for chemistry in 1954 for his
work on the nature of chemical bonds and one for peace in 1962 for his opposition to weapons of mass destruction. He
developed many of the theories and concepts that are foundational to our current understanding of chemistry, including
electronegativity and resonance structures.
Figure 7.2.4 : As the electronegativity difference increases between two atoms, the bond becomes more ionic.
A rough approximation of the electronegativity differences associated with covalent, polar covalent, and ionic bonds is shown in
Figure 7.2.4. This table is just a general guide, however, with many exceptions. For example, the H and F atoms in HF have an
electronegativity difference of 1.9, and the N and H atoms in NH3 a difference of 0.9, yet both of these compounds form bonds that
are considered polar covalent. Likewise, the Na and Cl atoms in NaCl have an electronegativity difference of 2.1, and the Mn and I
atoms in MnI2 have a difference of 1.0, yet both of these substances form ionic compounds.
The best guide to the covalent or ionic character of a bond is to consider the types of atoms involved and their relative positions in
the periodic table. Bonds between two nonmetals are generally covalent; bonding between a metal and a nonmetal is often ionic.
Some compounds contain both covalent and ionic bonds. The atoms in polyatomic ions, such as OH–, NO , and NH , are held
−
3
+
together by polar covalent bonds. However, these polyatomic ions form ionic compounds by combining with ions of opposite
nitrate is ionic, resulting from the electrostatic attraction between the ions K+ and NO , as well as covalent between the nitrogen
−
Bond polarities play an important role in determining the structure of proteins. Using the electronegativity values in Table A2,
arrange the following covalent bonds—all commonly found in amino acids—in order of increasing polarity. Then designate the
positive and negative atoms using the symbols δ+ and δ–:
C–H, C–N, C–O, N–H, O–H, S–H
Solution
The polarity of these bonds increases as the absolute value of the electronegativity difference increases. The atom with the δ–
designation is the more electronegative of the two. Table 7.2.1 shows these bonds in order of increasing polarity.
Table 7.2.1 : Bond Polarity and Electronegativity Difference
Bond ΔEN Polarity
δ− δ+
C–H 0.4 C − H
δ− δ+
S–H 0.4 S − H
δ+ δ−
C–N 0.5 C − N
δ− δ+
N–H 0.9 N − H
δ+ δ−
C–O 1.0 C − O
δ− δ+
O–H 1.4 O − H
Exercise 7.2.1
Silicones are polymeric compounds containing, among others, the following types of covalent bonds: Si–O, Si–C, C–H, and
C–C. Using the electronegativity values in Figure 7.2.3, arrange the bonds in order of increasing polarity and designate the
positive and negative atoms using the symbols δ+ and δ–.
Answer
Answer to Exercise 7.2.1
Bond Electronegativity Difference Polarity
δ+ δ−
Si–C 0.7 Si − C
δ+ δ−
Si–O 1.7 Si − O
Summary
Covalent bonds form when electrons are shared between atoms and are attracted by the nuclei of both atoms. In pure covalent
bonds, the electrons are shared equally. In polar covalent bonds, the electrons are shared unequally, as one atom exerts a stronger
force of attraction on the electrons than the other. The ability of an atom to attract a pair of electrons in a chemical bond is called its
electronegativity. The difference in electronegativity between two atoms determines how polar a bond will be. In a diatomic
Glossary
bond length
distance between the nuclei of two bonded atoms at which the lowest potential energy is achieved
covalent bond
bond formed when electrons are shared between atoms
electronegativity
tendency of an atom to attract electrons in a bond to itself
This page titled 7.2: Covalent Bonding is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Thus far, we have discussed the various types of bonds that form between atoms and/or ions. In all cases, these bonds involve the
sharing or transfer of valence shell electrons between atoms. In this section, we will explore the typical method for depicting
valence shell electrons and chemical bonds, namely Lewis symbols and Lewis structures.
Figure 7.3.1 shows the Lewis symbols for the elements of the third period of the periodic table. Electron dots are typically arranged
in four pairs located on the four "sides" of the atomic symbol.
Figure 7.3.1 : Lewis symbols illustrating the number of valence electrons for each element in the third period of the periodic table.
Lewis symbols can be used to illustrate the formation of cations from atoms, as shown here for sodium and calcium:
Likewise, they can be used to show the formation of anions from atoms, as shown here for chlorine and sulfur:
Figure 7.3.2 demonstrates the use of Lewis symbols to show the transfer of electrons during the formation of ionic compounds.
The Lewis structure indicates that each Cl atom has three pairs of electrons that are not used in bonding (called lone pairs) and one
shared pair of electrons (written between the atoms). A dash (or line) is usually used to indicate a shared pair of electrons:
In the Lewis model, a single shared pair of electrons is a single bond. Each Cl atom interacts with eight valence electrons total: the
six in the lone pairs and the two in the single bond.
A triple bond forms when three electron pairs are shared by a pair of atoms, as in carbon monoxide (CO) and the cyanide ion
(CN–):
For more complicated molecules and molecular ions, it is helpful to follow the step-by-step procedure outlined here:
1. Determine the total number of valence (outer shell) electrons among all the atoms. For cations, subtract one electron for each
positive charge. For anions, add one electron for each negative charge.
2. Draw a skeleton structure of the molecule or ion, arranging the atoms around a central atom. (Generally, the least
electronegative element should be placed in the center.) Connect each atom to the central atom with a single bond (one electron
pair).
3. Distribute the remaining electrons as lone pairs on the terminal atoms (except hydrogen), completing an octet around each
atom.
1. Determine the total number of valence (outer shell) electrons in the molecule or ion.
For a molecule, we add the number of valence electrons on each atom in the molecule:
SiH (7.3.1)
4
For a negative ion, such as CHO , we add the number of valence electrons on the atoms to the number of negative charges
−
on the ion (one electron is gained for each single negative charge):
−
CHO
2
+ 1 additional electron = 1
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
= 18 valence electrons
For a positive ion, such as NO+, we add the number of valence electrons on the atoms in the ion and then subtract the
number of positive charges on the ion (one electron is lost for each single positive charge) from the total number of valence
electrons:
+
NO
2. Draw a skeleton structure of the molecule or ion, arranging the atoms around a central atom and connecting each atom to the
central atom with a single (one electron pair) bond. (Note that we denote ions with brackets around the structure, indicating the
charge outside the brackets:)
3. When several arrangements of atoms are possible, as for CHO , we must use experimental evidence to choose the correct one.
−
In general, the less electronegative elements are more likely to be central atoms. In CHO , the less electronegative carbon
−
atom occupies the central position with the oxygen and hydrogen atoms surrounding it. Other examples include P in POCl3, S in
SO2, and Cl in ClO . An exception is that hydrogen is almost never a central atom. As the most electronegative element,
−
For OF2, we had 16 electrons remaining in Step 3, and we placed 12, leaving 4 to be placed on the central atom:
6. Rearrange the electrons of the outer atoms to make multiple bonds with the central atom in order to obtain octets wherever
possible.
SiH4: Si already has an octet, so nothing needs to be done.
CHO : We have distributed the valence electrons as lone pairs on the oxygen atoms, but the carbon atom lacks an octet:
−
NO+: For this ion, we added eight outer electrons, but neither atom has an octet. We cannot add any more electrons since we
have already used the total that we found in Step 1, so we must move electrons to form a multiple bond:
This still does not produce an octet, so we must move another pair, forming a triple bond:
NASA’s Cassini-Huygens mission detected a large cloud of toxic hydrogen cyanide (HCN) on Titan, one of Saturn’s moons.
Titan also contains ethane (H3CCH3), acetylene (HCCH), and ammonia (NH3). What are the Lewis structures of these
molecules?
Solution
Calculate the number of valence electrons.
HCN: (1 × 1) + (4 × 1) + (5 × 1) = 10
H3CCH3: (1 × 3) + (2 × 4) + (1 × 3) = 14
HCCH: (1 × 1) + (2 × 4) + (1 × 1) = 10
NH3: (5 × 1) + (3 × 1) = 8
Draw a skeleton and connect the atoms with single bonds. Remember that H is never a central atom:
Exercise 7.3.1
Both carbon monoxide, CO, and carbon dioxide, CO2, are products of the combustion of fossil fuels. Both of these gases also
cause problems: CO is toxic and CO2 has been implicated in global climate change. What are the Lewis structures of these two
molecules?
Answer
Fullerene Chemistry
Carbon soot has been known to man since prehistoric times, but it was not until fairly recently that the molecular structure of
the main component of soot was discovered. In 1996, the Nobel Prize in Chemistry was awarded to Richard Smalley, Robert
Curl, and Harold Kroto for their work in discovering a new form of carbon, the C60 buckminsterfullerene molecule. An entire
class of compounds, including spheres and tubes of various shapes, were discovered based on C60. This type of molecule,
called a fullerene, consists of a complex network of single- and double-bonded carbon atoms arranged in such a way that each
carbon atom obtains a full octet of electrons. Because of their size and shape, fullerenes can encapsulate other molecules, so
they have shown potential in various applications from hydrogen storage to targeted drug delivery systems. They also possess
unique electronic and optical properties that have been put to good use in solar powered devices and chemical sensors.
4. Place all remaining electrons on the central atom. Since there are no remaining electrons, this step does not apply.
5. Rearrange the electrons to make multiple bonds with the central atom in order to obtain octets wherever possible. We know that
an odd-electron molecule cannot have an octet for every atom, but we want to get each atom as close to an octet as possible. In
this case, nitrogen has only five electrons around it. To move closer to an octet for nitrogen, we take one of the lone pairs from
oxygen and use it to form a NO double bond. (We cannot take another lone pair of electrons on oxygen and form a triple bond
because nitrogen would then have nine electrons:)
An atom like the boron atom in BF3, which does not have eight electrons, is very reactive. It readily combines with a molecule
containing an atom with a lone pair of electrons. For example, NH3 reacts with BF3 because the lone pair on nitrogen can be shared
with the boron atom:
Table 7.3.5: In PCl5, the central atom phosphorus shares five pairs of electrons. In SF6, sulfur shares six pairs of electrons.
In some hypervalent molecules, such as IF5 and XeF4, some of the electrons in the outer shell of the central atom are lone pairs:
When we write the Lewis structures for these molecules, we find that we have electrons left over after filling the valence shells of
the outer atoms with eight electrons. These additional electrons must be assigned to the central atom.
Xenon is a noble gas, but it forms a number of stable compounds. We examined XeF earlier. What are the Lewis structures of
4
Solution
We can draw the Lewis structure of any covalent molecule by following the six steps discussed earlier. In this case, we can
condense the last few steps, since not all of them apply.
Step 1: Calculate the number of valence electrons:
XeF
2
: 8 + (2 × 7) = 22
XeF
6
: 8 + (6 × 7) = 50
Step 2: Draw a skeleton joining the atoms by single bonds. Xenon will be the central atom because fluorine cannot be a
central atom:
XeF6: We place three lone pairs of electrons around each F atom, accounting for 36 electrons. Two electrons remain, and this lone
pair is placed on the Xe atom:
The halogens form a class of compounds called the interhalogens, in which halogen atoms covalently bond to each other. Write
the Lewis structures for the interhalogens BrCl and ICl .
3
−
4
Answer
Summary
Valence electronic structures can be visualized by drawing Lewis symbols (for atoms and monatomic ions) and Lewis structures
(for molecules and polyatomic ions). Lone pairs, unpaired electrons, and single, double, or triple bonds are used to indicate where
the valence electrons are located around each atom in a Lewis structure. Most structures—especially those containing second row
elements—obey the octet rule, in which every atom (except H) is surrounded by eight electrons. Exceptions to the octet rule occur
for odd-electron molecules (free radicals), electron-deficient molecules, and hypervalent molecules.
Glossary
double bond
covalent bond in which two pairs of electrons are shared between two atoms
free radical
molecule that contains an odd number of electrons
hypervalent molecule
molecule containing at least one main group element that has more than eight electrons in its valence shell
Lewis structure
diagram showing lone pairs and bonding pairs of electrons in a molecule or an ion
Lewis symbol
symbol for an element or monatomic ion that uses a dot to represent each valence electron in the element or ion
lone pair
two (a pair of) valence electrons that are not used to form a covalent bond
octet rule
guideline that states main group atoms will form structures in which eight valence electrons interact with each nucleus, counting
bonding electrons as interacting with both atoms connected by the bond
single bond
This page titled 7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Previously, we discussed how to write Lewis structures for molecules and polyatomic ions. In some cases, however, there is
seemingly more than one valid structure for a molecule. We can use the concept of formal charges to help us predict the most
appropriate Lewis structure when more than one is reasonable.
We can double-check formal charge calculations by determining the sum of the formal charges for the whole structure. The sum of
the formal charges of all atoms in a molecule must be zero; the sum of the formal charges in an ion should equal the charge of the
ion.
We must remember that the formal charge calculated for an atom is not the actual charge of the atom in the molecule. Formal
charge is only a useful bookkeeping procedure; it does not indicate the presence of actual charges.
Solution
We divide the bonding electron pairs equally for all I– Cl bonds:
We assign lone pairs of electrons to their atoms. Each Cl atom now has seven electrons assigned to it, and the I atom has eight.
Subtract this number from the number of valence electrons for the neutral atom:
I: 7 – 8 = –1
Cl: 7 – 7 = 0
The sum of the formal charges of all the atoms equals –1, which is identical to the charge of the ion (–1).
Calculate the formal charge for each atom in the carbon monoxide molecule:
Answer
C −1, O +1
Solution
Assign one of the electrons in each Br–Cl bond to the Br atom and one to the Cl atom in that bond:
Assign the lone pairs to their atom. Now each Cl atom has seven electrons and the Br atom has seven electrons.
Subtract this number from the number of valence electrons for the neutral atom. This gives the formal charge:
Br: 7 – 7 = 0
Cl: 7 – 7 = 0
All atoms in BrCl
3
have a formal charge of zero, and the sum of the formal charges totals zero, as it must in a neutral
molecule.
Exercise 7.4.2
Answer
N: 0; all three Cl atoms: 0
To see how these guidelines apply, let us consider some possible structures for carbon dioxide, CO . We know from our previous
2
discussion that the less electronegative atom typically occupies the central position, but formal charges allow us to understand why
this occurs. We can draw three possibilities for the structure: carbon in the center and double bonds, carbon in the center with a
single and triple bond, and oxygen in the center with double bonds:
Three Lewis structures are shown. The left and right structures show a carbon atom double bonded to two oxygen atoms, each of
which has two lone pairs of electrons. The center structure shows a carbon atom that is triple bonded to an oxygen atom with one
lone pair of electrons and single bonded to an oxygen atom with three lone pairs of electrons. The third structure shows an oxygen
atom double bonded to another oxygen atom with to lone pairs of electrons. The first oxygen atom is also double bonded to a
carbon atom with two lone pairs of electrons.
Comparing the three formal charges, we can definitively identify the structure on the left as preferable because it has only formal
charges of zero (Guideline 1).
As another example, the thiocyanate ion, an ion formed from a carbon atom, a nitrogen atom, and a sulfur atom, could have three
different molecular structures: CNS , NCS , or CSN . The formal charges present in each of these molecular structures can help
– – –
us pick the most likely arrangement of atoms. Possible Lewis structures and the formal charges for each of the three possible
structures for the thiocyanate ion are shown here:
Two rows of structures and numbers are shown. The top row is labeled, “Structure” and depicts three Lewis structures and the
bottom row is labeled, “Formal charge.” The left structure shows a carbon atom double bonded to a nitrogen atom with two lone
electron pairs on one side and double bonded to a sulfur atom with two lone electron pairs on the other. The structure is surrounded
by brackets and has a superscripted negative sign. Below this structure are the numbers negative one, zero, and zero. The middle
structure shows a carbon atom with two lone pairs of electrons double bonded to a nitrogen atom that is double bonded to a sulfur
atom with two lone electron pairs. The structure is surrounded by brackets and has a superscripted negative sign. Below this
structure are the numbers negative two, positive one, and zero. The right structure shows a carbon atom with two lone electron
pairs double bonded to a sulfur atom that is double bonded to a nitrogen atom with two lone electron pairs. The structure is
surrounded by brackets and has a superscripted negative sign. Below this structure are the numbers negative two, positive two, and
one.
Note that the sum of the formal charges in each case is equal to the charge of the ion (–1). However, the first arrangement of atoms
is preferred because it has the lowest number of atoms with nonzero formal charges (Guideline 2). Also, it places the least
electronegative atom in the center, and the negative charge on the more electronegative element (Guideline 4).
Nitrous oxide, N2O, commonly known as laughing gas, is used as an anesthetic in minor surgeries, such as the routine
extraction of wisdom teeth. Which is the likely structure for nitrous oxide?
The structure with a terminal oxygen atom best satisfies the criteria for the most stable distribution of formal charge:
The number of atoms with formal charges are minimized (Guideline 2), and there is no formal charge larger than one
(Guideline 2). This is again consistent with the preference for having the less electronegative atom in the central position.
Exercise 7.4.3
Which is the most likely molecular structure for the nitrite (NO ) ion?
−
Answer
–
ONO
7.4.3: Resonance
You may have noticed that the nitrite anion in Example 7.4.3 can have two possible structures with the atoms in the same positions.
The electrons involved in the N–O double bond, however, are in different positions:
Two Lewis structures are shown. The left structure shows an oxygen atom with three lone pairs of electrons single bonded to a
nitrogen atom with one lone pair of electrons that is double bonded to an oxygen with two lone pairs of electrons. Brackets
surround this structure, and there is a superscripted negative sign. The right structure shows an oxygen atom with two lone pairs of
electrons double bonded to a nitrogen atom with one lone pair of electrons that is single bonded to an oxygen atom with three lone
pairs of electrons. Brackets surround this structure, and there is a superscripted negative sign.
If nitrite ions do indeed contain a single and a double bond, we would expect for the two bond lengths to be different. A double
bond between two atoms is shorter (and stronger) than a single bond between the same two atoms. Experiments show, however,
that both N–O bonds in NO have the same strength and length, and are identical in all other properties.
−
2
It is not possible to write a single Lewis structure for NO in which nitrogen has an octet and both bonds are equivalent. Instead,
−
we use the concept of resonance: if two or more Lewis structures with the same arrangement of atoms can be written for a molecule
or ion, the actual distribution of electrons is an average of that shown by the various Lewis structures. The actual distribution of
electrons in each of the nitrogen-oxygen bonds in NO is the average of a double bond and a single bond. We call the individual
−
Lewis structures resonance forms. The actual electronic structure of the molecule (the average of the resonance forms) is called a
resonance hybrid of the individual resonance forms. A double-headed arrow between Lewis structures indicates that they are
resonance forms. Thus, the electronic structure of the NO ion is shown as:
−
Three Lewis structures are shown with double headed arrows in between. Each structure is surrounded by brackets, and each has a
superscripted two negative sign. The left structure depicts a carbon atom bonded to three oxygen atoms. It is single bonded to two
of these oxygen atoms, each of which has three lone pairs of electrons, and double bonded to the third, which has two lone pairs of
electrons. The double bond is located between the lower left oxygen atom and the carbon atom. The central and right structures are
the same as the first, but the position of the double bonded oxygen has moved to the lower right oxygen in the central structure and
to the top oxygen in the right structure.
One oxygen atom must have a double bond to carbon to complete the octet on the central atom. All oxygen atoms, however, are
equivalent, and the double bond could form from any one of the three atoms. This gives rise to three resonance forms of the
carbonate ion. Because we can write three identical resonance structures, we know that the actual arrangement of electrons in the
carbonate ion is the average of the three structures. Again, experiments show that all three C–O bonds are exactly the same.
Summary
In a Lewis structure, formal charges can be assigned to each atom by treating each bond as if one-half of the electrons are assigned
to each atom. These hypothetical formal charges are a guide to determining the most appropriate Lewis structure. A structure in
which the formal charges are as close to zero as possible is preferred. Resonance occurs in cases where two or more Lewis
structures with identical arrangements of atoms but different distributions of electrons can be written. The actual distribution of
electrons (the resonance hybrid) is an average of the distribution indicated by the individual Lewis structures (the resonance forms).
Glossary
formal charge
charge that would result on an atom by taking the number of valence electrons on the neutral atom and subtracting the
nonbonding electrons and the number of bonds (one-half of the bonding electrons)
resonance
situation in which one Lewis structure is insufficient to describe the bonding in a molecule and the average of multiple
structures is observed
resonance forms
two or more Lewis structures that have the same arrangement of atoms but different arrangements of electrons
resonance hybrid
average of the resonance forms shown by the individual Lewis structures
This page titled 7.4: Formal Charges and Resonance is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
A bond’s strength describes how strongly each atom is joined to another atom, and therefore how much energy is required to break
the bond between the two atoms. In this section, you will learn about the bond strength of covalent bonds, and then compare that to
the strength of ionic bonds, which is related to the lattice energy of a compound.
For example, the bond energy of the pure covalent H–H bond, Δ H –H , is 436 kJ per mole of H–H bonds broken:
A reaction is shown with Lewis structures. The first structure shows a carbon atom single bonded to four hydrogen atoms with the
symbol, “( g )” written next to it. A right-facing arrow points to the letter “C” and the symbol “( g ),” which is followed by a plus
sign. Next is the number 4, the letter “H” and the symbol, “( g ).” To the right of this equation is another equation: capital delta H
superscript degree symbol equals 1660 k J.
The average C–H bond energy, D , is 1660/4 = 415 kJ/mol because there are four moles of C–H bonds broken per mole of the
C –H
reaction. Although the four C–H bonds are equivalent in the original molecule, they do not each require the same energy to break;
once the first bond is broken (which requires 439 kJ/mol), the remaining bonds are easier to break. The 415 kJ/mol value is the
average, not the exact value required to break any one bond.
The strength of a bond between two atoms increases as the number of electron pairs in the bond increases. Generally, as the bond
strength increases, the bond length decreases. Thus, we find that triple bonds are stronger and shorter than double bonds between
the same two atoms; likewise, double bonds are stronger and shorter than single bonds between the same two atoms. Average bond
energies for some common bonds appear in Table 7.5.2, and a comparison of bond lengths and bond strengths for some common
bonds appears in Table 7.5.2. When one atom bonds to various atoms in a group, the bond strength typically decreases as we move
down the group. For example, C–F is 439 kJ/mol, C–Cl is 330 kJ/mol, and C–Br is 275 kJ/mol.
Table 7.5.1 : Bond Energies (kJ/mol)
Bond Bond Energy Bond Bond Energy Bond Bond Energy
Table 7.5.2 : Average Bond Lengths and Bond Energies for Some Common Bonds
Bond Bond Length (Å) Bond Energy (kJ/mol)
C = C 1.34 611
C ≡ C 1.20 837
C = N 1.38 615
C ≡ N 1.16 891
C = O 1.23 741
C ≡ O 1.13 1080
We can use bond energies to calculate approximate enthalpy changes for reactions where enthalpies of formation are not available.
Calculations of this type will also tell us whether a reaction is exothermic or endothermic.
The enthalpy change, ΔH, for a chemical reaction is approximately equal to the sum of the energy required to break all bonds in the
reactants (energy “in”, positive sign) plus the energy released when all bonds are formed in the products (energy “out,” negative
sign). This can be expressed mathematically in the following way:
In this expression, the symbol Σ means “the sum of” and D represents the bond energy in kilojoules per mole, which is always a
positive number. The bond energy is obtained from a table and will depend on whether the particular bond is a single, double, or
triple bond. Thus, in calculating enthalpies in this manner, it is important that we consider the bonding in all reactants and products.
Because D values are typically averages for one type of bond in many different molecules, this calculation provides a rough
estimate, not an exact value, for the enthalpy of reaction.
Consider the following reaction:
H + Cl ⟶ 2 HCl (7.5.4)
2 (g) 2 (g) (g)
or
H– H + Cl– Cl ⟶ 2 H– Cl (7.5.5)
(g) (g) (g)
To form two moles of HCl, one mole of H–H bonds and one mole of Cl–Cl bonds must be broken. The energy required to break
these bonds is the sum of the bond energy of the H–H bond (436 kJ/mol) and the Cl–Cl bond (243 kJ/mol). During the reaction,
two moles of H–Cl bonds are formed (bond energy = 432 kJ/mol), releasing 2 × 432 kJ; or 864 kJ. Because the bonds in the
products are stronger than those in the reactants, the reaction releases more energy than it consumes:
This excess energy is released as heat, so the reaction is exothermic. Table T2 gives a value for the standard molar enthalpy of
formation of HCl(g), ΔH , of –92.307 kJ/mol. Twice that value is –184.6 kJ, which agrees well with the answer obtained earlier
∘
f
Methanol, CH3OH, may be an excellent alternative fuel. The high-temperature reaction of steam and carbon produces a
mixture of the gases carbon monoxide, CO, and hydrogen, H2, from which methanol can be produced. Using the bond energies
in Table 7.5.2, calculate the approximate enthalpy change, ΔH, for the reaction here:
Solution
First, we need to write the Lewis structures of the reactants and the products:
= −107 kJ
We can compare this value to the value calculated based on ΔH data from Appendix G:
∘
f
∘ ∘ ∘
ΔH = [ΔH CH OH(g)] − [ΔH CO(g) + 2 × ΔH H ]
f 3 f f 2
= [−201.0] − [−110.52 + 2 × 0]
= −90.5 kJ
Note that there is a fairly significant gap between the values calculated using the two different methods. This occurs because D
values are the average of different bond strengths; therefore, they often give only rough agreement with other data.
Exercise 7.5.1
Ethyl alcohol, CH3CH2OH, was one of the first organic chemicals deliberately synthesized by humans. It has many uses in
industry, and it is the alcohol contained in alcoholic beverages. It can be obtained by the fermentation of sugar or synthesized
by the hydration of ethylene in the following reaction:
A set of Lewis structures show a chemical reaction. The first structure shows two carbon atoms that are double bonded
together and are each single bonded to two hydrogen atoms. This structure is followed by a plus sign, then an oxygen atom
with two lone pairs of electrons single bonded to two hydrogen atoms. A right-facing arrow leads to a carbon atom single
bonded to three hydrogen atoms and a second carbon atom. The second carbon atom is single bonded to two hydrogen atoms
and an oxygen atom with two lone pairs of electrons. The oxygen atom is single bonded to a hydrogen atom as well.
Using the bond energies in Table 7.5.2, calculate an approximate enthalpy change, ΔH, for this reaction.
Answer
–35 kJ
energy required to separate one mole of the solid into its component gaseous ions. For the ionic solid MX, the lattice energy is the
enthalpy change of the process:
Note that we are using the convention where the ionic solid is separated into ions, so our lattice energies will be endothermic
(positive values). Some texts use the equivalent but opposite convention, defining lattice energy as the energy released when
separate ions combine to form a lattice and giving negative (exothermic) values. Thus, if you are looking up lattice energies in
another reference, be certain to check which definition is being used. In both cases, a larger magnitude for lattice energy indicates a
more stable ionic compound. For sodium chloride, ΔHlattice = 769 kJ. Thus, it requires 769 kJ to separate one mole of solid NaCl
into gaseous Na+ and Cl– ions. When one mole each of gaseous Na+ and Cl– ions form solid NaCl, 769 kJ of heat is released.
The lattice energy ΔH of an ionic crystal can be expressed by the following equation (derived from Coulomb’s law,
lattice
in which
C is a constant that depends on the type of crystal structure;
Z and Z are the charges on the ions; and
+ –
R is the interionic distance (the sum of the radii of the positive and negative ions).
o
Thus, the lattice energy of an ionic crystal increases rapidly as the charges of the ions increase and the sizes of the ions decrease.
When all other parameters are kept constant, doubling the charge of both the cation and anion quadruples the lattice energy. For
example, the lattice energy of LiF (Z+ and Z– = 1) is 1023 kJ/mol, whereas that of MgO (Z+ and Z– = 2) is 3900 kJ/mol (Ro is
nearly the same—about 200 pm for both compounds).
Different interatomic distances produce different lattice energies. For example, we can compare the lattice energy of MgF2 (2957
kJ/mol) to that of MgI2 (2327 kJ/mol) to observe the effect on lattice energy of the smaller ionic size of F– as compared to I–.
The precious gem ruby is aluminum oxide, Al2O3, containing traces of Cr3+. The compound Al2Se3 is used in the fabrication of
some semiconductor devices. Which has the larger lattice energy, Al2O3 or Al2Se3?
Solution
In these two ionic compounds, the charges Z+ and Z– are the same, so the difference in lattice energy will mainly depend upon
Ro. The O2– ion is smaller than the Se2– ion. Thus, Al2O3 would have a shorter interionic distance than Al2Se3, and Al2O3
would have the larger lattice energy.
Exercise 7.5.2
Zinc oxide, ZnO, is a very effective sunscreen. How would the lattice energy of ZnO compare to that of NaCl?
Answer
ZnO would have the larger lattice energy because the Z values of both the cation and the anion in ZnO are greater, and the
interionic distance of ZnO is smaller than that of NaCl.
Figure 7.5.1 : The Born-Haber cycle shows the relative energies of each step involved in the formation of an ionic solid from the
necessary elements in their reference states.
A diagram is shown. An upward facing arrow is drawn to the far left of the chart and is labeled “H increasing.” A horizontal line is
drawn at the bottom of the chart. A downward-facing, vertical arrow to the left side of this line is labeled, “Overall change.” Beside
this arrow is another label, “capital delta H subscript f, equals negative 553.5 k J per mol, ( Enthalpy of formation ).” Three
horizontal lines, one above the other, and all above the bottom line, are labeled, from bottom to top, as: “C s ( s ), plus sign, one
half F subscript 2, ( g ),” “C s ( g ), plus sign, one half F subscript 2, ( g ),” and “C s, superscript positive sign, ( g ), plus sign, one
half F subscript 2, ( g ).” Each of these lines is connected by an upward-facing vertical arrow. Each arrow is labeled, “capital delta
H subscript 1, equals 76.5 k J per mol, ( Enthalpy of sublimation ),” “capital delta H subscript 2, equals 375.7 k J per mol, (
ionization energy ),” and “capital delta H subscript 3 equals 79.4 k J / mol ( one half dissociation energy ).” Another horizontal line
is drawn in the center top portion of the diagram and is labeled “C s, superscript positive sign, ( g ), plus sign, F, ( g ).” There is one
more horizontal line drawn to the right of the overall diagram and located halfway down the image. An arrow connects the top line
to this line and is labeled, “capital delta H equals negative 328.2 k J / mol ( electron affinity ).” The line is labeled, “C s superscript
positive sign ( g ) plus F superscript negative sign ( g ).” The arrow connecting this line to the bottom line is labeled, “negative
capital delta H subscript lattice equals negative 756.9 k J / mol.” The arrow points to a label on the bottom line which reads, “C s F
( s ).”
We begin with the elements in their most common states, Cs(s) and F2(g). The ΔH represents the conversion of solid cesium into
∘
s
a gas, and then the ionization energy converts the gaseous cesium atoms into cations. In the next step, we account for the energy
required to break the F–F bond to produce fluorine atoms. Converting one mole of fluorine atoms into fluoride ions is an
exothermic process, so this step gives off energy (the electron affinity) and is shown as decreasing along the y-axis. We now have
one mole of Cs cations and one mole of F anions. These ions combine to produce solid cesium fluoride. The enthalpy change in
this step is the negative of the lattice energy, so it is also an exothermic quantity. The total energy involved in this conversion is
equal to the experimentally determined enthalpy of formation, ΔH , of the compound from its elements. In this case, the overall
f
∘
change is exothermic.
Hess’s law can also be used to show the relationship between the enthalpies of the individual steps and the enthalpy of formation.
Table 7.5.3 shows this for cesium fluoride, CsF.
Table 7.5.3 : Enthalpies of Select Transitions
Enthalpy of sublimation of Cs(s) Cs(s) ⟶ Cs(g)
∘
ΔH = ΔHs = 77 kJ/mol
1 1
One-half of the bond energy of F2 F (g) ⟶ F(g)
2
ΔH = D = 79 kJ/mol
2 2
Thus, the lattice energy can be calculated from other values. For cesium chloride, using this data, the lattice energy is:
The Born-Haber cycle may also be used to calculate any one of the other quantities in the equation for lattice energy, provided that
the remainder is known. For example, if the relevant enthalpy of sublimation ΔH , ionization energy (IE), bond dissociation
∘
s
enthalpy (D), lattice energy ΔHlattice, and standard enthalpy of formation ΔH are known, the Born-Haber cycle can be used to
∘
f
Summary
The strength of a covalent bond is measured by its bond dissociation energy, that is, the amount of energy required to break that
particular bond in a mole of molecules. Multiple bonds are stronger than single bonds between the same atoms. The enthalpy of a
reaction can be estimated based on the energy input required to break bonds and the energy released when new bonds are formed.
For ionic bonds, the lattice energy is the energy required to separate one mole of a compound into its gas phase ions. Lattice energy
increases for ions with higher charges and shorter distances between ions. Lattice energies are often calculated using the Born-
Haber cycle, a thermochemical cycle including all of the energetic steps involved in converting elements into an ionic compound.
Footnotes
1. This question is taken from the Chemistry Advanced Placement Examination and is used with the permission of the Educational
Testing Service.
Glossary
bond energy
(also, bond dissociation energy) energy required to break a covalent bond in a gaseous substance
Born-Haber cycle
thermochemical cycle relating the various energetic steps involved in the formation of an ionic solid from the relevant elements
lattice energy (ΔHlattice)
energy required to separate one mole of an ionic solid into its component gaseous ions
This page titled 7.5: Strengths of Ionic and Covalent Bonds is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Thus far, we have used two-dimensional Lewis structures to represent molecules. However, molecular structure is actually three-
dimensional, and it is important to be able to describe molecular bonds in terms of their distances, angles, and relative
arrangements in space (Figure 7.6.1). A bond angle is the angle between any two bonds that include a common atom, usually
measured in degrees. A bond distance (or bond length) is the distance between the nuclei of two bonded atoms along the straight
line joining the nuclei. Bond distances are measured in Ångstroms (1 Å = 10–10 m) or picometers (1 pm = 10–12 m, 100 pm = 1 Å).
Figure 7.6.1 : Bond distances (lengths) and angles are shown for the formaldehyde molecule, H2CO.
A pair of images are shown. The left image shows a carbon atom with three atoms bonded in a triangular arrangement around it.
There are two hydrogen atoms bonded on the left side of the carbon and the angle between them is labeled, “118 degrees” and,
“Bond angle.” The carbon is also double bonded to an oxygen atom. The double bond is shaded and there is a bracket which labels
the bond, “Bond length ( angstrom ), ( center to center ),” and, “1.21 angstrom.” The right image shows a ball-and-stick model of
the same elements. The hydrogen atoms are white, the carbon atom is black, and the oxygen atom is red."
Figure 7.6.5 : (a) The electron-pair geometry for the ammonia molecule is tetrahedral with one lone pair and three single bonds. (b)
The trigonal pyramidal molecular structure is determined from the electron-pair geometry. (c) The actual bond angles deviate
slightly from the idealized angles because the lone pair takes up a larger region of space than do the single bonds, causing the HNH
angle to be slightly smaller than 109.5°.
Three images are shown and labeled, “a,” “b,” and “c.” Image a shows a nitrogen atom single bonded to three hydrogen atoms.
There are four oval-shaped orbs that surround each hydrogen and one facing away from the rest of the molecule. These orbs are
located in a tetrahedral arrangement. Image b shows a ball-and-stick model of the nitrogen single bonded to the three hydrogen
atoms. Image c is the same as image a, but there are four curved, double headed arrows that circle the molecule and are labeled,
“106.8 degrees.”
Small distortions from the ideal angles in Figure 7.6.5 can result from differences in repulsion between various regions of electron
density. VSEPR theory predicts these distortions by establishing an order of repulsions and an order of the amount of space
occupied by different kinds of electron pairs. The order of electron-pair repulsions from greatest to least repulsion is:
lone pair-lone pair > lone pair-bonding pair > bonding pair-bonding pair
This order of repulsions determines the amount of space occupied by different regions of electrons. A lone pair of electrons
occupies a larger region of space than the electrons in a triple bond; in turn, electrons in a triple bond occupy more space than those
in a double bond, and so on. The order of sizes from largest to smallest is:
lone pair > triple bond > double bond > single bond
Consider formaldehyde, H2CO, which is used as a preservative for biological and anatomical specimens. This molecule has regions
of high electron density that consist of two single bonds and one double bond. The basic geometry is trigonal planar with 120°
bond angles, but we see that the double bond causes slightly larger angles (121°), and the angle between the single bonds is slightly
smaller (118°).
In the ammonia molecule, the three hydrogen atoms attached to the central nitrogen are not arranged in a flat, trigonal planar
molecular structure, but rather in a three-dimensional trigonal pyramid (Figure 7.6.6) with the nitrogen atom at the apex and the
three hydrogen atoms forming the base. The ideal bond angles in a trigonal pyramid are based on the tetrahedral electron pair
geometry. Again, there are slight deviations from the ideal because lone pairs occupy larger regions of space than do bonding
electrons. The H–N–H bond angles in NH3 are slightly smaller than the 109.5° angle in a regular tetrahedron (Figure 7.6.6)
because the lone pair-bonding pair repulsion is greater than the bonding pair-bonding pair repulsion. The ideal molecular structures
are predicted based on the electron-pair geometries for various combinations of lone pairs and bonding pairs.
According to VSEPR theory, the terminal atom locations (Xs in Figure 7.6.7) are equivalent within the linear, trigonal planar, and
tetrahedral electron-pair geometries (the first three rows of the table). It does not matter which X is replaced with a lone pair
because the molecules can be rotated to convert positions. For trigonal bipyramidal electron-pair geometries, however, there are
two distinct X positions (Figure 7.6.7a): an axial position (if we hold a model of a trigonal bipyramid by the two axial positions,
we have an axis around which we can rotate the model) and an equatorial position (three positions form an equator around the
middle of the molecule). The axial position is surrounded by bond angles of 90°, whereas the equatorial position has more space
available because of the 120° bond angles. In a trigonal bipyramidal electron-pair geometry, lone pairs always occupy equatorial
positions because these more spacious positions can more easily accommodate the larger lone pairs.
Theoretically, we can come up with three possible arrangements for the three bonds and two lone pairs for the ClF3 molecule
(Figure 7.6.7). The stable structure is the one that puts the lone pairs in equatorial locations, giving a T-shaped molecular structure.
Figure 7.6.7 : (a) In a trigonal bipyramid, the two axial positions are located directly across from one another, whereas the three
equatorial positions are located in a triangular arrangement. (b–d) The two lone pairs (red lines) in ClF3 have several possible
arrangements, but the T-shaped molecular structure (b) is the one actually observed, consistent with the larger lone pairs both
occupying equatorial positions.
Four sets of images are shown and labeled, “a,” “b,” “c,” and “d.” Each image is separated by a dashed vertical line. Image a shows
a six-faced, bi-pyramidal structure where the central vertical axis is labeled, “Axial,” and the horizontal plane is labeled,
“Equatorial.” Image b shows a pair of diagrams in the same shape as image a, but in these diagrams, the left has a chlorine atom in
the center while the right has a chlorine atom in the center, two fluorine atoms on the upper and lower ends, and one fluorine in the
left horizontal position. Image c shows a pair of diagrams in the same shape as image a, but in these diagrams, the left has a
chlorine atom in the center while the right has a chlorine atom in the center and three fluorine atoms in each horizontal position.
Image d shows a pair of diagrams in the same shape as image a, but in these diagrams, the left has a chlorine atom in the center
while the right has a chlorine atom in the center, two fluorine atoms in the horizontal positions, and one in the axial bottom
position.
When a central atom has two lone electron pairs and four bonding regions, we have an octahedral electron-pair geometry. The two
lone pairs are on opposite sides of the octahedron (180° apart), giving a square planar molecular structure that minimizes lone pair-
lone pair repulsions.
Predict the electron-pair geometry and molecular structure for each of the following:
a. carbon dioxide, CO2, a molecule produced by the combustion of fossil fuels
b. boron trichloride, BCl3, an important industrial chemical
Solution
(a) We write the Lewis structure of CO2 as:
This shows us two regions of high electron density around the carbon atom—each double bond counts as one region, and there
are no lone pairs on the carbon atom. Using VSEPR theory, we predict that the two regions of electron density arrange
themselves on opposite sides of the central atom with a bond angle of 180°. The electron-pair geometry and molecular
structure are identical, and CO2 molecules are linear.
(b) We write the Lewis structure of BCl3 as:
Thus we see that BCl3 contains three bonds, and there are no lone pairs of electrons on boron. The arrangement of three
regions of high electron density gives a trigonal planar electron-pair geometry. The B–Cl bonds lie in a plane with 120° angles
between them. BCl3 also has a trigonal planar molecular structure.
The electron-pair geometry and molecular structure of BCl3 are both trigonal planar. Note that the VSEPR geometry indicates
the correct bond angles (120°), unlike the Lewis structure shown above.
Exercise 7.6.1
Carbonate, CO , is a common polyatomic ion found in various materials from eggshells to antacids. What are the electron-
2−
Answer
The electron-pair geometry is trigonal planar and the molecular structure is trigonal planar. Due to resonance, all three C–O
bonds are identical. Whether they are single, double, or an average of the two, each bond counts as one region of electron
density.
Two of the top 50 chemicals produced in the United States, ammonium nitrate and ammonium sulfate, both used as fertilizers,
contain the ammonium ion. Predict the electron-pair geometry and molecular structure of the NH cation.
+
Figure 7.6.7 ).
Figure 7.6.8 : The ammonium ion displays a tetrahedral electron-pair geometry as well as a tetrahedral molecular structure.
Exercise 7.6.2
Answer
Any molecule with five electron pairs around the central atoms including no lone pairs will be trigonal bipyramidal. PF is 5
a common example
The next several examples illustrate the effect of lone pairs of electrons on molecular structure.
Solution
The Lewis structure of H2O indicates that there are four regions of high electron density around the oxygen atom: two lone
pairs and two chemical bonds:
Figure 7.6.9 . Thus, the electron-pair geometry is tetrahedral and the molecular structure is bent with an angle slightly less than
109.5°. In fact, the bond angle is 104.5°.
Exercise 7.6.3
The hydronium ion, H3O+, forms when acids are dissolved in water. Predict the electron-pair geometry and molecular structure
of this cation.
Answer
electron pair geometry: tetrahedral; molecular structure: trigonal pyramidal
Predicting Electron-pair Geometry and Molecular Structure: SF4, is extremely valuable for the preparation of fluorine-
containing compounds used as herbicides (i.e., SF4 is used as a fluorinating agent). Predict the electron-pair geometry and
molecular structure of a SF4 molecule.
Solution
The Lewis structure of SF4 indicates five regions of electron density around the sulfur atom: one lone pair and four bonding
pairs:
Figure 7.6.10 ).
Figure 7.6.10 : (a) SF4 has a trigonal bipyramidal arrangement of the five regions of electron density. (b) One of the regions is a
lone pair, which results in a seesaw-shaped molecular structure.
Answer
The electron-pair geometry is trigonal bipyramidal. The molecular structure is linear.
Of all the noble gases, xenon is the most reactive, frequently reacting with elements such as oxygen and fluorine. Predict the
electron-pair geometry and molecular structure of the XeF4 molecule.
Solution
The Lewis structure of XeF4 indicates six regions of high electron density around the xenon atom: two lone pairs and four
bonds:
Figure 7.6.11 : The five atoms are all in the same plane and have a square planar molecular structure.
Figure 7.6.11 : (a) XeF4 adopts an octahedral arrangement with two lone pairs (red lines) and four bonds in the electron-pair
geometry. (b) The molecular structure is square planar with the lone pairs directly across from one another.
Exercise 7.6.4
In a certain molecule, the central atom has three lone pairs and two bonds. What will the electron pair geometry and molecular
structure be?
Answer
electron pair geometry: trigonal bipyramidal; molecular structure: linear
The Lewis structure for the simplest amino acid, glycine, H2NCH2CO2H, is shown here. Predict the local geometry for the
nitrogen atom, the two carbon atoms, and the oxygen atom with a hydrogen atom attached:
Solution
Exercise 7.6.5
Another amino acid is alanine, which has the Lewis structure shown here. Predict the electron-pair geometry and local
structure of the nitrogen atom, the three carbon atoms, and the oxygen atom with hydrogen attached:
Answer
electron-pair geometries: nitrogen––tetrahedral; carbon (CH)—tetrahedral; carbon (CH3)—tetrahedral; carbon (CO2)—
trigonal planar; oxygen (OH)—tetrahedral; local structures: nitrogen—trigonal pyramidal; carbon (CH)—tetrahedral;
carbon (CH3)—tetrahedral; carbon (CO2)—trigonal planar; oxygen (OH)—bent (109°)
Click on each bond type or lone pair at right to add that group to the central atom. Once you have the complete molecule, rotate it
to examine the predicted molecular structure. What molecular structure is this?
Solution
The molecular structure is linear.
Exercise 7.6.6
Build a more complex molecule in the simulator. Identify the electron-group geometry, molecular structure, and bond angles.
Then try to find a chemical formula that would match the structure you have drawn.
Answer
Answers will vary. For example, an atom with four single bonds, a double bond, and a lone pair has an octahedral electron-
group geometry and a square pyramidal molecular structure. XeOF4 is a molecule that adopts this structure.
μ = Qr (7.6.1)
where
Q is the magnitude of the partial charges (determined by the electronegativity difference) and
r is the distance between the charges:
This bond moment can be represented as a vector, a quantity having both direction and magnitude (Figure 7.6.12). Dipole vectors
are shown as arrows pointing along the bond from the less electronegative atom toward the more electronegative atom. A small
plus sign is drawn on the less electronegative end to indicate the partially positive end of the bond. The length of the arrow is
proportional to the magnitude of the electronegativity difference between the two atoms.
Figure 7.6.12 : (a) There is a small difference in electronegativity between C and H, represented as a short vector. (b) The
electronegativity difference between B and F is much larger, so the vector representing the bond moment is much longer.
A whole molecule may also have a separation of charge, depending on its molecular structure and the polarity of each of its bonds.
If such a charge separation exists, the molecule is said to be a polar molecule (or dipole); otherwise the molecule is said to be
nonpolar. The dipole moment measures the extent of net charge separation in the molecule as a whole. We determine the dipole
moment by adding the bond moments in three-dimensional space, taking into account the molecular structure.
For diatomic molecules, there is only one bond, so its bond dipole moment determines the molecular polarity. Homonuclear
diatomic molecules such as Br2 and N2 have no difference in electronegativity, so their dipole moment is zero. For heteronuclear
molecules such as CO, there is a small dipole moment. For HF, there is a larger dipole moment because there is a larger difference
in electronegativity.
When a molecule contains more than one bond, the geometry must be taken into account. If the bonds in a molecule are arranged
such that their bond moments cancel (vector sum equals zero), then the molecule is nonpolar. This is the situation in CO2 (Figure
7.6.13A). Each of the bonds is polar, but the molecule as a whole is nonpolar. From the Lewis structure, and using VSEPR theory,
we determine that the CO2 molecule is linear with polar C=O bonds on opposite sides of the carbon atom. The bond moments
cancel because they are pointed in opposite directions. In the case of the water molecule (Figure 7.6.13B), the Lewis structure
Figure 7.6.13 : The overall dipole moment of a molecule depends on the individual bond dipole moments and how they are
arranged. (a) Each CO bond has a bond dipole moment, but they point in opposite directions so that the net CO2 molecule is
nonpolar. (b) In contrast, water is polar because the OH bond moments do not cancel out.
The OCS molecule has a structure similar to CO2, but a sulfur atom has replaced one of the oxygen atoms. To determine if this
molecule is polar, we draw the molecular structure. VSEPR theory predicts a linear molecule:
The C–O bond is considerably polar. Although C and S have very similar electronegativity values, S is slightly more
electronegative than C, and so the C-S bond is just slightly polar. Because oxygen is more electronegative than sulfur, the oxygen
end of the molecule is the negative end.
Chloromethane, CH3Cl, is another example of a polar molecule. Although the polar C–Cl and C–H bonds are arranged in a
tetrahedral geometry, the C–Cl bonds have a larger bond moment than the C–H bond, and the bond moments do not completely
cancel each other. All of the dipoles have a upward component in the orientation shown, since carbon is more electronegative than
hydrogen and less electronegative than chlorine:
When we examine the highly symmetrical molecules BF3 (trigonal planar), CH4 (tetrahedral), PF5 (trigonal bipyramidal), and SF6
(octahedral), in which all the polar bonds are identical, the molecules are nonpolar. The bonds in these molecules are arranged such
that their dipoles cancel. However, just because a molecule contains identical bonds does not mean that the dipoles will always
cancel. Many molecules that have identical bonds and lone pairs on the central atoms have bond dipoles that do not cancel.
Examples include H2S and NH3. A hydrogen atom is at the positive end and a nitrogen or sulfur atom is at the negative end of the
polar bonds in these molecules:
Figure 7.6.14 : (a) Molecules are always randomly distributed in the liquid state in the absence of an electric field. (b) When an
electric field is applied, polar molecules like HF will align to the dipoles with the field direction.
Open the molecule polarity simulation and select the “Three Atoms” tab at the top. This should display a molecule ABC with
three electronegativity adjustors. You can display or hide the bond moments, molecular dipoles, and partial charges at the right.
Turning on the Electric Field will show whether the molecule moves when exposed to a field, similar to Figure 7.6.14.
Use the electronegativity controls to determine how the molecular dipole will look for the starting bent molecule if:
a. A and C are very electronegative and B is in the middle of the range.
b. A is very electronegative, and B and C are not.
Solution
a. Molecular dipole moment points immediately between A and C.
b. Molecular dipole moment points along the A–B bond, toward A.
Exercise 7.6.7
Determine the partial charges that will give the largest possible bond dipoles.
Answer
The largest bond moments will occur with the largest partial charges. The two solutions above represent how unevenly the
electrons are shared in the bond. The bond moments will be maximized when the electronegativity difference is greatest.
The controls for A and C should be set to one extreme, and B should be set to the opposite extreme. Although the
magnitude of the bond moment will not change based on whether B is the most electronegative or the least, the direction of
the bond moment will.
Glossary
axial position
location in a trigonal bipyramidal geometry in which there is another atom at a 180° angle and the equatorial positions are at a
90° angle
bond angle
angle between any two covalent bonds that share a common atom
bond distance
(also, bond length) distance between the nuclei of two bonded atoms
dipole moment
property of a molecule that describes the separation of charge determined by the sum of the individual bond moments based on
the molecular structure
electron-pair geometry
arrangement around a central atom of all regions of electron density (bonds, lone pairs, or unpaired electrons)
equatorial position
one of the three positions in a trigonal bipyramidal geometry with 120° angles between them; the axial positions are located at a
90° angle
linear
shape in which two outside groups are placed on opposite sides of a central atom
molecular structure
structure that includes only the placement of the atoms in the molecule
octahedral
shape in which six outside groups are placed around a central atom such that a three-dimensional shape is generated with four
groups forming a square and the other two forming the apex of two pyramids, one above and one below the square plane
polar molecule
(also, dipole) molecule with an overall dipole moment
tetrahedral
shape in which four outside groups are placed around a central atom such that a three-dimensional shape is generated with four
corners and 109.5° angles between each pair and the central atom
trigonal bipyramidal
trigonal planar
shape in which three outside groups are placed in a flat triangle around a central atom with 120° angles between each pair and
the central atom
vector
quantity having magnitude and direction
This page titled 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
7.E.1.2: S7.1.1
The protons in the nucleus do not change during normal chemical reactions. Only the outer electrons move. Positive charges form
when electrons are lost.
7.E.1.3: Q7.1.2
Iron(III) sulfate [Fe2(SO4)3] is composed of Fe3+ and SO 2−
4
ions. Explain why a sample of iron(III) sulfate is uncharged.
7.E.1.4: Q7.1.3
Which of the following atoms would be expected to form negative ions in binary ionic compounds and which would be expected to
form positive ions: P, I, Mg, Cl, In, Cs, O, Pb, Co?
7.E.1.5: S7.1.3
P, I, Cl, and O would form anions because they are nonmetals. Mg, In, Cs, Pb, and Co would form cations because they are metals.
7.E.1.6: Q7.1.4
Which of the following atoms would be expected to form negative ions in binary ionic compounds and which would be expected to
form positive ions: Br, Ca, Na, N, F, Al, Sn, S, Cd?
7.E.1.7: Q7.1.5
Predict the charge on the monatomic ions formed from the following atoms in binary ionic compounds:
a. P
b. Mg
c. Al
d. O
e. Cl
f. Cs
7.E.1.8: S7.1.5
P3–; Mg2+; Al3+; O2–; Cl–; Cs+
7.E.1.9: Q7.1.6
Predict the charge on the monatomic ions formed from the following atoms in binary ionic compounds:
1. I
2. Sr
3. K
4. N
5. S
6. In
7.E.1.10: S7.1.6
1. I-
2. Sr2+
3. K+
4. N3-
5. S2-
7.E.1.11: Q7.1.7
Write the electron configuration for each of the following ions:
1. As3–
2. I–
3. Be2+
4. Cd2+
5. O2–
6. Ga3+
7. Li+
8. (h) N3–
9. (i) Sn2+
10. (j) Co2+
11. (k) Fe2+
12. (l) As3+
7.E.1.12: S7.1.7
[Ar]4s23d104p6; [Kr]4d105s25p6 1s2 [Kr]4d10; [He]2s22p6; [Ar]3d10; 1s2 (h) [He]2s22p6 (i) [Kr]4d105s2 (j) [Ar]3d7 (k) [Ar]3d6, (l)
[Ar]3d104s2
7.E.1.13: Q7.1.8
Write the electron configuration for the monatomic ions formed from the following elements (which form the greatest
concentration of monatomic ions in seawater):
1. Cl
2. Na
3. Mg
4. Ca
5. K
6. Br
7. Sr
8. (h) F
7.E.1.14: Q7.1.9
Write out the full electron configuration for each of the following atoms and for the monatomic ion found in binary ionic
compounds containing the element:
a. Al
b. Br
c. Sr
d. Li
e. As
f. S
7.E.1.15: S7.1.9
1s22s22p63s23p1; Al3+: 1s22s22p6; 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p5; 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p6; 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p65s2;
Sr2+: 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p6; 1s22s1;
Li+: 1s2; 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p3; 1s22s22p63s23p63d104s24p6; 1s22s22p63s23p4; 1s22s22p63s23p6
7.E.1.16: Q7.1.10
From the labels of several commercial products, prepare a list of six ionic compounds in the products. For each compound, write
the formula. (You may need to look up some formulas in a suitable reference.)
4. NO −
3
5. CO2
6. H2S
7. BH −
4
7.E.3.2: S7.4.1
eight electrons:
eight electrons:
no electrons
Ga3+;
no electrons
Li+;
eight electrons:
7.E.3.3: Q7.4.2
Many monatomic ions are found in seawater, including the ions formed from the following list of elements. Write the Lewis
symbols for the monatomic ions formed from the following elements:
a. Cl
b. Na
c. Mg
d. Ca
e. K
f. Br
g. Sr
h. F
7.E.3.4: Q7.4.3
Write the Lewis symbols of the ions in each of the following ionic compounds and the Lewis symbols of the atom from which they
are formed:
1. MgS
2. Al2O3
3. GaCl3
4. K2O
5. Li3N
6. KF
(a)
;
(b)
;
(c)
;
(e)
;
(f)
In the Lewis structures listed here, M and X represent various elements in the third period of the periodic table. Write the formula
of each compound using the chemical symbols of each element:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Write the Lewis structure for the diatomic molecule P2, an unstable form of phosphorus found in high-temperature phosphorus
vapor.
h. (h) BF −
i. (i) HCCH
j. (j) ClCN
k. (k) C 2+
2
(a)
In this case, the Lewis structure is inadequate to depict the fact that experimental studies have shown two unpaired electrons in
each oxygen molecule.
(b)
;
(c)
;
(d)
;
(e)
;
(f)
;
(g)
;
(i)
;
(j)
;
(k)
;
XeF4:
3
:
;
Cl2BBCl2:
2. ICl −
3. SO 2−
3
4. HONO
Correct the following statement: “The bonds in solid PbCl2 are ionic; the bond in a HCl molecule is covalent. Thus, all of the
valence electrons in PbCl2 are located on the Cl– ions, and all of the valence electrons in a HCl molecule are shared between the H
and Cl atoms.”
Two valence electrons per Pb atom are transferred to Cl atoms; the resulting Pb2+ ion has a 6s2 valence shell configuration. Two of
the valence electrons in the HCl molecule are shared, and the other six are located on the Cl atom as lone pairs of electrons.
Write Lewis structures for the following molecules or ions:
1. SbH3
2. XeF2
3. Se8 (a cyclic molecule with a ring of eight Se atoms)
Methanol, H3COH, is used as the fuel in some race cars. Ethanol, C2H5OH, is used extensively as motor fuel in Brazil. Both
methanol and ethanol produce CO2 and H2O when they burn. Write the chemical equations for these combustion reactions using
Lewis structures instead of chemical formulas.
Many planets in our solar system contain organic chemicals including methane (CH4) and traces of ethylene (C2H4), ethane (C2H6),
propyne (H3CCCH), and diacetylene (HCCCCH). Write the Lewis structures for each of these molecules.
Carbon tetrachloride was formerly used in fire extinguishers for electrical fires. It is no longer used for this purpose because of the
formation of the toxic gas phosgene, Cl2CO. Write the Lewis structures for carbon tetrachloride and phosgene.
urea:
pyruvic acid:
uracil:
carbonic acid:
;
(b)
;
(c)
;
(d)
;
(e)
A compound with a molar mass of about 28 g/mol contains 85.7% carbon and 14.3% hydrogen by mass. Write the Lewis structure
for a molecule of the compound.
A compound with a molar mass of about 42 g/mol contains 85.7% carbon and 14.3% hydrogen by mass. Write the Lewis structure
for a molecule of the compound.
Write resonance forms that describe the distribution of electrons in each of these molecules or ions.
1. sulfur dioxide, SO2
2. carbonate ion, CO 2−
4. pyridine:
;
(b)
;
(c)
;
(d)
;
(e)
Write the resonance forms of ozone, O3, the component of the upper atmosphere that protects the Earth from ultraviolet radiation.
Sodium nitrite, which has been used to preserve bacon and other meats, is an ionic compound. Write the resonance forms of the
nitrite ion, NO .
−
Write the Lewis structures for the following, and include resonance structures where appropriate. Indicate which has the strongest
carbon-oxygen bond.
1. CO2
2. CO
(a)
(b)
CO has the strongest carbon-oxygen bond because there is a triple bond joining C and O. CO2 has double bonds.
Toothpastes containing sodium hydrogen carbonate (sodium bicarbonate) and hydrogen peroxide are widely used. Write Lewis
structures for the hydrogen carbonate ion and hydrogen peroxide molecule, with resonance forms where appropriate.
Determine the formal charge of each element in the following:
1. HCl
2. CF4
3. PCl3
4. PF5
H: 0, Cl: 0; C: 0, F: 0; P: 0, Cl 0; P: 0, F: 0
Determine the formal charge of each element in the following:
1. H3O+
2. SO 2−
4
3. NH3
4. O 2−
5. H2O2
Calculate the formal charge of chlorine in the molecules Cl2, BeCl2, and ClF5.
Cl in Cl2: 0; Cl in BeCl2: 0; Cl in ClF5: 0
Calculate the formal charge of each element in the following compounds and ions:
1. F2CO
2. NO–
3. BF −
4. SnCl −
3
5. H2CCH2
6. ClF3
7. SeF6
8. (h) PO 3−
4
4. NO −
3
;
(b)
;
(c)
;
(d)
Based on formal charge considerations, which of the following would likely be the correct arrangement of atoms in nitrosyl
chloride: ClNO or ClON?
Based on formal charge considerations, which of the following would likely be the correct arrangement of atoms in hypochlorous
acid: HOCl or OClH?
HOCl
Based on formal charge considerations, which of the following would likely be the correct arrangement of atoms in sulfur dioxide:
OSO or SOO?
Draw the structure of hydroxylamine, H3NO, and assign formal charges; look up the structure. Is the actual structure consistent
with the formal charges?
The structure that gives zero formal charges is consistent with the actual structure:
Iodine forms a series of fluorides (listed here). Write Lewis structures for each of the four compounds and determine the formal
charge of the iodine atom in each molecule:
Which of the following structures would we expect for nitrous acid? Determine the formal charges:
Sulfuric acid is the industrial chemical produced in greatest quantity worldwide. About 90 billion pounds are produced each year in
the United States alone. Write the Lewis structure for sulfuric acid, H2SO4, which has two oxygen atoms and two OH groups
bonded to the sulfur.
1. −114 kJ;
2. 30 kJ;
3. (c) −1055 kJ
Using the bond energies in Table, determine the approximate enthalpy change for each of the following reactions:
1. Cl (g) + 3 F (g) ⟶ 2 ClF (g)
2 2 3
The greater bond energy is in the figure on the left. It is the more stable form.
How does the bond energy of HCldiffer from the standard enthalpy of formation of HCl(g)?
Using the standard enthalpy of formation data in Appendix G, show how the standard enthalpy of formation of HCl(g) can be used
to determine the bond energy.
1 1
∘ ∘
HCl(g) ⟶ H (g) + Cl (g) ΔH = −ΔH
2 2 1 f[HCl(g)]
2 2
1
∘ ∘
H (g) ⟶ H(g) ΔH = ΔH
2 2 f[H(g)]
2
1
∘ ∘
Cl (g) ⟶ Cl(g) ΔH = ΔH
2 3 f[Cl(g)]
2
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
HCl(g) ⟶ H(g) + Cl(g) ΔH = ΔH + ΔH + ΔH
298 1 2 3
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
DHCl = ΔH = ΔH + ΔH + ΔH (7.E.1)
298 f[HCl(g)] f[H(g)] f[Cl(g)]
= 431.6 kJ (7.E.3)
Using the standard enthalpy of formation data in Appendix G, calculate the bond energy of the carbon-sulfur double bond in CS2.
Using the standard enthalpy of formation data in Appendix G, determine which bond is stronger: the S–F bond in SF4(g) or in
SF6(g)?
The S–F bond in SF4 is stronger.
Using the standard enthalpy of formation data in Appendix G, determine which bond is stronger: the P–Cl bond in PCl3(g) or in
PCl5(g)?
Complete the following Lewis structure by adding bonds (not atoms), and then indicate the longest bond:
K 419 3050
Ca 590 1140
The first ionization energy of Mg is 738 kJ/mol and that of Al is 578 kJ/mol. Account for this difference.
When two electrons are removed from the valence shell, the Ca radius loses the outermost energy level and reverts to the lower n =
3 level, which is much smaller in radius. The +2 charge on calcium pulls the oxygen much closer compared with K, thereby
increasing the lattice energy relative to a less charged ion. (c) Removal of the 4s electron in Ca requires more energy than removal
of the 4s electron in K because of the stronger attraction of the nucleus and the extra energy required to break the pairing of the
electrons. The second ionization energy for K requires that an electron be removed from a lower energy level, where the attraction
is much stronger from the nucleus for the electron. In addition, energy is required to unpair two electrons in a full orbital. For Ca,
the second ionization potential requires removing only a lone electron in the exposed outer energy level. In Al, the removed
electron is relatively unprotected and unpaired in a p orbital. The higher energy for Mg mainly reflects the unpairing of the 2s
electron.
The lattice energy of LiF is 1023 kJ/mol, and the Li–F distance is 200.8 pm. NaF crystallizes in the same structure as LiF but with a
Na–F distance of 231 pm. Which of the following values most closely approximates the lattice energy of NaF: 510, 890, 1023,
1175, or 4090 kJ/mol? Explain your choice.
For which of the following substances is the least energy required to convert one mole of the solid into separate ions?
1. MgO
2. SrO
3. (c) KF
4. CsF
5. MgF2
(d)
The reaction of a metal, M, with a halogen, X2, proceeds by an exothermic reaction as indicated by this equation:
M(s) + X (g) ⟶ MX (s) . For each of the following, indicate which option will make the reaction more exothermic. Explain
2 2
your answers.
1. a large radius vs. a small radius for M+2
2. a high ionization energy vs. a low ionization energy for M
3. (c) an increasing bond energy for the halogen
4. a decreasing electron affinity for the halogen
5. an increasing size of the anion formed by the halogen
The lattice energy of LiF is 1023 kJ/mol, and the Li–F distance is 201 pm. MgO crystallizes in the same structure as LiF but with a
Mg–O distance of 205 pm. Which of the following values most closely approximates the lattice energy of MgO: 256 kJ/mol, 512
kJ/mol, 1023 kJ/mol, 2046 kJ/mol, or 4008 kJ/mol? Explain your choice.
4008 kJ/mol; both ions in MgO have twice the charge of the ions in LiF; the bond length is very similar and both have the same
structure; a quadrupling of the energy is expected based on the equation for lattice energy
Which compound in each of the following pairs has the larger lattice energy? Note: Mg2+ and Li+ have similar radii; O2– and F–
have similar radii. Explain your choices.
1. MgO or MgSe
2. LiF or MgO
3. (c) Li2O or LiCl
4
identical to the
H–C–H bond angle in CH4?
Explain how a molecule that contains polar bonds can be nonpolar.
As long as the polar bonds are compensated (for example. two identical atoms are found directly across the central atom from one
another), the molecule can be nonpolar.
As a general rule, MXn molecules (where M represents a central atom and X represents terminal atoms; n = 2 – 5) are polar if there
is one or more lone pairs of electrons on M. NH3 (M = N, X = H, n = 3) is an example. There are two molecular structures with
lone pairs that are exceptions to this rule. What are they?
Predict the electron pair geometry and the molecular structure of each of the following molecules or ions:
1. Both the electron geometry and the molecular structure are octahedral.
2. Both the electron geometry and the molecular structure are trigonal bipyramid.
3. (c) Both the electron geometry and the molecular structure are linear.
4. Both the electron geometry and the molecular structure are trigonal planar.
Identify the electron pair geometry and the molecular structure of each of the following molecules or ions:
1. IF+
6
2. CF4
3. (c) BF3
4. SiF −
5. BeCl2
What are the electron-pair geometry and the molecular structure of each of the following molecules or ions?
1. ClF5
2. ClO −
3. (c) TeCl 2−
4. PCl3
5. SeF4
6. PH −
electron-pair geometry: octahedral, molecular structure: square pyramidal; electron-pair geometry: tetrahedral, molecular structure:
bent; (c) electron-pair geometry: octahedral, molecular structure: square planar; electron-pair geometry: tetrahedral, molecular
structure: trigonal pyramidal; electron-pair geometry: trigonal bypyramidal, molecular structure: seesaw; electron-pair geometry:
tetrahedral, molecular structure: bent (109°)
Predict the electron pair geometry and the molecular structure of each of the following ions:
1. H3O+
2. PCl −
3. (c) SnCl −
4. BrCl −
5. ICl3
6. XeF4
7. (g) SF2
Identify the electron pair geometry and the molecular structure of each of the following molecules:
1. ClNO (N is the central atom)
2. CS2
3. (c) Cl2CO (C is the central atom)
4. Cl2SO (S is the central atom)
5. SO2F2 (S is the central atom)
6. XeO2F2 (Xe is the central atom)
7. (g) ClOF (Cl is the central atom)
+
2
electron-pair geometry: trigonal planar, molecular structure: bent (120°); electron-pair geometry: linear, molecular structure: linear;
(c) electron-pair geometry: trigonal planar, molecular structure: trigonal planar; electron-pair geometry: tetrahedral, molecular
structure: trigonal pyramidal; electron-pair geometry: tetrahedral, molecular structure: tetrahedral; electron-pair geometry: trigonal
bipyramidal, molecular structure: seesaw; (g) electron-pair geometry: tetrahedral, molecular structure: trigonal pyramidal
Predict the electron pair geometry and the molecular structure of each of the following:
1. IOF5 (I is the central atom)
7. (g) SiO 4−
Which of the following molecules and ions contain polar bonds? Which of these molecules and ions have dipole moments?
1. ClF5
2. ClO −
2
3. (c) TeCl 2−
4
4. PCl3
5. SeF4
6. PH −
2
7. (g) XeF2
All of these molecules and ions contain polar bonds. Only ClF5, ClO , PCl3, SeF4, and PH have dipole moments.
−
2
−
Which of the molecules and ions in Exercise contain polar bonds? Which of these molecules and ions have dipole moments?
1. H3O+
2. PCl−
4
3. (c) SnCl −
3
4. BrCl −
4
5. ICl3
6. XeF4
7. (g) SF2
Which of the following molecules have dipole moments?
1. CS2
2. SeS2
3. (c) CCl2F2
4. PCl3 (P is the central atom)
5. ClNO (N is the central atom)
SeS2, CCl2F2, PCl3, and ClNO all have dipole moments.
Identify the molecules with a dipole moment:
1. SF4
2. CF4
3. (c) Cl2CCBr2
4. CH3Cl
5. H2CO
The molecule XF3 has a dipole moment. Is X boron or phosphorus?
P
The molecule XCl2 has a dipole moment. Is X beryllium or sulfur?
Is the Cl2BBCl2 molecule polar or nonpolar?
nonpolar
There are three possible structures for PCl2F3 with phosphorus as the central atom. Draw them and discuss how measurements of
dipole moments could help distinguish among them.
Describe the molecular structure around the indicated atom or atoms:
1. the sulfur atom in sulfuric acid, H2SO4 [(HO)2SO2]
3. (c) SO3
4. SO2−
A molecule with the formula AB2, in which A and B represent different atoms, could have one of three different shapes. Sketch and
name the three different shapes that this molecule might have. Give an example of a molecule or ion for each shape.
A molecule with the formula AB3, in which A and B represent different atoms, could have one of three different shapes. Sketch and
name the three different shapes that this molecule might have. Give an example of a molecule or ion that has each shape.
Draw the Lewis electron dot structures for these molecules, including resonance structures where appropriate:
1. CS2−
3
2. CS2
3. (c) CS
predict the molecular shapes for CS2−
3
and CS2 and explain how you arrived at your predictions
(a)
;
(b)
;
(c)
Use the simulation to perform the following exercises for a two-atom molecule:
1. Adjust the electronegativity value so the bond dipole is pointing toward B. Then determine what the electronegativity values
must be to switch the dipole so that it points toward A.
2. With a partial positive charge on A, turn on the electric field and describe what happens.
3. (c) With a small partial negative charge on A, turn on the electric field and describe what happens.
4. Reset all, and then with a large partial negative charge on A, turn on the electric field and describe what happens.
Use the simulation to perform the following exercises for a real molecule. You may need to rotate the molecules in three
dimensions to see certain dipoles.
1. Sketch the bond dipoles and molecular dipole (if any) for O3. Explain your observations.
2. Look at the bond dipoles for NH3. Use these dipoles to predict whether N or H is more electronegative.
3. (c) Predict whether there should be a molecular dipole for NH3 and, if so, in which direction it will point. Check the molecular
dipole box to test your hypothesis.
The molecular dipole points away from the hydrogen atoms.
Use the Molecule Shape simulator to build a molecule. Starting with the central atom, click on the double bond to add one double
bond. Then add one single bond and one lone pair. Rotate the molecule to observe the complete geometry. Name the electron group
geometry and molecular structure and predict the bond angle. Then click the check boxes at the bottom and right of the simulator to
check your answers.
Use the Molecule Shape simulator to explore real molecules. On the Real Molecules tab, select H2O. Switch between the “real”
and “model” modes. Explain the difference observed.
The structures are very similar. In the model mode, each electron group occupies the same amount of space, so the bond angle is
shown as 109.5°. In the “real” mode, the lone pairs are larger, causing the hydrogens to be compressed. This leads to the smaller
angle of 104.5°.
Use the Molecule Shape simulator to explore real molecules. On the Real Molecules tab, select “model” mode and S2O. What is
the model bond angle? Explain whether the “real” bond angle should be larger or smaller than the ideal model angle.
This page titled 7.E: Chemical Bonding and Molecular Geometry (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
This page titled 8: Advanced Theories of Covalent Bonding is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
8.0: Prelude to Covalent Bonding
We have examined the basic ideas of bonding, showing that atoms share electrons to form molecules with stable Lewis structures
and that we can predict the shapes of those molecules by valence shell electron pair repulsion (VSEPR) theory. These ideas provide
an important starting point for understanding chemical bonding. But these models sometimes fall short in their abilities to predict
the behavior of real substances. How can we reconcile the geometries of s, p, and d atomic orbitals with molecular shapes that
show angles like 120° and 109.5°? Furthermore, we know that electrons and magnetic behavior are related through electromagnetic
fields. Both N2 and O2 have fairly similar Lewis structures that contain lone pairs of electrons.
Two Lewis diagrams are shown. The diagram on the left shows two nitrogen atoms, represented by the letter N connected by three
lines and with a lone pair of electrons on each end of the structure. The diagram on the right shows two oxygen atoms, depicted by
the letter O, connected by two lines. Two pairs of electrons surround each oxygen to the top and ends of the structure.
Yet oxygen demonstrates very different magnetic behavior than nitrogen. We can pour liquid nitrogen through a magnetic field with
no visible interactions, while liquid oxygen is attracted to the magnet and floats in the magnetic field. We need to understand the
additional concepts of valence bond theory, orbital hybridization, and molecular orbital theory to understand these observations.
Figure 8.0.1 : Oxygen molecules orient randomly most of the time, as shown in the top magnified view. However, when we pour
liquid oxygen through a magnet, the molecules line up with the magnetic field, and the attraction allows them to stay suspended
between the poles of the magnet where the magnetic field is strongest. Other diatomic molecules (like N2) flow past the magnet.
The detailed explanation of bonding described in this chapter allows us to understand this phenomenon. (credit: modification of
work by Jefferson Lab)
A pitcher is shown pouring liquid oxygen through the gap between two magnets, where it has formed a solid disk. A call out box
near the stream of liquid oxygen shows an image of six pairs of spheres, spread apart from one another. Another call out box near
the solid disk shows ten pairs of spheres much closer together.
This page titled 8.0: Prelude to Covalent Bonding is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As we know, a scientific theory is a strongly supported explanation for observed natural laws or large bodies of experimental data.
For a theory to be accepted, it must explain experimental data and be able to predict behavior. For example, VSEPR theory has
gained widespread acceptance because it predicts three-dimensional molecular shapes that are consistent with experimental data
collected for thousands of different molecules. However, VSEPR theory does not provide an explanation of chemical bonding.
There are successful theories that describe the electronic structure of atoms. We can use quantum mechanics to predict the specific
regions around an atom where electrons are likely to be located: A spherical shape for an s orbital, a dumbbell shape for a p orbital,
and so forth. However, these predictions only describe the orbitals around free atoms. When atoms bond to form molecules, atomic
orbitals are not sufficient to describe the regions where electrons will be located in the molecule. A more complete understanding
of electron distributions requires a model that can account for the electronic structure of molecules. One popular theory holds that a
covalent bond forms when a pair of electrons is shared by two atoms and is simultaneously attracted by the nuclei of both atoms. In
the following sections, we will discuss how such bonds are described by valence bond theory and hybridization.
Valence bond theory describes a covalent bond as the overlap of half-filled atomic orbitals (each containing a single electron) that
yield a pair of electrons shared between the two bonded atoms. We say that orbitals on two different atoms overlap when a portion
of one orbital and a portion of a second orbital occupy the same region of space. According to valence bond theory, a covalent bond
results when two conditions are met:
1. an orbital on one atom overlaps an orbital on a second atom and
2. the single electrons in each orbital combine to form an electron pair.
The mutual attraction between this negatively charged electron pair and the two atoms’ positively charged nuclei serves to
physically link the two atoms through a force we define as a covalent bond. The strength of a covalent bond depends on the extent
of overlap of the orbitals involved. Orbitals that overlap extensively form bonds that are stronger than those that have less overlap.
The energy of the system depends on how much the orbitals overlap. Figure 8.1.1 illustrates how the sum of the energies of two
hydrogen atoms (the colored curve) changes as they approach each other. When the atoms are far apart there is no overlap, and by
convention we set the sum of the energies at zero. As the atoms move together, their orbitals begin to overlap. Each electron begins
to feel the attraction of the nucleus in the other atom. In addition, the electrons begin to repel each other, as do the nuclei. While the
atoms are still widely separated, the attractions are slightly stronger than the repulsions, and the energy of the system decreases. (A
bond begins to form.) As the atoms move closer together, the overlap increases, so the attraction of the nuclei for the electrons
continues to increase (as do the repulsions among electrons and between the nuclei). At some specific distance between the atoms,
which varies depending on the atoms involved, the energy reaches its lowest (most stable) value. This optimum distance between
the two bonded nuclei is the bond distance between the two atoms. The bond is stable because at this point, the attractive and
repulsive forces combine to create the lowest possible energy configuration. If the distance between the nuclei were to decrease
further, the repulsions between nuclei and the repulsions as electrons are confined in closer proximity to each other would become
stronger than the attractive forces. The energy of the system would then rise (making the system destabilized), as shown at the far
left of Figure 8.1.1.
J lower in energy than the two separated hydrogen atoms. This may seem like a small number. However, we know
−19
7.24 × 10
from our earlier description of thermochemistry that bond energies are often discussed on a per-mole basis. For example, it requires
J to break one H–H bond, but it takes 4.36 × 10 J to break 1 mole of H–H bonds. A comparison of some bond
−19 5
7.24 × 10
lengths and energies is shown in Table 8.1.1. We can find many of these bonds in a variety of molecules, and this table provides
average values. For example, breaking the first C–H bond in CH4 requires 439.3 kJ/mol, while breaking the first C–H bond in
H– CH C H (a common paint thinner) requires 375.5 kJ/mol.
2 6 5
In addition to the distance between two orbitals, the orientation of orbitals also affects their overlap (other than for two s orbitals,
which are spherically symmetric). Greater overlap is possible when orbitals are oriented such that they overlap on a direct line
between the two nuclei. Figure 8.1.2 illustrates this for two p orbitals from different atoms; the overlap is greater when the orbitals
overlap end to end rather than at an angle.
Figure 8.1.2 : (a) The overlap of two p orbitals is greatest when the orbitals are directed end to end. (b) Any other arrangement
results in less overlap. The dots indicate the locations of the nuclei.
The overlap of two s orbitals (as in H2), the overlap of an s orbital and a p orbital (as in HCl), and the end-to-end overlap of two p
orbitals (as in Cl2) all produce sigma bonds (σ bonds), as illustrated in Figure 8.1.3. A σ bond is a covalent bond in which the
electron density is concentrated in the region along the internuclear axis; that is, a line between the nuclei would pass through the
center of the overlap region. Single bonds in Lewis structures are described as σ bonds in valence bond theory.
Figure 8.1.3 : Sigma (σ) bonds form from the overlap of the following: (a) two s orbitals, (b) an s orbital and a p orbital, and (c) two
p orbitals. The dots indicate the locations of the nuclei.
Three diagrams are shown and labeled “a,” “b,” and “c.” Diagram a shows two spherical orbitals lying side by side and
overlapping. Diagram b shows one spherical and one peanut-shaped orbital lying near one another so that the spherical orbital
overlaps with one end of the peanut-shaped orbital. Diagram c shows two peanut-shaped orbitals lying end to end so that one end
of each orbital overlaps the other.
A pi bond (π bond) is a type of covalent bond that results from the side-by-side overlap of two p orbitals, as illustrated in Figure
8.1.4. In a π bond, the regions of orbital overlap lie on opposite sides of the internuclear axis. Along the axis itself, there is a node,
Butadiene, C4H6, is used to make synthetic rubber. Identify the number of σ and π bonds contained in this molecule.
Butadiene
Solution
There are six σ C–H bonds and one σ C–C bond, for a total of seven from the single bonds. There are two double bonds that
each have a π bond in addition to the σ bond. This gives a total nine σ and two π bonds overall.
Exercise 8.1.1
Answer
(a) is a π bond with a node along the axis connecting the nuclei while (b) and (c) are σ bonds that overlap along the axis.
Summary
Valence bond theory describes bonding as a consequence of the overlap of two separate atomic orbitals on different atoms that
creates a region with one pair of electrons shared between the two atoms. When the orbitals overlap along an axis containing the
Glossary
overlap
coexistence of orbitals from two different atoms sharing the same region of space, leading to the formation of a covalent bond
node
plane separating different lobes of orbitals, where the probability of finding an electron is zero
pi bond (π bond)
covalent bond formed by side-by-side overlap of atomic orbitals; the electron density is found on opposite sides of the
internuclear axis
This page titled 8.1: Valence Bond Theory is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Thinking in terms of overlapping atomic orbitals is one way for us to explain how chemical bonds form in diatomic molecules.
However, to understand how molecules with more than two atoms form stable bonds, we require a more detailed model. As an
example, let us consider the water molecule, in which we have one oxygen atom bonding to two hydrogen atoms. Oxygen has the
electron configuration 1s22s22p4, with two unpaired electrons (one in each of the two 2p orbitals). Valence bond theory would
predict that the two O–H bonds form from the overlap of these two 2p orbitals with the 1s orbitals of the hydrogen atoms. If this
were the case, the bond angle would be 90°, as shown in Figure 8.2.1, because p orbitals are perpendicular to each other.
Experimental evidence shows that the bond angle is 104.5°, not 90°. The prediction of the valence bond theory model does not
match the real-world observations of a water molecule; a different model is needed.
Figure 8.2.1 : The hypothetical overlap of two of the 2p orbitals on an oxygen atom (red) with the 1s orbitals of two hydrogen
atoms (blue) would produce a bond angle of 90°. This is not consistent with experimental evidence.1
Two peanut-shaped orbitals lie perpendicular to one another. They overlap with spherical orbitals to the left and top of the diagram.
Quantum-mechanical calculations suggest why the observed bond angles in H2O differ from those predicted by the overlap of the
1s orbital of the hydrogen atoms with the 2p orbitals of the oxygen atom. The mathematical expression known as the wave
function, ψ, contains information about each orbital and the wavelike properties of electrons in an isolated atom. When atoms are
bound together in a molecule, the wave functions combine to produce new mathematical descriptions that have different shapes.
This process of combining the wave functions for atomic orbitals is called hybridization and is mathematically accomplished by the
linear combination of atomic orbitals, LCAO, (a technique that we will encounter again later). The new orbitals that result are
called hybrid orbitals. The valence orbitals in an isolated oxygen atom are a 2s orbital and three 2p orbitals. The valence orbitals in
an oxygen atom in a water molecule differ; they consist of four equivalent hybrid orbitals that point approximately toward the
corners of a tetrahedron (Figure 8.2.2). Consequently, the overlap of the O and H orbitals should result in a tetrahedral bond angle
(109.5°). The observed angle of 104.5° is experimental evidence for which quantum-mechanical calculations give a useful
explanation: Valence bond theory must include a hybridization component to give accurate predictions.
Figure 8.2.2 : (a) A water molecule has four regions of electron density, so VSEPR theory predicts a tetrahedral arrangement of
hybrid orbitals. (b) Two of the hybrid orbitals on oxygen contain lone pairs, and the other two overlap with the 1s orbitals of
hydrogen atoms to form the O–H bonds in H2O. This description is more consistent with the experimental structure.
Two diagrams are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Diagram a shows two peanut-shaped orbitals lying in a tetrahedral arrangement
around the letter “O.” Diagram b shows the same two orbitals, but they now overlap to the top and to the left with two spherical
orbitals, each labeled “H.” A pair of electrons occupies each lobe of the peanut-shaped orbitals.
8.2.1: sp Hybridization
The beryllium atom in a gaseous BeCl2 molecule is an example of a central atom with no lone pairs of electrons in a linear
arrangement of three atoms. There are two regions of valence electron density in the BeCl2 molecule that correspond to the two
covalent Be–Cl bonds. To accommodate these two electron domains, two of the Be atom’s four valence orbitals will mix to yield
two hybrid orbitals. This hybridization process involves mixing of the valence s orbital with one of the valence p orbitals to yield
two equivalent sp hybrid orbitals that are oriented in a linear geometry (Figure 8.2.3). In this figure, the set of sp orbitals appears
similar in shape to the original p orbital, but there is an important difference. The number of atomic orbitals combined always
equals the number of hybrid orbitals formed. The p orbital is one orbital that can hold up to two electrons. The sp set is two
equivalent orbitals that point 180° from each other. The two electrons that were originally in the s orbital are now distributed to the
two sp orbitals, which are half filled. In gaseous BeCl2, these half-filled hybrid orbitals will overlap with orbitals from the chlorine
atoms to form two identical σ bonds.
Figure 8.2.3 : Hybridization of an s orbital (blue) and a p orbital (red) of the same atom produces two sp hybrid orbitals (yellow).
Each hybrid orbital is oriented primarily in just one direction. Note that each sp orbital contains one lobe that is significantly larger
than the other. The set of two sp orbitals are oriented at 180°, which is consistent with the geometry for two domains.
A series of three diagrams connected by a right-facing arrow that is labeled, “Hybridization,” and a downward-facing arrow
labeled, “Gives a linear arrangement,” are shown. The first diagram shows a blue spherical orbital and a red, peanut-shaped orbital,
each placed on an X, Y, Z axis system. The second diagram shows the same two orbitals, but they are now purple and have one
enlarged lobe and one smaller lobe. Each lies along the x-axis in the drawing. The third diagram shows the same two orbitals, but
their smaller lobes now overlap along the x-axis while their larger lobes are located at and labeled as “180 degrees” from one
another.
We illustrate the electronic differences in an isolated Be atom and in the bonded Be atom in the orbital energy-level diagram in
Figure 8.2.4. These diagrams represent each orbital by a horizontal line (indicating its energy) and each electron by an arrow.
Energy increases toward the top of the diagram. We use one upward arrow to indicate one electron in an orbital and two arrows (up
and down) to indicate two electrons of opposite spin.
When atomic orbitals hybridize, the valence electrons occupy the newly created orbitals. The Be atom had two valence electrons,
so each of the sp orbitals gets one of these electrons. Each of these electrons pairs up with the unpaired electron on a chlorine atom
when a hybrid orbital and a chlorine orbital overlap during the formation of the Be–Cl bonds. Any central atom surrounded by just
two regions of valence electron density in a molecule will exhibit sp hybridization. Other examples include the mercury atom in the
linear HgCl2 molecule, the zinc atom in Zn(CH3)2, which contains a linear C–Zn–C arrangement, and the carbon atoms in HCCH
and CO2.
Figure 8.2.6 : This alternate way of drawing the trigonal planar sp2 hybrid orbitals is sometimes used in more crowded figures.
Three balloon-like orbitals are shown, and connect together near their narrower ends in one plane. The angle between a pair of
lobes is labeled, “120 degrees.”
The observed structure of the borane molecule, BH3, suggests sp2 hybridization for boron in this compound. The molecule is
trigonal planar, and the boron atom is involved in three bonds to hydrogen atoms ( Figure 8.2.7).
Figure 8.2.8 : In an isolated B atom, there are one 2s and three 2p valence orbitals. When boron is in a molecule with three regions
of electron density, three of the orbitals hybridize and create a set of three sp2 orbitals and one unhybridized 2p orbital. The three
half-filled hybrid orbitals each overlap with an orbital from a hydrogen atom to form three σ bonds in BH3.
A diagram is shown in two parts, connected by a right facing arrow labeled, “Hybridization.” The left diagram shows an up-facing
arrow labeled “E.” To the lower right of the arrow is a short, horizontal line labeled, “2 s,” that has two vertical half-arrows facing
up and down on it. To the upper right of the arrow are a series of three short, horizontal lines labeled, “2 p.” Above both sets of
these lines is the phrase, “Orbitals in an isolated B atom.” One of the lines has a vertical, up-facing arrow drawn on it. The right
side of the diagram shows three short, horizontal lines placed halfway up the space and each labeled, “s p superscript 2.” An
upward-facing half arrow is drawn vertically on each line. Above these lines is one other short, horizontal line, labeled, “2 p.”
Above both sets of lines is the phrase, “Orbitals in the s p superscript 2 hybridized B atom in B H subscript 3.”
Any central atom surrounded by three regions of electron density will exhibit sp2 hybridization. This includes molecules with a
lone pair on the central atom, such as ClNO (Figure 8.2.9), or molecules with two single bonds and a double bond connected to the
central atom, as in formaldehyde, CH2O, and ethene, H2CCH2.
Figure 8.2.9 : The central atom(s) in each of the structures shown contain three regions of electron density and are sp2 hybridized.
As we know from the discussion of VSEPR theory, a region of electron density contains all of the electrons that point in one
direction. A lone pair, an unpaired electron, a single bond, or a multiple bond would each count as one region of electron density.
Three Lewis structures are shown. The left-hand structure shows a chlorine atom surrounded by three lone pairs of electrons single
bonded to a nitrogen atom with one lone pair of electrons and double bonded to an oxygen atom with two lone pairs of electrons.
The middle structure shows a carbon atom single bonded to two hydrogen atoms and double bonded to an oxygen atom that has
two lone pairs of electrons. The right-hand structure shows two carbon atoms, double bonded to one another and each single
bonded to two hydrogen atoms.
Figure 8.2.12 : (a) In the ethane molecule, C2H6, each carbon has four sp3 orbitals. (b) These four orbitals overlap to form seven σ
bonds.
Two diagrams are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Diagram a shows two carbon atoms, each surrounded by their four s p subscript
three hybridized orbitals in a three dimensional arrangement. Each of the orbitals is shown overlapping with a spherical hydrogen
atom. Diagram b shows the same general arrangement, but the hydrogen atoms are just represented by an, “H” and their spherical
orbitals are not shown.
An sp3 hybrid orbital can also hold a lone pair of electrons. For example, the nitrogen atom in ammonia is surrounded by three
bonding pairs and a lone pair of electrons directed to the four corners of a tetrahedron. The nitrogen atom is sp3 hybridized with
one hybrid orbital occupied by the lone pair.
The molecular structure of water is consistent with a tetrahedral arrangement of two lone pairs and two bonding pairs of electrons.
Thus we say that the oxygen atom is sp3 hybridized, with two of the hybrid orbitals occupied by lone pairs and two by bonding
pairs. Since lone pairs occupy more space than bonding pairs, structures that contain lone pairs have bond angles slightly distorted
from the ideal. Perfect tetrahedra have angles of 109.5°, but the observed angles in ammonia (107.3°) and water (104.5°) are
slightly smaller. Other examples of sp3 hybridization include CCl4, PCl3, and NCl3.
Figure 8.2.13 : The three compounds pictured exhibit sp3d hybridization in the central atom and a trigonal bipyramid form. SF4 and
C lF
4
+
have one lone pair of electrons on the central atom, and ClF3 has two lone pairs giving it the T-shape shown.
Three Lewis structures are shown along with designations of molecular shape. The left image shows a sulfur atom singly bonded to
four fluorine atoms. The sulfur atom has one lone pair of electrons while each fluorine has three. Two fluorine atoms are drawn
vertically up and down from the sulfur while the other two are shown going into and out of the page. The second structure shows
one chlorine atom singly bonded to three fluorine atoms. The chlorine has two lone pairs of electrons while each fluorine has three.
Two fluorine atoms are drawn vertically up and down from the sulfur while the other is shown horizontally. The right structure
shows a chlorine atom singly bonded to four fluorine atoms. The chlorine atom has one lone pair of electrons and a superscript plus
sign, while each fluorine has three lone pairs of electrons. Two fluorine atoms are drawn vertically up and down from the sulfur
while the other two are shown going into and out of the page.
In a molecule of phosphorus pentachloride, PCl5, there are five P–Cl bonds (thus five pairs of valence electrons around the
phosphorus atom) directed toward the corners of a trigonal bipyramid. We use the 3s orbital, the three 3p orbitals, and one of the 3d
orbitals to form the set of five sp3d hybrid orbitals (Figure 8.2.13) that are involved in the P–Cl bonds. Other atoms that exhibit
sp3d hybridization include the sulfur atom in SF4 and the chlorine atoms in ClF3 and in ClF . (The electrons on fluorine atoms are
+
4
Figure 8.2.14 : (a) The five regions of electron density around phosphorus in PCl5 require five hybrid sp3d orbitals. (b) These
orbitals combine to form a trigonal bipyramidal structure with each large lobe of the hybrid orbital pointing at a vertex. As before,
there are also small lobes pointing in the opposite direction for each orbital (not shown for clarity).
Two images are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Image a depicts a ball-and-stick model in a trigonal bipyramidal arrangement.
Image b depicts the hybrid orbitals in the same arrangement and each is labeled, “s p superscript three d.”
The sulfur atom in sulfur hexafluoride, SF6, exhibits sp3d2 hybridization. A molecule of sulfur hexafluoride has six bonding pairs
of electrons connecting six fluorine atoms to a single sulfur atom. There are no lone pairs of electrons on the central atom. To bond
six fluorine atoms, the 3s orbital, the three 3p orbitals, and two of the 3d orbitals form six equivalent sp3d2 hybrid orbitals, each
directed toward a different corner of an octahedron. Other atoms that exhibit sp3d2 hybridization include the phosphorus atom in
PCl , the iodine atom in the interhalogens IF , IF5, ICl , IF and the xenon atom in XeF4.
− + − −
6 6 4 4
Ammonium sulfate is important as a fertilizer. What is the hybridization of the sulfur atom in the sulfate ion, SO 2−
4
?
Solution
The Lewis structure of sulfate shows there are four regions of electron density.
Figure 8.2.16 ).
A structure is shown in which a sulfur atom is bonded to four oxygen atoms in a tetrahedral arrangement. Two of the oxygen
atoms have a negative charge.
Exercise 8.2.1
What is the hybridization of the selenium atom in SeF4?
A Lewis structure is shown in which four fluorine atoms are each attached to one sulfur atom. Two of the attached fluorine
atoms are vertically attached up and down, while two are attached into and out of the page to the right. The sulfur also has one
lone pair of electrons attached to the left of the structure.
Answer
The selenium atom is sp3d hybridized.
Urea, NH2C(O)NH2, is sometimes used as a source of nitrogen in fertilizers. What is the hybridization of each nitrogen and
carbon atom in urea?
Solution
The Lewis structure of urea is
Exercise 8.2.1
Acetic acid, H3CC(O)OH, is the molecule that gives vinegar its odor and sour taste. What is the hybridization of the two
carbon atoms in acetic acid?
A Lewis structure is shown in which a carbon atom is double bonded to an oxygen atom that has two lone pairs of electrons
and single bonded to another oxygen atom that is single boned to a hydrogen atom. This second oxygen atom has two lone
pairs of electrons. The carbon is also single bonded to a carbon atom that is single bonded to three hydrogen atoms.
Answer
H3C, sp3; C(O)OH, sp2
Summary
We can use hybrid orbitals, which are mathematical combinations of some or all of the valence atomic orbitals, to describe the
electron density around covalently bonded atoms. These hybrid orbitals either form sigma (σ) bonds directed toward other atoms of
the molecule or contain lone pairs of electrons. We can determine the type of hybridization around a central atom from the
geometry of the regions of electron density about it. Two such regions imply sp hybridization; three, sp2 hybridization; four, sp3
hybridization; five, sp3d hybridization; and six, sp3d2 hybridization. Pi (π) bonds are formed from unhybridized atomic orbitals (p
or d orbitals).
8.2.5.2: Glossary
hybrid orbital
orbital created by combining atomic orbitals on a central atom
hybridization
model that describes the changes in the atomic orbitals of an atom when it forms a covalent compound
sp hybrid orbital
one of a set of two orbitals with a linear arrangement that results from combining one s and one p orbital
This page titled 8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The hybrid orbital model appears to account well for the geometry of molecules involving single covalent bonds. Is it also capable
of describing molecules containing double and triple bonds? We have already discussed that multiple bonds consist of σ and π
bonds. Next we can consider how we visualize these components and how they relate to hybrid orbitals. The Lewis structure of
ethene, C2H4, shows us that each carbon atom is surrounded by one other carbon atom and two hydrogen atoms.
Figure 8.3.2 ).
A Lewis structure is shown in which two carbon atoms are bonded together by a double bond. Each carbon atom is bonded to two
hydrogen atoms by a single bond.
Figure 8.3.1 : In ethene, each carbon atom is sp2 hybridized, and the sp2 orbitals and the p orbital are singly occupied. The hybrid
orbitals overlap to form σ bonds, while the p orbitals on each carbon atom overlap to form a π bond.
A diagram is shown in two parts, connected by a right facing arrow labeled, “Hybridization.” The left diagram shows an up-facing
arrow labeled, “E.” To the lower right of the arrow is a short, horizontal line labeled, “2 s,” that has two vertical half-arrows facing
up and down on it. To the upper right of the arrow are a series of three short, horizontal lines labeled, “2 p.” Above both sets of
lines is the phrase, “Orbitals in an isolated C atom.” Two of the lines have vertical, up-facing arrows drawn on them. The right side
of the diagram shows three short, horizontal lines placed halfway up the space and each labeled, “s p superscript 2.” An upward-
facing half arrow is drawn vertically on each line. Above these lines is one other short, horizontal line, labeled, “p.” Above both
sets of lines is the phrase, “Orbitals in the s p superscript 2 hybridized C atom in C subscript 2 H subscript 4.”
The π bond in the C=C double bond results from the overlap of the third (remaining) 2p orbital on each carbon atom that is not
involved in hybridization. This unhybridized p orbital (lobes shown in red and blue in Figure 8.3.2) is perpendicular to the plane of
the sp2 hybrid orbitals. Thus the unhybridized 2p orbitals overlap in a side-by-side fashion, above and below the internuclear axis
and form a π bond.
A diagram of a carbon atom with two balloon-like purple orbitals labeled, “sp” arranged in a linear fashion around it is shown. Four
red balloon-like orbitals are aligned in pairs in the y and z axes around the carbon and are labeled, “unhybridized p orbital,” and,
“Second unhybridized p orbital.”
Figure 8.3.3 : Diagram of the two linear sp hybrid orbitals of a carbon atom, which lie in a straight line, and the two unhybridized p
orbitals at perpendicular angles.
In molecules with sp hybrid orbitals, two unhybridized p orbitals remain on the atom (Figure 8.3.3). We find this situation in
acetylene, H−C≡C−H, which is a linear molecule. The sp hybrid orbitals of the two carbon atoms overlap end to end to form a σ
bond between the carbon atoms (Figure 8.3.4). The remaining sp orbitals form σ bonds with hydrogen atoms. The two
unhybridized p orbitals per carbon are positioned such that they overlap side by side and, hence, form two π bonds. The two carbon
atoms of acetylene are thus bound together by one σ bond and two π bonds, giving a triple bond.
A diagram is shown that is made up of two Lewis structures connected by a double ended arrow. The left image shows six carbon
atoms bonded together with alternating double and single bonds to form a six-sided ring. Each carbon is also bonded to a hydrogen
atom by a single bond. The right image shows the same structure, but the double and single bonds in between the carbon atoms
have changed positions.
Figure 8.3.5 : Each carbon atom in benzene, C6H6, is sp2 hybridized, independently of which resonance form is considered. The
electrons in the π bonds are not located in one set of p orbitals or the other, but rather delocalized throughout the molecule.
Some acid rain results from the reaction of sulfur dioxide with atmospheric water vapor, followed by the formation of sulfuric
acid. Sulfur dioxide, SO , is a major component of volcanic gases as well as a product of the combustion of sulfur-containing
2
Solution
The resonance structures of SO are 2
Exercise 8.3.1
Another acid in acid rain is nitric acid, HNO3, which is produced by the reaction of nitrogen dioxide, NO2, with atmospheric
water vapor. What is the hybridization of the nitrogen atom in NO2? (Note: the lone electron on nitrogen occupies a hybridized
orbital just as a lone pair would.)
Answer
sp2
Summary
Multiple bonds consist of a σ bond located along the axis between two atoms and one or two π bonds. The σ bonds are usually
formed by the overlap of hybridized atomic orbitals, while the π bonds are formed by the side-by-side overlap of unhybridized
orbitals. Resonance occurs when there are multiple unhybridized orbitals with the appropriate alignment to overlap, so the
placement of π bonds can vary.
This page titled 8.3: Multiple Bonds is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
For almost every covalent molecule that exists, we can now draw the Lewis structure, predict the electron-pair geometry, predict
the molecular geometry, and come close to predicting bond angles. However, one of the most important molecules we know, the
oxygen molecule O2, presents a problem with respect to its Lewis structure. We would write the following Lewis structure for O2:
A Lewis structure is shown. It is made up of two oxygen atoms, each with two lone pairs of electrons, bonded together with a
double bond.
This electronic structure adheres to all the rules governing Lewis theory. There is an O=O double bond, and each oxygen atom has
eight electrons around it. However, this picture is at odds with the magnetic behavior of oxygen. By itself, O2 is not magnetic, but it
is attracted to magnetic fields. Thus, when we pour liquid oxygen past a strong magnet, it collects between the poles of the magnet
and defies gravity. Such attraction to a magnetic field is called paramagnetism, and it arises in molecules that have unpaired
electrons. And yet, the Lewis structure of O2 indicates that all electrons are paired. How do we account for this discrepancy?
Magnetic susceptibility measures the force experienced by a substance in a magnetic field. When we compare the weight of a
sample to the weight measured in a magnetic field (Figure 8.4.1), paramagnetic samples that are attracted to the magnet will appear
heavier because of the force exerted by the magnetic field. We can calculate the number of unpaired electrons based on the increase
in weight.
Figure 8.4.1 : A Gouy balance compares the mass of a sample in the presence of a magnetic field with the mass with the
electromagnet turned off to determine the number of unpaired electrons in a sample.
Experiments show that each O2 molecule has two unpaired electrons. The Lewis-structure model does not predict the presence of
these two unpaired electrons. Unlike oxygen, the apparent weight of most molecules decreases slightly in the presence of an
inhomogeneous magnetic field. Materials in which all of the electrons are paired are diamagnetic and weakly repel a magnetic
field. Paramagnetic and diamagnetic materials do not act as permanent magnets. Only in the presence of an applied magnetic field
do they demonstrate attraction or repulsion.
Video 8.4.1 : Water, like most molecules, contains all paired electrons. Living things contain a large percentage of water, so they
demonstrate diamagnetic behavior. If you place a frog near a sufficiently large magnet, it will levitate. You can see videos of
diamagnetic floating frogs, strawberries, and more (levitating frog [www.youtube.com])
Molecular orbital theory (MO theory) provides an explanation of chemical bonding that accounts for the paramagnetism of the
oxygen molecule. It also explains the bonding in a number of other molecules, such as violations of the octet rule and more
molecules with more complicated bonding (beyond the scope of this text) that are difficult to describe with Lewis structures.
Additionally, it provides a model for describing the energies of electrons in a molecule and the probable location of these electrons.
Unlike valence bond theory, which uses hybrid orbitals that are assigned to one specific atom, MO theory uses the combination of
atomic orbitals to yield molecular orbitals that are delocalized over the entire molecule rather than being localized on its constituent
atoms. MO theory also helps us understand why some substances are electrical conductors, others are semiconductors, and still
others are insulators. Table 8.4.1 summarizes the main points of the two complementary bonding theories. Both theories provide
different, useful ways of describing molecular structure.
Table \(\PageIndex{1}\): Comparison of Bonding Theories
Valence Bond Theory Molecular Orbital Theory
considers bonds as localized between one pair of atoms considers electrons delocalized throughout the entire molecule
creates bonds from overlap of atomic orbitals (s, p, d…) and hybrid
combines atomic orbitals to form molecular orbitals (σ, σ*, π, π*)
orbitals (sp, sp2, sp3…)
Molecular orbital theory describes the distribution of electrons in molecules in much the same way that the distribution of electrons
in atoms is described using atomic orbitals. Using quantum mechanics, the behavior of an electron in a molecule is still described
by a wave function, Ψ, analogous to the behavior in an atom. Just like electrons around isolated atoms, electrons around atoms in
molecules are limited to discrete (quantized) energies. The region of space in which a valence electron in a molecule is likely to be
found is called a molecular orbital (Ψ2). Like an atomic orbital, a molecular orbital is full when it contains two electrons with
opposite spin.
We will consider the molecular orbitals in molecules composed of two identical atoms (H2 or Cl2, for example). Such molecules
are called homonuclear diatomic molecules. In these diatomic molecules, several types of molecular orbitals occur.
The mathematical process of combining atomic orbitals to generate molecular orbitals is called the linear combination of atomic
orbitals (LCAO). The wave function describes the wavelike properties of an electron. Molecular orbitals are combinations of
atomic orbital wave functions. Combining waves can lead to constructive interference, in which peaks line up with peaks, or
destructive interference, in which peaks line up with troughs (Figure 8.4.2). In orbitals, the waves are three dimensional, and they
combine with in-phase waves producing regions with a higher probability of electron density and out-of-phase waves producing
nodes, or regions of no electron density.
node between the nuclei. The asterisk signifies that the orbital is an antibonding orbital. Electrons in a σs orbital are attracted by
both nuclei at the same time and are more stable (of lower energy) than they would be in the isolated atoms. Adding electrons to
these orbitals creates a force that holds the two nuclei together, so we call these orbitals bonding orbitals. Electrons in the σ ∗
s
orbitals are located well away from the region between the two nuclei. The attractive force between the nuclei and these electrons
pulls the two nuclei apart. Hence, these orbitals are called antibonding orbitals. Electrons fill the lower-energy bonding orbital
before the higher-energy antibonding orbital, just as they fill lower-energy atomic orbitals before they fill higher-energy atomic
orbitals.
Figure 8.4.3 : Sigma (σ) and sigma-star (σ*) molecular orbitals are formed by the combination of two s atomic orbitals. The plus
(+) signs indicate the locations of nuclei.
A diagram is shown that depicts a vertical upward-facing arrow that lies to the left of all the other portions of the diagram and is
labeled, “E.” To the immediate right of the midpoint of the arrow are two circles each labeled with a positive sign, the letter S, and
the phrase, “Atomic orbitals.” These are followed by a right-facing horizontal arrow that points to the same two circles labeled with
plus signs, but they are now touching and are labeled, “Combine atomic orbitals.” Two right-facing arrows lead to the last portion
of the diagram, one facing upward and one facing downward. The upper arrow is labeled, “Subtract,” and points to two oblong
ovals labeled with plus signs, and the phrase, “Antibonding orbitals sigma subscript s superscript asterisk.” The lower arrow is
labeled, “Add,” and points to an elongated oval with two plus signs that is labeled, “Bonding orbital sigma subscript s.” The
heading over the last section of the diagram are the words, “Molecular orbitals.”
In p orbitals, the wave function gives rise to two lobes with opposite phases, analogous to how a two-dimensional wave has both
parts above and below the average. We indicate the phases by shading the orbital lobes different colors. When orbital lobes of the
same phase overlap, constructive wave interference increases the electron density. When regions of opposite phase overlap, the
destructive wave interference decreases electron density and creates nodes. When p orbitals overlap end to end, they create σ and
σ* orbitals (Figure 8.4.4). If two atoms are located along the x-axis in a Cartesian coordinate system, the two px orbitals overlap
end to end and form σpx (bonding) and σ (antibonding) (read as "sigma-p-x" and "sigma-p-x star," respectively). Just as with s-
∗
px
orbital overlap, the asterisk indicates the orbital with a node between the nuclei, which is a higher-energy, antibonding orbital.
The side-by-side overlap of two p orbitals gives rise to a pi (π) bonding molecular orbital and a \(π^*\) antibonding molecular
orbital, as shown in Figure 8.4.5. In valence bond theory, we describe π bonds as containing a nodal plane containing the
internuclear axis and perpendicular to the lobes of the p orbitals, with electron density on either side of the node. In molecular
orbital theory, we describe the π orbital by this same shape, and a π bond exists when this orbital contains electrons. Electrons in
this orbital interact with both nuclei and help hold the two atoms together, making it a bonding orbital. For the out-of-phase
combination, there are two nodal planes created, one along the internuclear axis and a perpendicular one between the nuclei.
Figure 8.4.5 : Side-by-side overlap of each two p orbitals results in the formation of two π molecular orbitals. Combining the out-
of-phase orbitals results in an antibonding molecular orbital with two nodes. One contains the internuclear axis, and one is
perpendicular to the axis. Combining the in-phase orbitals results in a bonding orbital. There is a node (blue plane) containing the
internuclear axis with the two lobes of the orbital located above and below this node.
Two horizontal rows of diagrams are shown. The upper and lower diagrams both begin with two vertical peanut-shaped orbitals
with a plus sign in between followed by a right-facing arrow. The upper diagram shows the same vertical peanut orbitals bending
slightly away from one another and separated by a dotted line. It is labeled, “pi subscript p superscript asterisk.” The lower diagram
shows the horizontal overlap of the two orbitals and is labeled, “pi subscript p.”
In the molecular orbitals of diatomic molecules, each atom also has two sets of p orbitals oriented side by side (py and pz), so these
four atomic orbitals combine pairwise to create two π orbitals and two π orbitals. The π and π orbitals are oriented at right
∗
py
∗
py
angles to the π and π orbitals. Except for their orientation, the πpy and πpz orbitals are identical and have the same energy; they
pz
∗
pz
are degenerate orbitals. The π and π antibonding orbitals are also degenerate and identical except for their orientation. A total
∗
py
∗
pz
of six molecular orbitals results from the combination of the six atomic p orbitals in two atoms: σ and σ , π and π , π and
px
∗
px py
∗
py pz
π .
∗
pz
Predict what type (if any) of molecular orbital would result from adding the wave functions so each pair of orbitals shown
overlap. The orbitals are all similar in energy.
Three diagrams are shown and labeled “a,” “b,” and “c.” Diagram a shows two horizontal peanut-shaped orbitals laying side-
by-side. They are labeled, “3 p subscript x and 3 p subscript x.” Diagram b shows one vertical and one horizontal peanut-
shaped orbital which are at right angles to one another. They are labeled, “3 p subscript x and 3 p subscript y.” Diagram c
shows two vertical peanut-shaped orbitals laying side-by-side and labeled, “3 p subscript y and 3 p subscript y.”
Solution
a. This is an in-phase combination, resulting in a σ3p orbital
b. This will not result in a new orbital because the in-phase component (bottom) and out-of-phase component (top) cancel out.
Only orbitals with the correct alignment can combine.
c. This is an out-of-phase combination, resulting in a π orbital.
∗
3p
Exercise 8.4.1
Label the molecular orbital shown as σ or π, bonding or antibonding and indicate where the node occurs.
Two orbitals are shown lying end-to-end. Each has one enlarged and one small side. The small sides are facing one another
Answer
The orbital is located along the internuclear axis, so it is a σ orbital. There is a node bisecting the internuclear axis, so it is
an antibonding orbital.
Two orbitals are shown lying end-to-end. Each has one enlarged and one small side. The small sides are facing one another and are
separated by a vertical dotted line.
While the descriptions of bonding described in this chapter involve many theoretical concepts, they also have many practical,
real-world applications. For example, drug design is an important field that uses our understanding of chemical bonding to
develop pharmaceuticals. This interdisciplinary area of study uses biology (understanding diseases and how they operate) to
identify specific targets, such as a binding site that is involved in a disease pathway. By modeling the structures of the binding
site and potential drugs, computational chemists can predict which structures can fit together and how effectively they will
bind (Figure 8.4.6). Thousands of potential candidates can be narrowed down to a few of the most promising candidates. These
Figure 8.4.6 : The molecule shown, HIV-1 protease, is an important target for pharmaceutical research. By designing molecules
that bind to this protein, scientists are able to drastically inhibit the progress of the disease.
A diagram of a molecule is shown. The image shows a tangle of ribbon-like, intertwined, pink and green curling lines with a
complex ball and stick model in the center.
valence shell only. The molecular orbitals are filled in the same manner as atomic orbitals, using the Aufbau principle and Hund’s
rule.
A diagram is shown that has an upward-facing vertical arrow running along the left side labeled, “E.” At the bottom center of the
diagram is a horizontal line labeled, “sigma subscript 2 s,” that has two vertical half arrows drawn on it, one facing up and one
facing down. This line is connected to the right and left by upward-facing, dotted lines to two more horizontal lines, each labeled,
“2 s.” The line on the left has two vertical half arrows drawn on it, one facing up and one facing down while the line of the right
has one half arrow facing up drawn on it. These two lines are connected by upward-facing dotted lines to another line in the center
of the diagram, but further up from the first. It is labeled, “sigma subscript 2 s superscript asterisk.” This horizontal line has one
upward-facing vertical half-arrow drawn on it. Moving farther up the center of the diagram is a long horizontal line labeled, “sigma
subscript 2 p subscript x,” which lies below two horizontal lines. These two horizontal lines lie side-by-side, and labeled, “pi
subscript 2 p subscript y,” and, “pi subscript 2 p subscript z.” Both the bottom and top lines are connected to the right and left by
upward-facing, dotted lines to three more horizontal lines, each labeled, “2 p.” These sets of lines are connected by upward-facing
dotted lines to another single line and then pair of double lines in the center of the diagram, but farther up from the lower lines.
They are labeled, “sigma subscript 2 p subscript x superscript asterisk,” and, ““pi subscript 2 p subscript y superscript asterisk,”
and, “pi subscript 2 p subscript z superscript asterisk,” respectively. The left and right sides of the diagram have headers that read,
”Atomic orbitals,” while the center is header reads “Molecular orbitals”.
We predict the distribution of electrons in these molecular orbitals by filling the orbitals in the same way that we fill atomic
orbitals, by the Aufbau principle. Lower-energy orbitals fill first, electrons spread out among degenerate orbitals before pairing,
and each orbital can hold a maximum of two electrons with opposite spins (Figure 8.4.7). Just as we write electron configurations
for atoms, we can write the molecular electronic configuration by listing the orbitals with superscripts indicating the number of
electrons present. For clarity, we place parentheses around molecular orbitals with the same energy. In this case, each orbital is at a
different energy, so parentheses separate each orbital. Thus we would expect a diatomic molecule or ion containing seven electrons
(such as Be ) would have the molecular electron configuration (σ ) (σ ) (σ ) (σ ) . It is common to omit the core electrons
+
2 1s
2 ∗
1s
2
2s
2 ∗
2s
1
from molecular orbital diagrams and configurations and include only the valence electrons.
The order of a covalent bond is a guide to its strength; a bond between two given atoms becomes stronger as the bond order
increases. If the distribution of electrons in the molecular orbitals between two atoms is such that the resulting bond would have a
bond order of zero, a stable bond does not form. We next look at some specific examples of MO diagrams and bond orders.
upward arrow indicates one electron in an orbital, and two (upward and downward) arrows indicate two electrons of opposite spin.
Figure 8.4.8 : The molecular orbital energy diagram predicts that H2 will be a stable molecule with lower energy than the separated
atoms.
A diagram is shown that has an upward-facing vertical arrow running along the left side labeled “E.” At the bottom center of the
diagram is a horizontal line labeled, “sigma subscript 1 s,” that has two vertical half arrows drawn on it, one facing up and one
facing down. This line is connected to the right and left by upward-facing, dotted lines to two more horizontal lines, each labeled,
“1 s,” and each with one vertical half-arrow facing up drawn on it. These two lines are connected by upward-facing dotted lines to
another line in the center of the diagram, but farther up from the first, and labeled, “sigma subscript 1 s superscript asterisk.” The
left and right sides of the diagram have headers that read, ”Atomic orbitals,” while the center header reads, “Molecular orbitals.”
The bottom left and right are labeled “H” while the center is labeled “H subscript 2.”
A dihydrogen molecule contains two bonding electrons and no antibonding electrons so we have
(2 − 0)
bond order in H = =1
2
2
Because the bond order for the H–H bond is equal to 1, the bond is a single bond.
A helium atom has two electrons, both of which are in its 1s orbital. Two helium atoms do not combine to form a dihelium
molecule, He2, with four electrons, because the stabilizing effect of the two electrons in the lower-energy bonding orbital would be
offset by the destabilizing effect of the two electrons in the higher-energy antibonding molecular orbital. We would write the
hypothetical electron configuration of He2 as (σ ) (σ ) as in Figure 8.4.9. The net energy change would be zero, so there is no
1s
2 ∗
1s
2
driving force for helium atoms to form the diatomic molecule. In fact, helium exists as discrete atoms rather than as diatomic
molecules. The bond order in a hypothetical dihelium molecule would be zero.
(2 − 2)
bond order in He = =0
2
2
A bond order of zero indicates that no bond is formed between two atoms.
Li2 2
(σ2s ) 1
Be2 (unstable) 2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
)
2
0
B2 2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
2
) (π2py , π2pz )
2
1
C2 2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
2
) (π2py , π2pz )
4
2
N2 2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
2 4 2
) (π2py , π2pz ) (σ2px ) 3
O2 2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
2 2 4
) (σ2px ) (π2py , π2pz ) (π
∗
2py
,π
∗
2pz
)
2
2
F2 2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
2 2 4
) (σ2px ) (π2py , π2pz ) (π
∗
2py
, π
∗
2pz
)
4
1
Ne2 (unstable) 2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
2 2 4
) (σ2px ) (π2py , π2pz ) (π
∗
2py
,π
∗
2pz
4
) (σ
∗
2px
2
) 0
We predict valence molecular orbital electron configurations just as we predict electron configurations of atoms. Valence electrons
are assigned to valence molecular orbitals with the lowest possible energies. Consistent with Hund’s rule, whenever there are two
or more degenerate molecular orbitals, electrons fill each orbital of that type singly before any pairing of electrons takes place.
As we saw in valence bond theory, σ bonds are generally more stable than π bonds formed from degenerate atomic orbitals.
Similarly, in molecular orbital theory, σ orbitals are usually more stable than π orbitals. However, this is not always the case. The
MOs for the valence orbitals of the second period are shown in Figure 8.4.10. Looking at Ne2 molecular orbitals, we see that the
order is consistent with the generic diagram shown in the previous section. However, for atoms with three or fewer electrons in the
p orbitals (Li through N) we observe a different pattern, in which the σp orbital is higher in energy than the πp set. Obtain the
molecular orbital diagram for a homonuclear diatomic ion by adding or subtracting electrons from the diagram for the neutral
molecule.
This switch in orbital ordering occurs because of a phenomenon called s-p mixing. s-p mixing does not create new orbitals; it
merely influences the energies of the existing molecular orbitals. The σs wavefunction mathematically combines with the σp
wavefunction, with the result that the σs orbital becomes more stable, and the σp orbital becomes less stable (Figure 8.4.11).
Similarly, the antibonding orbitals also undergo s-p mixing, with the σs* becoming more stable and the σp* becoming less stable.
degenerate orbitals to be unpaired, and this molecular electronic configuration for O2 is in accord with the fact that the oxygen
molecule has two unpaired electrons ( Figure 8.4.10). The presence of two unpaired electrons has proved to be difficult to explain
using Lewis structures, but the molecular orbital theory explains it quite well. In fact, the unpaired electrons of the oxygen
molecule provide a strong piece of support for the molecular orbital theory.
When two identical atomic orbitals on different atoms combine, two molecular orbitals result (e.g., H in Figure 8.4.8). The
2
bonding orbital is lower in energy than the original atomic orbitals because the atomic orbitals are in-phase in the molecular
orbital. The antibonding orbital is higher in energy than the original atomic orbitals because the atomic orbitals are out-of-
phase.
Figure 8.4.12 : Molecular orbitals in solids are so closely spaced that they are described as bands. The valence band is lower in
energy and the conduction band is higher in energy. The type of solid is determined by the size of the “band gap” between the
valence and conduction bands. Only a very small amount of energy is required to move electrons from the valence band to the
conduction band in a conductor, and so they conduct electricity well. In an insulator, the band gap is large, so that very few
electrons move, and they are poor conductors of electricity. Semiconductors are in between: they conduct electricity better than
insulators, but not as well as conductors.
This figure shows three diagrams. The first is labeled, “Insulator,” and it consists of two boxes. The “conduction” box is above
and the “valence” box is below. A large gap marked by 4 dashed lines contains a double-headed arrow. One head pointing
towards the “conduction box” and the other towards the “valence” box. The arrow is labeled, “Band gap.” The second diagram
is similar to the first, but the band gap is about half as large. This diagram is labeled, “Semiconductor.” The third diagram is
similar to the other two, but the band gap is about a fifth that of the “Semiconductor” diagram. This diagram is labeled,
“Conductor.”
In order to conduct electricity, electrons must move from the filled valence band to the empty conduction band where they can
move throughout the solid. The size of the band gap, or the energy difference between the top of the valence band and the
bottom of the conduction band, determines how easy it is to move electrons between the bands. Only a small amount of energy
is required in a conductor because the band gap is very small. This small energy difference is “easy” to overcome, so they are
good conductors of electricity. In an insulator, the band gap is so “large” that very few electrons move into the conduction
band; as a result, insulators are poor conductors of electricity. Semiconductors conduct electricity when “moderate” amounts of
energy are provided to move electrons out of the valence band and into the conduction band. Semiconductors, such as silicon,
are found in many electronics.
Semiconductors are used in devices such as computers, smartphones, and solar cells. Solar cells produce electricity when light
provides the energy to move electrons out of the valence band. The electricity that is generated may then be used to power a
light or tool, or it can be stored for later use by charging a battery. As of December 2014, up to 46% of the energy in sunlight
could be converted into electricity using solar cells.
Example 8.4.2: Molecular Orbital Diagrams, Bond Order, and Number of Unpaired Electrons
Draw the molecular orbital diagram for the oxygen molecule, O2. From this diagram, calculate the bond order for O2. How
does this diagram account for the paramagnetism of O2?
Solution
Figure 8.4.13 : The molecular orbital energy diagram for O2 predicts two unpaired electrons.
We calculate the bond order as
(8 − 4)
O = =2
2
2
Oxygen's paramagnetism is explained by the presence of two unpaired electrons in the (π2py, π2pz)* molecular orbitals.
Exercise 8.4.2
The main component of air is N2. From the molecular orbital diagram of N2, predict its bond order and whether it is
diamagnetic or paramagnetic.
Answer
N2 has a bond order of 3 and is diamagnetic.
2
. Will this ion be stable?
Solution
Looking at the appropriate MO diagram, we see that the π orbitals are lower in energy than the σp orbital. The valence electron
configuration for C2 is
2
(σ2s ) (σ
∗
2s
2
) (π2py , π2pz )
4
.
Adding two more electrons to generate the C 2−
2
anion will give a valence electron configuration of
2 ∗ 2 4 2
(σ2s ) (σ ) (π2py , π2pz ) (σ2px )
2s
Since this has six more bonding electrons than antibonding, the bond order will be 3, and the ion should be stable.
2
ion? Would it be paramagnetic or diamagnetic?
Answer
two, paramagnetic
This page titled 8.4: Molecular Orbital Theory is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
∘
H2(g) + C l2(g) ⇌ 2H C l(g) ΔHrxn = −184.7 kJ/mol (8.E.1)
3. Explain why bonds occur at specific average bond distances instead of the atoms approaching each other infinitely close.
4. Use valence bond theory to explain the bonding in F2, HF, and ClBr. Sketch the overlap of the atomic orbitals involved in the
bonds.
5. Use valence bond theory to explain the bonding in O2. Sketch the overlap of the atomic orbitals involved in the bonds in O2.
6. How many σ and π bonds are present in the molecule HCN?
7. A friend tells you N2 has three π bonds due to overlap of the three p-orbitals on each N atom. Do you agree?
8. Draw the Lewis structures for CO2 and CO, and predict the number of σ and π bonds for each molecule.
a. CO2
b. CO
8.E.0.1: Solutions
1. Similarities: Both types of bonds result from overlap of atomic orbitals on adjacent atoms and contain a maximum of two
electrons. Differences: σ bonds are stronger and result from end-to-end overlap and all single bonds are σ bonds; π bonds between
the same two atoms are weaker because they result from side-by-side overlap, and multiple bonds contain one or more π bonds (in
addition to a σ bond).
2
When H and Cl are separate (the x axis) the energy is at a particular value. As they approach, it decreases to a minimum at 127 pm
(the bond distance), and then it increases sharply as you get closer.
a. (a) H–Cl431 kJ/mol 427kJmol×mol6.022×1023bonds×1000 JkJ=7.09×10−19
b. (b) We know Hess’s law related to bond energies: ΔH°=ƩΔH∘BDE(broken)−ƩΔH∘BDE(formed) We are given the enthalpy of
reaction
−184.7kJ/mol = (ΔH ∘ BDE(H – H ) + ΔH ∘ BDE(C l– C l)) − (2ΔH ∘ BDE(H – C l)) (8.E.2)
2x = 863.7kJ/mol (8.E.5)
6. H– C ≡ N has two σ (H–C and C–N) and two π (making the CN triple bond).
7. No, two of the p orbitals (one on each N) will be oriented end-to-end and will form a σ bond.
8. (a) 2 σ 2 π;
(b) 1 σ 2 π;
(d) PCl5
A molecule with the formula AB3 could have one of four different shapes. Give the shape and the hybridization of the central A
atom for each.
trigonal planar, sp2; trigonal pyramidal (one lone pair on A) sp3; T-shaped (two lone pairs on A sp3d, or (three lone pairs on A)
sp3d2
Methionine, CH3SCH2CH2CH(NH2)CO2H, is an amino acid found in proteins. Draw a Lewis structure of this compound. What is
the hybridization type of each carbon, oxygen, the nitrogen, and the sulfur?
Draw a Lewis structure, predict the molecular geometry by VSEPR, and determine the hybridization of sulfur for the following:
(a) circular S8 molecule
(b) SO2 molecule
(c) SO3 molecule
(d) H2SO4 molecule (the hydrogen atoms are bonded to oxygen atoms)
(a) Each S has a bent (109°) geometry, sp3
Two important industrial chemicals, ethene, C2H4, and propene, C3H6, are produced by the steam (or thermal) cracking process:
2 C H (g) ⟶ C H (g) + C H (g) + CH (g) + H (g)
3 8 2 4 3 6 4 2
(b) Describe the geometry about the P atoms, the S atom, and the Cl atom in these species.
(c) Assign a hybridization to the P atoms, the S atom, and the Cl atom in these species.
(d) Determine the oxidation states and formal charge of the atoms in P4S3 and the ClO ion.
−
(a)
(b) P atoms, trigonal pyramidal; S atoms, bent, with two lone pairs; Cl atoms, trigonal pyramidal; (c) Hybridization about P, S, and
1
Cl is, in all cases, sp3; (d) Oxidation states P +1, S −1 , Cl +5, O –2. Formal charges: P 0; S 0; Cl +2: O –1
3
Identify the hybridization of each carbon atom in the following molecule. (The arrangement of atoms is given; you need to
determine how many bonds connect each pair of atoms.)
Write Lewis structures for NF3 and PF5. On the basis of hybrid orbitals, explain the fact that NF3, PF3, and PF5 are stable
molecules, but NF5 does not exist.
Phosphorus and nitrogen can form sp3 hybrids to form three bonds and hold one lone pair in PF3 and NF3, respectively. However,
nitrogen has no valence d orbitals, so it cannot form a set of sp3d hybrid orbitals to bind five fluorine atoms in NF5. Phosphorus has
d orbitals and can bind five fluorine atoms with sp3d hybrid orbitals in PF5.
In addition to NF3, two other fluoro derivatives of nitrogen are known: N2F4 and N2F2. What shapes do you predict for these two
molecules? What is the hybridization for the nitrogen in each molecule?
A useful solvent that will dissolve salts as well as organic compounds is the compound acetonitrile, H3CCN. It is present in paint
strippers.
(a) Write the Lewis structure for acetonitrile, and indicate the direction of the dipole moment in the molecule.
(b) Identify the hybrid orbitals used by the carbon atoms in the molecule to form σ bonds.
(c) Describe the atomic orbitals that form the π bonds in the molecule. Note that it is not necessary to hybridize the nitrogen atom.
(a)
(b) The terminal carbon atom uses sp3 hybrid orbitals, while the central carbon atom is sp hybridized. (c) Each of the two π bonds
is formed by overlap of a 2p orbital on carbon and a nitrogen 2p orbital.
For the molecule allene, H C = C = C H , give the hybridization of each carbon atom. Will the hydrogen atoms be in the same
2 2
(a) sp ; (b) sp; (c) sp2; (d) sp3; (e) sp3; (f) sp3d; (g) sp3
2
Describe the molecular geometry and hybridization of the N, P, or S atoms in each of the following compounds.
(a) H3PO4, phosphoric acid, used in cola soft drinks
(b) NH4NO3, ammonium nitrate, a fertilizer and explosive
(c) S2Cl2, disulfur dichloride, used in vulcanizing rubber
(d) K4[O3POPO3], potassium pyrophosphate, an ingredient in some toothpastes
For each of the following molecules, indicate the hybridization requested and whether or not the electrons will be delocalized:
(a) ozone (O3) central O hybridization
(b) carbon dioxide (CO2) central C hybridization
(c) nitrogen dioxide (NO2) central N hybridization
(d) phosphate ion (PO 3−
4
) central P hybridization
(a) sp , delocalized; (b) sp, localized; (c) sp2, delocalized; (d) sp3, delocalized
2
Draw the orbital diagram for carbon in CO2 showing how many carbon atom electrons are in each orbital.
Each of the four electrons is in a separate orbital and overlaps with an electron on an oxygen atom.
Explain why an electron in the bonding molecular orbital in the H2 molecule has a lower energy than an electron in the 1s atomic
orbital of either of the separated hydrogen atoms.
The pairing of the two bonding electrons lowers the energy of the system relative to the energy of the nonbonded electrons.
Predict the valence electron molecular orbital configurations for the following, and state whether they will be stable or unstable
ions.
(a) Na 2+
2
(b) Mg 2+
2
(c) Al 2+
(d) Si 2+
2
(e) P 2+
2
(f) S 2+
2
(g) F 2+
2
(h) Ar 2+
2
Determine the bond order of each member of the following groups, and determine which member of each group is predicted by the
molecular orbital model to have the strongest bond.
(a) H2, H , H +
2
−
2
(b) O2, O 2+
2
,O 2−
2
(d) F2, F , F +
2
−
2
(e) N2, N , N +
2
−
(a) H2 bond order = 1, H bond order = 0.5, H bond order = 0.5, strongest bond is H2; (b) O2 bond order = 2, O bond order =
+
2
−
2
2+
2
3; O bond order = 1, strongest bond is O ; (c) Li2 bond order = 1, Be bond order = 0.5, Be2 bond order = 0, strongest bond is
2−
2
2+
2
+
2
Li ;(d) F2 bond order = 1, F bond order = 1.5, F bond order = 0.5, strongest bond is F ; (e) N2 bond order = 3, N bond order
+ − + +
2 2 2 2 2
2
is diamagnetic, while O
4+
2
, which has the same number of valence electrons, is paramagnetic.
N2 has s-p mixing, so the π orbitals are the last filled in N
2+
2
. O2 does not have s-p mixing, so the σp orbital fills before the π
orbitals.
Using the MO diagrams, predict the bond order for the stronger bond in each pair:
(a) B2 or B +
2
(b) F2 or F +
(c) O2 or O 2+
(d) C or C
+
2
−
2
This page titled 8.E: Advanced Theories of Covalent Bonding (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
Paul Flowers (University of North Carolina - Pembroke), Klaus Theopold (University of Delaware) and Richard Langley
(Stephen F. Austin State University) with contributing authors. Textbook content produced by OpenStax College is licensed
under a Creative Commons Attribution License 4.0 license. Download for free at http://cnx.org/contents/85abf193-
2bd...a7ac8df6@9.110).
Thumbnail: As long as black-body radiation (not shown) doesn't escape a system, atoms in thermal agitation undergo essentially
elastic collisions. On average, two atoms rebound from each other with the same kinetic energy as before a collision. Five
atoms are colored red so their paths of motion are easier to see. (Public Domain; Greg L via Wikipedia)
This page titled 9: Gases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was
edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
9.1: Gas Pressure
Learning Objectives
Define the property of pressure
Define and convert among the units of pressure measurements
Describe the operation of common tools for measuring gas pressure
Calculate pressure from manometer data
The earth’s atmosphere exerts a pressure, as does any other gas. Although we do not normally notice atmospheric pressure, we are
sensitive to pressure changes—for example, when your ears “pop” during take-off and landing while flying, or when you dive
underwater. Gas pressure is caused by the force exerted by gas molecules colliding with the surfaces of objects (Figure 9.1.1).
Although the force of each collision is very small, any surface of appreciable area experiences a large number of collisions in a
short time, which can result in a high pressure. In fact, normal air pressure is strong enough to crush a metal container when not
balanced by equal pressure from inside the container.
Figure 9.1.1 : The atmosphere above us exerts a large pressure on objects at the surface of the earth, roughly equal to the weight of
a bowling ball pressing on an area the size of a human thumbnail.
Diagram of Earth with a square inch column of air molecules extending to the atmosphere. This column points to an arrow pointing
down on a bowling ball resting on a human thumbnail placed on top of a table.
Atmospheric pressure is caused by the weight of the column of air molecules in the atmosphere above an object, such as the tanker
car. At sea level, this pressure is roughly the same as that exerted by a full-grown African elephant standing on a doormat, or a
typical bowling ball resting on your thumbnail. These may seem like huge amounts, and they are, but life on earth has evolved
under such atmospheric pressure. If you actually perch a bowling ball on your thumbnail, the pressure experienced is twice the
usual pressure, and the sensation is unpleasant.
A dramatic illustration of atmospheric pressure is provided in this brief video, which shows a railway tanker car imploding when
its internal pressure is decreased.
Pressure is defined as the force exerted on a given area:
F
P = (9.1.1)
A
Let’s apply the definition of pressure (Equation 9.1.1 ) to determine which would be more likely to fall through thin ice in Figure
9.1.2.—the elephant or the figure skater?
Figure 9.1.2 : Although (a) an elephant’s weight is large, creating a very large force on the ground, (b) the figure skater exerts a
much higher pressure on the ice due to the small surface area of her skates. (credit a: modification of work by Guido da Rozze;
credit b: modification of work by Ryosuke Yagi).
Figure a is a photo of a large gray elephant on grassy, beige terrain. Figure b is a photo of a figure skater with her right skate on the
ice, upper torso lowered, arms extended upward behind her chest, and left leg extended upward behind her.
A large African elephant can weigh 7 tons, supported on four feet, each with a diameter of about 1.5 ft (footprint area of 250 in2),
so the pressure exerted by each foot is about 14 lb/in2:
lb 1 elephant 1 f oot
2
pressure per elephant f oot = 14, 000 × × = 14 lb/i n (9.1.2)
2
elephant 4 f eet 250 in
The figure skater weighs about 120 lbs, supported on two skate blades, each with an area of about 2 in2, so the pressure exerted by
each blade is about 30 lb/in2:
lb 1 skater 1 blade 2
pressure per skate blade = 120 × × = 30 lb/i n (9.1.3)
2
skater 2 blades 2 in
Even though the elephant is more than one hundred times heavier than the skater, it exerts less than one-half of the pressure and
would therefore be less likely to fall through thin ice. On the other hand, if the skater removes her skates and stands with bare feet
(or regular footwear) on the ice, the larger area over which her weight is applied greatly reduces the pressure exerted:
lb 1 skater 1 f oot
2
pressure per human f oot = 120 × × = 2 lb/i n (9.1.4)
2
skater 2 f eet 30 in
The SI unit of pressure is the pascal (Pa), with 1 Pa = 1 N/m2, where N is the newton, a unit of force defined as 1 kg m/s2. One
pascal is a small pressure; in many cases, it is more convenient to use units of kilopascal (1 kPa = 1000 Pa) or bar (1 bar = 100,000
Pa). In the United States, pressure is often measured in pounds of force on an area of one square inch—pounds per square inch (psi)
—for example, in car tires. Pressure can also be measured using the unit atmosphere (atm), which originally represented the
average sea level air pressure at the approximate latitude of Paris (45°). Table 9.1.1 provides some information on these and a few
other common units for pressure measurements
Table 9.1.1 : Pressure Units
Unit Name and Abbreviation Definition or Relation to Other Unit Comment
pounds per square inch (psi) air pressure at sea level is ~14.7 psi
The United States National Weather Service reports pressure in both inches of Hg and millibars. Convert a pressure of 29.2 in.
Hg into:
a. torr
b. atm
c. kPa
d. mbar
Solution
This is a unit conversion problem. The relationships between the various pressure units are given in Table 9.2.1.
25.4 mm 1 torr
a. 29.2 in Hg × × = 742 torr
1 in 1 mm Hg
1 atm
b. 742 torr × = 0.976 atm
760 torr
101.325 kPa
c. 742 torr × = 98.9 kPa
760 torr
Exercise 9.1.1
A typical barometric pressure in Kansas City is 740 torr. What is this pressure in atmospheres, in millimeters of mercury, in
kilopascals, and in bar?
Answer
0.974 atm; 740 mm Hg; 98.7 kPa; 0.987 bar
We can measure atmospheric pressure, the force exerted by the atmosphere on the earth’s surface, with a barometer (Figure 9.1.3).
A barometer is a glass tube that is closed at one end, filled with a nonvolatile liquid such as mercury, and then inverted and
immersed in a container of that liquid. The atmosphere exerts pressure on the liquid outside the tube, the column of liquid exerts
pressure inside the tube, and the pressure at the liquid surface is the same inside and outside the tube. The height of the liquid in the
tube is therefore proportional to the pressure exerted by the atmosphere.
where
h is the height of the fluid,
ρ is the density of the fluid, and
g is acceleration due to gravity.
Show the calculation supporting the claim that atmospheric pressure near sea level corresponds to the pressure exerted by a
column of mercury that is about 760 mm high. The density of mercury = 13.6 g/cm . 3
Solution
The hydrostatic pressure is given by Equation 9.1.5, with h = 760 mm, ρ = 13.6 g/cm , and g = 9.81 m/s . Plugging these
3 2
values into the Equation 9.1.5 and doing the necessary unit conversions will give us the value we seek. (Note: We are
expecting to find a pressure of ~101,325 Pa:)
2
kg ⋅ m/s kg
2
101, 325 N/ m = 101, 325 = 101, 325
2 2
m m⋅s
3 2 5 2 5 2
= (0.760 m)(13, 600 kg/ m )(9.81 m/ s ) = 1.01 × 10 kg/ms = 1.01 × 10 N/ m
5
= 1.01 × 10 Pa
Exercise 9.1.2
Calculate the height of a column of water at 25 °C that corresponds to normal atmospheric pressure. The density of water at
this temperature is 1.0 g/cm3.
Answer
10.3 m
A manometer is a device similar to a barometer that can be used to measure the pressure of a gas trapped in a container. A closed-
end manometer is a U-shaped tube with one closed arm, one arm that connects to the gas to be measured, and a nonvolatile liquid
(usually mercury) in between. As with a barometer, the distance between the liquid levels in the two arms of the tube (h in the
diagram) is proportional to the pressure of the gas in the container. An open-end manometer (Figure 9.1.3) is the same as a closed-
end manometer, but one of its arms is open to the atmosphere. In this case, the distance between the liquid levels corresponds to the
difference in pressure between the gas in the container and the atmosphere.
Figure 9.1.4 : A manometer can be used to measure the pressure of a gas. The (difference in) height between the liquid levels (h) is
a measure of the pressure. Mercury is usually used because of its large density.
The first manometer is closed end. The gas in the bulb exerts a certain pressure on the liquid in the tube so that the height, h,
between the two levels of liquid on both sides of the U tube is proportional to the pressure. The equation is P subscript gas equals to
h rho g. The second manometer has an open end. The equation for P subscript gas is equals to P subscript atm minus h rho g. The
final manometer is also open ended and has equation of P subscript gas equals to P subscript atm plus h rho g for cases where
pressure of the gas is greater than atmospheric pressure.
The pressure of a sample of gas is measured at sea level with an open-end Hg (mercury) manometer, as shown below.
Determine the pressure of the gas in:
a. mm Hg
b. atm
c. kPa
Solution
The pressure of the gas equals the hydrostatic pressure due to a column of mercury of height 13.7 cm plus the pressure of the
atmosphere at sea level. (The pressure at the bottom horizontal line is equal on both sides of the tube. The pressure on the left
is due to the gas and the pressure on the right is due to 13.7 cm of Hg plus atmospheric pressure.)
a. In mm Hg, this is: 137 mm Hg + 760 mm Hg = 897 mm Hg
1 atm
b. 897 mmHg × = 1.18 atm
760 mmHg
101.325 kPa
c. 1.18 atm × = 1.20 × 10
2
kPa
1 atm
Exercise 9.1.3
The pressure of a sample of gas is measured at sea level with an open-end Hg manometer, as shown below Determine the
pressure of the gas in:
a. mm Hg
b. atm
c. kPa
The height is the difference between the two levels of mercury on each side of the U tube and has a value of 4.63 inches. The
level on the left side is higher than the right.
Answer a
642 mm Hg
Blood pressure is measured using a device called a sphygmomanometer (Greek sphygmos = “pulse”). It consists of an
inflatable cuff to restrict blood flow, a manometer to measure the pressure, and a method of determining when blood flow
begins and when it becomes impeded (Figure 9.1.5). Since its invention in 1881, it has been an essential medical device. There
are many types of sphygmomanometers: manual ones that require a stethoscope and are used by medical professionals;
mercury ones, used when the most accuracy is required; less accurate mechanical ones; and digital ones that can be used with
little training but that have limitations. When using a sphygmomanometer, the cuff is placed around the upper arm and inflated
until blood flow is completely blocked, then slowly released. As the heart beats, blood forced through the arteries causes a rise
in pressure. This rise in pressure at which blood flow begins is the systolic pressure—the peak pressure in the cardiac cycle.
When the cuff’s pressure equals the arterial systolic pressure, blood flows past the cuff, creating audible sounds that can be
heard using a stethoscope. This is followed by a decrease in pressure as the heart’s ventricles prepare for another beat. As cuff
pressure continues to decrease, eventually sound is no longer heard; this is the diastolic pressure—the lowest pressure (resting
phase) in the cardiac cycle. Blood pressure units from a sphygmomanometer are in terms of millimeters of mercury (mm Hg).
Figure 9.1.5 : (a) A medical technician prepares to measure a patient’s blood pressure with a sphygmomanometer. (b) A typical
sphygmomanometer uses a valved rubber bulb to inflate the cuff and a diaphragm gauge to measure pressure. (credit a:
modification of work by Master Sgt. Jeffrey Allen)
Figure 9.1.7 : Earth’s atmosphere has five layers: the troposphere, the stratosphere, the mesosphere, the thermosphere, and the
exosphere.
The different layers of the atmosphere is illustrated as a cross sectional slice of the Earth's atmosphere. The different thickness of
each layer is shown. The thermosphere has the largest portion, followed by the exosphere, stratosphere, mesosphere, and
troposphere.
Climatology is the study of the climate, averaged weather conditions over long time periods, using atmospheric data. However,
climatologists study patterns and effects that occur over decades, centuries, and millennia, rather than shorter time frames of hours,
days, and weeks like meteorologists. Atmospheric science is an even broader field, combining meteorology, climatology, and other
scientific disciplines that study the atmosphere.
Summary
Gases exert pressure, which is force per unit area. The pressure of a gas may be expressed in the SI unit of pascal or kilopascal, as
well as in many other units including torr, atmosphere, and bar. Atmospheric pressure is measured using a barometer; other gas
pressures can be measured using one of several types of manometers.
Glossary
atmosphere (atm)
unit of pressure; 1 atm = 101,325 Pa
bar
(bar or b) unit of pressure; 1 bar = 100,000 Pa
barometer
device used to measure atmospheric pressure
hydrostatic pressure
pressure exerted by a fluid due to gravity
manometer
device used to measure the pressure of a gas trapped in a container
pascal (Pa)
SI unit of pressure; 1 Pa = 1 N/m2
pressure
force exerted per unit area
torr
1
unit of pressure; 1 torr = atm
760
This page titled 9.1: Gas Pressure is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
During the seventeenth and especially eighteenth centuries, driven both by a desire to understand nature and a quest to make balloons in which they could fly (Figure 9.2.1), a number of scientists
established the relationships between the macroscopic physical properties of gases, that is, pressure, volume, temperature, and amount of gas. Although their measurements were not precise by
today’s standards, they were able to determine the mathematical relationships between pairs of these variables (e.g., pressure and temperature, pressure and volume) that hold for an ideal gas—a
hypothetical construct that real gases approximate under certain conditions. Eventually, these individual laws were combined into a single equation—the ideal gas law—that relates gas quantities
for gases and is quite accurate for low pressures and moderate temperatures. We will consider the key developments in individual relationships (for pedagogical reasons not quite in historical order),
then put them together in the ideal gas law.
Figure 9.2.1 : In 1783, the first (a) hydrogen-filled balloon flight, (b) manned hot air balloon flight, and (c) manned hydrogen-filled balloon flight occurred. When the hydrogen-filled balloon
depicted in (a) landed, the frightened villagers of Gonesse reportedly destroyed it with pitchforks and knives. The launch of the latter was reportedly viewed by 400,000 people in Paris.
This figure includes three images. Image a is a black and white image of a hydrogen balloon apparently being deflated by a mob of people. In image b, a blue, gold, and red balloon is being held to
the ground with ropes while positioned above a platform from which smoke is rising beneath the balloon. In c, an image is shown in grey on a peach-colored background of an inflated balloon with
vertical striping in the air. It appears to have a basket attached to its lower side. A large stately building appears in the background.
Figure 9.2.2 : The effect of temperature on gas pressure: When the hot plate is off, the pressure of the gas in the sphere is relatively low. As the gas is heated, the pressure of the gas in the sphere
increases.
This figure includes three similar diagrams. In the first diagram to the left, a rigid spherical container of a gas to which a pressure gauge is attached at the top is placed in a large beaker of water,
indicated in light blue, atop a hot plate. The needle on the pressure gauge points to the far left on the gauge. The diagram is labeled “low P” above and “hot plate off” below. The second similar
diagram also has the rigid spherical container of gas placed in a large beaker from which light blue wavy line segments extend from the top of the liquid in the beaker. The beaker is situated on top
of a slightly reddened circular area. The needle on the pressure gauge points straight up, or to the middle on the gauge. The diagram is labeled “medium P” above and “hot plate on medium” below.
The third diagram also has the rigid spherical container of gas placed in a large beaker in which bubbles appear near the liquid surface and several wavy light blue line segments extend from the
surface out of the beaker. The beaker is situated on top of a bright red circular area. The needle on the pressure gauge points to the far right on the gauge. The diagram is labeled “high P” above and
“hot plate on high” below.
This relationship between temperature and pressure is observed for any sample of gas confined to a constant volume. An example of experimental pressure-temperature data is shown for a sample
of air under these conditions in Figure 9.2.3. We find that temperature and pressure are linearly related, and if the temperature is on the kelvin scale, then P and T are directly proportional (again,
when volume and moles of gas are held constant); if the temperature on the kelvin scale increases by a certain factor, the gas pressure increases by the same factor.
Figure 9.2.3 : For a constant volume and amount of air, the pressure and temperature are directly proportional, provided the temperature is in kelvin. (Measurements cannot be made at lower
temperatures because of the condensation of the gas.) When this line is extrapolated to lower pressures, it reaches a pressure of 0 at –273 °C, which is 0 on the kelvin scale and the lowest possible
temperature, called absolute zero.
This figure includes a table and a graph. The table has 3 columns and 7 rows. The first row is a header, which labels the columns “Temperature, degrees C,” “Temperature, K,” and “Pressure, k P a.”
The first column contains the values from top to bottom negative 150, negative 100, negative 50, 0, 50, and 100. The second column contains the values from top to bottom 173, 223, 273, 323, 373,
and 423. The third column contains the values 36.0, 46.4, 56.7, 67.1, 77.5, and 88.0. A graph appears to the right of the table. The horizontal axis is labeled “Temperature ( K ).” with markings and
labels provided for multiples of 100 beginning at 0 and ending at 500. The vertical axis is labeled “Pressure ( k P a )” with markings and labels provided for multiples of 10, beginning at 0 and
ending at 100. Six data points from the table are plotted on the graph with black dots. These dots are connected with a solid black line. A dashed line extends from the data point furthest to the left
to the origin. The graph shows a positive linear trend.
Guillaume Amontons was the first to empirically establish the relationship between the pressure and the temperature of a gas (~1700), and Joseph Louis Gay-Lussac determined the relationship
more precisely (~1800). Because of this, the P-T relationship for gases is known as either Amontons’s law or Gay-Lussac’s law. Under either name, it states that the pressure of a given amount of
gas is directly proportional to its temperature on the kelvin scale when the volume is held constant. Mathematically, this can be written:
where ∝ means “is proportional to,” and k is a proportionality constant that depends on the identity, amount, and volume of the gas.
P P
For a confined, constant volume of gas, the ratio is therefore constant (i.e., =k ). If the gas is initially in “Condition 1” (with P = P1 and T = T1), and then changes to “Condition 2” (with P =
T T
P1 P2 P1 P2
P2 and T = T2), we have that =k and =k , which reduces to = . This equation is useful for pressure-temperature calculations for a confined gas at constant volume. Note that
T1 T2 T1 T2
temperatures must be on the kelvin scale for any gas law calculations (0 on the kelvin scale and the lowest possible temperature is called absolute zero). (Also note that there are at least three ways
we can describe how the pressure of a gas changes as its temperature changes: We can use a table of values, a graph, or a mathematical equation.)
A can of hair spray is used until it is empty except for the propellant, isobutane gas.
a. On the can is the warning “Store only at temperatures below 120 °F (48.8 °C). Do not incinerate.” Why?
b. The gas in the can is initially at 24 °C and 360 kPa, and the can has a volume of 350 mL. If the can is left in a car that reaches 50 °C on a hot day, what is the new pressure in the can?
Solution
a. The can contains an amount of isobutane gas at a constant volume, so if the temperature is increased by heating, the pressure will increase proportionately. High temperature could lead to
high pressure, causing the can to burst. (Also, isobutane is combustible, so incineration could cause the can to explode.)
b. We are looking for a pressure change due to a temperature change at constant volume, so we will use Amontons’s/Gay-Lussac’s law. Taking P1 and T1 as the initial values, T2 as the
temperature where the pressure is unknown and P2 as the unknown pressure, and converting °C to K, we have:
P1 P2 360 kPa P2
= which means that =
T1 T2 297 K 323 K
Exercise 9.2.1
A sample of nitrogen, N2, occupies 45.0 mL at 27 °C and 600 torr. What pressure will it have if cooled to –73 °C while the volume remains constant?
Answer
400 torr
Video 9.2.1 : This video shows how cooling and heating a gas causes its volume to decrease or increase, respectively.
These examples of the effect of temperature on the volume of a given amount of a confined gas at constant pressure are true in general: The volume increases as the temperature increases, and
decreases as the temperature decreases. Volume-temperature data for a 1-mole sample of methane gas at 1 atm are listed and graphed in Figure 9.2.2.
V αT or V = constant ⋅ T or V = k ⋅ T
with k being a proportionality constant that depends on the amount and pressure of the gas.
V V1 V2
For a confined, constant pressure gas sample, is constant (i.e., the ratio = k), and as seen with the P-T relationship, this leads to another form of Charles’s law: = .
T T1 T2
A sample of carbon dioxide, CO2, occupies 0.300 L at 10 °C and 750 torr. What volume will the gas have at 30 °C and 750 torr?
Solution
Because we are looking for the volume change caused by a temperature change at constant pressure, this is a job for Charles’s law. Taking V1 and T1 as the initial values, T2 as the temperature at
which the volume is unknown and V2 as the unknown volume, and converting °C into K we have:
V1 V2 0.300 L V2
= which means that =
T1 T2 283 K 303 K
0.300 L × 303 K
Rearranging and solving gives: V 2 = = 0.321 L
283 K
This answer supports our expectation from Charles’s law, namely, that raising the gas temperature (from 283 K to 303 K) at a constant pressure will yield an increase in its volume (from 0.300 L to
0.321 L).
Exercise 9.2.2
A sample of oxygen, O2, occupies 32.2 mL at 30 °C and 452 torr. What volume will it occupy at –70 °C and the same pressure?
Answer
21.6 mL
Change Temperature is sometimes measured with a gas thermometer by observing the change in the volume of the gas as the temperature changes at constant pressure. The hydrogen in a
particular hydrogen gas thermometer has a volume of 150.0 cm3 when immersed in a mixture of ice and water (0.00 °C). When immersed in boiling liquid ammonia, the volume of the
hydrogen, at the same pressure, is 131.7 cm3. Find the temperature of boiling ammonia on the kelvin and Celsius scales.
Solution
A volume change caused by a temperature change at constant pressure means we should use Charles’s law. Taking V1 and T1 as the initial values, T2 as the temperature at which the volume is
unknown and V2 as the unknown volume, and converting °C into K we have:
3 3
V1 V2 150.0 cm 131.7 cm
= which means that =
T1 T2 273.15 K T2
3
131.7 cm × 273.15 K
Rearrangement gives T 2 =
3
= 239.8 K
150.0 cm
Subtracting 273.15 from 239.8 K, we find that the temperature of the boiling ammonia on the Celsius scale is –33.4 °C.
Exercise 9.2.3
What is the volume of a sample of ethane at 467 K and 1.1 atm if it occupies 405 mL at 298 K and 1.1 atm?
Answer
635 mL
Figure 9.2.5 : When a gas occupies a smaller volume, it exerts a higher pressure; when it occupies a larger volume, it exerts a lower pressure (assuming the amount of gas and the temperature do not
1
change). Since P and V are inversely proportional, a graph of vs. V is linear.
P
This figure contains a diagram and two graphs. The diagram shows a syringe labeled with a scale in m l or c c with multiples of 5 labeled beginning at 5 and ending at 30. The markings halfway
between these measurements are also provided. Attached at the top of the syringe is a pressure gauge with a scale marked by fives from 40 on the left to 5 on the right. The gauge needle rests
between 10 and 15, slightly closer to 15. The syringe plunger position indicates a volume measurement about halfway between 10 and 15 m l or c c. The first graph is labeled “V ( m L )” on the
horizontal axis and “P ( p s i )” on the vertical axis. Points are labeled at 5, 10, 15, 20, and 25 m L with corresponding values of 39.0, 19.5, 13.0, 9.8, and 6.5 p s i. The points are connected with a
smooth curve that is declining at a decreasing rate of change. The second graph is labeled “V ( m L )” on the horizontal axis and “1 divided by P ( p s i )” on the vertical axis. The horizontal axis is
labeled at multiples of 5, beginning at zero and extending up to 35 m L. The vertical axis is labeled by multiples of 0.02, beginning at 0 and extending up to 0.18. Six points indicated by black dots
on this graph are connected with a black line segment showing a positive linear trend.
Unlike the P-T and V-T relationships, pressure and volume are not directly proportional to each other. Instead, P and V exhibit inverse proportionality: Increasing the pressure results in a decrease
of the volume of the gas. Mathematically this can be written:
1
P ∝
V
or
1
P =k⋅
V
or
PV = k
or
P1 V1 = P2 V2
1
with k being a constant. Graphically, this relationship is shown by the straight line that results when plotting the inverse of the pressure ( ) versus the volume (V), or the inverse of volume
P
1
( ) versus the pressure (P ). Graphs with curved lines are difficult to read accurately at low or high values of the variables, and they are more difficult to use in fitting theoretical equations and
V
parameters to experimental data. For those reasons, scientists often try to find a way to “linearize” their data. If we plot P versus V, we obtain a hyperbola (Figure 9.2.6).
1
Figure 9.2.6 : The relationship between pressure and volume is inversely proportional. (a) The graph of P vs. V is a hyperbola, whereas (b) the graph of ( ) vs. V is linear.
P
This diagram shows two graphs. In a, a graph is shown with volume on the horizontal axis and pressure on the vertical axis. A curved line is shown on the graph showing a decreasing trend with a
decreasing rate of change. In b, a graph is shown with volume on the horizontal axis and one divided by pressure on the vertical axis. A line segment, beginning at the origin of the graph, shows a
positive, linear trend.
The relationship between the volume and pressure of a given amount of gas at constant temperature was first published by the English natural philosopher Robert Boyle over 300 years ago. It is
summarized in the statement now known as Boyle’s law: The volume of a given amount of gas held at constant temperature is inversely proportional to the pressure under which it is measured.
Solution
a. Estimating from the P-V graph gives a value for P somewhere around 27 psi.
1
b. Estimating from the versus V graph give a value of about 26 psi.
P
c. From Boyle’s law, we know that the product of pressure and volume (PV) for a given sample of gas at a constant temperature is always equal to the same value. Therefore we have P1V1 = k
and P2V2 = k which means that P1V1 = P2V2.
Using P1 and V1 as the known values 13.0 psi and 15.0 mL, P2 as the pressure at which the volume is unknown, and V2 as the unknown volume, we have:
Solving:
It was more difficult to estimate well from the P-V graph, so (a) is likely more inaccurate than (b) or (c). The calculation will be as accurate as the equation and measurements allow.
Exercise 9.2.4
The sample of gas has a volume of 30.0 mL at a pressure of 6.5 psi. Determine the volume of the gas at a pressure of 11.0 psi, using:
a. the P-V graph in Figure 9.2.6a
1
b. the vs. V graph in Figure 9.2.6b
P
c. the Boyle’s law equation
Comment on the likely accuracy of each method.
Answer a
about 17–18 mL
Answer b
~18 mL
Answer c
17.7 mL; it was more difficult to estimate well from the P-V graph, so (a) is likely more inaccurate than (b); the calculation will be as accurate as the equation and measurements allow
What do you do about 20 times per minute for your whole life, without break, and often without even being aware of it? The answer, of course, is respiration, or breathing. How does it work? It
turns out that the gas laws apply here. Your lungs take in gas that your body needs (oxygen) and get rid of waste gas (carbon dioxide). Lungs are made of spongy, stretchy tissue that expands
and contracts while you breathe. When you inhale, your diaphragm and intercostal muscles (the muscles between your ribs) contract, expanding your chest cavity and making your lung volume
larger. The increase in volume leads to a decrease in pressure (Boyle’s law). This causes air to flow into the lungs (from high pressure to low pressure). When you exhale, the process reverses:
Your diaphragm and rib muscles relax, your chest cavity contracts, and your lung volume decreases, causing the pressure to increase (Boyle’s law again), and air flows out of the lungs (from
high pressure to low pressure). You then breathe in and out again, and again, repeating this Boyle’s law cycle for the rest of your life (Figure 9.2.7).
Figure 9.2.7 : Breathing occurs because expanding and contracting lung volume creates small pressure differences between your lungs and your surroundings, causing air to be drawn into and
forced out of your lungs.
This figure contains two diagrams of a cross section of the human head and torso. The first diagram on the left is labeled “Inspiration.” It shows curved arrows in gray proceeding through the
nasal passages and mouth to the lungs. An arrow points downward from the diaphragm, which is relatively flat, just beneath the lungs. This arrow is labeled “Diaphragm contracts.” At the
entrance to the mouth and nasal passages, a label of P subscript lungs equals 1 dash 3 torr lower” is provided. The second, similar diagram, which is labeled “Expiration,” reverses the direction
of both arrows. Arrows extend from the lungs out through the nasal passages and mouth. Similarly, an arrow points up to the diaphragm, showing a curved diaphragm and lungs reduced in size
from the previous image. This arrow is labeled “Diaphragm relaxes.” At the entrance to the mouth and nasal passages, a label of P subscript lungs equals 1 dash 3 torr higher” is provided.
Mathematical relationships can also be determined for the other variable pairs, such as P versus n, and n versus T.
Visit this interactive PhET simulation to investigate the relationships between pressure, volume, temperature, and amount of gas. Use the
simulation to examine the effect of changing one parameter on another while holding the other parameters constant (as described in the
preceding sections on the various gas laws).
Combining these four laws yields the ideal gas law, a relation between the pressure, volume, temperature, and number of moles of a gas:
P V = nRT
where P is the pressure of a gas, V is its volume, n is the number of moles of the gas, T is its temperature on the kelvin scale, and R is a constant called the ideal gas constant or the universal gas
constant. The units used to express pressure, volume, and temperature will determine the proper form of the gas constant as required by dimensional analysis, the most commonly encountered
values being 0.08206 L atm mol–1 K–1 and 8.3145 kPa L mol–1 K–1.
The ideal gas law is easy to remember and apply in solving problems, as long as you use the proper values and units for the gas constant, R.
Gases whose properties of P, V, and T are accurately described by the ideal gas law (or the other gas laws) are said to exhibit ideal behavior or to approximate the traits of an ideal gas. An ideal gas
is a hypothetical construct that may be used along with kinetic molecular theory to effectively explain the gas laws as will be described in a later module of this chapter. Although all the calculations
presented in this module assume ideal behavior, this assumption is only reasonable for gases under conditions of relatively low pressure and high temperature. In the final module of this chapter, a
modified gas law will be introduced that accounts for the non-ideal behavior observed for many gases at relatively high pressures and low temperatures.
The ideal gas equation contains five terms, the gas constant R and the variable properties P, V, n, and T. Specifying any four of these terms will permit use of the ideal gas law to calculate the fifth
term as demonstrated in the following example exercises.
Solution
Exercise 9.2.5
Calculate the pressure in bar of 2520 moles of hydrogen gas stored at 27 °C in the 180-L storage tank of a modern hydrogen-powered car.
Answer
350 bar
P1 V1 P2 V2
If the number of moles of an ideal gas are kept constant under two different sets of conditions, a useful mathematical relationship called the combined gas law is obtained: = using
T1 T2
units of atm, L, and K. Both sets of conditions are equal to the product of n × R (where n = the number of moles of the gas and R is the ideal gas law constant).
When filled with air, a typical scuba tank with a volume of 13.2 L has a pressure of 153 atm (Figure 9.2.8). If the water temperature is 27 °C, how many liters of air will such a tank provide to a
diver’s lungs at a depth of approximately 70 feet in the ocean where the pressure is 3.13 atm?
Figure 9.2.8 : Scuba divers use compressed air to breathe while underwater. (credit: modification of work by Mark Goodchild)
This photograph shows a scuba diver underwater with a tank on his or her back and bubbles ascending from the breathing apparatus.
Letting 1 represent the air in the scuba tank and 2 represent the air in the lungs, and noting that body temperature (the temperature the air will be in the lungs) is 37 °C, we have:
(Note: Be advised that this particular example is one in which the assumption of ideal gas behavior is not very reasonable, since it involves gases at relatively high pressures and low
temperatures. Despite this limitation, the calculated volume can be viewed as a good “ballpark” estimate.)
Exercise 9.2.6
A sample of ammonia is found to occupy 0.250 L under laboratory conditions of 27 °C and 0.850 atm. Find the volume of this sample at 0 °C and 1.00 atm.
Answer
0.193 L
Figure 9.2.9 : Scuba divers, whether at the Great Barrier Reef or in the Caribbean, must be aware of buoyancy, pressure equalization, and the amount of time they spend underwater, to avoid the
risks associated with pressurized gases in the body. (credit: Kyle Taylor).
This picture shows colorful underwater corals and anemones in hues of yellow, orange, green, and brown, surrounded by water that appears blue in color.
Pressure increases with ocean depth, and the pressure changes most rapidly as divers reach the surface. The pressure a diver experiences is the sum of all pressures above the diver (from the
water and the air). Most pressure measurements are given in units of atmospheres, expressed as “atmospheres absolute” or ATA in the diving community: Every 33 feet of salt water represents
1 ATA of pressure in addition to 1 ATA of pressure from the atmosphere at sea level. As a diver descends, the increase in pressure causes the body’s air pockets in the ears and lungs to
compress; on the ascent, the decrease in pressure causes these air pockets to expand, potentially rupturing eardrums or bursting the lungs. Divers must therefore undergo equalization by adding
air to body airspaces on the descent by breathing normally and adding air to the mask by breathing out of the nose or adding air to the ears and sinuses by equalization techniques; the corollary
is also true on ascent, divers must release air from the body to maintain equalization. Buoyancy, or the ability to control whether a diver sinks or floats, is controlled by the buoyancy
compensator (BCD). If a diver is ascending, the air in his BCD expands because of lower pressure according to Boyle’s law (decreasing the pressure of gases increases the volume). The
expanding air increases the buoyancy of the diver, and she or he begins to ascend. The diver must vent air from the BCD or risk an uncontrolled ascent that could rupture the lungs. In
descending, the increased pressure causes the air in the BCD to compress and the diver sinks much more quickly; the diver must add air to the BCD or risk an uncontrolled descent, facing much
higher pressures near the ocean floor. The pressure also impacts how long a diver can stay underwater before ascending. The deeper a diver dives, the more compressed the air that is breathed
because of increased pressure: If a diver dives 33 feet, the pressure is 2 ATA and the air would be compressed to one-half of its original volume. The diver uses up available air twice as fast as
at the surface.
Figure 9.2.10 : Since the number of moles in a given volume of gas varies with pressure and temperature changes, chemists use standard temperature and pressure (273.15 K and 1 atm or 101.325
kPa) to report properties of gases.
This figure shows three balloons each filled with H e, N H subscript 2, and O subscript 2 respectively. Beneath the first balloon is the label “4 g of He” Beneath the second balloon is the label, “15 g
of N H subscript 2.” Beneath the third balloon is the label “32 g of O subscript 2.” Each balloon contains the same number of molecules of their respective gases.
Summary
The behavior of gases can be described by several laws based on experimental observations of their properties. The pressure of a given amount of gas is directly proportional to its absolute
temperature, provided that the volume does not change (Amontons’s law). The volume of a given gas sample is directly proportional to its absolute temperature at constant pressure (Charles’s law).
Summary
absolute zero
temperature at which the volume of a gas would be zero according to Charles’s law.
Amontons’s law
(also, Gay-Lussac’s law) pressure of a given number of moles of gas is directly proportional to its kelvin temperature when the volume is held constant
Avogadro’s law
volume of a gas at constant temperature and pressure is proportional to the number of gas molecules
Boyle’s law
volume of a given number of moles of gas held at constant temperature is inversely proportional to the pressure under which it is measured
Charles’s law
volume of a given number of moles of gas is directly proportional to its kelvin temperature when the pressure is held constant
ideal gas
hypothetical gas whose physical properties are perfectly described by the gas laws
This page titled 9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was
edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The study of the chemical behavior of gases was part of the basis of perhaps the most fundamental chemical revolution in history.
French nobleman Antoine Lavoisier, widely regarded as the “father of modern chemistry,” changed chemistry from a qualitative to
a quantitative science through his work with gases. He discovered the law of conservation of matter, discovered the role of oxygen
in combustion reactions, determined the composition of air, explained respiration in terms of chemical reactions, and more. He was
a casualty of the French Revolution, guillotined in 1794. Of his death, mathematician and astronomer Joseph-Louis Lagrange said,
“It took the mob only a moment to remove his head; a century will not suffice to reproduce it."
As described in an earlier chapter of this text, we can turn to chemical stoichiometry for answers to many of the questions that ask
“How much?” We can answer the question with masses of substances or volumes of solutions. However, we can also answer this
question another way: with volumes of gases. We can use the ideal gas equation to relate the pressure, volume, temperature, and
number of moles of a gas. Here we will combine the ideal gas equation with other equations to find gas density and molar mass.
We will deal with mixtures of different gases, and calculate amounts of substances in reactions involving gases. This section will
not introduce any new material or ideas, but will provide examples of applications and ways to integrate concepts we have already
discussed.
Example 9.3.1: Derivation of a Density Formula from the Ideal Gas Law
Use PV = nRT to derive a formula for the density of gas in g/L
Solution
P V = nRT
Multiply each side of the equation by the molar mass, ℳ. When moles are multiplied by ℳ in g/mol, g are obtained:
n P
(M) ( ) =( ) (M)
V RT
PM
M/V = ρ =
RT
Exercise 9.3.1
A gas was found to have a density of 0.0847 g/L at 17.0 °C and a pressure of 760 torr. What is its molar mass? What is the gas?
Answer
1 atm M
0.0847 g/L = 760 torr × × × 290 K
760 torr 0.0821 L atm /mol K
ℳ = 2.02 g/mol; therefore, the gas must be hydrogen (H2, 2.02 g/mol)
We must specify both the temperature and the pressure of a gas when calculating its density because the number of moles of a gas
(and thus the mass of the gas) in a liter changes with temperature or pressure. Gas densities are often reported at STP.
Using the Ideal Gas Law and Density of a Gas Cyclopropane, a gas once used with oxygen as a general anesthetic, is
composed of 85.7% carbon and 14.3% hydrogen by mass. Find the empirical formula. If 1.56 g of cyclopropane occupies a
volume of 1.00 L at 0.984 atm and 50 °C, what is the molecular formula for cyclopropane?
Solution
Strategy:
First solve the empirical formula problem using methods discussed earlier. Assume 100 g and convert the percentage of each
element into grams. Determine the number of moles of carbon and hydrogen in the 100-g sample of cyclopropane. Divide by
the smallest number of moles to relate the number of moles of carbon to the number of moles of hydrogen. In the last step,
realize that the smallest whole number ratio is the empirical formula:
1 mol C 7.136
85.7 g C × = 7.136 mol C = 1.00 mol C
12.01 g C 7.136
1 mol H 14.158
14.3 g H × = 14.158 mol H = 1.98 mol H
1.01 g H 7.136
M 42.0
ℳ = 42.0 g/mol, = = 2.99 , so (3)(CH2) = C3H6 (molecular formula)
EM 14.03
Exercise 9.3.2
Acetylene, a fuel used welding torches, is comprised of 92.3% C and 7.7% H by mass. Find the empirical formula. If 1.10 g of
acetylene occupies of volume of 1.00 L at 1.15 atm and 59.5 °C, what is the molecular formula for acetylene?
Answer
Empirical formula, CH; Molecular formula, C2H2
This equation can be used to derive the molar mass of a gas from measurements of its pressure, volume, temperature, and mass.
Figure 9.3.1 : When the volatile liquid in the flask is heated past its boiling point, it becomes gas and drives air out of the flask.
At tl ⟶g , the flask is filled with volatile liquid gas at the same pressure as the atmosphere. If the flask is then cooled to room
temperature, the gas condenses and the mass of the gas that filled the flask, and is now liquid, can be measured. (credit:
modification of work by Mark Ott)
Using this procedure, a sample of chloroform gas weighing 0.494 g is collected in a flask with a volume of 129 cm3 at 99.6 °C
when the atmospheric pressure is 742.1 mm Hg. What is the approximate molar mass of chloroform?
Solution
Since
m
M=
n
and
PV
n =
RT
then
mRT (0.494 g) × 0.08206 L ⋅ atm/mol K × 372.8 K
M= = = 120 g/mol
PV 0.976 atm × 0.129 L
Answer
124 g/mol P4
PT otal = PA + PB + PC +. . . = ∑ Pi
In the equation PTotal is the total pressure of a mixture of gases, PA is the partial pressure of gas A; PB is the partial pressure of gas
B; PC is the partial pressure of gas C; and so on.
Figure 9.3.2 : If equal-volume cylinders containing gas A at a pressure of 300 kPa, gas B at a pressure of 600 kPa, and gas C at a
pressure of 450 kPa are all combined in the same-size cylinder, the total pressure of the mixture is 1350 kPa.
This figure includes images of four gas-filled cylinders or tanks. Each has a valve at the top. The interior of the first cylinder is
shaded blue. This region contains 5 small blue circles that are evenly distributed. The label “300 k P a” is on the cylinder. The
second cylinder is shaded lavender. This region contains 8 small purple circles that are evenly distributed. The label “600 k P a” is
on the cylinder. To the right of these cylinders is a third cylinder. Its interior is shaded pale yellow. This region contains 12 small
yellow circles that are evenly distributed. The label “450 k P a” is on this region of the cylinder. An arrow labeled “Total pressure
combined” appears to the right of these three cylinders. This arrow points to a fourth cylinder. The interior of this cylinder is
shaded a pale green. It contains evenly distributed small circles in the following quantities and colors; 5 blue, 8 purple, and 12
yellow. This cylinder is labeled “1350 k P a.”
The partial pressure of gas A is related to the total pressure of the gas mixture via its mole fraction (X), a unit of concentration
defined as the number of moles of a component of a solution divided by the total number of moles of all components:
nA
PA = XA × PT otal where XA =
nT otal
where PA, XA, and nA are the partial pressure, mole fraction, and number of moles of gas A, respectively, and nTotal is the number of
moles of all components in the mixture.
−3 −1 −1
(2.50 × 10 mol)(0.08206 L atm mol K )(308 K )
−3
PH2 = = 6.32 × 10 atm
10.0 L
−3 −1 −1
(1.00 × 10 mol )(0.08206 L atm mol K )(308 K )
−3
PHe = = 2.53 × 10 atm
10.0 L
−4 −1 −1
(3.00 × 10 mol )(0.08206 L atm mol K )(308 K )
−4
PNe = = 7.58 × 10 atm
10.0 L
Exercise 9.3.2
A 5.73-L flask at 25 °C contains 0.0388 mol of N2, 0.147 mol of CO, and 0.0803 mol of H2. What is the total pressure in the
flask in atmospheres?
Answer
1.137 atm
Here is another example of this concept, but dealing with mole fraction calculations.
A gas mixture used for anesthesia contains 2.83 mol oxygen, O2, and 8.41 mol nitrous oxide, N2O. The total pressure of the
mixture is 192 kPa.
a. What are the mole fractions of O2 and N2O?
b. What are the partial pressures of O2 and N2O?
Solution
The mole fraction is given by
nA
XA =
nT otal
PA = XA × PT otal
For O2,
nO2 2.83mol
XO2 = = = 0.252
nT otal (2.83 + 8.41) mol
and
For N2O,
and
Exercise 9.3.3
What is the pressure of a mixture of 0.200 g of H2, 1.00 g of N2, and 0.820 g of Ar in a container with a volume of 2.00 L at 20
°C?
Answer
1.87 atm
Figure 9.3.3 : When a reaction produces a gas that is collected above water, the trapped gas is a mixture of the gas produced by the
reaction and water vapor. If the collection flask is appropriately positioned to equalize the water levels both within and outside the
flask, the pressure of the trapped gas mixture will equal the atmospheric pressure outside the flask (see the earlier discussion of
manometers).
This figure shows a diagram of equipment used for collecting a gas over water. To the left is an Erlenmeyer flask. It is
approximately two thirds full of a lavender colored liquid. Bubbles are evident in the liquid. The label “Reaction Producing Gas”
appears below the flask. A line segment connects this label to the liquid in the flask. The flask has a stopper in it through which a
single glass tube extends from the open region above the liquid in the flask up, through the stopper, to the right, then angles down
into a pan that is nearly full of light blue water. This tube again extends right once it is well beneath the water’s surface. It then
bends up into an inverted flask which is labeled “Collection Flask.” This collection flask is positioned with its mouth beneath the
surface of the light blue water and appears approximately half full. Bubbles are evident in the water in the inverted flask. The open
space above the water in the inverted flask is labeled “collected gas.”
However, there is another factor we must consider when we measure the pressure of the gas by this method. Water evaporates and
there is always gaseous water (water vapor) above a sample of liquid water. As a gas is collected over water, it becomes saturated
with water vapor and the total pressure of the mixture equals the partial pressure of the gas plus the partial pressure of the water
vapor. The pressure of the pure gas is therefore equal to the total pressure minus the pressure of the water vapor—this is referred to
as the “dry” gas pressure, that is, the pressure of the gas only, without water vapor.
The vapor pressure of water, which is the pressure exerted by water vapor in equilibrium with liquid water in a closed container,
depends on the temperature (Figure 9.3.4); more detailed information on the temperature dependence of water vapor can be found
in Table 9.3.1, and vapor pressure will be discussed in more detail in the next chapter on liquids.
Table 9.3.1 : Vapor Pressure of Ice and Water in Various Temperatures at Sea Level
Temperature Temperature Temperature
Pressure (torr) Pressure (torr) Pressure (torr)
(°C) (°C) (°C)
If 0.200 L of argon is collected over water at a temperature of 26 °C and a pressure of 750 torr in a system like that shown in
Figure 9.3.3, what is the partial pressure of argon?
Solution
According to Dalton’s law, the total pressure in the bottle (750 torr) is the sum of the partial pressure of argon and the partial
pressure of gaseous water:
PT = PAr + PH2 O
PAr = PT − PH2 O
The pressure of water vapor above a sample of liquid water at 26 °C is 25.2 torr (Appendix E), so:
Exercise 9.3.4
A sample of oxygen collected over water at a temperature of 29.0 °C and a pressure of 764 torr has a volume of 0.560 L. What
volume would the dry oxygen have under the same conditions of temperature and pressure?
Answer
0.583 L
a given volume of nitrogen gas reacts with three times that volume of hydrogen gas to produce two times that volume of ammonia
gas, if pressure and temperature remain constant.
The explanation for this is illustrated in Figure 9.3.4. According to Avogadro’s law, equal volumes of gaseous N2, H2, and NH3, at
the same temperature and pressure, contain the same number of molecules. Because one molecule of N2 reacts with three
molecules of H2 to produce two molecules of NH3, the volume of H2 required is three times the volume of N2, and the volume of
NH3 produced is two times the volume of N2.
Propane, C3H8(g), is used in gas grills to provide the heat for cooking. What volume of O2(g) measured at 25 °C and 760 torr is
required to react with 2.7 L of propane measured under the same conditions of temperature and pressure? Assume that the
propane undergoes complete combustion.
Solution
The ratio of the volumes of C3H8 and O2 will be equal to the ratio of their coefficients in the balanced equation for the reaction:
C H (g) + 5 O (g) ⟶ 3 CO (g) + 4 H O(l) (9.3.1)
3 8 2 2 2
From the equation, we see that one volume of C3H8 will react with five volumes of O2:
5 LO
2
2.7 L C3 H8 × = 13.5 L O
2
1 L C3 H8
Exercise 9.3.5
An acetylene tank for an oxyacetylene welding torch provides 9340 L of acetylene gas, C2H2, at 0 °C and 1 atm. How many
tanks of oxygen, each providing 7.00 × 103 L of O2 at 0 °C and 1 atm, will be required to burn the acetylene?
2C H +5 O ⟶ 4 CO +2 H O
2 2 2 2 2
Answer
3.34 tanks (2.34 × 104 L)
Ammonia is an important fertilizer and industrial chemical. Suppose that a volume of 683 billion cubic feet of gaseous
ammonia, measured at 25 °C and 1 atm, was manufactured. What volume of H2(g), measured under the same conditions, was
required to prepare this amount of ammonia by reaction with N2?
Solution
Because equal volumes of H2 and NH3 contain equal numbers of molecules and each three molecules of H2 that react produce
two molecules of NH3, the ratio of the volumes of H2 and NH3 will be equal to 3:2. Two volumes of NH3, in this case in units
of billion ft3, will be formed from three volumes of H2:
3
3 billion f t H2
3 3 3
683 billion f t NH3 × = 1.02 × 10 billion f t H2
3
2 billion f t NH3
The manufacture of 683 billion ft3 of NH3 required 1020 billion ft3 of H2. (At 25 °C and 1 atm, this is the volume of a cube
with an edge length of approximately 1.9 miles.)
Exercise 9.3.6
What volume of O2(g) measured at 25 °C and 760 torr is required to react with 17.0 L of ethylene, C2H4(g), measured under
the same conditions of temperature and pressure? The products are CO2 and water vapor.
Answer
51.0 L
What volume of hydrogen at 27 °C and 723 torr may be prepared by the reaction of 8.88 g of gallium with an excess of
hydrochloric acid?
Solution
To convert from the mass of gallium to the volume of H2(g), we need to do something like this:
1 mol Ga 3 mol H2
8.88 g Ga × × = 0.191 mol H2
69.723 g Ga 2 mol Ga
Sulfur dioxide is an intermediate in the preparation of sulfuric acid. What volume of SO2 at 343 °C and 1.21 atm is produced
by burning l.00 kg of sulfur in oxygen?
Answer
1.30 × 103 L
The thin skin of our atmosphere keeps the earth from being an ice planet and makes it habitable. In fact, this is due to less than
1
0.5% of the air molecules. Of the energy from the sun that reaches the earth, almost is reflected back into space, with the
3
rest absorbed by the atmosphere and the surface of the earth. Some of the energy that the earth absorbs is re-emitted as infrared
(IR) radiation, a portion of which passes back out through the atmosphere into space. However, most of this IR radiation is
absorbed by certain substances in the atmosphere, known as greenhouse gases, which re-emit this energy in all directions,
trapping some of the heat. This maintains favorable living conditions—without atmosphere, the average global average
temperature of 14 °C (57 °F) would be about –19 °C (–2 °F). The major greenhouse gases (GHGs) are water vapor, carbon
dioxide, methane, and ozone. Since the Industrial Revolution, human activity has been increasing the concentrations of GHGs,
which have changed the energy balance and are significantly altering the earth’s climate (Figure 9.3.6).
Figure 9.3.6 : Greenhouse gases trap enough of the sun’s energy to make the planet habitable—this is known as the greenhouse
effect. Human activities are increasing greenhouse gas levels, warming the planet and causing more extreme weather events.
There is strong evidence from multiple sources that higher atmospheric levels of CO2 are caused by human activity, with fossil
3
fuel burning accounting for about of the recent increase in CO2. Reliable data from ice cores reveals that CO2 concentration
4
in the atmosphere is at the highest level in the past 800,000 years; other evidence indicates that it may be at its highest level in
20 million years. In recent years, the CO2 concentration has increased from historical levels of below 300 ppm to almost 400
ppm today (Figure 9.3.7).
Summary
The ideal gas law can be used to derive a number of convenient equations relating directly measured quantities to properties of
interest for gaseous substances and mixtures. Appropriate rearrangement of the ideal gas equation may be made to permit the
calculation of gas densities and molar masses. Dalton’s law of partial pressures may be used to relate measured gas pressures for
gaseous mixtures to their compositions. Avogadro’s law may be used in stoichiometric computations for chemical reactions
involving gaseous reactants or products.
9.3.1.0.1: Key Equations
PTotal = PA + PB + PC + … = ƩiPi
PA = XA PTotal
nA
XA =
nT otal
9.3.1.0.1: Footnotes
1. “Quotations by Joseph-Louis Lagrange,” last modified February 2006, accessed February 10, 2015, www-history.mcs.st-
andrews.ac.../Lagrange.html
Summary
Dalton’s law of partial pressures
total pressure of a mixture of ideal gases is equal to the sum of the partial pressures of the component gases.
partial pressure
pressure exerted by an individual gas in a mixture
This page titled 9.3: Stoichiometry of Gaseous Substances, Mixtures, and Reactions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored,
remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit
history is available upon request.
If you have ever been in a room when a piping hot pizza was delivered, you have been made aware of the fact that gaseous
molecules can quickly spread throughout a room, as evidenced by the pleasant aroma that soon reaches your nose. Although
gaseous molecules travel at tremendous speeds (hundreds of meters per second), they collide with other gaseous molecules and
travel in many different directions before reaching the desired target. At room temperature, a gaseous molecule will experience
billions of collisions per second. The mean free path is the average distance a molecule travels between collisions. The mean free
path increases with decreasing pressure; in general, the mean free path for a gaseous molecule will be hundreds of times the
diameter of the molecule
In general, we know that when a sample of gas is introduced to one part of a closed container, its molecules very quickly disperse
throughout the container; this process by which molecules disperse in space in response to differences in concentration is called
diffusion (shown in Figure 9.4.1). The gaseous atoms or molecules are, of course, unaware of any concentration gradient, they
simply move randomly—regions of higher concentration have more particles than regions of lower concentrations, and so a net
movement of species from high to low concentration areas takes place. In a closed environment, diffusion will ultimately result in
equal concentrations of gas throughout, as depicted in Figure 9.4.1. The gaseous atoms and molecules continue to move, but since
their concentrations are the same in both bulbs, the rates of transfer between the bulbs are equal (no net transfer of molecules
occurs).
Figure 9.4.1 : (a) Two gases, H2 and O2, are initially separated. (b) When the stopcock is opened, they mix together. The lighter gas,
H2, passes through the opening faster than O2, so just after the stopcock is opened, more H2 molecules move to the O2 side than O2
molecules move to the H2 side. (c) After a short time, both the slower-moving O2 molecules and the faster-moving H2 molecules
have distributed themselves evenly on both sides of the vessel.
In this figure, three pairs of gas filled spheres or vessels are shown connected with a stopcock between them. In a, the figure is
labeled, “Stopcock closed.” Above, the left sphere is labeled, “H subscript 2.” It contains approximately 30 small, white, evenly
distributed circles. The sphere to its right is labeled, “O subscript 2.” It contains approximately 30 small red evenly distributed
circles. In b, the figure is labeled, “Stopcock open.” The stopcock valve handle is now parallel to the tube connecting the two
spheres. On the left, approximately 9 small, white circles and 4 small, red circles are present, with the red spheres appearing
slightly closer to the stopcock. On the right side, approximately 25 small, red spheres and 21 small, white spheres are present, with
the concentration of white spheres slightly greater near the stopcock. In c, the figure is labeled “Some time after Stopcock open.” In
this situation, the red and white spheres appear evenly mixed and uniformly distributed throughout both spheres.
We are often interested in the rate of diffusion, the amount of gas passing through some area per unit time:
amount of gas passing through an area
rate of diffusion =
unit of time
The diffusion rate depends on several factors: the concentration gradient (the increase or decrease in concentration from one point
to another); the amount of surface area available for diffusion; and the distance the gas particles must travel. Note also that the time
required for diffusion to occur is inversely proportional to the rate of diffusion, as shown in the rate of diffusion equation.
A process involving movement of gaseous species similar to diffusion is effusion, the escape of gas molecules through a tiny hole
such as a pinhole in a balloon into a vacuum (Figure 9.4.1). Although diffusion and effusion rates both depend on the molar mass
of the gas involved, their rates are not equal; however, the ratios of their rates are the same.
If a mixture of gases is placed in a container with porous walls, the gases effuse through the small openings in the walls. The lighter
gases pass through the small openings more rapidly (at a higher rate) than the heavier ones (Figure 9.4.2). In 1832, Thomas
Graham studied the rates of effusion of different gases and formulated Graham’s law of effusion: The rate of effusion of a gas is
inversely proportional to the square root of the mass of its particles:
1
rate of effusion ∝ −−
√M
This means that if two gases A and B are at the same temperature and pressure, the ratio of their effusion rates is inversely
proportional to the ratio of the square roots of the masses of their particles:
−−−
rate of effusion of B √MA
= −−−
rate of effusion of A √MB
Figure 9.4.3 : A balloon filled with air (the blue one) remains full overnight. A balloon filled with helium (the green one) partially
deflates because the smaller, light helium atoms effuse through small holes in the rubber much more readily than the heavier
molecules of nitrogen and oxygen found in air. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott)
This figure shows two photos. The first photo shows a blue balloon which floats above a green balloon. The green balloon is
resting on a surface. Both balloons are about the same size. The second photo shows the same two balloons, but the blue one is now
smaller than the green one. Both are resting on a surface.
Solution
From Graham’s law, we have:
Exercise 9.4.1
At a particular pressure and temperature, nitrogen gas effuses at the rate of 79 mL/s. Using the same apparatus at the same
temperature and pressure, at what rate will sulfur dioxide effuse?
Answer
52 mL/s
Here’s another example, making the point about how determining times differs from determining rates.
It takes 243 s for 4.46 × 10−5 mol Xe to effuse through a tiny hole. Under the same conditions, how long will it take 4.46 ×
10−5 mol Ne to effuse?
Solution
It is important to resist the temptation to use the times directly, and to remember how rate relates to time as well as how it
relates to mass. Recall the definition of rate of effusion:
amount of gas transferred
rate of effusion =
time
To get:
amount of Xe transferred
−−−−
√MNe
time for Xe
= −−−−
amount of Ne transferred √MXe
time for Ne
Noting that amount of A = amount of B, and solving for time for Ne:
amount of Xe
−−−− −−−−
time for Ne √MNe √MNe
time for Xe
= = =
−−−− −−−−
time for Xe √MXe √MXe
amount of Ne
time for Ne
Note that this answer is reasonable: Since Ne is lighter than Xe, the effusion rate for Ne will be larger than that for Xe, which
means the time of effusion for Ne will be smaller than that for Xe.
Exercise 9.4.2
2
A party balloon filled with helium deflates to of its original volume in 8.0 hours. How long will it take an identical balloon
3
1
filled with the same number of moles of air (ℳ = 28.2 g/mol) to deflate to of its original volume?
2
Answer
32 h
Finally, here is one more example showing how to calculate molar mass from effusion rate data.
An unknown gas effuses 1.66 times more rapidly than CO2. What is the molar mass of the unknown gas? Can you make a
reasonable guess as to its identity?
Solution
From Graham’s law, we have:
−−−−−
rate of ef f usion of Unknown √MCO2
= −−−−−−−−
rate of ef f usion of CO2 √MUnknown
Solve:
44.0 g/mol
MUnknown = = 16.0 g/mol
2
(1.66)
The gas could well be CH4, the only gas with this molar mass.
Exercise
Hydrogen gas effuses through a porous container 8.97-times faster than an unknown gas. Estimate the molar mass of the
unknown gas.
Answer
163 g/mol
Gaseous diffusion has been used to produce enriched uranium for use in nuclear power plants and weapons. Naturally
occurring uranium contains only 0.72% of 235U, the kind of uranium that is “fissile,” that is, capable of sustaining a nuclear
fission chain reaction. Nuclear reactors require fuel that is 2–5% 235U, and nuclear bombs need even higher concentrations.
One way to enrich uranium to the desired levels is to take advantage of Graham’s law. In a gaseous diffusion enrichment plant,
uranium hexafluoride (UF6, the only uranium compound that is volatile enough to work) is slowly pumped through large
cylindrical vessels called diffusers, which contain porous barriers with microscopic openings. The process is one of diffusion
because the other side of the barrier is not evacuated. The 235UF6 molecules have a higher average speed and diffuse through
the barrier a little faster than the heavier 238UF6 molecules. The gas that has passed through the barrier is slightly enriched in
235UF and the residual gas is slightly depleted. The small difference in molecular weights between 235UF and 238UF only
6 6 6
about 0.4% enrichment, is achieved in one diffuser (Figure 9.4.4). But by connecting many diffusers in a sequence of stages
(called a cascade), the desired level of enrichment can be attained.
Figure 9.4.4 : In a diffuser, gaseous UF6 is pumped through a porous barrier, which partially separates 235UF6 from 238UF6 The
UF6 must pass through many large diffuser units to achieve sufficient enrichment in 235U.
This figure shows a large cylindrical container oriented horizontally. A narrow tube or pipe which is labeled “porous barrier”
runs horizontally through the center of the tube and extends a short distance out from the left and right ends of the cylinder. At
the far left, an arrow points right into the tube. This arrow is labele, “Uranium hexafluoride ( U F subscript 6 ).” A line segment
connects the label, “High pressure feed tube,” to the tube where it enters the cylinder. In the short region of tube outside the
cylinder, 5 small, purple circles and 4 small, green circles are present. Inside the cylinder, an arrow points right through the
tube which contains many evenly distributed, purple circles and a handful of green circles which decrease in quantity moving
left to right through the cylinder. Curved arrows extend from the inner area of the tube into the outer region of the cylinder.
Three of these arrows point into the area above the tube and three point into the area below. Two line segments extend from the
label, “Higher speed superscript 235 U F subscript 6 diffuses through barrier faster than superscript 238 U F subscript 6,” to
two green circles in the space above the tube. In the short section of tubing just outside the cylinder, 8 small, purple circles are
present. An arrow labeled, “Depleted superscript 238 U F subscript 6,” points right extending from the end of this tube. The
larger space outside the tube contains approximately 100 evenly distributed small green circles and only 5 purple circles. Eight
of the purple circles appear at the left end of the cylinder. A tube exits the lower right end of the cylinder. It has 5 green circles
followed by a right pointing arrow and the label, “Enriched superscript 235 U F subscript 6.”
The large scale separation of gaseous 235UF6 from 238UF6 was first done during the World War II, at the atomic energy
installation in Oak Ridge, Tennessee, as part of the Manhattan Project (the development of the first atomic bomb). Although
the theory is simple, this required surmounting many daunting technical challenges to make it work in practice. The barrier
must have tiny, uniform holes (about 10–6 cm in diameter) and be porous enough to produce high flow rates. All materials (the
barrier, tubing, surface coatings, lubricants, and gaskets) need to be able to contain, but not react with, the highly reactive and
corrosive UF6.
Because gaseous diffusion plants require very large amounts of energy (to compress the gas to the high pressures required and
drive it through the diffuser cascade, to remove the heat produced during compression, and so on), it is now being replaced by
gas centrifuge technology, which requires far less energy. A current hot political issue is how to deny this technology to Iran, to
prevent it from producing enough enriched uranium for them to use to make nuclear weapons.
Summary
diffusion
movement of an atom or molecule from a region of relatively high concentration to one of relatively low concentration
(discussed in this chapter with regard to gaseous species, but applicable to species in any phase)
effusion
transfer of gaseous atoms or molecules from a container to a vacuum through very small openings
rate of diffusion
amount of gas diffusing through a given area over a given time
This page titled 9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The gas laws that we have seen to this point, as well as the ideal gas equation, are empirical, that is, they have been derived from
experimental observations. The mathematical forms of these laws closely describe the macroscopic behavior of most gases at
pressures less than about 1 or 2 atm. Although the gas laws describe relationships that have been verified by many experiments,
they do not tell us why gases follow these relationships.
The kinetic molecular theory (KMT) is a simple microscopic model that effectively explains the gas laws described in previous
modules of this chapter. This theory is based on the following five postulates described here. (Note: The term “molecule” will be
used to refer to the individual chemical species that compose the gas, although some gases are composed of atomic species, for
example, the noble gases.)
1. Gases are composed of molecules that are in continuous motion, travelling in straight lines and changing direction only when
they collide with other molecules or with the walls of a container.
2. The molecules composing the gas are negligibly small compared to the distances between them.
3. The pressure exerted by a gas in a container results from collisions between the gas molecules and the container walls.
4. Gas molecules exert no attractive or repulsive forces on each other or the container walls; therefore, their collisions are elastic
(do not involve a loss of energy).
5. The average kinetic energy of the gas molecules is proportional to the kelvin temperature of the gas.
The test of the KMT and its postulates is its ability to explain and describe the behavior of a gas. The various gas laws can be
derived from the assumptions of the KMT, which have led chemists to believe that the assumptions of the theory accurately
represent the properties of gas molecules. We will first look at the individual gas laws (Boyle’s, Charles’s, Amontons’s,
Avogadro’s, and Dalton’s laws) conceptually to see how the KMT explains them. Then, we will more carefully consider the
relationships between molecular masses, speeds, and kinetic energies with temperature, and explain Graham’s law.
Expressing mass in kilograms and speed in meters per second will yield energy values in units of joules (J = kg m2 s–2). To deal
with a large number of gas molecules, we use averages for both speed and kinetic energy. In the KMT, the root mean square
velocity of a particle, urms, is defined as the square root of the average of the squares of the velocities with n = the number of
particles:
−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−
−− 2 2 2 2
¯
¯¯¯
¯ u +u +u +u +…
√ 2 1 2 3 4
urms = u =√
n
The KEavg of a collection of gas molecules is also directly proportional to the temperature of the gas and may be described by the
equation:
3
KEavg = RT
2
where R is the gas constant and T is the kelvin temperature. When used in this equation, the appropriate form of the gas constant is
8.314 J mol-1K-1 (8.314 kg m2s–2mol-1K–1). These two separate equations for KEavg may be combined and rearranged to yield a
relation between molecular speed and temperature:
1 3
2
m urms = RT
2 2
−−−−−
3RT
urms = √ (9.5.1)
m
Solution
Convert the temperature into Kelvin:
Replace the variables and constants in the root-mean-square velocity formula (Equation 9.5.1 ), replacing Joules with the
equivalent kg m2s–2:
−−−−−
3RT
urms = √
m
−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−
3(8.314 J/mol K)(303 K)
urms = √
(0.028 kg/mol)
= 519 m/s
Exercise 9.5.1
Answer
441 m/s
If the temperature of a gas increases, its KEavg increases, more molecules have higher speeds and fewer molecules have lower
speeds, and the distribution shifts toward higher speeds overall, that is, to the right. If temperature decreases, KEavg decreases, more
molecules have lower speeds and fewer molecules have higher speeds, and the distribution shifts toward lower speeds overall, that
is, to the left. This behavior is illustrated for nitrogen gas in Figure 9.5.3.
Figure 9.5.3 : The molecular speed distribution for nitrogen gas (N2) shifts to the right and flattens as the temperature increases; it
shifts to the left and heightens as the temperature decreases.
A graph with four positively or right-skewed curves of varying heights is shown. The horizontal axis is labeled, “Velocity v ( m
divided by s ).” This axis is marked by increments of 500 beginning at 0 and extending up to 1500. The vertical axis is labeled,
“Fraction of molecules.” The label, “N subscript 2,” appears in the open space in the upper right area of the graph. The tallest and
narrowest of these curves is labeled, “100 K.” Its right end appears to touch the horizontal axis around 700 m per s. It is followed
by a slightly wider curve which is labeled, “200 K,” that is about three quarters of the height of the initial curve. Its right end
appears to touch the horizontal axis around 850 m per s. The third curve is significantly wider and only about half the height of the
initial curve. It is labeled, “500 K.” Its right end appears to touch the horizontal axis around 1450 m per s. The final curve is only
about one third the height of the initial curve. It is much wider than the others, so much so that its right end has not yet reached the
horizontal axis. This curve is labeled, “1000 K.”
At a given temperature, all gases have the same KEavg for their molecules. Gases composed of lighter molecules have more high-
speed particles and a higher urms, with a speed distribution that peaks at relatively higher velocities. Gases consisting of heavier
molecules have more low-speed particles, a lower urms, and a speed distribution that peaks at relatively lower velocities. This trend
is demonstrated by the data for a series of noble gases shown in Figure 9.5.4.
The gas simulator may be used to examine the effect of temperature on molecular
velocities. Examine the simulator’s “energy histograms” (molecular speed distributions)
and “species information” (which gives average speed values) for molecules of different
masses at various temperatures.
Using this relation, and the equation relating molecular speed to mass, Graham’s law may be easily derived as shown here:
−−−−−
3RT
urms = √
m
3RT 3RT
m = =
2 2
urms ¯¯
u
¯
−−−−−
3RT
√
−−−
−
ef f usion rate A urms A
mA mB
= = −−−−− =√
ef f usion rate B urms B 3RT mA
√
mB
The ratio of the rates of effusion is thus derived to be inversely proportional to the ratio of the square roots of their masses. This is
the same relation observed experimentally and expressed as Graham’s law.
Summary
The kinetic molecular theory is a simple but very effective model that effectively explains ideal gas behavior. The theory assumes
that gases consist of widely separated molecules of negligible volume that are in constant motion, colliding elastically with one
another and the walls of their container with average velocities determined by their absolute temperatures. The individual
3
KEavg = RT
2
−−−−−
3RT
urms =√
m
Summary
kinetic molecular theory
theory based on simple principles and assumptions that effectively explains ideal gas behavior
This page titled 9.5: The Kinetic-Molecular Theory is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Thus far, the ideal gas law, PV = nRT, has been applied to a variety of different types of problems, ranging from reaction
stoichiometry and empirical and molecular formula problems to determining the density and molar mass of a gas. As mentioned in
the previous modules of this chapter, however, the behavior of a gas is often non-ideal, meaning that the observed relationships
between its pressure, volume, and temperature are not accurately described by the gas laws. In this section, the reasons for these
deviations from ideal gas behavior are considered.
One way in which the accuracy of PV = nRT can be judged is by comparing the actual volume of 1 mole of gas (its molar volume,
Vm) to the molar volume of an ideal gas at the same temperature and pressure. This ratio is called the compressibility factor (Z)
with:
molar volume of gas at same T and P P Vm
Z = =( )
molar volume of ideal gas at same T and P RT
measured
Ideal gas behavior is therefore indicated when this ratio is equal to 1, and any deviation from 1 is an indication of non-ideal
behavior. Figure 9.6.1 shows plots of Z over a large pressure range for several common gases.
Figure 9.6.1 : A graph of the compressibility factor (Z) vs. pressure shows that gases can exhibit significant deviations from the
behavior predicted by the ideal gas law.
A graph is shown. The horizontal axis is labeled, “P ( a t m ).” Its scale begins at zero with markings provided by multiples of 200
up to 1000. The vertical axis is labeled, “Z le( k P a ).” This scale begins at zero and includes multiples of 0.5 up to 2.0. Six curves
are drawn of varying colors. One of these curves is a horizontal, light purple line extending right from 1.0 k P a on the vertical axis,
which is labeled “Ideal gas.” The region of the graph beneath this line is shaded tan. The remaining curves also start at the same
point on the vertical axis. An orange line extends to the upper right corner of the graph, reaching a value of approximately 1.7 k P a
at 1000 a t m. This orange curve is labeled, “H subscript 2.” A blue curve dips below the horizontal ideal gas line initially, then
increases to cross the line just past 200 a t m. This curve reaches a value of nearly 2.0 k P a at about 800 a t m. This curve is
labeled, “N subscript 2.” A red curve dips below the horizontal ideal gas line initially, then increases to cross the line just past 400 a
t m. This curve reaches a value of nearly 1.5 k P a at about 750 a t m. This curve is labeled, “O subscript 2.” A purple curve dips
below the horizontal ideal gas line, dipping even lower than the O subscript 2 curve initially, then increases to cross the ideal gas
line at about 400 a t m. This curve reaches a value of nearly 2.0 k P a at about 850 a t m. This curve is labeled, “C H subscript 4.” A
yellow curve dips below the horizontal ideal gas line, dipping lower than the other curves to a minimum of about 0.4 k P a at about
0.75 a t m, then increases to cross the ideal gas line at about 500 a t m. This curve reaches a value of about 1.6 k P a at about 900 a t
m. This curve is labeled, “C O subscript 2.”
As is apparent from Figure 9.6.1, the ideal gas law does not describe gas behavior well at relatively high pressures. To determine
why this is, consider the differences between real gas properties and what is expected of a hypothetical ideal gas.
Figure 9.6.2 : Raising the pressure of a gas increases the fraction of its volume that is occupied by the gas molecules and makes the
gas less compressible.
This figure includes three diagrams. In a, a cylinder with 9 purple spheres with trails indicating motion are shown. Above the
cylinder, the label, “Particles ideal gas,” is connected to two of the spheres with line segments extending into the square. The label
“Assumes” is beneath the square. In b, a cylinder and piston is shown. A relatively small open space is shaded lavender with 9
purple spheres packed close together. No motion trails are present on the spheres. Above the piston, a downward arrow labeled
“Pressure” is directed toward the enclosed area. In c, the cylinder is exactly the same as the first, but the number of molecules has
doubled.
At relatively low pressures, gas molecules have practically no attraction for one another because they are (on average) so far apart,
and they behave almost like particles of an ideal gas. At higher pressures, however, the force of attraction is also no longer
insignificant. This force pulls the molecules a little closer together, slightly decreasing the pressure (if the volume is constant) or
decreasing the volume (at constant pressure) (Figure 9.6.3). This change is more pronounced at low temperatures because the
molecules have lower KE relative to the attractive forces, and so they are less effective in overcoming these attractions after
colliding with one another.
Figure 9.6.3 : (a) Attractions between gas molecules serve to decrease the gas volume at constant pressure compared to an ideal gas
whose molecules experience no attractive forces. (b) These attractive forces will decrease the force of collisions between the
molecules and container walls, therefore reducing the pressure exerted compared to an ideal gas.
This figure includes two diagrams. Each involves two lavender shaded boxes that contain 14 relatively evenly distributed, purple
spheres. In the first box in a, a nearly centrally located purple sphere has 6 double-headed arrows extending outward from it to
nearby spheres. A single purple arrow is pointing right into open space. This box is labeled, “real.” There is a second box that looks
slightly larger than the first box in a. It has the same number of particles but no arrows. This box is labeled, “ideal.” In b, the first
box has a purple sphere at the right side which has 4 double-headed arrows radiating out to the top, bottom, and left to other
spheres. A single purple arrow points right through open space to the edge of the box. This box has no spheres positioned near its
right edge This box is labeled, “real.” The second box is the same size as the first box and contains the same number of particles.
There are no arrows in it, except for the purple arrow which appears to be bigger and bolder. This box is labeled, “ideal.”
This figure shows the equation P V equals n R T, with the P in blue text and the V in red text. This equation is followed by a right
pointing arrow. Following this arrow, to the right in blue text appears the equation ( P minus a n superscript 2 divided by V squared
),” which is followed by the red text ( V minus n b ). This is followed in black text with equals n R T. Beneath the second equation
appears the label, “Correction for molecular attraction” which is connected with a line segment to V squared. A second label,
“Correction for volume of molecules,” is similarly connected to n b which appears in red.
The constant a corresponds to the strength of the attraction between molecules of a particular gas, and the constant b corresponds to
2
n a
the size of the molecules of a particular gas. The “correction” to the pressure term in the ideal gas law is 2
, and the “correction”
V
to the volume is nb. Note that when V is relatively large and n is relatively small, both of these correction terms become negligible,
and the van der Waals equation reduces to the ideal gas law, PV = nRT. Such a condition corresponds to a gas in which a relatively
low number of molecules is occupying a relatively large volume, that is, a gas at a relatively low pressure. Experimental values for
the van der Waals constants of some common gases are given in Table 9.6.1.
Table 9.6.1 : Values of van der Waals Constants for Some Common Gases
Gas a (L2 atm/mol2) b (L/mol)
N2 1.39 0.0391
O2 1.36 0.0318
He 0.0342 0.0237
At low pressures, the correction for intermolecular attraction, a, is more important than the one for molecular volume, b. At high
pressures and small volumes, the correction for the volume of the molecules becomes important because the molecules themselves
are incompressible and constitute an appreciable fraction of the total volume. At some intermediate pressure, the two corrections
have opposing influences and the gas appears to follow the relationship given by PV = nRT over a small range of pressures. This
behavior is reflected by the “dips” in several of the compressibility curves shown in Figure 9.6.1. The attractive force between
molecules initially makes the gas more compressible than an ideal gas, as pressure is raised (Z decreases with increasing P). At
very high pressures, the gas becomes less compressible (Z increases with P), as the gas molecules begin to occupy an increasingly
significant fraction of the total gas volume.
Strictly speaking, the ideal gas equation functions well when intermolecular attractions between gas molecules are negligible and
the gas molecules themselves do not occupy an appreciable part of the whole volume. These criteria are satisfied under conditions
of low pressure and high temperature. Under such conditions, the gas is said to behave ideally, and deviations from the gas laws are
small enough that they may be disregarded—this is, however, very often not the case.
Example 9.6.1: Comparison of Ideal Gas Law and van der Waals Equation
A 4.25-L flask contains 3.46 mol CO2 at 229 °C. Calculate the pressure of this sample of CO2:
a. from the ideal gas law
b. from the van der Waals equation
Solution
(a) From the ideal gas law:
−1 −1
nRT 3.46 mol × 0.08206 L atm mol K × 502 K
P = = = 33.5 atm
V 4.25 L
−1 −1 2 2 2
3.46 mol × 0.08206 L atm mo l K × 502 K (3.46 mol ) × 3.59 L atm mo l
P = −
−1 2
(4.25 L − 3.46 mol × 0.0427 L mo l ) (4.25 L)
Exercise 9.6.1
A 560-mL flask contains 21.3 g N2 at 145 °C. Calculate the pressure of N2:
a. from the ideal gas law
b. from the van der Waals equation
c. Explain the reason(s) for the difference.
Answer a
46.562 atm
Answer b
46.594 atm
Answer c
The van der Waals equation takes into account the volume of the gas molecules themselves as well as intermolecular
attractions.
Summary
Gas molecules possess a finite volume and experience forces of attraction for one another. Consequently, gas behavior is not
necessarily described well by the ideal gas law. Under conditions of low pressure and high temperature, these factors are negligible,
the ideal gas equation is an accurate description of gas behavior, and the gas is said to exhibit ideal behavior. However, at lower
temperatures and higher pressures, corrections for molecular volume and molecular attractions are required to account for finite
molecular size and attractive forces. The van der Waals equation is a modified version of the ideal gas law that can be used to
account for the non-ideal behavior of gases under these conditions.
This page titled 9.6: Non-Ideal Gas Behavior is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
S9.1.1
The cutting edge of a knife that has been sharpened has a smaller surface area than a dull knife. Since pressure is force per unit
area, a sharp knife will exert a higher pressure with the same amount of force and cut through material more effectively.
Q9.1.2
Why do some small bridges have weight limits that depend on how many wheels or axles the crossing vehicle has?
Q9.1.3
Why should you roll or belly-crawl rather than walk across a thinly-frozen pond?
S9.1.3
Lying down distributes your weight over a larger surface area, exerting less pressure on the ice compared to standing up. If you
exert less pressure, you are less likely to break through thin ice.
Q9.1.4
A typical barometric pressure in Redding, California, is about 750 mm Hg. Calculate this pressure in atm and kPa.
Q9.1.5
A typical barometric pressure in Denver, Colorado, is 615 mm Hg. What is this pressure in atmospheres and kilopascals?
S9.1.5
0.809 atm; 82.0 kPa
Q9.1.6
A typical barometric pressure in Kansas City is 740 torr. What is this pressure in atmospheres, in millimeters of mercury, and in
kilopascals?
Q9.1.7
Canadian tire pressure gauges are marked in units of kilopascals. What reading on such a gauge corresponds to 32 psi?
S9.1.7
2.2 × 102 kPa
Q9.1.8
During the Viking landings on Mars, the atmospheric pressure was determined to be on the average about 6.50 millibars (1 bar =
0.987 atm). What is that pressure in torr and kPa?
Q9.1.9
The pressure of the atmosphere on the surface of the planet Venus is about 88.8 atm. Compare that pressure in psi to the normal
pressure on earth at sea level in psi.
S9.1.9
Earth: 14.7 lb in–2; Venus: 13.1× 103 lb in−2
Q9.1.10
A medical laboratory catalog describes the pressure in a cylinder of a gas as 14.82 MPa. What is the pressure of this gas in
atmospheres and torr?
S9.1.11
(a) 101.5 kPa; (b) 51 torr drop
Q9.1.12
Why is it necessary to use a nonvolatile liquid in a barometer or manometer?
Q9.1.13
The pressure of a sample of gas is measured at sea level with a closed-end manometer. The liquid in the manometer is mercury.
Determine the pressure of the gas in:
a. torr
b. Pa
c. bar
S9.1.13
(a) 264 torr; (b) 35,200 Pa; (c) 0.352 bar
Q9.1.14
The pressure of a sample of gas is measured with an open-end manometer, partially shown to the right. The liquid in the
manometer is mercury. Assuming atmospheric pressure is 29.92 in. Hg, determine the pressure of the gas in:
a. torr
b. Pa
c. bar
S9.1.15
(a) 623 mm Hg; (b) 0.820 atm; (c) 83.1 kPa
Q9.1.16
The pressure of a sample of gas is measured at sea level with an open-end mercury manometer. Assuming atmospheric pressure is
760 mm Hg, determine the pressure of the gas in:
a. mm Hg
b. atm
c. kPa
Q9.1.17
How would the use of a volatile liquid affect the measurement of a gas using open-ended manometers vs. closed-end manometers?
S9.1.17
With a closed-end manometer, no change would be observed, since the vaporized liquid would contribute equal, opposing pressures
in both arms of the manometer tube. However, with an open-ended manometer, a higher pressure reading of the gas would be
obtained than expected, since Pgas = Patm + Pvol liquid.
Q9.2.2
Explain how the volume of the bubbles exhausted by a scuba diver (Figure) change as they rise to the surface, assuming that they
remain intact.
S9.2.2
As the bubbles rise, the pressure decreases, so their volume increases as suggested by Boyle’s law.
Q9.2.3
One way to state Boyle’s law is “All other things being equal, the pressure of a gas is inversely proportional to its volume.” (a)
What is the meaning of the term “inversely proportional?” (b) What are the “other things” that must be equal?
Q9.2.4
An alternate way to state Avogadro’s law is “All other things being equal, the number of molecules in a gas is directly proportional
to the volume of the gas.”
a. What is the meaning of the term “directly proportional?”
b. What are the “other things” that must be equal?
S9.2.4
(a) The number of particles in the gas increases as the volume increases. (b) temperature, pressure
Q9.2.5
How would the graph in Figure change if the number of moles of gas in the sample used to determine the curve were doubled?
The volume and temperature are linearly related for 1 mole of methane gas at a constant pressure of 1 atm. If the temperature is in
kelvin, volume and temperature are directly proportional. The line stops at 111 K because methane liquefies at this temperature;
when extrapolated, it intersects the graph’s origin, representing a temperature of absolute zero.
Q9.2.6
How would the graph in Figure change if the number of moles of gas in the sample used to determine the curve were doubled?
S9.2.6
The curve would be farther to the right and higher up, but the same basic shape.
Q9.2.7
In addition to the data found in Figure, what other information do we need to find the mass of the sample of air used to determine
the graph?
Q9.2.8
Determine the volume of 1 mol of CH4 gas at 150 K and 1 atm, using Figure.
S9.2.8
16.3 to 16.5 L
Q9.2.9
Determine the pressure of the gas in the syringe shown in Figure when its volume is 12.5 mL, using:
a. the appropriate graph
b. Boyle’s law
Q9.2.10
A spray can is used until it is empty except for the propellant gas, which has a pressure of 1344 torr at 23 °C. If the can is thrown
into a fire (T = 475 °C), what will be the pressure in the hot can?
S9.2.10
3.40 × 103 torr
S9.2.11
P1 V1 P2 V2
we must use = and solve for T1
T1 T2
P1 V1 T2
T1 =
P2 V2
Where:
P1 = 744 torr
V1 = 11.2 L
P2 = 744 torr
V2 = 13.3 L
T2 = 328.15° K
276°K ; 3°C
Q9.2.12
A 2.50-L volume of hydrogen measured at –196 °C is warmed to 100 °C. Calculate the volume of the gas at the higher
temperature, assuming no change in pressure.
S9.2.13
12.1 L
Q9.2.14
A balloon inflated with three breaths of air has a volume of 1.7 L. At the same temperature and pressure, what is the volume of the
balloon if five more same-sized breaths are added to the balloon?
Q9.2.15
A weather balloon contains 8.80 moles of helium at a pressure of 0.992 atm and a temperature of 25 °C at ground level. What is the
volume of the balloon under these conditions?
S9.2.15
217 L
Q9.2.16
The volume of an automobile air bag was 66.8 L when inflated at 25 °C with 77.8 g of nitrogen gas. What was the pressure in the
bag in kPa?
S9.2.17
8.190 × 10–2 mol; 5.553 g
Q9.2.18
Iodine, I2, is a solid at room temperature but sublimes (converts from a solid into a gas) when warmed. What is the temperature in a
73.3-mL bulb that contains 0.292 g of I2 vapor at a pressure of 0.462 atm?
S9.2.18
1.) Use the equation P V = nRT and solve for T
PV
T =
nR
73.3 mL = 0.0733 L
atm L
3.) Use these values along with R = 0.08206 to solve for T
mole °K
359°K ; 86°C
Q9.2.19
How many grams of gas are present in each of the following cases?
a. 0.100 L of CO2 at 307 torr and 26 °C
b. 8.75 L of C2H4, at 378.3 kPa and 483 K
c. 221 mL of Ar at 0.23 torr and –54 °C
S9.2.19
(a) 7.24 × 10–2 g; (b) 23.1 g; (c) 1.5 × 10–4 g
Q9.2.20
A high altitude balloon is filled with 1.41 × 104 L of hydrogen at a temperature of 21 °C and a pressure of 745 torr. What is the
volume of the balloon at a height of 20 km, where the temperature is –48 °C and the pressure is 63.1 torr?
Q9.2.21
A cylinder of medical oxygen has a volume of 35.4 L, and contains O2 at a pressure of 151 atm and a temperature of 25 °C. What
volume of O2 does this correspond to at normal body conditions, that is, 1 atm and 37 °C?
S9.2.21
5561 L
Q9.2.22
A large scuba tank (Figure) with a volume of 18 L is rated for a pressure of 220 bar. The tank is filled at 20 °C and contains enough
air to supply 1860 L of air to a diver at a pressure of 2.37 atm (a depth of 45 feet). Was the tank filled to capacity at 20 °C?
S9.2.23
46.4 g
Q9.2.24
While resting, the average 70-kg human male consumes 14 L of pure O2 per hour at 25 °C and 100 kPa. How many moles of O2
are consumed by a 70 kg man while resting for 1.0 h?
Q9.2.25
For a given amount of gas showing ideal behavior, draw labeled graphs of:
a. the variation of P with V
b. the variation of V with T
c. the variation of P with T
1
d. the variation of with V
P
Q9.2.26
For a gas exhibiting ideal behavior:
Q9.2.27
A liter of methane gas, CH4, at STP contains more atoms of hydrogen than does a liter of pure hydrogen gas, H2, at STP. Using
Avogadro’s law as a starting point, explain why.
S9.2.28
(a) 1.85 L CCl2F2; (b) 4.66 L CH3CH2F
Q9.2.29
As 1 g of the radioactive element radium decays over 1 year, it produces 1.16 × 1018 alpha particles (helium nuclei). Each alpha
particle becomes an atom of helium gas. What is the pressure in pascal of the helium gas produced if it occupies a volume of 125
mL at a temperature of 25 °C?
Q9.2.30
A balloon that is 100.21 L at 21 °C and 0.981 atm is released and just barely clears the top of Mount Crumpet in British Columbia.
If the final volume of the balloon is 144.53 L at a temperature of 5.24 °C, what is the pressure experienced by the balloon as it
clears Mount Crumpet?
S9.2.30
0.644 atm
Q9.2.31
If the temperature of a fixed amount of a gas is doubled at constant volume, what happens to the pressure?
Q9.2.32
If the volume of a fixed amount of a gas is tripled at constant temperature, what happens to the pressure?
S9.2.32
The pressure decreases by a factor of 3.
S9.3.1
1.) First convert kPa to atm
1 atm
113.0 kP a × = 1.115 atm
101.325 kP a
PM
2.) The use the equation d = where d = density in g L-1 and M = molar mass in g mol-1
RT
g
(1.115 atm)(44.02 )
mol g
d = = 1.84
atm L L
(0.08206 )(325 °K )
mole °K
Q9.3.2
Calculate the density of Freon 12, CF2Cl2, at 30.0 °C and 0.954 atm.
Q9.3.3
Which is denser at the same temperature and pressure, dry air or air saturated with water vapor? Explain.
Q9.3.4
A cylinder of O2(g) used in breathing by emphysema patients has a volume of 3.00 L at a pressure of 10.0 atm. If the temperature
of the cylinder is 28.0 °C, what mass of oxygen is in the cylinder?
S9.3.4
38.8 g
Q9.3.5
What is the molar mass of a gas if 0.0494 g of the gas occupies a volume of 0.100 L at a temperature 26 °C and a pressure of 307
torr?
S9.3.5
1.) convert torr to atm and °C to °K
307 torr = 0.404atm
26°C = 300.°K
3.) Then divide grams by the number of moles to obtain the molar mass:
0.0494g g
= 30.0
0.00165 moles mole
Q9.3.6
What is the molar mass of a gas if 0.281 g of the gas occupies a volume of 125 mL at a temperature 126 °C and a pressure of 777
torr?
S9.3.6
72.0 g mol−1
Q9.3.7
How could you show experimentally that the molecular formula of propene is C3H6, not CH2?
Q9.3.8
The density of a certain gaseous fluoride of phosphorus is 3.93 g/L at STP. Calculate the molar mass of this fluoride and determine
its molecular formula.
S9.3.8
88.1 g mol−1; PF3
Q9.3.9
Consider this question: What is the molecular formula of a compound that contains 39% C, 45% N, and 16% H if 0.157 g of the
compound occupies 125 mL with a pressure of 99.5 kPa at 22 °C?
Q9.3.10
A 36.0–L cylinder of a gas used for calibration of blood gas analyzers in medical laboratories contains 350 g CO2, 805 g O2, and
4,880 g N2. At 25 degrees C, what is the pressure in the cylinder in atmospheres?
S9.3.10
141 atm
Q9.3.11
A cylinder of a gas mixture used for calibration of blood gas analyzers in medical laboratories contains 5.0% CO2, 12.0% O2, and
the remainder N2 at a total pressure of 146 atm. What is the partial pressure of each component of this gas? (The percentages given
indicate the percent of the total pressure that is due to each component.)
Q9.3.12
A sample of gas isolated from unrefined petroleum contains 90.0% CH4, 8.9% C2H6, and 1.1% C3H8 at a total pressure of 307.2
kPa. What is the partial pressure of each component of this gas? (The percentages given indicate the percent of the total pressure
that is due to each component.)
S9.3.12
CH4: 276 kPa; C2H6: 27 kPa; C3H8: 3.4 kPa
Q9.3.13
A mixture of 0.200 g of H2, 1.00 g of N2, and 0.820 g of Ar is stored in a closed container at STP. Find the volume of the container,
assuming that the gases exhibit ideal behavior.
Q9.3.14
Most mixtures of hydrogen gas with oxygen gas are explosive. However, a mixture that contains less than 3.0 % O2 is not. If
enough O2 is added to a cylinder of H2 at 33.2 atm to bring the total pressure to 34.5 atm, is the mixture explosive?
S9.3.14
Yes
Q9.3.15
A commercial mercury vapor analyzer can detect, in air, concentrations of gaseous Hg atoms (which are poisonous) as low as 2 ×
10−6 mg/L of air. At this concentration, what is the partial pressure of gaseous mercury if the atmospheric pressure is 733 torr at 26
°C?
Q9.3.16
A sample of carbon monoxide was collected over water at a total pressure of 756 torr and a temperature of 18 °C. What is the
pressure of the carbon monoxide? (See Table for the vapor pressure of water.)
S9.3.16
740 torr
Q9.3.17
In an experiment in a general chemistry laboratory, a student collected a sample of a gas over water. The volume of the gas was 265
mL at a pressure of 753 torr and a temperature of 27 °C. The mass of the gas was 0.472 g. What was the molar mass of the gas?
Q9.3.18
Joseph Priestley first prepared pure oxygen by heating mercuric oxide, HgO:
2 HgO(s) ⟶ 2 Hg(l) + O (g)
2
S9.3.18
(a) Determine the moles of HgO that decompose; using the chemical equation, determine the moles of O2 produced by
decomposition of this amount of HgO; and determine the volume of O2 from the moles of O2, temperature, and pressure. (b) 0.308
L
Q9.3.19
Cavendish prepared hydrogen in 1766 by the novel method of passing steam through a red-hot gun barrel:
4 H O(g) + 3 Fe(s) ⟶ Fe O (s) + 4 H (g) (9.E.1)
2 3 4 2
a. Outline the steps necessary to answer the following question: What volume of H2 at a pressure of 745 torr and a temperature of
20 °C can be prepared from the reaction of 15.O g of H2O?
b. Answer the question.
Q9.3.20
The chlorofluorocarbon CCl2F2 can be recycled into a different compound by reaction with hydrogen to produce CH2F2(g), a
compound useful in chemical manufacturing:
CCl F (g) + 4 H (g) ⟶ CH F (g) + 2 HCl(g) (9.E.2)
2 2 2 2 2
a. Outline the steps necessary to answer the following question: What volume of hydrogen at 225 atm and 35.5 °C would be
required to react with 1 ton (1.000 × 103 kg) of CCl2F2?
b. Answer the question.
S9.3.20
a. Determine the molar mass of CCl2F2. From the balanced equation, calculate the moles of H2 needed for the complete reaction.
From the ideal gas law, convert moles of H2 into volume.
b. 3.72 × 103 L
Q9.3.21
Automobile air bags are inflated with nitrogen gas, which is formed by the decomposition of solid sodium azide (NaN3). The other
product is sodium metal. Calculate the volume of nitrogen gas at 27 °C and 756 torr formed by the decomposition of 125 g of
sodium azide.
Q9.3.22
Lime, CaO, is produced by heating calcium carbonate, CaCO3; carbon dioxide is the other product.
a. Outline the steps necessary to answer the following question: What volume of carbon dioxide at 875° and 0.966 atm is
produced by the decomposition of 1 ton (1.000 × 103 kg) of calcium carbonate?
b. Answer the question.
S9.3.22
(a) Balance the equation. Determine the grams of CO2 produced and the number of moles. From the ideal gas law, determine the
volume of gas. (b) 7.43 × 105 L
Q9.3.23
Before small batteries were available, carbide lamps were used for bicycle lights. Acetylene gas, C2H2, and solid calcium
hydroxide were formed by the reaction of calcium carbide, CaC2, with water. The ignition of the acetylene gas provided the light.
Currently, the same lamps are used by some cavers, and calcium carbide is used to produce acetylene for carbide cannons.
a. Outline the steps necessary to answer the following question: What volume of C2H2 at 1.005 atm and 12.2 °C is formed by the
reaction of 15.48 g of CaC2 with water?
b. Answer the question.
S9.3.24
42.00 L
Q9.3.25
What volume of O2 at STP is required to oxidize 8.0 L of NO at STP to NO2? What volume of NO2 is produced at STP?
Q9.3.26
Consider the following questions:
a. What is the total volume of the CO2(g) and H2O(g) at 600 °C and 0.888 atm produced by the combustion of 1.00 L of C2H6(g)
measured at STP?
b. What is the partial pressure of H2O in the product gases?
S9.3.26
(a) 18.0 L; (b) 0.533 atm
Q9.3.27
Methanol, CH3OH, is produced industrially by the following reaction:
copper catalyst 300 °C, 300 atm
Q9.3.28
Assuming that the gases behave as ideal gases, find the ratio of the total volume of the reactants to the final volume.
Q9.3.29
What volume of oxygen at 423.0 K and a pressure of 127.4 kPa is produced by the decomposition of 129.7 g of BaO2 to BaO and
O2?
S9.3.29
10.57 L O2
Q9.3.30
A 2.50-L sample of a colorless gas at STP decomposed to give 2.50 L of N2 and 1.25 L of O2 at STP. What is the colorless gas?
Q9.3.31
Ethanol, C2H5OH, is produced industrially from ethylene, C2H4, by the following sequence of reactions:
3C H + 2 H SO ⟶ C H HSO + (C H ) SO (9.E.4)
2 4 2 4 2 5 4 2 5 2 4
C H HSO + (C H ) SO + 3 H O ⟶ 3 C H OH + 2 H SO (9.E.5)
2 5 4 2 5 2 4 2 2 5 2 4
What volume of ethylene at STP is required to produce 1.000 metric ton (1000 kg) of ethanol if the overall yield of ethanol is
90.1%?
S9.3.31
5.40 × 105 L
Q9.3.32
One molecule of hemoglobin will combine with four molecules of oxygen. If 1.0 g of hemoglobin combines with 1.53 mL of
oxygen at body temperature (37 °C) and a pressure of 743 torr, what is the molar mass of hemoglobin?
S9.3.33
XeF2
Q9.3.34
One method of analyzing amino acids is the van Slyke method. The characteristic amino groups (−NH2) in protein material are
allowed to react with nitrous acid, HNO2, to form N2 gas. From the volume of the gas, the amount of amino acid can be
determined. A 0.0604-g sample of a biological sample containing glycine, CH2(NH2)COOH, was analyzed by the van Slyke
method and yielded 3.70 mL of N2 collected over water at a pressure of 735 torr and 29 °C. What was the percentage of glycine in
the sample?
CH (NH )CO H + HNO ⟶ CH (OH)CO H + H O + N
2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
S9.4.1
4.2 hours
Q9.4.2
Explain why the numbers of molecules are not identical in the left- and right-hand bulbs shown in the center illustration of Figure.
Q9.4.3
Starting with the definition of rate of effusion and Graham’s finding relating rate and molar mass, show how to derive the Graham’s
law equation, relating the relative rates of effusion for two gases to their molecular masses.
S9.4.3
Effusion can be defined as the process by which a gas escapes through a pinhole into a vacuum. Graham’s law states that with a
1/2
rate A molar mass of B
mixture of two gases A and B: ( ) =( ) . Both A and B are in the same container at the same
rate B molar mass of A
Q9.4.4
Heavy water, D2O (molar mass = 20.03 g mol–1), can be separated from ordinary water, H2O (molar mass = 18.01), as a result of
the difference in the relative rates of diffusion of the molecules in the gas phase. Calculate the relative rates of diffusion of H2O and
D2O.
Q9.4.5
Which of the following gases diffuse more slowly than oxygen? F2, Ne, N2O, C2H2, NO, Cl2, H2S
S9.4.5
F2, N2O, Cl2, H2S
Q9.4.7
Calculate the relative rate of diffusion of 1H2 (molar mass 2.0 g/mol) compared to that of 2H2 (molar mass 4.0 g/mol) and the
relative rate of diffusion of O2 (molar mass 32 g/mol) compared to that of O3 (molar mass 48 g/mol).
S9.4.7
1.4; 1.2
Q9.4.8
A gas of unknown identity diffuses at a rate of 83.3 mL/s in a diffusion apparatus in which carbon dioxide diffuses at the rate of
102 mL/s. Calculate the molecular mass of the unknown gas.
Q9.4.9
When two cotton plugs, one moistened with ammonia and the other with hydrochloric acid, are simultaneously inserted into
opposite ends of a glass tube that is 87.0 cm long, a white ring of NH4Cl forms where gaseous NH3 and gaseous HCl first come
into contact. (Hint: Calculate the rates of diffusion for both NH3 and HCl, and find out how much faster NH3 diffuses than HCl.)
NH (g) + HCl(g) ⟶ NH Cl(s) (9.E.6)
3 4
Q9.4.10
At approximately what distance from the ammonia moistened plug does this occur?
S9.4.10
51.7 cm
Q9.5.1
Using the postulates of the kinetic molecular theory, explain why a gas uniformly fills a container of any shape.
Q9.5.2
Can the speed of a given molecule in a gas double at constant temperature? Explain your answer.
S9.5.2
Yes. At any given instant, there are a range of values of molecular speeds in a sample of gas. Any single molecule can speed up or
slow down as it collides with other molecules. The average velocity of all the molecules is constant at constant temperature.
Q9.5.3
Describe what happens to the average kinetic energy of ideal gas molecules when the conditions are changed as follows:
a. The pressure of the gas is increased by reducing the volume at constant temperature.
b. The pressure of the gas is increased by increasing the temperature at constant volume.
c. The average velocity of the molecules is increased by a factor of 2.
Q9.5.4
The distribution of molecular velocities in a sample of helium is shown in Figure. If the sample is cooled, will the distribution of
velocities look more like that of H2 or of H2O? Explain your answer.
Q9.5.5
What is the ratio of the average kinetic energy of a SO2 molecule to that of an O2 molecule in a mixture of two gases? What is the
ratio of the root mean square speeds, urms, of the two gases?
Q9.5.6
A 1-L sample of CO initially at STP is heated to 546 °C, and its volume is increased to 2 L.
a. What effect do these changes have on the number of collisions of the molecules of the gas per unit area of the container wall?
b. What is the effect on the average kinetic energy of the molecules?
c. What is the effect on the root mean square speed of the molecules?
S9.5.6
(a) The number of collisions per unit area of the container wall is constant. (b) The average kinetic energy doubles. (c) The root
–
mean square speed increases to √2 times its initial value; urms is proportional to KE . avg
Q9.5.7
The root mean square speed of H2 molecules at 25 °C is about 1.6 km/s. What is the root mean square speed of a N2 molecule at 25
°C?
Q9.5.8
Answer the following questions:
a. Is the pressure of the gas in the hot air balloon shown at the opening of this chapter greater than, less than, or equal to that of the
atmosphere outside the balloon?
b. Is the density of the gas in the hot air balloon shown at the opening of this chapter greater than, less than, or equal to that of the
atmosphere outside the balloon?
c. At a pressure of 1 atm and a temperature of 20 °C, dry air has a density of 1.2256 g/L. What is the (average) molar mass of dry
air?
d. The average temperature of the gas in a hot air balloon is 1.30 × 102 °F. Calculate its density, assuming the molar mass equals
that of dry air.
e. The lifting capacity of a hot air balloon is equal to the difference in the mass of the cool air displaced by the balloon and the
mass of the gas in the balloon. What is the difference in the mass of 1.00 L of the cool air in part (c) and the hot air in part (d)?
f. An average balloon has a diameter of 60 feet and a volume of 1.1 × 105 ft3. What is the lifting power of such a balloon? If the
weight of the balloon and its rigging is 500 pounds, what is its capacity for carrying passengers and cargo?
g. A balloon carries 40.0 gallons of liquid propane (density 0.5005 g/L). What volume of CO2 and H2O gas is produced by the
combustion of this propane?
h. A balloon flight can last about 90 minutes. If all of the fuel is burned during this time, what is the approximate rate of heat loss
(in kJ/min) from the hot air in the bag during the flight?
S9.5.1
(a) equal; (b) less than; (c) 29.48 g mol−1; (d) 1.0966 g L−1; (e) 0.129 g/L; (f) 4.01 × 105 g; net lifting capacity = 384 lb; (g) 270 L;
(h) 39.1 kJ min−1
Q9.5.1
R1
Show that the ratio of the rate of diffusion of Gas 1 to the rate of diffusion of Gas 2, , is the same at 0 °C and 100 °C.
R2
S9.6.1
Gases C, E, and F
Q9.6.3
Explain why the plot of PV for CO2 differs from that of an ideal gas.
S9.6.3
The gas behavior most like an ideal gas will occur under the conditions in (b). Molecules have high speeds and move through
greater distances between collision; they also have shorter contact times and interactions are less likely. Deviations occur with the
conditions described in (a) and (c). Under conditions of (a), some gases may liquefy. Under conditions of (c), most gases will
liquefy.
Q9.6.4
Describe the factors responsible for the deviation of the behavior of real gases from that of an ideal gas.
Q9.6.5
For which of the following gases should the correction for the molecular volume be largest: CO, CO2, H2, He, NH3, SF6?
S9.6.6
SF6
Q9.6.7
A 0.245-L flask contains 0.467 mol CO2 at 159 °C. Calculate the pressure:
a. using the ideal gas law
b. using the van der Waals equation
c. Explain the reason for the difference.
d. Identify which correction (that for P or V) is dominant and why.
S9.6.8
(a) A straight horizontal line at 1.0; (b) When real gases are at low pressures and high temperatures they behave close enough to
ideal gases that they are approximated as such, however, in some cases, we see that at a high pressure and temperature, the ideal
gas approximation breaks down and is significantly different from the pressure calculated by the van der Waals equation (c) The
greater the compressibility, the more the volume matters. At low pressures, the correction factor for intermolecular attractions is
more significant, and the effect of the volume of the gas molecules on Z would be a small lowering compressibility. At higher
pressures, the effect of the volume of the gas molecules themselves on Z would increase compressibility (see Figure) (d) Once
again, at low pressures, the effect of intermolecular attractions on Z would be more important than the correction factor for the
volume of the gas molecules themselves, though perhaps still small. At higher pressures and low temperatures, the effect of
intermolecular attractions would be larger. See Figure. (e) low temperatures
Exercises
Graphs showing the behavior of several different gases follow. Which of these gases exhibit behavior significantly different from
that expected for ideal gases?
Gases C, E, and F
Explain why the plot of PV for CO2 differs from that of an ideal gas.
Under which of the following sets of conditions does a real gas behave most like an ideal gas, and for which conditions is a real gas
expected to deviate from ideal behavior? Explain.
(a) high pressure, small volume
(b) high temperature, low pressure
(c) low temperature, high pressure
The gas behavior most like an ideal gas will occur under the conditions in (b). Molecules have high speeds and move through
greater distances between collision; they also have shorter contact times and interactions are less likely. Deviations occur with the
conditions described in (a) and (c). Under conditions of (a), some gases may liquefy. Under conditions of (c), most gases will
liquefy.
Describe the factors responsible for the deviation of the behavior of real gases from that of an
ideal gas.
For which of the following gases should the correction for the molecular volume be largest:
CO, CO2, H2, He, NH3, SF6?
SF6
A 0.245-L flask contains 0.467 mol CO2 at 159 °C. Calculate the pressure:
(a) using the ideal gas law
(b) using the van der Waals equation
(c) Explain the reason for the difference.
(d) Identify which correction (that for P or V) is dominant and why.
Answer the following questions:
(a) If XX behaved as an ideal gas, what would its graph of Z vs. P look like?
(b) For most of this chapter, we performed calculations treating gases as ideal. Was this justified?
(c) What is the effect of the volume of gas molecules on Z? Under what conditions is this effect small? When is it large? Explain
using an appropriate diagram.
(d) What is the effect of intermolecular attractions on the value of Z? Under what conditions is this effect small? When is it large?
Explain using an appropriate diagram.
(e) In general, under what temperature conditions would you expect Z to have the largest deviations from the Z for an ideal gas?
(a) A straight horizontal line at 1.0; (b) When real gases are at low pressures and high temperatures they behave close enough to
ideal gases that they are approximated as such, however, in some cases, we see that at a high pressure and temperature, the ideal
gas approximation breaks down and is significantly different from the pressure calculated by the van der Waals equation (c) The
greater the compressibility, the more the volume matters. At low pressures, the correction factor for intermolecular attractions is
more significant, and the effect of the volume of the gas molecules on Z would be a small lowering compressibility. At higher
pressures, the effect of the volume of the gas molecules themselves on Z would increase compressibility (see Figure) (d) Once
again, at low pressures, the effect of intermolecular attractions on Z would be more important than the correction factor for the
volume of the gas molecules themselves, though perhaps still small. At higher pressures and low temperatures, the effect of
intermolecular attractions would be larger. See Figure. (e) low temperatures
This page titled 9.E: Gases (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 10: Liquids and Solids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
10.0: Prelude to Liquids and Solids
The great distances between atoms and molecules in a gaseous phase, and the corresponding absence of any significant interactions
between them, allows for simple descriptions of many physical properties that are the same for all gases, regardless of their
chemical identities. As described in the final module of the chapter on gases, this situation changes at high pressures and low
temperatures—conditions that permit the atoms and molecules to interact to a much greater extent.
Figure 10.0.1 : Solid carbon dioxide (“dry ice”, left) sublimes vigorously when placed in a liquid (right), cooling the liquid and
generating a fog of condensed water vapor above the cylinder. (credit: modification of work by Paul Flowers)
This figure shows pieces of a white substance which appear to be sublimating. To the right of these pieces are three graduated
cylinders. Each cylinder holds a different color liquid, and above the liquid, the cylinders are filled with a fog-like substance. This
fog-like substance swirls out of the top and around the outside of the cylinders.
In the liquid and solid states, these interactions are of considerable strength and play an important role in determining a number of
physical properties that do depend on the chemical identity of the substance. In this chapter, the nature of these interactions and
their effects on various physical properties of liquid and solid phases will be examined.
This page titled 10.0: Prelude to Liquids and Solids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As was the case for gaseous substances, the kinetic molecular theory may be used to explain the behavior of solids and liquids. In
the following description, the term particle will be used to refer to an atom, molecule, or ion. Note that we will use the popular
phrase “intermolecular attraction” to refer to attractive forces between the particles of a substance, regardless of whether these
particles are molecules, atoms, or ions.
Consider these two aspects of the molecular-level environments in solid, liquid, and gaseous matter:
Particles in a solid are tightly packed together and often arranged in a regular pattern; in a liquid, they are close together with no
regular arrangement; in a gas, they are far apart with no regular arrangement.
Particles in a solid vibrate about fixed positions and do not generally move in relation to one another; in a liquid, they move
past each other but remain in essentially constant contact; in a gas, they move independently of one another except when they
collide.
The differences in the properties of a solid, liquid, or gas reflect the strengths of the attractive forces between the atoms, molecules,
or ions that make up each phase. The phase in which a substance exists depends on the relative extents of its intermolecular forces
(IMFs) and the kinetic energies (KE) of its molecules. IMFs are the various forces of attraction that may exist between the atoms
and molecules of a substance due to electrostatic phenomena, as will be detailed in this module. These forces serve to hold particles
close together, whereas the particles’ KE provides the energy required to overcome the attractive forces and thus increase the
distance between particles. Figure 10.1.1 illustrates how changes in physical state may be induced by changing the temperature,
hence, the average KE, of a given substance.
Figure 10.1.1 : Transitions between solid, liquid, and gaseous states of a substance occur when conditions of temperature or
pressure favor the associated changes in intermolecular forces. (Note: The space between particles in the gas phase is much greater
than shown.)
Three sealed flasks are labeled, “Crystalline solid,” “Liquid,” and “Gas,” from left to right. The first flask holds a cube composed
of small spheres sitting on the bottom while the second flask shows a lot of small spheres in the bottom that are spaced a small
distance apart from one another and have lines around them to indicate motion. The third flask shows a few spheres spread far from
one another with larger lines to indicate motion. There is a right-facing arrow that spans the top of all three flasks. The arrow is
labeled, “Increasing K E ( temperature ).” There is a left-facing arrow that spans the bottom of all three flasks. The arrow is
labeled, “Increasing I M F.”
As an example of the processes depicted in this figure, consider a sample of water. When gaseous water is cooled sufficiently, the
attractions between H2O molecules will be capable of holding them together when they come into contact with each other; the gas
condenses, forming liquid H2O. For example, liquid water forms on the outside of a cold glass as the water vapor in the air is
cooled by the cold glass, as seen in Figure 10.1.2.
Figure 10.1.3 : Gaseous butane is compressed within the storage compartment of a disposable lighter, resulting in its condensation
to the liquid state. (credit: modification of work by “Sam-Cat”/Flickr)
Finally, if the temperature of a liquid becomes sufficiently low, or the pressure on the liquid becomes sufficiently high, the
molecules of the liquid no longer have enough KE to overcome the IMF between them, and a solid forms. A more thorough
discussion of these and other changes of state, or phase transitions, is provided in a later module of this chapter.
Figure 10.1.4 : Intramolecular forces keep a molecule intact. Intermolecular forces hold multiple molecules together and determine
many of a substance’s properties.
An image is shown in which two molecules composed of a green sphere labeled “C l” connected on the right to a white sphere
labeled “H” are near one another with a dotted line labeled “Intermolecular force ( weak )” drawn between them. A line connects
the two spheres in each molecule and the line is labeled “Intramolecular force ( strong ).”
All of the attractive forces between neutral atoms and molecules are known as van der Waals forces, although they are usually
referred to more informally as intermolecular attraction. We will consider the various types of IMFs in the next three sections of
this module.
Figure 10.1.5 : Dispersion forces result from the formation of temporary dipoles, as illustrated here for two nonpolar diatomic
molecules.
Two pairs of molecules are shown where each molecule has one larger blue side labeled “delta sign, negative sign” and a smaller
red side labeled “delta sign, positive sign.” Toward the middle of the both molecules, but still on each distinct side, is a black dot.
Between the two images is a dotted line labeled, “Attractive force.” In the first image, the red and blue sides are labeled, “Unequal
distribution of electrons.” Below both images are brackets. The brackets are labeled, “Temporary dipoles.”
Dispersion forces that develop between atoms in different molecules can attract the two molecules to each other. The forces are
relatively weak, however, and become significant only when the molecules are very close. Larger and heavier atoms and molecules
exhibit stronger dispersion forces than do smaller and lighter atoms and molecules. F2 and Cl2 are gases at room temperature
(reflecting weaker attractive forces); Br2 is a liquid, and I2 is a solid (reflecting stronger attractive forces). Trends in observed
melting and boiling points for the halogens clearly demonstrate this effect, as seen in Table 10.1.1.
Table 10.1.1 : Melting and Boiling Points of the Halogens
Halogen Molar Mass Atomic Radius Melting Point Boiling Point
fluorine, F2 38 g/mol 72 pm 53 K 85 K
The increase in melting and boiling points with increasing atomic/molecular size may be rationalized by considering how the
strength of dispersion forces is affected by the electronic structure of the atoms or molecules in the substance. In a larger atom, the
valence electrons are, on average, farther from the nuclei than in a smaller atom. Thus, they are less tightly held and can more
easily form the temporary dipoles that produce the attraction. The measure of how easy or difficult it is for another electrostatic
charge (for example, a nearby ion or polar molecule) to distort a molecule’s charge distribution (its electron cloud) is known as
polarizability. A molecule that has a charge cloud that is easily distorted is said to be very polarizable and will have large
dispersion forces; one with a charge cloud that is difficult to distort is not very polarizable and will have small dispersion forces.
Order the following compounds of a group 14 element and hydrogen from lowest to highest boiling point: CH4, SiH4, GeH4,
and SnH4. Explain your reasoning.
Solution
Applying the skills acquired in the chapter on chemical bonding and molecular geometry, all of these compounds are predicted
to be nonpolar, so they may experience only dispersion forces: the smaller the molecule, the less polarizable and the weaker the
dispersion forces; the larger the molecule, the larger the dispersion forces. The molar masses of CH4, SiH4, GeH4, and SnH4
are approximately 16 g/mol, 32 g/mol, 77 g/mol, and 123 g/mol, respectively. Therefore, CH4 is expected to have the lowest
boiling point and SnH4 the highest boiling point. The ordering from lowest to highest boiling point is expected to be
CH4 < SiH4 < GeH4 < SnH4
A graph of the actual boiling points of these compounds versus the period of the group 14 elements shows this prediction to be
correct:
A line graph, titled “Carbon Family,” is shown where the y-axis is labeled “Temperature, ( degree sign C )” and has values of
“negative 200” to “negative 40” from bottom to top in increments of 20. The x-axis is labeled “Period” and has values of “0” to
“5” in increments of 1. The first point on the graph is labeled “C H subscript 4” and is at point “2, negative 160.” The second
point on the graph is labeled “S i H subscript 4” and is at point “3, negative 120” while the third point on the graph is labeled
“G e H subscript 4” and is at point “4, negative 100.” The fourth point on the graph is labeled “S n H subscript 4” and is at
point “5, negative 60.”
Order the following hydrocarbons from lowest to highest boiling point: C2H6, C3H8, and C4H10.
Answer
All of these compounds are nonpolar and only have London dispersion forces: the larger the molecule, the larger the
dispersion forces and the higher the boiling point. The ordering from lowest to highest boiling point is therefore
C2H6 < C3H8 < C4H10.
The shapes of molecules also affect the magnitudes of the dispersion forces between them. For example, boiling points for the
isomers n-pentane, isopentane, and neopentane (shown in Figure 10.1.6) are 36 °C, 27 °C, and 9.5 °C, respectively. Even though
these compounds are composed of molecules with the same chemical formula, C5H12, the difference in boiling points suggests that
dispersion forces in the liquid phase are different, being greatest for n-pentane and least for neopentane. The elongated shape of n-
pentane provides a greater surface area available for contact between molecules, resulting in correspondingly stronger dispersion
forces. The more compact shape of isopentane offers a smaller surface area available for intermolecular contact and, therefore,
weaker dispersion forces. Neopentane molecules are the most compact of the three, offering the least available surface area for
intermolecular contact and, hence, the weakest dispersion forces. This behavior is analogous to the connections that may be formed
between strips of VELCRO brand fasteners: the greater the area of the strip’s contact, the stronger the connection.
Figure 10.1.6 : The strength of the dispersion forces increases with the contact area between molecules, as demonstrated by the
boiling points of these pentane isomers.
Three images of molecules are shown. The first shows a cluster of large, gray spheres each bonded together and to several smaller,
white spheres. There is a gray, jagged line and then the mirror image of the first cluster of spheres is shown. Above these two
clusters is the label, “Small contact area, weakest attraction,” and below is the label, “neopentane boiling point: 9.5 degrees C.” The
second shows a chain of three gray spheres bonded by the middle sphere to a fourth gray sphere. Each gray sphere is bonded to
several smaller, white spheres. There is a jagged, gray line and then the mirror image of the first chain appears. Above these two
chains is the label, “Less surface area, less attraction,” and below is the label, “isopentane boiling point: 27 degrees C.” The third
image shows a chain of five gray spheres bonded together and to several smaller, white spheres. There is a jagged gray line and
then the mirror image of the first chain appears. Above these chains is the label, “Large contact area, strong attraction,” and below
is the label, “n-pentane boiling point 36 degrees C.”
Geckos have an amazing ability to adhere to most surfaces. They can quickly run up smooth walls and across ceilings that have
no toe-holds, and they do this without having suction cups or a sticky substance on their toes. And while a gecko can lift its
feet easily as it walks along a surface, if you attempt to pick it up, it sticks to the surface. How are geckos (as well as spiders
and some other insects) able to do this? Although this phenomenon has been investigated for hundreds of years, scientists only
recently uncovered the details of the process that allows geckos’ feet to behave this way.
Geckos’ toes are covered with hundreds of thousands of tiny hairs known as setae, with each seta, in turn, branching into
hundreds of tiny, flat, triangular tips called spatulae. The huge numbers of spatulae on its setae provide a gecko, shown in
Figure 10.1.7, with a large total surface area for sticking to a surface. In 2000, Kellar Autumn, who leads a multi-institutional
gecko research team, found that geckos adhered equally well to both polar silicon dioxide and nonpolar gallium arsenide. This
proved that geckos stick to surfaces because of dispersion forces—weak intermolecular attractions arising from temporary,
synchronized charge distributions between adjacent molecules. Although dispersion forces are very weak, the total attraction
over millions of spatulae is large enough to support many times the gecko’s weight.
In 2014, two scientists developed a model to explain how geckos can rapidly transition from “sticky” to “non-sticky.” Alex
Greaney and Congcong Hu at Oregon State University described how geckos can achieve this by changing the angle between
their spatulae and the surface. Geckos’ feet, which are normally nonsticky, become sticky when a small shear force is applied.
By curling and uncurling their toes, geckos can alternate between sticking and unsticking from a surface, and thus easily move
across it. Further investigations may eventually lead to the development of better adhesives and other applications.
Watch this video to learn more about Kellar Autumn’s research that determined that van der Waals forces are responsible for a
gecko’s ability to cling and climb.
The effect of a dipole-dipole attraction is apparent when we compare the properties of HCl molecules to nonpolar F2 molecules.
Both HCl and F2 consist of the same number of atoms and have approximately the same molecular mass. At a temperature of 150
K, molecules of both substances would have the same average KE. However, the dipole-dipole attractions between HCl molecules
are sufficient to cause them to “stick together” to form a liquid, whereas the relatively weaker dispersion forces between nonpolar
F2 molecules are not, and so this substance is gaseous at this temperature. The higher normal boiling point of HCl (188 K)
compared to F2 (85 K) is a reflection of the greater strength of dipole-dipole attractions between HCl molecules, compared to the
attractions between nonpolar F2 molecules. We will often use values such as boiling or freezing points, or enthalpies of
vaporization or fusion, as indicators of the relative strengths of IMFs of attraction present within different substances.
Solution
CO and N2 are both diatomic molecules with masses of about 28 amu, so they experience similar London dispersion forces.
Because CO is a polar molecule, it experiences dipole-dipole attractions. Because N2 is nonpolar, its molecules cannot exhibit
dipole-dipole attractions. The dipole-dipole attractions between CO molecules are comparably stronger than the dispersion
forces between nonpolar N2 molecules, so CO is expected to have the higher boiling point.
A common method for preparing oxygen is the decomposition
Exercise 10.1.2
Predict which will have the higher boiling point: ICl or Br . Explain your reasoning.
2
Answer
ICl. ICl and Br2 have similar masses (~160 amu) and therefore experience similar London dispersion forces. ICl is polar
and thus also exhibits dipole-dipole attractions; Br2 is nonpolar and does not. The relatively stronger dipole-dipole
attractions require more energy to overcome, so ICl will have the higher boiling point.
Figure 10.1.9 : Water molecules participate in multiple hydrogen-bonding interactions with nearby water molecules.
Five water molecules are shown near one another, but not touching. A dotted line lies between many of the hydrogen atoms on one
molecule and the oxygen atom on another molecule.
Despite use of the word “bond,” keep in mind that hydrogen bonds are intermolecular attractive forces, not intramolecular
attractive forces (covalent bonds). Hydrogen bonds are much weaker than covalent bonds, only about 5 to 10% as strong, but are
generally much stronger than other dipole-dipole attractions and dispersion forces.
Hydrogen bonds have a pronounced effect on the properties of condensed phases (liquids and solids). For example, consider the
trends in boiling points for the binary hydrides of group 15 (NH3, PH3, AsH3, and SbH3), group 16 hydrides (H2O, H2S, H2Se, and
H2Te), and group 17 hydrides (HF, HCl, HBr, and HI). The boiling points of the heaviest three hydrides for each group are plotted
in Figure 10.1.10. As we progress down any of these groups, the polarities of the molecules decrease slightly, whereas the sizes of
the molecules increase substantially. The effect of increasingly stronger dispersion forces dominates that of increasingly weaker
dipole-dipole attractions, and the boiling points are observed to increase steadily. For the group 15, 16, and 17 hydrides, the boiling
points for each class of compounds increase with increasing molecular mass for elements in periods 3, 4, and 5.
Consider the compounds dimethylether (CH3OCH3), ethanol (CH3CH2OH), and propane (CH3CH2CH3). Their boiling points,
not necessarily in order, are −42.1 °C, −24.8 °C, and 78.4 °C. Match each compound with its boiling point. Explain your
reasoning.
Solution
The VSEPR-predicted shapes of CH3OCH3, CH3CH2OH, and CH3CH2CH3 are similar, as are their molar masses (46 g/mol,
46 g/mol, and 44 g/mol, respectively), so they will exhibit similar dispersion forces. Since CH3CH2CH3 is nonpolar, it may
exhibit only dispersion forces. Because CH3OCH3 is polar, it will also experience dipole-dipole attractions. Finally,
CH3CH2OH has an −OH group, and so it will experience the uniquely strong dipole-dipole attraction known as hydrogen
bonding. So the ordering in terms of strength of IMFs, and thus boiling points, is CH3CH2CH3 < CH3OCH3 < CH3CH2OH.
The boiling point of propane is −42.1 °C, the boiling point of dimethylether is −24.8 °C, and the boiling point of ethanol is
78.5 °C.
Answer
The melting point and boiling point for methylamine are predicted to be significantly greater than those of ethane. CH3CH3
and CH3NH2 are similar in size and mass, but methylamine possesses an −NH group and therefore may exhibit hydrogen
bonding. This greatly increases its IMFs, and therefore its melting and boiling points. It is difficult to predict values, but the
known values are a melting point of −93 °C and a boiling point of −6 °C.
The cumulative effect of millions of hydrogen bonds effectively holds the two strands of DNA together. Importantly, the two
strands of DNA can relatively easily “unzip” down the middle since hydrogen bonds are relatively weak compared to the covalent
bonds that hold the atoms of the individual DNA molecules together. This allows both strands to function as a template for
replication.
Summary
The physical properties of condensed matter (liquids and solids) can be explained in terms of the kinetic molecular theory. In a
liquid, intermolecular attractive forces hold the molecules in contact, although they still have sufficient kinetic energy to move past
each other. Intermolecular attractive forces, collectively referred to as van der Waals forces, are responsible for the behavior of
liquids and solids and are electrostatic in nature. Dipole-dipole attractions result from the electrostatic attraction of the partial
negative end of one dipolar molecule for the partial positive end of another. The temporary dipole that results from the motion of
the electrons in an atom can induce a dipole in an adjacent atom and give rise to the London dispersion force. London forces
increase with increasing molecular size. Hydrogen bonds are a special type of dipole-dipole attraction that results when hydrogen is
bonded to one of the three most electronegative elements: F, O, or N.
dispersion force
(also, London dispersion force) attraction between two rapidly fluctuating, temporary dipoles; significant only when particles
are very close together
hydrogen bonding
occurs when exceptionally strong dipoles attract; bonding that exists when hydrogen is bonded to one of the three most
electronegative elements: F, O, or N
induced dipole
temporary dipole formed when the electrons of an atom or molecule are distorted by the instantaneous dipole of a neighboring
atom or molecule
instantaneous dipole
temporary dipole that occurs for a brief moment in time when the electrons of an atom or molecule are distributed
asymmetrically
intermolecular force
noncovalent attractive force between atoms, molecules, and/or ions
polarizability
measure of the ability of a charge to distort a molecule’s charge distribution (electron cloud)
This page titled 10.1: Intermolecular Forces is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
When you pour a glass of water, or fill a car with gasoline, you observe that water and gasoline flow freely. But when you pour
syrup on pancakes or add oil to a car engine, you note that syrup and motor oil do not flow as readily. The viscosity of a liquid is a
measure of its resistance to flow. Water, gasoline, and other liquids that flow freely have a low viscosity. Honey, syrup, motor oil,
and other liquids that do not flow freely, like those shown in Figure 10.2.1, have higher viscosities. We can measure viscosity by
measuring the rate at which a metal ball falls through a liquid (the ball falls more slowly through a more viscous liquid) or by
measuring the rate at which a liquid flows through a narrow tube (more viscous liquids flow more slowly).
Figure 10.2.1 : (a) Honey and (b) motor oil are examples of liquids with high viscosities; they flow slowly. (credit a: modification
of work by Scott Bauer; credit b: modification of work by David Nagy)
Two photographs are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Photo a shows a jar of honey with a dipper drizzling it onto a biscuit. More
biscuits are shown in a basket in the background. Photo b shows the engine of a car and a person adding motor oil to the engine.
The IMFs between the molecules of a liquid, the size and shape of the molecules, and the temperature determine how easily a
liquid flows. As Table 10.2.1 shows, the more structurally complex are the molecules in a liquid and the stronger the IMFs between
them, the more difficult it is for them to move past each other and the greater is the viscosity of the liquid. As the temperature
increases, the molecules move more rapidly and their kinetic energies are better able to overcome the forces that hold them
together; thus, the viscosity of the liquid decreases.
Table 10.2.1 : Viscosities of Common Substances at 25 °C
Substance Formula Viscosity (mPa·s)
mercury Hg 1.526
The various IMFs between identical molecules of a substance are examples of cohesive forces. The molecules within a liquid are
surrounded by other molecules and are attracted equally in all directions by the cohesive forces within the liquid. However, the
molecules on the surface of a liquid are attracted only by about one-half as many molecules. Because of the unbalanced molecular
attractions on the surface molecules, liquids contract to form a shape that minimizes the number of molecules on the surface—that
is, the shape with the minimum surface area. A small drop of liquid tends to assume a spherical shape, as shown in Figure 10.2.2,
Figure 10.2.2 : Attractive forces result in a spherical water drop that minimizes surface area; cohesive forces hold the sphere
together; adhesive forces keep the drop attached to the web. (credit photo: modification of work by “OliBac”/Flickr)
A photo of a spider’s web with droplets of water attached to it is shown. Two images are shown the right of the photo and arrows
lead from the photo to the images. The upper image shows twenty eight blue spheres stacked one atop the other in the bottom of a
circular background. Five arrows are drawn pointing to the sides and downward from the sphere in the top middle of the drawing.
The lower image shows another circular background of the same size as the first, but this time the blue spheres fill the image and
are packed closely together. A sphere in the middle has six arrows pointing in all directions away from it.
Surface tension is defined as the energy required to increase the surface area of a liquid, or the force required to increase the length
of a liquid surface by a given amount. This property results from the cohesive forces between molecules at the surface of a liquid,
and it causes the surface of a liquid to behave like a stretched rubber membrane. Surface tensions of several liquids are presented in
Table 10.2.2.
Table 10.2.2 : Surface Tensions of Common Substances at 25 °C
Substance Formula Surface Tension (mN/m)
mercury Hg 458.48
Among common liquids, water exhibits a distinctly high surface tension due to strong hydrogen bonding between its molecules. As
a result of this high surface tension, the surface of water represents a relatively “tough skin” that can withstand considerable force
without breaking. A steel needle carefully placed on water will float. Some insects, like the one shown in Figure 10.2.3, even
though they are denser than water, move on its surface because they are supported by the surface tension.
Figure 10.2.3 : Surface tension (right) prevents this insect, a “water strider,” from sinking into the water.
A photo and a diagram as shown and a right-facing arrow leads from the photo to the image. The photo shows an insect standing on
the surface of a sample of water. The image shows a square background that is two thirds covered in blue spheres that are closely
packet together. A brown line starts at the upper left corner of the background and rests on top of the first row of spheres. The
sphere directly under this low point of the line has four arrows drawn on it that face to both sides and downward. A sphere in the
bottom center of the image has six arrows drawn on it that all face outward in different directions.
The IMFs of attraction between two different molecules are called adhesive forces. Consider what happens when water comes into
contact with some surface. If the adhesive forces between water molecules and the molecules of the surface are weak compared to
the cohesive forces between the water molecules, the water does not “wet” the surface. For example, water does not wet waxed
surfaces or many plastics such as polyethylene. Water forms drops on these surfaces because the cohesive forces within the drops
Figure 10.2.4 : Differences in the relative strengths of cohesive and adhesive forces result in different meniscus shapes for mercury
(left) and water (right) in glass tubes. (credit: Mark Ott)
This figure shows two test tubes. The test tube on the left contains mercury with a meniscus that rounds up. The test tube on the
right contains water with a meniscus that rounds down.
If you place one end of a paper towel in spilled wine, as shown in Figure 10.2.5, the liquid wicks up the paper towel. A similar
process occurs in a cloth towel when you use it to dry off after a shower. These are examples of capillary action—when a liquid
flows within a porous material due to the attraction of the liquid molecules to the surface of the material and to other liquid
molecules. The adhesive forces between the liquid and the porous material, combined with the cohesive forces within the liquid,
may be strong enough to move the liquid upward against gravity.
Figure 10.2.5 : Wine wicks up a paper towel (left) because of the strong attractions of water (and ethanol) molecules to the −OH
groups on the towel’s cellulose fibers and the strong attractions of water molecules to other water (and ethanol) molecules (right).
(credit photo: modification of work by Mark Blaser)
A photo and a diagram are shown. In the photo, a paper towel is dipped into a bowl full of a red liquid sitting on a countertop. The
red liquid is traveling up the lower part of the paper towel, and this section of the photo has a square drawn around it. A right-
facing arrow leads from this square to the image. The image is square and has a background of two types of molecules, mixed
together. The first type of molecule is composed of two bonded black spheres, one of which is single bonded to three white spheres
and one of which is single bonded to two white spheres and a red sphere that is itself bonded to a white sphere. The other type of
molecule is composed of six black spheres bonded together in a row and bonded to other red and white spheres. Six upward-facing
arrows are drawn on top of this background. They have positive signs on their lower ends and negative signs on their heads. Four
upward-facing arrows are drawn with their signs reversed.
Towels soak up liquids like water because the fibers of a towel are made of molecules that are attracted to water molecules. Most
cloth towels are made of cotton, and paper towels are generally made from paper pulp. Both consist of long molecules of cellulose
that contain many −OH groups. Water molecules are attracted to these −OH groups and form hydrogen bonds with them, which
draws the H2O molecules up the cellulose molecules. The water molecules are also attracted to each other, so large amounts of
water are drawn up the cellulose fibers.
Capillary action can also occur when one end of a small diameter tube is immersed in a liquid, as illustrated in Figure 10.2.6. If the
liquid molecules are strongly attracted to the tube molecules, the liquid creeps up the inside of the tube until the weight of the liquid
and the adhesive forces are in balance. The smaller the diameter of the tube is, the higher the liquid climbs. It is partly by capillary
Figure 10.2.6 : Depending upon the relative strengths of adhesive and cohesive forces, a liquid may rise (such as water) or fall
(such as mercury) in a glass capillary tube. The extent of the rise (or fall) is directly proportional to the surface tension of the liquid
and inversely proportional to the density of the liquid and the radius of the tube.
An image of two beakers and a tube is shown. The first beaker, drawn on the left and labeled “Water,” is drawn half-full of a blue
liquid. Two tubes are placed vertically in the beaker and inserted into the liquid. The liquid is shown higher in the tubes than in the
beaker and is labeled “Capillary attraction.” The second beaker, drawn in the middle and labeled “Mercury,” is drawn half-full of a
gray liquid. Two tubes are placed vertically in the beaker and inserted into the liquid. The liquid is shown lower in the tubes than in
the beaker and is labeled “Capillary repulsion.” Lines point to the vertical tubes and label them “Capillary tubes.” A separate
drawing of one of the vertical tubes from the first beaker is shown on the right. A right-facing arrow leads from the liquid in the
tube to a square call-out box that shows a close-up view of the liquid’s surface. The distance across the tube is labeled “2 r” in this
image.
The height to which a liquid will rise in a capillary tube is determined by several factors as shown in the following equation:
2T cos θ
h = (10.2.1)
rρg
where
h is the height of the liquid inside the capillary tube relative to the surface of the liquid outside the tube,
T is the surface tension of the liquid,
θ is the contact angle between the liquid and the tube,
r is the radius of the tube, ρ is the density of the liquid, and
g is the acceleration due to gravity, 9.8 m/s2.
When the tube is made of a material to which the liquid molecules are strongly attracted, they will spread out completely on the
surface, which corresponds to a contact angle of 0°. This is the situation for water rising in a glass tube.
Solution
The liquid will rise to a height h given by Equation 10.2.1 :
2T cos θ
h =
rρg
The Newton is defined as a kg m/s2, and so the provided surface tension is equivalent to 0.07199 kg/s2. The provided density
must be converted into units that will cancel appropriately: ρ = 1000 kg/m3. The diameter of the tube in meters is 0.00025 m,
so the radius is 0.000125 m. For a glass tube immersed in water, the contact angle is θ = 0°, so cos θ = 1. Finally, acceleration
due to gravity on the earth is g = 9.8 m/s2. Substituting these values into the equation, and cancelling units, we have:
Exercise 10.2.1
Water rises in a glass capillary tube to a height of 8.4 cm. What is the diameter of the capillary tube?
Answer
diameter = 0.36 mm
Many medical tests require drawing a small amount of blood, for example to determine the amount of glucose in someone with
diabetes or the hematocrit level in an athlete. This procedure can be easily done because of capillary action, the ability of a
liquid to flow up a small tube against gravity, as shown in Figure 10.2.7. When your finger is pricked, a drop of blood forms
and holds together due to surface tension—the unbalanced intermolecular attractions at the surface of the drop. Then, when the
open end of a narrow-diameter glass tube touches the drop of blood, the adhesive forces between the molecules in the blood
and those at the glass surface draw the blood up the tube. How far the blood goes up the tube depends on the diameter of the
tube (and the type of fluid). A small tube has a relatively large surface area for a given volume of blood, which results in larger
(relative) attractive forces, allowing the blood to be drawn farther up the tube. The liquid itself is held together by its own
cohesive forces. When the weight of the liquid in the tube generates a downward force equal to the upward force associated
with capillary action, the liquid stops rising.
Figure 10.2.7 :: Blood is collected for medical analysis by capillary action, which draws blood into a small diameter glass tube.
(credit: modification of work by Centers for Disease Control and Prevention)
A photograph shows a person’s hand being held by a person wearing medical gloves. A thin glass tube is pressed against the
persons finger and blood is moving up the tube.
Glossary
adhesive force
force of attraction between molecules of different chemical identities
capillary action
cohesive force
force of attraction between identical molecules
surface tension
energy required to increase the area, or length, of a liquid surface by a given amount
viscosity
measure of a liquid’s resistance to flow
This page titled 10.2: Properties of Liquids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
We witness and utilize changes of physical state, or phase transitions, in a great number of ways. As one example of global
significance, consider the evaporation, condensation, freezing, and melting of water. These changes of state are essential aspects of
our earth’s water cycle as well as many other natural phenomena and technological processes of central importance to our lives. In
this module, the essential aspects of phase transitions are explored.
Figure 10.3.1 : In a closed container, dynamic equilibrium is reached when (a) the rate of molecules escaping from the liquid to
become the gas (b) increases and eventually (c) equals the rate of gas molecules entering the liquid. When this equilibrium is
reached, the vapor pressure of the gas is constant, although the vaporization and condensation processes continue.
Three images are shown and labeled “a,” “b,” and “c.” Each image shows a round bulb connected on the right to a tube that is
horizontal, then is bent vertically, curves, and then is vertical again to make a u-shape. A valve is located in the horizontal portion
of the tube. Image a depicts a liquid in the bulb, labeled, “Liquid,” and upward-facing arrows leading away from the surface of the
liquid. The phrase, “Molecules escape surface and form vapor” is written below the bulb, and a gray liquid in the u-shaped portion
of the tube is shown at equal heights on the right and left sides. Image b depicts a liquid in the bulb, labeled, “Liquid,” and upward-
facing arrows leading away from the surface of the liquid to molecules drawn in the upper portion of the bulb. A gray liquid in the
u-shaped portion of the tube is shown slightly higher on the right side than on the left side. Image c depicts a liquid in the bulb,
labeled, “Liquid,” and upward-facing arrows leading away from the surface of the liquid to molecules drawn in the upper portion of
the bulb. There are more molecules present in c than in b. The phrase “Equilibrium reached, vapor pressure determined,” is written
below the bulb and a gray liquid in the u-shaped portion of the tube is shown higher on the right side. A horizontal line is drawn
level with each of these liquid levels and the distance between the lines is labeled with a double-headed arrow. This section is
labeled with the phrase, “Vapor pressure.”
The chemical identities of the molecules in a liquid determine the types (and strengths) of intermolecular attractions possible;
consequently, different substances will exhibit different equilibrium vapor pressures. Relatively strong intermolecular attractive
forces will serve to impede vaporization as well as favoring “recapture” of gas-phase molecules when they collide with the liquid
surface, resulting in a relatively low vapor pressure. Weak intermolecular attractions present less of a barrier to vaporization, and a
Given the shown structural formulas for these four compounds, explain their relative vapor pressures in terms of types and
extents of IMFs:
Solution
Diethyl ether has a very small dipole and most of its intermolecular attractions are London forces. Although this molecule is
the largest of the four under consideration, its IMFs are the weakest and, as a result, its molecules most readily escape from the
liquid. It also has the highest vapor pressure. Due to its smaller size, ethanol exhibits weaker dispersion forces than diethyl
ether. However, ethanol is capable of hydrogen bonding and, therefore, exhibits stronger overall IMFs, which means that fewer
molecules escape from the liquid at any given temperature, and so ethanol has a lower vapor pressure than diethyl ether. Water
is much smaller than either of the previous substances and exhibits weaker dispersion forces, but its extensive hydrogen
bonding provides stronger intermolecular attractions, fewer molecules escaping the liquid, and a lower vapor pressure than for
either diethyl ether or ethanol. Ethylene glycol has two −OH groups, so, like water, it exhibits extensive hydrogen bonding. It
is much larger than water and thus experiences larger London forces. Its overall IMFs are the largest of these four substances,
which means its vaporization rate will be the slowest and, consequently, its vapor pressure the lowest.
Exercise 10.3.1
At 20 °C, the vapor pressures of several alcohols are given in this table. Explain these vapor pressures in terms of types and
extents of IMFs for these alcohols:
At 20 °C, the vapor pressures of several alcohols
Compound methanol CH3OH ethanol C2H5OH propanol C3H7OH butanol C4H9OH
Vapor Pressure at 20 °C 11.9 kPa 5.95 kPa 2.67 kPa 0.56 kPa
Answer
All these compounds exhibit hydrogen bonding; these strong IMFs are difficult for the molecules to overcome, so the vapor
pressures are relatively low. As the size of molecule increases from methanol to butanol, dispersion forces increase, which
means that the vapor pressures decrease as observed:
As temperature increases, the vapor pressure of a liquid also increases due to the increased average KE of its molecules. Recall that
at any given temperature, the molecules of a substance experience a range of kinetic energies, with a certain fraction of molecules
having a sufficient energy to overcome IMF and escape the liquid (vaporize). At a higher temperature, a greater fraction of
molecules have enough energy to escape from the liquid, as shown in Figure 10.3.2. The escape of more molecules per unit of time
and the greater average speed of the molecules that escape both contribute to the higher vapor pressure.
Figure 10.3.3: The boiling points of liquids are the temperatures at which their equilibrium vapor pressures equal the pressure of
the surrounding atmosphere. Normal boiling points are those corresponding to a pressure of 1 atm (101.3 kPa.)
A graph is shown where the x-axis is labeled “Temperature ( degree sign, C )” and has values of 200 to 1000 in increments of 200
and the y-axis is labeled “Pressure ( k P a )” and has values of 20 to 120 in increments of 20. A horizontal dotted line extends
across the graph at point 780 on the y-axis while three vertical dotted lines extend from points 35, 78, and 100 to meet the
horizontal dotted line. Four lines are graphed. The first line, labeled “ethyl ether,” begins at the point “0 , 200” and extends in a
slight curve to point “45, 1000” while the second line, labeled “ethanol”, extends from point “0, 20” to point “88, 1000” in a more
extreme curve. The third line, labeled “water,” begins at the point “0, 0” and extends in a curve to point “108, 1000” while the
fourth line, labeled “ethylene glycol,” extends from point “80, 0” to point “140, 100” in a very shallow curve.
A typical atmospheric pressure in Leadville, Colorado (elevation 10,200 feet) is 68 kPa. Use the graph in Figure 10.3.3 to
determine the boiling point of water at this elevation.
Exercise 10.3.2
The boiling point of ethyl ether was measured to be 10 °C at a base camp on the slopes of Mount Everest. Use Figure 10.3.3 to
determine the approximate atmospheric pressure at the camp.
Answer
Approximately 40 kPa (0.4 atm)
The quantitative relation between a substance’s vapor pressure and its temperature is described by the Clausius-Clapeyron
equation:
−Δ Hva p /RT
P = Ae (10.3.1)
where
ΔHvap is the enthalpy of vaporization for the liquid,
R is the gas constant, and
ln A is a constant whose value depends on the chemical identity of the substance.
Equation 10.3.1 is often rearranged into logarithmic form to yield the linear equation:
ΔHvap
ln P = − + ln A (10.3.2)
RT
This linear equation may be expressed in a two-point format that is convenient for use in various computations, as demonstrated in
the examples and exercises that follow. If at temperature T , the vapor pressure is P , and at temperature T , the vapor pressure is
1 1 2
ΔHvap
ln P1 = − + ln A
RT1
and
ΔHvap
ln P2 = − + ln A (10.3.3)
RT2
Since the constant, ln A, is the same, these two equations may be rearranged to isolate ln A and then set them equal to one another:
ΔHvap ΔHvap
ln P1 + = ln P2 +
RT1 RT2
P2 ΔHvap 1 1
ln( ) = ( − ) (10.3.4)
P1 R T1 T2
Isooctane (2,2,4-trimethylpentane) has an octane rating of 100. It is used as one of the standards for the octane-rating system
for gasoline. At 34.0 °C, the vapor pressure of isooctane is 10.0 kPa, and at 98.8 °C, its vapor pressure is 100.0 kPa. Use this
information to estimate the enthalpy of vaporization for isooctane.
P1 = 10.0 kP a and
o
T2 = 98.8 C = 372.0 K
P2 = 100 kP a
we can substitute them into this equation and solve for ΔHvap . Rearranging the Clausius-Clapeyron equation and solving for
ΔH vapyields:
P2
R ⋅ ln( )
P1
ΔHvap =
1 1
( − )
T1 T2
100 kP a
(8.3145 J/mol ⋅ K) ⋅ ln( )
10.0 kP a
=
1 1
( − )
307.2 K 372.0 K
Note that the pressure can be in any units, so long as they agree for both P values, but the temperature must be in kelvin for the
Clausius-Clapeyron equation to be valid.
Exercise 10.3.3
At 20.0 °C, the vapor pressure of ethanol is 5.95 kPa, and at 63.5 °C, its vapor pressure is 53.3 kPa. Use this information to
estimate the enthalpy of vaporization for ethanol.
Answer
47,782 J/mol = 47.8 kJ/mol
For benzene (C6H6), the normal boiling point is 80.1 °C and the enthalpy of vaporization is 30.8 kJ/mol. What is the boiling
point of benzene in Denver, where atmospheric pressure = 83.4 kPa?
Solution
If the temperature and vapor pressure are known at one point, along with the enthalpy of vaporization, ΔHvap, then the
temperature that corresponds to a different vapor pressure (or the vapor pressure that corresponds to a different temperature)
can be determined by using the Clausius-Clapeyron equation (Equation 10.3.1) :
P2 ΔHvap 1 1
ln( ) = ( − )
P1 R T1 T2
Since the normal boiling point is the temperature at which the vapor pressure equals atmospheric pressure at sea level, we
know one vapor pressure-temperature value (T = 80.1 °C = 353.3 K, P = 101.3 kPa, ΔH = 30.8 kJ/mol) and want to find
1 1 vap
Clapeyron equation and then solve for T . Rearranging the Clausius-Clapeyron equation and solving for T yields:
2 2
−1
P2
⎛ ⎞
−R ⋅ ln( )
⎜ P1 1 ⎟
T2 = ⎜ + ⎟
⎜ ΔHvap T1 ⎟
⎝ ⎠
−1
83.4 kPa
⎛ −(8.3145 J/mol ⋅ K) ⋅ ln( ) ⎞
⎜ 101.3 kPa 1 ⎟
= ⎜ + ⎟
⎜ 30, 800 J/mol 353.3 K ⎟
⎝ ⎠
∘
= 346.9 K or 73.8 C
Exercise 10.3.4
For acetone (CH ) CO, the normal boiling point is 56.5 °C and the enthalpy of vaporization is 31.3 kJ/mol. What is the vapor
3 2
Answer
30.1 kPa
represented by:
As described in the chapter on thermochemistry, the reverse of an endothermic process is exothermic. And so, the condensation of
a gas releases heat:
How much heat is required to evaporate 100.0 g of liquid ammonia, NH , at its boiling point if its enthalpy of vaporization is
3
4.8 kJ/mol?
Answer
28 kJ
Figure 10.3.5 : (a) This beaker of ice has a temperature of −12.0 °C. (b) After 10 minutes the ice has absorbed enough heat from the
air to warm to 0 °C. A small amount has melted. (c) Thirty minutes later, the ice has absorbed more heat, but its temperature is still
0 °C. The ice melts without changing its temperature. (d) Only after all the ice has melted does the heat absorbed cause the
temperature to increase to 22.2 °C. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott).
This figure shows four photos each labeled, “a,” “b,” “c,” and, “d.” Each photo shows a beaker with ice and a digital thermometer.
The first photo shows ice cubes in the beaker, and the thermometer reads negative 12.0 degrees C. The second photo shows slightly
melted ice, and the thermometer reads 0.0 degrees C. The third photo shows more water than ice in the beaker. The thermometer
reads 0.0 degrees C. The fourth photo shows the ice completely melted, and the thermometer reads 22.2 degrees C.
If we stop heating during melting and place the mixture of solid and liquid in a perfectly insulated container so no heat can enter or
escape, the solid and liquid phases remain in equilibrium. This is almost the situation with a mixture of ice and water in a very good
The reciprocal process, freezing, is an exothermic process whose enthalpy change is −6.0 kJ/mol at 0 °C:
H O(l) → H O(s) ΔHfrz = −ΔHfus = −6.01 kJ/mol (10.3.6)
2 2
Figure 10.3.6 : Sublimation of solid iodine in the bottom of the tube produces a purple gas that subsequently deposits as solid
iodine on the colder part of the tube above. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott)
This figure shows a test tube. In the bottom is a dark substance which breaks up into a purple gas at the top.
Like vaporization, the process of sublimation requires an input of energy to overcome intermolecular attractions. The enthalpy of
sublimation, ΔHsub, is the energy required to convert one mole of a substance from the solid to the gaseous state. For example, the
sublimation of carbon dioxide is represented by:
Likewise, the enthalpy change for the reverse process of deposition is equal in magnitude but opposite in sign to that for
sublimation:
Consider the extent to which intermolecular attractions must be overcome to achieve a given phase transition. Converting a solid
into a liquid requires that these attractions be only partially overcome; transition to the gaseous state requires that they be
completely overcome. As a result, the enthalpy of fusion for a substance is less than its enthalpy of vaporization. This same logic
can be used to derive an approximate relation between the enthalpies of all phase changes for a given substance. Though not an
entirely accurate description, sublimation may be conveniently modeled as a sequential two-step process of melting followed by
vaporization in order to apply Hess’s Law.
Viewed in this manner, the enthalpy of sublimation for a substance may be estimated as the sum of its enthalpies of fusion and
vaporization, as illustrated in Figure 10.3.7. For example:
Figure 10.3.7 : For a given substance, the sum of its enthalpy of fusion and enthalpy of vaporization is approximately equal to its
enthalpy of sublimation.
A diagram is shown with a vertical line drawn on the left side and labeled “Energy” and three horizontal lines drawn near the
bottom, lower third and top of the diagram. These three lines are labeled, from bottom to top, “Solid,” “Liquid” and “Gas.” Near
the middle of the diagram, a vertical, upward-facing arrow is drawn from the solid line to the gas line and labeled “Sublimation,
delta sign, H, subscript sub.” To the right of this arrow is a second vertical, upward-facing arrow that is drawn from the solid line to
the liquid line and labeled “Fusion, delta sign, H, subscript fus.” Above the second arrow is a third arrow drawn from the liquid line
to the gas line and labeled, “Vaporization, delta sign, H, subscript vap.”
q = mcΔT
where m is the mass of the substance and c is its specific heat. The relation applies to matter being heated or cooled, but not
undergoing a change in state. When a substance being heated or cooled reaches a temperature corresponding to one of its phase
transitions, further gain or loss of heat is a result of diminishing or enhancing intermolecular attractions, instead of increasing or
decreasing molecular kinetic energies. While a substance is undergoing a change in state, its temperature remains constant. Figure
10.3.8 shows a typical heating curve.
Example 10.3.6: Total Heat Needed to Change Temperature and Phase for a Substance
How much heat is required to convert 135 g of ice at −15 °C into water vapor at 120 °C?
Solution
The transition described involves the following steps:
1. Heat ice from −15 °C to 0 °C
2. Melt ice
3. Heat water from 0 °C to 100 °C
4. Boil water
5. Heat steam from 100 °C to 120 °C
The heat needed to change the temperature of a given substance (with no change in phase) is: q = m × c × ΔT (see previous
chapter on thermochemistry). The heat needed to induce a given change in phase is given by q = n × ΔH.
Using these equations with the appropriate values for specific heat of ice, water, and steam, and enthalpies of fusion and
vaporization, we have:
1 mol
= (135 g ⋅ 2.09 J/g ⋅ °C ⋅ 15°C) + (135 ⋅ ⋅ 6.01 kJ/mol)
18.02 g
1 mol
+(135 g ⋅ 4.18 J/g ⋅ °C ⋅ 100°C) + (135 g ⋅ ⋅ 40.67 kJ/mol)
18.02 g
Converting the quantities in J to kJ permits them to be summed, yielding the total heat required:
Exercise 10.3.6
What is the total amount of heat released when 94.0 g water at 80.0 °C cools to form ice at −30.0 °C?
Answer
40.5 kJ
Summary
Phase transitions are processes that convert matter from one physical state into another. There are six phase transitions between the
three phases of matter. Melting, vaporization, and sublimation are all endothermic processes, requiring an input of heat to overcome
intermolecular attractions. The reciprocal transitions of freezing, condensation, and deposition are all exothermic processes,
involving heat as intermolecular attractive forces are established or strengthened. The temperatures at which phase transitions occur
are determined by the relative strengths of intermolecular attractions and are, therefore, dependent on the chemical identity of the
substance.
ΔHvap
ln P = − + ln A
RT
P2 ΔHvap 1 1
ln( ) = ( − )
P1 R T1 T2
Glossary
boiling point
temperature at which the vapor pressure of a liquid equals the pressure of the gas above it
Clausius-Clapeyron equation
mathematical relationship between the temperature, vapor pressure, and enthalpy of vaporization for a substance
condensation
change from a gaseous to a liquid state
deposition
change from a gaseous state directly to a solid state
dynamic equilibrium
state of a system in which reciprocal processes are occurring at equal rates
freezing point
temperature at which the solid and liquid phases of a substance are in equilibrium; see also melting point
melting
change from a solid state to a liquid state
melting point
temperature at which the solid and liquid phases of a substance are in equilibrium; see also freezing point
sublimation
change from solid state directly to gaseous state
vapor pressure
(also, equilibrium vapor pressure) pressure exerted by a vapor in equilibrium with a solid or a liquid at a given temperature
vaporization
change from liquid state to gaseous state
This page titled 10.3: Phase Transitions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In the previous module, the variation of a liquid’s equilibrium vapor pressure with temperature was described. Considering the
definition of boiling point, plots of vapor pressure versus temperature represent how the boiling point of the liquid varies with
pressure. Also described was the use of heating and cooling curves to determine a substance’s melting (or freezing) point. Making
such measurements over a wide range of pressures yields data that may be presented graphically as a phase diagram. A phase
diagram combines plots of pressure versus temperature for the liquid-gas, solid-liquid, and solid-gas phase-transition equilibria of a
substance. These diagrams indicate the physical states that exist under specific conditions of pressure and temperature, and also
provide the pressure dependence of the phase-transition temperatures (melting points, sublimation points, boiling points). A typical
phase diagram for a pure substance is shown in Figure 10.4.1.
Figure 10.4.1 : The physical state of a substance and its phase-transition temperatures are represented graphically in a phase
diagram.
A graph is shown where the x-axis is labeled “Temperature” and the y-axis is labeled “Pressure.” A line extends from the lower left
bottom of the graph sharply upward to a point that is a third across the x-axis. A second line begins at the lower third of the first
line at a point labeled “triple point” and extends to the upper right corner of the graph where it is labeled “critical point.” The two
lines bisect the graph area to create three sections, labeled “solid” near the top left, “liquid” in the top middle and “gas” near the
bottom right. A pair of horizontal arrows, one left-facing and labeled “deposition” and one right-facing and labeled” sublimation,”
are drawn on top of the bottom section of the first line. A second pair of horizontal arrows, one left-facing and labeled “freezing”
and one right-facing and labeled “melting”, are drawn on top of the upper section of the first line. A third pair of horizontal arrows,
one left-facing and labeled “condensation” and one right-facing and labeled ”vaporization,” are drawn on top of the middle section
of the second line.
To illustrate the utility of these plots, consider the phase diagram for water shown in Figure 10.4.2.
Figure 10.4.4 : The immense pressures beneath glaciers result in partial melting to produce a layer of water that provides lubrication
to assist glacial movement. This satellite photograph shows the advancing edge of the Perito Moreno glacier in Argentina. (credit:
NASA)
A photograph shows an aerial view of a land mass. The white mass of a glacier is shown near the top left quadrant of the photo and
leads to two branching blue rivers. The open land is shown in brown.
The point of intersection of all three curves is labeled B in Figure 10.4.2. At the pressure and temperature represented by this point,
all three phases of water coexist in equilibrium. This temperature-pressure data pair is called the triple point. At pressures lower
than the triple point, water cannot exist as a liquid, regardless of the temperature.
Using the phase diagram for water given in Figure 10.4.2, determine the state of water at the following temperatures and
pressures:
a. −10 °C and 50 kPa
b. 25 °C and 90 kPa
c. 50 °C and 40 kPa
d. 80 °C and 5 kPa
e. −10 °C and 0.3 kPa
f. 50 °C and 0.3 kPa
Solution
Using the phase diagram for water, we can determine that the state of water at each temperature and pressure given are as
follows: (a) solid; (b) liquid; (c) liquid; (d) gas; (e) solid; (f) gas.
Answer
At 0.3 kPa: s⟶ g at −58 °C. At 50 kPa: s⟶ l at 0 °C, l ⟶ g at 78 °C
Consider the phase diagram for carbon dioxide shown in Figure 10.4.5 as another example. The solid-liquid curve exhibits a
positive slope, indicating that the melting point for CO2 increases with pressure as it does for most substances (water being a
notable exception as described previously). Notice that the triple point is well above 1 atm, indicating that carbon dioxide cannot
exist as a liquid under ambient pressure conditions. Instead, cooling gaseous carbon dioxide at 1 atm results in its deposition into
the solid state. Likewise, solid carbon dioxide does not melt at 1 atm pressure but instead sublimes to yield gaseous CO2. Finally,
notice that the critical point for carbon dioxide is observed at a relatively modest temperature and pressure in comparison to water.
Figure 10.4.5 : The pressure and temperature axes on this phase diagram of carbon dioxide are not drawn to constant scale in order
to illustrate several important properties.
A graph is shown where the x-axis is labeled “Temperature ( degree sign, C )” and has values of negative 100 to 100 in increments
of 25 and the y-axis is labeled “Pressure ( k P a )” and has values of 10 to 1,000,000. A line extends from the lower left bottom of
the graph upward to a point around“27, 9000,” where it ends. The space under this curve is labeled “Gas.” A second line extends in
a curve from point around “-73, 100” to “27, 1,000,000.” The area to the left of this line and above the first line is labeled “Solid”
while the area to the right is labeled “Liquid.” A section on the graph under the second line and past the point “28” on the x-axis is
labeled “S C F.”
Using the phase diagram for carbon dioxide shown in Figure 10.4.5, determine the state of CO2 at the following temperatures
and pressures:
a. −30 °C and 2000 kPa
b. −60 °C and 1000 kPa
c. −60 °C and 100 kPa
d. 20 °C and 1500 kPa
e. 0 °C and 100 kPa
f. 20 °C and 100 kPa
Solution
Using the phase diagram for carbon dioxide provided, we can determine that the state of CO2 at each temperature and pressure
given are as follows: (a) liquid; (b) solid; (c) gas; (d) liquid; (e) gas; (f) gas.
Determine the phase changes carbon dioxide undergoes when its temperature is varied, thus holding its pressure constant at
1500 kPa? At 500 kPa? At what approximate temperatures do these phase changes occur?
Answer
at 1500 kPa: s⟶ l at −45 °C, l⟶ g at −10 °C; at 500 kPa: s⟶ g at −58 °C
liquefy a gas at its critical temperature is called the critical pressure. The critical temperatures and critical pressures of some
common substances are given in Table 10.4.1.
Table 10.4.1 : Critical Temperatures and Critical Pressures of select substances
Substance Critical Temperature (K) Critical Pressure (atm)
Like a gas, a supercritical fluid will expand and fill a container, but its density is much greater than typical gas densities, typically
being close to those for liquids. Similar to liquids, these fluids are capable of dissolving nonvolatile solutes. They exhibit
essentially no surface tension and very low viscosities, however, so they can more effectively penetrate very small openings in a
solid mixture and remove soluble components. These properties make supercritical fluids extremely useful solvents for a wide
range of applications. For example, supercritical carbon dioxide has become a very popular solvent in the food industry, being used
to decaffeinate coffee, remove fats from potato chips, and extract flavor and fragrance compounds from citrus oils. It is nontoxic,
relatively inexpensive, and not considered to be a pollutant. After use, the CO2 can be easily recovered by reducing the pressure
and collecting the resulting gas.
If we shake a carbon dioxide fire extinguisher on a cool day (18 °C), we can hear liquid CO2 sloshing around inside the
cylinder. However, the same cylinder appears to contain no liquid on a hot summer day (35 °C). Explain these observations.
Solution
On the cool day, the temperature of the CO2 is below the critical temperature of CO2, 304 K or 31 °C (Table 10.4.1), so liquid
CO2 is present in the cylinder. On the hot day, the temperature of the CO2 is greater than its critical temperature of 31 °C.
Above this temperature no amount of pressure can liquefy CO2 so no liquid CO2 exists in the fire extinguisher.
Exercise 10.4.3
Ammonia can be liquefied by compression at room temperature; oxygen cannot be liquefied under these conditions. Why do
the two gases exhibit different behavior?
Answer
The critical temperature of ammonia is 405.5 K, which is higher than room temperature. The critical temperature of oxygen
is below room temperature; thus oxygen cannot be liquefied at room temperature.
Two images are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Image a shows a molecule composed of a five member ring composed of two blue
spheres and three black spheres. One of the blue spheres is bonded to a black sphere bonded to three white spheres and one of the
black spheres is bonded to a white sphere. The other two black spheres are double bonded together and make up one side of a six-
membered ring that is also composed of two more black spheres and two blue spheres, both of which are bonded to a black sphere
bonded to three white spheres. The black spheres are each double bonded to red spheres. Image b shows a diagram of two vertical
tubes that lie next to one another. The left-hand tube is labeled “Extraction vessel.” A small tube labeled “Soaked beans” leads into
the top of the tube and a label at the bottom of the tube reads “Decaffeinated beans.” The right tube is labeled “Absorption vessel.”
A tube near the top of this tube is labeled “Water” and another tube leads from the right tube to the left. This tube is labeled with a
left-facing arrow and the phrase “supercritical carbon dioxide.” There is a tube leading away from the bottom which is labeled,
“Caffeine and water.” There is another tube that leads from the extraction vessel to the absorption vessel which is labeled,
“supercritical C O subscript 2 plus caffeine.”
Supercritical fluid extraction using carbon dioxide is now being widely used as a more effective and environmentally friendly
decaffeination method (Figure 10.4.7). At temperatures above 304.2 K and pressures above 7376 kPa, CO2 is a supercritical fluid,
with properties of both gas and liquid. Like a gas, it penetrates deep into the coffee beans; like a liquid, it effectively dissolves
certain substances. Supercritical carbon dioxide extraction of steamed coffee beans removes 97−99% of the caffeine, leaving
coffee’s flavor and aroma compounds intact. Because CO2 is a gas under standard conditions, its removal from the extracted coffee
beans is easily accomplished, as is the recovery of the caffeine from the extract. The caffeine recovered from coffee beans via this
process is a valuable product that can be used subsequently as an additive to other foods or drugs.
Summary
The temperature and pressure conditions at which a substance exists in solid, liquid, and gaseous states are summarized in a phase
diagram for that substance. Phase diagrams are combined plots of three pressure-temperature equilibrium curves: solid-liquid,
liquid-gas, and solid-gas. These curves represent the relationships between phase-transition temperatures and pressures. The point
of intersection of all three curves represents the substance’s triple point—the temperature and pressure at which all three phases are
in equilibrium. At pressures below the triple point, a substance cannot exist in the liquid state, regardless of its temperature. The
terminus of the liquid-gas curve represents the substance’s critical point, the pressure and temperature above which a liquid phase
cannot exist.
Glossary
critical point
temperature and pressure above which a gas cannot be condensed into a liquid
phase diagram
pressure-temperature graph summarizing conditions under which the phases of a substance can exist
supercritical fluid
substance at a temperature and pressure higher than its critical point; exhibits properties intermediate between those of gaseous
and liquid states
This page titled 10.4: Phase Diagrams is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
When most liquids are cooled, they eventually freeze and form crystalline solids, solids in which the atoms, ions, or molecules are
arranged in a definite repeating pattern. It is also possible for a liquid to freeze before its molecules become arranged in an orderly
pattern. The resulting materials are called amorphous solids or noncrystalline solids (or, sometimes, glasses). The particles of such
solids lack an ordered internal structure and are randomly arranged (Figure 10.5.1).
Figure 10.5.1 : The entities of a solid phase may be arranged in a regular, repeating pattern (crystalline solids) or randomly
(amorphous).
The crystalline arrangement shows many circles drawn in rows and stacked together tightly. The amorphous arrangement shows
many circles spread slightly apart and in no organized pattern.
Metals and ionic compounds typically form ordered, crystalline solids. Substances that consist of large molecules, or a mixture of
molecules whose movements are more restricted, often form amorphous solids. For examples, candle waxes are amorphous solids
composed of large hydrocarbon molecules. Some substances, such as boron oxide (Figure 10.5.2), can form either crystalline or
amorphous solids, depending on the conditions under which it is produced. Also, amorphous solids may undergo a transition to the
crystalline state under appropriate conditions.
Figure 10.5.2 : (a) Diboron trioxide, B2O3, is normally found as a white, amorphous solid (a glass), which has a high degree of
disorder in its structure. (b) By careful, extended heating, it can be converted into a crystalline form of B2O3, which has a very
ordered arrangement.
The first structure of diboron trioxide shows five identical and separated hexagonal rings. The second structure of diboron trioxide
shows a more interconnected structure with four large rings forming a more stable structure.
Crystalline solids are generally classified according the nature of the forces that hold its particles together. These forces are
primarily responsible for the physical properties exhibited by the bulk solids. The following sections provide descriptions of the
Figure 10.5.6 : Carbon dioxide (CO2) consists of small, nonpolar molecules and forms a molecular solid with a melting point of
−78 °C. Iodine (I2) consists of larger, nonpolar molecules and forms a molecular solid that melts at 114 °C.
On the left, many red and grey molecules are densely stacked in a 3-D drawing to represent carbon dioxide. On the right, purple
molecules are scattered randomly to represent iodine.
Carbon is an essential element in our world. The unique properties of carbon atoms allow the existence of carbon-based life
forms such as ourselves. Carbon forms a huge variety of substances that we use on a daily basis, including those shown in
Figure 10.5.7. You may be familiar with diamond and graphite, the two most common allotropes of carbon. (Allotropes are
different structural forms of the same element.) Diamond is one of the hardest-known substances, whereas graphite is soft
enough to be used as pencil lead. These very different properties stem from the different arrangements of the carbon atoms in
the different allotropes.
Figure 10.5.7 : Diamond is extremely hard because of the strong bonding between carbon atoms in all directions. Graphite (in
pencil lead) rubs off onto paper due to the weak attractions between the carbon layers. An image of a graphite surface shows
the distance between the centers of adjacent carbon atoms. (credit left photo: modification of work by Steve Jurvetson; credit
middle photo: modification of work by United States Geological Survey)
A close up of a piece of diamond shows a three dimensional sturcture of a complex network of well bonded carbon atoms. A
close up of a graphite shows several layers of carbon sheets. Each sheet is composed of a repeated and connected hexagonal
structure of carbon atoms. The third diagram shows that the distance between the center of atoms is 1.4 times 10 to the power
of negative 10 meters.
You may be less familiar with a recently discovered form of carbon: graphene. Graphene was first isolated in 2004 by using
tape to peel off thinner and thinner layers from graphite. It is essentially a single sheet (one atom thick) of graphite. Graphene,
illustrated in Figure 10.5.8, is not only strong and lightweight, but it is also an excellent conductor of electricity and heat.
Figure 10.5.8 : Graphene sheets can be formed into buckyballs, nanotubes, and stacked layers.
A sheet of interconnected hexagonal rings is shown at the top. Below it, a bukcyball is shown which is a sphere is composed of
hexagonal rings. In the lower middle image, a nanotube is shown that is made by rolling a graphene sheet into a tube. In the
lower right image, stacked sheets made up of four horizontal sheets composed of joined, hexagonal rings is shown.
Figure 10.5.9 : Types of crystal defects include vacancies, interstitial atoms, and substitutions impurities.
Glossary
amorphous solid
(also, noncrystalline solid) solid in which the particles lack an ordered internal structure
crystalline solid
solid in which the particles are arranged in a definite repeating pattern
interstitial sites
spaces between the regular particle positions in any array of atoms or ions
ionic solid
solid composed of positive and negative ions held together by strong electrostatic attractions
metallic solid
solid composed of metal atoms
molecular solid
solid composed of neutral molecules held together by intermolecular forces of attraction
vacancy
defect that occurs when a position that should contain an atom or ion is vacant
This page titled 10.5: The Solid State of Matter is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Over 90% of naturally occurring and man-made solids are crystalline. Most solids form with a regular arrangement of their
particles because the overall attractive interactions between particles are maximized, and the total intermolecular energy is
minimized, when the particles pack in the most efficient manner. The regular arrangement at an atomic level is often reflected at a
macroscopic level. In this module, we will explore some of the details about the structures of metallic and ionic crystalline solids,
and learn how these structures are determined experimentally.
Figure 10.6.1 : A unit cell shows the locations of lattice points repeating in all directions.
A diagram of two images is shown. In the first image, a cube with a sphere at each corner is shown. The cube is labeled “Unit cell”
and the spheres at the corners are labeled “Lattice points.” The second image shows the same cube, but this time it is one cube
amongst eight that make up a larger cube. The original cube is shaded a color while the other cubes are not.
Let us begin our investigation of crystal lattice structure and unit cells with the most straightforward structure and the most basic
unit cell. To visualize this, imagine taking a large number of identical spheres, such as tennis balls, and arranging them uniformly in
a container. The simplest way to do this would be to make layers in which the spheres in one layer are directly above those in the
layer below, as illustrated in Figure 10.6.2. This arrangement is called simple cubic structure, and the unit cell is called the simple
cubic unit cell or primitive cubic unit cell.
Figure 10.6.4 : A simple cubic lattice unit cell contains one-eighth of an atom at each of its eight corners, so it contains one atom
total.
A diagram of two images is shown. In the first image, eight spheres are stacked together to form a cube and dots at the center of
each sphere are connected to form a cube shape. The dots are labeled “Lattice points” while a label under the image reads “Simple
cubic lattice cell.” The second image shows the portion of each sphere that lie inside the cube. The corners of the cube are shown
with small circles labeled “Lattice points” and the phrase “8 corners” is written below the image.
Example 10.6.1: Calculating Atomic Radius and Density for Metals (Part 1)
The edge length of the unit cell of alpha polonium is 336 pm.
a. Determine the radius of a polonium atom.
b. Determine the density of alpha polonium.
Solution
Alpha polonium crystallizes in a simple cubic unit cell:
The density of polonium can be found by determining the density of its unit cell (the mass contained within a unit cell divided
by the volume of the unit cell). Since a Po unit cell contains one-eighth of a Po atom at each of its eight corners, a unit cell
contains one Po atom.
The mass of a Po unit cell can be found by:
1 Po atom 1 mol Po 208.998 g
−22
1 Po unit cell × × × = 3.47 × 10 g
23
1 Po unit cell 6.022 × 10 Po atoms 1 mol Po
(Note that the edge length was converted from pm to cm to get the usual volume units for density.)
Therefore, the density of
−22
3.471 × 10 g
3
Po = = 9.16 g/cm
−23
3.79 × 10 cm3
Exercise 10.6.1
The edge length of the unit cell for nickel is 0.3524 nm. The density of Ni is 8.90 g/cm3. Does nickel crystallize in a simple
cubic structure? Explain.
Answer
No. If Ni were simple cubic, its density would be given by:
1 mol Ni 58.693 g
−23
1 Ni atom × × = 9.746 × 10 g
23
6.022 × 10 Ni atoms 1 mol Ni
3 −8 3 −23 3
V =l = (3.524 × 10 cm) = 4.376 × 10 cm
Most metal crystals are one of the four major types of unit cells. For now, we will focus on the three cubic unit cells: simple cubic
(which we have already seen), body-centered cubic unit cell, and face-centered cubic unit cell—all of which are illustrated in
Figure 10.6.5. (Note that there are actually seven different lattice systems, some of which have more than one type of lattice, for a
total of 14 different types of unit cells. We leave the more complicated geometries for later in this module.)
Figure 10.6.5 : Cubic unit cells of metals show (in the upper figures) the locations of lattice points and (in the lower figures) metal
atoms located in the unit cell.
Three pairs of images are shown. The first three images are in a row and are labeled “Lattice point locations” while the second
three images are in a row labeled “Cubic unit cells.” The first image in the top row shows a cube with black dots at each corner
while the first image in the second row is composed of eight spheres that are stacked together to form a cube and dots at the center
of each sphere are connected to form a cube shape. The name under this image reads “Simple cubic.” The second image in the top
row shows a cube with black dots at each corner and a red dot in the center while the second image in the second row is composed
of eight spheres that are stacked together to form a cube with one sphere in the center of the cube and dots at the center of each
corner sphere connected to form a cube shape. The name under this image reads “Body-centered cubic.” The third image in the top
row shows a cube with black dots at each corner and red dots in the center of each face while the third image in the second row is
composed of eight spheres that are stacked together to form a cube with six more spheres located in the center of each face of the
cube. Dots at the center of each corner sphere are connected to form a cube shape. The name under this image reads “Face-centered
cubic.”
Some metals crystallize in an arrangement that has a cubic unit cell with atoms at all of the corners and an atom in the center, as
shown in Figure 10.6.6. This is called a body-centered cubic (BCC) solid. Atoms in the corners of a BCC unit cell do not contact
each other but contact the atom in the center. A BCC unit cell contains two atoms: one-eighth of an atom at each of the eight
1
corners (8 × =1 atom from the corners) plus one atom from the center. Any atom in this structure touches four atoms in the
8
layer above it and four atoms in the layer below it. Thus, an atom in a BCC structure has a coordination number of eight.
Figure 10.6.6 : In a body-centered cubic structure, atoms in a specific layer do not touch each other. Each atom touches four atoms
in the layer above it and four atoms in the layer below it.
Three images are shown. The first image shows a cube with black dots at each corner and a red dot in the center while the second
image is composed of eight spheres that are stacked together to form a cube with one sphere in the center of the cube and dots at
the center of each corner sphere connected to form a cube shape. The name under this image reads “Body-centered cubic
structure.” The third image is the same as the second, but only shows the portions of the spheres that lie inside the cube shape.
Figure 10.6.7 :A face-centered cubic solid has atoms at the corners and, as the name implies, at the centers of the faces of its unit
cells.
Three images are shown. The first image shows a cube with black dots at each corner and red dots in the center of each face of the
cube while the second image is composed of eight spheres that are stacked together to form a cube with six more spheres, one
located on each face of the structure. Dots at the center of each corner sphere are connected to form a cube shape. The name under
this image reads “Face-centered cubic structure.” The third image is the same as the second, but only shows the portions of the
spheres that lie inside the cube shape.
Atoms in an FCC arrangement are packed as closely together as possible, with atoms occupying 74% of the volume. This structure
is also called cubic closest packing (CCP). In CCP, there are three repeating layers of hexagonally arranged atoms. Each atom
contacts six atoms in its own layer, three in the layer above, and three in the layer below. In this arrangement, each atom touches 12
near neighbors, and therefore has a coordination number of 12. The fact that FCC and CCP arrangements are equivalent may not be
immediately obvious, but why they are actually the same structure is illustrated in Figure 10.6.8.
Figure 10.6.8 : A CCP arrangement consists of three repeating layers (ABCABC…) of hexagonally arranged atoms. Atoms in a
CCP structure have a coordination number of 12 because they contact six atoms in their layer, plus three atoms in the layer above
and three atoms in the layer below. By rotating our perspective, we can see that a CCP structure has a unit cell with a face
containing an atom from layer A at one corner, atoms from layer B across a diagonal (at two corners and in the middle of the face),
and an atom from layer C at the remaining corner. This is the same as a face-centered cubic arrangement.
Three images are shown. In the first image, a side view shows a layer of blue spheres, labeled “C” stacked on top of, and sitting in
between the gaps in a second layer that is composed of green spheres, labeled “B,” which are sitting atop a purple layer of spheres
labeled “A.” A label below this image reads “Side view.” The second image shows a top view of the same layers of spheres, where
the top layer is “C,” the second layer is “B” and the lowest layer is “C.” This image is labeled “Top view” and written under this is
the phrase “Cubic closest packed structure.” The third image shows an upper view of the side of a cube composed of two sets of the
repeating layers shown in the other images. The layers are arranged “C, B, A, C, B, A, C” and the phrase written under this image
reads “Rotated view.”
Because closer packing maximizes the overall attractions between atoms and minimizes the total intermolecular energy, the atoms
in most metals pack in this manner. We find two types of closest packing in simple metallic crystalline structures: CCP, which we
Figure 10.6.9 : In both types of closest packing, atoms are packed as compactly as possible. Hexagonal closest packing consists of
two alternating layers (ABABAB…). Cubic closest packing consists of three alternating layers (ABCABCABC…).
Two images are shown. The first image, labeled “Hexagonal closest packed,” shows seven green spheres arranged in a circular
sheet lying atop another sheet that is the same except the spheres are purple. The second sheet is offset just a bit so that the spheres
of the top sheet lie in the grooves of the second sheet. Two more alternating green and purple layers of spheres lie below the first
pair. The second image shows seven blue spheres, labeled “Layer C,” arranged in a circular sheet laying atop another sheet, labeled
“Layer B” that is the same except the spheres are green. The second sheet is offset just a bit so that the spheres of the top sheet lie
in the grooves of the second sheet. Two more alternating purple and then blue layers of spheres lie below the first pair. The purple
layer is labeled “Layer A” and the phrase written below this image reads “Cubic closest packed.”
Example 10.6.2: Calculating Atomic Radius and Density for Metals (Part 2)
Calcium crystallizes in a face-centered cubic structure. The edge length of its unit cell is 558.8 pm.
a. What is the atomic radius of Ca in this structure?
b. Calculate the density of Ca.
Solution
(a) In an FCC structure, Ca atoms contact each other across the diagonal of the face, so the length of the diagonal is equal to
four Ca atomic radii (d = 4r).
Two adjacent edges and the diagonal of the face form a right triangle, with the length of each side equal to 558.8 pm and the
length of the hypotenuse equal to four Ca atomic radii:
2 2 2
a +a =d
2 2 2
(558.8 pm) + (558.5 pm) = (4r)
mass
(b) Density is given by density = . The density of calcium can be found by determining the density of its unit cell:
volume
for example, the mass contained within a unit cell divided by the volume of the unit cell. A face-centered Ca unit cell has one-
1 1
eighth of an atom at each of the eight corners (8 × =1 atom) and one-half of an atom on each of the six faces 6× =3
8 2
atoms), for a total of four atoms in the unit cell.
The mass of the unit cell can be found by:
4 Ca atoms 1 mol Ca 40.078 g
−22
1 Ca unit cell × × × = 2.662 × 10 g
23
1 Ca unit cell 6.022 × 10 Ca atoms 1 mol Ca
(Note that the edge length was converted from pm to cm to get the usual volume units for density.)
Then, the density of polonium:
−22
2.662 × 10 g 3
Po = = 1.53 g/cm
−22 3
1.745 × 10 cm
Exercise 10.6.2
Silver crystallizes in an FCC structure. The edge length of its unit cell is 409 pm.
a. What is the atomic radius of Ag in this structure?
b. Calculate the density of Ag.
Answer a
144 pm
Answer b
10.5 g/cm3
In general, a unit cell is defined by the lengths of three axes (a, b, and c) and the angles (α, β, and γ) between them, as illustrated in
Figure 10.6.10. The axes are defined as being the lengths between points in the space lattice. Consequently, unit cell axes join
points with identical environments.
Figure 10.6.10: A unit cell is defined by the lengths of its three axes (a, b, and c) and the angles (α, β, and γ) between the axes.
A cube is shown where each corner has a black dot drawn on it. A circle in the bottom of the cube is composed of three double-
ended arrows. The left top of this circle is labeled “alpha,” the top right is labeled “beta” and the bottom is labeled “gamma.” The
bottom left corner of the cube is labeled “a” while the bottom of the back face is labeled “b” and the top, back, left corner is labeled
“c.”
Figure 10.6.11:There are seven different lattice systems and 14 different unit cells.
A table is composed of two columns and eight rows. The header row reads “System / Axes / Angles” and “Unit Cells .” The first
column reads “Cubic, a equals b equals c, alpha equals beta equals gamma equals 90 degrees,” “Tetragonal, a equals b does not
equal c, alpha equals beta equals gamma equals 90 degrees,” “Orthorhombic, a does not equal b does not equal c, alpha equals beta
equals gamma equals 90 degrees,” “Monoclinic, a does not equal b does not equal c, alpha equals gamma equals 90 degrees, beta
does not equal 90 degrees,” “Triclinic, a does not equal b does not equal c, alpha does not equal beta does not equal gamma does
not equal 90 degrees,” “Hexagonal, a equals b does not equal c, alpha equals beta equals 90 degrees, gamma equals 120 degrees,”
“Rhombohedral, a equals b equals c, alpha equals beta equals gamma does not equal 90 degrees.” The second column is composed
of diagrams. The first set of diagrams in the first cell show a cube with spheres at each corner labeled “Simple,” a cube with
spheres in each corner and on each face labeled “Face-centered” and a cube with spheres in each corner and one in the center
labeled “Body-centered.” The second set of diagrams in the second cell show a vertical rectangle with spheres at each corner
labeled “Simple” and a vertical rectangle with spheres in each corner and one in the center labeled “Body-centered.” The third set
of diagrams in the third cell show a vertical rectangle with spheres at each corner labeled “Simple,” a vertical rectangle with
spheres in each corner and one in the center labeled “Body-centered,” a vertical rectangle with spheres in each corner and one on
the top and bottom faces labeled “Base-centered,” and a vertical rectangle with spheres in each corner and one on each face labeled
“Face-centered.” The fourth set of diagrams in the fourth cell show a vertical rectangle with spheres at each corner that is slanted to
one side labeled “Simple” and a vertical rectangle with spheres in each corner that is slanted to one side and has two spheres in the
center is labeled “Body-centered.” The fifth diagrams in the fifth cell show a cube that is slanted with spheres at each corner while
the sixth diagram in the sixth cell shows a pair of hexagonal rings that are connected together to form a six-sided shape with
spheres at each corner. The seventh diagram in the seventh cell shows a rectangle that is slanted with spheres at each corner.
Figure 10.6.12: Cations may occupy two types of holes between anions: octahedral holes or tetrahedral holes.
An image shows a top-view of a layer of blue spheres arranged in a sheet lying atop another sheet that is the same except the
spheres are green. The second sheet is offset just a bit so that the spheres of the top sheet lie in the grooves of the second sheet. A
third sheet composed of purple spheres lies at the bottom. The spaces created between the spheres in each layer are labeled
“Octahedral holes” and “Tetrahedral holes.”
Depending on the relative sizes of the cations and anions, the cations of an ionic compound may occupy tetrahedral or octahedral
holes, as illustrated in Figure 10.6.13. Relatively small cations occupy tetrahedral holes, and larger cations occupy octahedral
holes. If the cations are too large to fit into the octahedral holes, the anions may adopt a more open structure, such as a simple cubic
array. The larger cations can then occupy the larger cubic holes made possible by the more open spacing.
Figure 10.6.13:A cation’s size and the shape of the hole occupied by the compound are directly related.
A diagram of three images is shown. In the first image, eight stacked cubes, with purple spheres at each corner, that make up one
large cube are shown. The bottom left cube is different. It has green spheres at each corner and has four orange and six light purple
spheres located on the faces of the cube. Labels below this structure read “Tetrahedral hole” and “Cation radius is about 22.5 to
41.4 percent of the anion radius. In the second image, eight stacked cubes, with alternating orange and green spheres at each corner,
make up one large cube that is shown. The bottom left cube has darker lines that connect the spheres together. Labels below this
structure read “Octahedral hole” and “Cation radius is about 41.4 to 73.2 percent of the anion radius. In the third image, eight
stacked cubes, with purple spheres at each corner and light purple spheres on their interior faces, make up one large cube that is
shown. Labels below this structure read “Cubic hole” and “Cation radius is about 73.2 to 100 percent of the anion radius.”
Zinc sulfide is an important industrial source of zinc and is also used as a white pigment in paint. Zinc sulfide crystallizes with
zinc ions occupying one-half of the tetrahedral holes in a closest-packed array of sulfide ions. What is the formula of zinc
sulfide?
Solution
Because there are two tetrahedral holes per anion (sulfide ion) and one-half of these holes are occupied by zinc ions, there must
1
be ×2 , or 1, zinc ion per sulfide ion. Thus, the formula is ZnS.
2
Answer
Li Se
2
The ratio of octahedral holes to anions in either an HCP or CCP structure is 1:1. Thus, compounds with cations in octahedral holes
in a closest-packed array of anions can have a maximum cation:anion ratio of 1:1. In NiO, MnS, NaCl, and KH, for example, all of
the octahedral holes are filled. Ratios of less than 1:1 are observed when some of the octahedral holes remain empty.
Aluminum oxide crystallizes with aluminum ions in two-thirds of the octahedral holes in a closest-packed array of oxide ions.
What is the formula of aluminum oxide?
Solution
Because there is one octahedral hole per anion (oxide ion) and only two-thirds of these holes are occupied, the ratio of
2
aluminum to oxygen must be :1, which would give Al 2/3 O . The simplest whole number ratio is 2:3, so the formula is Al2O3.
3
Exercise 10.6.4
The white pigment titanium oxide crystallizes with titanium ions in one-half of the octahedral holes in a closest-packed array
of oxide ions. What is the formula of titanium oxide?
Answer
TiO
2
In a simple cubic array of anions, there is one cubic hole that can be occupied by a cation for each anion in the array. In CsCl, and
in other compounds with the same structure, all of the cubic holes are occupied. Half of the cubic holes are occupied in SrH2, UO2,
SrCl2, and CaF2.
Figure 10.6.14: Ionic compounds with similar-sized cations and anions, such as CsCl, usually form a simple cubic structure. They
can be described by unit cells with either cations at the corners or anions at the corners.
Three images are shown. The first image shows a cube with black dots at each corner and a red dot in the center. This cube is
stacked with seven others that are not colored to form a larger cube. The second image is composed of eight spheres that are
grouped together to form a cube with one smaller sphere in the center. The name under this image reads “Body-centered simple
cubic structure.” The third image shows five horizontal layers of purple spheres with layers of smaller green spheres in between.
We have said that the location of lattice points is arbitrary. This is illustrated by an alternate description of the CsCl structure in
which the lattice points are located in the centers of the cesium ions. In this description, the cesium ions are located on the lattice
points at the corners of the cell, and the chloride ion is located at the center of the cell. The two unit cells are different, but they
describe identical structures.
When an ionic compound is composed of a 1:1 ratio of cations and anions that differ significantly in size, it typically crystallizes
with an FCC unit cell, like that shown in Figure 10.6.15. Sodium chloride, NaCl, is an example of this, with Na+ and Cl− having
radii of 102 pm and 181 pm, respectively. We can think of this as chloride ions forming an FCC cell, with sodium ions located in
the octahedral holes in the middle of the cell edges and in the center of the cell. The sodium and chloride ions touch each other
along the cell edges. The unit cell contains four sodium ions and four chloride ions, giving the 1:1 stoichiometry required by the
formula, NaCl.
Figure 10.6.16: ZnS, zinc sulfide (or zinc blende) forms an FCC unit cell with sulfide ions at the lattice points and much smaller
zinc ions occupying half of the tetrahedral holes in the structure.
Two images are shown. The first image shows a cube with black dots at each corner and a red dot in the center of each face of the
cube. This cube is stacked with seven others that are not colored to form a larger cube. The second image is composed of eight
spheres that form the corners of a cube with six other spheres located in the face of the cube. The spheres are connected to one
another by lines. The name under this image reads “Z n S, face-centered unit cell.”
A calcium fluoride unit cell, like that shown in Figure 10.6.17, is also an FCC unit cell, but in this case, the cations are located on
the lattice points; equivalent calcium ions are located on the lattice points of an FCC lattice. All of the tetrahedral sites in the FCC
array of calcium ions are occupied by fluoride ions. There are four calcium ions and eight fluoride ions in a unit cell, giving a
calcium:fluorine ratio of 1:2, as required by the chemical formula, CaF2. Close examination of Figure 10.6.17 will reveal a simple
cubic array of fluoride ions with calcium ions in one half of the cubic holes. The structure cannot be described in terms of a space
lattice of points on the fluoride ions because the fluoride ions do not all have identical environments. The orientation of the four
calcium ions about the fluoride ions differs.
The edge length of the unit cell of LiCl (NaCl-like structure, FCC) is 0.514 nm or 5.14 Å. Assuming that the lithium ion is
small enough so that the chloride ions are in contact, calculate the ionic radius for the chloride ion. Note: The length unit
angstrom, Å, is often used to represent atomic-scale dimensions and is equivalent to 10−10 m.
Solution
On the face of a LiCl unit cell, chloride ions contact each other across the diagonal of the face:
Drawing a right triangle on the face of the unit cell, we see that the length of the diagonal is equal to four chloride radii (one
radius from each corner chloride and one diameter—which equals two radii—from the chloride ion in the center of the face),
so d = 4r . From the Pythagorean theorem, we have:
2 2 2
a +a =d
which yields:
2 2 2 2
(0.514 nm) + (0.514 nm) = (4r) = 16 r
Answer
The radius of the potassium ion is 1.33 Å.
It is important to realize that values for ionic radii calculated from the edge lengths of unit cells depend on numerous assumptions,
such as a perfect spherical shape for ions, which are approximations at best. Hence, such calculated values are themselves
approximate and comparisons cannot be pushed too far. Nevertheless, this method has proved useful for calculating ionic radii from
experimental measurements such as X-ray crystallographic determinations.
Figure 10.6.18: Light waves occupying the same space experience interference, combining to yield waves of greater (a) or lesser
(b) intensity, depending upon the separation of their maxima and minima.
A pair of images is shown that has four sections. In the first section, two sinusoidal waves are shown, one drawn above the other,
and a section from the top of one curve to the top of the next curve is labeled “lambda.” The curves align with one another. The
phrase below this reads “Constructive interference.” A right facing arrow leads from the first section to the second, which shows
one larger sinusoidal curve that has higher and lower peaks and troughs. A section from the top of one curve to the top of the next
curve is labeled “lambda” and the phrase below this reads “Maxima and minima reinforce.” In the second section, two sinusoidal
waves are shown, one drawn above the other, and a section from the top of one curve to the top of the next curve is labeled
“lambda.” The curves do not align with one another. The phrase below this reads “Destructive interference.” A right facing arrow
leads from the first section to the second, which shows one flat line. The phrase below this reads “Maxima and minima cancel.”
When X-rays of a certain wavelength, λ, are scattered by atoms in adjacent crystal planes separated by a distance, d, they may
undergo constructive interference when the difference between the distances traveled by the two waves prior to their combination is
an integer factor, n, of the wavelength. This condition is satisfied when the angle of the diffracted beam, θ, is related to the
wavelength and interatomic distance by the equation:
nλ = 2d sin θ (10.6.1)
This relation is known as the Bragg equation in honor of W. H. Bragg, the English physicist who first explained this phenomenon.
Figure 10.6.18 illustrates two examples of diffracted waves from the same two crystal planes. The figure on the left depicts waves
diffracted at the Bragg angle, resulting in constructive interference, while that on the right shows diffraction and a different angle
that does not satisfy the Bragg condition, resulting in destructive interference.
An X-ray diffractometer, such as the one illustrated in Figure 10.6.20, may be used to measure the angles at which X-rays are
diffracted when interacting with a crystal as described earlier. From such measurements, the Bragg equation may be used to
compute distances between atoms as demonstrated in the following example exercise.
Figure 10.6.20: (a) In a diffractometer, a beam of X-rays strikes a crystalline material, producing (b) an X-ray diffraction pattern
that can be analyzed to determine the crystal structure.
A diagram, labeled “a” shows a cube on the left with a channel bored into its right side labeled “X dash ray source.” A beam is
leaving from this channel and traveling in a horizontal line toward an oval-shaped, short tube, labeled “Collimator to focus beam”
and “X dash ray diffraction,” where it passes through a cube labeled “Crystalline material” and scatters onto a vertical sheet labeled
“Imaging surface.” A second diagram, labeled “b,” shows a square sheet with a large dot in the center labeled “X dash ray beam,”
that is surrounded by smaller dots arranged in rings and labeled “Diffracted X dash rays.”
Solution
The distance between the planes is found by solving the Bragg equation (Equation 10.6.1) for d.
This gives
nλ 1(0.1315 nm)
d = = = 0.154 nm
2 sin θ 2 sin(25.25°)
Exercise 10.6.6
A crystal with spacing between planes equal to 0.394 nm diffracts X-rays with a wavelength of 0.147 nm. What is the angle for
the first order diffraction?
Answer
21.9°
Glossary
body-centered cubic (BCC) solid
crystalline structure that has a cubic unit cell with lattice points at the corners and in the center of the cell
Bragg equation
equation that relates the angles at which X-rays are diffracted by the atoms within a crystal
coordination number
number of atoms closest to any given atom in a crystal or to the central metal atom in a complex
diffraction
redirection of electromagnetic radiation that occurs when it encounters a physical barrier of appropriate dimensions
hole
(also, interstice) space between atoms within a crystal
isomorphous
possessing the same crystalline structure
octahedral hole
open space in a crystal at the center of six particles located at the corners of an octahedron
space lattice
all points within a crystal that have identical environments
tetrahedral hole
tetrahedral space formed by four atoms or ions in a crystal
unit cell
smallest portion of a space lattice that is repeated in three dimensions to form the entire lattice
X-ray crystallography
experimental technique for determining distances between atoms in a crystal by measuring the angles at which X-rays are
diffracted when passing through the crystal
Paul Flowers (University of North Carolina - Pembroke), Klaus Theopold (University of Delaware) and Richard Langley (Stephen
F. Austin State University) with contributing authors. Textbook content produced by OpenStax College is licensed under a Creative
Commons Attribution License 4.0 license. Download for free at http://cnx.org/contents/85abf193-2bd...a7ac8df6@9.110).
This page titled 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
10.E.1.2: S10.1.1
Liquids and solids are similar in that they are matter composed of atoms, ions, or molecules. They are incompressible and have
similar densities that are both much larger than those of gases. They are different in that liquids have no fixed shape, and solids are
rigid.
10.E.1.3: Q10.1.2
In terms of the kinetic molecular theory, in what ways are liquids similar to solids? In what ways are liquids different from solids?
10.E.1.4: Q10.1.3
In terms of the kinetic molecular theory, in what ways are liquids similar to gases? In what ways are liquids different from gases?
10.E.1.5: S10.1.3
They are similar in that the atoms or molecules are free to move from one position to another. They differ in that the particles of a
liquid are confined to the shape of the vessel in which they are placed. In contrast, a gas will expand without limit to fill the space
into which it is placed.
10.E.1.6: Q10.1.4
Explain why liquids assume the shape of any container into which they are poured, whereas solids are rigid and retain their shape.
10.E.1.7: Q10.1.5
What is the evidence that all neutral atoms and molecules exert attractive forces on each other?
10.E.1.8: S10.1.5
All atoms and molecules will condense into a liquid or solid in which the attractive forces exceed the kinetic energy of the
molecules, at sufficiently low temperature.
10.E.1.9: Q10.1.6
Open the PhET States of Matter Simulation to answer the following questions:
a. Select the Solid, Liquid, Gas tab. Explore by selecting different substances, heating and cooling the systems, and changing the
state. What similarities do you notice between the four substances for each phase (solid, liquid, gas)? What differences do you
notice?
b. For each substance, select each of the states and record the given temperatures. How do the given temperatures for each state
correlate with the strengths of their intermolecular attractions? Explain.
c. Select the Interaction Potential tab, and use the default neon atoms. Move the Ne atom on the right and observe how the
potential energy changes. Select the Total Force button, and move the Ne atom as before. When is the total force on each atom
attractive and large enough to matter? Then select the Component Forces button, and move the Ne atom. When do the attractive
(van der Waals) and repulsive (electron overlap) forces balance? How does this relate to the potential energy versus the distance
between atoms graph? Explain.
10.E.1.10: Q10.1.7
Define the following and give an example of each:
a. dispersion force
b. dipole-dipole attraction
c. hydrogen bond
10.E.1.12: Q10.1.8
The types of intermolecular forces in a substance are identical whether it is a solid, a liquid, or a gas. Why then does a substance
change phase from a gas to a liquid or to a solid?
10.E.1.13: Q10.1.9
Why do the boiling points of the noble gases increase in the order He < Ne < Ar < Kr < Xe?
10.E.1.14: S10.1.9
The London forces typically increase as the number of electrons increase.
10.E.1.15: Q10.1.10
Neon and HF have approximately the same molecular masses.
a. Explain why the boiling points of Neon and HF differ.
b. Compare the change in the boiling points of Ne, Ar, Kr, and Xe with the change of the boiling points of HF, HCl, HBr, and HI,
and explain the difference between the changes with increasing atomic or molecular mass.
10.E.1.16: Q10.1.11
Arrange each of the following sets of compounds in order of increasing boiling point temperature:
a. HCl, H2O, SiH4
b. F2, Cl2, Br2
c. CH4, C2H6, C3H8
d. O2, NO, N2
10.E.1.17: S10.1.11
(a) SiH4 < HCl < H2O; (b) F2 < Cl2 < Br2; (c) CH4 < C2H6 < C3H8; (d) N2 < O2 < NO
10.E.1.18: Q10.1.12
The molecular mass of butanol, C4H9OH, is 74.14; that of ethylene glycol, CH2(OH)CH2OH, is 62.08, yet their boiling points are
117.2 °C and 174 °C, respectively. Explain the reason for the difference.
10.E.1.19: Q10.1.13
On the basis of intermolecular attractions, explain the differences in the boiling points of n–butane (−1 °C) and chloroethane (12
°C), which have similar molar masses.
10.E.1.20: S10.1.13
Only rather small dipole-dipole interactions from C-H bonds are available to hold n-butane in the liquid state. Chloroethane,
however, has rather large dipole interactions because of the Cl-C bond; the interaction is therefore stronger, leading to a higher
boiling point.
10.E.1.22: Q10.1.15
The melting point of H2O(s) is 0 °C. Would you expect the melting point of H2S(s) to be −85 °C, 0 °C, or 185 °C? Explain your
answer.
10.E.1.23: S10.1.15
−85 °C. Water has stronger hydrogen bonds so it melts at a higher temperature.
10.E.1.24: Q10.1.16
Silane (SiH4), phosphine (PH3), and hydrogen sulfide (H2S) melt at −185 °C, −133 °C, and −85 °C, respectively. What does this
suggest about the polar character and intermolecular attractions of the three compounds?
10.E.1.25: Q10.1.17
Explain why a hydrogen bond between two water molecules is weaker than a hydrogen bond between two hydrogen fluoride
molecules.
10.E.1.26: S10.1.17
The hydrogen bond between two hydrogen fluoride molecules is stronger than that between two water molecules because the
electronegativity of F is greater than that of O. Consequently, the partial negative charge on F is greater than that on O. The
hydrogen bond between the partially positive H and the larger partially negative F will be stronger than that formed between H and
O.
10.E.1.27: Q10.1.18
Under certain conditions, molecules of acetic acid, CH3COOH, form “dimers,” pairs of acetic acid molecules held together by
strong intermolecular attractions:
Draw a dimer of acetic acid, showing how two CH3COOH molecules are held together, and stating the type of IMF that is
responsible.
10.E.1.28: Q10.1.19
Proteins are chains of amino acids that can form in a variety of arrangements, one of which is a helix. What kind of IMF is
responsible for holding the protein strand in this shape? On the protein image, show the locations of the IMFs that hold the protein
together:
10.E.1.29: S10.1.19
H-bonding is the principle IMF holding the DNA strands together. The H-bonding is between the N − H and C = O .
10.E.1.30: Q10.1.20
The density of liquid NH3 is 0.64 g/mL; the density of gaseous NH3 at STP is 0.0007 g/mL. Explain the difference between the
densities of these two phases.
10.E.1.32: S10.1.21
(a) hydrogen bonding and dispersion forces; (b) dispersion forces; (c) dipole-dipole attraction and dispersion forces
10.E.2.2: Q10.2.2
Although steel is denser than water, a steel needle or paper clip placed carefully lengthwise on the surface of still water can be
made to float. Explain at a molecular level how this is possible:
10.E.2.3: S10.2.2
The water molecules have strong intermolecular forces of hydrogen bonding. The water molecules are thus attracted strongly to
one another and exhibit a relatively large surface tension, forming a type of “skin” at its surface. This skin can support a bug or
paper clip if gently placed on the water.
10.E.2.4: Q10.2.3
The surface tension and viscosity values for diethyl ether, acetone, ethanol, and ethylene glycol are shown here.
10.E.2.5: Q10.2.4
You may have heard someone use the figure of speech “slower than molasses in winter” to describe a process that occurs slowly.
Explain why this is an apt idiom, using concepts of molecular size and shape, molecular interactions, and the effect of changing
temperature.
10.E.2.6: S10.2.4
Temperature has an effect on intermolecular forces: the higher the temperature, the greater the kinetic energies of the molecules and
the greater the extent to which their intermolecular forces are overcome, and so the more fluid (less viscous) the liquid; the lower
the temperature, the lesser the intermolecular forces are overcome, and so the less viscous the liquid.
10.E.2.7: Q10.2.5
It is often recommended that you let your car engine run idle to warm up before driving, especially on cold winter days. While the
benefit of prolonged idling is dubious, it is certainly true that a warm engine is more fuel efficient than a cold one. Explain the
reason for this.
10.E.2.8: Q10.2.6
The surface tension and viscosity of water at several different temperatures are given in this table.
0 °C 75.6 1.79
20 °C 72.8 1.00
60 °C 66.2 0.47
a. As temperature increases, what happens to the surface tension of water? Explain why this occurs, in terms of molecular
interactions and the effect of changing temperature.
b. As temperature increases, what happens to the viscosity of water? Explain why this occurs, in terms of molecular interactions
and the effect of changing temperature.
10.E.2.9: S10.2.6
(a) As the water reaches higher temperatures, the increased kinetic energies of its molecules are more effective in overcoming
hydrogen bonding, and so its surface tension decreases. Surface tension and intermolecular forces are directly related. (b) The same
trend in viscosity is seen as in surface tension, and for the same reason.
10.E.2.10: Q10.2.7
At 25 °C, how high will water rise in a glass capillary tube with an inner diameter of 0.63 mm? Refer to Example for the required
information.
10.E.2.12: S10.2.8
9.5 × 10−5 m
10.E.3.2: Q10.3.2
Heat is added to ice at 0 °C. Explain why the temperature of the ice does not change. What does change?
10.E.3.3: S10.3.2
The heat is absorbed by the ice, providing the energy required to partially overcome intermolecular attractive forces in the solid and
causing a phase transition to liquid water. The solution remains at 0 °C until all the ice is melted. Only the amount of water existing
as ice changes until the ice disappears. Then the temperature of the water can rise.
10.E.3.4: Q10.3.3
What feature characterizes the dynamic equilibrium between a liquid and its vapor in a closed container?
10.E.3.5: Q10.3.4
Identify two common observations indicating some liquids have sufficient vapor pressures to noticeably evaporate?
10.E.3.6: S10.3.4
We can see the amount of liquid in an open container decrease and we can smell the vapor of some liquids.
10.E.3.7: Q10.3.5
Identify two common observations indicating some solids, such as dry ice and mothballs, have vapor pressures sufficient to
sublime?
10.E.3.8: Q10.3.6
What is the relationship between the intermolecular forces in a liquid and its vapor pressure?
10.E.3.9: S10.3.7
The vapor pressure of a liquid decreases as the strength of its intermolecular forces increases.
10.E.3.10: Q10.3.7
What is the relationship between the intermolecular forces in a solid and its melting temperature?
10.E.3.11: Q10.3.8
Why does spilled gasoline evaporate more rapidly on a hot day than on a cold day?
10.E.3.12: S10.3.8
As the temperature increases, the average kinetic energy of the molecules of gasoline increases and so a greater fraction of
molecules have sufficient energy to escape from the liquid than at lower temperatures.
10.E.3.13: Q10.3.9
Carbon tetrachloride, CCl4, was once used as a dry cleaning solvent, but is no longer used because it is carcinogenic. At 57.8 °C,
the vapor pressure of CCl4 is 54.0 kPa, and its enthalpy of vaporization is 33.05 kJ/mol. Use this information to estimate the normal
boiling point for CCl4.
10.E.3.15: S10.3.10
When the pressure of gas above the liquid is exactly 1 atm
10.E.3.16: Q10.3.11
How does the boiling of a liquid differ from its evaporation?
10.E.3.17: Q10.3.12
Use the information in Figure to estimate the boiling point of water in Denver when the atmospheric pressure is 83.3 kPa.
10.E.3.18: S10.3.12
approximately 95 °C
10.E.3.19: Q10.3.13
A syringe at a temperature of 20 °C is filled with liquid ether in such a way that there is no space for any vapor. If the temperature
is kept constant and the plunger is withdrawn to create a volume that can be occupied by vapor, what would be the approximate
pressure of the vapor produced?
10.E.3.20: Q10.3.14
Explain the following observations:
a. It takes longer to cook an egg in Ft. Davis, Texas (altitude, 5000 feet above sea level) than it does in Boston (at sea level).
b. Perspiring is a mechanism for cooling the body.
10.E.3.21: S10.3.14
(a) At 5000 feet, the atmospheric pressure is lower than at sea level, and water will therefore boil at a lower temperature. This
lower temperature will cause the physical and chemical changes involved in cooking the egg to proceed more slowly, and a longer
time is required to fully cook the egg. (b) As long as the air surrounding the body contains less water vapor than the maximum that
air can hold at that temperature, perspiration will evaporate, thereby cooling the body by removing the heat of vaporization
required to vaporize the water.
10.E.3.22: Q10.3.15
The enthalpy of vaporization of water is larger than its enthalpy of fusion. Explain why.
10.E.3.23: Q10.3.16
Explain why the molar enthalpies of vaporization of the following substances increase in the order CH4 < C2H6 < C3H8, even
though all three substances experience the same dispersion forces when in the liquid state.
10.E.3.24: S10.3.16
Dispersion forces increase with molecular mass or size. As the number of atoms composing the molecules in this homologous
series increases, so does the extent of intermolecular attraction via dispersion forces and, consequently, the energy required to
overcome these forces and vaporize the liquids.
10.E.3.25: Q10.3.17
Explain why the enthalpies of vaporization of the following substances increase in the order CH4 < NH3 < H2O, even though all
three substances have approximately the same molar mass.
10.E.3.26: Q10.3.18
The enthalpy of vaporization of CO2(l) is 9.8 kJ/mol. Would you expect the enthalpy of vaporization of CS2(l) to be 28 kJ/mol, 9.8
kJ/mol, or −8.4 kJ/mol? Discuss the plausibility of each of these answers.
10.E.3.28: Q10.3.19
The hydrogen fluoride molecule, HF, is more polar than a water molecule, H2O (for example, has a greater dipole moment), yet the
molar enthalpy of vaporization for liquid hydrogen fluoride is lesser than that for water. Explain.
10.E.3.29: Q10.3.20
Ethyl chloride (boiling point, 13 °C) is used as a local anesthetic. When the liquid is sprayed on the skin, it cools the skin enough to
freeze and numb it. Explain the cooling effect of liquid ethyl chloride.
10.E.3.30: S10.3.20
The thermal energy (heat) needed to evaporate the liquid is removed from the skin.
10.E.3.31: Q10.3.21
Which contains the compounds listed correctly in order of increasing boiling points?
a. N2 < CS2 < H2O < KCl
b. H2O < N2 < CS2 < KCl
c. N2 < KCl < CS2 < H2O
d. CS2 < N2 < KCl < H2O
e. KCl < H2O < CS2 < N2
10.E.3.32: Q10.3.22
How much heat is required to convert 422 g of liquid H2O at 23.5 °C into steam at 150 °C?
10.E.3.33: S10.3.22
1130 kJ
10.E.3.34: Q10.3.22
Evaporation of sweat requires energy and thus take excess heat away from the body. Some of the water that you drink may
eventually be converted into sweat and evaporate. If you drink a 20-ounce bottle of water that had been in the refrigerator at 3.8 °C,
how much heat is needed to convert all of that water into sweat and then to vapor?? (Note: Your body temperature is 36.6 °C. For
the purpose of solving this problem, assume that the thermal properties of sweat are the same as for water.)
10.E.3.35: Q10.3.24
Titanium tetrachloride, TiCl4, has a melting point of −23.2 °C and has a ΔH fusion = 9.37 kJ/mol.
a. How much energy is required to melt 263.1 g TiCl4?
b. For TiCl4, which will likely have the larger magnitude: ΔH fusion or ΔH vaporization? Explain your reasoning.
10.E.3.36: S10.3.24
(a) 13.0 kJ; (b) It is likely that the heat of vaporization will have a larger magnitude since in the case of vaporization the
intermolecular interactions have to be completely overcome, while melting weakens or destroys only some of them.
10.E.4.2: Q10.4.2
What phase changes will take place when water is subjected to varying pressure at a constant temperature of 0.005 °C? At 40 °C?
At −40 °C?
10.E.4.3: S10.4.2
At low pressures and 0.005 °C, the water is a gas. As the pressure increases to 4.6 torr, the water becomes a solid; as the pressure
increases still more, it becomes a liquid. At 40 °C, water at low pressure is a vapor; at pressures higher than about 75 torr, it
converts into a liquid. At −40 °C, water goes from a gas to a solid as the pressure increases above very low values.
10.E.4.4: Q10.4.3
Pressure cookers allow food to cook faster because the higher pressure inside the pressure cooker increases the boiling temperature
of water. A particular pressure cooker has a safety valve that is set to vent steam if the pressure exceeds 3.4 atm. What is the
approximate maximum temperature that can be reached inside this pressure cooker? Explain your reasoning.
10.E.4.5: Q10.4.4
From the phase diagram for carbon dioxide, determine the state of CO2 at:
a. 20 °C and 1000 kPa
b. 10 °C and 2000 kPa
c. 10 °C and 100 kPa
d. −40 °C and 500 kPa
e. −80 °C and 1500 kPa
f. −80 °C and 10 kPa
The pressure and temperature axes on this phase diagram of carbon dioxide are not drawn to constant scale in order to illustrate
several important properties.
10.E.4.7: Q10.4.5
Determine the phase changes that carbon dioxide undergoes as the pressure changes if the temperature is held at −50 °C? If the
temperature is held at −40 °C? At 20 °C?
The pressure and temperature axes on this phase diagram of carbon dioxide are not drawn to constant scale in order to illustrate
several important properties.
10.E.4.8: Q10.4.6
Consider a cylinder containing a mixture of liquid carbon dioxide in equilibrium with gaseous carbon dioxide at an initial pressure
of 65 atm and a temperature of 20 °C. Sketch a plot depicting the change in the cylinder pressure with time as gaseous carbon
dioxide is released at constant temperature.
10.E.4.9: S10.4.6
10.E.4.10: Q10.4.7
Dry ice, CO2(s), does not melt at atmospheric pressure. It sublimes at a temperature of −78 °C. What is the lowest pressure at
which CO2(s) will melt to give CO2(l)? At approximately what temperature will this occur? (See Figure for the phase diagram.)
10.E.4.12: Q10.4.8
If a severe storm results in the loss of electricity, it may be necessary to use a clothesline to dry laundry. In many parts of the
country in the dead of winter, the clothes will quickly freeze when they are hung on the line. If it does not snow, will they dry
anyway? Explain your answer.
10.E.4.13: S10.4.8
Yes, ice will sublime, although it may take it several days. Ice has a small vapor pressure, and some ice molecules form gas and
escape from the ice crystals. As time passes, more and more solid converts to gas until eventually the clothes are dry.
10.E.4.14: Q10.4.9
Is it possible to liquefy nitrogen at room temperature (about 25 °C)? Is it possible to liquefy sulfur dioxide at room temperature?
Explain your answers.
10.E.4.15: Q10.4.10
Elemental carbon has one gas phase, one liquid phase, and three different solid phases, as shown in the phase diagram:
10.E.5.2: S10.5.1
Amorphous solids lack an ordered internal structure. Liquid materials that contain large, cumbersome molecules that cannot move
readily into ordered positions generally form such solids.
10.E.5.4: S10.5.3
(e) molecular crystals
10.E.5.5: Q10.5.4
As it cools, olive oil slowly solidifies and forms a solid over a range of temperatures. Which best describes the solid?
a. ionic
b. covalent network
c. metallic
d. amorphous
e. molecular crystals
10.E.5.6: S10.5.4
(d) amorphous
10.E.5.7: Q10.5.5
Explain why ice, which is a crystalline solid, has a melting temperature of 0 °C, whereas butter, which is an amorphous solid,
softens over a range of temperatures.
10.E.5.8: S10.5.6
Ice has a crystalline structure stabilized by hydrogen bonding. These intermolecular forces are of comparable strength and thus
require the same amount of energy to overcome. As a result, ice melts at a single temperature and not over a range of temperatures.
The various, very large molecules that compose butter experience varied van der Waals attractions of various strengths that are
overcome at various temperatures, and so the melting process occurs over a wide temperature range.
10.E.5.9: Q10.5.7
Identify the type of crystalline solid (metallic, network covalent, ionic, or molecular) formed by each of the following substances:
a. SiO2
b. KCl
c. Cu
d. CO2
e. C (diamond)
f. BaSO4
g. NH3
h. NH4F
i. C2H5OH
10.E.5.10: S10.5.7
(a) SiO2, covalent network; (b) KCl, ionic; (c) Cu, metallic; (d) CO, molecular; (e) C (diamond), covalent network; (f) BaSO4,
ionic; (g) NH3, molecular; (h) NH4F, ionic; (i) C2H5OH, molecular
10.E.5.11: Q10.5.8
Identify the type of crystalline solid (metallic, network covalent, ionic, or molecular) formed by each of the following substances:
a. CaCl2
b. SiC
10.E.5.12: S10.5.8
(a) CaCl2, ionic; (b) SiC, covalent network; (c) N2, molecular; (d) Fe, metallic; (e) C (graphite), covalent network; (f)
CH3CH2CH2CH3, molecular; (g) HCl, molecular; (h) NH4NO3, ionic; (i) K3PO4, ionic
10.E.5.13: Q10.5.9
Classify each substance in the table as either a metallic, ionic, molecular, or covalent network solid:
10.E.5.14: S10.5.9
X = metallic; Y = covalent network; Z = ionic
10.E.5.15: Q10.5.10
Classify each substance in the table as either a metallic, ionic, molecular, or covalent network solid:
10.E.5.16: S10.5.10
X = ionic; Y = metallic; Z = covalent network
10.E.5.17: Q10.5.11
Identify the following substances as ionic, metallic, covalent network, or molecular solids:
Substance A is malleable, ductile, conducts electricity well, and has a melting point of 1135 °C. Substance B is brittle, does not
conduct electricity as a solid but does when molten, and has a melting point of 2072 °C. Substance C is very hard, does not conduct
electricity, and has a melting point of 3440 °C. Substance D is soft, does not conduct electricity, and has a melting point of 185 °C.
10.E.5.18: S10.5.11
A = metallic; B = ionic; C = covalent network; D = molecular
10.E.5.19: Q10.5.12
Substance A is shiny, conducts electricity well, and melts at 975 °C. Substance A is likely a(n):
a. ionic solid
b. metallic solid
c. molecular solid
d. covalent network solid
10.E.5.21: Q10.5.13
Substance B is hard, does not conduct electricity, and melts at 1200 °C. Substance B is likely a(n):
a. ionic solid
b. metallic solid
c. molecular solid
d. covalent network solid
10.E.5.22: S10.5.13
(d) covalent network solid
10.E.6.2: S10.6.1
The structure of this low-temperature form of iron (below 910 °C) is body-centered cubic. There is one-eighth atom at each of the
eight corners of the cube and one atom in the center of the cube.
10.E.6.3: Q10.6.2
Describe the crystal structure of Pt, which crystallizes with four equivalent metal atoms in a cubic unit cell.
10.E.6.4: Q10.6.3
What is the coordination number of a chromium atom in the body-centered cubic structure of chromium?
10.E.6.5: S10.6.3
eight
10.E.6.6: Q10.6.4
What is the coordination number of an aluminum atom in the face-centered cubic structure of aluminum?
10.E.6.7: Q10.6.5
Cobalt metal crystallizes in a hexagonal closest packed structure. What is the coordination number of a cobalt atom?
10.E.6.8: S10.6.5
12
10.E.6.9: Q10.6.6
Nickel metal crystallizes in a cubic closest packed structure. What is the coordination number of a nickel atom?
10.E.6.10: Q10.6.7
Tungsten crystallizes in a body-centered cubic unit cell with an edge length of 3.165 Å.
a. What is the atomic radius of tungsten in this structure?
b. Calculate the density of tungsten.
10.E.6.11: S10.6.7
(a) 1.370 Å; (b) 19.26 g/cm
10.E.6.13: Q10.6.9
Barium crystallizes in a body-centered cubic unit cell with an edge length of 5.025 Å
a. What is the atomic radius of barium in this structure?
b. Calculate the density of barium.
10.E.6.14: S10.6.9
(a) 2.176 Å; (b) 3.595 g/cm3
10.E.6.15: Q10.6.10
Aluminum (atomic radius = 1.43 Å) crystallizes in a cubic closely packed structure. Calculate the edge length of the face-centered
cubic unit cell and the density of aluminum.
10.E.6.16: Q10.6.11
The density of aluminum is 2.7 g/cm3; that of silicon is 2.3 g/cm3. Explain why Si has the lower density even though it has heavier
atoms.
10.E.6.17: S10.6.11
The crystal structure of Si shows that it is less tightly packed (coordination number 4) in the solid than Al (coordination number
12).
10.E.6.18: Q10.6.12
The free space in a metal may be found by subtracting the volume of the atoms in a unit cell from the volume of the cell. Calculate
the percentage of free space in each of the three cubic lattices if all atoms in each are of equal size and touch their nearest
neighbors. Which of these structures represents the most efficient packing? That is, which packs with the least amount of unused
space?
10.E.6.19: Q10.6.13
Cadmium sulfide, sometimes used as a yellow pigment by artists, crystallizes with cadmium, occupying one-half of the tetrahedral
holes in a closest packed array of sulfide ions. What is the formula of cadmium sulfide? Explain your answer.
10.E.6.20: S10.6.13
In a closest-packed array, two tetrahedral holes exist for each anion. If only half the tetrahedral holes are occupied, the numbers of
anions and cations are equal. The formula for cadmium sulfide is CdS.
10.E.6.21: Q10.6.14
A compound of cadmium, tin, and phosphorus is used in the fabrication of some semiconductors. It crystallizes with cadmium
occupying one-fourth of the tetrahedral holes and tin occupying one-fourth of the tetrahedral holes in a closest packed array of
phosphide ions. What is the formula of the compound? Explain your answer.
10.E.6.22: Q10.6.15
What is the formula of the magnetic oxide of cobalt, used in recording tapes, that crystallizes with cobalt atoms occupying one-
eighth of the tetrahedral holes and one-half of the octahedral holes in a closely packed array of oxide ions?
10.E.6.23: S10.6.15
Co3O4
10.E.6.24: Q10.6.16
A compound containing zinc, aluminum, and sulfur crystallizes with a closest-packed array of sulfide ions. Zinc ions are found in
one-eighth of the tetrahedral holes and aluminum ions in one-half of the octahedral holes. What is the empirical formula of the
10.E.6.25: Q10.6.17
A compound of thallium and iodine crystallizes in a simple cubic array of iodide ions with thallium ions in all of the cubic holes.
What is the formula of this iodide? Explain your answer.
10.E.6.26: S10.6.17
In a simple cubic array, only one cubic hole can be occupied be a cation for each anion in the array. The ratio of thallium to iodide
must be 1:1; therefore, the formula for thallium is TlI.
10.E.6.27: Q10.6.18
Which of the following elements reacts with sulfur to form a solid in which the sulfur atoms form a closest-packed array with all of
the octahedral holes occupied: Li, Na, Be, Ca, or Al?
10.E.6.28: Q10.6.19
What is the percent by mass of titanium in rutile, a mineral that contains titanium and oxygen, if structure can be described as a
closest packed array of oxide ions with titanium ions in one-half of the octahedral holes? What is the oxidation number of titanium?
10.E.6.29: S10.6.19
59.95%; The oxidation number of titanium is +4.
10.E.6.30: Q10.6.20
Explain why the chemically similar alkali metal chlorides NaCl and CsCl have different structures, whereas the chemically
different NaCl and MnS have the same structure.
10.E.6.31: Q10.6.21
As minerals were formed from the molten magma, different ions occupied the same cites in the crystals. Lithium often occurs along
with magnesium in minerals despite the difference in the charge on their ions. Suggest an explanation.
10.E.6.32: S10.6.21
Both ions are close in size: Mg, 0.65; Li, 0.60. This similarity allows the two to interchange rather easily. The difference in charge
is generally compensated by the switch of Si4+ for Al3+.
10.E.6.33: Q10.6.22
Rubidium iodide crystallizes with a cubic unit cell that contains iodide ions at the corners and a rubidium ion in the center. What is
the formula of the compound?
10.E.6.34: Q10.6.23
One of the various manganese oxides crystallizes with a cubic unit cell that contains manganese ions at the corners and in the
center. Oxide ions are located at the center of each edge of the unit cell. What is the formula of the compound?
10.E.6.35: S10.6.23
Mn2O3
10.E.6.36: Q10.6.24
NaH crystallizes with the same crystal structure as NaCl. The edge length of the cubic unit cell of NaH is 4.880 Å.
a. Calculate the ionic radius of H−. (The ionic radius of Li+ is 0.0.95 Å.)
b. Calculate the density of NaH.
10.E.6.37: Q10.6.25
Thallium(I) iodide crystallizes with the same structure as CsCl. The edge length of the unit cell of TlI is 4.20 Å. Calculate the ionic
radius of TI+. (The ionic radius of I− is 2.16 Å.)
10.E.6.39: Q10.6.26
A cubic unit cell contains manganese ions at the corners and fluoride ions at the center of each edge.
a. What is the empirical formula of this compound? Explain your answer.
b. What is the coordination number of the Mn3+ ion?
c. Calculate the edge length of the unit cell if the radius of a Mn3+ ion is 0.65 A.
d. Calculate the density of the compound.
10.E.6.40: Q10.6.27
What is the spacing between crystal planes that diffract X-rays with a wavelength of 1.541 nm at an angle θ of 15.55° (first order
reflection)?
10.E.6.41: S10.6.27
2.874 Å
10.E.6.42: Q10.6.28
A diffractometer using X-rays with a wavelength of 0.2287 nm produced first-order diffraction peak for a crystal angle θ = 16.21°.
Determine the spacing between the diffracting planes in this crystal.
10.E.6.43: Q10.6.29
A metal with spacing between planes equal to 0.4164 nm diffracts X-rays with a wavelength of 0.2879 nm. What is the diffraction
angle for the first order diffraction peak?
10.E.6.44: S10.6.29
20.2°
10.E.6.45: Q10.6.30
Gold crystallizes in a face-centered cubic unit cell. The second-order reflection (n = 2) of X-rays for the planes that make up the
tops and bottoms of the unit cells is at θ = 22.20°. The wavelength of the X-rays is 1.54 Å. What is the density of metallic gold?
10.E.6.46: Q10.6.31
When an electron in an excited molybdenum atom falls from the L to the K shell, an X-ray is emitted. These X-rays are diffracted
at an angle of 7.75° by planes with a separation of 2.64 Å. What is the difference in energy between the K shell and the L shell in
molybdenum assuming a first-order diffraction?
10.E.6.47: S10.6.31
1.74 × 104 eV
This page titled 10.E: Liquids and Solids (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 11: Solutions and Colloids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
11.0: Prelude to Solutions and Colloids
Coral reefs are home to about 25% of all marine species. They are being threatened by climate change, oceanic acidification, and
water pollution, all of which change the composition of the solution we know as seawater. Dissolved oxygen in seawater is critical
for sea creatures, but as the oceans warm, oxygen becomes less soluble. As the concentration of carbon dioxide in the atmosphere
increases, the concentration of carbon dioxide in the oceans increases, contributing to oceanic acidification. Coral reefs are
particularly sensitive to the acidification of the ocean, since the exoskeletons of the coral polyps are soluble in acidic solutions.
Humans contribute to the changing of seawater composition by allowing agricultural runoff and other forms of pollution to affect
our oceans.
Figure 11.0.1 : Coral reefs, such as this one at the Palmyra Atoll National Wildlife Refuge, are vital to the ecosystem of earth’s
oceans but are threatened by climate change and dissolved pollution. Marine life depends on the specific chemical composition of
the complex mixture we know as seawater. (credit: modification of work by “USFWS – Pacific Region”/Wikimedia Commons)
Solutions are crucial to the processes that sustain life and to many other processes involving chemical reactions. In this chapter, we
will consider the nature of solutions, and examine factors that determine whether a solution will form and what properties it may
have. In addition, we will discuss colloids—systems that resemble solutions but consist of dispersions of particles somewhat larger
than ordinary molecules or ions.
This page titled 11.0: Prelude to Solutions and Colloids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
An earlier chapter of this text introduced solutions, defined as homogeneous mixtures of two or more substances. Often, one
component of a solution is present at a significantly greater concentration, in which case it is called the solvent. The other
components of the solution present in relatively lesser concentrations are called solutes. Sugar is a covalent solid composed of
sucrose molecules, C H O . When this compound dissolves in water, its molecules become uniformly distributed among the
12 22 11
molecules of water:
C H O (s) ⟶ C H O (aq) (11.1.1)
12 22 11 12 22 11
The subscript “aq” in the equation signifies that the sucrose molecules are solutes and are therefore individually dispersed
throughout the aqueous solution (water is the solvent). Although sucrose molecules are heavier than water molecules, they remain
dispersed throughout the solution; gravity does not cause them to “settle out” over time.
Potassium dichromate, K Cr O , is an ionic compound composed of colorless potassium ions, K , and orange dichromate ions,
2 2 7
+
Cr O
2 7
. When a small amount of solid potassium dichromate is added to water, the compound dissolves and dissociates to yield
2 −
potassium ions and dichromate ions uniformly distributed throughout the mixture (Figure 11.1.1), as indicated in this equation:
+ 2 −
K Cr O (s) ⟶ 2 K (aq) + Cr O7 (aq) (11.1.2)
2 2 7 2
As with the mixture of sugar and water, this mixture is also an aqueous solution. Its solutes, potassium and dichromate ions, remain
individually dispersed among the solvent (water) molecules.
Figure 11.1.1 : When potassium dichromate (K Cr O ) is mixed with water, it forms a homogeneous orange solution. (credit:
2 2 7
Figure 11.1.2 : Samples of helium and argon spontaneously mix to give a solution in which the disorder of the atoms of the two
gases is increased.
Two figures are shown. The first contains two spherical containers joined by a closed stopcock. The container to the left is labeled
H e. It holds about thirty evenly dispersed, small, light blue spheres. The container on the right is labeled A r and contains about
thirty slightly larger blue-green spheres. The second, similar figure has an open stopcock between the two spherical containers. The
light blue and green spheres are evenly dispersed and present in both containers.
Ideal solutions may also form when structurally similar liquids are mixed. For example, mixtures of the alcohols methanol
(CH3OH) and ethanol (C2H5OH) form ideal solutions, as do mixtures of the hydrocarbons pentane, C H , and hexane, C H .
5 12 6 14
Placing methanol and ethanol, or pentane and hexane, in the bulbs shown in Figure 11.1.2 will result in the same diffusion and
subsequent mixing of these liquids as is observed for the He and Ar gases (although at a much slower rate), yielding solutions with
no significant change in energy. Unlike a mixture of gases, however, the components of these liquid-liquid solutions do, indeed,
Figure 11.1.3 : This schematic representation of dissolution shows a stepwise process involving the endothermic separation of
solute and solvent species (Steps 1 and 2) and exothermic solvation (Step 3).
The top, central region of the figure shows solute particles as seven blue spheres and solvent particles as 16 red spheres in separate,
labeled boxes. The particles in these boxes are touching. An arrow labeled “Step 1” points left of the solute box, and shows the blue
spheres no longer touching in another box labeled “expanded solute.” An arrow labeled “Step 2” points right from the solvent box
and shows the red spheres no longer touching in another box labeled “expanded solvent.” Arrows proceed from the bottom of the
expanded solute and expanded solvent boxes and join at the bottom of the figure where a step 3 label is shown. The joined arrows
point to a box just above in which the red and blue spheres are mixed together and touching. The solute and solvent boxes are
joined by another arrow labeled “direct formation of solution” which points downward at the center of the figure. This arrow also
points to the box containing mixed red and blue spheres near the bottom of the figure.
Three types of intermolecular attractive forces are relevant to the dissolution process: solute-solute, solvent-solvent, and solute-
solvent. As illustrated in Figure 11.1.3, the formation of a solution may be viewed as a stepwise process in which energy is
consumed to overcome solute-solute and solvent-solvent attractions (endothermic processes) and released when solute-solvent
attractions are established (an exothermic process referred to as solvation). The relative magnitudes of the energy changes
associated with these stepwise processes determine whether the dissolution process overall will release or absorb energy. In some
cases, solutions do not form because the energy required to separate solute and solvent species is so much greater than the energy
released by solvation.
Figure 11.1.4 : A mixture of nonpolar cooking oil and polar water does not yield a solution. (credit: Gautam Dogra).
For example, cooking oils and water will not mix to any appreciable extent to yield solutions (Figure 11.1.4). Hydrogen bonding is
the dominant intermolecular attractive force present in liquid water; the nonpolar hydrocarbon molecules of cooking oils are not
Figure 11.1.5 : An instant cold pack gets cold when certain salts, such as ammonium nitrate, dissolve in water—an endothermic
process.
This figure shows a single use instant cold pack with labels indicating an inner bag of water surrounded by white particulate
ammonium nitrate.
As noted at the beginning of this module, spontaneous solution formation is favored, but not guaranteed, by exothermic dissolution
processes. While many soluble compounds do, indeed, dissolve with the release of heat, some dissolve endothermically.
Ammonium nitrate (NH4NO3) is one such example and is used to make instant cold packs for treating injuries like the one pictured
in Figure 11.1.5. A thin-walled plastic bag of water is sealed inside a larger bag with solid NH4NO3. When the smaller bag is
broken, a solution of NH4NO3 forms, absorbing heat from the surroundings (the injured area to which the pack is applied) and
providing a cold compress that decreases swelling. Endothermic dissolutions such as this one require a greater energy input to
separate the solute species than is recovered when the solutes are solvated, but they are spontaneous nonetheless due to the increase
in disorder that accompanies formation of the solution.
Video 11.1.1 : Watch this brief video illustrating endothermic and exothermic dissolution processes.
Footnotes
1. If bubbles of gas are observed within the liquid, the mixture is not homogeneous and, thus, not a solution.
Glossary
alloy
solid mixture of a metallic element and one or more additional elements
ideal solution
solution that forms with no accompanying energy change
solvation
exothermic process in which intermolecular attractive forces between the solute and solvent in a solution are established
spontaneous process
physical or chemical change that occurs without the addition of energy from an external source
This page titled 11.1: The Dissolution Process is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
When some substances are dissolved in water, they undergo either a physical or a chemical change that yields ions in solution.
These substances constitute an important class of compounds called electrolytes. Substances that do not yield ions when dissolved
are called nonelectrolytes. If the physical or chemical process that generates the ions is essentially 100% efficient (all of the
dissolved compound yields ions), then the substance is known as a strong electrolyte. If only a relatively small fraction of the
dissolved substance undergoes the ion-producing process, it is called a weak electrolyte.
Substances may be identified as strong, weak, or nonelectrolytes by measuring the electrical conductance of an aqueous solution
containing the substance. To conduct electricity, a substance must contain freely mobile, charged species. Most familiar is the
conduction of electricity through metallic wires, in which case the mobile, charged entities are electrons. Solutions may also
conduct electricity if they contain dissolved ions, with conductivity increasing as ion concentration increases. Applying a voltage to
electrodes immersed in a solution permits assessment of the relative concentration of dissolved ions, either quantitatively, by
measuring the electrical current flow, or qualitatively, by observing the brightness of a light bulb included in the circuit (Figure
11.2.1).
Figure 11.2.1 : Solutions of nonelectrolytes such as ethanol do not contain dissolved ions and cannot conduct electricity. Solutions
of electrolytes contain ions that permit the passage of electricity. The conductivity of an electrolyte solution is related to the
strength of the electrolyte.
This diagram shows three separate beakers. Each has a wire plugged into a wall outlet. In each case, the wire leads from the wall to
the beaker and is split resulting in two ends. One end leads to a light bulb and continues on to a rectangle labeled with a plus sign.
The other end leads to a rectangle labeled with a minus sign. The rectangles are in a solution. In the first beaker, labeled “Ethanol
No Conductivity,” four pairs of linked small green spheres suspended in the solution between the rectangles. In the second beaker,
labeled “K C l Strong Conductivity,” six individual green spheres, three labeled plus and three labeled minus are suspended in the
solution. Each of the six spheres has an arrow extending from it pointing to the rectangle labeled with the opposite sign. In the third
beaker, labeled “Acetic acid solution Weak conductivity,” two pairs of joined green spheres and two individual spheres, one labeled
plus and one labeled minus are shown suspended between the two rectangles. The plus labeled sphere has an arrow pointing to the
rectangle labeled minus and the minus labeled sphere has an arrow pointing to the rectangle labeled plus.
When ionic compounds dissolve in water, the ions in the solid separate and disperse uniformly throughout the solution because
water molecules surround and solvate the ions, reducing the strong electrostatic forces between them. This process represents a
physical change known as dissociation. Under most conditions, ionic compounds will dissociate nearly completely when dissolved,
and so they are classified as strong electrolytes.
Let us consider what happens at the microscopic level when we add solid KCl to water. Ion-dipole forces attract the positive
(hydrogen) end of the polar water molecules to the negative chloride ions at the surface of the solid, and they attract the negative
(oxygen) ends to the positive potassium ions. The water molecules penetrate between individual K+ and Cl− ions and surround
them, reducing the strong interionic forces that bind the ions together and letting them move off into solution as solvated ions, as
Figure shows. The reduction of the electrostatic attraction permits the independent motion of each hydrated ion in a dilute solution,
resulting in an increase in the disorder of the system as the ions change from their fixed and ordered positions in the crystal to
mobile and much more disordered states in solution. This increased disorder is responsible for the dissolution of many ionic
compounds, including KCl, which dissolve with absorption of heat.
In other cases, the electrostatic attractions between the ions in a crystal are so large, or the ion-dipole attractive forces between the
ions and water molecules are so weak, that the increase in disorder cannot compensate for the energy required to separate the ions,
and the crystal is insoluble. Such is the case for compounds such as calcium carbonate (limestone), calcium phosphate (the
inorganic component of bone), and iron oxide (rust).
In some cases, we find that solutions prepared from covalent compounds conduct electricity because the solute molecules react
chemically with the solvent to produce ions. For example, pure hydrogen chloride is a gas consisting of covalent HCl molecules.
This gas contains no ions. However, when we dissolve hydrogen chloride in water, we find that the solution is a very good
conductor. The water molecules play an essential part in forming ions: Solutions of hydrogen chloride in many other solvents, such
as benzene, do not conduct electricity and do not contain ions.
Hydrogen chloride is an acid, and so its molecules react with water, transferring H+ ions to form hydronium ions (H 3O
+
) and
chloride ions (Cl−):
Summary
Substances that dissolve in water to yield ions are called electrolytes. Electrolytes may be covalent compounds that chemically
react with water to produce ions (for example, acids and bases), or they may be ionic compounds that dissociate to yield their
constituent cations and anions, when dissolved. Dissolution of an ionic compound is facilitated by ion-dipole attractions between
the ions of the compound and the polar water molecules. Soluble ionic substances and strong acids ionize completely and are
strong electrolytes, while weak acids and bases ionize to only a small extent and are weak electrolytes. Nonelectrolytes are
substances that do not produce ions when dissolved in water.
Glossary
dissociation
physical process accompanying the dissolution of an ionic compound in which the compound’s constituent ions are solvated
and dispersed throughout the solution
electrolyte
substance that produces ions when dissolved in water
ion-dipole attraction
electrostatic attraction between an ion and a polar molecule
nonelectrolyte
substance that does not produce ions when dissolved in water
strong electrolyte
substance that dissociates or ionizes completely when dissolved in water
weak electrolyte
substance that ionizes only partially when dissolved in water
This page titled 11.2: Electrolytes is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Imagine adding a small amount of salt to a glass of water, stirring until all the salt has dissolved, and then adding a bit more. You
can repeat this process until the salt concentration of the solution reaches its natural limit, a limit determined primarily by the
relative strengths of the solute-solute, solute-solvent, and solvent-solvent attractive forces discussed in the previous two modules of
this chapter. You can be certain that you have reached this limit because, no matter how long you stir the solution, undissolved salt
remains. The concentration of salt in the solution at this point is known as its solubility.
The solubility of a solute in a particular solvent is the maximum concentration that may be achieved under given conditions when
the dissolution process is at equilibrium. Referring to the example of salt in water:
+ −
NaCl(s) ⇌ Na (aq) + Cl (aq) (11.3.1)
When a solute’s concentration is equal to its solubility, the solution is said to be saturated with that solute. If the solute’s
concentration is less than its solubility, the solution is said to be unsaturated. A solution that contains a relatively low concentration
of solute is called dilute, and one with a relatively high concentration is called concentrated.
If we add more salt to a saturated solution of salt, we see it fall to the bottom and no more seems to dissolve. In fact, the added salt
does dissolve, as represented by the forward direction of the dissolution equation. Accompanying this process, dissolved salt will
precipitate, as depicted by the reverse direction of the equation. The system is said to be at equilibrium when these two reciprocal
processes are occurring at equal rates, and so the amount of undissolved and dissolved salt remains constant. Support for the
simultaneous occurrence of the dissolution and precipitation processes is provided by noting that the number and sizes of the
undissolved salt crystals will change over time, though their combined mass will remain the same.
Video 11.3.1 : Watch this impressive video showing the precipitation of sodium acetate from a supersaturated solution.
Solutions may be prepared in which a solute concentration exceeds its solubility. Such solutions are said to be supersaturated, and
they are interesting examples of nonequilibrium states. For example, the carbonated beverage in an open container that has not yet
“gone flat” is supersaturated with carbon dioxide gas; given time, the CO2 concentration will decrease until it reaches its
equilibrium value.
Figure 11.3.1 : The solubilities of these gases in water decrease as the temperature increases. All solubilities were measured with a
constant pressure of 101.3 kPa (1 atm) of gas above the solutions.
When the temperature of a river, lake, or stream is raised abnormally high, usually due to the discharge of hot water from some
industrial process, the solubility of oxygen in the water is decreased. Decreased levels of dissolved oxygen may have serious
consequences for the health of the water’s ecosystems and, in severe cases, can result in large-scale fish kills (Figure 11.3.2).
Figure 11.3.2 : (a) The small bubbles of air in this glass of chilled water formed when the water warmed to room temperature and
the solubility of its dissolved air decreased. (b) The decreased solubility of oxygen in natural waters subjected to thermal pollution
can result in large-scale fish kills. (credit a: modification of work by Liz West; credit b: modification of work by U.S. Fish and
Wildlife Service)
The solubility of a gaseous solute is also affected by the partial pressure of solute in the gas to which the solution is exposed. Gas
solubility increases as the pressure of the gas increases. Carbonated beverages provide a nice illustration of this relationship. The
carbonation process involves exposing the beverage to a relatively high pressure of carbon dioxide gas and then sealing the
beverage container, thus saturating the beverage with CO2 at this pressure. When the beverage container is opened, a familiar hiss
is heard as the carbon dioxide gas pressure is released, and some of the dissolved carbon dioxide is typically seen leaving solution
in the form of small bubbles (Figure 11.3.3). At this point, the beverage is supersaturated with carbon dioxide and, with time, the
dissolved carbon dioxide concentration will decrease to its equilibrium value and the beverage will become “flat.”
Cg = kPg
where k is a proportionality constant that depends on the identities of the gaseous solute and solvent, and on the solution
temperature. This is a mathematical statement of Henry’s law: The quantity of an ideal gas that dissolves in a definite volume of
liquid is directly proportional to the pressure of the gas.
At 20 °C, the concentration of dissolved oxygen in water exposed to gaseous oxygen at a partial pressure of 101.3 kPa (760
torr) is 1.38 × 10−3 mol L−1. Use Henry’s law to determine the solubility of oxygen when its partial pressure is 20.7 kPa (155
torr), the approximate pressure of oxygen in earth’s atmosphere.
Solution
According to Henry’s law, for an ideal solution the solubility, Cg, of a gas (1.38 × 10−3 mol L−1, in this case) is directly
proportional to the pressure, Pg, of the undissolved gas above the solution (101.3 kPa, or 760 torr, in this case). Because we
know both Cg and Pg, we can rearrange this expression to solve for k.
Cg = kPg
Cg
k =
Pg
−3 −1
1.38 × 10 mol L
=
101.3 kPa
−5 −1 −1
= 1.36 × 10 mol L kPa
−6 −1 −1
(1.82 × 10 mol L torr )
Cg = kPg
−5 −1 −1
1.36 × 10 mol L kPa × 20.7 kPa
−6 −1 −1
(or 1.82 × 10 mol L torr × 155 torr)
−4 −1
= 2.82 × 10 mol L
Note that various units may be used to express the quantities involved in these sorts of computations. Any combination of units
that yield to the constraints of dimensional analysis are acceptable.
Exposing a 100.0 mL sample of water at 0 °C to an atmosphere containing a gaseous solute at 20.26 kPa (152 torr) resulted in
the dissolution of 1.45 × 10−3 g of the solute. Use Henry’s law to determine the solubility of this gaseous solute when its
pressure is 101.3 kPa (760 torr).
Answer
7.25 × 10−3 g in 100.0 mL or 0.0725 g/L
Decompression sickness (DCS), or “the bends,” is an effect of the increased pressure of the air inhaled by scuba divers when
swimming underwater at considerable depths. In addition to the pressure exerted by the atmosphere, divers are subjected to
additional pressure due to the water above them, experiencing an increase of approximately 1 atm for each 10 m of depth.
Therefore, the air inhaled by a diver while submerged contains gases at the corresponding higher ambient pressure, and the
concentrations of the gases dissolved in the diver’s blood are proportionally higher per Henry’s law.
Figure 11.3.4 : (a) US Navy divers undergo training in a recompression chamber. (b) Divers receive hyperbaric oxygen therapy.
Two photos are shown. The first shows two people seated in a steel chamber on benches that run length of the chamber on each
side. The chamber has a couple of small circular windows and an open hatch-type door. One of the two people is giving a
thumbs up gesture. The second image provides a view through a small, circular window. Inside the two people can be seen
with masks over their mouths and noses. The people appear to be reading.
As the diver ascends to the surface of the water, the ambient pressure decreases and the dissolved gases becomes less soluble.
If the ascent is too rapid, the gases escaping from the diver’s blood may form bubbles that can cause a variety of symptoms
ranging from rashes and joint pain to paralysis and death. To avoid DCS, divers must ascend from depths at relatively slow
speeds (10 or 20 m/min) or otherwise make several decompression stops, pausing for several minutes at given depths during
the ascent. When these preventive measures are unsuccessful, divers with DCS are often provided hyperbaric oxygen therapy
in pressurized vessels called decompression (or recompression) chambers (Figure 11.3.4).
Deviations from Henry’s law are observed when a chemical reaction takes place between the gaseous solute and the solvent. Thus,
for example, the solubility of ammonia in water does not increase as rapidly with increasing pressure as predicted by the law
because ammonia, being a base, reacts to some extent with water to form ammonium ions and hydroxide ions.
Gases can form supersaturated solutions. If a solution of a gas in a liquid is prepared either at low temperature or under pressure
(or both), then as the solution warms or as the gas pressure is reduced, the solution may become supersaturated. In 1986, more than
1700 people in Cameroon were killed when a cloud of gas, almost certainly carbon dioxide, bubbled from Lake Nyos (Figure
11.3.5), a deep lake in a volcanic crater. The water at the bottom of Lake Nyos is saturated with carbon dioxide by volcanic activity
beneath the lake. It is believed that the lake underwent a turnover due to gradual heating from below the lake, and the warmer, less-
Figure 11.3.5 : (a) It is believed that the 1986 disaster that killed more than 1700 people near Lake Nyos in Cameroon resulted
when a large volume of carbon dioxide gas was released from the lake. (b) A CO2 vent has since been installed to help outgas the
lake in a slow, controlled fashion and prevent a similar catastrophe from happening in the future. (credit a: modification of work by
Jack Lockwood; credit b: modification of work by Bill Evans)
Two photos are shown. The first is an aerial view of a lake surrounded by green hills. The second shows a large body of water with
a fountain sending liquid up into the air several yards or meters above the surface of the water.
Figure 11.3.6 : Water and antifreeze are miscible; mixtures of the two are homogeneous in all proportions. (credit:
“dno1967”/Wikimedia commons)
Liquids that mix with water in all proportions are usually polar substances or substances that form hydrogen bonds. For such
liquids, the dipole-dipole attractions (or hydrogen bonding) of the solute molecules with the solvent molecules are at least as strong
as those between molecules in the pure solute or in the pure solvent. Hence, the two kinds of molecules mix easily. Likewise,
nonpolar liquids are miscible with each other because there is no appreciable difference in the strengths of solute-solute, solvent-
solvent, and solute-solvent intermolecular attractions. The solubility of polar molecules in polar solvents and of nonpolar molecules
in nonpolar solvents is, again, an illustration of the chemical axiom “like dissolves like.”
Two liquids that do not mix to an appreciable extent are called immiscible. Layers are formed when we pour immiscible liquids
into the same container. Gasoline, oil (Figure 11.3.7), benzene, carbon tetrachloride, some paints, and many other nonpolar liquids
are immiscible with water. The attraction between the molecules of such nonpolar liquids and polar water molecules is ineffectively
weak. The only strong attractions in such a mixture are between the water molecules, so they effectively squeeze out the molecules
of the nonpolar liquid. The distinction between immiscibility and miscibility is really one of degrees, so that miscible liquids are of
infinite mutual solubility, while liquids said to be immiscible are of very low (though not zero) mutual solubility.
This is a photo of a clear, colorless martini glass containing a golden colored liquid layer resting on top of a clear, colorless liquid.
Two liquids, such as bromine and water, that are of moderate mutual solubility are said to be partially miscible. Two partially
miscible liquids usually form two layers when mixed. In the case of the bromine and water mixture, the upper layer is water,
saturated with bromine, and the lower layer is bromine saturated with water. Since bromine is nonpolar, and, thus, not very soluble
in water, the water layer is only slightly discolored by the bright orange bromine dissolved in it. Since the solubility of water in
bromine is very low, there is no noticeable effect on the dark color of the bromine layer (Figure 11.3.8).
Figure 11.3.8 : Bromine (the deep orange liquid on the left) and water (the clear liquid in the middle) are partially miscible. The top
layer in the mixture on the right is a saturated solution of bromine in water; the bottom layer is a saturated solution of water in
bromine. (credit: Paul Flowers)
This figure shows three test tubes. The first test tube holds a dark orange-brown substance. The second test tube holds a clear
substance. The amount of substance in both test tubes is the same. The third test tube holds a dark orange-brown substance on the
bottom with a lighter orange substance on top. The amount of substance in the third test tube is almost double of the first two.
Figure 11.3.10: This hand warmer produces heat when the sodium acetate in a supersaturated solution precipitates. Precipitation of
the solute is initiated by a mechanical shockwave generated when the flexible metal disk within the solution is “clicked.” (credit:
modification of work by “Velela”/Wikimedia Commons)
Three photos of hand warmers are shown side by side with an arrow pointing from the first photo to the second, and another arrow
pointing from the second photo to the third. The first packet contains a clear colorless liquid and a small metal disc can be seen. In
the second packet, the disc can’t be seen and a dispersion of white liquid is beginning. In the third packet, all of the liquid is white.
Video 11.3.2: This video shows the crystallization process occurring in a hand warmer.
Summary
The extent to which one substance will dissolve in another is determined by several factors, including the types and relative
strengths of intermolecular attractive forces that may exist between the substances’ atoms, ions, or molecules. This tendency to
dissolve is quantified as substance’s solubility, its maximum concentration in a solution at equilibrium under specified conditions.
A saturated solution contains solute at a concentration equal to its solubility. A supersaturated solution is one in which a solute’s
concentration exceeds its solubility—a nonequilibrium (unstable) condition that will result in solute precipitation when the solution
is appropriately perturbed. Miscible liquids are soluble in all proportions, and immiscible liquids exhibit very low mutual solubility.
Solubilities for gaseous solutes decrease with increasing temperature, while those for most, but not all, solid solutes increase with
temperature. The concentration of a gaseous solute in a solution is proportional to the partial pressure of the gas to which the
solution is exposed, a relation known as Henry’s law.
Glossary
Henry’s law
law stating the proportional relationship between the concentration of dissolved gas in a solution and the partial pressure of the
gas in contact with the solution
immiscible
of negligible mutual solubility; typically refers to liquid substances
miscible
mutually soluble in all proportions; typically refers to liquid substances
partially miscible
of moderate mutual solubility; typically refers to liquid substances
saturated
of concentration equal to solubility; containing the maximum concentration of solute possible for a given temperature and
pressure
solubility
extent to which a solute may be dissolved in water, or any solvent
supersaturated
of concentration that exceeds solubility; a nonequilibrium state
This page titled 11.3: Solubility is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The properties of a solution are different from those of either the pure solute(s) or solvent. Many solution properties are dependent
upon the chemical identity of the solute. Compared to pure water, a solution of hydrogen chloride is more acidic, a solution of
ammonia is more basic, a solution of sodium chloride is more dense, and a solution of sucrose is more viscous. There are a few
solution properties, however, that depend only upon the total concentration of solute species, regardless of their identities. These
colligative properties include vapor pressure lowering, boiling point elevation, freezing point depression, and osmotic pressure.
This small set of properties is of central importance to many natural phenomena and technological applications, as will be
described in this module.
Because solution volumes vary with temperature, molar concentrations will likewise vary. When expressed as molarity, the
concentration of a solution with identical numbers of solute and solvent species will be different at different temperatures, due to
the contraction/expansion of the solution. More appropriate for calculations involving many colligative properties are mole-based
concentration units whose values are not dependent on temperature. Two such units are mole fraction (introduced in the previous
chapter on gases) and molality.
The mole fraction, χ, of a component is the ratio of its molar amount to the total number of moles of all solution components:
mol A
χA = (11.4.2)
total mol of all components
Molality is a concentration unit defined as the ratio of the numbers of moles of solute to the mass of the solvent in kilograms:
mol solute
m = (11.4.3)
kg solvent
Since these units are computed using only masses and molar amounts, they do not vary with temperature and, thus, are better suited
for applications requiring temperature-independent concentrations, including several colligative properties, as will be described in
this chapter module.
water)?
Solution
1 mol H2 O
mol H2 O = 2000 g × = 111 mol H2 O
18.02 g H2 O
Notice that mole fraction is a dimensionless property, being the ratio of properties with identical units (moles).
(b) To find molality, we need to know the moles of the solute and the mass of the solvent (in kg).
First, use the given mass of ethylene glycol and its molar mass to find the moles of solute:
mol C2 H2 (OH)2
2220 g C2 H4 (OH)2 ( ) = 35.8 mol C2 H4 (OH)2
62.07 g
molality = 17.9 m
Exercise 11.4.1
What are the mole fraction and molality of a solution that contains 0.850 g of ammonia, NH3, dissolved in 125 g of water?
Answer
7.14 × 10−3; 0.399 m
Calculate the mole fraction of solute and solvent in a 3.0 m solution of sodium chloride.
Solution
Converting from one concentration unit to another is accomplished by first comparing the two unit definitions. In this case,
both units have the same numerator (moles of solute) but different denominators. The provided molal concentration may be
written as:
3.0 mol NaCl
1.0 kg H2 O
The numerator for this solution’s mole fraction is, therefore, 3.0 mol NaCl. The denominator may be computed by deriving the
molar amount of water corresponding to 1.0 kg
1000 g mol H2 O
1.0 kg H2 O ( )( ) = 55 mol H2 O
1 kg 18.02 g
55 mol H2 O
XH2 O =
3.0 mol NaCl + 55 mol H2 O
XH O = 0.95
2
mol NaCl
XNaCl =
mol NaCl + mol H2 O
XNaCl = 0.052
Exercise 11.4.2
Answer
1.50 m
Dissolving a nonvolatile substance in a volatile liquid results in a lowering of the liquid’s vapor pressure. This phenomenon can be
rationalized by considering the effect of added solute molecules on the liquid's vaporization and condensation processes. To
vaporize, solvent molecules must be present at the surface of the solution. The presence of solute decreases the surface area
available to solvent molecules and thereby reduces the rate of solvent vaporization. Since the rate of condensation is unaffected by
the presence of solute, the net result is that the vaporization-condensation equilibrium is achieved with fewer solvent molecules in
the vapor phase (i.e., at a lower vapor pressure) (Figure 11.4.1). While this kinetic interpretation is useful, it does not account for
several important aspects of the colligative nature of vapor pressure lowering. A more rigorous explanation involves the property of
entropy, a topic of discussion in a later text chapter on thermodynamics. For purposes of understanding the lowering of a liquid's
vapor pressure, it is adequate to note that the greater entropy of a solution in comparison to its separate solvent and solute serves to
effectively stabilize the solvent molecules and hinder their vaporization. A lower vapor pressure results, and a correspondingly
higher boiling point as described in the next section of this module.
where PA is the partial pressure exerted by component A in the solution, P is the vapor pressure of pure A, and XA is the mole
∘
A
fraction of A in the solution. (Mole fraction is a concentration unit introduced in the chapter on gases.)
Recalling that the total pressure of a gaseous mixture is equal to the sum of partial pressures for all its components (Dalton’s law of
partial pressures), the total vapor pressure exerted by a solution containing i components is
∘
Psolution = ∑ Pi = ∑ Xi P (11.4.6)
i
i i
A nonvolatile substance is one whose vapor pressure is negligible (P° ≈ 0), and so the vapor pressure above a solution containing
only nonvolatile solutes is due only to the solvent:
∘
Psolution = Xsolvent P (11.4.7)
solvent
Compute the vapor pressure of an ideal solution containing 92.1 g of glycerin, C3H5(OH)3, and 184.4 g of ethanol, C2H5OH, at
40 °C. The vapor pressure of pure ethanol is 0.178 atm at 40 °C. Glycerin is essentially nonvolatile at this temperature.
Solution
Since the solvent is the only volatile component of this solution, its vapor pressure may be computed per Raoult’s law as:
∘
Psolution = Xsolvent P
solvent
First, calculate the molar amounts of each solution component using the provided mass data.
1 mol C3 H5 (OH)3
92.1 g C3 H5 (OH)3 × = 1.00 mol C3 H5 (OH)3
92.094 g C3 H5 (OH)3
1 mol C2 H5 OH
184.4 g C2 H5 OH × = 4.000 mol C2 H5 OH
46.069 g C2 H5 OH
Next, calculate the mole fraction of the solvent (ethanol) and use Raoult’s law to compute the solution’s vapor pressure.
∘
Psolv = XsolvP = 0.800 × 0.178 atm = 0.142 atm
solv
Exercise 11.4.3
A solution contains 5.00 g of urea, CO(NH2)2 (a nonvolatile solute) and 0.100 kg of water. If the vapor pressure of pure water
at 25 °C is 23.7 torr, what is the vapor pressure of the solution?
Answer
23.4 torr
where
Kb is the boiling point elevation constant, or the ebullioscopic constant and
m is the molal concentration (molality) of all solute species.
Boiling point elevation constants are characteristic properties that depend on the identity of the solvent. Values of Kb for several
solvents are listed in Table 11.4.1.
Table 11.4.1 : Boiling Point Elevation and Freezing Point Depression Constants for Several Solvents
Freezing Point (°C at 1
Solvent Boiling Point (°C at 1 atm) Kb (Cm−1) Kf (Cm−1)
atm)
The extent to which the vapor pressure of a solvent is lowered and the boiling point is elevated depends on the total number of
solute particles present in a given amount of solvent, not on the mass or size or chemical identities of the particles. A 1 m aqueous
solution of sucrose (342 g/mol) and a 1 m aqueous solution of ethylene glycol (62 g/mol) will exhibit the same boiling point
because each solution has one mole of solute particles (molecules) per kilogram of solvent.
Solution
Use the equation relating boiling point elevation to solute molality to solve this problem in two steps.
Add the boiling point elevation to the pure solvent’s boiling point.
Boiling temperature = 80.1 °C + 0.83 °C = 80.9 °C
Exercise 11.4.4
Answer
109.2 °C
Solution
We can solve this problem using four steps.
1. Convert from grams to moles of I using the molar mass of I in the unit conversion factor.
2 2
Answer
Figure 11.4.2 : A typical laboratory distillation unit is shown in (a) a photograph and (b) a schematic diagram of the components.
(credit a: modification of work by “Rifleman82”/Wikimedia commons; credit b: modification of work by “Slashme”/Wikimedia
Commons)
Figure a contains a photograph of a common laboratory distillation unit. Figure b provides a diagram labeling typical components
of a laboratory distillation unit, including a stirrer/heat plate with heat and stirrer speed control, a heating bath of oil or sand,
stirring means such as boiling chips, a still pot, a still head, a thermometer for boiling point temperature reading, a condenser with a
cool water inlet and outlet, a still receiver with a vacuum or gas inlet, a receiving flask for holding distillate, and a cooling bath.
Oil refineries use large-scale fractional distillation to separate the components of crude oil. The crude oil is heated to high
temperatures at the base of a tall fractionating column, vaporizing many of the components that rise within the column. As
vaporized components reach adequately cool zones during their ascent, they condense and are collected. The collected liquids are
simpler mixtures of hydrocarbons and other petroleum compounds that are of appropriate composition for various applications
(e.g., diesel fuel, kerosene, gasoline), as depicted in Figure 11.4.3.
automobile radiators. Seawater freezes at a lower temperature than fresh water, and so the Arctic and Antarctic oceans remain
unfrozen even at temperatures below 0 °C (as do the body fluids of fish and other cold-blooded sea animals that live in these
oceans).
Figure 11.4.4 : Rock salt (NaCl), calcium chloride (CaCl2), or a mixture of the two are used to melt ice. (credit: modification of
work by Eddie Welker)
The decrease in freezing point of a dilute solution compared to that of the pure solvent, ΔTf, is called the freezing point depression
and is directly proportional to the molal concentration of the solute
ΔTf = Kf m (11.4.9)
where
mis the molal concentration of the solute in the solvent and
K is called the freezing point depression constant (or cryoscopic constant).
f
Just as for boiling point elevation constants, these are characteristic properties whose values depend on the chemical identity of the
solvent. Values of Kf for several solvents are listed in Table 11.4.1.
Solution
Use the equation relating freezing point depression to solute molality to solve this problem in two steps.
2. Subtract the freezing point change observed from the pure solvent’s freezing point.
Exercise 11.4.6
What is the freezing point of a 1.85 m solution of a nonvolatile nonelectrolyte solute in nitrobenzene?
Answer
−9.3 °C
Sodium chloride and its group 2 analogs calcium and magnesium chloride are often used to de-ice roadways and sidewalks,
due to the fact that a solution of any one of these salts will have a freezing point lower than 0 °C, the freezing point of pure
water. The group 2 metal salts are frequently mixed with the cheaper and more readily available sodium chloride (“rock salt”)
for use on roads, since they tend to be somewhat less corrosive than the NaCl, and they provide a larger depression of the
freezing point, since they dissociate to yield three particles per formula unit, rather than two particles like the sodium chloride.
Because these ionic compounds tend to hasten the corrosion of metal, they would not be a wise choice to use in antifreeze for
the radiator in your car or to de-ice a plane prior to takeoff. For these applications, covalent compounds, such as ethylene or
propylene glycol, are often used. The glycols used in radiator fluid not only lower the freezing point of the liquid, but they
elevate the boiling point, making the fluid useful in both winter and summer. Heated glycols are often sprayed onto the surface
of airplanes prior to takeoff in inclement weather in the winter to remove ice that has already formed and prevent the formation
of more ice, which would be particularly dangerous if formed on the control surfaces of the aircraft (Video 11.4.1).
Video 11.4.1 : Freezing point depression is exploited to remove ice from the control surfaces of aircraft.
Figure 11.4.5 : These phase diagrams show water (solid curves) and an aqueous solution of nonelectrolyte (dashed curves).
This phase diagram indicates the pressure in atmospheres of water and a solution at various temperatures. The graph shows the
freezing point of water and the freezing point of the solution, with the difference between these two values identified as delta T
subscript f. The graph shows the boiling point of water and the boiling point of the solution, with the difference between these two
values identified as delta T subscript b. Similarly, the difference in the pressure of water and the solution at the boiling point of
water is shown and identified as delta P. This difference in pressure is labeled vapor pressure lowering. The lower level of the vapor
pressure curve for the solution as opposed to that of pure water shows vapor pressure lowering in the solution. Background colors
on the diagram indicate the presence of water and the solution in the solid state to the left, liquid state in the central upper region,
and gas to the right.
The liquid-vapor curve for the solution is located beneath the corresponding curve for the solvent, depicting the vapor pressure
lowering, ΔP, that results from the dissolution of nonvolatile solute. Consequently, at any given pressure, the solution’s boiling
point is observed at a higher temperature than that for the pure solvent, reflecting the boiling point elevation, ΔTb, associated with
the presence of nonvolatile solute. The solid-liquid curve for the solution is displaced left of that for the pure solvent, representing
the freezing point depression, ΔTf, that accompanies solution formation. Finally, notice that the solid-gas curves for the solvent and
its solution are identical. This is the case for many solutions comprising liquid solvents and nonvolatile solutes. Just as for
vaporization, when a solution of this sort is frozen, it is actually just the solvent molecules that undergo the liquid-to-solid
transition, forming pure solid solvent that excludes solute species. The solid and gaseous phases, therefore, are composed solvent
only, and so transitions between these phases are not subject to colligative effects.
Figure 11.4.6 : Osmosis results in the transfer of solvent molecules from a sample of low (or zero) solute concentration to a sample
of higher solute concentration.
The figure shows two U shaped tubes with a semi permeable membrane placed at the base of the U. In figure a, pure solvent is
present and indicated by small yellow spheres to the left of the membrane. To the right, a solution exists with larger blue spheres
intermingled with some small yellow spheres. At the membrane, arrows pointing from three small yellow spheres on both sides of
the membrane cross over the membrane. An arrow drawn from one of the large blue spheres does not cross the membrane, but
rather is reflected back from the surface of the membrane. The levels of liquid in both sides of the U shaped tube are equal. In
figure b, arrows again point from small yellow spheres across the semipermeable membrane from both sides. This diagram shows
the level of liquid in the left, pure solvent, side to be significantly lower than the liquid level on the right. Dashed lines are drawn
from these two liquid levels into the middle of the U-shaped tube and between them is the term osmotic pressure.
When osmosis is carried out in an apparatus like that shown in Figure 11.4.6, the volume of the solution increases as it becomes
diluted by accumulation of solvent. This causes the level of the solution to rise, increasing its hydrostatic pressure (due to the
weight of the column of solution in the tube) and resulting in a faster transfer of solvent molecules back to the pure solvent side.
When the pressure reaches a value that yields a reverse solvent transfer rate equal to the osmosis rate, bulk transfer of solvent
ceases. This pressure is called the osmotic pressure (Π ) of the solution. The osmotic pressure of a dilute solution is related to its
solute molarity, M, and absolute temperature, T, according to the equation
Π = M RT (11.4.10)
What is the osmotic pressure (atm) of a 0.30 M solution of glucose in water that is used for intravenous infusion at body
temperature, 37 °C?
= 7.6 atm
Exercise 11.4.7
What is the osmotic pressure (atm) a solution with a volume of 0.750 L that contains 5.0 g of methanol, CH3OH, in water at 37
°C?
Answer
5.3 atm
If a solution is placed in an apparatus like the one shown in Figure 11.4.7, applying pressure greater than the osmotic pressure of
the solution reverses the osmosis and pushes solvent molecules from the solution into the pure solvent. This technique of reverse
osmosis is used for large-scale desalination of seawater and on smaller scales to produce high-purity tap water for drinking.
Figure 11.4.7 : Applying a pressure greater than the osmotic pressure of a solution will reverse osmosis. Solvent molecules from the
solution are pushed into the pure solvent.
The figure shows a U shaped tube with a semi permeable membrane placed at the base of the U. Pure solvent is present and
indicated by small yellow spheres to the left of the membrane. To the right, a solution exists with larger blue spheres intermingled
with some small yellow spheres. At the membrane, arrows point from four small yellow spheres to the left of the membrane. On
the right side of the U, there is a disk that is the same width of the tube and appears to block it. The disk is at the same level as the
solution. An arrow points down from the top of the tube to the disk and is labeled, “Pressure greater than Π subscript solution.”
Examples of osmosis are evident in many biological systems because cells are surrounded by semipermeable membranes. Carrots
and celery that have become limp because they have lost water can be made crisp again by placing them in water. Water moves into
the carrot or celery cells by osmosis. A cucumber placed in a concentrated salt solution loses water by osmosis and absorbs some
salt to become a pickle. Osmosis can also affect animal cells. Solute concentrations are particularly important when solutions are
injected into the body. Solutes in body cell fluids and blood serum give these solutions an osmotic pressure of approximately 7.7
atm. Solutions injected into the body must have the same osmotic pressure as blood serum; that is, they should be isotonic with
blood serum. If a less concentrated solution, a hypotonic solution, is injected in sufficient quantity to dilute the blood serum, water
from the diluted serum passes into the blood cells by osmosis, causing the cells to expand and rupture. This process is called
Figure 11.4.8 : Red blood cell membranes are water permeable and will (a) swell and possibly rupture in a hypotonic solution; (b)
maintain normal volume and shape in an isotonic solution; and (c) shrivel and possibly die in a hypertonic solution. (credit a/b/c:
modifications of work by “LadyofHats”/Wikimedia commons)
This figure shows three scenarios relating to red blood cell membranes. In a, H subscript 2 O has two arrows drawn from it
pointing into a red disk. Beneath it in a circle are eleven similar disks with a bulging appearance, one of which appears to have
burst with blue liquid erupting from it. In b, the image is similar except that rather than having two arrows pointing into the red
disk, one points in and a second points out toward the H subscript 2 O. In the circle beneath, twelve of the red disks are present. In
c, both arrows are drawn from a red shriveled disk toward the H subscript 2 O. In the circle below, twelve shriveled disks are
shown.
A solution of 4.00 g of a nonelectrolyte dissolved in 55.0 g of benzene is found to freeze at 2.32 °C. What is the molar mass of
this compound?
Solution
We can solve this problem using the following steps.
1. Determine the change in freezing point from the observed freezing point and the freezing point of pure benzene (Table
11.5.1).
1. Determine the molal concentration from Kf, the freezing point depression constant for benzene (Table 11.5.1), and ΔTf.
\(ΔT_\ce{f}=K_\ce{f}m\)
ΔTf 3.2 °C
m = = = 0.63 m
−1
Kf 5.12 °Cm
1. Determine the number of moles of compound in the solution from the molal concentration and the mass of solvent used to make
the solution.
0.62 mol solute
Moles of solute = × 0.0550 kg solvent = 0.035 mol
1.00 kg solvent
2. Determine the molar mass from the mass of the solute and the number of moles in that mass.
\(\mathrm{Molar\: mass=\dfrac{4.00\:g}{0.034\:mol}=1.2×10^2\:g/mol}\)
Exercise 11.4.8
A solution of 35.7 g of a nonelectrolyte in 220.0 g of chloroform has a boiling point of 64.5 °C. What is the molar mass of this
compound?
Answer
1.8 × 102 g/mol
A 0.500 L sample of an aqueous solution containing 10.0 g of hemoglobin has an osmotic pressure of 5.9 torr at 22 °C. What is
the molar mass of hemoglobin?
Solution
Here is one set of steps that can be used to solve the problem:
Π = M RT
−3
Π 7.8 × 10 atm
−4
M = = = 3.2 × 10 M
RT (0.08206 L atm/mol K)(295 K)
−4
3.2 × 10 mol
1. moles of hemoglobin = × 0.500 L solution = 1.6 × 10
−4
mol
1 L solution
2. Determine the molar mass from the mass of hemoglobin and the number of moles in that mass.
10.0 g
4
molar mass = = 6.2 × 10 g/mol
−4
1.6 × 10 mol
What is the molar mass of a protein if a solution of 0.02 g of the protein in 25.0 mL of solution has an osmotic pressure of 0.56
torr at 25 °C?
Answer
2.7 × 104 g/mol
The concentration of ions in seawater is approximately the same as that in a solution containing 4.2 g of NaCl dissolved in 125
g of water. Assume that each of the ions in the NaCl solution has the same effect on the freezing point of water as a
nonelectrolyte molecule, and determine the freezing temperature the solution (which is approximately equal to the freezing
temperature of seawater).
Solution
We can solve this problem using the following series of steps.
Convert from grams to moles of NaCl using the molar mass of NaCl in the unit conversion factor. Result: 0.072 mol NaCl
Determine the number of moles of ions present in the solution using the number of moles of ions in 1 mole of NaCl as the
conversion factor (2 mol ions/1 mol NaCl). Result: 0.14 mol ions
Determine the molality of the ions in the solution from the number of moles of ions and the mass of solvent, in kilograms.
Result: 1.1 m
Use the direct proportionality between the change in freezing point and molal concentration to determine how much the
freezing point changes. Result: 2.0 °C
Determine the new freezing point from the freezing point of the pure solvent and the change. Result: −2.0 °C
Check each result as a self-assessment.
Exercise 11.4.10
Assume that each of the ions in calcium chloride, CaCl2, has the same effect on the freezing point of water as a nonelectrolyte
molecule. Calculate the freezing point of a solution of 0.724 g of CaCl2 in 175 g of water.
Answer
−0.208 °C
Assuming complete dissociation, a 1.0 m aqueous solution of NaCl contains 2.0 mole of ions (1.0 mol Na+ and 1.0 mol Cl−) per
each kilogram of water, and its freezing point depression is expected to be
ΔTf = 2.0 mol ions/kg water × 1.86 °C kg water/mol ion = 3.7 °C. (11.4.11)
When this solution is actually prepared and its freezing point depression measured, however, a value of 3.4 °C is obtained. Similar
discrepancies are observed for other ionic compounds, and the differences between the measured and expected colligative property
Values for measured van’t Hoff factors for several solutes, along with predicted values assuming complete dissociation, are shown
in Table 11.4.2.
Table 11.4.2 : Expected and Observed van’t Hoff Factors for Several 0.050 m Aqueous Electrolyte Solutions
Electrolyte Particles in Solution i (Predicted) i (Measured)
MgSO4 Mg2+, SO
2−
4
2 1.3
In 1923, the chemists Peter Debye and Erich Hückel proposed a theory to explain the apparent incomplete ionization of strong
electrolytes. They suggested that although interionic attraction in an aqueous solution is very greatly reduced by solvation of the
ions and the insulating action of the polar solvent, it is not completely nullified. The residual attractions prevent the ions from
behaving as totally independent particles (Figure 11.4.9). In some cases, a positive and negative ion may actually touch, giving a
solvated unit called an ion pair. Thus, the activity, or the effective concentration, of any particular kind of ion is less than that
indicated by the actual concentration. Ions become more and more widely separated the more dilute the solution, and the residual
interionic attractions become less and less. Thus, in extremely dilute solutions, the effective concentrations of the ions (their
activities) are essentially equal to the actual concentrations. Note that the van’t Hoff factors for the electrolytes in Table 11.4.2 are
for 0.05 m solutions, at which concentration the value of i for NaCl is 1.9, as opposed to an ideal value of 2.
Figure 11.4.9 : Ions become more and more widely separated the more dilute the solution, and the residual interionic attractions
become less.
The diagram shows four purple spheres labeled K superscript plus and four green spheres labeled C l superscript minus dispersed in
H subscript 2 O as shown by clusters of single red spheres with two white spheres attached. Red spheres represent oxygen and
white represent hydrogen. In two locations, the purple and green spheres are touching. In these two locations, the diagram is
labeled ion pair. All red and green spheres are surrounded by the white and red H subscript 2 O clusters. The white spheres are
attracted to the purple spheres and the red spheres are attracted to the green spheres.
ΔTb = Kbm
ΔTf = Kfm
Π = MRT
Footnotes
1. A nonelectrolyte shown for comparison.
Glossary
boiling point elevation
elevation of the boiling point of a liquid by addition of a solute
colligative property
property of a solution that depends only on the concentration of a solute species
crenation
process whereby biological cells become shriveled due to loss of water by osmosis
hemolysis
rupture of red blood cells due to the accumulation of excess water by osmosis
hypertonic
of greater osmotic pressure
hypotonic
of less osmotic pressure
ion pair
solvated anion/cation pair held together by moderate electrostatic attraction
isotonic
of equal osmotic pressure
osmosis
diffusion of solvent molecules through a semipermeable membrane
Raoult’s law
the partial pressure exerted by a solution component is equal to the product of the component’s mole fraction in the solution and
its equilibrium vapor pressure in the pure state
semipermeable membrane
a membrane that selectively permits passage of certain ions or molecules
This page titled 11.4: Colligative Properties is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As a child, you may have made suspensions such as mixtures of mud and water, flour and water, or a suspension of solid pigments
in water, known as tempera paint. These suspensions are heterogeneous mixtures composed of relatively large particles that are
visible (or that can be seen with a magnifying glass). They are cloudy, and the suspended particles settle out after mixing. On the
other hand, when we make a solution, we prepare a homogeneous mixture in which no settling occurs and in which the dissolved
species are molecules or ions. Solutions exhibit completely different behavior from suspensions. A solution may be colored, but it
is transparent, the molecules or ions are invisible, and they do not settle out on standing. A group of mixtures called colloids (or
colloidal dispersions) exhibit properties intermediate between those of suspensions and solutions (Figure 11.5.1). The particles in a
colloid are larger than most simple molecules; however, colloidal particles are small enough that they do not settle out upon
standing.
Figure 11.5.1 : (a) A solution is a homogeneous mixture that appears clear, such as the saltwater in this aquarium. (b) In a colloid,
such as milk, the particles are much larger but remain dispersed and do not settle. (c) A suspension, such as mud, is a
heterogeneous mixture of suspended particles that appears cloudy and in which the particles can settle. (credit a photo:
modification of work by Adam Wimsatt; credit b photo: modification of work by Melissa Wiese; credit c photo: modification of
work by Peter Burgess)
This figure contains three photos and correponding particle diagrams. In a, a photo of an aquarium containing fish is shown. The
particle diagram beneath it shows 90 tiny red spheres. In b, a photo is shown of milk being poured into a cup. The corresponding
particle diagram shows about 25 medium sized red spheres.In c, a photo is shown of two pairs of sandal clad feet in mud. The
particle diagram below shows 10 fairly large red spheres.
The particles in a colloid are large enough to scatter light, a phenomenon called the Tyndall effect. This can make colloidal
mixtures appear cloudy or opaque, such as the searchlight beams shown in Figure 11.5.2. Clouds are colloidal mixtures. They are
composed of water droplets that are much larger than molecules, but that are small enough that they do not settle out.
A colloidal gold sol results from the reduction of a very dilute solution of gold(III) chloride by a reducing agent such as
formaldehyde, tin(II) chloride, or iron(II) sulfate:
3+ −
Au +3 e → Au (11.5.2)
Some gold sols prepared in 1857 are still intact (the particles have not coalesced and settled), illustrating the long-term stability of
many colloids.
ashes with hot water. Animal fats contain polyesters of fatty acids (long-chain carboxylic acids). When animal fats are treated with
a base like potassium carbonate or sodium hydroxide, glycerol and salts of fatty acids such as palmitic, oleic, and stearic acid are
formed. The salts of fatty acids are called soaps. The sodium salt of stearic acid, sodium stearate, has the formula C H CO Na 17 35 2
and contains an uncharged nonpolar hydrocarbon chain, the C H − unit, and an ionic carboxylate group, the −CO unit
17 35
−
2
(Figure 11.5.3).
Figure 11.5.3 : Soaps contain a nonpolar hydrocarbon end (blue) and an ionic end (red). The ionic end is a carboxylate group. The
length of the hydrocarbon end can vary from soap to soap.
This figure shows a structural formula for soap known as sodium stearate. A hydrocarbon chain composed of 18 carbon atoms and
35 hydrogen atoms is shown with an ionic end with 2 oxygen atoms and a negative charge. A positively charged N a superscript
plus is also shown at the ionic end.
Detergents (soap substitutes) also contain nonpolar hydrocarbon chains, such as C H —, and an ionic group, such as a sulfate
12 25
— OSO , or a sulfonate — SO (Figure 11.5.4). Soaps form insoluble calcium and magnesium compounds in hard water;
− −
3 3
Figure 11.5.4 : Detergents contain a nonpolar hydrocarbon end (blue) and an ionic end (red). The ionic end can be either a sulfate or
a sulfonate. The length of the hydrocarbon end can vary from detergent to detergent.
This figure shows a structural formula for a detergent known as sodium lauryl sulfate. A hydrocarbon chain composed of 12 carbon
atoms and 25 hydrogen atoms is shown with an ionic end involving a negatively charged sulfur and four oxygen atoms at the ionic
end of the chain. A positively charged N a superscript plus is also shown at the ionic end.
Figure 11.5.5 : This diagrammatic cross section of an emulsified drop of oil in water shows how soap or detergent acts as an
emulsifier.
This figure shows a drop of oil in which approximately thirty hydrocarbon tails are oriented toward the center of the drop with
ionic ends indicated as tiny red spheres on the surface of the oil drop. Solvated cations are indicated as purple spheres surrounded
by clusters of H subscript 2 subscript O molecules shown as tiny clusters of red central oxygen spheres with two white hydrogen
spheres attached.
The blowout of the Deepwater Horizon oil drilling rig on April 20, 2010, in the Gulf of Mexico near Mississippi began the
largest marine oil spill in the history of the petroleum. In the 87 days following the blowout, an estimated 4.9 million barrels
(210 million gallons) of oil flowed from the ruptured well 5000 feet below the water’s surface. The well was finally declared
sealed on September 19, 2010.
Crude oil is immiscible with and less dense than water, so the spilled oil rose to the surface of the water. Floating booms,
skimmer ships, and controlled burns were used to remove oil from the water’s surface in an attempt to protect beaches and
wetlands along the Gulf coast. In addition to removal of the oil, attempts were also made to lessen its environmental impact by
rendering it “soluble” (in the loose sense of the term) and thus allowing it to be diluted to hopefully less harmful levels by the
vast volume of ocean water. This approach used 1.84 million gallons of the oil dispersant Corexit 9527, most of which was
injected underwater at the site of the leak, with small amounts being sprayed on top of the spill. Corexit 9527 contains 2-
butoxyethanol (C6H14O2), an amphiphilic molecule whose polar and nonpolar ends are useful for emulsifying oil into small
droplets, increasing the surface area of the oil and making it more available to marine bacteria for digestion (Figure 11.5.6).
While this approach avoids many of the immediate hazards that bulk oil poses to marine and coastal ecosystems, it introduces
the possibility of long-term effects resulting from the introduction of the complex and potential toxic components of petroleum
into the ocean’s food chain. A number of organizations are involved in monitoring the extended impact of this oil spill,
including the National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration.
Figure 11.5.7 : In a Cottrell precipitator, positively and negatively charged particles are attracted to highly charged electrodes,
where they are neutralized and deposited as dust.
This figure shows a diagram of a Cottrell precipitator. An arrow pointing into a cylindrical chamber shows the path of soot laden
smoke. In the presence of high DC voltage and both point and plate electrodes, soot particles are removed at the bottom of the
chamber and soot free air exits the top. A photo shows the honeycomb electrodes of a modern electrostatic precipitator.
The carbon and dust particles in smoke are often colloidally dispersed and electrically charged. The charged particles are attracted
to highly charged electrodes, where they are neutralized and deposited as dust (Figure 11.5.7. This is one of the important methods
used to clean up the smoke from a variety of industrial processes. The process is also important in the recovery of valuable
products from the smoke and flue dust of smelters, furnaces, and kilns. There are also ionic air filters designed for home use to
improve indoor air quality.
Figure 11.5.8 : Gelatin desserts are colloids in which an aqueous solution of sweeteners and flavors is dispersed throughout a
medium of solid proteins. (credit photo: modification of work by Steven Depolo).
In this figure, a large molecular model of gelatin is shown with black carbon atoms, red oxygen atoms, white hydrogen atoms, and
blue nitrogen atoms. A photo is shown of gelatin dessert cut into colorful rectangles.
Pectin, a carbohydrate from fruit juices, is a gel-forming substance important in jelly making. Silica gel, a colloidal dispersion of
hydrated silicon dioxide, is formed when dilute hydrochloric acid is added to a dilute solution of sodium silicate. Canned Heat is a
gel made by mixing alcohol and a saturated aqueous solution of calcium acetate.
Summary
Colloids are mixtures in which one or more substances are dispersed as relatively large solid particles or liquid droplets throughout
a solid, liquid, or gaseous medium. The particles of a colloid remain dispersed and do not settle due to gravity, and they are often
electrically charged. Colloids are widespread in nature and are involved in many technological applications.
Glossary
amphiphilic
molecules possessing both hydrophobic (nonpolar) and a hydrophilic (polar) parts
colloid
(also, colloidal dispersion) mixture in which relatively large solid or liquid particles are dispersed uniformly throughout a gas,
liquid, or solid
dispersion medium
solid, liquid, or gas in which colloidal particles are dispersed
dispersed phase
substance present as relatively large solid or liquid particles in a colloid
emulsifying agent
emulsion
colloid formed from immiscible liquids
gel
colloidal dispersion of a liquid in a solid
Tyndall effect
scattering of visible light by a colloidal dispersion
This page titled 11.5: Colloids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
11.E.1.2: S11.2.1
A solution can vary in composition, while a compound cannot vary in composition. Solutions are homogeneous at the molecular
level, while other mixtures are heterogeneous.
11.E.1.3: Q11.2.2
Which of the principal characteristics of solutions can we see in the solutions of K 2
Cr O
2 7
shown in
11.E.1.4: S11.2.2
The solutions are the same throughout (the color is constant throughout), and the composition of a solution of K2Cr2O7 in water
can vary.
11.E.1.5: Q11.2.3
When KNO3 is dissolved in water, the resulting solution is significantly colder than the water was originally.
a. Is the dissolution of KNO3 an endothermic or an exothermic process?
b. What conclusions can you draw about the intermolecular attractions involved in the process?
c. Is the resulting solution an ideal solution?
11.E.1.6: S11.2.3
(a) The process is endothermic as the solution is consuming heat. (b) Attraction between the K+ and NO ions is stronger than
−
between the ions and water molecules (the ion-ion interactions have a lower, more negative energy). Therefore, the dissolution
process increases the energy of the molecular interactions, and it consumes the thermal energy of the solution to make up for the
difference. (c) No, an ideal solution is formed with no appreciable heat release or consumption.
11.E.1.7: Q11.2.4
Give an example of each of the following types of solutions:
a. a gas in a liquid
b. a gas in a gas
c. a solid in a solid
11.E.1.8: S11.2.4
(a) CO2 in water; (b) O2 in N2 (air); (c) bronze (solution of tin or other metals in copper)
11.E.1.9: Q11.2.5
Indicate the most important types of intermolecular attractions in each of the following solutions:
a. The solution in Figure.
11.E.1.10: S11.2.5
(a) ion-dipole forces; (b) dipole-dipole forces; (c) dispersion forces; (d) dispersion forces; (e) hydrogen bonding
11.E.1.11: Q11.2.5
Predict whether each of the following substances would be more soluble in water (polar solvent) or in a hydrocarbon such as
heptane (C7H16, nonpolar solvent):
a. vegetable oil (nonpolar)
b. isopropyl alcohol (polar)
c. potassium bromide (ionic)
11.E.1.12: S11.2.5
(a) heptane; (b) water; (c) water
11.E.1.13: Q11.2.6
Heat is released when some solutions form; heat is absorbed when other solutions form. Provide a molecular explanation for the
difference between these two types of spontaneous processes.
11.E.1.14: S11.2.6
Heat is released when the total intermolecular forces (IMFs) between the solute and solvent molecules are stronger than the total
IMFs in the pure solute and in the pure solvent: Breaking weaker IMFs and forming stronger IMFs releases heat. Heat is absorbed
when the total IMFs in the solution are weaker than the total of those in the pure solute and in the pure solvent: Breaking stronger
IMFs and forming weaker IMFs absorbs heat.
11.E.1.15: Q11.2.7
Solutions of hydrogen in palladium may be formed by exposing Pd metal to H2 gas. The concentration of hydrogen in the
palladium depends on the pressure of H2 gas applied, but in a more complex fashion than can be described by Henry’s law. Under
certain conditions, 0.94 g of hydrogen gas is dissolved in 215 g of palladium metal.
a. Determine the molarity of this solution (solution density = 1.8 g/cm3).
b. Determine the molality of this solution (solution density = 1.8 g/cm3).
c. Determine the percent by mass of hydrogen atoms in this solution (solution density = 1.8 g/cm3).
11.E.1.16: S11.2.7
http://cnx.org/contents/mH6aqegx@2/The-Dissolution-Process
11.E.2.2: S11.3.2
Crystals of NaCl dissolve in water, a polar liquid with a very large dipole moment, and the individual ions become strongly
solvated. Hexane is a nonpolar liquid with a dipole moment of zero and, therefore, does not significantly interact with the ions of
the NaCl crystals.
11.E.2.3: Q11.3.2
Explain why solutions of HBr in benzene (a nonpolar solvent) are nonconductive, while solutions in water (a polar solvent) are
conductive.
11.E.2.5: Q11.3.3
Consider the solutions presented:
(a) Which of the following sketches best represents the ions in a solution of Fe(NO3)3(aq)?
(b) Write a balanced chemical equation showing the products of the dissolution of Fe(NO3)3.
11.E.2.6: S11.3.3
(a) Fe(NO3)3 is a strong electrolyte, thus it should completely dissociate into Fe3+ and (NO −
3
) ions. Therefore, (z) best represents
the solution. (b) Fe(NO ) (s) ⟶ Fe (aq) + 3 NO (aq)
3 3
3+ −
11.E.2.7: Q11.3.4
Compare the processes that occur when methanol (CH3OH), hydrogen chloride (HCl), and sodium hydroxide (NaOH) dissolve in
water. Write equations and prepare sketches showing the form in which each of these compounds is present in its respective
solution.
11.E.2.8: S11.3.3
Methanol, C H 3 OH , dissolves in water in all proportions, interacting via hydrogen bonding.
Methanol:
Hydrogen chloride, HCl, dissolves in and reacts with water to yield hydronium cations and chloride anions that are solvated by
strong ion-dipole interactions.
Hydrogen chloride:
+ −
H C l(g) + H2 O(l) → H3 O + Cl (11.E.2)
(aq) (aq)
Sodium hydroxide, NaOH, dissolves in water and dissociates to yield sodium cations and hydroxide anions that are strongly
solvated by ion-dipole interactions and hydrogen bonding, respectively.
Sodium hydroxide:
+ −
N aOH(s) → N a + OH (11.E.3)
(aq) (aq)
11.E.2.10: S11.3.5
(a) high conductivity (solute is an ionic compound that will dissociate when dissolved); (b) high conductivity (solute is a strong
acid and will ionize completely when dissolved); (c) nonconductive (solute is a covalent compound, neither acid nor base,
unreactive towards water); (d) low conductivity (solute is a weak base and will partially ionize when dissolved)
11.E.2.11: Q11.3.6
Why are most solid ionic compounds electrically nonconductive, whereas aqueous solutions of ionic compounds are good
conductors? Would you expect a liquid (molten) ionic compound to be electrically conductive or nonconductive? Explain.
11.E.2.12: S11.3.6
A medium must contain freely mobile, charged entities to be electrically conductive. The ions present in a typical ionic solid are
immobilized in a crystalline lattice and so the solid is not able to support an electrical current. When the ions are mobilized, either
by melting the solid or dissolving it in water to dissociate the ions, current may flow and these forms of the ionic compound are
conductive.
11.E.2.13: Q11.3.7
Indicate the most important type of intermolecular attraction responsible for solvation in each of the following solutions:
a. the solutions in Figure
b. methanol, CH3OH, dissolved in ethanol, C2H5OH
c. methane, CH4, dissolved in benzene, C6H6
d. the polar halocarbon CF2Cl2 dissolved in the polar halocarbon CF2ClCFCl2
e. O2(l) in N2(l)
11.E.2.14: S11.3.7
(a) ion-dipole; (b) hydrogen bonds; (c) dispersion forces; (d) dipole-dipole attractions; (e) dispersion forces
11.E.3.2: S11.4.1
Add a small crystal of N a S O . It will dissolve in an unsaturated solution, remain apparently unchanged in a saturated solution,
2 2 3
11.E.3.3: Q11.4.2
Supersaturated solutions of most solids in water are prepared by cooling saturated solutions. Supersaturated solutions of most gases
in water are prepared by heating saturated solutions. Explain the reasons for the difference in the two procedures.
11.E.3.4: S11.4.2
The solubility of solids usually decreases upon cooling a solution, while the solubility of gases usually decreases upon heating.
11.E.3.5: Q11.4.3
Suggest an explanation for the observations that ethanol, C2H5OH, is completely miscible with water and that ethanethiol,
C2H5SH, is soluble only to the extent of 1.5 g per 100 mL of water.
11.E.3.7: Q11.4.4
Calculate the percent by mass of KBr in a saturated solution of KBr in water at 10 °C using the following figure for useful data,
and report the computed percentage to one significant digit.
This graph shows how the solubility of several solids changes with temperature.
11.E.3.8: S11.4.4
At 10 °C, the solubility of KBr in water is approximately 60 g per 100 g of water.
60 g KBr
% KBr = = 40% (11.E.4)
(60 + 100) g solution
11.E.3.9: Q11.4.5
Which of the following gases is expected to be most soluble in water? Explain your reasoning.
a. CH4
b. CCl4
c. CHCl3
11.E.3.10: S11.4.5
(c) CHCl3 is expected to be most soluble in water. Of the three gases, only this one is polar and thus capable of experiencing
relatively strong dipole-dipole attraction to water molecules.
11.E.3.11: Q11.4.6
At 0 °C and 1.00 atm, as much as 0.70 g of O2 can dissolve in 1 L of water. At 0 °C and 4.00 atm, how many grams of O2 dissolve
in 1 L of water?
11.E.3.12: S11.4.6
This problem requires the application of Henry’s law. The governing equation is C g = kPg .
Cg 0.70 g
−1
k = = = 0.70 g atm (11.E.5)
Pg 1.00 atm
a. How did the concentration of dissolved CO2 in the beverage change when the bottle was opened?
b. What caused this change?
c. Is the beverage unsaturated, saturated, or supersaturated with CO2?
11.E.3.14: S11.4.7
(a) It decreased as some of the CO2 gas left the solution (evidenced by effervescence). (b) Opening the bottle released the high-
pressure CO2 gas above the beverage. The reduced CO2 gas pressure, per Henry’s law, lowers the solubility for CO2. (c) The
dissolved CO2 concentration will continue to slowly decrease until equilibrium is reestablished between the beverage and the very
low CO2 gas pressure in the opened bottle. Immediately after opening, the beverage, therefore, contains dissolved CO2 at a
concentration greater than its solubility, a nonequilibrium condition, and is said to be supersaturated.
11.E.3.15: Q11.4.8
The Henry’s law constant for CO2 is 3.4 × 10 M /atm at 25 °C. What pressure of carbon dioxide is needed to maintain a CO2
−2
11.E.3.16: S11.4.8
Cg 0.10 M
Pg = = = 2.9 atm (11.E.6)
−2
k 3.4 × 10 M /atm
11.E.3.17: Q11.4.9
The Henry’s law constant for O2 is 1.3 × 10 M /atm at 25 °C. What mass of oxygen would be dissolved in a 40-L aquarium at
−3
25 °C, assuming an atmospheric pressure of 1.00 atm, and that the partial pressure of O2 is 0.21 atm?
11.E.3.18: S11.4.9
Start with Henry's law
Cg = kPg (11.E.7)
and apply it to O 2
−3 −4
C (O2 ) = (1.3 × 10 M /atm)(0.21 atm) = 2.7 × 10 mol/L (11.E.8)
The total amount is \((2.7 \times 10^{−4}\; mol/L)(40\;L=1.08 \times 10^{−2} \;mol\]
11.E.3.19: Q11.4.10
How many liters of HCl gas, measured at 30.0 °C and 745 torr, are required to prepare 1.25 L of a 3.20-M solution of hydrochloric
acid?
11.E.3.20: S11.4.10
First, calculate the moles of HCl needed. Then use the ideal gas law to find the volume required.
M = mol L−1
3.20M=xmol1.25L
x = 4.00 mol HCl
Before using the ideal gas law, change pressure to atmospheres and convert temperature from °C to kelvin.
\[1\;atmx=760torr745torr
x = 0.9803 atm
V=nRTP=(4.000molHCl)(0.08206LatmK−1mol−1)(303.15K)0.9803atm=102 L HCl
102 L HCl
more http://cnx.org/contents/2488fW6W@2/Solubility
11.E.4.2: Q11.5.2
What is the microscopic explanation for the macroscopic behavior illustrated in [link]?
11.E.4.3: S11.5.2
The strength of the bonds between like molecules is stronger than the strength between unlike molecules. Therefore, some regions
will exist in which the water molecules will exclude oil molecules and other regions will exist in which oil molecules will exclude
water molecules, forming a heterogeneous region.
11.E.4.4: Q11.5.3
Sketch a qualitative graph of the pressure versus time for water vapor above a sample of pure water and a sugar solution, as the
liquids evaporate to half their original volume.
11.E.4.5: Q11.5.4
A solution of potassium nitrate, an electrolyte, and a solution of glycerin (C3H5(OH)3), a nonelectrolyte, both boil at 100.3 °C.
What other physical properties of the two solutions are identical?
11.E.4.6: S11.5.4
Both form homogeneous solutions; their boiling point elevations are the same, as are their lowering of vapor pressures. Osmotic
pressure and the lowering of the freezing point are also the same for both solutions.
11.E.4.7: Q11.5.5
What are the mole fractions of H3PO4 and water in a solution of 14.5 g of H3PO4 in 125 g of water?
11.E.4.9: S11.5.6
a. Find number of moles of HNO3 and H2O in 100 g of the solution. Find the mole fractions for the components.
b. The mole fraction of HNO3 is 0.378. The mole fraction of H2O is 0.622.
11.E.4.10: Q11.5.7
Calculate the mole fraction of each solute and solvent:
a. 583 g of H2SO4 in 1.50 kg of water—the acid solution used in an automobile battery
b. 0.86 g of NaCl in 1.00 × 102 g of water—a solution of sodium chloride for intravenous injection
c. 46.85 g of codeine, C18H21NO3, in 125.5 g of ethanol, C2H5OH
d. 25 g of I2 in 125 g of ethanol, C2H5OH
11.E.4.11: S11.5.7
1 mole H SO
a. 583 g H SO
2 4
×
2 4
= 5.94 mole H SO
2 4
98.08 g H SO
2 4
1000 g 1 mole H O
2
1.50 kg H O × × = 83.2 moles H O
2 2
1 kg 18.02 g H O
2
11.E.4.12: Q11.5.8
Calculate the mole fraction of each solute and solvent:
a. 0.710 kg of sodium carbonate (washing soda), Na2CO3, in 10.0 kg of water—a saturated solution at 0 °C
b. 125 g of NH4NO3 in 275 g of water—a mixture used to make an instant ice pack
c. 25 g of Cl2 in 125 g of dichloromethane, CH2Cl2
d. 0.372 g of histamine, C5H9N, in 125 g of chloroform, CHCl3
11.E.4.13: S11.5.8
a. X = 0.0119; X
Na2 C O3 H2 O = 0.988 ;
b. XNH4 NO3= 0.9927; X H2 O = 0.907 ;
c. X = 0.192; X
Cl2 C H2 C I2 = 0.808 ;
d. X = 0.00426; X
C5 H9 N CHCl3 = 0.997
11.E.4.14: Q11.5.9
Calculate the mole fractions of methanol, CH3OH; ethanol, C2H5OH; and water in a solution that is 40% methanol, 40% ethanol,
and 20% water by mass. (Assume the data are good to two significant figures.)
11.E.4.15: Q11.5.10
What is the difference between a 1 M solution and a 1 m solution?
11.E.4.16: S11.5.10
In a 1 M solution, the mole is contained in exactly 1 L of solution. In a 1 m solution, the mole is contained in exactly 1 kg of
solvent.
11.E.4.17: Q11.5.11
What is the molality of phosphoric acid, H3PO4, in a solution of 14.5 g of H3PO4 in 125 g of water?
11.E.4.18: Q11.5.12
What is the molality of nitric acid in a concentrated solution of nitric acid (68.0% HNO3 by mass)?
11.E.4.19: S11.5.12
(a) Determine the molar mass of HNO3. Determine the number of moles of acid in the solution. From the number of moles and the
mass of solvent, determine the molality. (b) 33.7 m
11.E.4.21: Q11.5.14
Calculate the molality of each of the following solutions:
a. 0.710 kg of sodium carbonate (washing soda), Na2CO3, in 10.0 kg of water—a saturated solution at 0°C
b. 125 g of NH4NO3 in 275 g of water—a mixture used to make an instant ice pack
c. 25 g of Cl2 in 125 g of dichloromethane, CH2Cl2
d. 0.372 g of histamine, C5H9N, in 125 g of chloroform, CHCl3
11.E.4.22: S11.5.14
(a) 6.70 × 10−1 m; (b) 5.67 m; (c) 2.8 m; (d) 0.0358 m
11.E.4.23: Q11.5.15
75 mg
The concentration of glucose, C6H12O6, in normal spinal fluid is . What is the molality of the solution?
100 g
11.E.4.24: Q11.5.16
A 13.0% solution of K2CO3 by mass has a density of 1.09 g/cm3. Calculate the molality of the solution.
11.E.4.25: S11.5.16
1.08 m
11.E.4.26: Q11.5.17
a. Why does 1 mol of sodium chloride depress the freezing point of 1 kg of water almost twice as much as 1 mol of glycerin?
b. What is the boiling point of a solution of 115.0 g of sucrose, C12H22O11, in 350.0 g of water?
11.E.4.27: S11.5.17
a. Determine the molar mass of sucrose; determine the number of moles of sucrose in the solution; convert the mass of solvent to
units of kilograms; from the number of moles and the mass of solvent, determine the molality; determine the difference between
the boiling point of water and the boiling point of the solution; determine the new boiling point.
b. 100.5 °C
11.E.4.28: Q11.5.18
What is the boiling point of a solution of 9.04 g of I2 in 75.5 g of benzene, assuming the I2 is nonvolatile?
11.E.4.29: Q11.5.19
What is the freezing temperature of a solution of 115.0 g of sucrose, C12H22O11, in 350.0 g of water, which freezes at 0.0 °C when
pure?
11.E.4.30: S11.5.19
(a) Determine the molar mass of sucrose; determine the number of moles of sucrose in the solution; convert the mass of solvent to
units of kilograms; from the number of moles and the mass of solvent, determine the molality; determine the difference between
the freezing temperature of water and the freezing temperature of the solution; determine the new freezing temperature. (b) −1.8 °C
11.E.4.31: Q11.5.20
What is the freezing point of a solution of 9.04 g of I2 in 75.5 g of benzene?
11.E.4.33: S11.5.21
(a) Determine the molar mass of Ca(NO3)2; determine the number of moles of Ca(NO3)2 in the solution; determine the number of
moles of ions in the solution; determine the molarity of ions, then the osmotic pressure. (b) 2.67 atm
11.E.4.34: Q11.5.22
What is osmotic pressure of a solution of bovine insulin (molar mass, 5700 g mol−1) at 18 °C if 100.0 mL of the solution contains
0.103 g of the insulin?
11.E.4.35: Q11.5.23
What is the molar mass of a solution of 5.00 g of a compound in 25.00 g of carbon tetrachloride (bp 76.8 °C; Kb = 5.02 °C/m) that
boils at 81.5 °C at 1 atm?
11.E.4.36: S11.5.24
(a) Determine the molal concentration from the change in boiling point and Kb; determine the moles of solute in the solution from
the molal concentration and mass of solvent; determine the molar mass from the number of moles and the mass of solute. (b) 2.1 ×
102 g mol−1
11.E.4.37: Q11.5.25
A sample of an organic compound (a nonelectrolyte) weighing 1.35 g lowered the freezing point of 10.0 g of benzene by 3.66 °C.
Calculate the molar mass of the compound.
11.E.4.38: Q11.5.26
A 1.0 m solution of HCl in benzene has a freezing point of 0.4 °C. Is HCl an electrolyte in benzene? Explain.
11.E.4.39: S11.5.26
No. Pure benzene freezes at 5.5 °C, and so the observed freezing point of this solution is depressed by ΔTf = 5.5 − 0.4 = 5.1 °C.
The value computed, assuming no ionization of HCl, is ΔTf = (1.0 m)(5.14 °C/m) = 5.1 °C. Agreement of these values supports the
assumption that HCl is not ionized.
11.E.4.40: Q11.5.27
A solution contains 5.00 g of urea, CO(NH2)2, a nonvolatile compound, dissolved in 0.100 kg of water. If the vapor pressure of
pure water at 25 °C is 23.7 torr, what is the vapor pressure of the solution?
11.E.4.41: Q11.5.28
A 12.0-g sample of a nonelectrolyte is dissolved in 80.0 g of water. The solution freezes at −1.94 °C. Calculate the molar mass of
the substance.
11.E.4.42: S11.5.28
144 g mol−1
11.E.4.43: Q11.5.29
Arrange the following solutions in order by their decreasing freezing points: 0.1 m Na3PO4, 0.1 m C2H5OH, 0.01 m CO2, 0.15 m
NaCl, and 0.2 m CaCl2.
11.E.4.44: Q11.5.30
Calculate the boiling point elevation of 0.100 kg of water containing 0.010 mol of NaCl, 0.020 mol of Na2SO4, and 0.030 mol of
MgCl2, assuming complete dissociation of these electrolytes.
11.E.4.46: Q11.5.31
How could you prepare a 3.08 m aqueous solution of glycerin, C3H8O3? What is the freezing point of this solution?
11.E.4.47: Q11.5.32
A sample of sulfur weighing 0.210 g was dissolved in 17.8 g of carbon disulfide, CS2 (Kb = 2.43 °C/m). If the boiling point
elevation was 0.107 °C, what is the formula of a sulfur molecule in carbon disulfide?
11.E.4.48: S11.5.32
S8
11.E.4.49: Q11.5.33
In a significant experiment performed many years ago, 5.6977 g of cadmium iodide in 44.69 g of water raised the boiling point
0.181 °C. What does this suggest about the nature of a solution of CdI2?
11.E.4.50: Q11.5.34
Lysozyme is an enzyme that cleaves cell walls. A 0.100-L sample of a solution of lysozyme that contains 0.0750 g of the enzyme
exhibits an osmotic pressure of 1.32 × 10−3 atm at 25 °C. What is the molar mass of lysozyme?
11.E.4.51: S11.5.34
1.39 × 104 g mol−1
11.E.4.52: Q11.5.35
The osmotic pressure of a solution containing 7.0 g of insulin per liter is 23 torr at 25 °C. What is the molar mass of insulin?
11.E.4.53: Q11.5.36
The osmotic pressure of human blood is 7.6 atm at 37 °C. What mass of glucose, C6H12O6, is required to make 1.00 L of aqueous
solution for intravenous feeding if the solution must have the same osmotic pressure as blood at body temperature, 37 °C?
11.E.4.54: S11.5.36
54 g
11.E.4.55: Q11.5.37
What is the freezing point of a solution of dibromobenzene, C6H4Br2, in 0.250 kg of benzene, if the solution boils at 83.5 °C?
11.E.4.56: Q11.5.38
What is the boiling point of a solution of NaCl in water if the solution freezes at −0.93 °C?
11.E.4.57: S11.5.38
100.26 °C
11.E.4.58: Q11.5.39
The sugar fructose contains 40.0% C, 6.7% H, and 53.3% O by mass. A solution of 11.7 g of fructose in 325 g of ethanol has a
boiling point of 78.59 °C. The boiling point of ethanol is 78.35 °C, and Kb for ethanol is 1.20 °C/m. What is the molecular formula
of fructose?
11.E.4.59: Q11.5.40
The vapor pressure of methanol, CH3OH, is 94 torr at 20 °C. The vapor pressure of ethanol, C2H5OH, is 44 torr at the same
temperature.
a. Calculate the mole fraction of methanol and of ethanol in a solution of 50.0 g of methanol and 50.0 g of ethanol.
b. Ethanol and methanol form a solution that behaves like an ideal solution. Calculate the vapor pressure of methanol and of
ethanol above the solution at 20 °C.
11.E.4.60: S11.5.40
(a) XC H3 OH ;
= 0.590 XC2 H5 OH = 0.410 ; (b) Vapor pressures are: CH3OH: 55 torr; C2H5OH: 18 torr; (c) CH3OH: 0.75; C2H5OH:
0.25
11.E.4.61: Q11.5.41
The triple point of air-free water is defined as 273.15 K. Why is it important that the water be free of air?
11.E.4.62: Q11.5.42
Meat can be classified as fresh (not frozen) even though it is stored at −1 °C. Why wouldn’t meat freeze at this temperature?
11.E.4.63: S11.5.42
The ions and compounds present in the water in the beef lower the freezing point of the beef below −1 °C.
11.E.4.64: Q11.5.43
An organic compound has a composition of 93.46% C and 6.54% H by mass. A solution of 0.090 g of this compound in 1.10 g of
camphor melts at 158.4 °C. The melting point of pure camphor is 178.4 °C. Kf for camphor is 37.7 °C/m. What is the molecular
formula of the solute? Show your calculations.
11.E.4.65: Q11.5.44
A sample of HgCl2 weighing 9.41 g is dissolved in 32.75 g of ethanol, C2H5OH (Kb = 1.20 °C/m). The boiling point elevation of
the solution is 1.27 °C. Is HgCl2 an electrolyte in ethanol? Show your calculations.
11.E.4.66: S11.5.44
1 mol HgCl2
⎛ 9.41 g × ⎞
⎜ 271.496 g ⎟
Δbp = Kb m = (1.20 °C/m)⎜ ⎟ = 1.27 °C
⎜ 0.03275 kg ⎟
⎝ ⎠
The observed change equals the theoretical change; therefore, no dissociation occurs.
11.E.4.67: Q11.5.45
A salt is known to be an alkali metal fluoride. A quick approximate determination of freezing point indicates that 4 g of the salt
dissolved in 100 g of water produces a solution that freezes at about −1.4 °C. What is the formula of the salt? Show your
calculations.
11.E.5.2: S11.6.1
Colloidal System Dispersed Phase Dispersion Medium
11.E.5.3: Q11.6.2
Distinguish between dispersion methods and condensation methods for preparing colloidal systems.
11.E.5.4: S11.6.2
Dispersion methods use a grinding device or some other means to bring about the subdivision of larger particles. Condensation
methods bring smaller units together to form a larger unit. For example, water molecules in the vapor state come together to form
very small droplets that we see as clouds.
11.E.5.5: Q11.6.3
How do colloids differ from solutions with regard to dispersed particle size and homogeneity?
11.E.5.6: S11.6.3
Colloidal dispersions consist of particles that are much bigger than the solutes of typical solutions. Colloidal particles are either
very large molecules or aggregates of smaller species that usually are big enough to scatter light. Colloids are homogeneous on a
macroscopic (visual) scale, while solutions are homogeneous on a microscopic (molecular) scale.
11.E.5.7: Q11.6.4
Explain the cleansing action of soap.
11.E.5.8: S11.6.4
Soap molecules have both a hydrophobic and a hydrophilic end. The charged (hydrophilic) end, which is usually associated with an
alkali metal ion, ensures water solubility The hydrophobic end permits attraction to oil, grease, and other similar nonpolar
substances that normally do not dissolve in water but are pulled into the solution by the soap molecules.
11.E.5.9: Q11.6.5
How can it be demonstrated that colloidal particles are electrically charged?
11.E.5.10: S11.6.5
If they are placed in an electrolytic cell, dispersed particles will move toward the electrode that carries a charge opposite to their
own charge. At this electrode, the charged particles will be neutralized and will coagulate as a precipitate.
This page titled 11.E: Solutions and Colloids (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Thumbnail: Molecular collisions frequency. (Public Domain; Sadi Carnot via Wikipedia)
This page titled 12: Kinetics is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that
was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
12.0: Prelude to Kinetics
The lizard in the photograph is not simply enjoying the sunshine or working on its tan. The heat from the sun’s rays is critical to the
lizard’s survival. A warm lizard can move faster than a cold one because the chemical reactions that allow its muscles to move
occur more rapidly at higher temperatures. In the absence of warmth, the lizard is an easy meal for predators.
Figure 12.0.1 : An agama lizard basks in the sun. As its body warms, the chemical reactions of its metabolism speed up.
From baking a cake to determining the useful lifespan of a bridge, rates of chemical reactions play important roles in our
understanding of processes that involve chemical changes. When planning to run a chemical reaction, we should ask at least two
questions. The first is: “Will the reaction produce the desired products in useful quantities?” The second question is: “How rapidly
will the reaction occur?” A reaction that takes 50 years to produce a product is about as useful as one that never gives a product at
all. A third question is often asked when investigating reactions in greater detail: “What specific molecular-level processes take
place as the reaction occurs?” Knowing the answer to this question is of practical importance when the yield or rate of a reaction
needs to be controlled.
The study of chemical kinetics concerns the second and third questions—that is, the rate at which a reaction yields products and the
molecular-scale means by which a reaction occurs. In this chapter, we will examine the factors that influence the rates of chemical
reactions, the mechanisms by which reactions proceed, and the quantitative techniques used to determine and describe the rate at
which reactions occur.
Paul Flowers (University of North Carolina - Pembroke), Klaus Theopold (University of Delaware) and Richard Langley
(Stephen F. Austin State University) with contributing authors. Textbook content produced by OpenStax College is licensed
under a Creative Commons Attribution License 4.0 license. Download for free at http://cnx.org/contents/85abf193-
2bd...a7ac8df6@9.110).
This page titled 12.0: Prelude to Kinetics is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
A rate is a measure of how some property varies with time. Speed is a familiar rate that expresses the distance traveled by an object
in a given amount of time. Wage is a rate that represents the amount of money earned by a person working for a given amount of
time. Likewise, the rate of a chemical reaction is a measure of how much reactant is consumed, or how much product is produced,
by the reaction in a given amount of time.
The rate of reaction is the change in the amount of a reactant or product per unit time. Reaction rates are therefore determined by
measuring the time dependence of some property that can be related to reactant or product amounts. Rates of reactions that
consume or produce gaseous substances, for example, are conveniently determined by measuring changes in volume or pressure.
For reactions involving one or more colored substances, rates may be monitored via measurements of light absorption. For
reactions involving aqueous electrolytes, rates may be measured via changes in a solution’s conductivity.
For reactants and products in solution, their relative amounts (concentrations) are conveniently used for purposes of expressing
reaction rates. If we measure the concentration of hydrogen peroxide, H2O2, in an aqueous solution, we find that it changes slowly
over time as the H2O2 decomposes, according to the equation:
The rate at which the hydrogen peroxide decomposes can be expressed in terms of the rate of change of its concentration, as shown
here:
change in concentration of reactant
rate of decomposition of H O =−
2 2
time interval
[ H O ]t − [ H O ]t
2 2 2 2 2 1
=−
t2 − t1
Δ[ H O ]
2 2
=−
Δt
This mathematical representation of the change in species concentration over time is the rate expression for the reaction. The
brackets indicate molar concentrations, and the symbol delta (Δ) indicates “change in.” Thus, [H O ] represents the molar
2 2 t1
concentration of hydrogen peroxide at some time t1; likewise, [H O ] represents the molar concentration of hydrogen peroxide at
2 2 t2
a later time t2; and Δ[H2O2] represents the change in molar concentration of hydrogen peroxide during the time interval Δt (that is,
t2 − t1). Since the reactant concentration decreases as the reaction proceeds, Δ[H2O2] is a negative quantity; we place a negative
sign in front of the expression because reaction rates are, by convention, positive quantities. Figure 12.1.1 provides an example of
data collected during the decomposition of H2O2.
Figure 12.1.1 : The rate of decomposition of H2O2 in an aqueous solution decreases as the concentration of H2O2 decreases.
To obtain the tabulated results for this decomposition, the concentration of hydrogen peroxide was measured every 6 hours over the
course of a day at a constant temperature of 40 °C. Reaction rates were computed for each time interval by dividing the change in
concentration by the corresponding time increment, as shown here for the first 6-hour period:
Notice that the reaction rates vary with time, decreasing as the reaction proceeds. Results for the last 6-hour period yield a reaction
rate of:
−Δ[ H O ] −(0.0625 mol/L − 0.125 mol/L)
2 2 −1 −1
= = 0.0104 mol L h
Δt (24.00 h − 18.00 h)
This behavior indicates the reaction continually slows with time. Using the concentrations at the beginning and end of a time period
over which the reaction rate is changing results in the calculation of an average rate for the reaction over this time interval. At any
specific time, the rate at which a reaction is proceeding is known as its instantaneous rate. The instantaneous rate of a reaction at
“time zero,” when the reaction commences, is its initial rate. Consider the analogy of a car slowing down as it approaches a stop
sign. The vehicle’s initial rate—analogous to the beginning of a chemical reaction—would be the speedometer reading at the
moment the driver begins pressing the brakes (t0). A few moments later, the instantaneous rate at a specific moment—call it t1—
would be somewhat slower, as indicated by the speedometer reading at that point in time. As time passes, the instantaneous rate
will continue to fall until it reaches zero, when the car (or reaction) stops. Unlike instantaneous speed, the car’s average speed is
not indicated by the speedometer; but it can be calculated as the ratio of the distance traveled to the time required to bring the
vehicle to a complete stop (Δt). Like the decelerating car, the average rate of a chemical reaction will fall somewhere between its
initial and final rates.
The instantaneous rate of a reaction may be determined one of two ways. If experimental conditions permit the measurement of
concentration changes over very short time intervals, then average rates computed as described earlier provide reasonably good
approximations of instantaneous rates. Alternatively, a graphical procedure may be used that, in effect, yields the results that would
be obtained if short time interval measurements were possible. If we plot the concentration of hydrogen peroxide against time, the
instantaneous rate of decomposition of H2O2 at any time t is given by the slope of a straight line that is tangent to the curve at that
time (Figure 12.1.2). We can use calculus to evaluating the slopes of such tangent lines, but the procedure for doing so is beyond
the scope of this chapter.
Figure 12.1.1 : This graph shows a plot of concentration versus time for a 1.000 M solution of H2O2. The rate at any instant is equal
to the opposite of the slope of a line tangential to this curve at that time. Tangents are shown at t = 0 h (“initial rate”) and at t = 10 h
(“instantaneous rate” at that particular time).
Physicians often use disposable test strips to measure the amounts of various substances in a patient’s urine (Figure 12.1.2).
These test strips contain various chemical reagents, embedded in small pads at various locations along the strip, which undergo
changes in color upon exposure to sufficient concentrations of specific substances. The usage instructions for test strips often
stress that proper read time is critical for optimal results. This emphasis on read time suggests that kinetic aspects of the
chemical reactions occurring on the test strip are important considerations.
The test for urinary glucose relies on a two-step process represented by the chemical equations shown here:
C H O +O −−−−→ C H O +H O (12.1.1)
6 12 6 2 6 10 6 2 2
catalyst
−
2H O +2 I −−−−→ I +2 H O+O (12.1.2)
2 2 2 2 2
catalyst
Figure 12.1.2 : Test strips are commonly used to detect the presence of specific substances in a person’s urine. Many test strips
have several pads containing various reagents to permit the detection of multiple substances on a single strip. (credit: Iqbal
Osman).
The stoichiometric factors derived from this equation may be used to relate reaction rates in the same manner that they are used to
related reactant and product amounts. The relation between the reaction rates expressed in terms of nitrogen production and
ammonia consumption, for example, is:
Δmol NH3 1 mol N2 Δmol N2
− × =
Δt 2 mol NH3 Δt
We can express this more simply without showing the stoichiometric factor’s units:
1 Δmol NH3 Δmol N2
− =
2 Δt Δt
Note that a negative sign has been added to account for the opposite signs of the two amount changes (the reactant amount is
decreasing while the product amount is increasing). If the reactants and products are present in the same solution, the molar
amounts may be replaced by concentrations:
1 Δ[ NH3 ] Δ[ N ]
2
− =
2 Δt Δt
Similarly, the rate of formation of H2 is three times the rate of formation of N2 because three moles of H2 form during the time
required for the formation of one mole of N2:
1 Δ[ H2 ] Δ[ N ]
2
=
3 Δt Δt
Figure 12.1.3 : This graph shows the changes in concentrations of the reactants and products during the reaction
2 NH ⟶ N + 3 H . The rates of change of the three concentrations are related by their stoichiometric factors, as shown by the
3 2 2
The first step in the production of nitric acid is the combustion of ammonia:
Write the equations that relate the rates of consumption of the reactants and the rates of formation of the products.
Solution
Considering the stoichiometry of this homogeneous reaction, the rates for the consumption of reactants and formation of
products are:
1 Δ[ NH3 ] 1 Δ[ O2 ] 1 Δ[NO] 1 Δ[ H2 O]
− =− = =
4 Δt 5 Δt 4 Δt 6 Δt
Exercise 12.1.1
The rate of formation of Br2 is 6.0 × 10−6 mol/L/s in a reaction described by the following net ionic equation:
− − +
5 Br + BrO 3 + 6 H ⟶ 3 Br +3 H O
2 2
Write the equations that relate the rates of consumption of the reactants and the rates of formation of the products.
Answer
− − +
1 Δ[ Br ] Δ[ BrO ] 1 Δ[ H ] 1 Δ[ Br 2 ] 1 Δ[ H2 O]
3
− =− =− = =
5 Δt Δt 6 Δt 3 Δt 3 Δt
The graph in Figure 12.1.3 shows the rate of the decomposition of H2O2 over time:
2H O ⟶ 2 H O+O
2 2 2 2
Based on these data, the instantaneous rate of decomposition of H2O2 at t = 11.1 h is determined to be 3.20 × 10−2 mol/L/h,
that is:
Δ[ H O ]
2 2 −2 −1 −1
− = 3.20 × 10 mol L h
Δt
Solution
Using the stoichiometry of the reaction, we may determine that:
1 Δ[ H2 O2 ] 1 Δ[ H2 O] Δ[ O ]
2
− = =
2 Δt 2 Δt Δt
Therefore:
1 Δ[ O ]
−2 −1 −1 2
× 3.20 × 10 mol L h =
2 Δt
and
Δ[ O ]
2 −2 −1 −1
= 1.60 × 10 mol L h
Δt
Exercise 12.1.2
If the rate of decomposition of ammonia, NH3, at 1150 K is 2.10 × 10−6 mol/L/s, what is the rate of production of nitrogen and
hydrogen?
Answer
1.05 × 10−6 mol/L/s, N2 and 3.15 × 10−6 mol/L/s, H2.
Summary
The rate of a reaction can be expressed either in terms of the decrease in the amount of a reactant or the increase in the amount of a
product per unit time. Relations between different rate expressions for a given reaction are derived directly from the stoichiometric
coefficients of the equation representing the reaction.
Glossary
average rate
rate of a chemical reaction computed as the ratio of a measured change in amount or concentration of substance to the time
interval over which the change occurred
initial rate
instantaneous rate of a chemical reaction at t = 0 s (immediately after the reaction has begun)
instantaneous rate
rate of a chemical reaction at any instant in time, determined by the slope of the line tangential to a graph of concentration as a
function of time
rate expression
mathematical representation relating reaction rate to changes in amount, concentration, or pressure of reactant or product
species per unit time
This page titled 12.1: Chemical Reaction Rates is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The rates at which reactants are consumed and products are formed during chemical reactions vary greatly. We can identify five factors that affect
the rates of chemical reactions: the chemical nature of the reacting substances, the state of subdivision (one large lump versus many small particles)
of the reactants, the temperature of the reactants, the concentration of the reactants, and the presence of a catalyst.
Figure 12.2.1 : (a) Iron powder reacts rapidly with dilute hydrochloric acid and produces bubbles of hydrogen gas because the powder has a large
total area: 2Fe(s) + 6HCl(aq) ⟶ 2FeCl3(aq) + 3H2(g). (surfaceb) An iron nail reacts more slowly.
This figure shows two photos labeled (a) and (b). Photo (a) shows the bottom of a test tube. The test tube is filled with a dark gas, and there is a dark
substance and bubbles in the bottom. Photo (b) shows a rod and bubbles in a test tube similar to photo (a), but the gas in the test tube is not as dark.
Video 12.2.1 : The reaction of cesium with water in slow motion and a discussion of how the state of reactants and particle size affect reaction
rates.
reaction depends on the amount of sulfur dioxide in the air (Figure 12.2.2). As an acidic oxide, sulfur dioxide combines with water vapor in the air
to produce sulfurous acid in the following reaction:
In a polluted atmosphere where the concentration of sulfur dioxide is high, calcium carbonate deteriorates more rapidly than in less polluted air.
Similarly, phosphorus burns much more rapidly in an atmosphere of pure oxygen than in air, which is only about 20% oxygen.
Figure 12.2.2 : Statues made from carbonate compounds such as limestone and marble typically weather slowly over time due to the actions of water,
and thermal expansion and contraction. However, pollutants like sulfur dioxide can accelerate weathering. As the concentration of air pollutants
increases, deterioration of limestone occurs more rapidly. (credit: James P Fisher III).
A photograph is shown of an angel statue. While some details of the statue, including facial features, are present, effects of weathering appear to be
diminishing these features.
Video 12.2.2 : Phosphorous burns rapidly in air, but it will burn even more rapidly if the concentration of oxygen in is higher.
Figure 12.2.3 : The presence of a catalyst increases the rate of a reaction by lowering its activation energy.
A graph is shown with the label, “Reaction coordinate,” on the x-axis. The x-axis is depicted as an arrow. The y-axis is also an arrow and is labeled,
“Energy.” There is a horizontal line that runs the width of the graph and appears just above the x-axis. A segment of this line is blue and is labeled,
“Reactants.” From the right end of this line segment, a solid black, concave down curve is shown which reaches the level just below the end of the y-
axis. The curve ends at another short, blue line labeled, “Products.” The “Products” line appears at a higher level than the “Reactants” line. An arrow
extends from the horizontal line to the apex of the curve. The arrow is labeled, “Uncatalyzed reaction activation energy.” A second, black concave
down curve is shown. This curve also meets the reactants and products blue line segments, but only extends to about two-thirds the height of the
initial curve. From the horizontal line is another arrow pointing to the apex of the second curve. This arrow is labeled, “Catalyzed reaction activation
energy.”
Chemical reactions occur when molecules collide with each other and undergo a chemical
transformation. Before physically performing a reaction in a laboratory, scientists can use molecular
modeling simulations to predict how the parameters discussed earlier will influence the rate of a
reaction. Use the PhET Reactions & Rates interactive to explore how temperature, concentration, and
the nature of the reactants affect reaction rates.
Summary
The rate of a chemical reaction is affected by several parameters. Reactions involving two phases proceed more rapidly when there is greater surface
area contact. If temperature or reactant concentration is increased, the rate of a given reaction generally increases as well. A catalyst can increase the
rate of a reaction by providing an alternative pathway that causes the activation energy of the reaction to decrease.
Glossary
catalyst
substance that increases the rate of a reaction without itself being consumed by the reaction
This page titled 12.2: Factors Affecting Reaction Rates is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As described in the previous module, the rate of a reaction is affected by the concentrations of reactants. Rate laws or rate equations
are mathematical expressions that describe the relationship between the rate of a chemical reaction and the concentration of its
reactants. In general, a rate law (or differential rate law, as it is sometimes called) takes this form:
m n p
rate = k[A] [B] [C ] …
in which [A], [B], and [C] represent the molar concentrations of reactants, and k is the rate constant, which is specific for a
particular reaction at a particular temperature. The exponents m, n, and p are usually positive integers (although it is possible for
them to be fractions or negative numbers). The rate constant k and the exponents m, n, and p must be determined experimentally by
observing how the rate of a reaction changes as the concentrations of the reactants are changed. The rate constant k is independent
of the concentration of A, B, or C, but it does vary with temperature and surface area.
The exponents in a rate law describe the effects of the reactant concentrations on the reaction rate and define the reaction order.
Consider a reaction for which the rate law is:
m n
rate = k[A] [B]
If the exponent m is 1, the reaction is first order with respect to A. If m is 2, the reaction is second order with respect to A. If n is 1,
the reaction is first order in B. If n is 2, the reaction is second order in B. If m or n is zero, the reaction is zero order in A or B,
respectively, and the rate of the reaction is not affected by the concentration of that reactant. The overall reaction order is the sum
of the orders with respect to each reactant. If m = 1 and n = 1, the overall order of the reaction is second order (m + n = 1 + 1 = 2).
The rate law:
rate = k[ H O ]
2 2
describes a reaction that is first order in hydrogen peroxide and first order overall. The rate law:
2
rate = k[C H ]
4 6
describes a reaction that is second order in C4H6 and second order overall. The rate law:
+ −
rate = k[ H ][ OH ]
describes a reaction that is first order in H+, first order in OH−, and second order overall.
is second order in NO2 and zero order in CO at 100 °C. What is the rate law for the reaction?
Solution
The reaction will have the form:
m n
rate = k[ NO ] [CO]
2
The reaction is second order in NO2; thus m = 2. The reaction is zero order in CO; thus n = 0. The rate law is:
2 0 2
rate = k[ NO ] [CO] = k[ NO ]
2 2
Exercise 12.3.1A
2
has been experimentally determined to be rate = k[NO] [H2]. What are the orders with respect to each reactant, and what is the
overall order of the reaction?
Answer
order in NO = 2;
order in H2 = 1;
overall order = 3
Exercise 12.3.1B
In a transesterification reaction, a triglyceride reacts with an alcohol to form an ester and glycerol. Many students learn about
the reaction between methanol (CH3OH) and ethyl acetate (CH3CH2OCOCH3) as a sample reaction before studying the
chemical reactions that produce biodiesel:
CH OH + CH CH OCOCH ⟶ CH OCOCH + CH CH OH
3 3 2 3 3 3 3 2
The rate law for the reaction between methanol and ethyl acetate is, under certain conditions, experimentally determined to be:
rate = k[ CH OH]
3
What is the order of reaction with respect to methanol and ethyl acetate, and what is the overall order of reaction?
Answer
order in CH3OH = 1;
order in CH3CH2OCOCH3 = 0;
overall order = 1
It is sometimes helpful to use a more explicit algebraic method, often referred to as the method of initial rates, to determine the
orders in rate laws. To use this method, we select two sets of rate data that differ in the concentration of only one reactant and set
up a ratio of the two rates and the two rate laws. After canceling terms that are equal, we are left with an equation that contains only
one unknown, the coefficient of the concentration that varies. We then solve this equation for the coefficient.
Ozone in the upper atmosphere is depleted when it reacts with nitrogen oxides. The rates of the reactions of nitrogen oxides
with ozone are important factors in deciding how significant these reactions are in the formation of the ozone hole over
Antarctica (Figure 12.3.1). One such reaction is the combination of nitric oxide, NO, with ozone, O3:
This reaction has been studied in the laboratory, and the following rate data were determined at 25 °C.
Δ[ NO ]
Trial [NO] (mol/L) [O ]
3
(mol/L) 2
(mol L
−1 −1
s )
Δt
Determine the rate law and the rate constant for the reaction at 25 °C.
Solution
The rate law will have the form:
m n
rate = k[NO] [O ]
3
We can determine the values of m, n, and k from the experimental data using the following three-part process:
3. Determine the value of k from one set of concentrations and the corresponding rate.
rate
k =
[NO][ O3 ]
−5 −1 −1
6.60 × 10 mol L s
=
−6 −1 −6 −1
(1.00 × 10 mol L )(3.00 × 10 mol L )
7 −1 −1
= 2.20 × 10 L mo l s
The large value of k tells us that this is a fast reaction that could play an important role in ozone depletion if [NO] is large
enough.
Exercise 12.3.2
Acetaldehyde decomposes when heated to yield methane and carbon monoxide according to the equation:
Determine the rate law and the rate constant for the reaction from the following experimental data:
Δ[ CH CHO]
Trial [ CH
3
CHO] (mol/L) −
3
(mol L
−1
s
−1
)
Δt
Answer
rate = k[ CH CHO]
3
2
with k = 6.73 × 10−6 L/mol/s
Using the initial rates method and the experimental data, determine the rate law and the value of the rate constant for this
reaction:
Δ[NO]
Trial [NO] (mol/L) [C l2 ] (mol/L) − (mol L
−1
s
−1
)
2Δt
Solution
As in Example 12.3.2, we can approach this problem in a stepwise fashion, determining the values of m and n from the
experimental data and then using these values to determine the value of k. In this example, however, we will use a different
approach to determine the values of m and n:
Determine the value of m from the data in which [NO] varies and [Cl2] is constant. We can write the ratios with the subscripts
x and y to indicate data from two different trials:
m n
ratex k[NO]x [ Cl ]x
2
=
m n
ratey k[NO]y [ Cl ]y
2
Using the third trial and the first trial, in which [Cl2] does not vary, gives:
m n
rate 3 0.00675 k(0.15 ) (0.10 )
= =
m n
rate 1 0.00300 k(0.10 ) (0.10 )
After canceling equivalent terms in the numerator and denominator, we are left with:
m
0.00675 (0.15)
=
m
0.00300 (0.10)
Determine the value of n from data in which [Cl2] varies and [NO] is constant.
m n
rate 2 0.00450 k(0.10 ) (0.15 )
= =
rate 1 0.00300 k(0.10 )m (0.10 )n
Cancelation gives:
n
0.0045 (0.15)
=
0.0030 (0.10)n
Determine the numerical value of the rate constant k with appropriate units. The units for the rate of a reaction are mol/L/s. The
units for k are whatever is needed so that substituting into the rate law expression affords the appropriate units for the rate. In
this example, the concentration units are mol3/L3. The units for k should be mol−2 L2/s so that the rate is in terms of mol/L/s.
To determine the value of k once the rate law expression has been solved, simply plug in values from the first experimental trial
and solve for k:
−1 −1 −1 2 −1 1
0.00300 mol L s = k(0.10 mol L ) (0.10 mol L )
−2 2 −1
k = 3.0 mol L s
Use the provided initial rate data to derive the rate law for the reaction whose equation is:
− − − −
OCl (aq) + I (aq) ⟶ OI (aq) + Cl (aq)
Determine the rate law expression and the value of the rate constant k with appropriate units for this reaction.
Answer
x y
rate 2 0.00092 k(0.0020 ) (0.0040 )
= =
x y
rate 3 0.00046 k(0.0020 ) (0.0020 )
2.00 = 2.00y
y=1
x y
rate 1 0.00184 k(0.0040 ) (0.0020 )
= =
x y
rate 2 0.00092 k(0.0020 ) (0.0040 )
x
2
2.00 =
y
2
x
2
2.00 =
1
2
x
4.00 = 2
x =2
Substituting the concentration data from trial 1 and solving for k yields:
− 2 − 1
rate = k[ OCl ] [I ]
2 1
0.00184 = k(0.0040 ) (0.0020 )
4 −2 2 −1
k = 5.75 × 10 mo l L s
2
CH CHO ⟶ CH + CO rate = k[ CH CHO]
3 4 3
2N O ⟶ 2 NO +O rate = k[ N O ]
2 5 2 2 2 5
2 NO +F ⟶ 2 NO F rate = k[ NO ][ F ]
2 2 2 2 2
2 NO Cl ⟶ 2 NO + Cl rate = k[ NO Cl]
2 2 2 2
It is important to note that rate laws are determined by experiment only and are not
reliably predicted by reaction stoichiometry.
Reaction orders also play a role in determining the units for the rate constant k. In Example 12.3.2, a second-order reaction, we
found the units for k to be L mol s , whereas in Example 12.3.3, a third order reaction, we found the units for k to be mol−2
−1 −1
zero mol/L/s
first s−1
second L/mol/s
Note that the units in the table can also be expressed in terms of molarity (M) instead of mol/L. Also, units of time other than the
second (such as minutes, hours, days) may be used, depending on the situation.
Summary
Rate laws provide a mathematical description of how changes in the amount of a substance affect the rate of a chemical reaction.
Rate laws are determined experimentally and cannot be predicted by reaction stoichiometry. The order of reaction describes how
much a change in the amount of each substance affects the overall rate, and the overall order of a reaction is the sum of the orders
for each substance present in the reaction. Reaction orders are typically first order, second order, or zero order, but fractional and
even negative orders are possible.
Glossary
method of initial rates
use of a more explicit algebraic method to determine the orders in a rate law
rate law
(also, rate equation) mathematical equation showing the dependence of reaction rate on the rate constant and the concentration
of one or more reactants
reaction order
value of an exponent in a rate law, expressed as an ordinal number (for example, zero order for 0, first order for 1, second order
for 2, and so on)
This page titled 12.3: Rate Laws is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The rate laws we have seen thus far relate the rate and the concentrations of reactants. We can also determine a second form of each
rate law that relates the concentrations of reactants and time. These are called integrated rate laws. We can use an integrated rate
law to determine the amount of reactant or product present after a period of time or to estimate the time required for a reaction to
proceed to a certain extent. For example, an integrated rate law is used to determine the length of time a radioactive material must
be stored for its radioactivity to decay to a safe level.
Using calculus, the differential rate law for a chemical reaction can be integrated with respect to time to give an equation that
relates the amount of reactant or product present in a reaction mixture to the elapsed time of the reaction. This process can either be
very straightforward or very complex, depending on the complexity of the differential rate law. For purposes of discussion, we will
focus on the resulting integrated rate laws for first-, second-, and zero-order reactions.
or alternatively
[A]0
ln( ) = kt
[A]t
or
−kt
[A] = [A]0 e
C H ⟶ 2C H
4 8 2 4
Solution
We use the integrated form of the rate law to answer questions regarding time:
[A]0
ln( ) = kt
[A]
There are four variables in the rate law, so if we know three of them, we can determine the fourth. In this case we know [A]0,
[A], and k, and need to find t.
The initial concentration of C4H8, [A]0, is not provided, but the provision that 80.0% of the sample has decomposed is enough
information to solve this problem. Let x be the initial concentration, in which case the concentration after 80.0% decomposition
is 20.0% of x or 0.200x. Rearranging the rate law to isolate t and substituting the provided quantities yields:
−1
0.100 mol L 1
= ln ×
−1 −3 −1
0.020 mol L 9.2 × 10 s
1
= 1.609 ×
−3 −1
9.2 × 10 s
2
= 1.7 × 10 s
Exercise 12.4.1
Iodine-131 is a radioactive isotope that is used to diagnose and treat some forms of thyroid cancer. Iodine-131 decays to xenon-
131 according to the equation:
The decay is first-order with a rate constant of 0.138 d−1. All radioactive decay is first order. How many days will it take for
90% of the iodine−131 in a 0.500 M solution of this substance to decay to Xe-131?
Answer
16.7 days
We can use integrated rate laws with experimental data that consist of time and concentration information to determine the order
and rate constant of a reaction. The integrated rate law can be rearranged to a standard linear equation format:
ln[A] = (−k)(t) + ln[A]0 (12.4.1)
y = mx + b (12.4.2)
A plot of ln[A] versus t for a first-order reaction is a straight line with a slope of −k and an intercept of ln[A] . If a set of rate data
0
are plotted in this fashion but do not result in a straight line, the reaction is not first order in A .
Show that the data in this Figure can be represented by a first-order rate law by graphing ln[H2O2] versus time. Determine the
rate constant for the rate of decomposition of H2O2 from this data.
Solution
The data from this Figure with the addition of values of ln[H2O2] are given in Figure 12.4.1.
Figure 12.4.1 : The linear relationship between the ln[H2O2] and time shows that the decomposition of hydrogen peroxide is a
first-order reaction.
Solutions to Example 12.4.2
1 0 1.000 0.0
The plot of ln[H2O2] versus time is linear, thus we have verified that the reaction may be described by a first-order rate law.
The rate constant for a first-order reaction is equal to the negative of the slope of the plot of ln[H2O2] versus time where:
In order to determine the slope of the line, we need two values of ln[H2O2] at different values of t (one near each end of the
line is preferable). For example, the value of ln[H2O2] when t is 6.00 h is −0.693; the value when t = 12.00 h is −1.386:
−1.386 − (−0.693)
slope =
12.00 h − 6.00 h
−0.693
=
6.00 h
−2 −1
= −1.155 × 10 h
−1 −1 −1 −1
k = −slope = −(−1.155 × 10 h ) = 1.155 × 10 h
Exercise 12.4.2
Graph the following data to determine whether the reaction A ⟶ B + C is first order.
Data for the reaction A ⟶ B + C
Trial Time (s) [A]
1 4.0 0.220
2 8.0 0.144
3 12.0 0.110
4 16.0 0.088
5 20.0 0.074
Answer
The plot of ln[A] vs. t is not a straight line. The equation is not first order:
where the terms in the equation have their usual meanings as defined earlier.
The reaction of butadiene gas (C4H6) with itself produces C8H12 gas as follows:
2 C H (g) ⟶ C H (g)
4 6 8 12
The reaction is second order with a rate constant equal to 5.76 × 10−2 L/mol/min under certain conditions. If the initial
concentration of butadiene is 0.200 M, what is the concentration remaining after 10.0 min?
Solution
We use the integrated form of the rate law to answer questions regarding time. For a second-order reaction, we have:
1 1
= kt +
[A] [A]0
We know three variables in this equation: [A]0 = 0.200 mol/L, k = 5.76 × 10−2 L/mol/min, and t = 10.0 min. Therefore, we can
solve for [A], the fourth variable:
1 −1 −1 −1
= (5.76 × 10 L mo l ) + 5.00 L mo l
[A]
1 −1
= 5.58 L mol
[A]
−1 −1
[A] = 1.79 × 10 mol L
Therefore 0.179 mol/L of butadiene remain at the end of 10.0 min, compared to the 0.200 mol/L that was originally present.
Exercise 12.4.3
If the initial concentration of butadiene is 0.0200 M, what is the concentration remaining after 20.0 min?
Answer
0.0196 mol/L
The integrated rate law for our second-order reactions has the form of the equation of a straight line:
1 1
= kt +
[A] [A]0
y = mx + b
1 1
A plot of versus t for a second-order reaction is a straight line with a slope of k and an intercept of . If the plot is not a
[A] [A]0
Test the data given to show whether the dimerization of C4H6 is a first- or a second-order reaction.
Solution
Solutions to Example 12.4.4
Trial Time (s) [C4H6] (M)
1 0 1.00 × 10−2
In order to distinguish a first-order reaction from a second-order reaction, we plot ln[C4H6] versus t and compare it with a plot
1
of versus t. The values needed for these plots follow.
[ C4 H6 ]
0 100 −4.605
The plots are shown in Figure 12.4.2. As you can see, the plot of ln[C4H6] versus t is not linear, therefore the reaction is not
1
first order. The plot of versus t is linear, indicating that the reaction is second order.
[C H ]
4 6
Figure 12.4.2 : These two graphs show first- and second-order plots for the dimerization of C4H6. Since the first-order plot
(left) is not linear, we know that the reaction is not first order. The linear trend in the second-order plot (right) indicates that the
reaction follows second-order kinetics.
Two graphs are shown, each with the label “Time ( s )” on the x-axis. The graph on the left is labeled, “l n [ C subscript 4 H
subscript 6 ],” on the y-axis. The graph on the right is labeled “1 divided by [ C subscript 4 H subscript 6 ],” on the y-axis. The
x-axes for both graphs show markings at 3000 and 6000. The y-axis for the graph on the left shows markings at negative 6,
negative 5, and negative 4. A decreasing slightly concave up curve is drawn through five points at coordinates that are (0,
negative 4.605), (1600, negative 5.289), (3200, negative 5.692), (4800, negative 5.978), and (6200, negative 6.175). The y-axis
for the graph on the right shows markings at 100, 300, and 500. An approximately linear increasing curve is drawn through
five points at coordinates that are (0, 100), (1600, 198), (3200, 296), and (4800, 395), and (6200, 481).
Exercise 12.4.4
1 5 0.952
2 10 0.625
3 15 0.465
4 20 0.370
5 25 0.308
6 35 0.230
Answer
1
Yes. The plot of vs. t is linear:
[A]
A zero-order reaction thus exhibits a constant reaction rate, regardless of the concentration of its reactants.
The integrated rate law for a zero-order reaction also has the form of the equation of a straight line:
[A] = −kt + [A]0
y = mx + b
A plot of [A] versus t for a zero-order reaction is a straight line with a slope of −k and an intercept of [A]0. Figure 12.4.3 shows a
plot of [NH3] versus t for the decomposition of ammonia on a hot tungsten wire and for the decomposition of ammonia on hot
quartz (SiO2). The decomposition of NH3 on hot tungsten is zero order; the plot is a straight line. The decomposition of NH3 on hot
quartz is not zero order (it is first order). From the slope of the line for the zero-order decomposition, we can determine the rate
constant:
−6
slope = −k = 1.3110 mol/L/s
[A]0 1
t = ln ×
[A] k
If we set the time t equal to the half-life, t1/2 , the corresponding concentration of A at this time is equal to one-half of its initial
1
concentration. Hence, when t = t 1/2 , [A] = [A]0 .
2
Therefore:
[A]0 1
t1/2 = ln ×
1 k
[A]0
2
1 1
= ln 2 × = 0.693 ×
k k
Thus:
0.693
t1/2 =
k
Calculate the rate constant for the first-order decomposition of hydrogen peroxide in water at 40 °C, using the data given in
Figure 12.4.4.
Figure 12.4.4 : The decomposition of H2O2 (2 H O ⟶ 2 H O + O ) at 40 °C is illustrated. The intensity of the color
2 2 2 2
symbolizes the concentration of H2O2 at the indicated times; H2O2 is actually colorless.
Solution The half-life for the decomposition of H2O2 is 2.16 × 104 s:
0.693
t1/2 =
k
0.693 0.693 −5 −1
k = = = 3.21 × 10 s
4
t1/2 2.16 × 10 s
Exercise 12.4.1
The first-order radioactive decay of iodine-131 exhibits a rate constant of 0.138 d−1. What is the half-life for this decay?
Answer
5.02 d.
or
1 1
− = kt
[A] [A]0
If
t = t1/2
then
1
[A] = [A]0
2
1
2[A]0 − = kt1/2
[A]0
1
= kt1/2
[A]0
Thus:
1
t1/2 =
k[A]0
For a second-order reaction, t is inversely proportional to the concentration of the reactant, and the half-life increases as the
1/2
reaction proceeds because the concentration of reactant decreases. Consequently, we find the use of the half-life concept to be more
complex for second-order reactions than for first-order reactions. Unlike with first-order reactions, the rate constant of a second-
order reaction cannot be calculated directly from the half-life unless the initial concentration is known.
[A]0
When half of the initial amount of reactant has been consumed t = t 1/2 and [A] = . Thus:
2
[A]0
= −kt1/2 + [A]0
2
[A]0
kt1/2 =
2
and
[A]0
t1/2 =
2k
The half-life of a zero-order reaction increases as the initial concentration increases. Equations for both differential and integrated
rate laws and the corresponding half-lives for zero-, first-, and second-order reactions are summarized in Table 12.4.1.
Table 12.4.1 : Summary of Rate Laws for Zero-, First-, and Second-Order Reactions
Zero-Order First-Order Second-Order
Glossary
half-life of a reaction (tl/2)
time required for half of a given amount of reactant to be consumed
This page titled 12.4: Integrated Rate Laws is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
We should not be surprised that atoms, molecules, or ions must collide before they can react with each other. Atoms must be close
together to form chemical bonds. This simple premise is the basis for a very powerful theory that explains many observations
regarding chemical kinetics, including factors affecting reaction rates. Collision theory is based on the following postulates:
2. The reacting species must collide in an orientation that allows contact between the atoms that will become bonded together
in the product.
3. The collision must occur with adequate energy to permit mutual penetration of the reacting species’ valence shells so that
the electrons can rearrange and form new bonds (and new chemical species).
We can see the importance of the two physical factors noted in postulates 2 and 3, the orientation and energy of collisions, when we
consider the reaction of carbon monoxide with oxygen:
Carbon monoxide is a pollutant produced by the combustion of hydrocarbon fuels. To reduce this pollutant, automobiles have
catalytic converters that use a catalyst to carry out this reaction. It is also a side reaction of the combustion of gunpowder that
results in muzzle flash for many firearms. If carbon monoxide and oxygen are present in sufficient quantity, the reaction is
spontaneous at high temperature and pressure.
The first step in the gas-phase reaction between carbon monoxide and oxygen is a collision between the two molecules:
Although there are many different possible orientations the two molecules can have relative to each other, consider the two
presented in Figure 12.5.1. In the first case, the oxygen side of the carbon monoxide molecule collides with the oxygen molecule.
In the second case, the carbon side of the carbon monoxide molecule collides with the oxygen molecule. The second case is clearly
more likely to result in the formation of carbon dioxide, which has a central carbon atom bonded to two oxygen atoms (O=C=O) .
This is a rather simple example of how important the orientation of the collision is in terms of creating the desired product of the
reaction.
Figure 12.5.1 : Illustrated are two collisions that might take place between carbon monoxide and oxygen molecules. The orientation
of the colliding molecules partially determines whether a reaction between the two molecules will occur.
If the collision does take place with the correct orientation, there is still no guarantee that the reaction will proceed to form carbon
dioxide. Every reaction requires a certain amount of activation energy for it to proceed in the forward direction, yielding an
Figure 12.5.2 : Possible transition states (activated complexes) for carbon monoxide reacting with oxygen to form carbon dioxide.
Solid lines represent covalent bonds, while dotted lines represent unstable orbital overlaps that may, or may not, become covalent
bonds as product is formed. In the first two examples in this figure, the O=O double bond is not impacted; therefore, carbon
dioxide cannot form. The third proposed transition state will result in the formation of carbon dioxide if the third “extra” oxygen
atom separates from the rest of the molecule.
In most circumstances, it is impossible to isolate or identify a transition state or activated complex. In the reaction between carbon
monoxide and oxygen to form carbon dioxide, activated complexes have only been observed spectroscopically in systems that
utilize a heterogeneous catalyst. The gas-phase reaction occurs too rapidly to isolate any such chemical compound.
Collision theory explains why most reaction rates increase as concentrations increase. With an increase in the concentration of any
reacting substance, the chances for collisions between molecules are increased because there are more molecules per unit of
volume. More collisions mean a faster reaction rate, assuming the energy of the collisions is adequate.
kinetic energy of reactant molecules plays an important role in a reaction because the energy necessary to form a product is
provided by a collision of a reactant molecule with another reactant molecule. (In single-reactant reactions, activation energy may
be provided by a collision of the reactant molecule with the wall of the reaction vessel or with molecules of an inert contaminant.)
If the activation energy is much larger than the average kinetic energy of the molecules, the reaction will occur slowly: Only a few
fast-moving molecules will have enough energy to react. If the activation energy is much smaller than the average kinetic energy of
the molecules, the fraction of molecules possessing the necessary kinetic energy will be large; most collisions between molecules
will result in reaction, and the reaction will occur rapidly.
Figure 12.5.3 shows the energy relationships for the general reaction of a molecule of A with a molecule of B to form molecules
of C and D:
A+B ⟶ C +D
The figure shows that the energy of the transition state is higher than that of the reactants A and B by an amount equal to E , the a
activation energy. Thus, the sum of the kinetic energies of A and B must be equal to or greater than Ea to reach the transition
state. After the transition state has been reached, and as C and D begin to form, the system loses energy until its total energy is
lower than that of the initial mixture. This lost energy is transferred to other molecules, giving them enough energy to reach the
transition state. The forward reaction (that between molecules A and B ) therefore tends to take place readily once the reaction has
started. In Figure 12.5.3, ΔH represents the difference in enthalpy between the reactants (A and B ) and the products (C and D).
The sum of E and ΔH represents the activation energy for the reverse reaction:
a
C +D ⟶ A+B
We can use the Arrhenius equation to relate the activation energy and the rate constant, k, of a given reaction:
−Ea /RT
k = Ae (12.5.1)
In this equation,
R is the ideal gas constant, which has a value 8.314 J/mol/K,
T is temperature on the Kelvin scale,
E is the activation energy in joules per mole,
a
A is a constant called the frequency factor, which is related to the frequency of collisions and the orientation of the reacting
molecules.
Both postulates of the collision theory of reaction rates are accommodated in the Arrhenius equation. The frequency factor A is
related to the rate at which collisions having the correct orientation occur. The exponential term, e , is related to the fraction
−Ea /RT
of collisions providing adequate energy to overcome the activation barrier of the reaction.
At one extreme, the system does not contain enough energy for collisions to overcome the activation barrier. In such cases, no
reaction occurs. At the other extreme, the system has so much energy that every collision with the correct orientation can overcome
the activation barrier, causing the reaction to proceed. In such cases, the reaction is nearly instantaneous.
The Arrhenius equation (Equation 12.5.1) describes quantitatively much of what we have already discussed about reaction rates.
For two reactions at the same temperature, the reaction with the higher activation energy has the lower rate constant and the slower
rate. The larger value of E results in a smaller value for e
a , reflecting the smaller fraction of molecules with enough energy
−Ea /RT
to react. Alternatively, the reaction with the smaller E has a larger fraction of molecules with enough energy to react. This will be
a
reflected as a larger value of e , a larger rate constant, and a faster rate for the reaction.
−Ea /RT
to the frequency factor, A . Hence a change in conditions or reactants that increases the number of collisions with a favorable
orientation for reaction results in an increase in A and, consequently, an increase in k .
A convenient approach to determining E for a reaction involves the measurement of
a k at different temperatures and using of an
alternate version of the Arrhenius equation that takes the form of linear equation:
−Ea 1
ln k = ( )( ) + ln A
R T
y = mx + b
1 −Ea
Thus, a plot of ln k versus gives a straight line with the slope , from which Ea may be determined. The intercept gives the
T R
value of ln A . This is sometimes call an Arrhenius Plot.
Example 12.5.1
Determination of Ea The variation of the rate constant with temperature for the decomposition of HI(g) to H2(g) and I2(g) is
given here. What is the activation energy for the reaction?
variation of the rate constant with temperature for the decomposition of HI(g) to H2(g) and I2(g)
T (K) k (L/mol/s)
Solution
1
Values of and ln k are:
T
1
Figure 12.5.5 is a graph of ln k versus . To determine the slope of the line, we need two values of ln k, which are determined
T
1
from the line at two values of (one near each end of the line is preferable). For example, the value of ln k determined from
T
1 1
the line when = 1.25 × 10
−3
is −2.593; the value when = 1.78 × 10
−3
is −14.447.
T T
1
Figure 12.5.5 : This graph shows the linear relationship between ln k and for the reaction 2 HI ⟶ H
2
+I
2
according to
T
the Arrhenius equation.
The slope of this line is given by the following expression:
Δ(ln k)
Slope =
1
Δ( )
T
(−14.447) − (−2.593)
=
−3 −1 −3 −1
(1.78 × 10 K ) − (1.25 × 10 K )
−11.854
4
= = 2.2 × 10 K
−3 −1
0.53 × 10 K
Ea
=−
R
Thus:
4 −1 −1
Ea = −slope × R = −(−2.2 × 10 K × 8.314 J mo l K )
5 −1
= 1.8 × 10 J mo l
In many situations, it is possible to obtain a reasonable estimate of the activation energy without going through the entire
process of constructing the Arrhenius plot. The Arrhenius equation:
or
k1 Ea 1 1
ln = ( − )
k2 R T2 T1
This equation can be rearranged to give a one-step calculation to obtain an estimate for the activation energy:
⎛ ⎞
⎜ ln k2 − ln k1 ⎟
Ea = −R ⎜ ⎟
⎜ 1 1 ⎟
( ) −( )
⎝ ⎠
T2 T1
Using the experimental data presented here, we can simply select two data entries. For this example, we select the first entry
and the last entry:
First and Last Entry
1
T (K) k (L/mol/s) (K
−1
) ln k
T
1
After calculating and ln k, we can substitute into the equation:
T
−3.231 − (−14.860)
−1 −1
Ea = −8.314 J mo l K ( )
−3 −3
1.28 × 10 K−1 − 1.80 × 10 K−1
Exercise 12.5.1
The rate constant for the rate of decomposition of N2O5 to NO and O2 in the gas phase is 1.66 L/mol/s at 650 K and 7.39
L/mol/s at 700 K:
Assuming the kinetics of this reaction are consistent with the Arrhenius equation, calculate the activation energy for this
decomposition.
Answer
113,000 J/mol
Summary
Chemical reactions require collisions between reactant species. These reactant collisions must be of proper orientation and
sufficient energy in order to result in product formation. Collision theory provides a simple but effective explanation for the effect
−Ea 1
ln k = ( )( ) + ln A
R T
k1 Ea 1 1
ln = ( − )
k2 R T2 T1
Glossary
activated complex
(also, transition state) unstable combination of reactant species representing the highest energy state of a reaction system
Arrhenius equation
mathematical relationship between the rate constant and the activation energy of a reaction
collision theory
model that emphasizes the energy and orientation of molecular collisions to explain and predict reaction kinetics
This page titled 12.5: Collision Theory is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
A balanced equation for a chemical reaction indicates what is reacting and what is produced, but it reveals nothing about how the reaction actually takes place. The reaction mechanism (or reaction
path) is the process, or pathway, by which a reaction occurs. A chemical reaction often occurs in steps, although it may not always be obvious to an observer. The decomposition of ozone, for
example, appears to follow a mechanism with two steps:
O (g) ⟶ O (g) + O (12.6.1)
3 2
O + O (g) ⟶ 2 O (g)
3 2
We call each step in a reaction mechanism an elementary reaction. Elementary reactions occur exactly as they are written and cannot be broken down into simpler steps. Elementary reactions add up
to the overall reaction, which, for the decomposition, is:
2 O (g) ⟶ 3 O (g) (12.6.2)
3 2
Notice that the oxygen atom produced in the first step of this mechanism is consumed in the second step and therefore does not appear as a product in the overall reaction. Species that are produced
in one step and consumed in a subsequent step are called intermediates.
While the overall reaction equation for the decomposition of ozone indicates that two molecules of ozone react to give three molecules of oxygen, the mechanism of the reaction does not involve
the collision and reaction of two ozone molecules. Rather, it involves a molecule of ozone decomposing to an oxygen molecule and an intermediate oxygen atom; the oxygen atom then reacts with a
second ozone molecule to give two oxygen molecules. These two elementary reactions occur exactly as they are shown in the reaction mechanism.
12.6.0.0.1: Unimolecular Elementary Reactions
The molecularity of an elementary reaction is the number of reactant species (atoms, molecules, or ions). For example, a unimolecular reaction involves the rearrangement of a single reactant
species to produce one or more molecules of product:
A ⟶ products (12.6.3)
A unimolecular reaction may be one of several elementary reactions in a complex mechanism. For example, the reaction:
O ⟶ O +O (12.6.5)
3 2
illustrates a unimolecular elementary reaction that occurs as one part of a two-step reaction mechanism. However, some unimolecular reactions may have only a single reaction in the reaction
mechanism. (In other words, an elementary reaction can also be an overall reaction in some cases.) For example, the gas-phase decomposition of cyclobutane, C4H8, to ethylene, C2H4, occurs via a
unimolecular, single-step mechanism:
In this figure, structural formulas are used to illustrate a chemical reaction. On the left, a structural formula for cyclobutane is shown. This structure is composed of 4 C atoms connected with single
bonds in a square shape. Each C atom is bonded to two other C atoms in the structure, leaving two bonds for H atoms pointing outward above, below, left, and right. An arrow points right to two
identical ethane molecules with a plus symbol between them. Each of these molecules contains two C atoms connected with a double bond oriented vertically between them. The C atom at the top
of these molecules has H atoms bonded above to the right and left. Similarly, the lower C atom has two H atoms bonded below to the right and left.
For these unimolecular reactions to occur, all that is required is the separation of parts of single reactant molecules into products.
Chemical bonds do not simply fall apart during chemical reactions. Energy is required to break chemical bonds. The activation energy for the decomposition of C4H8, for example, is 261 kJ per
mole. This means that it requires 261 kilojoules to distort one mole of these molecules into activated complexes that decompose into products:
In this figure, structural formulas are used to illustrate a chemical reaction, including an intermediate step. On the left, a structural formula for cyclobutane is shown. This structure is composed of 4
C atoms connected with single bonds in a square shape. Each C atom is bonded to two other C atoms in the structure, leaving two bonds for H atoms pointing outward above, below, left, and right.
This structure is labeled, “Cyclohexane.” An arrow points right to a similar structure which has the upper and lower bonds replaced by rows of 4 dots. Similarly, columns of 3 dots appear just inside
the line segments indicating the vertically oriented single bonds in the structure. The label “Activated complex” appears beneath this structure. A second arrow points right to two identical ethane
molecules with a plus symbol between them. Each of these molecules contains two C atoms connected with a double bond oriented vertically between them. The C atom at the top of these
molecules has H atoms bonded above to the right and left. Similarly, the lower C atom has two H atoms bonded below to the right and left. Below these two molecules appears the label “Ethylene.”
In a sample of C4H8, a few of the rapidly moving C4H8 molecules collide with other rapidly moving molecules and pick up additional energy. When the C4H8 molecules gain enough energy, they
can transform into an activated complex, and the formation of ethylene molecules can occur. In effect, a particularly energetic collision knocks a C4H8 molecule into the geometry of the activated
complex. However, only a small fraction of gas molecules travel at sufficiently high speeds with large enough kinetic energies to accomplish this. Hence, at any given moment, only a few molecules
pick up enough energy from collisions to react.
The rate of decomposition of C4H8 is directly proportional to its concentration. Doubling the concentration of C4H8 in a sample gives twice as many molecules per liter. Although the fraction of
molecules with enough energy to react remains the same, the total number of such molecules is twice as great. Consequently, there is twice as much C4H8 per liter, and the reaction rate is twice as
fast:
Δ[ C H ]
4 8
rate = − = k[ C H ] (12.6.6)
4 8
Δt
and
2A ⟶ products (12.6.8)
For the first type, in which the two reactant molecules are different, the rate law is first-order in A and first order in B:
For the second type, in which two identical molecules collide and react, the rate law is second order in A:
2
rate = k[A][A] = k[A] (12.6.10)
Some chemical reactions have mechanisms that consist of a single bimolecular elementary reaction. One example is the reaction of nitrogen dioxide with carbon monoxide:
Figure 12.6.1 : The probable mechanism for the reaction between NO and CO to yield NO and CO .
2 2
This figure provides an illustration of a reaction between two H I molecules using space filling models. H atoms are shown as white spheres, and I atoms are shown as purple spheres. On the left,
two H I molecules are shownwith a small white sphere bonded to a much larger purple sphere. The label, “Two H I molecules,” appears below. An arrow points right to a similar structure in which
the two molecules appear pushed together, so that the purple spheres of the two molecules are touching. Below appears the label, “Transition state.” Following another arrow, two white spheres are
shown vertically oriented and bonded together with the label, “H subscript 2” above. The H subscript 2 molecule is followed by a plus sign and two purple spheres bonded together with the label, “I
subscript 2” above. Below these structures is the label, “Hydrogen iodide molecules decompose to produce hydrogen H subscript 2 and iodine I subscript 2.”
Bimolecular elementary reactions may also be involved as steps in a multistep reaction mechanism. The reaction of atomic oxygen with ozone is one example:
O(g) + O (g) ⟶ 2 O (g) (12.6.12)
3 2
An elementary termolecular reaction involves the simultaneous collision of three atoms, molecules, or ions. Termolecular elementary reactions are uncommon because the probability of three
particles colliding simultaneously is less than one one-thousandth of the probability of two particles colliding. There are, however, a few established termolecular elementary reactions. The reaction
of nitric oxide with oxygen appears to involve termolecular steps:
2 NO + O ⟶ 2 NO (12.6.13)
2 2
2
rate = k[NO] [ O ]
2
Likewise, the reaction of nitric oxide with chlorine appears to involve termolecular steps:
2 NO + Cl ⟶ 2 NOCl (12.6.14)
2
2
rate = k[NO] [ Cl ]
2
Figure 12.6.2 : A cattle chute is a nonchemical example of a rate-determining step. Cattle can only be moved from one holding pen to another as quickly as one animal can make its way through the
chute. (credit: Loren Kerns)
A photo is shown of cattle passing through a narrow chute into a holding pen. A person directs them through the gate with a long white and red pole.
As described earlier, rate laws may be derived directly from the chemical equations for elementary reactions. This is not the case, however, for ordinary chemical reactions. The balanced equations
most often encountered represent the overall change for some chemical system, and very often this is the result of some multistep reaction mechanisms. In every case, we must determine the overall
rate law from experimental data and deduce the mechanism from the rate law (and sometimes from other data). The reaction of NO2 and CO provides an illustrative example:
For temperatures above 225 °C, the rate law has been found to be:
rate = k[ NO ][CO]
2
The reaction is first order with respect to NO2 and first-order with respect to CO. This is consistent with a single-step bimolecular mechanism and it is possible that this is the mechanism for this
reaction at high temperatures.
At temperatures below 225 °C, the reaction is described by a rate law that is second order with respect to NO2:
This is consistent with a mechanism that involves the following two elementary reactions, the first of which is slower and is therefore the rate-determining step:
NO (g) + NO (g) ⟶ NO (g) + NO(g) (slow)
2 2 3
The rate-determining step gives a rate law showing second-order dependence on the NO2 concentration, and the sum of the two equations gives the net overall reaction.
In general, when the rate-determining (slower) step is the first step in a mechanism, the rate law for the overall reaction is the same as the rate law for this step. However, when the rate-determining
step is preceded by a step involving an equilibrium reaction, the rate law for the overall reaction may be more difficult to derive.
An elementary reaction is at equilibrium when it proceeds in both the forward and reverse directions at equal rates. Consider the dimerization of NO to N2O2, with k1 used to represent the rate
constant of the forward reaction and k-1 used to represent the rate constant of the reverse reaction:
NO + NO ⇌ N O
2 2
rate =ratereverse
forward
2
k1 [NO] = k−1 [ N O ]
2 2
If N2O2 was an intermediate in a mechanism, this expression could be rearranged to represent the concentration of N2O2 in the overall rate law expression using algebraic manipulation:
2
k1 [NO]
( ) = [ N2 O2 ]
k−1
However, once again, intermediates cannot be listed as part of the overall rate law expression, though they can be included in an individual elementary reaction of a mechanism. Example 12.6.1
will illustrate how to derive overall rate laws from mechanisms involving equilibrium steps preceding the rate-determining step.
Example 12.6.1: Deriving the Overall Rate Law Expression for a Multistep Reaction
Mechanism Nitryl chloride (NO2Cl) decomposes to nitrogen dioxide (NO2) and chlorine gas (Cl2) according to the following mechanism:
1. 2 NO Cl(g) ⇌ ClO (g) + N O(g) + ClO(g) (fast, k1 represents the rate constant for the forward reaction and k−1 the rate constant for the reverse reaction)
2 2 2
2. N O(g) + ClO (g) ⇌ NO (g) + NOCl(g) (fast, k2 for the forward reaction, k−2 for the reverse reaction)
2 2 2
3. NOCl + ClO ⟶ NO + Cl (slow, k3 the rate constant for the forward reaction)
2 2
Determine the overall reaction, write the rate law expression for each elementary reaction, identify any intermediates, and determine the overall rate law expression.
Solution
For the overall reaction, simply sum the three steps, cancel intermediates, and combine like formulas:
Next, write the rate law expression for each elementary reaction. Remember that for elementary reactions that are part of a mechanism, the rate law expression can be derived directly from the
stoichiometry:
k1 [ NO Cl] = k−1 [ ClO ][ N O][ClO]
2 2 2 2
Rate = k3 [NOCl][ClO]
The third step, which is the slow step, is the rate-determining step. Therefore, the overall rate law expression could be written as Rate = k3 [NOCl][ClO]. However, both NOCl and ClO are
intermediates. Algebraic expressions must be used to represent [NOCl] and [ClO] such that no intermediates remain in the overall rate law expression.
2
k1 [ NO Cl]
2
Using elementary reaction 1, [ClO] = .
k−1 [ ClO ][ N O]
2 2
k2 [ N O][ ClO ]
Using elementary reaction 2, [NOCl] = 2 2
.
k−2 [ NO ]
2
Now substitute these algebraic expressions into the overall rate law expression and simplify:
2
k2 [ N O][ ClO ] k1 [ NO Cl]
2 2 2
rate = k3 ( )( )
k−2 [ NO ] k−1 [ ClO ][ N O]
2 2 2
2
k3 k2 k1 [ NO Cl]
2
rate =
k−2 k−1 [ NO ]
2
Notice that this rate law shows an inverse dependence on the concentration of one of the product species, consistent with the presence of an equilibrium step in the reaction mechanism.
Exercise 12.6.1
Atomic chlorine in the atmosphere reacts with ozone in the following pair of elementary reactions:
Cl + O (g) ⟶ ClO(g) + O (g) (rate constant k1 )
3 2
Determine the overall reaction, write the rate law expression for each elementary reaction, identify any intermediates, and determine the overall rate law expression.
Answer
overall reaction: O3
(g) + O ⟶ 2 O (g)
2
Summary
The sequence of individual steps, or elementary reactions, by which reactants are converted into products during the course of a reaction is called the reaction mechanism. The overall rate of a
reaction is determined by the rate of the slowest step, called the rate-determining step. Unimolecular elementary reactions have first-order rate laws, while bimolecular elementary reactions have
second-order rate laws. By comparing the rate laws derived from a reaction mechanism to that determined experimentally, the mechanism may be deemed either incorrect or plausible.
12.6.1.2: Glossary
bimolecular reaction
elementary reaction involving the collision and combination of two reactant species
elementary reaction
reaction that takes place precisely as depicted in its chemical equation
intermediate
molecule or ion produced in one step of a reaction mechanism and consumed in another
molecularity
number of reactant species (atoms, molecules or ions) involved in an elementary reaction
rate-determining step
(also, rate-limiting step) slowest elementary reaction in a reaction mechanism; determines the rate of the overall reaction
reaction mechanism
stepwise sequence of elementary reactions by which a chemical change takes place
termolecular reaction
elementary reaction involving the simultaneous collision and combination of three reactant species
unimolecular reaction
elementary reaction involving the rearrangement of a single reactant species to produce one or more molecules of product
This page titled 12.6: Reaction Mechanisms is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts
platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
We have seen that the rate of many reactions can be accelerated by catalysts. A catalyst speeds up the rate of a reaction by lowering
the activation energy; in addition, the catalyst is regenerated in the process. Several reactions that are thermodynamically favorable
in the absence of a catalyst only occur at a reasonable rate when a catalyst is present. One such reaction is catalytic hydrogenation,
the process by which hydrogen is added across an alkene C=C bond to afford the saturated alkane product. A comparison of the
reaction coordinate diagrams (also known as energy diagrams) for catalyzed and uncatalyzed alkene hydrogenation is shown in
Figure 12.7.1.
Figure 12.7.1 : This graph compares the reaction coordinates for catalyzed and uncatalyzed alkene hydrogenation.
A graph is shown with the label, “Reaction coordinate,” on the x-axis and the label,“Energy,” on the y-axis. Approximately half-
way up the y-axis, a short portion of a black concave down curve which has a horizontal line extended from it across the graph. The
left end of this line is labeled “H subscript 2 C equals C H subscript 2 plus H subscript 2.” The black concave down curve extends
upward to reach a maximum near the height of the y-axis. The peak of this curve is labeled, “Transition state.” A double sided
arrow extends from the horizontal line to the peak of the curve. This arrow is labeled, “Activation energy of Uncatalyzed reation.”
From the peak, the curve continues downward to a second horizontally flattened region well below the origin of the curve near the
x-axis. This flattened region is shaded in blue and is labeled “H subscript 3 C dash C H subscript 3.” A double sided arrow is drawn
from the lowers part of this curve at the far right of the graph to the line extending across the graph above it. This arrow is labeled,
“capital delta H less than 0 : exothermic.” A second curve is drawn with the same flattened regions at the start and end of the curve.
The height of this curve is about two-thirds the height of the first curve. A double sided arrow is drawn from the horizontal line that
originates at the left side of the graph to the peak of this second curve. This arrow is labeled, “Activation energy of catalyzed
reaction.”
Catalysts function by providing an alternate reaction mechanism that has a lower activation energy than would be found in the
absence of the catalyst. In some cases, the catalyzed mechanism may include additional steps, as depicted in the reaction diagrams
shown in Figure 12.7.2 This lower activation energy results in an increase in rate as described by the Arrhenius equation. Note that
a catalyst decreases the activation energy for both the forward and the reverse reactions and hence accelerates both the forward and
the reverse reactions. Consequently, the presence of a catalyst will permit a system to reach equilibrium more quickly, but it has no
effect on the position of the equilibrium as reflected in the value of its equilibrium constant (see the later chapter on chemical
equilibrium).
The two reaction diagrams here represent the same reaction: one without a catalyst and one with a catalyst. Identify which
diagram suggests the presence of a catalyst, and determine the activation energy for the catalyzed reaction:
In this figure, two graphs are shown. The x-axes are labeled, “Extent of reaction,” and the y-axes are labeled, “Energy ( k J ).”
The y-axes are marked off from 0 to 50 in intervals of five. In a, a blue curve is shown. It begins with a horizontal segment at
about 6. The curve then rises sharply near the middle to reach a maximum of about 32 and similarly falls to another horizontal
segment at about 10. In b, the curve begins and ends similarly, but the maximum reached near the center of the graph is only
20.
Solution
A catalyst does not affect the energy of reactant or product, so those aspects of the diagrams can be ignored; they are, as we
would expect, identical in that respect. There is, however, a noticeable difference in the transition state, which is distinctly
lower in diagram (b) than it is in (a). This indicates the use of a catalyst in diagram (b). The activation energy is the difference
between the energy of the starting reagents and the transition state—a maximum on the reaction coordinate diagram. The
reagents are at 6 kJ and the transition state is at 20 kJ, so the activation energy can be calculated as follows:
Exercise 12.7.1
Determine which of the two diagrams here (both for the same reaction) involves a catalyst, and identify the activation energy
for the catalyzed reaction:
In this figure, two graphs are shown. The x-axes are labeled, “Extent of reaction,” and the y-axes are labeledc “Energy (k J).”
The y-axes are marked off from 0 to 100 at intervals of 10. In a, a blue curve is shown. It begins with a horizontal segment at
about 10. The curve then rises sharply near the middle to reach a maximum of about 91, then sharply falls to about 52, again
rises sharply to about 73 and falls to another horizontal segment at about 5. In b, the curve begins and ends similarly, but the
first peak reaches about 81, drops to about 55, then rises to about 77 before falling to the horizontal region at about 5.
Answer
Diagram (b) is a catalyzed reaction with an activation energy of about 70 kJ.
Ozone is a relatively unstable molecule that decomposes to yield diatomic oxygen by the reverse of this equation. This
decomposition reaction is consistent with the following mechanism:
O ⟶ O +O (12.7.3)
3 2
O+O ⟶ 2O
3 2
The presence of nitric oxide, NO, influences the rate of decomposition of ozone. Nitric oxide acts as a catalyst in the following
mechanism:
NO(g) + O (g) ⟶ NO (g) + O (g) (12.7.4)
3 2 2
The overall chemical change for the catalyzed mechanism is the same as:
The nitric oxide reacts and is regenerated in these reactions. It is not permanently used up; thus, it acts as a catalyst. The rate of
decomposition of ozone is greater in the presence of nitric oxide because of the catalytic activity of NO. Certain compounds that
contain chlorine also catalyze the decomposition of ozone.
Figure 12.7.3 : (a) Mexican chemist Mario Molina (1943 –) shared the Nobel Prize in Chemistry in 1995 for his research on (b)
the Antarctic ozone hole. (credit a: courtesy of Mario Molina; credit b: modification of work by NASA)
A photograph is shown of Mario Molina. To the right of the photo, an image of Earth’s southern hemisphere is shown with a
central circular region in purple with a radius of about half that of the entire hemisphere. Just outside this region is a narrow
royal blue band, followed by an outer thin turquoise blue band. The majority of the outermost region is green. Two small bands
of yellow are present in the lower regions of the image.
In 1974, Molina and Rowland published a paper in the journal Nature (one of the major peer-reviewed publications in the field
of science) detailing the threat of chlorofluorocarbon gases to the stability of the ozone layer in earth’s upper atmosphere. The
ozone layer protects earth from solar radiation by absorbing ultraviolet light. As chemical reactions deplete the amount of
ozone in the upper atmosphere, a measurable “hole” forms above Antarctica, and an increase in the amount of solar ultraviolet
radiation— strongly linked to the prevalence of skin cancers—reaches earth’s surface. The work of Molina and Rowland was
instrumental in the adoption of the Montreal Protocol, an international treaty signed in 1987 that successfully began phasing
out production of chemicals linked to ozone destruction.
Molina and Rowland demonstrated that chlorine atoms from human-made chemicals can catalyze ozone destruction in a
process similar to that by which NO accelerates the depletion of ozone. Chlorine atoms are generated when chlorocarbons or
chlorofluorocarbons—once widely used as refrigerants and propellants—are photochemically decomposed by ultraviolet light
or react with hydroxyl radicals. A sample mechanism is shown here using methyl chloride:
\[\ce{CH3Cl + OH ⟶ Cl + other\: products} \nonumber \]
Chlorine radicals break down ozone and are regenerated by the following catalytic cycle:
Cl + O ⟶ ClO + O
3 2
ClO + O ⟶ Cl + O
2
overall Reaction: O +O ⟶ 2 O
3 2
A single monatomic chlorine can break down thousands of ozone molecules. Luckily, the majority of atmospheric chlorine exists as
the catalytically inactive forms Cl2 and ClONO2.
Figure 12.7.5 : In the mechanism for the pentose phosphate pathway, G6PD catalyzes the reaction that regulates NAPDH, a co-
enzyme that regulates glutathione, an antioxidant that protects red blood cells and other cells from oxidative damage.
A reaction mechanism is diagrammed in this figure. At the left, the name Glucose is followed by a horizontal, right pointing arrow,
labeled, “Hexokinase.” Below this arrow and to the left is a yellow star shape labeled, “A T P.” A curved arrow extends from this
shape to the right pointing arrow, and down to the right to a small brown oval labeled, “A D P.” To the right of the horizontal arrow
is the name Glucose 6 phosphate, which is followed by another horizontal, right pointing arrow which is labeled, “G 6 P D.” A
small orange rectangle below and left of this arrow is labeled “N A D P superscript plus.” A curved arrow extends from this shape
to the right pointing arrow, and down to the right to a small salmon-colored rectangle labeled “N A P D H.” A curved arrow
extends from this shape below and to the left, back to the orange rectangle labeled, “N A D P superscript plus.” Another curved
arrow extends from a green oval labeled “G S S G” below the orange rectangle, up to the arrow curving back to the orange
rectangle. This last curved arrow continues on to the lower right to a second green oval labeled, “G S H.” The end of this curved
arrow is labeled, “Glutathione reductase.” To the right of the rightmost horizontal arrow appears the name 6 phosphogluconate.
Figure 12.7.6 : There are four steps in the catalysis of the reaction C H + H ⟶ C H by nickel. (a) Hydrogen is adsorbed on
2 4 2 2 6
the surface, breaking the H–H bonds and forming Ni–H bonds. (b) Ethylene is adsorbed on the surface, breaking the π-bond and
forming Ni–C bonds. (c) Atoms diffuse across the surface and form new C–H bonds when they collide. (d) C2H6 molecules escape
from the nickel surface, since they are not strongly attracted to nickel.
In this figure, four diagrams labeled a through d are shown. In each, a green square surface is shown in perspective to provide a
three-dimensional appearance. In a, the label “N i surface” is placed above with a line segment extending to the green square. At
the lower left and upper right, pairs of white spheres bonded tougher together appear as well as white spheres on the green surface.
Black arrows are drawn from each of the white spheres above the surface to the white sphere on the green surface. In b, the white
spheres are still present on the green surface. Near the center of this surface is a molecule with two central black spheres with a
double bond indicated by two horizontal black rods between them. Above and below to the left and right, a total of four white
spheres are connected to the black spheres with white rods. A line segment extends from this structure to the label, “Ethylene
absorbed on surface breaking pi bonds.” Just above this is a nearly identical structure greyed out with three downward pointing
arrows to the black and white structure to indicate downward motion. The label “Ethylene” at the top of the diagram is connected
to the greyed out structure with a line segment. In c, the diagram is very similar to b except that the greyed out structure and labels
are gone and one of the white spheres near the black and white structure in each pair on the green surface is greyed out. Arrows
point from the greyed out white spheres to the double bond between the two black spheres. In d, only a single white sphere remains
from each pair in the green surface. A curved arrow points from the middle of the green surface to a model above with two central
black spheres with a single black rod indicating a single bond between them. Each of the black rods has three small white spheres
bonded as indicated by white rods between the black spheres and the small white spheres. The four bonds around each black sphere
are evenly distributed about the black spheres.
Other significant industrial processes that involve the use of heterogeneous catalysts include the preparation of sulfuric acid, the
preparation of ammonia, the oxidation of ammonia to nitric acid, and the synthesis of methanol, CH3OH. Heterogeneous catalysts
are also used in the catalytic converters found on most gasoline-powered automobiles (Figure 12.7.7).
Scientists developed catalytic converters to reduce the amount of toxic emissions produced by burning gasoline in internal
combustion engines. Catalytic converters take advantage of all five factors that affect the speed of chemical reactions to ensure
that exhaust emissions are as safe as possible.
By utilizing a carefully selected blend of catalytically active metals, it is possible to effect complete combustion of all carbon-
containing compounds to carbon dioxide while also reducing the output of nitrogen oxides. This is particularly impressive
when we consider that one step involves adding more oxygen to the molecule and the other involves removing the oxygen
(Figure 12.7.6).
In order to be as efficient as possible, most catalytic converters are preheated by an electric heater. This ensures that the metals in
the catalyst are fully active even before the automobile exhaust is hot enough to maintain appropriate reaction temperatures.
isomerases isomerization
Enzyme molecules possess an active site, a part of the molecule with a shape that allows it to bond to a specific substrate (a
reactant molecule), forming an enzyme-substrate complex as a reaction intermediate. There are two models that attempt to explain
Figure 12.7.7 : (a) According to the lock-and-key model, the shape of an enzyme’s active site is a perfect fit for the substrate. (b)
According to the induced fit model, the active site is somewhat flexible, and can change shape in order to bond with the substrate.
A diagram is shown of two possible interactions of an enzyme and a substrate. In a, which is labeled “Lock-and-key,” two diagrams
are shown. The first shows a green wedge-like shape with two small depressions in the upper surface of similar size, but the
depression on the left has a curved shape, and the depression on the right has a pointed shape. This green shape is labeled
“Enzyme.” Just above this shape are two smaller, irregular, lavender shapes each with a projection from its lower surface. The
lavender shape on the left has a curved projection which matches the shape of the depression on the left in the green shape below.
This projection is shaded orange and has a curved arrow extending from in to the matching depression in the green shape below.
Similarly, the lavender shape on the right has a projection with a pointed tip which matches the shape of the depression on the right
in the green shape below. This projection is shaded orange and has a curved arrow extending from in to the matching depression in
the green shape below. Two line segments extend from the depressions in the green shape to form an inverted V shape above the
depressions. Above this and between the lavender shapes is the label, “Active site is proper shape.” The label “Substrates” is at the
very top of the diagram with line segments extending to the two lavender shapes. To the right of this diagram is a second diagram
showing the lavender shapes positioned next to each other, fit snugly into the depressions in the green shape, which is labeled
“Enzyme.” Above this diagram is the label, “Substrate complex formed.” In b, which is labeled “Induced fit,” two diagrams are
shown. The first shows a green wedge-like shape with two small depressions in the upper surface of similar size, but irregular
shape. This green shape is labeled “Enzyme.” Just above this shape are two smaller irregular lavender shapes each with a projection
from its lower surface. The lavender shape on the left has a curved projection. This projection is shaded orange and has a curved
arrow extending from it to the irregular depression just below it in the green shape below. Similarly, the lavender shape on the right
has a projection with a pointed tip. This projection is shaded orange and has a curved arrow extending from it to the irregular
depression just below it in the green shape below. Two line segments extend from the depressions in the green shape to form an
inverted V shape above the depressions. Above this and between the lavender shapes is the label, “Active site changes to fit.” The
label, “Substrates” is at the very top of the diagram with line segments extending to the two lavender shapes. To the right of this
diagram is a second diagram showing the purple shapes positioned next to each other, fit snugly into the depressions in the green
shape, which is labeled “Enzyme.” Above this diagram is the label “Substrate complex formed.” The projections from the lavender
shapes match the depression shapes in the green shape, resulting in a proper fit.
Summary
Catalysts affect the rate of a chemical reaction by altering its mechanism to provide a lower activation energy. Catalysts can be
homogenous (in the same phase as the reactants) or heterogeneous (a different phase than the reactants).
Footnotes
1. “The Nobel Prize in Chemistry 1995,” Nobel Prize.org, accessed February 18, 2015, Nobel Prizes Chemistry
[www.nobelprize.org].
Glossary
heterogeneous catalyst
catalyst present in a different phase from the reactants, furnishing a surface at which a reaction can occur
homogeneous catalyst
This page titled 12.7: Catalysis is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Solution
First, a general reaction rate must be defined to know what any variation of a rate is. The reaction rate is defined as the measure
of the change in concentration of the reactants or products per unit time. The rate of a chemical reaction is not a constant and
rather changes continuously, and can be influenced by temperature. Rate of a reaction can be defined as the disappearance of
any reactant or appearance of any product. Thus, an average rate is the average reaction rate over a given period of time in the
reaction, the instantaneous rate is the reaction rate at a specific given moment during the reaction, and the initial rate is the
instantaneous rate at the very start of the reaction (when the product begins to form).
The instantaneous rate of a reaction can be denoted as
Δ[concentration]
lim
Δt→0 Δt
12.E.1.2: Q12.1.2
Ozone decomposes to oxygen according to the equation 2 O (g) ⟶ 3 O (g) . Write the equation that relates the rate expressions
3 2
for this reaction in terms of the disappearance of O3 and the formation of oxygen.
Solution
For the general reaction, aA ---> bB, the rate of the reaction can be expressed in terms of the disappearance of A or the
appearance of B over a certain time period as follows.
We want the rate of a reaction to be positive, but the change in the concentration of a reactant, A, will be negative because it is
being used up to be transformed into product, B. Therefore, when expressing the rate of the reaction in terms of the change in
the concentration of A, it is important to add a negative sign in front to ensure the overall rate positive.
Lastly, the rate must be normalized according to the stoichiometry of the reaction. In the decomposition of ozone to oxygen,
two moles of ozone form three moles of oxygen gas. This means that the increase in oxygen gas will be 1.5 times as great as the
decrease in ozone. Because the rate of the reaction should be able to describe both species, we divide the change in
concentration by its stoichiometric coefficient in the balanced reaction equation to deal with this issue.
Therefore, the rate of the reaction of the decomposition of ozone into oxygen gas can be described as follows:
Δ[O3] Δ[O2]
Rate = − = (12.E.2)
2ΔT 3ΔT
Answer
$$Rate=-\frac{Δ[O3]}{2ΔT}=\frac{Δ[O2]}{3ΔT}\]
12.E.1.3: Q12.1.3
In the nuclear industry, chlorine trifluoride is used to prepare uranium hexafluoride, a volatile compound of uranium used in the
separation of uranium isotopes. Chlorine trifluoride is prepared by the reaction Cl (g) + 3 F (g) ⟶ 2 ClF (g) . Write the
2 2 3
equation that relates the rate expressions for this reaction in terms of the disappearance of Cl2 and F2 and the formation of ClF3.
Solution
In this problem we are asked to write the equation that relates rate expressions in terms of disappearance of the reactants of the
equation and in terms of the formation of the product. A reaction rate gives insight to how rate is affected as a function of
aA + bB ⟶ cC + dD
.
Δ[A] Δ[B] Δ[C ] Δ[D]
And the rate can then be written as rate = − 1
a
=−
Δt
1
b Δt
=
1
c Δt
=
1
d Δt
. Here the negative signs are used to keep
the convention of expressing rates as positive numbers.
In this specific case we use the stoichiometry to get the specific rates of disappearance and formation (back to what was said in
the first paragraph). So, the problem just involves referring the to the equation and its balanced coefficients. Based upon the
equation we see that Cl2 is a reactant and has no coefficient, F2 has a coefficient of 3 and is also used up, and then ClF3 is a
product that increases two-fold with a coefficient of 2. So, the rate here can be written as:
Δ[C l2 ] 1 Δ[ F2 ] 1 Δ[C lF3 ]
rate = − =− =
Δt 3 Δt 2 Δt
Answer
1 Δ[ CIF3 ] Δ[ Cl ]
2 1 Δ[ F2 ]
rate = + =− =−
2 Δt Δt 3 Δt
12.E.1.4: Q12.1.4
A study of the rate of dimerization of C4H6 gave the data shown in the table:
2C H ⟶ C H
4 6 8 12
[C4H6] (M) 1.00 × 10−2 5.04 × 10−3 3.37 × 10−3 2.53 × 10−3 2.08 × 10−3
a. Determine the average rate of dimerization between 0 s and 1600 s, and between 1600 s and 3200 s.
b. Estimate the instantaneous rate of dimerization at 3200 s from a graph of time versus [C4H6]. What are the units of this rate?
c. Determine the average rate of formation of C8H12 at 1600 s and the instantaneous rate of formation at 3200 s from the rates
found in parts (a) and (b).
Solution
1.) The average rate of dimerization is the change in concentration of a reactant per unit time. In this case it would be:
Δ[ C4 H6 ]
rate of dimerization = −
Δt
−6 M
rate of dimerization = 3.10 × 10
s
−6 M
rate of dimerization = 1.04 × 10
s
2.) The instantaneous rate of dimerization at 3200 s can be found by graphing time versus [C4H6].
3200s−1600s
−0.00167M
1600s
−6 M
−1.04 × 10
s
For the slope between 3200 s and 4800 s use the points (3200s, 3.37 x 10-3 M) and (4800s, 2.53 x 10-3 M)
−3 −3
2.53×10 M−3.37×10 M
4800s−3200s
−4
−8.4×10 M
1600s
−7 M
−5.25 × 10
s
Take the two slopes you just found and find the average of them to get the instantaneous rate of dimerization.
−6 M −7 M
−1.04×10 +−5.25×x10
s s
−6 M
−1.565×10
s
− M
−7.83 × 10 7
s
s
and the units of this rate is M
s
.
3.) The average rate of formation of C8H12 at 1600 s and the instantaneous rate of formation at 3200 s can be found by using
our answers from part a and b. If you look back up at the original equation, you could see that C4H6 and C8H12 are related in a
two to one ratio. For every two moles of C4H6 used, there is one mole of C8H12 produced.
For this reaction, the average rate of dimerization and the average rate of formation can be linked through this equation:
−1 Δ[ C4 H6 ] Δ[ C8 H1 2 ]
=
2 Δt Δt
Notice that reactant side is negative because the reactants are being used up in the reaction.
So, for the average rate of formation of C8H12 at 1600 s, use the rate of dimerization between 0 s and 1600 s we found earlier
and plug into the equation:
−1 Δ[ C8 H12 ]
−6 M
× 3.10 × 10 =
2 s Δt
Δ[ C8 H12 ]
−6 M
= 1.55 × 10
Δt s
s
. The rate of formation will be positive because products
are being formed.
The instantaneous rate of formation for C8H12 can be linked to the instantaneous rate of dimerization by this equation:
So, for the instantaneous rate of formation for C8H12 at 3200 s, use the value of instantaneous rate of dimerization at 3200 s
found earlier and plug into the equation:
−1 M d[ C8 H12 ]
−
× −7.83 × 10 7 =
2 s dt
d[ C8 H12 ]
−7 M
= −3.92 × 10
dt s
Answer
a. 3.10 × 10
−6 M
s
and 1.04 × 10 −6 M
s
b. −7.83 × 10
−
7
M
s
and M
c. −3.92 × 10
−
7
M
12.E.1.5: Q12.1.5
A study of the rate of the reaction represented as 2A ⟶ B gave the following data:
a. Determine the average rate of disappearance of A between 0.0 s and 10.0 s, and between 10.0 s and 20.0 s.
b. Estimate the instantaneous rate of disappearance of A at 15.0 s from a graph of time versus [A]. What are the units of this rate?
c. Use the rates found in parts (a) and (b) to determine the average rate of formation of B between 0.00 s and 10.0 s, and the
instantaneous rate of formation of B at 15.0 s.
Solution
Equations: −△A
△time
and Rate= −△A
2△time
=
△B
time
−△A
Solve: 1.)The change in A from 0s to 10s is .625-1=-.375 so △time
=.375/10= 0.0374 M/s
△time
=.255/20-10= 0.0255M/s
2.) We can estimate the rate law graphing the points against different order equations to determine the right order.
Zero Order:
d[A]
= −k
dt
A t
∫ d[A] = −k ∫ dt
A∘ 0
[A] = −kt + [ A∘ ]
First Order:
d[A]
= −k[A]
dt
A
d[A]
∫ = −kdt
A∘ [A]
Second Order:
A t
d[A]
∫ = −k ∫ dt
2
A∘ [A] 0
1 1
= kt +
[A] [ A∘ ]
Now that we have found the linear from of each order we will plot the points vs an [A] y-axis, a Ln(A) y-axis, and a 1/[A]
y-axis. whichever of the plots has the most linear points will give us a good idea of the order and the slope will be the k
value.
Here we notice that the second order is most linear so we conclude the Rate to be..
−d[A]
2
= k[A]
2dt
At 15 seconds [A]=.465 and from the slope of the graph we find k=.116.so if we plug this data in and multiply both sides
by 2 to get rid of the 2 in the denominator on the left side of the equation we find that the rate of disappearance of A is .05
M/s where the units are equivalent to [mol*L-1*s-1]
3.) Using the equation −△A
=
2△time
we divide the rates in part a and b in half to get .0188 M/s from 0 to 10 seconds
△B
time
Answer
(a) average rate, 0 − 10 s = 0.0375 mol L−1 s−1; average rate, 12 − 18 s = 0.0225 mol L−1 s−1; (b) instantaneous rate, 15 s =
0.0500 mol L−1 s−1; (c) average rate for B formation = 0.0188 mol L−1 s−1; instantaneous rate for B formation = 0.0250 mol L−1
s−1
12.E.1.6: Q12.1.6
Consider the following reaction in aqueous solution:
− − +
5 Br (aq) + BrO 3 (aq) + 6 H (aq) ⟶ 3 Br (aq) + 3 H O(l)
2 2
– −4
If the rate of disappearance of Br (aq) at a particular moment during the reaction is 3.5 × 10 M s−1, what is the rate of appearance
of Br2(aq) at that moment?
Solution
Step 1. Define the rate of the reaction.
Recall:
For the general reaction: aA + bB → cC+ dD
Δ[A] Δ[B] Δ[C ] Δ[D]
rate = − =− = =
aΔt bΔt cΔt dΔt
− − +
Δ[Br ] Δ[BrO ] Δ[ H ] Δ[Br2 ] H2 O
The rate would be: rate = − 5Δt
=−
Δt
3
=−
6Δt
=
3Δt
=
3Δt
−
Δ[Br ] Δ[Br2 ]
rate = − =
5Δt 3Δt
−
Δ[Br ]
And,− Δt
= −3.5x 10
−4
Ms
−1
Δ[Br2 ]
So, 3.5x 10 −4
Ms
−1
= 5
3 Δt
Δ[Br2 ]
−4 −1
= 2.1x 10 Ms
Δt
Answer
Δ[Br2 ]
−4 −1
= 2.1x 10 Ms
Δt
Solution
Molarity of Hydrochloric Acid
Reaction rates are affected by the frequency at which molecules collide. High Molarity=High Concentration which means
more molecules are available to collide thus a faster reaction that one with a low molarity of HCl at a fixed volume.
Temperature of Solution
Higher temperatures increase the rate of reaction because molecules move faster thus colliding more frequently
increasing temperatures allows for more particles to move past activation energy barrier to start the reaction
Size of pieces of Magnesium
reaction rate is dependent on solid reactant size; smaller pieces increases the chance of collision because they enable a
greater surface area thus faster reaction rate
12.E.2.2: Q12.2.2
Go to the PhET Reactions & Rates interactive. Use the Single Collision tab to represent how the collision between monatomic
oxygen (O) and carbon monoxide (CO) results in the breaking of one bond and the formation of another. Pull back on the red
plunger to release the atom and observe the results. Then, click on “Reload Launcher” and change to “Angled shot” to see the
difference.
a. What happens when the angle of the collision is changed?
b. Explain how this is relevant to rate of reaction.
Solution
According to the collision theory, there are many factors that cause a reaction to happen, with three of the factors being how
often the molecules or atoms collide, the molecules' or atoms' orientations, and if there is sufficient energy for the reaction to
happen. So, if the angle of the plunger is changed, the atom that is shot (a lone Oxygen atom in this case) will hit the other
molecule (CO in this case) at a different spot and at a different angle, therefore changing the orientation and the number of
proper collisions will most likely not cause for a reaction to happen. Thanks to the simulation, we can see that this is true:
depending on the angle selected, the atom may take a long time to collide with the molecule and, when a collision does occur, it
may not result in the breaking of the bond and the forming of the other (no reaction happens).
12.E.2.3: Q12.2.3
In the PhET Reactions & Rates interactive, use the “Many Collisions” tab to observe how multiple atoms and molecules interact
under varying conditions. Select a molecule to pump into the chamber. Set the initial temperature and select the current amounts of
each reactant. Select “Show bonds” under Options. How is the rate of the reaction affected by concentration and temperature?
12.E.2.4: S12.2.3
Based on the Collision Theory, a reaction will only occur if the molecules collide with proper orientation and with sufficient energy
required for the reaction to occur. The minimum energy the molecules must collide with is called the activation energy (energy of
transition state).
Increasing the concentration of reactants increases the probability that reactants will collide in the correct orientation since there are
more reactants in the same volume of space. Therefore, increasing the concentration of reactants would increase the rate of the
reaction. Decreasing the concentration of reactants would decrease the rate of reaction because the overall number of possible
collisions would decrease.
Temperature is directly related the the kinetic energy of molecules and activation energy E is the minimum energy required for a
a
reaction to occur and doesn't change for a reaction. Increasing the temperature increases the kinetic energy of the reactants meaning
the reactants will move faster and collide with each other more frequently. Therefore, increasing the temperature increase the rate
of the reaction. Decreasing the temperature decreases the rate of reaction since the molecules will have less kinetic energy, move
slower, and therefore collide with each other less frequently.
12.E.2.5: Q12.2.4
In the PhET Reactions & Rates interactive, on the Many Collisions tab, set up a simulation with 15 molecules of A and 10
molecules of BC. Select “Show Bonds” under Options.
a. Leave the Initial Temperature at the default setting. Observe the reaction. Is the rate of reaction fast or slow?
b. Click “Pause” and then “Reset All,” and then enter 15 molecules of A and 10 molecules of BC once again. Select “Show
Bonds” under Options. This time, increase the initial temperature until, on the graph, the total average energy line is completely
above the potential energy curve. Describe what happens to the reaction.
Solution
a. On the simulation, we select the default setting and the reaction A+BC. In the default setting, we see frequent collisions, a
low initial temperature, and a total average energy lower than the energy of activation. The collision theory states that the rate of
a reaction is directly proportional to (the fraction of molecules with required orientation), (fractions of collisions with required
energy), and (collision frequency). Although we see moving and frequently colliding reactants, the rate of the forward reaction
is actually slow because it takes a long time for the products, AB and C, to start appearing. This is mainly because the fractions
of collisions with required energy is low, coming from the average energy of the molecules being lower than the energy of
activation.
b. The reaction proceeds at an even faster rate. Again, the collision theory states that the rate of a reaction is directly
proportional to (the fraction of molecules with required orientation), (fractions of collisions with required energy), and
(collision frequency). Because molecules have a higher amount of energy, they have more kinetic energy. With an increased
kinetic energy, the molecules not only collide more but also increase in the fraction of collision. However, the forward reaction
and the backward reaction both proceed at a fast rate, so both happen almost simultaneously. It takes a shorter time for both
reactions to happen. With both of the reactions adding up together overall, there is eventually a state of equilibrium. The process
at which equilibrium is reached, however, is faster. Therefore, the amount of products of A+BC stays the same after a while.
The rate constant (k) is a proportionality constant that relates the reaction rates to reactants. If the concentrations change, the rate
constant does not change.
For a reaction with the general equation: aA + bB → cC + dD
the experimentally determined rate law usually has the following form:
12.E.3.3: Q12.3.2
Doubling the concentration of a reactant increases the rate of a reaction four times. With this knowledge, answer the following
questions:
a. What is the order of the reaction with respect to that reactant?
b. Tripling the concentration of a different reactant increases the rate of a reaction three times. What is the order of the reaction
with respect to that reactant?
Solution
(a) 2; (b) 1
12.E.3.4: Q12.3.3
Tripling the concentration of a reactant increases the rate of a reaction nine times. With this knowledge, answer the following
questions:
a. What is the order of the reaction with respect to that reactant?
b. Increasing the concentration of a reactant by a factor of four increases the rate of a reaction four times. What is the order of the
reaction with respect to that reactant?
12.E.3.5: Q12.3.4
How much and in what direction will each of the following affect the rate of the reaction:
CO(g) + NO (g) ⟶ CO
2 2
(g) + NO(g) if the rate law for the reaction is rate = k[NO ] ?
2
2
Solution
(a) The process reduces the rate by a factor of 4. (b) Since CO does not appear in the rate law, the rate is not affected.
12.E.3.6: Q12.3.5
How will each of the following affect the rate of the reaction: CO(g) + NO (g) ⟶ CO (g) + NO(g)
2 2
if the rate law for the
reaction is rate = k[NO ][CO] ?
2
12.E.3.7: Q12.3.6
Regular flights of supersonic aircraft in the stratosphere are of concern because such aircraft produce nitric oxide, NO, as a
byproduct in the exhaust of their engines. Nitric oxide reacts with ozone, and it has been suggested that this could contribute to
depletion of the ozone layer. The reaction NO + O ⟶ NO + O is first order with respect to both NO and O3 with a rate
3 2 2
Solution
4.3 × 10−5 mol/L/s
12.E.3.8: Q12.3.7
Radioactive phosphorus is used in the study of biochemical reaction mechanisms because phosphorus atoms are components of
many biochemical molecules. The location of the phosphorus (and the location of the molecule it is bound in) can be detected from
the electrons (beta particles) it produces:
32 32 −
15
P ⟶ S+e
16
What is the instantaneous rate of production of electrons in a sample with a phosphorus concentration of 0.0033 M?
12.E.3.9: Q12.3.8
The rate constant for the radioactive decay of 14C is 1.21 × 10−4 year−1. The products of the decay are nitrogen atoms and electrons
(beta particles):
6 6 −
14
C ⟶ N+e
14
6
rate = k[ C]
14
What is the instantaneous rate of production of N atoms in a sample with a carbon-14 content of 6.5 × 10−9 M?
Solution
7.9 × 10−13 mol/L/year
12.E.3.10: Q12.3.9
What is the instantaneous rate of production of N atoms Q12.3.8 in a sample with a carbon-14 content of 1.5 × 10−9 M?
12.E.3.11: Q12.3.10
The decomposition of acetaldehyde is a second order reaction with a rate constant of 4.71 × 10−8 L/mol/s. What is the
instantaneous rate of decomposition of acetaldehyde in a solution with a concentration of 5.55 × 10−4 M?
12.E.3.12: Q12.3.11
Alcohol is removed from the bloodstream by a series of metabolic reactions. The first reaction produces acetaldehyde; then other
products are formed. The following data have been determined for the rate at which alcohol is removed from the blood of an
average male, although individual rates can vary by 25–30%. Women metabolize alcohol a little more slowly than men:
Determine the rate equation, the rate constant, and the overall order for this reaction.
Solution
rate = k; k = 2.0 × 10−2 mol/L/h (about 0.9 g/L/h for the average male); The reaction is zero order.
12.E.3.13: Q12.3.12
Under certain conditions the decomposition of ammonia on a metal surface gives the following data:
12.E.3.14: Q12.3.13
Nitrosyl chloride, NOCl, decomposes to NO and Cl2.
Determine the rate equation, the rate constant, and the overall order for this reaction from the following data:
Solution
Before we can figure out the rate constant first we must first determine the basic rate equation and rate order. The basic rate
equation for this reaction, where n is the rate order of NOCl and k is the rate constant, is
n
rate = k[N OC l]
Now that we have the order, we can substitute the first experimental values from the given table to find the rate constant, k
(8.0 x 10-10(mol/L/h)) = k(0.10 M)2 so
−10
8.0 × 10
−8 −1 −1
k = = 8 × 10 M sec
2
(0.10 M )
We were able to find the units of k using rate order, when the rate order is 2 units of k are M-1 x sec-1
So the rate equation is: rate = k[NOCl]2, it is second order, and k = 8 x 10-8 M-1 x sec-1
Overall rate law :
−8 2
rate = (8 × 10 ) [N OC l]
1/(M x sec)
Answer
rate = k[NOCl]2; k = 8.0 × 10−8 L/mol/s; second order
12.E.3.15: Q12.3.14
From the following data, determine the rate equation, the rate constant, and the order with respect to A for the reaction A ⟶ 2C .
Solution
A. Using the experimental data, we can compare the effects of changing [A] on the rate of reaction by relating ratios of [A] to
ratios of rates
and
−6
1.52 × 10
=4
−7
3.8 × 10
B. From this we know that doubling the concentration of A will result in quadrupling the rate of reaction. The order of this
reaction is 2.
C. We can now write the rate equation since we know the order:
2
rate = k[A]
D. By plugging in one set of experimental data into our rate equation we can solve for the rate constant, k:
−7 −2 2
3.8 × 10 = k × (1.33 × 10 )
−7
3.8 × 10
k =
−4
1.769 × 10
−1 −1
k = .00215M s
Answer
−1 −1
k = .00215M s
2nd Order
12.E.3.16: Q12.3.15
Nitrogen(II) oxide reacts with chlorine according to the equation:
The following initial rates of reaction have been observed for certain reactant concentrations:
What is the rate equation that describes the rate’s dependence on the concentrations of NO and Cl2? What is the rate constant?
What are the orders with respect to each reactant?
Solution
For the general equation,
aA + bB → cC + dD
Now, we need to find the reaction orders. Reaction orders can only be found through experimental values. We can compare two
reactions where one of the reactants has the same concentration for both trials, and solve for the reaction order.
We can use the data in the table provided. If we plug in the values for rows 1 and 2, we see that the values for the concentration
of Cl will cancel, leaving just the rates and the concentrations of NO.
m
[0.5]
1.14
= m
4.56 [1.0]
We can now solve for m, and we find that m =2. This means that the reaction order for [NO] is 2.
Now we must find the value of n. To do so, we can use the same equation but with the values from rows 2 and 3. This time, the
concentration of NO will cancel out.
n
4.56 [0.5]
= n
9.12 [1.0]
When we solve for n, we find that n = 1. This means that the reaction order for [Cl2] is 1.
We are one step closer to finishing our rate equation.
2
rate = k[N O] [C l2 ]
Finally, we can solve for the rate constant. To do this, we can use one of the trials of the experiment, and plug in the values for
the rate, and concentrations of reactants, then solve for k.
2
1.14mol/L/h = k[0.5mol/L] [0.5mol/L]
2 −2 −1
k = 9.12 L mol h
*A common mistake is forgetting units. Make sure to track your units throughout the process of determining your rate constant.
Be careful because the units will change relative to the reaction order.
Answer
rate = k[NO]2[Cl]2; k = 9.12 L2 mol−2 h−1; second order in NO; first order in Cl2
12.E.3.17: Q12.3.17
Hydrogen reacts with nitrogen monoxide to form dinitrogen monoxide (laughing gas) according to the equation:
H (g) + 2 NO(g) ⟶ N O(g) + H O(g)
2 2 2
Determine the rate equation, the rate constant, and the orders with respect to each reactant from the following data:
Solution
Determine the rate equation, the rate constant, and the orders with respect to each reactant.
The rate constant and the orders can be determined through the differential rate law. The general form of the differential
rate law is given below:
aA + bB + cC ==> products
where A, B, and C are the concentrations of the reactants, k is the rate constant, and n,m, and p refer to the order of
each reactant.
12.E.3.18: Q12.3.18
For the reaction A ⟶ B + C , the following data were obtained at 30 °C:
a. What is the order of the reaction with respect to [A], and what is the rate equation?
b. What is the rate constant?
Solution
1. The rate equation for an n order reaction is given as dr
dt
= k[A]
n
. Where [A] is the concentration in M, and dr
dt
is the rate in
M/s.
We can then use each set of data points, plug its values into the rate equation and solve for n . Note you can use any of the data
points as long as the concentration corresponds to its rate.
Rate equation 1: 4.17 × 10 −4
= k[0.230 ]
n
We divide Rate equation 1 by Rate equation 2 in order to cancel out k, the rate constant.
n
4.17×10
−4 k[0.230]
= n
−4
9.99×10 k[0.356]
n
0.417 = 0.646
Now the only unknown we have is n . Using logarithm rules one can solve for it.
ln 0.417 = n ⋅ ln 0.646
ln 0.417
=n =2
ln 0.646
dt
= k[A]
2
.
2. We can solve for k by plugging in any data point into our rate equation dr
dt
= k[A]
2
.
L
and dr
dt
= 4.17 × 10
−4 mol
L⋅s
] we get the equation
−4 mol mol 2
4.17 × 10 = k[0.230 ]
L⋅s L
mol⋅s
Since we know this is a second order reaction the appropriate units for k can also be written as 1
M⋅s
Answer
(a) The rate equation is second order in A and is written as rate = k[A]2. (b) k = 7.88 × 10−13 L mol−1 s−1
a. What is the order of the reaction with respect to [Q], and what is the rate equation?
b. What is the rate constant?
Solution
What is the order of the reaction with respect to [Q], and what is the rate equation?
Order reaction: 2 because when you use the ratio trial 3:2, it will look like this:
−2 x
2.94 ∗ 10 0.357
( )=( x
)
−2
1.04 ∗ 10 0.212
2.82 = 1.7x
x = 2 so the order of reaction is 2
Rate reaction equation: Rate=k[Q]2
What is the rate constant?
To find the rate constant (k) simply plug and calculate one of the trials into the rate equation
1.04 x 10-2=k[0.212]2
k=0.231 M s −1 −1
Answer
Order: 2
k=0.231 M −1
s
−1
12.E.3.20: Q12.3.20
The rate constant for the first-order decomposition at 45 °C of dinitrogen pentoxide, N2O5, dissolved in chloroform, CHCl3, is 6.2
× 10−4 min−1.
2N O ⟶ 4 NO +O
2 5 2 2
Solution
Step 1: The first step is to write the rate law. We know the general formula for for a first-order rate law. It is as follows:
Rate=k[A]
Step 2: We now plug in [N2O5] in for [A] in our general rate law. We also plug in our rate constant (k), which was given to us.
Now our equation looks as follows:
Rate=(6.2x10-4 min-1)[N2O5]
Step 3: We now plug in our given molarity. [N2O5]=0.4 M. Now our equation looks as follows:
Rate=(6.2x10-4 min-1)(0.4 M)
Step 4: We now solve our equation. Rate=(6.2x10-4 min-1)(0.4 M)= 2.48x10-4 M/min.
Step 5: Use significant figures and unit conversion to round 2.48x10-4 M/min to 2.5 × 10−4 (moles)L-1min-1
Answer
(a) 2.5 × 10−4 mol/L/min
The first reaction is run by burning ammonia in air over a platinum catalyst. This reaction is fast. The reaction in equation (c) is
also fast. The second reaction limits the rate at which nitric acid can be prepared from ammonia. If equation (b) is second order in
NO and first order in O2, what is the rate of formation of NO2 when the oxygen concentration is 0.50 M and the nitric oxide
concentration is 0.75 M? The rate constant for the reaction is 5.8 × 10−6 L2/mol2/s.
Solution
To determine the rate law for an equation we need to look at its slow step. Since both equation a and c are fast, equation b can
be considered the slow step of the reaction. The slow step is also considered the rate determining step of the system.
Hence, The rate determining step is the second step because it's the slow step.
rate of production of N O 2 = k[A]
m n
[B]
2 1
rate = k[N O] [ O2 ] M /s
−6 2 1
rate = (5.8 ∗ 10 )[0.75 ] [0.5 ] M /s
−6
rate = 1.6 ∗ 10 M /s
Answer
−6
rate = 1.6 ∗ 10 M /s
12.E.3.22: Q12.3.22
The following data have been determined for the reaction:
− − − −
I + OCl ⟶ IO + Cl
1 2 3
[I
−
]i ni t i al (M) 0.10 0.20 0.30
[OCl
−
]i ni t i al (M) 0.050 0.050 0.010
Determine the rate equation and the rate constant for this reaction.
Solution
Using the reactants, we can form the rate law of the reaction: $$ r=k[OCl^-]^n[I^-]^m \]
From there, we need to use the data to determine the order of both [OC l −
] and [I −
. In doing so, we need to compare r to r
] 1 2
such that:
m n −4
r1 (0.10 )(0.050 ) 3.05 × 10
= = (12.E.3)
m n −4
r2 (0.20 )(0.050 ) 6.20 × 10
m
0.5 = 0.5 (12.E.4)
m =1 (12.E.5)
1 n
(5 ) = 1.6666667 (12.E.7)
3
n
5 =5 (12.E.8)
n =1 (12.E.9)
Since we know that orders of both n and m are equal to one, we can not substitute them into the rate law equation along with the
respective concentrations (from either the first, second, or third reaction) and solve for the rate constant, k.
− n − m
r = k[OC l ] [I ] (12.E.10)
−4 1 1
3.05 ∗ 10 = k[0.05 ] [0.10 ] (12.E.11)
−2
L
k = 6.1 ∗ 10 (12.E.12)
mol × s
Thus the overall rate law is: $$ r = (6.1 * 10^{-2} \frac {L}{mol \times s})[OCl^-][I^-] \]
The units for K depend on the overall order of the reaction. To find the overall order we add m and n together. By doing this we
find an overall order of 2. This is why the units for K are $$ \frac {L}{mol \times s} \]
Answer
rate = k[I−][OCl−1]; k = 6.1 × 10−2 L mol −1 s−1
12.E.3.23: Q12.3.23
In the reaction
2N O + C l2 → 2N OC l
the reactants and products are gases at the temperature of the reaction. The following rate data were measured for three
experiments:
a. From these data, write the rate equation for this gas reaction. What order is the reaction in NO, Cl2, and overall?
b. Calculate the specific rate constant for this reaction.
Solution
a. The rate equation can be determined by designing experiments that measure the concentration(s) of one or more reactants or
products as a function of time. For the reaction A + B → products , for example, we need to determine k and the exponents m
and n in the following equation:
m n
rate = k[A] [B]
To do this, the initial concentration of B can be kept constant while varying the initial concentration of A and calculating the
initial reaction rate. This information would deduce the reaction order with respect to A. The same process can be done to find
4 =2
m
⟹ m =2 Because m=2, the reaction with respect to N O is 2. N O is second order.
m n
rate3 k[ A3 ] [ B3 ]
=
m n
rate1 k[ A1 ] [ B1 ]
n
2 =2 ⟹ n =1
To find the overall rate order, you simply add the orders together. Second order + first order makes the overall reaction third
order.
atm
2 1 −3 2 1
rate = k[N O] [C l2 ] ⟹ 5.1 ∗ 10 = k[0.5matm ] [0.5atm ]
sec
1
k = 0.0408
2
atm ∗ sec
Answer
NO is second order.
C l2 is first order.
Overall reaction order is three.
b)
−2 −1
k = 0.0408 atm ∗ sec
Solution
[A] = [A]0 − kt
First order when plotting ln[initial concentration] versus ln[ final concentration] you have a negative linear slope.
ln[A] = ln[A]0 − kt
Second order when plotting the 1/[initial concentration] versus 1/[final concentration] you have a positive linear slope.
1 1
= + kt
[A] [A]0
12.E.4.2: Q12.4.2
Use the data provided to graphically determine the order and rate constant of the following reaction: SO 2
Cl
2
⟶ SO
2
+ Cl
2
Time (s) 0 5.00 × 103 1.00 × 104 1.50 × 104 2.50 × 104 3.00 × 104 4.00 × 104
Solution
Use the data to graphically determine the order and rate constant of the following reaction.
In order to determine the rate law for a reaction from a set of data consisting of concentration (or the values of some function of
concentration) versus time, make three graphs of the data based on the integrated rate laws of each order reaction.
[concentration] versus time (linear for a zero order reaction) ln [concentration] versus time (linear for a 1st order reaction) 1 /
[concentration] versus time (linear for a 2nd order reaction)
slope= -2.0 x 10-5
k = 2.0 x 10-5
The graph that is linear indicates the order of the reaction. Then, you can find the correct rate equation:
In this graph, ln(concentration) vs time is linear, indicating that the reaction is first order.
k=-slope of line
12.E.4.3: Q12.4.3
Use the data provided in a graphical method to determine the order and rate constant of the following reaction:
2P ⟶ Q + W
[P] (M) 1.077 × 10−3 1.068 × 10−3 1.055 × 10−3 1.046 × 10−3 1.039 × 10−3
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
12.E.4.4: Q12.4.4
Pure ozone decomposes slowly to oxygen, 2 O (g) ⟶ 3 O (g)
3 2
. Use the data provided in a graphical method and determine the
order and rate constant of the reaction.
Time (h) 0 2.0 × 103 7.6 × 103 1.23 × 104 1.70 × 104 1.70 × 104
[O3] (M) 1.00 × 10−5 4.98 × 10−6 2.07 × 10−6 1.39 × 10−6 1.22 × 10−6 1.05 × 10−6
Solution
To determine the order and rate constant, you need to graph the data for zero order, first order, and second order by plotting
concentration versus time- [A] vs. time, natural logarithm (ln) of [A] vs. time, and 1/[A] vs. time respectively. The order of the
[P] (M) 1.077 × 10−3 1.068 × 10−3 1.055 × 10−3 1.046 × 10−3 1.039 × 10−3
O
,
3
Answer
12.E.4.5: Q12.4.5
From the given data, use a graphical method to determine the order and rate constant of the following reaction:
Time (s) 5.0 10.0 15.0 20.0 25.0 30.0 35.0 40.0
[X] (M) 0.0990 0.0497 0.0332 0.0249 0.0200 0.0166 0.0143 0.0125
Solution
In order to determine the order of the reaction we need to plot the data using three different graphs. All three graphs will have
time in seconds as the x-axis, but the y-axis is what will differ. One graph will plot concentration versus time, the second will
plot natural log of concentration versus time, and the other will plot 1/concentration versus times. Whichever graph results in a
line, we know that must be the order of the reaction. If we get a line using the first graph, it will be zero order, if it is a line for
the second graph it will be first order, and if it is a line for the third graph it will be a second order reaction. Now lets plot the
data to determine the order.
We can clearly see that the third graph, which plots 1/M versus time, is a straight line while the other two are slightly curved.
Therefore, we can determine that the rate of this reaction is second order. This also tells us that the units of the rate constant
which should be M-2s-1 for a second order reaction.
To determine the rate constant, called k, we simple need to figure out the slope of the third graph since that is the order of this
reaction. To find the slope of the line, we take two points and subtract the y values and then divide them by the difference of the
x values. This is how to do it:
Use the points (5, 10.101) and (40, 80).
Now use these to get the slop, aka the rate constant: (80-10.101)/(40-5) = 1.997 = k
So the rate constant for this second order reaction is 1.997 M-1s-1.
12.E.4.6: Q12.4.6
What is the half-life for the first-order decay of phosphorus-32? ( 32
15
P ⟶
32
16
S+e
−
) The rate constant for the decay is 4.85 × 10−2
day−1.
Solution
This is a first order reaction, so we can use our half life equation below:
0.693
t1/2 =
k
The rate constant is given to us in units per day. All we have to do, is to plug it into the equation.
= 14.3 days
A12.4.6
14.3 d
12.E.4.7: Q12.4.7
What is the half-life for the first-order decay of carbon-14? (
6
14
C ⟶
7
14
N+e
−
) The rate constant for the decay is 1.21 × 10−4
year−1.
Solution
To find the half life, we need to use the first-order half-life equation. All half life reactions undergo first order reactions.
The half-life equation for first order is
t1/2 = ln2/k
with k being the rate constant. The rate constant for carbon-14 was given as 1.21 × 10 −4
year
−1
.
Plug it in the equation.
−4 −1
t1/2 = ln2/(1.21 × 10 year )
Answer
The half-life for carbon-14 is calculated to be 5.73*103
12.E.4.8: Q12.4.8
What is the half-life for the decomposition of NOCl when the concentration of NOCl is 0.15 M? The rate constant for this second-
order reaction is 8.0 × 10−8 L/mol/s.
Solution
The half-life of a reaction, t1/2, is the amount of time that is required for a reactant concentration to decrease by half compared
to its initial concentration. When solving for the half-life of a reaction, we should first consider the order of reaction to
determine it's rate law. In this case, we are told that this reaction is second-order, so we know that the integrated rate law is
given as:
1 1
= kt +
[A] [A]0
Now it is just a matter of substituting the information we have been given to calculate t 1/2
, where the rate constant, k , is equal
to 8.0 × 10−8 L/mol/s and initial concentration, [A] , is equal to 0.15M:
0
1 7
t1/2 = = 8.33 × 10 seconds
−8
(8.0 × 10 )(0.15)
Answer
8.33 × 107 s
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
1
t1/2 =
−1 −6
(50.4 M /h)[2.35 × 10 M]
12.E.4.10: Q12.4.10
The reaction of compound A to give compounds C and D was found to be second-order in A. The rate constant for the reaction was
determined to be 2.42 L/mol/s. If the initial concentration is 0.500 mol/L, what is the value of t1/2?
Solution
As mentioned in the question the reaction of compound A will result in the formation of compounds C and D. This reaction was
found to be second-order in A. Therefore, we should use the second order equation for half-life which relates the rate constant
and initial concentrations to the half-life:
1
t 1 =
2 k[A]0
Since we were given k (rate constant) and Initial concentration of A, we have everything needed to calculate the half life of A.
L
mol
k = 0.5
s
mol
[A]0 = 2.42
L
When we plug in the given information notice that the units cancel out to seconds.
1
t 1 = = 0.826s
−
2 2.42Lmol mol
[0.500 ]
s L
Answer
0.826 s
12.E.4.11: Q12.4.11
The half-life of a reaction of compound A to give compounds D and E is 8.50 minutes when the initial concentration of A is 0.150
mol/L. How long will it take for the concentration to drop to 0.0300 mol/L if the reaction is (a) first order with respect to A or (b)
second order with respect to A?
Solution
Organize the given variables:
(half-life of A) t = 8.50min
1/2
t1 / 2
8.50min
= 0.0815mi n
−1
[A]
(rearranged for t) ln( [A]
) = −kt
0
[A]
−ln( ) = kt
[A]
0
[A]
−1
ln( ) = kt
[A]
0
[A]0
ln( ) = kt
[A]
[A]
0
ln( )
[A]
t =
k
0 .1 5 0 mol/ L
ln( )
ln(5.00)
(plug in variables) t =
0 .0 3 0 0 mol/ L
= = 19.7min
0.0815min− 1 0.0815min− 1
(rearranged for k) k = 1
t1 / 2[A]
0
1.275min⋅mol/L
= 0.784L/mol ⋅ min
(rearranged for t) 1
[A]
−
[A]0
1
= kt
1 1 1
t = ( − )
k [A] [A]0
0.0300mol/L
−
1
0.150mol/L
) =
1
0.784L/mol⋅min
(
80
3
L/mol) = 34.0min
Answer
a) 19.7 min
b) 34.0 min
12.E.4.12: Q12.4.12
Some bacteria are resistant to the antibiotic penicillin because they produce penicillinase, an enzyme with a molecular weight of 3
× 104 g/mol that converts penicillin into inactive molecules. Although the kinetics of enzyme-catalyzed reactions can be complex,
at low concentrations this reaction can be described by a rate equation that is first order in the catalyst (penicillinase) and that also
involves the concentration of penicillin. From the following data: 1.0 L of a solution containing 0.15 µg (0.15 × 10−6 g) of
penicillinase, determine the order of the reaction with respect to penicillin and the value of the rate constant.
Solution
The first step is to solve for the order or the reaction. This can be done by setting up two expressions which equate the rate to
the rate constant times the molar concentration of penicillin raised to the power of it's order. Once we have both expressions set
We can now use the natural logarithm to solve for x, or simply and intuitively see that in order for
the equation to work, x must be equal to one. Thus, the reaction is of the first order.
Now that we have the order of the reaction, we can proceed to solve for the value of the rate constant. Substituting x=1 into our
first equation yields the expression:
(1 x 10-10)=k[2.0 x 10-6]1
k=(1 x 10-10)/(2 x 10-6)
k= (5 x 10-5) min-1
We have a unit of min-1 because we divided (mol/L/min) by molarity, which is in (mol/L), yielding a unit of min-1.
We were given two important pieces of information to finish the problem. It is stated that the enzyme has a molecular weight of
3 × 104 g/mol, and that we have a one liter solution that contains (0.15 x 10-6 g) of penicillinase. Dividing the amount of grams
by the molecular weight yields 5 x 10-12 moles.
(0.15 x 10-6) g / (3 x 104) g/mol = (5 x 10-12) mol
Now that we have the amount of moles, we can divide our rate constant by this value.
(5 x 10-5) min-1 / (5 x 10-12) mol = (1 x 107) mol-1 min -1
Answer
12.E.4.13: Q12.4.13
Both technetium-99 and thallium-201 are used to image heart muscle in patients with suspected heart problems. The half-lives are 6
h and 73 h, respectively. What percent of the radioactivity would remain for each of the isotopes after 2 days (48 h)?
Solution
This problem is asking us for the percentage of radioactivity remaining after a certain time for both isotopes after 48 hours. We
must identify an equation that will help us solve this and we can determine that we can determine this information using the
first order equation.
Answer
Technetium-99: 0.39%
Thallium-201: 63.40%
12.E.4.14: Q12.4.14
There are two molecules with the formula C3H6. Propene, CH CH=CH , is the monomer of the polymer polypropylene, which is
3 2
When heated to 499 °C, cyclopropane rearranges (isomerizes) and forms propene with a rate constant of 5.95 × 10−4 s−1. What is
the half-life of this reaction? What fraction of the cyclopropane remains after 0.75 h at 499 °C?
Solution
Use the equation
ln2
t1 / 2 =
k
since this is a first-order reaction. You can tell that this is a first order reaction due to the units of measurement of the rate
constant, which is s-1. Different orders of reactions lead to different rate constants, and a rate constant of s-1 will always be first
order.
Plug into the equation, and you get half life = 1164.95 seconds. To convert this to hours, we would divide this number by 3600
seconds/hour, to get 0.324 hours.
Use the integrated first order rate law
[A]
ln = −kt
[A]0
. In this equation, [A]0 represents the initial amount of compound present at time 0, while [A] represents the amount of
compound that is left after the reaction has occurred. Therefore, the fraction
[A]
[A]0
is equal to the fraction of cyclopropane that remains after a certain amount of time, in this case, 0.75 hours.
Substitute x for the fraction of
[A]
[A]0
−4
ln(x) = −5.95x 10 (0.75)
(−0.000595)(0.75)
x =e
= 0.20058 = 20%.
So, the half life is 0.324 hours, and 20% of the cyclopropane will remain as 80% will have formed propene.
Answer
0.324 hours. ; 20% remains
12.E.4.15: Q12.4.16
Fluorine-18 is a radioactive isotope that decays by positron emission to form oxygen-18 with a half-life of 109.7 min. (A positron
is a particle with the mass of an electron and a single unit of positive charge; the nuclear equation is F ⟶ O + e .)
18
9
18
8
0
1
+
Physicians use 18F to study the brain by injecting a quantity of fluoro-substituted glucose into the blood of a patient. The glucose
accumulates in the regions where the brain is active and needs nourishment.
a. What is the rate constant for the decomposition of fluorine-18?
b. If a sample of glucose containing radioactive fluorine-18 is injected into the blood, what percent of the radioactivity will remain
after 5.59 h?
c. How long does it takFe for 99.99% of the 18F to decay?
Solution
a) The nuclear decay of an isotope of an element is represented by the first order equation:
ln(N/N0) = −kt
Where t is time, N0 is the initial amount of the substance, N is the amount of the substance after time t, and k is the rate
constant. We can rearrange the equation and isolate k so that we could solve for the rate constant:
k = [-ln(N/N0)] / t
We are given that fluorine-18 has a half-life of 109.7 minutes. Since we have the half-life, we can choose an arbitrary value for
N0 and use half of that value for N. In this case, we choose 100 for N0 and 50 for N. Now we can plug in those values into the
equation above and solve for k.
k = [-ln(50/100)] / 109.7
k = 0.6931 / 109.7 = 0.006319 min-1
The rate constant for this reaction is 0.006319 min-1.
b) For this problem, we are able to use the same equation from part a:
ln(N/N0) = −kt
However, this time we are given the amount of time elapsed instead of the half-life, and we are asked to determine the percent
of fluorine-18 radioactivity remaining after that time. In this problem, we must plug in values for N0, k (determined from part
a), and t.
But first, since we are given the elapsed time in hours, we must convert it into minutes:
5.59 hours x (60 minutes / 1 hours) = 335.4 minutes
This gives us the value for t. We also have values for k (0.006319 min-1) and N0 (again an arbitrary number.) Now we can plug
values into the original equation, giving us:
ln(N/100) = −(0.006319)(335.4)
We solve this equation by taking the exponential of both sides:
Answer
a) 0.006319 min-1
b) 12.0%
c) 1458 minutes
12.E.4.16: Q12.4.17
Suppose that the half-life of steroids taken by an athlete is 42 days. Assuming that the steroids biodegrade by a first-order process,
1
how long would it take for of the initial dose to remain in the athlete’s body?
64
Solution
252 days
for first order reaction: t1/2 = 0.693 / k
k = 0.693 / 42
k = 0.0165
for first order reaction: [A] = [A]0 e-kt
1/64 initial means that: [A] = 1/64 [A]0
therefore: 1/64 [A]0 = [A]0 e-0.0165t
t = 252 days
12.E.4.17: Q12.4.18
Recently, the skeleton of King Richard III was found under a parking lot in England. If tissue samples from the skeleton contain
about 93.79% of the carbon-14 expected in living tissue, what year did King Richard III die? The half-life for carbon-14 is 5730
years.
Solution
Using N (t) = N 0e
−rt
this problem is solved by the following:
−5730r
1/2 = e
r = 0.000121
Now that we know what r is, we can use this value in our original formula and solve for t, the amount of years that have passed.
This time, we use 93.78, the percent of the carbon-14 remaining as N(t) and 100 as the original, N0.
−0.000121t
93.78 = 100e
t = 530.7 years
Another way of doing this is by using these two equations:
0.693 nt
λ= and = -λt
t1/2 n0
Answer
King Richard III died in the year 1487
12.E.4.18: Q12.4.19
Nitroglycerine is an extremely sensitive explosive. In a series of carefully controlled experiments, samples of the explosive were
heated to 160 °C and their first-order decomposition studied. Determine the average rate constants for each experiment using the
following data:
Initial
[C3H5N3O9] 4.88 3.52 2.29 1.81 5.33 4.05 2.95 1.72
(M)
%
52.0 52.9 53.2 53.9 34.6 35.9 36.0 35.4
Decomposed
Solution
First we need to understand what the question is asking for: the average rate constant. The average rate constant is the variable
"k" when discussing kinetics and it can be defined as the proportionality constant in the equation that expresses the relationship
between the rate of a chemical reaction and the concentrations of the reacting substances. Knowing that we need to find K in
this first order reaction, we can look to formulas that include "k," initial and final concentrations [A] and[A] , and half life time
o t
For the first reaction, we have an initial concentration of 4.88 M, and a percentage decomposed. To find the final concentration,
we must multiply the initial concentration by the percentage decomposed to know how much decomposed, and subtract that
from the original to find out how much is left: 4.88M x 0.52= 2.54 M and 4.88M-2.54M=2.34M
Now, we have the variables we need, and we plug it into the equation above:
ln[A]t = −kt + ln[A]o
−(ln[2.34M]−ln[4.88M])
k= 300
−3
k = 2.45x10
Since it asks for the rate constant of each experiment, we now must do the same procedure for each data set to find the rate
constant:
Second experiment
ln[A]t = −kt + ln[A]o
−(ln[1.66M]−ln[3.52M])
k= 300
−3
k = 2.51x10
Third experiment
ln[A]t = −kt + ln[A]o
−(ln[1.07M]−ln[2.29M])
k= 300
−3
k = 2.54x10
Fourth experiment
ln[A]t = −kt + ln[A]o
−(ln[0.834M]−ln[1.81M])
k= 300
−3
k = 2.58x10
Fifth Experiment
ln[A]t = −kt + ln[A]o
−(ln[3.49M]−ln[5.33M])
k= 180
−3
k = 2.35x10
Sixth Experiment
ln[A]t = −kt + ln[A]o
−(ln[2.60M]−ln[4.05M])
k= 180
−3
k = 2.46x10
−(ln[1.89M]−ln[2.95M])
k= 180
−3
k = 2.47x10
Eighth experiment
ln[A]t = −kt + ln[A]o
−(ln[1.11M]−ln[1.72M])
k= 180
−3
k = 2.43x10
Answer
[A]0 (M) k × 103 (s−1)
4.88 2.45
3.52 2.51
2.29 2.54
1.81 2.58
5.33 2.35
4.05 2.44
2.95 2.47
1.72 2.43
12.E.4.19: Q12.4.20
For the past 10 years, the unsaturated hydrocarbon 1,3-butadiene (CH =CH– CH=CH ) has ranked 38th among the top 50
2 2
industrial chemicals. It is used primarily for the manufacture of synthetic rubber. An isomer exists also as cyclobutene:
The isomerization of cyclobutene to butadiene is first-order and the rate constant has been measured as 2.0 × 10−4 s−1 at 150 °C in a
0.53-L flask. Determine the partial pressure of cyclobutene and its concentration after 30.0 minutes if an isomerization reaction is
carried out at 150 °C with an initial pressure of 55 torr.
Solution
Since this is a first order reaction, the integrated rate law is: [A ] = [A ]e t 0
−kt
Partial Pressure: Use the integrated rate law to find the partial pressure at 30 minutes:
Use A = 55 torr, t = 30 min, and k = 2.0 ∗ 10
0
−4 −1
s to solve the integrated rate law equation:
1 6 0 sec
−4
−(2.0x10 )(30min⋅ )
sec
[ A30 ] = (55torr) ∗ e 1 min
RT
. Use this form of the gas law to solve for the initial concentration n.
mol∗L
, T = 423.15 K, and P = 1atm
760
= 0.07237 atm .
Solve the ideal gas equation using these values:
(55torr)(0.53L)
n = L∗ at m
= 0.00110 moles cyclobutene.
(0.08206 )(423.15K)
mol∗ K
V
:
n 0.00110moles
A0 = = = 0.00208M
V 0.53L
Concentration at 30 minutes: Find the concentration of cyclobutene at 30 minutes by using the integrated rate law given
above, using time t = 30 minutes, or 1800 seconds.
−0.36
[ A30 ] = (0.00208M )e = 0.00145M
So at 30 minutes, the cyclobutene concentration is 0.00145 M, and the partial pressure is 38.37 torr.
Answer
Partial Pressure: 38.37 torr.
Concentration: 0.00145 M
Solution
The two factors that may prevent a collision from producing a chemical reaction are:
1. Kinetic energy of the molecule
In order for chemical reactions to occur, molecules require enough velocity to overcome the minimum activation energy needed
to break the old bonds and form new bonds with other molecules. At higher temperatures, the molecules possess the minimum
amount of kinetic energy needed which ensures the collisions will be energetic enough to lead to a reaction.
2. The orientation of molecules during the collision
Two molecules have to collide in the right orientation in order for the reaction to occur. Molecules have to orient properly for
another molecule to collide at the right activation state.
12.E.5.2: Q12.5.2
When every collision between reactants leads to a reaction, what determines the rate at which the reaction occurs?
Solution
There has to be contact between reactants for a reaction to occur. The more the reactants collide, the more often reactions can
occur. Factors that determine reaction rates include concentration of reactants, temperature, physical states of reactants, surface
area, and the use of a catalyst. The reaction rate usually increases as the concentration of a reactant increases. Increasing the
temperature increases the average kinetic energy of molecules, causing them to collide more frequently, which increases the
reaction rate. When two reactants are in the same fluid phase, their particles collide more frequently, which increases the
reaction rate. If the surface area of a reactant is increased, more particles are exposed to the other reactant therefore more
collisions occur and the rate of reaction increases. A catalyst participates in a chemical reaction and increases the reaction rate
without changing itself.
Solution
Activation energy is the energy barrier that must be overcome in order for a reaction to occur. To get the molecules into a state
that allows them to break and form bonds, the molecules must be contorted (deformed, or bent) into an unstable state called the
transition state. The transition state is a high-energy state, and some amount of energy – the activation energy – must be added
in order for the molecule reach it. Because the transition state is unstable, reactant molecules don’t stay there long, but quickly
proceed to the next step of the chemical reaction.The activated complex is the highest energy of the transition state of the
reaction.
12.E.5.4: Q12.5.5
Describe how graphical methods can be used to determine the activation energy of a reaction from a series of data that includes the
rate of reaction at varying temperatures.
Solution
This method is based on the Arrhenius equation which can be used to show the effect of a change of temperature on the rate
constant, and therefore on the rate of reaction.
The rate constant is different from reaction rat in that the reaction rate is the measure of how fast or slow a chemical
reaction takes place while a rate constant is a constant that shows the relationship between the reaction rate and the
concentrations of the reactants or products.
For example, for the reaction A + B → C , the rate law would be:
a b
rate = k[A] [B]
k = rate constant
[A] = concentration of reactant A
a = order of reaction with respect to A
[B] = concentration of reactant B
b = order of reaction with respect to B
However, the rate constant remains constant only if you are changing the concentration of the reactants. If you change the
temperature or the catalyst of the reaction, the rate constant will change and this is demonstrated by the Arrhenius
equation:
− Ea
k = Ae RT
k1 −Ea 1 1
ln ( ) =( )( − )
k2 R T1 T2
k = rate constant
R = gas constant
T = temperature (K)
In other words, the activation energy of a reaction, E , from a series of data that includes the rate of reaction, k, at varying
a
temperatures can be determined by graphing it on a plot of ln k versus . You can then use the slope of the graph you have
1
T
−Ea
plotted to solve for E by setting the slope equal to
a
R
.
12.E.5.5: Q12.5.6
How does an increase in temperature affect rate of reaction? Explain this effect in terms of the collision theory of the reaction rate.
12.E.5.6: S12.5.6
Collision theory states that the rates of chemical reactions depend on the fraction of molecules with the correct orientation, fraction
of collisions with required energy, and the collision frequency. Because the fraction of collisions with required energy is a function
of temperature, as temperature increases, the fraction of collisions with required energy also increases. The kinetic energy of
reactants also increases with temperature which means molecules will collide more often increasing collisions frequency. With
increased fraction of collisions with required energy and collisions frequency, the rate of chemical reaction increases. We see
mathematically, from the Arrhenius equation, that temperature and the rate constant are related.
Ea
k = Ae RT
(12.E.14)
where k is the rate constant, A is a specific constant, R is 8.3145 J/K, Ea is the reaction-specific activation energy in J, and T is
temperature in K. We see from the equation that k is very sensitive to changes in the temperature.
12.E.5.7: Q12.5.7
The rate of a certain reaction doubles for every 10 °C rise in temperature.
a. How much faster does the reaction proceed at 45 °C than at 25 °C?
b. How much faster does the reaction proceed at 95 °C than at 25 °C?
Solution
By finding the difference in temperature, 45 °C - 25 °C, we get 20 °C. Since the rate of the reaction doubles every 10 °C
increase in temperature and the rate of the reaction experienced a 20 °C increase in temperature, we see that the reaction rate
doubled twice (22 = 4). As a result, the reaction proceeds four times faster.
Following the same process as in part a, we get the difference in temperature to be 70 °C. Since the rate of the reaction doubles
every 10 °C increase in temperature and the system experienced a 70 °C change, we see that the reaction doubled seven times
(27 = 128). We can see the reaction proceeds 128 times faster.
(a) 4-times faster (b) 128-times faster
12.E.5.8: Q12.5.8
In an experiment, a sample of NaClO3 was 90% decomposed in 48 min. Approximately how long would this decomposition have
taken if the sample had been heated 20 °C higher?
12.E.5.9: S12.5.8
First off, it is important to recognize that this decomposition reaction is a first-order reaction, which can be written as follows:
2N aC lO3 → 2N aC l + 3 O2
Understanding this, it is important to be able to then be able to recognize which equation would be most useful given the initial
conditions presented by the question. Since we are dealing with time, percentage of material left, and temperature, the only viable
R
(
1
t1
−
1
t2
)
However, this problem does not give us enough information such as what the activation energy is or the initial temperature in order
to mathematically solve this problem. Additionally, the problem tells us to approximate how long the decomposition would take,
which means we are asked to answer this question conceptually based on our knowledge of thermodynamics and reaction rates. As
a general rule of thumb, we know that for every 10˚C rise in temperature the rate of reaction doubles. Since the question tells us
that there is a 20˚C rise in temperature we can deduce that the reaction rate doubles twice, as per the general rule mentioned before.
This means the overall reaction rate for this decomposition would quadruple, or would be 4 times faster than the reaction rate
at the initial temperature.
We can gut check this answer by recalling how an increase in the average kinetic energy (temperature) decreases the time it takes
for the reaction to take place and increase the reaction rate. Thus, if we increase the temperature we should have a faster reaction
rate.
12.E.5.10: Q12.5.9
The rate constant at 325 °C for the decomposition reaction C H ⟶ 2 C 4 8 2
H
4
is 6.1 × 10−8 s−1, and the activation energy is 261 kJ
per mole of C4H8. Determine the frequency factor for the reaction.
Solution
12.E.5.11: S12.5.9
Using the Arrhenius equation allows me to find the frequency factor, A.
k=Ae-Ea/RT
k, Ea, R, and T are all known values. k, Ea, and T are given in the problem as 6.1x10-8, 261 kJ, and 598 K, respectively.
So, plugging them into the equation gives:
6.1x10-8 s-1=Ae(-261000 J)/(8.3145 J/mol)(598 K)
Take e(-261000 J)/(8.3145 J/mol)(598) and get 1.59 x 10-23. Divide k, 6.1 x 10-8, by 1.59 x 10-23 and get A=3.9 x 1015s-1
12.E.5.12: A12.5.9
15 −1
3.9 × 10 s
12.E.5.13: Q12.5.10
The rate constant for the decomposition of acetaldehyde (CH3CHO), to methane (CH4), and carbon monoxide (CO), in the gas
phase is 1.1 × 10−2 L/mol/s at 703 K and 4.95 L/mol/s at 865 K. Determine the activation energy for this decomposition.
12.E.5.14: S12.5.10
The equation for relating the rate constant and activation energy of a reaction is the Arrhenius equation:
Ea
−
k = Ae RT
(12.E.15)
When given two rate constants at two different temperatures but for the same reaction, the Arrhenius equation can be rewritten as:
k2 Ea 1 1
ln( ) = ( − ) (12.E.16)
k1 R T1 T2
In this problem, all the variables are given except for the Ea (activation energy).
k1 = 1.1 × 10−2 L/mol/s
T1 = 703 K
k2 = 4.95 L/mol/s
T2 = 865 K
R = 8.314 J/(mol K) (Ideal Gas Constant)
Now plug in all these values into the equation, and solve for Ea.
12.E.5.15: Q12.5.11
An elevated level of the enzyme alkaline phosphatase (ALP) in the serum is an indication of possible liver or bone disorder. The
level of serum ALP is so low that it is very difficult to measure directly. However, ALP catalyzes a number of reactions, and its
relative concentration can be determined by measuring the rate of one of these reactions under controlled conditions. One such
reaction is the conversion of p-nitrophenyl phosphate (PNPP) to p-nitrophenoxide ion (PNP) and phosphate ion. Control of
temperature during the test is very important; the rate of the reaction increases 1.47 times if the temperature changes from 30 °C to
37 °C. What is the activation energy for the ALP–catalyzed conversion of PNPP to PNP and phosphate?
Solution
43.0 kJ/mol
12.E.5.16: Q12.5.12
In terms of collision theory, to which of the following is the rate of a chemical reaction proportional?
a. the change in free energy per second
b. the change in temperature per second
c. the number of collisions per second
d. the number of product molecules
12.E.5.17: Q12.5.13
Hydrogen iodide, HI, decomposes in the gas phase to produce hydrogen, H2, and iodine, I2. The value of the rate constant, k, for the
reaction was measured at several different temperatures and the data are shown here:
What is the value of the activation energy (in kJ/mol) for this reaction?
Solution
177 kJ/mol
12.E.5.18: Q12.5.14
The element Co exists in two oxidation states, Co(II) and Co(III), and the ions form many complexes. The rate at which one of the
complexes of Co(III) was reduced by Fe(II) in water was measured. Determine the activation energy of the reaction from the
following data:
T (K) k (s−1)
293 0.054
298 0.100
12.E.5.19: Q12.5.15
The hydrolysis of the sugar sucrose to the sugars glucose and fructose,
C H O +H O ⟶ C H O +C H O
12 22 11 2 6 12 6 6 12 6
Solution
Ea = 108 kJ
A = 2.0 × 108 s−1
k = 3.2 × 10−10 s−1
(b) 1.81 × 108 h or 7.6 × 106 day. (c) Assuming that the reaction is irreversible simplifies the calculation because we do not
have to account for any reactant that, having been converted to product, returns to the original state.
12.E.5.20: Q12.5.16
Use the PhET Reactions & Rates interactive simulation to simulate a system. On the “Single collision” tab of the simulation applet,
enable the “Energy view” by clicking the “+” icon. Select the first A + BC ⟶ AB + C reaction (A is yellow, B is purple, and C
is navy blue). Using the “straight shot” default option, try launching the A atom with varying amounts of energy. What changes
when the Total Energy line at launch is below the transition state of the Potential Energy line? Why? What happens when it is
above the transition state? Why?
12.E.5.21: Q12.5.17
Use the PhET Reactions & Rates interactive simulation to simulate a system. On the “Single collision” tab of the simulation applet,
enable the “Energy view” by clicking the “+” icon. Select the first A + BC ⟶ AB + C reaction (A is yellow, B is purple, and C
is navy blue). Using the “angled shot” option, try launching the A atom with varying angles, but with more Total energy than the
transition state. What happens when the A atom hits the BC molecule from different directions? Why?
Solution
The A atom has enough energy to react with BC; however, the different angles at which it bounces off of BC without reacting
indicate that the orientation of the molecule is an important part of the reaction kinetics and determines whether a reaction will
occur.
12.E.6.2: Q12.6.2
In general, can we predict the effect of doubling the concentration of A on the rate of the overall reaction A + B ⟶ C ? Can we
predict the effect if the reaction is known to be an elementary reaction?
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
No. In general, for the overall reaction, we cannot predict the effect of changing the concentration without knowing the rate
equation. Yes. If the reaction is an elementary reaction, then doubling the concentration of A doubles the rate.
step 1: Cl + CO → COCl
12.E.6.4: Q12.6.4
Define these terms:
a. unimolecular reaction
b. bimolecular reaction
c. elementary reaction
d. overall reaction
12.E.6.5: Q12.6.5
What is the rate equation for the elementary termolecular reaction A + 2B ⟶ products ? For 3A ⟶ products ?
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
We are given that both of these reactions are elementary termolecular. The molecularity of a reaction refers to the number of
reactant particles that react together with the proper and energy and orientation. Termolecular reactions have three atoms to collide
simultaneously. As it is termolecular, and there are no additional reactants aside from the three given in each reaction, there are no
intermediate reactions. The rate law for elementary reactions is determined by the stoichiometry of the reaction without needed
experimental data.
The basic rate form for the elementary step is what follows:
rate = k ⋅ reactant 1 ⋅ reactant 2
i ii
⋅. . . Where i and ii are the stochiometric coefficient from reactant 1 and 2 respectively.
For: 3A → products
3
k⋅A = rate
For: A + 2B → products
2
k ⋅ [A] ⋅ [B] = rate
Answer
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
12.E.6.6: Q12.6.6
Given the following reactions and the corresponding rate laws, in which of the reactions might the elementary reaction and the
overall reaction be the same?
(a) Cl 2
+ CO ⟶ Cl CO
2
rate = k[ Cl ] 2
[CO]
2
(b) PCl 3
+ Cl
2
⟶ PCl
5
(c) 2 NO + H 2
⟶ N
2
+H O
2
rate = k[NO][ H ]
2
(d) 2 NO + O 2
⟶ 2 NO
2
2
rate = k[NO] [ O ]
2
(e) NO + O 3
⟶ NO
2
+O
2
rate = k[NO][ O ]
3
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
An elementary reaction is a chemical reaction in which the reactants directly form products in a single step. In another words, the
rate law for the overall reaction is same as experimentally found rate law. Out of 5 options, option (b),(d), and (e) are such reactions
12.E.6.7: Q12.6.7
Write the rate equation for each of the following elementary reactions:
sunlight
a. O −−−−→ O + O
3 2
b. O + Cl ⟶ O + ClO
3 2
c. ClO + O ⟶ Cl + O 2
d. O + NO ⟶ NO + O
3 2 2
e. NO + O ⟶ NO + O
2 2
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
Rate equations are dependent on the reactants and not the products.
The rate law of a reaction can be found using a rate constant (which is found experimentally), and the initial concentrations of
reactants.
A general solution for the equation
aA + bB → cC + dD
is rate = k[A] m
[B]
n
where m and n are reaction orders.
However, reaction orders are found experimentally, and since we do not have experimental data for these reactions, we can
disregard that part of the equation.
To find the rate laws, all we have to do is plug the reactants into the rate formula. This is only due to the case that these are
elementary reactions. Further reading on elementary reactions can be found on Libre Texts.
a. O3 ⟶ O2 + O
To write this reaction's rate equation, only focus on the reactant(s) and its/their concentration and multiplying that by a rate
constant, "k".
Rate = k[O3]
b. O3 + Cl ⟶ O2 + ClO
To write this reaction's rate equation, only focus on the reactant(s) and its/their concentration and multiplying that by a rate
constant, "k".
Rate = k[O3][Cl]
c. ClO + O ⟶ Cl + O2
Answer
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
(a) Rate1 = k[O3]; (b) Rate2 = k[O3][Cl]; (c) Rate3 = k[ClO][O]; (d) Rate2 = k[O3][NO]; (e) Rate3 = k[NO2][O]
12.E.6.8: Q12.6.8
Nitrogen(II) oxide, NO, reacts with hydrogen, H2, according to the following equation:
2 NO + 2 H ⟶ N +2 H O
2 2 2
What would the rate law be if the mechanism for this reaction were:
2 NO + H ⟶ N +H O (slow)
2 2 2 2
H O +H ⟶ 2 H O (fast)
2 2 2 2
The rate law of the mechanism is determined by the slow step of the reaction. Since the slow step is an elementary step, the rate
law can be drawn from the coefficients of the chemical equation. So therefore, the rate law is as follows: rate=k[NO]2[H2]. Since
both NO and H2 are reactants in the overall reaction (therefore are not intermediates in the reaction), no further steps have to be
done to determine the rate law.
12.E.6.9: Q12.6.9
Consider the reaction
CH4 + Cl2 → CH3Cl + HCl (occurs under light)
The mechanism is a chain reaction involving Cl atoms and CH3 radicals. Which of the following steps does not terminate this chain
reaction?
a. CH3 + Cl → CH3CI
b. CH3 + HCl → CH4 + Cl
c. CH3 + CH3 → C2H2
d. Cl + Cl → Cl2
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
Chain reactions involve reactions that create products necessary for more reactions to occur. In this case, a reaction step will
continue the chain reaction if a radical is generated. Radicals are highly reactive particles, so more reactions in the chain will take
place as long as they are present. The chlorine is considered a free radical as it has an unpaired electron; for this reason it is very
reactive and propagates a chain reaction. It does so by taking an electron from a stable molecule and making that molecule reactive,
and that molecule goes on to react with stable species, and in that manner a long series of "chain" reactions are initiated. A chlorine
radical will continue the chain by completing the following reaction:
The C H generated by this reaction can then react with other species, continuing to propagate the chain reaction.
3
Option 1 is incorrect because the only species it produces is C H C l, a product in the overall reaction that is unreactive. This
3
terminates the chain reaction because it fails to produce any C l or C H radicals that are necessary for further propagating the
3
overall reaction.
Option 2 is the correct answer because it produces a Cl radical. This Cl radical can continue the chain by colliding with C H4
molecules.
Option 3 is incorrect because it fails to produce a radical capable of continuing the chain.
Option 4 is incorrect because it produces C l , a molecule that does not react unless additional light is supplied. Therefore, this step
2
Answer
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
Answer: Option 2: C H 3 + H C l → C H4 + C l
12.E.6.10: Q12.6.10
Experiments were conducted to study the rate of the reaction represented by this equation.
Step 2: N 2
O
2
+H
2
⇌ H O+N O
2 2
Step 3: N 2
O+H
2
⇌ N
2
+H O
2
Based on the data presented, which of these is the rate determining step? Show that the mechanism is consistent with the observed
rate law for the reaction and the overall stoichiometry of the reaction.
S12.6.10
1. i) Find the order for [NO] by using experiment 3 and 4 where [H2] is constant
Notice that [NO] doubles from experiment 3 to 4 and the rate quadruples. So the order for [NO] is 2
ii) Find the order for [H2] by using experiment 1 and 2 where [NO] is constant
Notice that [H2] doubles from experiment 1 to 2 and the rate doubles as well. So the order for [H2] is 1
3. Put in the concentrations and the rate from one of the experiments into the rate law and solve for k. (Here, experiement 1 is used
but any of them will work)
2 2 −2 −1
rate = k[N O] [ H2 ] .00018 = k[.006 ] [.001]k = 5000M s
4. Plug in values for experiment 2 into the rate law equation and solve for the concentration of NO
2 2 −5
.00036 = 5000[N O] [.001][N O] = 7.2x 10 [N O] = .0085M
5. Write the rate laws for each step and then see which matches the rate law we found in question 2. The rate determining step (the
slow step) is the one that gives the rate for the overall reaction. Because of this, only those concentrations will influence the overall
reaction, contrary to what we would believe if we just looked at the overall reaction.
Step 1: N O + N O ⇌ N 2 O2
rate = k1 [N O]
2
This rate law is not the same as the one we calculate in question 2 so this can not be the rate determining
step
Step 2: N 2 O2 + H2 ⇌ N2 O + N2 O
rate = k2 [ N2 O2 ][ H2 ]
Since N O is an intermediate you must replace it in the rate law equation. Intermediates can not be in the rate law because
2 2
they do not appear in the overall reaction. Here you can take the reverse of equation 1 (k-1) and substitute the other side (the
reactants of equation 1) for the intermediate in the rate law equation.
rate1 = rate−1
2
k1 [N O] = k−1 [ N2 O2 ]
2
k1 [N O]
[ N2 O2 ] =
k−1
2
k2 k1 [N O] [ H2 ]
rate =
k−1
Answer
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
(a) NO: 2
H
2
:1
(b) Rate = k [NO]2[H2];
(c) k = 5.0 × 103 mol−2 L−2 min−1;
(d) 0.0050 mol/L;
(e) Step II is the rate-determining step.
12.E.6.11: Q12.6.11
The reaction of CO with Cl2 gives phosgene (COCl2), a nerve gas that was used in World War I. Use the mechanism shown here to
complete the following exercises:
Cl (g) ⇌ 2 Cl(g)
2
(fast, k1 represents the forward rate constant, k−1 the reverse rate constant)
CO(g) + Cl(g) ⟶ COCl(g) (slow, k2 the rate constant)
COCl(g) + Cl(g) ⟶ COCl (g) (fast, k3 the rate constant)
2
Solution
Add texts here. Do not delete this text first.
1. To write the overall reaction you have to identify the intermediates and leave them out. The easiest way to do this is to write out
all the products and reactants and cross out anything that is on both sides.
In this you will cross out the 2Cl(g) molecules and the COCl(g). What is left after that is the overall reaction.
2. For part two you will just list the intermediates that you crossed out.
Cl and COCl are intermediates
3. Each rate law will be the rate equal to the rate constant times the concentrations of the reactants
reaction 1
(forward) rate=k1[Cl2] ( reverse) rate=k-1[Cl]
reaction 2
rate=k2[CO][Cl]
Reaction 3
rate=k3[COCl][Cl]
4. The overall rate law is based off the slowest step (step #2), since it is the rate determining step, but Cl is present in that rate law
so we have to replace it with an equivalent that does not contain an intermediate. To do this you use the equilibrium since the rates
are the same you can set up the rate laws of the forward and reverse equal to each other.
k1[Cl2] = k-1[Cl]
[Cl]= k1[Cl2]/k-1
rate=k2[CO]k1[Cl2]/k-1
rate=k°[CO][Cl2]
Steps to replacing and intermediate
1. Set the forward and reverse reaction equal to each other using separate constants
2. Solve for the intermediate using algebra
3. Plug into the rate determining formula
4. All the k's will be condensed into a K prime constant
12.E.7.2: Q12.7.2
Compare the functions of homogeneous and heterogeneous catalysts.
O −−−−→O +O
3 2
O + Cl ⟶ O + ClO
3 2
ClO + O ⟶ Cl + O
2
2O ⟶ 3O
3 2
O −−−−→O +O
3 2
O + NO ⟶ NO +O
3 2 2
NO + O ⟶ NO + O
2 2
12.E.7.4: Q12.7.4
For each of the following pairs of reaction diagrams, identify which of the pair is catalyzed:
(a)
12.E.7.5: Q12.7.5
For each of the following pairs of reaction diagrams, identify which of the pairs is catalyzed:
(a)
12.E.7.6: Q12.7.6
For each of the following reaction diagrams, estimate the activation energy (Ea) of the reaction:
(a)
(b)
(b)
12.E.7.8: Q12.7.8
1. Based on the diagrams in Question Q12.7.6, which of the reactions has the fastest rate? Which has the slowest rate?
2. Based on the diagrams in Question Q12.7.7, which of the reactions has the fastest rate? Which has the slowest rate?
This page titled 12.E: Kinetics (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 13: Fundamental Equilibrium Concepts is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
13.0: Prelude to Equilibrium
Imagine a beach populated with sunbathers and swimmers. As those basking in the sun get too hot and want to cool off, they head
into the surf to swim. As the swimmers tire, they head to the beach to rest. If these two rates of transfer (sunbathers entering the
water, swimmers leaving the water) are equal, the number of sunbathers and swimmers would be constant, or at equilibrium,
although the identities of the people are constantly changing from sunbather to swimmer and back. An analogous situation occurs
in chemical reactions. Reactions can occur in both directions simultaneously (reactants to products and products to reactants) and
eventually reach a state of balance.
Figure 13.0.1 : Movement of carbon dioxide through tissues and blood cells involves several equilibrium reactions.
An image depicts three tan squares, lying side-by-side along the upper left corner. Two of the same squares also lie side-by-side in
the lower right corner. Each square has a black dot in the center. One of the squares is labeled, “C O subscript 2,” and has a double-
headed arrow pointing from it to a red tube-like structure that runs between the squares across the image from the upper right to the
lower left. This arrow is labeled, “C O subscript 2 dissolved in plasma.” The red tube has two round red shapes in it, and the upper
one is labeled, “C O subscript 2 carried in red blood cells.” The gaps between the squares and the red tube are colored light blue.
One of the squares along the top of the image is labeled, “C O subscript 2,” and is connected by a double-headed arrow to an
equation in the red tube that is labeled, “C O subscript 2, a plus sign, H subscript 2 O, right-facing arrow, H subscript 2 C O
subscript 3, right-facing arrow, H C O subscript 3 superscript negative sign, plus sign, H superscript positive sign.” The compound
“H C O subscript 3 superscript negative sign” is then connected by a double-headed arrow to the space in the red tube and is
labeled, “H C O subscript 3 superscript negative sign dissolved in plasma as carbonic acid.”
These balanced two-way reactions occur all around and even in us. For example, they occur in our blood, where the reaction
between carbon dioxide and water forms carbonic acid (HCO ) (Figure 13.0.1). Human physiology is adapted to the amount of
−
ionized products produced by this reaction (HCO and H+). In this chapter, you will learn how to predict the position of the
−
balance and the yield of a product of a reaction under specific conditions, how to change a reaction's conditions to increase or
reduce yield, and how to evaluate an equilibrium system's reaction to disturbances.
This page titled 13.0: Prelude to Equilibrium is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
A chemical reaction is usually written in a way that suggests it proceeds in one direction, the direction in which we read, but all
chemical reactions are reversible, and both the forward and reverse reaction occur to one degree or another depending on
conditions. In a chemical equilibrium, the forward and reverse reactions occur at equal rates, and the concentrations of products and
reactants remain constant. If we run a reaction in a closed system so that the products cannot escape, we often find the reaction
does not give a 100% yield of products. Instead, some reactants remain after the concentrations stop changing. At this point, when
there is no further change in concentrations of reactants and products, we say the reaction is at equilibrium. A mixture of reactants
and products is found at equilibrium.
For example, when we place a sample of dinitrogen tetroxide (N 2 O4 , a colorless gas) in a glass tube, it forms nitrogen dioxide (
NO , a brown gas) by the reaction
2
(Figure 13.1.1).
A three-part diagram is shown. At the top of the diagram, three beakers are shown, and each one contains a sealed tube. The tube in
the left beaker is full of a colorless gas which is connected to a zoom-in view of the particles in the tube by a downward-facing
arrow. This particle view shows seven particles, each composed of two connected blue spheres. Each blue sphere is connected to
two red spheres. The tube in the middle beaker is full of a light brown gas which is connected to a zoom-in view of the particles in
the tube by a downward-facing arrow. This particle view shows nine particles, five of which are composed of two connected blue
spheres. Each blue sphere is connected to two red spheres. The remaining four are composed of two red spheres connected to a blue
sphere. The tube in the right beaker is full of a brown gas which is connected to a zoom-in view of the particles in the tube by a
downward-facing arrow. This particle view shows eleven particles, three of which are composed of two connected blue spheres.
Each blue sphere is connected to two red spheres. The remaining eight are composed of two red spheres connected to a blue sphere.
At the bottom of the image are two graphs. The left graph has a y-axis labeled, “Concentration,” and an x-axis labeled, “Time.” A
red line labeled, “N O subscript 2,” begins in the bottom left corner of the graph at a point labeled, “0,” and rises near the highest
point on the y-axis before it levels off and becomes horizontal. A blue line labeled, “N subscript 2 O subscript 4,” begins near the
highest point on the y-axis and drops below the midpoint of the y-axis before leveling off. The right graph has a y-axis labeled,
“Rate,” and an x-axis labeled, “Time.” A red line labeled, “k subscript f, [ N subscript 2 O subscript 4 ],” begins in the bottom left
corner of the graph at a point labeled, “0,” and rises near the middle of the y-axis before it levels off and becomes horizontal. A
blue line labeled, “k subscript f, [ N O subscript 2 ] superscript 2,” begins near the highest point on the y-axis and drops to the same
point on the y-axis as the red line before leveling off. The point where both lines become horizontal is labeled, “Equilibrium
achieved.”
The formation of NO from N O is a reversible reaction, which is identified by the equilibrium arrow (⇌). All reactions are
2 2 4
reversible, but many reactions, for all practical purposes, proceed in one direction until the reactants are exhausted and will reverse
only under certain conditions. Such reactions are often depicted with a one-way arrow from reactants to products. Many other
reactions, such as the formation of NO from N O , are reversible under more easily obtainable conditions and, therefore, are
2 2 4
named as such. In a reversible reaction, the reactants can combine to form products and the products can react to form the reactants.
Thus, not only can N O decompose to form NO , but the NO produced can react to form N O . As soon as the forward
2 4 2 2 2 4
reaction produces any NO , the reverse reaction begins and NO starts to react to form N O . At equilibrium, the concentrations
2 2 2 4
of N O and NO no longer change because the rate of formation of NO is exactly equal to the rate of consumption of NO , and
2 4 2 2 2
the rate of formation of N O is exactly equal to the rate of consumption of N O . Chemical equilibrium is a dynamic process: As
2 4 2 4
with the swimmers and the sunbathers, the numbers of each remain constant, yet there is a flux back and forth between them
(Figure 13.1.2).
When we wish to speak about one particular component of a reversible reaction, we use a single arrow. For example, in the
equilibrium shown in Figure 13.1.1, the rate of the forward reaction
2 NO (g) → N O (g) (13.1.3)
2 2 4
The connection between chemistry and carbonated soft drinks goes back to 1767, when Joseph Priestley (1733–1804; mostly
known today for his role in the discovery and identification of oxygen) discovered a method of infusing water with carbon
dioxide to make carbonated water. In 1772, Priestly published a paper entitled “Impregnating Water with Fixed Air.” The paper
describes dripping oil of vitriol (today we call this sulfuric acid, but what a great way to describe sulfuric acid: “oil of vitriol”
literally means “liquid nastiness”) onto chalk (calcium carbonate). The resulting C O falls into the container of water beneath
2
the vessel in which the initial reaction takes place; agitation helps the gaseous C O mix into the liquid water.
2
Carbon dioxide is slightly soluble in water. There is an equilibrium reaction that occurs as the carbon dioxide reacts with the
water to form carbonic acid (H C O ). Since carbonic acid is a weak acid, it can dissociate into protons (H ) and hydrogen
2 3
+
carbonate ions (H C O ).
−
− +
CO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H CO (aq) ⇌ HCO (aq) + H (aq)
2 2 2 3 3
Today, CO can be pressurized into soft drinks, establishing the equilibrium shown above. Once you open the beverage
2
container, however, a cascade of equilibrium shifts occurs. First, the CO gas in the air space on top of the bottle escapes,
2
causing the equilibrium between gas-phase CO and dissolved or aqueous CO to shift, lowering the concentration of CO in
2 2 2
the soft drink. Less CO dissolved in the liquid leads to carbonic acid decomposing to dissolved CO and H2O. The lowered
2 2
carbonic acid concentration causes a shift of the final equilibrium. As long as the soft drink is in an open container, the CO 2
no longer at equilibrium and will continue until no more of the reactants remain. This results in a soft drink with a much
lowered CO concentration, often referred to as “flat.”
2
Figure 13.1.3 : When a soft drink is opened, several equilibrium shifts occur. (credit: modification of work by “D
Coetzee”/Flickr)
A bottle of soda sitting on the ground is shown with a large amount of fizz-filled liquid spewing out of the top.
Sublimation of Bromine
Br (l) ⇌ Br (g)
2 2
An equilibrium can be established for a physical change—like this liquid to gas transition—as well as for a chemical reaction.
Figure 13.1.4 shows a sample of liquid bromine at equilibrium with bromine vapor in a closed container. When we pour liquid
bromine into an empty bottle in which there is no bromine vapor, some liquid evaporates, the amount of liquid decreases, and
the amount of vapor increases. If we cap the bottle so no vapor escapes, the amount of liquid and vapor will eventually stop
changing and an equilibrium between the liquid and the vapor will be established. If the bottle were not capped, the bromine
vapor would escape and no equilibrium would be reached.
Figure 13.1.4 : An equilibrium is pictured between liquid bromine, Br2(l), the dark liquid, and bromine vapor, Br2(g), the
orange gas. Because the container is sealed, bromine vapor cannot escape and equilibrium is maintained. (credit: Bromine
[images-of-elements.com]).
A glass container is shown that is filled with an orange-brown gas and a small amount of dark orange liquid.
Summary
A reaction is at equilibrium when the amounts of reactants or products no longer change. Chemical equilibrium is a dynamic
process, meaning the rate of formation of products by the forward reaction is equal to the rate at which the products re-form
reactants by the reverse reaction.
Glossary
equilibrium
in chemical reactions, the state in which the conversion of reactants into products and the conversion of products back into
reactants occur simultaneously at the same rate; state of balance
This page titled 13.1: Chemical Equilibria is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Now that we have a symbol (⇌) to designate reversible reactions, we will need a way to express mathematically how the amounts
of reactants and products affect the equilibrium of the system. A general equation for a reversible reaction may be written as
follows:
mA + nB+ ⇌ xC + yD (13.2.1)
We can write the reaction quotient (Q) for this equation. When evaluated using concentrations, it is called Q . We use brackets to c
The reaction quotient is equal to the molar concentrations of the products of the chemical equation (multiplied together) over the
reactants (also multiplied together), with each concentration raised to the power of the coefficient of that substance in the balanced
chemical equation. For example, the reaction quotient for the reversible reaction
2 NO2(g) ⇌ N O4(g) (13.2.3)
2
b. N +3 H
2(g)
⇌ 2 NH 2(g) 3(g)
Solution
2
[O ]
3
a. Qc =
[O ]3
2
2
[NH ]
3
b. Q c =
3
[N ][H ]
2 2
4 6
[ NO ] [ H O]
2 2
c. Qc =
4 7
[ NH ] [ O ]
3 2
Exercise 13.2.1
Write the expression for the reaction quotient for each of the following reactions:
a. 2 SO (g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g)
2 2 3
b. C H (g) ⇌ 2 C H (g)
4 8 2 4
c. 2 C H (g) + 13 O (g) ⇌ 8 CO
4 10 2 2
(g) + 10 H O(g)
2
Answer b
2
[C H ]
2 4
Qc =
[C H ]
4 8
Answer c
8 10
[ CO ] [ H O]
2 2
Qc =
2 13
[C H ] [O ]
4 10 2
The numeric value of Q for a given reaction varies; it depends on the concentrations of products and reactants present at the time
c
when Q is determined. When pure reactants are mixed, Q is initially zero because there are no products present at that point. As
c c
the reaction proceeds, the value of Q increases as the concentrations of the products increase and the concentrations of the
c
reactants simultaneously decrease (Figure 13.2.1). When the reaction reaches equilibrium, the value of the reaction quotient no
longer changes because the concentrations no longer change.
Figure 13.2.1 : (a) The change in the concentrations of reactants and products is depicted as the 2 SO (g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g)
2 2 3
reaction approaches equilibrium. (b) The change in concentrations of reactants and products is depicted as the reaction
2 SO (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) + O (g) approaches equilibrium. (c) The graph shows the change in the value of the reaction quotient as
3 2 2
That a reaction quotient always assumes the same value at equilibrium can be expressed as:
x y
[C ] [D] . . .
Qc at equilibrium = Kc = (13.2.5)
[A]m [B]n . . .
This equation is a mathematical statement of the law of mass action: When a reaction has attained equilibrium at a given
temperature, the reaction quotient for the reaction always has the same value.
2 NO2(g) ⇌ N O4(g)
2
When 0.10 mol NO is added to a 1.0-L flask at 25 °C, the concentration changes so that at equilibrium, [NO2] = 0.016 M and
2
[N2O4] = 0.042 M.
a. What is the value of the reaction quotient before any reaction occurs?
b. What is the value of the equilibrium constant for the reaction?
Solution
0.10 mol
a. Before any product is formed, [NO 2] = = 0.10 M , and [N2O4] = 0 M. Thus,
1.0 L
[N O ] 0
2 4
Qc = = =0
2 2
[ NO ] 0.10
2
b. At equilibrium, the value of the equilibrium constant is equal to the value of the reaction quotient. At equilibrium,
[N O ] 0.042
2 4 2
Kc = Qc = = = 1.6 × 10 .
2 2
[ NO ] 0.016
2
units for K values computed as described here, since it is the magnitude of an equilibrium constant that relays useful
c
information. As will be discussed later in this module, the rigorous approach to computing equilibrium constants uses
dimensionless quantities derived from activities instead of molar concentrations, and so K values are truly unitless. c
Exercise 13.2.2
the concentrations at equilibrium are [SO2] = 0.90 M, [O2] = 0.35 M, and [SO3] = 1.1 M. What is the value of the equilibrium
constant, Kc?
Answer
Kc = 4.3
The magnitude of an equilibrium constant is a measure of the yield of a reaction when it reaches equilibrium. A large value for K c
indicates that equilibrium is attained only after the reactants have been largely converted into products. A small value of K — c
that is not at equilibrium will proceed in the direction that establishes equilibrium. The data in Figure 13.2.2 illustrate this. When
heated to a consistent temperature, 800 °C, different starting mixtures of CO, H O , CO , and H react to reach compositions
2 2 2
adhering to the same equilibrium (the value of Q changes until it equals the value of Kc). This value is 0.640, the equilibrium
c
It is important to recognize that an equilibrium can be established starting either from reactants or from products, or from a mixture
of both. For example, equilibrium was established from Mixture 2 in Figure 13.2.2 when the products of the reaction were heated
in a closed container. In fact, one technique used to determine whether a reaction is truly at equilibrium is to approach equilibrium
starting with reactants in one experiment and starting with products in another. If the same value of the reaction quotient is
observed when the concentrations stop changing in both experiments, then we may be certain that the system has reached
equilibrium.
Figure 13.2.2 : Concentrations of three mixtures are shown before and after reaching equilibrium at 800 °C for the so-called water
gas shift reaction (Equation 13.2.6 ).
Two sets of bar graphs are shown. The left is labeled, “Before reaction,” and the right is labeled, “At equilibrium.” Both graphs
have y-axes labeled, “Concentration ( M ),” and three bars on the x-axes labeled, “Mixture 1,” “Mixture 2,” and “Mixture 3.” The
y-axis has a scale beginning at 0.00 and ending at 0.10, with measurement increments of 0.02. The bars on the graphs are color
coded and a key is provided with a legend. Red is labeled, “C O;” blue is labeled, “H subscript 2 O;” green is labeled, “C O
subscript 2,” and yellow is labeled, “H subscript 2.” The graph on the left shows the red bar for mixture one just above 0.02 and the
blue bar near 0.05. For mixture two, the green bar is near 0.05, and the yellow bar is near 0.09. For mixture 3, the red bar is near
0.01, the blue bar is slightly above that with green and yellow topping it off at 0.02. On the right graph, the bar for mixture one
shows the red bar slightly above 0.01, the blue bar stacked on it rising slightly above 0.02, the green rising near 0.04, and the
yellow bar reaching near 0.05. A label above this bar reads, “Q equals 0.640.” The bar for mixture two shows the red bar slightly
above 0.02, the blue bar stacked on it rising near 0.05, the green rising near 0.07, and the yellow bar reaching near 0.10. A label
above this bar reads “Q equals 0.640.” The bar for mixture three shows the red bar near 0.01, the blue bar stacked on it rising
slightly above 0.01, the green rising near 0.02, and the yellow bar reaching 0.02. A label above this bar reads “Q equals 0.640”.
with K c = 0.64 . Determine in which direction the reaction proceeds as it goes to equilibrium in each of the three experiments
shown.
Reactant/Products for Three Experiments
Reactants/Products Experiment 1 Experiment 2 Experiment 3
Exercise 13.2.3
Calculate the reaction quotient and determine the direction in which each of the following reactions will proceed to reach
equilibrium.
(a) A 1.00-L flask containing 0.0500 mol of NO(g), 0.0155 mol of Cl2(g), and 0.500 mol of NOCl:
4
2 NO(g) + Cl (g) ⇌ 2 NOCl(g) Kc = 4.6 × 10
2
Answer a
Qc = 6.45 × 103, shifts right.
Answer b
Qc = 0.12, shifts left.
Answer c
Qc = 0, shifts right
In Example 13.2.2, it was mentioned that the common practice is to omit units when evaluating reaction quotients and equilibrium
constants. It should be pointed out that using concentrations in these computations is a convenient but simplified approach that
sometimes leads to results that seemingly conflict with the law of mass action. For example, equilibria involving aqueous ions
often exhibit equilibrium constants that vary quite significantly (are not constant) at high solution concentrations. This may be
avoided by computing K values using the activities of the reactants and products in the equilibrium system instead of their
c
concentrations. The activity of a substance is a measure of its effective concentration under specified conditions. While a detailed
solutions (being numerically equal to 1, these terms have no effect on the expression's value). Several examples of equilibria
yielding such expressions will be encountered in this section.
Example 2
− −
I (aq) + I (aq) ⇌ I (aq) (13.2.9)
2 3
Example 3
2+ − + 2+
Hg (aq) + NO (aq) + 3 H O (aq) ⇌ 2 Hg (aq) + HNO (aq) + 4 H O(l) (13.2.11)
2 3 3 2 2
Example 4
+ −
HF(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + F (aq) (13.2.13)
2 3
Example 5
+ −
NH (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ NH (aq) + OH (aq) (13.2.15)
3 2 4
In each of these examples, the equilibrium system is an aqueous solution, as denoted by the aq annotations on the solute formulas.
Since H2O(l) is the solvent for these solutions, it is assigned an activity of 1, and thus does not appear explicitly as a term in the
K expression, as discussed earlier, even though it may also appear as a reactant or product in the chemical equation.
c
Reactions in which all reactants and products are gases represent a second class of homogeneous equilibria. We use molar
concentrations in the following examples, but we will see shortly that partial pressures of the gases may be used as well:
Example 1
C H (g) ⇌ C H (g) + H (g) (13.2.17)
2 6 2 4 2
Example 2
Example 3
Example 4
C H (g) + 5 O (g) ⇌ 3 CO (g) + 4 H O(g) (13.2.23)
3 8 2 2 2
Note that the concentration of H O has been included in the last example because water is not the solvent in this gas-phase
2 (g)
P V = nRT (13.2.25)
n
P =( ) RT (13.2.26)
V
= M RT (13.2.27)
Thus, at constant temperature, the pressure of a gas is directly proportional to its concentration. Using the partial pressures of the
gases, we can write the reaction quotient for the system
C H (g) ⇌ C H (g) + H (g) (13.2.28)
2 6 2 4 2
In this equation we use QP to indicate a reaction quotient written with partial pressures: P C H
2 6
is the partial pressure of C2H6; P ,H
2
the partial pressure of H2; and P , the partial pressure of C2H4. At equilibrium:
C H
2 6
PC H PH
2 4 2
KP = QP = (13.2.30)
PC H
2 6
The subscript P in the symbol K designates an equilibrium constant derived using partial pressures instead of concentrations.
P
The equilibrium constant, KP, is still a constant, but its numeric value may differ from the equilibrium constant found for the same
reaction by using concentrations.
Conversion between a value for K , an equilibrium constant expressed in terms of concentrations, and a value for K , an
c P
equilibrium constant expressed in terms of pressures, is straightforward (a K or Q without a subscript could be either concentration
or pressure).
The equation relating K and K is derived as follows. For the gas-phase reaction:
c P
mA + nB ⇌ xC + yD (13.2.31)
with
x y
(PC ) (PD )
KP = (13.2.32)
m n
(PA ) (PB )
x y
([C] × RT ) ([D] × RT )
= (13.2.33)
m n
([A] × RT ) ([B] × RT )
x y x+y
[C ] [D] (RT )
= × (13.2.34)
[A]m [B]n (RT )m+n
(x+y)−(m+n)
= Kc (RT ) (13.2.35)
Δn
= Kc (RT ) (13.2.36)
Δn
KP = Kc (RT ) (13.2.37)
In this equation, Δn is the difference between the sum of the coefficients of the gaseous products and the sum of the coefficients of
the gaseous reactants in the reaction (the change in moles of gas between the reactants and the products). For the gas-phase reaction
mA + nB ⇌ xC + yD , we have
Δn = (x + y) − (m + n) (13.2.38)
Solution
(c) Δn = (2) − (1 + 3) = −2
Kc
KP = K (RT)Δn = K (RT)−2 =
c c
2
(RT )
Exercise 13.2.4
Write the equations for the conversion of K to KP for each of the following reactions, which occur in the gas phase:
c
b. N O (g) ⇌ 2 NO (g)
2 4 2
Answer a
KP = K (RT)−1
c
Answer b
KP = K (RT)c
Answer c
KP = K (RT);
c
Answer d
160 or 1.6 × 102
Example 1
CaO(s) + CO (g) ⇌ CaCO (s) (13.2.41)
2 3
Other heterogeneous equilibria involve phase changes, for example, the evaporation of liquid bromine, as shown in the following
equation:
Br (l) ⇌ Br (g) (13.2.45)
2 2
We can write equations for reaction quotients of heterogeneous equilibria that involve gases, using partial pressures instead of
concentrations. Two examples are:
CaO(s) + CO (g) ⇌ CaCO (s) (13.2.47)
2 3
Summary
For any reaction that is at equilibrium, the reaction quotient Q is equal to the equilibrium constant K for the reaction. If a reactant or
product is a pure solid, a pure liquid, or the solvent in a dilute solution, the concentration of this component does not appear in the
expression for the equilibrium constant. At equilibrium, the values of the concentrations of the reactants and products are constant.
Their particular values may vary depending on conditions, but the value of the reaction quotient will always equal K (Kc when
using concentrations or KP when using partial pressures).
A homogeneous equilibrium is an equilibrium in which all components are in the same phase. A heterogeneous equilibrium is an
equilibrium in which components are in two or more phases. We can decide whether a reaction is at equilibrium by comparing the
reaction quotient with the equilibrium constant for the reaction.
P = MRT
KP = K (RT)Δn
c
Glossary
equilibrium constant (K)
value of the reaction quotient for a system at equilibrium
heterogeneous equilibria
homogeneous equilibria
equilibria within a single phase
Kc
equilibrium constant for reactions based on concentrations of reactants and products
KP
equilibrium constant for gas-phase reactions based on partial pressures of reactants and products
This page titled 13.2: Equilibrium Constants is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As we saw in the previous section, reactions proceed in both directions (reactants go to products and products go to reactants). We
can tell a reaction is at equilibrium if the reaction quotient (Q) is equal to the equilibrium constant (K). We next address what
happens when a system at equilibrium is disturbed so that Q is no longer equal to K . If a system at equilibrium is subjected to a
perturbance or stress (such as a change in concentration) the position of equilibrium changes. Since this stress affects the
concentrations of the reactants and the products, the value of Q will no longer equal the value of K . To re-establish equilibrium,
the system will either shift toward the products (if Q < K ) or the reactants (if Q > K ) until Q returns to the same value as K .
This process is described by Le Chatelier's principle: When a chemical system at equilibrium is disturbed, it returns to equilibrium
by counteracting the disturbance. As described in the previous paragraph, the disturbance causes a change in Q; the reaction will
shift to re-establish Q = K .
A chemical system at equilibrium can be temporarily shifted out of equilibrium by adding or removing one or more of the
reactants or products. The concentrations of both reactants and products then undergo additional changes to return the system
to equilibrium.
The stress on the system in Figure 13.3.1 is the reduction of the equilibrium concentration of SCN− (lowering the concentration of
one of the reactants would cause Q to be larger than K). As a consequence, Le Chatelier's principle leads us to predict that the
concentration of Fe(SCN)2+ should decrease, increasing the concentration of SCN− part way back to its original concentration, and
increasing the concentration of Fe3+ above its initial equilibrium concentration.
Figure 13.3.1: (a) The test tube contains 0.1 M Fe3+. (b) Thiocyanate ion has been added to solution in (a), forming the red
Fe(SCN)2+ ion. Fe (aq) + SCN (aq) ⇌ Fe(SCN) (aq) . (c) Silver nitrate has been added to the solution in (b), precipitating
3+ − 2 +
some of the SCN− as the white solid AgSCN. Ag (aq) + SCN (aq) ⇌ AgSCN(s). The decrease in the SCN− concentration
+ −
shifts the first equilibrium in the solution to the left, decreasing the concentration (and lightening color) of the Fe(SCN)2+. (credit:
modification of work by Mark Ott).
Three capped test tubes held vertically in clamps are shown in pictures labeled, “a,” “b,” and “c.” The test tube in picture a is half
filled with a clear, orange liquid. The test tube in picture b is half filled with a dark, burgundy liquid. The test tube in picture c is
half filled with a slightly cloudy, orange liquid.
The effect of a change in concentration on a system at equilibrium is illustrated further by the equilibrium of this chemical reaction:
system so quickly that its concentration doubles before it begins to react (new [H ] = 0.442 M), the reaction will shift so that a
2
This gives:
2 2
[HI] (1.692)
Qc = = = 50.0 = Kc (13.3.3)
[ H2 ][ I2 ] (0.374)(0.153)
We have stressed this system by introducing additional H . The stress is relieved when the reaction shifts to the right, using up
2
some (but not all) of the excess H , reducing the amount of uncombined I , and forming additional HI .
2 2
Some changes to total pressure, like adding an inert gas that is not part of the equilibrium, will change the total pressure but not the
partial pressures of the gases in the equilibrium constant expression. Thus, addition of a gas not involved in the equilibrium will not
perturb the equilibrium.
As we increase the pressure of a gaseous system at equilibrium, either by decreasing the volume of the system or by adding more of
one of the components of the equilibrium mixture, we introduce a stress by increasing the partial pressures of one or more of the
components. In accordance with Le Chatelier's principle, a shift in the equilibrium that reduces the total number of molecules per
unit of volume will be favored because this relieves the stress. The reverse reaction would be favored by a decrease in pressure.
Consider what happens when we increase the pressure on a system in which NO, O , and NO are at equilibrium:
2 2
The formation of additional amounts of NO decreases the total number of molecules in the system because each time two
2
molecules of NO form, a total of three molecules of NO and O are consumed. This reduces the total pressure exerted by the
2 2
system and reduces, but does not completely relieve, the stress of the increased pressure. On the other hand, a decrease in the
pressure on the system favors decomposition of NO into NO and O , which tends to restore the pressure.
2 2
Because there is no change in the total number of molecules in the system during reaction, a change in pressure does not favor
either formation or decomposition of gaseous nitrogen monoxide.
Increasing the temperature of the reaction increases the internal energy of the system. Thus, increasing the temperature has the
effect of increasing the amount of one of the products of this reaction. The reaction shifts to the left to relieve the stress, and there
is an increase in the concentration of H and I and a reduction in the concentration of HI . Lowering the temperature of this
2 2
system reduces the amount of energy present, favors the production of heat, and favors the formation of hydrogen iodide.
When we change the temperature of a system at equilibrium, the equilibrium constant for the reaction changes. Lowering the
temperature in the HI system increases the equilibrium constant: At the new equilibrium the concentration of HI has increased and
the concentrations of H and I decreased. Raising the temperature decreases the value of the equilibrium constant, from 67.5 at
2 2
The positive ΔH value tells us that the reaction is endothermic and could be written
heat + N O (g) ⇌ 2 NO (g) (13.3.9)
2 4 2
At higher temperatures, the gas mixture has a deep brown color, indicative of a significant amount of brown NO molecules. If,
2
however, we put a stress on the system by cooling the mixture (withdrawing energy), the equilibrium shifts to the left to supply
some of the energy lost by cooling. The concentration of colorless N O increases, and the concentration of brown NO
2 4 2
A large quantity of ammonia is manufactured by this reaction. Each year, ammonia is among the top 10 chemicals, by mass,
manufactured in the world. About 2 billion pounds are manufactured in the United States each year. Ammonia plays a vital role in
our global economy. It is used in the production of fertilizers and is, itself, an important fertilizer for the growth of corn, cotton, and
other crops. Large quantities of ammonia are converted to nitric acid, which plays an important role in the production of fertilizers,
explosives, plastics, dyes, and fibers, and is also used in the steel industry.
Fritz Haber
Haber was born in Breslau, Prussia (presently Wroclaw, Poland) in December 1868. He went on to study chemistry and, while
at the University of Karlsruhe, he developed what would later be known as the Haber process: the catalytic formation of
ammonia from hydrogen and atmospheric nitrogen under high temperatures and pressures.
The work of Nobel Prize recipient Fritz Haber revolutionized agricultural practices in the early 20th century. His work also
affected wartime strategies, adding chemical weapons to the artillery.
Currently, the annual production of synthetic nitrogen fertilizers exceeds 100 million tons and synthetic fertilizer production
has increased the number of humans that arable land can support from 1.9 persons per hectare in 1908 to 4.3 in 2008. The
availability of nitrogen is a strong limiting factor to the growth of plants. Despite accounting for 78% of air, diatomic nitrogen (
N ) is nutritionally unavailable due the tremendous stability of the nitrogen-nitrogen triple bond. For plants to use atmospheric
2
nitrogen, the nitrogen must be converted to a more bioavailable form (this conversion is called nitrogen fixation).
In addition to his work in ammonia production, Haber is also remembered by history as one of the fathers of chemical warfare.
During World War I, he played a major role in the development of poisonous gases used for trench warfare. Regarding his role
in these developments, Haber said, “During peace time a scientist belongs to the World, but during war time he belongs to his
country.”1 Haber defended the use of gas warfare against accusations that it was inhumane, saying that death was death, by
whatever means it was inflicted. He stands as an example of the ethical dilemmas that face scientists in times of war and the
double-edged nature of the sword of science.
Like Haber, the products made from ammonia can be multifaceted. In addition to their value for agriculture, nitrogen
compounds can also be used to achieve destructive ends. Ammonium nitrate has also been used in explosives, including
improvised explosive devices. Ammonium nitrate was one of the components of the bomb used in the attack on the Alfred P.
Murrah Federal Building in downtown Oklahoma City on April 19, 1995.
It has long been known that nitrogen and hydrogen react to form ammonia. However, it became possible to manufacture ammonia
in useful quantities by the reaction of nitrogen and hydrogen only in the early 20th century after the factors that influence its
equilibrium were understood.
To be practical, an industrial process must give a large yield of product relatively quickly. One way to increase the yield of
ammonia is to increase the pressure on the system in which N2, H2, and NH3 are at equilibrium or are coming to equilibrium.
N (g) + 3 H (g) ⇌ 2 NH (g) (13.3.11)
2 2 3
The formation of additional amounts of ammonia reduces the total pressure exerted by the system and somewhat reduces the stress
of the increased pressure.
Although increasing the pressure of a mixture of N2, H2, and NH3 will increase the yield of ammonia, at low temperatures, the rate
of formation of ammonia is slow. At room temperature, for example, the reaction is so slow that if we prepared a mixture of N2 and
H2, no detectable amount of ammonia would form during our lifetime. The formation of ammonia from hydrogen and nitrogen is
an exothermic process:
N (g) + 3 H (g) → 2 NH (g) ΔH = −92.2 kJ (13.3.12)
2 2 3
Thus, increasing the temperature to increase the rate lowers the yield. If we lower the temperature to shift the equilibrium to favor
the formation of more ammonia, equilibrium is reached more slowly because of the large decrease of reaction rate with decreasing
temperature.
Part of the rate of formation lost by operating at lower temperatures can be recovered by using a catalyst. The net effect of the
catalyst on the reaction is to cause equilibrium to be reached more rapidly. In the commercial production of ammonia, conditions of
about 500 °C, 150–900 atm, and the presence of a catalyst are used to give the best compromise among rate, yield, and the cost of
the equipment necessary to produce and contain high-pressure gases at high temperatures (Figure 13.3.2).
<div data-mt-source="1"
Figure 13.3.2 : Commercial production of ammonia requires heavy equipment to handle the high temperatures and pressures
required. This schematic outlines the design of an ammonia plant.
Summary
Systems at equilibrium can be disturbed by changes to temperature, concentration, and, in some cases, volume and pressure;
volume and pressure changes will disturb equilibrium if the number of moles of gas is different on the reactant and product sides of
the reaction. The system's response to these disturbances is described by Le Chatelier's principle: The system will respond in a way
Footnotes
1. Herrlich, P. “The Responsibility of the Scientist: What Can History Teach Us About How Scientists Should Handle Research
That Has the Potential to Create Harm?” EMBO Reports 14 (2013): 759–764.
Glossary
Le Chatelier's principle
when a chemical system at equilibrium is disturbed, it returns to equilibrium by counteracting the disturbance
position of equilibrium
concentrations or partial pressures of components of a reaction at equilibrium (commonly used to describe conditions before a
disturbance)
stress
change to a reaction's conditions that may cause a shift in the equilibrium
This page titled 13.3: Shifting Equilibria - Le Chatelier’s Principle is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated
by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon
request.
We know that at equilibrium, the value of the reaction quotient of any reaction is equal to its equilibrium constant. Thus, we can
use the mathematical expression for Q to determine a number of quantities associated with a reaction at equilibrium or approaching
equilibrium. While we have learned to identify in which direction a reaction will shift to reach equilibrium, we want to extend that
understanding to quantitative calculations. We do so by evaluating the ways that the concentrations of products and reactants
change as a reaction approaches equilibrium, keeping in mind the stoichiometric ratios of the reaction. This algebraic approach to
equilibrium calculations will be explored in this section.
Changes in concentrations or pressures of reactants and products occur as a reaction system approaches equilibrium. In this section
we will see that we can relate these changes to each other using the coefficients in the balanced chemical equation describing the
system. We use the decomposition of ammonia as an example.
On heating, ammonia reversibly decomposes into nitrogen and hydrogen according to this equation:
If a sample of ammonia decomposes in a closed system and the concentration of N2 increases by 0.11 M, the change in the N2
concentration, Δ[N2], the final concentration minus the initial concentration, is 0.11 M. The change is positive because the
concentration of N2 increases.
The change in the H2 concentration, Δ[H2], is also positive—the concentration of H2 increases as ammonia decomposes. The
chemical equation tells us that the change in the concentration of H2 is three times the change in the concentration of N2 because
for each mole of N2 produced, 3 moles of H2 are produced.
Δ[ H ] = 3 × Δ[ N ]
2 2
= 3 × (0.11 M )
= 0.33 M
The change in concentration of NH3, Δ[NH3], is twice that of Δ[N2]; the equation indicates that 2 moles of NH3 must decompose
for each mole of N2 formed. However, the change in the NH3 concentration is negative because the concentration of ammonia
decreases as it decomposes.
Δ[ NH ] = −2 × Δ[ N ]
3 2
= −2 × (0.11 M )
= −0.22 M
Δ[ NH ] = −2 × Δ[ N ] Δ[ N ] = 0.11 M Δ[ H ] = 3 × Δ[ N ] (13.4.2)
3 2 2 2 2
Note that all the changes on one side of the arrows are of the same sign and that all the changes on the other side of the arrows are
of the opposite sign.
If we did not know the magnitude of the change in the concentration of N2, we could represent it by the symbol x.
Δ[ N ] = x
2
Δ[ NH ] = −2 × Δ[ N ] = −2x
3 2
− 2x x 3x (13.4.4)
The simplest way for us to find the coefficients for the concentration changes in any reaction is to use the coefficients in the
balanced chemical equation. The sign of the coefficient is positive when the concentration increases; it is negative when the
concentration decreases.
x (13.4.6)
––––– –––––
(b)
− −
I (aq) + I (aq) ⇌ I (aq) (13.4.7)
2 3
x (13.4.8)
––––– –––––
(c)
C H (g) + 5 O (g) ⇌ 3 CO (g) + 4 H O(g) (13.4.9)
3 8 2 2 2
x (13.4.10)
––––– ––––– –––––
Solution
(a)
C H (g) + 2 Br (g) ⇌ C H Br (g) (13.4.11)
2 2 2 2 2 4
x 2x −x (13.4.12)
(b)
− −
I (aq) + I (aq) ⇌ I (aq) (13.4.13)
2 3
−x −x x (13.4.14)
(c)
C H (g) + 5 O (g) ⇌ 3 CO (g) + 4 H O(g) (13.4.15)
3 8 2 2 2
x 5x − 3x − 4x (13.4.16)
Exercise 13.4.1
Complete the changes in concentrations for each of the following reactions:
(a)
2 SO (g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) (13.4.17)
2 2 3
x (13.4.18)
––––– –––––
(b)
C H (g) ⇌ 2 C H (g) (13.4.19)
4 8 2 4
− 2x (13.4.20)
–––––
(c)
4 NH (g) + 7 H O(g) ⇌ 4 NO (g) + 6 H O(g) (13.4.21)
3 2 2 2
(13.4.22)
––––– ––––– ––––– –––––
Answer a
2x, x, −2x
Answer b
Iodine molecules react reversibly with iodide ions to produce triiodide ions.
− −
I (aq) + I (aq) ⇌ I (aq)
2 3
If a solution with the concentrations of I2 and I− both equal to 1.000 × 10−3 M before reaction gives an equilibrium
concentration of I2 of 6.61 × 10−4 M, what is the equilibrium constant for the reaction?
Solution
We will begin this problem by calculating the changes in concentration as the system goes to equilibrium. Then we determine
the equilibrium concentrations and, finally, the equilibrium constant. First, we set up a table with the initial concentrations, the
changes in concentrations, and the equilibrium concentrations using −x as the change in concentration of I2.
−3 −4
x = 1.000 × 10 − 6.61 × 10
−4
= 3.39 × 10 M
−4
3.39 × 10 M
= = 776
−4 −4
(6.61 × 10 M )(6.61 × 10 M)
Exercise 13.4.2
Ethanol and acetic acid react and form water and ethyl acetate, the solvent responsible for the odor of some nail polish
removers.
C H OH + CH CO H ⇌ CH CO C H +H O
2 5 3 2 3 2 2 5 2
When 1 mol each of C2H5OH and CH3CO2H are allowed to react in 1 L of the solvent dioxane, equilibrium is established
1
when mol of each of the reactants remains. Calculate the equilibrium constant for the reaction. (Note: Water is not a solvent
3
in this reaction.)
Answer
Kc = 4
equilibrium mixture with air at 1 atm pressure at this temperature. In air, [N2] = 0.036 mol/L and [O2] 0.0089 mol/L.
Solution
We are given all of the equilibrium concentrations except that of NO. Thus, we can solve for the missing equilibrium
concentration by rearranging the equation for the equilibrium constant.
2
[NO] = Kc [ N ][ O ]
2 2
−−−−−−−−−
[NO] = √Kc [ N ][ O ]
2 2
−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−
−4
= √(4.1 × 10 )(0.036)(0.0089)
−−−−−−−− −
−7
= √1.31 × 10
−4
= 3.6 × 10
−4 2
(3.6 × 10 )
=
(0.036)(0.0089)
−4
= 4.0 × 10 = Kc
The answer checks; our calculated value gives the equilibrium constant within the error associated with the significant figures
in the problem.
Exercise 13.4.3
The equilibrium constant for the reaction of nitrogen and hydrogen to produce ammonia at a certain temperature is 6.00 × 10−2.
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of ammonia if the equilibrium concentrations of nitrogen and hydrogen are 4.26 M and
2.09 M, respectively.
Answer
1.53 mol/L
Under certain conditions, the equilibrium constant for the decomposition of PCl5(g) into PCl3(g) and Cl2(g) is 0.0211. What
are the equilibrium concentrations of PCl5, PCl3, and Cl2 if the initial concentration of PCl5 was 1.00 M?
Solution
Use the stepwise process described earlier.
1. The balanced equation for the decomposition of PCl5 is
PCl (g) ⇌ PCl (g) + Cl (g)
5 3 2
Because we have no products initially, Qc = 0 and the reaction will proceed to the right.
Let us represent the increase in concentration of PCl3 by the symbol x. The other changes may be written in terms of x by
considering the coefficients in the chemical equation.
PCl (g) ⇌ PCl (g) + Cl (g) (13.4.23)
5 3 2
−x x x (13.4.24)
The changes in concentration and the expressions for the equilibrium concentrations are:
This table has two main columns and four rows. The first row for the first column does not have a heading and then has the
following in the first column: Initial concentration ( M ), Change ( M ), Equilibrium concentration ( M ). The second column
has the header, “P C l subscript 5 equilibrium arrow P C l subscript 3 plus C l subscript 2.” Under the second column is a
subgroup of three rows and three columns. The first column has the following: 1.00, negative x, 1.00 minus x. The second
column has the following: 0, positive x, 0 plus x equals x. The third column has the following: 0, positive x, 0 plus x equals x.
Substituting the equilibrium concentrations into the equilibrium constant equation gives
[ PCl ][ Cl ]
3 2
Kc = = 0.0211
[ PCl ]
5
(x)(x)
=
(1.00 − x)
This equation contains only one variable, x, the change in concentration. We can write the equation as a quadratic equation and
solve for x using the quadratic formula.
(x)(x)
0.0211 =
(1.00 − x)
In this case, a = 1, b = 0.0211, and c = −0.0211. Substituting the appropriate values for a, b, and c yields:
−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−− −
2
−0.0211 ± √(0.0211 ) − 4(1)(−0.0211)
x =
2(1)
−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−
−4 −2
−0.0211 ± √(4.45 × 10 ) + (8.44 × 10 )
=
2
−0.0211 ± 0.291
=
2
Hence
−0.0211 + 0.291
x = = 0.135
2
or
−0.0211 − 0.291
x = = −0.156
2
Quadratic equations often have two different solutions, one that is physically possible and one that is physically impossible (an
extraneous root). In this case, the second solution (−0.156) is physically impossible because we know the change must be a
positive number (otherwise we would end up with negative values for concentrations of the products). Thus, x = 0.135 M.
The equilibrium concentrations are
[ PCl ] = 1.00 − 0.135 = 0.87 M
5
[ PCl ] = x = 0.135 M
3
[ Cl ] = x = 0.135 M
2
Substitution into the expression for Kc (to check the calculation) gives
[ PCl ][ Cl ] (0.135)(0.135)
3 2
Kc = = = 0.021
[ PCl ] 0.87
5
The equilibrium constant calculated from the equilibrium concentrations is equal to the value of Kc given in the problem (when
rounded to the proper number of significant figures). Thus, the calculated equilibrium concentrations check.
Exercise 13.4.4A
Acetic acid, CH3CO2H, reacts with ethanol, C2H5OH, to form water and ethyl acetate, CH3CO2C2H5.
CH CO H + C H OH ⇌ CH CO C H +H O
3 2 2 5 3 2 2 5 2
The equilibrium constant for this reaction with dioxane as a solvent is 4.0. What are the equilibrium concentrations when a
mixture that is 0.15 M in CH3CO2H, 0.15 M in C2H5OH, 0.40 M in CH3CO2C2H5, and 0.40 M in H2O are mixed in enough
dioxane to make 1.0 L of solution?
Answer
[CH3CO2H] = 0.36 M, [C2H5OH] = 0.36 M, [CH3CO2C2H5] = 0.17 M, [H2O] = 0.17 M
Exercise 13.4.4B
A 1.00-L flask is filled with 1.00 moles of H2 and 2.00 moles of I2. The value of the equilibrium constant for the reaction of
hydrogen and iodine reacting to form hydrogen iodide is 50.5 under the given conditions. What are the equilibrium
concentrations of H2, I2, and HI in moles/L?
Answer
[H2] = 0.06 M, [I2] = 1.06 M, [HI] = 1.88 M
Sometimes it is possible to use chemical insight to find solutions to equilibrium problems without actually solving a quadratic (or
more complicated) equation. First, however, it is useful to verify that equilibrium can be obtained starting from two extremes: all
(or mostly) reactants and all (or mostly) products.
Consider the ionization of 0.150 M HA, a weak acid.
+ − −4
HA(aq) ⇌ H (aq) + A (aq) Kc = 6.80 × 10
The most obvious way to determine the equilibrium concentrations would be to start with only reactants. This could be called the
“all reactant” starting point. Using x for the amount of acid ionized at equilibrium, this is the ICE table and solution.
This table has two main columns and four rows. The first row for the first column does not have a heading and then has the
following: Initial pressure ( M ), Change ( M ), Equilibrium ( M ). The second column has the header, “H A ( a q ) equilibrium
arrow H superscript plus sign ( a q ) plus A subscript negative sign ( a q ).” Under the second column is a subgroup of three
columns and three rows. The first column has the following: 0.150, negative x, 0.150 minus x. The second column has the
following: 0, x, x. The third column has the following: 0, x, x.
Setting up and solving the quadratic equation gives
+ −
[H ][ A ] (x)(x)
−4
Kc = = = 6.80 × 10
[HA] (0.150 − x)
2 −4 −4
x + 6.80 × 10 x − 1.02 × 10 =0
−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−
−4 −4 2 −4
x = −6.80 × 10 ± √(6.80 × 10 ) − (4)(1)(−1.02 × 10 ) (2)(1)
A less obvious way to solve the problem would be to assume all the HA ionizes first, then the system comes to equilibrium. This
could be called the “all product” starting point. Assuming all of the HA ionizes gives
[HA] = 0.150 − 0.150 = 0 M
+
[H ] = 0 + 0.150 = 0.150 M
−
[A ] = 0 + 0.150 = 0.150 M
Using these as initial concentrations and “y” to represent the concentration of HA at equilibrium, this is the ICE table for this
starting point.
0.30068 ± 0.020210
y =
2
Using the physically significant root (0.140 M) gives the equilibrium concentrations as
[HA] = y = 0.140 M
+
[H ] = 0.150 − y = 0.010 M
−
[A ] = 0.150 − y = 0.010 M
Thus, the two approaches give the same results (to three decimal places), and show that both starting points lead to the same
equilibrium conditions. The “all reactant” starting point resulted in a relatively small change (x) because the system was close to
equilibrium, while the “all product” starting point had a relatively large change (y) that was nearly the size of the initial
concentrations. It can be said that a system that starts “close” to equilibrium will require only a ”small” change in conditions (x) to
reach equilibrium.
Recall that a small Kc means that very little of the reactants form products and a large Kc means that most of the reactants form
products. If the system can be arranged so it starts “close” to equilibrium, then if the change (x) is small compared to any initial
concentrations, it can be neglected. Small is usually defined as resulting in an error of less than 5%. The following two examples
demonstrate this.
Solution
Using “x” to represent the concentration of each product at equilibrium gives this ICE table.
The exact solution may be obtained using the quadratic formula with
(x)(x)
Kc =
0.15 − x
solving
2 −10 −11
x + 4.9 × 10 − 7.35 × 10 =0
−6 −6
x = 8.56 × 10 M (3 sig. figs.) = 8.6 × 10 M (2 sig. figs.)
2
−10
x
4.9 × 10 =
0.15
2 −10 −11
x = (0.15)(4.9 × 10 ) = 7.4 × 10
− −−−−−−− −
−11 −6
x = √ 7.4 × 10 = 8.6 × 10 M
In this example, solving the exact (quadratic) equation and using approximations gave the same result to two significant
figures. While most of the time the approximation is a bit different from the exact solution, as long as the error is less than 5%,
the approximate solution is considered valid. In this problem, the 5% applies to IF (0.15 – x) ≈ 0.15 M, so if
−6
x 8.6 × 10
× 100% = × 100% = 0.006%
0.15 0.15
is less than 5%, as it is in this case, the assumption is valid. The approximate solution is thus a valid solution.
Exercise 13.4.5
Assume that x is much less than 0.25 M and calculate the error in your assumption.
Answer
[ OH
− +
] = [ NH
4
] = 0.0021 M; [NH3] = 0.25 M, error = 0.84%
If 0.010 mol Cu2+ is added to 1.00 L of a solution that is 1.00 M NH3 what are the concentrations when the system comes to
equilibrium?
Solution The initial concentration of copper(II) is 0.010 M. The equilibrium constant is very large so it would be better to start
with as much product as possible because “all products” is much closer to equilibrium than “all reactants.” Note that Cu2+ is
the limiting reactant; if all 0.010 M of it reacts to form product the concentrations would be
2+
[ Cu ] = 0.010 − 0.010 = 0 M
2+
[Cu(NH ) ] = 0.010 M
3 4
Using these “shifted” values as initial concentrations with x as the free copper(II) ion concentration at equilibrium gives this
ICE table.
This table has two main columns and four rows. The first row for the first column does not have a heading and then has the
following: Initial pressure ( M ), Change ( M ), Equilibrium ( M ). The second column has the header, “C u superscript 2
positive sign ( a q ) plus 4 N H subscript 3 ( a q ) equilibrium arrow C u ( N H subscript 3 ) subscript 4 superscript 2 positive
sign ( a q ).” Under the second column is a subgroup of three columns and three rows. The first column has the following: 0,
positive x, x. The second column has the following: 0.96, positive 4 x, 0.96 plus 4 x. The third column has the following:
0.010, negative x, 0.010 minus x.
Since we are starting close to equilibrium, x should be small so that
0.96 + 4x ≈ 0.96 M
0.010 − x ≈ 0.010 M
(0.010 − x) (0.010)
13
Kc = ≈ = 5.0 × 10
4 4
x(0.96 − 4x) x(0.96)
(0.010)
−16
x = = 2.4 × 10 M
4
Kc (0.96 )
This is much less than 5%, so the assumptions are valid. The concentrations at equilibrium are
2+ −16
[ Cu ] = x = 2.4 × 10 M
[ NH ] = 0.96 − 4x = 0.96 M
3
By starting with the maximum amount of product, this system was near equilibrium and the change (x) was very small. With only a
small change required to get to equilibrium, the equation for x was greatly simplified and gave a valid result well within the 5%
error maximum.
Exercise 13.4.6
What are the equilibrium concentrations when 0.25 mol Ni2+ is added to 1.00 L of 2.00 M NH3 solution?
2+ 2+
Ni (aq) + 6 NH (aq) ⇌ Ni (NH ) (aq)
3 3 6
with K c = 5.5 × 10
8
.
With such a large equilibrium constant, first form as much product as possible, then assume that only a small amount (x) of the
product shifts left. Calculate the error in your assumption.
Answer
, [NH3] = 0.50 M, [Ni2+] = 2.9 × 10–8 M, error = 1.2 × 10–5%
2+
[Ni (NH ) ] = 0.25 M
3 6
Summary
The ratios of the rate of change in concentrations of a reaction are equal to the ratios of the coefficients in the balanced chemical
equation. The sign of the coefficient of X is positive when the concentration increases and negative when it decreases. We learned
to approach three basic types of equilibrium problems. When given the concentrations of the reactants and products at equilibrium,
we can solve for the equilibrium constant; when given the equilibrium constant and some of the concentrations involved, we can
solve for the missing concentrations; and when given the equilibrium constant and the initial concentrations, we can solve for the
concentrations at equilibrium.
This page titled 13.4: Equilibrium Calculations is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
13.E.1.2: S13.1.1
The reaction can proceed in both the forward and reverse directions.
13.E.1.3: Q13.1.2
When writing an equation, how is a reversible reaction distinguished from a nonreversible reaction?
13.E.1.4: Q13.1.3
If a reaction is reversible, when can it be said to have reached equilibrium?
13.E.1.5: S13.1.3
When a system has reached equilibrium, no further changes in the reactant and product concentrations occur; the reactions continue
to occur, but at equivalent rates.
13.E.1.6: Q13.1.4
Is a system at equilibrium if the rate constants of the forward and reverse reactions are equal?
13.E.1.7: Q13.1.5
If the concentrations of products and reactants are equal, is the system at equilibrium?
13.E.1.8: S13.1.5
The concept of equilibrium does not imply equal concentrations, though it is possible.
13.E.2.2: Q13.2.2
Explain why an equilibrium between Br2(l) and Br2(g) would not be established if the container were not a closed vessel shown
below:
13.E.2.3: S13.2.2
Equilibrium cannot be established between the liquid and the gas phase if the top is removed from the bottle because the system is
not closed; one of the components of the equilibrium, the Br2 vapor, would escape from the bottle until all liquid disappeared.
Thus, more liquid would evaporate than can condense back from the gas phase to the liquid phase.
13.E.2.5: Q13.2.4
Among the solubility rules previously discussed is the statement: All chlorides are soluble except Hg2Cl2, AgCl, PbCl2, and CuCl.
13.E.2.6: Q13.2.5
1. (a) Write the expression for the equilibrium constant for the reaction represented by the equation
AgCl(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) . Is Kc > 1, < 1, or ≈ 1? Explain your answer.
+ −
2. (b) Write the expression for the equilibrium constant for the reaction represented by the equation
(aq) + 2 Cl (aq) ⇌ PbCl (s) . Is Kc > 1, < 1, or ≈ 1? Explain your answer.
2+ −
Pb
2
13.E.2.7: S13.2.5
1
(a) Kc = [Ag+][Cl−] < 1. AgCl is insoluble; thus, the concentrations of ions are much less than 1 M; (b) K c = >1
2+ − 2
[ Pb ] [ Cl ]
because PbCl2 is insoluble and formation of the solid will reduce the concentration of ions to a low level (<1 M).
13.E.2.8: Q13.2.6
Among the solubility rules previously discussed is the statement: Carbonates, phosphates, borates, and arsenates—except those of
the ammonium ion and the alkali metals—are insoluble.
a. Write the expression for the equilibrium constant for the reaction represented by the equation
(aq) + CO (aq) . Is Kc > 1, < 1, or ≈ 1? Explain your answer.
2+ −
CaCO (s) ⇌ Ca
3 3
b. Write the expression for the equilibrium constant for the reaction represented by the equation
(aq) ⇌ Ba (PO ) (s) . Is Kc > 1, < 1, or ≈ 1? Explain your answer.
2+ 3−
3 Ba (aq) + 2 PO
4 3 4 2
13.E.2.9: Q13.2.7
Benzene is one of the compounds used as octane enhancers in unleaded gasoline. It is manufactured by the catalytic conversion of
acetylene to benzene: 3 C H (g) ⟶ C H (g) . Which value of Kc would make this reaction most useful commercially? Kc ≈
2 2 6 6
13.E.2.10: S13.2.7
[C H ]
6 6
Since Kc =
3
, a value of Kc ≈ 10 means that C6H6 predominates over C2H2. In such a case, the reaction would be
[C H ]
2 2
13.E.2.11: Q13.2.8
Show that the complete chemical equation, the total ionic equation, and the net ionic equation for the reaction represented by the
equation KI(aq) + I (aq) ⇌ KI (aq) give the same expression for the reaction quotient. KI3 is composed of the ions K+ and I3−.
2 3
13.E.2.12: Q13.2.9
For a titration to be effective, the reaction must be rapid and the yield of the reaction must essentially be 100%. Is Kc > 1, < 1, or ≈
1 for a titration reaction?
13.E.2.13: S13.2.9
Kc > 1
13.E.2.14: Q13.2.10
For a precipitation reaction to be useful in a gravimetric analysis, the product of the reaction must be insoluble. Is Kc > 1, < 1, or ≈
1 for a useful precipitation reaction?
f. Br (g) ⇌ 2 Br(g)
2
13.E.2.16: S13.2.11
2 2 2
[ CH Cl][HCl] [NO] [ SO ] 1 [Br]
3 3
(a) Qc = ; (b) Q c = ; (c) Q c =
2
; (d) Q = [SO2]; (e) Q
c c =
5
; (f) Q
c = ; (g)
[ CH ][ Cl ] [ N ][ O ] [ SO ] [ O ] [P ][O ] [ Br ]
4 2 2 2 2
2 2 4 2
[ CO ]
Qc =
2
2
; (h) Q = [H2O]5
c
[ CH ] [ O ]
4 2
13.E.2.17: Q13.2.12
Write the mathematical expression for the reaction quotient, Qc, for each of the following reactions:
a. N (g) + 3 H (g) ⇌ 2 NH (g)
2 2 3
c. N O (g) ⇌ 2 NO (g)
2 4 2
h. S (g) ⇌ 8 S(g)
8
13.E.2.18: S13.2.12
The initial concentrations or pressures of reactants and products are given for each of the following systems. Calculate the reaction
quotient and determine the direction in which each system will proceed to reach equilibrium.
a. 2 NH (g) ⇌ N (g) + 3 H (g) K = 17 ; [NH3] = 0.20 M, [N2] = 1.00 M, [H2] = 1.00 M
3 2 2
c
b. 2 NH (g) ⇌ N (g) + 3 H (g) K = 6.8 × 10 ; initial pressures: NH3 = 3.0 atm, N2 = 2.0 atm, H2 = 1.0 atm
3 2 2 P
4
c. 2 SO (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) + O (g) K = 0.230 ; [SO3] = 0.00 M, [SO2] = 1.00 M, [O2] = 1.00 M
3 2 2 c
d. 2 SO (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) + O (g) K = 16.5 ; initial pressures: SO3 = 1.00 atm, SO2 = 1.00 atm, O2 = 1.00 atm
3 2 2 P
13.E.2.19: S13.2.13
(a) Q 25 proceeds left; (b) QP 0.22 proceeds right; (c) Q undefined proceeds left; (d) QP 1.00 proceeds right; (e) QP 0 proceeds
c c
13.E.2.20: Q13.2.14
The initial concentrations or pressures of reactants and products are given for each of the following systems. Calculate the reaction
quotient and determine the direction in which each system will proceed to reach equilibrium.
a. 2 NH (g) ⇌ N (g) + 3 H (g) K = 17 ; [NH3] = 0.50 M, [N2] = 0.15 M, [H2] = 0.12 M
3 2 2 c
b. 2 NH (g) ⇌ N (g) + 3 H (g) K = 6.8 × 10 ; initial pressures: NH3 = 2.00 atm, N2 = 10.00 atm, H2 = 10.00 atm
3 2 2 P
4
c. 2 SO (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) + O (g) K = 0.230 ; [SO3] = 2.00 M, [SO2] = 2.00 M, [O2] = 2.00 M
3 2 2 c
d. 2 SO (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) + O (g) K = 6.5 atm ; initial pressures: SO2 = 1.00 atm, O2 = 1.130 atm, SO3 = 0 atm
3 2 2 P
e. 2 NO(g) + Cl (g) ⇌ 2 NOCl(g) K = 2.5 × 10 ; initial pressures: NO = 1.00 atm, Cl2 = 1.00 atm, NOCl = 0 atm
2 P
3
13.E.2.21: Q13.2.15
The following reaction has KP = 4.50 × 10−5 at 720 K.
\[\ce{N2}(g)+\ce{3H2}(g) \rightleftharpoons \ce{2NH3}(g)\]
If a reaction vessel is filled with each gas to the partial pressures listed, in which direction will it shift to reach equilibrium? P(NH3)
= 93 atm, P(N2) = 48 atm, and P(H2) = 52
13.E.2.22: S13.2.15
The system will shift toward the reactants to reach equilibrium.
13.E.2.23: Q13.2.16
Determine if the following system is at equilibrium. If not, in which direction will the system need to shift to reach equilibrium?
\(\ce{SO2Cl2}(g) \rightleftharpoons \ce{SO2}(g)+\ce{Cl2}(g)\)
[SO2Cl2] = 0.12 M, [Cl2] = 0.16 M and [SO2] = 0.050 M. Kc for the reaction is 0.078.
13.E.2.24: Q13.2.17
Which of the systems described in Exercise give homogeneous equilibria? Which give heterogeneous equilibria?
13.E.2.25: S13.2.17
(a) homogenous; (b) homogenous; (c) homogenous; (d) heterogeneous; (e) heterogeneous; (f) homogenous; (g) heterogeneous; (h)
heterogeneous
13.E.2.26: Q13.2.18
Which of the systems described in Exercise give homogeneous equilibria? Which give heterogeneous equilibria?
13.E.2.27: Q13.2.19
For which of the reactions in Exercise does Kc (calculated using concentrations) equal KP (calculated using pressures)?
13.E.2.28: S13.2.19
This situation occurs in (a) and (b).
13.E.2.29: Q13.2.19
For which of the reactions in Exercise does Kc (calculated using concentrations) equal KP (calculated using pressures)?
13.E.2.30: Q13.2.20
Convert the values of Kc to values of KP or the values of KP to values of Kc.
a. N (g) + 3 H (g) ⇌ 2 NH (g) K = 0.50 at 400°C
2 2 3 c
b. H + I ⇌ 2 HI K = 50.2 at 448°C
2 2 c
13.E.2.31: S13.2.20
(a) KP = 1.6 × 10−4; (b) KP = 50.2; (c) Kc = 5.31 × 10−39; (d) Kc = 4.60 × 10−3
13.E.2.32: Q13.2.21
Convert the values of Kc to values of KP or the values of KP to values of Kc.
a. Cl (g) + Br (g) ⇌ 2 BrCl(g) K = 4.7 × 10 at 25°C
2 2 c
−2
13.E.2.34: S13.2.22
KP = PH O = 0.042. (13.E.1)
2
13.E.2.35: Q13.2.23
Write the expression of the reaction quotient for the ionization of HOCN in water.
13.E.2.36: Q13.2.24
Write the reaction quotient expression for the ionization of NH3 in water.
13.E.2.37: S13.2.24
+ −
[ NH ][ OH ]
4
Qc = (13.E.2)
[ HN ]
3
13.E.2.38: Q13.2.25
What is the approximate value of the equilibrium constant KP for the change C H OC H (l) ⇌ C H OC H (g) at 25 °C.
2 5 2 5 2 5 2 5
(Vapor pressure was described in the previous chapter on liquids and solids; refer back to this chapter to find the relevant
information needed to solve this problem.)
Under what conditions will decomposition in a closed container proceed to completion so that no CaCO3 remains?
13.E.3.2: S13.3.1
The amount of CaCO3 must be so small that P is less than KP when the CaCO3 has completely decomposed. In other words, the
CO
2
starting amount of CaCO3 cannot completely generate the full P required for equilibrium.
CO
2
13.E.3.3: Q13.3.2
Explain how to recognize the conditions under which changes in pressure would affect systems at equilibrium.
13.E.3.4: Q13.3.3
What property of a reaction can we use to predict the effect of a change in temperature on the value of an equilibrium constant?
13.E.3.5: S13.3.3
The change in enthalpy may be used. If the reaction is exothermic, the heat produced can be thought of as a product. If the reaction
is endothermic the heat added can be thought of as a reactant. Additional heat would shift an exothermic reaction back to the
reactants but would shift an endothermic reaction to the products. Cooling an exothermic reaction causes the reaction to shift
toward the product side; cooling an endothermic reaction would cause it to shift to the reactants' side.
13.E.3.6: Q13.3.4
What would happen to the color of the solution in part (b) of Figure if a small amount of NaOH were added and Fe(OH)3
precipitated? Explain your answer.
13.E.3.7: Q13.3.5
The following reaction occurs when a burner on a gas stove is lit:
\(\ce{CH4}(g)+\ce{2O2}(g)\rightleftharpoons\ce{CO2}(g)+\ce{2H2O}(g)\)
Is an equilibrium among CH4, O2, CO2, and H2O established under these conditions? Explain your answer.
13.E.3.9: Q13.3.6
A necessary step in the manufacture of sulfuric acid is the formation of sulfur trioxide, SO3, from sulfur dioxide, SO2, and oxygen,
O2, shown here. At high temperatures, the rate of formation of SO is higher, but the equilibrium amount (concentration or partial
3
a. (a) Does the equilibrium constant for the reaction increase, decrease, or remain about the same as the temperature increases?
b. (b) Is the reaction endothermic or exothermic?
13.E.3.10: Q13.3.7a
Suggest four ways in which the concentration of hydrazine, N2H4, could be increased in an equilibrium described by the following
equation:
\[\ce{N2}(g)+\ce{2H2}(g)\rightleftharpoons\ce{N2H4}(g) \hspace{20px} ΔH=\ce{95\:kJ}\]
13.E.3.11: S13.3.7a
Add N2; add H2; decrease the container volume; heat the mixture.
13.E.3.12: Q13.3.7b
Suggest four ways in which the concentration of PH3 could be increased in an equilibrium described by the following equation:
P (g) + 6 H (g) ⇌ 4 PH (g) ΔH = 110.5 kJ (13.E.4)
4 2 3
13.E.3.13: Q13.3.8
How will an increase in temperature affect each of the following equilibria? How will a decrease in the volume of the reaction
vessel affect each?
a. 2 NH (g) ⇌ N (g) + 3 H (g) ΔH = 92 kJ
3 2 2
13.E.3.14: S13.3.8
(a) ΔT increase = shift right, ΔP increase = shift left; (b) ΔT increase = shift right, ΔP increase = no effect; (c) ΔT increase = shift
left, ΔP increase = shift left; (d) ΔT increase = shift left, ΔP increase = shift right.
13.E.3.15: Q13.3.9
How will an increase in temperature affect each of the following equilibria? How will a decrease in the volume of the reaction
vessel affect each?
a. 2 H O(g) ⇌ 2 H (g) + O (g) ΔH = 484 kJ
2 2 2
13.E.3.16: Q13.3.10
Water gas is a 1:1 mixture of carbon monoxide and hydrogen gas and is called water gas because it is formed from steam and hot
carbon in the following reaction:
H O(g) + C(s) ⇌ H (g) + CO(g). (13.E.5)
2 2
Methanol, a liquid fuel that could possibly replace gasoline, can be prepared from water gas and hydrogen at high temperature and
pressure in the presence of a suitable catalyst.
b. What will happen to the concentrations of H , CO, and CH OH at equilibrium if more H2 is added?
2 3
d. What will happen to the concentrations of H , CO, and CH OH at equilibrium if CH3OH is added?
2 3
e. What will happen to the concentrations of HH , CO, and CH OH at equilibrium if the temperature of the system is increased?
2 3
f. What will happen to the concentrations of H , CO, and CH OH at equilibrium if more catalyst is added?
2 3
13.E.3.17: S13.3.10
[ CH OH]
a. Kc =
3
2
;
[ H ] [CO]
2
13.E.3.18: Q13.3.11
Nitrogen and oxygen react at high temperatures.
a. Write the expression for the equilibrium constant (Kc) for the reversible reaction
N (g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 NO(g) ΔH = 181 kJ (13.E.7)
2 2
b. What will happen to the concentrations of N2, O2, and NO at equilibrium if more O2 is added?
c. What will happen to the concentrations of N2, O2, and NO at equilibrium if N2 is removed?
d. What will happen to the concentrations of N2, O2, and NO at equilibrium if NO is added?
e. What will happen to the concentrations of N2, O2, and NO at equilibrium if the pressure on the system is increased by reducing
the volume of the reaction vessel?
f. What will happen to the concentrations of N2, O2, and NO at equilibrium if the temperature of the system is increased?
g. What will happen to the concentrations of N2, O2, and NO at equilibrium if a catalyst is added?
13.E.3.19: Q13.3.12
Water gas, a mixture of H2 and CO, is an important industrial fuel produced by the reaction of steam with red hot coke, essentially
pure carbon.
a. Write the expression for the equilibrium constant for the reversible reaction
C(s) + H O(g) ⇌ CO(g) + H (g) ΔH = 131.30 kJ (13.E.8)
2 2
b. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if more C is added?
c. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if H2O is removed?
d. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if CO is added?
e. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if the temperature of the system is increased?
13.E.3.20: S13.3.12
[CO][ H ]
2
(a) K c = ; (b) [H2O] no change, [CO] no change, [H2] no change; (c) [H2O] decreases, [CO] decreases, [H2] decreases;
[ H O]
2
(d) [H2O] increases, [CO] increases, [H2] decreases; (f) [H2O] decreases, [CO] increases, [H2] increases. In (b), (c), (d), and (e), the
mass of carbon will change, but its concentration (activity) will not change.
13.E.3.21: Q13.3.13
Pure iron metal can be produced by the reduction of iron(III) oxide with hydrogen gas.
a. Write the expression for the equilibrium constant (Kc) for the reversible reaction
b. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if more Fe is added?
c. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if H2O is removed?
d. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if H2 is added?
e. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if the pressure on the system is increased by
reducing the volume of the reaction vessel?
f. What will happen to the concentration of each reactant and product at equilibrium if the temperature of the system is increased?
13.E.3.22: Q13.3.14
Ammonia is a weak base that reacts with water according to this equation:
\[\ce{NH3}(aq)+\ce{H2O}(l)\rightleftharpoons\ce{NH4+}(aq)+\ce{OH-}(aq)\]
Will any of the following increase the percent of ammonia that is converted to the ammonium ion in water and why?
a. Addition of NaOH
b. Addition of HCl
c. Addition of NH4Cl
13.E.3.23: S13.3.14
Only (b)
13.E.3.24: Q13.3.15
Acetic acid is a weak acid that reacts with water according to this equation:
\[\ce{CH3CO2H}(aq)+\ce{H2O}(aq)\rightleftharpoons\ce{H3O+}(aq)+\ce{CH3CO2-}(aq)\]
Will any of the following increase the percent of acetic acid that reacts and produces CH 3
−
CO
2
ion?
a. Addition of HCl
b. Addition of NaOH
c. Addition of NaCH3CO2
13.E.3.25: Q13.3.16
Suggest two ways in which the equilibrium concentration of Ag+ can be reduced in a solution of Na+, Cl−, Ag+, and NO3
−
, in
contact with solid AgCl.
\(\ce{Na+}(aq)+\ce{Cl-}(aq)+\ce{Ag+}(aq)+\ce{NO3-}(aq)\rightleftharpoons\ce{AgCl}(s)+\ce{Na+}(aq)+\ce{NO3-}(aq)\)
ΔH = −65.9 kJ
13.E.3.26: S13.3.16
Add NaCl or some other salt that produces Cl− to the solution. Cooling the solution forces the equilibrium to the right, precipitating
more AgCl(s).
13.E.3.27: Q13.3.17
How can the pressure of water vapor be increased in the following equilibrium?
\[\ce{H2O}(l)\rightleftharpoons\ce{H2O}(g) \hspace{20px} ΔH=\ce{41\:kJ}\]
13.E.3.28: Q13.3.18
Additional solid silver sulfate, a slightly soluble solid, is added to a solution of silver ion and sulfate ion at equilibrium with solid
silver sulfate.
\[\ce{2Ag+}(aq)+\ce{SO4^2-}(aq)\rightleftharpoons\ce{Ag2SO4}(s)\]
Which of the following will occur?
a. Ag+ or SO concentrations will not change.
2−
d. The Ag+ ion concentration will increase and the SO ion concentration will decrease.
2−
4
13.E.3.29: S13.3.18
(a)
13.E.3.30: Q13.3.19
The amino acid alanine has two isomers, α-alanine and β-alanine. When equal masses of these two compounds are dissolved in
equal amounts of a solvent, the solution of α-alanine freezes at the lowest temperature. Which form, α-alanine or β-alanine, has the
larger equilibrium constant for ionization (HX ⇌ H + X ) ? + −
13.E.4.2: S13.4.1
2
[C]
Kc =
2
. [A] = 0.1 M, [B] = 0.1 M, [C] = 1 M; and [A] = 0.01, [B] = 0.250, [C] = 0.791.
[A][B]
13.E.4.3: Q13.4.2
A reaction is represented by this equation: 2 W(aq) ⇌ X(aq) + 2 Y(aq) Kc = 5 × 10
−4
13.E.4.4: Q13.4.3
What is the value of the equilibrium constant at 500 °C for the formation of NH3 according to the following equation?
N (g) + 3 H (g) ⇌ 2 NH (g) (13.E.10)
2 2 3
An equilibrium mixture of NH3(g), H2(g), and N2(g) at 500 °C was found to contain 1.35 M H2, 1.15 M N2, and 4.12 × 10−1 M
NH3.
13.E.4.5: S13.4.3
Kc = 6.00 × 10−2
13.E.4.6: Q13.4.4
Hydrogen is prepared commercially by the reaction of methane and water vapor at elevated temperatures.
What is the equilibrium constant for the reaction if a mixture at equilibrium contains gases with the following concentrations: CH4,
0.126 M; H2O, 0.242 M; CO, 0.126 M; H2 1.15 M, at a temperature of 760 °C?
A 0.72-mol sample of PCl5 is put into a 1.00-L vessel and heated. At equilibrium, the vessel contains 0.40 mol of PCl3(g) and 0.40
mol of Cl2(g). Calculate the value of the equilibrium constant for the decomposition of PCl5 to PCl3 and Cl2 at this temperature.
13.E.4.7: S13.4.4
Kc = 0.50
13.E.4.8: Q13.4.5
At 1 atm and 25 °C, NO2 with an initial concentration of 1.00 M is 3.3 × 10−3% decomposed into NO and O2. Calculate the value
of the equilibrium constant for the reaction.
13.E.4.9: Q13.4.6
Calculate the value of the equilibrium constant KP for the reaction 2 NO(g) + Cl (g) ⇌ 2 NOCl(g)
2
from these equilibrium
pressures: NO, 0.050 atm; Cl2, 0.30 atm; NOCl, 1.2 atm.
13.E.4.10: S13.4.6
The equilibrium equation is KP = 1.9 × 103
13.E.4.11: Q13.4.7
When heated, iodine vapor dissociates according to this equation:
I (g) ⇌ 2 I(g) (13.E.13)
2
At 1274 K, a sample exhibits a partial pressure of I2 of 0.1122 atm and a partial pressure due to I atoms of 0.1378 atm. Determine
the value of the equilibrium constant, KP, for the decomposition at 1274 K.
13.E.4.12: Q13.4.8
A sample of ammonium chloride was heated in a closed container.
At equilibrium, the pressure of NH3(g) was found to be 1.75 atm. What is the value of the equilibrium constant KP for the
decomposition at this temperature?
13.E.4.13: S13.4.8
KP = 3.06
13.E.4.14: Q13.4.9
At a temperature of 60 °C, the vapor pressure of water is 0.196 atm. What is the value of the equilibrium constant KP for the
transformation at 60 °C?
H O(l) ⇌ H O(g) (13.E.15)
2 2
13.E.4.15: Q13.4.10
Complete the changes in concentrations (or pressure, if requested) for each of the following reactions.
(a)
2 SO (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) + O (g) (13.E.16)
3 2 2
+x (13.E.17)
––––– –––––
0.125 M (13.E.18)
––––– –––––
(b)
4 NH (g) + 3 O (g) ⇌ 2 N (g) + 6 H O(g) (13.E.19)
3 2 2 2
3x (13.E.20)
––––– ––––– –––––
0.24 M (13.E.21)
––––– ––––– –––––
x (13.E.23)
––––– –––––
25 torr (13.E.24)
––––– –––––
x (13.E.26)
––––– ––––– –––––
5 atm (13.E.27)
––––– ––––– –––––
x (13.E.29)
–––––
−4
1.03 × 10 M (13.E.30)
–––––
4x (13.E.32)
–––––
0.40 atm (13.E.33)
–––––
13.E.4.16: S13.4.10
a. −2x, 2x, −0.250 M, 0.250 M;
b. 4x, −2x, −6x, 0.32 M, −0.16 M, −0.48 M;
c. −2x, 3x, −50 torr, 75 torr;
d. x, − x, −3x, 5 atm, −5 atm, −15 atm;
e. x, 1.03 × 10−4 M; (f) x, 0.1 atm.
13.E.4.17: Q13.4.11
Complete the changes in concentrations (or pressure, if requested) for each of the following reactions.
(a)
2 H (g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 H O(g) (13.E.34)
2 2 2
+ 2x (13.E.35)
––––– –––––
1.50 M (13.E.36)
––––– –––––
(b)
CS (g) + 4 H (g) ⇌ CH (g) + 2 H S(g) (13.E.37)
2 2 4 2
x (13.E.38)
––––– ––––– –––––
0.020 M (13.E.39)
––––– ––––– –––––
x (13.E.41)
––––– –––––
1.50 atm (13.E.42)
––––– –––––
x (13.E.44)
––––– ––––– –––––
60.6 torr (13.E.45)
––––– ––––– –––––
(e)
NH HS(s) ⇌ NH (g) + H S(g) (13.E.46)
4 3 2
x (13.E.47)
–––––
−6
9.8 × 10 M (13.E.48)
–––––
x (13.E.50)
–––––
0.012 atm (13.E.51)
–––––
13.E.4.18: Q13.4.12
Why are there no changes specified for Ni in Exercise, part (f)? What property of Ni does change?
13.E.4.20: Q13.4.13
Why are there no changes specified for NH4HS in Exercise, part (e)? What property of NH4HS does change?
13.E.4.21: Q13.4.14
Analysis of the gases in a sealed reaction vessel containing NH3, N2, and H2 at equilibrium at 400 °C established the concentration
of N2 to be 1.2 M and the concentration of H2 to be 0.24 M.
N (g) + 3 H (g) ⇌ 2 NH (g) Kc = 0.50 at 400 °C (13.E.52)
2 2 3
13.E.4.22: S13.4.14
[NH3] = 9.1 × 10−2 M
13.E.4.23: Q13.4.16
Calculate the number of moles of HI that are at equilibrium with 1.25 mol of H2 and 1.25 mol of I2 in a 5.00−L flask at 448 °C.
H +I ⇌ 2 HI Kc = 50.2 at 448 °C
2 2
13.E.4.24: Q13.4.17
What is the pressure of BrCl in an equilibrium mixture of Cl2, Br2, and BrCl if the pressure of Cl2 in the mixture is 0.115 atm and
the pressure of Br2 in the mixture is 0.450 atm?
−2
Cl (g) + Br (g) ⇌ 2 BrCl(g) KP = 4.7 × 10 (13.E.53)
2 2
13.E.4.25: S13.4.17
PBrCl = 4.9 × 10−2 atm
13.E.4.26: Q13.4.18
What is the pressure of CO2 in a mixture at equilibrium that contains 0.50 atm H2, 2.0 atm of H2O, and 1.0 atm of CO at 990 °C?
H (g) + CO (g) ⇌ H O(g) + CO(g) KP = 1.6 at 990 °C (13.E.54)
2 2 2
13.E.4.27: Q13.4.12
Cobalt metal can be prepared by reducing cobalt(II) oxide with carbon monoxide.
2
CoO(s) + CO(g) ⇌ Co(s) + CO (g) Kc = 4.90 × 10 at 550 °C
2
13.E.4.28: S13.4.12
[CO] = 2.0 × 10−4 M
13.E.4.29: Q13.4.13
Carbon reacts with water vapor at elevated temperatures.
C(s) + H O(g) ⇌ CO(g) + H (g) Kc = 0.2 at 1000 °C
2 2
What is the concentration of CO in an equilibrium mixture with [H2O] = 0.500 M at 1000 °C?
13.E.4.30: Q13.4.14
Sodium sulfate 10−hydrate, Na 2
SO
4
⋅ 10 H O
2
, dehydrates according to the equation
Na SO ⋅ 10 H O(s) ⇌ Na SO (s) + 10 H O(g) (13.E.55)
2 4 2 2 4 2
with Kp = 4.08 × 10
−25
at 25°C. What is the pressure of water vapor at equilibrium with a mixture of Na SO
2 4
⋅ 10 H O
2
and
NaSO
4
?
13.E.4.32: Q13.4.15
Calcium chloride 6−hydrate, CaCl2·6H2O, dehydrates according to the equation
−44
CaCl ⋅ 6 H O(s) ⇌ CaCl (s) + 6 H O(g) KP = 5.09 × 10 at 25 °C
2 2 2 2
What is the pressure of water vapor at equilibrium with a mixture of CaCl2·6H2O and CaCl2?
13.E.4.33: Q13.4.16
A student solved the following problem and found the equilibrium concentrations to be [SO2] = 0.590 M, [O2] = 0.0450 M, and
[SO3] = 0.260 M. How could this student check the work without reworking the problem? The problem was: For the following
reaction at 600 °C:
2 SO (g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 SO (g) Kc = 4.32
2 2 3
What are the equilibrium concentrations of all species in a mixture that was prepared with [SO3] = 0.500 M, [SO2] = 0 M, and [O2]
= 0.350 M?
13.E.4.34: S13.4.16
Calculate Q based on the calculated concentrations and see if it is equal to Kc. Because Q does equal 4.32, the system must be at
equilibrium.
13.E.4.35: Q13.4.16
A student solved the following problem and found [N2O4] = 0.16 M at equilibrium. How could this student recognize that the
answer was wrong without reworking the problem? The problem was: What is the equilibrium concentration of N2O4 in a mixture
formed from a sample of NO2 with a concentration of 0.10 M?
Assume that the change in concentration of N2O4 is small enough to be neglected in the following problem.
(a) Calculate the equilibrium concentration of both species in 1.00 L of a solution prepared from 0.129 mol of N2O4 with
chloroform as the solvent.
N O (g) ⇌ 2 NO (g)
2 4 2
Kc = 1.07 × 10
−5
in chloroform
(b) Show that the change is small enough to be neglected.
13.E.4.36: S13.4.16
(a)
[NO2] = 1.17 × 10−3 M
[N2O4] = 0.128 M
−4
5.87 × 10
(b) Percent error = × 100% = 0.455% . The change in concentration of N2O4 is far less than the 5% maximum
0.129
allowed.
13.E.4.37: Q13.4.17
Assume that the change in concentration of COCl2 is small enough to be neglected in the following problem.
a. Calculate the equilibrium concentration of all species in an equilibrium mixture that results from the decomposition of COCl2
with an initial concentration of 0.3166 M.
−10
COCl (g) ⇌ CO(g) + Cl (g) Kc = 2.2 × 10 (13.E.57)
2 2
13.E.4.39: S13.4.18
(a)
[H2S] = 0.810 atm
[H2] = 0.014 atm
S2] = 0.0072 atm
(b) The 2x is dropped from the equilibrium calculation because 0.014 is negligible when subtracted from 0.824. The percent error
0.014
associated with ignoring 2x is × 100% = 1.7% , which is less than allowed by the “5% test.” The error is, indeed,
0.824
negligible.
13.E.4.40: Q13.4.19
What are all concentrations after a mixture that contains [H2O] = 1.00 M and [Cl2O] = 1.00 M comes to equilibrium at 25 °C?
H O(g) + Cl O(g) ⇌ 2 HOCl(g) Kc = 0.0900 (13.E.58)
2 2
13.E.4.41: Q13.4.20
What are the concentrations of PCl5, PCl3, and Cl2 in an equilibrium mixture produced by the decomposition of a sample of pure
PCl5 with [PCl5] = 2.00 M?
PCl (g) ⇌ PCl (g) + Cl (g) Kc = 0.0211 (13.E.59)
5 3 2
13.E.4.42: S13.4.20
[PCl3] = 1.80 M; [PC3] = 0.195 M; [PCl3] = 0.195 M.
13.E.4.43: Q13.4.21
Calculate the pressures of all species at equilibrium in a mixture of NOCl, NO, and Cl2 produced when a sample of NOCl with a
pressure of 10.0 atm comes to equilibrium according to this reaction:
−4
2 NOCl(g) ⇌ 2 NO(g) + Cl (g) KP = 4.0 × 10 (13.E.60)
2
13.E.4.44: Q13.4.22
Calculate the equilibrium concentrations of NO, O2, and NO2 in a mixture at 250 °C that results from the reaction of 0.20 M NO
and 0.10 M O2. (Hint: K is large; assume the reaction goes to completion then comes back to equilibrium.)
5
2 NO(g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 NO (g) Kc = 2.3 × 10 at 250 °C (13.E.61)
2 2
13.E.4.45: S13.4.22
[NO2] = 0.19 M
[NO] = 0.0070 M
[O2] = 0.0035 M
13.E.4.46: Q13.4.23
Calculate the equilibrium concentrations that result when 0.25 M O2 and 1.0 M HCl react and come to equilibrium.
13
4 HCl(g) + O (g) ⇌ 2 Cl (g) + 2 H O(g) Kc = 3.1 × 10 (13.E.62)
2 2 2
What is the pressure of O3 remaining after a mixture of O3 with a pressure of 1.2 × 10−8 atm and NO with a pressure of 1.2 × 10−8
atm comes to equilibrium? (Hint: KP is large; assume the reaction goes to completion then comes back to equilibrium.)
13.E.4.48: S13.4.24
−26
PO = 4.9 × 10 atm
3
13.E.4.49: Q13.4.24
Calculate the pressures of NO, Cl2, and NOCl in an equilibrium mixture produced by the reaction of a starting mixture with 4.0 atm
NO and 2.0 atm Cl2. (Hint: KP is small; assume the reverse reaction goes to completion then comes back to equilibrium.)
3
2 NO(g) + Cl (g) ⇌ 2 NOCl(g) KP = 2.5 × 10
2
13.E.4.50: Q13.4.25
Calculate the number of grams of HI that are at equilibrium with 1.25 mol of H2 and 63.5 g of iodine at 448 °C.
H +I ⇌ 2 HI Kc = 50.2 at 448 °C
2 2
13.E.4.51: S13.4.25
507 g
13.E.4.52: Q13.4.26
Butane exists as two isomers, n−butane and isobutane.
KP = 2.5 at 25 °C
What is the pressure of isobutane in a container of the two isomers at equilibrium with a total pressure of 1.22 atm?
13.E.4.53: Q13.4.27
What is the minimum mass of CaCO3 required to establish equilibrium at a certain temperature in a 6.50-L container if the
equilibrium constant (Kc) is 0.050 for the decomposition reaction of CaCO3 at that temperature?
CaCO (s) ⇌ CaO(s) + CO (g)
3 2
13.E.4.54: S13.4.27
330 g
13.E.4.55: Q13.4.28
The equilibrium constant (Kc) for this reaction is 1.60 at 990 °C:
H (g) + CO (g) ⇌ H O(g) + CO(g) (13.E.64)
2 2 2
Calculate the number of moles of each component in the final equilibrium mixture obtained from adding 1.00 mol of H2, 2.00 mol
of CO2, 0.750 mol of H2O, and 1.00 mol of CO to a 5.00-L container at 990 °C.
13.E.4.56: Q13.4.29
At 25 °C and at 1 atm, the partial pressures in an equilibrium mixture of N2O4 and NO2 are PN
2
O
4
= 0.70 atm and
PNO = 0.30 atm.
2
13.E.4.57: S13.4.29
(a) Both gases must increase in pressure.
(b) P N O
2 4
= 8.0 atm and PNO
2
= 1.0 atm
13.E.4.58: Q13.4.30
In a 3.0-L vessel, the following equilibrium partial pressures are measured: N2, 190 torr; H2, 317 torr; NH3, 1.00 × 103 torr.
N (g) + 3 H (g) ⇌ 2 NH (g) (13.E.65)
2 2 3
a. How will the partial pressures of H2, N2, and NH3 change if H2 is removed from the system? Will they increase, decrease, or
remain the same?
b. Hydrogen is removed from the vessel until the partial pressure of nitrogen, at equilibrium, is 250 torr. Calculate the partial
pressures of the other substances under the new conditions.
13.E.4.59: Q13.4.31
The equilibrium constant (Kc) for this reaction is 5.0 at a given temperature.
\[\ce{CO}(g)+\ce{H2O}(g) <=> \ce{CO2}(g)+\ce{H2}(g)\)]
a. On analysis, an equilibrium mixture of the substances present at the given temperature was found to contain 0.20 mol of CO,
0.30 mol of water vapor, and 0.90 mol of H2 in a liter. How many moles of CO2 were there in the equilibrium mixture?
b. Maintaining the same temperature, additional H2 was added to the system, and some water vapor was removed by drying. A
new equilibrium mixture was thereby established containing 0.40 mol of CO, 0.30 mol of water vapor, and 1.2 mol of H2 in a
liter. How many moles of CO2 were in the new equilibrium mixture? Compare this with the quantity in part (a), and discuss
whether the second value is reasonable. Explain how it is possible for the water vapor concentration to be the same in the two
equilibrium solutions even though some vapor was removed before the second equilibrium was established.
13.E.4.60: S13.4.31
(a) 0.33 mol.
(b) [CO]2 = 0.50 M Added H2 forms some water to compensate for the removal of water vapor and as a result of a shift to the left
after H2 is added.
13.E.4.61: Q13.4.32a
Antimony pentachloride decomposes according to this equation:
SbCl (g) ⇌ SbCl (g) + Cl (g)
5 3 2
An equilibrium mixture in a 5.00-L flask at 448 °C contains 3.85 g of SbCl5, 9.14 g of SbCl3, and 2.84 g of Cl2. How many grams
of each will be found if the mixture is transferred into a 2.00-L flask at the same temperature?
13.E.4.62: Q13.4.32b
Consider the reaction between H2 and O2 at 1000 K
\[\ce{2H2}(g)+\ce{O2}(g)⇌\ce{2H2O}(g) \hspace{20px} K_P=\dfrac{(P_{\ce{H2O}})^2}{(P_{\ce{O2}})
(P_{\ce{H2}})^3}=1.33×10^{20}\]
If 0.500 atm of H2 and 0.500 atm of O2 are allowed to come to equilibrium at this temperature, what are the partial pressures of the
components?
13.E.4.63: S13.4.32b
−11
PH = 8.64 × 10 atm
2
\(P_{\ce{O2}}=0.250\:\ce{atm}\)
13.E.4.64: Q13.4.33
An equilibrium is established according to the following equation
2+ + 2+
Hg (aq) + NO − (aq) + 3 H (aq) ⇌ 2 Hg (aq) + HNO (aq) + H O(l) Kc = 4.6 (13.E.66)
2 3 2 2
13.E.4.65: Q13.4.34
Consider the equilibrium
a. What is the expression for the equilibrium constant (Kc) of the reaction?
b. How must the concentration of NH3 change to reach equilibrium if the reaction quotient is less than the equilibrium constant?
c. If the reaction were at equilibrium, how would a decrease in pressure (from an increase in the volume of the reaction vessel)
affect the pressure of NO2?
d. If the change in the pressure of NO2 is 28 torr as a mixture of the four gases reaches equilibrium, how much will the pressure of
O2 change?
13.E.4.66: S13.4.34
4 7
[ NH ] [ O ]
3 2
(a) Kc =
4 6
. (b) [NH3] must increase for Qc to reach Kc. (c) That decrease in pressure would decrease [NO2]. (d)
[ NO ] [ H O]
2 2
PO = 49 torr
2
13.E.4.67: Q13.4.35
The binding of oxygen by hemoglobin (Hb), giving oxyhemoglobin (HbO2), is partially regulated by the concentration of H3O+
and dissolved CO2 in the blood. Although the equilibrium is complicated, it can be summarized as
+ +
HbO (aq) + H O (aq) + CO (g) ⇌ CO − Hb − H + O (g) + H O(l)
2 3 2 2 2 2
13.E.4.68: Q13.4.36
The hydrolysis of the sugar sucrose to the sugars glucose and fructose follows a first-order rate equation for the disappearance of
sucrose.
C H O (aq) + H O(l) ⟶ C H O (aq) + C H O (aq)
12 22 11 2 6 12 6 6 12 6
Rate = k[C12H22O11]
In neutral solution, k = 2.1 × 10−11/s at 27 °C. (As indicated by the rate constant, this is a very slow reaction. In the human body,
the rate of this reaction is sped up by a type of catalyst called an enzyme.) (Note: That is not a mistake in the equation—the
products of the reaction, glucose and fructose, have the same molecular formulas, C6H12O6, but differ in the arrangement of the
atoms in their molecules). The equilibrium constant for the reaction is 1.36 × 105 at 27 °C. What are the concentrations of glucose,
fructose, and sucrose after a 0.150 M aqueous solution of sucrose has reached equilibrium? Remember that the activity of a solvent
(the effective concentration) is 1.
13.E.4.70: Q13.4.37
The density of trifluoroacetic acid vapor was determined at 118.1 °C and 468.5 torr, and found to be 2.784 g/L. Calculate Kc for the
association of the acid.
Liquid N2O3 is dark blue at low temperatures, but the color fades and becomes greenish at higher temperatures as the compound
decomposes to NO and NO2. At 25 °C, a value of KP = 1.91 has been established for this decomposition. If 0.236 moles of N2O3
are placed in a 1.52-L vessel at 25 °C, calculate the equilibrium partial pressures of N2O3(g), NO2(g), and NO(g).
13.E.4.71: S13.4.37
PN O = 1.90 atm and PNO = PNO = 1.90 atm
2 3 2
13.E.4.72: Q13.4.38
A 1.00-L vessel at 400 °C contains the following equilibrium concentrations: N2, 1.00 M; H2, 0.50 M; and NH3, 0.25 M. How
many moles of hydrogen must be removed from the vessel to increase the concentration of nitrogen to 1.1 M?
13.E.4.73: Q13.4.39
A 0.010 M solution of the weak acid HA has an osmotic pressure (see chapter on solutions and colloids) of 0.293 atm at 25 °C. A
0.010 M solution of the weak acid HB has an osmotic pressure of 0.345 atm under the same conditions.
(a) Which acid has the larger equilibrium constant for ionization
HA [HA(aq) ⇌ A −
(aq) + H
+
(aq)] or HB [HB(aq) ⇌ H +
(aq) + B
−
(aq)] ?
(b) What are the equilibrium constants for the ionization of these acids?
(Hint: Remember that each solution contains three dissolved species: the weak acid (HA or HB), the conjugate base (A− or B−), and
the hydrogen ion (H+). Remember that osmotic pressure (like all colligative properties) is related to the total number of solute
particles. Specifically for osmotic pressure, those concentrations are described by molarities.)
13.E.4.74: S13.4.39
(a) HB ionizes to a greater degree and has the larger Kc.
(b) Kc(HA) = 5 × 10−4
Kc(HB) = 3 × 10−3
This page titled 13.E: Fundamental Equilibrium Concepts (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
This page titled 14: Acid-Base Equilibria is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
14.1: Brønsted-Lowry Acids and Bases
Learning Objectives
Identify acids, bases, and conjugate acid-base pairs according to the Brønsted-Lowry definition
Write equations for acid and base ionization reactions
Use the ion-product constant for water to calculate hydronium and hydroxide ion concentrations
Describe the acid-base behavior of amphiprotic substances
Acids and bases have been known for a long time. When Robert Boyle characterized them in 1680, he noted that acids dissolve
many substances, change the color of certain natural dyes (for example, they change litmus from blue to red), and lose these
characteristic properties after coming into contact with alkalis (bases). In the eighteenth century, it was recognized that acids have a
sour taste, react with limestone to liberate a gaseous substance (now known to be CO2), and interact with alkalis to form neutral
substances. In 1815, Humphry Davy contributed greatly to the development of the modern acid-base concept by demonstrating that
hydrogen is the essential constituent of acids. Around that same time, Joseph Louis Gay-Lussac concluded that acids are substances
that can neutralize bases and that these two classes of substances can be defined only in terms of each other. The significance of
hydrogen was reemphasized in 1884 when Svante Arrhenius defined an acid as a compound that dissolves in water to yield
hydrogen cations (now recognized to be hydronium ions) and a base as a compound that dissolves in water to yield hydroxide
anions.
In an earlier chapter on chemical reactions, we defined acids and bases as Arrhenius did: We identified an acid as a compound that
dissolves in water to yield hydronium ions (H3O+) and a base as a compound that dissolves in water to yield hydroxide ions (
OH ). This definition is not wrong; it is simply limited.
−
Later, we extended the definition of an acid or a base using the more general definition proposed in 1923 by the Danish chemist
Johannes Brønsted and the English chemist Thomas Lowry. Their definition centers on the proton, H . A proton is what remains +
when a normal hydrogen atom, H , loses an electron. A compound that donates a proton to another compound is called a Brønsted-
1
1
Lowry acid, and a compound that accepts a proton is called a Brønsted-Lowry base. An acid-base reaction is the transfer of a
proton from a proton donor (acid) to a proton acceptor (base). In a subsequent chapter of this text we will introduce the most
general model of acid-base behavior introduced by the American chemist G. N. Lewis.
Acids may be compounds such as HCl or H2SO4, organic acids like acetic acid (CH COOH ) or ascorbic acid (vitamin C), or H2O.
3
3 +
Anions (such as \(\ce{HSO_4^-}\), H PO , HS , and HCO ) and cations (such as H O , NH , and [Al(H O) ] ) may also
2
−
4
− −
3 3
+ +
4 2 6
act as acids. Bases fall into the same three categories. Bases may be neutral molecules (such as H O , NH , and CH NH ), anions2 3 3 2
(such as OH , HS , HCO , CO , F , and PO ), or cations (such as [Al(H O) OH] ). The most familiar bases are ionic
− − −
3
2 −
3
− 3 −
4 2 5
2 +
compounds such as NaOH and Ca(OH) , which contain the hydroxide ion, OH . The hydroxide ion in these compounds accepts
2
−
We call the product that remains after an acid donates a proton the conjugate base of the acid. This species is a base because it can
accept a proton (to re-form the acid):
acid ⇌ proton + conjugate base (14.1.2)
+ −
HF ⇌ H +F (14.1.3)
+ −
H SO ⇌ H + HSO (14.1.4)
2 4 4
+ −
H O⇌ H + OH (14.1.5)
2
− + 2 −
HSO 4 ⇌ H + SO 4 (14.1.6)
+ +
NH ⇌ H + NH (14.1.7)
4 3
We call the product that results when a base accepts a proton the base’s conjugate acid. This species is an acid because it can give
up a proton (and thus re-form the base):
base + proton ⇌ conjugate acid (14.1.8)
+ +
H O+H ⇌ H O (14.1.10)
2 3
+ +
NH +H ⇌ NH (14.1.11)
3 4
2 − + −
S +H ⇌ HS (14.1.12)
2 − + −
CO3 +H ⇌ HCO3 (14.1.13)
− +
F +H ⇌ HF (14.1.14)
In these two sets of equations, the behaviors of acids as proton donors and bases as proton acceptors are represented in isolation. In
reality, all acid-base reactions involve the transfer of protons between acids and bases. For example, consider the acid-base reaction
that takes place when ammonia is dissolved in water. A water molecule (functioning as an acid) transfers a proton to an ammonia
molecule (functioning as a base), yielding the conjugate base of water, OH , and the conjugate acid of ammonia, NH :
− +
This figure has three parts in two rows. In the first row, two diagrams of acid-base pairs are shown. On the left, a space filling
model of H subscript 2 O is shown with a red O atom at the center and two smaller white H atoms attached in a bent shape. Above
this model is the label “H subscript 2 O (acid)” in purple. An arrow points right, which is labeled “Remove H superscript plus.” To
the right is another space filling model with a single red O atom to which a single smaller white H atom is attached. The label in
purple above this model reads, “O H superscript negative (conjugate base).” Above both of these red and white models is an
upward pointing bracket that is labeled “Conjugate acid-base pair.” To the right is a space filling model with a central blue N atom
to which three smaller white H atoms are attached in a triangular pyramid arrangement. A label in green above reads “N H
subscript 3 (base).” An arrow labeled “Add H superscript plus” points right. To the right of the arrow is another space filling model
with a blue central N atom and four smaller white H atoms in a tetrahedral arrangement. The green label above reads “N H
subscript 3 superscript plus (conjugate acid).” Above both of these blue and white models is an upward pointing bracket that is
labeled “Conjugate acid-base pair.” The second row of the figure shows the chemical reaction, H subscript 2 O ( l ) is shown in
purple, and is labeled below in purple as “acid,” plus N H subscript 3 (a q) in green, labeled below in green as “base,” followed by
a double sided arrow arrow and O H superscript negative (a q) in purple, labeled in purple as “conjugate base,” plus N H subscript
4 superscript plus (a q)” in green, which is labeled in green as “conjugate acid.” The acid on the left side of the equation is
connected to the conjugate base on the right with a purple line. Similarly, the base on the left is connected to the conjugate acid on
the right side.
The reaction between a Brønsted-Lowry acid and water is called acid ionization. For example, when hydrogen fluoride dissolves in
water and ionizes, protons are transferred from hydrogen fluoride molecules to water molecules, yielding hydronium ions and
fluoride ions:
Notice that both these ionization reactions are represented as equilibrium processes. The relative extent to which these acid and
base ionization reactions proceed is an important topic treated in a later section of this chapter. In the preceding paragraphs we saw
that water can function as either an acid or a base, depending on the nature of the solute dissolved in it. In fact, in pure water or in
any aqueous solution, water acts both as an acid and a base. A very small fraction of water molecules donate protons to other water
molecules to form hydronium ions and hydroxide ions:
This figure has two rows. In both rows, a chemical reaction is shown. In the first, structural formulas are provided. In this model, in
purple, O atom which has H atoms singly bonded above and to the right. The O atom has pairs of electron dots on its left and lower
sides. This is followed by a plus sign, which is followed in green by an O atom which has H atoms singly bonded above and to the
right. The O atom has pairs of electron dots on its left and lower sides. A double arrow follows. To the right, in brackets is a
structure with a central O atom in green, with green H atoms singly bonded above and to the right. A pair of green electron dots is
on the lower side of the O atom. To the left of the green O atom, a purple H atom is singly bonded. Outside the brackets to the right
is a superscript plus. This is followed by a plus sign and an O atom in purple with pairs of electron dots above, left, and below. An
H atom is singly bonded to the right. This atom has a superscript negative sign. The reaction is written in symbolic form below. H
subscript 2 O is labeled in purple below as “Acid subscript 1.” This is followed by plus H subscript 2 O, which is labeled in green
below as “Base subscript 2.” A double sided arrow follows. To the right is H subscript 3 O superscript plus, which is labeled in
green as below in as “Acid subscript 2.” This is followed by plus and O with pairs of dots above, below, and to the left with a
singly bonded H on the right with a superscript negative. The label below in purple reads, “ Base subscript 1.”
This type of reaction, in which a substance ionizes when one molecule of the substance reacts with another molecule of the same
substance, is referred to as autoionization. Pure water undergoes autoionization to a very slight extent. Only about two out of
every 10 molecules in a sample of pure water are ionized at 25 °C. The equilibrium constant for the ionization of water is called
9
The slight ionization of pure water is reflected in the small value of the equilibrium constant; at 25 °C, Kw has a value of
1.0 × 10
−14
. The process is endothermic, and so the extent of ionization and the resulting concentrations of hydronium ion and
hydroxide ion increase with temperature. For example, at 100 °C, the value for K is approximately 5.1 × 10 , roughly 50-
w
−13
Solution
The autoionization of water yields the same number of hydronium and hydroxide ions. Therefore, in pure water,
[ H O ] = [ OH ] . At 25 °C:
+ −
3
+ − + 2 − 2 −14
Kw = [ H O ][ OH ] = [H O ] = [ OH ] = 1.0 × 10
3 3
So:
− −−−−−−− −
+ − −14 −7
[H O ] = [ OH ] = √ 1.0 × 10 = 1.0 × 10 M
3
The hydronium ion concentration and the hydroxide ion concentration are the same, and we find that both equal
M .
−7
1.0 × 10
Exercise 14.1.1
Answer
+ − −7
[H O ] = [ OH ] = 4.9 × 10 M
3
It is important to realize that the autoionization equilibrium for water is established in all aqueous solutions. Adding an acid or base
to water will not change the position of the equilibrium. Example 14.12 demonstrates the quantitative aspects of this relation
between hydronium and hydroxide ion concentrations.
The Inverse Proportionality of [H3O+] and [OH-] A solution of carbon dioxide in water has a hydronium ion concentration of
M . What is the concentration of hydroxide ion at 25 °C?
−6
2.0 × 10
Solution
We know the value of the ion-product constant for water at 25 °C:
+ −
2 H O(l) ⇌ H O + OH
2 3 (aq) (aq)
+ − −14
Kw = [ H O ][ OH ] = 1.0 × 10
3
The hydroxide ion concentration in water is reduced to 5.0 × 10 M as the hydrogen ion concentration increases to
−9
M . This is expected from Le Chatelier’s principle; the autoionization reaction shifts to the left to reduce the stress
−6
2.0 × 10
of the increased hydronium ion concentration and the [OH ] is reduced relative to that in pure water.
−
−6 −9
= (2.0 × 10 )(5.0 × 10 )
−14
= 1.0 × 10
Exercise 14.1.2
What is the hydronium ion concentration in an aqueous solution with a hydroxide ion concentration of 0.001 M at 25 °C?
Answer
+ −11
[H O ] = 1 × 10 M
3
− −
HCO + H O(l) ⇌ H CO3(aq) + OH (14.1.17)
3(aq) 2 2 (aq)
a. as an acid with OH −
b. as a base with HI
Solution
a. HSO −
3
(aq) + OH
−
(aq) ⇌ SO
2−
3
(aq) + H O(l)
2
b. HSO −
3
(aq) + HI(aq) ⇌ H SO (aq) + I
2 3
−
(aq)
Exercise 14.1.3
Answer a
− −
H PO (aq) + HBr(aq) ⇌ H PO (aq) + Br (aq)
2 4 3 4
Answer b
− − 2−
H PO4 (aq) + OH (aq) ⇌ HPO4 (aq) + H O(l)
2 2
Summary
A compound that can donate a proton (a hydrogen ion) to another compound is called a Brønsted-Lowry acid. The compound that
accepts the proton is called a Brønsted-Lowry base. The species remaining after a Brønsted-Lowry acid has lost a proton is the
conjugate base of the acid. The species formed when a Brønsted-Lowry base gains a proton is the conjugate acid of the base. Thus,
an acid-base reaction occurs when a proton is transferred from an acid to a base, with formation of the conjugate base of the
reactant acid and formation of the conjugate acid of the reactant base. Amphiprotic species can act as both proton donors and
+ −
2 H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + OH (aq)
2 3
The ion product of water, Kw is the equilibrium constant for the autoionization reaction:
+ − −14
Kw = [ H3 O ][OH ] = 1.0 × 10 at 25°C
Glossary
acid ionization
reaction involving the transfer of a proton from an acid to water, yielding hydronium ions and the conjugate base of the acid
amphiprotic
species that may either gain or lose a proton in a reaction
amphoteric
species that can act as either an acid or a base
autoionization
reaction between identical species yielding ionic products; for water, this reaction involves transfer of protons to yield
hydronium and hydroxide ions
base ionization
reaction involving the transfer of a proton from water to a base, yielding hydroxide ions and the conjugate acid of the base
Brønsted-Lowry acid
proton donor
Brønsted-Lowry base
proton acceptor
conjugate acid
substance formed when a base gains a proton
conjugate base
substance formed when an acid loses a proton
This page titled 14.1: Brønsted-Lowry Acids and Bases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As discussed earlier, hydronium and hydroxide ions are present both in pure water and in all aqueous solutions, and their
concentrations are inversely proportional as determined by the ion product of water (K ). The concentrations of these ions in a
w
solution are often critical determinants of the solution’s properties and the chemical behaviors of its other solutes, and specific
vocabulary has been developed to describe these concentrations in relative terms. A solution is neutral if it contains equal
concentrations of hydronium and hydroxide ions; acidic if it contains a greater concentration of hydronium ions than hydroxide
ions; and basic if it contains a lesser concentration of hydronium ions than hydroxide ions.
A common means of expressing quantities, the values of which may span many orders of magnitude, is to use a logarithmic scale.
One such scale that is very popular for chemical concentrations and equilibrium constants is based on the p-function, defined as
shown where “X” is the quantity of interest and “log” is the base-10 logarithm:
pX = − log X (14.2.1)
+
The pH of a solution is therefore defined as shown here, where [H3O ] is the molar concentration of hydronium ion in the solution:
+
pH = − log[ H3 O ] (14.2.2)
Rearranging this equation to isolate the hydronium ion molarity yields the equivalent expression:
+ −pH
[ H3 O ] = 10 (14.2.3)
or
− −pOH
[OH ] = 10 (14.2.5)
Finally, the relation between these two ion concentration expressed as p-functions is easily derived from the K expression: w
+ −
Kw = [ H O ][ OH ] (14.2.6)
3
+ − + −
− log Kw = − log([ H3 O ][OH ]) = − log[ H3 O ] + − log[OH ] (14.2.7)
The hydronium ion molarity in pure water (or any neutral solution) is 1.0 × 10
−7
M at 25 °C. The pH and pOH of a neutral
solution at this temperature are therefore:
+ −7
pH = − log[ H3 O ] = − log(1.0 × 10 ) = 7.00 (14.2.10)
− −7
pOH = − log[OH ] = − log(1.0 × 10 ) = 7.00 (14.2.11)
And so, at this temperature, acidic solutions are those with hydronium ion molarities greater than 1.0 × 10 M and hydroxide ion −7
molarities less than 1.0 × 10 M (corresponding to pH values less than 7.00 and pOH values greater than 7.00). Basic solutions
−7
are those with hydronium ion molarities less than 1.0 × 10 M and hydroxide ion molarities greater than 1.0 × 10 M
−7 −7
(corresponding to pH values greater than 7.00 and pOH values less than 7.00).
Since the autoionization constant K is temperature dependent, these correlations between pH values and the
w
acidic/neutral/basic adjectives will be different at temperatures other than 25 °C. For example, the hydronium molarity of pure
water at 80 °C is 4.9 × 10−7 M, which corresponds to pH and pOH values of:
+
pH = − log[ H O ]
3
−7
= − log(4.9 × 10 )
= 6.31
−
pOH = − log[ OH ]
−7
= − log(4.9 × 10 )
= 6.31
At this temperature, then, neutral solutions exhibit pH = pOH = 6.31, acidic solutions exhibit pH less than 6.31 and pOH
greater than 6.31, whereas basic solutions exhibit pH greater than 6.31 and pOH less than 6.31. This distinction can be
important when studying certain processes that occur at nonstandard temperatures, such as enzyme reactions in warm-blooded
organisms. Unless otherwise noted, references to pH values are presumed to be those at standard temperature (25 °C) (Table
14.2.1).
Table 14.2.1 : Summary of Relations for Acidic, Basic and Neutral Solutions
Classification Relative Ion Concentrations pH at 25 °C
Figure 14.2.1 shows the relationships between [H3O+], [OH−], pH, and pOH, and gives values for these properties at standard
temperatures for some common substances.
What is the pH of stomach acid, a solution of HCl with a hydronium ion concentration of 1.2 × 10 −3
M ?
Solution
+
pH = − log[ H3 O ]
−3
= − log(1.2 × 10 )
= −(−2.92)
= 2.92
Air-saturated water has a hydronium ion concentration caused by the dissolved CO of 2.0 × 10 2
−6
M , about 20-times larger
than that of pure water. Calculate the pH of the solution at 25 °C.
Answer
5.70
Solution
+
pH = − log[ H3 O ] = 7.3
+
log[ H3 O ] = −7.3
+ −7.3
[ H3 O ] = 10
or
+
[H O ] = antilog of − 7.3
3
+ −8
[H O ] = 5 × 10 M
3
(On a calculator take the antilog, or the “inverse” log, of −7.3, or calculate 10−7.3.)
Exercise 14.2.2
Answer
12 M
+ −
H CO (aq) ⇌ H (aq) + HCO (aq) (14.2.13)
2 3 3
Acid rain is rainwater that has a pH of less than 5, due to a variety of nonmetal oxides, including CO2, SO2, SO3, NO, and NO2
being dissolved in the water and reacting with it to form not only carbonic acid, but sulfuric acid and nitric acid. The formation and
subsequent ionization of sulfuric acid are shown here:
+ −
H SO (aq) ⟶ H (aq) + HSO (aq) (14.2.15)
2 4 4
Carbon dioxide is naturally present in the atmosphere because we and most other organisms produce it as a waste product of
metabolism. Carbon dioxide is also formed when fires release carbon stored in vegetation or when we burn wood or fossil fuels.
Sulfur trioxide in the atmosphere is naturally produced by volcanic activity, but it also stems from burning fossil fuels, which have
traces of sulfur, and from the process of “roasting” ores of metal sulfides in metal-refining processes. Oxides of nitrogen are
Figure 14.2.2 : (a) Acid rain makes trees more susceptible to drought and insect infestation, and depletes nutrients in the soil. (b) It
also is corrodes statues that are carved from marble or limestone. (credit a: modification of work by Chris M Morris; credit b:
modification of work by “Eden, Janine and Jim”/Flickr)
Two photos are shown. Photograph a on the left shows the upper portion of trees against a bright blue sky. The tops of several trees
at the center of the photograph have bare branches and appear to be dead. Image b shows a statue of a man that appears to from the
revolutionary war era in either marble or limestone.
What are the pOH and the pH of a 0.0125-M solution of potassium hydroxide, KOH?
Solution
Potassium hydroxide is a highly soluble ionic compound and completely dissociates when dissolved in dilute solution, yielding
[OH−] = 0.0125 M:
−
pOH = − log[OH ] = − log 0.0125
= −(−1.903) = 1.903
pH + pOH = 14.00
Exercise 14.2.3
Answer
pOH = 11.6,
pH = 14.00 - pOH = 2.4
The acidity of a solution is typically assessed experimentally by measurement of its pH. The pOH of a solution is not usually
measured, as it is easily calculated from an experimentally determined pH value. The pH of a solution can be directly measured
using a pH meter (Figure 14.2.3).
The pH of a solution may also be visually estimated using colored indicators (Figure 14.2.3).
Figure 14.2.4 : (a) A universal indicator assumes a different color in solutions of different pH values. Thus, it can be added to a
solution to determine the pH of the solution. The eight vials each contain a universal indicator and 0.1-M solutions of progressively
weaker acids: HCl (pH = l), CH3CO2H (pH = 3), and NH4Cl (pH = 5), deionized water, a neutral substance (pH = 7); and 0.1-M
solutions of the progressively stronger bases: KCl (pH = 7), aniline, C6H5NH2 (pH = 9), NH3 (pH = 11), and NaOH (pH = 13). (b)
pH paper contains a mixture of indicators that give different colors in solutions of differing pH values. (credit: modification of
work by Sahar Atwa).
This figure contains two images. The first shows a variety of colors of solutions in labeled beakers. A red solution in a beaker is
labeled “0.10 M H C l.” An orange solution is labeled “0.10 M C H subscript 3 C O O H.” A yellow-orange solution is labeled “0.1
M N H subscript 4 C l.” A yellow solution is labeled “deionized water.” A second solution beaker is labeled “0.10 M K C l.” A
green solution is labeled “0.10 M aniline.” A blue solution is labeled “0.10 M N H subscript 4 C l (a q).” A final beaker containing
a dark blue solution is labeled “0.10 M N a O H.” Image b shows pHydrion paper that is used for measuring pH in the range of p H
from 1 to 12. The color scale for identifying p H based on color is shown along with several of the test strips used to evaluate p H.
Summary
The concentration of hydronium ion in a solution of an acid in water is greater than 1.0 × 10 M at 25 °C. The concentration of
−7
hydroxide ion in a solution of a base in water is greater than 1.0 × 10 M at 25 °C. The concentration of H3O+ in a solution can
−7
be expressed as the pH of the solution; pH = − log H O . The concentration of OH− can be expressed as the pOH of the solution:
3
+
[H3O+] = 10−pH
[OH−] = 10−pOH
pH + pOH = pKw = 14.00 at 25 °C
Glossary
acidic
describes a solution in which [H3O+] > [OH−]
basic
neutral
describes a solution in which [H3O+] = [OH−]
pH
logarithmic measure of the concentration of hydronium ions in a solution
pOH
logarithmic measure of the concentration of hydroxide ions in a solution
This page titled 14.2: pH and pOH is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
We can rank the strengths of acids by the extent to which they ionize in aqueous solution. The reaction of an acid with water is
given by the general expression:
+ −
HA(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + A (aq)
2 3
Water is the base that reacts with the acid HA, A is the conjugate base of the acid HA, and the hydronium ion is the conjugate
−
acid of water. A strong acid yields 100% (or very nearly so) of H O and A when the acid ionizes in water; Figure 14.3.1 lists
3
+ −
Figure 14.3.1 : Some of the common strong acids and bases are listed here.
Six Strong Acids Six Strong Bases
HClO
4
perchloric acid LiOH lithium hydroxide
HNO
3
nitric acid Sr(OH)
2
strontium hydroxide
H SO
2 4
sulfuric acid Ba(OH)
2
barium hydroxide
The relative strengths of acids may be determined by measuring their equilibrium constants in aqueous solutions. In solutions of the
same concentration, stronger acids ionize to a greater extent, and so yield higher concentrations of hydronium ions than do weaker
acids. The equilibrium constant for an acid is called the acid-ionization constant, Ka. For the reaction of an acid HA:
+ −
HA(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + A (aq)
2 3
where the concentrations are those at equilibrium. As noted in the section on equilibrium constants, although water is a reactant in
the reaction, it is the solvent as well, so its activity has a value of 1, which does not change the value of K . a
Note
It is a common error to claim that the molar concentration of the solvent is in some way involved in the equilibrium law. This
error is a result of a misunderstanding of solution thermodynamics. For example, it is often claimed that Ka = Keq[H2O] for
aqueous solutions. This equation is incorrect because it is an erroneous interpretation of the correct equation Ka = Keq(a ). H2 O
The larger the K of an acid, the larger the concentration of H O and A relative to the concentration of the
a 3
+ −
nonionized acid, HA. Thus a stronger acid has a larger ionization constant than does a weaker acid. The ionization
constants increase as the strengths of the acids increase.
The following data on acid-ionization constants indicate the order of acid strength: CH 3
CO H < HNO
2 2
< HSO
−
+ − −4
HNO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + NO (aq) Ka = 4.6 × 10
2 2 3 2
− + 2− −2
HSO 4 (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + SO 4 (aq) Ka = 1.2 × 10
2 3
Another measure of the strength of an acid is its percent ionization. The percent ionization of a weak acid is the ratio of the
concentration of the ionized acid to the initial acid concentration, times 100:
+
[H O ]
3 eq
% ionization = × 100% (14.3.1)
[HA]
0
Because the ratio includes the initial concentration, the percent ionization for a solution of a given weak acid varies depending on
the original concentration of the acid, and actually decreases with increasing acid concentration.
Calculate the percent ionization of a 0.125-M solution of nitrous acid (a weak acid), with a pH of 2.09.
Solution
The percent ionization for an acid is:
+
[H O ]
3 eq
× 100
[ HNO ]
2 0
The chemical equation for the dissociation of the nitrous acid is:
− +
HNO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ NO (aq) + H O (aq).
2 2 2 3
Since 10 −pH
= [H O
3
+
] , we find that 10 −2.09
= 8.1 × 10
−3
M , so that percent ionization (Equation 14.3.1) is:
−3
8.1 × 10
× 100 = 6.5%
0.125
Remember, the logarithm 2.09 indicates a hydronium ion concentration with only two significant figures.
Exercise 14.3.1
Calculate the percent ionization of a 0.10 M solution of acetic acid with a pH of 2.89.
Answer
1.3% ionized
We can rank the strengths of bases by their tendency to form hydroxide ions in aqueous solution. The reaction of a Brønsted-Lowry
base with water is given by:
+ −
B(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ HB (aq) + OH (aq)
2
Water is the acid that reacts with the base, HB is the conjugate acid of the base B , and the hydroxide ion is the conjugate base of
+
water. A strong base yields 100% (or very nearly so) of OH− and HB+ when it reacts with water; Figure 14.3.1 lists several strong
bases. A weak base yields a small proportion of hydroxide ions. Soluble ionic hydroxides such as NaOH are considered strong
bases because they dissociate completely when dissolved in water.
As we did with acids, we can measure the relative strengths of bases by measuring their base-ionization constant (Kb) in aqueous
solutions. In solutions of the same concentration, stronger bases ionize to a greater extent, and so yield higher hydroxide ion
concentrations than do weaker bases. A stronger base has a larger ionization constant than does a weaker base. For the reaction of a
base, B :
where the concentrations are those at equilibrium. Again, we do not see water in the equation because water is the solvent and has
an activity of 1. The chemical reactions and ionization constants of the three bases shown are:
− − −11
NO2 (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ HNO (aq) + OH (aq) Kb = 2.17 × 10
2 2
− − −10
CH CO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ CH CO H(aq) + OH (aq) Kb = 5.6 × 10
3 2 2 3 2
+ − −5
NH (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ NH (aq) + OH (aq) Kb = 1.8 × 10
3 2 4
A table of ionization constants of weak bases appears in Table E2. As with acids, percent ionization can be measured for basic
solutions, but will vary depending on the base ionization constant and the initial concentration of the solution.
Consider the ionization reactions for a conjugate acid-base pair, HA − A : −
+ −
HA(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + A (aq)
2 3
+ −
[H O ][ A ]
with K a =
3
.
[HA]
− −
A (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ OH (aq) + HA(aq)
2
[HA][OH]
with K b =
−
.
[A ]
Adding these two chemical equations yields the equation for the autoionization for water:
− + − −
HA(aq) + H O(l) + A (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + A (aq) + OH (aq) + HA(aq)
2 2 3
+ −
2 H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + OH (aq)
2 3
As shown in the previous chapter on equilibrium, the K expression for a chemical equation derived from adding two or more other
equations is the mathematical product of the other equations’ K expressions. Multiplying the mass-action expressions together and
cancelling common terms, we see that:
+ − −
[H O ][ A ] [HA][ OH ]
3 + −
Ka × Kb = × = [H O ][ OH ] = Kw
− 3
[HA] [A ]
For example, the acid ionization constant of acetic acid (CH3COOH) is 1.8 × 10−5, and the base ionization constant of its conjugate
base, acetate ion (CH COO ), is 5.6 × 10−10. The product of these two constants is indeed equal to K :
3
−
w
−5 −10 −14
Ka × Kb = (1.8 × 10 ) × (5.6 × 10 ) = 1.0 × 10 = Kw
The extent to which an acid, HA, donates protons to water molecules depends on the strength of the conjugate base, A , of the −
acid. If A is a strong base, any protons that are donated to water molecules are recaptured by A . Thus there is relatively little
− −
A
−
and H O in solution, and the acid, HA, is weak. If A is a weak base, water binds the protons more strongly, and the
3
+ −
solution contains primarily A and H O —the acid is strong. Strong acids form very weak conjugate bases, and weak acids form
−
3
+
Use the K for the nitrite ion, NO , to calculate the K for its conjugate acid.
b
−
2 a
Solution
Kb for NO is given in this section as 2.17 × 10−11. The conjugate acid of
−
2
NO
−
2
is HNO2; Ka for HNO2 can be calculated
using the relationship:
−14
Ka × Kb = 1.0 × 10 = Kw
−14
1.0 × 10
=
−11
2.17 × 10
−4
= 4.6 × 10
Exercise 14.3.2
We can determine the relative acid strengths of NH and HCN by comparing their ionization constants. The ionization
+
constant of HCN is given in Table E1 as 4.9 × 10−10. The ionization constant of NH is not listed, but the ionization constant
+
of its conjugate base, NH , is listed as 1.8 × 10−5. Determine the ionization constant of NH , and decide which is the stronger
3
+
acid, HCN or NH . +
Answer
NH
+
4
is the slightly stronger acid (Ka for NH = 5.6 × 10−10).
+
4
giving an equilibrium mixture with most of the acid present in the nonionized (molecular) form. This equilibrium, like other
equilibria, is dynamic; acetic acid molecules donate hydrogen ions to water molecules and form hydronium ions and acetate ions at
the same rate that hydronium ions donate hydrogen ions to acetate ions to reform acetic acid molecules and water molecules. We
can tell by measuring the pH of an aqueous solution of known concentration that only a fraction of the weak acid is ionized at any
moment (Figure 14.3.4). The remaining weak acid is present in the nonionized form.
For acetic acid, at equilibrium:
+ −
[H O ][ CH CO2 ]
3 3 −5
Ka = = 1.8 × 10
[ CH CO H]
3 2
Figure 14.3.4 : pH paper indicates that a 0.l-M solution of HCl (beaker on left) has a pH of 1. The acid is fully ionized and [H O ] 3
+
= 0.1 M. A 0.1-M solution of CH3CO2H (beaker on right) has a pH of 3 ( [H O ] = 0.001 M) because the weak acid CH3CO2H is
3
+
only partially ionized. In this solution, [H O ] < [CH CO H] . (credit: modification of work by Sahar Atwa)
3
+
3 2
This image shows two bottles containing clear colorless solutions. Each bottle contains a single p H indicator strip. The strip in the
bottle on the left is red, and a similar red strip is placed on a filter paper circle in front of the bottle on surface on which the bottles
are resting. Similarly, the second bottle on the right contains and orange strip and an orange strip is placed in front of it on a filter
paper circle. Between the two bottles is a pack of p Hydrion papers with a p H color scale on its cover.
Table 14.3.1 : Ionization Constants of Some Weak Acids
Ionization Reaction Ka at 25 °C
HSO
−
4
+H O ⇌ H O
2 3
+
+ SO
2−
4
1.2 × 10−2
HF + H O ⇌ H O
2 3
+
+F
−
3.5 × 10−4
HNO
2
+H O ⇌ H O
2 3
+
+ NO
−
2
4.6 × 10−4
HNCO + H O ⇌ H O
2 3
+
+ NCO
−
2 × 10−4
HCO H + H O ⇌ H O
2 2 3
+
+ HCO
−
2
1.8 × 10−4
CH CO H + H O ⇌ H O
3 2 2 3
+
+ CH CO
3
−
2
1.8 × 10−5
HCIO + H O ⇌ H O
2 3
+
+ CIO
−
2.9 × 10−8
HBrO + H O ⇌ H O
2 3
+
+ BrO
−
2.8 × 10−9
HCN + H O ⇌ H O
2 3
+
+ CN
−
4.9 × 10−10
Table 14.3.1 gives the ionization constants for several weak acids; additional ionization constants can be found in Table E1.
At equilibrium, a solution of a weak base in water is a mixture of the nonionized base, the conjugate acid of the weak base, and
hydroxide ion with the nonionized base present in the greatest concentration. Thus, a weak base increases the hydroxide ion
concentration in an aqueous solution (but not as much as the same amount of a strong base).
This gives an equilibrium mixture with most of the base present as the nonionized amine. This equilibrium is analogous to that
described for weak acids.
We can confirm by measuring the pH of an aqueous solution of a weak base of known concentration that only a fraction of the base
reacts with water (Figure 14.4.5). The remaining weak base is present as the unreacted form. The equilibrium constant for the
ionization of a weak base, K , is called the ionization constant of the weak base, and is equal to the reaction quotient when the
b
Figure 14.3.5 : pH paper indicates that a 0.1-M solution of NH3 (left) is weakly basic. The solution has a pOH of 3 ([OH−] = 0.001
M) because the weak base NH3 only partially reacts with water. A 0.1-M solution of NaOH (right) has a pOH of 1 because NaOH
is a strong base (credit: modification of work by Sahar Atwa).
The ionization constants of several weak bases are given in Table 14.3.2 and Table E2.
Table 14.3.2 : Ionization Constants of Some Weak Bases
Ionization Reaction Kb at 25 °C
(CH ) NH + H O ⇌ (CH ) NH
3 2 2 3 2
+
2
+ OH
−
5.9 × 10−4
CH NH
3 2
+ H O ⇌ CH NH
2 3
+
3
+ OH
−
4.4 × 10−4
(CH ) N + H O ⇌ (CH ) NH
3 3 2 3 3
+
+ OH
−
6.3 × 10−5
NH
3
+ H O ⇌ NH
2
+
4
+ OH
−
1.8 × 10−5
C H NH
6 5 2
+ H O ⇌ C N NH
2 6 5
+
3
+ OH
−
4.3 × 10−10
Vinegar is a solution of acetic acid, a weak acid. (credit: modification of work by “HomeSpot HQ”/Flickr)
+ −
[H O ][ CH CO ]
3 3 2
Ka =
[ CH CO H]
3 2
(0.00118)(0.00118)
=
0.0787
−5
= 1.77 × 10
Exercise 14.3.3
What is the equilibrium constant for the ionization of the HSO ion, the weak acid used in some household cleansers:
−
− + 2−
HSO 4 (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + SO 4 (aq)
2 3
Answer
Ka for HSO −
4
= 1.2 × ×10
−2
Solution
At equilibrium, the value of the equilibrium constant is equal to the reaction quotient for the reaction:
+ −
C H N O (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ C H N O H (aq) + OH (aq)
8 10 4 2 2 8 10 4 2
so
+ − −3 −3
[C H N O H ][ OH ] (5.0 × 10 )(2.5 × 10 )
8 10 4 2 −4
Kb = = = 2.5 × 10
[C H N O ] 0.050
8 10 4 2
Exercise 14.3.4
4
ion, a weak base:
2− − −
HPO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H PO (aq) + OH (aq)
4 2 2 4
[ H PO
2
−
4
]=0 ⋅ 042 M and
M.
2 −
[ HPO ]=0 ⋅ 341
4
Answer
Kb for HPO 2−
4
= 1.6 × 10
−7
+ −
HNO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + NO (aq)
2 2 3 2
Solution
We determine an equilibrium constant starting with the initial concentrations of HNO2, H O , and NO as well as one of the
3
+ −
2
final concentrations, the concentration of hydronium ion at equilibrium. (Remember that pH is simply another way to express
the concentration of hydronium ion.)
We can solve this problem with the following steps in which x is a change in concentration of a species in the reaction:
We can summarize the various concentrations and changes as shown here. Because water is the solvent, it has a fixed activity
equal to 1. Any small amount of water produced or used up during the reaction will not change water's role as the solvent, so
the value of its activity remains equal to 1 throughout the reaction.
To get the various values in the ICE (Initial, Change, Equilibrium) table, we first calculate [H O
3
+
, the equilibrium
]
+ −2.34
[H O ] = 10 = 0.0046 M
3
determined from the pH, and the initial concentration, [H O ] . The initial concentration of H O is its concentration in pure
3
+
i 3
+
water, which is so much less than the final concentration that we approximate it as zero (~0).
The change in concentration of NO is equal to the change in concentration of [H O ]. For each 1 mol of H O that forms,
−
2 3
+
3
+
1 mol of NO forms. The equilibrium concentration of HNO2 is equal to its initial concentration plus the change in its
−
concentration.
Now we can fill in the ICE table with the concentrations at equilibrium, as shown here:
Exercise 14.3.5
The pH of a solution of household ammonia, a 0.950-M solution of NH3, is 11.612. What is Kb for NH3.
Answer
−5
Kb = 1.8 × 10
Formic acid, HCO2H, is the irritant that causes the body’s reaction to ant stings.
The pain of an ant’s sting is caused by formic acid. (credit: John Tann)
What is the concentration of hydronium ion and the pH in a 0.534-M solution of formic acid?
+ − −4
HCO H(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + HCO (aq) Ka = 1.8 × 10
2 2 3 2
Solution
1. Determine x and equilibrium concentrations. The equilibrium expression is:
+ −
HCO H(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + HCO (aq)
2 2 3 2
Because water is the solvent, it has a fixed activity equal to 1. Any small amount of water produced or used up during the
reaction will not change water's role as the solvent, so the value of its activity remains equal to 1 throughout the reaction so we
do not need to consider it when setting up the ICE table.
The table shows initial concentrations (concentrations before the acid ionizes), changes in concentration, and equilibrium
concentrations follows (the data given in the problem appear in color):
(x)(x)
−4
= = 1.8 × 10
0.534 − x
Now solve for x. Because the initial concentration of acid is reasonably large and K is very small, we assume that a
x << 0.534, which permits us to simplify the denominator term as (0.534 − x) = 0.534. This gives:
2
x
−4
Ka = 1.8 × 10 =
0.534
−5
= 9.6 × 10
−−−−−−− −
−5
x = √ 9.6 × 10
−3
= 9.8 × 10
−2
= 1.8 × 10 (1.8% of 0.534)
−3
= 9.8 × 10 M
The pH of the solution can be found by taking the negative log of the [H 3
O
+
], so:
−3
pH = − log(9.8 × 10 ) = 2.01
Only a small fraction of a weak acid ionizes in aqueous solution. What is the percent ionization of acetic acid in a 0.100-M
solution of acetic acid, CH3CO2H?
+ − −5
CH CO H(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + CH CO (aq) Ka = 1.8 × 10
3 2 2 3 3 2
Hint
Determine [CH 3
−
CO
2
] at equilibrium.) Recall that the percent ionization is the fraction of acetic acid that is ionized × 100,
−
[ CH CO2 ]
3
or × 100 .
[ CH CO H]
3 2 initial
The following example shows that the concentration of products produced by the ionization of a weak base can be determined by
the same series of steps used with a weak acid.
Find the concentration of hydroxide ion in a 0.25-M solution of trimethylamine, a weak base:
+ − −5
(CH ) N(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ (CH ) NH (aq) + OH (aq) Kb = 6.3 × 10
3 3 2 3 3
Solution This problem requires that we calculate an equilibrium concentration by determining concentration changes as the
ionization of a base goes to equilibrium. The solution is approached in the same way as that for the ionization of formic acid in
Example 14.3.6. The reactants and products will be different and the numbers will be different, but the logic will be the same:
1. Determine x and equilibrium concentrations. The table shows the changes and concentrations:
If we assume that x is small relative to 0.25, then we can replace (0.25 − x) in the preceding equation with 0.25. Solving the
simplified equation gives:
−3
x = 4.0 × 10
This change is less than 5% of the initial concentration (0.25), so the assumption is justified.
Recall that, for this computation, x is equal to the equilibrium concentration of hydroxide ion in the solution (see earlier
tabulation):
− −3
([ OH ] = 0 + x = x = 4.0 × 10 M
−3
= 4.0 × 10 M
Exercise 14.3.7
a. Show that the calculation in Step 2 of this example gives an x of 4.3 × 10−3 and the calculation in Step 3 shows Kb = 6.3 ×
10−5.
b. Find the concentration of hydroxide ion in a 0.0325-M solution of ammonia, a weak base with a Kb of 1.76 × 10−5.
+
[ NH ]
4
Calculate the percent ionization of ammonia, the fraction ionized × 100, or × 100%
[ NH ]
3
Answer a
7.56 × 10
−4
M , 2.33%
Answer b
2.33%
Some weak acids and weak bases ionize to such an extent that the simplifying assumption that x is small relative to the initial
concentration of the acid or base is inappropriate. As we solve for the equilibrium concentrations in such cases, we will see that we
cannot neglect the change in the initial concentration of the acid or base, and we must solve the equilibrium equations by using the
quadratic equation.
Sodium bisulfate, NaHSO4, is used in some household cleansers because it contains the −
HSO 4 ion, a weak acid. What is the
pH of a 0.50-M solution of HSO ? −
4
− + 2− −2
HSO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + SO (aq) Ka = 1.2 × 10
4 2 3 4
Solution
We need to determine the equilibrium concentration of the hydronium ion that results from the ionization of HSO so that we −
4
can use [H O ] to determine the pH. As in the previous examples, we can approach the solution by the following steps:
3
+
1. Determine x and equilibrium concentrations. This table shows the changes and concentrations:
≤ 0.05
−
[HSO ]i
4
The value of x is not less than 5% of 0.50, so the assumption is not valid. We need the quadratic formula to find x.
The equation:
(x)(x)
−2
Ka = 1.2 × 10 =
0.50 − x
gives
−3 −2 2+
6.0 × 10 − 1.2 × 10 x =x
or
2+ −2 −3
x + 1.2 × 10 x − 6.0 × 10 =0
This equation can be solved using the quadratic formula. For an equation of the form
2+
ax + bx + c = 0,
−2
= 7.2 × 10 M
Exercise 14.3.8
a. Show that the quadratic formula gives x = 7.2 × 10 . −2
Hint
Answer
pH 11.16
− −
NH (aq) + H O(l) ⟶ NH (aq) + OH (aq)
2 2 3
Thus, O2− and NH appear to have the same base strength in water; they both give a 100% yield of hydroxide ion.
−
In the absence of any leveling effect, the acid strength of binary compounds of hydrogen with nonmetals (A) increases as the H-A
bond strength decreases down a group in the periodic table. For group 17, the order of increasing acidity is
HF < HCl < HBr < HI . Likewise, for group 16, the order of increasing acid strength is H2O < H2S < H2Se < H2Te. Across a
row in the periodic table, the acid strength of binary hydrogen compounds increases with increasing electronegativity of the
nonmetal atom because the polarity of the H-A bond increases. Thus, the order of increasing acidity (for removal of one proton)
across the second row is CH < NH < H O < HF ; across the third row, it is SiH < PH < H S < HCl (see Figure 14.3.6).
4 3 2 4 3 2
O ClOH, aluminum hydroxide, Al(OH) , calcium hydroxide, Ca(OH) , and potassium hydroxide, KOH :
3 3 2
A diagram is shown that includes a central atom designated with the letter E. Single bonds extend above, below, left, and right of
the E. An O atom is bonded to the right of the E, and an arrow points to the bond labeling it, “Bond a.” An H atom is single bonded
to the right of the O atom. An arrow pointing to this bond connects it to the label, “Bond b.”
If the central atom, E, has a low electronegativity, its attraction for electrons is low. Little tendency exists for the central atom to
form a strong covalent bond with the oxygen atom, and bond a between the element and oxygen is more readily broken than bond b
between oxygen and hydrogen. Hence bond a is ionic, hydroxide ions are released to the solution, and the material behaves as a
base—this is the case with Ca(OH)2 and KOH. Lower electronegativity is characteristic of the more metallic elements; hence, the
metallic elements form ionic hydroxides that are by definition basic compounds.
If, on the other hand, the atom E has a relatively high electronegativity, it strongly attracts the electrons it shares with the oxygen
atom, making bond a relatively strongly covalent. The oxygen-hydrogen bond, bond b, is thereby weakened because electrons are
displaced toward E. Bond b is polar and readily releases hydrogen ions to the solution, so the material behaves as an acid. High
electronegativities are characteristic of the more nonmetallic elements. Thus, nonmetallic elements form covalent compounds
containing acidic −OH groups that are called oxyacids.
Figure 14.3.7 : As the oxidation number of the central atom E increases, the acidity also increases.
A diagram is shown that includes four structural formulas for acids. A red, right pointing arrow is placed beneath the structures
which is labeled “Increasing acid strength.” At the top left, the structure of Nitrous acid is provided. It includes an H atom to which
an O atom with two unshared electron pairs is connected with a single bond to the right. A single bond extends to the right and
slightly below to a N atom with one unshared electron pair. A double bond extends up and to the right from this N atom to an O
atom which has two unshared electron pairs. To the upper right is a structure for Nitric acid. This structure differs from the previous
structure in that the N atom is directly to the right of the first O atom and a second O atom with three unshared electron pairs is
connected with a single bond below and to the right of the N atom which has no unshared electron pairs. At the lower left, an O
atom with two unshared electron pairs is double bonded to its right to an S atom with a single unshared electron pair. An O atom
with two unshared electron pairs is bonded above and an H atom is single bonded to this O atom. To the right of the S atom is a
single bond to another O atom with two unshared electron pairs to which an H atom is single bonded. This structure is labeled
“Sulfurous acid.” A similar structure which is labeled “Sulfuric acid” is placed in the lower right region of the figure. This structure
differs in that an H atom is single bonded to the left of the first O atom, leaving it with two unshared electron pairs and a fourth O
atom with two unshared electron pairs is double bonded beneath the S atom, leaving it with no unshared electron pairs.
Hydroxy compounds of elements with intermediate electronegativities and relatively high oxidation numbers (for example,
elements near the diagonal line separating the metals from the nonmetals in the periodic table) are usually amphoteric. This means
that the hydroxy compounds act as acids when they react with strong bases and as bases when they react with strong acids. The
amphoterism of aluminum hydroxide, which commonly exists as the hydrate Al(H O) (OH) , is reflected in its solubility in both
2 3 3
strong acids and strong bases. In strong bases, the relatively insoluble hydrated aluminum hydroxide, Al(H O) (OH) , is 2 3 3
−
converted into the soluble ion, [Al(H O) (OH) ] , by reaction with hydroxide ion:
2 2 4
− −
[Al (H O) (OH) ](aq) + OH (aq) ⇌ H O(l) + [Al (H O) (OH) ] (aq)
2 3 3 2 2 2 4
In this reaction, a proton is transferred from one of the aluminum-bound H2O molecules to a hydroxide ion in solution. The
Al(H O) (OH)
2 3
compound thus acts as an acid under these conditions. On the other hand, when dissolved in strong acids, it is
3
+ 3+
3H O (aq) + Al (H O) (OH) (aq) ⇌ Al (H O) (aq) + 3 H O(l)
3 2 3 3 2 6 2
In this case, protons are transferred from hydronium ions in solution to Al(H 2
O) (OH)
3 3
, and the compound functions as a base.
Summary
The strengths of Brønsted-Lowry acids and bases in aqueous solutions can be determined by their acid or base ionization constants.
Stronger acids form weaker conjugate bases, and weaker acids form stronger conjugate bases. Thus strong acids are completely
ionized in aqueous solution because their conjugate bases are weaker bases than water. Weak acids are only partially ionized
because their conjugate bases are strong enough to compete successfully with water for possession of protons. Strong bases react
with water to quantitatively form hydroxide ions. Weak bases give only small amounts of hydroxide ion. The strengths of the
binary acids increase from left to right across a period of the periodic table (CH4 < NH3 < H2O < HF), and they increase down a
group (HF < HCl < HBr < HI). The strengths of oxyacids that contain the same central element increase as the oxidation number of
Glossary
acid ionization constant (Ka)
equilibrium constant for the ionization of a weak acid
3
+
acts as a base to make all strong acids appear equally strong, and it acts as an acid to make all strong bases appear equally
strong
oxyacid
compound containing a nonmetal and one or more hydroxyl groups
percent ionization
ratio of the concentration of the ionized acid to the initial acid concentration, times 100
This page titled 14.3: Relative Strengths of Acids and Bases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As we have seen in the section on chemical reactions, when an acid and base are mixed, they undergo a neutralization reaction. The
word “neutralization” seems to imply that a stoichiometrically equivalent solution of an acid and a base would be neutral. This is
sometimes true, but the salts that are formed in these reactions may have acidic or basic properties of their own, as we shall now
see.
2. A strong acid and a weak base yield a weakly acidic solution, not because of the strong acid involved, but because of the
conjugate acid of the weak base.
3. A weak acid and a strong base yield a weakly basic solution. A solution of a weak acid reacts with a solution of a strong base to
form the conjugate base of the weak acid and the conjugate acid of the strong base. The conjugate acid of the strong base is a
weaker acid than water and has no effect on the acidity of the resulting solution. However, the conjugate base of the weak acid
is a weak base and ionizes slightly in water. This increases the amount of hydroxide ion in the solution produced in the reaction
and renders it slightly basic.
4. A weak acid plus a weak base can yield either an acidic, basic, or neutral solution. This is the most complex of the four types of
reactions. When the conjugate acid and the conjugate base are of unequal strengths, the solution can be either acidic or basic,
depending on the relative strengths of the two conjugates. Occasionally the weak acid and the weak base will have the same
strength, so their respective conjugate base and acid will have the same strength, and the solution will be neutral. To predict
whether a particular combination will be acidic, basic or neutral, tabulated K values of the conjugates must be compared.
not only neutralizes stomach acid, it also produces CO2(g), which may result in a satisfying belch.
Milk of Magnesia is a suspension of the sparingly soluble base magnesium hydroxide, Mg(OH)2. It works according to the
reaction:
2+ −
M g(OH )2 (s) ⇌ M g (aq) + 2OH (aq)
This reaction does not produce carbon dioxide, but magnesium-containing antacids can have a laxative effect. Several antacids
have aluminum hydroxide, Al(OH)3, as an active ingredient. The aluminum hydroxide tends to cause constipation, and some
antacids use aluminum hydroxide in concert with magnesium hydroxide to balance the side effects of the two substances.
Figure 14.4.1 : A neutralization reaction takes place between citric acid in lemons or acetic acid in vinegar, and the bases in the
flesh of fish.
Pickling is a method used to preserve vegetables using a naturally produced acidic environment. The vegetable, such as a
cucumber, is placed in a sealed jar submerged in a brine solution. The brine solution favors the growth of beneficial bacteria and
suppresses the growth of harmful bacteria. The beneficial bacteria feed on starches in the cucumber and produce lactic acid as a
waste product in a process called fermentation. The lactic acid eventually increases the acidity of the brine to a level that kills any
harmful bacteria, which require a basic environment. Without the harmful bacteria consuming the cucumbers they are able to last
much longer than if they were unprotected. A byproduct of the pickling process changes the flavor of the vegetables with the acid
making them taste sour.
A solution of this salt contains ammonium ions and chloride ions. The chloride ion has no effect on the acidity of the solution since
HCl is a strong acid. Chloride is a very weak base and will not accept a proton to a measurable extent. However, the ammonium
ion, the conjugate acid of ammonia, reacts with water and increases the hydronium ion concentration:
+ +
NH (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + NH (aq)
4 2 3 3
The equilibrium equation for this reaction is simply the ionization constant. Ka, for the acid NH : +
4
+
[H O ][ NH ]
3 3
= Ka
+
[ NH ]
4
We will not find a value of Ka for the ammonium ion in Table E1. However, it is not difficult to determine Ka for NH from the +
4
value of the ionization constant of water, Kw, and Kb, the ionization constant of its conjugate base, NH3, using the following
relationship:
Kw = Ka × Kb
This relation holds for any base and its conjugate acid or for any acid and its conjugate base.
Aniline is an amine that is used to manufacture dyes. It is isolated as aniline hydrochloride, [C H NH ]Cl, a salt prepared by 6 5
+
3
the reaction of the weak base aniline and hydrochloric acid. What is the pH of a 0.233 M solution of aniline hydrochloride?
+ +
C H NH (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + C H NH (aq)
6 5 3 2 3 6 5 2
Solution
The new step in this example is to determine Ka for the C H NH ion. The C H NH ion is the conjugate acid of a weak
6 5
+
3 6 5
+
3
base. The value of Ka for this acid is not listed in Table E1, but we can determine it from the value of Kb for aniline, C6H5NH2,
which is given as 4.6 × 10−10 :
+ −14
Ka (f or C6 H5 NH ) × Kb (f or C6 H5 NH2 ) = Kw = 1.0 × 10
3
−14
Kw 1.0 × 10
+ −5
Ka (f or C6 H5 NH ) = = = 2.3 × 10
3 −10
Kb (f or C6 H5 NH2 ) 4.6 × 10
Now we have the ionization constant and the initial concentration of the weak acid, the information necessary to determine the
equilibrium concentration of H3O+, and the pH:
Four tan rectangles are shown that are connected with right pointing arrows. The first is labeled “Determine the direction of
change.” The second is labeled “Determine x and the equilibrium concentrations.” The third is labeled “Solve for x and the
equilibrium concentrations.” The fourth is labeled “Check the math.”
With these steps we find [H3O+] = 2.3 × 10−3 M and pH = 2.64
Exercise 14.4.1
a. Do the calculations and show that the hydronium ion concentration for a 0.233-M solution of C H NH is 2.3 × 10−3 and 6 5
+
3
the pH is 2.64.
b. What is the hydronium ion concentration in a 0.100-M solution of ammonium nitrate, NH4NO3, a salt composed of the ions
NH and NO . Use the data in Table E1 to determine Kb for the ammonium ion. Which is the stronger acid C H NH or
+
4
−
3 6 5
+
3
NH ?
+
Answer a
Ka (for NH
+
4
−10
) = 5.6 × 10 , [H3O+] = 7.5 × 10−6 M
Answer b
C H NH
6 5
+
3
is the stronger acid (a) (b) .
A solution of this salt contains sodium ions and acetate ions. The sodium ion has no effect on the acidity of the solution. However,
the acetate ion, the conjugate base of acetic acid, reacts with water and increases the concentration of hydroxide ion:
The equilibrium equation for this reaction is the ionization constant, Kb, for the base CH CO . The value of Kb can be calculated
3
−
from the value of the ionization constant of water, Kw, and Ka, the ionization constant of the conjugate acid of the anion using the
equation:
w = Ka × Kb
Some handbooks do not report values of Kb. They only report ionization constants for acids. If we want to determine a Kb value
using one of these handbooks, we must look up the value of Ka for the conjugate acid and convert it to a Kb value.
Solution
We are given two of three equilibrium concentrations and asked to find the missing concentration. If we can find the
equilibrium constant for the reaction, the process is straightforward.
The acetate ion behaves as a base in this reaction; hydroxide ions are a product. We determine Kb as follows:
−14
−
Kw 1.0 × 10
−10
Kb (f or CH CO ) = = = 5.6 × 10
3 2 −5
Ka (f or C H3 C O2 H) 1.8 × 10
−6
[ CH CO H](2.5 × 10 )
3 2 −10
= = 5.6 × 10
(0.050)
Exercise 14.4.2
What is the pH of a 0.083-M solution of CN−? Use 4.9 × 10−10 as Ka for HCN. Hint: We will probably need to convert pOH to
pH or find [H3O+] using [OH−] in the final stages of this problem.
Answer
11.16
Determine whether aqueous solutions of the following salts are acidic, basic, or neutral:
a. KBr
b. NaHCO3
c. NH4Cl
d. Na2HPO4
e. NH4F
Solution
Consider each of the ions separately in terms of its effect on the pH of the solution, as shown here:
a. The K+ cation and the Br− anion are both spectators, since they are the cation of a strong base (KOH) and the anion of a
strong acid (HBr), respectively. The solution is neutral.
b. The Na+ cation is a spectator, and will not affect the pH of the solution; the HCO anion is amphiprotic.The Ka of HCO
−
3
−
3
−14
1.0 × 10
−11
is 4.7 × 10 , so the Kb of its conjugate base is −11
= 2.1 × 10
−4
. Since Kb >> Ka, the solution is basic.
4.7 × 10
−
c. The NH ion is acidic and the Cl ion is a spectator. The solution will be acidic.
+
d. The Na+ ion is a spectator and will not affect the pH of the solution, while the HPO 2 −
4
ion is amphiprotic. The Ka of
−14
1.0 × 10
HPO
2 −
4
is 4.2 × 10−13 and its Kb is −13
= 2.4 × 10
−2
. Because Kb >> Ka, the solution is basic.
4.2 × 10
−
e. The NH ion is listed as being acidic, and the F ion is listed as a base, so we must directly compare the Ka and the Kb of
+
4
the two ions. Ka of NH is 5.6 × 10−10, which seems very small, yet the Kb of F− is 1.4 × 10−11, so the solution is acidic,
+
4
Exercise 14.4.3
Determine whether aqueous solutions of the following salts are acidic, basic, or neutral:
a. K2CO3
b. CaCl2
c. KH2PO4
d. (NH4)2CO3
e. AlBr3
Answer a
basic
Answer b
neutral
Answer c
acidic
Answer d
basic
Answer e
acidic
the six closest water molecules (the so-called first solvation shell), even though it does interact with the other water molecules
surrounding this Al(H O) cluster as well:
2
3+
3+ −
Al (NO ) (s) + 6 H O(l) ⟶ Al (H O) (aq) + 3 NO (aq)
3 3 2 2 6 3
We frequently see the formula of this ion simply as “Al3+(aq)”, without explicitly noting the six water molecules that are the closest
ones to the aluminum ion and just describing the ion as being solvated in water (hydrated). This is similar to the simplification of
the formula of the hydronium ion, H3O+ to H+. However, in this case, the hydrated aluminum ion is a weak acid (Figure 14.4.2)
and donates a proton to a water molecule. Thus, the hydration becomes important and we may use formulas that show the extent of
hydration:
3+ + 2+ −5
Al (H O) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Al (H O) (OH) (aq) Ka = 1.4 × 10
2 6 2 3 2 5
As with other polyprotic acids, the hydrated aluminum ion ionizes in stages, as shown by:
3+ + 2+
Al (H O) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Al (H O) (OH) (aq)
2 6 2 3 2 5
2+ + +
Al (H O) (OH) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Al (H O) (OH) (aq)
2 5 2 3 2 4 2
+ +
Al (H O) (OH) 2 (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Al (H O) (OH) (aq)
2 4 2 3 2 3 3
Note that some of these aluminum species are exhibiting amphiprotic behavior, since they are acting as acids when they appear on
the left side of the equilibrium expressions and as bases when they appear on the right side.
Figure 14.4.2 : When an aluminum ion reacts with water, the hydrated aluminum ion becomes a weak acid.
A reaction is shown using ball and stick models. On the left, inside brackets with a superscript of 3 plus outside to the right is
structure labeled “[ A l ( H subscript 2 O ) subscript 6 ] superscript 3 plus.” Inside the brackets is s central grey atom to which 6 red
atoms are bonded in an arrangement that distributes them evenly about the central grey atom. Each red atom has two smaller white
atoms attached in a forked or bent arrangement. Outside the brackets to the right is a space-filling model that includes a red central
sphere with two smaller white spheres attached in a bent arrangement. Beneath this structure is the label “H subscript 2 O.” A
double sided arrow follows. Another set of brackets follows to the right of the arrows which have a superscript of two plus outside
to the right. The structure inside the brackets is similar to that on the left, except a white atom is removed from the structure. The
label below is also changed to “[ A l ( H subscript 2 O ) subscript 5 O H ] superscript 2 plus.” To the right of this structure and
outside the brackets is a space filling model with a central red sphere to which 3 smaller white spheres are attached. This structure
is labeled “H subscript 3 O superscript plus.”
However, the ionization of a cation carrying more than one charge is usually not extensive beyond the first stage. Additional
examples of the first stage in the ionization of hydrated metal ions are:
3+ + 2+
Fe(H O) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Fe(H O) (OH) (aq) Ka = 2.74
2 6 2 3 2 5
2+ + +
Cu(H O) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Cu(H O) (OH) (aq) Ka = 6.3
2 6 2 3 2 5
2+ + +
Zn(H O) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Zn(H O) (OH) (aq) Ka = 9.6
2 4 2 3 2 3
Solution
A reaction is shown using ball and stick models. On the left, inside brackets with a superscript of 3 plus outside to the right is
structure labeled “[ A l ( H subscript 2 O ) subscript 6 ] superscript 3 plus.” Inside the brackets is s central grey atom to which
6 red atoms are bonded in an arrangement that distributes them evenly about the central grey atom. Each red atom has two
smaller white atoms attached in a forked or bent arrangement. Outside the brackets to the right is a space-filling model that
includes a red central sphere with two smaller white spheres attached in a bent arrangement. Beneath this structure is the label
“H subscript 2 O.” A double sided arrow follows. Another set of brackets follows to the right of the arrows which have a
superscript of two plus outside to the right. The structure inside the brackets is similar to that on the left, except a white atom is
removed from the structure. The label below is also changed to “[ A l ( H subscript 2 O ) subscript 5 O H ] superscript 2 plus.”
To the right of this structure and outside the brackets is a space filling model with a central red sphere to which 3 smaller white
spheres are attached. This structure is labeled “H subscript 3 O superscript plus.”
1. Determine the direction of change. The equation for the reaction and Ka are:
3+ + 2+ −5
Al (H O) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + Al (H O) (OH) (aq) Ka = 1.4 × 10
2 6 2 3 2 5
This table has two main columns and four rows. The first row for the first column does not have a heading and then has the
following in the first column: Initial concentration ( M ), Change ( M ), Equilibrium concentration ( M ). The second column
has the header of “A l ( H subscript 2 O ) subscript 6 superscript 3 positive sign plus H subscript 2 O equilibrium arrow H
subscript 3 O superscript positive sign plus A l ( H subscript 2 O ) subscript 5 ( O H ) superscript 2 positive sign.” Under the
second column is a subgroup of four columns and three rows. The first column has the following: 0.10 (which appears in red),
negative x, 0.10 minus x. The second column is blank. The third column has the following: approximately 0, x, x. The fourth
column has the following: 0, x, x.
Solve for x and the equilibrium concentrations. Substituting the expressions for the equilibrium concentrations into the
equation for the ionization constant yields:
+ 2+
[H O ][Al (H O) (OH) ]
3 2 5
1. Ka =
3+
[Al (H O) ]
2 6
(x)(x)
−5
= = 1.4 × 10
0.10 − x
+
pH = −log[ H3 O ] = 2.92(an acidic solution)
−3
Check the work. The arithmetic checks; when 1.2 × 10 M is substituted for x, the result = Ka.
in a 0.15-M solution of Al(NO3)3 that contains enough of the strong acid HNO3 to bring [H3O+]
2+
What is [Al(H 2
O) (OH)
5
]
to 0.10 M?
Answer
2.1 × 10−5 M
The constants for the different stages of ionization are not known for many metal ions, so we cannot calculate the extent of their
ionization. However, practically all hydrated metal ions other than those of the alkali metals ionize to give acidic solutions.
Ionization increases as the charge of the metal ion increases or as the size of the metal ion decreases.
Summary
The characteristic properties of aqueous solutions of Brønsted-Lowry acids are due to the presence of hydronium ions; those of
aqueous solutions of Brønsted-Lowry bases are due to the presence of hydroxide ions. The neutralization that occurs when aqueous
solutions of acids and bases are combined results from the reaction of the hydronium and hydroxide ions to form water. Some salts
formed in neutralization reactions may make the product solutions slightly acidic or slightly basic. Solutions that contain salts or
hydrated metal ions have a pH that is determined by the extent of the hydrolysis of the ions in the solution. The pH of the solutions
may be calculated using familiar equilibrium techniques, or it may be qualitatively determined to be acidic, basic, or neutral
depending on the relative Ka and Kb of the ions involved.
This page titled 14.4: Hydrolysis of Salt Solutions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
We can classify acids by the number of protons per molecule that they can give up in a reaction. Acids such as HCl, HNO , and 3
HCN that contain one ionizable hydrogen atom in each molecule are called monoprotic acids. Their reactions with water are:
+ −
HCl(aq) + H O(l) ⟶ H O (aq) + Cl (aq)
2 3
+ −
HNO (aq) + H O(l) ⟶ H O (aq) + NO3 (aq)
3 2 3
+ −
HCN(aq) + H O(l) ⟶ H O (aq) + CN (aq)
2 3
This image contains two equilibrium reactions. The first shows a C atom bonded to three H atoms and another C atom. The second
C atom is double bonded to an O atom and also forms a single bond to another O atom. The second O atom is bonded to an H atom.
There is a plus sign and then the molecular formula H subscript 2 O. An equilibrium arrow follows the H subscript 2 O. To the
right of the arrow is H subscript 3 O superscript positive sign. There is a plus sign. The final structure shows a C atom bonded the
three H atoms and another C atom. This second C atom is double bonded to an O atom and single bonded to another O atom. The
entire structure is in brackets and a superscript negative sign appears outside the brackets. The second reaction shows C H subscript
3 C O O H ( a q ) plus H subscript 2 O ( l ) equilibrium arrow H subscript 3 O ( a q ) plus C H subscript 3 C O O superscript
negative sign ( a q ).
Similarly, monoprotic bases are bases that will accept a single proton.
with K a1
2
> 10 ; complete dissociation .
The second ionization is
− + 2 −
HSO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + SO (aq)
4 2 3 4
with K a2 = 1.2 × 10
−2
.
This stepwise ionization process occurs for all polyprotic acids. When we make a solution of a weak diprotic acid, we get a solution
that contains a mixture of acids. Carbonic acid, H CO , is an example of a weak diprotic acid. The first ionization of carbonic acid
2 3
with
The bicarbonate ion can also act as an acid. It ionizes and forms hydronium ions and carbonate ions in even smaller quantities.
Second Ionization
− + 2−
HCO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + CO (aq)
3 2 3 3
with
+ 2−
[H O ][ CO ]
3 3 −11
KHCO− = = 4.7 × 10
3 −
[ HCO3 ]
KH
2
CO
3
is larger than K by a factor of 104, so H2CO3 is the dominant producer of hydronium ion in the solution. This means
HCO
−
that little of the HCO formed by the ionization of H2CO3 ionizes to give hydronium ions (and carbonate ions), and the
−
concentrations of H3O+ and HCO are practically equal in a pure aqueous solution of H2CO3.
−
If the first ionization constant of a weak diprotic acid is larger than the second by a factor of at least 20, it is appropriate to treat the
first ionization separately and calculate concentrations resulting from it before calculating concentrations of species resulting from
subsequent ionization. This can simplify our work considerably because we can determine the concentration of H3O+ and the
conjugate base from the first ionization, then determine the concentration of the conjugate base of the second ionization in a
solution with concentrations determined by the first ionization.
When we buy soda water (carbonated water), we are buying a solution of carbon dioxide in water. The solution is acidic
because CO2 reacts with water to form carbonic acid, H2CO3. What are [H O ], [HCO ], and [CO ] in a saturated solution 3
+ −
3
2−
3
− + 2− −11
HCO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + CO (aq) Ka2 = 4.7 × 10 (equilibrium step 2)
3 2 3 3
Solution
As indicated by the ionization constants, H2CO3 is a much stronger acid than HCO , so H −
3 2
CO
3
is the dominant producer of
hydronium ion in solution. Thus there are two parts in the solution of this problem:
1. Using the customary four steps, we determine the concentration of H3O+ and HCO produced by ionization of H2CO3. −
2. Then we determine the concentration of CO in a solution with the concentration of H3O+ and HCO determined in (1).
2−
3
−
3
To summarize:
Four tan rectangles are shown that are connected with right pointing arrows. The first is labeled “left bracket H subscript 2 C O
subscript 3 right bracket.” The second is labeled “left bracket H subscript 3 O superscript plus right bracket and left bracket H
C O subscript 3 superscript negative right bracket from H subscript 2 C O subscript 3.” The third is labeled “left bracket C O
subscript 3 superscript 2 negative right bracket from H C O subscript 3 superscript negative.”
1. First Ionization: Determine the concentrations of H 3
O
+
and HCO . −
3
safely ignore the second ionization step and focus only on the first step (but address it in next part of problem).
+ − −7
H CO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + HCO3 (aq) Ka1 = 4.3 × 10
2 3 2 3
Four tan rectangles are shown that are connected with right pointing arrows. The first is labeled “Determine the direction of
change.” The second is labeled “Determine x and the equilibrium concentrations.” The third is labeled “Solve for x and the
equilibrium concentrations.” The fourth is labeled “Check the math.”
An abbreviated table of changes and concentrations shows:
Abbreviated table of changes and concentrations
ICE Table H CO
2 3
(aq) H O(l)
2
H O
3
+
(aq) HCO
−
3
(aq)
Change (M) −x - +x +x
Substituting the equilibrium concentrations into the equilibrium constant gives us:
+ −
[H O ][ HCO ] (x)(x)
3 3 −7
KH CO = = = 4.3 × 10
2 3
[ H CO ] 0.033 − x
2 3
Thus:
[ H CO ] = 0.033 M
2 3
+ − −4
[H O ] = [ HCO ] = 1.2 × 10 M
3 3
3
in a solution at equilibrium.
Since the equilibrium step 1 is has a much bigger K than equilibrium step 2 , we can the equilibrium conditions calculated
a
from first part of example as the initial conditions for an ICER Table for the equilibrium step 2 :
− + 2−
HCO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + CO (aq)
3 2 3 3
Change (M) −y - +y +y
+ 2−
[H O ][ CO ]
3 3
KHCO− =
3 −
[ HCO3 ]
−4
(1.2 × 10 M + y)(y)
=
−4
(1.2 × 10 M − y)
2− −11
[ CO ] = y ≈ 4.7 × 10
3
To summarize:
In part 1 of this example, we found that the H 2
CO
3
in a 0.033-M solution ionizes slightly and at equilibrium
[ H CO ] = 0.033 M, , and M . In part 2, we determined that
+ −4 − −4
[ H O ] = 1.2 × 10 [ HCO3 ] = 1.2 × 10
2 3 3
M .
2− −11
[ CO ] = 5.6 × 10
3
+ − −8
H S(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + HS (aq) Ka1 = 8.9 × 10
2 2 3
− + 2− −19
HS (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + S (aq) Ka2 = 1.0 × 10
2 3
Answer
[ H S] = 0.1M
2
, [H 3
O
+
] = [H S
−
] = 0.0001 M [ S , 2−
] = 1 × 10
−19
M
We note that the concentration of the sulfide ion is the same as Ka2. This is due to the fact that each subsequent dissociation
occurs to a lesser degree (as acid gets weaker).
with K a1 = 7.5 × 10
−3
.
The second ionization is
− + 2−
H PO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + HPO (aq)
2 4 2 3 4
with K a2 = 6.2 × 10
−8
.
The third ionization is
2− + 3−
HPO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + PO (aq)
4 2 3 4
with K a3 = 4.2 × 10
−13
.
As with the diprotic acids, the differences in the ionization constants of these reactions tell us that in each successive step the
degree of ionization is significantly weaker. This is a general characteristic of polyprotic acids and successive ionization constants
often differ by a factor of about 105 to 106. This set of three dissociation reactions may appear to make calculations of equilibrium
concentrations in a solution of H3PO4 complicated. However, because the successive ionization constants differ by a factor of 105
to 106, the calculations can be broken down into a series of parts similar to those for diprotic acids.
Polyprotic bases can accept more than one hydrogen ion in solution. The carbonate ion is an example of a diprotic base, since it can
accept up to two protons. Solutions of alkali metal carbonates are quite alkaline, due to the reactions:
2− − −
H O(l) + CO (aq) ⇌ HCO (aq) + OH (aq)
2 3 3
and
Summary
An acid that contains more than one ionizable proton is a polyprotic acid. The protons of these acids ionize in steps. The
differences in the acid ionization constants for the successive ionizations of the protons in a polyprotic acid usually vary by roughly
five orders of magnitude. As long as the difference between the successive values of Ka of the acid is greater than about a factor of
20, it is appropriate to break down the calculations of the concentrations of the ions in solution into a series of steps.
Glossary
diprotic acid
acid containing two ionizable hydrogen atoms per molecule. A diprotic acid ionizes in two steps
diprotic base
base capable of accepting two protons. The protons are accepted in two steps
monoprotic acid
acid containing one ionizable hydrogen atom per molecule
stepwise ionization
process in which an acid is ionized by losing protons sequentially
triprotic acid
acid that contains three ionizable hydrogen atoms per molecule; ionization of triprotic acids occurs in three steps
This page titled 14.5: Polyprotic Acids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
A mixture of a weak acid and its conjugate base (or a mixture of a weak base and its conjugate acid) is called a buffer solution, or a
buffer. Buffer solutions resist a change in pH when small amounts of a strong acid or a strong base are added (Figure 14.6.1). A
solution of acetic acid (CH COOH and sodium acetate CH COONa) is an example of a buffer that consists of a weak acid and
3 3
its salt. An example of a buffer that consists of a weak base and its salt is a solution of ammonia (NH (aq)) and ammonium 3
Figure 14.6.1 : (a) The unbuffered solution on the left and the buffered solution on the right have the same pH (pH 8); they are
basic, showing the yellow color of the indicator methyl orange at this pH. (b) After the addition of 1 mL of a 0.01-M HCl solution,
the buffered solution has not detectably changed its pH but the unbuffered solution has become acidic, as indicated by the change
in color of the methyl orange, which turns red at a pH of about 4. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott)
The pH changes very little. If we add an acid such as hydrochloric acid, most of the hydronium ions from the hydrochloric acid
combine with acetate ions, forming acetic acid molecules:
+ −
H O (aq) + CH CO (aq) ⟶ CH CO H(aq) + H O(l)
3 3 2 3 2 2
Thus, there is very little increase in the concentration of the hydronium ion, and the pH remains practically unchanged (Figure
14.6.2).
If we add an acid (hydronium ions), ammonia molecules in the buffer mixture react with the hydronium ions to form ammonium
ions and reduce the hydronium ion concentration almost to its original value:
+ +
H O (aq) + NH (aq) ⟶ NH (aq) + H O(l)
3 3 4 2
The three parts of the following example illustrate the change in pH that accompanies the addition of base to a buffered solution of
a weak acid and to an unbuffered solution of a strong acid.
Acetate buffers are used in biochemical studies of enzymes and other chemical components of cells to prevent pH changes that
might change the biochemical activity of these compounds.
a. Calculate the pH of an acetate buffer that is a mixture with 0.10 M acetic acid and 0.10 M sodium acetate.
b. Calculate the pH after 1.0 mL of 0.10 M NaOH is added to 100 mL of this buffer, giving a solution with a volume of 101
mL.
Solution
a. Calculate the pH of an acetate buffer that is a mixture with 0.10 M acetic acid and 0.10 M sodium acetate.
To determine the pH of the buffer solution we use a typical equilibrium calculation (as illustrated in earlier Examples):
3 2
and
+ −5
[H O ] = 0 + x = 1.8 × 10 M
3
Thus:
+ −5
pH = −log[ H3 O ] = −log(1.8 × 10 )
= 4.74
4. Check the work. If we calculate all calculated equilibrium concentrations, we find that the equilibrium value of the
reaction coefficient, Q = Ka.
(b) Calculate the pH after 1.0 mL of 0.10 M NaOH is added to 100 mL of this buffer, giving a solution with a volume of 101
mL.
First, we calculate the concentrations of an intermediate mixture resulting from the complete reaction between the acid in the
buffer and the added base. Then we determine the concentrations of the mixture at the new equilibrium:
1. Determine the moles of NaOH. One milliliter (0.0010 L) of 0.10 M NaOH contains:
2. Determine the moles of CH2CO2H. Before reaction, 0.100 L of the buffer solution contains:
0.100 mol C H3 C O2 H
−2
0.100 L × ( ) = 1.00 × 10 mol C H3 C O2 H
1 L
3. Solve for the amount of NaCH3CO2 produced. The 1.0 × 10−4 mol of NaOH neutralizes 1.0 × 10−4 mol of CH3CO2H,
leaving:
and producing 1.0 × 10−4 mol of NaCH3CO2. This makes a total of:
[\mathrm{(1.0×10^{−2})+(0.01×10^{−2})=1.01×10^{−2}\:mol\:NaCH_3CO_2} \nonumber \]
4. Find the molarity of the products. After reaction, CH3CO2H and NaCH3CO2 are contained in 101 mL of the intermediate
solution, so:
−3
9.9 × 10 mol
[ CH CO H] = = 0.098 M
3 2
0.101 L
−2
1.01 × 10 mol
[ NaCH CO ] = = 0.100 M
3 2
0.101 L
Now we calculate the pH after the intermediate solution, which is 0.098 M in CH3CO2H and 0.100 M in NaCH3CO2, comes to
equilibrium. The calculation is very similar to that in part (a) of this example:
This series of calculations gives a pH = 4.75. Thus the addition of the base barely changes the pH of the solution.
(c) For comparison, calculate the pH after 1.0 mL of 0.10 M NaOH is added to 100 mL of a solution of an unbuffered solution
with a pH of 4.74 (a 1.8 × 10−5-M solution of HCl). The volume of the final solution is 101 mL.
Solution
This 1.8 × 10−5-M solution of HCl has the same hydronium ion concentration as the 0.10-M solution of acetic acid-sodium
acetate buffer described in part (a) of this example. The solution contains:
−5
1.8 × 10 mol HCl
−6
0.100 L × ( ) = 1.8 × 10 mol HCl
1 L
As shown in part (b), 1 mL of 0.10 M NaOH contains 1.0 × 10−4 mol of NaOH. When the NaOH and HCl solutions are mixed,
the HCl is the limiting reagent in the reaction. All of the HCl reacts, and the amount of NaOH that remains is:
−4 −6 −5
(1.0 × 10 ) − (1.8 × 10 ) = 9.8 × 10 M
The pH is:
pH = 14.00 − pOH = 10.99
The pH changes from 4.74 to 10.99 in this unbuffered solution. This compares to the change of 4.74 to 4.75 that occurred when
the same amount of NaOH was added to the buffered solution described in part (b).
Exercise 14.6.1
Show that adding 1.0 mL of 0.10 M HCl changes the pH of 100 mL of a 1.8 × 10−5 M HCl solution from 4.74 to 3.00.
Answer
Initial pH of 1.8 × 10−5 M HCl; pH = −log[H3O+] = −log[1.8 × 10−5] = 4.74
⎛ ⎞
+ −4 −6
+
total moles H3 O ⎜ 1.0 × 10 mol + 1.8 × 10 mol ⎟
pH = −log[ H3 O ] = −log ( ) = −log ⎜ ⎟ = 3.00
total volume ⎜ 1 L ⎟
101 mL ( )
⎝ ⎠
1000 mL
Figure 14.6.3 : The indicator color (methyl orange) shows that a small amount of acid added to a buffered solution of pH 8
(beaker on the left) has little affect on the buffered system (middle beaker). However, a large amount of acid exhausts the
buffering capacity of the solution and the pH changes dramatically (beaker on the right). (credit: modification of work by Mark
Ott)
The buffer capacity is the amount of acid or base that can be added to a given volume of a buffer solution before the pH changes
significantly, usually by one unit. Buffer capacity depends on the amounts of the weak acid and its conjugate base that are in a
buffer mixture. For example, 1 L of a solution that is 1.0 M in acetic acid and 1.0 M in sodium acetate has a greater buffer
capacity than 1 L of a solution that is 0.10 M in acetic acid and 0.10 M in sodium acetate even though both solutions have the
same pH. The first solution has more buffer capacity because it contains more acetic acid and acetate ion.
[CH CO ] = 0.10 M .
−
3 2
2. Weak acids and their salts are better as buffers for pHs less than 7; weak bases and their salts are better as buffers for pHs
greater than 7.
Blood is an important example of a buffered solution, with the principal acid and ion responsible for the buffering action being
carbonic acid, H2CO3, and the bicarbonate ion, HCO . When an excess of hydrogen ion enters the blood stream, it is removed
−
3
The pH of human blood thus remains very near 7.35, that is, slightly basic. Variations are usually less than 0.1 of a pH unit. A
change of 0.4 of a pH unit is likely to be fatal.
+
[HA]
[H O ] = Ka ×
3 −
[A ]
Taking the negative logarithm of both sides of this equation, we arrive at:
[HA]
+
−log[ H3 O ] = −log Ka − log
−
[A ]
where pKa is the negative of the common logarithm of the ionization constant of the weak acid (pKa = −log Ka). This equation
relates the pH, the ionization constant of a weak acid, and the concentrations of the weak acid and its salt in a buffered solution.
Lawrence Joseph Henderson (1878–1942) was an American physician, biochemist and physiologist, to name only a few of
his many pursuits. He obtained a medical degree from Harvard and then spent 2 years studying in Strasbourg, then a part of
Germany, before returning to take a lecturer position at Harvard. He eventually became a professor at Harvard and worked
there his entire life. He discovered that the acid-base balance in human blood is regulated by a buffer system formed by the
dissolved carbon dioxide in blood. He wrote an equation in 1908 to describe the carbonic acid-carbonate buffer system in
blood. Henderson was broadly knowledgeable; in addition to his important research on the physiology of blood, he also
wrote on the adaptations of organisms and their fit with their environments, on sociology and on university education. He
also founded the Fatigue Laboratory, at the Harvard Business School, which examined human physiology with specific
focus on work in industry, exercise, and nutrition.
In 1916, Karl Albert Hasselbalch (1874–1962), a Danish physician and chemist, shared authorship in a paper with Christian
Bohr in 1904 that described the Bohr effect, which showed that the ability of hemoglobin in the blood to bind with oxygen
was inversely related to the acidity of the blood and the concentration of carbon dioxide. The pH scale was introduced in
1909 by another Dane, Sørensen, and in 1912, Hasselbalch published measurements of the pH of blood. In 1916,
Hasselbalch expressed Henderson’s equation in logarithmic terms, consistent with the logarithmic scale of pH, and thus the
Henderson-Hasselbalch equation was born.
The concentration of carbonic acid, H2CO3 is approximately 0.0012 M, and the concentration of the hydrogen carbonate
ion, HCO , is around 0.024 M. Using the Henderson-Hasselbalch equation and the pKa of carbonic acid at body
−
The fact that the H2CO3 concentration is significantly lower than that of the HCO ion may seem unusual, but this
−
imbalance is due to the fact that most of the by-products of our metabolism that enter our bloodstream are acidic.
Therefore, there must be a larger proportion of base than acid, so that the capacity of the buffer will not be exceeded.
Lactic acid is produced in our muscles when we exercise. As the lactic acid enters the bloodstream, it is neutralized by the
HCO
−
3
ion, producing H2CO3. An enzyme then accelerates the breakdown of the excess carbonic acid to carbon dioxide
and water, which can be eliminated by breathing. In fact, in addition to the regulating effects of the carbonate buffering
system on the pH of blood, the body uses breathing to regulate blood pH. If the pH of the blood decreases too far, an
increase in breathing removes CO2 from the blood through the lungs driving the equilibrium reaction such that [H3O+] is
lowered. If the blood is too alkaline, a lower breath rate increases CO2 concentration in the blood, driving the equilibrium
reaction the other way, increasing [H+] and restoring an appropriate pH.
Summary
A solution containing a mixture of an acid and its conjugate base, or of a base and its conjugate acid, is called a buffer solution.
Unlike in the case of an acid, base, or salt solution, the hydronium ion concentration of a buffer solution does not change greatly
when a small amount of acid or base is added to the buffer solution. The base (or acid) in the buffer reacts with the added acid
(or base).
Glossary
buffer capacity
amount of an acid or base that can be added to a volume of a buffer solution before its pH changes significantly (usually by
one pH unit)
buffer
mixture of a weak acid or a weak base and the salt of its conjugate; the pH of a buffer resists change when small amounts of
acid or base are added
Henderson-Hasselbalch equation
equation used to calculate the pH of buffer solutions
This page titled 14.6: Buffers is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that
was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
As seen in the chapter on the stoichiometry of chemical reactions, titrations can be used to quantitatively analyze solutions for their
acid or base concentrations. In this section, we will explore the changes in the concentrations of the acidic and basic species present
in a solution during the process of a titration.
Solution
Since HCl is a strong acid, we can assume that all of it dissociates. The initial concentration of H3O+ is [H O ] = 0.100 M .
3
+
When the base solution is added, it also dissociates completely, providing OH− ions. The H3O+ and OH− ions neutralize each
other, so only those of the two that were in excess remain, and their concentration determines the pH. Thus, the solution is
initially acidic (pH < 7), but eventually all the hydronium ions present from the original acid are neutralized, and the solution
becomes neutral. As more base is added, the solution turns basic.
The total initial amount of the hydronium ions is:
+ +
n(H )0 = [ H3 O ]0 × 0.02500 L = 0.002500 mol
Once X mL of the 0.100-M base solution is added, the number of moles of the OH− ions introduced is:
−
1 L
n(OH )0 = 0.100 M × X mL × ( )
1000 mL
+ + −
1 L
n(H ) = n(H )0 − n(OH )0 = 0.002500 mol − 0.100 M × X mL × ( )
1000 mL
1000 mL
0.002500 mol × ( ) − 0.100 M × X mL
1 L
=
25.00 mL + X mL
The preceding calculations work if n(H ) − n(OH ) > 0 and so n(H+) > 0. When n(H ) = n(OH ) , the H3O+ ions from
+
0
−
0
+
0
−
0
the acid and the OH− ions from the base mutually neutralize. At this point, the only hydronium ions left are those from the
autoionization of water, and there are no OH− particles to neutralize them. Therefore, in this case:
+ − + −14 + −7
[H O ] = [ OH ], [ H O ] = Kw = 1.0 × 10 ; [H O ] = 1.0 × 10
3 3 3
−7
pH = −log(1.0 × 10 ) = 7.00
n(H
+
) = n(H
+
)0 − n(OH
−
)0 , we calculate: n(OH ) = n(OH ) − n(H ) − −
0
+
0
In this case:
1 L
0.100 M × X mL × ( ) − 0.002500 mol
−
n(OH ) 1000 mL
−
[OH ] = =
V 1 L
(25.00 mL + X mL) ( )
1000 mL
1000 mL
0.100 M × X mL − 0.002500 mol × ( )
1 L
=
25.00 mL + X mL
then using the definition of pOH and its relationship to pH in room temperature aqueous solutios (Equation 14.7.1):
pH = 14 − pOH
−
= 14 + log([OH ])
Let us now consider the four specific cases presented in this problem:
(a) X = 0 mL
1000 mL
0.002500 mol × ( )
+
n(H ) 1 L
+
[ H3 O ] = = = 0.1 M
V 25.00 mL
= 1.000
(b) X = 12.50 mL
1000 mL
0.002500 mol × ( ) − 0.100 M × 12.50 mL
+
n(H ) 1 L
+
[ H3 O ] = = = 0.0333 M
V 25.00 mL + 12.50 mL
= 1.477
and
pH = 7.000
as described earlier.
(d) X = 37.50 mL
In this case:
− +
n(OH )0 > n(H )0
1000 mL
0.100 M × 35.70 mL − 0.002500 mol × ( )
−
n(OH ) 1 L
−
[OH ] = = = 0.0200 M
V 25.00 mL + 37.50 mL
= 14 + log(0.0200)
= 12.30
Exercise 14.7.1
Calculate the pH for the strong acid/strong base titration between 50.0 mL of 0.100 M HNO3(aq) and 0.200 M NaOH (titrant)
at the listed volumes of added base:
a. 0.00 mL,
b. 15.0 mL,
c. 25.0 mL, and
d. 40.0 mL.
Answer a
0.00: 1.000
Answer b
15.0: 1.5111
Answer c
25.0: 7e. Do not delete this text first.
Answer d
40.0: 12.523
In Example 14.7.1, we calculated pH at four points during a titration. Table 14.7.1 shows a detailed sequence of changes in the pH
of a strong acid and a weak acid in a titration with NaOH.
Table 14.7.1 : pH Values in the Titrations of a Strong Acid with a Strong Base and of a Weak Acid with a Strong Base
Volume of 0.100 M NaOH pH Values 0.100 M
Moles of NaOH Added pH Values 0.100 M HCl1 2
Added (mL) CH3 CO2 H
1. Titration of 25.00 mL of 0.100 M HCl (0.00250 mol of HCI) with 0.100 M NaOH.
2. Titration of 25.00 mL of 0.100 M CH3CO2H (0.00250 mol of CH3CO2H) with 0.100 M NaOH.
The simplest acid-base reactions are those of a strong acid with a strong base. Table 14.7.1 shows data for the titration of a 25.0-
mL sample of 0.100 M hydrochloric acid with 0.100 M sodium hydroxide. The values of the pH measured after successive
additions of small amounts of NaOH are listed in the first column of this table, and are graphed in Figure 14.7.1, in a form that is
called a titration curve. The pH increases slowly at first, increases rapidly in the middle portion of the curve, and then increases
slowly again. The point of inflection (located at the midpoint of the vertical part of the curve) is the equivalence point for the
titration. It indicates when equivalent quantities of acid and base are present. For the titration of a strong acid with a strong base,
the equivalence point occurs at a pH of 7.00 and the points on the titration curve can be calculated using solution stoichiometry
(Table 14.7.1 and Figure 14.7.1).
After the equivalence point, the two curves are identical because the pH is dependent on the excess of hydroxide ion in both cases.
The titration curve shown in Figure 14.7.1b is for the titration of 25.00 mL of 0.100 M CH3CO2H with 0.100 M NaOH. The
reaction can be represented as:
− −
CH CO H + OH ⟶ CH CO +H O
3 2 3 2 2
a. What is the initial pH before any amount of the NaOH solution has been added? Ka = 1.8 × 10−5 for CH3CO2H.
b. Find the pH after 25.00 mL of the NaOH solution have been added.
c. Find the pH after 12.50 mL of the NaOH solution has been added.
d. Find the pH after 37.50 mL of the NaOH solution has been added.
and
−−−−−−−−−−−−− − − −−−−−−−−−−−−− −
+ −5 −3
[H O ] = √ Ka × [ CH CO H] = √ 1.8 × 10 × 0.100 = 1.3 × 10
3 3 2
−3
pH = − log(1.3 × 10 ) = 2.87
(b) After 25.00 mL of NaOH are added, the number of moles of NaOH and CH3CO2H are equal because the amounts of the
solutions and their concentrations are the same. All of the CH3CO2H has been converted to CH CO . The concentration of 3
−
2
0.00250 mol −
= 0.0500 MCH CO2
3
0.0500 L
The equilibrium that must be focused on now is the basicity equilibrium for CH 3
CO2
−
:
− −
CH CO2 (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ CH CO H(aq) + OH (aq)
3 2 3 2
so we must determine Kb for the base by using the ion product constant for water:
−
[ CH CO H][ OH ]
3 2
Kb =
−
[ CH CO ]
3 2
− + +
[ CH CO ][ H ] [ CH CO H] [H ]
3 2 3 2
Ka = , so = .
−
[ CH CO H] [ CH CO2 ] Ka
3 2 3
Since Kw = [H+][OH−]:
+ −
[H ][ OH ]
Kb = (14.7.2)
Ka
Kw
= (14.7.3)
Ka
−14
1.0 × 10
= (14.7.4)
−5
1.8 × 10
−10
= 5.6 × 10 (14.7.5)
Let us denote the concentration of each of the products of this reaction, CH3CO2H and OH−, as x. Using the assumption that x
2
x
is small compared to 0.0500 M, K b = , and then:
0.0500 M
− −6
x = [ OH ] = 5.3 × 10
−6
pOH = − log(5.3 × 10 ) = 5.28
Note that the pH at the equivalence point of this titration is significantly greater than 7.
(c) In (a), 25.00 mL of the NaOH solution was added, and so practically all the CH3CO2H was converted into CH CO . In 3
−
this case, only 12.50 mL of the base solution has been introduced, and so only half of all the CH3CO2H is converted into
CH CO . The total initial number of moles of CH3CO2H is 0.02500L × 0.100 M = 0.00250 mol, and so after adding the
−
3 2
0.00250 mol
NaOH, the numbers of moles of CH3CO2H and CH 3
CO
−
2
are both approximately equal to = 0.00125 mol , and
2
their concentrations are the same.
So:
−2
pOH = − log(2.00 × 10 ) = 1.70, and pH = 14.00 − 1.70 = 12.30
Note that this result is the same as for the strong acid-strong base titration example provided, since the amount of the strong base
added moves the solution past the equivalence point.
Exercise 14.7.2
Calculate the pH for the weak acid/strong base titration between 50.0 mL of 0.100 M HCOOH(aq) (formic acid) and 0.200 M
NaOH (titrant) at the listed volumes of added base:
a. 0.00 mL,
b. 15.0 mL,
c. 25.0 mL, and
d. 30.0 mL.
Answer a
0.00 mL: 2.37
Answer b
15.0 mL: 3.92
Answer c
25.00 mL: 8.29
Answer d
30.0 mL: 12.097
+ −
[H O ][ In ]
3 −4
Ka = = 4.0 × 10
[HIn]
The anion of methyl orange, In , is yellow, and the nonionized form, HIn , is red. When we add acid to a solution of methyl
−
orange, the increased hydronium ion concentration shifts the equilibrium toward the nonionized red form, in accordance with Le
Chatelier’s principle. If we add base, we shift the equilibrium towards the yellow form. This behavior is completely analogous to
the action of buffers.
An indicator’s color is the visible result of the ratio of the concentrations of the two species In− and HIn . If most of the indicator
(typically about 60−90% or more) is present as In , then we see the color of the In ion, which would be yellow for methyl
− −
orange. If most is present as HIn , then we see the color of the HIn molecule: red for methyl orange. For methyl orange, we can
rearrange the equation for Ka and write:
−
[In ] [substance with yellow color] Ka
= = (14.7.6)
+
[HIn] [substance with red color] [ H3 O ]
−
[ In ]
Equation 14.7.6 shows us how the ratio of varies with the concentration of hydronium ion. The above expression describing
[HIn]
+
[ H3 O ] [H I n]
log( ) = log( ) (14.7.8)
−
Ka [I n ]
−
[I n ]
+
log([ H3 O ]) − log(Ka ) = − log( ) (14.7.9)
[H I n]
−
[I n ]
−pH + pKa = − log( ) (14.7.10)
[H I n]
−
[I n ]
pH = p Ka + log( ) (14.7.11)
[H I n]
or in general terms
[base]
pH = p Ka + log( ) (14.7.12)
[acid]
Equation 14.7.12 is the same as the Henderson-Hasselbalch equation, which can be used to describe the equilibrium of indicators.
When [H3O+] has the same numerical value as Ka, the ratio of [In−] to [HIn] is equal to 1, meaning that 50% of the indicator is
present in the red form (HIn) and 50% is in the yellow ionic form (In−), and the solution appears orange in color. When the
hydronium ion concentration increases to 8 × 10−4 M (a pH of 3.1), the solution turns red. No change in color is visible for any
further increase in the hydronium ion concentration (decrease in pH). At a hydronium ion concentration of 4 × 10−5 M (a pH of
4.4), most of the indicator is in the yellow ionic form, and a further decrease in the hydronium ion concentration (increase in pH)
does not produce a visible color change. The pH range between 3.1 (red) and 4.4 (yellow) is the color-change interval of methyl
orange; the pronounced color change takes place between these pH values.
There are many different acid-base indicators that cover a wide range of pH values and can be used to determine the approximate
pH of an unknown solution by a process of elimination. Universal indicators and pH paper contain a mixture of indicators and
exhibit different colors at different pHs. Figure 14.7.2 presents several indicators, their colors, and their color-change intervals.
Summary
A titration curve is a graph that relates the change in pH of an acidic or basic solution to the volume of added titrant. The
characteristics of the titration curve are dependent on the specific solutions being titrated. The pH of the solution at the equivalence
point may be greater than, equal to, or less than 7.00. The choice of an indicator for a given titration depends on the expected pH at
the equivalence point of the titration, and the range of the color change of the indicator.
Glossary
acid-base indicator
organic acid or base whose color changes depending on the pH of the solution it is in
color-change interval
titration curve
plot of the pH of a solution of acid or base versus the volume of base or acid added during a titration
This page titled 14.7: Acid-Base Titrations is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
14.E.1.2: S14.1.1
One example for NH3 as a conjugate acid: −
NH
2
+
+H ⟶ NH
3
; as a conjugate base:
+ −
NH (aq) + OH (aq) ⟶ NH (aq) + H O(l)
4 3 2
14.E.1.3: Q14.1.2
Write equations that show H 2
PO4
−
acting both as an acid and as a base.
14.E.1.4: Q14.1.3
Show by suitable net ionic equations that each of the following species can act as a Brønsted-Lowry acid:
a. H O3
+
b. HCl
c. NH3
d. CH3CO2H
e. NH +
f. HSO −
14.E.1.5: S14.1.3
a. H O (aq) ⟶ H (aq) + H O ;
3
+ +
2 (l)
d. CH CO H(aq) ⟶ H (aq) + CH CO
3 2
+
3
−
2
(aq) ;
e. NH (aq) ⟶ H (aq) + NH (aq) ;
+
4
+
4
+ 2−
14.E.1.6: Q14.1.4
Show by suitable net ionic equations that each of the following species can act as a Brønsted-Lowry acid:
a. HNO3
b. PH +
4
c. H2S
d. CH3CH2COOH
e. H PO
2
−
4
f. HS−
14.E.1.7: Q14.1.5
Show by suitable net ionic equations that each of the following species can act as a Brønsted-Lowry base:
a. H2O
b. OH −
c. NH3
d. CN−
e. S2−
f. H PO
2
−
4
14.E.1.8: S14.1.5
a. H O + H (aq) ⟶ H O
2 (l)
+
3
+
(aq)
b. OH (aq) + H (aq) ⟶ H
− +
2
O(l)
4
+
3 4
14.E.1.9: Q14.1.6
Show by suitable net ionic equations that each of the following species can act as a Brønsted-Lowry base:
a. HS−
b. PO 3−
4
c. NH −
d. C2H5OH
e. O2−
f. H PO
2
−
4
14.E.1.10: Q14.1.7
What is the conjugate acid of each of the following? What is the conjugate base of each?
a. OH −
b. H2O
c. HCO −
d. NH3
e. HSO −
f. H2O2
g. HS−
h. H N
5
+
14.E.1.11: S14.1.7
H2O, O2−; H3O+, OH ; H2CO3, CO ; NH , NH ; H2SO4, SO
− 2−
3
+
4
−
2
2−
4
;H
3
+
O
2
, HO ; H2S; S2−; H
−
2 6
N
2+
2
, H4N2
14.E.1.12: Q14.1.8
What is the conjugate acid of each of the following? What is the conjugate base of each?
a. H2S
b. H PO
2
−
4
c. PH3
d. HS−
e. HSO −
3
f. H O
3
+
2
g. H4N2
h. CH3OH
14.E.1.13: Q14.1.9
Identify and label the Brønsted-Lowry acid, its conjugate base, the Brønsted-Lowry base, and its conjugate acid in each of the
following equations:
a. HNO + H O ⟶ H O + NO
3 2 3
+ −
3
b. CN + H O ⟶ HCN + OH
−
2
−
c. H SO + Cl ⟶ HCl + HSO
2 4
− −
d. HSO + OH ⟶ SO + H O
−
4
− 2−
4 2
e. O + H O ⟶ 2 OH
2−
2
−
+ 3+ 2+ 2+
f. [Cu(H O) (OH)] + [Al(H O) ]
2 3 2 6
⟶ [Cu(H O) ]
2 4
+ [Al (H O) (OH)]
2 5
g. H S + NH ⟶ HS + NH
2
−
2
−
- 2−
HSO (CB) ; HSO (BA) , OH (BB), SO
−
4
−
4
(CB) , H2O(CA); O (BB), H2O(BA) OH (CB and CA); [Cu(H2O)3(OH)]+(BB),
2−
4
−
[Al(H2O)6] (BA), [Cu(H2O)4] (CA), [Al(H2O)5(OH)] (CB); H2S(BA), NH (BB) , HS−(CB), NH3(CA)
3+ 2+ 2+ −
2
14.E.1.15: Q14.1.10
Identify and label the Brønsted-Lowry acid, its conjugate base, the Brønsted-Lowry base, and its conjugate acid in each of the
following equations:
a. NO + H O ⟶ HNO + OH
−
2 2 2
−
b. HBr + H O ⟶ H O + Br
2 3
+ −
c. HS + H O ⟶ H S + OH
−
2 2
−
d. H PO + OH ⟶ HPO + H O
2
−
4
− 2−
4 2
e. H PO + HCl ⟶ H PO + Cl
2
−
4 3 4
−
2 6
3+
⟶ [Fe(H O) ]
2 6
3+
+ [Al (H O) (OH)]
2 5
2+
g. CH OH + H ⟶ CH O + H
3
−
3
−
2
14.E.1.16: Q14.1.11
What are amphiprotic species? Illustrate with suitable equations.
14.E.1.17: S14.1.11
Amphiprotic species may either gain or lose a proton in a chemical reaction, thus acting as a base or an acid. An example is H2O.
As an acid: H O(aq) + NH (aq) ⇌ NH
2 3
+
4
(aq) + OH
−
(aq) .
As a base: H O(aq) + HCl(aq) ⇌ H O
2 3
+
(aq) + Cl
−
(aq)
14.E.1.18: Q14.1.12
State which of the following species are amphiprotic and write chemical equations illustrating the amphiprotic character of these
species:
a. H2O
b. H PO
2
−
4
c. S2−
d. CO 2−
3
e. HSO −
4
14.E.1.19: Q14.1.13
State which of the following species are amphiprotic and write chemical equations illustrating the amphiprotic character of these
species.
a. NH3
b. HPO −
4
c. Br−
d. NH +
e. ASO 3−
14.E.1.20: S14.113
amphiprotic: NH
3
+H O
3
+
⟶ NH OH + H O
4 2
, NH + OCH ⟶ NH
3
−
3
−
2
+ CH OH
3
; HPO
2−
4
+ OH
−
⟶ PO
3−
4
+H O
2
,
HPO
2−
4
+ HClO
4
⟶ H PO
2
−
4
+ ClO
−
4
; not amphiprotic: Br−; NH ; AsO +
4
3−
4
14.E.1.21: Q14.1.14
Is the self ionization of water endothermic or exothermic? The ionization constant for water (Kw) is 2.9 × 10
−14
at 40 °C and
9.6 × 10 at 60 °C.
−14
14.E.2.2: S14.2.1
In a neutral solution [H3O+] = [OH−]. At 40 °C,
[H3O+] = [OH−] = (2.910−14)1/2 = 1.7 × 10−7.
14.E.2.3: Q14.2.2
The ionization constant for water (Kw) is 2.9 × 10−14 at 40 °C. Calculate [H3O+], [OH−], pH, and pOH for pure water at 40 °C.
14.E.2.4: Q14.2.3
The ionization constant for water (Kw) is 9.614 × 10−14 at 60 °C. Calculate [H3O+], [OH−], pH, and pOH for pure water at 60 °C.
14.E.2.5: S14.2.3
x = 3.101 × 10−7 M = [H3O+] = [OH−]
pH = -log 3.101 × 10−7 = −(−6.5085) = 6.5085
pOH = pH = 6.5085
14.E.2.6: Q14.2.4
Calculate the pH and the pOH of each of the following solutions at 25 °C for which the substances ionize completely:
a. 0.200 M HCl
b. 0.0143 M NaOH
c. 3.0 M HNO3
d. 0.0031 M Ca(OH)2
14.E.2.7: Q14.2.5
Calculate the pH and the pOH of each of the following solutions at 25 °C for which the substances ionize completely:
a. 0.000259 M HClO4
b. 0.21 M NaOH
c. 0.000071 M Ba(OH)2
d. 2.5 M KOH
14.E.2.8: S14.2.5
pH = 3.587; pOH = 10.413; pH = 0.68; pOH = 13.32; pOH = 3.85; pH = 10.15; pH = −0.40; pOH = 14.4
14.E.2.9: Q14.2.6
What are the pH and pOH of a solution of 2.0 M HCl, which ionizes completely?
14.E.2.10: Q14.2.6
What are the hydronium and hydroxide ion concentrations in a solution whose pH is 6.52?
14.E.2.11: S14.2.6
[H3O+] = 3.0 × 10−7 M; [OH−] = 3.3 × 10−8 M
14.E.2.12: Q14.2.7
Calculate the hydrogen ion concentration and the hydroxide ion concentration in wine from its pH. See below Figure for useful
information.
14.E.2.14: S14.2.9
[H3O+] = 1 × 10−2 M; [OH−] = 1 × 10−12 M
14.E.2.15: Q14.2.9
The hydronium ion concentration in a sample of rainwater is found to be 1.7 × 10−6 M at 25 °C. What is the concentration of
hydroxide ions in the rainwater?
14.E.2.16: Q14.2.10
The hydroxide ion concentration in household ammonia is 3.2 × 10−3 M at 25 °C. What is the concentration of hydronium ions in
the solution?
14.E.2.17: S14.2.10
[OH−] = 3.1 × 10−12 M
14.E.3.2: Q14.3.2
Explain why the neutralization reaction of a weak acid and a strong base gives a weakly basic solution.
The salt ionizes in solution, but the anion slightly reacts with water to form the weak acid. This reaction also forms OH−, which
causes the solution to be basic.
14.E.3.3: Q14.3.3
Use this list of important industrial compounds (and Figure) to answer the following questions regarding: CaO, Ca(OH)2,
CH3CO2H, CO2, HCl, H2CO3, HF, HNO2, HNO3, H3PO4, H2SO4, NH3, NaOH, Na2CO3.
a. Identify the strong Brønsted-Lowry acids and strong Brønsted-Lowry bases.
b. List those compounds in that can behave as Brønsted-Lowry acids with strengths lying between those of H3O+ and H2O.
14.E.3.4: Q14.3.4
The odor of vinegar is due to the presence of acetic acid, CH3CO2H, a weak acid. List, in order of descending concentration, all of
the ionic and molecular species present in a 1-M aqueous solution of this acid.
14.E.3.5: S14.3.4
[H2O] > [CH3CO2H] > [H 3
+
O ] ≈ [CH 3
−
CO2 ] > [OH−]
14.E.3.6: Q14.3.5
Household ammonia is a solution of the weak base NH3 in water. List, in order of descending concentration, all of the ionic and
molecular species present in a 1-M aqueous solution of this base.
14.E.3.7: Q14.3.4
Explain why the ionization constant, Ka, for H2SO4 is larger than the ionization constant for H2SO3.
14.E.3.8: S14.3.4
The oxidation state of the sulfur in H2SO4 is greater than the oxidation state of the sulfur in H2SO3.
14.E.3.9: Q14.3.7
Explain why the ionization constant, Ka, for HI is larger than the ionization constant for HF.
14.E.3.10: Q14.3.8
Gastric juice, the digestive fluid produced in the stomach, contains hydrochloric acid, HCl. Milk of Magnesia, a suspension of solid
Mg(OH)2 in an aqueous medium, is sometimes used to neutralize excess stomach acid. Write a complete balanced equation for the
neutralization reaction, and identify the conjugate acid-base pairs.
14.E.3.11: S14.3.8
2+ −
Mg (OH) (s) + HCl(aq) ⟶ Mg (aq) + 2 Cl (aq) + 2 H O(l)
2 2
BB BA CB CA
14.E.3.12: Q14.3.9
Nitric acid reacts with insoluble copper(II) oxide to form soluble copper(II) nitrate, Cu(NO3)2, a compound that has been used to
prevent the growth of algae in swimming pools. Write the balanced chemical equation for the reaction of an aqueous solution of
HNO3 with CuO.
14.E.3.13: Q14.3.10
What is the ionization constant at 25 °C for the weak acid CH NH
3
+
3
, the conjugate acid of the weak base CH3NH2, Kb = 4.4 ×
10−4.
14.E.3.14: S14.3.10
−11
Ka = 2.3 × 10
14.E.3.15: Q14.3.11
What is the ionization constant at 25 °C for the weak acid (CH 3
) NH
2
+
2
, the conjugate acid of the weak base (CH3)2NH, Kb = 7.4 ×
10−4?
14.E.3.16: Q14.3.12
Which base, CH3NH2 or (CH3)2NH, is the strongest base? Which conjugate acid, (CH 3
) NH
2
+
2
or (CH3)2NH, is the strongest acid?
14.E.3.17: S14.3.12
The strongest base or strongest acid is the one with the larger Kb or Ka, respectively. In these two examples, they are (CH3)2NH and
CH NH .
+
3 3
14.E.3.19: Q14.3.14
Which is the stronger base, (CH3)3N or H 2
BO
−
3
?
14.E.3.20: S14.3.14
triethylamine.
14.E.3.21: Q14.3.15
Predict which acid in each of the following pairs is the stronger and explain your reasoning for each.
a. H2O or HF
b. B(OH)3 or Al(OH)3
c. HSO or HSO
−
3
−
d. NH3 or H2S
e. H2O or H2Te
14.E.3.22: Q14.3.16
Predict which compound in each of the following pairs of compounds is more acidic and explain your reasoning for each.
a. HSO or HSeO
−
4
−
4
b. NH3 or H2O
c. PH3 or HI
d. NH3 or PH3
e. H2S or HBr
14.E.3.23: S14.3.16
a. HSO ; higher electronegativity of the central ion. H2O;
−
4
b. NH3 is a base and water is neutral, or decide on the basis of Ka values. HI;
c. PH3 is weaker than HCl; HCl is weaker than HI. Thus, PH3 is weaker than HI.
d. PH3; in binary compounds of hydrogen with nonmetals, the acidity increases for the element lower in a group.
e. HBr; in a period, the acidity increases from left to right; in a group, it increases from top to bottom. Br is to the left and below
S, so HBr is the stronger acid.
14.E.3.24: Q14.3.17
Rank the compounds in each of the following groups in order of increasing acidity or basicity, as indicated, and explain the order
you assign.
a. acidity: HCl, HBr, HI
b. basicity: H2O, OH−, H−, Cl−
c. basicity: Mg(OH)2, Si(OH)4, ClO3(OH) (Hint: Formula could also be written as HClO4).
d. acidity: HF, H2O, NH3, CH4
14.E.3.25: Q14.3.18
Rank the compounds in each of the following groups in order of increasing acidity or basicity, as indicated, and explain the order
you assign.
a. acidity: NaHSO3, NaHSeO3, NaHSO4
b. basicity: BrO , ClO , IO
−
2
−
2
−
2
−
2
−
3
−
2
−
2
−
acidity increases as the electronegativity of the central atom increases. Cl is more electronegative than Br, and I is the least
electronegative of the three.
c. HOI < HOBr < HOCl; in a series of the same form of oxyacids, the acidity increases as the electronegativity of the central atom
increases. Cl is more electronegative than Br, and I is the least electronegative of the three.
d. HOCl < HOClO < HOClO2 < HOClO3; in a series of oxyacids of the same central element, the acidity increases as the number
of oxygen atoms increases (or as the oxidation state of the central atom increases).
e. HTe < HS << PH < NH ; PH and NH are anions of weak bases, so they act as strong bases toward H+. HTe and
− − −
2
−
2
−
2
−
2
−
HS− are anions of weak acids, so they have less basic character. In a periodic group, the more electronegative element has the
more basic anion.
f. BrO < BrO < BrO < BrO ; with a larger number of oxygen atoms (that is, as the oxidation state of the central ion
−
4
−
3
−
2
−
increases), the corresponding acid becomes more acidic and the anion consequently less basic.
14.E.3.27: Q14.3.19
Both HF and HCN ionize in water to a limited extent. Which of the conjugate bases, F− or CN−, is the stronger base? See Table.
14.E.3.28: Q14.3.20
The active ingredient formed by aspirin in the body is salicylic acid, C6H4OH(CO2H). The carboxyl group (−CO2H) acts as a weak
acid. The phenol group (an OH group bonded to an aromatic ring) also acts as an acid but a much weaker acid. List, in order of
descending concentration, all of the ionic and molecular species present in a 0.001-M aqueous solution of C6H4OH(CO2H).
+ − − −
[ H O] > [ C H OH(CO H)] > [ H ] > [ C H OH(CO ) ] ≫ [ C H O(CO H) ] > [ OH ]
2 6 4 2 0 6 4 2 6 4 2
14.E.3.29: Q14.3.21
Explain why equilibrium calculations are not necessary to determine ionic concentrations in solutions of certain strong electrolytes
such as NaOH and HCl. Under what conditions are equilibrium calculations necessary as part of the determination of the
concentrations of all ions of some other strong electrolytes in solution?
14.E.3.30: S14.3.21
Strong electrolytes are 100% ionized, and, as long as the component ions are neither weak acids nor weak bases, the ionic species
present result from the dissociation of the strong electrolyte. Equilibrium calculations are necessary when one (or more) of the ions
is a weak acid or a weak base.
14.E.3.31: Q14.3.22
Are the concentrations of hydronium ion and hydroxide ion in a solution of an acid or a base in water directly proportional or
inversely proportional? Explain your answer.
14.E.3.32: Q14.3.23
What two common assumptions can simplify calculation of equilibrium concentrations in a solution of a weak acid?
14.E.3.33: S14.3.23
1. Assume that the change in initial concentration of the acid as the equilibrium is established can be neglected, so this
concentration can be assumed constant and equal to the initial value of the total acid concentration.
2. Assume we can neglect the contribution of water to the equilibrium concentration of H3O+.
14.E.3.35: Q14.3.25
Which of the following will increase the percent of NH3 that is converted to the ammonium ion in water (Hint: Use LeChâtelier’s
principle.)?
a. addition of NaOH
b. addition of HCl
c. addition of NH4Cl
14.E.3.36: S14.3.25
The addition of HCl
14.E.3.37: Q14.3.26
Which of the following will increase the percent of HF that is converted to the fluoride ion in water?
a. addition of NaOH
b. addition of HCl
c. addition of NaF
14.E.3.38: Q14.3.27
What is the effect on the concentrations of NO , HNO2, and OH− when the following are added to a solution of KNO2 in water:
−
2
a. HCl
b. HNO2
c. NaOH
d. NaCl
e. KNO
The equation for the equilibrium is:
− −
NO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ HNO (aq) + OH (aq) (14.E.2)
2 2 2
14.E.3.39: S14.3.27
a. Adding HCl will add H3O+ ions, which will then react with the OH− ions, lowering their concentration. The equilibrium will
shift to the right, increasing the concentration of HNO2, and decreasing the concentration of NO ions.
−
2
b. Adding HNO2 increases the concentration of HNO2 and shifts the equilibrium to the left, increasing the concentration of NO −
2
14.E.3.40: Q14.3.28
What is the effect on the concentration of hydrofluoric acid, hydronium ion, and fluoride ion when the following are added to
separate solutions of hydrofluoric acid?
a. HCl
b. KF
c. NaCl
d. KOH
e. HF
The equation for the equilibrium is:
+ −
HF(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + F (aq) (14.E.3)
2 3
14.E.3.42: S14.3.29
This is a case in which the solution contains a mixture of acids of different ionization strengths. In solution, the HCO2H exists
primarily as HCO2H molecules because the ionization of the weak acid is suppressed by the strong acid. Therefore, the HCO2H
contributes a negligible amount of hydronium ions to the solution. The stronger acid, HCl, is the dominant producer of hydronium
ions because it is completely ionized. In such a solution, the stronger acid determines the concentration of hydronium ions, and the
ionization of the weaker acid is fixed by the [H3O+] produced by the stronger acid.
14.E.3.43: Q14.3.30
From the equilibrium concentrations given, calculate Ka for each of the weak acids and Kb for each of the weak bases.
CH3CO2H: [H 3
O
+
] = 1.34 × 10−3 M;
[ CH CO
3
−
2
] = 1.34 × 10−3 M;
[CH3CO2H] = 9.866 × 10−2 M;
ClO−: [OH−] = 4.0 × 10−4 M;
[HClO] = 2.38 × 10−5 M;
[ClO−] = 0.273 M;
HCO2H: [HCO2H] = 0.524 M;
[H O
3
+
] = 9.8 × 10−3 M; [HCO −
2
] = 9.8 × 10−3 M;
C H NH
6 5
+
3
: [ C H NH
6 5
+
3
] = 0.233 M;
[C6H5NH2] = 2.3 × 10−3 M;
[H O
3
+
] = 2.3 × 10−3 M
From the equilibrium concentrations given, calculate Ka for each of the weak acids and Kb for each of the weak bases.
NH3: [OH−] = 3.1 × 10−3 M;
[ NH
+
4
] = 3.1 × 10−3 M;
[NH3] = 0.533 M;
HNO2: [H 3
O
+
] = 0.011 M;
[ NO
−
2
] = 0.0438 M;
[HNO2] = 1.07 M;
(CH3)3N: [(CH3)3N] = 0.25 M;
[(CH3)3NH+] = 4.3 × 10−3 M;
[OH−] = 4.3 × 10−3 M;
NH
+
4
: [ NH
+
4
] = 0.100 M;
[NH3] = 7.5 × 10−6 M;
[H3O+] = 7.5 × 10−6 M
a. K b = 1.8 × 10
−5
;
b. K a = 4.5 × 10
−4
;
c. K b = 7.4 × 10
−5
;
d. K a = 5.6 × 10
−10
14.E.3.45: Q14.3.32
Determine Ka for hydrogen sulfate ion, HSO . In a 0.10-M solution the acid is 29% ionized.
−
14.E.3.46: S14.3.32
−2
Ka = 1.2 × 10
14.E.3.47: Q14.3.33
Calculate the ionization constant for each of the following acids or bases from the ionization constant of its conjugate base or
conjugate acid:
a. F−
b. NH +
4
c. AsO 3−
d. (CH ) NH
3 2
+
2
e. NO −
f. HC O (as a base)
2
−
14.E.3.48: Q14.3.52
Calculate the ionization constant for each of the following acids or bases from the ionization constant of its conjugate base or
conjugate acid:
1. HTe− (as a base)
2. (CH ) NH 3 3
+
4. HO (as a base)
−
2
5. C H NH
6 5
+
3
14.E.3.49: S14.3.52
a. K = 4.3 × 10 ;
b
−12
b. K = 1.4 × 10 ;
a
−10
c. K = 1 × 10 ;
b
−7
d. K = 4.2 × 10 ;
b
−3
e. K = 4.2 × 10 ;
b
−3
f. K = 8.3 × 10
b
−13
14.E.3.50: Q14.3.53
For which of the following solutions must we consider the ionization of water when calculating the pH or pOH?
a. 3 × 10−8 M HNO3
b. 0.10 g HCl in 1.0 L of solution
c. 0.00080 g NaOH in 0.50 L of solution
d. 1 × 10−7 M Ca(OH)2
e. 0.0245 M KNO3
14.E.3.51: Q14.3.54
Even though both NH3 and C6H5NH2 are weak bases, NH3 is a much stronger acid than C6H5NH2. Which of the following is
correct at equilibrium for a solution that is initially 0.10 M in NH3 and 0.10 M in C6H5NH2?
a. [OH −
] = [ NH
+
4
]
b. [NH +
4
] = [ C H NH
6 5
+
3
]
c. [OH −
] = [ C H NH
6 5
+
3
]
14.E.3.52: Q14.3.55
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of the nonionized acids and all ions in a solution that is 0.25 M in HCO2H and 0.10 M in
HClO.
14.E.3.53: Q14.3.56
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of the nonionized acids and all ions in a solution that is 0.134 M in HNO2 and 0.120 M in
HBrO.
14.E.3.54: S14.3.56
[H3O+] = 7.5 × 10−3 M
[HNO2] = 0.126 [OH−] = 1.3 × 10−12 M [BrO−] = 3.2 × 10−8 M [HBrO] = 0.120 M
14.E.3.55: Q14.3.57
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of the nonionized bases and all ions in a solution that is 0.25 M in CH3NH2 and 0.10 M in
C5H5N (Kb = 1.7 × 10−9).
14.E.3.56: Q14.3.58
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of the nonionized bases and all ions in a solution that is 0.115 M in NH3 and 0.100 M in
C6H5NH2.
14.E.3.57: S14.3.58
[OH−] = [NO +
4
] = 0.0014 M
[NH3] = 0.144 M [H3O+] = 6.9 × 10−12 M [C 6
H NH
5
+
3
] = 3.9 × 10−8 M [C6H5NH2] = 0.100 M
14.E.3.58: Q14.3.59
Using the Ka values in Appendix H, place Al(H 2
O)
3+
6
in the correct location in Figure.
14.E.3.59: Q14.3.60
Calculate the concentration of all solute species in each of the following solutions of acids or bases. Assume that the ionization of
water can be neglected, and show that the change in the initial concentrations can be neglected. Ionization constants can be found
in Appendix H and Appendix I.
a. 0.0092 M HClO, a weak acid
b. 0.0784 M C6H5NH2, a weak base
c. 0.0810 M HCN, a weak acid
d. 0.11 M (CH3)3N, a weak base
e. 0.120 M Fe(H O) a weak acid, Ka = 1.6 × 10−7
2
2+
14.E.3.60: S14.3.60
+ −
[H O ][ ClO ] (x)(x) (x)(x)
3 −8
= ≈ = 3.5 × 10
[HClO] (0.0092 − x) 0.0092
Solving for x gives 1.79 × 10−5 M. This value is less than 5% of 0.0092, so the assumption that it can be neglected is valid. Thus,
the concentrations of solute species at equilibrium are:
[H3O+] = [ClO] = 1.8 × 10−5 M[HClO] = 0.00092 M [OH−] = 5.6 × 10−10 M;
+ −
[ C H NH ][ OH ] (x)(x) (x)(x)
6 5 3 −10
= ≈ = 4.6 × 10
[ C H NH ] (0.0784 − x) 0.0784
6 5 2
2
+ −
[H O ][ CN ] (x)(x) (x)(x)
Solving for x gives 5.69 × 10−6 M. This value is less than 5% of
3 −10
= ≈ = 4 × 10
[HCN] (0.0810 − x) 0.0810
0.0810, so the assumption that it can be neglected is valid. Thus, the concentrations of solute species at equilibrium are: [H3O+] =
+ −
[ (CH ) NH ][ OH ] (x)(x) (x)(x)
[CN−] = 5.7 × 10−6 M [HCN] = 0.0810 M [OH−] = 1.8 × 10−9 M;
3 3 −5
= ≈ = 7.4 × 10
[ (CH ) N] (0.11 − x) 0.11
3 3
Solving for x gives 2.85 × 10−3 M. This value is less than 5% of 0.11, so the assumption that it can be neglected is valid. Thus, the
concentrations of solute species at equilibrium are: [(CH3)3NH+] = [OH−] = 2.9 × 10−3 M [(CH3)3N] = 0.11 M [H3O+] = 3.5 ×
+ +
[Fe(H O) (OH) ][ H O ] (x)(x) (x)(x)
10−12 M; Solving for x gives 1.39 × 10−4 M. This value is
2 5 3 −7
= ≈ = 1.6 × 10
2+
[Fe(H O) ] (0.120 − x) 0.120
2 6
less than 5% of 0.120, so the assumption that it can be neglected is valid. Thus, the concentrations of solute species at equilibrium
are: [Fe(H2O)5(OH)+] = [H3O+] = 1.4 × 10−4 M [Fe(H O) ] = 0.120 M [OH−] = 7.2 × 10−11 M 2
2+
14.E.3.61: Q14.3.61
Propionic acid, C2H5CO2H (Ka = 1.34 × 10−5), is used in the manufacture of calcium propionate, a food preservative. What is the
hydronium ion concentration in a 0.698-M solution of C2H5CO2H?
14.E.3.62: Q14.3.62
White vinegar is a 5.0% by mass solution of acetic acid in water. If the density of white vinegar is 1.007 g/cm3, what is the pH?
14.E.3.63: S14.3.62
pH = 2.41
14.E.3.64: Q14.3.63
The ionization constant of lactic acid, CH3CH(OH)CO2H, an acid found in the blood after strenuous exercise, is 1.36 × 10−4. If
20.0 g of lactic acid is used to make a solution with a volume of 1.00 L, what is the concentration of hydronium ion in the solution?
14.E.3.65: Q14.3.64
Nicotine, C10H14N2, is a base that will accept two protons (K1 = 7 × 10−7, K2 = 1.4 × 10−11). What is the concentration of each
species present in a 0.050-M solution of nicotine?
14.E.3.66: S14.3.64
[C10H14N2] = 0.049 M
[C10H14N2H+] = 1.9 × 10−4 M [C 10
H
14
N H
2
2+
2
] = 1.4 × 10−11 M [OH−] = 1.9 × 10−4 M [H3O+] = 5.3 × 10−11 M
14.E.3.67: Q14.3.65
The pH of a 0.20-M solution of HF is 1.92. Determine Ka for HF from these data.
14.E.3.68: Q14.3.66
The pH of a 0.15-M solution of HSO is 1.43. Determine Ka for HSO from these data.
−
4
−
14.E.3.69: S14.3.66
−2
Ka = 1.2 × 10
14.E.3.70: Q14.3.67
The pH of a 0.10-M solution of caffeine is 11.16. Determine Kb for caffeine from these data:
+ −
C H N O (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ C H N O H (aq) + OH (aq)
8 10 4 2 2 8 10 4 2
14.E.3.71: Q14.3.68
The pH of a solution of household ammonia, a 0.950 M solution of NH3, is 11.612. Determine Kb for NH3 from these data.
14.E.4.2: Q14.4.2
Determine whether aqueous solutions of the following salts are acidic, basic, or neutral:
a. FeCl3
b. K2CO3
c. NH4Br
d. KClO4
14.E.4.3: S14.4.2
acidic; basic; acidic; neutral
14.E.4.4: Q14.4.3
Novocaine, C13H21O2N2Cl, is the salt of the base procaine and hydrochloric acid. The ionization constant for procaine is 7 × 10−6.
Is a solution of novocaine acidic or basic? What are [H3O+], [OH−], and pH of a 2.0% solution by mass of novocaine, assuming
that the density of the solution is 1.0 g/mL.
[ H2 C O3 ]
−
[ HCO3 ]
2−
[ CO ]
3
14.E.5.2: S15.5.1
[H3O+] and [HCO −
3
] are equal, H3O+ and HCO are practically equal
−
3
14.E.5.3: Q15.5.2
Calculate the concentration of each species present in a 0.050-M solution of H2S.
14.E.5.4: Q15.5.3
Calculate the concentration of each species present in a 0.010-M solution of phthalic acid, C6H4(CO2H)2.
14.E.5.5: S15.5.3
+ − −3
C H (CO H) (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + C H (CO H)(CO ) (aq) Ka = 1.1 × 10
6 4 2 2 2 3 6 4 2 2
+ 2− −6
C H (CO H)(CO )(aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + C H (CO ) (aq) Ka = 3.9 × 10
6 4 2 2 2 3 6 4 2 2
2
3.9 × 10−6 M, [OH−] 3.6 × 10−12 M
]
14.E.5.6: Q15.5.4
Salicylic acid, HOC6H4CO2H, and its derivatives have been used as pain relievers for a long time. Salicylic acid occurs in small
amounts in the leaves, bark, and roots of some vegetation (most notably historically in the bark of the willow tree). Extracts of
these plants have been used as medications for centuries. The acid was first isolated in the laboratory in 1838.
1. Both functional groups of salicylic acid ionize in water, with Ka = 1.0 × 10−3 for the—CO2H group and 4.2 × 10−13 for the −OH
group. What is the pH of a saturated solution of the acid (solubility = 1.8 g/L).
2. Aspirin was discovered as a result of efforts to produce a derivative of salicylic acid that would not be irritating to the stomach
lining. Aspirin is acetylsalicylic acid, CH3CO2C6H4CO2H. The −CO2H functional group is still present, but its acidity is
reduced, Ka = 3.0 × 10−4. What is the pH of a solution of aspirin with the same concentration as a saturated solution of salicylic
acid (See Part a).
3. Under some conditions, aspirin reacts with water and forms a solution of salicylic acid and acetic acid:
CH CO C H CO H(aq) + H O(l) ⟶ HOC H CO H(aq) + CH CO H(aq) (14.E.4)
3 2 6 4 2 2 6 4 2 3 2
i. Which of the acids salicylic acid or acetic acid produces more hydronium ions in solution such a solution?
ii. What are the concentrations of molecules and ions in a solution produced by the hydrolysis of 0.50 g of aspirin dissolved in
enough water to give 75 mL of solution?
14.E.5.7: Q15.5.5
The ion HTe− is an amphiprotic species; it can act as either an acid or a base.
a. What is Ka for the acid reaction of HTe− with H2O?
b. What is Kb for the reaction in which HTe− functions as a base in water?
c. Demonstrate whether or not the second ionization of H2Te can be neglected in the calculation of [HTe−] in a 0.10 M solution of
H2Te.
14.E.5.8: S15.5.5
a. K = 1 × 10 ;
a2
−5
b. K = 4.3 × 10
b
−12
;
2− +
[ Te ][ H O ] (x)(0.0141 + x) (x)(0.0141)
. Solving for x gives 1 × 10−5 M. Therefore, compared with
3
c. −
= ≈
−5
= 1 × 10
[ HTe ] (0.0141 − x) 0.0141
14.E.6.2: Q14.6.2
Explain why the pH does not change significantly when a small amount of an acid or a base is added to a solution that contains
equal amounts of the acid H3PO4 and a salt of its conjugate base NaH2PO4.
14.E.6.3: S14.6.2
Excess H3O+ is removed primarily by the reaction:
H O
3
+
(aq) + H PO
2
−
4
(aq) ⟶ H PO (aq) + H O(l)
3 4 2
Excess base is removed by the reaction:
− −
OH (aq) + H PO (aq) ⟶ H PO (aq) + H O(l)
3 4 2 4 2
14.E.6.4: Q14.6.3
Explain why the pH does not change significantly when a small amount of an acid or a base is added to a solution that contains
equal amounts of the base NH3 and a salt of its conjugate acid NH4Cl.
14.E.6.6: S14.6.4
[H3O+] = 1.5 × 10−4 M
14.E.6.7: Q14.6.5
What is [H3O+] in a solution of 0.075 M HNO2 and 0.030 M NaNO2?
14.E.6.8: S14.6.6
+ − −5
HNO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H O (aq) + NO (aq) Ka = 4.5 × 10
2 2 3 2
14.E.6.9: Q14.6.6
What is [OH−] in a solution of 0.125 M CH3NH2 and 0.130 M CH3NH3Cl?
14.E.6.10: S14.6.6
+ − −4
CH NH (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ CH NH (aq) + OH (aq) Kb = 4.4 × 10
3 2 2 3 3
14.E.6.11: Q14.6.7
What is [OH−] in a solution of 1.25 M NH3 and 0.78 M NH4NO3?
14.E.6.12: S14.6.7
+ − −5
NH (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ NH (aq) + OH (aq) Kb = 1.8 × 10
3 2 4
14.E.6.13: Q14.6.8
What concentration of NH4NO3 is required to make [OH−] = 1.0 × 10−5 in a 0.200-M solution of NH3?
14.E.6.14: S14.6.8
[NH4NO3] = 0.36 M
14.E.6.15: Q14.6.9A
What concentration of NaF is required to make [H3O+] = 2.3 × 10−4 in a 0.300-M solution of HF?
14.E.6.16: Q14.6.9B
What is the effect on the concentration of acetic acid, hydronium ion, and acetate ion when the following are added to an acidic
buffer solution of equal concentrations of acetic acid and sodium acetate:
a. HCl
b. KCH3CO2
c. NaCl
d. KOH
e. CH3CO2H
14.E.6.17: S14.6.10
a. The added HCl will increase the concentration of H3O+ slightly, which will react with CH CO and produce CH3CO2H in the
3
−
b. The added KCH3CO2 will increase the concentration of [CH CO ] which will react with H3O+ and produce CH3CO2 H in the
3
−
2 3
−
e. The added CH3CO2H will increase its concentration, causing more of it to dissociate and producing more [CH CO ] and 3
−
H3O+ in the process. Thus, [H3O+] increases slightly and [CH CO ] increases. 3
−
14.E.6.19: Q14.6.1
A buffer solution is prepared from equal volumes of 0.200 M acetic acid and 0.600 M sodium acetate. Use 1.80 × 10−5 as Ka for
acetic acid.
1. What is the pH of the solution?
2. Is the solution acidic or basic?
14.E.6.20: Q14.6.1
What is the pH of a solution that results when 3.00 mL of 0.034 M HCl is added to 0.200 L of the original buffer?
a. pH = 5.222;
b. The solution is acidic. (c) pH = 5.221
14.E.6.21: Q14.6.1
A 5.36–g sample of NH4Cl was added to 25.0 mL of 1.00 M NaOH and the resulting solution diluted to 0.100 L.
a. What is the pH of this buffer solution?
b. Is the solution acidic or basic?
c. What is the pH of a solution that results when 3.00 mL of 0.034 M HCl is added to the solution?
Which acid in [link] is most appropriate for preparation of a buffer solution with a pH of 3.1? Explain your choice.
+
[H O ]
3
To prepare the best buffer for a weak acid HA and its salt, the ratio should be as close to 1 as possible for effective buffer
Ka
+ + −3.1
action. The [H3O ] concentration in a buffer of pH 3.1 is [H3O ] = 10 = 7.94 × 10−4 M
We can now solve for Ka of the best acid as follows:
+
[H O ]
3
=1
Ka
+
[H O ]
3 −4
Ka = = 7.94 × 10
1
In [link], the acid with the closest Ka to 7.94 × 10−4 is HF, with a Ka of 7.2 × 10−4.
Which acid in [link] is most appropriate for preparation of a buffer solution with a pH of 3.7? Explain your choice.
close to 1 as possible. The pOH of the buffer is 14.00 − 10.65 = 3.35. Therefore, [OH−] is [OH−] = 10−pOH = 10−3.35 = 4.467 × 10−4
M.
−
[ OH ]
We can now solve for Kb of the best base as follows: =1 Kb = [OH−] = 4.47 × 10−4 In [link], the base with the closest Kb
Kb
14.E.6.22: Q14.6.4
Saccharin, C7H4NSO3H, is a weak acid (Ka = 2.1 × 10−2). If 0.250 L of diet cola with a buffered pH of 5.48 was prepared from
2.00 × 10−3 g of sodium saccharide, Na(C7H4NSO3), what are the final concentrations of saccharine and sodium saccharide in the
solution?
14.E.6.23: S14.6.4
The molar mass of sodium saccharide is 205.169 g/mol. Using the abbreviations HA for saccharin and NaA for sodium saccharide
the number of moles of NaA in the solution is:
9.75 × 10−6 mol. This ionizes initially to form saccharin ions, A−, with: [A−] = 3.9 × 10−5 M
14.E.6.24: Q14.6.5
What is the pH of 1.000 L of a solution of 100.0 g of glutamic acid (C5H9NO4, a diprotic acid; K1 = 8.5 × 10−5, K2 = 3.39 × 10−10)
to which has been added 20.0 g of NaOH during the preparation of monosodium glutamate, the flavoring agent? What is the pH
when exactly 1 mol of NaOH per mole of acid has been added?
14.E.7.2: S14.7.1
At the equivalence point in the titration of a weak base with a strong acid, the resulting solution is slightly acidic due to the
presence of the conjugate acid. Thus, pick an indicator that changes color in the acidic range and brackets the pH at the equivalence
point. Methyl orange is a good example.
14.E.7.3: Q14.7.2
Explain why an acid-base indicator changes color over a range of pH values rather than at a specific pH.
14.E.7.4: Q14.7.3
Why can we ignore the contribution of water to the concentrations of H3O+ in the solutions of following acids:
0.0092 M HClO, a weak acid
0.0810 M HCN, a weak acid
0.120 M Fe(H O) a weak acid, Ka = 1.6 × 10−7
2+
2 6
14.E.7.5: S14.7.3
In an acid solution, the only source of OH− ions is water. We use Kw to calculate the concentration. If the contribution from water
was neglected, the concentration of OH− would be zero.
14.E.7.6: Q14.7.4
We can ignore the contribution of water to the concentration of OH− in a solution of the following bases:
14.E.7.7: Q14.7.5
Draw a curve for a series of solutions of HF. Plot [H3O+]total on the vertical axis and the total concentration of HF (the sum of the
concentrations of both the ionized and nonionized HF molecules) on the horizontal axis. Let the total concentration of HF vary
from 1 × 10−10 M to 1 × 10−2 M.
14.E.7.8: Q14.7.6
Draw a curve similar to that shown in Figure for a series of solutions of NH3. Plot [OH−] on the vertical axis and the total
concentration of NH3 (both ionized and nonionized NH3 molecules) on the horizontal axis. Let the total concentration of NH3 vary
from 1 × 10−10 M to 1 × 10−2 M.
14.E.7.9: Q14.7.7
Calculate the pH at the following points in a titration of 40 mL (0.040 L) of 0.100 M barbituric acid (Ka = 9.8 × 10−5) with 0.100 M
KOH.
1. no KOH added
2. 20 mL of KOH solution added
14.E.7.10: S14.7.7
1. pH = 2.50;
2. pH = 4.01;
3. pH = 5.60;
4. pH = 8.35;
5. pH = 11.08
14.E.7.11: Q14.7.8
The indicator dinitrophenol is an acid with a Ka of 1.1 × 10−4. In a 1.0 × 10−4-M solution, it is colorless in acid and yellow in base.
Calculate the pH range over which it goes from 10% ionized (colorless) to 90% ionized (yellow).
This page titled 14.E: Acid-Base Equilibria (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Thumbnail: Lead (II) iodide precipitates when potassium iodide is mixed with lead (II) nitrate. (CC BY-SA 3.0
Unported; PRHaney via Wikipedia)
This page titled 15: Equilibria of Other Reaction Classes is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
15.1: Precipitation and Dissolution
Learning Objectives
Write chemical equations and equilibrium expressions representing solubility equilibria
Carry out equilibrium computations involving solubility, equilibrium expressions, and solute concentrations
The preservation of medical laboratory blood samples, mining of sea water for magnesium, formulation of over-the-counter
medicines such as Milk of Magnesia and antacids, and treating the presence of hard water in your home’s water supply are just a
few of the many tasks that involve controlling the equilibrium between a slightly soluble ionic solid and an aqueous solution of its
ions.
In some cases, we want to prevent dissolution from occurring. Tooth decay, for example, occurs when the calcium hydroxylapatite,
which has the formula Ca5(PO4)3(OH), in our teeth dissolves. The dissolution process is aided when bacteria in our mouths feast on
the sugars in our diets to produce lactic acid, which reacts with the hydroxide ions in the calcium hydroxylapatite. Preventing the
dissolution prevents the decay. On the other hand, sometimes we want a substance to dissolve. We want the calcium carbonate in a
chewable antacid to dissolve because the CO ions produced in this process help soothe an upset stomach.
2−
In this section, we will find out how we can control the dissolution of a slightly soluble ionic solid by the application of Le
Chatelier’s principle. We will also learn how to use the equilibrium constant of the reaction to determine the concentration of ions
present in a solution.
This equilibrium, like other equilibria, is dynamic; some of the solid AgCl continues to dissolve, but at the same time, Ag+ and Cl–
ions in the solution combine to produce an equal amount of the solid. At equilibrium, the opposing processes have equal rates.
Figure 15.1.1 : Silver chloride is a sparingly soluble ionic solid. When it is added to water, it dissolves slightly and produces a
mixture consisting of a very dilute solution of Ag+ and Cl– ions in equilibrium with undissolved silver chloride.
The equilibrium constant for the equilibrium between a slightly soluble ionic solid and a solution of its ions is called the solubility
product (Ksp) of the solid. Recall from the chapter on solutions and colloids that we use an ion’s concentration as an approximation
of its activity in a dilute solution. For silver chloride, at equilibrium:
+ −
AgCl(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + Cl (aq)
with
+ −
Ksp = [ Ag (aq)][ Cl (aq)]
When looking at dissolution reactions such as this, the solid is listed as a reactant, whereas the ions are listed as products. The
solubility product constant, as with every equilibrium constant expression, is written as the product of the concentrations of each of
PbS 7 × 10–29
Al(OH)3 2 × 10–32
Fe(OH)3 4 × 10–38
Some common solubility products are listed in Table 15.1.1 according to their Ksp values, whereas a more extensive compilation of
products appears in Table E3. Each of these equilibrium constants is much smaller than 1 because the compounds listed are only
slightly soluble. A small Ksp represents a system in which the equilibrium lies to the left, so that relatively few hydrated ions would
be present in a saturated solution.
Write the ionic equation for the dissolution and the solubility product expression for each of the following slightly soluble ionic
compounds:
a. AgI, silver iodide, a solid with antiseptic properties
b. CaCO3, calcium carbonate, the active ingredient in many over-the-counter chewable antacids
c. Mg(OH)2, magnesium hydroxide, the active ingredient in Milk of Magnesia
d. Mg(NH4)PO4, magnesium ammonium phosphate, an essentially insoluble substance used in tests for magnesium
e. Ca5(PO4)3OH, the mineral apatite, a source of phosphate for fertilizers
(Hint: When determining how to break (d) and (e) up into ions, refer to the list of polyatomic ions in the section on chemical
nomenclature.)
Solution
a. AgI(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + I (aq)
+ −
Ksp = [ Ag
+ −
][ I ]
3
(aq) Ksp = [ Ca
2+
][ CO
2−
3
]
− 2
c. Mg(OH) (s) ⇌ Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq) K = [Mg ][OH
2
2+ −
sp
2+
]
4
3−
4 sp = [ Mg
2+
][ NH
+
4
][ PO4
3−
]
5 3
e. Ca (PO ) OH(s) ⇌ 5 Ca
5 4 3
2+
(aq) + 3 PO
3−
4
(aq) + OH
−
(aq) Ksp = [ Ca
2+
] [ PO
3−
4
] [ OH
−
]
Exercise 15.1.1
Write the ionic equation for the dissolution and the solubility product for each of the following slightly soluble compounds:
a. BaSO4
b. Ag2SO4
c. Al(OH)3
d. Pb(OH)Cl
Answer a
2+ 2− 2+ 2−
BaSO (s) ⇌ Ba (aq) + SO (aq) Ksp = [ Ba ][ SO ]
4 4 4
Answer b
Answer c
2+ − 3+ − 3
Al (OH) (s) ⇌ Al (aq) + 3 OH (aq) Ksp = [ Al ] [ OH ]
3
Answer d
2+ − − 2+ − −
Pb(OH)Cl(s) ⇌ Pb (aq) + OH (aq) + Cl (aq) Ksp = [ Pb ][ OH ][ Cl ]
Now we will extend the discussion of Ksp and show how the solubility product constant is determined from the solubility of its
ions, as well as how Ksp can be used to determine the molar solubility of a substance.
In this case, we calculate the solubility product by taking the solid’s solubility expressed in units of moles per liter (mol/L), known
as its molar solubility.
We began the chapter with an informal discussion of how the mineral fluorite is formed. Fluorite, CaF2, is a slightly soluble
solid that dissolves according to the equation:
2+ −
CaF (s) ⇌ Ca (aq) + 2 F (aq)
2
The concentration of Ca2+ in a saturated solution of CaF2 is 2.1 × 10–4 M; therefore, that of F– is 4.2 × 10–4 M, that is, twice the
concentration of Ca2+. What is the solubility product of fluorite?
Solution
First, write out the Ksp expression, then substitute in concentrations and solve for Ksp:
2+ −
CaF (s) ⇌ Ca (aq) + 2 F (aq)
2
−4 −4 2
= (2.1 × 10 )(4.2 × 10 )
−11
= 3.7 × 10
Exercise 15.1.2
In a saturated solution that is in contact with solid Mg(OH)2, the concentration of Mg2+ is 3.7 × 10–5 M. What is the solubility
product for Mg(OH)2?
2+ −
Mg (OH) (s) ⇌ Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq)
2
Answer
2.0 × 10–13
Solution
The solubility product constant of copper(I) bromide is 6.3 × 10 . –9
Create an ICE table (as introduced in the chapter on fundamental equilibrium concepts), leaving the CuBr column empty as it
is a solid and does not contribute to the Ksp:
At equilibrium:
+ −
Ksp = [ Cu ][ Br ]
−9 2
6.3 × 10 = (x)(x) = x
−−−−−−−−−−
−9 −5
x = √ (6.3 × 10 ) = 7.9 × 10
Exercise 15.1.3
The Ksp of AgI is 1.5 × 10–16. Calculate the molar solubility of silver iodide.
Answer
1.2 × 10–8 M
Determination of Molar Solubility from Ksp, Part II The Ksp of calcium hydroxide, Ca(OH)2, is 8.0 × 10–6. Calculate the molar
solubility of calcium hydroxide.
Solution
The solubility product constant of calcium hydroxide is 1.3 × 10–6.
The reaction is:
2+ −
Ca (OH) (s) ⇌ Ca (aq) + 2 OH (aq)
2
At equilibrium:
2+ − 2
Ksp = [ Ca ] [ OH ]
−6 2 2 3
1.3 × 10 = (x)(2x ) = (x)(4 x ) = 4 x
−−−−−−−−−
−6
1.3 × 10
3 −3
x =√ = 6.9 × 10
4
Exercise 15.1.4
The Ksp of PbI2 is 1.4 × 10–8. Calculate the molar solubility of lead(II) iodide.
Answer
1.5 × 10–3 M
Note that solubility is not always given as a molar value. When the solubility of a compound is given in some unit other than moles
per liter, we must convert the solubility into moles per liter (i.e., molarity) in order to use it in the solubility product constant
expression. Example 15.1.5 shows how to perform those unit conversions before determining the solubility product equilibrium.
Many of the pigments used by artists in oil-based paints (Figure 15.1.2) are sparingly soluble in water. For example, the
solubility of the artist’s pigment chrome yellow, PbCrO4, is 4.6 × 10–6 g/L. Determine the solubility product equilibrium
constant for PbCrO4.
Figure 15.1.2 : Oil paints contain pigments that are very slightly soluble in water. In addition to chrome yellow (PbCrO4),
examples include Prussian blue (Fe7(CN)18), the reddish-orange color vermilion (HgS), and green color veridian (Cr2O3).
(credit: Sonny Abesamis)
Solution
We are given the solubility of PbCrO4 in grams per liter. If we convert this solubility into moles per liter, we can find the
equilibrium concentrations of Pb2+ and CrO , then Ksp:
2−
4
−8
1.4 × 10 mol PbCrO4
=
1 L
−8
= 1.4 × 10 M
The chemical equation for the dissolution indicates that 1 mol of PbCrO4 gives 1 mol of Pb2+(aq) and 1 mol of CrO 2 −
4
(aq) :
2+ 2−
PbCrO (s) ⇌ Pb (aq) + CrO (aq)
4 4
2+
Thus, both [Pb ] and [CrO 2−
4
] are equal to the molar solubility of PbCrO4:
2+ 2− −8
[ Pb ] = [ CrO ] = 1.4 × 10 M
4
2+
Solve. Ksp = [Pb ] [CrO 2−
4
] = (1.4 × 10–8)(1.4 × 10–8) = 2.0 × 10–16
Exercise 15.1.5
The solubility of TlCl [thallium(I) chloride], an intermediate formed when thallium is being isolated from ores, is 3.46 grams
per liter at 20 °C. What is its solubility product?
Answer
2.08 × 10–4
Calomel, Hg2Cl2, is a compound composed of the diatomic ion of mercury(I), Hg , and chloride ions, Cl–. Although most 2+
mercury compounds are now known to be poisonous, eighteenth-century physicians used calomel as a medication. Their
patients rarely suffered any mercury poisoning from the treatments because calomel is quite insoluble:
2+ − −18
Hg Cl (s) ⇌ Hg (aq) + 2 Cl (aq) Ksp = 1.1 × 10
2 2 2
Solution
The molar solubility of Hg2Cl2 is equal to the concentration of Hg 2+
2
ions because for each 1 mol of Hg2Cl2 that dissolves, 1
mol of Hg forms: 2+
1. Determine the direction of change. Before any Hg2Cl2 dissolves, Q is zero, and the reaction will shift to the right to reach
equilibrium.
2. Determine x and equilibrium concentrations. Concentrations and changes are given in the following ICE table:
mol of Cl– forms for each 1 mol of Hg that forms. Hg2Cl2 is a pure solid, so it does not appear in the calculation.
2+
3. Solve for x and the equilibrium concentrations. We substitute the equilibrium concentrations into the expression for Ksp and
calculate the value of x:
2+ − 2
Ksp = [ Hg ] [ Cl ]
2
−18 2
1.1 × 10 = (x)(2x)
3 −18
4x = 1.1 × 10
−−−−−−−−−−−−
−18
1.1 × 10 −7
3
x = √( ) = 6.5 × 10 M
4
− −7 −6
[ Cl ] = 2x = 2(6.5 × 10 ) = 1.3 × 10 M
Exercise 15.1.6
Determine the molar solubility of MgF2 from its solubility product: Ksp = 6.4 × 10–9.
Answer
1.2 × 10–3 M
Tabulated Ksp values can also be compared to reaction quotients calculated from experimental data to tell whether a solid will
precipitate in a reaction under specific conditions: Q equals Ksp at equilibrium; if Q is less than Ksp, the solid will dissolve until Q
equals Ksp; if Q is greater than Ksp, precipitation will occur at a given temperature until Q equals Ksp.
Various types of medical imaging techniques are used to aid diagnoses of illnesses in a noninvasive manner. One such
technique utilizes the ingestion of a barium compound before taking an X-ray image. A suspension of barium sulfate, a chalky
powder, is ingested by the patient. Since the Ksp of barium sulfate is 1.1 × 10–10, very little of it dissolves as it coats the lining
of the patient’s intestinal tract. Barium-coated areas of the digestive tract then appear on an X-ray as white, allowing for greater
visual detail than a traditional X-ray (Figure 15.1.3).
Further diagnostic testing can be done using barium sulfate and fluoroscopy. In fluoroscopy, a continuous X-ray is passed
through the body so the doctor can monitor, on a TV or computer screen, the barium sulfate’s movement as it passes through
the digestive tract. Medical imaging using barium sulfate can be used to diagnose acid reflux disease, Crohn’s disease, and
ulcers in addition to other conditions.
We can establish this equilibrium either by adding solid calcium carbonate to water or by mixing a solution that contains calcium
ions with a solution that contains carbonate ions. If we add calcium carbonate to water, the solid will dissolve until the
concentrations are such that the value of the reaction quotient (Q=[Ca ][CO ]) is equal to the solubility product (Ksp = 4.8 ×
2+ 2−
3
10–9). If we mix a solution of calcium nitrate, which contains Ca2+ ions, with a solution of sodium carbonate, which contains CO 2−
ions, the slightly soluble ionic solid CaCO3 will precipitate, provided that the concentrations of Ca2+ and CO ions are such that
2−
Q is greater than Ksp for the mixture. The reaction shifts to the left and the concentrations of the ions are reduced by formation of
the solid until the value of Q equals Ksp. A saturated solution in equilibrium with the undissolved solid will result. If the
concentrations are such that Q is less than Ksp, then the solution is not saturated and no precipitate will form.
We can compare numerical values of Q with Ksp to predict whether precipitation will occur, as Example 15.1.7 shows. (Note: Since
all forms of equilibrium constants are temperature dependent, we will assume a room temperature environment going forward in
this chapter unless a different temperature value is explicitly specified.)
The concentration of Mg2+(aq) in sea water is 0.0537 M. Will Mg(OH)2 precipitate when enough Ca(OH)2 is added to give a
[OH–] of 0.0010 M?
Solution
This problem asks whether the reaction:
2+ −
Mg (OH) (s) ⇌ Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq)
2
Because Q is greater than Ksp (Q = 5.4 × 10–8 is larger than Ksp = 8.9 × 10–12), we can expect the reaction to shift to the left
and form solid magnesium hydroxide. Mg(OH)2(s) forms until the concentrations of magnesium ion and hydroxide ion are
reduced sufficiently so that the value of Q is equal to Ksp.
Exercise 15.1.7
Use the solubility products in Table E3 to determine whether CaHPO4 will precipitate from a solution with [Ca2+] = 0.0001 M
and [HPO ] = 0.001 M.
2−
Answer
No precipitation of CaHPO4; Q = 1 × 10–7, which is less than Ksp
Does silver chloride precipitate when equal volumes of a 2.0 × 10–4-M solution of AgNO3 and a 2.0 × 10–4-M solution of NaCl
are mixed?
(Note: The solution also contains Na+ and NO ions, but when referring to solubility rules, one can see that sodium nitrate is
−
Solution
The equation for the equilibrium between solid silver chloride, silver ion, and chloride ion is:
+ −
AgCl(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + Cl (aq)
The reaction quotient, Q, is momentarily greater than Ksp for AgCl, so a supersaturated solution is formed:
+ − −4 −4 −8
Q = [ Ag ][ Cl ] = (1.0 × 10 )(1.0 × 10 ) = 1.0 × 10 > Ksp
Since supersaturated solutions are unstable, AgCl will precipitate from the mixture until the solution returns to equilibrium, with Q
equal to Ksp.
Exercise 15.1.8
Will KClO4 precipitate when 20 mL of a 0.050-M solution of K+ is added to 80 mL of a 0.50-M solution of ClO ? −
(Remember to calculate the new concentration of each ion after mixing the solutions before plugging into the reaction quotient
expression.)
Answer
No, Q = 4.0 × 10–3, which is less than Ksp = 1.07 × 10–2
In the previous two examples, we have seen that Mg(OH)2 or AgCl precipitate when Q is greater than Ksp. In general, when a
solution of a soluble salt of the Mm+ ion is mixed with a solution of a soluble salt of the Xn– ion, the solid, MpXq precipitates if the
Blood will not clot if calcium ions are removed from its plasma. Some blood collection tubes contain salts of the oxalate ion,
C O
2
, for this purpose (Figure 15.1.4). At sufficiently high concentrations, the calcium and oxalate ions form solid,
2−
4
CaC2O4•H2O (which also contains water bound in the solid). The concentration of Ca2+ in a sample of blood serum is 2.2 ×
10–3 M. What concentration of C O ion must be established before CaC2O4•H2O begins to precipitate?
2
2−
Figure 15.1.4 : Anticoagulants can be added to blood that will combine with the Ca2+ ions in blood serum and prevent the
blood from clotting. (credit: modification of work by Neeta Lind)
Solution
The equilibrium expression is:
2+ 2−
CaC O (s) ⇌ Ca (aq) + C O4 (aq)
2 4 2
CaC2O4 does not appear in this expression because it is a solid. Water does not appear because it is the solvent.
Solid CaC2O4 does not begin to form until Q equals Ksp. Because we know Ksp and [Ca2+], we can solve for the concentration
of C O that is necessary to produce the first trace of solid:
2
2−
4
2+ 2− −8
Q = Ksp = [ Ca ][ C O4 ] = 1.96 × 10
2
−3 2− −8
(2.2 × 10 )[ C O ] = 1.96 × 10
2 4
−8
2−
1.96 × 10
−6
[C O ] = = 8.9 × 10
2 4
−3
2.2 × 10
A concentration of [C 2
2−
O
4
] = 8.9 × 10–6 M is necessary to initiate the precipitation of CaC2O4 under these conditions.
Exercise 15.1.9
If a solution contains 0.0020 mol of CrO per liter, what concentration of Ag+ ion must be reached by adding solid AgNO3
2−
4
before Ag2CrO4 begins to precipitate? Neglect any increase in volume upon adding the solid silver nitrate.
Answer
4.5 × 10–9 M
Clothing washed in water that has a manganese [Mn2+(aq)] concentration exceeding 0.1 mg/L (1.8 × 10–6 M) may be stained
by the manganese upon oxidation, but the amount of Mn2+ in the water can be reduced by adding a base. If a person doing
laundry wishes to add a buffer to keep the pH high enough to precipitate the manganese as the hydroxide, Mn(OH)2, what pH
is required to keep [Mn2+] equal to 1.8 × 10–6 M?
Solution
The dissolution of Mn(OH)2 is described by the equation:
2+ − −13
Mn(OH) (s) ⇌ Mn (aq) + 2 OH (aq) Ksp = 2 × 10
2
We need to calculate the concentration of OH– when the concentration of Mn2+ is 1.8 × 10–6 M. From that, we calculate the
pH. At equilibrium:
2+ − 2
Ksp = [ Mn ] [ OH ]
or
−6 − 2 −13
(1.8 × 10 )[ OH ] = 2 × 10
so
− −4
[ OH ] = 3.3 × 10 M
If the person doing laundry adds a base, such as the sodium silicate (Na4SiO4) in some detergents, to the wash water until the pH is
raised to 10.52, the manganese ion will be reduced to a concentration of 1.8 × 10–6 M; at that concentration or less, the ion will not
stain clothing.
Exercise 15.1.10
The first step in the preparation of magnesium metal is the precipitation of Mg(OH)2 from sea water by the addition of
Ca(OH)2. The concentration of Mg2+(aq) in sea water is 5.37 × 10–2 M. Calculate the pH at which [Mg2+] is diminished to 1.0
× 10–5 M by the addition of Ca(OH)2.
Answer
10.97
Due to their light sensitivity, mixtures of silver halides are used in fiber optics for medical lasers, in photochromic eyeglass lenses
(glass lenses that automatically darken when exposed to sunlight), and—before the advent of digital photography—in photographic
film. Even though AgCl (Ksp = 1.6 × 10–10), AgBr (Ksp = 5.0 × 10–13), and AgI (Ksp = 1.5 × 10–16) are each quite insoluble, we
cannot prepare a homogeneous solid mixture of them by adding Ag+ to a solution of Cl–, Br–, and I–; essentially all of the AgI will
precipitate before any of the other solid halides form because of its smaller value for Ksp. However, we can prepare a homogeneous
mixture of the solids by slowly adding a solution of Cl–, Br–, and I– to a solution of Ag+.
manufacturing facilities. An abundance of phosphate causes excess algae to grow, which impacts the amount of oxygen available
for marine life as well as making water unsuitable for human consumption.
Figure 15.1.5 : Wastewater treatment facilities, such as this one, remove contaminants from wastewater before the water is released
back into the natural environment. (credit: “eutrophication&hypoxia”/Wikimedia Commons)
One common way to remove phosphates from water is by the addition of calcium hydroxide, known as lime, Ca(OH)2. The lime is
converted into calcium carbonate, a strong base, in the water. As the water is made more basic, the calcium ions react with
phosphate ions to produce hydroxylapatite, Ca5(PO4)3(OH), which then precipitates out of the solution:
2+ 3− −
5 Ca + 3 PO + OH ⇌ Ca (PO ) ⋅ (OH) (s)
4 10 4 6 2
The precipitate is then removed by filtration and the water is brought back to a neutral pH by the addition of CO2 in a recarbonation
process. Other chemicals can also be used for the removal of phosphates by precipitation, including iron(III) chloride and
aluminum sulfate.
Selective precipitation can also be used in qualitative analysis. In this method, reagents are added to an unknown chemical mixture
in order to induce precipitation. Certain reagents cause specific ions to precipitate out; therefore, the addition of the reagent can be
used to determine whether the ion is present in the solution.
Solution
The two equilibria involved are:
+ − −10
AgCl(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) Ksp = 1.6 × 10
+ − −16
AgI(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + I (aq) Ksp = 1.5 × 10
If the solution contained about equal concentrations of Cl– and I–, then the silver salt with the smallest Ksp (AgI) would precipitate
first. The concentrations are not equal, however, so we should find the [Ag+] at which AgCl begins to precipitate and the [Ag+] at
which AgI begins to precipitate. The salt that forms at the lower [Ag+] precipitates first.
Exercise 15.1.11
If silver nitrate solution is added to a solution which is 0.050 M in both Cl– and Br– ions, at what [Ag+] would precipitation
begin, and what would be the formula of the precipitate?
Answer
[Ag+] = 1.0 × 10–11 M; AgBr precipitates first
If we were to add potassium iodide (KI) to this solution, we would be adding a substance that shares a common ion with silver
iodide. Le Chatelier’s principle tells us that when a change is made to a system at equilibrium, the reaction will shift to counteract
that change. In this example, there would be an excess of iodide ions, so the reaction would shift toward the left, causing more
silver iodide to precipitate out of solution.
Calculate the molar solubility of cadmium sulfide (CdS) in a 0.010-M solution of cadmium bromide (CdBr2). The Ksp of CdS
is 1.0 × 10–28.
Solution
The first thing you should notice is that the cadmium sulfide is dissolved in a solution that contains cadmium ions. We need to
use an ICE table to set up this problem and include the CdBr2 concentration as a contributor of cadmium ions:
2+ 2−
CdS(s) ⇌ Cd (aq) + S (aq)
2+ 2− −28
Ksp = [ Cd ][ S ] = 1.0 × 10
−28 2 −28
(0.010 + x)(x) = 1.0 × 10 x + 0.010x − 1.0 × 10 =0
We can solve this equation using the quadratic formula, but we can also make an assumption to make this calculation much
simpler. Since the Ksp value is so small compared with the cadmium concentration, we can assume that the change between the
initial concentration and the equilibrium concentration is negligible, so that 0.010 + x ~ 0.010. Going back to our Ksp expression,
we would now get:
2+ 2− −28
Ksp = [ Cd ][ S ] = 1.0 × 10
−28
(0.010)(x) = 1.0 × 10
−26
x = 1.0 × 10
Exercise 15.1.12
Calculate the molar solubility of aluminum hydroxide, Al(OH)3, in a 0.015-M solution of aluminum nitrate, Al(NO3)3. The Ksp
of Al(OH)3 is 2 × 10–32.
Answer
4 × 10–11
Summary
The equilibrium constant for an equilibrium involving the precipitation or dissolution of a slightly soluble ionic solid is called the
solubility product, Ksp, of the solid. When we have a heterogeneous equilibrium involving the slightly soluble solid MpXq and its
ions Mm+ and Xn–:
m+ n−
Mp Xq (s) ⇌ p M (aq) + q X (aq)
The solubility product of a slightly soluble electrolyte can be calculated from its solubility; conversely, its solubility can be
calculated from its Ksp, provided the only significant reaction that occurs when the solid dissolves is the formation of its ions. A
slightly soluble electrolyte begins to precipitate when the magnitude of the reaction quotient for the dissolution reaction exceeds the
magnitude of the solubility product. Precipitation continues until the reaction quotient equals the solubility product. A reagent can
be added to a solution of ions to allow one ion to selectively precipitate out of solution. The common ion effect can also play a role
in precipitation reactions. In the presence of an ion in common with one of the ions in the solution, Le Chatelier’s principle applies
and more precipitate comes out of solution so that the molar solubility is reduced.
Glossary
common ion effect
molar solubility
solubility of a compound expressed in units of moles per liter (mol/L)
selective precipitation
process in which ions are separated using differences in their solubility with a given precipitating reagent
This page titled 15.1: Precipitation and Dissolution is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In 1923, G. N. Lewis proposed a generalized definition of acid-base behavior in which acids and bases are identified by their ability
to accept or to donate a pair of electrons and form a coordinate covalent bond.
A coordinate covalent bond (or dative bond) occurs when one of the atoms in the bond provides both bonding electrons. For
example, a coordinate covalent bond occurs when a water molecule combines with a hydrogen ion to form a hydronium ion. A
coordinate covalent bond also results when an ammonia molecule combines with a hydrogen ion to form an ammonium ion. Both
of these equations are shown here.
In the following reaction, each of two ammonia molecules, Lewis bases, donates a pair of electrons to a silver ion, the Lewis acid:
Nonmetal oxides act as Lewis acids and react with oxide ions, Lewis bases, to form oxyanions:
The last displacement reaction shows how the reaction of a Brønsted-Lowry acid with a base fits into the Lewis concept. A
Brønsted-Lowry acid such as HCl is an acid-base adduct according to the Lewis concept, and proton transfer occurs because a
more stable acid-base adduct is formed. Thus, although the definitions of acids and bases in the two theories are quite different, the
theories overlap considerably.
Many slightly soluble ionic solids dissolve when the concentration of the metal ion in solution is decreased through the formation
of complex (polyatomic) ions in a Lewis acid-base reaction. For example, silver chloride dissolves in a solution of ammonia
+ +
because the silver ion reacts with ammonia to form the complex ion Ag(NH ) . The Lewis structure of the Ag(NH ) ion is:
3 2 3 2
+ +
Ag (aq) + 2 NH (aq) ⟶ Ag (NH ) (aq)
3 3 2
+ −
Net: AgCl(s) + 2 NH (aq) ⟶ Ag (NH ) (aq) + Cl (aq)
3 3 2
Aluminum hydroxide dissolves in a solution of sodium hydroxide or another strong base because of the formation of the complex
− −
ion Al(OH) . The Lewis structure of the Al(OH) ion is:
4 4
3+ − −
Al (aq) + 4 OH (aq) ⟶ Al (OH) 4 (aq)
− −
Net: Al (OH) (s) + OH (aq) ⟶ Al (OH) (aq)
3 4
Mercury(II) sulfide dissolves in a solution of sodium sulfide because HgS reacts with the S2– ion:
2+ 2−
HgS(s) ⟶ Hg (aq) + S (aq)
2+ 2− 2−
Hg (aq) + 2 S (aq) ⟶ HgS2 (aq)
2− 2−
Net: HgS(s) + S (aq) ⟶ HgS (aq)
2
A complex ion consists of a central atom, typically a transition metal cation, surrounded by ions, or molecules called ligands. These
ligands can be neutral molecules like H2O or NH3, or ions such as CN– or OH–. Often, the ligands act as Lewis bases, donating a
pair of electrons to the central atom. The ligands aggregate themselves around the central atom, creating a new ion with a charge
equal to the sum of the charges and, most often, a transitional metal ion. This more complex arrangement is why the resulting ion is
called a complex ion. The complex ion formed in these reactions cannot be predicted; it must be determined experimentally. The
types of bonds formed in complex ions are called coordinate covalent bonds, as electrons from the ligands are being shared with the
central atom. Because of this, complex ions are sometimes referred to as coordination complexes. This will be studied further in
upcoming chapters.
The equilibrium constant for the reaction of the components of a complex ion to form the complex ion in solution is called a
formation constant (Kf) (sometimes called a stability constant). For example, the complex ion Cu(CN) is shown here: −
At equilibrium:
−
[Cu(CN)2 ]
Kf = Q =
+ − 2
[ Cu ] [ CN ]
The inverse of the formation constant is the dissociation constant (Kd), the equilibrium constant for the decomposition of a complex
ion into its components in solution. We will work with dissociation constants further in the exercises for this section. Table E4 and
Table 15.2.1 are tables of formation constants. In general, the larger the formation constant, the more stable the complex; however,
as in the case of Ksp values, the stoichiometry of the compound must be considered.
Table 15.2.1 : Common Complex Ions by Decreasing Formation Constants
Substance Kf at 25 °C
[Cd(CN) ]
4
2−
3 × 1018
1.7 × 107
+
Ag(NH )
3 2
[AlF ]
6
3−
7 × 1019
As an example of dissolution by complex ion formation, let us consider what happens when we add aqueous ammonia to a mixture
of silver chloride and water. Silver chloride dissolves slightly in water, giving a small concentration of Ag+ ([Ag+] = 1.3 × 10–5 M):
+ −
AgCl(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + Cl (aq)
+
However, if NH3 is present in the water, the complex ion, Ag(NH 3
)
2
, can form according to the equation:
+ +
Ag (aq) + 2 NH (aq) ⇌ Ag (NH ) (aq)
3 3 2
with
The large size of this formation constant indicates that most of the free silver ions produced by the dissolution of AgCl combine
with NH3 to form Ag(NH ) . As a consequence, the concentration of silver ions, [Ag+], is reduced, and the reaction quotient for
3
+
the dissolution of silver chloride, [Ag+][Cl–], falls below the solubility product of AgCl:
+ −
Q = [ Ag ][ Cl ] < Ksp
More silver chloride then dissolves. If the concentration of ammonia is great enough, all of the silver chloride dissolves.
Calculate the concentration of the silver ion in a solution that initially is 0.10 M with respect to Ag(NH 3
)
+
2
.
Solution
We use the familiar path to solve this problem:
+
1. Determine the direction of change. The complex ion Ag(NH 3
)
2
is in equilibrium with its components, as represented by
the equation:
+ +
Ag (aq) + 2 NH (aq) ⇌ Ag (NH ) (aq)
3 3 2
We write the equilibrium as a formation reaction because Table E4 lists formation constants for complex ions. Before equilibrium,
0.10
the reaction quotient is larger than the equilibrium constant (K_f = 1.7 \times 10^7\), and Q = =∞ (it is infinitely large),
0 ×0
so the reaction shifts to the left to reach equilibrium.
This page titled 15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
There are times when one equilibrium reaction does not adequately describe the system being studied. Sometimes we have more
than one type of equilibrium occurring at once (for example, an acid-base reaction and a precipitation reaction).
The ocean is a unique example of a system with multiple equilibria, or multiple states of solubility equilibria working
simultaneously. Carbon dioxide in the air dissolves in sea water, forming carbonic acid (H2CO3). The carbonic acid then ionizes to
form hydrogen ions and bicarbonate ions (HCO ) , which can further ionize into more hydrogen ions and carbonate ions (CO ):
−
3
2−
CO (g) ⇌ CO (aq)
2 2
CO (aq) + H O ⇌ H CO (aq)
2 2 2 3
+ −
H CO (aq) ⇌ H (aq) + HCO (aq)
2 3 3
− + 2−
HCO3 (aq) ⇌ H (aq) + CO3 (aq)
The excess H+ ions make seawater more acidic. Increased ocean acidification can then have negative impacts on reef-building
coral, as they cannot absorb the calcium carbonate they need to grow and maintain their skeletons (Figure 15.3.1). This in turn
disrupts the local biosystem that depends upon the health of the reefs for its survival. If enough local reefs are similarly affected,
the disruptions to sea life can be felt globally. The world’s oceans are presently in the midst of a period of intense acidification,
believed to have begun in the mid-nineteenth century, and which is now accelerating at a rate faster than any change to oceanic pH
in the last 20 million years.
Figure 15.3.1 : Healthy coral reefs (a) support a dense and diverse array of sea life across the ocean food chain. But when coral are
unable to adequately build and maintain their calcium carbonite skeletons because of excess ocean acidification, the unhealthy reef
(b) is only capable of hosting a small fraction of the species as before, and the local food chain starts to collapse. (credit a:
modification of work by NOAA Photo Library; credit b: modification of work by “prilfish”/Flickr).
Learn more about ocean acidification and how it affects other marine creatures.
Slightly soluble solids derived from weak acids generally dissolve in strong acids, unless their solubility products are extremely
small. For example, we can dissolve CuCO3, FeS, and Ca3(PO4)2 in HCl because their basic anions react to form weak acids
(H2CO3, H2S, and H PO ). The resulting decrease in the concentration of the anion results in a shift of the equilibrium
2
−
When exposed to acid, phosphate ions react with hydronium ions to form hydrogen phosphate ions and ultimately, phosphoric acid:
3− + 2−
PO (aq) + H O ⇌ H PO +H O
4 3 2 4 2
2− + −
PO (aq) + H O ⇌ H PO +H O
4 3 2 4 2
− +
H PO +H O ⇌ H PO +H O
2 4 3 3 4 2
These reactions decrease the phosphate and hydroxide ion concentrations, and additional hydroxylapatite dissolves in an acidic
solution in accord with Le Chatelier’s principle. Our teeth develop cavities when acid waste produced by bacteria growing on them
causes the hydroxylapatite of the enamel to dissolve. Fluoride toothpastes contain sodium fluoride, NaF, or stannous fluoride [more
properly named tin(II) fluoride], SnF2. They function by replacing the OH– ion in hydroxylapatite with F– ion, producing
fluorapatite, Ca5(PO4)3F:
+ −
NaF + Ca (PO ) OH ⇌ Ca (PO ) F + Na + OH
5 4 3 5 4 3
The resulting Ca5(PO4)3F is slightly less soluble than Ca5(PO4)3OH, and F– is a weaker base than OH–. Both of these factors make
the fluorapatite more resistant to attack by acids than hydroxylapatite. See the Chemistry in Everyday Life feature on the role of
fluoride in preventing tooth decay for more information.
As we saw previously, fluoride ions help protect our teeth by reacting with hydroxylapatite to form fluorapatite, Ca5(PO4)3F.
Since it lacks a hydroxide ion, fluorapatite is more resistant to attacks by acids in our mouths and is thus less soluble,
protecting our teeth. Scientists discovered that naturally fluorinated water could be beneficial to your teeth, and so it became
common practice to add fluoride to drinking water. Toothpastes and mouthwashes also contain amounts of fluoride (Figure
15.3.3).
Figure 15.3.3 : Fluoride, found in many toothpastes, helps prevent tooth decay (credit: Kerry Ceszyk).
Unfortunately, excess fluoride can negate its advantages. Natural sources of drinking water in various parts of the world have
varying concentrations of fluoride, and places where that concentration is high are prone to certain health risks when there is
When acid rain attacks limestone or marble, which are calcium carbonates, a reaction occurs that is similar to the acid attack on
hydroxylapatite. The hydronium ion from the acid rain combines with the carbonate ion from calcium carbonates and forms the
hydrogen carbonate ion, a weak acid:
+ 2− −
H O (aq) + CO (aq) ⟶ HCO (aq) + H O(l)
3 3 3 2
Calcium hydrogen carbonate, Ca(HCO3)2, is soluble, so limestone and marble objects slowly dissolve in acid rain.
If calcium carbonate is added to a concentrated acid, hydronium ion reacts with the carbonate ion according to the equation:
+ 2−
2H O (aq) + CO (aq) ⟶ H CO (aq) + 2 H O(l)
3 3 2 3 2
(Acid rain is usually not sufficiently acidic to cause this reaction; however, laboratory acids are.) The solution may become
saturated with the weak electrolyte carbonic acid, which is unstable, and carbon dioxide gas can be evolved:
These reactions decrease the carbonate ion concentration, and additional calcium carbonate dissolves. If enough acid is present, the
concentration of carbonate ion is reduced to such a low level that the reaction quotient for the dissolution of calcium carbonate
remains less than the solubility product of calcium carbonate, even after all of the calcium carbonate has dissolved.
Calculate the concentration of ammonium ion that is required to prevent the precipitation of Mg(OH)2 in a solution with
[Mg2+] = 0.10 M and [NH3] = 0.10 M.
Solution
Two equilibria are involved in this system:
Reaction (1): Mg(OH) (s) ⇌ Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq); K = 8.9 × 10
2
2+ −
sp
−12
4
−
sp
−5
To prevent the formation of solid Mg(OH)2, we must adjust the concentration of OH– so that the reaction quotient for Equation
(1), Q = [Mg2+][OH–]2, is less than Ksp for Mg(OH)2. (To simplify the calculation, we determine the concentration of OH–
when Q = Ksp.) [OH–] can be reduced by the addition of NH , which shifts Reaction (2) to the left and reduces [OH–].
+
4
− −6
[ OH ] = 9.4 × 10 M
Solid Mg(OH)2 will not form in this solution when [OH ] is less than 9.4 × 10–6 M.
–
+
[ NH ] = 0.19 M
4
When [NH ] equals 0.19 M, [OH–] will be 9.4 × 10–6 M. Any [NH
+
4
+
4
] greater than 0.19 M will reduce [OH–] below 9.4 × 10–6
M and prevent the formation of Mg(OH)2.
+ 2− −26
2 H O(l) + H S(aq) ⇌ 2 H O (aq) + S (aq) K = 1.0 × 10
2 2 3
and calculate the concentration of hydronium ion required to prevent the precipitation of ZnS in a solution that is 0.050 M in
Zn2+ and saturated with H2S (0.10 M H2S).
Answer
+
[H O ] > 0.2 M
3
([S2–] is less than 2 × 10–26 M and precipitation of ZnS does not occur.)
Therefore, precise calculations of the solubility of solids from the solubility product are limited to cases in which the only
significant reaction occurring when the solid dissolves is the formation of its ions.
Unexposed silver halides are removed from photographic film when they react with sodium thiosulfate (Na2S2O3, called hypo)
to form the complex ion Ag(S O ) (Kf = 4.7 × 1013). The reaction with silver bromide is:
3−
2 3 2
What mass of Na2S2O3 is required to prepare 1.00 L of a solution that will dissolve 1.00 g of AgBr by the formation of
3−
Ag(S O )
2 3
? 2
Solution
Two equilibria are involved when AgBr dissolves in a solution containing the S 2
O3
2−
ion:
Reaction (1): AgBr(s) ⇌ Ag +
(aq) + Br
−
(aq) Ksp = 5.0 × 10
−13
3−
Reaction (2): Ag (aq) + S O
+
2
2−
3
(aq) ⇌ Ag (S O )
2 3 2
(aq) Kf = 4.7 × 10
13
In order for 1.00 g of AgBr to dissolve, the [Ag+] in the solution that results must be low enough for Q for Reaction (1) to be
smaller than Ksp for this reaction. We reduce [Ag+] by adding S O and thus cause Reaction (2) to shift to the right. We need
2
2−
3
the following steps to determine what mass of Na2S2O3 is needed to provide the necessary S O . 2
2−
1. We calculate the [Br–] produced by the complete dissolution of 1.00 g of AgBr (5.33 × 10–3 mol AgBr) in 1.00 L of solution:
− −3
[ Br ] = 5.33 × 10 M
We use [Br–] and Ksp to determine the maximum possible concentration of Ag+ that can be present without causing
reprecipitation of AgBr:
+ −11
[ Ag ] = 9.4 × 10 M
We determine the [S O ] required to make [Ag+] = 9.4 × 10–11 M after the remaining Ag+ ion has reacted with S
2
2−
3
2−
2 O3
3−
[Ag (S O ) ]
2 3 2 13
Kf = = 4.7 × 10
+ 2− 2
[ Ag ][S O ]
2 3
2− −3
[S O ] = 1.1 × 10 M
2 3
When [S 2
2−
O
3
] is 1.1 × 10–3 M, [Ag+] is 9.4 × 10–11 M and all AgBr remains dissolved.
We determine the total number of moles of S O that must be added to the solution. This equals the amount that reacts
2
2−
with Ag+ to form Ag(S O ) plus the amount of free S O in solution at equilibrium. To form 5.33 × 10–3 mol of
2 3
3−
2 2
2−
Ag(S O )
2 3 2
requires 2 × (5.33 × 10–3) mol of S O . In addition, 1.1 × 10–3 mol of unreacted S O is present (Step 3).
3−
2
2−
3 2
2−
−3 2− −3 2− −2 2−
2 × (5.33 × 10 mol S2 O ) + 1.1 × 10 mol S2 O = 1.18 × 10 mol S2 O
3 3 3
Thus, 1.00 L of a solution prepared from 1.9 g Na2S2O3 dissolves 1.0 g of AgBr.
Exercise 15.3.2
AgCl(s), silver chloride, is well known to have a very low solubility: Ag(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) , Ksp = 1.6 × 10–10. + −
Adding ammonia significantly increases the solubility of AgCl because a complex ion is formed:
+ 7
Ag (aq) + 2 NH (aq) ⇌ Ag (NH ) (aq) , Kf = 1.7 × 10 . What mass of NH3 is required to prepare 1.00 L of solution that
+
3 3 2
+
will dissolve 2.00 g of AgCl by formation of Ag(NH ) ? 3 2
Answer
1.00 L of a solution prepared with 4.81 g NH3 dissolves 2.0 g of AgCl.
This could be important to a laundry because clothing washed in water that has a manganese concentration exceeding 0.1 mg per
liter may be stained by the manganese. We can reduce the concentration of manganese by increasing the concentration of hydroxide
ion. We could add, for example, a small amount of NaOH or some other base such as the silicates found in many laundry
detergents. As the concentration of OH– ion increases, the equilibrium responds by shifting to the left and reducing the
concentration of Mn2+ ion while increasing the amount of solid Mn(OH)2 in the equilibrium mixture, as predicted by Le Chatelier’s
principle.
What is the effect on the amount of solid Mg(OH)2 that dissolves and the concentrations of Mg2+ and OH– when each of the
following are added to a mixture of solid Mg(OH)2 in water at equilibrium?
a. MgCl2
b. KOH
Solution
The equilibrium among solid Mg(OH)2 and a solution of Mg2+ and OH– is:
2+ −
Mg (OH) (s) ⇌ Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq)
2
(a) The reaction shifts to the left to relieve the stress produced by the additional Mg2+ ion, in accordance with Le Chatelier’s
principle. In quantitative terms, the added Mg2+ causes the reaction quotient to be larger than the solubility product (Q > Ksp),
and Mg(OH)2 forms until the reaction quotient again equals Ksp. At the new equilibrium, [OH–] is less and [Mg2+] is greater
than in the solution of Mg(OH)2 in pure water. More solid Mg(OH)2 is present.
(b) The reaction shifts to the left to relieve the stress of the additional OH– ion. Mg(OH)2 forms until the reaction quotient
again equals Ksp. At the new equilibrium, [OH–] is greater and [Mg2+] is less than in the solution of Mg(OH)2 in pure water.
More solid Mg(OH)2 is present.
(c) The concentration of OH– is reduced as the OH– reacts with the acid. The reaction shifts to the right to relieve the stress of
less OH– ion. In quantitative terms, the decrease in the OH– concentration causes the reaction quotient to be smaller than the
solubility product (Q < Ksp), and additional Mg(OH)2 dissolves until the reaction quotient again equals Ksp. At the new
equilibrium, [OH–] is less and [Mg2+] is greater than in the solution of Mg(OH)2 in pure water. More Mg(OH)2 is dissolved.
(d) NaNO3 contains none of the species involved in the equilibrium, so we should expect that it has no appreciable effect on
the concentrations of Mg2+ and OH–. (As we have seen previously, dissolved salts change the activities of the ions of an
electrolyte. However, the salt effect is generally small, and we shall neglect the slight errors that may result from it.)
(e) The addition of solid Mg(OH)2 has no effect on the solubility of Mg(OH)2 or on the concentration of Mg2+ and OH–. The
concentration of Mg(OH)2 does not appear in the equation for the reaction quotient:
2+ − 2
Q = [ Mg ] [ OH ]
Thus, changing the amount of solid magnesium hydroxide in the mixture has no effect on the value of Q, and no shift is
required to restore Q to the value of the equilibrium constant.
Exercise 15.3.3
What is the effect on the amount of solid NiCO3 that dissolves and the concentrations of Ni2+ and CO
2−
3
when each of the
following are added to a mixture of the slightly soluble solid NiCO3 and water at equilibrium?
a. Ni(NO3)2
b. KClO4
c. NiCO3
d. K2CO3
e. HNO3 (reacts with carbonate giving HCO or H2O and CO2)
−
3
Answer
(a) mass of NiCO3(s) increases, [Ni2+] increases, [CO ] decreases; (b) no appreciable effect; (c) no effect except to increase
2−
3
the amount of solid NiCO3; (d) mass of NiCO3(s) increases, [Ni2+] decreases, [CO ] increases; (e) mass of NiCO3(s)
2−
Summary
Several systems we encounter consist of multiple equilibria, systems where two or more equilibria processes are occurring
simultaneously. Some common examples include acid rain, fluoridation, and dissolution of carbon dioxide in sea water. When
Glossary
multiple equilibrium
system characterized by more than one state of balance between a slightly soluble ionic solid and an aqueous solution of ions
working simultaneously
This page titled 15.3: Coupled Equilibria is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
x (15.E.2)
––––––
2+ 2−
CaCO (s) ⟶ Ca (aq) + CO3 (aq) (15.E.3)
3
x (15.E.4)
––––––
2+ −
Mg (OH) (s) ⟶ Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq) (15.E.5)
2
x (15.E.6)
––––––
2+ 3−
Mg (PO ) (s) ⟶ 3 Mg (aq) + 2 PO (aq) (15.E.7)
3 4 2 4
x (15.E.8)
––––––
2+ 3− −
Ca (PO ) OH(s) ⟶ 5 Ca (aq) + 3 PO4 (aq) + OH (aq) (15.E.9)
5 4 3
x (15.E.10)
–––––– ––––––
15.E.1.2: S15.1.1
+ −
AgI(s) ⟶ Ag (aq) + I (aq) (15.E.11)
x x (15.E.12)
–
–
2+ 2−
CaCO (s) ⟶ Ca (aq) + CO (aq) (15.E.13)
3 3
x x (15.E.14)
–
–
2+ −
Mg (OH) (s) ⟶ Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq) (15.E.15)
2
x 2x (15.E.16)
–––
2+ 3−
Mg (PO ) (s) ⟶ 3 Mg (aq) + 2 PO4 (aq) (15.E.17)
3 4 2
3x 2x (15.E.18)
–––
2+ 3− −
Ca (PO ) OH(s) ⟶ 5 Ca (aq) + 3 PO (aq) + OH (aq) (15.E.19)
5 4 3 4
5x 3x x (15.E.20)
––– –––
15.E.1.3: Q15.1.2
Complete the changes in concentrations for each of the following reactions:
2+ 2−
BaSO (s) ⟶ Ba (aq) + SO (aq) (15.E.21)
4 4
x (15.E.22)
––––––
+ 2−
Ag SO (s) ⟶ 2 Ag (aq) + SO 4 (aq) (15.E.23)
2 4
x (15.E.24)
––––––
3+ −
Al (OH) (s) ⟶ Al (aq) + 3 OH (aq) (15.E.25)
3
x (15.E.26)
––––––
2+ − −
Pb(OH)Cl(s) ⟶ Pb (aq) + OH (aq) + Cl (aq) (15.E.27)
x (15.E.28)
–––––– ––––––
2+ 3−
Ca (AsO ) (s) ⟶ 3 Ca (aq) + 2 AsO (aq) (15.E.29)
3 4 2 4
3x (15.E.30)
––––––
15.E.1.4: Q15.1.3
How do the concentrations of Ag+ and CrO 2−
4
in a saturated solution above 1.0 g of solid Ag2CrO4 change when 100 g of solid
Ag2CrO4 is added to the system? Explain.
15.E.1.6: Q15.1.4
How do the concentrations of Pb2+ and S2– change when K2S is added to a saturated solution of PbS?
15.E.1.7: Q15.1.5
What additional information do we need to answer the following question: How is the equilibrium of solid silver bromide with a
saturated solution of its ions affected when the temperature is raised?
15.E.1.8: S15.1.5
The solubility of silver bromide at the new temperature must be known. Normally the solubility increases and some of the solid
silver bromide will dissolve.
15.E.1.9: Q15.1.6
Which of the following slightly soluble compounds has a solubility greater than that calculated from its solubility product because
of hydrolysis of the anion present: CoSO3, CuI, PbCO3, PbCl2, Tl2S, KClO4?
15.E.1.10: Q15.1.7
Which of the following slightly soluble compounds has a solubility greater than that calculated from its solubility product because
of hydrolysis of the anion present: AgCl, BaSO4, CaF2, Hg2I2, MnCO3, ZnS, PbS?
15.E.1.11: S15.1.7
CaF2, MnCO3, and ZnS
15.E.1.12: Q15.1.8
Write the ionic equation for dissolution and the solubility product (Ksp) expression for each of the following slightly soluble ionic
compounds:
a. PbCl2
b. Ag2S
c. Sr3(PO4)2
d. SrSO4
15.E.1.13: Q15.1.9
Write the ionic equation for the dissolution and the Ksp expression for each of the following slightly soluble ionic compounds:
a. LaF3
b. CaCO3
c. Ag2SO4
d. Pb(OH)2
15.E.1.14: Q15.1.10
− 3
a. LaF (s) ⇌ La (aq) + 3 F (aq) K
3
3+ −
sp = [ La
3+
][F ] ;
− 2
d. Pb(OH) 2
(s) ⇌ Pb
2+
(aq) + 2 OH
−
(aq) Ksp = [ Pb
2+
] [ OH ]
15.E.1.15: Q15.1.11
The Handbook of Chemistry and Physics gives solubilities of the following compounds in grams per 100 mL of water. Because
these compounds are only slightly soluble, assume that the volume does not change on dissolution and calculate the solubility
product for each.
a. BaSiF6, 0.026 g/100 mL (contains SiF 2−
6
ions)
b. Ce(IO3)4, 1.5 × 10–2 g/100 mL
15.E.1.16: Q15.1.12
The Handbook of Chemistry and Physics gives solubilities of the following compounds in grams per 100 mL of water. Because
these compounds are only slightly soluble, assume that the volume does not change on dissolution and calculate the solubility
product for each.
a. BaSeO4, 0.0118 g/100 mL
b. Ba(BrO3)2•H2O, 0.30 g/100 mL
c. NH4MgAsO4•6H2O, 0.038 g/100 mL
d. La2(MoO4)3, 0.00179 g/100 mL
15.E.1.17: S15.1.12
(a)1.77 × 10–7; 1.6 × 10–6; 2.2 × 10–9; 7.91 × 10–22
15.E.1.18: Q15.1.13
Use solubility products and predict which of the following salts is the most soluble, in terms of moles per liter, in pure water: CaF2,
Hg2Cl2, PbI2, or Sn(OH)2.
15.E.1.19: Q15.1.14
Assuming that no equilibria other than dissolution are involved, calculate the molar solubility of each of the following from its
solubility product:
a. KHC4H4O6
b. PbI2
c. Ag4[Fe(CN)6], a salt containing the Fe(CN) ion−
d. Hg2I2
15.E.1.20: S15.1.15
2 × 10–2 M; 1.3 × 10–3 M; 2.27 × 10–9 M; 2.2 × 10–10 M
15.E.1.21: Q15.1.16
Assuming that no equilibria other than dissolution are involved, calculate the molar solubility of each of the following from its
solubility product:
a. Ag2SO4
b. PbBr2
c. AgI
d. CaC2O4•H2O
15.E.1.22: Q15.1.X
Assuming that no equilibria other than dissolution are involved, calculate the concentration of all solute species in each of the
following solutions of salts in contact with a solution containing a common ion. Show that changes in the initial concentrations of
the common ions can be neglected.
a. AgCl(s) in 0.025 M NaCl
b. CaF2(s) in 0.00133 M KF
c. Ag2SO4(s) in 0.500 L of a solution containing 19.50 g of K2SO4
d. Zn(OH)2(s) in a solution buffered at a pH of 11.45
15.E.1.23: S15.1.X
7.2 × 10−9 M = [Ag+], [Cl−] = 0.025 M
−9
7.2 × 10 M
Check: × 100% = 2.9 × 10
−5
% , an insignificant change;
0.025 M
0.2238 M = [SO 2−
4
; [Ag+] = 2.30 × 10–9 M
]
−9
1.15 × 10
Check: × 100% = 5.14 × 10
−7
; the condition is satisfied.
0.2238
15.E.1.24: Q15.1.X
Assuming that no equilibria other than dissolution are involved, calculate the concentration of all solute species in each of the
following solutions of salts in contact with a solution containing a common ion. Show that changes in the initial concentrations of
the common ions can be neglected.
a. TlCl(s) in 1.250 M HCl
b. PbI2(s) in 0.0355 M CaI2
c. Ag2CrO4(s) in 0.225 L of a solution containing 0.856 g of K2CrO4
d. Cd(OH)2(s) in a solution buffered at a pH of 10.995
Assuming that no equilibria other than dissolution are involved, calculate the concentration of all solute species in each of the
following solutions of salts in contact with a solution containing a common ion. Show that it is not appropriate to neglect the
changes in the initial concentrations of the common ions.
a. TlCl(s) in 0.025 M TlNO3
b. BaF2(s) in 0.0313 M KF
c. MgC2O4 in 2.250 L of a solution containing 8.156 g of Mg(NO3)2
d. Ca(OH)2(s) in an unbuffered solution initially with a pH of 12.700
15.E.1.25: S15.1.X
[Cl–] = 7.6 × 10−3 M
−3
7.6 × 10
Check: × 100% = 30%
0.025
This value is too large to drop x. Therefore solve by using the quadratic equation:
[Ti+] = 3.1 × 10–2 M
[Cl–] = 6.1 × 10–3
[Ba2+] = 1.7 × 10–3 M
−3
1.7 × 10
Check: × 100% = 5.5%
0.0313
This value is too large to drop x, and the entire equation must be solved.
[Ba2+] = 1.6 × 10–3 M
[F–] = 0.0329 M;
Mg(NO3)2 = 0.02444 M
2− −3
[C O ] = 3.5 × 10
2 4
−3
3.5 × 10
Check: × 100% = 14%
0.02444
This value is greater than 5%, so the quadratic equation must be used:
2− −3
[ C O4 ] = 3.5 × 10 M
2
2+
[Mg ] = 0.0275 M
[OH–] = 0.0501 M
This value is greater than 5%, so a more exact method, such as successive approximations, must be used.
[Ca2+] = 2.8 × 10–3 M
[OH–] = 0.053 × 10–2 M
15.E.1.26: Q15.1.X
Explain why the changes in concentrations of the common ions in Exercise can be neglected.
15.E.1.27: Q15.1.X
Explain why the changes in concentrations of the common ions in Exercise cannot be neglected.
15.E.1.28: S15.1.X
The changes in concentration are greater than 5% and thus exceed the maximum value for disregarding the change.
15.E.1.29: Q15.1.X
Calculate the solubility of aluminum hydroxide, Al(OH)3, in a solution buffered at pH 11.00.
15.E.1.30: Q15.1.X
Refer to Appendix J for solubility products for calcium salts. Determine which of the calcium salts listed is most soluble in moles
per liter and which is most soluble in grams per liter.
15.E.1.31: S15.1.X
CaSO4·2H2O is the most soluble Ca salt in mol/L, and it is also the most soluble Ca salt in g/L.
15.E.1.32: Q15.1.X
Most barium compounds are very poisonous; however, barium sulfate is often administered internally as an aid in the X-ray
examination of the lower intestinal tract. This use of BaSO4 is possible because of its low solubility. Calculate the molar solubility
of BaSO4 and the mass of barium present in 1.00 L of water saturated with BaSO4.
15.E.1.33: Q15.1.X
Public Health Service standards for drinking water set a maximum of 250 mg/L (2.60 × 10–3 M) of SO because of its cathartic
2−
4
action (it is a laxative). Does natural water that is saturated with CaSO4 (“gyp” water) as a result or passing through soil containing
gypsum, CaSO4•2H2O, meet these standards? What is SO in such water?
2−
4
15.E.1.34: S15.1.X
4.9 × 10–3 M = [SO 2−
4
] = [Ca2+]; Since this concentration is higher than 2.60 × 10–3 M, “gyp” water does not meet the standards.
15.E.1.35: Q15.1.X
Perform the following calculations:
a. Calculate [Ag+] in a saturated aqueous solution of AgBr.
b. What will [Ag+] be when enough KBr has been added to make [Br–] = 0.050 M?
c. What will [Br–] be when enough AgNO3 has been added to make [Ag+] = 0.020 M?
The solubility product of CaSO4•2H2O is 2.4 × 10–5. What mass of this salt will dissolve in 1.0 L of 0.010 M SO 2−
4
?
15.E.1.36: S15.1.X
Mass (CaSO4•2H2O) = 0.34 g/L
15.E.1.37: Q15.1.X
Assuming that no equilibria other than dissolution are involved, calculate the concentrations of ions in a saturated solution of each
of the following (see Table E3 for solubility products).
15.E.1.38: Q15.1.X
Assuming that no equilibria other than dissolution are involved, calculate the concentrations of ions in a saturated solution of each
of the following (see Table E3 for solubility products).
a. AgI
b. Ag2SO4
c. Mn(OH)2
d. Sr(OH)2•8H2O
e. the mineral brucite, Mg(OH)2
15.E.1.39: S15.1.X
[Ag+] = [I–] = 1.2 × 10–8 M; [Ag+] = 2.86 × 10–2 M, [SO ] = 1.43 × 10–2 M; [Mn2+] = 2.2 × 10–5 M, [OH–] = 4.5 × 10–5 M; [Sr2+]
2−
= 4.3 × 10–2 M, [OH–] = 8.6 × 10–2 M; [Mg2+] = 1.6 × 10–4 M, [OH–] = 3.1 × 10–4 M.
15.E.1.40: Q15.1.X
The following concentrations are found in mixtures of ions in equilibrium with slightly soluble solids. From the concentrations
given, calculate Ksp for each of the slightly soluble solids indicated:
a. AgBr: [Ag+] = 5.7 × 10–7 M, [Br–] = 5.7 × 10–7 M
b. CaCO3: [Ca2+] = 5.3 × 10–3 M, [CO ] = 9.0 × 10–7 M
2−
3
15.E.1.41: Q15.1.X
The following concentrations are found in mixtures of ions in equilibrium with slightly soluble solids. From the concentrations
given, calculate Ksp for each of the slightly soluble solids indicated:
a. TlCl: [Tl+] = 1.21 × 10–2 M, [Cl–] = 1.2 × 10–2 M
b. Ce(IO3)4: [Ce4+] = 1.8 × 10–4 M, [IO ] = 2.6 × 10–13 M
−
3
15.E.1.42: S15.1.X
2.0 × 10–4; 5.1 × 10–17; 1.35 × 10–4; 1.18 × 10–5; 1.08 × 10–10
15.E.1.43: Q15.1.X
Which of the following compounds precipitates from a solution that has the concentrations indicated? (See Table E3 for Ksp
values.)
a. KClO4: [K+] = 0.01 M, [ClO ] = 0.01 M
−
15.E.1.44: Q15.1.X
Which of the following compounds precipitates from a solution that has the concentrations indicated? (See Table E3 for Ksp
values.)
15.E.1.45: S15.1.X
a. CaCO3 does precipitate.
b. The compound does not precipitate.
c. The compound does not precipitate.
d. The compound precipitates.
15.E.1.46: Q15.1.X
Calculate the concentration of Tl+ when TlCl just begins to precipitate from a solution that is 0.0250 M in Cl–.
15.E.1.47: Q15.1.X
Calculate the concentration of sulfate ion when BaSO4 just begins to precipitate from a solution that is 0.0758 M in Ba2+.
15.E.1.48: S15.1.X
1.42 × 10−9 M
15.E.1.49: Q15.1.X
Calculate the concentration of Sr2+ when SrF2 starts to precipitate from a solution that is 0.0025 M in F–.
15.E.1.50: Q15.1.X
Calculate the concentration of PO 3−
4
when Ag3PO4 starts to precipitate from a solution that is 0.0125 M in Ag+.
15.E.1.51: S15.1.X
9.2 × 10−13 M
15.E.1.52: Q15.1.X
Calculate the concentration of F– required to begin precipitation of CaF2 in a solution that is 0.010 M in Ca2+.
15.E.1.53: Q15.1.X
Calculate the concentration of Ag+ required to begin precipitation of Ag2CO3 in a solution that is 2.50 × 10–6 M in CO . 2−
15.E.1.54: S15.1.X
[Ag+] = 1.8 × 10–3 M
15.E.1.55: Q15.1.X
What [Ag+] is required to reduce [CO 2−
3
] to 8.2 × 10–4 M by precipitation of Ag2CO3?
15.E.1.56: Q15.1.X
What [F–] is required to reduce [Ca2+] to 1.0 × 10–4 M by precipitation of CaF2?
15.E.1.57: S15.1.X
6.2 × 10–4
15.E.1.58: Q15.1.X
A volume of 0.800 L of a 2 × 10–4-M Ba(NO3)2 solution is added to 0.200 L of 5 × 10–4 M Li2SO4. Does BaSO4 precipitate?
Explain your answer.
15.E.1.59: Q15.1.X
Perform these calculations for nickel(II) carbonate.
15.E.1.60: S15.1.X
2.28 L; 7.3 × 10–7 g
15.E.1.61: Q15.1.X
Iron concentrations greater than 5.4 × 10–6 M in water used for laundry purposes can cause staining. What [OH–] is required to
reduce [Fe2+] to this level by precipitation of Fe(OH)2?
15.E.1.62: Q15.1.X
A solution is 0.010 M in both Cu2+ and Cd2+. What percentage of Cd2+ remains in the solution when 99.9% of the Cu2+ has been
precipitated as CuS by adding sulfide?
15.E.1.63: S15.1.X
100% of it is dissolved
15.E.1.64: Q15.1.X
A solution is 0.15 M in both Pb2+ and Ag+. If Cl– is added to this solution, what is [Ag+] when PbCl2 begins to precipitate?
15.E.1.65: Q15.1.X
What reagent might be used to separate the ions in each of the following mixtures, which are 0.1 M with respect to each ion? In
some cases it may be necessary to control the pH. (Hint: Consider the Ksp values given in Appendix J.)
a. Hg and Cu2+
2+
b. SO and Cl–
2−
4
15.E.1.66: S15.1.X
a. Hg and Cu2+: Add SO .
2+
2
2−
15.E.1.67: Q15.1.X
A solution contains 1.0 × 10–5 mol of KBr and 0.10 mol of KCl per liter. AgNO3 is gradually added to this solution. Which forms
first, solid AgBr or solid AgCl?
15.E.1.68: Q15.1.X
A solution contains 1.0 × 10–2 mol of KI and 0.10 mol of KCl per liter. AgNO3 is gradually added to this solution. Which forms
first, solid AgI or solid AgCl?
15.E.1.69: S15.1.X
AgI will precipitate first.
15.E.1.71: Q15.1.X
About 50% of urinary calculi (kidney stones) consist of calcium phosphate, Ca3(PO4)2. The normal mid range calcium content
excreted in the urine is 0.10 g of Ca2+ per day. The normal mid range amount of urine passed may be taken as 1.4 L per day. What
is the maximum concentration of phosphate ion that urine can contain before a calculus begins to form?
15.E.1.72: S15.1.X
4 × 10−9 M
15.E.1.73: Q15.1.X
The pH of normal urine is 6.30, and the total phosphate concentration ([PO ] + [HPO ] + [H PO ] + [H3PO4]) is 0.020 M.
3−
4
2−
4 2
−
4
What is the minimum concentration of Ca2+ necessary to induce kidney stone formation? (See Exercise for additional information.)
15.E.1.74: Q15.1.X
Magnesium metal (a component of alloys used in aircraft and a reducing agent used in the production of uranium, titanium, and
other active metals) is isolated from sea water by the following sequence of reactions:
2+ 2+
Mg (aq) + Ca (OH) (aq) ⟶ Mg (OH) (s) + Ca (aq)
2 2
electrolysis
15.E.1.75: S15.1.X
3.99 kg
15.E.1.76: Q15.1.X
Hydrogen sulfide is bubbled into a solution that is 0.10 M in both Pb2+ and Fe2+ and 0.30 M in HCl. After the solution has come to
equilibrium it is saturated with H2S ([H2S] = 0.10 M). What concentrations of Pb2+ and Fe2+ remain in the solution? For a saturated
solution of H2S we can use the equilibrium:
+ 2− −26
H S(aq) + 2 H O(l) ⇌ 2 H O (aq) + S (aq) K = 1.0 × 10
2 2 3
15.E.1.77: Q15.1.X
Perform the following calculations involving concentrations of iodate ions:
a. The iodate ion concentration of a saturated solution of La(IO3)3 was found to be 3.1 × 10–3 mol/L. Find the Ksp.
b. Find the concentration of iodate ions in a saturated solution of Cu(IO3)2 (Ksp = 7.4 × 10–8).
15.E.1.78: S15.1.X
3.1 × 10–11; [Cu2+] = 2.6 × 10–3; [IO −
3
] = 5.3 × 10–3
15.E.1.79: Q15.1.X
Calculate the molar solubility of AgBr in 0.035 M NaBr (Ksp = 5 × 10–13).
15.E.1.81: S15.1.X
1.8 × 10–5 g Pb(OH)2
15.E.1.82: Q15.1.X
Use the simulation from the earlier Link to Learning to complete the following exercise:. Using 0.01 g CaF2, give the Ksp values
found in a 0.2-M solution of each of the salts. Discuss why the values change as you change soluble salts.
15.E.1.83: Q15.1.X
How many grams of Milk of Magnesia, Mg(OH)2 (s) (58.3 g/mol), would be soluble in 200 mL of water. Ksp = 7.1 × 10–12. Include
the ionic reaction and the expression for Ksp in your answer. (Kw = 1 × 10–14 = [H3O+][OH–])
15.E.1.84: S15.1.X
2+ −
Mg (OH) (s) ⇌ Mg + 2 OH (15.E.31)
2
2+ − 2
Ksp = [ Mg ] [ OH ] (15.E.32)
15.E.1.85: Q15.1.X
Two hypothetical salts, LM2 and LQ, have the same molar solubility in H2O. If Ksp for LM2 is 3.20 × 10–5, what is the Ksp value
for LQ?
15.E.1.86: Q15.1.X
Which of the following carbonates will form first? Which of the following will form last? Explain.
a. MgCO 3
Ksp = 3.5 × 10
−8
b. CaCO 3
Ksp = 4.2 × 10
−7
c. SrCO 3
−9
Ksp = 3.9 × 10
d. BaCO 3
Ksp = 4.4 × 10
−5
e. MnCO 3
Ksp = 5.1 × 10
−9
15.E.1.87: S15.1.X
SrCO3 will form first, since it has the smallest Ksp value it is the least soluble. BaCO3 will be the last to precipitate, it has the
largest Ksp value.
15.E.1.88: Q15.1.X
How many grams of Zn(CN)2(s) (117.44 g/mol) would be soluble in 100 mL of H2O? Include the balanced reaction and the
expression for Ksp in your answer. The Ksp value for Zn(CN)2(s) is 3.0 × 10–16.
15.E.2.2: S15.2.X
when the amount of solid is so small that a saturated solution is not produced
15.E.2.3: Q15.2.X
Explain why the addition of NH3 or HNO3 to a saturated solution of Ag2CO3 in contact with solid Ag2CO3 increases the solubility
of the solid.
15.E.2.5: S15.2.X
2.35 × 10–4 M
15.E.2.6: Q15.2.X
Explain why addition of NH3 or HNO3 to a saturated solution of Cu(OH)2 in contact with solid Cu(OH)2 increases the solubility of
the solid.
15.E.2.7: S15.2.X
Sometimes equilibria for complex ions are described in terms of dissociation constants, Kd. For the complex ion AlF6
3−
the
dissociation reaction is:
3+ − 6
[ Al ][F ]
3− 3+ − −24
AlF6 ⇌ Al +6 F \)and\(Kd = = 2 × 10 (15.E.33)
3−
[ AlF ]
6
15.E.2.8: Q15.2.X
Calculate the value of the formation constant, Kf, for AlF 3−
6
.
15.E.2.9: S15.2.X
5 × 1023
15.E.2.10: Q15.2.X
Using the value of the formation constant for the complex ion Co(NH 3
)
2+
6
, calculate the dissociation constant.
15.E.2.11: Q15.2.X
Using the dissociation constant, Kd = 7.8 × 10–18, calculate the equilibrium concentrations of Cd2+ and CN– in a 0.250-M solution
of Cd(CN) . 2−
15.E.2.12: S15.2.X
15.E.2.13: Q15.2.X
Using the dissociation constant, Kd = 3.4 × 10–15, calculate the equilibrium concentrations of Zn2+ and OH– in a 0.0465-M solution
2−
of Zn(OH) .4
15.E.2.14: Q15.2.X
Using the dissociation constant, Kd = 2.2 × 10–34, calculate the equilibrium concentrations of Co3+ and NH3 in a 0.500-M solution
of Co(NH ) .
3
3+
15.E.2.15: S15.2.X
[Co3+] = 3.0 × 10–6 M; [NH3] = 1.8 × 10–5 M
15.E.2.17: Q15.2.X
Calculate the mass of potassium cyanide ion that must be added to 100 mL of solution to dissolve 2.0 × 10–2 mol of silver cyanide,
AgCN.
15.E.2.18: S15.2.X
1.3 g
15.E.2.19: Q15.2.X
Calculate the minimum concentration of ammonia needed in 1.0 L of solution to dissolve 3.0 × 10–3 mol of silver bromide.
15.E.2.20: Q15.2.X
A roll of 35-mm black and white photographic film contains about 0.27 g of unexposed AgBr before developing. What mass of
Na2S2O3•5H2O (sodium thiosulfate pentahydrate or hypo) in 1.0 L of developer is required to dissolve the AgBr as Ag(S O ) 2 3
3−
15.E.2.21: S15.2.X
0.80 g
15.E.2.22: Q15.2.X
We have seen an introductory definition of an acid: An acid is a compound that reacts with water and increases the amount of
hydronium ion present. In the chapter on acids and bases, we saw two more definitions of acids: a compound that donates a proton
(a hydrogen ion, H+) to another compound is called a Brønsted-Lowry acid, and a Lewis acid is any species that can accept a pair
of electrons. Explain why the introductory definition is a macroscopic definition, while the Brønsted-Lowry definition and the
Lewis definition are microscopic definitions.
15.E.2.23: Q15.2.X
Write the Lewis structures of the reactants and product of each of the following equations, and identify the Lewis acid and the
Lewis base in each:
a. CO + OH ⟶ HCO
2
− −
3
b. B(OH) + OH ⟶ B(OH)3
− −
c. I + I ⟶ I
−
2
−
3
e. O + SO ⟶ SO
2−
3
2−
15.E.2.24: S15.2.X
(a)
;
(b)
;
(d)
;
(e)
15.E.2.25: Q15.2.X
Write the Lewis structures of the reactants and product of each of the following equations, and identify the Lewis acid and the
Lewis base in each:
a. CS + SH ⟶ HCS
2
− −
b. BF + F ⟶ BF
3
− −
4
c. I + SnI ⟶ SnI
−
2
−
3
−
d. Al(OH) + OH ⟶ Al(OH)
3
−
4
e. F + SO ⟶ SFO
−
3
−
3
15.E.2.26: Q15.2.X
Using Lewis structures, write balanced equations for the following reactions:
a. HCl(g) + PH (g) ⟶ 3
b. H O + CH ⟶
3
+ −
3
c. CaO + SO ⟶ 3
d. NH + C H O ⟶
+
4 2 5
−
15.E.2.27: S15.2.X
(a)
;
CaO + SO ⟶ CaSO
3 4
;
+ −
NH +C H O ⟶ C H OH + NH
4 2 5 2 5 3
15.E.2.28: Q15.2.X
Calculate [HgCl 2−
4
] in a solution prepared by adding 0.0200 mol of NaCl to 0.250 L of a 0.100-M HgCl2 solution.
15.E.2.29: Q15.2.X
In a titration of cyanide ion, 28.72 mL of 0.0100 M AgNO3 is added before precipitation begins. [The reaction of Ag+ with CN–
goes to completion, producing the Ag(CN) complex.] Precipitation of solid AgCN takes place when excess Ag+ is added to the
−
2
−
solution, above the amount needed to complete the formation of Ag(CN) . How many grams of NaCN were in the original
2
sample?
15.E.2.30: S15.2.X
0.0281 g
15.E.2.31: Q15.2.X
What are the concentrations of Ag+, CN–, and Ag(CN) in a saturated solution of AgCN?
−
15.E.2.33: S15.2.X
HNO (l) + HF(l) ⟶ H NO
3 2
+
3
+F
−
; HF(l) + BF 3
(g) ⟶ H
+
+ BF
4
15.E.2.34: Q15.2.X
The simplest amino acid is glycine, H2NCH2CO2H. The common feature of amino acids is that they contain the functional groups:
an amine group, –NH2, and a carboxylic acid group, –CO2H. An amino acid can function as either an acid or a base. For glycine,
the acid strength of the carboxyl group is about the same as that of acetic acid, CH3CO2H, and the base strength of the amino group
is slightly greater than that of ammonia, NH3.
15.E.2.35: Q15.2.X
Write the Lewis structures of the ions that form when glycine is dissolved in 1 M HCl and in 1 M KOH.
15.E.2.36: Q15.2.X
Write the Lewis structure of glycine when this amino acid is dissolved in water. (Hint: Consider the relative base strengths of the –
NH2 and −CO groups.)
−
2
15.E.2.37: Q15.2.X
Boric acid, H3BO3, is not a Brønsted-Lowry acid but a Lewis acid.
a. Write an equation for its reaction with water.
b. Predict the shape of the anion thus formed.
c. What is the hybridization on the boron consistent with the shape you have predicted?
15.E.2.38: S15.2.X
H BO
3 3
+ H O ⟶ H BO
2 4
−
4
+H ; The electronic and molecular shapes are the same—both tetrahedral. The tetrahedral
+
15.E.3.2: Q15.3.2
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of Ni2+ in a 1.0-M solution [Ni(NH3)6](NO3)2.
15.E.3.3: S15.3.2
0.014 M
15.E.3.4: Q15.3.3
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of Zn2+ in a 0.30-M solution of Zn(CN) 2−
4
.
15.E.3.5: Q15.3.4
Calculate the equilibrium concentration of Cu2+ in a solution initially with 0.050 M Cu2+ and 1.00 M NH3.
15.E.3.6: S15.3.2
1.0 × 10–13 M
15.E.3.8: Q15.3.6
Calculate the Fe3+ equilibrium concentration when 0.0888 mole of K3[Fe(CN)6] is added to a solution with 0.0.00010 M CN–.
15.E.3.9: S15.3.2
9 × 10−22 M
15.E.3.10: Q15.3.7
Calculate the Co2+ equilibrium concentration when 0.100 mole of [Co(NH3)6](NO3)2 is added to a solution with 0.025 M NH3.
Assume the volume is 1.00 L.
15.E.3.11: Q15.3.8
The equilibrium constant for the reaction Hg (aq) + 2 Cl (aq) ⇌ HgCl (aq) is 1.6 × 1013. Is HgCl2 a strong electrolyte or a
2+ −
weak electrolyte? What are the concentrations of Hg2+ and Cl– in a 0.015-M solution of HgCl2?
15.E.3.12: S15.3.2
6.2 × 10–6 M = [Hg2+]; 1.2 × 10–5 M = [Cl–]; The substance is a weak electrolyte because very little of the initial 0.015 M HgCl2
dissolved.
15.E.3.13: Q15.3.9
Calculate the molar solubility of Sn(OH)2 in a buffer solution containing equal concentrations of NH3 and NH . +
15.E.3.14: Q15.3.X
Calculate the molar solubility of Al(OH)3 in a buffer solution with 0.100 M NH3 and 0.400 M NH . +
4
15.E.3.15: S15.3.2
[OH−] = 4.5 × 10−5; [Al3+] = 2.1 × 10–20 (molar solubility)
What is the molar solubility of CaF2 in a 0.100-M solution of HF? Ka for HF = 7.2 × 10–4.
15.E.3.17: Q15.3.X
What is the molar solubility of BaSO4 in a 0.250-M solution of NaHSO4? Ka for HSO = 1.2 × 10–2.
−
4
15.E.3.18: S15.3.2
2−
[ SO 4 ] = 0.049 M
15.E.3.19: Q15.3.X
What is the molar solubility of Tl(OH)3 in a 0.10-M solution of NH3?
15.E.3.20: Q15.3.X
What is the molar solubility of Pb(OH)2 in a 0.138-M solution of CH3NH2?
15.E.3.21: S15.3.2
[OH–] = 7.6 × 10−3 M
[Pb2+] = 4.8 × 10–12 (molar solubility)
15.E.3.22: Q15.3.X
A solution of 0.075 M CoBr2 is saturated with H2S ([H2S] = 0.10 M). What is the minimum pH at which CoS begins to precipitate?
2+ 2− −27
CoS(s) ⇌ Co (aq) + S (aq) Ksp = 4.5 × 10
A 0.125-M solution of Mn(NO3)2 is saturated with H2S ([H2S] = 0.10 M). At what pH does MnS begin to precipitate?
2+ 2− −22
MnS(s) ⇌ Mn (aq) + S (aq) Ksp = 4.3 × 10
+ 2− −26
H S(aq) + 2 H O(l) ⇌ 2 H O (aq) + S (aq) K = 1.0 × 10
2 2 3
15.E.3.23: S15.3.2
3.27
15.E.3.24: Q15.3.X
Calculate the molar solubility of BaF2 in a buffer solution containing 0.20 M HF and 0.20 M NaF.
15.E.3.25: Q15.3.X
Calculate the molar solubility of CdCO3 in a buffer solution containing 0.115 M Na2CO3 and 0.120 M NaHCO3
15.E.3.26: S15.3.2
2−
[ CO3 ] = 0.115 M
[Cd ] = 3 × 10−12 M
2+
15.E.3.27: Q15.3.X
To a 0.10-M solution of Pb(NO3)2 is added enough HF(g) to make [HF] = 0.10 M.
a. Does PbF2 precipitate from this solution? Show the calculations that support your conclusion.
b. What is the minimum pH at which PbF2 precipitates?
Calculate the concentration of Cd2+ resulting from the dissolution of CdCO3 in a solution that is 0.010 M in H2CO3.
15.E.3.28: S15.3.2
1 × 10−5 M
15.E.3.29: Q15.3.X
Both AgCl and AgI dissolve in NH3.
a. What mass of AgI dissolves in 1.0 L of 1.0 M NH3?
b. What mass of AgCl dissolves in 1.0 L of 1.0 M NH3?
Calculate the volume of 1.50 M CH3CO2H required to dissolve a precipitate composed of 350 mg each of CaCO3, SrCO3, and
BaCO3.
15.E.3.30: S15.3.2
0.0102 L (10.2 mL)
15.E.3.31: Q15.3.X
Even though Ca(OH)2 is an inexpensive base, its limited solubility restricts its use. What is the pH of a saturated solution of
Ca(OH)2?
15.E.3.32: Q15.3.X
What mass of NaCN must be added to 1 L of 0.010 M Mg(NO3)2 in order to produce the first trace of Mg(OH)2?
15.E.3.33: S15.3.2
5 × 10−3 g
15.E.3.34: Q15.3.X
Magnesium hydroxide and magnesium citrate function as mild laxatives when they reach the small intestine. Why do magnesium
hydroxide and magnesium citrate, two very different substances, have the same effect in your small intestine. (Hint: The contents
of the small intestine are basic.)
In a saturated solution of MgF2 at 18 °C, the concentration of Mg2+ is 1.21 × 10–3 M. The equilibrium is represented by the
preceding equation.
a. Write the expression for the solubility-product constant, Ksp, and calculate its value at 18 °C.
b. Calculate the equilibrium concentration of Mg2+ in 1.000 L of saturated MgF2 solution at 18 °C to which 0.100 mol of solid KF
has been added. The KF dissolves completely. Assume the volume change is negligible.
c. Predict whether a precipitate of MgF2 will form when 100.0 mL of a 3.00 × 10–3-M solution of Mg(NO3)2 is mixed with 200.0
mL of a 2.00 × 10–3-M solution of NaF at 18 °C. Show the calculations to support your prediction.
d. At 27 °C the concentration of Mg2+ in a saturated solution of MgF2 is 1.17 × 10–3 M. Is the dissolving of MgF2 in water an
endothermic or an exothermic process? Give an explanation to support your conclusion.
15.E.3.36: S15.3.2
Ksp = [Mg2+][F–]2 = (1.21 × 10–3)(2 × 1.21 × 10–3)2 = 7.09 × 10–9; 7.09 × 10–7 M
Determine the concentration of Mg2+ and F– that will be present in the final volume. Compare the value of the ion product [Mg2+]
[F–]2 with Ksp. If this value is larger than Ksp, precipitation will occur. 0.1000 L × 3.00 × 10–3 M Mg(NO3)2 = 0.3000 L × M
Mg(NO3)2 M Mg(NO3)2 = 1.00 × 10–3 M 0.2000 L × 2.00 × 10–3 M NaF = 0.3000 L × M NaF M NaF = 1.33 × 10–3 M ion product
= (1.00 × 10–3)(1.33 × 10–3)2 = 1.77 × 10–9 This value is smaller than Ksp, so no precipitation will occur. MgF2 is less soluble at 27
°C than at 18 °C. Because added heat acts like an added reagent, when it appears on the product side, the Le Chatelier’s principle
states that the equilibrium will shift to the reactants’ side to counter the stress. Consequently, less reagent will dissolve. This
situation is found in our case. Therefore, the reaction is exothermic.
15.E.3.37: Q15.3.X
Which of the following compounds, when dissolved in a 0.01-M solution of HClO4, has a solubility greater than in pure water:
CuCl, CaCO3, MnS, PbBr2, CaF2? Explain your answer.
15.E.3.38: Q15.3.X
Which of the following compounds, when dissolved in a 0.01-M solution of HClO4, has a solubility greater than in pure water:
AgBr, BaF2, Ca3(PO4)3, ZnS, PbI2? Explain your answer.
BaF2, Ca3(PO4)2, ZnS; each is a salt of a weak acid, and the [H 3
O
+
] from perchloric acid reduces the equilibrium concentration of
the anion, thereby increasing the concentration of the cations
15.E.3.39: Q15.3.X
What is the effect on the amount of solid Mg(OH)2 that dissolves and the concentrations of Mg2+ and OH– when each of the
following are added to a mixture of solid Mg(OH)2 and water at equilibrium?
a. MgCl2
b. KOH
c. HClO4
d. NaNO3
e. Mg(OH)2
15.E.3.40: Q15.3.X
What is the effect on the amount of CaHPO4 that dissolves and the concentrations of Ca2+ and HPO when each of the following
−
4
15.E.3.41: S15.3.X
Effect on amount of solid CaHPO4, [Ca2+], [OH–]: increase, increase, decrease; decrease, increase, decrease; no effect, no effect, no
effect; decrease, increase, decrease; increase, no effect, no effect
15.E.3.42: Q15.3.X
Identify all chemical species present in an aqueous solution of Ca3(PO4)2 and list these species in decreasing order of their
concentrations. (Hint: Remember that the PO ion is a weak base.)
3−
4
15.E.3.43: Q15.3.X
A volume of 50 mL of 1.8 M NH3 is mixed with an equal volume of a solution containing 0.95 g of MgCl2. What mass of NH4Cl
must be added to the resulting solution to prevent the precipitation of Mg(OH)2?
15.E.3.44: S15.3.X
7.1 g
15.E.4:
This page titled 15.E: Equilibria of Other Reaction Classes (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
This page titled 16: Thermodynamics is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
16.1: Spontaneity
Learning Objectives
Distinguish between spontaneous and nonspontaneous processes
Describe the dispersal of matter and energy that accompanies certain spontaneous processes
In this section, consider the differences between two types of changes in a system: Those that occur spontaneously and those that occur only with the continuous input of energy. In doing so,
we’ll gain an understanding as to why some systems are naturally inclined to change in one direction under certain conditions. We’ll also gain insight into how the spontaneity of a process
affects the distribution of energy and matter within the system.
Figure 16.1.1 : Both U-238 and Tc-99m undergo spontaneous radioactive decay, but at drastically different rates. Over the course of one week, essentially all of a Tc-99m sample and none of a
U-238 sample will have decayed. (CC by 4.0; Morgan Johnson via LibreTexts)
Two curves are shown to represent U-238 and Tc-99m respectively. The vertical axes represents the percentage of isotope remaining and the horizontal axes is the time that has elapsed in days.
As another example, consider the conversion of diamond into graphite (Figure 16.1.2).
C(s, diamond) ⟶ C(s, graphite) (16.1.1)
The phase diagram for carbon indicates that graphite is the stable form of this element under ambient atmospheric pressure, while diamond is the stable allotrope at very high pressures, such as
those present during its geologic formation. Thermodynamic calculations of the sort described in the last section of this chapter indicate that the conversion of diamond to graphite at ambient
pressure occurs spontaneously, yet diamonds are observed to exist, and persist, under these conditions. Though the process is spontaneous under typical ambient conditions, its rate is extremely
slow, and so for all practical purposes diamonds are indeed “forever.” Situations such as these emphasize the important distinction between the thermodynamic and the kinetic aspects of a
process. In this particular case, diamonds are said to be thermodynamically unstable but kinetically stable under ambient conditions.
Figure 16.1.2 : The conversion of carbon from the diamond allotrope to the graphite allotrope is spontaneous at ambient pressure, but its rate is immeasurably slow at low to moderate
temperatures. This process is known as graphitization, and its rate can be increased to easily measurable values at temperatures in the 1000–2000 K range. (credit "diamond" photo: modification
of work by "Fancy Diamonds"/Flickr; credit "graphite" photo: modification of work by images-of-elements.com/carbon.php)
Comparison of diamond and graphite shown in its physical form as well as its molecular arrangement respectively.
=0 (P = 0 in a vaccum) (16.1.3)
Note as well that since the system is isolated, no heat has been exchanged with the surroundings (q = 0). The first law of thermodynamics confirms that there has been no change in the system’s
internal energy as a result of this process.
= 0 +0 = 0 (16.1.4)
The spontaneity of this process is therefore not a consequence of any change in energy that accompanies the process. Instead, the movement of the gas appears to be related to the greater, more
uniform dispersal of matter that results when the gas is allowed to expand. Initially, the system was comprised of one flask containing matter and another flask containing nothing. After the
spontaneous process took place, the matter was distributed both more widely (occupying twice its original volume) and more uniformly (present in equal amounts in each flask).
Figure 16.1.3 : An isolated system consists of an ideal gas in one flask that is connected by a closed valve to a second flask containing a vacuum. Once the valve is opened, the gas
spontaneously becomes evenly distributed between the flasks.
When the valve is closed, all of the gas molecules accumlating only in one side of the flask. The diagram with the open valve shows gas being equally distributed among the two flasks. The
dispersion of the gas is labeled as spontaneous while the reverse is labeled as non spontaneous.
Now consider two objects at different temperatures: object X at temperature TX and object Y at temperature TY, with TX > TY (Figure 16.1.4). When these objects come into contact, heat
spontaneously flows from the hotter object (X) to the colder one (Y). This corresponds to a loss of thermal energy by X and a gain of thermal energy by Y.
From the perspective of this two-object system, there was no net gain or loss of thermal energy, rather the available thermal energy was redistributed among the two objects. This spontaneous
process resulted in a more uniform dispersal of energy.
Figure 16.1.4 :When two objects at different temperatures come in contact, heat spontaneously flows from the hotter to the colder object.
Two separated blocks. One is labeled X and the other labeled Y. The diagram next to it shows the two blocks in contact with one another.
As illustrated by the two processes described, an important factor in determining the spontaneity of a process is the extent to which it changes the dispersal or distribution of matter and/or
energy. In each case, a spontaneous process took place that resulted in a more uniform distribution of matter or energy.
Describe how matter and energy are redistributed when the following spontaneous processes take place:
a. A solid sublimes.
b. A gas condenses.
c. A drop of food coloring added to a glass of water forms a solution with uniform color.
Solution
Figure 16.1.5 :(credit a: modification of work by Jenny Downing; credit b: modification of work by “Fuzzy Gerdes”/Flickr; credit c: modification of work by Sahar Atwa)
This figure has three photos labeled, “a,” “b,” and “c.” Photo a shows a glass with dry ice in water. There is a thick vapor coming from the top of the glass. Photo b shows water forming
outside of a glass containing cold beverage. Photo c shows a sealed container that holds a red liquid.
a. Sublimation is the conversion of a solid (relatively high density) to a gas (much lesser density). This process yields a much greater dispersal of matter, since the molecules will occupy a
much greater volume after the solid-to-gas transition. However, an input of energy from the surroundings ss required for the molecules to leave the solid phase and enter the gas phase.
b. Condensation is the conversion of a gas (relatively low density) to a liquid (much greater density). This process yields a much lesser dispersal of matter, since the molecules will occupy
a much lesser volume after the gas-to-liquid transition. As the gas molecules move together to form the droplets of liquid, they form intermolecular forces and thus release energy to the
surroundings.
c. The process in question is dilution. The food dye molecules initially occupy a much smaller volume (the drop of dye solution) than they occupy once the process is complete (in the full
glass of water). The process therefore entails a greater dispersal of matter. The process may also yield a more uniform dispersal of matter, since the initial state of the system involves
two regions of different dye concentrations (high in the drop, zero in the water), and the final state of the system contains a single dye concentration throughout. This process can occur
with out a change in energy because the molecules have kinetic energy relative to the temperature of the water, and so will be constantly in motion.
Exercise 16.1.1
Describe how matter and energy are redistributed when you empty a canister of compressed air into a room.
Answer
This process entails both a greater and more uniform dispersal of matter as the compressed air in the canister is permitted to expand into the lower-pressure air of the room. The process
also requires an input of energy to disrupt the intermolecular forces between the closely-spaced gas molecules that are originally compressed into the container. If you were to touch the
nozzle of the canister, you would notice that it is cold because the exiting molecules are taking energy away from their surroundings, and the canister is part of the surroundings.
Summary
Chemical and physical processes have a natural tendency to occur in one direction under certain conditions. A spontaneous process occurs without the need for a continual input of energy from
some external source, while a nonspontaneous process requires such. Systems undergoing a spontaneous process may or may not experience a gain or loss of energy, but they will experience a
Glossary
nonspontaneous process
process that requires continual input of energy from an external source
spontaneous change
process that takes place without a continuous input of energy from an external source
This page titled 16.1: Spontaneity is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts
platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In 1824, at the age of 28, Nicolas Léonard Sadi Carnot (Figure 16.2.2) published the results of an extensive study regarding the
efficiency of steam heat engines. In a later review of Carnot’s findings, Rudolf Clausius introduced a new thermodynamic property
that relates the spontaneous heat flow accompanying a process to the temperature at which the process takes place. This new
property was expressed as the ratio of the reversible heat (qrev) and the kelvin temperature (T). The term reversible process refers to
a process that takes place at such a slow rate that it is always at equilibrium and its direction can be changed (it can be “reversed”)
by an infinitesimally small change is some condition. Note that the idea of a reversible process is a formalism required to support
the development of various thermodynamic concepts; no real processes are truly reversible, rather they are classified as
irreversible.
Figure 16.2.1 : (a) Nicholas Léonard Sadi Carnot’s research into steam-powered machinery and (b) Rudolf Clausius’s later study of
those findings led to groundbreaking discoveries about spontaneous heat flow processes.
Similar to other thermodynamic properties, this new quantity is a state function, and so its change depends only upon the initial and
final states of a system. In 1865, Clausius named this property entropy (S) and defined its change for any process as the following:
qrev
ΔS = (16.2.1)
T
The entropy change for a real, irreversible process is then equal to that for the theoretical reversible process that involves the same
initial and final states.
ΔS = Sf − Si
= k ln Ωf − k ln Ωi
Ωf
= k ln (16.2.3)
Ωi
For processes involving an increase in the number of microstates of the system, Ω > Ω , the entropy of the system increases,
f i
ΔS > 0 . Conversely, processes that reduce the number of microstates in the system, Ω < Ω , yield a decrease in system entropy,
f i
Figure 16.2.2 : The sixteen microstates associated with placing four particles in two boxes are shown. The microstates are collected
into five distributions—(a), (b), (c), (d), and (e)—based on the numbers of particles in each box.
Five rows of diagrams that look like dominoes are shown and labeled a, b, c, d, and e. Row a has one “domino” that has four dots
on the left side, red, green, blue and yellow in a clockwise pattern from the top left, and no dots on the right. Row b has four
“dominos,” each with three dots on the left and one dot on the right. The first shows a “domino” with green, yellow and blue on the
left and red on the right. The second “domino” has yellow, blue and red on the left and green on the right. The third “domino” has
red, green and yellow on the left and blue on the right while the fourth has red, green and blue on the left and yellow on the right.
Row c has six “dominos”, each with two dots on either side. The first has a red and green on the left and a blue and yellow on the
right. The second has a red and blue on the left and a green and yellow on the right while the third has a yellow and red on the left
and a green and blue on the right. The fourth has a green and blue on the left and a red and yellow on the right. The fifth has a
green and yellow on the left and a red and blue on the right. The sixth has a blue and yellow on the left and a green and red on the
right. Row d has four “dominos,” each with one dot on the left and three on the right. The first “domino” has red on the left and a
blue, green and yellow on the right. The second has a green on the left and a red, yellow and blue on the right. The third has a blue
on the left and a red, green and yellow on the right. The fourth has a yellow on the left and a red, green and blue on the right. Row e
has 1 “domino” with no dots on the left and four dots on the right that are red, green, blue and yellow.
Consider the general case of a system comprised of N particles distributed among n boxes. The number of microstates possible for
such a system is nN. For example, distributing four particles among two boxes will result in 24 = 16 different microstates as
illustrated in Figure 16.2.2. Microstates with equivalent particle arrangements (not considering individual particle identities) are
grouped together and are called distributions (sometimes called macrostates or configurations). The probability that a system will
exist with its components in a given distribution is proportional to the number of microstates within the distribution. Since entropy
increases logarithmically with the number of microstates, the most probable distribution is therefore the one of greatest entropy.
For this system, the most probable configuration is one of the six microstates associated with distribution (c) where the particles are
evenly distributed between the boxes, that is, a configuration of two particles in each box. The probability of finding the system in
this configuration is
6 3
=
16 8
The least probable configuration of the system is one in which all four particles are in one box, corresponding to distributions (a)
and (e), each with a probability of
1
16
The probability of finding all particles in only one box (either the left box or right box) is then
1 1 2 1
( + ) = =
16 16 16 8
Figure 16.2.3 : This shows a microstate model describing the flow of heat from a hot object to a cold object. (a) Before the heat
flow occurs, the object comprised of particles A and B contains both units of energy and as represented by a distribution of three
microstates. (b) If the heat flow results in an even dispersal of energy (one energy unit transferred), a distribution of four
microstates results. (c) If both energy units are transferred, the resulting distribution has three microstates.
Three rows labeled a, b, and c are shown and each contains rectangles with two sides where the left side is labeled, “A,” and “B,”
and the right is labeled, “C,” and “D.” Row a has three rectangles where the first has a dot above and below the letter A, the second
has a dot above the A and B, and the third which has a dot above and below the letter B. Row b has four rectangles; the first has a
dot above A and C, the second has a dot above A and D, the third has a dot above B and C and the fourth has a dot above B and D.
Row c has three rectangles; the first has a dot above and below the letter C, the second has a dot above C and D and the third has a
dot above and below the letter D.
A similar approach may be used to describe the spontaneous flow of heat. Consider a system consisting of two objects, each
containing two particles, and two units of energy (represented as “*”) in Figure 16.2.3. The hot object is comprised of particles A
and B and initially contains both energy units. The cold object is comprised of particles C and D, which initially has no energy
units. Distribution (a) shows the three microstates possible for the initial state of the system, with both units of energy contained
within the hot object. If one of the two energy units is transferred, the result is distribution (b) consisting of four microstates. If both
energy units are transferred, the result is distribution (c) consisting of three microstates. And so, we may describe this system by a
total of ten microstates. The probability that the heat does not flow when the two objects are brought into contact, that is, that the
system remains in distribution (a), is . More likely is the flow of heat to yield one of the other two distribution, the combined
3
10
probability being . The most likely result is the flow of heat to yield the uniform dispersal of energy represented by distribution
7
10
(b), the probability of this configuration being . As for the previous example of matter dispersal, extrapolating this treatment to
4
10
macroscopic collections of particles dramatically increases the probability of the uniform distribution relative to the other
distributions. This supports the common observation that placing hot and cold objects in contact results in spontaneous heat flow
that ultimately equalizes the objects’ temperatures. And, again, this spontaneous process is also characterized by an increase in
system entropy.
Consider the system shown here. What is the change in entropy for a process that converts the system from distribution (a) to
(c)?
Solution
We are interested in the following change:
The initial number of microstates is one, the final six:
Ωc
ΔS = k ln
Ωa
−23
6
= 1.38 × 10 J/K × ln
1
−23
= 2.47 × 10 J/K
The sign of this result is consistent with expectation; since there are more microstates possible for the final state than for the
initial state, the change in entropy should be positive.
Exercise 16.2.1
Consider the system shown in Figure 16.2.3. What is the change in entropy for the process where all the energy is transferred
from the hot object (AB) to the cold object (CD)?
Answer
0 J/K
Figure 16.2.5 : Entropy increases as the temperature of a substance is raised, which corresponds to the greater spread of kinetic
energies. When a substance melts or vaporizes, it experiences a significant increase in entropy.
Two graphs are shown. The y-axis of the left graph is labeled, “Fraction of molecules,” while the x-axis is labeled, “Velocity, v ( m
/ s ),” and has values of 0 through 1,500 along the axis with increments of 500. Four lines are plotted on this graph. The first,
labeled, “100 K,” peaks around 200 m / s while the second, labeled, “200 K,” peaks near 300 m / s and is slightly lower on the y-
axis than the first. The third line, labeled, “500 K,” peaks around 550 m / s and is lower than the first two on the y-axis. The fourth
line, labeled, “1000 K,” peaks around 750 m / s and is the lowest of the four on the y-axis. Each line get increasingly broad. The
second graph has a y-axis labeled, “Entropy, S,” with an upward-facing arrow and an x-axis labeled, “Temperature ( K ),” and a
right-facing arrow. The graph has three equally spaced columns in the background, labeled, “Solid,” “Liquid,” and, “Gas,” from
left to right. A line extends slightly upward through the first column in a slight upward direction, then goes straight up in the
transition between the first two columns. In then progresses in a slight upward direction through the second column, then goes up
dramatically between the second and third columns, then continues in a slight upward direction once more. The first vertical region
of this line is labeled, “Melting,” and the second is labeled, “Boiling.”
Predict the sign of the entropy change for the following processes. Indicate the reason for each of your predictions.
a. One mole liquid water at room temperature ⟶ one mole liquid water at 50 °C
b. Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) ⟶ AgCl(s)
+ −
15
c. C H (l) +
6 6
O (g) ⟶ 6 CO (g) + 3 H O(l)
2 2 2
2
d. NH 3
(s) ⟶ NH (l)
3
Solution
a. positive, temperature increases
b. negative, reduction in the number of ions (particles) in solution, decreased dispersal of matter
c. negative, net decrease in the amount of gaseous species
d. positive, phase transition from solid to liquid, net increase in dispersal of matter
Exercise 16.2.2
Predict the sign of the enthalpy change for the following processes. Give a reason for your prediction.
a. NaNO (s) ⟶ Na (aq) + NO (aq)
3
+ −
3
Answer a
Positive; The solid dissolves to give an increase of mobile ions in solution.
Answer b
Negative; The liquid becomes a more ordered solid.
Answer c
Positive; The relatively ordered solid becomes a gas
Answer d
Positive; There is a net production of one mole of gas.
Glossary
entropy (S)
state function that is a measure of the matter and/or energy dispersal within a system, determined by the number of system
microstates often described as a measure of the disorder of the system
microstate (W)
possible configuration or arrangement of matter and energy within a system
reversible process
process that takes place so slowly as to be capable of reversing direction in response to an infinitesimally small change in
conditions; hypothetical construct that can only be approximated by real processes removed
This page titled 16.2: Entropy is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
To illustrate this relation, consider again the process of heat flow between two objects, one identified as the system and the other as
the surroundings. There are three possibilities for such a process:
1. The objects are at different temperatures, and heat flows from the hotter to the cooler object. This is always observed to occur
spontaneously. Designating the hotter object as the system and invoking the definition of entropy yields the following:
−qrev qrev
ΔSsys = and ΔSsurr = (16.3.2)
Tsys Tsurr
The arithmetic signs of qrev denote the loss of heat by the system and the gain of heat by the surroundings. Since Tsys > Tsurr in
this scenario, the magnitude of the entropy change for the surroundings will be greater than that for the system, and so the sum
of ΔSsys and ΔSsurr will yield a positive value for ΔSuniv. This process involves an increase in the entropy of the universe.
2. The objects are at different temperatures, and heat flows from the cooler to the hotter object. This is never observed to occur
spontaneously. Again designating the hotter object as the system and invoking the definition of entropy yields the following:
qrev −qrev
ΔSsys = and ΔSsurr = (16.3.3)
Tsys Tsurr
The arithmetic signs of qrev denote the gain of heat by the system and the loss of heat by the surroundings. The magnitude of the
entropy change for the surroundings will again be greater than that for the system, but in this case, the signs of the heat changes
will yield a negative value for ΔSuniv. This process involves a decrease in the entropy of the universe.
3. The temperature difference between the objects is infinitesimally small, Tsys ≈ Tsurr, and so the heat flow is thermodynamically
reversible. See the previous section’s discussion). In this case, the system and surroundings experience entropy changes that are
equal in magnitude and therefore sum to yield a value of zero for ΔSuniv. This process involves no change in the entropy of the
universe.
These results lead to a profound statement regarding the relation between entropy and spontaneity known as the second law of
thermodynamics: all spontaneous changes cause an increase in the entropy of the universe. A summary of these three relations is
provided in Table 16.3.1.
Table 16.3.1 : The Second Law of Thermodynamics
ΔSuniv > 0 spontaneous
We may use this equation to predict the spontaneity of a process as illustrated in Example 16.3.1.
is 22.1 J/K and requires that the surroundings transfer 6.00 kJ of heat to the system. Is the process spontaneous at −10.00 °C? Is
it spontaneous at +10.00 °C?
Solution
We can assess the spontaneity of the process by calculating the entropy change of the universe. If ΔSuniv is positive, then the
process is spontaneous. At both temperatures, ΔSsys = 22.1 J/K and qsurr = −6.00 kJ.
At −10.00 °C (263.15 K), the following is true:
qsurr
ΔSuniv = ΔSsys + ΔSsurr = ΔSsys +
T
3
−6.00 × 10 J
= 22.1 J/K + = −0.7 J/K
263.15 K
3
−6.00 × 10 J
= 22.1 J/K + = +0.9 J/K
283.15 K
Exercise 16.3.1
Using this information, determine if liquid water will spontaneously freeze at the same temperatures. What can you say about
the values of Suniv?
Answer
Entropy is a state function, and freezing is the opposite of melting. At −10.00 °C spontaneous, +0.7 J/K; at +10.00 °C
nonspontaneous, −0.9 J/K.
We can make careful calorimetric measurements to determine the temperature dependence of a substance’s entropy and to derive
absolute entropy values under specific conditions. Standard entropies are given the label S for values determined for one mole
∘
298
of substance, isolated in its pure form in its own container, at a pressure of 1 bar and a temperature of 298 K.
Definition: Term
The thermodynamic standard state of a substance refers to an isolated sample of that substance, in its own container, at 1.000
bar (0.9869 atm) pressure. If the substance is a solute, the most common standard state is one in which the concentration of the
solute is 1.000 molal (sometimes approximated with 1.000 M). There is no defined temperature for the standard state, but most
discussions about standard state assume that the temperature is 298.15 K (25ºC) unless otherwise noted.
This may seem like a strange definition, because it requires that each of the reactants and each of the products of a reaction
are kept separate from one another, unmixed. The entropy of mixing must be determined separately.
The standard entropy change (ΔS°) for any process may be computed from the standard entropies of its reactant and product
species like the following:
∘ ∘
ΔS° = ∑ ν S (products) − ∑ ν S (reactants) (16.3.6)
298 298
Here, ν represents stoichiometric coefficients in the balanced equation representing the process. For example, ΔS° for the following
reaction at room temperature
mA + nB ⟶ xC + yD (16.3.7)
Table 16.3.2 lists some standard entropies at 298.15 K. You can find additional standard entropies in Tables T1 or T2.
Table 16.3.2 : Standard Entropies (at 298.15 K, 1 atm)
J
Substance S
∘
298
mol K
carbon
CO(g) 197.7
CO2(g) 213.8
CH4(g) 186.3
C2H4(g) 219.5
C2H6(g) 229.5
CH3OH(l) 126.8
C2H5OH(l) 160.7
hydrogen
H2(g) 130.57
H(g) 114.6
mol K
H2O(g) 188.71
H2O(l) 69.91
HCI(g) 186.8
H2S(g) 205.7
oxygen
O2(g) 205.03
H O(g) ⟶ H O(l)
2 2
Solution
The value of the standard entropy change at room temperature, ΔS ∘
298
, is the difference between the standard entropy of the
product, H2O(l), and the standard entropy of the reactant, H2O(g).
∘ ∘ ∘
ΔS =S (H O(l)) − S (H O(g))
298 298 2 298 2
−1 −1 −1 −1 −1 −1
= (70.0 J mol K ) − (188.8 Jmol K ) = −118.8 J mol K
Exercise 16.3.2
Answer
−120.6 J mol−1 K−1
Calculate the standard entropy change for the combustion of methanol, CH3OH at room temperature:
Solution
The value of the standard entropy change is equal to the difference between the standard entropies of the products and the
entropies of the reactants scaled by their stoichiometric coefficients.
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
ΔS = ΔS = ∑ νS (products) − ∑ ν S (reactants)
298 298 298
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
= [2 S (CO (g)) + 4 S (H O(l))] − [2 S (CH OH(l)) + 3 S (O (g))]
298 2 298 2 298 3 298 2
Answer
24.7 J/mol•K
Summary
The second law of thermodynamics states that a spontaneous process increases the entropy of the universe, Suniv > 0. If ΔSuniv < 0,
the process is nonspontaneous, and if ΔSuniv = 0, the system is at equilibrium. The third law of thermodynamics establishes the zero
for entropy as that of a perfect, pure crystalline solid at 0 K. With only one possible microstate, the entropy is zero. We may
compute the standard entropy change for a process by using standard entropy values for the reactants and products involved in the
process.
Glossary
second law of thermodynamics
entropy of the universe increases for a spontaneous process
This page titled 16.3: The Second and Third Laws of Thermodynamics is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
One of the challenges of using the second law of thermodynamics to determine if a chemical reaction is spontaneous is that we
must determine the entropy change for the system and the entropy change for the surroundings. A second challenge when working
with a chemical reaction is that we need to take into account the mixing of the substances, an issue that does not occur when
observing the phase change if a pure substance. An alternative approach involving a new thermodynamic property defined in terms
of system properties only was introduced in the late nineteenth century by American mathematician Josiah Willard Gibbs. This new
property is called the Gibbs free energy (G) (or simply the free energy), and it is defined in terms of a system’s enthalpy and
entropy as the following:
G = H −TS
Free energy is a state function, and at constant temperature and pressure, the standard free energy change (ΔG°) may be expressed
as the following:
º º º
ΔGsys = ΔHsys − T ΔSsys
(For simplicity’s sake, the subscript “sys” will be omitted henceforth.) We can understand the relationship between this system
property and the spontaneity of a process by recalling the previously derived second law expression:
qsurr
ΔSuniv = ΔS +
T
The first law requires that qsurr = −qsys , and at constant pressure qsys = ΔH , and so this expression may be rewritten as the
following:
ΔH
ΔSuniv = ΔS −
T
ΔH is the enthalpy change of the system. Multiplying both sides of this equation by −T, and rearranging yields the following:
−T ΔSuniv = ΔH − T ΔS
Comparing this equation to the previous one for free energy change shows the following relation:
ΔG = −T ΔSuniv (16.4.1)
The free energy change is therefore a reliable indicator of the spontaneity of a process, being directly related to the previously
identified spontaneity indicator, ΔS . Table 16.4.1 summarizes the relation between the spontaneity of a process and the
univ
It is important to understand that for phase changes, ΔGº tells you if the phase change is spontaneous or not; will it happen, or not
happen. For chemical reactions, ΔGº tells you the extent of a reaction. In other words, ΔGº for a reaction tells you how much
product will be present at equilibrium. A reaction with ΔGº < 0 is considered product-favored at equilibrium; there will be more
products than reactants when the reaction reaches equilibrium. A reaction with ΔGº > 0 is considered reactant-favored at
equilibrium; there will be more reactants than products when the reaction reaches equilibrium.
Use standard enthalpy and entropy data from Tables T1 or T2 to calculate the standard free energy change for the vaporization
of water at room temperature (298 K). What does the computed value for ΔG° say about the spontaneity of this physical
change for a pure substance?
Solution
The process of interest is the following:
The standard change in free energy may be calculated using the following equation:
∘
ΔG = ΔH ° − T ΔS° (16.4.4)
298
Combining at 298 K:
∘ ∘ ∘
ΔH ° = ΔH = ΔH (H O(g)) − ΔH (H O(l))
298 f 2 f 2
= 44.01 kJ/mol
∘ ∘ ∘
ΔS° = ΔS =S (H O(g)) − S (H O(l))
298 298 2 298 2
= 118.8 J/mol ⋅ K
ΔG° = ΔH ° − T ΔS°
1 kJ
= 44.01 kJ/mol − (298 K × 118.8 J/mol ⋅ K) ×
1000 J
Use standard enthalpy and entropy data from Tables T1 or T2 to calculate the standard free energy change for the reaction
shown here (298 K). What does the computed value for ΔG° say about the extent of this reaction at 298 K?
Answer
ΔG
∘
298
= 102.0 kJ/mol ; the reaction is reactant-favored at equilibrium at 25 °C. There will be more C 2
H (g)
6
than H
2
(g)
and C 2
H (g)
4
at equilibrium
Free energy changes may also use the standard free energy of formation (ΔG ), for each of the reactants and products involved in
∘
f
the reaction. The standard free energy of formation is the free energy change that accompanies the formation of one mole of a
substance from its elements in their standard states. Similar to the standard enthalpies of formation, (ΔG ) is by definition zero for ∘
f
elemental substances under standard state conditions. The approach to computing the free energy change for a reaction using this
approach is the same as that demonstrated previously for enthalpy and entropy changes. For the reaction
mA + nB ⟶ xC + yD,
∘ ∘
= ∑ νΔG (products) − ∑ νΔG (reactants) (16.4.6)
298 298
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
= [xΔG (C) + yΔG (D)] − [mΔG (A) + nΔG (B)]. (16.4.7)
f f f f
Solution
The required data are available in Tables T1 or T2 and are shown here.
Required data for Tables T1 or T2
Compound ΔG
∘
f
(kJ/mol) ΔH
∘
f
(kJ/mol) S
∘
298
(J/K⋅mol)
Hg(l) 0 0 75.9
O2(g) 0 0 205.2
1
∘ ∘ ∘
= [1ΔG Hg(l) + ΔG O (g)] − 1ΔG HgO(s, yellow)
298 298 2 298
2
1
= [1 mol(0 kJ/mol) + mol(0 kJ/mol)] − 1 mol(−58.43 kJ/mol) = 58.43 kJ/mol
2
1
∘ ∘ ∘
= [1ΔH Hg(l) + ΔH O (g)] − 1ΔH HgO(s, yellow)
298 298 2 298
2
1
= [1 mol(0 kJ/mol) + mol(0 kJ/mol)] − 1 mol(−90.46 kJ/mol) = 90.46 kJ/mol
2
∘ ∘ ∘
ΔS = ∑ νΔS (products) − ∑ νΔS (reactants)
298 298 298
1
∘ ∘ ∘
= [1ΔS Hg(l) + ΔS O (g)] − 1ΔS HgO(s, yellow)
298 298 2 298
2
1
= [1 mol(75.9 J/mol K) + mol(205.2 J/mol K)] − 1 mol(71.13 J/mol K) = 107.4 J/mol K
2
1 kJ
= 90.46 kJ − 298.15 K × 107.4 J/K ⋅ mol ×
1000 J
Both ways to calculate the standard free energy change at 25 °C give the same numerical value (to three significant figures),
and both predict that the process is reactant-favored at equilibrium at room temperature.
Exercise 16.4.2
Calculate ΔG° using (a) free energies of formation and (b) enthalpies of formation and entropies (Tables T1 or T2). Do the
results indicate the reaction to be product-favored or reactant-favored at equilibrium at 25 °C?
Answer
141.5 kJ/mol, reactant-favored at equilibrium
Note
The numerical value of ΔGº is always dependent on the temperature. In this section we are determining whether or not the
sign of ΔGº is dependent on the temperature.
The extent of a process, as reflected in the arithmetic sign of its standard free energy change, is then determined by the signs of the
enthalpy and entropy changes and, in some cases, the absolute temperature. Since T is the absolute (Kelvin) temperature, it can
only have positive values. Four possibilities therefore exist with regard to the signs of the enthalpy and entropy changes:
1. Both ΔHº and ΔSº are positive. This condition describes an endothermic process that involves an increase in system entropy.
In this case, ΔGº will be negative if the magnitude of the TΔSº term is greater than ΔHº. If the TΔSº term is less than ΔHº, the
free energy change will be positive. Such a process is product-favored at equilibrium at high temperatures and reactant-
favored at equilibrium at low temperatures.
2. Both ΔHº and ΔSº are negative. This condition describes an exothermic process that involves a decrease in system entropy. In
this case, ΔGº will be negative if the magnitude of the TΔSº term is less than ΔHº. If the TΔSº term’s magnitude is greater than
ΔHº, the free energy change will be positive. Such a process is product-favored at equilibrium at low temperatures
and reactant-favored at equilibrium at high temperatures.
3. ΔHº is positive and ΔSº is negative. This condition describes an endothermic process that involves a decrease in system
entropy. In this case, ΔGº will be positive regardless of the temperature. Such a process is reactant-favored at equilibrium at all
temperatures.
4. ΔHº is negative and ΔSº is positive. This condition describes an exothermic process that involves an increase in system
entropy. In this case, ΔGº will be negative regardless of the temperature. Such a process is product-favored at equilibrium at all
temperatures.
These four scenarios are summarized in Table 16.4.1
Table 16.4.1
Sign of ΔH o
Sign of ΔS o
Sign of ΔG o
Temperature Dependence of ΔG o
º
Does the sign of ΔG of this process depend upon temperature?
Solution
Exercise 16.4.3
Answer
ΔHº and ΔSº are both negative; the reaction is product-favored at equilibrium at low temperatures.
When considering the conclusions drawn regarding the temperature dependence of the sign of ΔGº, it is important to keep in mind
what the terms “high” and “low” mean. Since these terms are adjectives, the temperatures in question are deemed high or low
relative to some reference temperature. A process that is reactant-favored at equilibrium at one temperature but product-favored at
equilibrium at another temperature will necessarily undergo a change in “extent” (as reflected by its ΔGº) as temperature varies.
This is clearly illustrated by a graphical presentation of the free energy change equation, in which ΔGº is plotted on the y axis
versus T on the x axis:
º º º
ΔG = ΔH − T ΔS
y = b + mx
Such a plot is shown in Figure 16.4.2. A process whose enthalpy and entropy changes are of the same arithmetic sign will exhibit a
temperature-dependence for the sign of ΔGº as depicted by the two yellow lines in the plot. Each line crosses from one spontaneity
domain (positive or negative ΔGº) to the other at a temperature that is characteristic of the process in question. This temperature is
represented by the x-intercept of the line, that is, the value of T for which ΔGº is zero:
º º º
ΔG = 0 = ΔH − T ΔS
º
ΔH
T =
º
ΔS
Thus, saying a process is product-favored at equilibrium at “high” or “low” temperatures means the temperature is above or below,
respectively, that temperature at which ΔGº for the process is zero.
Note
In this discussion, we have used two different descriptions for the meaning of the sign of ΔGº. You should be aware of the
meaning of each description.
a) Extent of Reaction: This description is used to predict the ratio of the product and reactant concentrations at equilibrium. In
this description, we use the thermodynamic term ΔGº to tell us the same information as the equilibrium constant, K.
When ΔGº < 0, K > 1, and the reaction will be product-favored at equilibrium. When ΔGº > 0, K< 1, and the reaction is
reactant-favored at equilibrium. When ΔGº = 0, K =1, and the reaction will have roughly equal amounts of products and
reactants at equilibrium. In all cases, the reaction will form a mixture of products and reactants at equilibrium. We use the sign
and magnitude of ΔGº to tell us how much product will be made if the reaction is allowed to reach equilibrium.
b) Spontaneity: This description is much more complicated because it involves two different interpretations of how a reaction
at standard state occurs. One interpretation involves the hypothetical process in which the reaction proceeds from a starting
point of pure reactants to a finishing point of pure products, with all substances isolated in their own containers under standard
state conditions. In the second, more realistic interpretation, the reaction starts with all reactants and all products in their
standard state in one container. We then allow this specific mixture to react an infinitesimally small amount so that we can
obtain a rate of change in free energy with respect to the extent of reaction when all reactants and products are mixed and
Figure 16.4.2 : These plots show the variation in ΔGº with temperature for the four possible combinations of arithmetic sign for
ΔHº and ΔSº. Note that in this graph of ΔGº, "spontaneous" is synonymous with "product-favored at equilibrium", and
"nonspontaneous" is synonymous with "reactant-favored at equilibrium".
As defined in the chapter on liquids and solids, the boiling point of a liquid is the temperature at which its solid and liquid
phases are in equilibrium (that is, when vaporization and condensation occur at equal rates). Use the information in Tables T1
or T2 to estimate the boiling point of water.
Solution
The process of interest is the following phase change:
H O(l) ⟶ H O(g)
2 2
∘ ∘
ΔS° = ΔS (H O(g)) − ΔS (H O(l))
298 2 298 2
3
ΔH ° 44.01 × 10 J/mol
T = = = 370.5 K = 97.3 °C
ΔS° 118.8 J/K ⋅ mol
The accepted value for water’s normal boiling point is 373.2 K (100.0 °C), and so this calculation is in reasonable agreement.
Note that the values for enthalpy and entropy changes data used were derived from standard data at 298 K (Tables T1 or T2.).
If desired, you could obtain more accurate results by using enthalpy and entropy changes determined at (or at least closer to)
the actual boiling point.
Exercise 16.4.4
Answer
313 K (accepted value 319 K).
R is the gas constant (8.314 J/K mol), T is the kelvin or absolute temperature, and Q is the reaction quotient. We may use this
equation to predict the spontaneity for a process under any given set of conditions as illustrated in Example 16.4.1.
What is the free energy change for the process shown here under the specified conditions?
T = 25 °C, P N
2
,
= 0.870 atm PH
2
= 0.250 atm , and P NH
3
= 12.9 atm
Solution
Equation 16.4.8 relates free energy change to standard free energy change and reaction quotient and may be used directly:
3
kJ J (0.250 ) × 0.870
= 33.0 + (8.314 × 298 K × ln )
2
mol mol K 12.9
J
= 9680 or 9.68 kJ/mol
mol
Since the computed value for ΔG is positive, the reaction is nonspontaneous under these conditions. The reaction will proceed
in the reverse direction to reach equilibrium.
Exercise 16.4.5
Calculate the free energy change for this same reaction at 875 °C in a 5.00 L mixture containing 0.100 mol of each gas. Is the
reaction spontaneous under these conditions?
Answer
ΔG = −47 kJ; yes, the reaction proceeds in the forward direction, as written, to reach equilibrium.
For a system at equilibrium, Q = K and ΔG = 0, and the Equation 16.4.8 may be written as
0 = ΔG° + RT ln K
at equilibrium
or alternatively
Δ G°
−
K =e RT (16.4.10)
This form of the equation provides a useful link between these two essential thermodynamic properties, and it can be used to derive
equilibrium constants from standard free energy changes and vice versa. The relations between standard free energy changes and
equilibrium constants are summarized in Table 16.4.1.
Table 16.4.1 : Relations between Standard Free Energy Changes and Equilibrium Constants
K ΔG° Comments
Given that the standard free energies of formation of Ag+(aq), Cl−(aq), and AgCl(s) are 77.1 kJ/mol, −131.2 kJ/mol, and
−109.8 kJ/mol, respectively, calculate the solubility product, Ksp, for AgCl.
Solution
The reaction of interest is the following:
+ − + −
AgCl(s) ⇌ Ag (aq) + Cl (aq) Ksp = [ Ag ][ Cl ]
The standard free energy change for this reaction is first computed using standard free energies of formation for its reactants
and products:
= 55.7 kJ/mol
The equilibrium constant for the reaction may then be derived from its standard free energy change via Equation 16.4.10:
ΔG°
− ΔG°
Ksp = e RT = exp(− )
RT
3
55.7 × 10 J/mol
= exp(− )
8.314 J/mol ⋅ K × 298.15 K
−22.470 −10
= exp(−22.470) = e = 1.74 × 10
Use the thermodynamic data provided in Tables T1 or T2 to calculate the equilibrium constant for the dissociation of
dinitrogen tetroxide at 25 °C.
NO2(g) ⇌ N O4(g)
2
Answer
K = 6.9
To further illustrate the relation between these two essential thermodynamic concepts, consider the observation that reactions
spontaneously proceed in a direction that ultimately establishes equilibrium. As may be shown by plotting the free energy change
versus the extent of the reaction (for example, as reflected in the value of Q), equilibrium is established when the system’s free
energy is minimized (Figure 16.4.3). If a system is present with reactants and products present in nonequilibrium amounts (Q ≠ K),
the reaction will proceed spontaneously in the direction necessary to establish equilibrium.
Figure 16.4.3 : These plots show the free energy versus reaction progress for systems whose standard free changes are (a) negative,
(b) positive, and (c) zero. Nonequilibrium systems will proceed spontaneously in whatever direction is necessary to minimize free
energy and establish equilibrium. Note that reactions with K equal to exactly 1.000 are rare.
Summary
Gibbs free energy (G) is a state function defined with regard to system quantities only and may be used to predict the spontaneity
of a process. A negative value for ΔG indicates that the process will proceed in the forward direction to reach equilibrium; a
positive ΔG indicates that the process will proceed in the reverse direction to reach equilibrium ; and a ΔG of zero indicates that the
system is at equilibrium. A negative value for ΔGº means that the reaction is product-favored at equilibrium. A positive value
for ΔGº means that the reaction is reactant-favored at equilibrium. If ΔGº equals 0 (a rare occurrence), the reaction has roughly
Glossary
Gibbs free energy change (G)
thermodynamic property defined in terms of system enthalpy and entropy; all spontaneous processes involve a decrease in G
change in free energy accompanying the formation of one mole of substance from its elements in their standard states
This page titled 16.4: Gibbs Energy is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
16.E.1.2: S16.1.1
A reaction has a natural tendency to occur and takes place without the continual input of energy from an external source.
16.E.1.3: Q16.1.2
What is a nonspontaneous reaction?
16.E.1.4: Q16.1.3
Indicate whether the following processes are spontaneous or nonspontaneous.
a. Liquid water freezing at a temperature below its freezing point
b. Liquid water freezing at a temperature above its freezing point
c. The combustion of gasoline
d. A ball thrown into the air
e. A raindrop falling to the ground
f. Iron rusting in a moist atmosphere
16.E.1.5: S16.1.2
spontaneous; nonspontaneous; spontaneous; nonspontaneous; spontaneous; spontaneous
16.E.1.6: Q16.1.4
A helium-filled balloon spontaneously deflates overnight as He atoms diffuse through the wall of the balloon. Describe the redistribution of matter and/or energy that accompanies
this process.
16.E.1.7: Q16.1.5
Many plastic materials are organic polymers that contain carbon and hydrogen. The oxidation of these plastics in air to form carbon dioxide and water is a spontaneous process;
however, plastic materials tend to persist in the environment. Explain.
16.E.1.8: S16.1.5
Although the oxidation of plastics is spontaneous, the rate of oxidation is very slow. Plastics are therefore kinetically stable and do not decompose appreciably even over relatively
long periods of time.
16.E.2.2: Q16.2.2
In Figure all of the possible distributions and microstates are shown for four different particles shared between two boxes. Determine the entropy change, ΔS, for the system when
it is converted from distribution to distribution (d).
16.E.2.4: Q16.2.3
How does the process described in the previous item relate to the system shown in [link]?
16.E.2.5: Q16.2.4
Consider a system similar to the one below, except that it contains six particles instead of four. What is the probability of having all the particles in only one of the two boxes in the
1
case? Compare this with the similar probability for the system of four particles that we have derived to be equal to . What does this comparison tell us about even larger systems?
8
16.E.2.6: S16.2.4
1 1
The probability for all the particles to be on one side is . This probability is noticeably lower than the result for the four-particle system. The conclusion we can make is that
32 8
the probability for all the particles to stay in only one part of the system will decrease rapidly as the number of particles increases, and, for instance, the probability for all
molecules of gas to gather in only one side of a room at room temperature and pressure is negligible since the number of gas molecules in the room is very large.
16.E.2.7: Q16.2.5
Consider the system shown in Figure. What is the change in entropy for the process where the energy is initially associated only with particle A, but in the final state the energy is
distributed between two different particles?
16.E.2.8: Q16.2.6
Consider the system shown in Figure. What is the change in entropy for the process where the energy is initially associated with particles A and B, and the energy is distributed
between two particles in different boxes (one in A-B, the other in C-D)?
16.E.2.9: S16.2.6
There is only one initial state. For the final state, the energy can be contained in pairs A-C, A-D, B-C, or B-D. Thus, there are four final possible states.
Wf 4
−23 −23
ΔS = k ln( ) = 1.38 × 10 J/K × ln( ) = 1.91 × 10 J/K (16.E.2)
Wi 1
16.E.2.10: Q16.2.7
Arrange the following sets of systems in order of increasing entropy. Assume one mole of each substance and the same temperature for each member of a set.
a. H2(g), HBrO4(g), HBr(g)
b. H2O(l), H2O(g), H2O(s)
c. He(g), Cl2(g), P4(g)
16.E.2.11: Q16.2.8
At room temperature, the entropy of the halogens increases from I2 to Br2 to Cl2. Explain.
16.E.2.12: S16.2.8
The masses of these molecules would suggest the opposite trend in their entropies. The observed trend is a result of the more significant variation of entropy with a physical state.
At room temperature, I2 is a solid, Br2 is a liquid, and Cl2 is a gas.
16.E.2.13: Q16.2.9
Consider two processes: sublimation of I2(s) and melting of I2(s) (Note: the latter process can occur at the same temperature but somewhat higher pressure).
I (s) ⟶ I (g) (16.E.3)
2 2
Is ΔS positive or negative in these processes? In which of the processes will the magnitude of the entropy change be greater?
16.E.2.14: Q16.2.11
Indicate which substance in the given pairs has the higher entropy value. Explain your choices.
a. C2H5OH(l) or C3H7OH(l)
b. C2H5OH(l) or C2H5OH(g)
c. 2Hor H(g)
16.E.2.16: Q16.2.11
Predict the sign of the entropy change for the following processes:
a. An ice cube is warmed to near its melting point.
b. Exhaled breath forms fog on a cold morning.
c. Snow melts.
16.E.2.17: Q16.2.12
Predict the sign of the enthalpy change for the following processes. Give a reason for your prediction.
a. Pb (aq) + S (aq) ⟶ PbS(s)
2+ 2−
16.E.2.18: S16.2.12
Negative. The relatively ordered solid precipitating decreases the number of mobile ions in solution. Negative. There is a net loss of three moles of gas from reactants to products.
Positive. There is a net increase of seven moles of gas from reactants to products.
16.E.2.19: Q16.2.13
Write the balanced chemical equation for the combustion of methane, CH4(g), to give carbon dioxide and water vapor. Explain why it is difficult to predict whether ΔS is positive
or negative for this chemical reaction.
16.E.2.20: Q16.2.14
Write the balanced chemical equation for the combustion of benzene, C6H6(l), to give carbon dioxide and water vapor. Would you expect ΔS to be positive or negative in this
process?
16.E.2.21: S16.2.14
C H (l) + 7.5 O (g) ⟶ 3 H O(g) + 6 CO (g) (16.E.5)
6 6 2 2 2
There are 7.5 moles of gas initially, and 3 + 6 = 9 moles of gas in the end. Therefore, it is likely that the entropy increases as a result of this reaction, and ΔS is positive.
16.E.3.2: Q16.3.1
Calculate ΔS ∘
298
for the following changes.
a. SnCl (l) ⟶ SnCl (g)
4 4
b. CS (g) ⟶ CS (l)
2 2
c. Cu(s) ⟶ Cu(g)
d. H O(l) ⟶ H O(g)
2 2
16.E.3.3: S16.3.1
107 J/K; −86.4 J/K; 133.2 J/K; 118.8 J/K; −326.6 J/K; −171.9 J/K; (g) −7.2 J/K
16.E.3.4: Q16.3.2
Determine the entropy change for the combustion of liquid ethanol, C2H5OH, under standard state conditions to give gaseous carbon dioxide and liquid water.
16.E.3.5: Q16.3.3
Determine the entropy change for the combustion of gaseous propane, C3H8, under standard state conditions to give gaseous carbon dioxide and water.
16.E.3.6: S16.3.3
100.6 J/K
16.E.3.7: Q16.3.4
“Thermite” reactions have been used for welding metal parts such as railway rails and in metal refining. One such thermite reaction is:
Fe O (s) + 2 Al(s) ⟶ Al O (s) + 2 Fe(s) (16.E.6)
2 3 2 3
Is the reaction spontaneous at room temperature under standard conditions? During the reaction, the surroundings absorb 851.8 kJ/mol of heat.
16.E.3.8: Q16.3.5
Using the relevant S ∘
298
values listed in Appendix G, calculate S ∘
298
for the following changes:
a. N (g) + 3 H (g) ⟶ 2 NH (g)
2 2 3
5
b. N 2
(g) + O (g) ⟶ N O (g)
2 2 5
2
16.E.3.10: Q16.3.6
From the following information, determine ΔS ∘
298
for the following:
a. N(g) + O(g) ⟶ NO(g) ΔS = ? ∘
298
16.E.3.11: Q16.3.7
By calculating ΔSuniv at each temperature, determine if the melting of 1 mole of NaCl(s) is spontaneous at 500 °C and at 700 °C.
What assumptions are made about the thermodynamic information (entropy and enthalpy values) used to solve this problem?
16.E.3.12: S16.3.7
As ΔSuniv < 0 at each of these temperatures, melting is not spontaneous at either of them. The given values for entropy and enthalpy are for NaCl at 298 K. It is assumed that these
do not change significantly at the higher temperatures used in the problem.
16.E.3.13: Q16.3.8
Use the standard entropy data in Appendix G to determine the change in entropy for each of the reactions listed in [link]. All are run under standard state conditions and 25 °C.
16.E.3.14: Q16.3.8
2.86 J/K; 24.8 J/K; −113.2 J/K; −24.7 J/K; 15.5 J/K; 290.0 J/K
16.E.4.2: Q16.4.2
A reactions has ΔH
∘
298
= 100 kJ/mol and ΔS
298
∘
= 250 J/mol⋅K . Is the reaction spontaneous at room temperature? If not, under what temperature conditions will it become
spontaneous?
16.E.4.3: S16.4.2
The reaction is nonspontaneous at room temperature. Above 400 K, ΔG will become negative, and the reaction will become spontaneous.
16.E.4.4: Q16.4.3
Explain what happens as a reaction starts with ΔG < 0 (negative) and reaches the point where ΔG = 0.
Use the standard free energy of formation data in Appendix G to determine the free energy change for each of the following reactions, which are run under standard state
conditions and 25 °C. Identify each as either spontaneous or nonspontaneous at these conditions.
a. MnO (s) ⟶ Mn(s) + O (g)
2 2
16.E.4.5: S16.4.3
465.1 kJ nonspontaneous; −106.86 kJ spontaneous; −53.6 kJ spontaneous; −83.4 kJ spontaneous; −406.7 kJ spontaneous; −30.0 kJ spontaneous
16.E.4.6: Q16.4.4
Use the standard free energy data in Appendix G to determine the free energy change for each of the following reactions, which are run under standard state conditions and 25 °C.
Identify each as either spontaneous or nonspontaneous at these conditions.
a. C(s, graphite) + O (g) ⟶ CO (g) 2 2
Given:
∘
P (s) + 5 O (g) ⟶ P O (s) ΔG = −2697.0 kJ/mol (16.E.7)
4 2 4 10 298
∘
2 H (g) + O (g) ⟶ 2 H O(g) ΔG = −457.18 kJ/mol (16.E.8)
2 2 2 298
∘
6 H O(g) + P O (g) ⟶ 4 H PO (l) ΔG = −428.66 kJ/mol (16.E.9)
2 4 10 3 4 298
16.E.4.7: Q16.4.5
a. Determine the standard free energy of formation, ΔG , for phosphoric acid. ∘
f
b. How does your calculated result compare to the value in Appendix G? Explain.
16.E.4.9: Q16.4.6
Is the formation of ozone (O3(g)) from oxygen (O2(g)) spontaneous at room temperature under standard state conditions?
16.E.4.10: Q16.4.7
Consider the decomposition of red mercury(II) oxide under standard state conditions.
2 HgO(s, red) ⟶ 2 Hg(l) + O (g) (16.E.10)
2
16.E.4.11: S16.4.7
The reaction is nonspontaneous; Above 566 °C the process is spontaneous.
16.E.4.12: Q16.4.8
Among other things, an ideal fuel for the control thrusters of a space vehicle should decompose in a spontaneous exothermic reaction when exposed to the appropriate catalyst.
Evaluate the following substances under standard state conditions as suitable candidates for fuels.
a. Ammonia: 2 NH (g) ⟶ N (g) + 3 H (g) 3 2 2
1
d. Hydrogen peroxide: H 2
O (l) ⟶ H O(g) +
2 2
O (g)
2
2
16.E.4.13: Q16.4.9
Calculate ΔG° for each of the following reactions from the equilibrium constant at the temperature given.
a. N (g) + O (g) ⟶ 2 NO(g) T = 2000 °C K = 4.1 × 10
2 2 p
−4
16.E.4.14: S16.4.9
1.5 × 102 kJ; −21.9 kJ; −5.34 kJ; −0.383 kJ; 18 kJ; 71 kJ
16.E.4.15: Q16.4.10
Calculate ΔG° for each of the following reactions from the equilibrium constant at the temperature given.
a. Cl (g) + Br (g) ⟶ 2 BrCl(g) T = 25 °C K = 4.7 × 10
2 2 p
−2
16.E.4.16: Q16.4.11
Calculate the equilibrium constant at 25 °C for each of the following reactions from the value of ΔG° given.
a. O (g) + 2 F (g) ⟶ 2 OF (g) ΔG° = −9.2 kJ
2 2 2
16.E.4.17: S16.4.11
K = 41; K = 0.053; K = 6.9 × 1013; K = 1.9; K = 0.04
16.E.4.18: Q16.4.2
Calculate the equilibrium constant at 25 °C for each of the following reactions from the value of ΔG° given.
a. I (s) + Cl (g) ⟶ 2 ICl(g) ΔG° = −10.88 kJ
2 2
16.E.4.19: Q16.4.13
Calculate the equilibrium constant at the temperature given.
a. (a) O (g) + 2 F (g) ⟶ 2 F
2 2 2
O(g) (T = 100 °C)
16.E.4.20: S16.4.13
In each of the following, the value of ΔG is not given at the temperature of the reaction. Therefore, we must calculate ΔG° from the values ΔH° and ΔS° and then calculate ΔG
from the relation ΔG° = ΔH° − TΔS°.
a. K = 1.29
b. K = 2.51 × 10−3
c. K = 4.83 × 103
d. K = 0.219
e. K = 16.1
16.E.4.21: Q16.4.14
Calculate the equilibrium constant at the temperature given.
a. (a) I (s) + Cl (g) ⟶ 2 ICl(g) (T = 100 °C)
2 2
16.E.4.22: Q16.4.15
Consider the following reaction at 298 K:
N O (g) ⇌ 2 NO (g) KP = 0.142 (16.E.11)
2 4 2
What is the standard free energy change at this temperature? Describe what happens to the initial system, where the reactants and products are in standard states, as it approaches
equilibrium.
16.E.4.23: S16.4.16
The standard free energy change is ΔG = −RT ln K = 4.84 kJ/mol . When reactants and products are in their standard states (1 bar or 1 atm), Q = 1. As the reaction proceeds
∘
298
toward equilibrium, the reaction shifts left (the amount of products drops while the amount of reactants increases): Q < 1, and ΔG becomes less positive as it approaches zero.
298
At equilibrium, Q = K, and ΔG = 0.
16.E.4.24: Q16.4.17
Determine the normal boiling point (in kelvin) of dichloroethane, CH2Cl2. Find the actual boiling point using the Internet or some other source, and calculate the percent error in
the temperature. Explain the differences, if any, between the two values.
16.E.4.25: Q16.4.18
Under what conditions is N 2
O (g) ⟶ NO(g) + NO (g)
3 2
spontaneous?
16.E.4.26: S16.4.18
The reaction will be spontaneous at temperatures greater than 287 K.
16.E.4.27: Q16.4.19
At room temperature, the equilibrium constant (Kw) for the self-ionization of water is 1.00 × 10−14. Using this information, calculate the standard free energy change for the
aqueous reaction of hydrogen ion with hydroxide ion to produce water. (Hint: The reaction is the reverse of the self-ionization reaction.)
16.E.4.28: Q16.4.20
3
Hydrogen sulfide is a pollutant found in natural gas. Following its removal, it is converted to sulfur by the reaction 2 H 2
S(g) + SO (g) ⇌
2
S (s, rhombic) + 2 H O(l)
8 2
. What
8
is the equilibrium constant for this reaction? Is the reaction endothermic or exothermic?
16.E.4.29: S16.4.20
K = 5.35 × 1015
The process is exothermic.
16.E.4.30: Q16.4.21
Consider the decomposition of CaCO3(s) into CaO(s) and CO2(g). What is the equilibrium partial pressure of CO2 at room temperature?
16.E.4.31: Q16.4.22
In the laboratory, hydrogen chloride (HCl(g)) and ammonia (NH3(g)) often escape from bottles of their solutions and react to form the ammonium chloride (NH4Cl(s)), the white
glaze often seen on glassware. Assuming that the number of moles of each gas that escapes into the room is the same, what is the maximum partial pressure of HCl and NH3 in the
laboratory at room temperature? (Hint: The partial pressures will be equal and are at their maximum value when at equilibrium.)
16.E.4.32: S16.4.22
1.0 × 10−8 atm. This is the maximum pressure of the gases under the stated conditions.
16.E.4.33: Q16.4.23
Benzene can be prepared from acetylene. 3 C H (g) ⇌ C 2 2 6
H (g)
6
. Determine the equilibrium constant at 25 °C and at 850 °C. Is the reaction spontaneous at either of these
temperatures? Why is all acetylene not found as benzene?
16.E.4.35: Q16.4.25
Carbon tetrachloride, an important industrial solvent, is prepared by the chlorination of methane at 850 K.
CH (g) + 4 Cl (g) ⟶ CCl (g) + 4 HCl(g) (16.E.13)
4 2 4
What is the equilibrium constant for the reaction at 850 K? Would the reaction vessel need to be heated or cooled to keep the temperature of the reaction constant?
16.E.4.36: Q16.4.25B
Acetic acid, CH3CO2H, can form a dimer, (CH3CO2H)2, in the gas phase.
2 CH CO H(g) ⟶ (CH CO H) (g) (16.E.14)
3 2 3 2 2
The dimer is held together by two hydrogen bonds with a total strength of 66.5 kJ per mole of dimer.
At 25 °C, the equilibrium constant for the dimerization is 1.3 × 103 (pressure in atm). What is ΔS° for the reaction?
16.E.4.37: S16.4.25B
−0.16 kJ
16.E.4.38: Q16.4.26
Nitric acid, HNO3, can be prepared by the following sequence of reactions:
4 NH (g) + 5 O (g) ⟶ 4 NO(g) + 6 H O(g) (16.E.15)
3 2 2
How much heat is evolved when 1 mol of NH3(g) is converted to HNO3(l)? Assume standard states at 25 °C.
16.E.4.39: Q16.4.27A
Determine ΔG for the following reactions.
(a) Antimony pentachloride decomposes at 448 °C. The reaction is:
SbCl (g) ⟶ SbCl (g) + Cl (g) (16.E.18)
5 3 2
An equilibrium mixture in a 5.00 L flask at 448 °C contains 3.85 g of SbCl5, 9.14 g of SbCl3, and 2.84 g of Cl2.
Chlorine molecules dissociate according to this reaction:
Cl (g) ⟶ 2 Cl(g) (16.E.19)
2
16.E.4.40: S16.4.27A
a. (a) −22.1 kJ;
b. 61.6 kJ/mol
16.E.4.41: Q16.4.27
Given that the ΔG for Pb2+(aq) and Cl−(aq) is −24.3 kJ/mole and −131.2 kJ/mole respectively, determine the solubility product, Ksp, for PbCl2(s).
∘
f
16.E.4.42: Q16.4.28
Determine the standard free energy change, ΔG , for the formation of S2−(aq) given that the ΔG for Ag+(aq) and Ag2S(s) are 77.1 k/mole and −39.5 kJ/mole respectively, and
∘
f
∘
f
16.E.4.43: S16.4.28
90 kJ/mol
16.E.4.44: Q16.4.29
Determine the standard enthalpy change, entropy change, and free energy change for the conversion of diamond to graphite. Discuss the spontaneity of the conversion with respect
to the enthalpy and entropy changes. Explain why diamond spontaneously changing into graphite is not observed.
16.E.4.45: Q16.4.30
The evaporation of one mole of water at 298 K has a standard free energy change of 8.58 kJ.
∘
H O(l) ⇌ H O(g) ΔG = 8.58 kJ (16.E.20)
2 2 298
d. If the evaporation of water were always nonspontaneous at room temperature, wet laundry would never dry when placed outside. In order for laundry to dry, what must be the
value of P in the air?
H O
2
16.E.4.46: S16.4.30
(a) Under standard thermodynamic conditions, the evaporation is nonspontaneous; Kp = 0.031; The evaporation of water is spontaneous; P H O
2
must always be less than Kp or less
than 0.031 atm. 0.031 atm represents air saturated with water vapor at 25 °C, or 100% humidity.
16.E.4.47: Q16.4.31
In glycolysis, the reaction of glucose (Glu) to form glucose-6-phosphate (G6P) requires ATP to be present as described by the following equation:
∘
Glu + ATP ⟶ G6P + ADP ΔG = −17 kJ (16.E.21)
298
Determine the standard free energy change for the following reaction, and explain why ATP is necessary to drive this process:
∘
Glu ⟶ G6P ΔG =? (16.E.23)
298
16.E.4.48: Q16.4.32
One of the important reactions in the biochemical pathway glycolysis is the reaction of glucose-6-phosphate (G6P) to form fructose-6-phosphate (F6P):
∘
G6P ⇌ F6P ΔG = 1.7 kJ (16.E.24)
298
16.E.4.49: S16.4.32
28
(a) Nonspontaneous as ΔG ∘
298
>0 ; ΔG∘
298
= −RT ln K, ΔG = 1.7 × 10
3
+ (8.314 × 335 × ln ) = −2.5 kJ . The forward reaction to produce F6P is spontaneous under
128
these conditions.
16.E.4.50: Q16.4.33
Without doing a numerical calculation, determine which of the following will reduce the free energy change for the reaction, that is, make it less positive or more negative, when
the temperature is increased. Explain.
a. (a) N (g) + 3 H (g) ⟶ 2 NH (g)
2 2 3
When ammonium chloride is added to water and stirred, it dissolves spontaneously and the resulting solution feels cold. Without doing any calculations, deduce the signs of ΔG,
ΔH, and ΔS for this process, and justify your choices.
16.E.4.51: S16.4.33
ΔG is negative as the process is spontaneous. ΔH is positive as with the solution becoming cold, the dissolving must be endothermic. ΔS must be positive as this drives the process,
and it is expected for the dissolution of any soluble ionic compound.
16.E.4.52: Q16.4.34
An important source of copper is from the copper ore, chalcocite, a form of copper(I) sulfide. When heated, the Cu2S decomposes to form copper and sulfur described by the
following equation:
b. The reaction of sulfur with oxygen yields sulfur dioxide as the only product. Write an equation that describes this reaction, and determine ΔG for the process. ∘
298
c. The production of copper from chalcocite is performed by roasting the Cu2S in air to produce the Cu. By combining the equations from Parts (a) and (b), write the equation that
describes the roasting of the chalcocite, and explain why coupling these reactions together makes for a more efficient process for the production of the copper.
16.E.4.53: Q16.4.35
What happens to ΔG ∘
298
(becomes more negative or more positive) for the following chemical reactions when the partial pressure of oxygen is increased?
a. (a) S(s) + O (g) ⟶ SO (g)
2 2
16.E.4.54: S16.4.35
a. (a) Increasing P will shift the equilibrium toward the products, which increases the value of K. ΔG therefore becomes more negative.
O
2
∘
298
b. Increasing P will shift the equilibrium toward the products, which increases the value of K. ΔG therefore becomes more negative.
O
2
∘
298
c. Increasing P will shift the equilibrium the reactants, which decreases the value of K. ΔG therefore becomes more positive.
O
2
∘
298
This page titled 16.E: Thermodynamics (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and
standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 17: Electrochemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
17.1: Balancing Oxidation-Reduction Reactions
Learning Objectives
Define electrochemistry and a number of important associated terms
Split oxidation-reduction reactions into their oxidation half-reactions and reduction half-reactions
Produce balanced oxidation-reduction equations for reactions in acidic or basic solution
Identify oxidizing agents and reducing agents
Electricity refers to a number of phenomena associated with the presence and flow of electric charge. Electricity includes such
diverse things as lightning, static electricity, the current generated by a battery as it discharges, and many other influences on our
daily lives. The flow or movement of charge is an electric current (Figure 17.1.1). Electrons or ions may carry the charge. The
elementary unit of charge is the charge of a proton, which is equal in magnitude to the charge of an electron. The SI unit of charge
is the coulomb (C) and the charge of a proton is 1.602 × 10−19 C. The presence of an electric charge generates an electric field.
Electric current is the rate of flow of charge.
Figure 17.1.1 : Electricity-related phenomena include lightning, accumulation of static electricity, and current produced by a
battery. (credit left: modification of work by Thomas Bresson; credit middle: modification of work by Chris Darling; credit right:
modification of work by Windell Oskay).
The SI unit for electrical current is the SI base unit called the ampere (A), which is a flow rate of 1 coulomb of charge per second
(1 A = 1 C/s). An electric current flows in a path, called an electric circuit. In most chemical systems, it is necessary to maintain a
closed path for current to flow. The flow of charge is generated by an electrical potential difference, or potential, between two
points in the circuit. Electrical potential is the ability of the electric field to do work on the charge. The SI unit of electrical
potential is the volt (V). When 1 coulomb of charge moves through a potential difference of 1 volt, it gains or loses 1 joule (J) of
energy. Table 17.1.1 summarizes some of this information about electricity.
Table 17.1.1 : Common Electrical Terms
Quantity Definition Measure or Unit
Electric potential The force trying to move the charge volt = V = J/C
Electrochemistry studies oxidation-reduction reactions, which were first discussed in an earlier chapter, where we learned that
oxidation was the loss of electrons and reduction was the gain of electrons. The reactions discussed tended to be rather simple, and
conservation of mass (atom counting by type) and deriving a correctly balanced chemical equation were relatively simple. In this
section, we will concentrate on the half-reaction method for balancing oxidation-reduction reactions. The use of half-reactions is
important partly for balancing more complicated reactions and partly because many aspects of electrochemistry are easier to
discuss in terms of half-reactions. There are alternate methods of balancing these reactions; however, there are no good alternatives
to half-reactions for discussing what is occurring in many systems. The half-reaction method splits oxidation-reduction reactions
into their oxidation “half” and reduction “half” to make finding the overall equation easier.
Electrochemical reactions frequently occur in solutions, which could be acidic, basic, or neutral. When balancing oxidation-
reduction reactions, the nature of the solution may be important. It helps to see this in an actual problem. Consider the following
unbalanced oxidation-reduction reaction in acidic solution:
We can start by collecting the species we have so far into an unbalanced oxidation half-reaction and an unbalanced reduction half-
reaction. Each of these half-reactions contain the same element in two different oxidation states. The Fe2+ has lost an electron to
become Fe3+; therefore, the iron underwent oxidation. The reduction is not as obvious; however, the manganese gained five
electrons to change from Mn7+ to Mn2+.
2+ 3+
oxidation (unbalanced): Fe (aq) ⟶ Fe (aq)
− 2+
reduction (unbalanced): MnO (aq) ⟶ Mn (aq)
4
In acidic solution, there are hydrogen ions present, which are often useful in balancing half-reactions. It may be necessary to use
the hydrogen ions directly or as a reactant that may react with oxygen to generate water. Hydrogen ions are very important in acidic
solutions where the reactants or products contain hydrogen and/or oxygen. In this example, the oxidation half-reaction involves
neither hydrogen nor oxygen, so hydrogen ions are not necessary to the balancing. However, the reduction half-reaction does
involve oxygen. It is necessary to use hydrogen ions to convert this oxygen to water.
− + 2+
charge not balanced: MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
4 2
The situation is different in basic solution because the hydrogen ion concentration is lower and the hydroxide ion concentration is
higher. After finishing this example, we will examine how basic solutions differ from acidic solutions. A neutral solution may be
treated as acidic or basic, though treating it as acidic is usually easier.
The iron atoms in the oxidation half-reaction are balanced (mass balance); however, the charge is unbalanced, since the charges on
the ions are not equal. It is necessary to use electrons to balance the charge. The way to balance the charge is by adding electrons to
one side of the equation. Adding a single electron on the right side gives a balanced oxidation half-reaction:
2+ 3+ −
oxidation (balanced): Fe (aq) ⟶ Fe (aq) + e
You should check the half-reaction for the number of each atom type and the total charge on each side of the equation. The charges
include the actual charges of the ions times the number of ions and the charge on an electron times the number of electrons.
Fe: Does (1 × 1) = (1 × 1)? Yes.
If the atoms and charges balance, the half-reaction is balanced. In oxidation half-reactions, electrons appear as products (on the
right). As discussed in the earlier chapter, since iron underwent oxidation, iron is the reducing agent.
Now return to the reduction half-reaction equation:
− + 2+
reduction (unbalanced): MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
4 2
The atoms are balanced (mass balance), so it is now necessary to check for charge balance. The total charge on the left of the
reaction arrow is [(−1) × (1) + (8) × (+1)], or +7, while the total charge on the right side is [(1) × (+2) + (4) × (0)], or +2. The
difference between +7 and +2 is five; therefore, it is necessary to add five electrons to the left side to achieve charge balance.
− + − 2+
Reduction (balanced): MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) + 5 e ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
4 2
You should check this half-reaction for each atom type and for the charge, as well:
Mn: Does (1 × 1) = (1 × 1)? Yes.
Now that this half-reaction is balanced, it is easy to see it involves reduction because electrons were gained when MnO was −
4
reduced to Mn2+. In all reduction half-reactions, electrons appear as reactants (on the left side). As discussed in the earlier chapter,
the species that was reduced, MnO in this case, is also called the oxidizing agent. We now have two balanced half-reactions.
−
4
2+ 3+ −
oxidation: Fe (aq) ⟶ Fe (aq) + e
− + − 2+
reduction: MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) + 5 e ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
4 2
− + − 2+
reduction: MnO 4 (aq) + 8 H (aq) + 5 e ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
2
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
2+ − + 3+ 2+
overall: 5 Fe (aq) + MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) ⟶ 5 Fe (aq) + Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
4 2
The electrons do not appear in the final answer because the oxidation electrons are the same electrons as the reduction electrons
and they “cancel.” Carefully check each side of the overall equation to verify everything was combined correctly:
Fe: Does (5 × 1) = (5 × 1)? Yes.
Everything checks, so this is the overall equation in acidic solution. If something does not check, the most common error occurs
during the multiplication of the individual half-reactions.
Now suppose we wanted the solution to be basic. Recall that basic solutions have excess hydroxide ions. Some of these hydroxide
ions will react with hydrogen ions to produce water. The simplest way to generate the balanced overall equation in basic solution is
to start with the balanced equation in acidic solution, then “convert” it to the equation for basic solution. However, it is necessary to
exercise caution when doing this, as many reactants behave differently under basic conditions and many metal ions will precipitate
as the metal hydroxide. We just produced the following reaction, which we want to change to a basic reaction:
2+ − + 3+ 2+
5 Fe (aq) + MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) ⟶ 5 Fe (aq) + Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
4 2
However, under basic conditions, MnO normally reduces to MnO2 and iron will be present as either Fe(OH)2 or Fe(OH)3. For
−
In this case, it is necessary to add two hydroxide ions to each side of the equation to convert the two hydrogen ions on the left into
water:
− − + − − −
Cl (aq) + 2 MnO (aq) + (2 H + 2 OH )(aq) ⟶ ClO (aq) + 2 MnO (s) + H O(l) + 2 OH (aq)
4 3 2 2
Note that both sides of the equation show water. Simplifying should be done when necessary, and gives the desired equation. In this
case, it is necessary to remove one H2O from each side of the reaction arrows.
− − − −
Cl (aq) + 2 MnO (aq) + H O(l) ⟶ ClO (aq) + 2 MnO (s) + 2 OH (aq)
4 2 3 2
Again, check each side of the overall equation to make sure there are no errors:
Cl: Does (1 × 1) = (1 × 1)? Yes.
Solution
This is an oxidation-reduction reaction, so start by collecting the species given into an unbalanced oxidation half-reaction and
an unbalanced reduction half-reaction.
3+ 2−
oxidation (unbalanced): Cr (aq) ⟶ Cr O (aq)
2 7
− 2+
reduction (unbalanced): MnO (aq) ⟶ Mn (aq)
4
In acidic solution, we can use or generate hydrogen ions (H+). Adding seven water molecules to the left side provides the necessary
oxygen; the “left over” hydrogen appears as 14 H+ on the right:
3+ 2− +
oxidation (unbalanced): 2 Cr (aq) + 7 H O(l) ⟶ Cr O (aq) + 14 H (aq)
2 2 7
The left side of the equation has a total charge of [2 × (+3) = +6], and the right side a total charge of [−2 + 14 × (+1) = +12]. The
difference is six; adding six electrons to the right side produces a mass- and charge-balanced oxidation half-reaction (in acidic
solution):
3+ 2− + −
oxidation (balanced): 2 Cr (aq) + 7 H O(l) ⟶ Cr O (aq) + 14 H (aq) + 6 e
2 2 7
Now work on the reduction. It is necessary to convert the four oxygen atoms in the permanganate into four water molecules. To do
this, add eight H+ to convert the oxygen into four water molecules:
− + 2+
reduction (unbalanced): MnO 4 (aq) + 8 H (aq) ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
2
Then add five electrons to the left side to balance the charge:
− + − 2+
reduction: MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) + 5 e ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l)
4 2
The least common multiple for the electrons is 30, so multiply the oxidation half-reaction by five, the reduction half-reaction by
six, combine, and simplify:
3+ − + 2− + 2+
10 Cr (aq) + 35 H O(l) + 6 MnO 4 (aq) + 48 H (aq) ⟶ 5 Cr O7 (aq) + 70 H (aq) + 6 Mn (aq) + 24 H O(l)
2 2 2
3+ − 2− + 2+
10 Cr (aq) + 11 H O(l) + 6 MnO (aq) ⟶ 5 Cr O (aq) + 22 H (aq) + 6 Mn (aq)
2 4 2 7
Exercise 17.1.1
Answer
2+ +
Hg (aq) + 2 Ag(s) ⟶ 2 Hg(l) + 2 Ag (aq)
2
Solution
This is an oxidation-reduction reaction, so start by collecting the species given into an unbalanced oxidation half-reaction and
an unbalanced reduction half-reaction
2−
oxidation (unbalanced): Cr(OH) (s) ⟶ CrO (aq)
3 4
−
reduction (unbalanced): MnO (aq) ⟶ MnO (s)
4 2
The left side of the equation has a total charge of [0], and the right side a total charge of [−2 + 5 × (+1) = +3]. The difference is
three, adding three electrons to the right side produces a mass- and charge-balanced oxidation half-reaction (in acidic solution):
2− + −
oxidation (balanced): Cr(OH) (s) + H O(l) ⟶ CrO (aq) + 5 H (aq) + 3 e
3 2 4
Now work on the reduction. It is necessary to convert the four O atoms in the MnO4− minus the two O atoms in MnO2 into two
water molecules. To do this, add four H+ to convert the oxygen into two water molecules:
− +
reduction (unbalanced): MnO 4 (aq) + 4 H (aq) ⟶ MnO (s) + 2 H O(l)
2 2
Then add three electrons to the left side to balance the charge:
− + −
reduction (balanced): MnO (aq) + 4 H (aq) + 3 e ⟶ MnO (s) + 2 H O(l)
4 2 2
− + −
reduction: MnO (aq) + 4 H (aq) + 3 e ⟶ MnO (s) + 2 H O(l)
4 2 2
In this case, both half reactions involve the same number of electrons; therefore, simply add the two half-reactions together.
− + 2− +
MnO (aq) + 4 H (aq) + Cr(OH) (s) + H O(l) ⟶ CrO (aq) + MnO (s) + 2 H O(l) + 5 H (aq)
4 3 2 4 2 2
− 2− +
MnO (aq) + Cr(OH) (s) ⟶ CrO (aq) + MnO (s) + H O(l) + H (aq)
4 3 4 2 2
This is the balanced equation in acidic solution. For a basic solution, add one hydroxide ion to each side and simplify:
− − 2− + −
OH (aq) + MnO (aq) + Cr(OH) (s) ⟶ CrO (aq) + MnO (s) + H O(l) + (H + OH )(aq)
4 3 4 2 2
− − 2−
OH (aq) + MnO 4 (aq) + Cr(OH) (s) ⟶ CrO4 (aq) + MnO (s) + 2 H O(l)
3 2 2
Exercise 17.1.2
Balance the following in the type of solution indicated.
a. H + Cu ⟶ Cu (acidic solution)
2
2+
c. Fe + Ag ⟶ Fe + Ag
+ 2+
Answer a
2+ +
H (g) + Cu (aq) ⟶ 2 H (aq) + Cu(s)
2
Answer b
H (g) + Cu(OH) (s) ⟶ 2 H O(l) + Cu(s)
2 2 2
Answer c
+ 2+
Fe(s) + 2 Ag (aq) ⟶ Fe (aq) + 2 Ag(s)
Answer d
oxidizing agent = species reduced: Cu2+, Cu(OH)2, Ag+
Answer e
reducing agent = species oxidized: H2, H2, Fe.
Summary
An electric current consists of moving charge. The charge may be in the form of electrons or ions. Current flows through an
unbroken or closed circular path called a circuit. The current flows through a conducting medium as a result of a difference in
electrical potential between two points in a circuit. Electrical potential has the units of energy per charge. In SI units, charge is
C J
measured in coulombs (C), current in amperes (A = ) , and electrical potential in volts (V = ) .
s C
Oxidation is the loss of electrons, and the species that is oxidized is also called the reducing agent. Reduction is the gain of
electrons, and the species that is reduced is also called the oxidizing agent. Oxidation-reduction reactions can be balanced using the
half-reaction method. In this method, the oxidation-reduction reaction is split into an oxidation half-reaction and a reduction half-
reaction. The oxidation half-reaction and reduction half-reaction are then balanced separately. Each of the half-reactions must have
the same number of each type of atom on both sides of the equation and show the same total charge on each side of the equation.
Charge is balanced in oxidation half-reactions by adding electrons as products; in reduction half-reactions, charge is balanced by
adding electrons as reactants. The total number of electrons gained by reduction must exactly equal the number of electrons lost by
oxidation when combining the two half-reactions to give the overall balanced equation. Balancing oxidation-reduction reaction
equations in aqueous solutions frequently requires that oxygen or hydrogen be added or removed from a reactant. In acidic
solution, hydrogen is added by adding hydrogen ion (H+) and removed by producing hydrogen ion; oxygen is removed by adding
hydrogen ion and producing water, and added by adding water and producing hydrogen ion. A balanced equation in basic solution
can be obtained by first balancing the equation in acidic solution, and then adding hydroxide ion to each side of the balanced
equation in such numbers that all the hydrogen ions are converted to water.
current
C
flow of electrical charge; the SI unit of charge is the coulomb (C) and current is measured in amperes (1 A = 1 )
s
electrical potential
energy per charge; in electrochemical systems, it depends on the way the charges are distributed within the system; the SI unit
J
of electrical potential is the volt (1 V = 1 )
C
half-reaction method
method that produces a balanced overall oxidation-reduction reaction by splitting the reaction into an oxidation “half” and
reduction “half,” balancing the two half-reactions, and then combining the oxidation half-reaction and reduction half-reaction in
such a way that the number of electrons generated by the oxidation is exactly canceled by the number of electrons required by
the reduction
oxidation half-reaction
the “half” of an oxidation-reduction reaction involving oxidation; the half-reaction in which electrons appear as products;
balanced when each atom type, as well as the charge, is balanced
reduction half-reaction
the “half” of an oxidation-reduction reaction involving reduction; the half-reaction in which electrons appear as reactants;
balanced when each atom type, as well as the charge, is balanced
This page titled 17.1: Balancing Oxidation-Reduction Reactions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated
by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon
request.
Galvanic cells, also known as voltaic cells, are electrochemical cells in which spontaneous oxidation-reduction reactions produce
electrical energy. In writing the equations, it is often convenient to separate the oxidation-reduction reactions into half-reactions to
facilitate balancing the overall equation and to emphasize the actual chemical transformations.
Consider what happens when a clean piece of copper metal is placed in a solution of silver nitrate (Figure 17.2.1). As soon as the
copper metal is added, silver metal begins to form and copper ions pass into the solution. The blue color of the solution on the far
right indicates the presence of copper ions. The reaction may be split into its two half-reactions. Half-reactions separate the
oxidation from the reduction, so each can be considered individually.
2+ −
oxidation: Cu(s) ⟶ Cu (aq) + 2 e (17.2.1)
+ − + −
reduction: 2 × (Ag (aq) + e ⟶ Ag(s)) or 2 Ag (aq) + 2 e ⟶ 2 Ag(s) (17.2.2)
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
+ 2+
overall: 2 Ag (aq) + Cu(s) ⟶ 2 Ag(s) + Cu (aq) (17.2.3)
The equation for the reduction half-reaction had to be doubled so the number electrons “gained” in the reduction half-reaction
equaled the number of electrons “lost” in the oxidation half-reaction.
Figure 17.2.1 : When a clean piece of copper metal is placed into a clear solution of silver nitrate (a), an oxidation-reduction
reaction occurs that results in the exchange of Cu2+ for Ag+ ions in solution. As the reaction proceeds (b), the solution turns blue
(c) because of the copper ions present, and silver metal is deposited on the copper strip as the silver ions are removed from
solution. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott)
Galvanic or voltaic cells involve spontaneous electrochemical reactions in which the half-reactions are separated (Figure 17.2.2) so
that current can flow through an external wire. The beaker on the left side of the figure is called a half-cell, and contains a 1 M
solution of copper(II) nitrate [Cu(NO3)2] with a piece of copper metal partially submerged in the solution. The copper metal is an
electrode. The copper is undergoing oxidation; therefore, the copper electrode is the anode. The anode is connected to a voltmeter
with a wire and the other terminal of the voltmeter is connected to a silver electrode by a wire. The silver is undergoing reduction;
therefore, the silver electrode is the cathode. The half-cell on the right side of the figure consists of the silver electrode in a 1 M
solution of silver nitrate (AgNO3). At this point, no current flows—that is, no significant movement of electrons through the wire
occurs because the circuit is open. The circuit is closed using a salt bridge, which transmits the current with moving ions. The salt
bridge consists of a concentrated, nonreactive, electrolyte solution such as the sodium nitrate (NaNO3) solution used in this
example. As electrons flow from left to right through the electrode and wire, nitrate ions (anions) pass through the porous plug on
the left into the copper(II) nitrate solution. This keeps the beaker on the left electrically neutral by neutralizing the charge on the
copper(II) ions that are produced in the solution as the copper metal is oxidized. At the same time, the nitrate ions are moving to the
left, sodium ions (cations) move to the right, through the porous plug, and into the silver nitrate solution on the right. These added
cations “replace” the silver ions that are removed from the solution as they were reduced to silver metal, keeping the beaker on the
right electrically neutral. Without the salt bridge, the compartments would not remain electrically neutral and no significant current
would flow. However, if the two compartments are in direct contact, a salt bridge is not necessary. The instant the circuit is
completed, the voltmeter reads +0.46 V, this is called the cell potential. The cell potential is created when the two dissimilar metals
are connected, and is a measure of the energy per unit charge available from the oxidation-reduction reaction. The volt is the
derived SI unit for electrical potential
In this equation, A is the current in amperes and C the charge in coulombs. Note that volts must be multiplied by the charge in
coulombs (C) to obtain the energy in joules (J).
Figure 17.2.2 : In this standard galvanic cell, the half-cells are separated; electrons can flow through an external wire and become
available to do electrical work.
When the electrochemical cell is constructed in this fashion, a positive cell potential indicates a spontaneous reaction and that the
electrons are flowing from the left to the right. There is a lot going on in Figure 17.2.2, so it is useful to summarize things for this
system:
Electrons flow from the anode to the cathode: left to right in the standard galvanic cell in the figure.
The electrode in the left half-cell is the anode because oxidation occurs here. The name refers to the flow of anions in the salt
bridge toward it.
The electrode in the right half-cell is the cathode because reduction occurs here. The name refers to the flow of cations in the
salt bridge toward it.
Oxidation occurs at the anode (the left half-cell in the figure).
Reduction occurs at the cathode (the right half-cell in the figure).
The cell potential, +0.46 V, in this case, results from the inherent differences in the nature of the materials used to make the two
half-cells.
The salt bridge must be present to close (complete) the circuit and both an oxidation and reduction must occur for current to
flow.
There are many possible galvanic cells, so a shorthand notation is usually used to describe them. The cell notation (sometimes
called a cell diagram) provides information about the various species involved in the reaction. This notation also works for other
types of cells. A vertical line, │, denotes a phase boundary and a double line, ‖, the salt bridge. Information about the anode is
written to the left, followed by the anode solution, then the salt bridge (when present), then the cathode solution, and, finally,
information about the cathode to the right. The cell notation for the galvanic cell in Figure 17.2.2 is then
2+ +
Cu(s) │Cu (aq, 1 M )║Ag (aq, 1 M )│Ag(s)
Note that spectator ions are not included and that the simplest form of each half-reaction was used. When known, the initial
concentrations of the various ions are usually included.
One of the simplest cells is the Daniell cell. It is possible to construct this battery by placing a copper electrode at the bottom of a
jar and covering the metal with a copper sulfate solution. A zinc sulfate solution is floated on top of the copper sulfate solution;
then a zinc electrode is placed in the zinc sulfate solution. Connecting the copper electrode to the zinc electrode allows an electric
current to flow. This is an example of a cell without a salt bridge, and ions may flow across the interface between the two solutions.
Some oxidation-reduction reactions involve species that are poor conductors of electricity, and so an electrode is used that does not
participate in the reactions. Frequently, the electrode is platinum, gold, or graphite, all of which are inert to many chemical
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
+ 2+
overall: Mg(s) + 2 H (aq) ⟶ Mg (aq) + H (g) (17.2.6)
2
The cell used an inert platinum wire for the cathode, so the cell notation is
The magnesium electrode is an active electrode because it participates in the oxidation-reduction reaction. Inert electrodes, like the
platinum electrode in Figure 17.2.3, do not participate in the oxidation-reduction reaction and are present so that current can flow
through the cell. Platinum or gold generally make good inert electrodes because they are chemically unreactive.
Figure 17.2.2 : The oxidation of magnesium to magnesium ion occurs in the beaker on the left side in this apparatus; the reduction
of hydrogen ions to hydrogen occurs in the beaker on the right. A nonreactive, or inert, platinum wire allows electrons from the left
beaker to move into the right beaker. The overall reaction is: Mg + 2 H ⟶ Mg + H , which is represented in cell notation
+ 2+
Write the oxidation and reduction half-reactions and write the reaction using cell notation. Which reaction occurs at the anode?
The cathode?
Solution
By inspection, Cr is oxidized when three electrons are lost to form Cr3+, and Cu2+ is reduced as it gains two electrons to form
Cu. Balancing the charge gives
3+ −
oxidation: 2 Cr(s) ⟶ 2 Cr (aq) + 6 e (17.2.7)
2+ −
reduction: 3 Cu (aq) + 6 e ⟶ 3 Cu(s) (17.2.8)
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
2+ 3+
overall: 2 Cr(s) + 3 Cu (aq) ⟶ 2 Cr (aq) + 3 Cu(s) (17.2.9)
Cell notation uses the simplest form of each of the equations, and starts with the reaction at the anode. No concentrations were
specified so:
Write the oxidation and reduction half-reactions and write the reaction using cell notation. Which reaction occurs at the anode?
The cathode?
Solution
By inspection, Fe2+ undergoes oxidation when one electron is lost to form Fe3+, and MnO4− is reduced as it gains five electrons
to form Mn2+. Balancing the charge gives
2+ 3+ −
oxidation: 5(Fe (aq) ⟶ Fe (aq) + e ) (17.2.10)
− + − 2+
reduction: MnO 4 (aq) + 8 H (aq) + 5 e ⟶ Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l) (17.2.11)
2
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
2+ − + 3+ 2+
overall: 5 Fe (aq) + MnO (aq) + 8 H (aq) ⟶ 5 Fe (aq) + Mn (aq) + 4 H O(l) (17.2.12)
4 2
Cell notation uses the simplest form of each of the equations, and starts with the reaction at the anode. It is necessary to use an
inert electrode, such as platinum, because there is no metal present to conduct the electrons from the anode to the cathode. No
concentrations were specified so:
Exercise 17.2.1
Use cell notation to describe the galvanic cell where copper(II) ions are reduced to copper metal and zinc metal is oxidized to
zinc ions.
Answer
From the information given in the problem:
2+ −
anode (oxidation): Zn(s) ⟶ Zn (aq) + 2 e (17.2.13)
2+ −
cathode (reduction): Cu (aq) + 2 e ⟶ Cu(s) (17.2.14)
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
2+ 2+
overall: Zn(s) + Cu (aq) ⟶ Zn (aq) + Cu(s) (17.2.15)
Summary
Electrochemical cells typically consist of two half-cells. The half-cells separate the oxidation half-reaction from the reduction half-
reaction and make it possible for current to flow through an external wire. One half-cell, normally depicted on the left side in a
figure, contains the anode. Oxidation occurs at the anode. The anode is connected to the cathode in the other half-cell, often shown
on the right side in a figure. Reduction occurs at the cathode. Adding a salt bridge completes the circuit allowing current to flow.
Anions in the salt bridge flow toward the anode and cations in the salt bridge flow toward the cathode. The movement of these ions
completes the circuit and keeps each half-cell electrically neutral. Electrochemical cells can be described using cell notation. In this
notation, information about the reaction at the anode appears on the left and information about the reaction at the cathode on the
right. The salt bridge is represented by a double line, ‖. The solid, liquid, or aqueous phases within a half-cell are separated by a
Glossary
active electrode
electrode that participates in the oxidation-reduction reaction of an electrochemical cell; the mass of an active electrode changes
during the oxidation-reduction reaction
anode
electrode in an electrochemical cell at which oxidation occurs; information about the anode is recorded on the left side of the
salt bridge in cell notation
cathode
electrode in an electrochemical cell at which reduction occurs; information about the cathode is recorded on the right side of the
salt bridge in cell notation
cell notation
shorthand way to represent the reactions in an electrochemical cell
cell potential
difference in electrical potential that arises when dissimilar metals are connected; the driving force for the flow of charge
(current) in oxidation-reduction reactions
galvanic cell
electrochemical cell that involves a spontaneous oxidation-reduction reaction; electrochemical cells with positive cell
potentials; also called a voltaic cell
inert electrode
electrode that allows current to flow, but that does not otherwise participate in the oxidation-reduction reaction in an
electrochemical cell; the mass of an inert electrode does not change during the oxidation-reduction reaction; inert electrodes are
often made of platinum or gold because these metals are chemically unreactive.
voltaic cell
another name for a galvanic cell
This page titled 17.2: Galvanic Cells is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The cell potential results from the difference in the electrical potentials for each electrode. While it is impossible to determine the
electrical potential of a single electrode, we can assign an electrode the value of zero and then use it as a reference. The electrode
chosen as the zero is shown in Figure 17.4.1 and is called the standard hydrogen electrode (SHE). The SHE consists of 1 atm of
hydrogen gas bubbled through a 1 M HCl solution, usually at room temperature. Platinum, which is chemically inert, is used as the
electrode. The reduction half-reaction chosen as the reference is
+ −
2H (aq, 1 M ) + 2 e ⇌ H (g, 1 atm) E° = 0 V
2
E° is the standard reduction potential. The superscript “°” on the E denotes standard conditions (1 bar or 1 atm for gases, 1 M for
solutes). The voltage is defined as zero for all temperatures.
Figure 17.3.1 : Hydrogen gas at 1 atm is bubbled through 1 M HCl solution. Platinum, which is inert to the action of the 1 M HCl,
is used as the electrode. Electrons on the surface of the electrode combine with H+ in solution to produce hydrogen gas.
A galvanic cell consisting of a SHE and Cu2+/Cu half-cell can be used to determine the standard reduction potential for Cu2+
(Figure 17.3.2). In cell notation, the reaction is
+ 2+
Pt(s) │H2 (g, 1 atm) │H (aq, 1 M ) ║Cu (aq, 1 M ) │Cu(s)
Electrons flow from the anode to the cathode. The reactions, which are reversible, are
+ −
Anode (oxidation): H (g) ⟶ 2 H (aq) + 2 e
2
2+ −
Cathode (reduction): Cu (aq) + 2 e ⟶ Cu(s)
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
2+ +
Overall: Cu (aq) + H (g) ⟶ 2 H (aq) + Cu(s)
2
The standard reduction potential can be determined by subtracting the standard reduction potential for the reaction occurring at the
anode from the standard reduction potential for the reaction occurring at the cathode. The minus sign is necessary because
oxidation is the reverse of reduction.
∘ ∘ ∘
E =E −E
cell cathode anode
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
+0.34 V = E 2+
−E +
=E 2+
−0 = E 2+
Cu /Cu H /H Cu /Cu Cu /Cu
2
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
+ +
overall: 2 Ag (aq) + H (g) ⟶ 2 H (aq) + 2 Ag(s)
2
The standard reduction potential can be determined by subtracting the standard reduction potential for the reaction occurring at the
anode from the standard reduction potential for the reaction occurring at the cathode. The minus sign is needed because oxidation is
the reverse of reduction.
∘ ∘ ∘
E =E −E
cell cathode anode
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
+0.80 V = E +
−E +
=E +
−0 = E +
Ag /Ag H /H Ag /Ag Ag /Ag
2
It is important to note that the potential is not doubled for the cathode reaction.
The SHE is rather dangerous and rarely used in the laboratory. Its main significance is that it established the zero for standard
reduction potentials. Once determined, standard reduction potentials can be used to determine the standard cell potential, E , for ∘
cell
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
+ 2+
overall: Cu(s) + 2 Ag (aq) ⟶ Cu (aq) + 2 Ag(s)
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
E =E −E =E +
−E 2+
= 0.80 V − 0.34 V = 0.46 V
cell cathode anode Ag /Ag Cu /Cu
Again, note that when calculating E , standard reduction potentials always remain the same even when a half-reaction is
∘
cell
multiplied by a factor. Standard reduction potentials for selected reduction reactions are shown in Table 17.3.1. A more complete
list is provided in Tables P1 or P2.
F (g) + 2 e
2
−
⟶ 2F
−
(aq) +2.866
PbO (s) + SO
2
2−
4
(aq) + 4 H
+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ PbSO (s) + 2 H O(l)
4 2
+1.69
MnO
−
4
(aq) + 8 H
+
(aq) + 5 e
−
⟶ Mn
2+
(aq) + 4 H O(l)
2
+1.507
Au
3+
(aq) + 3 e
−
⟶ Au(s) +1.498
Cl (g) + 2 e
2
−
⟶ 2 Cl
−
(aq) +1.35827
O (g) + 4 H
2
+
(aq) + 4 e
−
⟶ 2 H O(l)
2
+1.229
Pt
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Pt(s) +1.20
Br (aq) + 2 e
2
−
⟶ 2 Br
−
(aq) +1.0873
Ag
+
(aq) + e
−
⟶ Ag(s) +0.7996
Hg
2+
2
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ 2 Hg(l) +0.7973
Fe
3+
(aq) + e
−
⟶ Fe
2+
(aq) +0.771
MnO
−
4
(aq) + 2 H O(l) + 3 e
2
−
⟶ MnO (s) + 4 OH
2
−
(aq) +0.558
I (s) + 2 e
2
−
⟶ 2I
−
(aq) +0.5355
Cu
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Cu(s) +0.34
Hg Cl (s) + 2 e
2 2
−
⟶ 2 Hg(l) + 2 Cl
−
(aq) +0.26808
AgCl(s) + e
−
⟶ Ag(s) + Cl
−
(aq) +0.22233
Sn
4+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Sn
2+
(aq) +0.151
2H
+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ H (g)
2
0.00
Pb
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Pb(s) −0.1262
Sn
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Sn(s) −0.1375
Ni
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Ni(s) −0.257
Co
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Co(s) −0.28
PbSO (s) + 2 e
4
−
⟶ Pb(s) + SO
2−
4
(aq) −0.3505
Cd
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Cd(s) −0.4030
Fe
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Fe(s) −0.447
Cr
3+
(aq) + 3 e
−
⟶ Cr(s) −0.744
Mn
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Mn(s) −1.185
Zn(OH) (s) + 2 e
2
−
⟶ Zn(s) + 2 OH
−
(aq) −1.245
Zn
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Zn(s) −0.7618
Al
3+
(aq) + 3 e
−
⟶ Al(s) −1.662
Mg
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Mg(s) −2.372
Na
+
(aq) + e
−
⟶ Na(s) −2.71
Ca
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Ca(s) −2.868
Ba
2+
(aq) + 2 e
−
⟶ Ba(s) −2.912
K
+
(aq) + e
−
⟶ K(s) −2.931
Li
+
(aq) + e
−
⟶ Li(s) −3.04
Tables like this make it possible to determine the standard cell potential for many oxidation-reduction reactions.
What is the standard cell potential for a galvanic cell that consists of Au3+/Au and Ni2+/Ni half-cells? Identify the oxidizing
and reducing agents.
Solution
Using Table 17.3.1, the reactions involved in the galvanic cell, both written as reductions, are
3+ − ∘
Au (aq) + 3 e ⟶ Au(s) E 3+
= +1.498 V
Au /Au
2+ − ∘
Ni (aq) + 2 e ⟶ Ni(s) E 2+
= −0.257 V
Ni /Ni
Galvanic cells have positive cell potentials, and all the reduction reactions are reversible. The reaction at the anode will be the
half-reaction with the smaller or more negative standard reduction potential. Reversing the reaction at the anode (to show the
oxidation) but not its standard reduction potential gives:
2+ − ∘ ∘
Anode (oxidation): Ni(s) ⟶ Ni (aq) + 2 e E =E 2+
= −0.257 V
anode Ni /Ni
3+ − ∘ ∘
Cathode (reduction): Au (aq) + 3 e ⟶ Au(s) E =E 3+
= +1.498 V
cathode Au /Au
The reduction potentials are not scaled by the stoichiometric coefficients when calculating the cell potential, and the unmodified
standard reduction potentials must be used.
∘ ∘ ∘
E =E −E = 1.498 V − (−0.257 V) = 1.755 V
cell cathode anode
From the half-reactions, Ni is oxidized, so it is the reducing agent, and Au3+ is reduced, so it is the oxidizing agent.
A galvanic cell consists of a Mg electrode in 1 M Mg(NO3)2 solution and a Ag electrode in 1 M AgNO3 solution. Calculate the
standard cell potential at 25 °C.
Answer
+ 2+ ∘
Mg(s) + 2 Ag (aq) ⟶ Mg (aq) + 2 Ag(s) E = 0.7996 V − (−2.372 V) = 3.172 V
cell
Summary
Assigning the potential of the standard hydrogen electrode (SHE) as zero volts allows the determination of standard reduction
potentials, E°, for half-reactions in electrochemical cells. As the name implies, standard reduction potentials use standard states (1
bar or 1 atm for gases; 1 M for solutes, often at 298.15 K) and are written as reductions (where electrons appear on the left side of
the equation). The reduction reactions are reversible, so standard cell potentials can be calculated by subtracting the standard
reduction potential for the reaction at the anode from the standard reduction for the reaction at the cathode. When calculating the
standard cell potential, the standard reduction potentials are not scaled by the stoichiometric coefficients in the balanced overall
equation.
Glossary
standard cell potential (E ∘
cell
)
the cell potential when all reactants and products are in their standard states (1 bar or 1 atm or gases; 1 M for solutes), usually at
298.15 K; can be calculated by subtracting the standard reduction potential for the half-reaction at the anode from the standard
reduction potential for the half-reaction occurring at the cathode
This page titled 17.3: Standard Reduction Potentials is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
We will now extend electrochemistry by determining the relationship between E and the thermodynamics quantities such as
∘
cell
ΔG° (Gibbs free energy) and K (the equilibrium constant). In galvanic cells, chemical energy is converted into electrical energy,
which can do work. The electrical work is the product of the charge transferred multiplied by the potential difference (voltage):
C
4
= 9.648 × 10
mol
4
J
= 9.648 × 10
V ⋅ mol
Therefore
−
total charge = (number of moles of e ) × F = nF
In this equation, n is the number of moles of electrons for the balanced oxidation-reduction reaction. The measured cell potential is
the maximum potential the cell can produce and is related to the electrical work (wele) by
−wele
Ecell = or wele = −nF Ecell
nF
The negative sign for the work indicates that the electrical work is done by the system (the galvanic cell) on the surroundings. In an
earlier chapter, the free energy was defined as the energy that was available to do work. In particular, the change in free energy was
defined in terms of the maximum work (w max ), which, for electrochemical systems, is w . ele
ΔG = wmax = wele
= −nF Ecell
We can verify the signs are correct when we realize that n and F are positive constants and that galvanic cells, which have positive
cell potentials, involve spontaneous reactions. Thus, spontaneous reactions, which have ΔG < 0 , must have E > 0 . If all the cell
This provides a way to relate standard cell potentials to equilibrium constants, since
ΔG° = −RT ln K
∘
−nF E = −RT ln K
cell
or
RT
∘
E = ln K
cell
nF
Most of the time, the electrochemical reactions are run at standard temperature (298.15 K). Collecting terms at this temperature
yields
J
(8.314 ) (298.15 K)
K⋅mol
= ln K
n × 96, 485 C/V⋅mol
0.0257 V
= ln K
n
where n is the number of moles of electrons. The logarithm in equations involving cell potentials is often expressed using base 10
logarithms (i.e., log or just log), which changes the constant by a factor of 2.303:
10
0.0592 V
∘
E = log K
cell
n
Thus, if ΔG°, K, or E is known or can be calculated, the other two quantities can be readily determined. The relationships are
∘
cell
Figure 17.4.1 : The relationships between ΔG°, K, and E . Given any one of the three quantities, the other two can be calculated,
∘
cell
so any of the quantities could be used to determine whether a process was spontaneous.
A diagram is shown that involves three double headed arrows positioned in the shape of an equilateral triangle. The vertices are
labeled in red. The top vertex is labeled “K.“ The vertex at the lower left is labeled “delta G superscript degree symbol.” The vertex
at the lower right is labeled “E superscript degree symbol subscript cell.” The right side of the triangle is labeled “E superscript
degree symbol subscript cell equals ( R T divided by n F ) l n K.” The lower side of the triangle is labeled “delta G superscript
degree symbol equals negative n F E superscript degree symbol subscript cell.” The left side of the triangle is labeled “delta G
superscript degree symbol equals negative R T l n K.”
Given any one of the quantities, the other two can be calculated.
What is the standard Gibbs free energy change and equilibrium constant for the following reaction at 25 °C?
+ 2+
2 Ag (aq) + Fe(s) ⇌ 2 Ag(s) + Fe (aq)
Solution
The reaction involves an oxidation-reduction reaction, so the standard cell potential can be calculated using the data in Table
P1.
2+ − ∘
anode (oxidation): Fe(s) ⟶ Fe (aq) + 2 e E 2+
= −0.447 V
Fe /Fe
+ − ∘
cathode (reduction): 2 × (Ag (aq) + e ⟶ Ag(s)) E +
= 0.7996 V
Ag /Ag
∘ ∘ ∘ ∘ ∘
E =E −E =E +
−E 2+
= +1.247 V
cell cathode anode Ag /Ag Fe /Fe
∘
n×Ecell /0.0592 V
K = 10
2×1.247 V/0.0592 V
= 10
42.128
= 10
42
= 1.3 × 10
J kJ
ΔG° = −2 × 96, 485 × 1.247 V = −240.6
V⋅mol mol
Check your answer: A positive standard cell potential means a spontaneous reaction, so the standard free energy change should
be negative, and an equilibrium constant should be >1.
Exercise 17.4.1
What is the standard Gibbs free energy change and the equilibrium constant for the following reaction at room temperature? Is
the reaction spontaneous?
2+ 2+ +
Sn(s) + 2 Cu (aq) ⇌ Sn (aq) + 2 Cu (aq)
Answer
kJ
Spontaneous; n = 2; E ∘
cell
;
= +0.291 V ΔG° = −56.2 ; K = 6.8 × 10 . 9
mol
Now that the connection has been made between the free energy and cell potentials, nonstandard concentrations follow. Recall that
ΔG = ΔG° + RT ln Q
where Q is the reaction quotient (see the chapter on equilibrium fundamentals). Converting to cell potentials:
∘
−nF Ecell = −nF E + RT ln Q (17.4.1)
cell
or
RT
∘
Ecell = E − ln Q (17.4.2)
cell
nF
Equation 17.4.2 is the generalized Nernst equation that is applicable at any temperature. However, is can be simplified for reactions
occuring at 25 °C (298.15 K) by rewriting it as
0.0257 V
∘
Ecell = E − ln Q (17.4.3)
cell
n
or
0.0592 V
∘
Ecell = E − log10 Q (17.4.4)
cell
n
If the temperature is not 298.15 K, it is necessary to recalculate the potential with Equation17.4.2. With the Nernst equation, it is
possible to calculate the cell potential at nonstandard conditions. This adjustment is necessary because potentials determined under
different conditions will have different values.
Solution
There are two ways to solve the problem. If the thermodynamic information in Table T1 were available, you could calculate
the free energy change. If the free energy change is negative, the process is spontaneous. The other approach, which we will
use, requires information like that given in Table P1. Using those data, the cell potential can be determined. If the cell potential
is positive, the process is spontaneous. Collecting information from Table P1 and the problem,
2+ − ∘
Anode (oxidation): Co(s) ⟶ Co (aq) + 2 e E 2+
= −0.28 V
Co /Co
2+ − ∘
Cathode (reduction): Fe (aq) + 2 e ⟶ Fe(s) E 2+
= −0.447 V
Fe /Fe
∘ ∘ ∘
E =E −E = −0.447 V − (−0.28 V) = −0.17 V
cell cathode anode
The process is not spontaneous under standard conditions. Using the Nernst equation and the concentrations stated in the
problem and n = 2 ,
2+
[ Co ] 0.15 M
Q = = = 0.077
2+
[ Fe ] 1.94 M
Now we can insert these into the Nernst Equation at room temperature (Equation 17.4.4)
0.0592 V
∘
Ecell = E − log Q
cell
n
0.0592 V
= −0.17 V − log 0.077
2
Exercise 17.4.2
What is the cell potential for the following reaction at room temperature?
3+ 2+
│Al
Al(s) (aq, 0.15 M ) ║Cu (aq, 0.025 M ) │Cu(s)
What are the values of n and Q for the overall reaction? Is the reaction spontaneous under these conditions?
Answer
n = 6; Q = 1440; Ecell = +1.97 V, spontaneous.
Finally, we will take a brief look at a special type of cell called a concentration cell. In a concentration cell, the electrodes are the
same material and the half-cells differ only in concentration. Since one or both compartments is not standard, the cell potentials
will be unequal; therefore, there will be a potential difference, which can be determined with the aid of the Nernst equation.
2+ − ∘
Cathode: Zn (aq, 0.50 M ) + 2 e ⟶ Zn(s) E = −0.7618 V
cathode
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
2+ 2+ ∘
Overall: Zn (aq, 0.50 M ) ⟶ Zn (aq, 0.10 M ) E = 0.000 V
cell
The standard cell potential is zero because the anode and cathode involve the same reaction; only the concentration of Zn2+
changes. Substituting into the Nernst equation,
0.0592 V 0.10
Ecell = 0.000 V − log = +0.021 V
2 0.50
Exercise 17.4.3
What value of Q for the previous concentration cell would result in a voltage of 0.10 V? If the concentration of zinc ion at the
cathode was 0.50 M, what was the concentration at the anode?
Answer
Q = 0.00042; [Zn2+]cat = 2.1 \times 10−4 M.
Summary
Electrical work (wele) is the negative of the product of the total charge (Q) and the cell potential (Ecell). The total charge can be
calculated as the number of moles of electrons (n) times the Faraday constant (F = 96,485 C/mol e−). Electrical work is the
maximum work that the system can produce and so is equal to the change in free energy. Thus, anything that can be done with or to
a free energy change can also be done to or with a cell potential. The Nernst equation relates the cell potential at nonstandard
conditions to the logarithm of the reaction quotient. Concentration cells exploit this relationship and produce a positive cell
potential using half-cells that differ only in the concentration of their solutes.
Glossary
concentration cell
galvanic cell in which the two half-cells are the same except for the concentration of the solutes; spontaneous when the overall
reaction is the dilution of the solute
Nernst equation
equation that relates the logarithm of the reaction quotient (Q) to nonstandard cell potentials; can be used to relate equilibrium
constants to standard cell potentials
This page titled 17.4: The Nernst Equation is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
A battery is an electrochemical cell or series of cells that produces an electric current. In principle, any galvanic cell could be used
as a battery. An ideal battery would never run down, produce an unchanging voltage, and be capable of withstanding environmental
extremes of heat and humidity. Real batteries strike a balance between ideal characteristics and practical limitations. For example,
the mass of a car battery is about 18 kg or about 1% of the mass of an average car or light-duty truck. This type of battery would
supply nearly unlimited energy if used in a smartphone, but would be rejected for this application because of its mass. Thus, no
single battery is “best” and batteries are selected for a particular application, keeping things like the mass of the battery, its cost,
reliability, and current capacity in mind. There are two basic types of batteries: primary and secondary. A few batteries of each type
are described next.
electrode is a rod made of carbon that is surrounded by a paste of manganese(IV) oxide, zinc chloride, ammonium chloride, carbon
powder, and a small amount of water. The reaction at the anode can be represented as the ordinary oxidation of zinc:
2+ − ∘
Zn(s) ⟶ Zn (aq) + 2 e E 2+
= −0.7618 V
Zn /Zn
The reaction at the cathode is more complicated, in part because more than one reaction occurs. The series of reactions that occurs
at the cathode is approximately
− −
2 MnO (s) + 2 NH Cl(aq) + 2 e ⟶ Mn O (s) + 2 NH (aq) + H O(l) + 2 Cl
2 4 2 3 3 2
2+ −
2 MnO (s) + 2 NH Cl(aq) + Zn(s) ⟶ Zn (aq) + Mn O (s) + 2 NH (aq) + H O(l) + 2 Cl
2 4 2 3 3 2
with an overall cell potential which is initially about 1.5 V, but decreases as the battery is used. It is important to remember that the
voltage delivered by a battery is the same regardless of the size of a battery. For this reason, D, C, A, AA, and AAA batteries all
have the same voltage rating. However, larger batteries can deliver more moles of electrons. As the zinc container oxidizes, its
contents eventually leak out, so this type of battery should not be left in any electrical device for extended periods.
Alkaline batteries (Figure 17.5.2) were developed in the 1950s partly to address some of the
performance issues with zinc–carbon dry cells. They are manufactured to be exact replacements for zinc-
carbon dry cells. As their name suggests, these types of batteries use alkaline electrolytes, often
potassium hydroxide. The reactions are
− − ∘
anode: Zn(s) + 2 OH (aq) ⟶ ZnO(s) + H O(l) + 2 e E = −1.28 V
2 anode
− − ∘
cathode: 2 MnO (s) + H O(l) + 2 e ⟶ Mn O (s) + 2 OH (aq) E = +0.15 V
2 2 2 3 cathode
––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
∘
overall: Zn(s) + 2 MnO (s) ⟶ ZnO(s) + Mn O (s) E = +1.43 V
2 2 3 cell
An alkaline battery can deliver about three to five times the energy of a zinc-carbon dry cell of similar size. Alkaline batteries are
prone to leaking potassium hydroxide, so these should also be removed from devices for long-term storage. While some alkaline
batteries are rechargeable, most are not. Attempts to recharge an alkaline battery that is not rechargeable often leads to rupture of
the battery and leakage of the potassium hydroxide electrolyte.
− −
cathode: NiO (s) + 2 H O(l) + 2 e ⟶ Ni (OH) (s) + 2 OH (aq)
2 2 2
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
overall: Cd(s) + NiO (s) + 2 H O(l) ⟶ Cd(OH) (s) + Ni (OH) (s)
2 2 2 2
The voltage is about 1.2 V to 1.25 V as the battery discharges. When properly treated, a NiCd battery can be recharged about 1000
times. Cadmium is a toxic heavy metal so NiCd batteries should never be opened or put into the regular trash.
Figure 17.5.3 : NiCd batteries use a “jelly-roll” design that significantly increases the amount of current the battery can deliver as
compared to a similar-sized alkaline battery.
Lithium ion batteries (Figure 17.5.4) are among the most popular rechargeable batteries and are used in many portable electronic
devices. The reactions are
+ −
anode: LiCoO ⇌ Li 1−x CoO + x Li + xe
2 2
+ −
cathode: x Li + xe + xC ⇌ x LiC
6 6
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
overall: LiCoO + xC ⇌ Li 1−x CoO + x LiC
2 6 2 6
Figure 17.5.4 : In a lithium ion battery, charge flows between the electrodes as the lithium ions move between the anode and
cathode.
The lead acid battery (Figure 17.5.5) is the type of secondary battery used in your automobile. It is inexpensive and capable of
producing the high current required by automobile starter motors. The reactions for a lead acid battery are
− + −
anode: Pb(s) + HSO (aq) ⟶ PbSO (s) + H (aq) + 2 e
4 4
− + −
cathode: PbO (s) + HSO 4 (aq) + 3 H (aq) + 2 e ⟶ PbSO (s) + 2 H O(l)
2 4 2
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
overall: Pb(s) + PbO (s) + 2 H SO (aq) ⟶ 2 PbSO (s) + 2 H O(l)
2 2 4 4 2
Each cell produces 2 V, so six cells are connected in series to produce a 12-V car battery. Lead acid batteries are heavy and contain
a caustic liquid electrolyte, but are often still the battery of choice because of their high current density. Since these batteries
contain a significant amount of lead, they must always be disposed of properly.
Figure 17.5.5 : The lead acid battery in your automobile consists of six cells connected in series to give 12 V. Their low cost and
high current output makes these excellent candidates for providing power for automobile starter motors.
− 2−
cathode: O +4 e ⟶ 2O
2
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
overall: 2 H +O ⟶ 2H O
2 2 2
The voltage is about 0.9 V. The efficiency of fuel cells is typically about 40% to 60%, which is higher than the typical internal
combustion engine (25% to 35%) and, in the case of the hydrogen fuel cell, produces only water as exhaust. Currently, fuel cells
are rather expensive and contain features that cause them to fail after a relatively short time.
Summary
Batteries are galvanic cells, or a series of cells, that produce an electric current. When cells are combined into batteries, the
potential of the battery is an integer multiple of the potential of a single cell. There are two basic types of batteries: primary and
secondary. Primary batteries are “single use” and cannot be recharged. Dry cells and (most) alkaline batteries are examples of
primary batteries. The second type is rechargeable and is called a secondary battery. Examples of secondary batteries include
nickel-cadmium (NiCd), lead acid, and lithium ion batteries. Fuel cells are similar to batteries in that they generate an electrical
current, but require continuous addition of fuel and oxidizer. The hydrogen fuel cell uses hydrogen and oxygen from the air to
produce water, and is generally more efficient than internal combustion engines.
Summary
alkaline battery
primary battery that uses an alkaline (often potassium hydroxide) electrolyte; designed to be an exact replacement for the dry
cell, but with more energy storage and less electrolyte leakage than typical dry cell
battery
galvanic cell or series of cells that produces a current; in theory, any galvanic cell
dry cell
primary battery, also called a zinc-carbon battery; can be used in any orientation because it uses a paste as the electrolyte; tends
to leak electrolyte when stored
fuel cell
devices that produce an electrical current as long as fuel and oxidizer are continuously added; more efficient than internal
combustion engines
nickel-cadmium battery
(NiCd battery) secondary battery that uses cadmium, which is a toxic heavy metal; heavier than lithium ion batteries, but with
similar performance characteristics
primary battery
single-use nonrechargeable battery
secondary battery
battery that can be recharged
This page titled 17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Corrosion is usually defined as the degradation of metals due to an electrochemical process. The formation of rust on iron, tarnish
on silver, and the blue-green patina that develops on copper are all examples of corrosion. The total cost of corrosion in the United
States is significant, with estimates in excess of half a trillion dollars a year.
Changing Colors
The Statue of Liberty is a landmark every American recognizes. The Statue of Liberty is easily identified by its height, stance,
and unique blue-green color. When this statue was first delivered from France, its appearance was not green. It was brown, the
color of its copper “skin.” So how did the Statue of Liberty change colors? The change in appearance was a direct result of
corrosion. The copper that is the primary component of the statue slowly underwent oxidation from the air. The oxidation-
reduction reactions of copper metal in the environment occur in several steps. Copper metal is oxidized to copper(I) oxide (
Cu O), which is red, and then to copper(II) oxide, which is black.
2
1
2 Cu(s) + O (g) → Cu O(s)
2 2 2
red
1
Cu O(s) + O (g) → 2 CuO(s)
2 2 2
black
Coal, which was often high in sulfur, was burned extensively in the early part of the last century. As a result, sulfur trioxide,
carbon dioxide, and water all reacted with the CuO.
These three compounds are responsible for the characteristic blue-green patina seen today. Fortunately, formation of the patina
created a protective layer on the surface, preventing further corrosion of the copper skin. The formation of the protective layer
is a form of passivation, which is discussed further in a later chapter.
This figure contains two photos of the Statue of Liberty. Photo a appears to be an antique photo which shows the original brown color of the copper covered statue. Photo b shows the blue-green appearance of
the statue today. In both photos, the statue is shown atop a building, with a body of water in the background."
Figure 17.6.1 : (a) The Statue of Liberty is covered with a copper skin, and was originally brown, as shown in this painting. (b)
Exposure to the elements has resulted in the formation of the blue-green patina seen today.
Perhaps the most familiar example of corrosion is the formation of rust on iron. Iron will rust when it is exposed to oxygen and
water. The main steps in the rusting of iron appear to involve the following. Once exposed to the atmosphere, iron rapidly oxidizes.
2 + − ∘
anode: Fe(s) → Fe +2 e E 2 +
= −0.44 V
(aq) Fe /Fe
+ 2 + ∘
overall: 2 Fe(s) + O2(g) + 4 H → 2 Fe + 2 H O(l) E = +1.67 V
(aq) (aq) 2 cell
What we call rust is hydrated iron(III) oxide, which forms when iron(II) ions react further with oxygen.
2 + +
4 Fe + O2(g) + (4 + 2x)H O(l) → 2 Fe O ⋅ x H O(s) + 8 H
(aq) 2 2 3 2 (aq)
Figure 17.6.2 : Once the paint is scratched on a painted iron surface, corrosion occurs and rust begins to form. The speed of the
spontaneous reaction is increased in the presence of electrolytes, such as the sodium chloride used on roads to melt ice and snow or
in salt water.
A grey rectangle, labeled “iron,” is shown with thin purple layers, labeled “Paint layer,” at its upper
and lower surfaces. A gap in the upper purple layer at the upper left of the diagram is labeled “Cathodic site.” A
blue droplet labeled “water” is positioned on top of the gap. A curved arrow extends from a space above the droplet
to the surface of the grey region and into the water droplet. The base of the arrow is labeled “O subscript 2” and the
tip of the arrow is labeled “H subscript 2 O.” A gap to the right and on the bottom side of the grey region shows that
some of the grey region is gone from the region beneath the purple layer. A water droplet covers this gap and extends into the open
space in the grey rectangle. The label “F e superscript 2 positive” is at the center of the droplet. A curved arrow
points from the edge of the grey area below to the label. A second curved arrow extends from the F e superscript 2 positive arrow
to a rust brown chunk on the lower surface of the purple layer at the edge of the water droplet. A curved arrow extends from O
subscript 2 outside the droplet into the droplet to the rust brown chunk. The grey region at the lower right portion of the diagram is
labeled “Anodic site.” An arrow extends from the anodic site toward the cathodic site, which is labeled “e
superscript negative.”
One way to keep iron from corroding is to keep it painted. The layer of paint prevents the water and oxygen necessary for rust
formation from coming into contact with the iron. As long as the paint remains intact, the iron is protected from corrosion.
Other strategies include alloying the iron with other metals. For example, stainless steel is mostly iron with a bit of chromium. The
chromium tends to collect near the surface, where it forms an oxide layer that protects the iron.
Zinc-plated or galvanized iron uses a different strategy. Zinc is more easily oxidized than iron because zinc has a lower reduction
potential. Since zinc has a lower reduction potential, it is a more active metal. Thus, even if the zinc coating is scratched, the zinc
will still oxidize before the iron. This suggests that this approach should work with other active metals.
Figure 17.6.3 : One way to protect an underground iron storage tank is through cathodic protection. Using an active metal like zinc
or magnesium for the anode effectively makes the storage tank the cathode, preventing it from corroding (oxidizing).
A diagram is shown of an underground storage tank system. Underground, to the left end of the diagram is a horizontal grey tank
which is labeled “Object to be protected.” A black line extends upward from the center of the tank above ground. An arrow points
upward at the left side of the line segment. A horizontal black line segment continues right above ground, which is labeled “No
power source is needed.” A line segment extends up and to the right, which is labeled “ Lead wire.” A line segment with a
downward pointing arrow to its right extends downward below the ground to a second metal tank-like structure, labeled “Sacrificial
anode” which is vertically oriented. Five black arrows point left underground toward the first tank. These arrows are collectively
labeled “Protective current.”
Another important way to protect metal is to make it the cathode in a galvanic cell. This is cathodic protection and can be used for
metals other than just iron. For example, the rusting of underground iron storage tanks and pipes can be prevented or greatly
reduced by connecting them to a more active metal such as zinc or magnesium. This is also used to protect the metal parts in water
heaters. The more active metals (lower reduction potential) are called sacrificial anodes because as they get used up as they corrode
Summary
Corrosion is the degradation of a metal caused by an electrochemical process. Large sums of money are spent each year repairing
the effects of, or preventing, corrosion. Some metals, such as aluminum and copper, produce a protective layer when they corrode
in air. The thin layer that forms on the surface of the metal prevents oxygen from coming into contact with more of the metal atoms
and thus “protects” the remaining metal from further corrosion. Iron corrodes (forms rust) when exposed to water and oxygen. The
rust that forms on iron metal flakes off, exposing fresh metal, which also corrodes. One way to prevent, or slow, corrosion is by
coating the metal. Coating prevents water and oxygen from contacting the metal. Paint or other coatings will slow corrosion, but
they are not effective once scratched. Zinc-plated or galvanized iron exploits the fact that zinc is more likely to oxidize than iron.
As long as the coating remains, even if scratched, the zinc will oxidize before the iron. Another method for protecting metals is
cathodic protection. In this method, an easily oxidized and inexpensive metal, often zinc or magnesium (the sacrificial anode), is
electrically connected to the metal that must be protected. The more active metal is the sacrificial anode, and is the anode in a
galvanic cell. The “protected” metal is the cathode, and remains unoxidized. One advantage of cathodic protection is that the
sacrificial anode can be monitored and replaced if needed.
Glossary
cathodic protection
method of protecting metal by using a sacrificial anode and effectively making the metal that needs protecting the cathode, thus
preventing its oxidation
corrosion
degradation of metal through an electrochemical process
galvanized iron
method for protecting iron by covering it with zinc, which will oxidize before the iron; zinc-plated iron
sacrificial anode
more active, inexpensive metal used as the anode in cathodic protection; frequently made from magnesium or zinc
This page titled 17.6: Corrosion is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
In galvanic cells, chemical energy is converted into electrical energy. The opposite is true for electrolytic cells. In electrolytic cells,
electrical energy causes nonspontaneous reactions to occur in a process known as electrolysis. The charging electric barttery shows
one such process. Electrical energy is converted into the chemical energy in the battery as it is charged. Once charged, the battery
can be used to power the automobile. The same principles are involved in electrolytic cells as in galvanic cells. We will look at
three electrolytic cells and the quantitative aspects of electrolysis.
17.7.0.0.1: The Electrolysis of Molten Sodium Chloride
In molten sodium chloride, the ions are free to migrate to the electrodes of an electrolytic cell. A simplified diagram of the cell
commercially used to produce sodium metal and chlorine gas is shown in Figure 17.7.1. Sodium is a strong reducing agent and
chlorine is used to purify water, and is used in antiseptics and in paper production. The reactions are
− − ∘
anode: 2 Cl (l) ⟶ Cl (g) + 2 e E −
= +1.3 V (17.7.1)
2 Cl / Cl
2
+ − ∘
cathode: Na (l) + e ⟶ Na(l) E +
= −2.7 V (17.7.2)
Na /Na
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
+ − ∘
overall: 2 Na (l) + 2 Cl (l) ⟶ 2 Na(l) + Cl (g) E = −4.0 V (17.7.3)
2 cell
The power supply (battery) must supply a minimum of 4 V, but, in practice, the applied voltages are typically higher because of
inefficiencies in the process itself.
Figure 17.7.1 : Passing an electric current through molten sodium chloride decomposes the material into sodium metal and chlorine
gas. Care must be taken to keep the products separated to prevent the spontaneous formation of sodium chloride.
17.7.0.0.1: The Electrolysis of Water
It is possible to split water into hydrogen and oxygen gas by electrolysis. Acids are typically added to increase the concentration of
hydrogen ion in solution (Figure 17.7.2). The reactions are
+ − ∘
anode: 2 H O(l) ⟶ O (g) + 4 H (aq) + 4 e E = +1.229 V (17.7.4)
2 2 anode
+ − ∘
cathode: 2 H (aq) + 2 e ⟶ H (g) E =0 V (17.7.5)
2 cathode
¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯¯
¯
∘
overall: 2 H O(l) ⟶ 2 H (g) + O (g) E = −1.229 V (17.7.6)
2 2 2 cell
Note that the sulfuric acid is not consumed and that the volume of hydrogen gas produced is twice the volume of oxygen gas
produced. The minimum applied voltage is 1.229 V.
+ − ∘
(ii) 2 H O(l) ⟶ O (g) + 4 H (aq) + 4 e E = +1.229 V (17.7.8)
2 2 anode
These values suggest that water should be oxidized at the anode because a smaller potential would be needed—using reaction (ii)
for the oxidation would give a less-negative cell potential. When the experiment is run, it turns out chlorine, not oxygen, is
produced at the anode. The unexpected process is so common in electrochemistry that it has been given the name overpotential.
The overpotential is the difference between the theoretical cell voltage and the actual voltage that is necessary to cause electrolysis.
It turns out that the overpotential for oxygen is rather high and effectively makes the reduction potential more positive. As a result,
under normal conditions, chlorine gas is what actually forms at the anode.
Now consider the cathode. Three reductions could occur:
+ − ∘
(iii) 2 H (aq) + 2 e ⟶ H (g) E =0 V (17.7.9)
2 cathode
− − ∘
(iv) 2 H O(l) + 2 e ⟶ H (g) + 2 OH (aq) E = −0.8277 V (17.7.10)
2 2 cathode
+ − ∘
(v) Na (aq) + e ⟶ Na(s) E = −2.71 V (17.7.11)
cathode
Reaction (v) is ruled out because it has such a negative reduction potential. Under standard state conditions, reaction (iii) would be
preferred to reaction (iv). However, the pH of a sodium chloride solution is 7, so the concentration of hydrogen ions is only 1× 10−7
M. At such low concentrations, reaction (iii) is unlikely and reaction (iv) occurs. The overall reaction is then
− − ∘
overall: 2 H O(l) + 2 Cl (aq) ⟶ H (g) + Cl (g) + 2 OH (aq) E = −2.186 V
2 2 2 cell
As the reaction proceeds, hydroxide ions replace chloride ions in solution. Thus, sodium hydroxide can be obtained by evaporating
the water after the electrolysis is complete. Sodium hydroxide is valuable in its own right and is used for things like oven cleaner,
drain opener, and in the production of paper, fabrics, and soap.
Figure 17.7.3 : The spoon, which is made of an inexpensive metal, is connected to the negative terminal of the voltage source and
acts as the cathode. The anode is a silver electrode. Both electrodes are immersed in a silver nitrate solution. When a steady current
is passed through the solution, the net result is that silver metal is removed from the anode and deposited on the cathode.
In the figure, the anode consists of a silver electrode, shown on the left. The cathode is located on the right and is the spoon, which
is made from inexpensive metal. Both electrodes are immersed in a solution of silver nitrate. As the potential is increased, current
flows. Silver metal is lost at the anode as it goes into solution.
+ −
anode: Ag(s) ⟶ Ag (aq) + e
The mass of the cathode increases as silver ions from the solution are deposited onto the spoon
+ −
cathode: Ag (aq) + e ⟶ Ag(s)
The net result is the transfer of silver metal from the anode to the cathode. The quality of the object is usually determined by the
thickness of the deposited silver and the rate of deposition.
Q = I ×t = n×F
where
t is the time in seconds,
n the number of moles of electrons, and
F is the Faraday constant.
Moles of electrons can be used in stoichiometry problems. The time required to deposit a specified amount of metal might also be
requested, as in the second of the following examples.
Solution
Faraday’s constant can be used to convert the charge (Q) into moles of electrons (n). The charge is the current (I) multiplied by
the time
10.23 C 60 min 60 s
× 1 hr × ×
Q s hr min 36, 830 C
−
n = = = = 0.3817 mol e
− −
F 96, 485 C/mol e 96, 485 C/mol e
From the problem, the solution contains AgNO3, so the reaction at the cathode involves 1 mole of electrons for each mole of
silver
+ −
cathode: Ag (aq) + e ⟶ Ag(s)
Check your answer: From the stoichiometry, 1 mole of electrons would produce 1 mole of silver. Less than one-half a mole of
electrons was involved and less than one-half a mole of silver was produced.
Exercise 17.7.1
Aluminum metal can be made from aluminum ions by electrolysis. What is the half-reaction at the cathode? What mass of
aluminum metal would be recovered if a current of 2.50 × 103 A passed through the solution for 15.0 minutes? Assume the
yield is 100%.
Answer
Al
3+ −
(aq) + 3 e ⟶ Al(s) ; 7.77 mol Al = 210.0 g Al.
In one application, a 0.010-mm layer of chromium must be deposited on a part with a total surface area of 3.3 m2 from a
solution of containing chromium(III) ions. How long would it take to deposit the layer of chromium if the current was 33.46
A? The density of chromium (metal) is 7.19 g/cm3.
Solution This problem brings in a number of topics covered earlier. An outline of what needs to be done is:
If the total charge can be determined, the time required is just the charge divided by the current
The total charge can be obtained from the amount of Cr needed and the stoichiometry
The amount of Cr can be obtained using the density and the volume Cr required
The volume Cr required is the thickness times the area
Solving in steps, and taking care with the units, the volume of Cr required is
2
1 cm 10, 000 cm
2 3
volume = (0.010 mm × ) × (3.3 m ×( )) = 33 cm
2
10 mm 1 m
Cubic centimeters were used because they match the volume unit used for the density. The amount of Cr is then
1 mol Cr
mol Cr = 237 g Cr × = 4.56 mol Cr
52.00 g Cr
Since the solution contains chromium(III) ions, 3 moles of electrons are required per mole of Cr. The total charge is then
−
3 mol e 96485 C
6
Q = 4.56 mol Cr × × = 1.32 × 10 C
−
1 mol Cr mol e
Check your answer: In a long problem like this, a single check is probably not enough. Each of the steps gives a reasonable
number, so things are probably correct. Pay careful attention to unit conversions and the stoichiometry.
Exercise 17.7.2
What mass of zinc is required to galvanize the top of a 3.00 m × 5.50 m sheet of iron to a thickness of 0.100 mm of zinc? If the
zinc comes from a solution of Zn(NO3)2 and the current is 25.5 A, how long will it take to galvanize the top of the iron? The
density of zinc is 7.140 g/cm3.
Answer
231 g Zn required 23,000 minutes.
Summary
Using electricity to force a nonspontaneous process to occur is electrolysis. Electrolytic cells are electrochemical cells with
negative cell potentials (meaning a positive Gibbs free energy), and so are nonspontaneous. Electrolysis can occur in electrolytic
cells by introducing a power supply, which supplies the energy to force the electrons to flow in the nonspontaneous direction.
Electrolysis is done in solutions, which contain enough ions so current can flow. If the solution contains only one material, like the
electrolysis of molten sodium chloride, it is a simple matter to determine what is oxidized and what is reduced. In more
complicated systems, like the electrolysis of aqueous sodium chloride, more than one species can be oxidized or reduced and the
standard reduction potentials are used to determine the most likely oxidation (the half-reaction with the largest [most positive]
standard reduction potential) and reduction (the half-reaction with the smallest [least positive] standard reduction potential).
Sometimes unexpected half-reactions occur because of overpotential. Overpotential is the difference between the theoretical half-
reaction reduction potential and the actual voltage required. When present, the applied potential must be increased, making it
possible for a different reaction to occur in the electrolytic cell. The total charge, Q, that passes through an electrolytic cell can be
expressed as the current (I) multiplied by time (Q = It) or as the moles of electrons (n) multiplied by Faraday’s constant (Q = nF).
These relationships can be used to determine things like the amount of material used or generated during electrolysis, how long the
reaction must proceed, or what value of the current is required.
Summary
electrolysis
process using electrical energy to cause a nonspontaneous process to occur
electrolytic cell
electrochemical cell in which electrolysis is used; electrochemical cell with negative cell potentials
electroplating
depositing a thin layer of one metal on top of a conducting surface
overpotential
This page titled 17.7: Electrolysis is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 17.E: Electrochemistry (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled 18: Representative Metals, Metalloids, and Nonmetals is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
1
18.1: Periodicity
Learning Objectives
Classify elements
Make predictions about the periodicity properties of the representative elements
We begin this section by examining the behaviors of representative metals in relation to their positions in the periodic table. The primary focus of
this section will be the application of periodicity to the representative metals.
It is possible to divide elements into groups according to their electron configurations. The representative elements are elements where the s and p
orbitals are filling. The transition elements are elements where the d orbitals (groups 3–11 on the periodic table) are filling, and the inner transition
metals are the elements where the f orbitals are filling. The d orbitals fill with the elements in group 11; therefore, the elements in group 12 qualify
as representative elements because the last electron enters an s orbital. Metals among the representative elements are the representative metals.
Metallic character results from an element’s ability to lose its outer valence electrons and results in high thermal and electrical conductivity, among
other physical and chemical properties. There are 20 nonradioactive representative metals in groups 1, 2, 3, 12, 13, 14, and 15 of the periodic table
(the elements shaded in yellow in Figure 18.1.1). The radioactive elements copernicium, flerovium, polonium, and livermorium are also metals but
are beyond the scope of this chapter.
Figure 18.1.1 : The location of the representative metals is shown in the periodic table. Nonmetals are shown in green, metalloids in purple, and the
transition metals and inner transition metals in blue.
In addition to the representative metals, some of the representative elements are metalloids. A metalloid is an element that has properties that are
between those of metals and nonmetals; these elements are typically semiconductors. The remaining representative elements are nonmetals. Unlike
metals, which typically form cations and ionic compounds (containing ionic bonds), nonmetals tend to form anions or molecular compounds. In
general, the combination of a metal and a nonmetal produces a salt. A salt is an ionic compound consisting of cations and anions.
Figure 18.1.2 : Lithium floats in paraffin oil because its density is less than the density of paraffin oil.
The alkali metals all react vigorously with water to form hydrogen gas and a basic solution of the metal hydroxide. This means they are easier to
oxidize than is hydrogen. As an example, the reaction of lithium with water is:
Alkali metals react directly with all the nonmetals (except the noble gases) to yield binary ionic compounds containing 1+ metal ions. These metals
are so reactive that it is necessary to avoid contact with both moisture and oxygen in the air. Therefore, they are stored in sealed containers under
mineral oil, as shown in Figure 18.1.3, to prevent contact with air and moisture. The pure metals never exist free (uncombined) in nature due to their
high reactivity. In addition, this high reactivity makes it necessary to prepare the metals by electrolysis of alkali metal compounds.
Figure 18.1.3 : To prevent contact with air and water, potassium for laboratory use comes as sticks or beads stored under kerosene or mineral oil, or
in sealed containers. (credit: Potassium [images-of-elements.com])
Unlike many other metals, the reactivity and softness of the alkali metals make these metals unsuitable for structural applications. However, there are
applications where the reactivity of the alkali metals is an advantage. For example, the production of metals such as titanium and zirconium relies, in
part, on the ability of sodium to reduce compounds of these metals. The manufacture of many organic compounds, including certain dyes, drugs, and
perfumes, utilizes reduction by lithium or sodium.
Figure 18.1.4 : Colored flames from strontium, cesium, sodium and lithium (from left to right). Picture courtesy of the Claire Murray and Annabelle
Baker from the Diamond Light Source.
Sodium and its compounds impart a bright yellow color to a flame, as seen in Figure 18.1.4. Passing an electrical discharge through sodium vapor
also produces this color. In both cases, this is an example of an emission spectrum as discussed in the chapter on electronic structure. Streetlights
Video 18.1.1: This video demonstrates the reactions of the alkali metals with water.
For this reason, a CO2 fire extinguisher will not extinguish a magnesium fire. Additionally, the brilliant white light emitted by burning magnesium
makes it useful in flares and fireworks.
Zinc is the most reactive in group 12, and mercury is the least reactive. (This is the reverse of the reactivity trend of the metals of groups 1 and 2, in
which reactivity increases down a group. The increase in reactivity with increasing atomic number only occurs for the metals in groups 1 and 2.) The
decreasing reactivity is due to the formation of ions with a pseudo-noble gas configuration and to other factors that are beyond the scope of this
discussion. The chemical behaviors of zinc and cadmium are quite similar to each other but differ from that of mercury.
Zinc and cadmium have lower reduction potentials than hydrogen, and, like the alkali metals and alkaline earth metals, they will produce hydrogen
gas when they react with acids. The reaction of zinc with hydrochloric acid, shown in Figure 18.1.6, is:
Figure 18.1.6 : Zinc is an active metal. It dissolves in hydrochloric acid, forming a solution of colorless Zn2+ ions, Cl– ions, and hydrogen gas.
Zinc is a silvery metal that quickly tarnishes to a blue-gray appearance. This change in color is due to an adherent coating of a basic carbonate,
Zn2(OH)2CO3, which passivates the metal to inhibit further corrosion. Dry cell and alkaline batteries contain a zinc anode. Brass (Cu and Zn) and
some bronze (Cu, Sn, and sometimes Zn) are important zinc alloys. About half of zinc production serves to protect iron and other metals from
corrosion. This protection may take the form of a sacrificial anode (also known as a galvanic anode, which is a means of providing cathodic
protection for various metals) or as a thin coating on the protected metal. Galvanized steel is steel with a protective coating of zinc.
The clear NO initially formed quickly undergoes further oxidation to the reddish brown NO2.
Figure 18.1.7 : From left to right: Hg(l), Hg + concentrated HCl, Hg + concentrated HNO3. (credit: Sahar Atwa)
Most mercury compounds decompose when heated. Most mercury compounds contain mercury with a 2+-oxidation state. When there is a large
excess of mercury, it is possible to form compounds containing the Hg ion. All mercury compounds are toxic, and it is necessary to exercise great
2+
Amalgams
An amalgam is an alloy of mercury with one or more other metals. This is similar to considering steel to be an alloy of iron with other metals.
Most metals will form an amalgam with mercury, with the main exceptions being iron, platinum, tungsten, and tantalum. Due to toxicity issues
with mercury, there has been a significant decrease in the use of amalgams. Historically, amalgams were important in electrolytic cells and in the
extraction of gold. Amalgams of the alkali metals still find use because they are strong reducing agents and easier to handle than the pure alkali
metals. Prospectors had a problem when they found finely divided gold. They learned that adding mercury to their pans collected the gold into
the mercury to form an amalgam for easier collection. Unfortunately, losses of small amounts of mercury over the years left many streams in
California polluted with mercury. Dentists use amalgams containing silver and other metals to fill cavities. There are several reasons to use an
amalgam including low cost, ease of manipulation, and longevity compared to alternate materials. Dental amalgams are approximately 50%
mercury by weight, which, in recent years, has become a concern due to the toxicity of mercury.
After reviewing the best available data, the Food and Drug Administration (FDA) considers amalgam-based fillings to be safe for adults and
children over six years of age. Even with multiple fillings, the mercury levels in the patients remain far below the lowest levels associated with
harm. Clinical studies have found no link between dental amalgams and health problems. Health issues may not be the same in cases of children
under six or pregnant women. The FDA conclusions are in line with the opinions of the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and Centers
for Disease Control (CDC). The only health consideration noted is that some people are allergic to the amalgam or one of its components.
18.1.5: Group 13
Group 13 contains the metalloid boron and the metals aluminum, gallium, indium, and thallium. The lightest element, boron, is semiconducting, and
its binary compounds tend to be covalent and not ionic. The remaining elements of the group are metals, but their oxides and hydroxides change
characters. The oxides and hydroxides of aluminum and gallium exhibit both acidic and basic behaviors. A substance, such as these two, that will
react with both acids and bases is amphoteric. This characteristic illustrates the combination of nonmetallic and metallic behaviors of these two
elements. Indium and thallium oxides and hydroxides exhibit only basic behavior, in accordance with the clearly metallic character of these two
elements. The melting point of gallium is unusually low (about 30 °C) and will melt in your hand.
Aluminum is amphoteric because it will react with both acids and bases. A typical reaction with an acid is:
With both acids and bases, the reaction with aluminum generates hydrogen gas.
The group 13 elements have a valence shell electron configuration of ns2np1. Aluminum normally uses all of its valence electrons when it reacts,
giving compounds in which it has an oxidation state of 3+. Although many of these compounds are covalent, others, such as AlF3 and Al2(SO4)3, are
ionic. Aqueous solutions of aluminum salts contain the cation [Al(H O) ] , abbreviated as Al3+(aq). Gallium, indium, and thallium also form
3+
2 6
ionic compounds containing M3+ ions. These three elements exhibit not only the expected oxidation state of 3+ from the three valence electrons but
also an oxidation state (in this case, 1+) that is two below the expected value. This phenomenon, the inert pair effect, refers to the formation of a
stable ion with an oxidation state two lower than expected for the group. The pair of electrons is the valence s orbital for those elements. In general,
the inert pair effect is important for the lower p-block elements. In an aqueous solution, the Tl+(aq) ion is more stable than is Tl3+(aq). In general,
these metals will react with air and water to form 3+ ions; however, thallium reacts to give thallium(I) derivatives. The metals of group 13 all react
directly with nonmetals such as sulfur, phosphorus, and the halogens, forming binary compounds.
The metals of group 13 (Al, Ga, In, and Tl) are all reactive. However, passivation occurs as a tough, hard, thin film of the metal oxide forms upon
exposure to air. Disruption of this film may counter the passivation, allowing the metal to react. One way to disrupt the film is to expose the
passivated metal to mercury. Some of the metal dissolves in the mercury to form an amalgam, which sheds the protective oxide layer to expose the
metal to further reaction. The formation of an amalgam allows the metal to react with air and water.
Video 18.1.2 : Although easily oxidized, the passivation of aluminum makes it very useful as a strong, lightweight building material. Because of the
formation of an amalgam, mercury is corrosive to structural materials made of aluminum. This video demonstrates how the integrity of an aluminum
beam can be destroyed by the addition of a small amount of elemental mercury.
The most important uses of aluminum are in the construction and transportation industries, and in the manufacture of aluminum cans and aluminum
foil. These uses depend on the lightness, toughness, and strength of the metal, as well as its resistance to corrosion. Because aluminum is an
excellent conductor of heat and resists corrosion, it is useful in the manufacture of cooking utensils.
Aluminum is a very good reducing agent and may replace other reducing agents in the isolation of certain metals from their oxides. Although more
expensive than reduction by carbon, aluminum is important in the isolation of Mo, W, and Cr from their oxides.
18.1.6: Group 14
The metallic members of group 14 are tin, lead, and flerovium. Carbon is a typical nonmetal. The remaining elements of the group, silicon and
germanium, are examples of semimetals or metalloids. Tin and lead form the stable divalent cations, Sn2+ and Pb2+, with oxidation states two below
the group oxidation state of 4+. The stability of this oxidation state is a consequence of the inert pair effect. Tin and lead also form covalent
compounds with a formal 4+-oxidation state. For example, SnCl4 and PbCl4 are low-boiling covalent liquids.
18.1.7: Group 15
Bismuth, the heaviest member of group 15, is a less reactive metal than the other representative metals. It readily gives up three of its five valence
electrons to active nonmetals to form the tri-positive ion, Bi3+. It forms compounds with the group oxidation state of 5+ only when treated with
strong oxidizing agents. The stability of the 3+-oxidation state is another example of the inert pair effect.
Summary
This section focuses on the periodicity of the representative elements. These are the elements where the electrons are entering the s and p orbitals.
The representative elements occur in groups 1, 2, and 12–18. These elements are representative metals, metalloids, and nonmetals. The alkali metals
(group 1) are very reactive, readily form ions with a charge of 1+ to form ionic compounds that are usually soluble in water, and react vigorously
with water to form hydrogen gas and a basic solution of the metal hydroxide. The outermost electrons of the alkaline earth metals (group 2) are more
difficult to remove than the outer electron of the alkali metals, leading to the group 2 metals being less reactive than those in group 1. These
elements easily form compounds in which the metals exhibit an oxidation state of 2+. Zinc, cadmium, and mercury (group 12) commonly exhibit the
group oxidation state of 2+ (although mercury also exhibits an oxidation state of 1+ in compounds that contain Hg ). Aluminum, gallium, indium,
2+
and thallium (group 13) are easier to oxidize than is hydrogen. Aluminum, gallium, and indium occur with an oxidation state 3+ (however, thallium
also commonly occurs as the Tl+ ion). Tin and lead form stable divalent cations and covalent compounds in which the metals exhibit the 4+-
oxidation state.
Glossary
alkaline earth metal
any of the metals (beryllium, magnesium, calcium, strontium, barium, and radium) occupying group 2 of the periodic table; they are reactive,
divalent metals that form basic oxides
allotropes
two or more forms of the same element, in the same physical state, with different chemical structures
bismuth
heaviest member of group 15; a less reactive metal than other representative metals
metal (representative)
atoms of the metallic elements of groups 1, 2, 12, 13, 14, 15, and 16, which form ionic compounds by losing electrons from their outer s or p
orbitals
metalloid
element that has properties that are between those of metals and nonmetals; these elements are typically semiconductors
passivation
representative element
element where the s and p orbitals are filling
representative metal
metal among the representative elements
This page titled 18.1: Periodicity is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to
the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Because of their reactivity, we do not find most representative metals as free elements in nature. However, compounds that contain
ions of most representative metals are abundant. In this section, we will consider the two common techniques used to isolate the
metals from these compounds—electrolysis and chemical reduction.
These metals primarily occur in minerals, with lithium found in silicate or phosphate minerals, and sodium and potassium found in
salt deposits from evaporation of ancient seas and in silicates. The alkaline earth metals occur as silicates and, with the exception of
beryllium, as carbonates and sulfates. Beryllium occurs as the mineral beryl, Be3Al2Si6O18, which, with certain impurities, may be
either the gemstone emerald or aquamarine. Magnesium is in seawater and, along with the heavier alkaline earth metals, occurs as
silicates, carbonates, and sulfates. Aluminum occurs abundantly in many types of clay and in bauxite, an impure aluminum oxide
hydroxide. The principle tin ore is the oxide cassiterite, SnO2, and the principle lead and thallium ores are the sulfides or the
products of weathering of the sulfides. The remaining representative metals occur as impurities in zinc or aluminum ores.
18.2.1: Electrolysis
Ions of metals in of groups 1 and 2, along with aluminum, are very difficult to reduce; therefore, it is necessary to prepare these
elements by electrolysis, an important process discussed in the chapter on electrochemistry. Briefly, electrolysis involves using
electrical energy to drive unfavorable chemical reactions to completion; it is useful in the isolation of reactive metals in their pure
forms. Sodium, aluminum, and magnesium are typical examples.
The electrolysis cell contains molten sodium chloride (melting point 801 °C), to which calcium chloride has been added to lower
the melting point to 600 °C (a colligative effect). The passage of a direct current through the cell causes the sodium ions to migrate
to the negatively charged cathode and pick up electrons, reducing the ions to sodium metal. Chloride ions migrate to the positively
charged anode, lose electrons, and undergo oxidation to chlorine gas. The overall cell reaction comes from adding the following
reactions:
+ −
at the cathode: 2 Na +2 e ⟶ 2 Na(l) (18.2.1)
− −
at the anode: 2 Cl ⟶ Cl (g) + 2 e (18.2.2)
2
+ −
overall change: 2 Na + 2 Cl ⟶ 2 Na(l) + Cl (g) (18.2.3)
2
Separation of the molten sodium and chlorine prevents recombination. The liquid sodium, which is less dense than molten sodium
chloride, floats to the surface and flows into a collector. The gaseous chlorine goes to storage tanks. Chlorine is also a valuable
product.
After the removal of the impurities by filtration, the addition of acid to the aluminate leads to the reprecipitation of aluminum
hydroxide:
+ +
Na[Al (OH) ](aq) + H O (aq) ⟶ Al (OH) (s) + Na (aq) + 2 H O(l)
4 3 3 2
The next step is to remove the precipitated aluminum hydroxide by filtration. Heating the hydroxide produces aluminum oxide,
Al2O3, which dissolves in a molten mixture of cryolite, Na3AlF6, and calcium fluoride, CaF2. Electrolysis of this solution takes
place in a cell like that shown in Figure 18.2.2. Reduction of aluminum ions to the metal occurs at the cathode, while oxygen,
carbon monoxide, and carbon dioxide form at the anode.
Some production facilities have moved away from electrolysis completely. In the next section, we will see how the Pidgeon process
leads to the chemical reduction of magnesium.
Si(s) + 2 MgO(s) −
→ SiO (s) + 2 Mg(g)
2
Although this reaction is unfavorable in terms of thermodynamics, the removal of the magnesium vapor produced takes advantage
of Le Chatelier’s principle to continue the forward progress of the reaction. Over 75% of the world’s production of magnesium,
primarily in China, comes from this process.
2 ZnS(s) + 3 O (g) −
→ 2 ZnO(s) + 2 SO (g)
2 2
ZnCO (s) −
→ ZnO(s) + CO (g)
3 2
Carbon, in the form of coal, reduces the zinc oxide to form zinc vapor:
The zinc can be distilled (boiling point 907 °C) and condensed. This zinc contains impurities of cadmium (767 °C), iron (2862 °C),
lead (1750 °C), and arsenic (613 °C). Careful redistillation produces pure zinc. Arsenic and cadmium are distilled from the zinc
because they have lower boiling points. At higher temperatures, the zinc is distilled from the other impurities, mainly lead and iron.
The molten tin collects at the bottom of the furnace and is drawn off and cast into blocks.
Summary
Because of their chemical reactivity, it is necessary to produce the representative metals in their pure forms by reduction from
naturally occurring compounds. Electrolysis is important in the production of sodium, potassium, and aluminum. Chemical
reduction is the primary method for the isolation of magnesium, zinc, and tin. Similar procedures are important for the other
representative metals.
Glossary
chemical reduction
method of preparing a representative metal using a reducing agent
Downs cell
electrochemical cell used for the commercial preparation of metallic sodium (and chlorine) from molten sodium chloride
Hall–Héroult cell
electrolysis apparatus used to isolate pure aluminum metal from a solution of alumina in molten cryolite
Pidgeon process
chemical reduction process used to produce magnesium through the thermal reaction of magnesium oxide with silicon
This page titled 18.2: Occurrence and Preparation of the Representative Metals is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
A series of six elements called the metalloids separate the metals from the nonmetals in the periodic table. The metalloids are boron, silicon,
germanium, arsenic, antimony, and tellurium. These elements look metallic; however, they do not conduct electricity as well as metals so they are
semiconductors. They are semiconductors because their electrons are more tightly bound to their nuclei than are those of metallic conductors. Their
chemical behavior falls between that of metals and nonmetals. For example, the pure metalloids form covalent crystals like the nonmetals, but like
the metals, they generally do not form monatomic anions. This intermediate behavior is in part due to their intermediate electronegativity values. In
this section, we will briefly discuss the chemical behavior of metalloids and deal with two of these elements—boron and silicon—in more detail.
The metalloid boron exhibits many similarities to its neighbor carbon and its diagonal neighbor silicon. All three elements form covalent
compounds. However, boron has one distinct difference in that its 2s22p1 outer electron structure gives it one less valence electron than it has
valence orbitals. Although boron exhibits an oxidation state of 3+ in most of its stable compounds, this electron deficiency provides boron with the
ability to form other, sometimes fractional, oxidation states, which occur, for example, in the boron hydrides.
Silicon has the valence shell electron configuration 3s23p2, and it commonly forms tetrahedral structures in which it is sp3 hybridized with a formal
oxidation state of 4+. The major differences between the chemistry of carbon and silicon result from the relative strength of the carbon-carbon bond,
carbon’s ability to form stable bonds to itself, and the presence of the empty 3d valence-shell orbitals in silicon. Silicon’s empty d orbitals and
boron’s empty p orbital enable tetrahedral silicon compounds and trigonal planar boron compounds to act as Lewis acids. Carbon, on the other hand,
has no available valence shell orbitals; tetrahedral carbon compounds cannot act as Lewis acids. Germanium is very similar to silicon in its chemical
behavior.
Arsenic and antimony generally form compounds in which an oxidation state of 3+ or 5+ is exhibited; however, arsenic can form arsenides with an
oxidation state of 3−. These elements tarnish only slightly in dry air but readily oxidize when warmed.
Tellurium combines directly with most elements. The most stable tellurium compounds are the tellurides—salts of Te2− formed with active metals
and lanthanides—and compounds with oxygen, fluorine, and chlorine, in which tellurium normally exhibits an oxidation state 2+ or 4+. Although
tellurium(VI) compounds are known (for example, TeF6), there is a marked resistance to oxidation to this maximum group oxidation state.
Figure 18.3.1 : (a) Arsenic and (b) antimony have a layered structure similar to that of (c) graphite, except that the layers are puckered rather than
planar. (d) Elemental tellurium forms spiral chains.
Elemental silicon, germanium, arsenic, antimony, and tellurium are lustrous, metallic-looking solids. Silicon and germanium crystallize with a
diamond structure. Each atom within the crystal has covalent bonds to four neighboring atoms at the corners of a regular tetrahedron. Single crystals
of silicon and germanium are giant, three-dimensional molecules. There are several allotropes of arsenic with the most stable being layer like and
containing puckered sheets of arsenic atoms. Each arsenic atom forms covalent bonds to three other atoms within the sheet. The crystal structure of
antimony is similar to that of arsenic, both shown in Figure 18.3.1. The structures of arsenic and antimony are similar to the structure of graphite,
covered later in this chapter. Tellurium forms crystals that contain infinite spiral chains of tellurium atoms. Each atom in the chain bonds to two
other atoms.
Figure 18.3.2 : An icosahedron is a symmetrical, solid shape with 20 faces, each of which is an equilateral triangle. The faces meet at 12 corners.
The name silicon is derived from the Latin word for flint, silex. The metalloid silicon readily forms compounds containing Si-O-Si bonds, which are
of prime importance in the mineral world. This bonding capability is in contrast to the nonmetal carbon, whose ability to form carbon-carbon bonds
gives it prime importance in the plant and animal worlds.
An amorphous substance is a material that appears to be a solid, but does not have a long-range order like a true solid. Treatment with hydrochloric
acid removes the magnesium oxide. Further purification of the boron begins with conversion of the impure boron into boron trichloride. The next
step is to heat a mixture of boron trichloride and hydrogen:
1500 °C
Extremely pure silicon is necessary for the manufacture of semiconductor electronic devices. This process begins with the conversion of impure
silicon into silicon tetrahalides, or silane (SiH4), followed by decomposition at high temperatures. Zone refining, illustrated in Figure 18.3.3,
completes the purification. In this method, a rod of silicon is heated at one end by a heat source that produces a thin cross-section of molten silicon.
Slowly lowering the rod through the heat source moves the molten zone from one end of the rod to other. As this thin, molten region moves,
impurities in the silicon dissolve in the liquid silicon and move with the molten region. Ultimately, the impurities move to one end of the rod, which
is then cut off.
Silicon reacts with halogens at high temperatures, forming volatile tetrahalides, such as SiF4.
Unlike carbon, silicon does not readily form double or triple bonds. Silicon compounds of the general formula SiX4, where X is a highly
electronegative group, can act as Lewis acids to form six-coordinate silicon. For example, silicon tetrafluoride, SiF4, reacts with sodium fluoride to
yield Na2[SiF6], which contains the octahedral [SiF ] ion in which silicon is sp3d2 hybridized:
6
2−
Antimony reacts readily with stoichiometric amounts of fluorine, chlorine, bromine, or iodine, yielding trihalides or, with excess fluorine or chlorine,
forming the pentahalides SbF5 and SbCl5. Depending on the stoichiometry, it forms antimony(III) sulfide, Sb2S3, or antimony(V) sulfide when
heated with sulfur. As expected, the metallic nature of the element is greater than that of arsenic, which lies immediately above it in group 15.
Boron trifluoride reacts with hydrofluoric acid, to yield a solution of fluoroboric acid, HBF4:
+ −
BF (aq) + HF(aq) + H O(l) ⟶ H O (aq) + BF (aq)
3 2 3 4
In this reaction, the BF3 molecule acts as the Lewis acid (electron pair acceptor) and accepts a pair of electrons from a fluoride ion:
All the tetrahalides of silicon, SiX4, have been prepared. Silicon tetrachloride can be prepared by direct chlorination at elevated temperatures or by
heating silicon dioxide with chlorine and carbon:
Δ
Silicon tetrachloride is a covalent tetrahedral molecule, which is a nonpolar, low-boiling (57 °C), colorless liquid. It is possible to prepare silicon
tetrafluoride by the reaction of silicon dioxide with hydrofluoric acid:
Hydrofluoric acid is the only common acid that will react with silicon dioxide or silicates. This reaction occurs because the silicon-fluorine bond is
the only bond that silicon forms that is stronger than the silicon-oxygen bond. For this reason, it is possible to store all common acids, other than
hydrofluoric acid, in glass containers.
Except for silicon tetrafluoride, silicon halides are extremely sensitive to water. Upon exposure to water, SiCl4 reacts rapidly with hydroxide groups,
replacing all four chlorine atoms to produce unstable orthosilicic acid, Si(OH)4 or H4SiO4, which slowly decomposes into SiO2.
Figure 18.3.4 : Laboratory glassware, such as Pyrex and Kimax, is made of borosilicate glass because it does not break when heated. The inclusion
of borates in the glass helps to mediate the effects of thermal expansion and contraction. This reduces the likelihood of thermal shock, which causes
silicate glass to crack upon rapid heating or cooling. (credit: “Tweenk”/Wikimedia Commons)
The boron atom in B(OH)3 is sp2 hybridized and is located at the center of an equilateral triangle with oxygen atoms at the corners. In solid B(OH)3,
hydrogen bonding holds these triangular units together. Boric acid, shown in Figure 18.3.5, is a very weak acid that does not act as a proton donor
but rather as a Lewis acid, accepting an unshared pair of electrons from the Lewis base OH−:
− + −10
B(OH) (aq) + 2 H O(l) ⇌ B(OH) (aq) + H O (aq) Ka = 5.8 × 10
3 2 4 3
three- and four-coordinated boron atoms. The structures of the anions found in CaB2O4, K[B5O6(OH)4]⋅2H2O (commonly written KB5O8⋅4H2O)
and Na2[B4O5(OH)4]⋅8H2O (commonly written Na2B4O7⋅10H2O) are shown in Figure 18.3.6. Commercially, the most important borate is borax,
Na2[B4O5(OH)4]⋅8H2O, which is an important component of some laundry detergents. Most of the supply of borax comes directly from dry lakes,
such as Searles Lake in California, or is prepared from kernite, Na2B4O7⋅4H2O.
Figure 18.3.6 : The borate anions are (a) CaB2O4, (b) KB5O8⋅4H2O, and (c) Na2B4O7⋅10H2O. The anion in CaB2O4 is an “infinite” chain.
Silicon dioxide, silica, occurs in both crystalline and amorphous forms. The usual crystalline form of silicon dioxide is quartz, a hard, brittle, clear,
colorless solid. It is useful in many ways—for architectural decorations, semiprecious jewels, and frequency control in radio transmitters. Silica
takes many crystalline forms, or polymorphs, in nature. Trace amounts of Fe3+ in quartz give amethyst its characteristic purple color. The term
quartz is also used for articles such as tubing and lenses that are manufactured from amorphous silica. Opal is a naturally occurring form of
amorphous silica.
The contrast in structure and physical properties between silicon dioxide and carbon dioxide is interesting, as illustrated in Figure 18.3.7. Solid
carbon dioxide (dry ice) contains single CO2 molecules with each of the two oxygen atoms attached to the carbon atom by double bonds. Very weak
intermolecular forces hold the molecules together in the crystal. The volatility of dry ice reflect these weak forces between molecules. In contrast,
silicon dioxide is a covalent network solid. In silicon dioxide, each silicon atom links to four oxygen atoms by single bonds directed toward the
corners of a regular tetrahedron, and SiO4 tetrahedra share oxygen atoms. This arrangement gives a three dimensional, continuous, silicon-oxygen
network. A quartz crystal is a macromolecule of silicon dioxide. The difference between these two compounds is the ability of the group 14 elements
to form strong π bonds. Second-period elements, such as carbon, form very strong π bonds, which is why carbon dioxide forms small molecules with
strong double bonds. Elements below the second period, such as silicon, do not form π bonds as readily as second-period elements, and when they
do form, the π bonds are weaker than those formed by second-period elements. For this reason, silicon dioxide does not contain π bonds but only σ
bonds.
Summary
The elements boron, silicon, germanium, arsenic, antimony, and tellurium separate the metals from the nonmetals in the periodic table. These
elements, called metalloids or sometimes semimetals, exhibit properties characteristic of both metals and nonmetals. The structures of these
elements are similar in many ways to those of nonmetals, but the elements are electrical semiconductors.
Glossary
amorphous
solid material such as a glass that does not have a regular repeating component to its three-dimensional structure; a solid but not a crystal
borate
compound containing boron-oxygen bonds, typically with clusters or chains as a part of the chemical structure
polymorph
variation in crystalline structure that results in different physical properties for the resulting compound
silicate
compound containing silicon-oxygen bonds, with silicate tetrahedra connected in rings, sheets, or three-dimensional networks, depending on the
other elements involved in the formation of the compounds
This page titled 18.3: Structure and General Properties of the Metalloids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The nonmetals are elements located in the upper right portion of the periodic table. Their properties and behavior are quite different
from those of metals on the left side. Under normal conditions, more than half of the nonmetals are gases, one is a liquid, and the
rest include some of the softest and hardest of solids. The nonmetals exhibit a rich variety of chemical behaviors. They include the
most reactive and least reactive of elements, and they form many different ionic and covalent compounds. This section presents an
overview of the properties and chemical behaviors of the nonmetals, as well as the chemistry of specific elements. Many of these
nonmetals are important in biological systems.
In many cases, trends in electronegativity enable us to predict the type of bonding and the physical states in compounds involving
the nonmetals. We know that electronegativity decreases as we move down a given group and increases as we move from left to
right across a period. The nonmetals have higher electronegativities than do metals, and compounds formed between metals and
nonmetals are generally ionic in nature because of the large differences in electronegativity between them. The metals form cations,
the nonmetals form anions, and the resulting compounds are solids under normal conditions. On the other hand, compounds formed
between two or more nonmetals have small differences in electronegativity between the atoms, and covalent bonding—sharing of
electrons—results. These substances tend to be molecular in nature and are gases, liquids, or volatile solids at room temperature
and pressure.
In normal chemical processes, nonmetals do not form monatomic positive ions (cations) because their ionization energies are too
high. All monatomic nonmetal ions are anions; examples include the chloride ion, Cl−, the nitride ion, N3−, and the selenide ion,
Se2−. The common oxidation states that the nonmetals exhibit in their ionic and covalent compounds are shown in Figure 18.4.1.
Remember that an element exhibits a positive oxidation state when combined with a more electronegative element and that it
exhibits a negative oxidation state when combined with a less electronegative element.
Figure 18.4.1 : Nonmetals exhibit these common oxidation states in ionic and covalent compounds.
The first member of each nonmetal group exhibits different behaviors, in many respects, from the other group members. The
reasons for this include smaller size, greater ionization energy, and (most important) the fact that the first member of each group
has only four valence orbitals (one 2s and three 2p) available for bonding, whereas other group members have empty d orbitals in
their valence shells, making possible five, six, or even more bonds around the central atom. For example, nitrogen forms only NF3,
whereas phosphorus forms both PF3 and PF5.
Remember that an element exhibits a positive oxidation state when combined with a more
electronegative element and that it exhibits a negative oxidation state when combined
with a less electronegative element.
Another difference between the first group member and subsequent members is the greater ability of the first member to form π
bonds. This is primarily a function of the smaller size of the first member of each group, which allows better overlap of atomic
orbitals. Nonmetals, other than the first member of each group, rarely form π bonds to nonmetals that are the first member of a
group. For example, sulfur-oxygen π bonds are well known, whereas sulfur does not normally form stable π bonds to itself.
The variety of oxidation states displayed by most of the nonmetals means that many of their chemical reactions involve changes in
oxidation state through oxidation-reduction reactions. There are five general aspects of the oxidation-reduction chemistry:
1. Nonmetals oxidize most metals. The oxidation state of the metal becomes positive as it undergoes oxidation and that of the
nonmetal becomes negative as it undergoes reduction. For example:
2. With the exception of nitrogen and carbon, which are poor oxidizing agents, a more electronegative nonmetal oxidizes a less
electronegative nonmetal or the anion of the nonmetal:
S (s) + O (g) → 2 S O (s)
2 2
0 +4
0 −2
− −
Cl (g) + 2 I (aq) → I (s) + 2 Cl (aq)
2 2
0 0
Fluorine and oxygen are the strongest oxidizing agents within their respective groups; each oxidizes all the elements that lie
below it in the group. Within any period, the strongest oxidizing agent is in group 17. A nonmetal often oxidizes an element that
lies to its left in the same period. For example:
The stronger a nonmetal is as an oxidizing agent, the more difficult it is to oxidize the anion formed by the nonmetal. This
means that the most stable negative ions are formed by elements at the top of the group or in group 17 of the period.
Fluorine and oxygen are the strongest oxidizing elements known. Fluorine does not form compounds in which it exhibits
positive oxidation states; oxygen exhibits a positive oxidation state only when combined with fluorine. For example:
− −
2F (g) + 2 OH (aq) → O F (g) + 2 F (aq) + H O (l)
2 2 2
+2
0 −1
With the exception of most of the noble gases, all nonmetals form compounds with oxygen, yielding covalent oxides. Most of these
oxides are acidic, that is, they react with water to form oxyacids. Recall from the acid-base chapter that an oxyacid is an acid
consisting of hydrogen, oxygen, and some other element. Notable exceptions are carbon monoxide, CO, nitrous oxide, N2O, and
nitric oxide, NO. There are three characteristics of these acidic oxides:
1. Oxides such as SO2 and N2O5, in which the nonmetal exhibits one of its common oxidation states, are acid anhydrides and react
with water to form acids with no change in oxidation state. The product is an oxyacid. For example:
2. Those oxides such as NO2 and ClO2, in which the nonmetal does not exhibit one of its common oxidation states, also react with
water. In these reactions, the nonmetal is both oxidized and reduced. For example:
Reactions in which the same element is both oxidized and reduced are called disproportionation reactions.
3. The acid strength increases as the electronegativity of the central atom increases. To learn more, see the discussion in the
chapter on acid-base chemistry.
The binary hydrogen compounds of the nonmetals also exhibit an acidic behavior in water, although only HCl, HBr, and HI are
strong acids. The acid strength of the nonmetal hydrogen compounds increases from left to right across a period and down a group.
For example, ammonia, NH3, is a weaker acid than is water, H2O, which is weaker than is hydrogen fluoride, HF. Water, H2O, is
also a weaker acid than is hydrogen sulfide, H2S, which is weaker than is hydrogen selenide, H2Se. Weaker acidic character implies
greater basic character.
18.4.2: Carbon
Carbon occurs in the uncombined (elemental) state in many forms, such as diamond, graphite, charcoal, coke, carbon black,
graphene, and fullerene.
Diamond, shown in Figure 18.4.2, is a very hard crystalline material that is colorless and transparent when pure. Each atom forms
four single bonds to four other atoms at the corners of a tetrahedron (sp3 hybridization); this makes the diamond a giant molecule.
Carbon-carbon single bonds are very strong, and, because they extend throughout the crystal to form a three-dimensional network,
the crystals are very hard and have high melting points (~4400 °C).
Figure 18.4.2 : (a) Diamond and (b) graphite are two forms of carbon. (c) In the crystal structure of diamond, the covalent bonds
form three-dimensional tetrahedrons. (d) In the crystal structure of graphite, each planar layer is composed of six-membered rings.
(credit a: modification of work by “Fancy Diamonds”/Flickr; credit b: modification of work from Carbon [images-of-
elements.com])
Graphite, also shown in Figure 18.4.2, is a soft, slippery, grayish-black solid that conducts electricity. These properties relate to its
structure, which consists of layers of carbon atoms, with each atom surrounded by three other carbon atoms in a trigonal planar
arrangement. Each carbon atom in graphite forms three σ bonds, one to each of its nearest neighbors, by means of sp2-hybrid
orbitals. The unhybridized p orbital on each carbon atom will overlap unhybridized orbitals on adjacent carbon atoms in the same
layer to form π bonds. Many resonance forms are necessary to describe the electronic structure of a graphite layer; Figure 18.4.3
illustrates two of these forms.
Figure 18.4.3 : (a) Carbon atoms in graphite have unhybridized p orbitals. Each p orbital is perpendicular to the plane of carbon
atoms. (b) These are two of the many resonance forms of graphite necessary to describe its electronic structure as a resonance
hybrid.
Atoms within a graphite layer are bonded together tightly by the σ and π bonds; however, the forces between layers are weak.
London dispersion forces hold the layers together. To learn more, see the discussion of these weak forces in the chapter on liquids
and solids. The weak forces between layers give graphite the soft, flaky character that makes it useful as the so-called “lead” in
pencils and the slippery character that makes it useful as a lubricant. The loosely held electrons in the resonating π bonds can move
throughout the solid and are responsible for the electrical conductivity of graphite.
Other forms of elemental carbon include carbon black, charcoal, and coke. Carbon black is an amorphous form of carbon prepared
by the incomplete combustion of natural gas, CH4. It is possible to produce charcoal and coke by heating wood and coal,
respectively, at high temperatures in the absence of air.
Figure 18.4.5 : (a) Graphene and (b) carbon nanotubes are both allotropes of carbon.
Graphene is a very strong, lightweight, and efficient conductor of heat and electricity discovered in 2003. As in graphite, the carbon
atoms form a layer of six-membered rings with sp2-hybridized carbon atoms at the corners. Resonance stabilizes the system and
leads to its conductivity. Unlike graphite, there is no stacking of the layers to give a three-dimensional structure. Andre Geim and
Kostya Novoselov at the University of Manchester won the 2010 Nobel Prize in Physics for their pioneering work characterizing
graphene.
The simplest procedure for preparing graphene is to use a piece of adhesive tape to remove a single layer of graphene from the
surface of a piece of graphite. This method works because there are only weak London dispersion forces between the layers in
graphite. Alternative methods are to deposit a single layer of carbon atoms on the surface of some other material (ruthenium,
iridium, or copper) or to synthesize it at the surface of silicon carbide via the sublimation of silicon.
There currently are no commercial applications of graphene. However, its unusual properties, such as high electron mobility and
thermal conductivity, should make it suitable for the manufacture of many advanced electronic devices and for thermal
management applications.
Carbon nanotubes are carbon allotropes, which have a cylindrical structure. Like graphite and graphene, nanotubes consist of rings
of sp2-hybridized carbon atoms. Unlike graphite and graphene, which occur in layers, the layers wrap into a tube and bond together
to produce a stable structure. The walls of the tube may be one atom or multiple atoms thick.
18.4.3: Phosphorus
The name phosphorus comes from the Greek words meaning light bringing. When phosphorus was first isolated, scientists noted
that it glowed in the dark and burned when exposed to air. Phosphorus is the only member of its group that does not occur in the
uncombined state in nature; it exists in many allotropic forms. We will consider two of those forms: white phosphorus and red
phosphorus.
White phosphorus is a white, waxy solid that melts at 44.2 °C and boils at 280 °C. It is insoluble in water, is very soluble in carbon
disulfide, and bursts into flame in air. As a solid, as a liquid, as a gas, and in solution, white phosphorus exists as P4 molecules with
four phosphorus atoms at the corners of a regular tetrahedron (Figure 18.4.5). Each phosphorus atom covalently bonds to the other
three atoms in the molecule by single covalent bonds. White phosphorus is the most reactive allotrope and is very toxic.
Figure 18.4.5 : (a) Because white phosphorus bursts into flame in air, it is stored in water. (b) The structure of white phosphorus
consists of P4 molecules arranged in a tetrahedron. (c) Red phosphorus is much less reactive than is white phosphorus. (d) The
structure of red phosphorus consists of networks of P4 tetrahedra joined by P-P single bonds. (credit a: modification of work from
Phosphorus [images-of-elements.com])
Heating white phosphorus to 270–300 °C in the absence of air yields red phosphorus. Red phosphorus is denser, has a higher
melting point (~600 °C), is much less reactive, is essentially nontoxic, and is easier and safer to handle than is white phosphorus.
Its structure is highly polymeric and appears to contain three-dimensional networks of P4 tetrahedra joined by P-P single bonds.
Red phosphorus is insoluble in solvents that dissolve white phosphorus. When red phosphorus is heated, P4 molecules sublime
from the solid.
18.4.4: Sulfur
The allotropy of sulfur is far greater and more complex than that of any other element. Sulfur is the brimstone referred to in the
Bible and other places, and references to sulfur occur throughout recorded history—right up to the relatively recent discovery that it
is a component of the atmospheres of Venus and of Io, a moon of Jupiter. The most common and most stable allotrope of sulfur is
yellow, rhombic sulfur, so named because of the shape of its crystals. Rhombic sulfur is the form to which all other allotropes
revert at room temperature. Crystals of rhombic sulfur melt at 113 °C. Cooling this liquid gives long needles of monoclinic sulfur.
This form is stable from 96 °C to the melting point, 119 °C. At room temperature, it gradually reverts to the rhombic form.
Both rhombic sulfur and monoclinic sulfur contain S8 molecules in which atoms form eight-membered, puckered rings that
resemble crowns (Figure 18.4.6). Each sulfur atom is bonded to each of its two neighbors in the ring by covalent S-S single bonds.
Summary
Nonmetals have structures that are very different from those of the metals, primarily because they have greater electronegativity
and electrons that are more tightly bound to individual atoms. Most nonmetal oxides are acid anhydrides, meaning that they react
with water to form acidic solutions. Molecular structures are common for most of the nonmetals, and several have multiple
allotropes with varying physical properties.
Glossary
acid anhydride
compound that reacts with water to form an acid or acidic solution
disproportionation reaction
chemical reaction where a single reactant is simultaneously reduced and oxidized; it is both the reducing agent and the
oxidizing agent
Hydrogen is the most abundant element in the universe. The sun and other stars are composed largely of hydrogen. Astronomers
estimate that 90% of the atoms in the universe are hydrogen atoms. Hydrogen is a component of more compounds than any other
element. Water is the most abundant compound of hydrogen found on earth. Hydrogen is an important part of petroleum, many
minerals, cellulose and starch, sugar, fats, oils, alcohols, acids, and thousands of other substances.
At ordinary temperatures, hydrogen is a colorless, odorless, tasteless, and nonpoisonous gas consisting of the diatomic molecule
H2. Hydrogen is composed of three isotopes, and unlike other elements, these isotopes have different names and chemical symbols:
protium, 1H, deuterium, 2H (or “D”), and tritium 3H (or “T”). In a naturally occurring sample of hydrogen, there is one atom of
deuterium for every 7000 H atoms and one atom of radioactive tritium for every 1018 H atoms. The chemical properties of the
different isotopes are very similar because they have identical electron structures, but they differ in some physical properties
because of their differing atomic masses. Elemental deuterium and tritium have lower vapor pressure than ordinary hydrogen.
Consequently, when liquid hydrogen evaporates, the heavier isotopes are concentrated in the last portions to evaporate. Electrolysis
of heavy water, D2O, yields deuterium. Most tritium originates from nuclear reactions.
water gas
Water gas is as an industrial fuel. It is possible to produce additional hydrogen by mixing the water gas with steam in the presence
of a catalyst to convert the CO to CO2. This reaction is the water gas shift reaction.
It is also possible to prepare a mixture of hydrogen and carbon monoxide by passing hydrocarbons from natural gas or petroleum
and steam over a nickel-based catalyst. Propane is an example of a hydrocarbon reactant:
900 °C
18.5.1.2: Electrolysis
Hydrogen forms when direct current electricity passes through water (electrolysis) containing an electrolyte such as H2SO4, (Figure
18.5.1.) Bubbles of hydrogen form at the cathode, and oxygen evolves at the anode. The net reaction is:
Figure 18.5.2 : The reaction of iron with an acid produces hydrogen. Here, iron reacts with hydrochloric acid. (credit: Mark Ott)
Metal hydrides are expensive but convenient sources of hydrogen, especially where space and weight are important factors. They
are important in the inflation of life jackets, life rafts, and military balloons.
18.5.2: Reactions
Under normal conditions, hydrogen is relatively inactive chemically, but when heated, it enters into many chemical reactions.
Two thirds of the world’s hydrogen production is devoted to the manufacture of ammonia, which is a fertilizer and used in the
manufacture of nitric acid. Large quantities of hydrogen are also important in the process of hydrogenation, discussed in the
chapter on organic chemistry.
It is possible to use hydrogen as a nonpolluting fuel. The reaction of hydrogen with oxygen is a very exothermic reaction, releasing
286 kJ of energy per mole of water formed. Hydrogen burns without explosion under controlled conditions. The oxygen-hydrogen
torch, because of the high heat of combustion of hydrogen, can achieve temperatures up to 2800 °C. The hot flame of this torch is
useful in cutting thick sheets of many metals. Liquid hydrogen is also an important rocket fuel (Figure 18.5.3).
MH or MH
2
⟶ MOH or M(OH)
2
+H
2
ionic hydrides with group 1 and Ca, Sr, and Ba
H + C ⟶ (no reaction)
2
3H
2
+N
2
⟶ 2 NH
3
requires high pressure and temperature; low yield
2H
2
+O
2
⟶ 2H O
2
exothermic and potentially explosive
H
2
+S ⟶ H S
2
requires heating; low yield
H
2
+X
2
⟶ 2 HX X = F, Cl, Br, and I; explosive with F2; low yield with I2
The commercial production of ammonia is by the direct combination of the elements in the Haber process:
catalyst
Figure 18.5.4 : The structure of ammonia is shown with a central nitrogen atom and three hydrogen atoms.
Ammonia is a colorless gas with a sharp, pungent odor. Smelling salts utilize this powerful odor. Gaseous ammonia readily
liquefies to give a colorless liquid that boils at −33 °C. Due to intermolecular hydrogen bonding, the enthalpy of vaporization of
liquid ammonia is higher than that of any other liquid except water, so ammonia is useful as a refrigerant. Ammonia is quite soluble
in water (658 L at STP dissolves in 1 L H2O).
The chemical properties of ammonia are as follows:
1. Ammonia acts as a Brønsted base, as discussed in the chapter on acid-base chemistry. The ammonium ion is similar in size to
the potassium ion; compounds of the two ions exhibit many similarities in their structures and solubilities.
2. Ammonia can display acidic behavior, although it is a much weaker acid than water. Like other acids, ammonia reacts with
metals, although it is so weak that high temperatures are necessary. Hydrogen and (depending on the stoichiometry) amides
(salts of NH ), imides (salts of NH2−), or nitrides (salts of N3−) form.
−
2
3. The nitrogen atom in ammonia has its lowest possible oxidation state (3−) and thus is not susceptible to reduction. However, it
can be oxidized. Ammonia burns in air, giving NO and water. Hot ammonia and the ammonium ion are active reducing agents.
Of particular interest are the oxidations of ammonium ion by nitrite ion, NO , to yield pure nitrogen and by nitrate ion to yield
−
Chloramine, NH2Cl, results from the reaction of sodium hypochlorite, NaOCl, with ammonia in basic solution. In the presence of a
large excess of ammonia at low temperature, the chloramine reacts further to produce hydrazine, N2H4:
− −
NH (aq) + OCl (aq) ⟶ NH Cl(aq) + OH (aq)
3 2
− −
NH Cl(aq) + NH (aq) + OH (aq) ⟶ N H (aq) + Cl (aq) + H O(l)
2 3 2 4 2
Anhydrous hydrazine is relatively stable in spite of its positive free energy of formation:
∘ −1
N (g) + 2 H (g) ⟶ N H (l) ΔG = 149.2 kJ mo l
2 2 2 4 f
Hydrazine is a fuming, colorless liquid that has some physical properties remarkably similar to those of H2O (it melts at 2 °C, boils
at 113.5 °C, and has a density at 25 °C of 1.00 g/mL). It burns rapidly and completely in air with substantial evolution of heat:
Like ammonia, hydrazine is both a Brønsted base and a Lewis base, although it is weaker than ammonia. It reacts with strong acids
and forms two series of salts that contain the N H and N H ions, respectively. Some rockets use hydrazine as a fuel.
2
+
5 2
2+
− 2−
P (s) + 4 OH (aq) + 2 H O(l) ⟶ 2 HPO (aq) + 2 PH (g)
4 2 3 3
Phosphine is a colorless, very poisonous gas, which has an odor like that of decaying fish. Heat easily decomposes phosphine
(4 PH ⟶ P + 6 H ) , and the compound burns in air. The major uses of phosphine are as a fumigant for grains and in
3 4 2
semiconductor processing. Like ammonia, gaseous phosphine unites with gaseous hydrogen halides, forming phosphonium
compounds like PH4Cl and PH4I. Phosphine is a much weaker base than ammonia; therefore, these compounds decompose in
water, and the insoluble PH3 escapes from solution.
It is easy to oxidize the sulfur in metal sulfides and in hydrogen sulfide, making metal sulfides and H2S good reducing agents. In
acidic solutions, hydrogen sulfide reduces Fe3+ to Fe2+, MnO to Mn2+, Cr O to Cr3+, and HNO3 to NO2. The sulfur in H2S
−
4 2
2−
7
usually oxidizes to elemental sulfur, unless a large excess of the oxidizing agent is present. In which case, the sulfide may oxidize
to SO or SO (or to SO2 or SO3 in the absence of water):
2−
3
2−
4
This oxidation process leads to the removal of the hydrogen sulfide found in many sources of natural gas. The deposits of sulfur in
volcanic regions may be the result of the oxidation of H2S present in volcanic gases.
Hydrogen sulfide is a weak diprotic acid that dissolves in water to form hydrosulfuric acid. The acid ionizes in two stages, yielding
hydrogen sulfide ions, HS−, in the first stage and sulfide ions, S2−, in the second. Since hydrogen sulfide is a weak acid, aqueous
solutions of soluble sulfides and hydrogen sulfides are basic:
2− − −
S (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ HS (aq) + OH (aq)
2
− −
HS (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ H S(g) + OH (aq)
2 2
Gaseous hydrogen fluoride is also a by-product in the preparation of phosphate fertilizers by the reaction of fluoroapatite,
Ca5(PO4)3F, with sulfuric acid. The reaction of concentrated sulfuric acid with a chloride salt produces hydrogen chloride both
commercially and in the laboratory.
In most cases, sodium chloride is the chloride of choice because it is the least expensive chloride. Hydrogen bromide and hydrogen
iodide cannot be prepared using sulfuric acid because this acid is an oxidizing agent capable of oxidizing both bromide and iodide.
However, it is possible to prepare both hydrogen bromide and hydrogen iodide using an acid such as phosphoric acid because it is a
weaker oxidizing agent. For example:
− −
H PO (l) + Br (aq) ⟶ HBr(g) + H PO (aq)
3 4 2 4
All of the hydrogen halides are very soluble in water, forming hydrohalic acids. With the exception of hydrogen fluoride, which has
a strong hydrogen-fluoride bond, they are strong acids. Reactions of hydrohalic acids with metals, metal hydroxides, oxides, or
carbonates produce salts of the halides. Most chloride salts are soluble in water. AgCl, PbCl2, and Hg2Cl2 are the commonly
encountered exceptions.
The halide ions give the substances the properties associated with X−(aq). The heavier halide ions (Cl−, Br−, and I−) can act as
reducing agents, and the lighter halogens or other oxidizing agents will oxidize them:
− −
Cl (aq) + 2 e ⟶ 2 Cl (aq) E° = 1.36 V
2
− −
Br (aq) + 2 e ⟶ 2 Br (aq) E° = 1.09 V
2
− −
I (aq) + 2 e ⟶ 2I (aq) E° = 0.54 V
2
Hydrofluoric acid is unique in its reactions with sand (silicon dioxide) and with glass, which is a mixture of silicates:
The volatile silicon tetrafluoride escapes from these reactions. Because hydrogen fluoride attacks glass, it can frost or etch glass
and is used to etch markings on thermometers, burets, and other glassware.
The largest use for hydrogen fluoride is in production of hydrochlorofluorocarbons for refrigerants, in plastics, and in propellants.
The second largest use is in the manufacture of cryolite, Na3AlF6, which is important in the production of aluminum. The acid is
also important in the production of other inorganic fluorides (such as BF3), which serve as catalysts in the industrial synthesis of
certain organic compounds.
Hydrochloric acid is relatively inexpensive. It is an important and versatile acid in industry and is important for the manufacture of
metal chlorides, dyes, glue, glucose, and various other chemicals. A considerable amount is also important for the activation of oil
wells and as pickle liquor—an acid used to remove oxide coating from iron or steel that is to be galvanized, tinned, or enameled.
The amounts of hydrobromic acid and hydroiodic acid used commercially are insignificant by comparison.
Summary
Hydrogen is the most abundant element in the universe and its chemistry is truly unique. Although it has some chemical reactivity
that is similar to that of the alkali metals, hydrogen has many of the same chemical properties of a nonmetal with a relatively low
electronegativity. It forms ionic hydrides with active metals, covalent compounds in which it has an oxidation state of 1− with less
electronegative elements, and covalent compounds in which it has an oxidation state of 1+ with more electronegative nonmetals. It
reacts explosively with oxygen, fluorine, and chlorine, less readily with bromine, and much less readily with iodine, sulfur, and
nitrogen. Hydrogen reduces the oxides of metals with lower reduction potentials than chromium to form the metal and water. The
hydrogen halides are all acidic when dissolved in water.
hydrogen halide
binary compound formed between hydrogen and the halogens: HF, HCl, HBr, and HI
hydrogenation
addition of hydrogen (H2) to reduce a compound
This page titled 18.5: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of Hydrogen is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
The chemistry of carbon is extensive; however, most of this chemistry is not relevant to this chapter. The other aspects of the
chemistry of carbon will appear in the chapter covering organic chemistry. In this chapter, we will focus on the carbonate ion and
related substances. The metals of groups 1 and 2, as well as zinc, cadmium, mercury, and lead(II), form ionic carbonates—
compounds that contain the carbonate anions, CO . The metals of group 1, magnesium, calcium, strontium, and barium also form
2−
3
hydrogen carbonates—compounds that contain the hydrogen carbonate anion, HCO , also known as the bicarbonate anion.
−
3
With the exception of magnesium carbonate, it is possible to prepare carbonates of the metals of groups 1 and 2 by the reaction of
carbon dioxide with the respective oxide or hydroxide. Examples of such reactions include:
Na O(s) + CO (g) ⟶ Na CO (s) (18.6.1)
2 2 2 3
The carbonates of the alkaline earth metals of group 12 and lead(II) are not soluble. These carbonates precipitate upon mixing a
solution of soluble alkali metal carbonate with a solution of soluble salts of these metals. Examples of net ionic equations for the
reactions are:
2+ 2−
Ca (aq) + CO3 (aq) ⟶ CaCO (s) (18.6.3)
3
2+ 2−
Pb (aq) + CO (aq) ⟶ PbCO (s) (18.6.4)
3 3
Pearls and the shells of most mollusks are calcium carbonate. Tin(II) or one of the trivalent or tetravalent ions such as Al3+ or Sn4+
behave differently in this reaction as carbon dioxide and the corresponding oxide form instead of the carbonate.
Alkali metal hydrogen carbonates such as NaHCO3 and CsHCO3 form by saturating a solution of the hydroxides with carbon
dioxide. The net ionic reaction involves hydroxide ion and carbon dioxide:
− −
OH (aq) + CO (aq) ⟶ HCO (aq)
2 3
It is possible to isolate the solids by evaporation of the water from the solution.
Although they are insoluble in pure water, alkaline earth carbonates dissolve readily in water containing carbon dioxide because
hydrogen carbonate salts form. For example, caves and sinkholes form in limestone when CaCO3 dissolves in water containing
dissolved carbon dioxide:
2+ −
CaCO (s) + CO (aq) + H O(l) ⟶ Ca (aq) + 2 HCO (aq)
3 2 2 3
Hydrogen carbonates of the alkaline earth metals remain stable only in solution; evaporation of the solution produces the carbonate.
Stalactites and stalagmites, like those shown in Figure 18.6.1, form in caves when drops of water containing dissolved calcium
hydrogen carbonate evaporate to leave a deposit of calcium carbonate.
Carbonates are moderately strong bases. Aqueous solutions are basic because the carbonate ion accepts hydrogen ion from water in
this reversible reaction:
2− − −
CO (aq) + H O(l) ⇌ HCO (aq) + OH (aq)
3 2 3
Carbonates react with acids to form salts of the metal, gaseous carbon dioxide, and water. The reaction of calcium carbonate, the
active ingredient of the antacid Tums, with hydrochloric acid (stomach acid), as shown in Figure 18.6.2, illustrates the reaction:
Figure 18.6.2 : The reaction of calcium carbonate with hydrochloric acid is shown. (credit: Mark Ott)
Other applications of carbonates include glass making—where carbonate ions serve as a source of oxide ions—and synthesis of
oxides.
Hydrogen carbonates are amphoteric because they act as both weak acids and weak bases. Hydrogen carbonate ions act as acids
and react with solutions of soluble hydroxides to form a carbonate and water:
With acids, hydrogen carbonates form a salt, carbon dioxide, and water. Baking soda (bicarbonate of soda or sodium bicarbonate) is
sodium hydrogen carbonate. Baking powder contains baking soda and a solid acid such as potassium hydrogen tartrate (cream of
tartar), KHC4H4O6. As long as the powder is dry, no reaction occurs; immediately after the addition of water, the acid reacts with
the hydrogen carbonate ions to form carbon dioxide:
Dough will trap the carbon dioxide, causing it to expand during baking, producing the characteristic texture of baked goods.
Summary
The usual method for the preparation of the carbonates of the alkali and alkaline earth metals is by reaction of an oxide or
hydroxide with carbon dioxide. Other carbonates form by precipitation. Metal carbonates or hydrogen carbonates such as limestone
(CaCO3), the antacid Tums (CaCO3), and baking soda (NaHCO3) are common examples. Carbonates and hydrogen carbonates
decompose in the presence of acids and most decompose on heating.
Glossary
bicarbonate anion
salt of the hydrogen carbonate ion, HCO −
3
carbonate
salt of the anion CO 2−
3
; often formed by the reaction of carbon dioxide with bases
hydrogen carbonate
salt of carbonic acid, H2CO3 (containing the anion HCO ) in which one hydrogen atom has been replaced; an acid carbonate;
−
3
This page titled 18.6: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of Carbonates is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
Most pure nitrogen comes from the fractional distillation of liquid air. The atmosphere consists of 78% nitrogen by volume. This
means there are more than 20 million tons of nitrogen over every square mile of the earth’s surface. Nitrogen is a component of
proteins and of the genetic material (DNA/RNA) of all plants and animals.
Under ordinary conditions, nitrogen is a colorless, odorless, and tasteless gas. It boils at 77 K and freezes at 63 K. Liquid nitrogen
is a useful coolant because it is inexpensive and has a low boiling point. Nitrogen is very unreactive because of the very strong
triple bond between the nitrogen atoms. The only common reactions at room temperature occur with lithium to form Li3N, with
certain transition metal complexes, and with hydrogen or oxygen in nitrogen-fixing bacteria. The general lack of reactivity of
nitrogen makes the remarkable ability of some bacteria to synthesize nitrogen compounds using atmospheric nitrogen gas as the
source one of the most exciting chemical events on our planet. This process is one type of nitrogen fixation. In this case, nitrogen
fixation is the process where organisms convert atmospheric nitrogen into biologically useful chemicals. Nitrogen fixation also
occurs when lightning passes through air, causing molecular nitrogen to react with oxygen to form nitrogen oxides, which are then
carried down to the soil.
Figure 18.7.2 : Nitrous oxide, N2O, is an anesthetic that has these molecular (left) and resonance (right) structures.
Low yields of nitric oxide, NO, form when heating nitrogen and oxygen together. NO also forms when lightning passes through air
during thunderstorms. Burning ammonia is the commercial method of preparing nitric oxide. In the laboratory, the reduction of
nitric acid is the best method for preparing nitric oxide. When copper reacts with dilute nitric acid, nitric oxide is the principal
reduction product:
Gaseous nitric oxide is the most thermally stable of the nitrogen oxides and is the simplest known thermally stable molecule with
an unpaired electron. It is one of the air pollutants generated by internal combustion engines, resulting from the reaction of
atmospheric nitrogen and oxygen during the combustion process.
At room temperature, nitric oxide is a colorless gas consisting of diatomic molecules. As is often the case with molecules that
contain an unpaired electron, two molecules combine to form a dimer by pairing their unpaired electrons to form a bond. Liquid
and solid NO both contain N2O2 dimers, like that shown in Figure 18.7.3. Most substances with unpaired electrons exhibit color by
absorbing visible light; however, NO is colorless because the absorption of light is not in the visible region of the spectrum.
Figure 18.7.3 : This shows the equilibrium between NO and N2O2. The molecule, N2O2, absorbs light.
Cooling a mixture of equal parts nitric oxide and nitrogen dioxide to −21 °C produces dinitrogen trioxide, a blue liquid consisting
of N2O3 molecules (Figure 18.7.4). Dinitrogen trioxide exists only in the liquid and solid states. When heated, it reverts to a
mixture of NO and NO2.
Figure 18.7.4 : Dinitrogen trioxide, N2O3, only exists in liquid or solid states and has these molecular (left) and resonance (right)
structures.
It is possible to prepare nitrogen dioxide in the laboratory by heating the nitrate of a heavy metal, or by the reduction of
concentrated nitric acid with copper metal, as shown in Figure 18.7.5. Commercially, it is possible to prepare nitrogen dioxide by
oxidizing nitric oxide with air.
Figure 18.7.5 : The reaction of copper metal with concentrated HNO3 produces a solution of Cu(NO3)2 and brown fumes of NO2.
(credit: modification of work by Mark Ott)
The nitrogen dioxide molecule (Figure 18.7.6) contains an unpaired electron, which is responsible for its color and paramagnetism.
It is also responsible for the dimerization of NO2. At low pressures or at high temperatures, nitrogen dioxide has a deep brown
Figure 18.7.6 : The molecular and resonance structures for nitrogen dioxide (NO2, left) and dinitrogen tetraoxide (N2O4, right) are
shown.
Dinitrogen pentaoxide, N2O5 (Figure 18.7.7 ), is a white solid that is formed by the dehydration of nitric acid by phosphorus(V)
oxide (tetraphosphorus decoxide):
Figure 18.7.7 : This image shows the molecular structure and one resonance structure of a molecule of dinitrogen pentaoxide, N2O5.
The oxides of nitrogen(III), nitrogen(IV), and nitrogen(V) react with water and form nitrogen-containing oxyacids. Nitrogen(III)
oxide, N2O3, is the anhydride of nitrous acid; HNO2 forms when N2O3 reacts with water. There are no stable oxyacids containing
nitrogen with an oxidation state of 4+; therefore, nitrogen(IV) oxide, NO2, disproportionates in one of two ways when it reacts with
water. In cold water, a mixture of HNO2 and HNO3 forms. At higher temperatures, HNO3 and NO will form. Nitrogen(V) oxide,
N2O5, is the anhydride of nitric acid; HNO3 is produced when N2O5 reacts with water:
The nitrogen oxides exhibit extensive oxidation-reduction behavior. Nitrous oxide resembles oxygen in its behavior when heated
with combustible substances. N2O is a strong oxidizing agent that decomposes when heated to form nitrogen and oxygen. Because
one-third of the gas liberated is oxygen, nitrous oxide supports combustion better than air (one-fifth oxygen). A glowing splinter
bursts into flame when thrust into a bottle of this gas. Nitric oxide acts both as an oxidizing agent and as a reducing agent. For
example:
Nitrogen dioxide (or dinitrogen tetraoxide) is a good oxidizing agent. For example:
Summary
Nitrogen exhibits oxidation states ranging from 3− to 5+. Because of the stability of the N≡N triple bond, it requires a great deal of
energy to make compounds from molecular nitrogen. Active metals such as the alkali metals and alkaline earth metals can reduce
nitrogen to form metal nitrides. Nitrogen oxides and nitrogen hydrides are also important substances.
This page titled 18.7: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of Nitrogen is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
The industrial preparation of phosphorus is by heating calcium phosphate, obtained from phosphate rock, with sand and coke:
Δ
The phosphorus distills out of the furnace and is condensed into a solid or burned to form P4O10. The preparation of many other
phosphorus compounds begins with P4O10. The acids and phosphates are useful as fertilizers and in the chemical industry. Other
uses are in the manufacture of special alloys such as ferrophosphorus and phosphor bronze. Phosphorus is important in making
pesticides, matches, and some plastics. Phosphorus is an active nonmetal. In compounds, phosphorus usually occurs in oxidation
states of 3−, 3+, and 5+. Phosphorus exhibits oxidation numbers that are unusual for a group 15 element in compounds that contain
phosphorus-phosphorus bonds; examples include diphosphorus tetrahydride, H2P-PH2, and tetraphosphorus trisulfide, P4S3,
illustrated in Figure 18.8.1.
Figure 18.8.2 : This image shows the molecular structures of P4O6 (left) and P4O10 (right).
Phosphorus(V) oxide, P4O10, is a white powder that is prepared by burning phosphorus in excess oxygen. Its enthalpy of formation
is very high (−2984 kJ), and it is quite stable and a very poor oxidizing agent. Dropping P4O10 into water produces a hissing sound,
heat, and orthophosphoric acid:
Because of its great affinity for water, phosphorus(V) oxide is an excellent drying agent for gases and solvents, and for removing
water from many compounds.
Figure 18.8.3: This image shows the molecular structure of PCl3 (left) and PCl5 (right) in the gas phase.
Like most other nonmetal halides, both phosphorus chlorides react with an excess of water and yield hydrogen chloride and an
oxyacid: PCl3 yields phosphorous acid H3PO3 and PCl5 yields phosphoric acid, H3PO4.
The pentahalides of phosphorus are Lewis acids because of the empty valence d orbitals of phosphorus. These compounds readily
react with halide ions (Lewis bases) to give the anion PX . Whereas phosphorus pentafluoride is a molecular compound in all
−
states, X-ray studies show that solid phosphorus pentachloride is an ionic compound, [PCl ][PCl ], as are phosphorus
+
4
−
6
4
+
Summary
Phosphorus (group 15) commonly exhibits oxidation states of 3− with active metals and of 3+ and 5+ with more electronegative
nonmetals. The halogens and oxygen will oxidize phosphorus. The oxides are phosphorus(V) oxide, P4O10, and phosphorus(III)
oxide, P4O6. The two common methods for preparing orthophosphoric acid, H3PO4, are either the reaction of a phosphate with
sulfuric acid or the reaction of water with phosphorus(V) oxide. Orthophosphoric acid is a triprotic acid that forms three types of
salts.
This page titled 18.8: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of Phosphorus is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
Oxygen is the most abundant element on the earth’s crust. The earth’s surface is composed of the crust, atmosphere, and hydrosphere. About 50% of
the mass of the earth’s crust consists of oxygen (combined with other elements, principally silicon). Oxygen occurs as O2 molecules and, to a limited
extent, as O3 (ozone) molecules in air. It forms about 20% of the mass of the air. About 89% of water by mass consists of combined oxygen. In
combination with carbon, hydrogen, and nitrogen, oxygen is a large part of plants and animals.
Oxygen is a colorless, odorless, and tasteless gas at ordinary temperatures. It is slightly denser than air. Although it is only slightly soluble in water
(49 mL of gas dissolves in 1 L at STP), oxygen’s solubility is very important to aquatic life.
Most of the oxygen isolated commercially comes from air and the remainder from the electrolysis of water. The separation of oxygen from air begins
with cooling and compressing the air until it liquefies. As liquid air warms, oxygen with its higher boiling point (90 K) separates from nitrogen,
which has a lower boiling point (77 K). It is possible to separate the other components of air at the same time based on differences in their boiling
points.
Oxygen is essential in combustion processes such as the burning of fuels. Plants and animals use the oxygen from the air in respiration. The
administration of oxygen-enriched air is an important medical practice when a patient is receiving an inadequate supply of oxygen because of shock,
pneumonia, or some other illness.
The chemical industry employs oxygen for oxidizing many substances. A significant amount of oxygen produced commercially is important in the
removal of carbon from iron during steel production. Large quantities of pure oxygen are also necessary in metal fabrication and in the cutting and
welding of metals with oxyhydrogen and oxyacetylene torches.
Liquid oxygen is important to the space industry. It is an oxidizing agent in rocket engines. It is also the source of gaseous oxygen for life support in
space.
As we know, oxygen is very important to life. The energy required for the maintenance of normal body functions in human beings and in other
organisms comes from the slow oxidation of chemical compounds. Oxygen is the final oxidizing agent in these reactions. In humans, oxygen passes
from the lungs into the blood, where it combines with hemoglobin, producing oxyhemoglobin. In this form, blood transports the oxygen to tissues,
where it is transferred to the tissues. The ultimate products are carbon dioxide and water. The blood carries the carbon dioxide through the veins to
the lungs, where the blood releases the carbon dioxide and collects another supply of oxygen. Digestion and assimilation of food regenerate the
materials consumed by oxidation in the body; the energy liberated is the same as if the food burned outside the body.
Green plants continually replenish the oxygen in the atmosphere by a process called photosynthesis. The products of photosynthesis may vary, but,
in general, the process converts carbon dioxide and water into glucose (a sugar) and oxygen using the energy of light:
chlorophyll
dioxide
Thus, the oxygen that became carbon dioxide and water by the metabolic processes in plants and animals returns to the atmosphere by
photosynthesis.
When dry oxygen is passed between two electrically charged plates, ozone (O3, illustrated in Figure 18.9.1), an allotrope of oxygen possessing a
distinctive odor, forms. The formation of ozone from oxygen is an endothermic reaction, in which the energy comes from an electrical discharge,
heat, or ultraviolet light:
electric discharge
The sharp odor associated with sparking electrical equipment is due, in part, to ozone.
Figure 18.9.1 : The image shows the bent ozone (O3) molecule and the resonance structures necessary to describe its bonding.
The reactive oxygen atoms recombine with molecular oxygen to complete the ozone cycle. The presence of stratospheric ozone decreases the
frequency of skin cancer and other damaging effects of ultraviolet radiation. It has been clearly demonstrated that chlorofluorocarbons, CFCs
(known commercially as Freons), which were present as aerosol propellants in spray cans and as refrigerants, caused depletion of ozone in the
stratosphere. This occurred because ultraviolet light also causes CFCs to decompose, producing atomic chlorine. The chlorine atoms react with
ozone molecules, resulting in a net removal of O3 molecules from stratosphere. This process is explored in detail in our coverage of chemical
kinetics. There is a worldwide effort to reduce the amount of CFCs used commercially, and the ozone hole is already beginning to decrease in size as
atmospheric concentrations of atomic chlorine decrease. While ozone in the stratosphere helps protect us, ozone in the troposphere is a problem.
This ozone is a toxic component of photochemical smog.
The uses of ozone depend on its reactivity with other substances. It can be used as a bleaching agent for oils, waxes, fabrics, and starch: It oxidizes
the colored compounds in these substances to colorless compounds. It is an alternative to chlorine as a disinfectant for water.
18.9.1: Reactions
Elemental oxygen is a strong oxidizing agent. It reacts with most other elements and many compounds.
The oxides of halogens, at least one of the noble gases, and metals with higher reduction potentials than copper do not form by the direct action of
the elements with oxygen.
It is also possible to oxidize oxides such as CO and P4O6 that contain an element with a lower oxidation state. The ease with which elemental
oxygen picks up electrons is mirrored by the difficulty of removing electrons from oxygen in most oxides. Of the elements, only the very reactive
fluorine can oxidize oxides to form oxygen gas.
oxygen-oxygen covalent bonds that have a bond order of , In addition, there are (3) hydroxides, containing hydroxide ions, OH−. All representative
3
metals form oxides. Some of the metals of group 2 also form peroxides, MO2, and the metals of group 1 also form peroxides, M2O2, and
superoxides, MO2.
18.9.3.1: Oxides
It is possible to produce the oxides of most representative metals by heating the corresponding hydroxides (forming the oxide and gaseous water) or
carbonates (forming the oxide and gaseous CO2). Equations for example reactions are:
Δ
2 Al (OH) (s) −
→ Al O (s) + 3 H O(g)
3 2 3 2
CaCO (s) −
→ CaO(s) + CO (g)
3 2
However, alkali metal salts generally are very stable and do not decompose easily when heated. Alkali metal oxides result from the oxidation-
reduction reactions created by heating nitrates or hydroxides with the metals. Equations for sample reactions are:
2 LiOH(s) + 2 Li(s) −
→ 2 Li O(s) + H (g)
2 2
With the exception of mercury(II) oxide, it is possible to produce the oxides of the metals of groups 2–15 by burning the corresponding metal in air.
The heaviest member of each group, the member for which the inert pair effect is most pronounced, forms an oxide in which the oxidation state of
the metal ion is two less than the group oxidation state (inert pair effect). Thus, Tl2O, PbO, and Bi2O3 form when burning thallium, lead, and
bismuth, respectively. The oxides of the lighter members of each group exhibit the group oxidation state. For example, SnO2 forms from burning tin.
Mercury(II) oxide, HgO, forms slowly when mercury is warmed below 500 °C; it decomposes at higher temperatures.
Burning the members of groups 1 and 2 in air is not a suitable way to form the oxides of these elements. These metals are reactive enough to
combine with nitrogen in the air, so they form mixtures of oxides and ionic nitrides. Several also form peroxides or superoxides when heated in air.
Ionic oxides all contain the oxide ion, a very powerful hydrogen ion acceptor. With the exception of the very insoluble aluminum oxide, Al2O3,
tin(IV), SnO2, and lead(IV), PbO2, the oxides of the representative metals react with acids to form salts. Some equations for these reactions are:
The oxides of the metals of groups 1 and 2 and of thallium(I) oxide react with water and form hydroxides. Examples of such reactions are:
The oxides of the alkali metals have little industrial utility, unlike magnesium oxide, calcium oxide, and aluminum oxide. Magnesium oxide is
important in making firebrick, crucibles, furnace linings, and thermal insulation—applications that require chemical and thermal stability. Calcium
oxide, sometimes called quicklime or lime in the industrial market, is very reactive, and its principal uses reflect its reactivity. Pure calcium oxide
emits an intense white light when heated to a high temperature (as illustrated in Figure 18.9.2:). Blocks of calcium oxide heated by gas flames were
the stage lights in theaters before electricity was available. This is the source of the phrase “in the limelight.”
Figure 18.9.2 : Calcium oxide has many industrial uses. When it is heated at high temperatures, it emits an intense white light.
Calcium oxide and calcium hydroxide are inexpensive bases used extensively in chemical processing, although most of the useful products prepared
from them do not contain calcium. Calcium oxide, CaO, is made by heating calcium carbonate, CaCO3, which is widely and inexpensively available
as limestone or oyster shells:
Although this decomposition reaction is reversible, it is possible to obtain a 100% yield of CaO by allowing the CO2 to escape. It is possible to
prepare calcium hydroxide by the familiar acid-base reaction of a soluble metal oxide with water:
Both CaO and Ca(OH)2 are useful as bases; they accept protons and neutralize acids.
Alumina (Al2O3) occurs in nature as the mineral corundum, a very hard substance used as an abrasive for grinding and polishing. Corundum is
important to the jewelry trade as ruby and sapphire. The color of ruby is due to the presence of a small amount of chromium; other impurities
produce the wide variety of colors possible for sapphires. Artificial rubies and sapphires are now manufactured by melting aluminum oxide (melting
point = 2050 °C) with small amounts of oxides to produce the desired colors and cooling the melt in such a way as to produce large crystals. Ruby
lasers use synthetic ruby crystals.
Zinc oxide, ZnO, was a useful white paint pigment; however, pollutants tend to discolor the compound. The compound is also important in the
manufacture of automobile tires and other rubber goods, and in the preparation of medicinal ointments. For example, zinc-oxide-based sunscreens,
as shown in Figure 18.9.3, help prevent sunburn. The zinc oxide in these sunscreens is present in the form of very small grains known as
Figure 18.9.3 : Zinc oxide protects exposed skin from sunburn. (credit: modification of work by "osseous"/Flickr)
2 Na(s) + O (g) −
→ Na O (s)
2 2 2
2 Na O(s) + O (g) −
→ 2 Na O (s)
2 2 2 2
2 SrO(s) + O (g) −
→ 2 SrO (s)
2 2
The peroxides of potassium, rubidium, and cesium can be prepared by heating the metal or its oxide in a carefully controlled amount of oxygen:
2 K(s) + O (g) ⟶ K O (s) (2 mol K per mol O2 )
2 2 2
With an excess of oxygen, the superoxides KO2, RbO2, and CsO2 form. For example:
The stability of the peroxides and superoxides of the alkali metals increases as the size of the cation increases.
18.9.3.3: Hydroxides
Hydroxides are compounds that contain the OH− ion. It is possible to prepare these compounds by two general types of reactions. Soluble metal
hydroxides can be produced by the reaction of the metal or metal oxide with water. Insoluble metal hydroxides form when a solution of a soluble salt
of the metal combines with a solution containing hydroxide ions.
With the exception of beryllium and magnesium, the metals of groups 1 and 2 react with water to form hydroxides and hydrogen gas. Examples of
such reactions include:
However, these reactions can be violent and dangerous; therefore, it is preferable to produce soluble metal hydroxides by the reaction of the
respective oxide with water:
Most metal oxides are base anhydrides. This is obvious for the soluble oxides because they form metal hydroxides. Most other metal oxides are
insoluble and do not form hydroxides in water; however, they are still base anhydrides because they will react with acids.
It is possible to prepare the insoluble hydroxides of beryllium, magnesium, and other representative metals by the addition of sodium hydroxide to a
solution of a salt of the respective metal. The net ionic equations for the reactions involving a magnesium salt, an aluminum salt, and a zinc salt are:
2+ −
Mg (aq) + 2 OH (aq) ⟶ Mg (OH) (s)
2
3+ −
Al (aq) + 3 OH (aq) ⟶ Al (OH) (s)
3
An excess of hydroxide must be avoided when preparing aluminum, gallium, zinc, and tin(II) hydroxides, or the hydroxides will dissolve with the
− − 2− −
formation of the corresponding complex ions: Al(OH) , Ga(OH) , Zn(OH) , and Sn(OH) (Figure 18.9.4). The important aspect of complex
4 4 4 3
ions for this chapter is that they form by a Lewis acid-base reaction with the metal being the Lewis acid.
Figure 18.9.4 : (a) Mixing solutions of NaOH and Zn(NO3)2 produces a white precipitate of Zn(OH)2. (b) Addition of an excess of NaOH results in
dissolution of the precipitate. (credit: modification of work by Mark Ott)
Industry uses large quantities of sodium hydroxide as a cheap, strong base. Sodium chloride is the starting material for the production of NaOH
because NaCl is a less expensive starting material than the oxide. Sodium hydroxide is among the top 10 chemicals in production in the United
States, and this production was almost entirely by electrolysis of solutions of sodium chloride. This process is the chlor-alkali process, and it is the
primary method for producing chlorine.
Sodium hydroxide is an ionic compound and melts without decomposition. It is very soluble in water, giving off a great deal of heat and forming
very basic solutions: 40 grams of sodium hydroxide dissolves in only 60 grams of water at 25 °C. Sodium hydroxide is employed in the production
of other sodium compounds and is used to neutralize acidic solutions during the production of other chemicals such as petrochemicals and polymers.
Many of the applications of hydroxides are for the neutralization of acids (such as the antacid shown in Figure 18.9.5) and for the preparation of
oxides by thermal decomposition. An aqueous suspension of magnesium hydroxide constitutes the antacid milk of magnesia. Because of its ready
availability (from the reaction of water with calcium oxide prepared by the decomposition of limestone, CaCO3), low cost, and activity, calcium
hydroxide is used extensively in commercial applications needing a cheap, strong base. The reaction of hydroxides with appropriate acids is also
used to prepare salts.
Figure 18.9.5 : Calcium carbonate, CaCO3, can be consumed in the form of an antacid to neutralize the effects of acid in your stomach. (credit:
“Midnightcomm”/Wikimedia Commons)
The electrons produced travel through the outside electrical circuit to the negative electrode. Although the positive sodium ions migrate toward this
negative electrode, metallic sodium does not form because sodium ions are too difficult to reduce under the conditions used. (Recall that metallic
sodium is active enough to react with water and hence, even if produced, would immediately react with water to produce sodium ions again.)
Instead, water molecules pick up electrons from the electrode and undergo reduction to form hydrogen gas and hydroxide ions:
− −
2 H O(l) + 2 e (from the negative electrode) ⟶ H (g) + 2 OH (aq)
2 2
The overall result is the conversion of the aqueous solution of NaCl to an aqueous solution of NaOH, gaseous Cl2, and gaseous H2:
Figure 18.9.6 : This image shows the molecular structure (left) and resonance forms (right) of sulfur dioxide.
Commercial production of sulfur dioxide is from either burning sulfur or roasting sulfide ores such as ZnS, FeS2, and Cu2S in air. (Roasting, which
forms the metal oxide, is the first step in the separation of many metals from their ores.) A convenient method for preparing sulfur dioxide in the
laboratory is by the action of a strong acid on either sulfite salts containing the SO ion or hydrogen sulfite salts containing HSO . Sulfurous acid,
2−
3
−
3
H2SO3, forms first, but quickly decomposes into sulfur dioxide and water. Sulfur dioxide also forms when many reducing agents react with hot,
concentrated sulfuric acid. Sulfur trioxide forms slowly when heating sulfur dioxide and oxygen together, and the reaction is exothermic:
Sulfur dioxide is a gas at room temperature, and the SO2 molecule is bent. Sulfur trioxide melts at 17 °C and boils at 43 °C. In the vapor state, its
molecules are single SO3 units (Figure 18.9.7), but in the solid state, SO3 exists in several polymeric forms.
Figure 18.9.7 : This image shows the structure (top) of sulfur trioxide in the gas phase and its resonance forms (bottom).
The sulfur oxides react as Lewis acids with many oxides and hydroxides in Lewis acid-base reactions, with the formation of sulfites or hydrogen
sulfites, and sulfates or hydrogen sulfates, respectively.
Figure 18.9.8 : This image shows the structures of the (a) Cl2O and (b) ClO2 molecules.
As a class, the oxides are extremely reactive and unstable, and their chemistry has little practical importance. Dichlorine oxide, formally called
dichlorine monoxide, and chlorine dioxide, both shown in Figure 18.9.8, are the only commercially important compounds. They are important as
bleaching agents (for use with pulp and flour) and for water treatment.
Figure 18.9.9 : This image shows the molecular structure (left) of nitric acid, HNO3 and its resonance forms (right).
In the laboratory, it is possible to produce nitric acid by heating a nitrate salt (such as sodium or potassium nitrate) with concentrated sulfuric acid:
Δ
The Ostwald process is the commercial method for producing nitric acid. This process involves the oxidation of ammonia to nitric oxide, NO;
oxidation of nitric oxide to nitrogen dioxide, NO2; and further oxidation and hydration of nitrogen dioxide to form nitric acid:
or
Pure nitric acid is a colorless liquid. However, it is often yellow or brown in color because NO2 forms as the acid decomposes. Nitric acid is stable in
aqueous solution; solutions containing 68% of the acid are commercially available concentrated nitric acid. It is both a strong oxidizing agent and a
strong acid.
The action of nitric acid on a metal rarely produces H2 (by reduction of H+) in more than small amounts. Instead, the reduction of nitrogen occurs.
The products formed depend on the concentration of the acid, the activity of the metal, and the temperature. Normally, a mixture of nitrates, nitrogen
oxides, and various reduction products form. Less active metals such as copper, silver, and lead reduce concentrated nitric acid primarily to nitrogen
dioxide. The reaction of dilute nitric acid with copper produces NO. In each case, the nitrate salts of the metals crystallize upon evaporation of the
resultant solutions.
Nonmetallic elements, such as sulfur, carbon, iodine, and phosphorus, undergo oxidation by concentrated nitric acid to their oxides or oxyacids, with
the formation of NO2:
Nitric acid oxidizes many compounds; for example, concentrated nitric acid readily oxidizes hydrochloric acid to chlorine and chlorine dioxide. A
mixture of one part concentrated nitric acid and three parts concentrated hydrochloric acid (called aqua regia, which means royal water) reacts
vigorously with metals. This mixture is particularly useful in dissolving gold, platinum, and other metals that are more difficult to oxidize than
hydrogen. A simplified equation to represent the action of aqua regia on gold is:
Video 18.9.1 : Although gold is generally unreactive, you can watch a video of the complex mixture of compounds present in aqua regia dissolving
it into solution.
Nitrates, salts of nitric acid, form when metals, oxides, hydroxides, or carbonates react with nitric acid. Most nitrates are soluble in water; indeed,
one of the significant uses of nitric acid is to prepare soluble metal nitrates.
Nitric acid finds extensive use in the laboratory and in chemical industries as a strong acid and strong oxidizing agent. It is important in the
manufacture of explosives, dyes, plastics, and drugs. Salts of nitric acid (nitrates) are valuable as fertilizers. Gunpowder is a mixture of potassium
nitrate, sulfur, and charcoal.
The reaction of N2O3 with water gives a pale blue solution of nitrous acid, HNO2. However, HNO2 (shown in Figure 18.9.10) is easier to prepare by
the addition of an acid to a solution of nitrite; nitrous acid is a weak acid, so the nitrite ion is basic in aqueous solution:
− +
NO2 (aq) + H O (aq) ⟶ HNO (aq) + H O(l)
3 2 2
Nitrous acid is very unstable and exists only in solution. It disproportionates slowly at room temperature (rapidly when heated) into nitric acid and
nitric oxide. Nitrous acid is an active oxidizing agent with strong reducing agents, and strong oxidizing agents oxidize it to nitric acid.
Figure 18.9.10: This image shows the molecular structure of a molecule of nitrous acid, HNO2.
Sodium nitrite, NaNO2, is an additive to meats such as hot dogs and cold cuts. The nitrite ion has two functions. It limits the growth of bacteria that
can cause food poisoning, and it prolongs the meat’s retention of its red color. The addition of sodium nitrite to meat products is controversial
because nitrous acid reacts with certain organic compounds to form a class of compounds known as nitrosamines. Nitrosamines produce cancer in
laboratory animals. This has prompted the FDA to limit the amount of NaNO2 in foods.
The nitrites are much more stable than the acid, but nitrites, like nitrates, can explode. Nitrites, like nitrates, are also soluble in water (AgNO2 is only
slightly soluble).
Heating the resulting solution expels the hydrogen chloride and leads to the evaporation of water. When sufficient water evaporates, white crystals of
phosphorous acid will appear upon cooling. The crystals are deliquescent, very soluble in water, and have an odor like that of garlic. The solid melts
at 70.1 °C and decomposes at about 200 °C by disproportionation into phosphine and orthophosphoric acid:
Figure 18.9.12: In a molecule of phosphorous acid, H3PO3, only the two hydrogen atoms bonded to an oxygen atom are acidic.
A space filling model shows an orange atom labeled, “P,” bonded on three sides to red atoms labeled, “O,” and on the other side to a white atom
labeled, “H.” Two of the red atoms are bonded to white atoms labeled, “H.” A Lewis structure is also shown in which a phosphorus atom is single
bonded to a hydrogen atom and three oxygen atoms, two of which have two lone pairs of electrons and single bonds to hydrogen atoms, and one of
which has three lone pairs of electrons.
Phosphorous acid forms only two series of salts, which contain the dihydrogen phosphite ion, H PO , or the hydrogen phosphate ion,
2
−
3
HPO
2−
3
,
respectively. It is not possible to replace the third atom of hydrogen because it is not very acidic, as it is not easy to ionize the P-H bond.
4
−
Being a diprotic acid, sulfuric acid forms both sulfates, such as Na2SO4, and hydrogen sulfates, such as NaHSO4. Most sulfates are soluble in water;
however, the sulfates of barium, strontium, calcium, and lead are only slightly soluble in water.
NaHSO4, exhibit acidic behavior, and this compound is the primary ingredient in some household cleansers.
Hot, concentrated sulfuric acid is an oxidizing agent. Depending on its concentration, the temperature, and the strength of the reducing agent,
sulfuric acid oxidizes many compounds and, in the process, undergoes reduction to SO2, HSO , SO , S, H2S, or S2−. −
3
2−
Sulfur dioxide dissolves in water to form a solution of sulfurous acid, as expected for the oxide of a nonmetal. Sulfurous acid is unstable, and it is
not possible to isolate anhydrous H2SO3. Heating a solution of sulfurous acid expels the sulfur dioxide. Like other diprotic acids, sulfurous acid
ionizes in two steps: The hydrogen sulfite ion, HSO , and the sulfite ion, SO , form. Sulfurous acid is a moderately strong acid. Ionization is
−
3
2−
3
about 25% in the first stage, but it is much less in the second (Ka1 = 1.2 × 10−2 and Ka2 = 6.2 × 10−8).
In order to prepare solid sulfite and hydrogen sulfite salts, it is necessary to add a stoichiometric amount of a base to a sulfurous acid solution and
then evaporate the water. These salts also form from the reaction of SO2 with oxides and hydroxides. Heating solid sodium hydrogen sulfite forms
sodium sulfite, sulfur dioxide, and water:
Δ
2 NaHSO (s) −
→ Na SO (s) + SO (g) + H O(l)
3 2 3 2 2
Strong oxidizing agents can oxidize sulfurous acid. Oxygen in the air oxidizes it slowly to the more stable sulfuric acid:
Δ
+ −
2 H SO (aq) + O (g) + 2 H O(l) −
→2H O (aq) + 2 HSO (aq)
2 3 2 2 3 4
Solutions of sulfites are also very susceptible to air oxidation to produce sulfates. Thus, solutions of sulfites always contain sulfates after exposure to
air.
The only known oxyacid of fluorine is the very unstable hypofluorous acid, HOF, which is prepared by the reaction of gaseous fluorine with ice:
The compound is very unstable and decomposes above −40 °C. This compound does not ionize in water, and there are no known salts. It is uncertain
whether the name hypofluorous acid is even appropriate for HOF; a more appropriate name might be hydrogen hypofluorite.
The reactions of chlorine and bromine with water are analogous to that of fluorine with ice, but these reactions do not go to completion, and
mixtures of the halogen and the respective hypohalous and hydrohalic acids result. Other than HOF, the hypohalous acids only exist in solution. The
hypohalous acids are all very weak acids; however, HOCl is a stronger acid than HOBr, which, in turn, is stronger than HOI.
The addition of base to solutions of the hypohalous acids produces solutions of salts containing the basic hypohalite ions, OX−. It is possible to
isolate these salts as solids. All of the hypohalites are unstable with respect to disproportionation in solution, but the reaction is slow for
hypochlorite. Hypobromite and hypoiodite disproportionate rapidly, even in the cold:
− − −
3 XO (aq) ⟶ 2 X (aq) + XO3 (aq)
Sodium hypochlorite is an inexpensive bleach (Clorox) and germicide. The commercial preparation involves the electrolysis of cold, dilute, aqueous
sodium chloride solutions under conditions where the resulting chlorine and hydroxide ion can react. The net reaction is:
electrical energy
− −
Cl (aq) + H O(l) −−−−−−−−−→ ClO (aq) + H (g)
2 2
The only definitely known halous acid is chlorous acid, HClO2, obtained by the reaction of barium chlorite with dilute sulfuric acid:
Filtering the insoluble barium sulfate leaves a solution of HClO2. Chlorous acid is not stable; it slowly decomposes in solution to yield chlorine
dioxide, hydrochloric acid, and water. Chlorous acid reacts with bases to give salts containing the chlorite ion (shown in Figure 18.9.14). Sodium
chlorite finds an extensive application in the bleaching of paper because it is a strong oxidizing agent and does not damage the paper.
Chloric acid, HClO3, and bromic acid, HBrO3, are stable only in solution. The reaction of iodine with concentrated nitric acid produces stable white
iodic acid, HIO3:
It is possible to obtain the lighter halic acids from their barium salts by reaction with dilute sulfuric acid. The reaction is analogous to that used to
prepare chlorous acid. All of the halic acids are strong acids and very active oxidizing agents. The acids react with bases to form salts containing
chlorate ions (shown in Figure 18.9.15). Another preparative method is the electrochemical oxidation of a hot solution of a metal halide to form the
appropriate metal chlorates. Sodium chlorate is a weed killer; potassium chlorate is used as an oxidizing agent.
Figure 18.9.15: Chlorate ions, ClO , are produced when halic acids react with bases.
−
Perchloric acid, HClO4, forms when treating a perchlorate, such as potassium perchlorate, with sulfuric acid under reduced pressure. The HClO4 can
be distilled from the mixture:
Dilute aqueous solutions of perchloric acid are quite stable thermally, but concentrations above 60% are unstable and dangerous. Perchloric acid and
its salts are powerful oxidizing agents, as the very electronegative chlorine is more stable in a lower oxidation state than 7+. Serious explosions have
occurred when heating concentrated solutions with easily oxidized substances. However, its reactions as an oxidizing agent are slow when perchloric
acid is cold and dilute. The acid is among the strongest of all acids. Most salts containing the perchlorate ion (Figure 18.9.16) are soluble. It is
possible to prepare them from reactions of bases with perchloric acid and, commercially, by the electrolysis of hot solutions of their chlorides.
Summary
Oxygen is one of the most reactive elements. This reactivity, coupled with its abundance, makes the chemistry of oxygen very rich and well
understood. Compounds of the representative metals with oxygen exist in three categories (1) oxides, (2) peroxides and superoxides, and (3)
hydroxides. Heating the corresponding hydroxides, nitrates, or carbonates is the most common method for producing oxides. Heating the metal or
metal oxide in oxygen may lead to the formation of peroxides and superoxides. The soluble oxides dissolve in water to form solutions of hydroxides.
Most metals oxides are base anhydrides and react with acids. The hydroxides of the representative metals react with acids in acid-base reactions to
form salts and water. The hydroxides have many commercial uses.
All nonmetals except fluorine form multiple oxides. Nearly all of the nonmetal oxides are acid anhydrides. The acidity of oxyacids requires that the
hydrogen atoms bond to the oxygen atoms in the molecule rather than to the other nonmetal atom. Generally, the strength of the oxyacid increases
with the number of oxygen atoms bonded to the nonmetal atom and not to a hydrogen.
chlor-alkali process
electrolysis process for the synthesis of chlorine and sodium hydroxide
hydrogen sulfate
HSO ion −
4
hydrogen sulfite
HSO ion −
3
hydroxide
compound of a metal with the hydroxide ion OH− or the group −OH
nitrate
NO3
−
ion; salt of nitric acid
Ostwald process
industrial process used to convert ammonia into nitric acid
oxide
binary compound of oxygen with another element or group, typically containing O2− ions or the group –O– or =O
ozone
allotrope of oxygen; O3
peroxide
molecule containing two oxygen atoms bonded together or as the anion, O 2−
2
photosynthesis
process whereby light energy promotes the reaction of water and carbon dioxide to form carbohydrates and oxygen; this allows photosynthetic
organisms to store energy
sulfate
SO
2−
4
ion
sulfite
SO
2−
3
ion
superoxide
oxide containing the anion O −
2
This page titled 18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of Oxygen is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Sulfur exists in nature as elemental deposits as well as sulfides of iron, zinc, lead, and copper, and sulfates of sodium, calcium,
barium, and magnesium. Hydrogen sulfide is often a component of natural gas and occurs in many volcanic gases, like those shown
in Figure 18.10.1. Sulfur is a constituent of many proteins and is essential for life.
Figure 18.10.1: Volcanic gases contain hydrogen sulfide. (credit: Daniel Julie/Wikimedia Commons)
The Frasch process, illustrated in Figure 18.10.2, is important in the mining of free sulfur from enormous underground deposits in
Texas and Louisiana. Superheated water (170 °C and 10 atm pressure) is forced down the outermost of three concentric pipes to the
underground deposit. The hot water melts the sulfur. The innermost pipe conducts compressed air into the liquid sulfur. The air
forces the liquid sulfur, mixed with air, to flow up through the outlet pipe. Transferring the mixture to large settling vats allows the
solid sulfur to separate upon cooling. This sulfur is 99.5% to 99.9% pure and requires no purification for most uses.
Figure 18.10.2: The Frasch process is used to mine sulfur from underground deposits.
Larger amounts of sulfur also come from hydrogen sulfide recovered during the purification of natural gas.
Sulfur exists in several allotropic forms. The stable form at room temperature contains eight-membered rings, and so the true
formula is S8. However, chemists commonly use S to simplify the coefficients in chemical equations; we will follow this practice in
this book.
The chemistry of sulfur with an oxidation state of 2− is similar to that of oxygen. Unlike oxygen, however, sulfur forms many
compounds in which it exhibits positive oxidation states.
Summary
Sulfur (group 16) reacts with almost all metals and readily forms the sulfide ion, S2−, in which it has as oxidation state of 2−. Sulfur
reacts with most nonmetals.
Glossary
Frasch process
important in the mining of free sulfur from enormous underground deposits
This page titled 18.10: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of Sulfur is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
The elements in group 17 are the halogens. These are the elements fluorine, chlorine, bromine, iodine, and astatine. These elements are too reactive
to occur freely in nature, but their compounds are widely distributed. Chlorides are the most abundant; although fluorides, bromides, and iodides are
less common, they are reasonably available. In this section, we will examine the occurrence, preparation, and properties of halogens. Next, we will
examine halogen compounds with the representative metals followed by an examination of the interhalogens. This section will conclude with some
applications of halogens.
− + 2+
MnO 2(s) + 2 Cl +4 H O ⟶ Mn + Cl2(g) + 6 H O(l)
(aq) 3 (aq) (aq) 2
The commercial preparation of bromine involves the oxidation of bromide ion by chlorine:
− −
2 Br + Cl2(g) ⟶ Br 2(l) + 2 Cl
(aq) (aq)
Chlorine is a stronger oxidizing agent than bromine. This method is important for the production of essentially all domestic bromine.
Some iodine comes from the oxidation of iodine chloride, ICl, or iodic acid, HlO . The commercial preparation of iodine utilizes the reduction of
3
sodium iodate, NaIO , an impurity in deposits of Chile saltpeter, with sodium hydrogen sulfite:
3
− − − 2 −
2 IO + 5 HSO ⟶ 3 HSO + 2 SO + H O(l) + I2(s)
3(aq) 3(aq) 4(aq) 4(aq) 2
Figure 18.11.1: Chlorine is a pale yellow-green gas (left), gaseous bromine is deep orange (center), and gaseous iodine is purple (right). (Fluorine is
so reactive that it is too dangerous to handle.) (credit: Sahar Atwa)
Bromine is only slightly soluble in water, but it is miscible in all proportions in less polar (or nonpolar) solvents such as chloroform, carbon
tetrachloride, and carbon disulfide, forming solutions that vary from yellow to reddish-brown, depending on the concentration.
− −
I2(s) + I ⟶ I (18.11.1)
(aq) 3(aq)
The easier it is to oxidize the halide ion, the more difficult it is for the halogen to act as an oxidizing agent. Fluorine generally oxidizes an element to
its highest oxidation state, whereas the heavier halogens may not. For example, when excess fluorine reacts with sulfur, SF forms. Chlorine gives6
Fluorine is the most powerful oxidizing agent of the known elements. It spontaneously oxidizes most other elements; therefore, the reverse reaction,
the oxidation of fluorides, is very difficult to accomplish. Fluorine reacts directly and forms binary fluorides with all of the elements except the
lighter noble gases (He, Ne, and Ar). Fluorine is such a strong oxidizing agent that many substances ignite on contact with it. Drops of water inflame
in fluorine and form O , OF , H O , O , and HF. Wood and asbestos ignite and burn in fluorine gas. Most hot metals burn vigorously in fluorine.
2 2 2 2 3
However, it is possible to handle fluorine in copper, iron, or nickel containers because an adherent film of the fluoride salt passivates their surfaces.
Fluorine is the only element that reacts directly with the noble gas xenon.
Although it is a strong oxidizing agent, chlorine is less active than fluorine. Mixing chlorine and hydrogen in the dark makes the reaction between
them to be imperceptibly slow. Exposure of the mixture to light causes the two to react explosively. Chlorine is also less active towards metals than
fluorine, and oxidation reactions usually require higher temperatures. Molten sodium ignites in chlorine. Chlorine attacks most nonmetals (C, N2,
and O2 are notable exceptions), forming covalent molecular compounds. Chlorine generally reacts with compounds that contain only carbon and
hydrogen (hydrocarbons) by adding to multiple bonds or by substitution.
In cold water, chlorine undergoes a disproportionation reaction:
+ −
Cl2(aq) + 2 H O(l) ⟶ HOCl(aq) + H O + Cl
2 3 (aq) (aq)
Half the chlorine atoms oxidize to the 1+ oxidation state (hypochlorous acid), and the other half reduce to the 1− oxidation state (chloride ion). This
disproportionation is incomplete, so chlorine water is an equilibrium mixture of chlorine molecules, hypochlorous acid molecules, hydronium ions,
and chloride ions. When exposed to light, this solution undergoes a photochemical decomposition:
sunlight
+ −
2 HOCl(aq) + 2 H O(l) −−−−→2H O + 2 Cl + O2(g)
2 3 (aq) (aq)
The nonmetal chlorine is more electronegative than any other element except fluorine, oxygen, and nitrogen. In general, very electronegative
elements are good oxidizing agents; therefore, we would expect elemental chlorine to oxidize all of the other elements except for these three (and the
nonreactive noble gases). Its oxidizing property, in fact, is responsible for its principal use. For example, phosphorus(V) chloride, an important
intermediate in the preparation of insecticides and chemical weapons, is manufactured by oxidizing the phosphorus with chlorine:
A great deal of chlorine is also used to oxidize, and thus to destroy, organic or biological materials in water purification and in bleaching.
The chemical properties of bromine are similar to those of chlorine, although bromine is the weaker oxidizing agent and its reactivity is less than that
of chlorine.
Iodine is the least reactive of the halogens. It is the weakest oxidizing agent, and the iodide ion is the most easily oxidized halide ion. Iodine reacts
with metals, but heating is often required. It does not oxidize other halide ions.
Compared with the other halogens, iodine reacts only slightly with water. Traces of iodine in water react with a mixture of starch and iodide ion,
forming a deep blue color. This reaction is a very sensitive test for the presence of iodine in water.
Video 18.11.1 : Reactions of the alkali metals with elemental halogens are very exothermic and often quite violent. Under controlled conditions,
they provide exciting demonstrations for budding students of chemistry. You can view the initial heating of the sodium that removes the coating of
sodium hydroxide, sodium peroxide, and residual mineral oil to expose the reactive surface. The reaction with chlorine gas then proceeds very
nicely.
If a metal can exhibit two oxidation states, it may be necessary to control the stoichiometry in order to obtain the halide with the lower oxidation
state. For example, preparation of tin(II) chloride requires a 1:1 ratio of Sn to Cl , whereas preparation of tin(IV) chloride requires a 1:2 ratio:
2
The active representative metals—those that are easier to oxidize than hydrogen—react with gaseous hydrogen halides to produce metal halides and
hydrogen. The reaction of zinc with hydrogen fluoride is:
The active representative metals also react with solutions of hydrogen halides to form hydrogen and solutions of the corresponding halides.
Examples of such reactions include:
Hydroxides, carbonates, and some oxides react with solutions of the hydrogen halides to form solutions of halide salts. It is possible to prepare
additional salts by the reaction of these hydroxides, carbonates, and oxides with aqueous solution of other acids:
A few halides and many of the other salts of the representative metals are insoluble. It is possible to prepare these soluble salts by metathesis
reactions that occur when solutions of soluble salts are mixed (Figure 18.11.2). Metathesis reactions are examined in the chapter on the
stoichiometry of chemical reactions.
Figure 18.11.3: Underground deposits of sodium chloride are found throughout the world and are often mined. This is a tunnel in the Kłodawa salt
mine in Poland. (credit: Jarek Zok).
18.11.4: Interhalogens
Compounds formed from two or more different halogens are interhalogens. Interhalogen molecules consist of one atom of the heavier halogen
bonded by single bonds to an odd number of atoms of the lighter halogen. The structures of IF3, IF5, and IF7 are illustrated in Figure 18.11.4
Formulas for other interhalogens, each of which comes from the reaction of the respective halogens, are in Table 18.11.1.
Figure 18.11.4: The structure of IF is T-shaped (left), IF is square pyramidal (center), and IF is pentagonal bipyramidal (right).
3 5 7
Three ball-and-stick models are shown. The left structure, labeled, “I F subscript 3,” shows a purple atom labeled, “I,” bonded to three green atoms
labeled, “F,” and with two lone pairs of electrons. The middle structure, labeled, “I F subscript 5,” shows a purple atom labeled, “I,” bonded to five
green atoms labeled, “F,” and with one lone pair of electrons. The right image, labeled, “I F subscript 7,” shows a purple atom labeled, “I,” bonded
to seven green atoms labeled, “F.”
Note from Table 18.11.1 that fluorine is able to oxidize iodine to its maximum oxidation state, 7+, whereas bromine and chlorine, which are more
difficult to oxidize, achieve only the 5+-oxidation state. A 7+-oxidation state is the limit for the halogens. Because smaller halogens are grouped
about a larger one, the maximum number of smaller atoms possible increases as the radius of the larger atom increases. Many of these compounds
are unstable, and most are extremely reactive. The interhalogens react like their component halides; halogen fluorides, for example, are stronger
oxidizing agents than are halogen chlorides.
Table 18.11.1: Interhalogens
YX YX3 YX5 YX7
BrCl(g)
IBr(s)
ICl(l) ICl3(s)
The ionic polyhalides of the alkali metals, such as KI3, KICl2, KICl4, CsIBr2, and CsBrCl2, which contain an anion composed of at least three
halogen atoms, are closely related to the interhalogens. As seen previously, the formation of the polyhalide anion I is responsible for the solubility
−
18.11.5: Applications
The fluoride ion and fluorine compounds have many important uses. Compounds of carbon, hydrogen, and fluorine are replacing Freons
(compounds of carbon, chlorine, and fluorine) as refrigerants. Teflon is a polymer composed of –CF2CF2– units. Fluoride ion is added to water
supplies and to some toothpastes as SnF2 or NaF to fight tooth decay. Fluoride partially converts teeth from Ca5(PO4)3(OH) into Ca5(PO4)3F.
Chlorine is important to bleach wood pulp and cotton cloth. The chlorine reacts with water to form hypochlorous acid, which oxidizes colored
substances to colorless ones. Large quantities of chlorine are important in chlorinating hydrocarbons (replacing hydrogen with chlorine) to produce
compounds such as tetrachloride (CCl4), chloroform (CHCl3), and ethyl chloride (C2H5Cl), and in the production of polyvinyl chloride (PVC) and
other polymers. Chlorine is also important to kill the bacteria in community water supplies.
Bromine is important in the production of certain dyes, and sodium and potassium bromides are used as sedatives. At one time, light-sensitive silver
bromide was a component of photographic film.
Iodine in alcohol solution with potassium iodide is an antiseptic (tincture of iodine). Iodide salts are essential for the proper functioning of the
thyroid gland; an iodine deficiency may lead to the development of a goiter. Iodized table salt contains 0.023% potassium iodide. Silver iodide is
useful in the seeding of clouds to induce rain; it was important in the production of photographic film and iodoform, CHI3, is an antiseptic.
Summary
The halogens form halides with less electronegative elements. Halides of the metals vary from ionic to covalent; halides of nonmetals are covalent.
Interhalogens form by the combination of two or more different halogens. All of the representative metals react directly with elemental halogens or
with solutions of the hydrohalic acids (HF, HCl, HBr, and HI) to produce representative metal halides. Other laboratory preparations involve the
addition of aqueous hydrohalic acids to compounds that contain such basic anions, such as hydroxides, oxides, or carbonates.
This page titled 18.11: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of Halogens is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The elements in group 18 are the noble gases (helium, neon, argon, krypton, xenon, and radon). They earned the name “noble”
because they were assumed to be nonreactive since they have filled valence shells. In 1962, Dr. Neil Bartlett at the University of
British Columbia proved this assumption to be false.
These elements are present in the atmosphere in small amounts. Some natural gas contains 1–2% helium by mass. Helium is
isolated from natural gas by liquefying the condensable components, leaving only helium as a gas. The United States possesses
most of the world’s commercial supply of this element in its helium-bearing gas fields. Argon, neon, krypton, and xenon come
from the fractional distillation of liquid air. Radon comes from other radioactive elements. More recently, it was observed that this
radioactive gas is present in very small amounts in soils and minerals. Its accumulation in well-insulated, tightly sealed buildings,
however, constitutes a health hazard, primarily lung cancer.
The boiling points and melting points of the noble gases are extremely low relative to those of other substances of comparable
atomic or molecular masses. This is because only weak London dispersion forces are present, and these forces can hold the atoms
together only when molecular motion is very slight, as it is at very low temperatures. Helium is the only substance known that does
not solidify on cooling at normal pressure. It remains liquid close to absolute zero (0.001 K) at ordinary pressures, but it solidifies
under elevated pressure.
Helium is used for filling balloons and lighter-than-air craft because it does not burn, making it safer to use than hydrogen. Helium
at high pressures is not a narcotic like nitrogen. Thus, mixtures of oxygen and helium are important for divers working under high
pressures. Using a helium-oxygen mixture avoids the disoriented mental state known as nitrogen narcosis, the so-called rapture of
the deep. Helium is important as an inert atmosphere for the melting and welding of easily oxidizable metals and for many
chemical processes that are sensitive to air.
Liquid helium (boiling point, 4.2 K) is an important coolant to reach the low temperatures necessary for cryogenic research, and it
is essential for achieving the low temperatures necessary to produce superconduction in traditional superconducting materials used
in powerful magnets and other devices. This cooling ability is necessary for the magnets used for magnetic resonance imaging, a
common medical diagnostic procedure. The other common coolant is liquid nitrogen (boiling point, 77 K), which is significantly
cheaper.
Neon is a component of neon lamps and signs. Passing an electric spark through a tube containing neon at low pressure generates
the familiar red glow of neon. It is possible to change the color of the light by mixing argon or mercury vapor with the neon or by
utilizing glass tubes of a special color.
Argon was useful in the manufacture of gas-filled electric light bulbs, where its lower heat conductivity and chemical inertness
made it preferable to nitrogen for inhibiting the vaporization of the tungsten filament and prolonging the life of the bulb.
Fluorescent tubes commonly contain a mixture of argon and mercury vapor. Argon is the third most abundant gas in dry air.
Krypton-xenon flash tubes are used to take high-speed photographs. An electric discharge through such a tube gives a very intense
1
light that lasts only of a second. Krypton forms a difluoride, KrF2, which is thermally unstable at room temperature.
50, 000
Stable compounds of xenon form when xenon reacts with fluorine. Xenon difluoride, XeF2, forms after heating an excess of xenon
gas with fluorine gas and then cooling. The material forms colorless crystals, which are stable at room temperature in a dry
atmosphere. Xenon tetrafluoride, XeF4, (Figure 18.12.1) and xenon hexafluoride, XeF6, are prepared in an analogous manner, with
a stoichiometric amount of fluorine and an excess of fluorine, respectively. Compounds with oxygen are prepared by replacing
fluorine atoms in the xenon fluorides with oxygen.
Dry, solid xenon trioxide, XeO3, is extremely explosive—it will spontaneously detonate. Both XeF6 and XeO3 disproportionate in
basic solution, producing xenon, oxygen, and salts of the perxenate ion, XeO , in which xenon reaches its maximum oxidation
4−
sate of 8+.
Radon apparently forms RnF2—evidence of this compound comes from radiochemical tracer techniques.
Unstable compounds of argon form at low temperatures, but stable compounds of helium and neon are not known.
Summary
The most significant property of the noble gases (group 18) is their inactivity. They occur in low concentrations in the atmosphere.
They find uses as inert atmospheres, neon signs, and as coolants. The three heaviest noble gases react with fluorine to form
fluorides. The xenon fluorides are the best characterized as the starting materials for a few other noble gas compounds.
Glossary
halide
compound containing an anion of a group 17 element in the 1− oxidation state (fluoride, F−; chloride, Cl−; bromide, Br−; and
iodide, I−)
interhalogen
compound formed from two or more different halogens
This page titled 18.12: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of the Noble Gases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored,
remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit
history is available upon request.
1 2
Na I
Sr Se
Al O
Na + I ⟶ 2 NaI (18.E.1)
2
2 Na + Se ⟶ Na Se
2
2 Na + O ⟶ Na O
2 2 2
Sr + I ⟶ SrI (18.E.2)
2 2
Sr + Se ⟶ SeSe
2 Sr + O ⟶ 2 SrO
2
2 Al + 3 I ⟶ 2 AlI (18.E.3)
2 3
2 Al + 3 Se ⟶ Al Se
2 3
4 Al + 3 O ⟶ 2 Al O
2 2 3
Predict the best choice in each of the following. You may wish to review the chapter on electronic structure for relevant examples.
1. (a) the most metallic of the elements Al, Be, and Ba
2. (b) the most covalent of the compounds NaCl, CaCl2, and BeCl2
3. (c) the lowest first ionization energy among the elements Rb, K, and Li
4. (d) the smallest among Al, Al+, and Al3+
5. (e) the largest among Cs+, Ba2+, and Xe
Sodium chloride and strontium chloride are both white solids. How could you distinguish one from the other?
The possible ways of distinguishing between the two include infrared spectroscopy by comparison of known compounds, a flame
test that gives the characteristic yellow color for sodium (strontium has a red flame), or comparison of their solubilities in water. At
35.7 g 53.8 g
20 °C, NaCl dissolves to the extent of compared with for SrCl2. Heating to 100 °C provides an easy test, since
100 mL 100 mL
39.12 g 100.8 g
the solubility of NaCl is , but that of SrCl2 is . Density determination on a solid is sometimes difficult, but there
100 mL 100 mL
is enough difference (2.165 g/mL NaCl and 3.052 g/mL SrCl2) that this method would be viable and perhaps the easiest and least
expensive test to perform.
The reaction of quicklime, CaO, with water produces slaked lime, Ca(OH)2, which is widely used in the construction industry to
make mortar and plaster. The reaction of quicklime and water is highly exothermic:
−1
CaO(s) + H O(l) ⟶ Ca (OH) (s) ΔH = −350 kJ mo l (18.E.4)
2 2
1. (a) What is the enthalpy of reaction per gram of quicklime that reacts?
2. (b) How much heat, in kilojoules, is associated with the production of 1 ton of slaked lime?
How many moles of ionic species are present in 1.0 L of a solution marked 1.0 M mercury(I) nitrate?
What is the mass of fish, in kilograms, that one would have to consume to obtain a fatal dose of mercury, if the fish contains 30
parts per million of mercury by weight? (Assume that all the mercury from the fish ends up as mercury(II) chloride in the body and
that a fatal dose is 0.20 g of HgCl2.) How many pounds of fish is this?
11 lb
The elements sodium, aluminum, and chlorine are in the same period.
1. (a) Which has the greatest electronegativity?
2. (b) Which of the atoms is smallest?
3. (c) Write the Lewis structure for the simplest covalent compound that can form between aluminum and chlorine.
4. (d) Will the oxide of each element be acidic, basic, or amphoteric?
Does metallic tin react with HCl?
Yes, tin reacts with hydrochloric acid to produce hydrogen gas.
What is tin pest, also known as tin disease?
Compare the nature of the bonds in PbCl2 to that of the bonds in PbCl4.
In PbCl2, the bonding is ionic, as indicated by its melting point of 501 °C. In PbCl4, the bonding is covalent, as evidenced by it
being an unstable liquid at room temperature.
Is the reaction of rubidium with water more or less vigorous than that of sodium? How does the rate of reaction of magnesium
compare?
f ractionating
tower
Why is it necessary to keep the chlorine and sodium, resulting from the electrolysis of sodium chloride, separate during the
production of sodium metal?
Give balanced equations for the overall reaction in the electrolysis of molten lithium chloride and for the reactions occurring at the
electrodes. You may wish to review the chapter on electrochemistry for relevant examples.
Cathode (reduction): 2 Li
+
+2 e
−
⟶ 2 Li(l) ; Anode (oxidation): 2 Cl
−
⟶ Cl (g) + 2 e
2
−
; Overall reaction:
+ −
2 Li + 2 Cl ⟶ 2 Li(l) + Cl (g)
2
The electrolysis of molten sodium chloride or of aqueous sodium chloride produces chlorine.
Calculate the mass of chlorine produced from 3.00 kg sodium chloride in each case. You may wish to review the chapter on
electrochemistry for relevant examples.
What mass, in grams, of hydrogen gas forms during the complete reaction of 10.01 g of calcium with water?
0.5035 g H2
Recover: 2 Na[Al(OH) 4
](s) + H SO (aq) ⟶ 2 Al (OH) (s) + Na SO (aq) + 2 H O(l)
2 4 3 2 4 2
Sinter: 2 Al(OH) 3
(s) ⟶ Al O (s) + 3 H O(g)
2 3 2
What is the common ore of tin and how is tin separated from it?
A chemist dissolves a 1.497-g sample of a type of metal (an alloy of Sn, Pb, Sb, and Cu) in nitric acid, and metastannic acid,
H2SnO3, is precipitated. She heats the precipitate to drive off the water, which leaves 0.4909 g of tin(IV) oxide. What was the
percentage of tin in the original sample?
25.83%
Consider the production of 100 kg of sodium metal using a current of 50,000 A, assuming a 100% yield.
(a) How long will it take to produce the 100 kg of sodium metal?
(b) What volume of chlorine at 25 °C and 1.00 atm forms?
What mass of magnesium forms when 100,000 A is passed through a MgCl2 melt for 1.00 h if the yield of magnesium is 85% of
the theoretical yield?
39 kg
8. (h) SbCl5
9. (i) TeF6
Write a Lewis structure for each of the following molecules or ions. You may wish to review the chapter on chemical bonding.
1. (a) H3BPH3
2. (b) BF−
3. (c) BBr3
4. (d) B(CH3)3
5. (e) B(OH)3
(a) H3BPH3:
;
(c) BBr3:
;
(d) B(CH3)3:
;
(e) B(OH)3:
Describe the hybridization of boron and the molecular structure about the boron in each of the following:
1. (a) H3BPH3
2. (b) BF −
3. (c) BBr3
4. (d) B(CH3)3
5. (e) B(OH)3
Using only the periodic table, write the complete electron configuration for silicon, including any empty orbitals in the valence
shell. You may wish to review the chapter on electronic structure.
3. (c) Si2H6
4. (d) Si(OH)4
5. (e) SiF 2−
6
Describe the hybridization of silicon and the molecular structure of the following molecules and ions:
1. (a) (CH3)3SiH
2. (b) SiO 4−
3. (c) Si2H6
4. (d) Si(OH)4
5. (e) SiF 2−
6
(a) (CH3)3SiH: sp3 bonding about Si; the structure is tetrahedral; (b) SiO : sp3 bonding about Si; the structure is tetrahedral; (c)
4−
Si2H6: sp3 bonding about each Si; the structure is linear along the Si-Si bond; (d) Si(OH)4: sp3 bonding about Si; the structure is
tetrahedral; (e) SiF : sp3d2 bonding about Si; the structure is octahedral
2−
6
Describe the hybridization and the bonding of a silicon atom in elemental silicon.
Classify each of the following molecules as polar or nonpolar. You may wish to review the chapter on chemical bonding.
(a) SiH4
(b) Si2H6
(c) SiCl3H
(d) SiF4
(e) SiCl2F2
(a) nonpolar; (b) nonpolar; (c) polar; (d) nonpolar; (e) polar
Silicon reacts with sulfur at elevated temperatures. If 0.0923 g of silicon reacts with sulfur to give 0.3030 g of silicon sulfide,
determine the empirical formula of silicon sulfide.
Name each of the following compounds:
1. (a) TeO2
2. (b) Sb2S3
3. (c) GeF4
4. (d) SiH4
5. (e) GeH4
(a) tellurium dioxide or tellurium(IV) oxide; (b) antimony(III) sulfide; (c) germanium(IV) fluoride; (d) silane or silicon(IV)
hydride; (e) germanium(IV) hydride
Write a balanced equation for the reaction of elemental boron with each of the following (most of these reactions require high
temperature):
1. (a) F2
2. (b) O2
3. (c) S
4. (d) Se
5. (e) Br2
Why is boron limited to a maximum coordination number of four in its compounds?
Boron has only s and p orbitals available, which can accommodate a maximum of four electron pairs. Unlike silicon, no d orbitals
are available in boron.
(a) ΔH° = 87 kJ; ΔG° = 44 kJ; (b) ΔH° = −109.9 kJ; ΔG° = −154.7 kJ; (c) ΔH° = −510 kJ; ΔG° = −601.5 kJ
A hydride of silicon prepared by the reaction of Mg2Si with acid exerted a pressure of 306 torr at 26 °C in a bulb with a volume of
57.0 mL. If the mass of the hydride was 0.0861 g, what is its molecular mass? What is the molecular formula for the hydride?
Suppose you discovered a diamond completely encased in a silicate rock. How would you chemically free the diamond without
harming it?
A mild solution of hydrofluoric acid would dissolve the silicate and would not harm the diamond.
Identify the Lewis acid and the Lewis base among the reactants. The reaction is also an oxidation-reduction reaction. Identify the
oxidizing agent, the reducing agent, and the changes in oxidation number that occur in the reaction.
In drawing Lewis structures, we learn that a hydrogen atom forms only one bond in a covalent compound. Why?
Hydrogen has only one orbital with which to bond to other atoms. Consequently, only one two-electron bond can form.
What mass of CaH2 is necessary to react with water to provide enough hydrogen gas to fill a balloon at 20 °C and 0.8 atm pressure
with a volume of 4.5 L? The balanced equation is:
What mass of hydrogen gas results from the reaction of 8.5 g of KH with water?
KH + H O ⟶ KOH + H (18.E.8)
2 2
0.43 g H2
3
ion, yet silicon does not form an analogous SiO 2−
3
ion. Why?
Complete and balance the following chemical equations:
(a) hardening of plaster containing slaked lime
Ca (OH) + CO ⟶ (18.E.9)
2 2
(b) removal of sulfur dioxide from the flue gas of power plants
CaO + SO ⟶ (18.E.10)
2
(c) the reaction of baking powder that produces carbon dioxide gas and causes bread to rise
NaHCO + NaH PO ⟶ (18.E.11)
3 2 4
(a) Ca(OH) 2
(aq) + CO (g) ⟶ CaCO (s) + H O(l)
2 3 2
; (b) CaO(s) + SO 2
(g) ⟶ CaSO (s)
3
;
(c) 2 NaHCO 3
(s) + NaH PO (aq) ⟶ Na PO (aq) + 2 CO (g) + 2 H O(l)
2 4 3 4 2 2
Heating a sample of Na2CO3⋅xH2O weighing 4.640 g until the removal of the water of hydration leaves 1.720 g of anhydrous
Na2CO3. What is the formula of the hydrated compound?
4. (d) NF3
5. (e) N
−
3
2−
(a) NH :
For each of the following, indicate the hybridization of the nitrogen atom (for N , the central nitrogen).
−
1. (a) N2F4
2. (b) NH −
2
3. (c) NF3
4. (d) N −
3
Explain how ammonia can function both as a Brønsted base and as a Lewis base.
Ammonia acts as a Brønsted base because it readily accepts protons and as a Lewis base in that it has an electron pair to donate.
Brønsted base: NH 3
+H O
3
+
⟶ NH
+
4
+H O
2
Lewis base: 2 NH 3
+
+ Ag ⟶ [ H N − Ag − NH ]
3 3
+
Determine the oxidation state of nitrogen in each of the following. You may wish to review the chapter on chemical bonding for
relevant examples.
1. (a) NCl3
2. (b) ClNO
3. (c) N2O5
4. (d) N2O3
5. (e) NO −
6. (f) N2O4
7. (g) N2O
8. (h) NO −
9. (i) HNO2
10. (j) HNO3
For each of the following, draw the Lewis structure, predict the ONO bond angle, and give the hybridization of the nitrogen. You
may wish to review the chapters on chemical bonding and advanced theories of covalent bonding for relevant examples.
(a) NO2
(b) NO −
(c) NO +
2
(a) NO2:
geometry with an ONO bond angle slightly less than 120°. (c) NO : +
2
Nitrogen is sp hybridized. The molecule has a linear geometry with an ONO bond angle of 180°.
How many grams of gaseous ammonia will the reaction of 3.0 g hydrogen gas and 3.0 g of nitrogen gas produce?
Although PF5 and AsF5 are stable, nitrogen does not form NF5 molecules. Explain this difference among members of the same
group.
Nitrogen cannot form a NF5 molecule because it does not have d orbitals to bond with the additional two fluorine atoms.
The equivalence point for the titration of a 25.00-mL sample of CsOH solution with 0.1062 M HNO3 is at 35.27 mL. What is the
concentration of the CsOH solution?
3. (c) P2H4
4. (d) PO3−
4
5. (e) PF5
(a)
;
(b)
;
(c)
;
(d)
;
(e)
3. (c) P2H4
4. (d) PO 3−
4
Complete and balance each of the following chemical equations. (In some cases, there may be more than one correct answer.)
1. (a) P + Al ⟶
4
2. (b) P + Na ⟶
4
3. (c) P + F ⟶
4 2
4. (d) P + Cl ⟶
4 2
5. (e) P + O ⟶
4 2
6. (f) P O + O ⟶
4 6 2
Describe the hybridization of phosphorus in each of the following compounds: P4O10, P4O6, PH4I (an ionic compound), PBr3,
H3PO4, H3PO3, PH3, and P2H4. You may wish to review the chapter on advanced theories of covalent bonding.
What volume of 0.200 M NaOH is necessary to neutralize the solution produced by dissolving 2.00 g of PCl3 is an excess of water?
Note that when H3PO3 is titrated under these conditions, only one proton of the acid molecule reacts.
291 mL
How much POCl3 can form from 25.0 g of PCl5 and the appropriate amount of H2O?
How many tons of Ca3(PO4)2 are necessary to prepare 5.0 tons of phosphorus if the yield is 90%?
28 tons
Write equations showing the stepwise ionization of phosphorous acid.
Draw the Lewis structures and describe the geometry for the following:
1. (a) PF +
4
2. (b) PF5
3. (c) PF −
6
4. (d) POF3
(a)
;
(b)
;
(d)
Why does phosphorous acid form only two series of salts, even though the molecule contains three hydrogen atoms?
Assign an oxidation state to phosphorus in each of the following:
1. (a) NaH2PO3
2. (b) PF5
3. (c) P4O6
4. (d) K3PO4
5. (e) Na3P
6. (f) Na4P2O7
(a) P = 3+; (b) P = 5+; (c) P = 3+; (d) P = 5+; (e) P = 3−; (f) P = 5+
Phosphoric acid, one of the acids used in some cola drinks, is produced by the reaction of phosphorus(V) oxide, an acidic oxide,
with water. Phosphorus(V) oxide is prepared by the combustion of phosphorus.
1. (a) Write the empirical formula of phosphorus(V) oxide.
2. (b) What is the molecular formula of phosphorus(V) oxide if the molar mass is about 280.
3. (c) Write balanced equations for the production of phosphorus(V) oxide and phosphoric acid.
4. (d) Determine the mass of phosphorus required to make 1.00 × 104 kg of phosphoric acid, assuming a yield of 98.85%.
What volume of 0.250 M H2SO4 solution is required to neutralize a solution that contains 5.00 g of CaCO3?
Which is the stronger acid, HClO4 or HBrO4? Why?
HClO4 is the stronger acid because, in a series of oxyacids with similar formulas, the higher the electronegativity of the central
atom, the stronger is the attraction of the central atom for the electrons of the oxygen(s). The stronger attraction of the oxygen
electron results in a stronger attraction of oxygen for the electrons in the O-H bond, making the hydrogen more easily released. The
weaker this bond, the stronger the acid.
Write a balanced chemical equation for the reaction of an excess of oxygen with each of the following. Remember that oxygen is a
strong oxidizing agent and tends to oxidize an element to its maximum oxidation state.
1. (a) Mg
2. (b) Rb
3. (c) Ga
4. (d) C2H2
5. (e) CO
Which is the stronger acid, H2SO4 or H2SeO4? Why? You may wish to review the chapter on acid-base equilibria.
As H2SO4 and H2SeO4 are both oxyacids and their central atoms both have the same oxidation number, the acid strength depends
on the relative electronegativity of the central atom. As sulfur is more electronegative than selenium, H2SO4 is the stronger acid.
Explain why sulfuric acid, H2SO4, which is a covalent molecule, dissolves in water and produces a solution that contains ions.
How many grams of Epsom salts (MgSO4⋅7H2O) will form from 5.0 kg of magnesium?
5.1 × 104 g
(c) PCl5
(d) SeF4
(e) ClF3
(a)
;
(b)
;
(c)
;
(d)
;
(e)
Which halogen has the highest ionization energy? Is this what you would predict based on what you have learned about periodic
properties?
Name each of the following compounds:
(a) BrF3
(c) ClO2
(d) ICl3
(e) F2
(a) I: 7+; (b) I: 7+; (c) Cl: 4+; (d) I: 3+; Cl: 1−; (e) F: 0
Physiological saline concentration—that is, the sodium chloride concentration in our bodies—is approximately 0.16 M. A saline
solution for contact lenses is prepared to match the physiological concentration. If you purchase 25 mL of contact lens saline
solution, how many grams of sodium chloride have you bought?
4. (d) XeO 4−
5. (e) XeO3
A mixture of xenon and fluorine was heated. A sample of the white solid that formed reacted with hydrogen to yield 81 mL of
xenon (at STP) and hydrogen fluoride, which was collected in water, giving a solution of hydrofluoric acid. The hydrofluoric acid
solution was titrated, and 68.43 mL of 0.3172 M sodium hydroxide was required to reach the equivalence point. Determine the
empirical formula for the white solid and write balanced chemical equations for the reactions involving xenon.
The empirical formula is XeF6, and the balanced reactions are:
Δ
Xe(g) + 3 F (g) −
→ XeF (s) (18.E.17)
2 6
Basic solutions of Na4XeO6 are powerful oxidants. What mass of Mn(NO3)2•6H2O reacts with 125.0 mL of a 0.1717 M basic
solution of Na4XeO6 that contains an excess of sodium hydroxide if the products include Xe and solution of sodium permanganate?
This page titled 18.E: Representative Metals, Metalloids, and Nonmetals (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored,
remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit
history is available upon request.
This page titled 19: Transition Metals and Coordination Chemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
1
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their Compounds
Learning Objectives
Outline the general approach for the isolation of transition metals from natural sources
Describe typical physical and chemical properties of the transition metals
Identify simple compound classes for transition metals and describe their chemical properties
We have daily contact with many transition metals. Iron occurs everywhere—from the rings in your spiral notebook and the cutlery
in your kitchen to automobiles, ships, buildings, and in the hemoglobin in your blood. Titanium is useful in the manufacture of
lightweight, durable products such as bicycle frames, artificial hips, and jewelry. Chromium is useful as a protective plating on
plumbing fixtures and automotive detailing.
Transition metals are defined as those elements that have (or readily form) partially filled d orbitals. As shown in Figure 19.1.2, the
d-block elements in groups 3–11 are transition elements. The f-block elements, also called inner transition metals (the lanthanides
and actinides), also meet this criterion because the d orbital is partially occupied before the f orbitals. The d orbitals fill with the
copper family (group 11); for this reason, the next family (group 12) are technically not transition elements. However, the group 12
elements do display some of the same chemical properties and are commonly included in discussions of transition metals. Some
chemists do treat the group 12 elements as transition metals.
Figure 19.1.1 : Transition metals often form vibrantly colored complexes. The minerals malachite (green), azurite (blue), and
proustite (red) are some examples. (credit left: modification of work by James St. John; credit middle: modification of work by
Stephanie Clifford; credit right: modification of work by Terry Wallace)
The first crystal is a jade green mineral chunk. The second is a crystalline chunk which is primarily bright royal blue. The third
shows long red crystals.
The d-block elements are divided into the first transition series (the elements Sc through Cu), the second transition series (the
elements Y through Ag), and the third transition series (the element La and the elements Hf through Au). Actinium, Ac, is the first
member of the fourth transition series, which also includes Rf through Rg.
Figure 19.1.2 : The transition metals are located in groups 3–11 of the periodic table. The inner transition metals are in the two rows
below the body of the table.
The f-block elements are the elements Ce through Lu, which constitute the lanthanide series (or lanthanoid series), and the elements
Th through Lr, which constitute the actinide series (or actinoid series). Because lanthanum behaves very much like the lanthanide
Review how to write electron configurations, covered in the chapter on electronic structure and periodic properties of elements.
Recall that for the transition and inner transition metals, it is necessary to remove the s electrons before the d or f electrons.
Then, for each ion, give the electron configuration:
a. cerium(III)
b. lead(II)
c. Ti2+
d. Am3+
e. Pd2+
For the examples that are transition metals, determine to which series they belong.
Solution
For ions, the s-valence electrons are lost prior to the d or f electrons.
a. Ce3+[Xe]4f1; Ce3+ is an inner transition element in the lanthanide series.
b. Pb2+[Xe]6s25d104f14; the electrons are lost from the p orbital. This is a main group element.
c. titanium(II) [Ar]3d2; first transition series
d. americium(III) [Rn]5f6; actinide
e. palladium(II) [Kr]4d8; second transition series
Exercise 19.1.1
Check Your Learning Give an example of an ion from the first transition series with no d electrons.
Answer
V5+ is one possibility. Other examples include Sc3+, Ti4+, Cr6+, and Mn7+.
Lanthanides (elements 57–71) are fairly abundant in the earth’s crust, despite their historic characterization as rare earth
elements. Thulium, the rarest naturally occurring lanthanoid, is more common in the earth’s crust than silver (4.5 × 10−5%
versus 0.79 × 10−5% by mass). There are 17 rare earth elements, consisting of the 15 lanthanoids plus scandium and yttrium.
They are called rare because they were once difficult to extract economically, so it was rare to have a pure sample; due to
similar chemical properties, it is difficult to separate any one lanthanide from the others. However, newer separation methods,
such as ion exchange resins similar to those found in home water softeners, make the separation of these elements easier and
more economical. Most ores that contain these elements have low concentrations of all the rare earth elements mixed together.
The commercial applications of lanthanides are growing rapidly. For example, europium is important in flat screen displays
found in computer monitors, cell phones, and televisions. Neodymium is useful in laptop hard drives and in the processes that
convert crude oil into gasoline (Figure 19.1.3). Holmium is found in dental and medical equipment. In addition, many
alternative energy technologies rely heavily on lanthanoids. Neodymium and dysprosium are key components of hybrid vehicle
engines and the magnets used in wind turbines.
The transition elements have many properties in common with other metals. They are almost all hard, high-melting solids that
conduct heat and electricity well. They readily form alloys and lose electrons to form stable cations. In addition, transition metals
form a wide variety of stable coordination compounds, in which the central metal atom or ion acts as a Lewis acid and accepts one
or more pairs of electrons. Many different molecules and ions can donate lone pairs to the metal center, serving as Lewis bases. In
this chapter, we shall focus primarily on the chemical behavior of the elements of the first transition series.
Ruthenium, osmium, rhodium, iridium, palladium, and platinum are the platinum metals. With difficulty, they form simple cations
that are stable in water, and, unlike the earlier elements in the second and third transition series, they do not form stable oxyanions.
Both the d- and f-block elements react with nonmetals to form binary compounds; heating is often required. These elements react
with halogens to form a variety of halides ranging in oxidation state from 1+ to 6+. On heating, oxygen reacts with all of the
transition elements except palladium, platinum, silver, and gold. The oxides of these latter metals can be formed using other
reactants, but they decompose upon heating. The f-block elements, the elements of group 3, and the elements of the first transition
series except copper react with aqueous solutions of acids, forming hydrogen gas and solutions of the corresponding salts.
Transition metals can form compounds with a wide range of oxidation states. Some of the observed oxidation states of the elements
of the first transition series are shown in Figure 19.1.4. As we move from left to right across the first transition series, we see that
the number of common oxidation states increases at first to a maximum towards the middle of the table, then decreases. The values
in the table are typical values; there are other known values, and it is possible to synthesize new additions. For example, in 2014,
researchers were successful in synthesizing a new oxidation state of iridium (9+).
Which is the strongest oxidizing agent in acidic solution: dichromate ion, which contains chromium(VI), permanganate ion,
which contains manganese(VII), or titanium dioxide, which contains titanium(IV)?
Solution
First, we need to look up the reduction half reactions (Table P1) for each oxide in the specified oxidation state:
2− + − 3+
Cr O + 14 H +6 e ⟶ 2 Cr +7 H O +1.33 V
2 7 2
− + − 2+
MnO +8 H +5 e ⟶ Mn +H O +1.51 V
4 2
+ − 2+
TiO +4 H +2 e ⟶ Ti +2 H O −0.50 V
2 2
A larger reduction potential means that it is easier to reduce the reactant. Permanganate, with the largest reduction potential, is
the strongest oxidizer under these conditions. Dichromate is next, followed by titanium dioxide as the weakest oxidizing agent
(the hardest to reduce) of this set.
Exercise 19.1.2
Predict what reaction (if any) will occur between HCl and Co(s), and between HBr and Pt(s). You will need to use the standard
reduction potentials from (Table P1).
Answer
Co(s) + 2 HCl ⟶ H
2
+ CoCl (aq)
2
; no reaction because Pt(s) will not be oxidized by H+
iron implements were made from iron meteorites. Surviving iron artifacts dating from approximately 4000 to 2500 BC are rare, but
all known examples contain specific alloys of iron and nickel that occur only in extraterrestrial objects, not on earth. It took
thousands of years of technological advances before civilizations developed iron smelting, the ability to extract a pure element
from its naturally occurring ores and for iron tools to become common.
Figure 19.1.5 : Transition metals occur in nature in various forms. Examples include (a) a nugget of copper, (b) a deposit of gold,
and (c) an ore containing oxidized iron. (credit a: modification of work by Copper [images-of-elements.com]; credit c: modification
of work by Iron ore [images-of-elements.com])
Generally, the transition elements are extracted from minerals found in a variety of ores. However, the ease of their recovery varies
widely, depending on the concentration of the element in the ore, the identity of the other elements present, and the difficulty of
reducing the element to the free metal.
In general, it is not difficult to reduce ions of the d-block elements to the free element. Carbon is a sufficiently strong reducing
agent in most cases. However, like the ions of the more active main group metals, ions of the f-block elements must be isolated by
electrolysis or by reduction with an active metal such as calcium.
We shall discuss the processes used for the isolation of iron, copper, and silver because these three processes illustrate the principal
means of isolating most of the d-block metals. In general, each of these processes involves three principal steps: preliminary
treatment, smelting, and refining.
1. Preliminary treatment. In general, there is an initial treatment of the ores to make them suitable for the extraction of the metals.
This usually involves crushing or grinding the ore, concentrating the metal-bearing components, and sometimes treating these
substances chemically to convert them into compounds that are easier to reduce to the metal.
2. Smelting. The next step is the extraction of the metal in the molten state, a process called smelting, which includes reduction of
the metallic compound to the metal. Impurities may be removed by the addition of a compound that forms a slag—a substance
with a low melting point that can be readily separated from the molten metal.
3. Refining. The final step in the recovery of a metal is refining the metal. Low boiling metals such as zinc and mercury can be
refined by distillation. When fused on an inclined table, low melting metals like tin flow away from higher-melting impurities.
Electrolysis is another common method for refining metals.
Near the bottom of a furnace are nozzles through which preheated air is blown into the furnace. As soon as the air enters, the coke
in the region of the nozzles is oxidized to carbon dioxide with the liberation of a great deal of heat. The hot carbon dioxide passes
upward through the overlying layer of white-hot coke, where it is reduced to carbon monoxide:
The carbon monoxide serves as the reducing agent in the upper regions of the furnace. The individual reactions are indicated in
Figure 19.1.6.
The iron oxides are reduced in the upper region of the furnace. In the middle region, limestone (calcium carbonate) decomposes,
and the resulting calcium oxide combines with silica and silicates in the ore to form slag. The slag is mostly calcium silicate and
contains most of the commercially unimportant components of the ore:
Just below the middle of the furnace, the temperature is high enough to melt both the iron and the slag. They collect in layers at the
bottom of the furnace; the less dense slag floats on the iron and protects it from oxidation. Several times a day, the slag and molten
iron are withdrawn from the furnace. The iron is transferred to casting machines or to a steelmaking plant (Figure 19.1.7).
In these reactions, the silicon dioxide behaves as a Lewis acid, which accepts a pair of electrons from the Lewis base (the oxide
ion).
Reduction of the Cu2S that remains after smelting is accomplished by blowing air through the molten material. The air converts
part of the Cu2S into Cu2O. As soon as copper(I) oxide is formed, it is reduced by the remaining copper(I) sulfide to metallic
copper:
The copper obtained in this way is called blister copper because of its characteristic appearance, which is due to the air blisters it
contains (Figure 19.1.8). This impure copper is cast into large plates, which are used as anodes in the electrolytic refining of the
metal (which is described in the chapter on electrochemistry).
Figure 19.1.9 : Naturally occurring free silver may be found as nuggets (a) or in veins (b). (credit a: modification of work by
“Teravolt”/Wikimedia Commons; credit b: modification of work by James St. John)
A. A small clump of bronze-colored metal with a very rough, irregular surface. B. A layer-like region of silver metal embedded in
rock.
Hydrology involves the separation of a metal from a mixture by first converting it into soluble ions and then extracting and
reducing them to precipitate the pure metal. In the presence of air, alkali metal cyanides readily form the soluble
dicyanoargentate(I) ion, [Ag(CN) ] , from silver metal or silver-containing compounds such as Ag2S and AgCl. Representative
2
−
equations are:
− − −
4 Ag(s) + 8 CN (aq) + O (g) + 2 H O(l) ⟶ 4 [Ag (CN) ] (aq) + 4 OH (aq)
2 2 2
− − −
2 Ag S(s) + 8 CN (aq) + O (g) + 2 H O(l) ⟶ 4 [Ag (CN) ] (aq) + 2 S(s) + 4 OH (aq)
2 2 2 2
− − −
AgCl(s) + 2 CN (aq) ⟶ [Ag (CN) ] (aq) + Cl (aq)
2
The silver is precipitated from the cyanide solution by the addition of either zinc or iron(II) ions, which serves as the reducing
agent:
− 2−
2 [Ag (CN) ] (aq) + Zn(s) ⟶ 2 Ag(s) + [Zn(CN) ] (aq)
2 4
One of the steps for refining silver involves converting silver into dicyanoargenate(I) ions:
− − −
4 Ag(s) + 8 CN (aq) + O (g) + 2 H O(l) ⟶ 4 [Ag (CN) ] (aq) + 4 OH (aq)
2 2 2
Explain why oxygen must be present to carry out the reaction. Why does the reaction not occur as:
Solution
The charges, as well as the atoms, must balance in reactions. The silver atom is being oxidized from the 0 oxidation state to the
1+ state. Whenever something loses electrons, something must also gain electrons (be reduced) to balance the equation.
Oxygen is a good oxidizing agent for these reactions because it can gain electrons to go from the 0 oxidation state to the 2−
state.
Exercise 19.1.3
During the refining of iron, carbon must be present in the blast furnace. Why is carbon necessary to convert iron oxide into
iron?
Answer
The carbon is converted into CO, which is the reducing agent that accepts electrons so that iron(III) can be reduced to
iron(0).
19.1.3.1: Halides
Anhydrous halides of each of the transition elements can be prepared by the direct reaction of the metal with halogens. For
example:
Heating a metal halide with additional metal can be used to form a halide of the metal with a lower oxidation state:
The stoichiometry of the metal halide that results from the reaction of the metal with a halogen is determined by the relative
amounts of metal and halogen and by the strength of the halogen as an oxidizing agent. Generally, fluorine forms fluoride-
containing metals in their highest oxidation states. The other halogens may not form analogous compounds.
In general, the preparation of stable water solutions of the halides of the metals of the first transition series is by the addition of a
hydrohalic acid to carbonates, hydroxides, oxides, or other compounds that contain basic anions. Sample reactions are:
NiCO (s) + 2 HF(aq) ⟶ NiF (aq) + H O(l) + CO (g)
3 2 2 2
Most of the first transition series metals also dissolve in acids, forming a solution of the salt and hydrogen gas. For example:
The polarity of bonds with transition metals varies based not only upon the electronegativities of the atoms involved but also upon
the oxidation state of the transition metal. Remember that bond polarity is a continuous spectrum with electrons being shared
evenly (covalent bonds) at one extreme and electrons being transferred completely (ionic bonds) at the other. No bond is ever 100%
ionic, and the degree to which the electrons are evenly distributed determines many properties of the compound. Transition metal
halides with low oxidation numbers form more ionic bonds. For example, titanium(II) chloride and titanium(III) chloride (TiCl2
and TiCl3) have high melting points that are characteristic of ionic compounds, but titanium(IV) chloride (TiCl4) is a volatile liquid,
19.1.3.2: Oxides
As with the halides, the nature of bonding in oxides of the transition elements is determined by the oxidation state of the metal.
Oxides with low oxidation states tend to be more ionic, whereas those with higher oxidation states are more covalent. These
variations in bonding are because the electronegativities of the elements are not fixed values. The electronegativity of an element
increases with increasing oxidation state. Transition metals in low oxidation states have lower electronegativity values than oxygen;
therefore, these metal oxides are ionic. Transition metals in very high oxidation states have electronegativity values close to that of
oxygen, which leads to these oxides being covalent.
The oxides of the first transition series can be prepared by heating the metals in air. These oxides are Sc2O3, TiO2, V2O5, Cr2O3,
Mn3O4, Fe3O4, Co3O4, NiO, and CuO.
Alternatively, these oxides and other oxides (with the metals in different oxidation states) can be produced by heating the
corresponding hydroxides, carbonates, or oxalates in an inert atmosphere. Iron(II) oxide can be prepared by heating iron(II)
oxalate, and cobalt(II) oxide is produced by heating cobalt(II) hydroxide:
With the exception of CrO3 and Mn2O7, transition metal oxides are not soluble in water. They can react with acids and, in a few
cases, with bases. Overall, oxides of transition metals with the lowest oxidation states are basic (and react with acids), the
intermediate ones are amphoteric, and the highest oxidation states are primarily acidic. Basic metal oxides at a low oxidation state
react with aqueous acids to form solutions of salts and water. Examples include the reaction of cobalt(II) oxide accepting protons
from nitric acid, and scandium(III) oxide accepting protons from hydrochloric acid:
The oxides of metals with oxidation states of 4+ are amphoteric, and most are not soluble in either acids or bases. Vanadium(V)
oxide, chromium(VI) oxide, and manganese(VII) oxide are acidic. They react with solutions of hydroxides to form salts of the
oxyanions VO , CrO , and MnO . For example, the complete ionic equation for the reaction of chromium(VI) oxide with a
3−
4
2−
4
−
4
Chromium(VI) oxide and manganese(VII) oxide react with water to form the acids H2CrO4 and HMnO4, respectively.
19.1.3.3: Hydroxides
When a soluble hydroxide is added to an aqueous solution of a salt of a transition metal of the first transition series, a gelatinous
precipitate forms. For example, adding a solution of sodium hydroxide to a solution of cobalt sulfate produces a gelatinous pink or
blue precipitate of cobalt(II) hydroxide. The net ionic equation is:
2+ −
Co (aq) + 2 OH (aq) ⟶ Co (OH) (s)
2
In this and many other cases, these precipitates are hydroxides containing the transition metal ion, hydroxide ions, and water
coordinated to the transition metal. In other cases, the precipitates are hydrated oxides composed of the metal ion, oxide ions, and
water of hydration:
These substances do not contain hydroxide ions. However, both the hydroxides and the hydrated oxides react with acids to form
salts and water. When precipitating a metal from solution, it is necessary to avoid an excess of hydroxide ion, as this may lead to
complex ion formation as discussed later in this chapter. The precipitated metal hydroxides can be separated for further processing
or for waste disposal.
19.1.3.4: Carbonates
Many of the elements of the first transition series form insoluble carbonates. It is possible to prepare these carbonates by the
addition of a soluble carbonate salt to a solution of a transition metal salt. For example, nickel carbonate can be prepared from
solutions of nickel nitrate and sodium carbonate according to the following net ionic equation:
2+ 2−
Ni (aq) + CO ⟶ NiCO (s)
3 3
The reactions of the transition metal carbonates are similar to those of the active metal carbonates. They react with acids to form
metals salts, carbon dioxide, and water. Upon heating, they decompose, forming the transition metal oxides.
The common compounds that we have just discussed can also be used to prepare salts. The reactions involved include the reactions
of oxides, hydroxides, or carbonates with acids. For example:
+ − 2+ −
Ni (OH) (s) + 2 H O (aq) + 2 ClO (aq) ⟶ Ni (aq) + 2 ClO (aq) + 4 H O(l)
2 3 4 4 2
Substitution reactions involving soluble salts may be used to prepare insoluble salts. For example:
2+ − + 2− + −
Ba (aq) + 2 Cl (aq) + 2 K (aq) + CrO (aq) ⟶ BaCrO (s) + 2 K (aq) + 2 Cl (aq)
4 4
In our discussion of oxides in this section, we have seen that reactions of the covalent oxides of the transition elements with
hydroxides form salts that contain oxyanions of the transition elements.
Figure 19.1.11: (a) This magnetic levitation train (or maglev) uses superconductor technology to move along its tracks. (b) A
magnet can be levitated using a dish like this as a superconductor. (credit a: modification of work by Alex Needham; credit b:
modification of work by Kevin Jarrett)
A. a white train is on a track with a building standing on a bed of water in the background. B. A magnet is floating in a dish with
frost emerging from the dish.
Researchers are also working on using this technology to develop other applications, such as smaller and more powerful
microchips. In addition, high-temperature superconductors can be used to generate magnetic fields for applications such as medical
devices, magnetic levitation trains, and containment fields for nuclear fusion reactors (Figure 19.1.11).
Video 19.1.1 : Watch how a high-temperature superconductor levitates around a magnetic racetrack in the video.
Glossary
actinide series
(also, actinoid series) actinium and the elements in the second row or the f-block, atomic numbers 89–103
coordination compound
stable compound in which the central metal atom or ion acts as a Lewis acid and accepts one or more pairs of electrons
d-block element
one of the elements in groups 3–11 with valence electrons in d orbitals
f-block element
(also, inner transition element) one of the elements with atomic numbers 58–71 or 90–103 that have valence electrons in f
orbitals; they are frequently shown offset below the periodic table
hydrometallurgy
process in which a metal is separated from a mixture by first converting it into soluble ions, extracting the ions, and then
reducing the ions to precipitate the pure metal
lanthanide series
(also, lanthanoid series) lanthanum and the elements in the first row or the f-block, atomic numbers 57–71
platinum metals
group of six transition metals consisting of ruthenium, osmium, rhodium, iridium, palladium, and platinum that tend to occur in
the same minerals and demonstrate similar chemical properties
smelting
process of extracting a pure metal from a molten ore
steel
superconductor
material that conducts electricity with no resistance
third transition series
transition elements in the sixth period of the periodic table (third row of the d-block), atomic numbers 57 and 72–79
This page titled 19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their Compounds is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
The hemoglobin in your blood, the chlorophyll in green plants, vitamin B , and the catalyst used in the manufacture of polyethylene all contain coordination compounds. Ions of the metals,
12
especially the transition metals, are likely to form complexes. Many of these compounds are highly colored (Figure 19.2.1). In the remainder of this chapter, we will consider the structure and
bonding of these remarkable compounds.
Figure 19.2.1 : Metal ions that contain partially filled d subshell usually form colored complex ions; ions with empty d subshell (d0) or with filled d subshells (d10) usually form colorless complexes.
This figure shows, from left to right, solutions containing [M(H2O)6]n+ ions with M = Sc3+(d0), Cr3+(d3), Co2+(d7), Ni2+(d8), Cu2+(d9), and Zn2+(d10). (credit: Sahar Atwa)
There are six containers that are each filled with a different color liquid. The first is clear, followed by purple, red, teal, blue, and the last one is also clear.
Remember that in most main group element compounds, the valence electrons of the isolated atoms combine to form chemical bonds that satisfy the octet rule. For instance, the four valence
electrons of carbon overlap with electrons from four hydrogen atoms to form CH4. The one valence electron leaves sodium and adds to the seven valence electrons of chlorine to form the ionic
formula unit NaCl (Figure 19.2.2). Transition metals do not normally bond in this fashion. They primarily form coordinate covalent bonds, a form of the Lewis acid-base interaction in which both
of the electrons in the bond are contributed by a donor (Lewis base) to an electron acceptor (Lewis acid). The Lewis acid in coordination complexes, often called a central metal ion (or atom), is
often a transition metal or inner transition metal, although main group elements can also form coordination compounds. The Lewis base donors, called ligands, can be a wide variety of chemicals—
atoms, molecules, or ions. The only requirement is that they have one or more electron pairs, which can be donated to the central metal. Most often, this involves a donor atom with a lone pair of
electrons that can form a coordinate bond to the metal.
Figure 19.2.2 : (a) Covalent bonds involve the sharing of electrons, and ionic bonds involve the transferring of electrons associated with each bonding atom, as indicated by the colored electrons. (b)
However, coordinate covalent bonds involve electrons from a Lewis base being donated to a metal center. The lone pairs from six water molecules form bonds to the scandium ion to form an
octahedral complex. (Only the donated pairs are shown.)
The coordination sphere consists of the central metal ion or atom plus its attached ligands. Brackets in a formula enclose the coordination sphere; species outside the brackets are not part of the
coordination sphere. The coordination number of the central metal ion or atom is the number of donor atoms bonded to it. The coordination number for the silver ion in [Ag(NH3)2]+ is two (Figure
2−
19.2.3). For the copper(II) ion in [CuCl4] , the coordination number is four, whereas for the cobalt(II) ion in [Co(H2O)6]2+ the coordination number is six. Each of these ligands is monodentate,
from the Greek for “one toothed,” meaning that they connect with the central metal through only one atom. In this case, the number of ligands and the coordination number are equal.
Figure 19.2.3 : The complexes (a) [Ag(NH3)2]+, (b) [Cu(Cl)4]2−, and (c) [Co(H2O)6]2+ have coordination numbers of two, four, and six, respectively. The geometries of these complexes are the
same as we have seen with VSEPR theory for main group elements: linear, tetrahedral, and octahedral.
The structural formulas for Ag N H 3 subscript 2, C u C l subscript 4, and C o H 2 O subscript 6 is shown in enclosing brackets showing their individual charges on the top right of positive 1,
negative 2 and positive 2 respectively.
Many other ligands coordinate to the metal in more complex fashions. Bidentate ligands are those in which two atoms coordinate to the metal center. For example, ethylenediamine (en,
H2NCH2CH2NH2) contains two nitrogen atoms, each of which has a lone pair and can serve as a Lewis base (Figure 19.2.4). Both of the atoms can coordinate to a single metal center. In the
complex [Co(en)3]3+, there are three bidentate en ligands, and the coordination number of the cobalt(III) ion is six. The most common coordination numbers are two, four, and six, but examples of
all coordination numbers from 1 to 15 are known.
Figure 19.2.4 : (a) The ethylenediamine (en) ligand contains two atoms with lone pairs that can coordinate to the metal center. (b) The cobalt(III) complex [Co(en) ]
3
3+
contains three of these
ligands, each forming two bonds to the cobalt ion.
Any ligand that bonds to a central metal ion by more than one donor atom is a polydentate ligand (or “many teeth”) because it can bite into the metal center with more than one bond. The term
chelate (pronounced “KEY-late”) from the Greek for “claw” is also used to describe this type of interaction. Many polydentate ligands are chelating ligands, and a complex consisting of one or
more of these ligands and a central metal is a chelate. A chelating ligand is also known as a chelating agent. A chelating ligand holds the metal ion rather like a crab’s claw would hold a marble.
Figure 19.2.4 showed one example of a chelate and the heme complex in hemoglobin is another important example (Figure 19.2.5). It contains a polydentate ligand with four donor atoms that
coordinate to iron.
bidentate ligands. Tridentate ligands, tetradentate ligands, pentadentate ligands, and hexadentate ligands contain three, four, five, and six donor atoms, respectively. The heme ligand (Figure 19.2.5)
is a tetradentate ligand.
Figure 19.2.6 : Each of the anionic ligands shown attaches in a bidentate fashion to platinum(II), with both a nitrogen and oxygen atom coordinating to the metal.
[Pt(NH3)2Cl4] as diaminetetrachloroplatinum(IV).
3. If more than one ligand of a given type is present, the number is indicated by the prefixes di- (for two), tri- (for three), tetra- (for four), penta- (for five), and hexa- (for six). Sometimes, the
prefixes bis- (for two), tris- (for three), and tetrakis- (for four) are used when the name of the ligand already includes di-, tri-, or tetra-, or when the ligand name begins with a vowel. For
example, the ion bis(bipyridyl)osmium(II) uses bis- to signify that there are two ligands attached to Os, and each bipyridyl ligand contains two pyridine groups (C5H4N).
Table 19.2.1 : Examples of Anionic Ligands
Anionic Ligand Name
F− fluoro
Cl− chloro
Br− bromo
I− iodo
CN− cyano
NO
−
3
nitrato
OH− hydroxo
O2– oxo
C O
2
2−
4
oxalato
CO
2−
2
carbonato
When the complex is either a cation or a neutral molecule, the name of the central metal atom is spelled exactly like the name of the element and is followed by a Roman numeral in parentheses to
indicate its oxidation state (Tables 19.2.2, 19.2.3, and 19.2.3). When the complex is an anion, the suffix -ate is added to the stem of the name of the metal, followed by the Roman numeral
designation of its oxidation state.
Table 19.2.2 : Select Coordination Complexes based on total Charge
Examples in Which the Complex Is Cation
[Pt(NH3)2Cl4] diaminetetrachloroplatinum(IV)
[Ni(H2NCH2CH2NH2)2Cl2] dichlorobis(ethylenediamine)nickel(II)
Sometimes, the Latin name of the metal is used when the English name is clumsy. For example, ferrate is used instead of ironate, plumbate instead leadate, and stannate instead of tinate. The
oxidation state of the metal is determined based on the charges of each ligand and the overall charge of the coordination compound. For example, in [Cr(H2O)4Cl2]Br, the coordination sphere (in
brackets) has a charge of 1+ to balance the bromide ion. The water ligands are neutral, and the chloride ligands are anionic with a charge of 1− each. To determine the oxidation state of the metal,
we set the overall charge equal to the sum of the ligands and the metal: +1 = −2 + x, so the oxidation state (x) is equal to 3+.
Solution
a. There are two Na+ ions, so the coordination sphere has a negative two charge: [PtCl6]2−. There are six anionic chloride ligands, so −2 = −6 + x, and the oxidation state of the platinum is 4+.
The name of the complex is sodium hexachloroplatinate(IV), and the coordination number is six.
b. The coordination sphere has a charge of 3− (based on the potassium) and the oxalate ligands each have a charge of 2−, so the metal oxidation state is given by −3 = −6 + x, and this is an
iron(III) complex. The name is potassium trisoxalatoferrate(III) (note that tris is used instead of tri because the ligand name starts with a vowel). Because oxalate is a bidentate ligand, this
complex has a coordination number of six.
c. In this example, the coordination sphere has a cationic charge of 2+. The NH3 ligand is neutral, but the chloro ligand has a charge of 1−. The oxidation state is found by +2 = −1 + x and is
3+, so the complex is pentaaminechlorocobalt(III) chloride and the coordination number is six.
Exercise 19.2.1
The complex potassium dicyanoargenate(I) is used to make antiseptic compounds. Give the formula and coordination number.
Answer
K[Ag(CN)2]; coordination number two
Figure 19.2.7 : These are geometries of some complexes with coordination numbers of seven and eight.
Table 19.2.3 : Coordination Numbers and Molecular Geometry
Coordination Number Molecular Geometry Example
2 linear [Ag(NH3)2]+
6 octahedral [CoCl6]3−
8 dodecahedron [Mo(CN)8]4−
Unlike main group atoms in which both the bonding and nonbonding electrons determine the molecular shape, the nonbonding d-electrons do not change the arrangement of the ligands. Octahedral
complexes have a coordination number of six, and the six donor atoms are arranged at the corners of an octahedron around the central metal ion. Examples are shown in Figure 19.2.8. The chloride
and nitrate anions in [Co(H2O)6]Cl2 and [Cr(en)3](NO3)3, and the potassium cations in K2[PtCl6], are outside the brackets and are not bonded to the metal ion.
Figure 19.2.8 : Many transition metal complexes adopt octahedral geometries, with six donor atoms forming bond angles of 90° about the central atom with adjacent ligands. Note that only ligands
within the coordination sphere affect the geometry around the metal center.
The structural formulas for C o H 2 O subscript 6, C r e n subscript 3, and P t c l subscript 6 is shown in enclosing brackets showing their individual charges on the top right. These charges are
positive 2, positive 3 and negative 2 respectively. 2 chloride ions, 3 nitrate ions, and 2 potassium ions are shown outside of the three brackets respectively.
For transition metals with a coordination number of four, two different geometries are possible: tetrahedral or square planar. Unlike main group elements, where these geometries can be predicted
from VSEPR theory, a more detailed discussion of transition metal orbitals (discussed in the section on Crystal Field Theory) is required to predict which complexes will be tetrahedral and which
will be square planar. In tetrahedral complexes such as [Zn(CN)4]2− (Figure 19.2.9), each of the ligand pairs forms an angle of 109.5°. In square planar complexes, such as [Pt(NH3)2Cl2], each
ligand has two other ligands at 90° angles (called the cis positions) and one additional ligand at an 180° angle, in the trans position.
Figure 19.2.10: The cis and trans isomers of [Co(H2O)4Cl2]+ contain the same ligands attached to the same metal ion, but the spatial arrangement causes these two compounds to have very different
properties.
For the Violet, cis form the two chlorine is adjacent to one another. For the green, trans form, the two chlorine is opposite from one another.
Different geometric isomers of a substance are different chemical compounds. They exhibit different properties, even though they have the same formula. For example, the two isomers of
[Co(NH3)4Cl2]NO3 differ in color; the cis form is violet, and the trans form is green. Furthermore, these isomers have different dipole moments, solubilities, and reactivities. As an example of how
the arrangement in space can influence the molecular properties, consider the polarity of the two [Co(NH3)4Cl2]NO3 isomers. Remember that the polarity of a molecule or ion is determined by the
bond dipoles (which are due to the difference in electronegativity of the bonding atoms) and their arrangement in space. In one isomer, cis chloride ligands cause more electron density on one side
of the molecule than on the other, making it polar. For the trans isomer, each ligand is directly across from an identical ligand, so the bond dipoles cancel out, and the molecule is nonpolar.
Identify which geometric isomer of [Pt(NH3)2Cl2] is shown in Figure 19.2.9b. Draw the other geometric isomer and give its full name.
Solution
In the Figure 19.2.9b, the two chlorine ligands occupy cis positions. The other form is shown in below. When naming specific isomers, the descriptor is listed in front of the name. Therefore,
this complex is trans-diaminedichloroplatinum(II).
Structural formula of trans-diaminedichloroplatinum(II). The chlorine atoms are opposite each other in the same plane. This is also the case for the two amines.
The trans isomer of [Pt(NH3)2Cl2] has each ligand directly across from an adjacent ligand.
Exercise 19.2.2
Answer
Cobalt is located at the center with the left and right wedges connected to bromine and H 2 O respectively. The left and right dash lines are connected to H 2 O and bromine respectively.
Pointing directly upwards and downwards opposite from one another are the chlorine. The entire structural formula is enclosed in square bracket with a superscript of 2 negative.
Another important type of isomers are optical isomers, or enantiomers, in which two objects are exact mirror images of each other but cannot be lined up so that all parts match. This means that
optical isomers are nonsuperimposable mirror images. A classic example of this is a pair of hands, in which the right and left hand are mirror images of one another but cannot be superimposed.
Optical isomers are very important in organic and biochemistry because living systems often incorporate one specific optical isomer and not the other. Unlike geometric isomers, pairs of optical
isomers have identical properties (boiling point, polarity, solubility, etc.). Optical isomers differ only in the way they affect polarized light and how they react with other optical isomers. For
coordination complexes, many coordination compounds such as [M(en)3]n+ [in which Mn+ is a central metal ion such as iron(III) or cobalt(II)] form enantiomers, as shown in Figure 19.2.11. These
two isomers will react differently with other optical isomers. For example, DNA helices are optical isomers, and the form that occurs in nature (right-handed DNA) will bind to only one isomer of
[M(en)3]n+ and not the other.
Figure 19.2.11: The complex [M(en)3]n+ (Mn+ = a metal ion, en = ethylenediamine) has a nonsuperimposable mirror image.
Two structural formulas of open bracket M e n subscript 3 close bracket superscript n positive are shown as mirror images with the dashed vertical line in the center as the mirror plane.
The [Co(en)2Cl2]+ ion exhibits geometric isomerism (cis/trans), and its cis isomer exists as a pair of optical isomers (Figure 19.2.12).
Figure 19.2.13: (a) Chlorophyll comes in several different forms, which all have the same basic structure around the magnesium center. (b) Copper phthalocyanine blue, a square planar copper
complex, is present in some blue dyes.
Figure 19.2.14: (a) Detergents, (b) paints, and (c) fertilizers are all made using transition metal catalysts. (credit a: modification of work by “Mr. Brian”/Flickr; credit b: modification of work by
Ewen Roberts; credit c: modification of work by “osseous”/Flickr)
Many other coordination complexes are also brightly colored. The square planar copper(II) complex phthalocyanine blue (from Figure 19.2.13) is one of many complexes used as pigments or dyes.
This complex is used in blue ink, blue jeans, and certain blue paints.
The structure of heme (Figure 19.2.15), the iron-containing complex in hemoglobin, is very similar to that in chlorophyll. In hemoglobin, the red heme complex is bonded to a large protein
molecule (globin) by the attachment of the protein to the heme ligand. Oxygen molecules are transported by hemoglobin in the blood by being bound to the iron center. When the hemoglobin loses
its oxygen, the color changes to a bluish red. Hemoglobin will only transport oxygen if the iron is Fe2+; oxidation of the iron to Fe3+ prevents oxygen transport.
Figure 19.2.15: Hemoglobin contains four protein subunits, each of which has an iron center attached to a heme ligand (shown in red), which is coordinated to a globin protein. Each subunit is
shown in a different color.
Three dimensional structure of hemoglobin has many ribbon like structures forming helices and are entangled with one another in a disordered manner. The four subunits are colored differently.
Around the center of hemoglobin are multiple linear structures composed of red globules.
Complexing agents often are used for water softening because they tie up such ions as Ca2+, Mg2+, and Fe2+, which make water hard. Many metal ions are also undesirable in food products because
these ions can catalyze reactions that change the color of food. Coordination complexes are useful as preservatives. For example, the ligand EDTA, (HO2CCH2)2NCH2CH2N(CH2CO2H)2,
coordinates to metal ions through six donor atoms and prevents the metals from reacting (Figure 19.2.16). This ligand also is used to sequester metal ions in paper production, textiles, and
detergents, and has pharmaceutical uses.
Figure 19.2.17: Coordination complexes are used as drugs. (a) British Anti-Lewisite is used to treat heavy metal poisoning by coordinating metals (M), and enterobactin (b) allows excess iron in the
blood to be removed.
Ligands like BAL and enterobactin are important in medical treatments for heavy metal poisoning. However, chelation therapies can disrupt the normal concentration of ions in the body,
leading to serious side effects, so researchers are searching for new chelation drugs. One drug that has been developed is dimercaptosuccinic acid (DMSA), shown in Figure 19.2.18. Identify
which atoms in this molecule could act as donor atoms.
Structural formula for <span class=
DMSA
is shown with all of the lone pairs on O and S drawn out. " style="width: 650px; height: 191px;" width="650px" height="191px" data-cke-saved-src="/@api/deki/files/65922/
CNX
_Chem_19_02_DMSA.jpg" src="/@api/deki/files/65922/CNX_Chem_19_02_DMSA.jpg" data-quail-id="607">
Figure 19.2.18: Dimercaptosuccinic acid is used to treat heavy metal poisoning.
Solution
All of the oxygen and sulfur atoms have lone pairs of electrons that can be used to coordinate to a metal center, so there are six possible donor atoms. Geometrically, only two of these atoms
can be coordinated to a metal at once. The most common binding mode involves the coordination of one sulfur atom and one oxygen atom, forming a five-member ring with the metal.
Exercise 19.2.3
Some alternative medicine practitioners recommend chelation treatments for ailments that are not clearly related to heavy metals, such as cancer and autism, although the practice is discouraged
by many scientific organizations.1 Identify at least two biologically important metals that could be disrupted by chelation therapy.
Answer
Ca, Fe, Zn, and Cu
Ligands are also used in the electroplating industry. When metal ions are reduced to produce thin metal coatings, metals can clump together to form clusters and nanoparticles. When metal
coordination complexes are used, the ligands keep the metal atoms isolated from each other. It has been found that many metals plate out as a smoother, more uniform, better-looking, and more
adherent surface when plated from a bath containing the metal as a complex ion. Thus, complexes such as [Ag(CN)2]− and [Au(CN)2]− are used extensively in the electroplating industry.
In 1965, scientists at Michigan State University discovered that there was a platinum complex that inhibited cell division in certain microorganisms. Later work showed that the complex was cis-
diaminedichloroplatinum(II), [Pt(NH3)2(Cl)2], and that the trans isomer was not effective. The inhibition of cell division indicated that this square planar compound could be an anticancer agent. In
1978, the US Food and Drug Administration approved this compound, known as cisplatin, for use in the treatment of certain forms of cancer. Since that time, many similar platinum compounds
have been developed for the treatment of cancer. In all cases, these are the cis isomers and never the trans isomers. The diamine (NH3)2 portion is retained with other groups, replacing the dichloro
[(Cl)2] portion. The newer drugs include carboplatin, oxaliplatin, and satraplatin.
Summary
The transition elements and main group elements can form coordination compounds, or complexes, in which a central metal atom or ion is bonded to one or more ligands by coordinate covalent
bonds. Ligands with more than one donor atom are called polydentate ligands and form chelates. The common geometries found in complexes are tetrahedral and square planar (both with a
coordination number of four) and octahedral (with a coordination number of six). Cis and trans configurations are possible in some octahedral and square planar complexes. In addition to these
geometrical isomers, optical isomers (molecules or ions that are mirror images but not superimposable) are possible in certain octahedral complexes. Coordination complexes have a wide variety of
uses including oxygen transport in blood, water purification, and pharmaceutical use.
Footnotes
1. National Council against Health Fraud, NCAHF Policy Statement on Chelation Therapy, (Peabody, MA, 2002).
central metal
ion or atom to which one or more ligands is attached through coordinate covalent bonds
chelate
complex formed from a polydentate ligand attached to a central metal
chelating ligand
ligand that attaches to a central metal ion by bonds from two or more donor atoms
cis configuration
configuration of a geometrical isomer in which two similar groups are on the same side of an imaginary reference line on the molecule
coordination compound
substance consisting of atoms, molecules, or ions attached to a central atom through Lewis acid-base interactions
coordination number
number of coordinate covalent bonds to the central metal atom in a complex or the number of closest contacts to an atom in a crystalline form
coordination sphere
central metal atom or ion plus the attached ligands of a complex
donor atom
atom in a ligand with a lone pair of electrons that forms a coordinate covalent bond to a central metal
ionization isomer
(or coordination isomer) isomer in which an anionic ligand is replaced by the counter ion in the inner coordination sphere
ligand
ion or neutral molecule attached to the central metal ion in a coordination compound
linkage isomer
coordination compound that possesses a ligand that can bind to the transition metal in two different ways (CN− vs. NC−)
monodentate
ligand that attaches to a central metal through just one coordinate covalent bond
optical isomer
(also, enantiomer) molecule that is a nonsuperimposable mirror image with identical chemical and physical properties, except when it reacts with other optical isomers
polydentate ligand
ligand that is attached to a central metal ion by bonds from two or more donor atoms, named with prefixes specifying how many donors are present (e.g., hexadentate = six coordinate bonds
formed)
trans configuration
configuration of a geometrical isomer in which two similar groups are on opposite sides of an imaginary reference line on the molecule
This page titled 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and
standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The behavior of coordination compounds cannot be adequately explained by the same theories used for main group element
chemistry. The observed geometries of coordination complexes are not consistent with hybridized orbitals on the central metal
overlapping with ligand orbitals, as would be predicted by valence bond theory. The observed colors indicate that the d orbitals
often occur at different energy levels rather than all being degenerate, that is, of equal energy, as are the three p orbitals. To explain
the stabilities, structures, colors, and magnetic properties of transition metal complexes, a different bonding model has been
developed. Just as valence bond theory explains many aspects of bonding in main group chemistry, crystal field theory is useful in
understanding and predicting the behavior of transition metal complexes.
19.3.1). These two orbitals are called the eg orbitals (the symbol actually refers to the symmetry of the orbitals, but we will use it as
a convenient name for these two orbitals in an octahedral complex). The other three orbitals, the dxy, dxz, and dyz orbitals, have
lobes that point between the ligands and are called the t2g orbitals (again, the symbol really refers to the symmetry of the orbitals).
As six ligands approach the metal ion along the axes of the octahedron, their point charges repel the electrons in the d orbitals of
the metal ion. However, the repulsions between the electrons in the eg orbitals (the d and d z
2 orbitals) and the ligands are
2
x −y
2
greater than the repulsions between the electrons in the t2g orbitals (the dzy, dxz, and dyz orbitals) and the ligands. This is because the
lobes of the eg orbitals point directly at the ligands, whereas the lobes of the t2g orbitals point between them. Thus, electrons in the
eg orbitals of the metal ion in an octahedral complex have higher potential energies than those of electrons in the t2g orbitals. The
difference in energy may be represented as shown in Figure 19.3.2.
−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−−→
a few ligands of the spectrochemical series, in order of increasing field strength of the ligand
In this series, ligands on the left cause small crystal field splittings and are weak-field ligands, whereas those on the right cause
larger splittings and are strong-field ligands. Thus, the Δoct value for an octahedral complex with iodide ligands (I−) is much
smaller than the Δoct value for the same metal with cyanide ligands (CN−).
Electrons in the d orbitals follow the aufbau (“filling up”) principle, which says that the orbitals will be filled to give the lowest
total energy, just as in main group chemistry. When two electrons occupy the same orbital, the like charges repel each other. The
energy needed to pair up two electrons in a single orbital is called the pairing energy (P). Electrons will always singly occupy each
orbital in a degenerate set before pairing. P is similar in magnitude to Δoct. When electrons fill the d orbitals, the relative
magnitudes of Δoct and P determine which orbitals will be occupied.
In [Fe(CN)6]4−, the strong field of six cyanide ligands produces a large Δoct. Under these conditions, the electrons require less
energy to pair than they require to be excited to the eg orbitals (Δoct > P). The six 3d electrons of the Fe2+ ion pair in the three t2g
orbitals (Figure 19.3.3). Complexes in which the electrons are paired because of the large crystal field splitting are called low-spin
complexes because the number of unpaired electrons (spins) is minimized.
Figure 19.3.3 : Iron(II) complexes have six electrons in the 5d orbitals. In the absence of a crystal field, the orbitals are degenerate.
For coordination complexes with strong-field ligands such as [Fe(CN)6]4−, Δoct is greater than P, and the electrons pair in the lower
energy t2g orbitals before occupying the eg orbitals. With weak-field ligands such as H2O, the ligand field splitting is less than the
pairing energy, Δoct less than P, so the electrons occupy all d orbitals singly before any pairing occurs.
In [Fe(H2O)6]2+, on the other hand, the weak field of the water molecules produces only a small crystal field splitting (Δoct < P).
Because it requires less energy for the electrons to occupy the eg orbitals than to pair together, there will be an electron in each of
the five 3d orbitals before pairing occurs. For the six d electrons on the iron(II) center in [Fe(H2O)6]2+, there will be one pair of
electrons and four unpaired electrons (Figure 19.3.3). Complexes such as the [Fe(H2O)6]2+ ion, in which the electrons are unpaired
because the crystal field splitting is not large enough to cause them to pair, are called high-spin complexes because the number of
unpaired electrons (spins) is maximized.
Solution
The complexes are octahedral.
a. Cr3+ has a d3 configuration. These electrons will all be unpaired.
b. Cu2+ is d9, so there will be one unpaired electron.
c. Co3+ has d6 valence electrons, so the crystal field splitting will determine how many are paired. Nitrite is a strong-field
ligand, so the complex will be low spin. Six electrons will go in the t2g orbitals, leaving 0 unpaired.
Exercise 19.3.1
The size of the crystal field splitting only influences the arrangement of electrons when there is a choice between pairing
electrons and filling the higher-energy orbitals. For which d-electron configurations will there be a difference between high-
and low-spin configurations in octahedral complexes?
Answer
d4, d5, d6, and d7
CFT is applicable to molecules in geometries other than octahedral. In octahedral complexes, remember that the lobes of the eg
set point directly at the ligands. For tetrahedral complexes, the d orbitals remain in place, but now we have only four ligands
located between the axes (Figure 19.3.4). None of the orbitals points directly at the tetrahedral ligands. However, the eg set
(along the Cartesian axes) overlaps with the ligands less than does the t2g set. By analogy with the octahedral case, predict the
energy diagram for the d orbitals in a tetrahedral crystal field. To avoid confusion, the octahedral eg set becomes a tetrahedral e
set, and the octahedral t2g set becomes a t2 set.
Figure 19.3.4 : This diagram shows the orientation of the tetrahedral ligands with respect to the axis system for the orbitals.
Solution
Since CFT is based on electrostatic repulsion, the orbitals closer to the ligands will be destabilized and raised in energy relative
to the other set of orbitals. The splitting is less than for octahedral complexes because the overlap is less, so Δtet is usually
Exercise 19.3.2
Answer
4; because Δtet is small, all tetrahedral complexes are high spin and the electrons go into the t2 orbitals before pairing
The other common geometry is square planar. It is possible to consider a square planar geometry as an octahedral structure with a
pair of trans ligands removed. The removed ligands are assumed to be on the z-axis. This changes the distribution of the d orbitals,
as orbitals on or near the z-axis become more stable, and those on or near the x- or y-axes become less stable. This results in the
octahedral t2g and the eg sets splitting and gives a more complicated pattern with no simple Δoct. The basic pattern is:
Figure 19.3.5 : (a) An object is black if it absorbs all colors of light. If it reflects all colors of light, it is white. An object has a color
if it absorbs all colors except one, such as this yellow strip. The strip also appears yellow if it absorbs the complementary color
from white light (in this case, indigo). (b) Complementary colors are located directly across from one another on the color wheel.
(c) A solution of [Cu(NH3)4]2+ ions absorbs red and orange light, so the transmitted light appears as the complementary color, blue.
The octahedral complex [Ti(H2O)6]3+ has a single d electron. To excite this electron from the ground state t2g orbital to the eg
orbital, this complex absorbs light from 450 to 600 nm. The maximum absorbance corresponds to Δoct and occurs at 499 nm.
Calculate the value of Δoct in Joules and predict what color the solution will appear.
Solution
Using Planck's equation (refer to the section on electromagnetic energy), we calculate:
8
c 3.00 × 10 m/s
14
v= so = 6.01 × 10 Hz
λ 499 nm × 1 m
9
10 nm
−34 14 −19
E = hnu so 6.63 × 10 J⋅s × 6.01 × 10 Hz = 3.99 × 10 Joules/ion
Because the complex absorbs 600 nm (orange) through 450 (blue), the indigo, violet, and red wavelengths will be transmitted,
and the complex will appear purple.
Exercise 19.3.3
A complex that appears green, absorbs photons of what wavelengths?
Answer
red, 620–800 nm
Figure 19.3.6 : The partially filled d orbitals of the stable ions Cr3+(aq), Fe3+(aq), and Co2+(aq) (left, center and right, respectively)
give rise to various colors. (credit: Sahar Atwa)
The specific ligands coordinated to the metal center also influence the color of coordination complexes. For example, the iron(II)
complex [Fe(H2O)6]SO4 appears blue-green because the high-spin complex absorbs photons in the red wavelengths (Figure
19.3.7). In contrast, the low-spin iron(II) complex K4[Fe(CN)6] appears pale yellow because it absorbs higher-energy violet
photons.
Figure 19.3.7 : Both (a) hexaaquairon(II) sulfate and (b) potassium hexacyanoferrate(II) contain d6 iron(II) octahedral metal
centers, but they absorb photons in different ranges of the visible spectrum.
In general, strong-field ligands cause a large split in the energies of d orbitals of the central metal atom (large Δoct). Transition
metal coordination compounds with these ligands are yellow, orange, or red because they absorb higher-energy violet or blue light.
On the other hand, coordination compounds of transition metals with weak-field ligands are often blue-green, blue, or indigo
because they absorb lower-energy yellow, orange, or red light.
Video 19.3.8 : Watch this video of the reduction of vanadium complexes to observe the colorful effect of changing oxidation states.
A coordination compound of the Cu+ ion has a d10 configuration, and all the eg orbitals are filled. To excite an electron to a higher
level, such as the 4p orbital, photons of very high energy are necessary. This energy corresponds to very short wavelengths in the
Figure 19.3.8 : (a) Copper(I) complexes with d10 configurations such as CuI tend to be colorless, whereas (b) d9 copper(II)
complexes such as Cu(NO3)2·5H2O are brightly colored.
Summary
Crystal field theory treats interactions between the electrons on the metal and the ligands as a simple electrostatic effect. The
presence of the ligands near the metal ion changes the energies of the metal d orbitals relative to their energies in the free ion. Both
the color and the magnetic properties of a complex can be attributed to this crystal field splitting. The magnitude of the splitting
(Δoct) depends on the nature of the ligands bonded to the metal. Strong-field ligands produce large splitting and favor low-spin
complexes, in which the t2g orbitals are completely filled before any electrons occupy the eg orbitals. Weak-field ligands favor
formation of high-spin complexes. The t2g and the eg orbitals are singly occupied before any are doubly occupied.
Glossary
crystal field splitting (Δoct)
difference in energy between the t2g and eg sets or t and e sets of orbitals
eg orbitals
set of two d orbitals that are oriented on the Cartesian axes for coordination complexes; in octahedral complexes, they are
higher in energy than the t2g orbitals
geometric isomers
isomers that differ in the way in which atoms are oriented in space relative to each other, leading to different physical and
chemical properties
high-spin complex
complex in which the electrons maximize the total electron spin by singly populating all of the orbitals before pairing two
electrons into the lower-energy orbitals
low-spin complex
complex in which the electrons minimize the total electron spin by pairing in the lower-energy orbitals before populating the
higher-energy orbitals
strong-field ligand
ligand that causes larger crystal field splittings
t2g orbitals
set of three d orbitals aligned between the Cartesian axes for coordination complexes; in octahedral complexes, they are
lowered in energy compared to the eg orbitals according to CFT
weak-field ligand
ligand that causes small crystal field splittings
This page titled 19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of Coordination Compounds is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored,
remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit
history is available upon request.
19.E.1.2: S19.1.1
The electron configuration of an atom is the representation of the arrangement of electrons distributed among the orbital shells and sub-shells.
The electron configuration of each element is unique to its position on the periodic table where the energy level is determined by the period and
the number of electrons is given by the atomic number of the element. There are four different types of orbitals (s, p, d, and f) which have
different shapes and each orbital can hold a maximum of 2 electrons, but the p, d and f orbitals have different sub-levels, meaning that they are
able to hold more electrons.
The periodic table is broken up into groups which we can use to determine orbitals and thus, write electron configurations:
Group 1 & 2: S orbital
Group 13 - 18: P orbital
Group 3 - 12: D orbital
Lanthanide & Actinides: F orbital
Each orbital (s, p, d, f) has a maximum number of electrons it can hold. An easy way to remember the electron maximum of each is to
look at the periodic table and count the number of periods in each collection of groups.
Group 1 & 2: 2 (2 electrons total = 1 orbital x max of 2 electrons = 2 electrons)
Group 13 - 18: 6 (6 electrons total = 3 orbitals x 2 electrons max = 6 electrons)
Group 3 - 12: 10 (10 electrons total = 5 orbitals x 2 electrons max = 10 electrons)
Lanthanide & Actinides: 14 (14 electrons total = 7 orbitals x 2 electrons max = 14 electrons)
Electron fills the orbitals in a specific pattern that affects the order in which the long-hand versions are written:
Electron filling pattern: 1s, 2s, 2p, 3s, 3p, 4s, 3d, 4p, 5s, 4d, 5p, 6s, 4f, 5d, 6p, 7s, 5f
An easier and faster way to write electron configurations is to use noble gas configurations as short-cuts. We are able to do this because
the electron configurations of the noble gases always have all filled orbitals.
He: 1s22s2
Ne: 1s22s22p6
Ar: 1s22s22p63s23p6
Kr: 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d104p6
Xe: 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d104p65s24d105p6
Rn: 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d104p65s24d105p66s24f145d106p6
The most common noble gas configuration used is Ar. When you want to use the noble gas configuration short-cut, you place the
noble gas's symbol inside of brackets:
[Ar]
and then write it preceding the rest of the configuration, which is solely the orbitals the proceed after that of the noble gas.
a. Sc
Let's start off by identifying where Scandium sits on the periodic table: row 4, group 3. This identification is the critical basis we need to
write its electron configuration.
19.E.1.3: A19.1.1
a. Sc: [Ar]4s23d1
b. Ti: [Ar]4s23d2
c. Cr: [Ar]4s13d5
d. Fe: [Ar]4s23d6
e. Ru: [Kr]5s14d7 (anomalous configuration)
19.E.1.5: S19.1.2
Electrons are distributed into molecular orbitals, the s, p, d, andf blocks. An orbital will have a number in front of it and a letter that
corresponds to the block. The s block holds two electrons, the p block holds six, the d block holds ten, and the f block holds fourteen. So, based
on the number of electrons an atom has, the molecular orbitals are filled up in a certain way. The order of the orbitals is
. An exponent will be put after the letter for each orbital to signify how
1s, 2s, 2p, 3s, 3p, 4s, 3d, 4p, 5s, 4d, 5p, 6s, 4f , 5d, 6p, 7s, 5f , 6d, 7p
many electrons are in that orbital. Noble gas notation can also be used by putting the noble gas prior to the element you are writing the
configuration for, and then proceed by writing the orbitals filled after the noble gas. Metal ions of the d-block will have the two electrons
removed from the s block prior to any electrons being removed from the proceeding d-block.
Solutions:
1. T i
Titanium has an atomic number of 22, meaning it has 22 electrons. The noble gas prior to Titanium is Argon. Looking at row 4 of the periodic
table, Titanium still has 4 electrons to be placed in orbitals since Argon has 18 electrons that are already placed. The remaining electrons will
fill the 4s orbital and the remaining two electrons will go into the 3d orbital. [Ar]4s23d2
2. T i
+2
This is an ion with a plus 2 charge, meaning 2 electrons have been removed. The electrons will be removed from the 4s orbital and the 2
remaining electrons will be placed in the 3d orbital. Like number 1, the prior noble gas is Argon. [Ar]3d2
3. T i
+3
This is an ion with a plus 3 charge, meaning 3 electrons have been removed. The first 2 electrons will be removed from the 4s orbital, and the
third will be taken from the 3d orbital, and the 1 remaining electron will be placed in the 3d orbital. Like number 1, the prior noble gas is
Argon. [Ar]3d1
4. T i
+4
This is an ion with a plus 4 charge, meaning 4 electrons have been removed. The first 2 electrons will be removed from the 4s orbital and the
second 2 will be removed from the 3d orbital. This results in the ion having the same electron configuration as Argon. [Ar]
Answers:
1. [Ar]4s 2
3d
2
2. [Ar]3d 2
3. [Ar]3d 1
4. [Ar]
19.E.1.6: A19.1.2
a. [Ar]4s 3d2 2
b. [Ar]3d 2
c. [Ar]3d 1
d. [Ar]
19.E.1.7: Q19.1.3
Write the electron configurations for each of the following elements and its 3+ ions:
a. La
b. Sm
c. Lu
19.E.1.8: S19.1.3
In order to write the electron configuration, we begin by finding the element on the periodic table. Since La, Sm, and Lu are all a period below
the noble gas Xenon, we can abbreviate 1s 2s 2p 3s 3p 3d 4s 4p 4d 5s 5p as [Xe] when writing the orbital configurations. We then
2 2 6 2 6 10 2 6 10 2 6
find the remaining of the orbital configurations using the Aufbau Principle. For other elements not just those in period 6, the shorthand notation
using noble gases would be the noble gas in the period above the given element.
2. Sm has eight more electrons. The 6s orbital is filled as previously and the 4f orbital receives 6 electrons because pairing electrons requires
lower energy on the 4f shell than on the 5d shell.
Sm : [Xe] 6s 2
4f
6
3. Lu has seventeen more electrons. Two electrons fill the 6s orbital, 14 electrons fill the 4f orbital, and extra single electron goes to the 5d
orbital .
Lu : [Xe] 6s 2
4f
14
5d
1
To find the 3+ ion electron configuration, we remove 3 electrons from the neutral configuration, starting with the 6s orbital.
1. The ionization of La3+ removes the three extra electrons. So it reverts back to the stable Xenon configuration.
La
3+
: [Xe]
2. The ionization of Sm3+ removes two electrons from the 6s shell and one from the outermost (4f) shell
Sm
3+
: [Xe] 4f 5
3. The ionization of Lu3+ removes its two 6s shell and one from the outermost (5d) shell, leaving only a full 4f shell
Lu
3+
: [Xe] 4f 14
19.E.1.9: A19.1.3
La: [Xe]6s 25d 1, La3+: [Xe]; Sm: [Xe]6s 24f 6, Sm3+: [Xe]4f 5; Lu: [Xe]6s 24f 145d 1, Lu3+: [Xe]4f 14
19.E.1.10: Q19.1.4
Why are the lanthanoid elements not found in nature in their elemental forms?
19.E.1.11: A19.1.4
Lanthanides are rarely found in their elemental forms because they readily give their electrons to other more electronegative elements, forming
compounds instead of staying in a pure elemental form. They have very similar chemical properties with one another, are often found deep
within the earth, and difficult to extract. They are the inner transition elements and have partially filled d orbitals that can donate electrons.
Because of this, they are very reactive and electropositive.
19.E.1.12: Q19.1.5
Which of the following elements is most likely to be used to prepare La by the reduction of La2O3: Al, C, or Fe? Why?
19.E.1.13: S19.1.5
An activity series is a list of elements in decreasing order of their reactivity. Elements on the top of the list are good reducing agents because
they easily give up an electron, and elements on the bottom of the series are good oxidizing agents because they are highly electronegative
would really want to accept an electron.
Step 1: Compare Aluminum, Carbon, and Iron on an activity series. Many activity series include carbon and hydrogen as references. An
activity series can be found here
The activity series goes in the order (from top to bottom): Aluminum, Carbon, and Iron.
Step 2: Identify which element is the best reducing agent.
Elements on the top of the list are the best reducing agents, because they give up electrons the best.
Aluminum is the best reducing agent of the options available.
Therefore aluminum will be the best reducing agent to prepare La by the reduction of La2O3 because it is the most reactive in the series
amongst the three elements.
19.E.1.14: A19.1.5
Al is used because it is the strongest reducing agent and the only option listed that can provide sufficient driving force to convert La(III) into
La.
19.E.1.15: Q19.1.6
Which of the following is the strongest oxidizing agent: VO 3 −
4
, CrO
2−
4
, or MnO ?
−
4
We know that O has a -2 oxidation state and the overall charge of the ion is -3. We just need to determine Vanadate's oxidation number in this
compound.
V + −2(4) = −3
V = +5
Vanadate has an oxidation number of +5, which is its highest possible oxidation state.
2−
CrO
4
Like in the previous calculation, O has a -2 oxidation state. The overall charge is -2. So calculate for chromium.
Cr + −2(4) = −2
Cr = +6
Mn = +7
19.E.1.17: A19.1.6
−
M nO
4
19.E.1.18: Q19.1.7
Which of the following elements is most likely to form an oxide with the formula MO3: Zr, Nb, or Mo?
19.E.1.19: S19.1.7
Mo because Zr has an oxidation state of +4 and Nb has a oxidation state of +5 and those would not balance out the charge of 3 oxygens in the
state of -2 which creates a charge of -6. Mo however has multiple oxidation states, the most common being +6 which balances out the -6 charge
created by 3 oxygen ions. This is why its most likely to form an oxide with the formula MO3 or MoO . 3
19.E.1.20: A19.1.7
Mo
19.E.1.21: Q19.1.8
The following reactions all occur in a blast furnace. Which of these are redox reactions?
a. 3 Fe O (s) + CO(g) ⟶ 2 Fe O (s) + CO
2 3 3 4 2
(g)
changed from +3 to +2.67, we can say that Fe had gained electrons and therefore reduced. In the reactant, CO, carbon has an oxidation number
of +2, and in CO (product) carbon has an oxidation number of +4. Therefore, carbon has lost electrons and it has been oxidized. Since there is
2
oxidation and reduction of species- we can conclude that this is a redox reaction.
b. In the reactant, Fe O , Fe has an oxidation number of +2.67. In the product, FeO, Fe has an oxidation number of +2. Since the oxidation of
3 4
Fe has changed from +2.67 to +2, electrons have been added therefore Fe has been reduced. In the reactant, CO, carbon has an oxidation
number of +2, and in CO (product) carbon has an oxidation number of +4. Therefore, carbon has lost electrons and it has been oxidized. Since
2
there is oxidation and reduction of species- we can conclude that this is a redox reaction.
c. In the reactant side, in FeO, Fe has an oxidation number of +2 and in the products side Fe has an oxidation number of 0. Since the oxidation
number of Fe changed from +2 to 0, electrons have been gained and therefore Fe has been reduced. In the reactant, CO, carbon has an
oxidation number of +2, and in CO (product) carbon has an oxidation number of +4. Therefore, carbon has lost electrons and it has been
2
oxidized. Since there is oxidation and reduction of species- we can conclude that this is a redox reaction.
d. In the reactants C has an oxidation number of 0, and in the products side in CO , C has an oxidation number of +4. Since the oxidation
2
number of C has changed from 0 to +4, we can say that C has been oxidized. In the reactants, in O oxygen has an oxidation number of 0, and
2
in the products CO2, oxygen has an oxidation number of -2. Since the oxidation number of oxygen has changed from 0 to -2, oxygen has been
reduced. Since there is oxidation and reduction of species- we can conclude that this is a redox reaction.
e. In the reactants CO has an oxidation number of +4, and in the products side in CO, C has an oxidation number of +2. Since carbon went
2
from +4 to +2, carbon has been reduced. In the reactants, in CO oxygen has an oxidation number of -4 and in the products CO carbon has an
2
oxidation number of -2. Since oxygen went from -4 to -2, it has been oxidized. Since there is oxidation and reduction of species- we can
conclude that this is a redox reaction.
f. In the reactants, CaCO Ca has an oxidation number of +2, and in products CaO Ca has an oxidation number of +2. Since the oxidization
3
number doesn't change- we can conclude that this equation is not a redox reaction.
g. In the products CaO Ca has an oxidation number of +2, and in the products CaSiO Ca has an oxidation number of +2. Since the oxidization
3
number doesn't change- we can conclude that this equation is not a redox reaction.
19.E.1.23: A19.1.8
a, b, c, d, e
19.E.1.24: Q19.1.9
Why is the formation of slag useful during the smelting of iron?
19.E.1.25: S19.1.9
Slag is a substance formed as a byproduct of iron ore or iron pellets melting together in a blast furnace. Slag is also the byproduct that is formed
when a desired metal has been separated from its raw ore. It is important to note that slag from steel mills is created in a manner that reduces
the loss of the desired iron ore. The CaSiO slag is less dense than the molten iron, so it can easily be separated. Also, the floating slag layer
3
creates a barrier that prevents the molten iron from exposure to O , which would oxidize the Fe back to Fe O . Since Fe has a low reduction
2 2 3
potential of -0.440 this means it has a high oxidation potential so it would easily oxidize in the presence of O2. Creating a barrier between iron
and oxygen allows the maximum product of iron to be obtained in the end of smelting.
19.E.1.26: A19.1.9
The CaSiO3 slag is less dense than the molten iron, so it can easily be separated. Also, the floating slag layer creates a barrier that prevents the
molten iron from exposure to O2, which would oxidize the Fe back to Fe2O3.
19.E.1.27: Q19.1.10
Would you expect an aqueous manganese(VII) oxide solution to have a pH greater or less than 7.0? Justify your answer.
19.E.1.28: S19.1.10
Manganese(VII) oxide, can be written as Mn2O7.
19.E.1.29: A19.1.10
In relation to the Lewis acid-base theory, the Lewis acid accepts lone pair electrons; thus, it is also known as the electron pair acceptor. This
may be any chemical species. Acids are substances that must be lower than 7. Therefore, oxides of manganese is most likely going to become
more acidic in (aq) solutions if the oxidation number increases.
19.E.1.30: Q19.1.11
Iron(II) can be oxidized to iron(III) by dichromate ion, which is reduced to chromium(III) in acid solution. A 2.5000-g sample of iron ore is
dissolved and the iron converted into iron(II). Exactly 19.17 mL of 0.0100 M Na2Cr2O7 is required in the titration. What percentage of the ore
sample was iron?
19.E.1.31: S19.1.11
To answer this question, we must first identify the net ionic equation from the given half-reactions. We can write the oxidation and reduction
half-reactions:
2+ 3+
oxidation: Fe → Fe (19.E.1)
2− 3+
reduction: Cr O → Cr (19.E.2)
2 7
We can quickly balance the oxidation half-reaction by adding the appropriate number of electrons to get
2+ 3+ −
Fe → Fe + e (19.E.3)
The first step in balancing the reduction half-reaction is to balance elements in the equation other than O and H. In doing so, we get
2− 3+
Cr O → 2 Cr (19.E.4)
2 7
The second step would be to add enough water molecules to balance the oxygen.
2− 3+
Cr O → 2 Cr +7 H O (19.E.5)
2 7 2
+
Next, we add the correct amount of H to balance the hydrogen atoms.
2− + 3+
Cr O7 + 14 H → 2 Cr +7 H O (19.E.6)
2 2
The electrons involved in both half-reactions must be equal in order for us to combine the two to get the net ionic equation. This can be done by
multiplying each equation by the appropriate coefficient. Scaling the oxidation half-reaction by 6, we get
2+ 3+ −
6 Fe → 6 Fe + 6 e (19.E.8)
From this we can see that the mole ratio of Cr2O72- to Fe2+ is 1:6. Given that 19.17 mL (or 0.01917 L) of 0.01 M Na2Cr2O7 was needed for
titration we know that
−4
0.01917 L × 0.01 M = 1.917 × 10 mol (19.E.11)
of Na2Cr2O7 reacted. Also, since any number of moles of Na2Cr2O7 produces the same number of moles of Cr2O72- in solution
−4 −4 2−
1.917 × 10 mol of Na Cr O = 1.917 × 10 mol of Cr O (19.E.12)
2 2 7 2 7
2+
0.0011502 mol of Fe = 0.0011502 mol of Fe (19.E.14)
Now we can find the number of grams of iron that were present in the 2.5 g iron ore sample.
55.847 g
0.0011502 mol of Fe × = 0.0642352194 g of Fe (19.E.15)
1 mol
Finally, we can answer the question and find what percentage of the ore sample was iron.
0.0642352194 g
× 100 ≈ 2.57% (19.E.16)
2.5 g
19.E.1.32: A19.1.11
2.57%
19.E.1.33: Q19.1.12
How many cubic feet of air at a pressure of 760 torr and 0 °C is required per ton of Fe2O3 to convert that Fe2O3 into iron in a blast furnace? For
this exercise, assume air is 19% oxygen by volume.
19.E.1.34: S19.1.12
This question uses a series of unit conversions and the P V = nRT equation.
The first step is to write out the balanced chemical equation for the conversion of Fe2O3 to pure iron.
Next, we need to analyze the original question to determine the value that we need to solve for. Because the question asks for a value of cubic
feet, we know we need to solve for volume. We can manipulate P V = nRT to solve for volume.
V = nRT /P (19.E.18)
Now determine the known variables and convert into units that will be easy to deal with.
453.592 grams F e2 O3 1 mole F e2 O3 3 moles O2
n = 2000 lbs F e2 O3 (19.E.19)
1 lb F e2 O3 159.69 grams F e2 O3 2 moles F e2 O3
∘
T = 0 C = 273 K (19.E.22)
Now plug the numbers into the manipulated gas law to get to an answer for V.
V = 190991.8 liters of O2 (19.E.24)
3
thus we have 6744.811 ft of O2
We then refer back to the initial question and remember that this value is only 19% of the volume of the total air. So use a simple equation to
determine the total volume of air in cubic feet.
3
6744.811f t = .19x (19.E.26)
19.E.1.35: A19.1.12
35499 ft3 of air
19.E.1.36: Q19.1.13
Find the potentials of the following electrochemical cell:
Cd | Cd2+ (M = 0.10) ‖ Ni2+ (M = 0.50) | Ni
19.E.1.37: S19.1.13
Step 1 Write out your two half reactions and identify which is oxidation and which is reduction using the acronym OIL RIG to remember that
oxidation is loss of electrons and reduction is gain of electrons
Cd(s)⟶Cd2+(aq)+2e- (oxidation)
Ni2+(aq)+2e-⟶Ni(s) (reduction)
Step 2 Write out complete balanced equation
Cd(s)+ Ni2+(aq)⟶Cd2+(aq)+Ni(s)
Step 3 Find Eocell
Image result for reduction potential table
Eocell = Ecathode-Eanode
oxidation: Cd(s)⟶Cd2+(aq)+2e- Eo=-0.40V
reduction: Ni2+(aq)+2e-⟶Ni(s) Eo=-0.26V
* E values come from standard reduction potentials table given above. Also, remember anode is where oxidation happens, and cathode is
where reduction happens.
Eocell=-0.26-(-.40)
Eocell=0.14V
Step 4 Find Q
Q=[products]/[reactants] (look at complete balanced equation) (remember that [x] means the concentration of x typically given in
molarity and that we ignore solids or liquids)
Q=[Cd2+]/[Ni2+]
Q=0.10/0.50
Q=0.2
Step 5 Calculate E using E= Eocell-(.0592/n)logQ (n is number of moles of electrons transferred and in our case the balanced reaction transfers 2
electrons)
E= 0.14-(.0592/2)log(0.2)
E= 0.14-(-.207)
E=0.16 V
19.E.1.38: A19.1.13
0.16 V
19.E.1.39: Q19.1.14
A 2.5624-g sample of a pure solid alkali metal chloride is dissolved in water and treated with excess silver nitrate. The resulting precipitate,
filtered and dried, weighs 3.03707 g. What was the percent by mass of chloride ion in the original compound? What is the identity of the salt?
19.E.1.40: S19.1.14
A 2.5624-g sample of a pure solid alkali metal chloride is dissolved in water and treated with excess silver nitrate. The resulting
precipitate, filtered and dried, weighs 3.03707 g. What was the percent by mass of chloride ion in the original compound? What is the
identity of the salt?
Assuming that metal chloride is XCl
Since the molar ratio of the compounds are 1:1 so the number of moles of XCl used = 0.0211 mol
We can calculate the weight of Cl- with the equation:
0.0211mol × 35.5g/mol = 0.7490g (19.E.29)
the amount of metal present in the original compound is the weight of the compound subtracted by weight of the Cl ion:
(2.5624 − 0.7490)g = 1.8134g (19.E.30)
So the atomic mass is 85.943 g/mol which is of Rb hence the identity of the salt is RbCl
19.E.1.41: Q19.1.15
3+ 2+
The standard reduction potential for the reaction [Co(H O) ] (aq) + e ⟶ [Co(H O) ] (aq) is about 1.8 V. The reduction potential for
2 6
−
2 6
the reaction [Co(NH ) ] (aq) + e ⟶ [Co(NH ) ] (aq) is +0.1 V. Calculate the cell potentials to show whether the complex ions,
3 6
3+ −
3 6
2+
[Co(H2O)6]2+ and/or [Co(NH3)6]2+, can be oxidized to the corresponding cobalt(III) complex by oxygen.
19.E.1.42: S19.1.15
To calculate the cell potential, we need to know the potentials for each half reaction. After doing so, we need to determine which one is being
oxidized and which one is being reduced. The one that is oxidized is the anode and the one that is reduced is the cathode. To find the cell
potential, you use this formula and the reduction potential values found in a reduction potential table. If E°cell is positive, ΔG is negative and
the reaction is spontaneous.
E°cell= E°cathode - E°anode
Because it states that [C o(H 2 O)6 ]
3+
will be oxidized, this means it is the anode.
O2 (g) + 4 H
+
(aq) + 4 e
−
→ 2 H2 O +1.229 V
O2 is being reduced, so it is the cathode.
1.229V - 1.8V= -.571 V, or -0.6 V using significant figures. This cannot happen spontaneously because E°cell is negative.
For [C o(N H 3 )6 ]
3+
, it is again being oxidized, meaning it’s the anode.
1.229-.1= 1.129 V or 1.1 V using significant figures. This reaction is spontaneous because E°cell is positive.
19.E.1.43: A19.1.15
a) E ° = −0.6 V, E ° is negative so this reduction is not spontaneous.
b) E ° = +1.1 V, E ° is positive so this reduction is spontaneous.
19.E.1.44: Q19.1.16
Predict the products of each of the following reactions. (Note: In addition to using the information in this chapter, also use the knowledge you
have accumulated at this stage of your study, including information on the prediction of reaction products.)
a. MnCO (s) + HI(aq) ⟶
3
b. CoO(s) + O (g) ⟶ 2
19.E.1.45: S19.1.16
There is a myriad of reactions that can occur, which include: single replacement, double replacement, combustion, acid-base/neutralization,
decomposition or synthesis. The first step to determine the products of a reaction is to identify the type of reaction. From then on, the next steps
you take to predict the products will vary based on the reaction type.
1. This reaction is a double displacement reaction, in which the cations and anions of the reactants switch places to form new compounds.
Writing out the equation in terms of it's aqueous ions will help you visualize what exactly is getting moved around:
+ − + 2− 2+ −
2H (aq) + 2 I (aq) → 2 H (aq) + C O (aq) + M n (aq) + 2 I (aq) (19.E.32)
3
In this case, the hydrogen cations will recombine with carbonate anions whilst manganese cations will recombine with iodide anions giving
us the following equation:
MnCO (s) + 2 HI(aq) ⟶ MnI (aq) + H CO (aq) (19.E.33)
3 2 2 3
This is still not the final answer however, as carbonic acid is unstable and decomposes to carbon dioxide and water under standard
conditions. Taking this into account, our final equation is:
MnCO (s) + 2 HI(aq) ⟶ MnI (aq) + CO (g) + H O(l) (19.E.34)
3 2 2 2
2. This reaction is a synthesis reaction, in which two or more reactants combine to form a more complex compound. In this case we are also
reacting a metal oxide with oxygen which would result in another metal oxide as the product. The resulting product would be the mixed
valence oxide Co3O4 in which one cobalt atom has a +2 oxidation state whilst the other two have a +3 oxidation state. Now all is left is to
balance the equation:
6 CoO(s) + O (g) ⟶ 2 Co O (s) (19.E.35)
2 3 4
3. Like equation 2, this reaction is also a synthesis reaction involving a metal and oxygen which should result in the formation of a metal
oxide. It is a matter now of balancing the oxidation states to attain a neutral compound. Oxygen will always hold a -2 oxidation state in
compounds whilst lanthanum will always exhibit a +3 oxidation state. As such, a combination of 2 lanthanum atoms with a +3 oxidation
state and 3 oxygen atoms with a -2 oxidation state will give us a molecule with an overall charge of 0 (3(-2)+2(+3)=0). We know our
product now, La2O3, and now just need to balance the overall equation, giving us:
4 La(s) + 3 O (g) ⟶ 2 La O (s) (19.E.36)
2 2 3
4. This reaction is slightly harder to define as it encapsulates both the properties of synthesis and decomposition reactions, wherein vanadium
reacts with vanadium tetrachloride to produce vanadium trichloride. This reaction however is primarily a synthesis reaction since we are
combining two reactants to produce one complex compound. With vanadium trichloride as our product, we can balance the equation:
V(s) + 3 VCl (s) ⟶ 4 VCl (s) (19.E.37)
4 3
5. This is another synthesis reaction combining cobalt and fluorine. This equation includes the "xs" notation in front of fluorine which is short
for 'excess', meaning more fluorine than actually required is present in the reactants, ensuring the reaction goes to completion. Finding the
products if a simple matter of combining the cobalt and fluorine into one molecule, which already leaves us with a balanced equation:
Co(s) + xsF (g) ⟶ CoF (s) (19.E.38)
2 2
6. It may not be obvious here, but the reaction we've been given here is actually an acid-base/neutralization reaction, with chromium
trioxide acting as the acid and cesium hydroxide as the base. Chromium trioxide is referred to as an acidic oxide which means that it will
react with water to form an acid. Note that this reaction can still proceed even if the reactants aren't in the same phases. The basic rule for
acid-base/neutralization reactions is they form a salt (salt being the general term for any ionic compound formed from acid-base reactions)
and water. Since we know water is one of our products, our other product must be a salt composed of cesium, chromium and oxygen. Thus,
our other product should be cesium chromate, and you can now balance the equation accordingly:
CrO (s) + 2 CsOH(aq) ⟶ Cs CrO (aq) + H O (19.E.39)
3 2 4 2
19.E.1.47: Q19.1.17
Predict the products of each of the following reactions. (Note: In addition to using the information in this chapter, also use the knowledge you
have accumulated at this stage of your study, including information on the prediction of reaction products.)
a. Fe(s) + H SO (aq) ⟶2 4
d. Cr(s) + O (g) ⟶ 2
e. Mn O (s) + HCl(aq) ⟶
2 3
19.E.1.48: S19.1.17
Predict the products of each of the following reactions.
Fe(s)+H2SO4(aq)⟶ ?
Whenever a metal reacts with an acid, the products are salt and hydrogen. Because Fe is lower on the activity series, we know that when
it reacts with an acid it will result in the formation of Hydrogen gas. To simplify the equation is:
M etal + Acid ⟶ Salt + H ydrogen (19.E.40)
The salt produced will depend on the metal and in this case, the metal is iron (Fe) so the resulting equation would be:
This equation works out as the H2 is removed from H2SO2, resulting in a SO42- ion where Fe will take on an oxidation state of Fe+2 to
form FeSO4 which will be the salt in this example.
But since FeSO4 and H2SO4 are aqueous, the reactants and products can also be written as its ions where the overall equation can be:
+ −4 + −4
Fe(s) + 2 H O (aq) + SO 2 (aq) ⟶ Fe (aq) + SO 2 (aq) + H (g) + 2 H O(l) (19.E.42)
3 2 2 2
FeCl3(aq)+NaOH(aq)⟶ ?
In this case, adding a metal hydroxide (NaOH) to a solution with a transition metal ion (Fe) will form a transition metal hydroxide
(XOH). As iron is bonded to three chlorine atoms in the reactants side, it has the oxidation state of +3 where three hydroxide ions (OH-)
are needed to balance out the charges when they are bonded in the products. The remaining ions are Na+ and Cl- where they bond
together in a 1:1 ratio where there are 3 molecules of NaCl once the reaction is balanced.
The overall reaction will be:
NOTE: Fe(OH)3(s) is a solid as it is a rule that all all transition metal hydroxides are insoluble and a precipitate is formed.
Since NaOH(aq) and NaCl(aq) are aqueous, we can write them out in their ion forms:
+ − + +
FeCl (aq) + 3 Na (aq) + 3 OH (aq) + Fe(OH) (s) + 3 Na (aq) + 3 Cl (aq) (19.E.44)
3 3
Mn(OH)2(s)+HBr(aq)⟶ ?
This is an example of a metal hydroxide reacting with an acid where a metal salt and water will always be formed:
M etalH ydroxide + Acid ⟶ M etalSalt + W ater (19.E.45)
When this rule is applied to this equation, we will get the following:
Mn(OH) (s) + HBr(aq) ⟶ MnBr (aq) + 2 H O(l) (19.E.46)
2 2 2
But to follow through with this question, the aqueous solutions such as HBr(aq) and MnBr2(aq) can be re-written as:
+ − + −
Mn(OH) (s) + 2 H O (aq) + 2 Br (aq) ⟶ Mn (aq) + 2 Br (aq) + 4 H O(l) (19.E.47)
2 3 2 2
However, Cr2O3 is the main oxide of chromium so it can be assumed that this is the general product of this reaction.
Mn2O3(s)+HCl(aq)⟶?
This follows the general reaction of a metal oxide and an acid will always result in a salt and water
M etalOxide + Acid ⟶ Salt + W ater (19.E.52)
Using this general reaction, similar to the general reactions above, the reaction will result in:
Mn O (s) + HCl(aq) ⟶ 2 MnCl (s) + 9 H O(l) (19.E.53)
2 3 3 2
However, since HCl is an aqueous solution, the overall equation can also be re-written as:
+ −
Mn O (s) + 6 H O (aq) + 6 Cl (aq) ⟶ 2 MnCl (s) + 9 H O(l) (19.E.54)
2 3 3 3 2
Ti(s)+xsF2(g)⟶?
Titanium is able to react with the halogens where there are two oxidation state that titanium can be: +3 and +4. The following reactions
follow each oxidation state accordingly:
2 Ti(s) + 3 F (g) ⟶ 2 TiF (s) (19.E.55)
2 3
However, since there is the symbol "xs", this indicates that F2 is added in excess so the second reaction is favored more as it drives the
reaction to completion.
OVERALL:
\[\ce{Ti}(s)+\ce{xsF2}(g)⟶\ce{TiF4}(g)\]
A19.1.17
a. Fe(s) + 2 H O (aq) + SO (aq) ⟶ Fe (aq) + SO (aq) + H (g) + 2 H O(l) ;
3
+ 2−
4
2+ 2−
4 2 2
3
+ +
3 2
19.E.1.49: Q19.1.18
Describe the electrolytic process for refining copper.
19.E.1.50: S19.1.18
By electrolysis, copper can be refined and purely made. The reason why copper needs to remove the impurities is because it helps increase the
electrical conductivity in electrical wire. You can refine copper and remove the impurities through electrolysis. Pure copper is important in
making electrical wire, because it creates better electrical conductivity when transferring electricity. In order for better electrical conductivity,
the impurities needs to be removed and this can be done by firing the impure copper to remove the impurities, such as sulfur, oxygen, etc. and
shaping them into electrical anodes that can be used in electrolysis. Then the copper electrodes are placed into an electrical cell (into separate
beakers) where electrical current can pass through the beakers and onto the electrodes. Through this process, the copper is stripped off of the
anode and deposited onto the cathode. This process helps remove the impurities and refine copper because all the copper has been deposited
onto the cathode all in one electrode. This process increases the weight of the cathode due to copper being deposited onto the cathode. This is a
prime example of how to tell if an electrode is a cathode or an anode, as stated in Q17.2.9 above.
7
in hydrochloric acid.
c. Cr2+ is added to Cr O in acid solution.
2
2−
19.E.1.52: S19.1.19
1. is added to a solution of in acid.
Oxidized half-reaction:
Reduction half reaction:
Overall reaction:
Chromium will precipitate out of the solution because it has a higher reduction potential than Zinc; the reaction is a single replacement.
2. is added to a solution containing an excess of in hydrochloric acid.
Dissociation reaction:
Oxidation half-reaction:
Reduction half-reaction:
Overall reaction:
The reduction potential for permanganate is larger so the reaction is still favorable even when the oxidation of is negative.
3. is added to in acid solution.
Reduction half-reaction:
Oxidation half-reaction:
Overall reaction:
The reaction is favorable with a high positive
4. is heated with .
Reduction half-reaction:
Oxidation half-reaction:
Overall reaction:
Heat creates a product with higher energy than both previous reactants.
5. is added to in water.
Strong acid dissociation:
Overall reaction:
This reaction works by exchange of electrons to yield Chromium ions.
6. is added to an aqueous solution of .
Overall reaction:
Iron hydroxide will precipitate because the two metals will exchange anions.
19.E.1.53: A19.1.19
a. Cr (SO ) (aq) + 2 Zn(s) + 2 H O (aq) ⟶ 2 Zn (aq) + H (g) + 2 H O(l) + 2 Cr (aq) + 3 SO (aq) ;
2 4 3 3
+ 2+
2 2
2+ 2−
2
−
c. In acid solution between pH 2 and pH 6, CrO forms HrCO , which is in equilibrium with dichromate ion. The reaction is
2−
4
−
4
(aq) + 12 H O(l) ;
2+ 2− + 3+
3 Cr (aq) + CrO (aq) + 8 H O (aq) ⟶ 4 Cr
4 3 2
Δ
d. 8 CrO 3
(s) + 9 Mn(s) ⟶ 4 Cr O (s) + 3 Mn O (s)
2 3 3 4
;
19.E.1.54: Q19.1.20
What is the gas produced when iron(II) sulfide is treated with a nonoxidizing acid?
19.E.1.55: S19.1.20
Formula for iron(II) sulfide:
F eS (19.E.57)
Definition of non-oxidizing acid: A non-oxidizing acid is an acid that doesn't act the oxidizing agent. Its anion is a weaker oxidizing agent than
H+, thus it can't be reduced. Examples of non-oxidizing acids:
H C l, H I , H Br, H3 P O4 , H2 S O4 (19.E.58)
Step 2: Choose one of the non-oxidizing acid, in this case HCl, and write the chemical reaction:
F eS(s) + 2H C l(aq) → F eC l2 (s) + H2 S(g) (19.E.59)
The gas produced when iron (II) sulfide treated with a non-oxidizing acid, HCl, is H2S (dihydrogen sulfide) gas.
19.E.1.56: Q19.1.21
Predict the products of each of the following reactions and then balance the chemical equations.
a. Fe is heated in an atmosphere of steam.
b. NaOH is added to a solution of Fe(NO3)3.
c. FeSO4 is added to an acidic solution of KMnO4.
d. Fe is added to a dilute solution of H2SO4.
e. A solution of Fe(NO3)2 and HNO3 is allowed to stand in air.
f. FeCO3 is added to a solution of HClO4.
g. Fe is heated in air.
19.E.1.57: S19.1.21
a. Steam is water (H 2
O )
We can write out the reaction as:
Fe +H 2
O →?
This is a single replacement reaction, so Fe replaces H . So, one of the products is Fe
2 3
O
4
since it is a combination of iron(II) oxide, FeO, and
iron(III) oxide, Fe O .
2 3
The Fe is heated in an atmosphere of steam. H becomes neutrally charged and becomes another product.
2
Next, the net ionic reaction has to be written to get rid of the spectator ions in the reaction, this is written as:
Fe
2 +
+ MnO + H → Fe
−
4
+ 3 +
+ Mn 2 +
+H 2
O
4
is reduced to Mn
2 +
. These can be written as two half
reactions:
MnO
−
4
→ Mn 2 +
The reduction half reaction also has to be balanced, but with H ions and H +
2
O , this is shown as:
MnO
−
4
+ 8 H → Mn + 2 +
+4H 2
O
After the charge of the Mn atoms are balanced, the overall charge has to be balanced on both sides because on the reactants side, the charge is
7 +, and the charge on the products side is 2 +. The overall charge can be balanced by adding electrons, this is shown as:
MnO
−
4
+ 8 H + 5 e → Mn + − 2 +
+4H 2
O
Now since both half reactions are balanced, the electrons in both half reactions have to be equal, and then the half reactions are added together.
After this is done, the reaction looks like this:
MnO 4
−
+ 8 H + 5 Fe + 2 +
+ 5 e → Mn − 2 +
+4H 2
O + 5 Fe 3 +
+5e −
The 5 e on both sides cancel out and the final balanced reaction is:
−
MnO
−
4
+ 8 H + 5 Fe
+ 2 +
→Mn 2 +
+4H 2
O + 5 Fe 3 +
We write the oxygen term in the reactants because it is stated that the solution is allowed to stand in air.
We just have to analyze the possible products that can be formed and we can see that the hydrogen from nitric acid can combine with oxygen
gas to form water and then combining everything together, we get the final reaction to be:
4 Fe(NO ) (aq)
3 2
+ 4 HNO 3
(aq) +O 2
(g) →2H 2
O(l) + 4 Fe(NO 3
) (aq)
3
The Fe 2 +
ion switches spots with the H ion to form Fe(ClO +
4
)
2
as a product.
When the H ion is added to the (CO
+
3
)
2 −
ion, H 2
CO
3
is formed.
After balancing the coefficients, the final reaction is:
FeCO (s)
3
+ HClO 4
(aq) → Fe(ClO 4
) (aq)
2
+H 2
O(l) + CO 2
(g)
19.E.1.58: A19.1.21
a. 3 Fe(s) + 4 H O(g) ⟶ Fe
2 3
O (s) + 4 H (g)
4 2
;
H2 O
b. 3 NaOH(aq) + Fe(NO 3
) (aq) −
3
−→ Fe(OH) (s) + 3 Na
3
+
(aq) + 3 NO3 (aq)
−
;
2
3 +
+ 2 −
d. Fe(s) + (2 H O) (aq) + (SO ) (aq) → Fe (aq) + SO (aq) + H (g) + 2 H
3 4
2 + 2 −
4 2 2
O(l)
19.E.1.59: Q19.1.22
Balance the following equations by oxidation-reduction methods; note that three elements change oxidation state.
Co (NO ) (s) ⟶ Co O (s) + NO (g) + O (g) (19.E.60)
3 2 2 3 2 2
19.E.1.60: S19.1.22
Balance the following equations by oxidation-reduction methods; note that three elements change oxidation state.
In this reaction, N changes oxidation states from +5 to +4 (reduced), Co changes oxidation states from +2 to +3 (oxidized), and O changes
oxidation states from -2 to 0 (also oxidized).
First, split this reaction into an oxidation and reduction half reaction set, and balance all of the elements that are not hydrogen or oxygen (we
will deal with these later):
Reduction : 2C o(N O3 )2 → C o2 O3 + 4N O2 (19.E.62)
Now, for the oxidation reaction, we are only dealing with O2 on the products side. In order to balance this, we will need to add water and
hydrogen to both sides:
+
Oxidation : 2 H2 O → O2 + 4 H (19.E.63)
Balance the amount of oxygens on each side by adding the correct number of water molecules (H2O), and balance the amount of hydrogen by
adding the correct number of H+ atoms:
+
Reduction : 2 H + 2C o(N O3 )2 → C o2 O3 + 4N O2 + H2 O (19.E.64)
+
Oxidation : 2 H2 O → O2 + 4 H (19.E.65)
Finally, balance the charges by adding electrons to each side of the equation. For the reduction reaction, we will add 2 electrons to balance out
the 2H+, and to the oxidation reaction, we will add 4 electrons to balance out the 4H+. Remember, the goal of this step is to make sure that the
charges are balanced, so we can cancel them out in the end.
− +
Reduction : 2 e + 2H + 2C o(N O3 )2 → C o2 O3 + 4N O2 + H2 O (19.E.66)
+ −
Oxidation : 2 H2 O → O2 + 4 H + 4e (19.E.67)
Multiply the reduction reaction by two, in order to balance the charges so there are 4 electrons on each side of the reaction.
− +
Reduction : 2(2 e + 2H + 2C o(N O3 )2 → C o2 O3 + 4N O2 + H2 O) (19.E.68)
Both sides have overall charges of 0 and can be checked to see if they are balanced.
19.E.1.61: A19.1.22
4C o(N O3 )2 (s) → 2C O2 O3 (s) + 8N O2 (g) + O2 (g) (19.E.71)
19.E.1.62: Q19.1.23
Dilute sodium cyanide solution is slowly dripped into a slowly stirred silver nitrate solution. A white precipitate forms temporarily but
dissolves as the addition of sodium cyanide continues. Use chemical equations to explain this observation. Silver cyanide is similar to silver
chloride in its solubility.
− + −
This can be written out in the following way: as CN is added, the silver and the cyanide combine : Ag (aq)+CN (aq)→AgCN (s)
As more CN- is added the silver and two cyanide combine to create a more stable compound: Ag+(aq)+2CN−(aq)→[Ag(CN)2]- (aq)
AgCN(s) + CN- (aq) → [Ag(CN)2]- (aq)
19.E.1.64: A19.1.23
As CN− is added,
+ −
Ag (aq) + CN (aq) ⟶ AgCN(s) (19.E.73)
−
As more CN is added,
+ − −
Ag (aq) + 2 CN (aq) ⟶ [Ag (CN) ] (aq) (19.E.74)
2
− −
AgCN(s) + CN (aq) ⟶ [Ag (CN) ] (aq) (19.E.75)
2
19.E.1.65: Q19.1.24
Predict which will be more stable, [CrO4]2− or [WO4]2−, and explain.
19.E.1.66: S19.1.24
According to the rules associated with Crystal Field Stabilizing Energies, stable molecules contain more electrons in the lower-energy
molecular orbitals than in the high-energy molecular orbitals. In this case, both complexes have O4 as ligands, and both have a -2 charge.
Therefore, you determine stability by comparing the metals. Chromium is in the 3d orbital, according to the periodic table. Tungsten (W) is in
the 5d orbital. 3d is a lower energy level than 5d.Higher-level orbitals are more easily ionized, and make their base elemental form more stable.
If the elemental form is more stable the oxidized form is less stable. Therefore, [CrO4]2− is more stable than [WO4]2−.
19.E.1.67: A19.1.24
[CrO4]2- is more stable because Chromium is in the 3d orbital while Tungsten is in the 4d orbital, which has a higher energy level and makes it
less stable.
19.E.1.68: Q19.1.25
Give the oxidation state of the metal for each of the following oxides of the first transition series. (Hint: Oxides of formula M3O4 are examples
of mixed valence compounds in which the metal ion is present in more than one oxidation state. It is possible to write these compound formulas
in the equivalent format MO·M2O3, to permit estimation of the metal’s two oxidation states.)
a. Sc2O3
b. TiO2
c. V2O5
d. CrO3
e. MnO2
f. Fe3O4
g. Co3O4
h. NiO
19.E.1.69: S19.1.25
The first step to solving this problem is looking at the rules of Oxidizing states for various elements:
chem.libretexts.org/Core/Analytical_Chemistry/Electrochemistry/Redox_Chemistry/Oxidation_State
The main rules that will be used in these problems will be the oxidation state rule 6 which states that oxidation state for Oxygen is (-2) and rule
2 which is that the total sum of the oxidation state of all atoms in any given species is equal to the net charge on that species. Solving these
problems requires simple algebra. The oxidation states of both elements in the compound is equal to zero, so set the unknown oxidation of the
element that is not oxygen to a variable x, and the oxidation state of Oxygen equal to −2. Then multiply both oxygen states by the number of
atoms of the element present. Add the values together, set the equation equal to zero and solve for x.
1. Sc O = 3(−2) + 2x = 0 ⟶ −6 + 2x = 0 ⟶ x = Sc = +3 Sc
2 3
3+
2. TiO = 2(−2) + x = 0 ⟶ −4 + x = 0 ⟶ x = T i = +4 T i
2
4+
3. V O = 5(−2) + 2x = 0 ⟶ −10 + 2x = 0 ⟶ x = V = +5 V
2 5
5+
4. CrO = 3(−2) + x = 0 ⟶ −6 + x = 0 ⟶ x = C r = +6 C r
3
6+
5. MnO = 2(−2) + x = 0 ⟶ −4 + x = 0 ⟶ x = M n = +4 M n
2
4+
6. Fe O = FeO ⋅ Fe O =
3 4 2 3
2+
FeO = −2 + x = 0 ⟶ x = F e = +2 Fe
3=
Fe O = 3(−2) + 2x = 0 ⟶ −6 + 2x = 0 ⟶ x = F e = +3 Fe
2 3
(One Fe Atom has an oxidation state of +2 and the other 2 Fe atoms have an oxidation state of +3)
7. Co 3
O
4
= CoO ⋅ Co O
2 3
=
2+
CoO = −2 + x = 0 ⟶ x = C o = +2 Co
3+
Co O = 3(−2) + 2x = 0 ⟶ −6 + 2x = 0 ⟶ x = C o = +3 Co
2 3
(One Co Atom has an oxidation state of +2 and the other 2 Co atoms have an oxidation state of +3)
8. NiO = −2 + x = 0 ⟶ x = N i = +2 Ni
2+
9. Cu 2
O = −2 + 2x = 0 ⟶ −2 + 2x = 0 ⟶ x = C u = +1 Cu
1+
19.E.1.70: A19.1.25
Sc3+; Ti4+; V5+; Cr6+; Mn4+; Fe2+ and Fe3+; Co2+ and Co3+; Ni2+; Cu+
19.E.2.2: S19.2.1
First we must identify whether or not the ligand has more than one bonded atom (bidentate/polydentate). Using the table below we are able to
do this.
Now that we have identified the number of bonded atoms from each ligand, we can find the total number of atoms bonded to the central metal
ion, giving us the coordination number.
a. : We can identify the metal ion in the complex as Pt, platinum, as the other two are listed as ligands above and are
[P t(H2 O)2 Br2 ]
nonmetallic. We can now use the number of ligands and their bonding atoms to find its coordination number. From the table above we see
that H2O has only one bonding atom and Br as well. So for each Br atom we have one bonding atom, and we have two of these, yielding 2
bonding atoms; this is the same for H2O, giving us a total number of 4 bonding atoms, and therefore a coordination number of 4.
b. [P t(N H )(py)(C l)(Br)] (py = pyridine, C5H5N): The metal ion in this complex, similarly to the first one, can be identified as Pt,
3
platinum. The ligands can be identified as NH3, pyridine, Cl, and Br, which are all monodentate ligands and have one bonding atom each.
Since we have four ligands, each with one bonding atom, the total number of bonding atoms on the metal ion is 4, therefore the complex has
a coordination number of 4.
c. [Zn(N H ) C l ]: The metal ion in this complex can be identified as Zn, zinc, and the ligands can be identified as NH3 and Cl. Since these
3 2 2
two are both monodentate ligands they have one bonding atom each. Since we have a total of two NH3 and two Cl ligands, we get a total of
four monodentate ligands, giving us 4 bonding atoms and a coordination number of 4.
d. [Zn(N H )(py)(C l)(Br)]: The metal ion in this complex can be identified as Zn, zinc, and the ligands can be identified as NH3, pyridine,
3
Cl, and Br, which are all monodentate ligands and have one bonding atom each. Since we have four ligands, each with one bonding atom,
the total number of bonding atoms on the metal ion is 4, therefore the complex has a coordination number of 4.
e. [N i(H O) C l ]: The metal ion in this complex can be identified as Ni, nickel, and we can now use the number of ligands and their
2 4 2
bonding atoms to find its coordination number. From the table above we see that H2O has only one bonding atom and Cl as well. So for
each Cl atom we have one bonding atom, and we have two of these, yielding 2 bonding atoms. H2O is the same, having only one bonding
atom, but there are four of these. So this gives us a total number of 6 bonding atoms, and therefore a coordination number of 6.
f. [F e(en) (C N ) ] (en = ethylenediamine, C2H8N2): The metal ion in this complex can be identified as Fe, iron, and the ligands can be
2 2
+
identified as (en) and CN. Since (en) is bidentate, meaning it has 2 bonding atoms, and there are two of these, the total number of bonding
atoms from (en) is four. Since CN is monodentate, meaning it has one bonding atom, and there are two of these, the total number of bonding
atoms from CN ligand is two. So, the total number of bonding atoms is 6, therefore the complex has a coordination number of 6.
19.E.2.3: A19.2.1
a. The 2 aqua and the 2 bromo ligands form a total of 4 coordinate covalent bonds and as a result the coordination number is 4.
b. The ammine, pyridine, chloro and bromo each form one coordinate covalent bond that gives a total of 4 and hence CN=4.
c. Two ammine and two chloro ligands give a total of 4 coordinate covalent bonds and a CN = 4.
d. One ammine, a pyrimidine, a chloro and a bromo ligand give a total of 4 covalent bonds, resulting in CN = 4.
e. Four aqua ligands and two chloro ligands form a total of 6 coordinate covalent bonds and a CN =6.
f. Ethylenediamine is a bidentate ligand that forms two coordinate covalent bonds; along with two cyano ligands, it forms a total of 6
bonds, and hence has a CN=6.
19.E.2.4: Q19.2.2
Give the coordination numbers and write the formulas for each of the following, including all isomers where appropriate:
a. tetrahydroxozincate(II) ion (tetrahedral)
b. hexacyanopalladate(IV) ion
c. dichloroaurate ion (note that aurum is Latin for "gold")
d. diamminedichloroplatinum(II)
e. potassium diamminetetrachlorochromate(III)
f. hexaamminecobalt(III) hexacyanochromate(III)
g. dibromobis(ethylenediamine) cobalt(III) nitrate
19.E.2.5: S19.2.2
To determine coordination numbers we must count the total number of ligands bonded to the central metal and distinguish monodentate and
polydentate ligands. To determine the formulas, we use the nomenclature rules and work backwards.
1. "tetrahydroxo" = 4 hydroxide ligands; since hydroxide is a monodentate ligand, we have a total of 4 bonds to the central metal.
Coordination Number: 4
We review the basics of nomenclature and see that "tetra" = 4 and "hydroxo" = OH-. Since the charge on zinc is 2+, which is given in the
nomenclature by the Roman numerals, we can calculate the total charge on the complex to be 2-.
Formula: [Zn(OH)4]2−
19.E.2.6: A19.2.2
a. 4, [Zn(OH)4]2−;
b. 6, [Pd(CN)6]2−;
c. 2, [AuCl2]−;
d. 4, [Pt(NH3)2Cl2];
e. 6, K[Cr(NH3)2Cl4];
f. 6, [Co(NH3)6][Cr(CN)6];
g. 6, [Co(en)2Br2]NO3
19.E.2.7: Q19.2.3
Give the coordination number for each metal ion in the following compounds:
a. [Co(CO3)3]3− (note that CO32− is bidentate in this complex)
b. [Cu(NH3)4]2+
c. [Co(NH3)4Br2]2(SO4)3
d. [Pt(NH3)4][PtCl4]
e. [Cr(en)3](NO3)3
f. [Pd(NH3)2Br2] (square planar)
g. K3[Cu(Cl)5]
h. [Zn(NH3)2Cl2]
Q19.2.4
Sketch the structures of the following complexes. Indicate any cis, trans, and optical isomers.
a. [Pt(H2O)2Br2] (square planar)
b. [Pt(NH3)(py)(Cl)(Br)] (square planar, py = pyridine, C5H5N)
c. [Zn(NH3)3Cl]+ (tetrahedral)
d. [Pt(NH3)3Cl]+ (square planar)
e. [Ni(H2O)4Cl2]
f. [Co(C2O4)2Cl2]3− (note that C O is the bidentate oxalate ion, −O
2
2−
4 2
−
CCO
2
)
19.E.2.9: S19.2.4
Cis and trans are a type of geometric isomer, meaning there is a difference in the orientation in which the ligands are attached to the central
metal. In cis, two of the same ligands are adjacent to one another and in trans, two of the same ligands are directly across from one another.
Optical isomers → have the ability to rotate light, optical isomers are also chiral. Only chiral complexes have optical isomers
Chiral → asymmetric, structure of its mirror image is not superimposable
Enantiomers: chiral optical isomers (compound can have multiple enantiomers)
Tetrahedral complex with 4 distinct ligands → always chiral
For tetrahedral, if 2 ligands are the same, then it cannot be chiral, has a plane of symmetry
Solutions:
a. [P t(H2 O)2 Br2 ] (square planar)
This complex has 2 kinds of ligands. The matching ligands can either be adjacent to each other and be cis, or they can be across from each
other and be trans.
b. [P t(N H 3 )(py)(C l)(Br)] (square planar, py = pyridine, C 5 H5 N )
This complex has 4 different ligands. There is no plane of symmetry in any of the enantiomers, making the structures chiral and therefore has
optical isomers.
c. [Zn(N H 3 )3 C l]
+
(tetrahedral)
There is a plane of symmetry from N H through Zn to the other N H , therefore it is not chiral.
3 3
d. [P t(N H +
3 )3 C l] (square planar)
There is a plane of symmetry from N H through P t to the other N H , therefore it is not chiral.
3 3
The C l ligands can either be right next to each other, or directly across from one another allowing for both cis and trans geometries.
f. [C o(C2 O4 )2 C l2 ]
−
3 (note that C
2 O4
−
2 is the bidentate oxalate ion, −
O2 C C O
−
There is a plane of symmetry from C l through Co to the other C l in a "trans" chlorine configuration, therefore it is not chiral in a chlorine
"trans" configuration. However, there is no symmetry in the chlorine "cis" configuration, indicating multiple "cis" isomers.
19.E.2.10: A19.2.4
a. [Pt(H2O)2Br2]:
b. [Pt(NH3)(py)(Cl)(Br)]:
c. [Zn(NH3)3Cl]+ :
d. [Pt(NH3)3Cl]+ :
e. [Ni(H2O)4Cl2]:
f. [Co(C2O4)2Cl2]3−:
19.E.2.12: S19.2.5
We are instructed to draw all geometric isomers and optical isomers for the specified compound. Optical isomers exist when an isomer
configuration is not superimposable on its mirror image. This means there are two distinct molecular shapes. Often a left and right hand are
cited as an example; if you were to take your right hand and place it upon your left, you cannot make the major parts of your hand align on top
of one another. The basic idea when deciding whether something is optically active is to look for a plane of symmetry--if you are able to bisect
a compound in a manner that establishes symmetry, then the compound does not have an optical isomer.
Cis isomers exist when there are 2 ligands of the same species placed at 90 degree angles from each other. Trans isomers exist when there are 2
ligands of the same species placed at 180 degree angles from each other.
Problem 1
This compound is an octahedral molecule, so the six ligands (atoms in the complex that are not the central transition metal) are placed around
the central atom at 90 degree angles. Two optical isomers exist for [Co(en)2(NO2)Cl]+. The second isomer is drawn by taking the mirror image
of the first.
Problem 2
This compound is also an octahedral molecule. Two cis (optical) isomers and one trans isomer exist for [Co(en)2Cl2]+. The trans isomer can be
drawn by placing the chlorine ligands in positions where they form a 180 degree angle with the central atom. The first cis isomer can be drawn
by placing the chlorine ligands in positions where they form a 90 degree angle with the central atom. The second cis isomer can be found by
mirroring the first cis isomer, like we did in problem 1.
Problem 3
This compound is also an octahedral molecule. One trans isomer and one cis isomer of [Pt(NH3)2Cl4] exist. The trans isomer can be drawn by
placing the ammonia ligands in positions where they form a 180 degree angle with the central atom. The cis isomer can be drawn by placing
the ammonia ligands in positions where they form a 90 degree angle with the central atom.
Problem 4
This compound is also an octahedral molecule. Two optical isomers for [Cr(en)3]3+ exist. The second optical isomer can be drawn by taking the
mirror image of the first optical isomer.
19.E.2.13: Q19.2.6
Name each of the compounds or ions given in Exercise Q19.2.3, including the oxidation state of the metal.
19.E.2.14: S19.2.6
Rules to follow for coordination complexes
1. Cations are always named before the anions.
2. Ligands are named before the metal atom or ion.
3. Ligand names are modified with an ‐o added to the root name of an anion. For neutral ligands the name of the molecule is used, with the
exception of OH2, NH3, CO and NO.
4. The prefixes mono‐, di‐, tri‐, tetra‐, penta‐, and hexa‐ are used to denote the number of simple ligands.
5. The prefixes bis‐, tris‐, tetrakis‐, etc., are used for more complicated ligands or ones that already contain di‐, tri‐, etc.
6. The oxidation state of the central metal ion is designated by a Roman numeral in parentheses.
7. When more than one type of ligand is present, they are named alphabetically. Prefixes do not affect the order.
8. If the complex ion has a negative charge, the suffix –ate is added to the name of the metal.
9. In the case of complex‐ion isomerism the names cis, trans, fac, or mer may precede the formula of the complex‐ion name to indicate the
spatial arrangement of the ligands. Cis means the ligands occupy adjacent coordination positions, and trans means opposite positions just as
they do for organic compounds. The complexity of octahedral complexes allows for two additional geometric isomers that are peculiar to
coordination complexes. Fac means facial, or that the three like ligands occupy the vertices of one face of the octahedron. Mer means
meridional, or that the three like ligands occupy the vertices of a triangle one side of which includes the central metal atom or ion.
19.E.2.15: A19.2.6
a. tricarbonatocobaltate(III) ion;
b. tetraaminecopper(II) ion;
c. tetraaminedibromocobalt(III) sulfate;
d. tetraamineplatinum(II) tetrachloroplatinate(II);
e. tris-(ethylenediamine)chromium(III) nitrate;
f. diaminedibromopalladium(II);
g. potassium pentachlorocuprate(II);
h. diaminedichlorozinc(II)
19.E.2.16: Q19.2.7
Name each of the compounds or ions given in Exercise Q19.2.5.
S19.2.7
Given:
19.E.2.17: A19.2.7
1. Chlorobis(ethylenediamine)nitrocobalt(III)
2. Dichlorobis(Ethylenediamine)cobalt(III)
3. Diamminetetrachloroplatinum(IV)
4. Tris(ethylenediamine)cromium(III)
5. Diamminedichloroplatinum(II)
19.E.2.18: Q19.2.8
Specify whether the following complexes have isomers.
a. tetrahedral [Ni(CO)2(Cl)2]
b. trigonal bipyramidal [Mn(CO)4NO]
c. [Pt(en)2Cl2]Cl2
19.E.2.19: S19.2.8
Isomers are compounds that have the same number of atoms, but have different structures. Structural isomers (linkage, ionization,
coordination) and stereoisomers (geometric and optical) can occur with several compounds.
1. tetrahedral [Ni(CO) 2 (Cl )2 ]
(Fig 1.) In this model, nickel is the dark green central atom, carbonyl ligands are the pink atom, and chloro ligands are the light green atoms.
Immediately, we can cancel out the possibility of linkage, ionization, and coordination isomers. There are no other coordination complexes for
coordination isomerism, there is no ligand that can bond to the atom in more than one way for it to exhibit linkage isomerism, and there are no
ions outside the coordination sphere for ionization isomerism.
This is a tetrahedral structure which immediately rules out any geometric isomers since they require 90° and/or 180° bond angles. Tetrahedral
structures have 109.5° angles.
To confirm that the structure has no optical isomer, we must determine if there is a plane of symmetry. Structures that have no plane of
symmetry are considered chiral and would have optical isomers.
(Fig 2.) We can rotate the structure and find that there is indeed a plane of symmetry through the two chloro ligands and central atom and
between the carbonyl ligands.
Since there is a plane of symmetry, we can conclude that there are no optical isomers.
(Fig 3.) The central purple atom is manganese, the carbonyl ligands are the pink atoms, and the nitrosyl ligand is the fuschia atom.
There are no ions, other coordination complex, and ambidentate ligands. Therefore, no structural isomers exist for this structure.
Geometric isomers do not exist for this compound because there is only one nitrosyl ligand.
(Fig 4.) Dashed line bisects molecule and shows plane of symmetry. The molecule is rotated in this image.
In the image above, after the structure has been rotated, we can see that there is a plane of symmetry. Thus, there are no optical isomers.
No isomers (the ones mentioned above) exist for this compound.
3. [Pt(en)2 C l2 ]C l2
(Fig 5.) The green atoms are the chloro ligands, the the central atom is platinum, and the grey/blue atoms are ethyldiamine ligands.
Coordination isomerism cannot exist for this complex because there are no other complexes. There are no linkage isomers because there are no
ambidentate ligands. Ionization isomers cannot exist in this complex either, even though there is a neutral molecule outside the coordination
sphere. If we exchange Cl with one ethyldiamine molecule, There would be 5 ligands in the coordination sphere instead of 4. This difference
2
in the ratio of metal atom to ligands means that an ionization isomer cannot exist.
(Fig 6.) Here, one chloro ligand exchanged places with the ethyldiamine so that it can be at a 90° angle with the other chloro ligand.
The image above, shows the chloro and ethyldiamine ligands at a 90° angle with its other identical ligand. This is the cis isomer, while Fig. 5
shows the trans isomer.
Fig 5. shows that there is a plane of symmetry in the trans isomer. Therefore, that structure does not have an optical isomer. On the other hand,
the cis isomer does not have a plane of symmetry and therefore has an optical isomer.
19.E.2.21: Q19.2.9
Predict whether the carbonate ligand CO 2−
3
will coordinate to a metal center as a monodentate, bidentate, or tridentate ligand.
19.E.2.22: S19.2.9
2
CO3 − can be either monodentate or bidentate, since two of its oxygen atoms have lone pairs as shown above and can form covalent bonds
with a transition metal ion. In most cases carbonate is monodentate because of its trigonal planar geometry (there is 120 degrees between the
oxygens so it's hard for both to bind to the same metal). However, in some cases it will bind to two different metals, making it bidentate.
19.E.2.23: A19.2.9
CO3-2 will coordinate to a metal center as a monodentate ligand.
19.E.2.24: Q19.2.10
Draw the geometric, linkage, and ionization isomers for [CoCl5CN][CN].
19.E.2.25: S19.2.10
Isomers are compounds with same formula but different atom arrangement. There are two subcategories: structural isomers, which are
isomers that contain the same number of atoms of each kind but differ in which atoms are bonded to one another, and stereoisomers, isomers
that have the same molecular formula and ligands, but differ in the arrangement of those ligands in 3D space.
There are three subcategories under structural isomers: ionization isomers, which are isomers that are identical except for a ligand has
exchanging places with an anion or neutral molecule that was originally outside the coordination complex; coordination isomers, isomers that
have an interchange of some ligands from the cationic part to the anionic part; and linkage isomers, in two or more coordination compounds in
which the donor atom of at least one of the ligands is different.
There are also two main kinds of stereoisomers: geometric isomers, metal complexes that differ only in which ligands are adjacent to one
another (cis) or directly across from one another (trans) in the coordination sphere of the metal, and optical isomers, which occurs when the
mirror image of an object is non-superimposable on the original object.
Some of the isomers look almost identical, but that is because the CN ligand can be attached by both (but not at the same time) the C or N.
19.E.2.26: A19.2.10
19.E.3.2: S19.3.1
The crystal field theory is is a model that describes the breaking of degeneracies of electron orbital states, usually d or f orbitals, due to a
static electric field produced by a surrounding charge distribution.
The degenerate d-orbitals split into two levels, e and t , in the presence of ligands.
g 2g
The energy difference between the two levels is called the crystal-field splitting energy, Δ . ∘
After 1 electron each has been filled in the three t orbitals, the filling of the fourth electron takes place either in the e orbital or in the t ,
2g g 2g
where the electrons pair up. depending on whether the complex is high spin or low spin.
If the Δ value of a ligand is less than the pairing energy (P), then the electrons enter the e orbital, but if the Δ value of a ligand is more
∘ g ∘
than the pairing energy (P), then the electrons enter the t orbital.
2g
when the is less than the pairing energy, the electrons prefer then eg orbitals because there is not enough energy to pair the electrons
together. It will be high spin
when the is more then the pairing energy, the electrons prefer the t2g because there is enough energy to pair the electrons. It will be low
spin.
Step 1: Determine the oxidation state of the Fe
For [F e(N O ) ] and [F eF ] , both N O and F have a charge of -1. Since there is 6 of them then that means the charge is -6 and in
2 6
3−
6
3−
2 6
2
−
3−
[F eF6 ]
19.E.3.3: A19.3.1
[Fe(NO2)6]3−:1 electron
[FeF6]3−:5 electrons
19.E.3.4: Q19.3.2
Draw the crystal field diagrams for [Fe(NO2)6]4− and [FeF6]2−. State whether each complex is high spin or low spin, paramagnetic or
diamagnetic, and compare Δoct to P for each complex.
19.E.3.5: S19.3.2
a)
−4
[F e(N O2 )6 ] (19.E.76)
NO2- has a -1 charge. The overall ion has a -4 charge, therefore Fe must be +2 charge. (The math:
x + (6)(−1) = −4, x + −6 = −4, x = +2 or 2+(6*-1)=-4)
F- has a -1 charge. The overall ion has a -3 charge, therefore Fe must be +3 charge. (The math:
x + (−1)(6) = −3, x + −6 = −3, x = +3 or 3+(6*-1)=-3)
19.E.3.6: A19.3.2
19.E.3.7: Q19.3.3
Give the oxidation state of the metal, number of d electrons, and the number of unpaired electrons predicted for [Co(NH3)6]Cl3.
oxidation state of Co = +3 (19.E.79)
3+
So the oxidation state of Co is +3. Now we need to identify the number of d-electrons in the Co ion. The electron configuration for cobalt
that has no charge is
2 7
[Ar]4 s 3 d (19.E.80)
3+
However, a Co ion has 3 less electrons than its neutral counterpart and has an electron configuration of
6
[Ar]3d (19.E.81)
For transition metals, the s electrons are lost first. So cobalt loses its two 4s electrons first and then loses a single 3d electron meaning Co3+ ion
has 6 d electrons. To predict the number of unpaired electrons, we must first determine if the complex is high spin or low spin. Whether the
complex is high spin or low spin is determined by the ligand in the coordinate complex. Specifically, the ligand must be identified as either a
weak-field ligand or a strong-field ligand based on the spectrochemical series. Weak-field ligands induce high spin while strong-field ligands
induce low spin. We can then construct the energy diagram or crystal field diagram of the designated spin that has the proper electron placings.
The geometric shape of the compound must also be identified to construct the correct diagram. Finally, from this crystal field diagram we can
determine the number of unpaired electrons. The number of electrons in the diagram is equal to the number of d electrons of the metal. The
ligand in this case is NH3, which is a strong field ligand according to the spectrochemical series. This means that the complex is low spin.
Additionally, six monodentate ligands means the ligand field is octahedral. The number of electrons that will be in the diagram is 6 since the
metal ion Co3+ has 6 d electrons. Now the proper crystal field diagram can be constructed.
From the crystal field diagram, we can tell that the complex has no unpaired electrons.
19.E.3.9: A19.3.3
a) 3+
b) 6 d electrons
c) No unpaired electrons
19.E.3.10: Q19.3.4
The solid anhydrous solid CoCl2 is blue in color. Because it readily absorbs water from the air, it is used as a humidity indicator to monitor if
equipment (such as a cell phone) has been exposed to excessive levels of moisture. Predict what product is formed by this reaction, and how
many unpaired electrons this complex will have.
19.E.3.11: S19.3.4
From our knowledge of ligands and coordination compounds (or if you need a refresher Coordination Compounds), we can assume the product
of CoCl2 in water. H2O is a common weak field ligand that forms six ligand bonds around the central Cobalt atom while the Chloride stays on
the outer sphere. We can use this to determine the complex:
[C o(H2 O)6 ]C l2
From this formation, we can use the Crystal Field Theory (CFT)(Crystal Field Theory) to determine the number of unpaired electrons. This
coordination compound has six ligand bonds attached to the central atom which means the CFT model will follow the octahedral splitting.
19.E.3.12: A19.3.4
[Co(H2O)6]Cl2 with three unpaired electrons.
19.E.3.13: Q19.3.5
Is it possible for a complex of a metal in the transition series to have six unpaired electrons? Explain.
19.E.3.14: A19.3.5
Is it possible for a complex of a metal in the transition series to have six unpaired electrons? Explain.
It is not possible for a metal in the transition series to have six unpaired electrons. This is because transition metals have a general electron
configuration of (n-1)d1-10 ns1-2 where n is the quantum number. The last electron will go into the d orbital which has 5 orbitals that can each
contain 2 electrons, yielding 10 electrons total. According to Hund's Rule, electrons prefer to fill each orbital singly before they pair up. This is
more energetically favorable. Since there are only 5 orbitals and due to Hund's Rule, the maximum number of unpaired electrons a transition
metal can have is 5. Therefore, there cannot be a complex of a transition metal that has 6 unpaired electrons.
For example, lets look at iron's electron configuration. Iron has an electron configuration of 1s22s22p63s23p64s23d6. Now the most important
orbital to look at is the d orbital which has 6 electrons in it, but there are only 4 unpaired electrons as you can see by this diagram:
3d: [↿⇂] [↿] [↿][↿][↿]
Each [ ] represents an orbital within the d orbital. This diagram follows Hund's rule and shows why no transition metal can have 6 unpaired
electrons.
19.E.3.15: Q19.3.6
How many unpaired electrons are present in each of the following?
a. [CoF6]3− (high spin)
b. [Mn(CN)6]3− (low spin)
c. [Mn(CN)6]4− (low spin)
d. [MnCl6]4− (high spin)
e. [RhCl6]3− (low spin)
19.E.3.16: S19.3.6
1. For [CoF6]3-, we first found the oxidation state of Co, which is 3+ since F has a 1- charge and since there is 6 F, Co's charge has to be 3+ for
the overall charge to be 3-.
charge of Co + -6 = -6 (19.E.82)
charge of Co = +3 (19.E.83)
After finding the oxidation state, I then go to the periodic table to find its electron configuration: [Ar]3d6
We distribute the 6 d-orbital electrons along the complex and since it is high spin, the electrons is distributed once in each energy level before it
is paired. There is only one pair and the other 4 electrons are unpaired, making the answer 4.
charge of Mn + -6 = -3 (19.E.84)
charge of Mn = +3 (19.E.85)
There is a difference between this and number 1. This is low spin so instead of distributing one electron in each level before pairing it, I must
distribute one electron on the bottom and then pair them all up before I'm able to move to the top portion. So since there is 4, there is only a pair
at dyz and the other two electrons are unpaired. Making the number of unpaired electrons 2.
3.The same process as number 2 is applied. The only difference is that the charge of Mn is now 2+ so the electron configuration: [Ar]3d5.
charge of Mn + -6 = -4 (19.E.86)
charge of Mn = +2 (19.E.87)
Since is it low spin like number 2, I only need to add an extra electron to the next level, making that 2 pairs of electron and only 1 electron
unpaired.
4. Since Cl has a -1 charge like CN, Mn's charge is also 2+ with the same electron configuration as number 3, which is 5.
charge of Mn + -6 = -4 (19.E.88)
charge of Mn = +2 (19.E.89)
With 5 electrons, this is high spin instead of low. So as stated in number 1, we pair distribute the electrons on all levels first. Since there are 5
electrons and 5 levels and they are al distributed, there are zero pairs, making that 5 unpaired electrons.
charge of Mn = +3 (19.E.91)
With a low spin and 6 electrons, all electrons are paired up, making it 0 electrons that are unpaired.
19.E.3.17: A19.3.6
4; 2; 1; 5; 0
19.E.3.18: Q19.3.7
Explain how the diphosphate ion, [O3P−O−PO3]4−, can function as a water softener that prevents the precipitation of Fe2+ as an insoluble iron
salt.
19.E.3.19: S19.3.7
The diphosphate ion, [O3P−O−PO3]4− can function as a water softener keeping the iron in a water soluble form because of its more negative
electrochemical potential than water's. This is similar to the way plating prevents metals from reacting with oxygen to corrode.
Mineral deposits are formed by ionic reactions. The Fe2+ will form an insoluble iron salt of iron(III) oxide-hydroxide when a salt of ferric iron
hydrolyzes water. However, with the addition of [O3P−O−PO3]4−, the Fe2+ cations are more attracted to the PO3 group, forming a Fe(PO3)
complex.
The excess minerals in this type of water is considered hard thus its name hard water.
19.E.3.20: Q19.3.8
For complexes of the same metal ion with no change in oxidation number, the stability increases as the number of electrons in the t2g orbitals
increases. Which complex in each of the following pairs of complexes is more stable?
a. [Fe(H2O)6]2+ or [Fe(CN)6]4−
b. [Co(NH3)6]3+ or [CoF6]3−
c. [Mn(CN)6]4− or [MnCl6]4−
19.E.3.21: S19.3.8
The Spectrochemical Series is as follows
− − − − − − − − −
I < Br < SC N ≈ Cl <F < OH < ON O < ox < H2 O < SC N < EDT A < N H3 < en < N O (19.E.92)
2
< CN
The strong field ligands (on the right) are low spin which fills in more electrons in the t2g orbitals. The weak field ligands (on the left) are high
spin so it can fill electrons in the t2g orbitals and eg orbitals. In conclusion, more electrons are filled up from the strong field ligands because
a. [F e(C N ) 6]
4−
CN is a stronger ligand than H 2O so it is low spin, which fills up the t2g orbitals.
b. [C o(N H 3+
3 )6 ]
For more information regarding the shape of the complex and d-electron configuration, libretext provides more information on how to classify
high and low spin complexes.
19.E.3.22: A19.3.8
[Fe(CN)6]4−; [Co(NH3)6]3+; [Mn(CN)6]4−
19.E.3.23: Q19.3.9
Trimethylphosphine, P(CH3)3, can act as a ligand by donating the lone pair of electrons on the phosphorus atom. If trimethylphosphine is added
to a solution of nickel(II) chloride in acetone, a blue compound that has a molecular mass of approximately 270 g and contains 21.5% Ni,
26.0% Cl, and 52.5% P(CH3)3 can be isolated. This blue compound does not have any isomeric forms. What are the geometry and molecular
formula of the blue compound?
19.E.3.24: S19.3.9
1)Find the empirical formula. There is a total of 270 grams. To find out how many grams of each element/compound there are,
multiply the percentage by the mass (270).
Now that we have the grams of each element/compound, we can convert them to moles by using their molar mass.
1mol.
(58.055gN i)( ) = 0.989mol. N i (19.E.96)
58.69gN i
1mol.
(70.2gC l)( ) = 1.98mol. C l (19.E.97)
35.45gC l
1mol.
(141.75gP (C H3 )3 )( ) = 1.86mol. P (C H3 )3 (19.E.98)
76.07gP (C H3 )3
Now that we have the moles of all elements/compounds, we can find the ratio of all them to each other. To do this, we take the
element/compound with the least amount of moles and divide all element/compound moles by this amount. In this case, Ni has the
least number of moles.
0.989mol. N i
=1 (19.E.99)
0.989mol. N i
1.98mol. C l
= approx.2 (19.E.100)
0.989mol. N i
1.86mol. P (C H3 )3
= approx.2 (19.E.101)
0.989mol. N i
19.E.3.25: A19.3.9
a) NiCl(P(CH3)3)2
b) Tetrahedral
19.E.3.26: Q19.3.10
Would you expect the complex [Co(en)3]Cl3 to have any unpaired electrons? Any isomers?
19.E.3.27: S19.3.10
Assign oxidation states to each element. Cl- has a -1 oxidation state. En is neutral, so 0. The entire complex is also neutral, so in order to
balance the charges out, Co must be +3 because there are 3 chlorides, which gives a -3 charge.
STEP 2:
Write the electron configuration for C o3+
. [Ar]3d . There are 6 electrons.
6
STEP 3:
Check where en lies on the spectrochemical series. Does it have a strong field strength? It does, so these electrons will exist at the d-level with
high splitting energy because the magnitude of the pairing energy is less than the crystal field splitting energy in the octahedral field.
You will the notice that there aren't any unpaired electrons when you draw the Crystal Field Theory (CFT) diagram.
This complex does not have any geometric isomers because cis-trans structures cannot be formed. The mirror image is nonsuperimpoasable,
which means the enantiomers are chiral molecules; if the mirror image is placed on top on the original molecule, then they will never be
perfectly aligned to give the same molecule.
19.E.3.28: A19.3.10
The complex does not have any unpaired electrons. The complex does not have any geometric isomers, but the mirror image is
nonsuperimposable, so it has an optical isomer.
19.E.3.29: Q19.3.11
Would you expect the Mg3[Cr(CN)6]2 to be diamagnetic or paramagnetic? Explain your reasoning.
3(+2) + 2(x) = 0
x = 3
Now that we found the charge of the coordination complex, we are able to find the charge of the transition metal Cr given that the charge of CN is -1. Again, using the subscripts we find the
oxidation state of Cr, y, to be:
y + 6(−1) = −3
y = 3
A19.3.11
a) Paramagnetic
19.E.3.31: Q19.3.12
Would you expect salts of the gold ion, Au+, to be colored? Explain.
19.E.3.32: S19.3.12
No. Colored ions have unpaired electrons in their outmost orbital. A partially filled d orbital, for example, can yield various colors. After
completing the noble gas configuration, we see that Au+ has a configuration of [Xe] 4f145d10. Since Au+ has a completely filled d sublevel, we
are certain that any salts of the gold ion, Au+ will be colorless.
*An example of a colored ion would be copper(II). Cu2+ has an electron configuration of [Ar]3d9. It has one unpaired electron. Copper(II)
appears blue.
19.E.3.33: A19.3.12
No. Au+ has a complete 5d sublevel.
19.E.3.34: Q19.3.13
[CuCl4]2− is green. [Cu(H2O)6]2+is blue. Which absorbs higher-energy photons? Which is predicted to have a larger crystal field splitting?
19.E.3.35: S19.3.13
In this case;
[CuCl4]2- appears green but is opposite of red on the color wheel which is absorbed and is characterized by wavelengths 620-800
nanometers.
[Cu(H2O)6]2+ appears blue but is opposite of orange on the color wheel which is absorbed and is characterized by wavelengths 580-620
nanometers.
When determining which absorbs the higher energy photons, one must look at the complex itself. A higher energy indicates a high
energy photon absorbed and a lower energy indicates a lower energy photon absorbed. How can we determine this? By looking at the
complex and more specifically the ligand attached and its location in the spectrochemical series.
The ligands attached are Water and Chlorine and since Water is a stronger ligand than Chlorine according to the series, it also has larger
energy, indicating a higher energy. This means that the complex [Cu(H2O)6]2+ absorbs a higher energy photon because of its a stronger
ligand than chlorine.
Part 2 of this question also asks which complex is predicted to have a larger crystal field splitting. To determine this you also use the
spectrochemical series and see which ligand is stronger. Since H2O is stronger than Cl- on the spectrochemical series, we can say
[Cu(H2O)6]2+ has a higher crystal field splitting.
19.E.3.36: A19.3.13
a) [Cu(H2O)6]2+
b)
[Cu(H2O)6]2+ has a higher crystal field splitting
This page titled 20: Organic Chemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
20.0: Prelude to Organic Chemistry
All living things on earth are formed mostly of carbon compounds. The prevalence of carbon compounds in living things has led to
the epithet “carbon-based” life. The truth is we know of no other kind of life. Early chemists regarded substances isolated from
organisms (plants and animals) as a different type of matter that could not be synthesized artificially, and these substances were
thus known as organic compounds. The widespread belief called vitalism held that organic compounds were formed by a vital force
present only in living organisms. The German chemist Friedrich Wohler was one of the early chemists to refute this aspect of
vitalism, when, in 1828, he reported the synthesis of urea, a component of many body fluids, from nonliving materials. Since then,
it has been recognized that organic molecules obey the same natural laws as inorganic substances, and the category of organic
compounds has evolved to include both natural and synthetic compounds that contain carbon. Some carbon-containing compounds
are not classified as organic, for example, carbonates and cyanides, and simple oxides, such as CO and CO2. Although a single,
precise definition has yet to be identified by the chemistry community, most agree that a defining trait of organic molecules is the
presence of carbon as the principal element, bonded to hydrogen and other carbon atoms.
Figure 20.0.1 : All organic compounds contain carbon and most are formed by living things, although they are also formed by
geological and artificial processes. (credit left: modification of work by Jon Sullivan; credit left middle: modification of work by
Deb Tremper; credit right middle: modification of work by “annszyp”/Wikimedia Commons; credit right: modification of work by
George Shuklin)
Today, organic compounds are key components of plastics, soaps, perfumes, sweeteners, fabrics, pharmaceuticals, and many other
substances that we use every day. The value to us of organic compounds ensures that organic chemistry is an important discipline
within the general field of chemistry. In this chapter, we discuss why the element carbon gives rise to a vast number and variety of
compounds, how those compounds are classified, and the role of organic compounds in representative biological and industrial
settings.
This page titled 20.0: Prelude to Organic Chemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The largest database1 of organic compounds lists about 10 million substances, which include compounds originating from living
organisms and those synthesized by chemists. The number of potential organic compounds has been estimated2 at 1060—an
astronomically high number. The existence of so many organic molecules is a consequence of the ability of carbon atoms to form
up to four strong bonds to other carbon atoms, resulting in chains and rings of many different sizes, shapes, and complexities.
The simplest organic compounds contain only the elements carbon and hydrogen, and are called hydrocarbons. Even though they
are composed of only two types of atoms, there is a wide variety of hydrocarbons because they may consist of varying lengths of
chains, branched chains, and rings of carbon atoms, or combinations of these structures. In addition, hydrocarbons may differ in the
types of carbon-carbon bonds present in their molecules. Many hydrocarbons are found in plants, animals, and their fossils; other
hydrocarbons have been prepared in the laboratory. We use hydrocarbons every day, mainly as fuels, such as natural gas, acetylene,
propane, butane, and the principal components of gasoline, diesel fuel, and heating oil. The familiar plastics polyethylene,
polypropylene, and polystyrene are also hydrocarbons. We can distinguish several types of hydrocarbons by differences in the
bonding between carbon atoms. This leads to differences in geometries and in the hybridization of the carbon orbitals.
20.1.1: Alkanes
Alkanes, or saturated hydrocarbons, contain only single covalent bonds between carbon atoms. Each of the carbon atoms in an
alkane has sp3 hybrid orbitals and is bonded to four other atoms, each of which is either carbon or hydrogen. The Lewis structures
and models of methane, ethane, and pentane are illustrated in Figure 20.1.1. Carbon chains are usually drawn as straight lines in
Lewis structures, but one has to remember that Lewis structures are not intended to indicate the geometry of molecules. Notice that
the carbon atoms in the structural models (the ball-and-stick and space-filling models) of the pentane molecule do not lie in a
straight line. Because of the sp3 hybridization, the bond angles in carbon chains are close to 109.5°, giving such chains in an alkane
a zigzag shape.
The structures of alkanes and other organic molecules may also be represented in a less detailed manner by condensed structural
formulas (or simply, condensed formulas). Instead of the usual format for chemical formulas in which each element symbol appears
just once, a condensed formula is written to suggest the bonding in the molecule. These formulas have the appearance of a Lewis
structure from which most or all of the bond symbols have been removed. Condensed structural formulas for ethane and pentane
are shown at the bottom of Figure 20.1.1, and several additional examples are provided in the exercises at the end of this chapter.
Figure 20.1.1 : Pictured are the Lewis structures, ball-and-stick models, and space-filling models for molecules of methane, ethane,
and pentane.
A common method used by organic chemists to simplify the drawings of larger molecules is to use a skeletal structure (also called
a line-angle structure). In this type of structure, carbon atoms are not symbolized with a C, but represented by each end of a line or
Figure 20.1.2 : The same structure can be represented three different ways: an expanded formula, a condensed formula, and a
skeletal structure.
Example 20.1.1
Drawing Skeletal Structures Draw the skeletal structures for these two molecules:
Solution
Each carbon atom is converted into the end of a line or the place where lines intersect. All hydrogen atoms attached to the
carbon atoms are left out of the structure (although we still need to recognize they are there):
Figure a shows a branched skeleton structure that looks like a plus sign with line segments extending up and to the right and
down and to the left of the rightmost point of the plus sign. Figure b appears in a zig zag pattern made with six line segments.
The segments rise, fall, rise, fall, rise, and fall moving left to right across the figure.
Exercise 20.1.1
Figure a shows five C H subscript 2 groups and one C H group bonded in a hexagonal ring. A C H subscript 3 group appears
above and to the right of the ring, bonded to the ring on the C H group appearing at the upper right portion of the ring. In b, a
straight chain molecule composed of C H subscript 3 C H subscript 2 C H subscript 2 C H subscript 2 C H subscript 3 is
shown.
Answer
Example 20.1.2
Interpreting Skeletal Structures Identify the chemical formula of the molecule represented here:
This figure shows a pentagon with a vertex pointing right, from which a line segment extends that has two line segments
attached at its right end, one extending up and to the right, and the other extending down and to the right.
Solution
There are eight places where lines intersect or end, meaning that there are eight carbon atoms in the molecule. Since we know
that carbon atoms tend to make four bonds, each carbon atom will have the number of hydrogen atoms that are required for
four bonds. This compound contains 16 hydrogen atoms for a molecular formula of C8H16.
Location of the hydrogen atoms:
In this figure a ring composed of four C H subscript 2 groups and one C H group in a pentagonal shape is shown. From the C H
group, which is at the right side of the pentagon, a C H is bonded. From this C H, a C H subscript 3 group is bonded above and
to the right and a second is bonded below and to the right.
Exercise 20.1.2
A skeleton model is shown with a zig zag pattern that rises, falls, rises, and falls again left to right through the center of the
molecule. From the two risen points, line segments extend both up and down, creating four branches.
Answer
C9H20
Hydrocarbons with the same formula, including alkanes, can have different structures. For example, two alkanes have the formula
C4H10: They are called n-butane and 2-methylpropane (or isobutane), and have the following Lewis structures:
The compounds n-butane and 2-methylpropane are structural isomers (the term constitutional isomers is also commonly used).
Constitutional isomers have the same molecular formula but different spatial arrangements of the atoms in their molecules. The n-
butane molecule contains an unbranched chain, meaning that no carbon atom is bonded to more than two other carbon atoms. We
use the term normal, or the prefix n, to refer to a chain of carbon atoms without branching. The compound 2–methylpropane has a
branched chain (the carbon atom in the center of the Lewis structure is bonded to three other carbon atoms)
Identifying isomers from Lewis structures is not as easy as it looks. Lewis structures that look different may actually represent the
same isomers. For example, the three structures in Figure 20.1.3 all represent the same molecule, n-butane, and hence are not
different isomers. They are identical because each contains an unbranched chain of four carbon atoms.
When more than one substituent is present, either on the same carbon atom or on different carbon atoms, the substituents are listed
alphabetically. Because the carbon atom numbering begins at the end closest to a substituent, the longest chain of carbon atoms is
numbered in such a way as to produce the lowest number for the substituents. The ending -o replaces -ide at the end of the name of
an electronegative substituent (in ionic compounds, the negatively charged ion ends with -ide like chloride; in organic compounds,
such atoms are treated as substituents and the -o ending is used). The number of substituents of the same type is indicated by the
prefixes di- (two), tri- (three), tetra- (four), and so on (for example, difluoro- indicates two fluoride substituents).
Solution
This structure shows a C atom bonded to the H atoms and another C atom. This second C atom is bonded to two H atoms and
another C atom. This third C atom is bonded to an H atom, a B r atom, and another C atom. This fourth C atom is bonded to
two H atoms and a C l atom. The C atoms are numbered 4, 3, 2, and 1 from left to right.
The four-carbon chain is numbered from the end with the chlorine atom. This puts the substituents on positions 1 and 2
(numbering from the other end would put the substituents on positions 3 and 4). Four carbon atoms means that the base name
of this compound will be butane. The bromine at position 2 will be described by adding 2-bromo-; this will come at the
beginning of the name, since bromo- comes before chloro- alphabetically. The chlorine at position 1 will be described by
adding 1-chloro-, resulting in the name of the molecule being 2-bromo-1-chlorobutane.
Exercise 20.1.3
This figure shows a C atom bonded to three H atoms and another C atom. This second C atom is bonded to two H atoms and a
third C atom. The third C atom is bonded to two B r atoms and a fourth C atom. This C atom is bonded to an H atom, and I
atom, and a fifth C atom. This last C atom is bonded to three H atoms.
Answer
3,3-dibromo-2-iodopentane
We call a substituent that contains one less hydrogen than the corresponding alkane an alkyl group. The name of an alkyl group is
obtained by dropping the suffix -ane of the alkane name and adding -yl:
A chain of six carbon atoms, numbered 6, 5, 4, 3, 2, and 1 is shown. Bonded above carbon 3, a chain of two carbons is shown,
numbered 1 and 2 moving upward. H atoms are present directly above, below, left and right of all carbon atoms in positions
not already taken up in bonding to other carbon atoms.
Solution
The longest carbon chain runs horizontally across the page and contains six carbon atoms (this makes the base of the name
hexane, but we will also need to incorporate the name of the branch). In this case, we want to number from right to left (as
shown by the blue numbers) so the branch is connected to carbon 3 (imagine the numbers from left to right—this would put the
branch on carbon 4, violating our rules). The branch attached to position 3 of our chain contains two carbon atoms (numbered
in red)—so we take our name for two carbons eth- and attach -yl at the end to signify we are describing a branch. Putting all
the pieces together, this molecule is 3-ethylhexane.
Exercise 20.1.4
Name the following molecule:
Answer
4-propyloctane
Some hydrocarbons can form more than one type of alkyl group when the hydrogen atoms that would be removed have different
“environments” in the molecule. This diversity of possible alkyl groups can be identified in the following way: The four hydrogen
atoms in a methane molecule are equivalent; they all have the same environment. They are equivalent because each is bonded to a
carbon atom (the same carbon atom) that is bonded to three hydrogen atoms. (It may be easier to see the equivalency in the ball and
stick models in Figure 20.1.3. Removal of any one of the four hydrogen atoms from methane forms a methyl group. Likewise, the
six hydrogen atoms in ethane are equivalent and removing any one of these hydrogen atoms produces an ethyl group. Each of the
six hydrogen atoms is bonded to a carbon atom that is bonded to two other hydrogen atoms and a carbon atom. However, in both
propane and 2–methylpropane, there are hydrogen atoms in two different environments, distinguished by the adjacent atoms or
groups of atoms:
Figure 20.1.4 .
Alkanes are relatively stable molecules, but heat or light will activate reactions that involve the breaking of C–H or C–C single
bonds. Combustion is one such reaction:
Alkanes burn in the presence of oxygen, a highly exothermic oxidation-reduction reaction that produces carbon dioxide and water.
As a consequence, alkanes are excellent fuels. For example, methane, CH4, is the principal component of natural gas. Butane,
C4H10, used in camping stoves and lighters is an alkane. Gasoline is a liquid mixture of continuous- and branched-chain alkanes,
each containing from five to nine carbon atoms, plus various additives to improve its performance as a fuel. Kerosene, diesel oil,
and fuel oil are primarily mixtures of alkanes with higher molecular masses. The main source of these liquid alkane fuels is crude
oil, a complex mixture that is separated by fractional distillation. Fractional distillation takes advantage of differences in the boiling
points of the components of the mixture (Figure 20.1.5). You may recall that boiling point is a function of intermolecular
interactions, which was discussed in the chapter on solutions and colloids.
The C–Cl portion of the chloroethane molecule is an example of a functional group, the part or moiety of a molecule that imparts a
specific chemical reactivity. The types of functional groups present in an organic molecule are major determinants of its chemical
properties and are used as a means of classifying organic compounds as detailed in the remaining sections of this chapter.
20.1.3: Alkenes
Organic compounds that contain one or more double or triple bonds between carbon atoms are described as unsaturated. You have
likely heard of unsaturated fats. These are complex organic molecules with long chains of carbon atoms, which contain at least one
double bond between carbon atoms. Unsaturated hydrocarbon molecules that contain one or more double bonds are called alkenes.
Carbon atoms linked by a double bond are bound together by two bonds, one σ bond and one π bond. Double and triple bonds give
rise to a different geometry around the carbon atom that participates in them, leading to important differences in molecular shape
and properties. The differing geometries are responsible for the different properties of unsaturated versus saturated fats.
Ethene, C2H4, is the simplest alkene. Each carbon atom in ethene, commonly called ethylene, has a trigonal planar structure. The
second member of the series is propene (propylene) (Figure 20.1.6); the butene isomers follow in the series. Four carbon atoms in
the chain of butene allows for the formation of isomers based on the position of the double bond, as well as a new form of
isomerism.
Figure 20.1.7 : The reaction for the polymerization of ethylene to polyethylene is shown.
This diagram has three rows, showing ethylene reacting to form polyethylene. In the first row, Lewis structural formulas show three
molecules of ethylene being added together, which are each composed of two doubly bonded C atoms, each with two bonded H
atoms. Ellipses, or three dots, are present before and after the molecule structures, which in turn are followed by an arrow pointing
right. On the right side of the arrow, the ellipses or dots again appear to the left of a dash that connects to a chain of 7 C atoms, each
with H atoms connected above and below. A dash appears at the end of the chain, which in turn is followed by ellipses or dots. The
reaction diagram is repeated in the second row using ball-and-stick models for the structures. In these representations, single bonds
are represented with sticks, double bonds are represented with two parallel sticks, and elements are represented with balls. Carbon
atoms are black and hydrogen atoms are white in this image. In the third row, space-filling models are shown. In these models,
atoms are enlarged spheres which are pushed together, without sticks to represent bonds.
Polyethylene is a member of one subset of synthetic polymers classified as plastics. Plastics are synthetic organic solids that can be
molded; they are typically organic polymers with high molecular masses. Most of the monomers that go into common plastics
(ethylene, propylene, vinyl chloride, styrene, and ethylene terephthalate) are derived from petrochemicals and are not very
Figure 20.1.8 : Each type of recyclable plastic is imprinted with a code for easy identification.
This table shows recycling symbols, names, and uses of various types of plastics. Symbols are shown with three arrows in a
triangular shape surrounding a number. Number 1 is labeled P E T E. The related plastic, polyethylene terephthalate (P E T E), is
used in soda bottles and oven-ready food trays. Number 2 is labeled H D P E. The related plastic is high-density polyethylene (H D
P E), which is used in bottles for milk and dishwashing liquids. Number 3 is labeled V. The related plastic is polyvinyl chloride or
(P V C). This plastic is used in food trays, plastic wrap, and bottles for mineral water and shampoo. Number 4 is labeled L D P E.
This plastic is low density polyethylene (L D P E). It is used in shopping bags and garbage bags. Number 5 is labeled P P. The
related plastic is polypropylene (P P). It is used in margarine tubs and microwaveable food trays. Number 6 is labeled P S. The
related plastic is polystyrene (P S). It is used in yogurt tubs, foam meat trays, egg cartons, vending cups, plastic cutlery, and
packaging for electronics and toys. Number 7 is labeled other for any other plastics. Items in this category include those plastic
materials that do not fit any other category. Melamine used in plastic plates and cups is an example.
The name of an alkene is derived from the name of the alkane with the same number of carbon atoms. The presence of the double
bond is signified by replacing the suffix -ane with the suffix -ene. The location of the double bond is identified by naming the
smaller of the numbers of the carbon atoms participating in the double bond:
This diagram illustrates the reaction of ethene and C l subscript 2 to form 1 comma 2 dash dichloroethane. In this reaction, the
structural formula of ethane is shown. It has a double bond between the two C atoms with two H atoms bonded to each C atom plus
C l bonded to C l. This is shown on to the left of an arrow. The two C atoms and the double bond between them are shown in red.
To the right of the arrow, the 1 comma 2 dash dichloroethane molecule is shown. It has only single bonds and each C atom has a C l
with three pairs of electron dots bonded beneath it. The C and C l atoms, single bond between them, and electron pairs are shown in
red. Each C atom also has two H atoms bonded to it.
Solution
The reactant is a five-carbon chain that contains a carbon-carbon double bond, so the base name will be pentene. We begin
counting at the end of the chain closest to the double bond—in this case, from the left—the double bond spans carbons 2 and 3,
so the name becomes 2-pentene. Since there are two carbon-containing groups attached to the two carbon atoms in the double
bond—and they are on the same side of the double bond—this molecule is the cis-isomer, making the name of the starting
alkene cis-2-pentene. The product of the halogenation reaction will have two chlorine atoms attached to the carbon atoms that
were a part of the carbon-carbon double bond:
C H subscript 3 is bonded down and to the right to C H which is bonded down and to the left to C l. C H is also bonded to
another C H which is bonded down and to the right to C l and up and to the right to C H subscript 2. C H subscript 2 is also
bonded to C H subscript 3.
This molecule is now a substituted alkane and will be named as such. The base of the name will be pentane. We will count
from the end that numbers the carbon atoms where the chlorine atoms are attached as 2 and 3, making the name of the product
2,3-dichloropentane.
Exercise 20.1.5
Provide names for the reactant and product of the reaction shown:
This shows a C atom bonded to three H atoms and another C atom. This second C atom is bonded to two H atoms and a third C
atom. This third C atom is bonded to one H atom and also forms a double bond with a fourth C atom. This fourth C atom is
bonded to one H atom and a fifth C atom. This fifth C atom is bonded to two H atoms and a sixth C atom. This sixth C atom is
bonded to three H atoms. There is a plus sign followed by a C l atom bonded to another C l atom. There is a reaction arrow. no
products are shown.
Answer
reactant: cis-3-hexene, product: 3,4-dichlorohexane
20.1.6: Alkynes
Hydrocarbon molecules with one or more triple bonds are called alkynes; they make up another series of unsaturated hydrocarbons.
Two carbon atoms joined by a triple bond are bound together by one σ bond and two π bonds. The sp-hybridized carbons involved
in the triple bond have bond angles of 180°, giving these types of bonds a linear, rod-like shape.
The structural formula and name for ethyne, also known as acetylene, are shown. In red, two C atoms are shown with a triple bond
illustrated by three horizontal line segments between them. Shown in black at each end of the structure, a single H atom is bonded.
The IUPAC nomenclature for alkynes is similar to that for alkenes except that the suffix -yne is used to indicate a triple bond in the
chain. For example, C H C H C ≡ CH is called 1-butyne.
3 2
Describe the geometry and hybridization of the carbon atoms in the following molecule:
A structural formula is shown with C H subscript 3 bonded to a C atom which is triple bonded to another C atom which is
bonded to C H subscript 3. Each C atom is labeled 1, 2, 3, and 4 from left to right.
Solution
Carbon atoms 1 and 4 have four single bonds and are thus tetrahedral with sp3 hybridization. Carbon atoms 2 and 3 are
involved in the triple bond, so they have linear geometries and would be classified as sp hybrids.
Exercise 20.1.6
Identify the hybridization and bond angles at the carbon atoms in the molecule shown:
A structural formula is shown with an H atom bonded to a C atom. The C atom has a triple bond with another C atom which is
also bonded to C H. The C H has a double bond with another C H which is also bonded up and to the right to C H subscript 3.
Each C atom is labeled 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5 from left to right.
Answer
carbon 1: sp, 180°; carbon 2: sp, 180°; carbon 3: sp2, 120°; carbon 4: sp2, 120°; carbon 5: sp3, 109.5°
Chemically, the alkynes are similar to the alkenes. Since the C ≡ C functional group has two π bonds, alkynes typically react even
more readily, and react with twice as much reagent in addition reactions. The reaction of acetylene with bromine is a typical
example:
Figure 20.1.10.
This structural formula shows a six carbon hydrocarbon ring. On the left side there are six C atoms. The C atom on top and to the
left forms a single bond to the C atom on the top and to the right. The C atom has a double bond to another C atom which has a
single bond to a C atom. That C atom has a double bond to another C atom which has a single bond to a C atom. That C atom
forms a double bond with another C atom. Each C atom has a single bond to an H atom. There is a double sided arrow and the
structure on the right is almost identical to the structure on the left. The structure on the right shows double bonds where the
structure on the left showed single bonds. The structure on the right shows single bonds where the stucture on the left showed
double bonds.
Figure 20.1.10: This condensed formula shows the unique bonding structure of benzene.
A six carbon hydrocarbon ring structural formula is shown. Each C atom is bonded to only one H atom. A circle is at the center of
the ring.
There are many derivatives of benzene. The hydrogen atoms can be replaced by many different substituents. Aromatic compounds
more readily undergo substitution reactions than addition reactions; replacement of one of the hydrogen atoms with another
substituent will leave the delocalized double bonds intact. The following are typical examples of substituted benzene derivatives:
Toluene and xylene are important solvents and raw materials in the chemical industry. Styrene is used to produce the polymer
polystyrene.
One possible isomer created by a substitution reaction that replaces a hydrogen atom attached to the aromatic ring of toluene
with a chlorine atom is shown here. Draw two other possible isomers in which the chlorine atom replaces a different hydrogen
atom attached to the aromatic ring:
Two structural formulas are shown. The first has a six carbon hydrocarbon ring in which four of the carbon atoms are each
bonded to only one H atom. At the upper right of the ring, the carbon that does not have a bonded H atom has a C H subscript 3
group attached. The C to the lower right has a C l atom attached. A circle is at the center of the ring. The second molecule has a
hexagon with a circle inside. From a vertex of the hexagon at the upper right a C H subscript 3 group is attached. From the
vertex at the lower right, a C l atom is attached.
Solution
Since the six-carbon ring with alternating double bonds is necessary for the molecule to be classified as aromatic, appropriate
isomers can be produced only by changing the positions of the chloro-substituent relative to the methyl-substituent:
Two pairs of structural formulas are shown. The first has a six carbon hydrocarbon ring in which four of the C atoms are each
bonded to only one H atom. At the upper right of the ring, the C atom that does not have a bonded H atom has a C H subscript
3 group attached. The C atom to the right has a C l atom attached. A circle is at the center of the ring. The second molecule in
the first pair has a hexagon with a circle inside. From a vertex of the hexagon at the upper right a C H subscript 3 group is
attached. From the vertex at the right, a C l atom is attached. The second pair first shows a six carbon hydrocarbon ring in
which four of the C atoms are each bonded to only one H atom. A C l atom is attached to the left-most C atom and a C H
subscript 3 group is attached to the right-most C atom. A circle is at the center of the ring. The second molecule in the pair has
a hexagon with a circle inside. A C H subscript 3 group is attached to a vertex on the right side of the hexagon and to a vertex
on the left side, a C l atom is bonded.
Answer
Three pairs of structural formulas are shown. The first has a six carbon hydrocarbon ring in which four of the C atoms are
each bonded to only one H atom. At the upper right and right of the ring, the two C atoms that do not have bonded H atoms
have one B r atom bonded each. A circle is at the center of the ring. Beneath this structure, a similar structure is shown
which has a hexagon with a circle inside. From vertices of the hexagon at the upper right and right single B r atoms are
attached. The second has a six carbon hydrocarbon ring in which four of the C atoms are each bonded to only one H atom.
At the upper right and lower right of the ring, the two C atoms that do not have bonded H atoms have a single B r atom
bonded each. A circle is at the center of the ring. Beneath this structure, a similar structure is shown which has a hexagon
with a circle inside. From vertices of the hexagon at the upper right and lower right single B r atoms are attached. The third
has a six carbon hydrocarbon ring in which four of the C atoms are each bonded to only one H atom. At the upper right and
lower left of the ring, the two C atoms that do not have bonded H atoms have B r atoms bonded. A circle is at the center of
the ring. Beneath this structure, a similar structure is shown which has a hexagon with a circle inside. From vertices of the
hexagon at the upper right and lower left, single B r atoms are attached.
Summary
Strong, stable bonds between carbon atoms produce complex molecules containing chains, branches, and rings. The chemistry of
these compounds is called organic chemistry. Hydrocarbons are organic compounds composed of only carbon and hydrogen. The
alkanes are saturated hydrocarbons—that is, hydrocarbons that contain only single bonds. Alkenes contain one or more carbon-
carbon double bonds. Alkynes contain one or more carbon-carbon triple bonds. Aromatic hydrocarbons contain ring structures with
delocalized π electron systems.
Footnotes
1. This is the Beilstein database, now available through the Reaxys site (www.elsevier.com/online-tools/reaxys).
2. Peplow, Mark. “Organic Synthesis: The Robo-Chemist,” Nature 512 (2014): 20–2.
3. Physical properties for C4H10 and heavier molecules are those of the normal isomer, n-butane, n-pentane, etc.
4. STP indicates a temperature of 0 °C and a pressure of 1 atm.
Glossary
addition reaction
reaction in which a double carbon-carbon bond forms a single carbon-carbon bond by the addition of a reactant. Typical
reaction for an alkene.
alkane
alkene
molecule consisting of carbon and hydrogen containing at least one carbon-carbon double bond
alkyl group
substituent, consisting of an alkane missing one hydrogen atom, attached to a larger structure
alkyne
molecule consisting of carbon and hydrogen containing at least one carbon-carbon triple bond
aromatic hydrocarbon
cyclic molecule consisting of carbon and hydrogen with delocalized alternating carbon-carbon single and double bonds,
resulting in enhanced stability
functional group
part of an organic molecule that imparts a specific chemical reactivity to the molecule
organic compound
natural or synthetic compound that contains carbon
saturated hydrocarbon
molecule containing carbon and hydrogen that has only single bonds between carbon atoms
skeletal structure
shorthand method of drawing organic molecules in which carbon atoms are represented by the ends of lines and bends in
between lines, and hydrogen atoms attached to the carbon atoms are not shown (but are understood to be present by the context
of the structure)
substituent
branch or functional group that replaces hydrogen atoms in a larger hydrocarbon chain
substitution reaction
reaction in which one atom replaces another in a molecule
This page titled 20.1: Hydrocarbons is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
20.2.1: Alcohols
Incorporation of an oxygen atom into carbon- and hydrogen-containing molecules leads to new functional groups and new families
of compounds. When the oxygen atom is attached by single bonds, the molecule is either an alcohol or ether.
Alcohols are derivatives of hydrocarbons in which an –OH group has replaced a hydrogen atom. Although all alcohols have one or
more hydroxyl (–OH) functional groups, they do not behave like bases such as NaOH and KOH. NaOH and KOH are ionic
compounds that contain OH– ions. Alcohols are covalent molecules; the –OH group in an alcohol molecule is attached to a carbon
atom by a covalent bond.
Ethanol, CH3CH2OH, also called ethyl alcohol, is a particularly important alcohol for human use. Ethanol is the alcohol produced
by some species of yeast that is found in wine, beer, and distilled drinks. It has long been prepared by humans harnessing the
metabolic efforts of yeasts in fermenting various sugars:
Large quantities of ethanol are synthesized from the addition reaction of water with ethylene using an acid as a catalyst:
This reaction shows two carbons connected by a double bond, each with two bonded H atoms plus H O H arrow labeled “H
subscript 3 O superscript plus” followed by two carbon atoms connected with a single bond with 5 bonded H atoms and an O H
group shown in red at the right end of the molecule. The O of this group is shown with 2 pairs of electron dots.
Alcohols containing two or more hydroxyl groups can be made. Examples include 1,2-ethanediol (ethylene glycol, used in
antifreeze) and 1,2,3-propanetriol (glycerine, used as a solvent for cosmetics and medicines):
Solution
The carbon chain contains five carbon atoms. If the hydroxyl group was not present, we would have named this molecule
pentane. To address the fact that the hydroxyl group is present, we change the ending of the name to -ol. In this case, since the
–OH is attached to carbon 2 in the chain, we would name this molecule 2-pentanol.
Exercise 20.2.1
The structure shown has a C H subscript 3 group bonded up and to the right to a C atom. The C atom is bonded down and to
the right to a C H subscript 2 group. The C H subscript 2 group is bonded up and to the right to a C H subscript 2 group. The C
H subscript 2 group is bonded down and to the right to a C H subscript 3 group. The second C atom (from left to right) is
bonded to a C H subscript 3 group and an O H group.
Answer
2-methyl-2-pentanol
20.2.3: Ethers
Ethers are compounds that contain the functional group –O–. Ethers do not have a designated suffix like the other types of
molecules we have named so far. In the IUPAC system, the oxygen atom and the smaller carbon branch are named as an alkoxy
substituent and the remainder of the molecule as the base chain, as in alkanes. As shown in the following compound, the red
symbols represent the smaller alkyl group and the oxygen atom, which would be named “methoxy.” The larger carbon branch
would be ethane, making the molecule methoxyethane. Many ethers are referred to with common names instead of the IUPAC
system names. For common names, the two branches connected to the oxygen atom are named separately and followed by “ether.”
The common name for the compound shown in below is ethylmethyl ether:
Solution
Exercise 20.2.2
Provide the IUPAC and common name for the ether shown:
A molecular structure shows a C H subscript 3 group bonded up and to the right to an O atom. The O atom is bonded down and
to the right to a C H group. The C H group is bonded up and to the right to a C H subscript 3 group. The C H group is also
bonded down and to the right to another C H subscript 3 group.
Answer
IUPAC: 2-methoxypropane; common: isopropylmethyl ether
Ethers can be obtained from alcohols by the elimination of a molecule of water from two molecules of the alcohol. For example,
when ethanol is treated with a limited amount of sulfuric acid and heated to 140 °C, diethyl ether and water are formed:
In the general formula for ethers, R—O—R, the hydrocarbon groups (R) may be the same or different. Diethyl ether, the most
widely used compound of this class, is a colorless, volatile liquid that is highly flammable. It was first used in 1846 as an
anesthetic, but better anesthetics have now largely taken its place. Diethyl ether and other ethers are presently used primarily as
solvents for gums, fats, waxes, and resins. Tertiary-butyl methyl ether, C4H9OCH3 (abbreviated MTBE—italicized portions of
names are not counted when ranking the groups alphabetically—so butyl comes before methyl in the common name), is used as an
additive for gasoline. MTBE belongs to a group of chemicals known as oxygenates due to their capacity to increase the oxygen
content of gasoline.
Carbohydrates are large biomolecules made up of carbon, hydrogen, and oxygen. The dietary forms of carbohydrates are foods
rich in these types of molecules, like pastas, bread, and candy. The name “carbohydrate” comes from the formula of the
molecules, which can be described by the general formula Cm(H2O)n, which shows that they are in a sense “carbon and water”
or “hydrates of carbon.” In many cases, m and n have the same value, but they can be different. The smaller carbohydrates are
generally referred to as “sugars,” the biochemical term for this group of molecules is “saccharide” from the Greek word for
sugar (Figure 20.2.1). Depending on the number of sugar units joined together, they may be classified as monosaccharides
(one sugar unit), disaccharides (two sugar units), oligosaccharides (a few sugars), or polysaccharides (the polymeric version of
sugars—polymers were described in the feature box earlier in this chapter on recycling plastics). The scientific names of sugars
can be recognized by the suffix -ose at the end of the name (for instance, fruit sugar is a monosaccharide called “fructose” and
milk sugar is a disaccharide called lactose composed of two monosaccharides, glucose and galactose, connected together).
Sugars contain some of the functional groups we have discussed: Note the alcohol groups present in the structures and how
monosaccharide units are linked to form a disaccharide by formation of an ether.
Figure 20.2.2 : Diabetes is a disease characterized by high concentrations of glucose in the blood. Treating diabetes involves
making lifestyle changes, monitoring blood-sugar levels, and sometimes insulin injections. (credit: “Blausen Medical
Communications”/Wikimedia Commons)
In 2013, it was estimated that approximately 3.3% of the world’s population (~380 million people) suffered from diabetes,
resulting in over a million deaths annually. Prevention involves eating a healthy diet, getting plenty of exercise, and
maintaining a normal body weight. Treatment involves all of these lifestyle practices and may require injections of insulin.
Summary
Many organic compounds that are not hydrocarbons can be thought of as derivatives of hydrocarbons. A hydrocarbon derivative
can be formed by replacing one or more hydrogen atoms of a hydrocarbon by a functional group, which contains at least one atom
of an element other than carbon or hydrogen. The properties of hydrocarbon derivatives are determined largely by the functional
group. The –OH group is the functional group of an alcohol. The –R–O–R– group is the functional group of an ether.
Glossary
alcohol
organic compound with a hydroxyl group (–OH) bonded to a carbon atom
ether
organic compound with an oxygen atom that is bonded to two carbon atoms
This page titled 20.2: Alcohols and Ethers is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Another class of organic molecules contains a carbon atom connected to an oxygen atom by a double bond, commonly called a
carbonyl group. The trigonal planar carbon in the carbonyl group can attach to two other substituents leading to several subfamilies
(aldehydes, ketones, carboxylic acids and esters) described in this section.
20.3.0.0.1: Aldehydes and Ketones
Both aldehydes and ketones contain a carbonyl group, a functional group with a carbon-oxygen double bond. The names for
aldehyde and ketone compounds are derived using similar nomenclature rules as for alkanes and alcohols, and include the class-
identifying suffixes -al and -one, respectively.
Five structures are shown. The first is a C atom with an R group bonded to the left and an H atom to the right. An O atom is double
bonded above the C atom. This structure is labeled, “Functional group of an aldehyde.” The second structure shows a C atom with
R groups bonded to the left and right. An O atom is double bonded above the C atom. This structure is labeled, “Functional group
of a ketone.” The third structure looks exactly like the functional group of a ketone. The fourth structure is labeled C H subscript 3
C H O. It is also labeled, “An aldehyde,” and “ethanal (acetaldehyde).” This structure has a C atom to which 3 H atoms are bonded
above, below, and to the left. In red to the right of this C atom, a C atom is attached which has an O atom double bonded above and
an H atom bonded to the right. The O atom as two sets of electron dots. The fifth structure is labeled C H subscript 3 C O C H
subscript 2 C H subscript 3. It is also labeled, “A ketone,” and “butanone.” This structure has a C atom to which 3 H atoms are
bonded above, below, and to the left. To the right of this in red is a C atom to which an O atom is double bonded above. The O
atom has two sets of electron dots. Attached to the right of this red C atom in black is a two carbon atom chain with H atoms
attached above, below, and to the right.
In an aldehyde, the carbonyl group is bonded to at least one hydrogen atom. In a ketone, the carbonyl group is bonded to two
carbon atoms. As text, an aldehyde group is represented as –CHO; a ketone is represented as –C(O)– or –CO–.
In both aldehydes and ketones, the geometry around the carbon atom in the carbonyl group is trigonal planar; the carbon atom
exhibits sp2 hybridization. Two of the sp2 orbitals on the carbon atom in the carbonyl group are used to form σ bonds to the other
carbon or hydrogen atoms in a molecule. The remaining sp2 hybrid orbital forms a σ bond to the oxygen atom. The unhybridized p
orbital on the carbon atom in the carbonyl group overlaps a p orbital on the oxygen atom to form the π bond in the double bond.
Like the C = O bond in carbon dioxide, the C = O bond of a carbonyl group is polar (recall that oxygen is significantly more
electronegative than carbon, and the shared electrons are pulled toward the oxygen atom and away from the carbon atom). Many of
the reactions of aldehydes and ketones start with the reaction between a Lewis base and the carbon atom at the positive end of the
polar C = O bond to yield an unstable intermediate that subsequently undergoes one or more structural rearrangements to form the
final product (Figure 20.3.1).
A reaction is shown. On the left appears an alcohol and on the right, a carbonyl group. Above the reaction arrow appears the word
“oxidation.” The alcohol is represented as a C atom with dashes to the left and below, an H atom bonded above, and an O atom
bonded to an H atom in red connected to the right. The O atom has two sets of electron dots. The carbonyl group is indicated in red
with a C atom to which an O atom is double bonded above. Dashes appear left and right of the C atom in black. The O atom has
two sets of electron dots.
Methane represents the completely reduced form of an organic molecule that contains one carbon atom. Sequentially replacing
each of the carbon-hydrogen bonds with a carbon-oxygen bond would lead to an alcohol, then an aldehyde, then a carboxylic
acid (discussed later), and, finally, carbon dioxide:
CH ⟶ CH OH ⟶ CH O ⟶ HCO H ⟶ CO
4 3 2 2 2
What are the oxidation numbers for the carbon atoms in the molecules shown here?
Solution
In this example, we can calculate the oxidation number (review the chapter on oxidation-reduction reactions if necessary) for
the carbon atom in each case (note how this would become difficult for larger molecules with additional carbon atoms and
hydrogen atoms, which is why organic chemists use the definition dealing with replacing C–H bonds with C–O bonds
described).
For CH4, the carbon atom carries a –4 oxidation number (the hydrogen atoms are assigned oxidation numbers of +1 and the
carbon atom balances that by having an oxidation number of –4)
For the alcohol (in this case, methanol), the carbon atom has an oxidation number of –2 (the oxygen atom is assigned –2,
the four hydrogen atoms each are assigned +1, and the carbon atom balances the sum by having an oxidation number of –2;
note that compared to the carbon atom in CH4, this carbon atom has lost two electrons so it was oxidized)
Exercise 20.3.1
Indicate whether the marked carbon atoms in the three molecules here are oxidized or reduced relative to the marked carbon
atom in ethanol:
A molecular structure is shown. A C H subscript 3 group is bonded up and to the right to a C H subscript 2 group. Bonded to
the C H subscript 2 group down and to the right is an O H group.
There is no need to calculate oxidation states in this case; instead, just compare the types of atoms bonded to the marked
carbon atoms:
Three molecular structures are shown, each with a red central C atom. In a, a C H subscript 3 group is bonded to the lower left,
an H atom is bonded above, and H subscript 2 appears to the right of the central C atom. In b, an O atom is double bonded
above the central C atom, a C H subscript 3 group is bonded to the lower left, and an H atom is bonded to the lower right. In c,
an O atom is double bonded above the central C atom, a C H subscript 3 group is bonded to the lower left, and an O H group is
bonded to the lower right.
Answer a
reduced (bond to oxygen atom replaced by bond to hydrogen atom);
Answer b
oxidized (one bond to hydrogen atom replaced by one bond to oxygen atom);
Answer c
oxidized (2 bonds to hydrogen atoms have been replaced by bonds to an oxygen atom)
Aldehydes are commonly prepared by the oxidation of alcohols whose –OH functional group is located on the carbon atom at the
end of the chain of carbon atoms in the alcohol:
A reaction is shown. An alcohol appears on the left and an aldehyde on the right of the reaction arrow. The alcohol is shown as C H
subscript 3 C H subscript 2 C H subscript 2 O H, and the aldehyde is shown as C H subscript 3 C H subscript 2 C H O. The O H
group at the right end of the alcohol structure and the C H O group at the right end of the aldehyde structure are in red.
Alcohols that have their –OH groups in the middle of the chain are necessary to synthesize a ketone, which requires the carbonyl
group to be bonded to two other carbon atoms:
A chemical reaction is shown. On the left, a structure of propionic acid is indicated. This structure includes a 2 carbon hydrocarbon
group on the left end in black. Above, below, and to the left, H atoms are bonded. This group is bonded to a red group comprised of
a C atom to which an O atom is double bonded above. To the right of the red C atom, an O atom is connected with a single bond.
To the right of the O atom, an H atom is bonded. To the right of this structure appears a plus and N a O H. Following the reaction
arrow, the propionate ion is shown. This structure is in brackets. Appearing inside the brackets, is a 2 carbon hydrocarbon group on
the left end. Above, below, and to the left, H atoms are bonded. To the right of this group, a group in red is attached comprised of a
C atom to which an O atom is double bonded above and a second O atom is single bonded to the right. Outside the brackets appears
a superscript minus symbol. This is followed by a plus sign, N a superscript plus another plus sign and H subscript 2 O. The singly
bonded O atom in the propionate ion structure has 3 pairs of electron dots. All other O atoms have two pairs of electron dots.
Carboxylic acids are weak acids, meaning they are not 100% ionized in water. Generally only about 1% of the molecules of a
carboxylic acid dissolved in water are ionized at any given time. The remaining molecules are undissociated in solution.
We prepare carboxylic acids by the oxidation of aldehydes or alcohols whose –OH functional group is located on the carbon atom
at the end of the chain of carbon atoms in the alcohol:
A chemical reaction with two arrows is shown. On the left, an alcohol, indicated with a C atom to which an R group is bonded to
the left, H atoms are bonded above and below, and in red, a single bonded O atom with an H atom bonded to the right is shown.
Following the first reaction arrow, an aldehyde is shown. This structure is represented with an R group bonded to a red C atom to
which an H atom is bonded above and to the right, and an O atom is double bonded below and to the right. Appearing to the right
of the second arrow, is a carboxylic acid comprised of an R group bonded to a C atom to which, in red, an O atom is single bonded
with an H atom bonded to its right side. A red O is double bonded below and to the right. All O atoms have two pairs of electron
dots.
Esters are produced by the reaction of acids with alcohols. For example, the ester ethyl acetate, CH3CO2CH2CH3, is formed when
acetic acid reacts with ethanol:
The simplest carboxylic acid is formic acid, HCO2H, known since 1670. Its name comes from the Latin word formicus, which
means “ant”; it was first isolated by the distillation of red ants. It is partially responsible for the pain and irritation of ant and wasp
stings, and is responsible for a characteristic odor of ants that can be sometimes detected in their nests.
Acetic acid, CH3CO2H, constitutes 3–6% vinegar. Cider vinegar is produced by allowing apple juice to ferment without oxygen
present. Yeast cells present in the juice carry out the fermentation reactions. The fermentation reactions change the sugar present in
the juice to ethanol, then to acetic acid. Pure acetic acid has a penetrating odor and produces painful burns. It is an excellent solvent
for many organic and some inorganic compounds, and it is essential in the production of cellulose acetate, a component of many
synthetic fibers such as rayon.
The distinctive and attractive odors and flavors of many flowers, perfumes, and ripe fruits are due to the presence of one or more
esters (Figure 20.3.3). Among the most important of the natural esters are fats (such as lard, tallow, and butter) and oils (such as
linseed, cottonseed, and olive oils), which are esters of the trihydroxyl alcohol glycerine, C3H5(OH)3, with large carboxylic acids,
such as palmitic acid, CH3(CH2)14CO2H, stearic acid, CH3(CH2)16CO2H, and oleic acid, C H (C H ) CH = CH(C H ) C O H.
3 2 7 2 7 2
Oleic acid is an unsaturated acid; it contains a C = C double bond. Palmitic and stearic acids are saturated acids that contain no
double or triple bonds.
Figure 20.3.3 : Over 350 different volatile molecules (many members of the ester family) have been identified in strawberries.
(credit: Rebecca Siegel)
Summary
Functional groups related to the carbonyl group include the –CHO group of an aldehyde, the –CO– group of a ketone, the –CO2H
group of a carboxylic acid, and the –CO2R group of an ester. The carbonyl group, a carbon-oxygen double bond, is the key
structure in these classes of organic molecules: Aldehydes contain at least one hydrogen atom attached to the carbonyl carbon
atom, ketones contain two carbon groups attached to the carbonyl carbon atom, carboxylic acids contain a hydroxyl group attached
to the carbonyl carbon atom, and esters contain an oxygen atom attached to another carbon group connected to the carbonyl carbon
atom. All of these compounds contain oxidized carbon atoms relative to the carbon atom of an alcohol group.
20.3.1.1: Glossary
aldehyde
organic compound containing a carbonyl group bonded to two hydrogen atoms or a hydrogen atom and a carbon substituent
carbonyl group
carbon atom double bonded to an oxygen atom
ester
organic compound containing a carbonyl group with an attached oxygen atom that is bonded to a carbon substituent
ketone
organic compound containing a carbonyl group with two carbon substituents attached to it
This page titled 20.3: Aldehydes, Ketones, Carboxylic Acids, and Esters is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or
curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available
upon request.
Amines are molecules that contain carbon-nitrogen bonds. The nitrogen atom in an amine has a lone pair of electrons and three
bonds to other atoms, either carbon or hydrogen. Various nomenclatures are used to derive names for amines, but all involve the
class-identifying suffix –ine as illustrated here for a few simple examples:
Figure 20.4.1 ) is one such heterocyclic amine. A heterocyclic compound contains atoms of two or more different elements in its
ring structure.
Figure 20.4.1 : The illustration shows one of the resonance structures of pyridine.
The genetic material for all living things is a polymer of four different molecules, which are themselves a combination of three
subunits. The genetic information, the code for developing an organism, is contained in the specific sequence of the four
molecules, similar to the way the letters of the alphabet can be sequenced to form words that convey information. The
information in a DNA sequence is used to form two other types of polymers, one of which are proteins. The proteins interact to
form a specific type of organism with individual characteristics.
A genetic molecule is called DNA, which stands for deoxyribonucleic acid. The four molecules that make up DNA are called
nucleotides. Each nucleotide consists of a single- or double-ringed molecule containing nitrogen, carbon, oxygen, and
hydrogen called a nitrogenous base. Each base is bonded to a five-carbon sugar called deoxyribose. The sugar is in turn bonded
to a phosphate group (−PO ) When new DNA is made, a polymerization reaction occurs that binds the phosphate group of
3−
one nucleotide to the sugar group of a second nucleotide. The nitrogenous bases of each nucleotide stick out from this sugar-
phosphate backbone. DNA is actually formed from two such polymers coiled around each other and held together by hydrogen
bonds between the nitrogenous bases. Thus, the two backbones are on the outside of the coiled pair of strands, and the bases
are on the inside. The shape of the two strands wound around each other is called a double helix (Figure 20.4.2).
It probably makes sense that the sequence of nucleotides in the DNA of a cat differs from those of a dog. But it is also true that
the sequences of the DNA in the cells of two individual pugs differ. Likewise, the sequences of DNA in you and a sibling differ
(unless your sibling is an identical twin), as do those between you and an unrelated individual. However, the DNA sequences
of two related individuals are more similar than the sequences of two unrelated individuals, and these similarities in sequence
can be observed in various ways. This is the principle behind DNA fingerprinting, which is a method used to determine
whether two DNA samples came from related (or the same) individuals or unrelated individuals.
Like ammonia, amines are weak bases due to the lone pair of electrons on their nitrogen atoms:
The basicity of an amine’s nitrogen atom plays an important role in much of the compound’s chemistry. Amine functional groups
are found in a wide variety of compounds, including natural and synthetic dyes, polymers, vitamins, and medications such as
penicillin and codeine. They are also found in many molecules essential to life, such as amino acids, hormones, neurotransmitters,
and DNA.
The name alkaloid means “like an alkali.” Thus, an alkaloid reacts with acid. The free compound can be recovered after extraction
by reaction with a base:
+ − − −
[ R NH ] Cl + OH ⟶ R N + H O + Cl
3 3 2
The structures of many naturally occurring alkaloids have profound physiological and psychotropic effects in humans. Examples of
these drugs include nicotine, morphine, codeine, and heroin. The plant produces these substances, collectively called secondary
plant compounds, as chemical defenses against the numerous pests that attempt to feed on the plant:
Figure 20.4.3 ).
Figure 20.4.3 : Poppies can be used in the production of opium, a plant latex that contains morphine from which other opiates, such
as heroin, can be synthesized. (credit: Karen Roe)
Amides are molecules that contain nitrogen atoms connected to the carbon atom of a carbonyl group. Like amines, various
nomenclature rules may be used to name amides, but all include use of the class-specific suffix -amide:
The reaction between amines and carboxylic acids to form amides is biologically important. It is through this reaction that amino
acids (molecules containing both amine and carboxylic acid substituents) link together in a polymer to form proteins.
Figure 20.4.4 : This condensation reaction forms a dipeptide from two amino acids and leads to the formation of water.
Figure 20.4.5 : A computer rendering shows the three-dimensional structure of the enzyme phenylalanine hydroxylase. In the
disease phenylketonuria, a defect in the shape of phenylalanine hydroxylase causes it to lose its function in breaking down
phenylalanine.
20.4.3: Kevlar
Kevlar (Figure 20.4.6) is a synthetic polymer made from two monomers 1,4-phenylene-diamine and terephthaloyl chloride (Kevlar
is a registered trademark of DuPont). Kevlar’s first commercial use was as a replacement for steel in racing tires. Kevlar is
typically spun into ropes or fibers. The material has a high tensile strength-to-weight ratio (it is about 5 times stronger than an equal
weight of steel), making it useful for many applications from bicycle tires to sails to body armor.
Figure 20.4.6 : This illustration shows the formula for polymeric Kevlar.
The material owes much of its strength to hydrogen bonds between polymer chains (refer back to the chapter on intermolecular
interactions). These bonds form between the carbonyl group oxygen atom (which has a partial negative charge due to oxygen’s
electronegativity) on one monomer and the partially positively charged hydrogen atom in the N–H bond of an adjacent monomer in
the polymer structure (dashed lines in Figure 20.4.7). There is additional strength derived from the interaction between the
unhybridized p orbitals in the six-membered rings, called aromatic stacking.
Figure 20.4.8 : (a) These soldiers are sorting through pieces of a Kevlar helmet that helped absorb a grenade blast. Kevlar is also
used to make (b) canoes and (c) marine mooring lines. (credit a: modification of work by “Cla68”/Wikimedia Commons; credit b:
modification of work by “OakleyOriginals”/Flickr; credit c: modification of work by Casey H. Kyhl)
In addition to its better-known uses, Kevlar is also often used in cryogenics for its very low thermal conductivity (along with its
high strength). Kevlar maintains its high strength when cooled to the temperature of liquid nitrogen (–196 °C).
The table here summarizes the structures discussed in this chapter:
Glossary
amine
organic molecule in which a nitrogen atom is bonded to one or more alkyl group
amide
organic molecule that features a nitrogen atom connected to the carbon atom in a carbonyl group
This page titled 20.4: Amines and Amides is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
20.E.1.2: S20.1.1
There are several sets of answers; one is:
(a) C5H12
(b) C5H10
(c) C5H8
20.E.1.3: Q20.1.2
What is the difference between the hybridization of carbon atoms’ valence orbitals in saturated and unsaturated hydrocarbons?
20.E.1.4: Q20.1.3
On a microscopic level, how does the reaction of bromine with a saturated hydrocarbon differ from its reaction with an unsaturated
hydrocarbon? How are they similar?
20.E.1.5: Q20.1.4
Both reactions result in bromine being incorporated into the structure of the product. The difference is the way in which that
incorporation takes place. In the saturated hydrocarbon, an existing C–H bond is broken, and a bond between the C and the Br can
then be formed. In the unsaturated hydrocarbon, the only bond broken in the hydrocarbon is the π bond whose electrons can be
used to form a bond to one of the bromine atoms in Br2 (the electrons from the Br–Br bond form the other C–Br bond on the other
carbon that was part of the π bond in the starting unsaturated hydrocarbon).
20.E.1.6: Q20.1.5
On a microscopic level, how does the reaction of bromine with an alkene differ from its reaction with an alkyne? How are they
similar?
20.E.1.8: S20.1.6
Unbranched alkanes have free rotation about the C–C bonds, yielding all orientations of the substituents about these bonds
equivalent, interchangeable by rotation. In the unbranched alkenes, the inability to rotate about the C = C bond results in fixed
(unchanging) substituent orientations, thus permitting different isomers. Since these concepts pertain to phenomena at the
molecular level, this explanation involves the microscopic domain.
Explain why these two molecules are not isomers:
20.E.1.9: Q20.1.7
Explain why these two molecules are not isomers:
20.E.1.10: S20.1.6
They are the same compound because each is a saturated hydrocarbon containing an unbranched chain of six carbon atoms.
20.E.1.11: Q20.1.7
How does the carbon-atom hybridization change when polyethylene is prepared from ethylene?
20.E.1.12: Q20.1.8
Write the Lewis structure and molecular formula for each of the following hydrocarbons:
a. hexane
b. 3-methylpentane
c. cis-3-hexene
d. 4-methyl-1-pentene
e. 3-hexyne
f. 4-methyl-2-pentyne
20.E.1.13: Q20.1.9
(a) C6H14
(c) C6H12
(d) C6H12
(e) C6H10
(f) C6H10
20.E.1.15: Q20.1.11
Give the complete IUPAC name for each of the following compounds:
a. CH3CH2CBr2CH3
b. (CH3)3CCl
c.
d. \(\mathrm{CH_3CH_2C≡CH\, CH_3CH_2C≡CH}\
e.
f.
g. (C H 3 )2 CHC H2 CH = C H2
20.E.1.16: S20.1.11
(a) 2,2-dibromobutane; (b) 2-chloro-2-methylpropane; (c) 2-methylbutane; (d) 1-butyne; (e) 4-fluoro-4-methyl-1-octyne; (f) trans-
1-chloropropene; (g) 5-methyl-1-pentene
20.E.1.17: Q20.1.12
Give the complete IUPAC name for each of the following compounds:
a. (CH3)2CHF
b. CH3CHClCHClCH3
c.
d. C H3 C H2 CH = CHC H3
20.E.1.18: Q20.1.13
Butane is used as a fuel in disposable lighters. Write the Lewis structure for each isomer of butane.
20.E.1.19: S20.1.13
20.E.1.20: Q20.1.14
Write Lewis structures and name the five structural isomers of hexane.
20.E.1.21: Q20.1.15
Write Lewis structures for the cis–trans isomers of C H 3 CH = CHCl .
20.E.1.22: S20.1.15
20.E.1.23: Q20.1.16
Write structures for the three isomers of the aromatic hydrocarbon xylene, C6H4(CH3)2.
20.E.1.24: Q20.1.17
Isooctane is the common name of the isomer of C8H18 used as the standard of 100 for the gasoline octane rating:
20.E.1.25: Q20.1.18
(a) 2,2,4-trimethylpentane; (b) 2,2,3-trimethylpentane, 2,3,4-trimethylpentane, and 2,3,3-trimethylpentane:
20.E.1.27: Q20.1.20
Write Lewis structures and IUPAC names for all isomers of C4H9Cl.
20.E.1.28: S20.1.20
20.E.1.29: Q20.1.21
Name and write the structures of all isomers of the propyl and butyl alkyl groups.
20.E.1.30: Q20.1.22
Write the structures for all the isomers of the –C5H11 alkyl group.
20.E.1.31: Q20.1.23
In the following, the carbon backbone and the appropriate number of hydrogen atoms are shown in condensed form:
20.E.1.33: Q20.1.25
Benzene is one of the compounds used as an octane enhancer in unleaded gasoline. It is manufactured by the catalytic conversion
of acetylene to benzene:
3C H ⟶ C H (20.E.1)
2 2 6 6
Draw Lewis structures for these compounds, with resonance structures as appropriate, and determine the hybridization of the
carbon atoms in each.
20.E.1.34: S20.1.25
20.E.1.35: Q20.1.26
In acetylene, the bonding uses sp hybrids on carbon atoms and s orbitals on hydrogen atoms. In benzene, the carbon atoms are sp2
hybridized.
20.E.1.36: Q20.1.27
Teflon is prepared by the polymerization of tetrafluoroethylene. Write the equation that describes the polymerization using Lewis
symbols.
20.E.1.37: Q20.1.28
Write two complete, balanced equations for each of the following reactions, one using condensed formulas and one using Lewis
structures.
20.E.1.38: S20.1.28
(a) CH = CC H 2 C H3 + 2 I2 ⟶ CHI2 C I2 C H2 C H3
(b) CH 3
CH CH CH CH
2 2 2 3
+8 O
2
⟶ 5 CO
2
+6 H O
2
20.E.1.39: Q20.1.29
Write two complete, balanced equations for each of the following reactions, one using condensed formulas and one using Lewis
structures.
a. 2-butene reacts with chlorine.
b. benzene burns in air.
20.E.1.40: Q20.1.30
What mass of 2-bromopropane could be prepared from 25.5 g of propene? Assume a 100% yield of product.
20.E.1.41: S20.1.30
65.2 g
20.E.1.42: Q20.1.31
Acetylene is a very weak acid; however, it will react with moist silver(I) oxide and form water and a compound composed of silver
and carbon. Addition of a solution of HCl to a 0.2352-g sample of the compound of silver and carbon produced acetylene and
0.2822 g of AgCl.
a. What is the empirical formula of the compound of silver and carbon?
b. The production of acetylene on addition of HCl to the compound of silver and carbon suggests that the carbon is present as the
acetylide ion, C . Write the formula of the compound showing the acetylide ion.
2−
20.E.1.43: Q20.1.32
Ethylene can be produced by the pyrolysis of ethane:
C H ⟶ C H +H
2 6 2 4 2
How many kilograms of ethylene is produced by the pyrolysis of 1.000 × 103 kg of ethane, assuming a 100.0% yield?
20.E.1.44: S20.1.33
9.328 × 102 kg
(b)
(c)
Give the complete IUPAC name and the common name for each of the following compounds:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(a) 1-ethoxybutane, butyl ethyl ether; (b) 1-ethoxypropane, ethyl propyl ether; (c) 1-methoxypropane, methyl propyl ether
Write the condensed structures of both isomers with the formula C2H6O. Label the functional group of each isomer.
Write the condensed structures of all isomers with the formula C2H6O2. Label the functional group (or groups) of each isomer.
;
(b) C H 3 C H2 OH ⟶ C H2 = C H2 + H2 O
(b)
(c)
(a)
(b)
(c)
20.E.3.3: Q20.3.3
Predict the products of reducing the following molecules. In each case, identify the product that will result from the minimal
decrease in oxidation state for the highlighted carbon atom:
(a)
(c)
20.E.3.4: Q20.3.4
Explain why it is not possible to prepare a ketone that contains only two carbon atoms.
20.E.3.5: S20.3.4
A ketone contains a group bonded to two additional carbon atoms; thus, a minimum of three carbon atoms are needed.
20.E.3.6: Q20.3.5
How does hybridization of the substituted carbon atom change when an alcohol is converted into an aldehyde? An aldehyde to a
carboxylic acid?
20.E.3.7: Q20.3.6
Fatty acids are carboxylic acids that have long hydrocarbon chains attached to a carboxylate group. How does a saturated fatty acid
differ from an unsaturated fatty acid? How are they similar?
20.E.3.8: S20.3.6
Since they are both carboxylic acids, they each contain the –COOH functional group and its characteristics. The difference is the
hydrocarbon chain in a saturated fatty acid contains no double or triple bonds, whereas the hydrocarbon chain in an unsaturated
fatty acid contains one or more multiple bonds.
20.E.3.9: S20.3.7
Write a condensed structural formula, such as CH3CH3, and describe the molecular geometry at each carbon atom.
a. propene
b. 1-butanol
c. ethyl propyl ether
d. cis-4-bromo-2-heptene
e. 2,2,3-trimethylhexane
f. formaldehyde
20.E.3.10: Q20.3.8
Write a condensed structural formula, such as CH3CH3, and describe the molecular geometry at each carbon atom.
a. 2-propanol
b. acetone
c. dimethyl ether
d. acetic acid
20.E.3.11: S20.3.8
(a) CH3CH(OH)CH3: all carbons are tetrahedral; (b) CH C(==O)CH : the end carbons are tetrahedral and the central carbon is
3 3
trigonal planar; (c) CH3OCH3: all are tetrahedral; (d) CH3COOH: the methyl carbon is tetrahedral and the acid carbon is trigonal
planar; (e) CH3CH2CH2CH(CH3)CHCH2: all are tetrahedral except the right-most two carbons, which are trigonal planar
20.E.3.12: Q20.3.9
The foul odor of rancid butter is caused by butyric acid, CH3CH2CH2CO2H.
a. Draw the Lewis structure and determine the oxidation number and hybridization for each carbon atom in the molecule.
b. The esters formed from butyric acid are pleasant-smelling compounds found in fruits and used in perfumes. Draw the Lewis
structure for the ester formed from the reaction of butyric acid with 2-propanol.
20.E.3.13: Q20.3.10
Write the two-resonance structures for the acetate ion.
20.E.3.14: Q20.3.11
Write two complete, balanced equations for each of the following reactions, one using condensed formulas and one using Lewis
structures:
a. ethanol reacts with propionic acid
b. benzoic acid, C6H5CO2H, is added to a solution of sodium hydroxide
20.E.3.15: Q20.3.12
Write two complete balanced equations for each of the following reactions, one using condensed formulas and one using Lewis
structures.
a. 1-butanol reacts with acetic acid
b. propionic acid is poured onto solid calcium carbonate
20.E.3.16: S20.3.12
(a) CH 3
CH CH CH OH + CH C(O)OH ⟶ CH C(O)OCH CH CH CH
2 2 2 3 3 2 2 2 3
+H O
2
:
(b) 2 CH 3
CH COOH + CaCO
2 3
⟶ (CH CH COO) Ca + CO
3 2 2 2
+H O
2
:
20.E.3.18: Q20.3.14
Alcohols A, B, and C all have the composition C4H10O. Molecules of alcohol A contain a branched carbon chain and can be
oxidized to an aldehyde; molecules of alcohol B contain a linear carbon chain and can be oxidized to a ketone; and molecules of
alcohol C can be oxidized to neither an aldehyde nor a ketone. Write the Lewis structures of these molecules.
20.E.3.19: S20.3.15
20.E.4.2: Q20.4.2
What is the molecular structure about the nitrogen atom in trimethyl amine and in the trimethyl ammonium ion, (CH3)3NH+? What
is the hybridization of the nitrogen atom in trimethyl amine and in the trimethyl ammonium ion?
20.E.4.3: S20.4.2
Trimethyl amine: trigonal pyramidal, sp3; trimethyl ammonium ion: tetrahedral, sp3
20.E.4.4: Q20.4.3
Write the two resonance structures for the pyridinium ion, C5H5NH+.
20.E.4.5: Q20.4.4
Draw Lewis structures for pyridine and its conjugate acid, the pyridinium ion, C5H5NH+. What are the geometries and
hybridizations about the nitrogen atoms in pyridine and in the pyridinium ion?
20.E.4.7: Q20.4.6
Write two complete balanced equations for the following reaction, one using condensed formulas and one using Lewis structures.
Methyl amine is added to a solution of HCl.
20.E.4.8: S20.4.6
+ +
CH NH +H O ⟶ CH NH +H O (20.E.2)
3 2 3 3 3 2
20.E.4.9: Q20.4.7
Write two complete, balanced equations for each of the following reactions, one using condensed formulas and one using Lewis
structures.
Ethylammonium chloride is added to a solution of sodium hydroxide.
20.E.4.10: Q20.4.8
Identify any carbon atoms that change hybridization and the change in hybridization during the reactions in [link].
20.E.4.11: S20.4.8
CH3CH = CHCH3(sp2) + Cl ⟶ CH3CH(Cl)H(Cl)CH3(sp3);
2C6H6(sp2) + 15O2 ⟶ 12CO2(sp) + 6H2O
20.E.4.12: Q20.4.9
Identify any carbon atoms that change hybridization and the change in hybridization during the reactions in [link].
20.E.4.13: Q20.4.10
Identify any carbon atoms that change hybridization and the change in hybridization during the reactions in [link].
20.E.4.14: S20.4.10
the carbon in CO32−, initially at sp2, changes hybridization to sp in CO2
This page titled 21: Nuclear Chemistry is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability
Learning Objectives
Describe nuclear structure in terms of protons, neutrons, and electrons
Calculate mass defect and binding energy for nuclei
Explain trends in the relative stability of nuclei
Nuclear chemistry is the study of reactions that involve changes in nuclear structure. The chapter on atoms, molecules, and ions
introduced the basic idea of nuclear structure, that the nucleus of an atom is composed of protons and, with the exception of H , 1
1
neutrons. Recall that the number of protons in the nucleus is called the atomic number (Z ) of the element, and the sum of the
number of protons and the number of neutrons is the mass number (A ). Atoms with the same atomic number but different mass
numbers are isotopes of the same element. When referring to a single type of nucleus, we often use the term nuclide and identify it
by the notation:
A
X (21.1.1)
Z
where
X is the symbol for the element,
A is the mass number, and
Often a nuclide is referenced by the name of the element followed by a hyphen and the mass number. For example, 14
6
C is called
“carbon-14.”
Protons and neutrons, collectively called nucleons, are packed together tightly in a nucleus. With a radius of about 10−15 meters, a
nucleus is quite small compared to the radius of the entire atom, which is about 10−10 meters. Nuclei are extremely dense compared
to bulk matter, averaging 1.8 × 10 grams per cubic centimeter. For example, water has a density of 1 gram per cubic centimeter,
14
and iridium, one of the densest elements known, has a density of 22.6 g/cm3. If the earth’s density were equal to the average
nuclear density, the earth’s radius would be only about 200 meters (earth’s actual radius is approximately 6.4 × 10 meters, 30,000
6
times larger). Example 21.1.1 demonstrates just how great nuclear densities can be in the natural world.
Solution
We can treat both the neutron star and the U-235 nucleus as spheres. Then the density for both is given by:
m
ρ =
V
with
4 3
V = πr
3
1 1
(a) The radius of the neutron star is × 26 km = × 2.6 × 10
4 4
m = 1.3 × 10 m so the density of the neutron star is:
2 2
m
=
4 3
πr
3
30
2.4(1.99 × 10 kg)
=
4 4 3
π(1.3 × 10 m )
3
17 3
= 5.2 × 10 kg/ m
1
(b) The radius of the U-235 nucleus is × 15 × 10
−15
m = 7.5 × 10
−15
m , so the density of the U-235 nucleus is:
2
m
ρ =
V
m
=
4 3
πr
3
−27
1.66×10 kg
235 amu ( )
1 amu
=
4 −15 3
π(7.5 × 10 m)
3
17 3
= 2.2 × 10 kg/ m
These values are fairly similar (same order of magnitude), but the nucleus is more than twice as dense as the neutron star.
Exercise 21.1.1
Find the density of a neutron star with a mass of 1.97 solar masses and a diameter of 13 km, and compare it to the density of a
hydrogen nucleus, which has a diameter of 1.75 fm (1 f m = 1 × 10 m ). –15
Answer
The density of the neutron star is 3.4 × 10 kg/m . The density of a hydrogen nucleus is 6.0 × 10
18 3 17
kg/ m
3
. The neutron
star is 5.7 times denser than the hydrogen nucleus.
To hold positively charged protons together in the very small volume of a nucleus requires very strong attractive forces because the
positively charged protons repel one another strongly at such short distances. The force of attraction that holds the nucleus together
is the strong nuclear force. (The strong force is one of the four fundamental forces that are known to exist. The others are the
electromagnetic force, the gravitational force, and the nuclear weak force.) This force acts between protons, between neutrons, and
between protons and neutrons. It is very different from the electrostatic force that holds negatively charged electrons around a
positively charged nucleus (the attraction between opposite charges). Over distances less than 10−15 meters and within the nucleus,
the strong nuclear force is much stronger than electrostatic repulsions between protons; over larger distances and outside the
nucleus, it is essentially nonexistent.
However, mass spectrometric measurements reveal that the mass of an He atom is 4.0026 amu, less than the combined masses of
4
2
its six constituent subatomic particles. This difference between the calculated and experimentally measured masses is known as the
mass defect of the atom. In the case of helium, the mass defect indicates a “loss” in mass of 4.0331 amu – 4.0026 amu = 0.0305
amu. The loss in mass accompanying the formation of an atom from protons, neutrons, and electrons is due to the conversion of
that mass into energy that is evolved as the atom forms. The nuclear binding energy is the energy produced when the atoms’
nucleons are bound together; this is also the energy needed to break a nucleus into its constituent protons and neutrons. In
where E is energy, m is mass of the matter being converted, and c is the speed of light in a vacuum. This equation can be used to
find the amount of energy that results when matter is converted into energy. Using this mass-energy equivalence equation, the
nuclear binding energy of a nucleus may be calculated from its mass defect, as demonstrated in Example 21.1.2. A variety of units
are commonly used for nuclear binding energies, including electron volts (eV), with 1 eV equaling the amount of energy necessary
to the move the charge of an electron across an electric potential difference of 1 volt, making 1 eV = 1.602 × 10 J.
−19
Solution
The mass defect for a He nucleus is 0.0305 amu, as shown previously. Determine the binding energy in joules per nuclide
4
2
using the mass-energy equivalence equation. To accommodate the requested energy units, the mass defect must be expressed in
kilograms (recall that 1 J = 1 kg m2/s2).
(a) First, express the mass defect in g/mol. This is easily done considering the numerical equivalence of atomic mass (amu) and
molar mass (g/mol) that results from the definitions of the amu and mole units (refer to the previous discussion in the chapter
on atoms, molecules, and ions if needed). The mass defect is therefore 0.0305 g/mol. To accommodate the units of the other
terms in the mass-energy equation, the mass must be expressed in kg, since 1 J = 1 kg m2/s2. Converting grams into kilograms
yields a mass defect of 3.05 × 10 kg/mol. Substituting this quantity into the mass-energy equivalence equation yields:
–5
\[\begin{align*} E &=mc^2 \\[4pt] &= \dfrac{3.05 \times 10^{-5}\;kg}{mol} \times \left(\dfrac{2.998 \times 10^8\;m}
{s}\right)^2 \\[4pt] &= 2.74×10^{12}\:kg\:m^2s^{-2}mol^{-1} \\[4pt] &=2.74 \times 10^{12}\;J/mol=2.74\: TJ /mol
\end{align*} \nonumber \]
Note that this tremendous amount of energy is associated with the conversion of a very small amount of matter (about 30 mg,
roughly the mass of typical drop of water).
(b) The binding energy for a single nucleus is computed from the molar binding energy using Avogadro’s number:
1 mol
12 −1
E = 2.74 × 10 J mol ×
23
6.022 × 10 nuclei
−12
= 4.55 × 10 J = 4.55 pJ
7
= 2.84 × 10 eV = 28.4 M eV
Exercise 21.1.2
Answer
148.4 MeV
Figure 21.1.1 : This plot shows the nuclides that are known to exist and those that are stable. The stable nuclides are indicated in
blue, and the unstable nuclides are indicated in green. Note that all isotopes of elements with atomic numbers greater than 83 are
unstable. The solid line is the line where n = Z.
The nuclei that are to the left or to the right of the band of stability are unstable and exhibit radioactivity. They change
spontaneously (decay) into other nuclei that are either in, or closer to, the band of stability. These nuclear decay reactions convert
one unstable isotope (or radioisotope) into another, more stable, isotope. We will discuss the nature and products of this radioactive
decay in subsequent sections of this chapter.
Several observations may be made regarding the relationship between the stability of a nucleus and its structure. Nuclei with even
numbers of protons, neutrons, or both are more likely to be stable (Table 21.1.1). Nuclei with certain numbers of nucleons, known
as magic numbers, are stable against nuclear decay. These numbers of protons or neutrons (2, 8, 20, 28, 50, 82, and 126) make
complete shells in the nucleus. These are similar in concept to the stable electron shells observed for the noble gases. Nuclei that
have magic numbers of both protons and neutrons, such as He, O, Ca, and Pb and are particularly stable. These trends in
4
2
16
8
40
20
208
82
53 even odd
50 odd even
5 odd odd
The relative stability of a nucleus is correlated with its binding energy per nucleon, the total binding energy for the nucleus divided
by the number or nucleons in the nucleus. For instance, the binding energy for a He nucleus is therefore:
4
2
28.4 MeV
= 7.10 MeV/nucleon (21.1.4)
4 nucleons
The binding energy per nucleon of a nuclide on the curve shown in Figure 21.1.2
Figure 21.1.2 : The binding energy per nucleon is largest for nuclides with mass number of approximately 56.
The iron nuclide Fe lies near the top of the binding energy curve (Figure 21.1.2) and is one of the most stable nuclides. What
56
26
is the binding energy per nucleon (in MeV) for the nuclide Fe (atomic mass of 55.9349 amu)?
56
26
Solution
As in Example, we first determine the mass defect of the nuclide, which is the difference between the mass of 26 protons, 30
neutrons, and 26 electrons, and the observed mass of an Fe atom:
56
26
Mass def ect = [(26 × 1.0073 amu) + (30 × 1.0087 amu) + (26 × 0.00055 amu)] − 55.9349 amu
= 0.5302 amu
We next calculate the binding energy for one nucleus from the mass defect using the mass-energy equivalence equation:
−11
= 7.913 × 10 J
We then convert the binding energy in joules per nucleus into units of MeV per nuclide:
−11
1 MeV
7.913 × 10 J× = 493.9 MeV
−13
1.602 × 10 J
Finally, we determine the binding energy per nucleon by dividing the total nuclear binding energy by the number of nucleons
in the atom:
493.9 MeV
Binding energy per nucleon = = 8.820 MeV/nucleon
56
Note that this is almost 25% larger than the binding energy per nucleon for He.(Note also that this is the same process as in
4
2
Example \(\PageIndex{2}\, but with the additional step of dividing the total nuclear binding energy by the number of
nucleons.)
Exercise 21.1.3
Answer
7.810 MeV/nucleon
Summary
An atomic nucleus consists of protons and neutrons, collectively called nucleons. Although protons repel each other, the nucleus is
held tightly together by a short-range, but very strong, force called the strong nuclear force. A nucleus has less mass than the total
mass of its constituent nucleons. This “missing” mass is the mass defect, which has been converted into the binding energy that
holds the nucleus together according to Einstein’s mass-energy equivalence equation, E = mc2. Of the many nuclides that exist,
only a small number are stable. Nuclides with even numbers of protons or neutrons, or those with magic numbers of nucleons, are
especially likely to be stable. These stable nuclides occupy a narrow band of stability on a graph of number of protons versus
number of neutrons. The binding energy per nucleon is largest for the elements with mass numbers near 56; these are the most
stable nuclei.
Glossary
band of stability
(also, belt of stability, zone of stability, or valley of stability) region of graph of number of protons versus number of neutrons
containing stable (nonradioactive) nuclides
magic number
nuclei with specific numbers of nucleons that are within the band of stability
nuclear chemistry
study of the structure of atomic nuclei and processes that change nuclear structure
nucleon
collective term for protons and neutrons in a nucleus
nuclide
nucleus of a particular isotope
radioactivity
phenomenon exhibited by an unstable nucleon that spontaneously undergoes change into a nucleon that is more stable; an
unstable nucleon is said to be radioactive
radioisotope
isotope that is unstable and undergoes conversion into a different, more stable isotope
Paul Flowers (University of North Carolina - Pembroke), Klaus Theopold (University of Delaware) and Richard Langley
(Stephen F. Austin State University) with contributing authors. Textbook content produced by OpenStax College is licensed
under a Creative Commons Attribution License 4.0 license. Download for free at http://cnx.org/contents/85abf193-
2bd...a7ac8df6@9.110).
This page titled 21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Changes of nuclei that result in changes in their atomic numbers, mass numbers, or energy states are nuclear reactions. To describe
a nuclear reaction, we use an equation that identifies the nuclides involved in the reaction, their mass numbers and atomic numbers,
and the other particles involved in the reaction.
constituents of atomic nuclei, and have been described previously. Alpha particles ( He , also represented by the symbol α) are
4
2
4
2
high-energy helium nuclei. Beta particles ( β , also represented by the symbol e) are high-energy electrons, and gamma rays
0
−1
0
−1
are photons of very high-energy electromagnetic radiation. Positrons ( e , also represented by the symbol β) are positively
+1
0
+1
0
charged electrons (“anti-electrons”). The subscripts and superscripts are necessary for balancing nuclear equations, but are usually
optional in other circumstances. For example, an alpha particle is a helium nucleus (He) with a charge of +2 and a mass number of
4, so it is symbolized He. This works because, in general, the ion charge is not important in the balancing of nuclear equations.
4
2
Figure 21.2.1 : Although many species are encountered in nuclear reactions, this table summarizes the names, symbols,
representations, and descriptions of the most common of these.
This table has four columns and seven rows. The first row is a header row and it labels each column: “Name,” “Symbol(s),”
“Representation,” and “Description.” Under the “Name” column are the following: “Alpha particle,” “Beta particle,” “Positron,”
“Proton,” “Neutron,” and “Gamma ray.” Under the “Symbol(s)” column are the following: “ superscript 4 stacked over a subscript
2 H e or lowercase alpha,” “superscript 0 stacked over a subscript 1 e or lowercase beta,” “superscript 0 stacked over a positive
subscript 1 e or lowercase beta superscript positive sign,” “superscript 1 stacked over a subscript 1 H or lowercase rho superscript 1
stacked over a subscript 1 H,” “superscript 1 stacked over a subscript 0 n or lowercase eta superscript 1 stacked over a subscript 0
n,” and a lowercase gamma. Under the “Representation column,” are the following: two white sphere attached to two blue spheres
of about the same size with positive signs in them; a small red sphere with a negative sign in it; a small red sphere with a positive
sign in it; a blue spheres with a positive sign in it; a white sphere; and a purple squiggle ling with an arrow pointing right to a
lowercase gamma. Under the “Description” column are the following: “(High-energy) helium nuclei consisting of two protons and
two neutrons,” “(High-energy) elections,” “Particles with the same mass as an electron but with 1 unit of positive charge,” “Nuclei
of hydrogen atoms,” “Particles with a mass approximately equal to that of a proton but with no charge,” and “Very high-energy
electromagnetic radiation.”
Gamma rays compose short wavelength, high-energy electromagnetic radiation and are (much) more energetic than better-known
X-rays. Gamma rays are produced when a nucleus undergoes a transition from a higher to a lower energy state, similar to how a
photon is produced by an electronic transition from a higher to a lower energy level. Due to the much larger energy differences
between nuclear energy shells, gamma rays emanating from a nucleus have energies that are typically millions of times larger than
electromagnetic radiation emanating from electronic transitions.
we knew that a proton, H , was one of the two products. Example 21.2.1 shows how we can identify a nuclide by balancing the
1
1
nuclear reaction.
Solution
The nuclear reaction can be written as:
25 4 1 A
12
Mg + 2 He → 1
H+ Z
X
where
A is the mass number and
Z is the atomic number of the new nuclide, X .
Because the sum of the mass numbers of the reactants must equal the sum of the mass numbers of the products:
25 + 4 = A + 1
so
A = 28
12 + 2 = Z + 1
so
Z = 13
Exercise 21.2.1
The nuclide I combines with an electron and produces a new nucleus and no other massive particles. What is the equation
125
53
Answer
125 0 125
53
I+ e → 52
Te
−1
Following are the equations of several nuclear reactions that have important roles in the history of nuclear chemistry:
The first naturally occurring unstable element that was isolated, polonium, was discovered by the Polish scientist Marie Curie
and her husband Pierre in 1898. It decays, emitting α particles:
212 208 4
Po ⟶ Pb + He
84 82 2
The first nuclide to be prepared by artificial means was an isotope of oxygen, 17O. It was made by Ernest Rutherford in 1919 by
bombarding nitrogen atoms with α particles:
14 4 17 1
7
N+ α ⟶ 8
O + 1H
2
James Chadwick discovered the neutron in 1932, as a previously unknown neutral particle produced along with 12C by the
nuclear reaction between 9Be and 4He:
9 4 12 1
4
Be + 2 He ⟶ 6
C+ n
0
The first element to be prepared that does not occur naturally on the earth, technetium, was created by bombardment of
molybdenum by deuterons (heavy hydrogen, H ), by Emilio Segre and Carlo Perrier in 1937:
2
1
2 97 1 97
1
H + 42 Mo ⟶ 2 n + 43 Tc
0
The first controlled nuclear chain reaction was carried out in a reactor at the University of Chicago in 1942. One of the many
reactions involved was:
235 1 87 146 1
U+ n ⟶ Br + La + 3 n
92 0 35 57 0
Summary
Nuclei can undergo reactions that change their number of protons, number of neutrons, or energy state. Many different particles can
be involved in nuclear reactions. The most common are protons, neutrons, positrons (which are positively charged electrons), alpha
(α) particles (which are high-energy helium nuclei), beta (β) particles (which are high-energy electrons), and gamma (γ) rays
(which compose high-energy electromagnetic radiation). As with chemical reactions, nuclear reactions are always balanced. When
a nuclear reaction occurs, the total mass (number) and the total charge remain unchanged.
Glossary
alpha particle
(α or He or
4
2
4
2
α ) high-energy helium nucleus; a helium atom that has lost two electrons and contains two protons and two
neutrons
antimatter
particles with the same mass but opposite properties (such as charge) of ordinary particles
beta particle
(β or −1
0
e or −1
0
) high-energy electron
β
gamma ray
nuclear reaction
change to a nucleus resulting in changes in the atomic number, mass number, or energy state
positron ( +1
0
β or 0
+1
)
e
antiparticle to the electron; it has identical properties to an electron, except for having the opposite (positive) charge
This page titled 21.2: Nuclear Equations is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Following the somewhat serendipitous discovery of radioactivity by Becquerel, many prominent scientists began to investigate this
new, intriguing phenomenon. Among them were Marie Curie (the first woman to win a Nobel Prize, and the only person to win two
Nobel Prizes in different sciences—chemistry and physics), who was the first to coin the term “radioactivity,” and Ernest
Rutherford (of gold foil experiment fame), who investigated and named three of the most common types of radiation. During the
beginning of the twentieth century, many radioactive substances were discovered, the properties of radiation were investigated and
quantified, and a solid understanding of radiation and nuclear decay was developed.
The spontaneous change of an unstable nuclide into another is radioactive decay. The unstable nuclide is called the parent nuclide;
the nuclide that results from the decay is known as the daughter nuclide. The daughter nuclide may be stable, or it may decay itself.
The radiation produced during radioactive decay is such that the daughter nuclide lies closer to the band of stability than the parent
nuclide, so the location of a nuclide relative to the band of stability can serve as a guide to the kind of decay it will undergo (Figure
21.3.1).
Figure 21.3.1 : A nucleus of uranium-238 (the parent nuclide) undergoes α decay to form thorium-234 (the daughter nuclide). The
alpha particle removes two protons (green) and two neutrons (gray) from the uranium-238 nucleus.
A diagram shows two spheres composed of many smaller white and green spheres connected by a right-facing arrow with another,
down-facing arrow coming off of it. The left sphere, labeled “Parent nucleus uranium dash 238” has two white and two green
spheres that are near one another and are outlined in red. These two green and two white spheres are shown near the tip of the
down-facing arrow and labeled “alpha particle.” The right sphere, labeled “Daughter nucleus radon dash 234,” looks the same as
the left, but has a space for four smaller spheres outlined with a red dotted line.
Although the radioactive decay of a nucleus is too small to see with the naked eye, we can indirectly view radioactive decay in an
environment called a cloud chamber. Click here to learn about cloud chambers and to view an interesting Cloud Chamber
Demonstration from the Jefferson Lab.
Figure 21.3.2 : Alpha particles, which are attracted to the negative plate and deflected by a relatively small amount, must be
positively charged and relatively massive. Beta particles, which are attracted to the positive plate and deflected a relatively large
amount, must be negatively charged and relatively light. Gamma rays, which are unaffected by the electric field, must be
uncharged.
A diagram is shown. A gray box on the left side of the diagram labeled “Lead block” has a chamber hollowed out in the center in
which a sample labeled “Radioactive substance” is placed. A blue beam is coming from the sample, out of the block, and passing
through two horizontally placed plates that are labeled “Electrically charged plates.” The top plate is labeled with a positive sign
while the bottom plate is labeled with a negative sign. The beam is shown to break into three beams as it passes in between the
plates; in order from top to bottom, they are red, labeled “beta rays,” purple labeled “gamma rays” and green labeled “alpha rays.”
The beams are shown to hit a vertical plate labeled “Photographic plate” on the far right side of the diagram.
Alpha (α ) decay is the emission of an α particle from the nucleus. For example, polonium-210 undergoes α decay:
210 4 206 210 4 206
Po ⟶ He + Pb or Po ⟶ α+ Pb
84 2 82 84 2 82
Alpha decay occurs primarily in heavy nuclei (A > 200, Z > 83). Because the loss of an α particle gives a daughter nuclide with a
mass number four units smaller and an atomic number two units smaller than those of the parent nuclide, the daughter nuclide has a
larger n:p ratio than the parent nuclide. If the parent nuclide undergoing α decay lies below the band of stability, the daughter
nuclide will lie closer to the band.
Beta (β) decay is the emission of an electron from a nucleus. Iodine-131 is an example of a nuclide that undergoes β decay:
131 0 131 131 0 131
53
I ⟶ e+ 54
X or 53
I ⟶ −1
β+ 54
Xe
−1
There is no change in mass number or atomic number during the emission of a γ ray unless the γ emission accompanies one of the
other modes of decay.
Positron emission (β decay) is the emission of a positron from the nucleus. Oxygen-15 is an example of a nuclide that undergoes
+
positron emission:
15 0 15 15 0 15
O ⟶ e+ N or O ⟶ β+ N
8 +1 7 8 +1 7
Positron emission is observed for nuclides in which the n:p ratio is low. These nuclides lie below the band of stability. Positron
decay is the conversion of a proton into a neutron with the emission of a positron. The n:p ratio increases, and the daughter nuclide
lies closer to the band of stability than did the parent nuclide.
Electron capture occurs when one of the inner electrons in an atom is captured by the atom’s nucleus. For example, potassium-40
undergoes electron capture:
40 0 40
K+ e ⟶ Ar
19 −1 18
Electron capture occurs when an inner shell electron combines with a proton and is converted into a neutron. The loss of an inner
shell electron leaves a vacancy that will be filled by one of the outer electrons. As the outer electron drops into the vacancy, it will
emit energy. In most cases, the energy emitted will be in the form of an X-ray. Like positron emission, electron capture occurs for
“proton-rich” nuclei that lie below the band of stability. Electron capture has the same effect on the nucleus as does positron
emission: The atomic number is decreased by one and the mass number does not change. This increases the n:p ratio, and the
daughter nuclide lies closer to the band of stability than did the parent nuclide. Whether electron capture or positron emission
occurs is difficult to predict. The choice is primarily due to kinetic factors, with the one requiring the smaller activation energy
being the one more likely to occur. Figure 21.3.3 summarizes these types of decay, along with their equations and changes in
atomic and mass numbers.
PET Scan
Positron emission tomography (PET) scans use radiation to diagnose and track health conditions and monitor medical
treatments by revealing how parts of a patient’s body function (Figure 21.3.4). To perform a PET scan, a positron-emitting
radioisotope is produced in a cyclotron and then attached to a substance that is used by the part of the body being investigated.
This “tagged” compound, or radiotracer, is then put into the patient (injected via IV or breathed in as a gas), and how it is used
by the tissue reveals how that organ or other area of the body functions.
analog called fludeoxyglucose (FDG). How FDG is used by the body provides critical diagnostic information; for example,
since cancers use glucose differently than normal tissues, FDG can reveal cancers. The 18F emits positrons that interact with
nearby electrons, producing a burst of gamma radiation. This energy is detected by the scanner and converted into a detailed,
three-dimensional, color image that shows how that part of the patient’s body functions. Different levels of gamma radiation
produce different amounts of brightness and colors in the image, which can then be interpreted by a radiologist to reveal what
is going on. PET scans can detect heart damage and heart disease, help diagnose Alzheimer’s disease, indicate the part of a
brain that is affected by epilepsy, reveal cancer, show what stage it is, and how much it has spread, and whether treatments are
effective. Unlike magnetic resonance imaging and X-rays, which only show how something looks, the big advantage of PET
scans is that they show how something functions. PET scans are now usually performed in conjunction with a computed
tomography scan.
radiation emitted is cut in half every 5.27 years. (Note that for a given substance, the intensity of radiation that it produces is
directly proportional to the rate of decay of the substance and the amount of the substance.) This is as expected for a process
following first-order kinetics. Thus, a cobalt-60 source that is used for cancer treatment must be replaced regularly to continue to be
effective.
decay rate = λN
where N0 is the initial number of nuclei or moles of the isotope, and Nt is the number of nuclei/moles remaining at time t. Example
21.3.1 applies these calculations to find the rates of radioactive decay for specific nuclides.
c. How long does it take for a sample of Co to disintegrate to the extent that only 2.0% of the original amount remains?
60
27
Solution
(a) The value of the rate constant is given by:
Nt
(b) The fraction of 60
27
Co that is left after time t is given by . Rearranging the first-order relationship Nt = N0e–λt to solve for
N0
The fraction of Co that will remain after 15.0 years is 0.138. Or put another way, 13.8% of the
60
27
60
27
Co originally present will
remain after 15 years.
(c) 2.00% of the original amount of 60
27
Co is equal to 0.0200 × N0. Substituting this into the equation for time for first-order
kinetics, we have:
1 Nt 1 0.0200 × N0
t =− ln( ) =− ln( ) = 29.6 y
−1
λ N0 0.132 y N0
Exercise 21.3.1
Radon-222, Rn, has a half-life of 3.823 days. How long will it take a sample of radon-222 with a mass of 0.750 g to decay
222
86
Answer
11.1 days
Because each nuclide has a specific number of nucleons, a particular balance of repulsion and attraction, and its own degree of
stability, the half-lives of radioactive nuclides vary widely. For example: the half-life of Bi is 1.9 × 1019 years; Ra is 24,000
209
83
239
94
years; Rn is 3.82 days; and element-111 (Rg for roentgenium) is 1.5 × 10–3 seconds. The half-lives of a number of radioactive
222
86
isotopes important to medicine are shown in Table 21.3.1, and others are listed in Appendix N1.
Table 21.3.1 : Half-lives of Radioactive Isotopes Important to Medicine
Type Decay Mode Half-Life Uses
the total; and trace amounts of C. Carbon-14 forms in the upper atmosphere by the reaction of nitrogen atoms with neutrons from
14
6
14 12
All isotopes of carbon react with oxygen to produce CO2 molecules. The ratio of CO to CO depends on the ratio of CO to
6 2 6 2
14
6
CO in the atmosphere. The natural abundance of CO in the atmosphere is approximately 1 part per trillion; until recently, this
12 14
6 6
14 12
has generally been constant over time, as seen is gas samples found trapped in ice. The incorporation of C CO and CO 14
6 6 2 6 2
into plants is a regular part of the photosynthesis process, which means that the C : C ratio found in a living plant is the same
14
6
12
6
as the C : C ratio in the atmosphere. But when the plant dies, it no longer traps carbon through photosynthesis. Because C is
14
6
12
6
12
6
a stable isotope and does not undergo radioactive decay, its concentration in the plant does not change. However, carbon-14 decays
by β emission with a half-life of 5730 years:
14 14 0
6
C ⟶ 7
N+ e
−1
Thus, the C : C ratio gradually decreases after the plant dies. The decrease in the ratio with time provides a measure of the time
14
6
12
6
that has elapsed since the death of the plant (or other organism that ate the plant). Figure 21.3.7 visually depicts this process.
Figure 21.3.7 : Along with stable carbon-12, radioactive carbon-14 is taken in by plants and animals, and remains at a constant
level within them while they are alive. After death, the C-14 decays and the C-14:C-12 ratio in the remains decreases. Comparing
this ratio to the C-14:C-12 ratio in living organisms allows us to determine how long ago the organism lived (and died).
A diagram shows a cow standing on the ground next to a tree. In the upper left of the diagram, where the sky is represented, a
single white sphere is shown and is connected by a downward-facing arrow to a larger sphere composed of green and white spheres
that is labeled “superscript 14, subscript 7, N.” This structure is connected to three other structures by a right-facing arrow. Each of
the three it points to are composed of green and white spheres and all have arrows pointing from them to the ground. The first of
these is labeled “Trace, superscript 14, subscript 6, C,” the second is labeled “1 percent, superscript 13, subscript 6, C” and the last
is labeled “99 percent, superscript 12, subscript 6, C.” Two downward-facing arrows that merge into one arrow lead from the cow
and tree to the ground and are labeled “organism dies” and “superscript 14, subscript 6, C, decay begins.” A right-facing arrow
labeled on top as “Decay” and on bottom as “Time” leads from this to a label of “superscript 14, subscript 6, C, backslash,
superscript 12, subscript 6, C, ratio decreased.” Near the top of the tree is a downward facing arrow with the label “superscript 14,
subscript 6, C, backslash, superscript 12, subscript 6, C, ratio is constant in living organisms” that leads to the last of the lower
statements.
For example, with the half-life of C being 5730 years, if the C : C ratio in a wooden object found in an archaeological dig is
14
6
14
6
12
6
half what it is in a living tree, this indicates that the wooden object is 5730 years old. Highly accurate determinations of C : C 14
6
12
6
ratios can be obtained from very small samples (as little as a milligram) by the use of a mass spectrometer.
Solution
The rate of decay (number of disintegrations/minute/gram of carbon) is proportional to the amount of radioactive C-14 left in
the paper, so we can substitute the rates for the amounts, N, in the relationship:
1 Nt 1 Ratet
t =− ln( ) ⟶ t =− ln( )
λ N0 λ Rate0
where the subscript 0 represents the time when the plants were cut to make the paper, and the subscript t represents the current
time.
The decay constant can be determined from the half-life of C-14, 5730 years:
ln 2 0.693
−4 −1
λ = = = 1.21 × 10 y
t1/2 5730 y
Therefore, the Dead Sea Scrolls are approximately 1900 years old (Figure 21.3.8).
Figure 21.3.8 : Carbon-14 dating has shown that these pages from the Dead Sea Scrolls were written or copied on paper made
from plants that died between 100 BC and AD 50.
Exercise 21.3.2
More accurate dates of the reigns of ancient Egyptian pharaohs have been determined recently using plants that were preserved
in their tombs. Samples of seeds and plant matter from King Tutankhamun’s tomb have a C-14 decay rate of 9.07
disintegrations/min/g of C. How long ago did King Tut’s reign come to an end?
Answer
about 3350 years ago, or approximately 1340 BC
There have been some significant, well-documented changes to the C : C ratio. The accuracy of a straightforward application
14
6
12
6
of this technique depends on the C : C ratio in a living plant being the same now as it was in an earlier era, but this is not
14
6
12
6
12
always valid. Due to the increasing accumulation of CO2 molecules (largely CO ) in the atmosphere caused by combustion of
6 2
fossil fuels (in which essentially all of the C has decayed), the ratio of C : C in the atmosphere may be changing. This
14
6
14
6
12
6
12
manmade increase in CO in the atmosphere causes the C : C ratio to decrease, and this in turn affects the ratio in currently
6 2
14
6
12
6
living organisms on the earth. Fortunately, however, we can use other data, such as tree dating via examination of annual growth
rings, to calculate correction factors. With these correction factors, accurate dates can be determined. In general, radioactive dating
only works for about 10 half-lives; therefore, the limit for carbon-14 dating is about 57,000 years.
An igneous rock contains 9.58 × 10–5 g of U-238 and 2.51 × 10–5 g of Pb-206, and much, much smaller amounts of Pb-208.
Determine the approximate time at which the rock formed.
Solution
The sample of rock contains very little Pb-208, the most common isotope of lead, so we can safely assume that all the Pb-206
in the rock was produced by the radioactive decay of U-238. When the rock formed, it contained all of the U-238 currently in
it, plus some U-238 that has since undergone radioactive decay.
The amount of U-238 currently in the rock is:
⎛ 1 mol U ⎞
−5 −7
9.58 × 10 g U × = 4.03 × 10 mol U
⎝ 238 g U ⎠
Because when one mole of U-238 decays, it produces one mole of Pb-206, the amount of U-238 that has undergone radioactive
decay since the rock was formed is:
⎛ 1 mol Pb ⎞ 1 mol U
−5 −7
2.51 × 10 g Pb × ×( ) = 1.22 × 10 mol U
⎝ 206 g Pb ⎠ 1 mol Pb
The amount of time that has passed since the formation of the rock is given by:
1 Nt
t =− ln( )
λ N0
with N0 representing the original amount of U-238 and Nt representing the present amount of U-238.
U-238 decays into Pb-206 with a half-life of 4.5 × 109 y, so the decay constant λ is:
ln 2 0.693
−10 −1
λ = = = 1.54 × 10 y
9
t1/2 4.5 × 10 y
Exercise 21.3.3
A sample of rock contains 6.14 × 10–4 g of Rb-87 and 3.51 × 10–5 g of Sr-87. Calculate the age of the rock. (The half-life of
the β decay of Rb-87 is 4.7 × 1010 y.)
Answer
3.7 × 109 y
Summary
Nuclei that have unstable n:p ratios undergo spontaneous radioactive decay. The most common types of radioactivity are α decay, β
decay, γ emission, positron emission, and electron capture. Nuclear reactions also often involve γ rays, and some nuclei decay by
electron capture. Each of these modes of decay leads to the formation of a new nucleus with a more stable n:p ratio. Some
substances undergo radioactive decay series, proceeding through multiple decays before ending in a stable isotope. All nuclear
decay processes follow first-order kinetics, and each radioisotope has its own characteristic half-life, the time that is required for
half of its atoms to decay. Because of the large differences in stability among nuclides, there is a very wide range of half-lives of
radioactive substances. Many of these substances have found useful applications in medical diagnosis and treatment, determining
the age of archaeological and geological objects, and more.
Glossary
alpha (α) decay
loss of an alpha particle during radioactive decay
daughter nuclide
nuclide produced by the radioactive decay of another nuclide; may be stable or may decay further
electron capture
combination of a core electron with a proton to yield a neutron within the nucleus
half-life (t1/2)
time required for half of the atoms in a radioactive sample to decay
parent nuclide
unstable nuclide that changes spontaneously into another (daughter) nuclide
positron emission
(also, β+ decay) conversion of a proton into a neutron, which remains in the nucleus, and a positron, which is emitted
radiocarbon dating
highly accurate means of dating objects 30,000–50,000 years old that were derived from once-living matter; achieved by
calculating the ratio of C : C in the object vs. the ratio of C : C in the present-day atmosphere
14
6
12
6
14
6
12
6
radiometric dating
use of radioisotopes and their properties to date the formation of objects such as archeological artifacts, formerly living
organisms, or geological formations
This page titled 21.3: Radioactive Decay is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
After the discovery of radioactivity, the field of nuclear chemistry was created and developed rapidly during the early twentieth century. A slew of new discoveries in the 1930s and 1940s, along
with World War II, combined to usher in the Nuclear Age in the mid-twentieth century. Science learned how to create new substances, and certain isotopes of certain elements were found to possess
the capacity to produce unprecedented amounts of energy, with the potential to cause tremendous damage during war, as well as produce enormous amounts of power for society’s needs during
peace.
The 17
8
O and 1
1
H nuclei that are produced are stable, so no further (nuclear) changes occur.
To reach the kinetic energies necessary to produce transmutation reactions, devices called particle accelerators are used. These devices use magnetic and electric fields to increase the speeds of
nuclear particles. In all accelerators, the particles move in a vacuum to avoid collisions with gas molecules. When neutrons are required for transmutation reactions, they are usually obtained from
radioactive decay reactions or from various nuclear reactions occurring in nuclear reactors. The Chemistry in Everyday Life feature that follows discusses a famous particle accelerator that made
worldwide news.
Figure 21.4.1 : A small section of the LHC is shown with workers traveling along it. (credit: Christophe Delaere)
In 2012, CERN announced that experiments at the LHC showed the first observations of the Higgs boson, an elementary particle that helps explain the origin of mass in fundamental particles.
This long-anticipated discovery made worldwide news and resulted in the awarding of the 2103 Nobel Prize in Physics to François Englert and Peter Higgs, who had predicted the existence of
this particle almost 50 years previously.
Prior to 1940, the heaviest-known element was uranium, whose atomic number is 92. Now, many artificial elements have been synthesized and isolated, including several on such a large scale that
they have had a profound effect on society. One of these—element 93, neptunium (Np)—was first made in 1940 by McMillan and Abelson by bombarding uranium-238 with neutrons. The reaction
creates unstable uranium-239, with a half-life of 23.5 minutes, which then decays into neptunium-239. Neptunium-239 is also radioactive, with a half-life of 2.36 days, and it decays into plutonium-
239. The nuclear reactions are:
238 1 239
U+ n ⟶ U
92 0 92
239 239 0
92
U ⟶ 93
Np + e t 1
half-life = 23.5 min
−1
2
239 239 0
93
Np ⟶ 94
Pu + e t 1
half-life = 2.36 days
−1
2
Plutonium is now mostly formed in nuclear reactors as a byproduct during the decay of uranium. Some of the neutrons that are released during U-235 decay combine with U-238 nuclei to form
uranium-239; this undergoes β decay to form neptunium-239, which in turn undergoes β decay to form plutonium-239 as illustrated in the preceding three equations. It is possible to summarize
these equations as:
− −
β β
238 1 239 239 239
U+ n⟶ U−→ Np −→ Pu
92 0 92 93 94
Heavier isotopes of plutonium—Pu-240, Pu-241, and Pu-242—are also produced when lighter plutonium nuclei capture neutrons. Some of this highly radioactive plutonium is used to produce
military weapons, and the rest presents a serious storage problem because they have half-lives from thousands to hundreds of thousands of years.
Although they have not been prepared in the same quantity as plutonium, many other synthetic nuclei have been produced. Nuclear medicine has developed from the ability to convert atoms of one
type into other types of atoms. Radioactive isotopes of several dozen elements are currently used for medical applications. The radiation produced by their decay is used to image or treat various
organs or portions of the body, among other uses.
The elements beyond element 92 (uranium) are called transuranium elements. As of this writing, 22 transuranium elements have been produced and officially recognized by IUPAC; several other
elements have formation claims that are waiting for approval. Some of these elements are shown in Table 21.4.1.
Table 21.4.1 : Preparation of Some of the Transuranium Elements
Name Symbol Atomic Number Reaction
239 240
americium Am 95 94
Pu +
1
0
n ⟶
95
Am +
0
−1
e
curium Cm 96 239
94
Pu +
4
2 He ⟶
242
96 Cm +
1
0
n
californium Cf 98 242
96 Cm +
4
2 He ⟶
245
98 Cf +
1
0
n
238 253
einsteinium Es 99 92
U + 15
1
0
n ⟶
99
Es + 7
0
−1
e
206 54 257 1
82 Pb + 24 Cr ⟶ 106 Sg +3 n
seaborgium Sg 106 249 18 263
0
1
Cf + O ⟶ Sg + 4 n
98 8 106 0
Figure 21.4.2 : When a slow neutron hits a fissionable U-235 nucleus, it is absorbed and forms an unstable U-236 nucleus. The U-236 nucleus then rapidly breaks apart into two smaller nuclei (in
this case, Ba-141 and Kr-92) along with several neutrons (usually two or three), and releases a very large amount of energy.
A diagram is shown which has a white sphere labeled “superscript, 1, subscript 0, n” followed by a right-facing arrow and a large sphere composed of many smaller white and green spheres labeled
“superscript, 235, subscript 92, U.” The single sphere has impacted the larger sphere. A right-facing arrow leads from the larger sphere to a vertical dumbbell shaped collection of the same white
and green spheres labeled “superscript, 236, subscript 92, U, Unstable nucleus.” Two right-facing arrows lead from the top and bottom of this structure to two new spheres that are also composed of
green and white spheres and are slightly smaller than the others. The top sphere is labeled “superscript, 92, subscript 36, K r” while the lower one is labeled “superscript, 141, subscript 56, B a.” A
starburst pattern labeled “Energy” lies between these two spheres and has three right-facing arrows leading from it to three white spheres labeled “3, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n.” A balanced
nuclear equation is written below the diagram and says “superscript, 235, subscript 92, U, plus sign, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n, yield arrow, superscript, 236, subscript 92, U, yield arrow,
superscript, 141, subscript 56, B a, plus sign, superscript, 92, subscript 36, K r, plus sign, 3, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n.”
Among the products of Meitner, Hahn, and Strassman’s fission reaction were barium, krypton, lanthanum, and cerium, all of which have nuclei that are more stable than uranium-235. Since then,
hundreds of different isotopes have been observed among the products of fissionable substances. A few of the many reactions that occur for U-235, and a graph showing the distribution of its
fission products and their yields, are shown in Figure 21.4.3. Similar fission reactions have been observed with other uranium isotopes, as well as with a variety of other isotopes such as those of
plutonium.
Figure 21.4.3 : (a) Nuclear fission of U-235 produces a range of fission products. (b) The larger fission products of U-235 are typically one isotope with a mass number around 85–105, and another
isotope with a mass number that is about 50% larger, that is, about 130–150.
Five nuclear equations and a graph are shown. The first equation is “superscript, 235, subscript 92, U, plus sign, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n, yield arrow, superscript, 236, subscript 92, U, yield
arrow, superscript, 90, subscript 38, S r, plus sign, superscript, 144, subscript 54, X e, plus sign, 2, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n.” The second equation is “superscript, 235, subscript 92, U, plus sign,
superscript, 1, subscript 0, n, yield arrow, superscript, 236, subscript 92, U, yield arrow, superscript, 87, subscript 35, B r, plus sign, superscript, 146, subscript 57, L a, plus sign, 3, superscript, 1,
subscript 0, n.” The third equation is “superscript, 235, subscript 92, U, plus sign, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n, yield arrow, superscript, 236, subscript 92, U, yield arrow, superscript, 97, subscript
37, R b, plus sign, superscript, 137, subscript 55, C s, plus sign, 3, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n.” The fourth equation is “superscript, 235, subscript 92, U, plus sign, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n,
yield arrow, superscript, 236, subscript 92, U, yield arrow, superscript, 137, subscript 52, T e, plus sign, superscript, 97, subscript 40, Z r, plus sign, 2, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n.” The fifth
equation is “superscript, 235, subscript 92, U, plus sign, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n, yield arrow, superscript, 236, subscript 92, U, yield arrow, superscript, 141, subscript 56, B a, plus sign,
superscript, 92, subscript 36, K r, plus sign, 3, superscript, 1, subscript 0, n.” A graph is also shown where the y-axis is labeled “Fission yield, open parenthesis, percent sign, close parenthesis” and
has values of 0 to 9 in increments of 1 while the x-axis is labeled “Mass number” and has values of 60 to 180 in increments of 20. The graph begins near point “65, 0” and rises rapidly to near “92,
6.6,” then drops just as rapidly to “107, 0” and remains there to point “127, 0.” The graph then rises again to near “132, 8,” then goes up and down a bit before falling to a point “153, 0,” and going
horizontal.
A tremendous amount of energy is produced by the fission of heavy elements. For instance, when one mole of U-235 undergoes fission, the products weigh about 0.2 grams less than the reactants;
this “lost” mass is converted into a very large amount of energy, about 1.8 × 1010 kJ per mole of U-235. Nuclear fission reactions produce incredibly large amounts of energy compared to chemical
reactions. The fission of 1 kilogram of uranium-235, for example, produces about 2.5 million times as much energy as is produced by burning 1 kilogram of coal.
As described earlier, when undergoing fission U-235 produces two “medium-sized” nuclei, and two or three neutrons. These neutrons may then cause the fission of other uranium-235 atoms, which
in turn provide more neutrons that can cause fission of even more nuclei, and so on. If this occurs, we have a nuclear chain reaction (Figure 21.4.4). On the other hand, if too many neutrons escape
the bulk material without interacting with a nucleus, then no chain reaction will occur.
Figure 21.4.5 : (a) In a subcritical mass, the fissile material is too small and allows too many neutrons to escape the material, so a chain reaction does not occur. (b) In a critical mass, a large enough
number of neutrons in the fissile material induce fission to create a chain reaction.
The images are shown and labeled “a,” “b” and “c.” Image a, labeled “Sub-critical mass,” shows a blue circle background with a white sphere near the outer, top, left edge of the circle. A
downward, right-facing arrow indicates that the white sphere enters the circle. Seven small, yellow starbursts are drawn in the blue circle and each has an arrow facing from it to outside the circle,
in seemingly random directions. Image b, labeled “Critical mass,” shows a blue circle background with a white sphere near the outer, top, left edge of the circle. A downward, right-facing arrow
indicates that the white sphere enters the circle. Seventeen small, yellow starbursts are drawn in the blue circle and each has an arrow facing from it to outside the circle, in seemingly random
directions. Image c, labeled “Critical mass from neutron deflection,” shows a blue circle background, lying in a larger purple circle, with a white sphere near the outer, top, left edge of the purple
circle. A downward, right-facing arrow indicates that the white sphere enters both of the circles. Thirteen small, yellow starbursts are drawn in the blue circle and each has an arrow facing from it to
outside the blue circle, and a couple outside of the purple circle, in seemingly random directions.
An atomic bomb (Figure 21.4.6) contains several pounds of fissionable material, U or Pu, a source of neutrons, and an explosive device for compressing it quickly into a small volume. When
235
92
239
94
fissionable material is in small pieces, the proportion of neutrons that escape through the relatively large surface area is great, and a chain reaction does not take place. When the small pieces of
fissionable material are brought together quickly to form a body with a mass larger than the critical mass, the relative number of escaping neutrons decreases, and a chain reaction and explosion
result.
Figure 21.4.7 : (a) The Diablo Canyon Nuclear Power Plant near San Luis Obispo is the only nuclear power plant currently in operation in California. The domes are the containment structures for
the nuclear reactors, and the brown building houses the turbine where electricity is generated. Ocean water is used for cooling. (b) The Diablo Canyon uses a pressurized water reactor, one of a few
different fission reactor designs in use around the world, to produce electricity. Energy from the nuclear fission reactions in the core heats water in a closed, pressurized system. Heat from this
system produces steam that drives a turbine, which in turn produces electricity. (credit a: modification of work by “Mike” Michael L. Baird; credit b: modification of work by the Nuclear
Regulatory Commission)
A photo labeled “a” and a diagram labeled “b” is shown. The photo is of a power plant with two large white domes and many buildings. The diagram shows a cylindrical container with thick walls
labeled “Walls made of concrete and steel” and three main components inside. The first of these components is a pair of tall cylinders labeled “Steam generators” that sit to either side of a shorter
cylinder labeled “Core.” Next to the core is a thin cylinder labeled “Pressurizer.” To the left of the outer walls is a set of pistons labeled “Turbines” that sit above a series of other equipment.
When control rod assemblies are inserted into the fuel element in the reactor core, they absorb a larger fraction of the slow neutrons, thereby slowing the rate of the fission reaction and decreasing
the power produced. Conversely, if the control rods are removed, fewer neutrons are absorbed, and the fission rate and energy production increase. In an emergency, the chain reaction can be shut
down by fully inserting all of the control rods into the nuclear core between the fuel rods.
Figure 21.4.8 : The nuclear reactor core shown in (a) contains the fuel and control rod assembly shown in (b). (credit: modification of work by E. Generalic,
glossary.periodni.com/glossar...en=control+rod)
Two diagrams are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Diagram a shows a cut-away view of a vertical tube with a flat, horizontal plate near the bottom that connects to a series of vertical pipes lined up
next to one another and labeled “Fuel rods.” A second horizontal plate labeled “Grid” lies at the top of the pipes and a second set of thinner, vertical pipes, labeled “Control rods,” leads from this
plate to the top of the container. The walls of the container are labeled “Steel pressure vessel.” A blue, right-facing arrow leads from an entry point in the left side of the container and is followed by
a second, down-facing blue arrow and a curved, right-facing arrow that trace along the outer, bottom edge of the container. A blue and red arrow follows these and faces up the right side of the
container to an exit near the right face where a red, right-facing arrow leads out. Diagram b is a cut-away image of a vertical, rectangular, three dimensional set of vertical pipes. The pipes are
labeled “Fuel rods” and are inserted into an upper and lower horizontal plate labeled “Grid.” Four thin rods extend above the pipes and are labeled “Control rods.
Video 21.4.1 : Click here to watch a 3-minute video from the Nuclear Energy Institute on how nuclear reactors work.
Nuclear power plants are designed in such a way that they cannot form a supercritical mass of fissionable material and therefore cannot create a nuclear explosion. But as history has shown, failures
of systems and safeguards can cause catastrophic accidents, including chemical explosions and nuclear meltdowns (damage to the reactor core from overheating). The following Chemistry in
Everyday Life feature explores three infamous meltdown incidents.
Nuclear Accidents
The importance of cooling and containment are amply illustrated by three major accidents that occurred with the nuclear reactors at nuclear power generating stations in the United States
(Three Mile Island), the former Soviet Union (Chernobyl), and Japan (Fukushima).
The hydrogen accumulated in the confinement building, and it was feared that there was danger of an explosion of the mixture of hydrogen and air in the building. Consequently, hydrogen gas
and radioactive gases (primarily krypton and xenon) were vented from the building. Within a week, cooling water circulation was restored and the core began to cool. The plant was closed for
nearly 10 years during the cleanup process.
Although zero discharge of radioactive material is desirable, the discharge of radioactive krypton and xenon, such as occurred at the Three Mile Island plant, is among the most tolerable. These
gases readily disperse in the atmosphere and thus do not produce highly radioactive areas. Moreover, they are noble gases and are not incorporated into plant and animal matter in the food
chain. Effectively none of the heavy elements of the core of the reactor were released into the environment, and no cleanup of the area outside of the containment building was necessary
(Figure 21.4.9).
Figure 21.4.9 : (a) In this 2010 photo of Three Mile Island, the remaining structures from the damaged Unit 2 reactor are seen on the left, whereas the separate Unit 1 reactor, unaffected by the
accident, continues generating power to this day (right). (b) President Jimmy Carter visited the Unit 2 control room a few days after the accident in 1979.
Two photos, labeled “a” and “b” are shown. Photo a is an aerial view of a nuclear power plant. Photo b shows a small group of men walking through a room filled with electronics.
Another major nuclear accident involving a reactor occurred in April 1986, at the Chernobyl Nuclear Power Plant in Ukraine, which was still a part of the former Soviet Union. While operating
at low power during an unauthorized experiment with some of its safety devices shut off, one of the reactors at the plant became unstable. Its chain reaction became uncontrollable and increased
to a level far beyond what the reactor was designed for. The steam pressure in the reactor rose to between 100 and 500 times the full power pressure and ruptured the reactor. Because the reactor
was not enclosed in a containment building, a large amount of radioactive material spewed out, and additional fission products were released, as the graphite (carbon) moderator of the core
ignited and burned. The fire was controlled, but over 200 plant workers and firefighters developed acute radiation sickness and at least 32 soon died from the effects of the radiation. It is
predicted that about 4000 more deaths will occur among emergency workers and former Chernobyl residents from radiation-induced cancer and leukemia. The reactor has since been
encapsulated in steel and concrete, a now-decaying structure known as the sarcophagus. Almost 30 years later, significant radiation problems still persist in the area, and Chernobyl largely
remains a wasteland.
In 2011, the Fukushima Daiichi Nuclear Power Plant in Japan was badly damaged by a 9.0-magnitude earthquake and resulting tsunami. Three reactors up and running at the time were shut
down automatically, and emergency generators came online to power electronics and coolant systems. However, the tsunami quickly flooded the emergency generators and cut power to the
pumps that circulated coolant water through the reactors. High-temperature steam in the reactors reacted with zirconium alloy to produce hydrogen gas. The gas escaped into the containment
building, and the mixture of hydrogen and air exploded. Radioactive material was released from the containment vessels as the result of deliberate venting to reduce the hydrogen pressure,
deliberate discharge of coolant water into the sea, and accidental or uncontrolled events.
An evacuation zone around the damaged plant extended over 12.4 miles away, and an estimated 200,000 people were evacuated from the area. All 48 of Japan’s nuclear power plants were
subsequently shut down, remaining shuttered as of December 2014. Since the disaster, public opinion has shifted from largely favoring to largely opposing increasing the use of nuclear power
plants, and a restart of Japan’s atomic energy program is still stalled (Figure 21.4.10).
Figure 21.4.10: (a) After the accident, contaminated waste had to be removed, and (b) an evacuation zone was set up around the plant in areas that received heavy doses of radioactive fallout.
(credit a: modification of work by “Live Action Hero”/Flickr)
A photo and a map, labeled “a” and “b,” respectively, are shown. Photo a shows a man in a body-covering safety suit working near a series of blue, plastic coated containers. Map b shows a
section of land with the ocean on each side. Near the upper right side of the land is a small red dot, labeled “greater than, 12.5, m R backslash, h r,” that is surrounded by a zone of orange that
extends in the upper left direction labeled “2.17, dash, 12.5, m R backslash, h r.” The orange is surrounded by an outline of yellow labeled “1.19, dash, 2.17, m R backslash, h r” and a wider
outline of green labeled “0.25, dash, 1.19, m R backslash, h r.” A large area of light blue, labeled “0.03, dash, 0.25, m R backslash, h r” surrounds the green area and extends to the lower middle
of the map. A large section of the lower middle and left of the land is covered by dark blue, labeled “less than 0.03, m R backslash, h r.”
The energy produced by a reactor fueled with enriched uranium results from the fission of uranium as well as from the fission of plutonium produced as the reactor operates. As discussed
previously, the plutonium forms from the combination of neutrons and the uranium in the fuel. In any nuclear reactor, only about 0.1% of the mass of the fuel is converted into energy. The other
99.9% remains in the fuel rods as fission products and unused fuel. All of the fission products absorb neutrons, and after a period of several months to a few years, depending on the reactor, the
fission products must be removed by changing the fuel rods. Otherwise, the concentration of these fission products would increase and absorb more neutrons until the reactor could no longer
operate.
Spent fuel rods contain a variety of products, consisting of unstable nuclei ranging in atomic number from 25 to 60, some transuranium elements, including plutonium and americium, and unreacted
uranium isotopes. The unstable nuclei and the transuranium isotopes give the spent fuel a dangerously high level of radioactivity. The long-lived isotopes require thousands of years to decay to a
safe level. The ultimate fate of the nuclear reactor as a significant source of energy in the United States probably rests on whether or not a politically and scientifically satisfactory technique for
processing and storing the components of spent fuel rods can be developed.
A helium nucleus has a mass that is 0.7% less than that of four hydrogen nuclei; this lost mass is converted into energy during the fusion. This reaction produces about 3.6 × 1011 kJ of energy per
mole of He produced. This is somewhat larger than the energy produced by the nuclear fission of one mole of U-235 (1.8 × 1010 kJ), and over 3 million times larger than the energy produced by
4
2
9
This change proceeds with a mass loss of 0.0188 amu, corresponding to the release of 1.69 × 10 kilojoules per mole of He formed. The very high temperature is necessary to give the nuclei
4
2
enough kinetic energy to overcome the very strong repulsive forces resulting from the positive charges on their nuclei so they can collide.
Useful fusion reactions require very high temperatures for their initiation—about 15,000,000 K or more. At these temperatures, all molecules dissociate into atoms, and the atoms ionize, forming
plasma. These conditions occur in an extremely large number of locations throughout the universe—stars are powered by fusion. Humans have already figured out how to create temperatures high
enough to achieve fusion on a large scale in thermonuclear weapons. A thermonuclear weapon such as a hydrogen bomb contains a nuclear fission bomb that, when exploded, gives off enough
energy to produce the extremely high temperatures necessary for fusion to occur.
Another much more beneficial way to create fusion reactions is in a fusion reactor, a nuclear reactor in which fusion reactions of light nuclei are controlled. Because no solid materials are stable at
such high temperatures, mechanical devices cannot contain the plasma in which fusion reactions occur. Two techniques to contain plasma at the density and temperature necessary for a fusion
reaction are currently the focus of intensive research efforts: containment by a magnetic field and by the use of focused laser beams (Figure 21.4.11). A number of large projects are working to
attain one of the biggest goals in science: getting hydrogen fuel to ignite and produce more energy than the amount supplied to achieve the extremely high temperatures and pressures that are
required for fusion. At the time of this writing, there are no self-sustaining fusion reactors operating in the world, although small-scale controlled fusion reactions have been run for very brief
periods.
Figure 21.4.11: (a) This model is of the International Thermonuclear Experimental Reactor (ITER) reactor. Currently under construction in the south of France with an expected completion date of
2027, the ITER will be the world’s largest experimental Tokamak nuclear fusion reactor with a goal of achieving large-scale sustained energy production. (b) In 2012, the National Ignition Facility
at Lawrence Livermore National Laboratory briefly produced over 500,000,000,000 watts (500 terawatts, or 500 TW) of peak power and delivered 1,850,000 joules (1.85 MJ) of energy, the largest
laser energy ever produced and 1000 times the power usage of the entire United States in any given moment. Although lasting only a few billionths of a second, the 192 lasers attained the
conditions needed for nuclear fusion ignition. This image shows the target prior to the laser shot. (credit a: modification of work by Stephan Mosel)
Two photos are shown and labeled “a” and “b.” Photo a shows a model of the ITER reactor made up of colorful components. Photo b shows a close-up view of the end of a long, mechanical arm
made up of many metal components.
Summary
It is possible to produce new atoms by bombarding other atoms with nuclei or high-speed particles. The products of these transmutation reactions can be stable or radioactive. A number of artificial
elements, including technetium, astatine, and the transuranium elements, have been produced in this way.
Nuclear power as well as nuclear weapon detonations can be generated through fission (reactions in which a heavy nucleus is split into two or more lighter nuclei and several neutrons). Because the
neutrons may induce additional fission reactions when they combine with other heavy nuclei, a chain reaction can result. Useful power is obtained if the fission process is carried out in a nuclear
reactor. The conversion of light nuclei into heavier nuclei (fusion) also produces energy. At present, this energy has not been contained adequately and is too expensive to be feasible for commercial
energy production.
Glossary
chain reaction
repeated fission caused when the neutrons released in fission bombard other atoms
containment system
(also, shield) a three-part structure of materials that protects the exterior of a nuclear fission reactor and operating personnel from the high temperatures, pressures, and radiation levels inside the
reactor
control rod
material inserted into the fuel assembly that absorbs neutrons and can be raised or lowered to adjust the rate of a fission reaction
critical mass
amount of fissionable material that will support a self-sustaining (nuclear fission) chain reaction
fission
splitting of a heavier nucleus into two or more lighter nuclei, usually accompanied by the conversion of mass into large amounts of energy
fusion
combination of very light nuclei into heavier nuclei, accompanied by the conversion of mass into large amounts of energy
fusion reactor
nuclear reactor in which fusion reactions of light nuclei are controlled
nuclear moderator
substance that slows neutrons to a speed low enough to cause fission
nuclear reactor
environment that produces energy via nuclear fission in which the chain reaction is controlled and sustained without explosion
nuclear transmutation
conversion of one nuclide into another nuclide
particle accelerator
device that uses electric and magnetic fields to increase the kinetic energy of nuclei used in transmutation reactions
reactor coolant
assembly used to carry the heat produced by fission in a reactor to an external boiler and turbine where it is transformed into electricity
subcritical mass
amount of fissionable material that cannot sustain a chain reaction; less than a critical mass
supercritical mass
amount of material in which there is an increasing rate of fission
transmutation reaction
bombardment of one type of nuclei with other nuclei or neutrons
transuranium element
element with an atomic number greater than 92; these elements do not occur in nature
This page titled 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the
LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Radioactive isotopes have the same chemical properties as stable isotopes of the same element, but they emit radiation, which can
be detected. If we replace one (or more) atom(s) with radioisotope(s) in a compound, we can track them by monitoring their
radioactive emissions. This type of compound is called a radioactive tracer (or radioactive label). Radioisotopes are used to follow
the paths of biochemical reactions or to determine how a substance is distributed within an organism. Radioactive tracers are also
used in many medical applications, including both diagnosis and treatment. They are used to measure engine wear, analyze the
geological formation around oil wells, and much more.
Radioisotopes have revolutionized medical practice, where they are used extensively. Over 10 million nuclear medicine procedures
and more than 100 million nuclear medicine tests are performed annually in the United States. Four typical examples of radioactive
tracers used in medicine are technetium-99 ( Tc), thallium-201 ( Tl), iodine-131 ( I), and sodium-24 ( Na). Damaged
99
43
201
81
131
53
24
11
tissues in the heart, liver, and lungs absorb certain compounds of technetium-99 preferentially. After it is injected, the location of
the technetium compound, and hence the damaged tissue, can be determined by detecting the γ rays emitted by the Tc-99 isotope.
Thallium-201 (Figure 21.5.1) becomes concentrated in healthy heart tissue, so the two isotopes, Tc-99 and Tl-201, are used
together to study heart tissue. Iodine-131 concentrates in the thyroid gland, the liver, and some parts of the brain. It can therefore be
used to monitor goiter and treat thyroid conditions, such as Grave’s disease, as well as liver and brain tumors. Salt solutions
containing compounds of sodium-24 are injected into the bloodstream to help locate obstructions to the flow of blood.
Figure 21.5.1 : Administering thallium-201 to a patient and subsequently performing a stress test offer medical professionals an
opportunity to visually analyze heart function and blood flow. (credit: modification of work by “Blue0ctane”/Wikimedia
Commons)
A medical professional is assisting a topless elderly man on a treadmill with sensors and electrical wires connected to his torso.
Radioisotopes used in medicine typically have short half-lives—for example, the ubiquitous Tc-99m has a half-life of 6.01 hours.
This makes Tc-99m essentially impossible to store and prohibitively expensive to transport, so it is made on-site instead. Hospitals
and other medical facilities use Mo-99 (which is primarily extracted from U-235 fission products) to generate Tc-99. Mo-99
undergoes β decay with a half-life of 66 hours, and the Tc-99 is then chemically extracted (Figure 21.5.2). The parent nuclide Mo-
99 is part of a molybdate ion, MoO ; when it decays, it forms the pertechnetate ion, TcO . These two water-soluble ions are
2−
4
−
4
separated by column chromatography, with the higher charge molybdate ion adsorbing onto the alumina in the column, and the
lower charge pertechnetate ion passing through the column in the solution. A few micrograms of Mo-99 can produce enough Tc-99
to perform as many as 10,000 tests.
matrix in the column, whereas the TcO passes through and is collected. (b) Tc-99 was used in this scan of the neck of a patient
−
4
with Grave’s disease. The scan shows the location of high concentrations of Tc-99. (credit a: modification of work by the
Department of Energy; credit b: modification of work by “MBq”/Wikimedia Commons)
The first image shows a hand pouring a liquid from a measuring cylinder into a column held up by a clamp. Below the column is a
glass tube. The second picture shows red dots on a dark background dispersed everywhere with four spots of heavily concentrated
regions.
Radioisotopes can also be used, typically in higher doses than as a tracer, as treatment. Radiation therapy is the use of high-energy
radiation to damage the DNA of cancer cells, which kills them or keeps them from dividing (Figure 21.5.3). A cancer patient may
receive external beam radiation therapy delivered by a machine outside the body, or internal radiation therapy (brachytherapy) from
a radioactive substance that has been introduced into the body. Note that chemotherapy is similar to internal radiation therapy in
that the cancer treatment is injected into the body, but differs in that chemotherapy uses chemical rather than radioactive substances
to kill the cancer cells.
Figure 21.5.3 : The cartoon in (a) shows a cobalt-60 machine used in the treatment of cancer. The diagram in (b) shows how the
gantry of the Co-60 machine swings through an arc, focusing radiation on the targeted region (tumor) and minimizing the amount
of radiation that passes through nearby regions.
A. A woman lies down as she goes into a dome shaped medical machine. B. A closer view of the women's head shows gamma rays
from radioactive cobalt attacks the target on the woman's head.
Cobalt-60 is a synthetic radioisotope produced by the neutron activation of Co-59, which then undergoes β decay to form Ni-60,
along with the emission of γ radiation. The overall process is:
59 1 60 60 0 0
Co + n ⟶ Co ⟶ Ni + β+2 γ
27 0 27 28 −1 0
The overall decay scheme for this is shown graphically in Figure 21.5.4.
but the process is much more complex, proceeding through a series of steps in which various organic compounds are produced. In
studies of the pathway of this reaction, plants were exposed to CO2 containing a high concentration of C. At regular intervals, the
14
6
plants were analyzed to determine which organic compounds contained carbon-14 and how much of each compound was present.
From the time sequence in which the compounds appeared and the amount of each present at given time intervals, scientists learned
more about the pathway of the reaction.
Commercial applications of radioactive materials are equally diverse (Figure 21.5.5). They include determining the thickness of
films and thin metal sheets by exploiting the penetration power of various types of radiation. Flaws in metals used for structural
purposes can be detected using high-energy gamma rays from cobalt-60 in a fashion similar to the way X-rays are used to examine
the human body. In one form of pest control, flies are controlled by sterilizing male flies with γ radiation so that females breeding
with them do not produce offspring. Many foods are preserved by radiation that kills microorganisms that cause the foods to spoil.
Figure 21.5.5 : Common commercial uses of radiation include (a) X-ray examination of luggage at an airport and (b) preservation
of food. (credit a: modification of work by the Department of the Navy; credit b: modification of work by the US Department of
Agriculture)
A. A man is observing a monitor which shows the X-ray of luggages. B. Many apples on processing belts.
Americium-241, an α emitter with a half-life of 458 years, is used in tiny amounts in ionization-type smoke detectors (Figure
21.5.6). The α emissions from Am-241 ionize the air between two electrode plates in the ionizing chamber. A battery supplies a
potential that causes movement of the ions, thus creating a small electric current. When smoke enters the chamber, the movement
of the ions is impeded, reducing the conductivity of the air. This causes a marked drop in the current, triggering an alarm.
Summary
Compounds known as radioactive tracers can be used to follow reactions, track the distribution of a substance, diagnose and treat
medical conditions, and much more. Other radioactive substances are helpful for controlling pests, visualizing structures, providing
fire warnings, and for many other applications. Hundreds of millions of nuclear medicine tests and procedures, using a wide variety
of radioisotopes with relatively short half-lives, are performed every year in the US. Most of these radioisotopes have relatively
short half-lives; some are short enough that the radioisotope must be made on-site at medical facilities. Radiation therapy uses
high-energy radiation to kill cancer cells by damaging their DNA. The radiation used for this treatment may be delivered externally
or internally.
Glossary
chemotherapy
similar to internal radiation therapy, but chemical rather than radioactive substances are introduced into the body to kill cancer
cells
radiation therapy
use of high-energy radiation to damage the DNA of cancer cells, which kills them or keeps them from dividing
radioactive tracer
(also, radioactive label) radioisotope used to track or follow a substance by monitoring its radioactive emissions
This page titled 21.5: Uses of Radioisotopes is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The increased use of radioisotopes has led to increased concerns over the effects of these materials on biological systems (such as
humans). All radioactive nuclides emit high-energy particles or electromagnetic waves. When this radiation encounters living cells,
it can cause heating, break chemical bonds, or ionize molecules. The most serious biological damage results when these radioactive
emissions fragment or ionize molecules. For example, alpha and beta particles emitted from nuclear decay reactions possess much
higher energies than ordinary chemical bond energies. When these particles strike and penetrate matter, they produce ions and
molecular fragments that are extremely reactive. The damage this does to biomolecules in living organisms can cause serious
malfunctions in normal cell processes, taxing the organism’s repair mechanisms and possibly causing illness or even death (Figure
21.6.1).
Figure 21.6.1 : Radiation can harm biological systems by damaging the DNA of cells. If this damage is not properly repaired, the
cells may divide in an uncontrolled manner and cause cancer.
A diagram is shown which has a white sphere followed by a right-facing arrow and a large sphere composed of many smaller white
and green spheres. The single sphere has impacted the larger sphere. A right-facing arrow leads from the larger sphere to a pair of
smaller spheres which are collections of the same white and green spheres. A starburst pattern lies between these two spheres and
has three right-facing arrows leading from it to two white spheres and a circle full of ten smaller, peach-colored circles with purple
dots in their centers. An arrow leads downward from this circle to a box that contains a helical shape with a starburst near its top
left side and is labeled “D N A damage.” A right-facing arrow leads from this circle to a second circle, with nine smaller, peach-
colored circles with purple dots in their centers and one fully purple small circle labeled “Cancer cell.” A right-facing arrow leads
to a final circle, this time full of the purple cells, that is labeled “Tumor.”
Figure 21.6.2 : Lower frequency, lower-energy electromagnetic radiation is nonionizing, and higher frequency, higher-energy
electromagnetic radiation is ionizing.
Energy absorbed from nonionizing radiation speeds up the movement of atoms and molecules, which is equivalent to heating the
sample. Although biological systems are sensitive to heat (as we might know from touching a hot stove or spending a day at the
beach in the sun), a large amount of nonionizing radiation is necessary before dangerous levels are reached. Ionizing radiation,
however, may cause much more severe damage by breaking bonds or removing electrons in biological molecules, disrupting their
structure and function. The damage can also be done indirectly, by first ionizing H2O (the most abundant molecule in living
organisms), which forms a H2O+ ion that reacts with water, forming a hydronium ion and a hydroxyl radical:
Figure 21.6.3 .
Figure 21.6.4 : The ability of different types of radiation to pass through material is shown. From least to most penetrating, they are
alpha < beta < neutron < gamma.
A diagram shows four particles in a vertical column on the left, followed by an upright sheet of paper, a person’s hand, an upright
sheet of metal, a glass of water, a thick block of concrete and an upright, thick piece of lead. The top particle listed is made up of
two white spheres and two green spheres that are labeled with positive signs and is labeled “Alpha.” A right-facing arrow leads
from this to the paper. The second particle is a red sphere labeled “Beta” and is followed by a right-facing arrow that passes
through the paper and stops at the hand. The third particle is a white sphere labeled “Neutron” and is followed by a right-facing
arrow that passes through the paper, hand and metal but is stopped at the glass of water. The fourth particle is shown by a squiggly
arrow and it passes through all of the substances but stops at the lead. Terms at the bottom read, from left to right, “Paper,”
“Metal,” “Water,” “Concrete” and “Lead.”
For many people, one of the largest sources of exposure to radiation is from radon gas (Rn-222). Radon-222 is an α emitter with a
half–life of 3.82 days. It is one of the products of the radioactive decay series of U-238, which is found in trace amounts in soil and
rocks. The radon gas that is produced slowly escapes from the ground and gradually seeps into homes and other structures above.
Figure 21.6.5 : Radon-222 seeps into houses and other buildings from rocks that contain uranium-238, a radon emitter. The radon
enters through cracks in concrete foundations and basement floors, stone or porous cinderblock foundations, and openings for
water and gas pipes.
A cut-away image of the side of a house and four layers of the ground it rests on is shown, as well as a second cut-away image of a
person’s head and chest cavity. The house is shown with a restroom on the second floor and a basement with a water heater as the
first floor. Green arrows lead from the lowest ground layer, labeled “radon in ground water,” from the third ground layer, labeled
“Bedrock” and “Fractured bedrock,” from the second layer, labeled “radon in well water,” and from the top layer, labeled “radon in
soil to the inside of the basement area. In the smaller image of the torso, a green arrow is shown to enter the person’s nasal passage
and travel to the lungs. This is labeled “Inhalation of radon decay products.” A small coiled, helical structure next to the torso is
labeled “alpha particle” on one section where it has a starburst pattern and “Radiation damage to D N A” on another segment.
Radon is found in buildings across the country, with amounts dependent on location. The average concentration of radon inside
houses in the US (1.25 pCi/L) is about three times the level found in outside air, and about one in six houses have radon levels high
enough that remediation efforts to reduce the radon concentration are recommended. Exposure to radon increases one’s risk of
getting cancer (especially lung cancer), and high radon levels can be as bad for health as smoking a carton of cigarettes a day.
Radon is the number one cause of lung cancer in nonsmokers and the second leading cause of lung cancer overall. Radon exposure
is believed to cause over 20,000 deaths in the US per year.
the gray (Gy), with 1 Gy = 1 J of energy absorbed per kilogram of tissue. In medical applications, the radiation absorbed dose (rad)
is more often used (1 rad = 0.01 Gy; 1 rad results in the absorption of 0.01 J/kg of tissue). The SI unit measuring tissue damage
caused by radiation is the sievert (Sv). This takes into account both the energy and the biological effects of the type of radiation
involved in the radiation dose.
Table 21.6.1 : Units Used for Measuring Radiation
Measurement Purpose Unit Quantity Measured Description
The roentgen equivalent for man (rem) is the unit for radiation damage that is used most frequently in medicine (1 rem = 1 Sv).
Note that the tissue damage units (rem or Sv) includes the energy of the radiation dose (rad or Gy), along with a biological factor
referred to as the RBE (for relative biological effectiveness), that is an approximate measure of the relative damage done by the
radiation. These are related by:
with RBE approximately 10 for α radiation, 2(+) for protons and neutrons, and 1 for β and γ radiation.
Cobalt-60 (t1/2 = 5.26 y) is used in cancer therapy since the γ rays it emits can be focused in small areas where the cancer is
located. A 5.00-g sample of Co-60 is available for cancer treatment.
a. What is its activity in Bq?
b. What is its activity in Ci?
Solution
The activity is given by:
ln 2 ln 2 g 60
Activity = λN = ( )N =( ) × 5.00 g = 0.659 of Co that decay
t1/2 5.26 y y
decay
14
= 2.10 × 10
s
decay
(a) Since 1 Bq = 1
s
, the activity in Becquerel (Bq) is:
decay 1 Bq
14 14
2.10 × 10 ×( ) = 2.10 × 10 Bq
decay
s
1
s
decay
(b) Since 1 Ci = 3.7 × 10 11
s
, the activity in curie (Ci) is:
decay 1 Ci
14 2
2.10 × 10 ×( ) = 5.7 × 10 Ci
s 11 decay
3.7 × 10
s
Tritium is a radioactive isotope of hydrogen (t = 12.32 years) that has several uses, including self-powered lighting, in
1/2
which electrons emitted in tritium radioactive decay cause phosphorus to glow. Its nucleus contains one proton and two
neutrons, and the atomic mass of tritium is 3.016 amu. What is the activity of a sample containing 1.00mg of tritium (a) in Bq
and (b) in Ci?
Answer a
11
3.56 × 10 Bq
Answer b
0.962 Ci
50 nausea hours
55 fatigue —
70 vomiting —
90 diarrhea —
100 hemorrhage —
internal bleeding —
It is impossible to avoid some exposure to ionizing radiation. We are constantly exposed to background radiation from a variety of
natural sources, including cosmic radiation, rocks, medical procedures, consumer products, and even our own atoms. We can
minimize our exposure by blocking or shielding the radiation, moving farther from the source, and limiting the time of exposure.
Summary
We are constantly exposed to radiation from a variety of naturally occurring and human-produced sources. This radiation can affect
living organisms. Ionizing radiation is the most harmful because it can ionize molecules or break chemical bonds, which damages
the molecule and causes malfunctions in cell processes. It can also create reactive hydroxyl radicals that damage biological
molecules and disrupt physiological processes. Radiation can cause somatic or genetic damage, and is most harmful to rapidly
reproducing cells. Types of radiation differ in their ability to penetrate material and damage tissue, with alpha particles the least
penetrating, but potentially most damaging, and gamma rays the most penetrating.
Various devices, including Geiger counters, scintillators, and dosimeters, are used to detect and measure radiation, and monitor
radiation exposure. We use several units to measure radiation: becquerels or curies for rates of radioactive decay; gray or rads for
energy absorbed; and rems or sieverts for biological effects of radiation. Exposure to radiation can cause a wide range of health
effects, from minor to severe, including death. We can minimize the effects of radiation by shielding with dense materials such as
lead, moving away from the source of radiation, and limiting time of exposure.
Footnotes
1. 1 Source: US Environmental Protection Agency
Glossary
becquerel (Bq)
SI unit for rate of radioactive decay; 1 Bq = 1 disintegration/s.
curie (Ci)
Larger unit for rate of radioactive decay frequently used in medicine; 1 Ci = 3.7 × 1010 disintegrations/s.
Geiger counter
Instrument that detects and measures radiation via the ionization produced in a Geiger-Müller tube.
gray (Gy)
SI unit for measuring radiation dose; 1 Gy = 1 J absorbed/kg tissue.
ionizing radiation
Radiation that can cause a molecule to lose an electron and form an ion.
millicurie (mCi)
Larger unit for rate of radioactive decay frequently used in medicine; 1 Ci = 3.7 × 1010 disintegrations/s.
nonionizing radiation
Radiation that speeds up the movement of atoms and molecules; it is equivalent to heating a sample, but is not energetic enough
to cause the ionization of molecules.
scintillation counter
Instrument that uses a scintillator—a material that emits light when excited by ionizing radiation—to detect and measure
radiation.
sievert (Sv)
SI unit measuring tissue damage caused by radiation; takes energy and biological effects of radiation into account.
This page titled 21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
b. 29
13
Al
c. 73
36
Kr
d. 194
77
Ir
21.E.1.2: Q21.2.2
Write the following isotopes in nuclide notation (e.g., " 14
6
C ")
a. oxygen-14
b. copper-70
c. tantalum-175
d. francium-217
21.E.1.3: Q21.2.3
For the following isotopes that have missing information, fill in the missing information to complete the notation
a. 34
14
X
b. 36
P
c. 57
X
Mn
d. 121
56
X
21.E.1.4: Q21.2.4
For each of the isotopes in Question 21.2.3, determine the numbers of protons, neutrons, and electrons in a neutral atom of the
isotope.
21.E.1.5: Q21.2.5
Write the nuclide notation, including charge if applicable, for atoms with the following characteristics:
a. 25 protons, 20 neutrons, 24 electrons
b. 45 protons, 24 neutrons, 43 electrons
c. 53 protons, 89 neutrons, 54 electrons
d. 97 protons, 146 neutrons, 97 electrons
21.E.1.6: Q21.2.6
Calculate the density of the 24
12
Mg nucleus in g/mL, assuming that it has the typical nuclear diameter of 1 × 10–13 cm and is
spherical in shape.
21.E.1.7: Q21.2.7
What are the two principal differences between nuclear reactions and ordinary chemical changes?
21.E.1.8: Q21.2.8
The mass of the atom 23
11
Na is 22.9898 amu.
a. Calculate its binding energy per atom in millions of electron volts.
b. Calculate its binding energy per nucleon.
21.E.1.9: Q21.2.9
Which of the following nuclei lie within the band of stability?
21.E.1.10: Q21.2.10
Which of the following nuclei lie within the band of stability?
a. argon-40
b. oxygen-16
c. 122Ba
d. 58Ni
e. 205Tl
f. 210Tl
g. 226Ra
h. magnesium-24
21.E.2.2: Q21.3.2
Which of the various particles (α particles, β particles, and so on) that may be produced in a nuclear reaction are actually nuclei?
21.E.2.3: Q21.3.3
Complete each of the following equations by adding the missing species:
a. 27
13
Al +
4
2
He ⟶ ? +
1
0
n
b. 239
94
Pu+ ? ⟶
242
96
Cm +
1
0
n
c. 14
7
4
N + 2 He ⟶ ? + 1 H
1
d. 235
92
U ⟶ ?+
135
55
Cs + 4
1
0
n
21.E.2.4: Q21.3.4
Complete each of the following equations:
a. 7
3
Li + ? ⟶ 2
4
2
He
b. 14
6
C ⟶
14
7
N+ ?
c. 27
13
4
Al + 2 He ⟶ ? +
1
0
n
d. 250
96
Cm ⟶ ? + 38 Sr + 4
98 1
0
n
21.E.2.6: Q21.3.6
Technetium-99 is prepared from 98Mo. Molybdenum-98 combines with a neutron to give molybdenum-99, an unstable isotope that
emits a β particle to yield an excited form of technetium-99, represented as 99Tc*. This excited nucleus relaxes to the ground state,
represented as 99Tc, by emitting a γ ray. The ground state of 99Tc then emits a β particle. Write the equations for each of these
nuclear reactions.
21.E.2.7: Q21.3.7
The mass of the atom 19
9
F is 18.99840 amu.
a. Calculate its binding energy per atom in millions of electron volts.
b. Calculate its binding energy per nucleon.
21.E.2.8: Q21.3.8
For the reaction 14
6
C ⟶
14
7
N+ ? , if 100.0 g of carbon reacts, what volume of nitrogen gas (N2) is produced at 273 K and 1 atm?
21.E.3.2: Q21.4.2
What changes occur to the atomic number and mass of a nucleus during each of the following decay scenarios?
a. an α particle is emitted
b. a β particle is emitted
c. γ radiation is emitted
d. a positron is emitted
e. an electron is captured
21.E.3.3: Q21.4.3
What is the change in the nucleus that results from the following decay scenarios?
a. emission of a β particle
b. emission of a β+ particle
c. capture of an electron
21.E.3.4: Q21.4.4
Many nuclides with atomic numbers greater than 83 decay by processes such as electron emission. Explain the observation that the
emissions from these unstable nuclides also normally include α particles.
21.E.3.5: Q21.4.5
Why is electron capture accompanied by the emission of an X-ray?
21.E.3.6: Q21.4.6
Explain how unstable heavy nuclides (atomic number > 83) may decompose to form nuclides of greater stability (a) if they are
below the band of stability and (b) if they are above the band of stability.
21.E.3.8: Q21.4.8
The following nuclei do not lie in the band of stability. How would they be expected to decay? Explain your answer.
a. 34
15
P
b. 239
92
U
c. 38
20
Ca
d. 3
1
H
e. 245
94
Pu
21.E.3.9: Q21.4.9
The following nuclei do not lie in the band of stability. How would they be expected to decay?
a. 28
15
P
b. 235
92
U
c. 37
20 Ca
d. 9
3
Li
e. 245
96
Cm
21.E.3.10: Q21.4.10
Predict by what mode(s) of spontaneous radioactive decay each of the following unstable isotopes might proceed:
a. He6
2
b. Zn60
30
c. 235
Pa
91
d. Np241
94
e. 18F
f. 129Ba
g. 237Pu
21.E.3.11: Q21.4.11
Write a nuclear reaction for each step in the formation of Po from
218
84
238
92
U , which proceeds by a series of decay reactions involving
the step-wise emission of α, β, β, α, α, α, α particles, in that order.
21.E.3.12: Q21.4.12
Write a nuclear reaction for each step in the formation of Pb from
208
82
228
90
, which proceeds by a series of decay reactions
Th
21.E.3.13: Q21.4.13
Define the term half-life and illustrate it with an example.
21.E.3.14: Q21.4.14
A 1.00 × 10–6-g sample of nobelium, 254
102
No , has a half-life of 55 seconds after it is formed. What is the percentage of 254
102
No
21.E.3.16: Q21.4.16
The isotope 208Tl undergoes β decay with a half-life of 3.1 min.
a. What isotope is produced by the decay?
b. How long will it take for 99.0% of a sample of pure 208Tl to decay?
c. What percentage of a sample of pure 208Tl remains un-decayed after 1.0 h?
21.E.3.17: Q21.4.17
If 1.000 g of Ra produces 0.0001 mL of the gas
226
88
222
86
Rn at STP (standard temperature and pressure) in 24 h, what is the half-life
of 226Ra in years?
21.E.3.18: Q21.4.18
The isotope Sr is one of the extremely hazardous species in the residues from nuclear power generation. The strontium in a
90
38
21.E.3.19: Q21.4.19
Technetium-99 is often used for assessing heart, liver, and lung damage because certain technetium compounds are absorbed by
damaged tissues. It has a half-life of 6.0 h. Calculate the rate constant for the decay of Tc. 99
43
21.E.3.20: Q21.4.20
What is the age of mummified primate skin that contains 8.25% of the original quantity of 14C?
21.E.3.21: Q21.4.21
A sample of rock was found to contain 8.23 mg of rubidium-87 and 0.47 mg of strontium-87.
a. Calculate the age of the rock if the half-life of the decay of rubidium by β emission is 4.7 × 1010 y.
b. If some Sr was initially present in the rock, would the rock be younger, older, or the same age as the age calculated in (a)?
87
38
21.E.3.22: Q21.4.22
A laboratory investigation shows that a sample of uranium ore contains 5.37 mg of 238
92
U and 2.52 mg of 206
82
. Calculate the age
Pb
21.E.3.23: Q21.4.23
Plutonium was detected in trace amounts in natural uranium deposits by Glenn Seaborg and his associates in 1941. They proposed
that the source of this 239Pu was the capture of neutrons by 238U nuclei. Why is this plutonium not likely to have been trapped at
the time the solar system formed 4.7 × 109 years ago?
21.E.3.24: Q21.4.24
A Be atom (mass = 7.0169 amu) decays into a Li atom (mass = 7.0160 amu) by electron capture. How much energy (in millions
7
4
7
3
21.E.3.25: Q21.4.25
A B atom (mass = 8.0246 amu) decays into a Be atom (mass = 8.0053 amu) by loss of a β+ particle (mass = 0.00055 amu) or by
8
5
8
4
electron capture. How much energy (in millions of electron volts) is produced by this reaction?
21.E.3.26: Q21.4.26
Isotopes such as 26Al (half-life: 7.2 × 105 years) are believed to have been present in our solar system as it formed, but have since
decayed and are now called extinct nuclides.
26
a. Al decays by β+ emission or electron capture. Write the equations for these two nuclear transformations.
21.E.3.27: Q21.4.27
Write a balanced equation for each of the following nuclear reactions:
a. bismuth-212 decays into polonium-212
b. beryllium-8 and a positron are produced by the decay of an unstable nucleus
c. neptunium-239 forms from the reaction of uranium-238 with a neutron and then spontaneously converts into plutonium-239
d. strontium-90 decays into yttrium-90
21.E.3.28: Q21.4.28
Write a balanced equation for each of the following nuclear reactions:
a. mercury-180 decays into platinum-176
b. zirconium-90 and an electron are produced by the decay of an unstable nucleus
c. thorium-232 decays and produces an alpha particle and a radium-228 nucleus, which decays into actinium-228 by beta decay
d. neon-19 decays into fluorine-19
21.E.4.2: Q21.5.2
How does nuclear fission differ from nuclear fusion? Why are both of these processes exothermic?
21.E.4.3: Q21.5.3
Both fusion and fission are nuclear reactions. Why is a very high temperature required for fusion, but not for fission?
21.E.4.4: Q21.5.4
Cite the conditions necessary for a nuclear chain reaction to take place. Explain how it can be controlled to produce energy, but not
produce an explosion.
21.E.4.5: Q21.5.5
Describe the components of a nuclear reactor.
21.E.4.6: Q21.5.6
In usual practice, both a moderator and control rods are necessary to operate a nuclear chain reaction safely for the purpose of
energy production. Cite the function of each and explain why both are necessary.
21.E.4.7: Q21.5.7
Describe how the potential energy of uranium is converted into electrical energy in a nuclear power plant.
21.E.4.8: Q21.5.8
The mass of a hydrogen atom ( H) is 1.007825 amu; that of a tritium atom ( H) is 3.01605 amu; and that of an α particle is
1
1
3
1
4.00150 amu. How much energy in kilojoules per mole of He produced is released by the following fusion reaction:
4
2
H + H ⟶ He .
1 3 4
1 1 2
is a dynamic equilibrium?
21.E.5.2: Q21.6.2
Technetium-99m has a half-life of 6.01 hours. If a patient injected with technetium-99m is safe to leave the hospital once 75% of
the dose has decayed, when is the patient allowed to leave?
21.E.5.3: Q21.6.3
Iodine that enters the body is stored in the thyroid gland from which it is released to control growth and metabolism. The thyroid
can be imaged if iodine-131 is injected into the body. In larger doses, I-131 is also used as a means of treating cancer of the thyroid.
I-131 has a half-life of 8.70 days and decays by β− emission.
a. Write a nuclear equation for the decay.
b. How long will it take for 95.0% of a dose of I-131 to decay?
21.E.6.2: Q21.7.2
Based on what is known about Radon-222’s primary decay method, why is inhalation so dangerous?
21.E.6.3: Q21.7.3
Given specimens uranium-232 (t 1/2
= 68.9 y ) and uranium-233 (t 1/2
= 159, 200 y ) of equal mass, which one would have greater
activity and why?
21.E.6.4: Q21.7.4
A scientist is studying a 2.234 g sample of thorium-229 (t1/2 = 7340 y) in a laboratory.
a. What is its activity in Bq?
b. What is its activity in Ci?
21.E.6.5: Q21.7.5
Given specimens neon-24 (t 1/2 = 3.38 min ) and bismuth-211 (t 1/2 = 2.14 min ) of equal mass, which one would have greater
activity and why?
This page titled 21.E: Nuclear Chemistry (Exercises) is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled Appendices is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that
was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1
Composition of Commercial Acids and Bases
Composition of Commercial Acids and Bases
Composition of Commercial Acids and Bases
Footnotes
1. 1 Acids and bases are commercially available as aqueous solutions. This table lists properties (densities and concentrations) of
common acid and base solutions. Nominal values are provided in cases where the manufacturer cites a range of concentrations
and densities.
2. 2 This column contains specific gravity data. In the case of this table, specific gravity is the ratio of density of a substance to the
density of pure water at the same conditions. Specific gravity is often cited on commercial labels.
3. 3 This solution is sometimes called “ammonium hydroxide,” although this term is not chemically accurate.
This page titled Composition of Commercial Acids and Bases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
The power (exponent) of 10 is equal to the number of places the decimal is shifted to give the digit number. The exponential
method is particularly useful notation for every large and very small numbers. For example, 1,230,000,000 = 1.23 × 109, and
0.00000000036 = 3.6 × 10−10.
Solution
−3 −5
3.00 × 10 = 300 × 10
−5 −5 −5 −3
(5.00 × 10 ) + (300 × 10 ) = 305 × 10 = 3.05 × 10
Solution
−7 −6
4.0 × 10 = 0.40 × 10
−6 −6 −6
(5.0 × 10 ) − (0.40 × 10 ) = 4.6 × 10
Solution
−8 3 (−8)+(+3) −5
(4.2 × 10 ) × (2.0 × 10 ) = (4.2 × 2.0) × 10 = 8.4 × 10
Solution
−5
3.6 × 10 3.6 (−5)−(−4) −1 −2
=( ) × 10 = 0.60 × 10 = 6.0 × 10
−4
6.0 × 10 6.0
Solution
−6 2 2×(−6) −12 −11
(4.0 × 10 ) = 4 × 4 × 10 = 16 × 10 = 1.6 × 10
Solution
4 3 3×4 12
(2 × 10 ) = 2 × 2 × 2 × 10 = 8 × 10
2: Significant Figures
A beekeeper reports that he has 525,341 bees. The last three figures of the number are obviously inaccurate, for during the time the
keeper was counting the bees, some of them died and others hatched; this makes it quite difficult to determine the exact number of
bees. It would have been more accurate if the beekeeper had reported the number 525,000. In other words, the last three figures are
not significant, except to set the position of the decimal point. Their exact values have no meaning useful in this situation. In
reporting any information as numbers, use only as many significant figures as the accuracy of the measurement warrants.
The importance of significant figures lies in their application to fundamental computation. In addition and subtraction, the sum or
difference should contain as many digits to the right of the decimal as that in the least certain of the numbers used in the
computation (indicated by underscoring in the following example).
Solution
4.38 3 g
–
0.002 3 g
––
–––––––
4.38 5 g
–
In multiplication and division, the product or quotient should contain no more digits than that in the factor containing the least
number of significant figures.
Solution
0.623 8 × 6. 6 = 4. 1
– – –
When rounding numbers, increase the retained digit by 1 if it is followed by a number larger than 5 (“round up”). Do not change
the retained digit if the digits that follow are less than 5 (“round down”). If the retained digit is followed by 5, round up if the
retained digit is odd, or round down if it is even (after rounding, the retained digit will thus always be even).
1000 103 3
10 101 1
1 100 0
0.1 10−1 −1
0.001 10−3 −3
What is the common logarithm of 60? Because 60 lies between 10 and 100, which have logarithms of 1 and 2, respectively, the
logarithm of 60 is 1.7782; that is,
1.7782
60 = 10
The common logarithm of a number less than 1 has a negative value. The logarithm of 0.03918 is −1.4069, or
1
−1.4069
0.03918 = 10 =
1.4069
10
To obtain the common logarithm of a number, use the log button on your calculator. To calculate a number from its logarithm, take
the inverse log of the logarithm, or calculate 10x (where x is the logarithm of the number).
The natural logarithm of a number (ln) is the power to which e must be raised to equal the number; e is the constant 2.7182818. For
example, the natural logarithm of 10 is 2.303; that is,
2.303 2.303
10 = e = 2.7182818
To obtain the natural logarithm of a number, use the ln button on your calculator. To calculate a number from its natural logarithm,
enter the natural logarithm and take the inverse ln of the natural logarithm, or calculate ex (where x is the natural logarithm of the
number).
Logarithms are exponents; thus, operations involving logarithms follow the same rules as operations involving exponents.
1. The logarithm of a product of two numbers is the sum of the logarithms of the two numbers. \[\log xy= \log x + \log y, \textrm{
and }\ln xy=\ln x + \ln y \nonumber \]
2. The logarithm of the number resulting from the division of two numbers is the difference between the logarithms of the two
numbers. \[\log\dfrac{x}{y}=\log x-\log y,\textrm{ and } \ln\dfrac{x}{y}=\ln x-\ln y \nonumber \]
3. The logarithm of a number raised to an exponent is the product of the exponent and the logarithm of the number.
n n
log x = n log x and ln x = n ln x
The solution or roots for any quadratic equation can be calculated using the following formula:
− − −−−−−
2
−b ± √ b − 4ac
x =
2a
− −−−−− −− −−−
−13 ± √ 169 + 120 −13 ± √289 −13 ± 17
x = = =
6 6 6
Quadratic equations constructed on physical data always have real roots, and of these real roots, often only those having positive
values are of any significance.
Exercise 10
1 5
2 10
3 7
4 14
This table contains the following points: (1,5), (2,10), (3,7), and (4,14). Each of these points can be plotted on a graph and
connected to produce a graphical representation of the dependence of y on x.
If the function that describes the dependence of y on x is known, it may be used to compute x,y data pairs that may subsequently be
plotted.
Exercise 11
Plotting Data Pairs If we know that y = x2 + 2, we can produce a table of a few (x,y) values and then plot the line based on the
data shown here.
Table for Exercise 11
x y = x2 + 2
1 3
2 6
3 11
4 18
Equilibrium Kf
Al
3+
+6F
−
⇌ [AlF ]
6
3−
7 × 1019
Cd
2+
+ 4 NH
3
⇌ [Cd(NH ) ]
3 4
2+
1.3 × 107
Cd
2+
+ 4 CN
−
⇌ [Cd(CN) ]
4
2−
3 × 1018
Co
2+
+ 6 NH
3
⇌ [Co (NH ) ]
3 6
2+
1.3 × 105
Co
3+
+ 6 NH
3
⇌ [Co (NH ) ]
3 6
3+
2.3 × 1033
1.0 × 1016
+ −
Cu + 2 CN ⇌ [Cu(CN) ]
2
Cu
2+
+ 4 NH
3
⇌ [Cu(NH ) ]
3 4
2+
1.7 × 1013
Fe
2+
+ 6 CN
−
⇌ [Fe(CN) ]
6
4−
1.5 × 1035
Fe
3+
+ 6 CN
−
⇌ [Fe(CN) ]
6
3−
2 × 1043
Fe
3+
+ 6 SCN
−
⇌ [Fe(SCN) ]
6
3−
3.2 × 103
Hg
2+
+ 4 Cl
−
⇌ [HgCl ]
4
2−
1.1 × 1016
Ni
2+
+ 6 NH
3
⇌ [Ni(NH ) ]
3 6
2+
2.0 × 108
1.8 × 105
+ − −
Ag + 2 Cl ⇌ [AgCl ]
2
1 × 1021
+ − −
Ag + 2 CN ⇌ [Ag (CN) ]
2
1.7 × 107
+ +
Ag + 2 NH ⇌ [Ag (NH ) ]
3 3 2
Zn
2+
+ 4 CN
−
⇌ [Zn(CN) ]
4
2−
2.1 × 1019
Zn
2+
+ 4 OH
−
⇌ [Zn(OH) ]
4
2−
2 × 1015
Fe
3+
+ SCN
−
⇌ [Fe(SCN)]
2+
8.9 × 102
Ag
+
+ 4 SCN
−
⇌ [Ag (SCN) ]
4
3−
1.2 × 1010
Pb
2+
+4I
−
⇌ [PbI ]
4
2−
3.0 × 104
Pt
2+
+ 4 Cl
−
⇌ [PtCl ]
4
2−
1 × 1016
Cu
2+
+ 4 CN ⇌ [Cu(CN) ]
4
2−
1.0 × 1025
Co
2+
+ 4 SCN
−
⇌ [Co (SCN) ]
4
2−
1 × 103
This page titled Formation Constants for Complex Ions is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
gas constant (R) 8.205784 × 10−2 L atm mol−1 K−1 = 8.314510 J mol−1 K−1
This page titled Fundamental Physical Constants is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1.7 × 10−7
arsenic
5.1 × 10−12
carbonic
4.7 × 10−11
6.2 × 10−8
phosphoric
4.2 × 10−13
H3PO3 5 × 10−2
phosphorous
2.0 × 10−7
sulfurous
6.4 × 10−8
This page titled Ionization Constants of Weak Acids is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
This page titled Ionization Constants of Weak Bases is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax
via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Substance Ksp at 25 °C
aluminum
Al(OH)3 2 × 10−32
barium
Ba3(PO4)2 6 × 10−39
bismuth
BiO(OH) 4 × 10−10
Bi2S3 1 × 10−97
cadmium
calcium
CaHPO4 7 × 10−7
chromium
cobalt
CoS(α) 5 × 10−22
CoS(β) 3 × 10−26
Substance Ksp at 25 °C
copper
iron
Fe(OH)3 4 × 10−38
lead
PbF2 4 × 10−8
PbS 7 × 10−29
PbCrO4 2 × 10−16
Pb3(PO4)2 1 × 10−54
magnesium
MgCO3·3H2O ca 1 × 10−5
MgNH4PO4 3 × 10−13
MgC2O4 7 × 10−7
manganese
Mn(OH)2 2 × 10−13
mercury
Substance Ksp at 25 °C
Hg2CO3 9 × 10−15
Hg2CrO4 2 × 10−9
nickel
NiS(α) 4 × 10−20
potassium
KHC4H4O6 3 × 10−4
silver
1
2
Ag O(Ag
2
+
+ OH
−
) 2 × 10−8
strontium
SrCO3 7 × 10−10
SrC2O4·H2O 4 × 10−7
thallium
Substance Ksp at 25 °C
Tl2S 6 × 10−22
tin
Sn(OH)2 3 × 10−27
SnS 1 × 10−26
zinc
ZnCO3 2 × 10−10
This page titled Solubility Products is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Ag
+
+e
−
⟶ Ag +0.7996
AgCl + e
−
⟶ Ag + Cl
−
+0.22233
−
[Ag (CN) ]
2
+e
−
⟶ Ag + 2 CN
−
−0.31
Ag CrO
2 4
+2e
−
⟶ 2 Ag + CrO
2−
4
+0.45
+
[Ag (NH ) ]
3 2
+e
−
⟶ Ag + 2 NH
3
+0.373
[Ag (S O ) ]
2 3 2
3+
+e
−
⟶ Ag + 2 S O
2
2−
3
+0.017
[AlF ]
6
3−
+3e
−
⟶ Al + 6 F
−
−2.07
Al
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Al −1.662
Am
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Am −2.048
Au
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Au +1.498
Au
+
+e
−
⟶ Au +1.692
Ba
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Ba −2.912
Be
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Be −1.847
Br (aq) + 2 e
2
−
⟶ 2 Br
−
+1.0873
Ca
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Ca −2.868
Ce
3
+3e
−
⟶ Ce −2.483
Ce
4+
+e
−
⟶ Ce
3+
+1.61
Cd
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Cd −0.4030
[Cd(CN) ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Cd + 4 CN
−
−1.09
[Cd(NH ) ]
3 4
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Cd + 4 NH
3
−0.61
CdS + 2 e
−
⟶ Cd + S
2−
−1.17
Cl
2
+2e
−
⟶ 2 Cl
−
+1.35827
ClO
−
4
+H O+2e
2
−
⟶ ClO
−
3
+ 2 OH
−
+0.36
ClO
−
3
+H O+2e
2
−
⟶ ClO
−
2
+ 2 OH
−
+0.33
ClO
−
2
+H O+2e
2
−
⟶ ClO
−
+ 2 OH
−
+0.66
ClO
−
+H O+2e
2
−
⟶ Cl
−
+ 2 OH
−
+0.89
ClO
−
4
+2H O
3
+
+2e
−
⟶ ClO
−
3
+3H O
2
+1.189
ClO
−
3
+3H O
3
+
+2e
−
⟶ HClO
2
+4H O
2
+1.21
HClO + H O
3
+
+2e
−
⟶ Cl
−
+2H O
2
+1.482
1
HClO + H O
3
+
+e
−
⟶ Cl
2
+2H O
2
+1.611
2
HClO
2
+2H O
3
+
+2e
−
⟶ HClO + 3 H O
2
+1.628
Co
3+
+e
−
⟶ Co
2+
(2 mol // H SO )
2 4
+1.83
Co
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Co −0.28
[Co (NH ) ]
3 6
3+
+e
−
⟶ [Co (NH ) ]
3 6
2+
+0.1
Co (OH)
3
+e
−
⟶ Co (OH)
2
+ OH
−
+0.17
Cr
3
+3e
−
⟶ Cr −0.744
Cr
3+
+e
−
⟶ Cr
2+
−0.407
Cr
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Cr −0.913
−
[Cu(CN) ]
2
+e
−
⟶ Cu + 2 CN
−
−0.43
CrO
2−
4
+4H O+3e
2
−
⟶ Cr(OH)
3
+ 5 OH
−
−0.13
Cr O
2
2−
7
+ 14 H O
3
+
+6e
−
⟶ 2 Cr
3+
+ 21 H O
2
+1.232
−
[Cr(OH) ]
4
+3e
−
⟶ Cr + 4 OH
−
−1.2
Cr(OH)
3
+3e
−
⟶ Cr + 3 OH
−
−1.48
Cu
2+
+e
−
⟶ Cu
+
+0.153
Cu
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Cu +0.34
Cu
+
+e
−
⟶ Cu +0.521
F
2
+2e
−
⟶ 2F
−
+2.866
Fe
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Fe −0.447
Fe
3+
+e
−
⟶ Fe
2+
+0.771
[Fe(CN) ]
6
3−
+e
−
⟶ [Fe(CN) ]
6
4−
+0.36
Fe(OH)
2
+2e
−
⟶ Fe + 2 OH
−
−0.88
FeS + 2 e
−
⟶ Fe + S
2−
−1.01
Ga
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Ga −0.549
Gd
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Gd −2.279
1
H
2
+e
−
⟶ H
−
−2.23
2
2H O+2e
2
−
⟶ H
2
+ 2 OH
−
−0.8277
H O
2 2
+2H O
3
+
+2e
−
⟶ 4H O
2
+1.776
2H O
3
+
+2e
−
⟶ H
2
+2H O
2
0.00
HO
−
2
+H O+2e
2
−
⟶ 3 OH
−
+0.878
Hf
4+
+4e
−
⟶ Hf −1.55
Hg
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Hg +0.851
2 Hg
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Hg
2+
2
+0.92
Hg
2+
2
+2e
−
⟶ 2 Hg +0.7973
[HgBr ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Hg + 4 Br
−
+0.21
Hg Cl
2 2
+2e
−
⟶ 2 Hg + 2 Cl
−
+0.26808
[Hg (CN) ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Hg + 4 CN
−
−0.37
[HgI ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Hg + 4 I
−
−0.04
HgS + 2 e
−
⟶ Hg + S
2−
−0.70
I
2
+2e
−
⟶ 2I
−
+0.5355
In
3+
+3e
−
⟶ In −0.3382
K
+
+e
−
⟶ K −2.931
La
3+
+3e
−
⟶ La −2.52
Li
+
+e
−
⟶ Li −3.04
Lu
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Lu −2.28
Mg
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Mg −2.372
Mn
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Mn −1.185
MnO
2
+2H O+2e
2
−
⟶ Mn(OH)
2
+ 2 OH
−
−0.05
MnO
−
4
+2H O+3e
2
−
⟶ MnO
2
+ 4 OH
−
+0.558
MnO
2
+4H
+
+2e
−
⟶ Mn
2+
+2H O
2
+1.23
MnO
−
4
+8H
+
+5e
−
⟶ Mn
2+
+4H O
2
+1.507
Na
+
+e
−
⟶ Na −2.71
Nd
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Nd −2.323
Ni
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Ni −0.257
[Ni(NH ) ]
3 6
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Ni + 6 NH
3
−0.49
NiO
2
+4H
+
+2e
−
⟶ Ni
2+
+2H O
2
+1.593
NiO
2
+2H O+2e
2
−
⟶ Ni(OH)
2
+ 2 OH
−
+0.49
NiS + 2 e
−
⟶ Ni + S
2−
+0.76
NO
−
3
+4H
+
+3e
−
⟶ NO + 2 H O
2
+0.957
NO
−
3
+3H
+
+2e
−
⟶ HNO
2
+H O
2
+0.92
NO
−
3
+H O+2e
2
−
⟶ NO
−
2
+ 2 OH
−
+0.10
Np
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Np −1.856
O
2
+2H O+4e
2
−
⟶ 4 OH
−
+0.401
O
2
+2H
+
+2e
−
⟶ H O
2 2
+0.695
O
2
+4H
+
+4e
−
⟶ 2H O
2
+1.229
Pb
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Pb −0.1262
PbO
2
+ SO
2−
4
+4H
+
+2e
−
⟶ PbSO
4
+2H O
2
+1.69
PbS + 2 e
−
⟶ Pb + S
2−
−0.95
PbSO
4
+2e
−
⟶ Pb + SO
2−
4
−0.3505
Pd
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Pd +0.987
[PdCl ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Pd + 4 Cl
−
+0.591
Pt
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Pt +1.20
[PtBr ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Pt + 4 Br
−
+0.58
[PtCl ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Pt + 4 Cl
−
+0.755
[PtCl ]
6
2−
+2e
−
⟶ [PtCl ]
4
2−
+ 2 Cl
−
+0.68
Pu
3
+3e
−
⟶ Pu −2.03
Ra
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Ra −2.92
Rb
+
+e
−
⟶ Rb −2.98
[RhCl
6
]
3−
+3e
−
⟶ Rh + 6 Cl
−
+0.44
S+2 e
−
⟶ S
2−
−0.47627
S+2 H
+
+2e
−
⟶ H S
2
+0.142
Sc
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Sc −2.09
Se + 2 H
+
+2e
−
⟶ H Se
2
−0.399
[SiF ]
6
2−
+4e
−
⟶ Si + 6 F
−
−1.2
SiO
2−
3
+3H O+4e
2
−
⟶ Si + 6 OH
−
−1.697
SiO
2
+4H
+
+4e
−
⟶ Si + 2 H O
2
−0.86
Sm
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Sm −2.304
Sn
4+
+2e
−
⟶ Sn
2+
+0.151
Sn
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Sn −0.1375
[SnF ]
6
2−
+4e
−
⟶ Sn + 6 F
−
−0.25
SnS + 2 e
−
⟶ Sn + S
2−
−0.94
Sr
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Sr −2.89
TeO
2
+4H
+
+4e
−
⟶ Te + 2 H O
2
+0.593
Th
4+
+4e
−
⟶ Th −1.90
Ti
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Ti −1.630
U
3+
+3e
−
⟶ U −1.79
V
2+
+2e
−
⟶ V −1.19
Y
3+
+3e
−
⟶ Y −2.37
Zn
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Zn −0.7618
[Zn(CN) ]
4
2−
+2e
−
⟶ Zn + 4 CN
−
−1.26
[Zn(NH ) ]
3 4
2+
+2e
−
⟶ Zn + 4 NH
3
−1.04
Zn(OH)
2
+2e
−
⟶ Zn + 2 OH
−
−1.245
[Zn(OH) ]
4
2
+2e
−
⟶ Zn + 4 OH
−
−1.199
ZnS + 2 e
−
⟶ Zn + S
2−
−1.40
Zr
4
+4e
−
⟶ Zr −1.539
This page titled Standard Electrode (Half-Cell) Potentials is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by
OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
Substance ΔH
∘
f
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
298
∘
(J K–1 mol–1)
aluminum
Al(s) 0 0 28.3
Al
3 +
(aq) -531 -485 -321.7
antimony
Sb(s) 0 0 45.69
SbOCl(s) –374.0 — —
arsenic
As(s) 0 0 35.1
H3AsO4(s) –906.3 — —
barium
Ba(s) 0 0 62.5
Ba
2 +
(aq) -537.6 -560.8 9.6
Substance ΔH
f
∘
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
beryllium
Be(s) 0 0 9.50
bismuth
Bi(s) 0 0 56.74
boron
B(s) 0 0 5.86
bromine
Br2(l) 0 0 152.23
Br
−
(aq) -120.9 -102.82 80.71
cadmium
Cd(s) 0 0 51.76
Cd
2 +
(aq) -75.90 -77.61 -73.2
calcium
Substance ΔH
f
∘
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
Ca(s) 0 0 41.6
Ca
2 +
(aq) -542.96 -553.04 -55.2
carbon
CO
2 −
3
(aq) -677.1 -527.8 -56.9
HCO
−
3
(aq) -691.11 -587.06 95
Substance ΔH
f
∘
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
cesium
Cs
+
(aq) -248 -282.0 133
chlorine
Cl2(g) 0 0 223.1
Cl
−
(aq) -167.2 -131.2 56.5
Cl2O7(l) 238.1 — —
Cl2O7(g) 272.0 — —
HClO4(l) –40.58 — —
chromium
Cr(s) 0 0 23.77
CrO
2 −
4
(aq) -881.2 -727.8 50.21
Cr O
2
2 −
7
(aq) -1490.3 -1301.1 261.9
CrO3(s) –589.5 — —
(NH4)2Cr2O7(s) –1806.7 — —
cobalt
Co(s) 0 0 30.0
Co
2 +
(aq) -67.4 -51.5 -155
Co
3 +
(aq) 92 134 -305.0
Co(NO3)2(s) –420.5 — —
copper
Cu(s) 0 0 33.15
Substance ΔH
f
∘
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
Cu
+
(aq) 51.9 50.2 -26
Cu
2 +
(aq) 64.77 65.49 -99.6
Cu(NO3)2(s) –302.9 — —
fluorine
F2(g) 0 0 202.8
F
−
(aq) -332.6 -278.8 -13.8
hydrogen
H2(g) 0 0 130.7
H
+
(aq) 0 0 0
OH
−
(aq) -230.0 -157.2 -10.75
H O
3
+
(aq) -285.8 69.91
iodine
I2(s) 0 0 116.14
I
−
(aq) -55.19 -51.57 11.13
Substance ΔH
∘
f
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
iron
Fe(s) 0 0 27.3
Fe
2 +
(aq) -89.1 -78.90 -137.7
Fe
3 +
(aq) -48.5 -4.7 -315.9
lead
Pb(s) 0 0 64.81
Pb
2 +
(aq) -1.7 -24.43 10.5
Pb(OH)2(s) –515.9 — —
Pb(NO3)2(s) –451.9 — —
lithium
Li(s) 0 0 29.1
Li
+
(aq) -278.5 -293.3 13.4
Substance ΔH
f
∘
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
magnesium
Mg
2 +
(aq) -466.9 -454.8 -138.1
manganese
Mn(s) 0 0 32.0
Mn
2 +
(aq) -220.8 -228.1 -73.6
MnO
−
4
(aq) -541.4 -447.2 191.2
MnO
2 −
4
(aq) -653.0 -500.7 59
mercury
Hg(l) 0 0 75.9
Hg
2 +
(aq) 164.8
Hg
2 +
2
(aq) 172.4 153.9 84.5
nitrogen
N2(g) 0 0 191.6
NO
−
3
(aq) -205.0 -108.7 146.4
Substance ΔH
∘
f
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
NH
+
4
(aq) -132.5 -79.31 113.4
NH4NO2(s) –256.5 — —
oxygen
O2(g) 0 0 205.2
phosphorus
P4(s) 0 0 164.4
P4O6(s) –1640.1 — —
PO
3 −
4
(aq) -1277 -1019 -222
HPO3(s) –948.5 — —
HPO
2 −
4
(aq) -1292.1 -1089.3 -33
H PO
2
−
4
(aq) -1296.3 -1130.4 90.4
H3PO2(s) –604.6 — —
H3PO3(s) –964.4 — —
H4P2O7(s) –2241.0 — —
potassium
K(s) 0 0 64.7
Substance ΔH
f
∘
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
K
+
(aq) -252.4 -283.3 102.5
rubidium
Rb
+
(aq) -246 -282.2 124
silicon
Si(s) 0 0 18.8
silver
Ag(s) 0 0 42.55
Ag
+
(aq) 105.6 77.11 72.68
sodium
Na(s) 0 0 51.3
Na
+
(aq) -240.1 -261.9 59
strontium
Sr
2 +
(aq) -545.8 -557.3 -32.6
sulfur
S
2 −
(aq) 41.8 83.7 22
Substance ΔH
∘
f
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
SO
2 −
4
(aq) -909.3 -744.5 20.1
S O
2
2 −
3
(aq) -648.5 -522.5 67
HS
−
(aq) -17.7 12.6 61.1
HSO
−
4
(aq) -885.75 -752.87 126.9
H2S2O7(s) –1273.6 — —
SCl2(l) –50 — —
SCl2(g) –19.7 — —
S2Cl2(l) –59.4 — —
SOCl2(l) –245.6 — —
SO2Cl2(l) –394.1 — —
tin
Sn(s) 0 0 51.2
titanium
Ti(s) 0 0 30.7
tungsten
W(s) 0 0 32.6
zinc
Zn(s) 0 0 41.6
Substance ΔH
f
∘
(kJ mol–) ΔG
∘
f
(kJ mol–1) S
∘
298
(J K–1 mol–1)
Zn
2 +
(aq) -153.9 -147.1 -112.1
complexes
NH4[Co(NH3)2(NO2)4] –837.6 — —
[Co(NH3)6][Co(NH3)2(NO2)4]3 –2733.0 — —
[Co(en)3](ClO4)3 –762.7 — —
[Co(en)3]Br2 –595.8 — —
[Co(en)3]I2 –475.3 — —
[Co(en)3]I3 –519.2 — —
[Pt(NH3)4]Cl2 –725.5 — —
[Ni(NH3)6]Cl2 –994.1 — —
[Ni(NH3)6]Br2 –923.8 — —
[Ni(NH3)6]I2 –808.3 — —
This page titled Standard Thermodynamic Properties for Selected Substances is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed,
and/or curated by OpenStax via source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is
available upon request.
This page titled The Periodic Table is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source
content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
millimeter (mm) = 0.001 m (exact, definition) inch (in.) = 2.54 cm (exact, definition)
Units of Volume
Units of Volume
Units of Mass
Units of Mass
Units of Energy
Units of Energy
Units of Pressure
Units of Pressure
This page titled Units and Conversion Factors is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via
source content that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
0 999.8395
10 999.7026
15 999.1026
20 998.2071
22 997.7735
25 997.0479
30 995.6502
40 992.2
60 983.2
80 971.8
100 958.4
0 4.6 613.2812
4 6.1 813.2642
10 9.2 1226.562
15 12.8 1706.522
20 17.5 2333.135
22 19.8 2639.776
25 23.8 3173.064
30 31.8 4239.64
35 42.2 5626.188
40 55.3 7372.707
45 71.9 9585.852
50 92.5 12332.29
55 118.0 15732
60 149.4 19918.31
65 187.5 24997.88
70 233.7 31157.35
75 289.1 38543.39
80 355.1 47342.64
85 433.6 57808.42
90 525.8 70100.71
95 633.9 84512.82
0 0.112 14.95
5 0.182 14.74
10 0.288 14.54
15 0.465 14.33
20 0.671 14.17
25 0.991 14.00
30 1.432 13.84
35 2.042 13.69
40 2.851 13.55
45 3.917 13.41
50 5.297 13.28
55 7.080 13.15
60 9.311 13.03
75 19.95 12.70
Standard Water Melting and Boiling Temperatures and Enthalpies of the Transitions
Standard Water Melting and Boiling Temperatures and Enthalpies of the Transitions
Water Cryoscopic (Freezing Point Depression) and Ebullioscopic (Boiling Point Elevation) Constants
Water Cryoscopic (Freezing Point Depression) and Ebullioscopic (Boiling Point Elevation) Constants
Water full-range spectral absorption curve. This curve shows the full-range spectral absorption for water. The y-axis signifies the
absorption in 1/cm. If we divide 1 by this value, we will obtain the length of the path (in cm) after which the intensity of a light
beam passing through water decays by a factor of the base of the natural logarithm e (e = 2.718281828).
Footnotes
1. 1 Data for t < 0 °C are for supercooled water
2. 2 pKw = –log10(Kw)
This page titled Water Properties is shared under a CC BY 4.0 license and was authored, remixed, and/or curated by OpenStax via source content
that was edited to the style and standards of the LibreTexts platform; a detailed edit history is available upon request.
1 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
bond length chemical equation coordinate covalent bond
7.2: Covalent Bonding 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations 15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases
borate chemical property coordination compound
18.3: Structure and General Properties of the 1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties 19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
Metalloids Chemical Reduction Compounds
Boyle's Law 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
18.2: Occurrence and Preparation of the
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and Representative Metals coordination number
Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law chemical symbol 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids
Bragg equation 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism
10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids chemical thermodynamics coordination sphere
buffer 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
5.3: Enthalpy
14.6: Buffers chemistry core electron
Buffer Capacity 6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron
1.1: Chemistry in Context
Configurations)
14.6: Buffers Chemotherapy
Buret corrosion
21.5: Uses of Radioisotopes
17.6: Corrosion
4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis circuit covalent bond
17.1: Balancing Oxidation-Reduction Reactions
2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds
C cis configuration 7.2: Covalent Bonding
calorie 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals covalent compound
5.1: Energy Basics coefficient 2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds
calorimeter 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations covalent network solid
5.2: Calorimetry cohesive force 10.5: The Solid State of Matter
Calorimetry 10.2: Properties of Liquids covalent radius
5.2: Calorimetry colligative property 6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties
capillary action 11.4: Colligative Properties crenation
10.2: Properties of Liquids collision theory 11.4: Colligative Properties
Carbonate 12.5: Collision Theory critical mass
18.6: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of colloid 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
Carbonates 11.5: Colloids critical point
carbonyl group combustion analysis 10.4: Phase Diagrams
20.3: Aldehydes, Ketones, Carboxylic Acids, and
Esters
4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis crystal field splitting
Combustion Reaction 19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of
carboxylic acid Coordination Compounds
4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions
20.3: Aldehydes, Ketones, Carboxylic Acids, and
Esters common ion effect crystal field theory
15.1: Precipitation and Dissolution 19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of
catalyst Coordination Compounds
12.2: Factors Affecting Reaction Rates complete ionic equation
4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations crystalline solid
cathode 10.5: The Solid State of Matter
17.2: Galvanic Cells complex ion
15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases cubic centimeter
cathodic protection 1.4: Measurements
17.6: Corrosion compound
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter cubic closest packing
cation 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids
2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism compressibility factor
9.6: Non-Ideal Gas Behavior cubic meter
Cell Notation 1.4: Measurements
17.2: Galvanic Cells concentrated
3.3: Molarity curie (unit)
cell potential 21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation
17.2: Galvanic Cells concentration
3.3: Molarity Current
Celsius 17.1: Balancing Oxidation-Reduction Reactions
1.4: Measurements concentration cell
central metal 17.4: The Nernst Equation
condensation D
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
chain reaction 10.3: Phase Transitions d orbital
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy conjugate acid 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
Charles's Law 14.1: Brønsted-Lowry Acids and Bases Dalton's atomic theory
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and containment system 2.1: Early Ideas in Atomic Theory
Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy Dalton's Law of Partial Pressure
chelate continuous spectrum 9.3: Stoichiometry of Gaseous Substances, Mixtures,
and Reactions
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
chelating ligand control rod daughter nuclide
21.3: Radioactive Decay
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
chemical change conversion factors density
1.4: Measurements
1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties 1.6: Mathematical Treatment of Measurement
Results
2 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
deposition electromagnetic spectrum exothermic process
10.3: Phase Transitions 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy 5.1: Energy Basics
diffraction electron expansion work
10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids 2.2: Evolution of Atomic Theory 5.3: Enthalpy
diffusion Electron Affinity extensive property
9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases 6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties 1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties
dilution electron capture external beam radiation therapy
3.3: Molarity 21.3: Radioactive Decay 21.5: Uses of Radioisotopes
dimensional analysis electron configuration
1.6: Mathematical Treatment of Measurement 6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron F
Results Configurations)
f orbital
dipole moment electron density 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
Fahrenheit
diprotic acid electron volt 1.6: Mathematical Treatment of Measurement
14.5: Polyprotic Acids 21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability Results
diprotic base electronegativity Faraday's constant
14.5: Polyprotic Acids 7.2: Covalent Bonding 17.4: The Nernst Equation
dispersed phase electroplating first law of thermodynamics
11.5: Colloids 17.7: Electrolysis 5.3: Enthalpy
dispersion element first transition series
10.1: Intermolecular Forces 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter 19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
dispersion medium elementary reaction Compounds
11.5: Colloids 12.6: Reaction Mechanisms fissile
disproportionation reaction empirical formula 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
18.4: Structure and General Properties of the 2.4: Chemical Formulas fission
Nonmetals empirical formula mass 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
dissociation 3.2: Determining Empirical and Molecular Formulas fissionable
11.2: Electrolytes emulsifying agent 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
dissociation constant 11.5: Colloids formal charge
15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases emulsion 7.4: Formal Charges and Resonance
dissolved 11.5: Colloids formation constant
3.3: Molarity End point 15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases
donor atom 4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis formula mass
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals endothermic process 3.1: Formula Mass and the Mole Concept
double bond 5.1: Energy Basics fourth transition series
7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures Energy 19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
Downs cell 5.1: Energy Basics Compounds
18.2: Occurrence and Preparation of the Enthalpy Frasch process
Representative Metals 18.10: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of
5.3: Enthalpy
dry cell Enthalpy change
Sulfur
17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells Free radical
5.3: Enthalpy
dynamic equilibrium entropy
7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures
10.3: Phase Transitions freezing
16.2: Entropy
10.3: Phase Transitions
equatorial position
E 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
freezing point
Effective Nuclear Charge 10.3: Phase Transitions
equilibrium
6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties freezing point depression
13.1: Chemical Equilibria
effusion 11.4: Colligative Properties
equilibrium constant
9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases freezing point depression constant
13.2: Equilibrium Constants
eg orbitals 11.4: Colligative Properties
equivalence point
19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of frequency
4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis
Coordination Compounds 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
ester
electrical potential frequency factor
20.3: Aldehydes, Ketones, Carboxylic Acids, and
17.1: Balancing Oxidation-Reduction Reactions Esters 12.5: Collision Theory
electrical work ether fuel cell
17.4: The Nernst Equation 20.2: Alcohols and Ethers 17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells
Electrolysis exact number functional group
17.7: Electrolysis 1.5: Measurement Uncertainty, Accuracy, and 20.1: Hydrocarbons
electrolyte Precision fundamental unit of charge
11.2: Electrolytes excess reactant 2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism
electrolytic cell 4.4: Reaction Yields fusion
17.7: Electrolysis excited state 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
Electromagnetic Radiation 6.2: The Bohr Model fusion reactor
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
3 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
G hole indicator
galvanic cell 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids 4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis
17.2: Galvanic Cells homogeneous catalyst induced dipole
galvanized iron 12.7: Catalysis 10.1: Intermolecular Forces
17.6: Corrosion homogeneous equilibria inert electrode
gamma emission 13.2: Equilibrium Constants 17.2: Galvanic Cells
21.3: Radioactive Decay homogeneous mixture inert gas
gamma ray 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter 2.5: The Periodic Table
21.2: Nuclear Equations Hund's rule inert pair effect
gas 6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron 7.1: Ionic Bonding
Configurations) initial rate
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
hybrid orbital 12.1: Chemical Reaction Rates
Geiger counter
8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals inner transition metal
21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation
hybridization 2.5: The Periodic Table
gel
8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals instantaneous dipole
11.5: Colloids
hydrocarbon 10.1: Intermolecular Forces
geometric isomers
5.3: Enthalpy instantaneous rate
19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of
Coordination Compounds hydrogen bonding 12.1: Chemical Reaction Rates
Gibbs Free Energy 10.1: Intermolecular Forces integrated rate law
16.4: Gibbs Energy hydrogen carbonate 12.4: Integrated Rate Laws
goiter 18.6: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of intensity
Carbonates
2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
hydrogen halide intensive property
Graham's law
18.5: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of
9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases 1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties
Hydrogen
gravimetric analysis hydrogen sulfate interference pattern
4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of
gray (unit) Oxygen interhalogen
21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation hydrogen sulfite 18.12: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of the
ground state Noble Gases
18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of
6.2: The Bohr Model Oxygen intermediate
group hydrogenation 12.6: Reaction Mechanisms
2.5: The Periodic Table 18.5: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of intermolecular force
Hydrogen 10.1: Intermolecular Forces
H hydrometallurgy internal energy
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their 5.3: Enthalpy
Haber Process Compounds
18.5: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of
internal radiation therapy
hydrostatic pressure 21.5: Uses of Radioisotopes
Hydrogen
9.1: Gas Pressure International System of Units
halide
hydroxide 1.4: Measurements
18.12: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of the
Noble Gases 18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of interstitial sites
Oxygen
halogen 10.5: The Solid State of Matter
hypertonic
2.5: The Periodic Table ion
11.4: Colligative Properties
heat 2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism
hypervalent molecule
5.1: Energy Basics ion pair
7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures
Heat capacity 11.4: Colligative Properties
hypothesis
5.1: Energy Basics ionic bond
1.1: Chemistry in Context
Heisenberg Uncertainty Principle 2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds
hypotonic 7.1: Ionic Bonding
6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
11.4: Colligative Properties ionic compound
hemolysis
11.4: Colligative Properties 2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds
Henry's law
I ionic solid
11.3: Solubility
ideal gas 10.5: The Solid State of Matter
hertz 9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and ionic solvent
Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy 17.7: Electrolysis
ideal gas constant Ionization Energy
Hess's law 9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and
5.3: Enthalpy 6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties
Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law
heterogeneous catalyst ideal gas law ionization isomer
12.7: Catalysis 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and
heterogeneous equilibria Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law ionizing radiation
13.2: Equilibrium Constants ideal solution 21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation
heterogeneous mixture 11.1: The Dissolution Process isoelectronic
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter immiscible 6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties
hexagonal closest packing 11.3: Solubility isomers
10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids 2.4: Chemical Formulas
4 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
isomorphous ligand miscible
10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids 15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases 11.3: Solubility
isotonic 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals mixture
11.4: Colligative Properties limiting reactant 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
isotope 4.4: Reaction Yields molality
2.2: Evolution of Atomic Theory line spectrum 11.4: Colligative Properties
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy molar mass
J Linear 3.1: Formula Mass and the Mole Concept
7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity molar solubility
joule
5.1: Energy Basics
linkage isomer 15.1: Precipitation and Dissolution
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals molarity
K liquid 3.3: Molarity
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter mole
Kc
liter 3.1: Formula Mass and the Mole Concept
13.2: Equilibrium Constants
1.4: Measurements mole fraction
kelvin
lithium ion battery 9.3: Stoichiometry of Gaseous Substances, Mixtures,
1.4: Measurements
17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells and Reactions
ketone
lone pair molecular compound
20.3: Aldehydes, Ketones, Carboxylic Acids, and
Esters 7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures 2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds
kilogram molecular equation
1.4: Measurements M 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations
Kinetic Energy macroscopic domain molecular formula
5.1: Energy Basics 1.1: Chemistry in Context 2.4: Chemical Formulas
kinetic molecular theory magic number molecular orbital theory
9.5: The Kinetic-Molecular Theory 21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability 8.4: Molecular Orbital Theory
Kp magnetic quantum number molecular solid
13.2: Equilibrium Constants 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory 10.5: The Solid State of Matter
manometer Molecular Structure
L 9.1: Gas Pressure 7.4: Formal Charges and Resonance
7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
lanthanide mass
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
molecularity
2.5: The Periodic Table
12.6: Reaction Mechanisms
lanthanide series mass defect
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability
molecule
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
Compounds mass number
Lattice Energy 2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism
monatomic ion
2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds
7.5: Strengths of Ionic and Covalent Bonds mass percentage
law 3.4: Other Units for Solution Concentrations
monodentate
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
1.1: Chemistry in Context mean free path
law of conservation of matter 9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases
monoprotic acid
14.5: Polyprotic Acids
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter melting
law of constant composition 10.3: Phase Transitions
multiple equilibrium
15.3: Coupled Equilibria
2.1: Early Ideas in Atomic Theory melting point
law of definite proportions 10.3: Phase Transitions
2.1: Early Ideas in Atomic Theory metal N
Law of Mass Action 2.5: The Periodic Table Nernst Equation
13.2: Equilibrium Constants 18.1: Periodicity 17.4: The Nernst Equation
law of multiple proportions metallic solid net ionic equation
2.1: Early Ideas in Atomic Theory 10.5: The Solid State of Matter 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations
Le Chatelier's Principle metalloid neutral
13.3: Shifting Equilibria - Le Chatelier’s Principle 2.5: The Periodic Table 14.2: pH and pOH
18.1: Periodicity neutron
lead acid battery
meter 2.2: Evolution of Atomic Theory
17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells
1.4: Measurements Nitrate
length
Method of Initial Rates 18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of
1.4: Measurements
12.3: Rate Laws Oxygen
leveling effect of water
microscopic domain nitrogen fixation
14.3: Relative Strengths of Acids and Bases
1.1: Chemistry in Context 18.7: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of
Lewis Acid Nitrogen
microstates
15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases noble gas
16.2: Entropy
Lewis base 2.5: The Periodic Table
millicurie (unit)
15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases node
21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation
Lewis structure 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
milliliter
7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures 8.1: Valence Bond Theory
1.4: Measurements
Lewis symbol nomenclature
7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures 2.7: Chemical Nomenclature
5 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
nonelectrolyte oxide physical property
11.2: Electrolytes 18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of 1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties
nonionizing radiation Oxygen pi bond
21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation oxidizing agent 8.1: Valence Bond Theory
nonmetal 4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions Pidgeon process
2.5: The Periodic Table oxyacid 18.2: Occurrence and Preparation of the
nonpolar covalent bond 2.7: Chemical Nomenclature Representative Metals
14.3: Relative Strengths of Acids and Bases plasma
7.2: Covalent Bonding
nonspontaneous process oxyanion 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds platinum metals
16.1: Spontaneity
normal boiling point Ozone 19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of Compounds
10.3: Phase Transitions
Oxygen pnictogen
nuclear binding energy
2.5: The Periodic Table
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability
P pOH
Nuclear chemistry
p orbital 14.2: pH and pOH
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability
nuclear fuel
6.3: Development of Quantum Theory polar covalent bond
pairing energy 7.2: Covalent Bonding
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
nuclear moderator
19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of polar molecule
Coordination Compounds 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy parent nuclide
nuclear reaction polarizability
21.3: Radioactive Decay 10.1: Intermolecular Forces
21.2: Nuclear Equations partial pressure
Nuclear Reactor polyatomic ion
9.3: Stoichiometry of Gaseous Substances, Mixtures, 2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy and Reactions
nuclear transmutation polydentate ligand
partially miscible
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy 11.3: Solubility
nucleon polymorph
particle accelerator
18.3: Structure and General Properties of the
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy Metalloids
nucleus parts per billion position of equilibrium
2.2: Evolution of Atomic Theory 3.4: Other Units for Solution Concentrations 13.3: Shifting Equilibria - Le Chatelier’s Principle
nutritional calorie Parts per million Positron
5.2: Calorimetry 3.4: Other Units for Solution Concentrations 21.2: Nuclear Equations
pascal positron emission
O 9.1: Gas Pressure 21.3: Radioactive Decay
Octahedral passivation Potential Energy
7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity 18.1: Periodicity 5.1: Energy Basics
octahedral hole Pauli exclusion principle pounds per square inch
10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory 9.1: Gas Pressure
octet rule percent composition precipitate
7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures 3.2: Determining Empirical and Molecular Formulas 4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions
optical isomer percent of ionization Precipitation reaction
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals 14.3: Relative Strengths of Acids and Bases 4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions
orbital diagram percent yield precision
6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron 4.4: Reaction Yields 1.5: Measurement Uncertainty, Accuracy, and
Configurations) period Precision
organic compound 2.5: The Periodic Table pressure
20.1: Hydrocarbons periodic law 9.1: Gas Pressure
osmosis 2.5: The Periodic Table primary battery
11.4: Colligative Properties periodic table 17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells
osmotic pressure 2.5: The Periodic Table principal quantum number
11.4: Colligative Properties Peroxide 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
Ostwald process 18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of product
18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of Oxygen 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations
Oxygen pH proton
overall reaction order 14.2: pH and pOH 2.2: Evolution of Atomic Theory
12.3: Rate Laws phase diagram PSI (Unit)
overlap 10.4: Phase Diagrams 9.1: Gas Pressure
8.1: Valence Bond Theory photon pure covalent bond
overpotential 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy 7.2: Covalent Bonding
17.7: Electrolysis photosynthesis pure substance
oxidation 18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions Oxygen
Physical change
1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties
6 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
Q representative metal simple cubic structure
Quantitative Analysis 18.1: Periodicity 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids
4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis resonance simple cubic unit cell
Quantization 7.4: Formal Charges and Resonance 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids
8.3: Multiple Bonds single bond
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
resonance forms 7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures
quantum mechanics
7.4: Formal Charges and Resonance skeletal structure
6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
resonance hybrid 20.1: Hydrocarbons
quantum number
7.4: Formal Charges and Resonance smelting
6.2: The Bohr Model
reversible process 19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
16.2: Entropy Compounds
R reversible reaction solid
radiation absorbed dose 13.1: Chemical Equilibria 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation
roentgen equivalent man solubility
radiation dosimeter 21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation 11.3: Solubility
21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation
root mean square velocity solubility product
radiation therapy 9.5: The Kinetic-Molecular Theory 15.1: Precipitation and Dissolution
21.5: Uses of Radioisotopes
rounding solute
radioactive decay 1.5: Measurement Uncertainty, Accuracy, and 3.3: Molarity
21.3: Radioactive Decay Precision solvation
radioactive decay series 11.1: The Dissolution Process
21.3: Radioactive Decay S solvent
radioactive tracer s orbital 3.3: Molarity
21.5: Uses of Radioisotopes 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory sp hybrid orbital
radioactivity sacrificial anode 8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability 17.6: Corrosion sp2 hybrid orbital
radiocarbon dating saturated 8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals
21.3: Radioactive Decay 11.3: Solubility sp3 hybrid orbital
radioisotope saturated hydrocarbon 8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability 20.1: Hydrocarbons sp3d hybrid orbital
Radiometric Dating scientific method 8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals
21.3: Radioactive Decay 1.1: Chemistry in Context sp3d2 hybrid orbital
Raoult's Law scintillation counter 8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals
11.4: Colligative Properties 21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation space lattice
rare earth element second 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
Compounds
1.4: Measurements spatial isomers
Second Law of Thermodynamics 2.4: Chemical Formulas
rate constant
12.3: Rate Laws
16.3: The Second and Third Laws of specific heat capacity
Thermodynamics 5.1: Energy Basics
rate expression second transition series
12.1: Chemical Reaction Rates
spectator ion
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations
rate law Compounds
spectrochemical series
12.3: Rate Laws secondary battery
19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of
rate of diffusion 17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells Coordination Compounds
9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases selective precipitation spin quantum number
rate of reaction 15.1: Precipitation and Dissolution 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory
12.1: Chemical Reaction Rates semipermeable membrane spontaneous change
reactant 11.4: Colligative Properties 16.1: Spontaneity
4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations series spontaneous process
reaction mechanism 2.5: The Periodic Table 11.1: The Dissolution Process
12.6: Reaction Mechanisms shell standard cell potential
Reaction order 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory 17.3: Standard Reduction Potentials
12.3: Rate Laws SI units standard conditions of temperature and
Reaction Quotient 1.4: Measurements
pressure
13.2: Equilibrium Constants sievert (unit)
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and
reactor coolant 21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy sigma bond standard enthalpy of combustion
reduction 8.1: Valence Bond Theory 5.3: Enthalpy
4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions Significant figures Standard Enthalpy of Formation
relative biological effectiveness 1.5: Measurement Uncertainty, Accuracy, and 5.3: Enthalpy
21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation Precision
standard entropy
representative element silicate
16.3: The Second and Third Laws of
2.5: The Periodic Table 18.3: Structure and General Properties of the Thermodynamics
18.1: Periodicity Metalloids
7 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
standard entropy change superoxide triprotic acid
16.3: The Second and Third Laws of 18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of 14.5: Polyprotic Acids
Thermodynamics Oxygen Tyndall effect
standard free energy change supersaturated 11.5: Colloids
16.4: Gibbs Energy 11.3: Solubility
standard free energy of formation surface tension U
16.4: Gibbs Energy 10.2: Properties of Liquids
uncertainty
standard hydrogen electrode surroundings 1.5: Measurement Uncertainty, Accuracy, and
17.3: Standard Reduction Potentials 5.2: Calorimetry Precision
standard molar volume symbolic domain unified atomic mass unit
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and 1.1: Chemistry in Context 2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism
Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law system unimolecular reaction
standard reduction potential 5.2: Calorimetry 12.6: Reaction Mechanisms
17.3: Standard Reduction Potentials
unit
standard state T 1.4: Measurements
5.3: Enthalpy
t2g orbitals unit cell
standing wave 19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy Coordination Compounds unsaturated
state function temperature 11.3: Solubility
5.3: Enthalpy 5.1: Energy Basics
Steel termolecular reaction V
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their 12.6: Reaction Mechanisms
Compounds vacancy
Tetrahedral 10.5: The Solid State of Matter
stepwise ionization 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
14.5: Polyprotic Acids Valence Bond Theory
tetrahedral hole 8.1: Valence Bond Theory
stoichiometric factor 10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids
4.3: Reaction Stoichiometry Valence Electrons
theoretical yield 6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron
stoichiometry 4.4: Reaction Yields Configurations)
4.3: Reaction Stoichiometry
theory valence shell
STP 1.1: Chemistry in Context 6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and
Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law
thermal energy Configurations)
5.1: Energy Basics valence shell electron pair repulsion
stress
13.3: Shifting Equilibria - Le Chatelier’s Principle
thermochemistry theory
5.1: Energy Basics 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
strong electrolyte
11.2: Electrolytes
Third Law of Thermodynamics van der Waals equation
16.3: The Second and Third Laws of 9.6: Non-Ideal Gas Behavior
strong nuclear force Thermodynamics
21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability van der Waals force
third transition series 10.1: Intermolecular Forces
structural formula 19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
2.4: Chemical Formulas Compounds
van't Hoff factor
structural isomers 11.4: Colligative Properties
titrant
2.4: Chemical Formulas 4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis
vapor pressure
subcritical mass 10.3: Phase Transitions
titration analysis
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy 4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis
vapor pressure of water
sublimation 9.3: Stoichiometry of Gaseous Substances, Mixtures,
titration curve and Reactions
10.3: Phase Transitions 14.7: Acid-Base Titrations
vaporization
subshell torr 10.3: Phase Transitions
6.3: Development of Quantum Theory 9.1: Gas Pressure
viscosity
substituent trans configuration 10.2: Properties of Liquids
20.1: Hydrocarbons 19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals
voltaic cell
substitution reaction transition metal 17.2: Galvanic Cells
20.1: Hydrocarbons 2.5: The Periodic Table
volume
sulfate transmutation reaction 1.4: Measurements
18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
Oxygen volume percentage
transuranium element 3.4: Other Units for Solution Concentrations
Sulfite 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy
18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of VSEPR
Oxygen
trigonal bipyramidal 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
superconductor
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
Trigonal Planar W
Compounds 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity
water gas shift reaction
supercritical fluid triple bond
13.2: Equilibrium Constants
10.4: Phase Diagrams 7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures
Wave
supercritical mass triple point
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy
21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy 10.4: Phase Diagrams
8 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
wavefunction weak electrolyte work
6.3: Development of Quantum Theory 11.2: Electrolytes 5.1: Energy Basics
wavelength weight
6.1: Electromagnetic Energy 1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter
9 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/278609
Glossary
Alpha particle | (α or He or
4
α ) high-energy
4
Atomic orbital | mathematical function that
Accuracy | how closely a measurement aligns with a 2 2
missing one hydrogen atom, attached to a larger Atom | smallest particle of an element that can enter
structure into a chemical combination Bidentate ligand | ligand that coordinates to one
central metal through coordinate bonds from two
Alkyne | molecule consisting of carbon and Atomic mass | average mass of atoms of an different atoms
hydrogen containing at least one carbon-carbon triple element, expressed in amu
bond
Binary acid | compound that contains hydrogen and
Atomic mass unit (amu) | (also, unified atomic one other element, bonded in a way that imparts acidic
Allotropes | two or more forms of the same element, mass unit, u, or Dalton, Da) unit of mass equal to
1
properties to the compound (ability to release H+ ions
in the same physical state, with different chemical 12 when dissolved in water)
structures of the mass of a 12C atom
Binary compound | compound containing two
Alloy | solid mixture of a metallic element and one or Atomic number (Z) | number of protons in the different elements.
more additional elements nucleus of an atom
Binding energy per nucleon | total binding
Alpha (α) decay | loss of an alpha particle during energy for the nucleus divided by the number of
radioactive decay nucleons in the nucleus
1 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Bismuth | heaviest member of group 15; a less Calorie (cal) | unit of heat or other energy; the Circuit | path taken by a current as it flows because
reactive metal than other representative metals amount of energy required to raise 1 gram of water by of an electrical potential difference
1 degree Celsius; 1 cal is defined as 4.184 J
Blackbody | idealized perfect absorber of all cis configuration | configuration of a geometrical
incident electromagnetic radiation; such bodies emit Calorimeter | device used to measure the amount of isomer in which two similar groups are on the same
electromagnetic radiation in characteristic continuous heat absorbed or released in a chemical or physical side of an imaginary reference line on the molecule
spectra called blackbody radiation process
Clausius-Clapeyron equation | mathematical
Body-centered cubic (BCC) solid | crystalline Calorimetry | process of measuring the amount of relationship between the temperature, vapor pressure,
structure that has a cubic unit cell with lattice points at heat involved in a chemical or physical process and enthalpy of vaporization for a substance
the corners and in the center of the cell
Capillary action | flow of liquid within a porous Coefficient | number placed in front of symbols or
Body-centered cubic unit cell | simplest material due to the attraction of the liquid molecules to formulas in a chemical equation to indicate their
repeating unit of a body-centered cubic crystal; it is a the surface of the material and to other liquid relative amount
cube containing lattice points at each corner and in the molecules
center of the cube Cohesive force | force of attraction between
Carbonate | salt of the anion CO ; often formed
2−
3
identical molecules
Bohr’s model of the hydrogen atom | by the reaction of carbon dioxide with bases
structural model in which an electron moves around Colligative property | property of a solution that
the nucleus only in circular orbits, each with a specific Catalyst | substance that increases the rate of a depends only on the concentration of a solute species
allowed radius; the orbiting electron does not normally reaction without itself being consumed by the reaction Collision theory | model that emphasizes the
emit electromagnetic radiation, but does so when energy and orientation of molecular collisions to
Cathode | electrode in an electrochemical cell at
changing from one orbit to another. explain and predict reaction kinetics
which reduction occurs; information about the cathode
Boiling point | temperature at which the vapor is recorded on the right side of the salt bridge in cell Colloid | (also, colloidal dispersion) mixture in
pressure of a liquid equals the pressure of the gas notation which relatively large solid or liquid particles are
above it dispersed uniformly throughout a gas, liquid, or solid
Cathodic protection | method of protecting metal
Boiling point elevation | elevation of the boiling by using a sacrificial anode and effectively making the Color-change interval | range in pH over which
point of a liquid by addition of a solute metal that needs protecting the cathode, thus the color change of an indicator takes place
preventing its oxidation
Boiling point elevation constant | the Combustion analysis | gravimetric technique used
proportionality constant in the equation relating Cation | positively charged atom or molecule to determine the elemental composition of a compound
boiling point elevation to solute molality; also known (contains fewer electrons than protons) via the collection and weighing of its gaseous
as the ebullioscopic constant combustion products
Cell notation | shorthand way to represent the
Bomb calorimeter | device designed to measure reactions in an electrochemical cell Common ion effect | effect on equilibrium when a
the energy change for processes occurring under substance with an ion in common with the dissolved
Cell potential | difference in electrical potential that
conditions of constant volume; commonly used for species is added to the solution; causes a decrease in
arises when dissimilar metals are connected; the
reactions involving solid and gaseous reactants or the solubility of an ionic species, or a decrease in the
driving force for the flow of charge (current) in
products ionization of a weak acid or base
oxidation-reduction reactions
Bond angle | angle between any two covalent bonds Celsius (°C) | unit of temperature; water freezes at 0 Complete ionic equation | chemical equation in
that share a common atom which all dissolved ionic reactants and products,
°C and boils at 100 °C on this scale
Bond dipole moment | separation of charge in a including spectator ions, are explicitly represented by
Central metal | ion or atom to which one or more formulas for their dissociated ions
bond that depends on the difference in
ligands is attached through coordinate covalent bonds
electronegativity and the bond distance represented by Compound | pure substance that can be
partial charges or a vector Chain reaction | repeated fission caused when the decomposed into two or more elements
neutrons released in fission bombard other atoms
Bond distance | (also, bond length) distance Compressibility factor (Z) | ratio of the
between the nuclei of two bonded atoms Chalcogen | element in group 16 experimentally measured molar volume for a gas to its
Bond energy | (also, bond dissociation energy) Chelate | complex formed from a polydentate ligand molar volume as computed from the ideal gas equation
energy required to break a covalent bond in a gaseous attached to a central metal Concentrated | qualitative term for a solution
substance containing solute at a relatively high concentration
Chelating ligand | ligand that attaches to a central
Bond length | distance between the nuclei of two metal ion by bonds from two or more donor atoms Concentration | quantitative measure of the
bonded atoms at which the lowest potential energy is relative amounts of solute and solvent present in a
achieved Chemical change | change producing a different
kind of matter from the original kind of matter solution
Borate | compound containing boron-oxygen bonds, Concentration cell | galvanic cell in which the two
typically with clusters or chains as a part of the Chemical equation | symbolic representation of a
half-cells are the same except for the concentration of
chemical structure chemical reaction
the solutes; spontaneous when the overall reaction is
Born-Haber cycle | thermochemical cycle relating Chemical property | behavior that is related to the the dilution of the solute
the various energetic steps involved in the formation of change of one kind of matter into another kind of
matter Condensation | change from a gaseous to a liquid
an ionic solid from the relevant elements state
Bragg equation | equation that relates the angles at Chemical reduction | method of preparing a
representative metal using a reducing agent Conjugate acid | substance formed when a base
which X-rays are diffracted by the atoms within a gains a proton
crystal Chemical symbol | one-, two-, or three-letter
abbreviation used to represent an element or its atoms
Conjugate base | substance formed when an acid
Brønsted-Lowry acid | proton donor loses a proton
Brønsted-Lowry base | proton acceptor Chemical thermodynamics | area of science that
deals with the relationships between heat, work, and Containment system | (also, shield) a three-part
Buffer | mixture of a weak acid or a weak base and all forms of energy associated with chemical and structure of materials that protects the exterior of a
the salt of its conjugate; the pH of a buffer resists physical processes nuclear fission reactor and operating personnel from
change when small amounts of acid or base are added the high temperatures, pressures, and radiation levels
Chemistry | study of the composition, properties, inside the reactor
Buffer capacity | amount of an acid or base that and interactions of matter
can be added to a volume of a buffer solution before its Continuous spectrum | electromagnetic radiation
pH changes significantly (usually by one pH unit) Chemotherapy | similar to internal radiation given off in an unbroken series of wavelengths (e.g.,
therapy, but chemical rather than radioactive white light from the sun)
Buret | device used for the precise delivery of substances are introduced into the body to kill cancer
variable liquid volumes, such as in a titration analysis cells Control rod | material inserted into the fuel
assembly that absorbs neutrons and can be raised or
Chlor-alkali process | electrolysis process for the lowered to adjust the rate of a fission reaction
synthesis of chlorine and sodium hydroxide
2 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Coordination compound | stable compound in d-block element | one of the elements in groups 3– Effective nuclear charge | charge that leads to
which the central metal atom or ion acts as a Lewis 11 with valence electrons in d orbitals the Coulomb force exerted by the nucleus on an
acid and accepts one or more pairs of electrons electron, calculated as the nuclear charge minus
Dalton (Da) | alternative unit equivalent to the shielding
Coordination compound | substance consisting atomic mass unit
of atoms, molecules, or ions attached to a central atom eg orbitals | set of two d orbitals that are oriented on
through Lewis acid-base interactions Dalton’s atomic theory | set of postulates that the Cartesian axes for coordination complexes; in
established the fundamental properties of atoms octahedral complexes, they are higher in energy than
Coordination number | number of atoms closest the t2g orbitals
to any given atom in a crystal or to the central metal
Daughter nuclide | nuclide produced by the
radioactive decay of another nuclide; may be stable or
atom in a complex Electrical potential | energy per charge; in
may decay further
electrochemical systems, it depends on the way the
Coordination number | number of coordinate charges are distributed within the system; the SI unit of
covalent bonds to the central metal atom in a complex Density | ratio of mass to volume for a substance or
or the number of closest contacts to an atom in a object electrical potential is the volt (1 V = 1
J
)
C
crystalline form Deposition | change from a gaseous state directly to
a solid state Electrical work (wele) | negative of total charge
Coordination sphere | central metal atom or ion
plus the attached ligands of a complex Diffraction | redirection of electromagnetic times the cell potential; equal to wmax for the system,
radiation that occurs when it encounters a physical and so equals the free energy change (ΔG)
Core electron | electron in an atom that occupies
barrier of appropriate dimensions Electrolyte | substance that produces ions when
the orbitals of the inner shells
dissolved in water
Corrosion | degradation of metal through an Dilute | qualitative term for a solution containing
electrochemical process solute at a relatively low concentration Electromagnetic radiation | energy transmitted
Dilution | process of adding solvent to a solution in by waves that have an electric-field component and a
Covalent bond | attractive force between the nuclei magnetic-field component
order to lower the concentration of solutes
of a molecule’s atoms and pairs of electrons between
the atoms Dimensional analysis | (also, factor-label method) Electromagnetic spectrum | range of energies
that electromagnetic radiation can comprise, including
Covalent bond | bond formed when electrons are versatile mathematical approach that can be applied to
radio, microwaves, infrared, visible, ultraviolet, X-
shared between atoms computations ranging from simple unit conversions to
rays, and gamma rays; since electromagnetic radiation
more complex, multi-step calculations involving
energy is proportional to the frequency and inversely
Covalent compound | (also, molecular several different quantities
proportional to the wavelength, the spectrum can also
compound) composed of molecules formed by atoms
of two or more different elements
Dipole moment | property of a molecule that be specified by ranges of frequencies or wavelengths
describes the separation of charge determined by the
Covalent network solid | solid whose particles sum of the individual bond moments based on the Electron | negatively charged, subatomic particle of
are held together by covalent bonds molecular structure relatively low mass located outside the nucleus
Covalent radius | one-half the distance between Dipole-dipole attraction | intermolecular Electron affinity | energy required to add an
the nuclei of two identical atoms when they are joined attraction between two permanent dipoles electron to a gaseous atom to form an anion
by a covalent bond Electron capture | combination of a core electron
Diprotic acid | acid containing two ionizable
with a proton to yield a neutron within the nucleus
Crenation | process whereby biological cells hydrogen atoms per molecule. A diprotic acid ionizes
become shriveled due to loss of water by osmosis in two steps Electron configuration | electronic structure of
Critical mass | amount of fissionable material that Diprotic base | base capable of accepting two an atom in its ground state given as a listing of the
will support a self-sustaining (nuclear fission) chain protons. The protons are accepted in two steps orbitals occupied by the electrons
reaction Electron density | a measure of the probability of
Dispersed phase | substance present as relatively
Critical point | temperature and pressure above large solid or liquid particles in a colloid locating an electron in a particular region of space, it is
which a gas cannot be condensed into a liquid equal to the squared absolute value of the wave
Dispersion force | (also, London dispersion force) function ψ
Crystal field splitting (Δoct) | difference in attraction between two rapidly fluctuating, temporary
energy between the t2g and eg sets or t and e sets of dipoles; significant only when particles are very close
Electron volt (eV) | measurement unit of nuclear
binding energies, with 1 eV equaling the amount
orbitals together
energy due to the moving an electron across an electric
Crystal field theory | model that explains the Dispersion medium | solid, liquid, or gas in which potential difference of 1 volt
energies of the orbitals in transition metals in terms of colloidal particles are dispersed
electrostatic interactions with the ligands but does not Electron-pair geometry | arrangement around a
include metal ligand bonding Disproportionation reaction | chemical reaction central atom of all regions of electron density (bonds,
where a single reactant is simultaneously reduced and lone pairs, or unpaired electrons)
Crystalline solid | solid in which the particles are oxidized; it is both the reducing agent and the
arranged in a definite repeating pattern oxidizing agent
Electronegativity | tendency of an atom to attract
electrons in a bond to itself
Cubic centimeter (cm3 or cc) | volume of a Dissociation | physical process accompanying the
cube with an edge length of exactly 1 cm dissolution of an ionic compound in which the Element | substance that is composed of a single
compound’s constituent ions are solvated and type of atom; a substance that cannot be decomposed
Cubic closest packing (CCP) | crystalline dispersed throughout the solution by a chemical change
structure in which planes of closely packed atoms or
ions are stacked as a series of three alternating layers Dissolved | describes the process by which solute Empirical formula | formula showing the
of different relative orientations (ABC) components are dispersed in a solvent composition of a compound given as the simplest
whole-number ratio of atoms
Cubic meter (m3) | SI unit of volume Donor atom | atom in a ligand with a lone pair of
electrons that forms a coordinate covalent bond to a
Empirical formula mass | sum of average atomic
Curie (Ci) | larger unit for rate of radioactive decay central metal
masses for all atoms represented in an empirical
frequently used in medicine; 1 Ci = 3.7 × 1010 formula
disintegrations/s Double bond | covalent bond in which two pairs of
electrons are shared between two atoms Emulsifying agent | amphiphilic substance used to
Current | flow of electrical charge; the SI unit of stabilize the particles of some emulsions
charge is the coulomb (C) and current is measured in Downs cell | electrochemical cell used for the
C commercial preparation of metallic sodium (and
Emulsion | colloid formed from immiscible liquids
amperes (1 A = 1 )
s chlorine) from molten sodium chloride End point | measured volume of titrant solution that
Dynamic equilibrium | state of a system in which yields the change in sample solution appearance or
d orbital | region of space with high electron density other property expected for stoichiometric equivalence
that is either four lobed or contains a dumbbell and reciprocal processes are occurring at equal rates
(see equivalence point)
torus shape; describes orbitals with l = 2. An electron
in this orbital is called a d electron Endothermic process | chemical reaction or
physical change that absorbs heat
3 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Energy | capacity to supply heat or do work Fissile (or fissionable) | when a material is Geometric isomers | isomers that differ in the way
capable of sustaining a nuclear fission reaction in which atoms are oriented in space relative to each
Enthalpy (H) | sum of a system’s internal energy other, leading to different physical and chemical
and the mathematical product of its pressure and Fission | splitting of a heavier nucleus into two or properties
volume more lighter nuclei, usually accompanied by the
conversion of mass into large amounts of energy Gibbs free energy change (G) | thermodynamic
Enthalpy change (ΔH) | heat released or property defined in terms of system enthalpy and
absorbed by a system under constant pressure during a Formal charge | charge that would result on an entropy; all spontaneous processes involve a decrease
chemical or physical process atom by taking the number of valence electrons on the in G
neutral atom and subtracting the nonbonding electrons
Entropy (S) | state function that is a measure of the and the number of bonds (one-half of the bonding Gravimetric analysis | quantitative chemical
matter and/or energy dispersal within a system,
electrons) analysis method involving the separation of an analyte
determined by the number of system microstates often
from a sample by a physical or chemical process and
described as a measure of the disorder of the system Formula mass | sum of the average masses for all subsequent mass measurements of the analyte, reaction
atoms represented in a chemical formula; for covalent
Equatorial position | one of the three positions in product, and/or sample
compounds, this is also the molecular mass
a trigonal bipyramidal geometry with 120° angles Gray (Gy) | SI unit for measuring radiation dose; 1
between them; the axial positions are located at a 90° Fourth transition series | transition elements in Gy = 1 J absorbed/kg tissue
angle the seventh period of the periodic table (fourth row of
the d-block), atomic numbers 89 and 104–111 Ground state | state in which the electrons in an
Equilibrium | in chemical reactions, the state in atom, ion, or molecule have the lowest energy possible
which the conversion of reactants into products and the Frasch process | important in the mining of free
conversion of products back into reactants occur sulfur from enormous underground deposits Group | vertical column of the periodic table
simultaneously at the same rate; state of balance
Free radical | molecule that contains an odd Haber process | main industrial process used to
Equilibrium constant (K) | value of the reaction number of electrons produce ammonia from nitrogen and hydrogen;
quotient for a system at equilibrium involves the use of an iron catalyst and elevated
Freezing | change from a liquid state to a solid state temperatures and pressures
Equivalence point | volume of titrant solution
required to react completely with the analyte in a
Freezing point | temperature at which the solid and Half-life (t1/2) | time required for half of the atoms
liquid phases of a substance are in equilibrium; see
titration analysis; provides a stoichiometric amount of in a radioactive sample to decay
also melting point
titrant for the sample’s analyte according to the
titration reaction
Half-life of a reaction (tl/2) | time required for
Freezing point depression | lowering of the half of a given amount of reactant to be consumed
Ether | organic compound with an oxygen atom that freezing point of a liquid by addition of a solute
is bonded to two carbon atoms Half-reaction method | method that produces a
Freezing point depression constant | (also, balanced overall oxidation-reduction reaction by
cryoscopic constant) proportionality constant in the
Exact number | number derived by counting or by splitting the reaction into an oxidation “half” and
equation relating freezing point depression to solute
definition reduction “half,” balancing the two half-reactions, and
molality
then combining the oxidation half-reaction and
Excess reactant | reactant present in an amount reduction half-reaction in such a way that the number
greater than required by the reaction stoichiometry Frequency (ν ) | number of wave cycles (peaks or
troughs) that pass a specified point in space per unit of electrons generated by the oxidation is exactly
Excited state | state having an energy greater than time canceled by the number of electrons required by the
the ground-state energy reduction
Frequency factor (A) | proportionality constant in
Exothermic process | chemical reaction or the Arrhenius equation, related to the relative number Halide | compound containing an anion of a group 17
physical change that releases heat of collisions having an orientation capable of leading element in the 1− oxidation state (fluoride, F−;
to product formation chloride, Cl−; bromide, Br−; and iodide, I−)
Expansion work (pressure-volume work) |
work done as a system expands or contracts against Functional group | part of an organic molecule Hall–Héroult cell | electrolysis apparatus used to
external pressure that imparts a specific chemical reactivity to the isolate pure aluminum metal from a solution of
molecule alumina in molten cryolite
Extensive property | property of a substance that
depends on the amount of the substance Fundamental unit of charge | (also called the Halogen | element in group 17
elementary charge) equals the magnitude of the charge Heat (q) | transfer of thermal energy between two
External beam radiation therapy | radiation
of an electron (e) with e = 1.602 × 10−19 C bodies
delivered by a machine outside the body
f orbital | multilobed region of space with high Fusion | combination of very light nuclei into heavier Heat capacity (C) | extensive property of a body of
electron density, describes orbitals with l = 3. An nuclei, accompanied by the conversion of mass into matter that represents the quantity of heat required to
electron in this orbital is called an f electron large amounts of energy increase its temperature by 1 degree Celsius (or 1
Fusion reactor | nuclear reactor in which fusion kelvin)
f-block element | (also, inner transition element)
reactions of light nuclei are controlled Heisenberg uncertainty principle | rule stating
one of the elements with atomic numbers 58–71 or 90–
103 that have valence electrons in f orbitals; they are Galvanic cell | electrochemical cell that involves a that it is impossible to exactly determine both certain
frequently shown offset below the periodic table spontaneous oxidation-reduction reaction; conjugate dynamical properties such as the momentum
electrochemical cells with positive cell potentials; also and the position of a particle at the same time. The
Face-centered cubic (FCC) solid | crystalline uncertainty principle is a consequence of quantum
structure consisting of a cubic unit cell with lattice called a voltaic cell
particles exhibiting wave–particle duality
points on the corners and in the center of each face Galvanized iron | method for protecting iron by
covering it with zinc, which will oxidize before the Hemolysis | rupture of red blood cells due to the
Face-centered cubic unit cell | simplest accumulation of excess water by osmosis
repeating unit of a face-centered cubic crystal; it is a iron; zinc-plated iron
cube containing lattice points at each corner and in the Gamma (γ) emission | decay of an excited-state Henderson-Hasselbalch equation | equation
center of each face nuclide accompanied by emission of a gamma ray used to calculate the pH of buffer solutions
Fahrenheit | unit of temperature; water freezes at 32 Gamma ray | (γ or ) short wavelength, high-
0
γ
Henry’s law | law stating the proportional
relationship between the concentration of dissolved
0
°F and boils at 212 °F on this scale energy electromagnetic radiation that exhibits wave-
gas in a solution and the partial pressure of the gas in
Faraday’s constant (F) | charge on 1 mol of particle duality
contact with the solution
electrons; F = 96,485 C/mol e− Gas | state in which matter has neither definite
volume nor shape
Hertz (Hz) | the unit of frequency, which is the
First law of thermodynamics | internal energy number of cycles per second, s−1
of a system changes due to heat flow in or out of the Geiger counter | instrument that detects and
system or work done on or by the system measures radiation via the ionization produced in a
Hess’s law | if a process can be represented as the
sum of several steps, the enthalpy change of the
First transition series | transition elements in the Geiger-Müller tube
process equals the sum of the enthalpy changes of the
fourth period of the periodic table (first row of the d- Gel | colloidal dispersion of a liquid in a solid steps
block), atomic numbers 21–29
4 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Heterogeneous catalyst | catalyst present in a Immiscible | of negligible mutual solubility; Ionic compound | compound composed of cations
different phase from the reactants, furnishing a surface typically refers to liquid substances and anions combined in ratios, yielding an electrically
at which a reaction can occur neutral substance
Indicator | substance added to the sample in a
Heterogeneous equilibria | equilibria between titration analysis to permit visual detection of the end Ionic solid | solid composed of positive and negative
reactants and products in different phases point ions held together by strong electrostatic attractions
Heterogeneous mixture | combination of Induced dipole | temporary dipole formed when Ionization energy | energy required to remove an
substances with a composition that varies from point to the electrons of an atom or molecule are distorted by electron from a gaseous atom or ion. The associated
point the instantaneous dipole of a neighboring atom or number (e.g., second ionization energy) corresponds to
molecule the charge of the ion produced (X2+)
Hexagonal closest packing (HCP) | crystalline
structure in which close packed layers of atoms or ions Inert electrode | electrode that allows current to Ionization isomer | (or coordination isomer)
are stacked as a series of two alternating layers of flow, but that does not otherwise participate in the isomer in which an anionic ligand is replaced by the
different relative orientations (AB) oxidation-reduction reaction in an electrochemical cell; counter ion in the inner coordination sphere
the mass of an inert electrode does not change during
High-spin complex | complex in which the the oxidation-reduction reaction; inert electrodes are Ionizing radiation | radiation that can cause a
electrons maximize the total electron spin by singly often made of platinum or gold because these metals molecule to lose an electron and form an ion
populating all of the orbitals before pairing two are chemically unreactive.
electrons into the lower-energy orbitals
Isoelectronic | group of ions or atoms that have
identical electron configurations
Inert gas | (also, noble gas) element in group 18
Hole | (also, interstice) space between atoms within a
crystal Inert pair effect | tendency of heavy atoms to form Isomers | compounds with the same chemical
formula but different structures
ions in which their valence s electrons are not lost
Homogeneous catalyst | catalyst present in the
same phase as the reactants Initial rate | instantaneous rate of a chemical Isomorphous | possessing the same crystalline
reaction at t = 0 s (immediately after the reaction has structure
Homogeneous equilibria | equilibria within a begun)
single phase
Isotonic | of equal osmotic pressure
Inner transition metal | (also, lanthanide or Isotopes | atoms that contain the same number of
Homogeneous mixture | (also, solution) actinide) element in the bottom two rows; if in the first
combination of substances with a composition that is protons but different numbers of neutrons
row, also called lanthanide, or if in the second row,
uniform throughout Joule (J) | SI unit of energy; 1 joule is the kinetic
also called actinide
energy of an object with a mass of 2 kilograms moving
Hund’s rule | every orbital in a subshell is singly Instantaneous dipole | temporary dipole that with a velocity of 1 meter per second, 1 J = 1 kg m2/s
occupied with one electron before any one orbital is occurs for a brief moment in time when the electrons and 4.184 J = 1 cal
doubly occupied, and all electrons in singly occupied of an atom or molecule are distributed asymmetrically
orbitals have the same spin Kc | equilibrium constant for reactions based on
Instantaneous rate | rate of a chemical reaction at concentrations of reactants and products
Hydrocarbon | compound composed only of any instant in time, determined by the slope of the line
hydrogen and carbon; the major component of fossil Kelvin (K) | SI unit of temperature; 273.15 K = 0 ºC
tangential to a graph of concentration as a function of
fuels
time Kilogram (kg) | standard SI unit of mass; 1 kg =
Hydrogen bonding | occurs when exceptionally Integrated rate law | equation that relates the approximately 2.2 pounds
strong dipoles attract; bonding that exists when
concentration of a reactant to elapsed time of reaction Kinetic energy | energy of a moving body, in
hydrogen is bonded to one of the three most
electronegative elements: F, O, or N Intensity | property of wave-propagated energy joules, equal to
1
mv
2
(where m = mass and v =
related to the amplitude of the wave, such as 2
Hydrogen carbonate | salt of carbonic acid, brightness of light or loudness of sound velocity)
H2CO3 (containing the anion HCO ) in which one
−
3
hydrogen atom has been replaced; an acid carbonate; Intensive property | property of a substance that is KP | equilibrium constant for gas-phase reactions
independent of the amount of the substance based on partial pressures of reactants and products
also known as bicarbonate ion
Hydrogen halide | binary compound formed Interference pattern | pattern typically consisting Lanthanide | inner transition metal in the top of the
of alternating bright and dark fringes; it results from bottom two rows of the periodic table
between hydrogen and the halogens: HF, HCl, HBr,
and HI constructive and destructive interference of waves Lanthanide series | (also, lanthanoid series)
Interhalogen | compound formed from two or more lanthanum and the elements in the first row or the f-
Hydrogen sulfate | HSO ion −
4
different halogens block, atomic numbers 57–71
Hydrogen sulfite | HSO ion −
5 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Law of multiple proportions | when two Mass-energy equivalence equation | Albert Molecular structure | arrangement of atoms in a
elements react to form more than one compound, a Einstein’s relationship showing that mass and energy molecule or ion
fixed mass of one element will react with masses of are equivalent
the other element in a ratio of small whole numbers
Molecular structure | structure that includes only
Mass-volume percent | ratio of solute mass to the placement of the atoms in the molecule
Le Chatelier's principle | when a chemical solution volume, expressed as a percentage
system at equilibrium is disturbed, it returns to Molecule | bonded collection of two or more atoms
equilibrium by counteracting the disturbance Matter | anything that occupies space and has mass of the same or different elements
Length | measure of one dimension of an object Melting | change from a solid state to a liquid state Monatomic ion | ion composed of a single atom
Leveling effect of water | any acid stronger than Melting point | temperature at which the solid and Monodentate | ligand that attaches to a central
H O
+
, or any base stronger than OH− will react with liquid phases of a substance are in equilibrium; see metal through just one coordinate covalent bond
3
also freezing point
water to form H O , or OH−, respectively; water acts
3
+
Monoprotic acid | acid containing one ionizable
as a base to make all strong acids appear equally Metal | element that is shiny, malleable, good hydrogen atom per molecule
strong, and it acts as an acid to make all strong bases conductor of heat and electricity
Multiple equilibrium | system characterized by
appear equally strong Metal (representative) | atoms of the metallic more than one state of balance between a slightly
Lewis structure | diagram showing lone pairs and elements of groups 1, 2, 12, 13, 14, 15, and 16, which soluble ionic solid and an aqueous solution of ions
bonding pairs of electrons in a molecule or an ion form ionic compounds by losing electrons from their working simultaneously
outer s or p orbitals
Lewis symbol | symbol for an element or Nernst equation | equation that relates the
monatomic ion that uses a dot to represent each Metallic solid | solid composed of metal atoms logarithm of the reaction quotient (Q) to nonstandard
valence electron in the element or ion cell potentials; can be used to relate equilibrium
Metalloid | element that conducts heat and constants to standard cell potentials
Ligand | ion or neutral molecule attached to the electricity moderately well, and possesses some
central metal ion in a coordination compound properties of metals and some properties of nonmetals Net ionic equation | chemical equation in which
only those dissolved ionic reactants and products that
Limiting reactant | reactant present in an amount Metalloid | element that has properties that are undergo a chemical or physical change are represented
lower than required by the reaction stoichiometry, thus between those of metals and nonmetals; these elements (excludes spectator ions)
limiting the amount of product generated are typically semiconductors
Neutral | describes a solution in which [H3O+] =
Line spectrum | electromagnetic radiation emitted Meter (m) | standard metric and SI unit of length; 1 [OH−]
at discrete wavelengths by a specific atom (or atoms) m = approximately 1.094 yards
in an excited state Neutron | uncharged, subatomic particle located in
Method of initial rates | use of a more explicit the nucleus
Linear | shape in which two outside groups are algebraic method to determine the orders in a rate law
placed on opposite sides of a central atom Nitrate | NO ion; salt of nitric acid
−
Linkage isomer | coordination compound that much too small to be sensed directly Nitrogen fixation | formation of nitrogen
possesses a ligand that can bind to the transition metal Microstate (W) | possible configuration or compounds from molecular nitrogen
in two different ways (CN− vs. NC−) arrangement of matter and energy within a system Noble gas | (also, inert gas) element in group 18
Liquid | state of matter that has a definite volume but Millicurie (mCi) | larger unit for rate of radioactive Node | any point of a standing wave with zero
indefinite shape decay frequently used in medicine; 1 Ci = 3.7 × 1010 amplitude
Liter (L) | (also, cubic decimeter) unit of volume; 1 disintegrations/s
L = 1,000 cm 3 Node | plane separating different lobes of orbitals,
Milliliter (mL) | 1/1,000 of a liter; equal to 1 cm3 where the probability of finding an electron is zero
Lone pair | two (a pair of) valence electrons that are Miscible | mutually soluble in all proportions; Nomenclature | system of rules for naming objects
not used to form a covalent bond typically refers to liquid substances of interest
Low-spin complex | complex in which the Mixture | matter that can be separated into its
electrons minimize the total electron spin by pairing in
Nonelectrolyte | substance that does not produce
components by physical means ions when dissolved in water
the lower-energy orbitals before populating the higher-
energy orbitals Molality (m) | a concentration unit defined as the Nonionizing radiation | radiation that speeds up
ratio of the numbers of moles of solute to the mass of the movement of atoms and molecules; it is equivalent
Macroscopic domain | realm of everyday things the solvent in kilograms to heating a sample, but is not energetic enough to
that are large enough to sense directly by human sight
Molar mass | mass in grams of 1 mole of a cause the ionization of molecules
and touch
substance Nonmetal | element that appears dull, poor
Magic number | nuclei with specific numbers of conductor of heat and electricity
nucleons that are within the band of stability Molar solubility | solubility of a compound
expressed in units of moles per liter (mol/L) Nonspontaneous process | process that requires
Magnetic quantum number (ml) | quantum
Molarity (M) | unit of concentration, defined as the continual input of energy from an external source
number signifying the orientation of an atomic orbital
around the nucleus; orbitals having different values of number of moles of solute dissolved in 1 liter of Normal boiling point | temperature at which a
ml but the same subshell value of l have the same solution liquid’s vapor pressure equals 1 atm (760 torr)
energy (are degenerate), but this degeneracy can be
removed by application of an external magnetic field
Mole | amount of substance containing the same Nuclear binding energy | energy lost when an
number of atoms, molecules, ions, or other entities as atom’s nucleons are bound together (or the energy
Main-group element | (also, representative the number of atoms in exactly 12 grams of 12C needed to break a nucleus into its constituent protons
element) element in columns 1, 2, and 12–18 and neutrons)
Molecular compound | (also, covalent
Manometer | device used to measure the pressure compound) composed of molecules formed by atoms Nuclear chemistry | study of the structure of
of a gas trapped in a container of two or more different elements atomic nuclei and processes that change nuclear
Molecular equation | chemical equation in which structure
Mass | fundamental property indicating amount of
matter all reactants and products are represented as neutral Nuclear fuel | fissionable isotope present in
substances sufficient quantities to provide a self-sustaining chain
Mass defect | difference between the mass of an reaction in a nuclear reactor
atom and the summed mass of its constituent Molecular formula | formula indicating the
subatomic particles (or the mass “lost” when nucleons composition of a molecule of a compound and giving Nuclear moderator | substance that slows
are brought together to form a nucleus) the actual number of atoms of each element in a neutrons to a speed low enough to cause fission
molecule of the compound.
Mass number (A) | sum of the numbers of Nuclear reaction | change to a nucleus resulting in
neutrons and protons in the nucleus of an atom Molecular solid | solid composed of neutral changes in the atomic number, mass number, or energy
molecules held together by intermolecular forces of state
Mass percentage | ratio of solute-to-solution mass attraction
expressed as a percentage
6 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Nuclear reactor | environment that produces Pairing energy (P) | energy required to place two Platinum metals | group of six transition metals
energy via nuclear fission in which the chain reaction electrons with opposite spins into a single orbital consisting of ruthenium, osmium, rhodium, iridium,
is controlled and sustained without explosion palladium, and platinum that tend to occur in the same
Parent nuclide | unstable nuclide that changes minerals and demonstrate similar chemical properties
Nuclear transmutation | conversion of one spontaneously into another (daughter) nuclide
nuclide into another nuclide Pnictogen | element in group 15
Partially miscible | of moderate mutual solubility;
Nucleon | collective term for protons and neutrons in typically refers to liquid substances POH | logarithmic measure of the concentration of
a nucleus hydroxide ions in a solution
Particle accelerator | device that uses electric and
Nucleus | massive, positively charged center of an magnetic fields to increase the kinetic energy of nuclei Polar covalent bond | covalent bond between
atom made up of protons and neutrons used in transmutation reactions atoms of different electronegativities; a covalent bond
with a positive end and a negative end
Nuclide | nucleus of a particular isotope Parts per billion (ppb) | ratio of solute-to-
solution mass multiplied by 109 Polar molecule | (also, dipole) molecule with an
Nutritional calorie (Calorie) | unit used for overall dipole moment
quantifying energy provided by digestion of foods, Parts per million (ppm) | ratio of solute-to-
defined as 1000 cal or 1 kcal solution mass multiplied by 106 Polarizability | measure of the ability of a charge to
distort a molecule’s charge distribution (electron
Octahedral | shape in which six outside groups are Pascal (Pa) | SI unit of pressure; 1 Pa = 1 N/m2
cloud)
placed around a central atom such that a three-
dimensional shape is generated with four groups Passivation | metals with a protective nonreactive Polyatomic ion | ion composed of more than one
forming a square and the other two forming the apex film of oxide or other compound that creates a barrier atom
of two pyramids, one above and one below the square for chemical reactions; physical or chemical removal
plane of the passivating film allows the metals to Polydentate ligand | ligand that is attached to a
demonstrate their expected chemical reactivity central metal ion by bonds from two or more donor
Octahedral hole | open space in a crystal at the atoms, named with prefixes specifying how many
center of six particles located at the corners of an
Pauli exclusion principle | specifies that no two donors are present (e.g., hexadentate = six coordinate
electrons in an atom can have the same value for all
octahedron bonds formed)
four quantum numbers
Octet rule | guideline that states main group atoms Polymorph | variation in crystalline structure that
will form structures in which eight valence electrons Percent composition | percentage by mass of the results in different physical properties for the resulting
interact with each nucleus, counting bonding electrons various elements in a compound compound
as interacting with both atoms connected by the bond Percent ionization | ratio of the concentration of Position of equilibrium | concentrations or partial
the ionized acid to the initial acid concentration, times
Optical isomer | (also, enantiomer) molecule that is pressures of components of a reaction at equilibrium
100
a nonsuperimposable mirror image with identical (commonly used to describe conditions before a
chemical and physical properties, except when it reacts Percent yield | measure of the efficiency of a disturbance)
with other optical isomers reaction, expressed as a percentage of the theoretical
yield Positron ( 0
β or 0
) | antiparticle to the
e
Orbital diagram | pictorial representation of the
+1 +1
2 common in the US
Ostwald process | industrial process used to PH | logarithmic measure of the concentration of
convert ammonia into nitric acid
Precision | how closely a measurement matches the
hydronium ions in a solution same measurement when repeated
Overall reaction order | sum of the reaction Phase diagram | pressure-temperature graph
orders for each substance represented in the rate law
Pressure | force exerted per unit area
summarizing conditions under which the phases of a
Overlap | coexistence of orbitals from two different substance can exist Principal quantum number (n) | quantum
number specifying the shell an electron occupies in an
atoms sharing the same region of space, leading to the Photon | smallest possible packet of electromagnetic atom
formation of a covalent bond radiation, a particle of light
Oxidation half-reaction | the “half” of an Product | substance formed by a chemical or
Photosynthesis | process whereby light energy physical change; shown on the right side of the arrow
oxidation-reduction reaction involving oxidation; the promotes the reaction of water and carbon dioxide to in a chemical equation
half-reaction in which electrons appear as products; form carbohydrates and oxygen; this allows
balanced when each atom type, as well as the charge, photosynthetic organisms to store energy Proton | positively charged, subatomic particle
is balanced located in the nucleus
Physical change | change in the state or properties
Oxide | binary compound of oxygen with another of matter that does not involve a change in its chemical Pure covalent bond | (also, nonpolar covalent
element or group, typically containing O2− ions or the composition bond) covalent bond between atoms of identical
group –O– or =O electronegativities
Physical property | characteristic of matter that is
Oxyacid | compound that contains hydrogen, not associated with any change in its chemical Pure substance | homogeneous substance that has
oxygen, and one other element, bonded in a way that a constant composition
composition
imparts acidic properties to the compound (ability to
release H+ ions when dissolved in water) Pi bond (π bond) | covalent bond formed by side- Quantitative analysis | the determination of the
by-side overlap of atomic orbitals; the electron density amount or concentration of a substance in a sample
Oxyacid | compound containing a nonmetal and one is found on opposite sides of the internuclear axis
or more hydroxyl groups Quantization | occurring only in specific discrete
Pidgeon process | chemical reduction process used values, not continuous
Oxyanion | polyatomic anion composed of a central to produce magnesium through the thermal reaction of
atom bonded to oxygen atoms Quantum mechanics | field of study that includes
magnesium oxide with silicon quantization of energy, wave-particle duality, and the
Ozone | allotrope of oxygen; O3 Plasma | gaseous state of matter containing a large Heisenberg uncertainty principle to describe matter
p orbital | dumbbell-shaped region of space with number of electrically charged atoms and/or molecules Quantum number | integer number having only
high electron density, describes orbitals with l = 1. An specific allowed values and used to characterize the
electron in this orbital is called a p electron arrangement of electrons in an atom
7 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Radiation absorbed dose (rad) | SI unit for Reduction half-reaction | the “half” of an Series | (also, period) horizontal row of the period
measuring radiation dose, frequently used in medical oxidation-reduction reaction involving reduction; the table
applications; 1 rad = 0.01 Gy half-reaction in which electrons appear as reactants;
balanced when each atom type, as well as the charge,
Shell | set of orbitals with the same principal quantum
Radiation dosimeter | device that measures is balanced
number, n
ionizing radiation and is used to determine personal
radiation exposure Relative biological effectiveness (RBE) | SI units (International System of Units) |
measure of the relative damage done by radiation standards fixed by international agreement in the
Radiation therapy | use of high-energy radiation International System of Units (Le Système
to damage the DNA of cancer cells, which kills them Representative element | (also, main-group International d’Unités)
or keeps them from dividing element) element in columns 1, 2, and 12–18
Sievert (Sv) | SI unit measuring tissue damage
Radioactive decay | spontaneous decay of an Representative element | element where the s caused by radiation; takes into account energy and
unstable nuclide into another nuclide and p orbitals are filling biological effects of radiation
Radioactive decay series | chains of successive Representative metal | metal among the Sigma bond (σ bond) | covalent bond formed by
disintegrations (radioactive decays) that ultimately representative elements overlap of atomic orbitals along the internuclear axis
lead to a stable end-product
Resonance | situation in which one Lewis structure Significant figures | (also, significant digits) all of
Radioactive tracer | (also, radioactive label) is insufficient to describe the bonding in a molecule the measured digits in a determination, including the
radioisotope used to track or follow a substance by and the average of multiple structures is observed uncertain last digit
monitoring its radioactive emissions
Resonance forms | two or more Lewis structures Silicate | compound containing silicon-oxygen
Radioactivity | phenomenon exhibited by an that have the same arrangement of atoms but different bonds, with silicate tetrahedra connected in rings,
unstable nucleon that spontaneously undergoes change arrangements of electrons sheets, or three-dimensional networks, depending on
into a nucleon that is more stable; an unstable nucleon the other elements involved in the formation of the
is said to be radioactive
Resonance hybrid | average of the resonance compounds
forms shown by the individual Lewis structures
Radiocarbon dating | highly accurate means of Simple cubic structure | crystalline structure with
Reversible process | process that takes place so a cubic unit cell with lattice points only at the corners
dating objects 30,000–50,000 years old that were
slowly as to be capable of reversing direction in
derived from once-living matter; achieved by
response to an infinitesimally small change in Simple cubic unit cell | (also, primitive cubic unit
calculating the ratio of C : C in the object vs. the
14 12
6 6
conditions; hypothetical construct that can only be cell) unit cell in the simple cubic structure
ratio of C : C in the present-day atmosphere
14 12
approximated by real processes removed
Single bond | bond in which a single pair of
6 6
Radioisotope | isotope that is unstable and Reversible reaction | chemical reaction that can electrons is shared between two atoms
undergoes conversion into a different, more stable proceed in both the forward and reverse directions
isotope under given conditions
Skeletal structure | shorthand method of drawing
organic molecules in which carbon atoms are
Radiometric dating | use of radioisotopes and Roentgen equivalent man (rem) | unit for represented by the ends of lines and bends in between
their properties to date the formation of objects such as radiation damage, frequently used in medicine; 1 rem lines, and hydrogen atoms attached to the carbon
archeological artifacts, formerly living organisms, or = 1 Sv atoms are not shown (but are understood to be present
geological formations by the context of the structure)
Rounding | procedure used to ensure that calculated
Raoult’s law | the partial pressure exerted by a results properly reflect the uncertainty in the Smelting | process of extracting a pure metal from a
solution component is equal to the product of the measurements used in the calculation molten ore
component’s mole fraction in the solution and its
equilibrium vapor pressure in the pure state s orbital | spherical region of space with high Solid | state of matter that is rigid, has a definite
electron density, describes orbitals with l = 0. An shape, and has a fairly constant volume
Rare earth element | collection of 17 elements electron in this orbital is called an s electron
including the lanthanides, scandium, and yttrium that Solubility | extent to which a solute may be
often occur together and have similar chemical Sacrificial anode | more active, inexpensive metal dissolved in water, or any solvent
properties, making separation difficult used as the anode in cathodic protection; frequently
made from magnesium or zinc
Solubility product (Ksp) | equilibrium constant
Rate constant (k) | proportionality constant in the for the dissolution of a slightly soluble electrolyte
relationship between reaction rate and concentrations Saturated | of concentration equal to solubility;
containing the maximum concentration of solute Solute | solution component present in a
of reactants concentration less than that of the solvent
possible for a given temperature and pressure
Rate expression | mathematical representation Solvation | exothermic process in which
relating reaction rate to changes in amount, Saturated hydrocarbon | molecule containing
intermolecular attractive forces between the solute and
concentration, or pressure of reactant or product carbon and hydrogen that has only single bonds
solvent in a solution are established
species per unit time between carbon atoms
Scientific method | path of discovery that leads Solvent | solution component present in a
Rate law | (also, rate equation) mathematical concentration that is higher relative to other
equation showing the dependence of reaction rate on from question and observation to law or hypothesis to
theory, combined with experimental verification of the components
the rate constant and the concentration of one or more
reactants hypothesis and any necessary modification of the Space lattice | all points within a crystal that have
theory identical environments
Rate of reaction | measure of the speed at which a
chemical reaction takes place Scintillation counter | instrument that uses a Spatial isomers | compounds in which the relative
scintillator—a material that emits light when excited orientations of the atoms in space differ
Reactant | substance undergoing a chemical or by ionizing radiation—to detect and measure radiation
physical change; shown on the left side of the arrow in Specific heat capacity (c) | intensive property of
a chemical equation Second (s) | SI unit of time a substance that represents the quantity of heat
Second law of thermodynamics | entropy of the required to raise the temperature of 1 gram of the
Reaction order | value of an exponent in a rate law, substance by 1 degree Celsius (or 1 kelvin)
expressed as an ordinal number (for example, zero universe increases for a spontaneous process
order for 0, first order for 1, second order for 2, and so Second transition series | transition elements in Spectator ion | ion that does not undergo a
on) chemical or physical change during a reaction, but its
the fifth period of the periodic table (second row of the
presence is required to maintain charge neutrality
Reaction quotient (Q) | ratio of the product of d-block), atomic numbers 39–47
molar concentrations (or pressures) of the products to Selective precipitation | process in which ions are Spectrochemical series | ranking of ligands
that of the reactants, each concentration (or pressure) separated using differences in their solubility with a according to the magnitude of the crystal field splitting
being raised to the power equal to the coefficient in the given precipitating reagent they induce
equation Spin quantum number (ms) | number specifying
Semipermeable membrane | a membrane that
Reactor coolant | assembly used to carry the heat selectively permits passage of certain ions or the electron spin direction, either +
1
or −
1
8 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Spontaneous change | process that takes place Strong electrolyte | substance that dissociates or Thermal energy | kinetic energy associated with
without a continuous input of energy from an external ionizes completely when dissolved in water the random motion of atoms and molecules
source
Strong nuclear force | force of attraction between Thermochemistry | study of measuring the
Spontaneous process | physical or chemical nucleons that holds a nucleus together amount of heat absorbed or released during a chemical
change that occurs without the addition of energy from reaction or a physical change
an external source Strong-field ligand | ligand that causes larger
crystal field splittings Third law of thermodynamics | entropy of a
Standard cell potential (E
∘
cell
) | the cell Structural formula | shows the atoms in a
perfect crystal at absolute zero (0 K) is zero
potential when all reactants and products are in their molecule and how they are connected Third transition series | transition elements in
standard states (1 bar or 1 atm or gases; 1 M for the sixth period of the periodic table (third row of the
solutes), usually at 298.15 K; can be calculated by Structural isomer | one of two substances that d-block), atomic numbers 57 and 72–79
subtracting the standard reduction potential for the have the same molecular formula but different physical
half-reaction at the anode from the standard reduction and chemical properties because their atoms are Titrant | solution containing a known concentration
potential for the half-reaction occurring at the cathode bonded differently of substance that will react with the analyte in a
titration analysis
Standard enthalpy of combustion ( ∘
ΔHc ) | Subcritical mass | amount of fissionable material
heat released when one mole of a compound that cannot sustain a chain reaction; less than a critical Titration analysis | quantitative chemical analysis
undergoes complete combustion under standard mass method that involves measuring the volume of a
conditions reactant solution required to completely react with the
Sublimation | change from solid state directly to analyte in a sample
gaseous state
Standard enthalpy of formation (ΔH ) | ∘
f Titration curve | plot of the pH of a solution of
enthalpy change of a chemical reaction in which 1 Subshell | set of orbitals in an atom with the same acid or base versus the volume of base or acid added
mole of a pure substance is formed from its elements values of n and l during a titration
in their most stable states under standard state
Substituent | branch or functional group that
conditions Torr | unit of pressure; 1 torr =
1
replaces hydrogen atoms in a larger hydrocarbon chain atm
760
Standard entropy (S°) | entropy for a substance
at 1 bar pressure; tabulated values are usually
Substitution reaction | reaction in which one trans configuration | configuration of a
atom replaces another in a molecule geometrical isomer in which two similar groups are on
determined at 298.15 K and denoted S ∘
298
Sulfate | SO 2−
ion opposite sides of an imaginary reference line on the
Standard entropy change (ΔS°) | change in 4
molecule
entropy for a reaction calculated using the standard Sulfite | SO 2−
ion
entropies, usually at room temperature and denoted
3
Transition metal | element in columns 3–11
ΔS
∘
298
Superconductor | material that conducts electricity Transmutation reaction | bombardment of one
with no resistance type of nuclei with other nuclei or neutrons
Standard free energy change (ΔG°) | change
in free energy for a process occurring under standard Supercritical fluid | substance at a temperature Transuranium element | element with an atomic
conditions (1 bar pressure for gases, 1 M concentration and pressure higher than its critical point; exhibits
number greater than 92; these elements do not occur in
for solutions) properties intermediate between those of gaseous and
nature
liquid states
Standard free energy of formation (ΔG ∘
) | Trigonal bipyramidal | shape in which five
f
Supercritical mass | amount of material in which outside groups are placed around a central atom such
change in free energy accompanying the formation of there is an increasing rate of fission
one mole of substance from its elements in their that three form a flat triangle with 120° angles between
standard states Superoxide | oxide containing the anion O −
each pair and the central atom, and the other two form
2
the apex of two pyramids, one above and one below
Standard hydrogen electrode (SHE) | the Supersaturated | of concentration that exceeds the triangular plane
electrode consists of hydrogen gas bubbling through solubility; a nonequilibrium state
hydrochloric acid over an inert platinum electrode Trigonal planar | shape in which three outside
whose reduction at standard conditions is assigned a Surface tension | energy required to increase the groups are placed in a flat triangle around a central
value of 0 V; the reference point for standard reduction area, or length, of a liquid surface by a given amount atom with 120° angles between each pair and the
potentials central atom
Surroundings | all matter other than the system
Standard reduction potential (E°) | the value being studied Triple bond | bond in which three pairs of electrons
of the reduction under standard conditions (1 bar or 1 are shared between two atoms
Symbolic domain | specialized language used to
atm for gases; 1 M for solutes) usually at 298.15 K; represent components of the macroscopic and Triple point | temperature and pressure at which the
tabulated values used to calculate standard cell microscopic domains, such as chemical symbols, vapor, liquid, and solid phases of a substance are in
potentials chemical formulas, chemical equations, graphs, equilibrium
Standard state | set of physical conditions as drawings, and calculations
Triprotic acid | acid that contains three ionizable
accepted as common reference conditions for reporting System | portion of matter undergoing a chemical or hydrogen atoms per molecule; ionization of triprotic
thermodynamic properties; 1 bar of pressure, and physical change being studied acids occurs in three steps
solutions at 1 molar concentrations, usually at a
temperature of 298.15 K t2g orbitals | set of three d orbitals aligned between Tyndall effect | scattering of visible light by a
the Cartesian axes for coordination complexes; in colloidal dispersion
Standing wave | (also, stationary wave) localized octahedral complexes, they are lowered in energy
wave phenomenon characterized by discrete compared to the eg orbitals according to CFT Uncertainty | estimate of amount by which
wavelengths determined by the boundary conditions measurement differs from true value
used to generate the waves; standing waves are Temperature | intensive property of matter that is a
inherently quantized quantitative measure of “hotness” and “coldness” Unified atomic mass unit (u) | alternative unit
equivalent to the atomic mass unit
State function | property depending only on the Tetrahedral | shape in which four outside groups
state of a system, and not the path taken to reach that are placed around a central atom such that a three- Unit | standard of comparison for measurements
state dimensional shape is generated with four corners and Unit cell | smallest portion of a space lattice that is
109.5° angles between each pair and the central atom repeated in three dimensions to form the entire lattice
Steel | material made from iron by removing
impurities in the iron and adding substances that Tetrahedral hole | tetrahedral space formed by Unit conversion factor | ratio of equivalent
produce alloys with properties suitable for specific four atoms or ions in a crystal quantities expressed with different units; used to
uses convert from one unit to a different unit
Theoretical yield | amount of product that may be
Stepwise ionization | process in which an acid is produced from a given amount of reactant(s) according Unsaturated | of concentration less than solubility
ionized by losing protons sequentially to the reaction stoichiometry
Vacancy | defect that occurs when a position that
Stress | change to a reaction's conditions that may Theory | well-substantiated, comprehensive, testable should contain an atom or ion is vacant
cause a shift in the equilibrium explanation of a particular aspect of nature
9 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Valence bond theory | description of bonding that Van’t Hoff factor (i) | the ratio of the number of Wavefunction (ψ) | mathematical description of an
involves atomic orbitals overlapping to form σ or π moles of particles in a solution to the number of moles atomic orbital that describes the shape of the orbital; it
bonds, within which pairs of electrons are shared of formula units dissolved in the solution can be used to calculate the probability of finding the
electron at any given location in the orbital, as well as
Valence electrons | electrons in the outermost or Vapor pressure | (also, equilibrium vapor pressure) dynamical variables such as the energy and the angular
valence shell (highest value of n) of a ground-state pressure exerted by a vapor in equilibrium with a solid
momentum
atom; determine how an element reacts or a liquid at a given temperature
Wavelength (λ) | distance between two consecutive
Valence shell | outermost shell of electrons in a Vaporization | change from liquid state to gaseous peaks or troughs in a wave
ground-state atom; for main group elements, the state
orbitals with the highest n level (s and p subshells) are Weak electrolyte | substance that ionizes only
in the valence shell, while for transition metals, the
Vector | quantity having magnitude and direction partially when dissolved in water
highest energy s and d subshells make up the valence Viscosity | measure of a liquid’s resistance to flow
shell and for inner transition elements, the highest s, d,
Weak-field ligand | ligand that causes small
Voltaic cell | another name for a galvanic cell crystal field splittings
and f subshells are included
Valence shell electron-pair repulsion theory Volume | amount of space occupied by an object Weight | force that gravity exerts on an object
(VSEPR) | theory used to predict the bond angles in Volume percentage | ratio of solute-to-solution Work (w) | energy transfer due to changes in
a molecule based on positioning regions of high external, macroscopic variables such as pressure and
volume expressed as a percentage
electron density as far apart as possible to minimize volume; or causing matter to move against an
electrostatic repulsion Wave | oscillation that can transport energy from one opposing force
point to another in space
Van der Waals equation | modified version of X-ray crystallography | experimental technique
the ideal gas equation containing additional terms to Wave-particle duality | term used to describe the for determining distances between atoms in a crystal
account for non-ideal gas behavior fact that elementary particles including matter exhibit by measuring the angles at which X-rays are diffracted
properties of both particles (including localized when passing through the crystal
Van der Waals force | attractive or repulsive force position, momentum) and waves (including
between molecules, including dipole-dipole, dipole-
nonlocalization, wavelength, frequency)
induced dipole, and London dispersion forces; does
not include forces due to covalent or ionic bonding, or
the attraction between ions and molecules
10 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
11 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
12 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
13 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
14 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
15 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
16 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
17 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
18 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
19 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
20 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
21 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
22 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
23 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
24 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
25 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
26 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
27 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
28 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
29 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
30 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
31 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
32 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
33 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
34 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
35 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
36 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
37 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
38 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
39 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
40 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
41 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
42 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
43 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
44 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
45 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
46 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
47 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
48 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
49 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
50 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
51 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
52 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
53 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
54 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
55 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
56 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
57 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
58 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
59 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
60 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
61 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
62 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
63 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
64 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
65 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
66 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
67 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
68 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
69 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
70 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
71 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
72 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
73 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
74 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
75 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
76 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
77 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
78 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
79 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
80 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
81 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
82 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
83 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
84 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
85 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
86 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
87 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
88 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
89 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
90 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
91 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
92 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
93 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
94 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
95 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
96 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
97 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
98 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
99 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
100 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
101 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
102 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
103 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
104 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
105 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
106 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
107 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
108 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
109 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
110 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
111 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
112 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
113 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
114 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
115 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
116 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
117 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
118 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
119 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
120 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
121 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
122 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
123 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
124 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/279192
Detailed Licensing
Overview
Title: Chemistry 1e (OpenSTAX)
Webpages: 189
All licenses found:
CC BY 4.0: 95.2% (180 pages)
Undeclared: 4.8% (9 pages)
By Page
Chemistry 1e (OpenSTAX) - CC BY 4.0 4: Stoichiometry of Chemical Reactions - CC BY 4.0
Front Matter - Undeclared 4.0: Prelude to Stoichiometry - CC BY 4.0
TitlePage - Undeclared 4.1: Writing and Balancing Chemical Equations - CC
InfoPage - Undeclared BY 4.0
Table of Contents - Undeclared 4.2: Classifying Chemical Reactions - CC BY 4.0
Licensing - Undeclared 4.3: Reaction Stoichiometry - CC BY 4.0
1: Essential Ideas of Chemistry - CC BY 4.0 4.4: Reaction Yields - CC BY 4.0
4.5: Quantitative Chemical Analysis - CC BY 4.0
1.1: Chemistry in Context - CC BY 4.0
4.E: Stoichiometry of Chemical Reactions (Exercises)
1.2: Phases and Classification of Matter - CC BY 4.0
- CC BY 4.0
1.3: Physical and Chemical Properties - CC BY 4.0
1.4: Measurements - CC BY 4.0 5: Thermochemistry - CC BY 4.0
1.5: Measurement Uncertainty, Accuracy, and 5.0: Prelude to Thermochemistry - CC BY 4.0
Precision - CC BY 4.0 5.1: Energy Basics - CC BY 4.0
1.6: Mathematical Treatment of Measurement Results 5.2: Calorimetry - CC BY 4.0
- CC BY 4.0 5.3: Enthalpy - CC BY 4.0
1.E: Essential Ideas of Chemistry (Exercises) - CC 5.E: Thermochemistry (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
BY 4.0 6: Electronic Structure and Periodic Properties - CC BY
2: Atoms, Molecules, and Ions - CC BY 4.0 4.0
2.0: Prelude to Atoms - CC BY 4.0 6.1: Electromagnetic Energy - CC BY 4.0
2.1: Early Ideas in Atomic Theory - CC BY 4.0 6.2: The Bohr Model - CC BY 4.0
2.2: Evolution of Atomic Theory - CC BY 4.0 6.3: Development of Quantum Theory - CC BY 4.0
2.3: Atomic Structure and Symbolism - CC BY 4.0 6.4: Electronic Structure of Atoms (Electron
2.4: Chemical Formulas - CC BY 4.0 Configurations) - CC BY 4.0
2.5: The Periodic Table - CC BY 4.0 6.5: Periodic Variations in Element Properties - CC
2.6: Molecular and Ionic Compounds - CC BY 4.0 BY 4.0
2.7: Chemical Nomenclature - CC BY 4.0 6.E: Electronic Structure and Periodic Properties
2.E: Atoms, Molecules, and Ions (Exercises) - CC BY (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
4.0 7: Chemical Bonding and Molecular Geometry - CC BY
3: Composition of Substances and Solutions - CC BY 4.0 4.0
3.1: Formula Mass and the Mole Concept - CC BY 7.0: Prelude to Chemical Bonding and Molecular
4.0 Geometry - CC BY 4.0
3.2: Determining Empirical and Molecular Formulas 7.1: Ionic Bonding - CC BY 4.0
- CC BY 4.0 7.2: Covalent Bonding - CC BY 4.0
3.3: Molarity - CC BY 4.0 7.3: Lewis Symbols and Structures - CC BY 4.0
3.4: Other Units for Solution Concentrations - CC BY 7.4: Formal Charges and Resonance - CC BY 4.0
4.0 7.5: Strengths of Ionic and Covalent Bonds - CC BY
3.E: Composition of Substances and Solutions 4.0
(Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 7.6: Molecular Structure and Polarity - CC BY 4.0
1 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/417134
7.E: Chemical Bonding and Molecular Geometry 13.1: Chemical Equilibria - CC BY 4.0
(Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 13.2: Equilibrium Constants - CC BY 4.0
8: Advanced Theories of Covalent Bonding - CC BY 4.0 13.3: Shifting Equilibria - Le Chatelier’s Principle -
8.0: Prelude to Covalent Bonding - CC BY 4.0 CC BY 4.0
8.1: Valence Bond Theory - CC BY 4.0 13.4: Equilibrium Calculations - CC BY 4.0
8.2: Hybrid Atomic Orbitals - CC BY 4.0 13.E: Fundamental Equilibrium Concepts (Exercises)
8.3: Multiple Bonds - CC BY 4.0 - CC BY 4.0
8.4: Molecular Orbital Theory - CC BY 4.0 14: Acid-Base Equilibria - CC BY 4.0
8.E: Advanced Theories of Covalent Bonding 14.1: Brønsted-Lowry Acids and Bases - CC BY 4.0
(Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 14.2: pH and pOH - CC BY 4.0
9: Gases - CC BY 4.0 14.3: Relative Strengths of Acids and Bases - CC BY
4.0
9.1: Gas Pressure - CC BY 4.0
14.4: Hydrolysis of Salt Solutions - CC BY 4.0
9.2: Relating Pressure, Volume, Amount, and
14.5: Polyprotic Acids - CC BY 4.0
Temperature - The Ideal Gas Law - CC BY 4.0
14.6: Buffers - CC BY 4.0
9.3: Stoichiometry of Gaseous Substances, Mixtures,
14.7: Acid-Base Titrations - CC BY 4.0
and Reactions - CC BY 4.0
14.E: Acid-Base Equilibria (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
9.4: Effusion and Diffusion of Gases - CC BY 4.0
9.5: The Kinetic-Molecular Theory - CC BY 4.0 15: Equilibria of Other Reaction Classes - CC BY 4.0
9.6: Non-Ideal Gas Behavior - CC BY 4.0 15.1: Precipitation and Dissolution - CC BY 4.0
9.E: Gases (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 15.2: Lewis Acids and Bases - CC BY 4.0
10: Liquids and Solids - CC BY 4.0 15.3: Coupled Equilibria - CC BY 4.0
10.0: Prelude to Liquids and Solids - CC BY 4.0 15.E: Equilibria of Other Reaction Classes
10.1: Intermolecular Forces - CC BY 4.0 (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
10.2: Properties of Liquids - CC BY 4.0 16: Thermodynamics - CC BY 4.0
10.3: Phase Transitions - CC BY 4.0 16.1: Spontaneity - CC BY 4.0
10.4: Phase Diagrams - CC BY 4.0 16.2: Entropy - CC BY 4.0
10.5: The Solid State of Matter - CC BY 4.0 16.3: The Second and Third Laws of
10.6: Lattice Structures in Crystalline Solids - CC BY Thermodynamics - CC BY 4.0
4.0 16.4: Gibbs Energy - CC BY 4.0
10.E: Liquids and Solids (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 16.E: Thermodynamics (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
11: Solutions and Colloids - CC BY 4.0 17: Electrochemistry - CC BY 4.0
11.0: Prelude to Solutions and Colloids - CC BY 4.0 17.1: Balancing Oxidation-Reduction Reactions - CC
11.1: The Dissolution Process - CC BY 4.0 BY 4.0
11.2: Electrolytes - CC BY 4.0 17.2: Galvanic Cells - CC BY 4.0
11.3: Solubility - CC BY 4.0 17.3: Standard Reduction Potentials - CC BY 4.0
11.4: Colligative Properties - CC BY 4.0 17.4: The Nernst Equation - CC BY 4.0
11.5: Colloids - CC BY 4.0 17.5: Batteries and Fuel Cells - CC BY 4.0
11.E: Solutions and Colloids (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 17.6: Corrosion - CC BY 4.0
12: Kinetics - CC BY 4.0 17.7: Electrolysis - CC BY 4.0
12.0: Prelude to Kinetics - CC BY 4.0 17.E: Electrochemistry (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
12.1: Chemical Reaction Rates - CC BY 4.0 18: Representative Metals, Metalloids, and Nonmetals -
12.2: Factors Affecting Reaction Rates - CC BY 4.0 CC BY 4.0
12.3: Rate Laws - CC BY 4.0 18.1: Periodicity - CC BY 4.0
12.4: Integrated Rate Laws - CC BY 4.0 18.2: Occurrence and Preparation of the
12.5: Collision Theory - CC BY 4.0 Representative Metals - CC BY 4.0
12.6: Reaction Mechanisms - CC BY 4.0 18.3: Structure and General Properties of the
12.7: Catalysis - CC BY 4.0 Metalloids - CC BY 4.0
12.E: Kinetics (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 18.4: Structure and General Properties of the
13: Fundamental Equilibrium Concepts - CC BY 4.0 Nonmetals - CC BY 4.0
13.0: Prelude to Equilibrium - CC BY 4.0
2 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/417134
18.5: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of 20.3: Aldehydes, Ketones, Carboxylic Acids, and
Hydrogen - CC BY 4.0 Esters - CC BY 4.0
18.6: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of 20.4: Amines and Amides - CC BY 4.0
Carbonates - CC BY 4.0 20.E: Organic Chemistry (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
18.7: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of 21: Nuclear Chemistry - CC BY 4.0
Nitrogen - CC BY 4.0 21.1: Nuclear Structure and Stability - CC BY 4.0
18.8: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of 21.2: Nuclear Equations - CC BY 4.0
Phosphorus - CC BY 4.0 21.3: Radioactive Decay - CC BY 4.0
18.9: Occurrence, Preparation, and Compounds of 21.4: Transmutation and Nuclear Energy - CC BY 4.0
Oxygen - CC BY 4.0 21.5: Uses of Radioisotopes - CC BY 4.0
18.10: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of 21.6: Biological Effects of Radiation - CC BY 4.0
Sulfur - CC BY 4.0 21.E: Nuclear Chemistry (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
18.11: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of
Appendices - CC BY 4.0
Halogens - CC BY 4.0
18.12: Occurrence, Preparation, and Properties of the Composition of Commercial Acids and Bases - CC
Noble Gases - CC BY 4.0 BY 4.0
18.E: Representative Metals, Metalloids, and Essential Mathematics - CC BY 4.0
Nonmetals (Exercises) - CC BY 4.0 Formation Constants for Complex Ions - CC BY 4.0
Fundamental Physical Constants - CC BY 4.0
19: Transition Metals and Coordination Chemistry - CC
Ionization Constants of Weak Acids - CC BY 4.0
BY 4.0
Ionization Constants of Weak Bases - CC BY 4.0
19.1: Properties of Transition Metals and Their
Solubility Products - CC BY 4.0
Compounds - CC BY 4.0
Standard Electrode (Half-Cell) Potentials - CC BY 4.0
19.2: Coordination Chemistry of Transition Metals -
Standard Thermodynamic Properties for Selected
CC BY 4.0
Substances - CC BY 4.0
19.3: Optical and Magnetic Properties of
The Periodic Table - CC BY 4.0
Coordination Compounds - CC BY 4.0
Units and Conversion Factors - CC BY 4.0
19.E: Transition Metals and Coordination Chemistry
Water Properties - CC BY 4.0
(Exercises) - CC BY 4.0
Back Matter - Undeclared
20: Organic Chemistry - CC BY 4.0
Index - Undeclared
20.0: Prelude to Organic Chemistry - CC BY 4.0 Glossary - Undeclared
20.1: Hydrocarbons - CC BY 4.0 Detailed Licensing - Undeclared
20.2: Alcohols and Ethers - CC BY 4.0
3 https://chem.libretexts.org/@go/page/417134